From 054feab897713bba67a6c4436732234307d27a52 Mon Sep 17 00:00:00 2001
From: fshee
Date: Fri, 30 Apr 2021 02:28:21 +0000
Subject: [PATCH] Feat(*): Project init.
---
.gitignore | 1 +
LICENSE | 661 +
README | 1 +
go.mod | 8 +
go.sum | 12 +
index.html | 81 +
main.go | 253 +
makefile | 28 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/LICENSE | 21 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/README.md | 55 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/go.mod | 1 +
.../jinzhu/inflection/inflections.go | 273 +
.../github.com/jinzhu/inflection/wercker.yml | 23 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/Guardfile | 3 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/License | 21 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/README.md | 131 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/go.mod | 3 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/main.go | 194 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/now.go | 212 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/time.go | 9 +
vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/wercker.yml | 23 +
.../github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/.codecov.yml | 4 +
vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/.gitignore | 14 +
vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/LICENSE | 21 +
vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/README.md | 590 +
vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/backup.go | 85 +
.../github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/callback.go | 392 +
vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/convert.go | 299 +
vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/doc.go | 135 +
vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/error.go | 150 +
vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/go.mod | 3 +
vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/go.sum | 0
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3-binding.c | 230877 +++++++++++++++
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3-binding.h | 12275 +
vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3.go | 2157 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_context.go | 103 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_func_crypt.go | 120 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_go18.go | 70 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_libsqlite3.go | 19 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_load_extension.go | 84 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_load_extension_omit.go | 24 +
.../sqlite3_opt_allow_uri_authority.go | 15 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_app_armor.go | 16 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_foreign_keys.go | 15 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_fts5.go | 14 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_icu.go | 17 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_introspect.go | 15 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_json1.go | 13 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_preupdate.go | 20 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_preupdate_hook.go | 112 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_preupdate_omit.go | 21 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_secure_delete.go | 15 +
.../sqlite3_opt_secure_delete_fast.go | 15 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_stat4.go | 15 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_unlock_notify.c | 85 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_unlock_notify.go | 93 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_userauth.go | 289 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_userauth_omit.go | 152 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_vacuum_full.go | 15 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_vacuum_incr.go | 15 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_vtable.go | 660 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_other.go | 17 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_solaris.go | 14 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_trace.go | 287 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_type.go | 62 +
.../go-sqlite3/sqlite3_usleep_windows.go | 39 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_windows.go | 18 +
.../github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3ext.h | 664 +
.../mattn/go-sqlite3/static_mock.go | 37 +
vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/License | 21 +
vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/README.md | 17 +
vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/errors.go | 7 +
vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/go.mod | 8 +
vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/go.sum | 8 +
vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/migrator.go | 285 +
vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/sqlite.go | 180 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/.gitignore | 5 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/License | 21 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/README.md | 42 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/association.go | 513 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks.go | 327 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/associations.go | 390 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/callbacks.go | 83 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/callmethod.go | 23 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/create.go | 370 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/delete.go | 168 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/helper.go | 95 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/interfaces.go | 39 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/preload.go | 164 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/query.go | 228 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/raw.go | 16 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/row.go | 21 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/transaction.go | 31 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/update.go | 261 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/chainable_api.go | 293 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/clause.go | 88 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/delete.go | 23 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/expression.go | 344 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/from.go | 37 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/group_by.go | 48 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/insert.go | 39 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/joins.go | 47 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/limit.go | 48 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/locking.go | 31 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/on_conflict.go | 52 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/order_by.go | 54 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/returning.go | 30 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/select.go | 45 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/set.go | 60 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/update.go | 38 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/values.go | 45 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/where.go | 177 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/with.go | 4 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/errors.go | 42 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/finisher_api.go | 649 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/go.mod | 8 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/go.sum | 4 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/gorm.go | 441 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/interfaces.go | 63 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/logger/logger.go | 187 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/logger/sql.go | 133 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/migrator.go | 81 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/migrator/migrator.go | 758 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/model.go | 15 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/prepare_stmt.go | 169 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/scan.go | 251 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/check.go | 37 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/field.go | 834 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/index.go | 141 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/interfaces.go | 25 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/naming.go | 154 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/relationship.go | 616 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/schema.go | 283 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/utils.go | 197 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/soft_delete.go | 138 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/statement.go | 674 +
vendor/gorm.io/gorm/utils/utils.go | 113 +
vendor/modules.txt | 18 +
138 files changed, 263043 insertions(+)
create mode 100644 .gitignore
create mode 100644 LICENSE
create mode 100644 README
create mode 100644 go.mod
create mode 100644 go.sum
create mode 100644 index.html
create mode 100644 main.go
create mode 100644 makefile
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/LICENSE
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/README.md
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/go.mod
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/inflections.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/wercker.yml
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/Guardfile
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/License
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/README.md
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/go.mod
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/main.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/now.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/time.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/wercker.yml
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/.codecov.yml
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/.gitignore
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/LICENSE
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/README.md
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/backup.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/callback.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/convert.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/doc.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/error.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/go.mod
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/go.sum
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3-binding.c
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3-binding.h
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_context.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_func_crypt.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_go18.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_libsqlite3.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_load_extension.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_load_extension_omit.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_allow_uri_authority.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_app_armor.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_foreign_keys.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_fts5.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_icu.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_introspect.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_json1.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_preupdate.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_preupdate_hook.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_preupdate_omit.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_secure_delete.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_secure_delete_fast.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_stat4.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_unlock_notify.c
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_unlock_notify.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_userauth.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_userauth_omit.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_vacuum_full.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_vacuum_incr.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_opt_vtable.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_other.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_solaris.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_trace.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_type.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_usleep_windows.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3_windows.go
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3ext.h
create mode 100644 vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/static_mock.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/License
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/README.md
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/errors.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/go.mod
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/go.sum
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/migrator.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/driver/sqlite/sqlite.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/.gitignore
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/License
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/README.md
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/association.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/associations.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/callbacks.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/callmethod.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/create.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/delete.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/helper.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/interfaces.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/preload.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/query.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/raw.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/row.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/transaction.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/callbacks/update.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/chainable_api.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/clause.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/delete.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/expression.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/from.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/group_by.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/insert.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/joins.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/limit.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/locking.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/on_conflict.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/order_by.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/returning.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/select.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/set.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/update.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/values.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/where.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/clause/with.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/errors.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/finisher_api.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/go.mod
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/go.sum
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/gorm.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/interfaces.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/logger/logger.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/logger/sql.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/migrator.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/migrator/migrator.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/model.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/prepare_stmt.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/scan.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/check.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/field.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/index.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/interfaces.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/naming.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/relationship.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/schema.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/schema/utils.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/soft_delete.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/statement.go
create mode 100644 vendor/gorm.io/gorm/utils/utils.go
create mode 100644 vendor/modules.txt
diff --git a/.gitignore b/.gitignore
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1fcb152
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitignore
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+out
diff --git a/LICENSE b/LICENSE
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..29bcfaa
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE
@@ -0,0 +1,661 @@
+ GNU AFFERO GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+ Version 3, 19 November 2007
+
+ Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
+ of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
+
+ Preamble
+
+ The GNU Affero General Public License is a free, copyleft license for
+software and other kinds of works, specifically designed to ensure
+cooperation with the community in the case of network server software.
+
+ The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed
+to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast,
+our General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your freedom to
+share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free
+software for all its users.
+
+ When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
+price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
+have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
+them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you
+want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new
+free programs, and that you know you can do these things.
+
+ Developers that use our General Public Licenses protect your rights
+with two steps: (1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer
+you this License which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute
+and/or modify the software.
+
+ A secondary benefit of defending all users' freedom is that
+improvements made in alternate versions of the program, if they
+receive widespread use, become available for other developers to
+incorporate. Many developers of free software are heartened and
+encouraged by the resulting cooperation. However, in the case of
+software used on network servers, this result may fail to come about.
+The GNU General Public License permits making a modified version and
+letting the public access it on a server without ever releasing its
+source code to the public.
+
+ The GNU Affero General Public License is designed specifically to
+ensure that, in such cases, the modified source code becomes available
+to the community. It requires the operator of a network server to
+provide the source code of the modified version running there to the
+users of that server. Therefore, public use of a modified version, on
+a publicly accessible server, gives the public access to the source
+code of the modified version.
+
+ An older license, called the Affero General Public License and
+published by Affero, was designed to accomplish similar goals. This is
+a different license, not a version of the Affero GPL, but Affero has
+released a new version of the Affero GPL which permits relicensing under
+this license.
+
+ The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
+modification follow.
+
+ TERMS AND CONDITIONS
+
+ 0. Definitions.
+
+ "This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License.
+
+ "Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of
+works, such as semiconductor masks.
+
+ "The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this
+License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and
+"recipients" may be individuals or organizations.
+
+ To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work
+in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an
+exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the
+earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work.
+
+ A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based
+on the Program.
+
+ To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without
+permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for
+infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a
+computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying,
+distribution (with or without modification), making available to the
+public, and in some countries other activities as well.
+
+ To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other
+parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through
+a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying.
+
+ An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices"
+to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible
+feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2)
+tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the
+extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the
+work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If
+the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a
+menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion.
+
+ 1. Source Code.
+
+ The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work
+for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source
+form of a work.
+
+ A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official
+standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of
+interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that
+is widely used among developers working in that language.
+
+ The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other
+than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of
+packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major
+Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that
+Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an
+implementation is available to the public in source code form. A
+"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component
+(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system
+(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to
+produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it.
+
+ The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all
+the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable
+work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to
+control those activities. However, it does not include the work's
+System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free
+programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but
+which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source
+includes interface definition files associated with source files for
+the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically
+linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require,
+such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those
+subprograms and other parts of the work.
+
+ The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users
+can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding
+Source.
+
+ The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that
+same work.
+
+ 2. Basic Permissions.
+
+ All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of
+copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated
+conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited
+permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a
+covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its
+content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your
+rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law.
+
+ You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not
+convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains
+in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose
+of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you
+with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with
+the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do
+not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works
+for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction
+and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of
+your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you.
+
+ Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under
+the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10
+makes it unnecessary.
+
+ 3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law.
+
+ No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological
+measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article
+11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or
+similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such
+measures.
+
+ When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid
+circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention
+is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to
+the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or
+modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's
+users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of
+technological measures.
+
+ 4. Conveying Verbatim Copies.
+
+ You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you
+receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
+appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice;
+keep intact all notices stating that this License and any
+non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code;
+keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all
+recipients a copy of this License along with the Program.
+
+ You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey,
+and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee.
+
+ 5. Conveying Modified Source Versions.
+
+ You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to
+produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the
+terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
+
+ a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified
+ it, and giving a relevant date.
+
+ b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is
+ released under this License and any conditions added under section
+ 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to
+ "keep intact all notices".
+
+ c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this
+ License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This
+ License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7
+ additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts,
+ regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no
+ permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not
+ invalidate such permission if you have separately received it.
+
+ d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display
+ Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive
+ interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your
+ work need not make them do so.
+
+ A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent
+works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work,
+and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program,
+in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an
+"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not
+used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users
+beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work
+in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other
+parts of the aggregate.
+
+ 6. Conveying Non-Source Forms.
+
+ You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms
+of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the
+machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License,
+in one of these ways:
+
+ a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product
+ (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the
+ Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium
+ customarily used for software interchange.
+
+ b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product
+ (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a
+ written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as
+ long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product
+ model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a
+ copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the
+ product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical
+ medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no
+ more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this
+ conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the
+ Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge.
+
+ c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the
+ written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This
+ alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and
+ only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord
+ with subsection 6b.
+
+ d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated
+ place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the
+ Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no
+ further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the
+ Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to
+ copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source
+ may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party)
+ that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain
+ clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the
+ Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the
+ Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is
+ available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements.
+
+ e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided
+ you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding
+ Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no
+ charge under subsection 6d.
+
+ A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded
+from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be
+included in conveying the object code work.
+
+ A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any
+tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family,
+or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation
+into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product,
+doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular
+product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a
+typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status
+of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user
+actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product
+is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial
+commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent
+the only significant mode of use of the product.
+
+ "Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods,
+procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install
+and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from
+a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must
+suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object
+code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because
+modification has been made.
+
+ If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or
+specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as
+part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the
+User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a
+fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the
+Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied
+by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply
+if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install
+modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has
+been installed in ROM).
+
+ The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a
+requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates
+for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for
+the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a
+network may be denied when the modification itself materially and
+adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and
+protocols for communication across the network.
+
+ Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided,
+in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly
+documented (and with an implementation available to the public in
+source code form), and must require no special password or key for
+unpacking, reading or copying.
+
+ 7. Additional Terms.
+
+ "Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this
+License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions.
+Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall
+be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent
+that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions
+apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately
+under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by
+this License without regard to the additional permissions.
+
+ When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option
+remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of
+it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own
+removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place
+additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work,
+for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission.
+
+ Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you
+add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of
+that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms:
+
+ a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the
+ terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or
+
+ b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or
+ author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal
+ Notices displayed by works containing it; or
+
+ c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or
+ requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in
+ reasonable ways as different from the original version; or
+
+ d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or
+ authors of the material; or
+
+ e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some
+ trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or
+
+ f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that
+ material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of
+ it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for
+ any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on
+ those licensors and authors.
+
+ All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further
+restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you
+received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is
+governed by this License along with a term that is a further
+restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains
+a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this
+License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms
+of that license document, provided that the further restriction does
+not survive such relicensing or conveying.
+
+ If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you
+must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the
+additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating
+where to find the applicable terms.
+
+ Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the
+form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions;
+the above requirements apply either way.
+
+ 8. Termination.
+
+ You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly
+provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or
+modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under
+this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third
+paragraph of section 11).
+
+ However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your
+license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a)
+provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and
+finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright
+holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means
+prior to 60 days after the cessation.
+
+ Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is
+reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the
+violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have
+received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that
+copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after
+your receipt of the notice.
+
+ Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the
+licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under
+this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently
+reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same
+material under section 10.
+
+ 9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies.
+
+ You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or
+run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work
+occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission
+to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However,
+nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or
+modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do
+not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a
+covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so.
+
+ 10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients.
+
+ Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically
+receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and
+propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible
+for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License.
+
+ An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an
+organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an
+organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered
+work results from an entity transaction, each party to that
+transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever
+licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could
+give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the
+Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if
+the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts.
+
+ You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the
+rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may
+not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of
+rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation
+(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that
+any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for
+sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it.
+
+ 11. Patents.
+
+ A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this
+License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The
+work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version".
+
+ A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims
+owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or
+hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted
+by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version,
+but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a
+consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For
+purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant
+patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of
+this License.
+
+ Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free
+patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to
+make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and
+propagate the contents of its contributor version.
+
+ In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express
+agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent
+(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to
+sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a
+party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a
+patent against the party.
+
+ If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license,
+and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone
+to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a
+publicly available network server or other readily accessible means,
+then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so
+available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the
+patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner
+consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent
+license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have
+actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the
+covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work
+in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that
+country that you have reason to believe are valid.
+
+ If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or
+arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a
+covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties
+receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify
+or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license
+you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered
+work and works based on it.
+
+ A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within
+the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is
+conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are
+specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered
+work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is
+in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment
+to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying
+the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the
+parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory
+patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work
+conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily
+for and in connection with specific products or compilations that
+contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement,
+or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007.
+
+ Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting
+any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may
+otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law.
+
+ 12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom.
+
+ If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
+otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
+excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a
+covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
+License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may
+not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you
+to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey
+the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this
+License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program.
+
+ 13. Remote Network Interaction; Use with the GNU General Public License.
+
+ Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, if you modify the
+Program, your modified version must prominently offer all users
+interacting with it remotely through a computer network (if your version
+supports such interaction) an opportunity to receive the Corresponding
+Source of your version by providing access to the Corresponding Source
+from a network server at no charge, through some standard or customary
+means of facilitating copying of software. This Corresponding Source
+shall include the Corresponding Source for any work covered by version 3
+of the GNU General Public License that is incorporated pursuant to the
+following paragraph.
+
+ Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have
+permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed
+under version 3 of the GNU General Public License into a single
+combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this
+License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work,
+but the work with which it is combined will remain governed by version
+3 of the GNU General Public License.
+
+ 14. Revised Versions of this License.
+
+ The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of
+the GNU Affero General Public License from time to time. Such new versions
+will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
+address new problems or concerns.
+
+ Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the
+Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU Affero General
+Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the
+option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered
+version or of any later version published by the Free Software
+Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the
+GNU Affero General Public License, you may choose any version ever published
+by the Free Software Foundation.
+
+ If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future
+versions of the GNU Affero General Public License can be used, that proxy's
+public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you
+to choose that version for the Program.
+
+ Later license versions may give you additional or different
+permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any
+author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a
+later version.
+
+ 15. Disclaimer of Warranty.
+
+ THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
+APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT
+HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY
+OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
+THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
+PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM
+IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF
+ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
+
+ 16. Limitation of Liability.
+
+ IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
+WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS
+THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY
+GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE
+USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
+DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD
+PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS),
+EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+SUCH DAMAGES.
+
+ 17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16.
+
+ If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided
+above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms,
+reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates
+an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the
+Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a
+copy of the Program in return for a fee.
+
+ END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
+
+ How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
+
+ If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
+possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
+free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
+
+ To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
+to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
+state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
+the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
+
+ A URL Shortener called Link.
+ Copyright (C) 2021 i@fsh.ee
+
+ This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU Affero General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
+ (at your option) any later version.
+
+ This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+ GNU Affero General Public License for more details.
+
+ You should have received a copy of the GNU Affero General Public License
+ along with this program. If not, see .
+
+Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
+
+ If your software can interact with users remotely through a computer
+network, you should also make sure that it provides a way for users to
+get its source. For example, if your program is a web application, its
+interface could display a "Source" link that leads users to an archive
+of the code. There are many ways you could offer source, and different
+solutions will be better for different programs; see section 13 for the
+specific requirements.
+
+ You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school,
+if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary.
+For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU AGPL, see
+.
diff --git a/README b/README
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cce3ee2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+https://fsh.ee/
diff --git a/go.mod b/go.mod
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..96be31f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/go.mod
@@ -0,0 +1,8 @@
+module git.fsh.ee/i/link
+
+go 1.16
+
+require (
+ gorm.io/driver/sqlite v1.1.4
+ gorm.io/gorm v1.21.9
+)
diff --git a/go.sum b/go.sum
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..48ccbf2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/go.sum
@@ -0,0 +1,12 @@
+github.com/jinzhu/inflection v1.0.0 h1:K317FqzuhWc8YvSVlFMCCUb36O/S9MCKRDI7QkRKD/E=
+github.com/jinzhu/inflection v1.0.0/go.mod h1:h+uFLlag+Qp1Va5pdKtLDYj+kHp5pxUVkryuEj+Srlc=
+github.com/jinzhu/now v1.1.1/go.mod h1:d3SSVoowX0Lcu0IBviAWJpolVfI5UJVZZ7cO71lE/z8=
+github.com/jinzhu/now v1.1.2 h1:eVKgfIdy9b6zbWBMgFpfDPoAMifwSZagU9HmEU6zgiI=
+github.com/jinzhu/now v1.1.2/go.mod h1:d3SSVoowX0Lcu0IBviAWJpolVfI5UJVZZ7cO71lE/z8=
+github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3 v1.14.5 h1:1IdxlwTNazvbKJQSxoJ5/9ECbEeaTTyeU7sEAZ5KKTQ=
+github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3 v1.14.5/go.mod h1:WVKg1VTActs4Qso6iwGbiFih2UIHo0ENGwNd0Lj+XmI=
+gorm.io/driver/sqlite v1.1.4 h1:PDzwYE+sI6De2+mxAneV9Xs11+ZyKV6oxD3wDGkaNvM=
+gorm.io/driver/sqlite v1.1.4/go.mod h1:mJCeTFr7+crvS+TRnWc5Z3UvwxUN1BGBLMrf5LA9DYw=
+gorm.io/gorm v1.20.7/go.mod h1:0HFTzE/SqkGTzK6TlDPPQbAYCluiVvhzoA1+aVyzenw=
+gorm.io/gorm v1.21.9 h1:INieZtn4P2Pw6xPJ8MzT0G4WUOsHq3RhfuDF1M6GW0E=
+gorm.io/gorm v1.21.9/go.mod h1:F+OptMscr0P2F2qU97WT1WimdH9GaQPoDW7AYd5i2Y0=
diff --git a/index.html b/index.html
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..92368c9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/index.html
@@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
+
+
+
+ A Minimal, SQLite-Backed URL Shortener
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+A Minimal, SQLite-Backed URL Shortener
+
+
+
+
+
| Examples:
+|
+| 1. Create a short link to https://duckduckgo.com
+| $ curl -d https://duckduckgo.com %s
+| %s/502fb5543c36014f
+|
+| 2. Deleting a short link
+| $ TMP=$(mktemp)
+| $ # temp file will store header
+| $ LINK=$(curl -sS %s -d https://duckduckgo.com -D $TMP)
+| $ # the link has been successfully created
+| $ DEL=$(cat $TMP | grep -i delete-with | awk '{print$2}'| tr -d '\r')
+| $ # deletion key is stored in 'X-Delete-With' header.
+| $ curl $LINK
+| <a href="https://duckduckgo.com">Permanent Redirect</a>.
+| $ # the link is working as expected
+| $ curl $LINK -X DELETE -d $DEL
+| $ curl $LINK
+| record not found
+| $ # the link has been successfully deleted.
+
+
+Please note: this is an example deployment. If you attempt to create a short
+link here you will receive a 401 Unauthorized. If you like the examples above
+and want to use this URL shortener you should self-host an instance. It's easy
+to do (one of the design goals). Below are instructions detailing how.
+
+
+
| How to self-host:
+|
+| 1. Install dependencies:
+| a. The Go programming language:
+| https://golang.org/doc/install
+| b. Git version control.
+| https://git-scm.com/book/en/v2/Getting-Started-Installing-Git
+|
+| * On FreeBSD this would be:
+| $ pkg install -y go git
+|
+| 2. Fetch, complile, and execute the source code:
+| $ env GO111MODULE=off go get git.fsh.ee/i/link
+| $ env GO111MODULE=off go run git.fsh.ee/i/link -url https://your.domain.com -port 8080 -db /path/to/sqlite/file -seed secret
+|
+| * The server is now running on localhost at port 8080.
+| * If the SQLite database at this filepath does not exist it will be created.
+| * All logging will be printed to standard error and standard output.
+
+
diff --git a/main.go b/main.go
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b06eda1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/main.go
@@ -0,0 +1,253 @@
+// A URL Shortener called Link.
+// Copyright (C) 2021 i@fsh.ee
+//
+// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+// it under the terms of the GNU Affero General Public License as published by
+// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
+// (at your option) any later version.
+//
+// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+// GNU Affero General Public License for more details.
+//
+// You should have received a copy of the GNU Affero General Public License
+// along with this program. If not, see .
+package main
+
+import (
+ "crypto/md5"
+ _ "embed"
+ "errors"
+ "flag"
+ "fmt"
+ "hash/maphash"
+ "io/ioutil"
+ "log"
+ "net/http"
+ "net/url"
+ "os"
+ "strconv"
+ "strings"
+ "time"
+
+ "gorm.io/driver/sqlite"
+ "gorm.io/gorm"
+ "gorm.io/gorm/logger"
+)
+
+//go:embed index.html
+var indexTemplate string
+
+type DB struct {
+ *gorm.DB
+ log *log.Logger
+ hashSeed string
+}
+
+func NewDB(l *log.Logger, dbFilePath, hashSeed string) (DB, error) {
+ _, err := os.Stat(dbFilePath)
+ if os.IsNotExist(err) {
+ err := ioutil.WriteFile(dbFilePath, []byte{}, 0600)
+ if err != nil {
+ return DB{}, err
+ }
+ }
+ db, err := gorm.Open(sqlite.Open(dbFilePath), &gorm.Config{
+ NowFunc: func() time.Time { return time.Now().UTC() },
+ Logger: logger.Default.LogMode(logger.Silent),
+ })
+ if err != nil {
+ return DB{}, err
+ }
+ return DB{db, l, hashSeed}, db.AutoMigrate(&Link{})
+}
+
+type Link struct {
+ gorm.Model
+ Big string
+ Smol string `gorm:"unique"`
+ Del string `gorm:"unique"`
+}
+
+func (db DB) getHashShortLink(s fmt.Stringer) string {
+ h := maphash.Hash{}
+ h.WriteString(s.String())
+ return strings.TrimSpace(strings.TrimLeft(fmt.Sprintf("%#x\n", h.Sum64()), "0x"))
+}
+
+func (db DB) getHashDeleteKey(s fmt.Stringer) string {
+ return strings.TrimSpace(fmt.Sprintf("%x", md5.Sum([]byte(db.hashSeed+s.String()+strconv.FormatInt(time.Now().Unix(), 10)))))
+}
+
+func (db DB) NewLink(u *url.URL) (Link, error) {
+ return db.NewLinkWithShortLink(u, db.getHashShortLink(u))
+}
+
+func (db DB) NewLinkWithShortLink(u *url.URL, hash string) (Link, error) {
+ var (
+ link = Link{Big: u.String(), Smol: hash, Del: db.getHashDeleteKey(u)}
+ err = db.Create(&link).Error
+ )
+ // TODO: If error due to unique issue should attempt to retry a few times.
+ if err != nil {
+ db.log.Println(err)
+ return Link{}, err
+ }
+ return link, nil
+}
+
+func (db DB) GetLink(smol string) (l Link, e error) {
+ res := db.Where(&Link{Smol: smol}).First(&l)
+ return l, res.Error
+}
+
+func (db DB) DelLink(smol, del string) error {
+ link, err := db.GetLink(smol)
+ if err != nil {
+ return err
+ }
+ res := db.Where(&Link{Del: del}).Delete(&link)
+ if res.RowsAffected < 1 {
+ return gorm.ErrRecordNotFound
+ }
+ return res.Error
+}
+
+type controller struct {
+ log *log.Logger
+ db DB
+ url string
+}
+
+func NewController(logger *log.Logger, db DB, url string) controller {
+ return controller{logger, db, strings.TrimRight(url, "/")}
+}
+
+func (c controller) Err(rw http.ResponseWriter, r *http.Request, err error) {
+ if errors.Is(err, gorm.ErrRecordNotFound) {
+ rw.WriteHeader(http.StatusNotFound)
+ rw.Write([]byte(err.Error()))
+ return
+ }
+ c.log.Println(err)
+ rw.WriteHeader(http.StatusInternalServerError)
+ rw.Write([]byte(err.Error()))
+}
+
+func (c controller) ServeHTTP(rw http.ResponseWriter, r *http.Request) {
+ switch r.Method {
+
+ case http.MethodGet:
+ switch strings.TrimRight(r.URL.Path, "/") {
+
+ case "":
+ rw.Header().Add("Content-Type", "text/html")
+ rw.Write([]byte(fmt.Sprintf(indexTemplate, c.url, c.url, c.url)))
+ return
+
+ case "/favicon.ico":
+ http.NotFound(rw, r)
+ return
+
+ default:
+ link, err := c.db.GetLink(strings.TrimLeft(r.URL.Path, "/"))
+ if err != nil {
+ c.Err(rw, r, err)
+ return
+ }
+ http.Redirect(rw, r, link.Big, http.StatusPermanentRedirect)
+ return
+
+ }
+
+ case http.MethodPost:
+ b, err := ioutil.ReadAll(r.Body)
+ if err != nil {
+ c.Err(rw, r, err)
+ return
+ }
+ u, err := url.Parse(string(b))
+ if err != nil {
+ c.Err(rw, r, err)
+ return
+ }
+ if u.Scheme != "http" && u.Scheme != "https" {
+ rw.WriteHeader(http.StatusBadRequest)
+ rw.Write([]byte("URL must contain scheme. E.G. missing `http://` or `https://`."))
+ return
+ }
+ var (
+ link Link
+ h = strings.Trim(r.URL.Path, "/")
+ )
+ if h != "" {
+ link, err = c.db.NewLinkWithShortLink(u, h)
+
+ } else {
+ link, err = c.db.NewLink(u)
+ }
+ if err != nil {
+ c.Err(rw, r, err)
+ return
+ }
+ rw.Header().Set("X-Delete-With", link.Del)
+ rw.WriteHeader(http.StatusFound)
+ rw.Write([]byte(fmt.Sprintf("%s/%s", c.url, link.Smol)))
+ return
+
+ case http.MethodDelete:
+ b, err := ioutil.ReadAll(r.Body)
+ if err != nil {
+ c.Err(rw, r, err)
+ return
+ }
+ if len(b) < 1 {
+ rw.WriteHeader(http.StatusBadRequest)
+ rw.Write([]byte("Must include deletion key in DELETE body."))
+ return
+ }
+ var (
+ smol = strings.TrimSpace(strings.TrimLeft(r.URL.Path, "/"))
+ del = strings.TrimSpace(string(b))
+ )
+ if err := c.db.DelLink(smol, del); err != nil {
+ c.Err(rw, r, err)
+ return
+ }
+ rw.WriteHeader(http.StatusNoContent)
+ return
+
+ }
+
+ http.NotFound(rw, r)
+}
+
+func main() {
+ var (
+ logPrefix = "link: "
+ startupLogger = log.New(os.Stdout, logPrefix, 0)
+ applicationLogger = log.New(ioutil.Discard, logPrefix, 0)
+ v = flag.Bool("v", false, "verbose logging")
+ port = flag.Uint("port", 8080, "port to listen on")
+ dbFilePath = flag.String("db", "", "sqlite database filepath: required")
+ url = flag.String("url", "", "service url: required")
+ hashSeed = flag.String("seed", "", "hash seed: required")
+ )
+ flag.Parse()
+ if *dbFilePath == "" || *url == "" || *hashSeed == "" {
+ flag.Usage()
+ return
+ }
+ if *v {
+ applicationLogger = log.New(os.Stdout, logPrefix, 0)
+ }
+ db, err := NewDB(applicationLogger, *dbFilePath, *hashSeed)
+ if err != nil {
+ startupLogger.Fatal(err)
+ return
+ }
+ http.Handle("/", NewController(applicationLogger, db, *url))
+ startupLogger.Println("listening on port", *port)
+ startupLogger.Fatal(http.ListenAndServe(fmt.Sprintf(":%d", *port), nil))
+}
diff --git a/makefile b/makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f0a9b5e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,28 @@
+BIN=out
+CC=go1.16
+
+all: setup vendor gen build
+
+setup:
+ @env GOOD=off go get golang.org/dl/go1.16
+ @env GOOD=off $(CC) download
+
+vendor: go.mod go.sum
+ @$(CC) mod tidy
+ @$(CC) mod vendor
+
+build:
+ @$(CC) build -ldflags='-s -w' -o $(BIN)
+
+gen:
+ @$(CC) generate ./...
+
+test:
+ @env $(ENV) $(CC) test ./... -cover -count 1
+
+run: gen build
+ @clear
+ @env $(ENV) ./$(BIN) -v -url https://dev.fsh.ee -port 8080 -db /tmp/link_test_db_1.sql -seed secret
+
+dev:
+ @find . -type f | grep -E '(.*)\.(go|html)' | entr -cr make run
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/LICENSE b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/LICENSE
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a1ca9a0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/LICENSE
@@ -0,0 +1,21 @@
+The MIT License (MIT)
+
+Copyright (c) 2015 - Jinzhu
+
+Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
+of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
+in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
+to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
+copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
+furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
+
+The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+
+THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
+FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
+AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
+LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
+OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
+SOFTWARE.
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/README.md b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a3de336
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,55 @@
+# Inflection
+
+Inflection pluralizes and singularizes English nouns
+
+[![wercker status](https://app.wercker.com/status/f8c7432b097d1f4ce636879670be0930/s/master "wercker status")](https://app.wercker.com/project/byKey/f8c7432b097d1f4ce636879670be0930)
+
+## Basic Usage
+
+```go
+inflection.Plural("person") => "people"
+inflection.Plural("Person") => "People"
+inflection.Plural("PERSON") => "PEOPLE"
+inflection.Plural("bus") => "buses"
+inflection.Plural("BUS") => "BUSES"
+inflection.Plural("Bus") => "Buses"
+
+inflection.Singular("people") => "person"
+inflection.Singular("People") => "Person"
+inflection.Singular("PEOPLE") => "PERSON"
+inflection.Singular("buses") => "bus"
+inflection.Singular("BUSES") => "BUS"
+inflection.Singular("Buses") => "Bus"
+
+inflection.Plural("FancyPerson") => "FancyPeople"
+inflection.Singular("FancyPeople") => "FancyPerson"
+```
+
+## Register Rules
+
+Standard rules are from Rails's ActiveSupport (https://github.com/rails/rails/blob/master/activesupport/lib/active_support/inflections.rb)
+
+If you want to register more rules, follow:
+
+```
+inflection.AddUncountable("fish")
+inflection.AddIrregular("person", "people")
+inflection.AddPlural("(bu)s$", "${1}ses") # "bus" => "buses" / "BUS" => "BUSES" / "Bus" => "Buses"
+inflection.AddSingular("(bus)(es)?$", "${1}") # "buses" => "bus" / "Buses" => "Bus" / "BUSES" => "BUS"
+```
+
+## Contributing
+
+You can help to make the project better, check out [http://gorm.io/contribute.html](http://gorm.io/contribute.html) for things you can do.
+
+## Author
+
+**jinzhu**
+
+*
+*
+*
+
+## License
+
+Released under the [MIT License](http://www.opensource.org/licenses/MIT).
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/go.mod b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/go.mod
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2fb7690
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/go.mod
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+module github.com/jinzhu/inflection
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/inflections.go b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/inflections.go
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..606263b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/inflections.go
@@ -0,0 +1,273 @@
+/*
+Package inflection pluralizes and singularizes English nouns.
+
+ inflection.Plural("person") => "people"
+ inflection.Plural("Person") => "People"
+ inflection.Plural("PERSON") => "PEOPLE"
+
+ inflection.Singular("people") => "person"
+ inflection.Singular("People") => "Person"
+ inflection.Singular("PEOPLE") => "PERSON"
+
+ inflection.Plural("FancyPerson") => "FancydPeople"
+ inflection.Singular("FancyPeople") => "FancydPerson"
+
+Standard rules are from Rails's ActiveSupport (https://github.com/rails/rails/blob/master/activesupport/lib/active_support/inflections.rb)
+
+If you want to register more rules, follow:
+
+ inflection.AddUncountable("fish")
+ inflection.AddIrregular("person", "people")
+ inflection.AddPlural("(bu)s$", "${1}ses") # "bus" => "buses" / "BUS" => "BUSES" / "Bus" => "Buses"
+ inflection.AddSingular("(bus)(es)?$", "${1}") # "buses" => "bus" / "Buses" => "Bus" / "BUSES" => "BUS"
+*/
+package inflection
+
+import (
+ "regexp"
+ "strings"
+)
+
+type inflection struct {
+ regexp *regexp.Regexp
+ replace string
+}
+
+// Regular is a regexp find replace inflection
+type Regular struct {
+ find string
+ replace string
+}
+
+// Irregular is a hard replace inflection,
+// containing both singular and plural forms
+type Irregular struct {
+ singular string
+ plural string
+}
+
+// RegularSlice is a slice of Regular inflections
+type RegularSlice []Regular
+
+// IrregularSlice is a slice of Irregular inflections
+type IrregularSlice []Irregular
+
+var pluralInflections = RegularSlice{
+ {"([a-z])$", "${1}s"},
+ {"s$", "s"},
+ {"^(ax|test)is$", "${1}es"},
+ {"(octop|vir)us$", "${1}i"},
+ {"(octop|vir)i$", "${1}i"},
+ {"(alias|status)$", "${1}es"},
+ {"(bu)s$", "${1}ses"},
+ {"(buffal|tomat)o$", "${1}oes"},
+ {"([ti])um$", "${1}a"},
+ {"([ti])a$", "${1}a"},
+ {"sis$", "ses"},
+ {"(?:([^f])fe|([lr])f)$", "${1}${2}ves"},
+ {"(hive)$", "${1}s"},
+ {"([^aeiouy]|qu)y$", "${1}ies"},
+ {"(x|ch|ss|sh)$", "${1}es"},
+ {"(matr|vert|ind)(?:ix|ex)$", "${1}ices"},
+ {"^(m|l)ouse$", "${1}ice"},
+ {"^(m|l)ice$", "${1}ice"},
+ {"^(ox)$", "${1}en"},
+ {"^(oxen)$", "${1}"},
+ {"(quiz)$", "${1}zes"},
+}
+
+var singularInflections = RegularSlice{
+ {"s$", ""},
+ {"(ss)$", "${1}"},
+ {"(n)ews$", "${1}ews"},
+ {"([ti])a$", "${1}um"},
+ {"((a)naly|(b)a|(d)iagno|(p)arenthe|(p)rogno|(s)ynop|(t)he)(sis|ses)$", "${1}sis"},
+ {"(^analy)(sis|ses)$", "${1}sis"},
+ {"([^f])ves$", "${1}fe"},
+ {"(hive)s$", "${1}"},
+ {"(tive)s$", "${1}"},
+ {"([lr])ves$", "${1}f"},
+ {"([^aeiouy]|qu)ies$", "${1}y"},
+ {"(s)eries$", "${1}eries"},
+ {"(m)ovies$", "${1}ovie"},
+ {"(c)ookies$", "${1}ookie"},
+ {"(x|ch|ss|sh)es$", "${1}"},
+ {"^(m|l)ice$", "${1}ouse"},
+ {"(bus)(es)?$", "${1}"},
+ {"(o)es$", "${1}"},
+ {"(shoe)s$", "${1}"},
+ {"(cris|test)(is|es)$", "${1}is"},
+ {"^(a)x[ie]s$", "${1}xis"},
+ {"(octop|vir)(us|i)$", "${1}us"},
+ {"(alias|status)(es)?$", "${1}"},
+ {"^(ox)en", "${1}"},
+ {"(vert|ind)ices$", "${1}ex"},
+ {"(matr)ices$", "${1}ix"},
+ {"(quiz)zes$", "${1}"},
+ {"(database)s$", "${1}"},
+}
+
+var irregularInflections = IrregularSlice{
+ {"person", "people"},
+ {"man", "men"},
+ {"child", "children"},
+ {"sex", "sexes"},
+ {"move", "moves"},
+ {"mombie", "mombies"},
+}
+
+var uncountableInflections = []string{"equipment", "information", "rice", "money", "species", "series", "fish", "sheep", "jeans", "police"}
+
+var compiledPluralMaps []inflection
+var compiledSingularMaps []inflection
+
+func compile() {
+ compiledPluralMaps = []inflection{}
+ compiledSingularMaps = []inflection{}
+ for _, uncountable := range uncountableInflections {
+ inf := inflection{
+ regexp: regexp.MustCompile("^(?i)(" + uncountable + ")$"),
+ replace: "${1}",
+ }
+ compiledPluralMaps = append(compiledPluralMaps, inf)
+ compiledSingularMaps = append(compiledSingularMaps, inf)
+ }
+
+ for _, value := range irregularInflections {
+ infs := []inflection{
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile(strings.ToUpper(value.singular) + "$"), replace: strings.ToUpper(value.plural)},
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile(strings.Title(value.singular) + "$"), replace: strings.Title(value.plural)},
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile(value.singular + "$"), replace: value.plural},
+ }
+ compiledPluralMaps = append(compiledPluralMaps, infs...)
+ }
+
+ for _, value := range irregularInflections {
+ infs := []inflection{
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile(strings.ToUpper(value.plural) + "$"), replace: strings.ToUpper(value.singular)},
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile(strings.Title(value.plural) + "$"), replace: strings.Title(value.singular)},
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile(value.plural + "$"), replace: value.singular},
+ }
+ compiledSingularMaps = append(compiledSingularMaps, infs...)
+ }
+
+ for i := len(pluralInflections) - 1; i >= 0; i-- {
+ value := pluralInflections[i]
+ infs := []inflection{
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile(strings.ToUpper(value.find)), replace: strings.ToUpper(value.replace)},
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile(value.find), replace: value.replace},
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile("(?i)" + value.find), replace: value.replace},
+ }
+ compiledPluralMaps = append(compiledPluralMaps, infs...)
+ }
+
+ for i := len(singularInflections) - 1; i >= 0; i-- {
+ value := singularInflections[i]
+ infs := []inflection{
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile(strings.ToUpper(value.find)), replace: strings.ToUpper(value.replace)},
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile(value.find), replace: value.replace},
+ inflection{regexp: regexp.MustCompile("(?i)" + value.find), replace: value.replace},
+ }
+ compiledSingularMaps = append(compiledSingularMaps, infs...)
+ }
+}
+
+func init() {
+ compile()
+}
+
+// AddPlural adds a plural inflection
+func AddPlural(find, replace string) {
+ pluralInflections = append(pluralInflections, Regular{find, replace})
+ compile()
+}
+
+// AddSingular adds a singular inflection
+func AddSingular(find, replace string) {
+ singularInflections = append(singularInflections, Regular{find, replace})
+ compile()
+}
+
+// AddIrregular adds an irregular inflection
+func AddIrregular(singular, plural string) {
+ irregularInflections = append(irregularInflections, Irregular{singular, plural})
+ compile()
+}
+
+// AddUncountable adds an uncountable inflection
+func AddUncountable(values ...string) {
+ uncountableInflections = append(uncountableInflections, values...)
+ compile()
+}
+
+// GetPlural retrieves the plural inflection values
+func GetPlural() RegularSlice {
+ plurals := make(RegularSlice, len(pluralInflections))
+ copy(plurals, pluralInflections)
+ return plurals
+}
+
+// GetSingular retrieves the singular inflection values
+func GetSingular() RegularSlice {
+ singulars := make(RegularSlice, len(singularInflections))
+ copy(singulars, singularInflections)
+ return singulars
+}
+
+// GetIrregular retrieves the irregular inflection values
+func GetIrregular() IrregularSlice {
+ irregular := make(IrregularSlice, len(irregularInflections))
+ copy(irregular, irregularInflections)
+ return irregular
+}
+
+// GetUncountable retrieves the uncountable inflection values
+func GetUncountable() []string {
+ uncountables := make([]string, len(uncountableInflections))
+ copy(uncountables, uncountableInflections)
+ return uncountables
+}
+
+// SetPlural sets the plural inflections slice
+func SetPlural(inflections RegularSlice) {
+ pluralInflections = inflections
+ compile()
+}
+
+// SetSingular sets the singular inflections slice
+func SetSingular(inflections RegularSlice) {
+ singularInflections = inflections
+ compile()
+}
+
+// SetIrregular sets the irregular inflections slice
+func SetIrregular(inflections IrregularSlice) {
+ irregularInflections = inflections
+ compile()
+}
+
+// SetUncountable sets the uncountable inflections slice
+func SetUncountable(inflections []string) {
+ uncountableInflections = inflections
+ compile()
+}
+
+// Plural converts a word to its plural form
+func Plural(str string) string {
+ for _, inflection := range compiledPluralMaps {
+ if inflection.regexp.MatchString(str) {
+ return inflection.regexp.ReplaceAllString(str, inflection.replace)
+ }
+ }
+ return str
+}
+
+// Singular converts a word to its singular form
+func Singular(str string) string {
+ for _, inflection := range compiledSingularMaps {
+ if inflection.regexp.MatchString(str) {
+ return inflection.regexp.ReplaceAllString(str, inflection.replace)
+ }
+ }
+ return str
+}
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/wercker.yml b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/wercker.yml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5e6ce98
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/inflection/wercker.yml
@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
+box: golang
+
+build:
+ steps:
+ - setup-go-workspace
+
+ # Gets the dependencies
+ - script:
+ name: go get
+ code: |
+ go get
+
+ # Build the project
+ - script:
+ name: go build
+ code: |
+ go build ./...
+
+ # Test the project
+ - script:
+ name: go test
+ code: |
+ go test ./...
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/Guardfile b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/Guardfile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0b860b0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/Guardfile
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+guard 'gotest' do
+ watch(%r{\.go$})
+end
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/License b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/License
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..037e165
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/License
@@ -0,0 +1,21 @@
+The MIT License (MIT)
+
+Copyright (c) 2013-NOW Jinzhu
+
+Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
+of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
+in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
+to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
+copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
+furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
+
+The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
+all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+
+THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
+FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
+AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
+LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
+OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
+THE SOFTWARE.
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/README.md b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f9d715d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,131 @@
+## Now
+
+Now is a time toolkit for golang
+
+[![wercker status](https://app.wercker.com/status/a350da4eae6cb28a35687ba41afb565a/s/master "wercker status")](https://app.wercker.com/project/byKey/a350da4eae6cb28a35687ba41afb565a)
+
+## Install
+
+```
+go get -u github.com/jinzhu/now
+```
+
+## Usage
+
+Calculating time based on current time
+
+```go
+import "github.com/jinzhu/now"
+
+time.Now() // 2013-11-18 17:51:49.123456789 Mon
+
+now.BeginningOfMinute() // 2013-11-18 17:51:00 Mon
+now.BeginningOfHour() // 2013-11-18 17:00:00 Mon
+now.BeginningOfDay() // 2013-11-18 00:00:00 Mon
+now.BeginningOfWeek() // 2013-11-17 00:00:00 Sun
+now.BeginningOfMonth() // 2013-11-01 00:00:00 Fri
+now.BeginningOfQuarter() // 2013-10-01 00:00:00 Tue
+now.BeginningOfYear() // 2013-01-01 00:00:00 Tue
+
+now.EndOfMinute() // 2013-11-18 17:51:59.999999999 Mon
+now.EndOfHour() // 2013-11-18 17:59:59.999999999 Mon
+now.EndOfDay() // 2013-11-18 23:59:59.999999999 Mon
+now.EndOfWeek() // 2013-11-23 23:59:59.999999999 Sat
+now.EndOfMonth() // 2013-11-30 23:59:59.999999999 Sat
+now.EndOfQuarter() // 2013-12-31 23:59:59.999999999 Tue
+now.EndOfYear() // 2013-12-31 23:59:59.999999999 Tue
+
+now.WeekStartDay = time.Monday // Set Monday as first day, default is Sunday
+now.EndOfWeek() // 2013-11-24 23:59:59.999999999 Sun
+```
+
+Calculating time based on another time
+
+```go
+t := time.Date(2013, 02, 18, 17, 51, 49, 123456789, time.Now().Location())
+now.With(t).EndOfMonth() // 2013-02-28 23:59:59.999999999 Thu
+```
+
+Calculating time based on configuration
+
+```go
+location, err := time.LoadLocation("Asia/Shanghai")
+
+myConfig := &now.Config{
+ WeekStartDay: time.Monday,
+ TimeLocation: location,
+ TimeFormats: []string{"2006-01-02 15:04:05"},
+}
+
+t := time.Date(2013, 11, 18, 17, 51, 49, 123456789, time.Now().Location()) // // 2013-11-18 17:51:49.123456789 Mon
+myConfig.With(t).BeginningOfWeek() // 2013-11-18 00:00:00 Mon
+
+myConfig.Parse("2002-10-12 22:14:01") // 2002-10-12 22:14:01
+myConfig.Parse("2002-10-12 22:14") // returns error 'can't parse string as time: 2002-10-12 22:14'
+```
+
+### Monday/Sunday
+
+Don't be bothered with the `WeekStartDay` setting, you can use `Monday`, `Sunday`
+
+```go
+now.Monday() // 2013-11-18 00:00:00 Mon
+now.Sunday() // 2013-11-24 00:00:00 Sun (Next Sunday)
+now.EndOfSunday() // 2013-11-24 23:59:59.999999999 Sun (End of next Sunday)
+
+t := time.Date(2013, 11, 24, 17, 51, 49, 123456789, time.Now().Location()) // 2013-11-24 17:51:49.123456789 Sun
+now.With(t).Monday() // 2013-11-18 00:00:00 Sun (Last Monday if today is Sunday)
+now.With(t).Sunday() // 2013-11-24 00:00:00 Sun (Beginning Of Today if today is Sunday)
+now.With(t).EndOfSunday() // 2013-11-24 23:59:59.999999999 Sun (End of Today if today is Sunday)
+```
+
+### Parse String to Time
+
+```go
+time.Now() // 2013-11-18 17:51:49.123456789 Mon
+
+// Parse(string) (time.Time, error)
+t, err := now.Parse("2017") // 2017-01-01 00:00:00, nil
+t, err := now.Parse("2017-10") // 2017-10-01 00:00:00, nil
+t, err := now.Parse("2017-10-13") // 2017-10-13 00:00:00, nil
+t, err := now.Parse("1999-12-12 12") // 1999-12-12 12:00:00, nil
+t, err := now.Parse("1999-12-12 12:20") // 1999-12-12 12:20:00, nil
+t, err := now.Parse("1999-12-12 12:20:21") // 1999-12-12 12:20:00, nil
+t, err := now.Parse("10-13") // 2013-10-13 00:00:00, nil
+t, err := now.Parse("12:20") // 2013-11-18 12:20:00, nil
+t, err := now.Parse("12:20:13") // 2013-11-18 12:20:13, nil
+t, err := now.Parse("14") // 2013-11-18 14:00:00, nil
+t, err := now.Parse("99:99") // 2013-11-18 12:20:00, Can't parse string as time: 99:99
+
+// MustParse must parse string to time or it will panic
+now.MustParse("2013-01-13") // 2013-01-13 00:00:00
+now.MustParse("02-17") // 2013-02-17 00:00:00
+now.MustParse("2-17") // 2013-02-17 00:00:00
+now.MustParse("8") // 2013-11-18 08:00:00
+now.MustParse("2002-10-12 22:14") // 2002-10-12 22:14:00
+now.MustParse("99:99") // panic: Can't parse string as time: 99:99
+```
+
+Extend `now` to support more formats is quite easy, just update `now.TimeFormats` with other time layouts, e.g:
+
+```go
+now.TimeFormats = append(now.TimeFormats, "02 Jan 2006 15:04")
+```
+
+Please send me pull requests if you want a format to be supported officially
+
+## Contributing
+
+You can help to make the project better, check out [http://gorm.io/contribute.html](http://gorm.io/contribute.html) for things you can do.
+
+# Author
+
+**jinzhu**
+
+*
+*
+*
+
+## License
+
+Released under the [MIT License](http://www.opensource.org/licenses/MIT).
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/go.mod b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/go.mod
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..018d266
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/go.mod
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+module github.com/jinzhu/now
+
+go 1.12
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/main.go b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/main.go
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3225e26
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/main.go
@@ -0,0 +1,194 @@
+// Package now is a time toolkit for golang.
+//
+// More details README here: https://github.com/jinzhu/now
+//
+// import "github.com/jinzhu/now"
+//
+// now.BeginningOfMinute() // 2013-11-18 17:51:00 Mon
+// now.BeginningOfDay() // 2013-11-18 00:00:00 Mon
+// now.EndOfDay() // 2013-11-18 23:59:59.999999999 Mon
+package now
+
+import "time"
+
+// WeekStartDay set week start day, default is sunday
+var WeekStartDay = time.Sunday
+
+// TimeFormats default time formats will be parsed as
+var TimeFormats = []string{
+ "2006", "2006-1", "2006-1-2", "2006-1-2 15", "2006-1-2 15:4", "2006-1-2 15:4:5", "1-2",
+ "15:4:5", "15:4", "15",
+ "15:4:5 Jan 2, 2006 MST", "2006-01-02 15:04:05.999999999 -0700 MST", "2006-01-02T15:04:05-07:00",
+ "2006.1.2", "2006.1.2 15:04:05", "2006.01.02", "2006.01.02 15:04:05", "2006.01.02 15:04:05.999999999",
+ "1/2/2006", "1/2/2006 15:4:5", "2006/01/02", "2006/01/02 15:04:05",
+ time.ANSIC, time.UnixDate, time.RubyDate, time.RFC822, time.RFC822Z, time.RFC850,
+ time.RFC1123, time.RFC1123Z, time.RFC3339, time.RFC3339Nano,
+ time.Kitchen, time.Stamp, time.StampMilli, time.StampMicro, time.StampNano,
+}
+
+// Config configuration for now package
+type Config struct {
+ WeekStartDay time.Weekday
+ TimeLocation *time.Location
+ TimeFormats []string
+}
+
+// DefaultConfig default config
+var DefaultConfig *Config
+
+// New initialize Now based on configuration
+func (config *Config) With(t time.Time) *Now {
+ return &Now{Time: t, Config: config}
+}
+
+// Parse parse string to time based on configuration
+func (config *Config) Parse(strs ...string) (time.Time, error) {
+ if config.TimeLocation == nil {
+ return config.With(time.Now()).Parse(strs...)
+ } else {
+ return config.With(time.Now().In(config.TimeLocation)).Parse(strs...)
+ }
+}
+
+// MustParse must parse string to time or will panic
+func (config *Config) MustParse(strs ...string) time.Time {
+ if config.TimeLocation == nil {
+ return config.With(time.Now()).MustParse(strs...)
+ } else {
+ return config.With(time.Now().In(config.TimeLocation)).MustParse(strs...)
+ }
+}
+
+// Now now struct
+type Now struct {
+ time.Time
+ *Config
+}
+
+// With initialize Now with time
+func With(t time.Time) *Now {
+ config := DefaultConfig
+ if config == nil {
+ config = &Config{
+ WeekStartDay: WeekStartDay,
+ TimeFormats: TimeFormats,
+ }
+ }
+
+ return &Now{Time: t, Config: config}
+}
+
+// New initialize Now with time
+func New(t time.Time) *Now {
+ return With(t)
+}
+
+// BeginningOfMinute beginning of minute
+func BeginningOfMinute() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).BeginningOfMinute()
+}
+
+// BeginningOfHour beginning of hour
+func BeginningOfHour() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).BeginningOfHour()
+}
+
+// BeginningOfDay beginning of day
+func BeginningOfDay() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).BeginningOfDay()
+}
+
+// BeginningOfWeek beginning of week
+func BeginningOfWeek() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).BeginningOfWeek()
+}
+
+// BeginningOfMonth beginning of month
+func BeginningOfMonth() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).BeginningOfMonth()
+}
+
+// BeginningOfQuarter beginning of quarter
+func BeginningOfQuarter() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).BeginningOfQuarter()
+}
+
+// BeginningOfYear beginning of year
+func BeginningOfYear() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).BeginningOfYear()
+}
+
+// EndOfMinute end of minute
+func EndOfMinute() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).EndOfMinute()
+}
+
+// EndOfHour end of hour
+func EndOfHour() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).EndOfHour()
+}
+
+// EndOfDay end of day
+func EndOfDay() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).EndOfDay()
+}
+
+// EndOfWeek end of week
+func EndOfWeek() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).EndOfWeek()
+}
+
+// EndOfMonth end of month
+func EndOfMonth() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).EndOfMonth()
+}
+
+// EndOfQuarter end of quarter
+func EndOfQuarter() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).EndOfQuarter()
+}
+
+// EndOfYear end of year
+func EndOfYear() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).EndOfYear()
+}
+
+// Monday monday
+func Monday() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).Monday()
+}
+
+// Sunday sunday
+func Sunday() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).Sunday()
+}
+
+// EndOfSunday end of sunday
+func EndOfSunday() time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).EndOfSunday()
+}
+
+// Parse parse string to time
+func Parse(strs ...string) (time.Time, error) {
+ return With(time.Now()).Parse(strs...)
+}
+
+// ParseInLocation parse string to time in location
+func ParseInLocation(loc *time.Location, strs ...string) (time.Time, error) {
+ return With(time.Now().In(loc)).Parse(strs...)
+}
+
+// MustParse must parse string to time or will panic
+func MustParse(strs ...string) time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now()).MustParse(strs...)
+}
+
+// MustParseInLocation must parse string to time in location or will panic
+func MustParseInLocation(loc *time.Location, strs ...string) time.Time {
+ return With(time.Now().In(loc)).MustParse(strs...)
+}
+
+// Between check now between the begin, end time or not
+func Between(time1, time2 string) bool {
+ return With(time.Now()).Between(time1, time2)
+}
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/now.go b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/now.go
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..84c2b52
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/now.go
@@ -0,0 +1,212 @@
+package now
+
+import (
+ "errors"
+ "regexp"
+ "time"
+)
+
+// BeginningOfMinute beginning of minute
+func (now *Now) BeginningOfMinute() time.Time {
+ return now.Truncate(time.Minute)
+}
+
+// BeginningOfHour beginning of hour
+func (now *Now) BeginningOfHour() time.Time {
+ y, m, d := now.Date()
+ return time.Date(y, m, d, now.Time.Hour(), 0, 0, 0, now.Time.Location())
+}
+
+// BeginningOfDay beginning of day
+func (now *Now) BeginningOfDay() time.Time {
+ y, m, d := now.Date()
+ return time.Date(y, m, d, 0, 0, 0, 0, now.Time.Location())
+}
+
+// BeginningOfWeek beginning of week
+func (now *Now) BeginningOfWeek() time.Time {
+ t := now.BeginningOfDay()
+ weekday := int(t.Weekday())
+
+ if now.WeekStartDay != time.Sunday {
+ weekStartDayInt := int(now.WeekStartDay)
+
+ if weekday < weekStartDayInt {
+ weekday = weekday + 7 - weekStartDayInt
+ } else {
+ weekday = weekday - weekStartDayInt
+ }
+ }
+ return t.AddDate(0, 0, -weekday)
+}
+
+// BeginningOfMonth beginning of month
+func (now *Now) BeginningOfMonth() time.Time {
+ y, m, _ := now.Date()
+ return time.Date(y, m, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, now.Location())
+}
+
+// BeginningOfQuarter beginning of quarter
+func (now *Now) BeginningOfQuarter() time.Time {
+ month := now.BeginningOfMonth()
+ offset := (int(month.Month()) - 1) % 3
+ return month.AddDate(0, -offset, 0)
+}
+
+// BeginningOfHalf beginning of half year
+func (now *Now) BeginningOfHalf() time.Time {
+ month := now.BeginningOfMonth()
+ offset := (int(month.Month()) - 1) % 6
+ return month.AddDate(0, -offset, 0)
+}
+
+// BeginningOfYear BeginningOfYear beginning of year
+func (now *Now) BeginningOfYear() time.Time {
+ y, _, _ := now.Date()
+ return time.Date(y, time.January, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, now.Location())
+}
+
+// EndOfMinute end of minute
+func (now *Now) EndOfMinute() time.Time {
+ return now.BeginningOfMinute().Add(time.Minute - time.Nanosecond)
+}
+
+// EndOfHour end of hour
+func (now *Now) EndOfHour() time.Time {
+ return now.BeginningOfHour().Add(time.Hour - time.Nanosecond)
+}
+
+// EndOfDay end of day
+func (now *Now) EndOfDay() time.Time {
+ y, m, d := now.Date()
+ return time.Date(y, m, d, 23, 59, 59, int(time.Second-time.Nanosecond), now.Location())
+}
+
+// EndOfWeek end of week
+func (now *Now) EndOfWeek() time.Time {
+ return now.BeginningOfWeek().AddDate(0, 0, 7).Add(-time.Nanosecond)
+}
+
+// EndOfMonth end of month
+func (now *Now) EndOfMonth() time.Time {
+ return now.BeginningOfMonth().AddDate(0, 1, 0).Add(-time.Nanosecond)
+}
+
+// EndOfQuarter end of quarter
+func (now *Now) EndOfQuarter() time.Time {
+ return now.BeginningOfQuarter().AddDate(0, 3, 0).Add(-time.Nanosecond)
+}
+
+// EndOfHalf end of half year
+func (now *Now) EndOfHalf() time.Time {
+ return now.BeginningOfHalf().AddDate(0, 6, 0).Add(-time.Nanosecond)
+}
+
+// EndOfYear end of year
+func (now *Now) EndOfYear() time.Time {
+ return now.BeginningOfYear().AddDate(1, 0, 0).Add(-time.Nanosecond)
+}
+
+// Monday monday
+func (now *Now) Monday() time.Time {
+ t := now.BeginningOfDay()
+ weekday := int(t.Weekday())
+ if weekday == 0 {
+ weekday = 7
+ }
+ return t.AddDate(0, 0, -weekday+1)
+}
+
+// Sunday sunday
+func (now *Now) Sunday() time.Time {
+ t := now.BeginningOfDay()
+ weekday := int(t.Weekday())
+ if weekday == 0 {
+ return t
+ }
+ return t.AddDate(0, 0, (7 - weekday))
+}
+
+// EndOfSunday end of sunday
+func (now *Now) EndOfSunday() time.Time {
+ return New(now.Sunday()).EndOfDay()
+}
+
+func (now *Now) parseWithFormat(str string, location *time.Location) (t time.Time, err error) {
+ for _, format := range now.TimeFormats {
+ t, err = time.ParseInLocation(format, str, location)
+
+ if err == nil {
+ return
+ }
+ }
+ err = errors.New("Can't parse string as time: " + str)
+ return
+}
+
+var hasTimeRegexp = regexp.MustCompile(`(\s+|^\s*)\d{1,2}((:\d{1,2})*|((:\d{1,2}){2}\.(\d{3}|\d{6}|\d{9})))\s*$`) // match 15:04:05, 15:04:05.000, 15:04:05.000000 15, 2017-01-01 15:04, etc
+var onlyTimeRegexp = regexp.MustCompile(`^\s*\d{1,2}((:\d{1,2})*|((:\d{1,2}){2}\.(\d{3}|\d{6}|\d{9})))\s*$`) // match 15:04:05, 15, 15:04:05.000, 15:04:05.000000, etc
+
+// Parse parse string to time
+func (now *Now) Parse(strs ...string) (t time.Time, err error) {
+ var (
+ setCurrentTime bool
+ parseTime []int
+ currentLocation = now.Location()
+ onlyTimeInStr = true
+ currentTime = formatTimeToList(now.Time)
+ )
+
+ for _, str := range strs {
+ hasTimeInStr := hasTimeRegexp.MatchString(str) // match 15:04:05, 15
+ onlyTimeInStr = hasTimeInStr && onlyTimeInStr && onlyTimeRegexp.MatchString(str)
+ if t, err = now.parseWithFormat(str, currentLocation); err == nil {
+ location := t.Location()
+ parseTime = formatTimeToList(t)
+
+ for i, v := range parseTime {
+ // Don't reset hour, minute, second if current time str including time
+ if hasTimeInStr && i <= 3 {
+ continue
+ }
+
+ // If value is zero, replace it with current time
+ if v == 0 {
+ if setCurrentTime {
+ parseTime[i] = currentTime[i]
+ }
+ } else {
+ setCurrentTime = true
+ }
+
+ // if current time only includes time, should change day, month to current time
+ if onlyTimeInStr {
+ if i == 4 || i == 5 {
+ parseTime[i] = currentTime[i]
+ continue
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ t = time.Date(parseTime[6], time.Month(parseTime[5]), parseTime[4], parseTime[3], parseTime[2], parseTime[1], parseTime[0], location)
+ currentTime = formatTimeToList(t)
+ }
+ }
+ return
+}
+
+// MustParse must parse string to time or it will panic
+func (now *Now) MustParse(strs ...string) (t time.Time) {
+ t, err := now.Parse(strs...)
+ if err != nil {
+ panic(err)
+ }
+ return t
+}
+
+// Between check time between the begin, end time or not
+func (now *Now) Between(begin, end string) bool {
+ beginTime := now.MustParse(begin)
+ endTime := now.MustParse(end)
+ return now.After(beginTime) && now.Before(endTime)
+}
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/time.go b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/time.go
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..52dd8b2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/time.go
@@ -0,0 +1,9 @@
+package now
+
+import "time"
+
+func formatTimeToList(t time.Time) []int {
+ hour, min, sec := t.Clock()
+ year, month, day := t.Date()
+ return []int{t.Nanosecond(), sec, min, hour, day, int(month), year}
+}
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/wercker.yml b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/wercker.yml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5e6ce98
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/jinzhu/now/wercker.yml
@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
+box: golang
+
+build:
+ steps:
+ - setup-go-workspace
+
+ # Gets the dependencies
+ - script:
+ name: go get
+ code: |
+ go get
+
+ # Build the project
+ - script:
+ name: go build
+ code: |
+ go build ./...
+
+ # Test the project
+ - script:
+ name: go test
+ code: |
+ go test ./...
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/.codecov.yml b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/.codecov.yml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..35cde5c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/.codecov.yml
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+coverage:
+ status:
+ project: off
+ patch: off
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/.gitignore b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/.gitignore
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fa0e6b5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/.gitignore
@@ -0,0 +1,14 @@
+*.db
+*.exe
+*.dll
+*.o
+
+# VSCode
+.vscode
+
+# Exclude from upgrade
+upgrade/*.c
+upgrade/*.h
+
+# Exclude upgrade binary
+upgrade/upgrade
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/LICENSE b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/LICENSE
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ca458bb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/LICENSE
@@ -0,0 +1,21 @@
+The MIT License (MIT)
+
+Copyright (c) 2014 Yasuhiro Matsumoto
+
+Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
+of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
+in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
+to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
+copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
+furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
+
+The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
+copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+
+THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
+FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
+AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
+LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
+OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
+SOFTWARE.
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/README.md b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..274d8f2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,590 @@
+go-sqlite3
+==========
+
+[![GoDoc Reference](https://godoc.org/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3?status.svg)](http://godoc.org/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3)
+[![GitHub Actions](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/workflows/Go/badge.svg)](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/actions?query=workflow%3AGo)
+[![Financial Contributors on Open Collective](https://opencollective.com/mattn-go-sqlite3/all/badge.svg?label=financial+contributors)](https://opencollective.com/mattn-go-sqlite3)
+[![codecov](https://codecov.io/gh/mattn/go-sqlite3/branch/master/graph/badge.svg)](https://codecov.io/gh/mattn/go-sqlite3)
+[![Go Report Card](https://goreportcard.com/badge/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3)](https://goreportcard.com/report/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3)
+
+Latest stable version is v1.14 or later not v2.
+
+~~**NOTE:** The increase to v2 was an accident. There were no major changes or features.~~
+
+# Description
+
+sqlite3 driver conforming to the built-in database/sql interface
+
+Supported Golang version: See .github/workflows/go.yaml
+
+[This package follows the official Golang Release Policy.](https://golang.org/doc/devel/release.html#policy)
+
+### Overview
+
+- [go-sqlite3](#go-sqlite3)
+- [Description](#description)
+ - [Overview](#overview)
+- [Installation](#installation)
+- [API Reference](#api-reference)
+- [Connection String](#connection-string)
+ - [DSN Examples](#dsn-examples)
+- [Features](#features)
+ - [Usage](#usage)
+ - [Feature / Extension List](#feature--extension-list)
+- [Compilation](#compilation)
+ - [Android](#android)
+- [ARM](#arm)
+- [Cross Compile](#cross-compile)
+- [Google Cloud Platform](#google-cloud-platform)
+ - [Linux](#linux)
+ - [Alpine](#alpine)
+ - [Fedora](#fedora)
+ - [Ubuntu](#ubuntu)
+ - [Mac OSX](#mac-osx)
+ - [Windows](#windows)
+ - [Errors](#errors)
+- [User Authentication](#user-authentication)
+ - [Compile](#compile)
+ - [Usage](#usage-1)
+ - [Create protected database](#create-protected-database)
+ - [Password Encoding](#password-encoding)
+ - [Available Encoders](#available-encoders)
+ - [Restrictions](#restrictions)
+ - [Support](#support)
+ - [User Management](#user-management)
+ - [SQL](#sql)
+ - [Examples](#examples)
+ - [*SQLiteConn](#sqliteconn)
+ - [Attached database](#attached-database)
+- [Extensions](#extensions)
+ - [Spatialite](#spatialite)
+- [FAQ](#faq)
+- [License](#license)
+- [Author](#author)
+
+# Installation
+
+This package can be installed with the go get command:
+
+ go get github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3
+
+_go-sqlite3_ is *cgo* package.
+If you want to build your app using go-sqlite3, you need gcc.
+However, after you have built and installed _go-sqlite3_ with `go install github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3` (which requires gcc), you can build your app without relying on gcc in future.
+
+***Important: because this is a `CGO` enabled package you are required to set the environment variable `CGO_ENABLED=1` and have a `gcc` compile present within your path.***
+
+# API Reference
+
+API documentation can be found here: http://godoc.org/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3
+
+Examples can be found under the [examples](./_example) directory
+
+# Connection String
+
+When creating a new SQLite database or connection to an existing one, with the file name additional options can be given.
+This is also known as a DSN string. (Data Source Name).
+
+Options are append after the filename of the SQLite database.
+The database filename and options are seperated by an `?` (Question Mark).
+Options should be URL-encoded (see [url.QueryEscape](https://golang.org/pkg/net/url/#QueryEscape)).
+
+This also applies when using an in-memory database instead of a file.
+
+Options can be given using the following format: `KEYWORD=VALUE` and multiple options can be combined with the `&` ampersand.
+
+This library supports dsn options of SQLite itself and provides additional options.
+
+Boolean values can be one of:
+* `0` `no` `false` `off`
+* `1` `yes` `true` `on`
+
+| Name | Key | Value(s) | Description |
+|------|-----|----------|-------------|
+| UA - Create | `_auth` | - | Create User Authentication, for more information see [User Authentication](#user-authentication) |
+| UA - Username | `_auth_user` | `string` | Username for User Authentication, for more information see [User Authentication](#user-authentication) |
+| UA - Password | `_auth_pass` | `string` | Password for User Authentication, for more information see [User Authentication](#user-authentication) |
+| UA - Crypt | `_auth_crypt` |
SHA1
SSHA1
SHA256
SSHA256
SHA384
SSHA384
SHA512
SSHA512
| Password encoder to use for User Authentication, for more information see [User Authentication](#user-authentication) |
+| UA - Salt | `_auth_salt` | `string` | Salt to use if the configure password encoder requires a salt, for User Authentication, for more information see [User Authentication](#user-authentication) |
+| Auto Vacuum | `_auto_vacuum` \| `_vacuum` |
`0` \| `none`
`1` \| `full`
`2` \| `incremental`
| For more information see [PRAGMA auto_vacuum](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_auto_vacuum) |
+| Busy Timeout | `_busy_timeout` \| `_timeout` | `int` | Specify value for sqlite3_busy_timeout. For more information see [PRAGMA busy_timeout](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_busy_timeout) |
+| Case Sensitive LIKE | `_case_sensitive_like` \| `_cslike` | `boolean` | For more information see [PRAGMA case_sensitive_like](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_case_sensitive_like) |
+| Defer Foreign Keys | `_defer_foreign_keys` \| `_defer_fk` | `boolean` | For more information see [PRAGMA defer_foreign_keys](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_defer_foreign_keys) |
+| Foreign Keys | `_foreign_keys` \| `_fk` | `boolean` | For more information see [PRAGMA foreign_keys](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_foreign_keys) |
+| Ignore CHECK Constraints | `_ignore_check_constraints` | `boolean` | For more information see [PRAGMA ignore_check_constraints](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_ignore_check_constraints) |
+| Immutable | `immutable` | `boolean` | For more information see [Immutable](https://www.sqlite.org/c3ref/open.html) |
+| Journal Mode | `_journal_mode` \| `_journal` |
DELETE
TRUNCATE
PERSIST
MEMORY
WAL
OFF
| For more information see [PRAGMA journal_mode](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_journal_mode) |
+| Locking Mode | `_locking_mode` \| `_locking` |
NORMAL
EXCLUSIVE
| For more information see [PRAGMA locking_mode](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_locking_mode) |
+| Mode | `mode` |
ro
rw
rwc
memory
| Access Mode of the database. For more information see [SQLite Open](https://www.sqlite.org/c3ref/open.html) |
+| Mutex Locking | `_mutex` |
no
full
| Specify mutex mode. |
+| Query Only | `_query_only` | `boolean` | For more information see [PRAGMA query_only](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_query_only) |
+| Recursive Triggers | `_recursive_triggers` \| `_rt` | `boolean` | For more information see [PRAGMA recursive_triggers](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_recursive_triggers) |
+| Secure Delete | `_secure_delete` | `boolean` \| `FAST` | For more information see [PRAGMA secure_delete](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_secure_delete) |
+| Shared-Cache Mode | `cache` |
shared
private
| Set cache mode for more information see [sqlite.org](https://www.sqlite.org/sharedcache.html) |
+| Synchronous | `_synchronous` \| `_sync` |
0 \| OFF
1 \| NORMAL
2 \| FULL
3 \| EXTRA
| For more information see [PRAGMA synchronous](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_synchronous) |
+| Time Zone Location | `_loc` | auto | Specify location of time format. |
+| Transaction Lock | `_txlock` |
immediate
deferred
exclusive
| Specify locking behavior for transactions. |
+| Writable Schema | `_writable_schema` | `Boolean` | When this pragma is on, the SQLITE_MASTER tables in which database can be changed using ordinary UPDATE, INSERT, and DELETE statements. Warning: misuse of this pragma can easily result in a corrupt database file. |
+
+## DSN Examples
+
+```
+file:test.db?cache=shared&mode=memory
+```
+
+# Features
+
+This package allows additional configuration of features available within SQLite3 to be enabled or disabled by golang build constraints also known as build `tags`.
+
+[Click here for more information about build tags / constraints.](https://golang.org/pkg/go/build/#hdr-Build_Constraints)
+
+### Usage
+
+If you wish to build this library with additional extensions / features.
+Use the following command.
+
+```bash
+go build --tags ""
+```
+
+For available features see the extension list.
+When using multiple build tags, all the different tags should be space delimted.
+
+Example:
+
+```bash
+go build --tags "icu json1 fts5 secure_delete"
+```
+
+### Feature / Extension List
+
+| Extension | Build Tag | Description |
+|-----------|-----------|-------------|
+| Additional Statistics | sqlite_stat4 | This option adds additional logic to the ANALYZE command and to the query planner that can help SQLite to chose a better query plan under certain situations. The ANALYZE command is enhanced to collect histogram data from all columns of every index and store that data in the sqlite_stat4 table.
The query planner will then use the histogram data to help it make better index choices. The downside of this compile-time option is that it violates the query planner stability guarantee making it more difficult to ensure consistent performance in mass-produced applications.
SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT4 is an enhancement of SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT3. STAT3 only recorded histogram data for the left-most column of each index whereas the STAT4 enhancement records histogram data from all columns of each index.
The SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT3 compile-time option is a no-op and is ignored if the SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT4 compile-time option is used |
+| Allow URI Authority | sqlite_allow_uri_authority | URI filenames normally throws an error if the authority section is not either empty or "localhost".
However, if SQLite is compiled with the SQLITE_ALLOW_URI_AUTHORITY compile-time option, then the URI is converted into a Uniform Naming Convention (UNC) filename and passed down to the underlying operating system that way |
+| App Armor | sqlite_app_armor | When defined, this C-preprocessor macro activates extra code that attempts to detect misuse of the SQLite API, such as passing in NULL pointers to required parameters or using objects after they have been destroyed.
App Armor is not available under `Windows`. |
+| Disable Load Extensions | sqlite_omit_load_extension | Loading of external extensions is enabled by default.
To disable extension loading add the build tag `sqlite_omit_load_extension`. |
+| Foreign Keys | sqlite_foreign_keys | This macro determines whether enforcement of foreign key constraints is enabled or disabled by default for new database connections.
Each database connection can always turn enforcement of foreign key constraints on and off and run-time using the foreign_keys pragma.
Enforcement of foreign key constraints is normally off by default, but if this compile-time parameter is set to 1, enforcement of foreign key constraints will be on by default |
+| Full Auto Vacuum | sqlite_vacuum_full | Set the default auto vacuum to full |
+| Incremental Auto Vacuum | sqlite_vacuum_incr | Set the default auto vacuum to incremental |
+| Full Text Search Engine | sqlite_fts5 | When this option is defined in the amalgamation, versions 5 of the full-text search engine (fts5) is added to the build automatically |
+| International Components for Unicode | sqlite_icu | This option causes the International Components for Unicode or "ICU" extension to SQLite to be added to the build |
+| Introspect PRAGMAS | sqlite_introspect | This option adds some extra PRAGMA statements.
PRAGMA function_list
PRAGMA module_list
PRAGMA pragma_list
|
+| JSON SQL Functions | sqlite_json | When this option is defined in the amalgamation, the JSON SQL functions are added to the build automatically |
+| Pre Update Hook | sqlite_preupdate_hook | Registers a callback function that is invoked prior to each INSERT, UPDATE, and DELETE operation on a database table. |
+| Secure Delete | sqlite_secure_delete | This compile-time option changes the default setting of the secure_delete pragma.
When this option is not used, secure_delete defaults to off. When this option is present, secure_delete defaults to on.
The secure_delete setting causes deleted content to be overwritten with zeros. There is a small performance penalty since additional I/O must occur.
On the other hand, secure_delete can prevent fragments of sensitive information from lingering in unused parts of the database file after it has been deleted. See the documentation on the secure_delete pragma for additional information |
+| Secure Delete (FAST) | sqlite_secure_delete_fast | For more information see [PRAGMA secure_delete](https://www.sqlite.org/pragma.html#pragma_secure_delete) |
+| Tracing / Debug | sqlite_trace | Activate trace functions |
+| User Authentication | sqlite_userauth | SQLite User Authentication see [User Authentication](#user-authentication) for more information. |
+
+# Compilation
+
+This package requires `CGO_ENABLED=1` ennvironment variable if not set by default, and the presence of the `gcc` compiler.
+
+If you need to add additional CFLAGS or LDFLAGS to the build command, and do not want to modify this package. Then this can be achieved by using the `CGO_CFLAGS` and `CGO_LDFLAGS` environment variables.
+
+## Android
+
+This package can be compiled for android.
+Compile with:
+
+```bash
+go build --tags "android"
+```
+
+For more information see [#201](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/201)
+
+# ARM
+
+To compile for `ARM` use the following environment.
+
+```bash
+env CC=arm-linux-gnueabihf-gcc CXX=arm-linux-gnueabihf-g++ \
+ CGO_ENABLED=1 GOOS=linux GOARCH=arm GOARM=7 \
+ go build -v
+```
+
+Additional information:
+- [#242](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/242)
+- [#504](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/504)
+
+# Cross Compile
+
+This library can be cross-compiled.
+
+In some cases you are required to the `CC` environment variable with the cross compiler.
+
+## Cross Compiling from MAC OSX
+The simplest way to cross compile from OSX is to use [xgo](https://github.com/karalabe/xgo).
+
+Steps:
+- Install [xgo](https://github.com/karalabe/xgo) (`go get github.com/karalabe/xgo`).
+- Ensure that your project is within your `GOPATH`.
+- Run `xgo local/path/to/project`.
+
+Please refer to the project's [README](https://github.com/karalabe/xgo/blob/master/README.md) for further information.
+
+# Google Cloud Platform
+
+Building on GCP is not possible because Google Cloud Platform does not allow `gcc` to be executed.
+
+Please work only with compiled final binaries.
+
+## Linux
+
+To compile this package on Linux you must install the development tools for your linux distribution.
+
+To compile under linux use the build tag `linux`.
+
+```bash
+go build --tags "linux"
+```
+
+If you wish to link directly to libsqlite3 then you can use the `libsqlite3` build tag.
+
+```
+go build --tags "libsqlite3 linux"
+```
+
+### Alpine
+
+When building in an `alpine` container run the following command before building.
+
+```
+apk add --update gcc musl-dev
+```
+
+### Fedora
+
+```bash
+sudo yum groupinstall "Development Tools" "Development Libraries"
+```
+
+### Ubuntu
+
+```bash
+sudo apt-get install build-essential
+```
+
+## Mac OSX
+
+OSX should have all the tools present to compile this package, if not install XCode this will add all the developers tools.
+
+Required dependency
+
+```bash
+brew install sqlite3
+```
+
+For OSX there is an additional package install which is required if you wish to build the `icu` extension.
+
+This additional package can be installed with `homebrew`.
+
+```bash
+brew upgrade icu4c
+```
+
+To compile for Mac OSX.
+
+```bash
+go build --tags "darwin"
+```
+
+If you wish to link directly to libsqlite3 then you can use the `libsqlite3` build tag.
+
+```
+go build --tags "libsqlite3 darwin"
+```
+
+Additional information:
+- [#206](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/206)
+- [#404](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/404)
+
+## Windows
+
+To compile this package on Windows OS you must have the `gcc` compiler installed.
+
+1) Install a Windows `gcc` toolchain.
+2) Add the `bin` folders to the Windows path if the installer did not do this by default.
+3) Open a terminal for the TDM-GCC toolchain, can be found in the Windows Start menu.
+4) Navigate to your project folder and run the `go build ...` command for this package.
+
+For example the TDM-GCC Toolchain can be found [here](https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdm-gcc/).
+
+## Errors
+
+- Compile error: `can not be used when making a shared object; recompile with -fPIC`
+
+ When receiving a compile time error referencing recompile with `-FPIC` then you
+ are probably using a hardend system.
+
+ You can compile the library on a hardend system with the following command.
+
+ ```bash
+ go build -ldflags '-extldflags=-fno-PIC'
+ ```
+
+ More details see [#120](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/120)
+
+- Can't build go-sqlite3 on windows 64bit.
+
+ > Probably, you are using go 1.0, go1.0 has a problem when it comes to compiling/linking on windows 64bit.
+ > See: [#27](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/27)
+
+- `go get github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3` throws compilation error.
+
+ `gcc` throws: `internal compiler error`
+
+ Remove the download repository from your disk and try re-install with:
+
+ ```bash
+ go install github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3
+ ```
+
+# User Authentication
+
+This package supports the SQLite User Authentication module.
+
+## Compile
+
+To use the User authentication module the package has to be compiled with the tag `sqlite_userauth`. See [Features](#features).
+
+## Usage
+
+### Create protected database
+
+To create a database protected by user authentication provide the following argument to the connection string `_auth`.
+This will enable user authentication within the database. This option however requires two additional arguments:
+
+- `_auth_user`
+- `_auth_pass`
+
+When `_auth` is present on the connection string user authentication will be enabled and the provided user will be created
+as an `admin` user. After initial creation, the parameter `_auth` has no effect anymore and can be omitted from the connection string.
+
+Example connection string:
+
+Create an user authentication database with user `admin` and password `admin`.
+
+`file:test.s3db?_auth&_auth_user=admin&_auth_pass=admin`
+
+Create an user authentication database with user `admin` and password `admin` and use `SHA1` for the password encoding.
+
+`file:test.s3db?_auth&_auth_user=admin&_auth_pass=admin&_auth_crypt=sha1`
+
+### Password Encoding
+
+The passwords within the user authentication module of SQLite are encoded with the SQLite function `sqlite_cryp`.
+This function uses a ceasar-cypher which is quite insecure.
+This library provides several additional password encoders which can be configured through the connection string.
+
+The password cypher can be configured with the key `_auth_crypt`. And if the configured password encoder also requires an
+salt this can be configured with `_auth_salt`.
+
+#### Available Encoders
+
+- SHA1
+- SSHA1 (Salted SHA1)
+- SHA256
+- SSHA256 (salted SHA256)
+- SHA384
+- SSHA384 (salted SHA384)
+- SHA512
+- SSHA512 (salted SHA512)
+
+### Restrictions
+
+Operations on the database regarding to user management can only be preformed by an administrator user.
+
+### Support
+
+The user authentication supports two kinds of users
+
+- administrators
+- regular users
+
+### User Management
+
+User management can be done by directly using the `*SQLiteConn` or by SQL.
+
+#### SQL
+
+The following sql functions are available for user management.
+
+| Function | Arguments | Description |
+|----------|-----------|-------------|
+| `authenticate` | username `string`, password `string` | Will authenticate an user, this is done by the connection; and should not be used manually. |
+| `auth_user_add` | username `string`, password `string`, admin `int` | This function will add an user to the database. if the database is not protected by user authentication it will enable it. Argument `admin` is an integer identifying if the added user should be an administrator. Only Administrators can add administrators. |
+| `auth_user_change` | username `string`, password `string`, admin `int` | Function to modify an user. Users can change their own password, but only an administrator can change the administrator flag. |
+| `authUserDelete` | username `string` | Delete an user from the database. Can only be used by an administrator. The current logged in administrator cannot be deleted. This is to make sure their is always an administrator remaining. |
+
+These functions will return an integer.
+
+- 0 (SQLITE_OK)
+- 23 (SQLITE_AUTH) Failed to perform due to authentication or insufficient privileges
+
+##### Examples
+
+```sql
+// Autheticate user
+// Create Admin User
+SELECT auth_user_add('admin2', 'admin2', 1);
+
+// Change password for user
+SELECT auth_user_change('user', 'userpassword', 0);
+
+// Delete user
+SELECT user_delete('user');
+```
+
+#### *SQLiteConn
+
+The following functions are available for User authentication from the `*SQLiteConn`.
+
+| Function | Description |
+|----------|-------------|
+| `Authenticate(username, password string) error` | Authenticate user |
+| `AuthUserAdd(username, password string, admin bool) error` | Add user |
+| `AuthUserChange(username, password string, admin bool) error` | Modify user |
+| `AuthUserDelete(username string) error` | Delete user |
+
+### Attached database
+
+When using attached databases. SQLite will use the authentication from the `main` database for the attached database(s).
+
+# Extensions
+
+If you want your own extension to be listed here or you want to add a reference to an extension; please submit an Issue for this.
+
+## Spatialite
+
+Spatialite is available as an extension to SQLite, and can be used in combination with this repository.
+For an example see [shaxbee/go-spatialite](https://github.com/shaxbee/go-spatialite).
+
+## extension-functions.c from SQLite3 Contrib
+
+extension-functions.c is available as an extension to SQLite, and provides the following functions:
+
+- Math: acos, asin, atan, atn2, atan2, acosh, asinh, atanh, difference, degrees, radians, cos, sin, tan, cot, cosh, sinh, tanh, coth, exp, log, log10, power, sign, sqrt, square, ceil, floor, pi.
+- String: replicate, charindex, leftstr, rightstr, ltrim, rtrim, trim, replace, reverse, proper, padl, padr, padc, strfilter.
+- Aggregate: stdev, variance, mode, median, lower_quartile, upper_quartile
+
+For an example see [dinedal/go-sqlite3-extension-functions](https://github.com/dinedal/go-sqlite3-extension-functions).
+
+# FAQ
+
+- Getting insert error while query is opened.
+
+ > You can pass some arguments into the connection string, for example, a URI.
+ > See: [#39](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/39)
+
+- Do you want to cross compile? mingw on Linux or Mac?
+
+ > See: [#106](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/106)
+ > See also: http://www.limitlessfx.com/cross-compile-golang-app-for-windows-from-linux.html
+
+- Want to get time.Time with current locale
+
+ Use `_loc=auto` in SQLite3 filename schema like `file:foo.db?_loc=auto`.
+
+- Can I use this in multiple routines concurrently?
+
+ Yes for readonly. But, No for writable. See [#50](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/50), [#51](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/51), [#209](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/209), [#274](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/274).
+
+- Why I'm getting `no such table` error?
+
+ Why is it racy if I use a `sql.Open("sqlite3", ":memory:")` database?
+
+ Each connection to `":memory:"` opens a brand new in-memory sql database, so if
+ the stdlib's sql engine happens to open another connection and you've only
+ specified `":memory:"`, that connection will see a brand new database. A
+ workaround is to use `"file::memory:?cache=shared"` (or `"file:foobar?mode=memory&cache=shared"`). Every
+ connection to this string will point to the same in-memory database.
+
+ Note that if the last database connection in the pool closes, the in-memory database is deleted. Make sure the [max idle connection limit](https://golang.org/pkg/database/sql/#DB.SetMaxIdleConns) is > 0, and the [connection lifetime](https://golang.org/pkg/database/sql/#DB.SetConnMaxLifetime) is infinite.
+
+ For more information see
+ * [#204](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/204)
+ * [#511](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/511)
+ * https://www.sqlite.org/sharedcache.html#shared_cache_and_in_memory_databases
+ * https://www.sqlite.org/inmemorydb.html#sharedmemdb
+
+- Reading from database with large amount of goroutines fails on OSX.
+
+ OS X limits OS-wide to not have more than 1000 files open simultaneously by default.
+
+ For more information see [#289](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/289)
+
+- Trying to execute a `.` (dot) command throws an error.
+
+ Error: `Error: near ".": syntax error`
+ Dot command are part of SQLite3 CLI not of this library.
+
+ You need to implement the feature or call the sqlite3 cli.
+
+ More information see [#305](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/305)
+
+- Error: `database is locked`
+
+ When you get a database is locked. Please use the following options.
+
+ Add to DSN: `cache=shared`
+
+ Example:
+ ```go
+ db, err := sql.Open("sqlite3", "file:locked.sqlite?cache=shared")
+ ```
+
+ Second please set the database connections of the SQL package to 1.
+
+ ```go
+ db.SetMaxOpenConns(1)
+ ```
+
+ More information see [#209](https://github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/issues/209)
+
+## Contributors
+
+### Code Contributors
+
+This project exists thanks to all the people who contribute. [[Contribute](CONTRIBUTING.md)].
+
+
+### Financial Contributors
+
+Become a financial contributor and help us sustain our community. [[Contribute](https://opencollective.com/mattn-go-sqlite3/contribute)]
+
+#### Individuals
+
+
+
+#### Organizations
+
+Support this project with your organization. Your logo will show up here with a link to your website. [[Contribute](https://opencollective.com/mattn-go-sqlite3/contribute)]
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+# License
+
+MIT: http://mattn.mit-license.org/2018
+
+sqlite3-binding.c, sqlite3-binding.h, sqlite3ext.h
+
+The -binding suffix was added to avoid build failures under gccgo.
+
+In this repository, those files are an amalgamation of code that was copied from SQLite3. The license of that code is the same as the license of SQLite3.
+
+# Author
+
+Yasuhiro Matsumoto (a.k.a mattn)
+
+G.J.R. Timmer
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/backup.go b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/backup.go
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e222cc8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/backup.go
@@ -0,0 +1,85 @@
+// Copyright (C) 2019 Yasuhiro Matsumoto .
+//
+// Use of this source code is governed by an MIT-style
+// license that can be found in the LICENSE file.
+
+package sqlite3
+
+/*
+#ifndef USE_LIBSQLITE3
+#include
+#else
+#include
+#endif
+#include
+*/
+import "C"
+import (
+ "runtime"
+ "unsafe"
+)
+
+// SQLiteBackup implement interface of Backup.
+type SQLiteBackup struct {
+ b *C.sqlite3_backup
+}
+
+// Backup make backup from src to dest.
+func (destConn *SQLiteConn) Backup(dest string, srcConn *SQLiteConn, src string) (*SQLiteBackup, error) {
+ destptr := C.CString(dest)
+ defer C.free(unsafe.Pointer(destptr))
+ srcptr := C.CString(src)
+ defer C.free(unsafe.Pointer(srcptr))
+
+ if b := C.sqlite3_backup_init(destConn.db, destptr, srcConn.db, srcptr); b != nil {
+ bb := &SQLiteBackup{b: b}
+ runtime.SetFinalizer(bb, (*SQLiteBackup).Finish)
+ return bb, nil
+ }
+ return nil, destConn.lastError()
+}
+
+// Step to backs up for one step. Calls the underlying `sqlite3_backup_step`
+// function. This function returns a boolean indicating if the backup is done
+// and an error signalling any other error. Done is returned if the underlying
+// C function returns SQLITE_DONE (Code 101)
+func (b *SQLiteBackup) Step(p int) (bool, error) {
+ ret := C.sqlite3_backup_step(b.b, C.int(p))
+ if ret == C.SQLITE_DONE {
+ return true, nil
+ } else if ret != 0 && ret != C.SQLITE_LOCKED && ret != C.SQLITE_BUSY {
+ return false, Error{Code: ErrNo(ret)}
+ }
+ return false, nil
+}
+
+// Remaining return whether have the rest for backup.
+func (b *SQLiteBackup) Remaining() int {
+ return int(C.sqlite3_backup_remaining(b.b))
+}
+
+// PageCount return count of pages.
+func (b *SQLiteBackup) PageCount() int {
+ return int(C.sqlite3_backup_pagecount(b.b))
+}
+
+// Finish close backup.
+func (b *SQLiteBackup) Finish() error {
+ return b.Close()
+}
+
+// Close close backup.
+func (b *SQLiteBackup) Close() error {
+ ret := C.sqlite3_backup_finish(b.b)
+
+ // sqlite3_backup_finish() never fails, it just returns the
+ // error code from previous operations, so clean up before
+ // checking and returning an error
+ b.b = nil
+ runtime.SetFinalizer(b, nil)
+
+ if ret != 0 {
+ return Error{Code: ErrNo(ret)}
+ }
+ return nil
+}
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/callback.go b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/callback.go
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c3ce752
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/callback.go
@@ -0,0 +1,392 @@
+// Copyright (C) 2019 Yasuhiro Matsumoto .
+//
+// Use of this source code is governed by an MIT-style
+// license that can be found in the LICENSE file.
+
+package sqlite3
+
+// You can't export a Go function to C and have definitions in the C
+// preamble in the same file, so we have to have callbackTrampoline in
+// its own file. Because we need a separate file anyway, the support
+// code for SQLite custom functions is in here.
+
+/*
+#ifndef USE_LIBSQLITE3
+#include
+#else
+#include
+#endif
+#include
+
+void _sqlite3_result_text(sqlite3_context* ctx, const char* s);
+void _sqlite3_result_blob(sqlite3_context* ctx, const void* b, int l);
+*/
+import "C"
+
+import (
+ "errors"
+ "fmt"
+ "math"
+ "reflect"
+ "sync"
+ "unsafe"
+)
+
+//export callbackTrampoline
+func callbackTrampoline(ctx *C.sqlite3_context, argc int, argv **C.sqlite3_value) {
+ args := (*[(math.MaxInt32 - 1) / unsafe.Sizeof((*C.sqlite3_value)(nil))]*C.sqlite3_value)(unsafe.Pointer(argv))[:argc:argc]
+ fi := lookupHandle(C.sqlite3_user_data(ctx)).(*functionInfo)
+ fi.Call(ctx, args)
+}
+
+//export stepTrampoline
+func stepTrampoline(ctx *C.sqlite3_context, argc C.int, argv **C.sqlite3_value) {
+ args := (*[(math.MaxInt32 - 1) / unsafe.Sizeof((*C.sqlite3_value)(nil))]*C.sqlite3_value)(unsafe.Pointer(argv))[:int(argc):int(argc)]
+ ai := lookupHandle(C.sqlite3_user_data(ctx)).(*aggInfo)
+ ai.Step(ctx, args)
+}
+
+//export doneTrampoline
+func doneTrampoline(ctx *C.sqlite3_context) {
+ ai := lookupHandle(C.sqlite3_user_data(ctx)).(*aggInfo)
+ ai.Done(ctx)
+}
+
+//export compareTrampoline
+func compareTrampoline(handlePtr unsafe.Pointer, la C.int, a *C.char, lb C.int, b *C.char) C.int {
+ cmp := lookupHandle(handlePtr).(func(string, string) int)
+ return C.int(cmp(C.GoStringN(a, la), C.GoStringN(b, lb)))
+}
+
+//export commitHookTrampoline
+func commitHookTrampoline(handle unsafe.Pointer) int {
+ callback := lookupHandle(handle).(func() int)
+ return callback()
+}
+
+//export rollbackHookTrampoline
+func rollbackHookTrampoline(handle unsafe.Pointer) {
+ callback := lookupHandle(handle).(func())
+ callback()
+}
+
+//export updateHookTrampoline
+func updateHookTrampoline(handle unsafe.Pointer, op int, db *C.char, table *C.char, rowid int64) {
+ callback := lookupHandle(handle).(func(int, string, string, int64))
+ callback(op, C.GoString(db), C.GoString(table), rowid)
+}
+
+//export authorizerTrampoline
+func authorizerTrampoline(handle unsafe.Pointer, op int, arg1 *C.char, arg2 *C.char, arg3 *C.char) int {
+ callback := lookupHandle(handle).(func(int, string, string, string) int)
+ return callback(op, C.GoString(arg1), C.GoString(arg2), C.GoString(arg3))
+}
+
+//export preUpdateHookTrampoline
+func preUpdateHookTrampoline(handle unsafe.Pointer, dbHandle uintptr, op int, db *C.char, table *C.char, oldrowid int64, newrowid int64) {
+ hval := lookupHandleVal(handle)
+ data := SQLitePreUpdateData{
+ Conn: hval.db,
+ Op: op,
+ DatabaseName: C.GoString(db),
+ TableName: C.GoString(table),
+ OldRowID: oldrowid,
+ NewRowID: newrowid,
+ }
+ callback := hval.val.(func(SQLitePreUpdateData))
+ callback(data)
+}
+
+// Use handles to avoid passing Go pointers to C.
+type handleVal struct {
+ db *SQLiteConn
+ val interface{}
+}
+
+var handleLock sync.Mutex
+var handleVals = make(map[unsafe.Pointer]handleVal)
+
+func newHandle(db *SQLiteConn, v interface{}) unsafe.Pointer {
+ handleLock.Lock()
+ defer handleLock.Unlock()
+ val := handleVal{db: db, val: v}
+ var p unsafe.Pointer = C.malloc(C.size_t(1))
+ if p == nil {
+ panic("can't allocate 'cgo-pointer hack index pointer': ptr == nil")
+ }
+ handleVals[p] = val
+ return p
+}
+
+func lookupHandleVal(handle unsafe.Pointer) handleVal {
+ handleLock.Lock()
+ defer handleLock.Unlock()
+ return handleVals[handle]
+}
+
+func lookupHandle(handle unsafe.Pointer) interface{} {
+ return lookupHandleVal(handle).val
+}
+
+func deleteHandles(db *SQLiteConn) {
+ handleLock.Lock()
+ defer handleLock.Unlock()
+ for handle, val := range handleVals {
+ if val.db == db {
+ delete(handleVals, handle)
+ C.free(handle)
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+// This is only here so that tests can refer to it.
+type callbackArgRaw C.sqlite3_value
+
+type callbackArgConverter func(*C.sqlite3_value) (reflect.Value, error)
+
+type callbackArgCast struct {
+ f callbackArgConverter
+ typ reflect.Type
+}
+
+func (c callbackArgCast) Run(v *C.sqlite3_value) (reflect.Value, error) {
+ val, err := c.f(v)
+ if err != nil {
+ return reflect.Value{}, err
+ }
+ if !val.Type().ConvertibleTo(c.typ) {
+ return reflect.Value{}, fmt.Errorf("cannot convert %s to %s", val.Type(), c.typ)
+ }
+ return val.Convert(c.typ), nil
+}
+
+func callbackArgInt64(v *C.sqlite3_value) (reflect.Value, error) {
+ if C.sqlite3_value_type(v) != C.SQLITE_INTEGER {
+ return reflect.Value{}, fmt.Errorf("argument must be an INTEGER")
+ }
+ return reflect.ValueOf(int64(C.sqlite3_value_int64(v))), nil
+}
+
+func callbackArgBool(v *C.sqlite3_value) (reflect.Value, error) {
+ if C.sqlite3_value_type(v) != C.SQLITE_INTEGER {
+ return reflect.Value{}, fmt.Errorf("argument must be an INTEGER")
+ }
+ i := int64(C.sqlite3_value_int64(v))
+ val := false
+ if i != 0 {
+ val = true
+ }
+ return reflect.ValueOf(val), nil
+}
+
+func callbackArgFloat64(v *C.sqlite3_value) (reflect.Value, error) {
+ if C.sqlite3_value_type(v) != C.SQLITE_FLOAT {
+ return reflect.Value{}, fmt.Errorf("argument must be a FLOAT")
+ }
+ return reflect.ValueOf(float64(C.sqlite3_value_double(v))), nil
+}
+
+func callbackArgBytes(v *C.sqlite3_value) (reflect.Value, error) {
+ switch C.sqlite3_value_type(v) {
+ case C.SQLITE_BLOB:
+ l := C.sqlite3_value_bytes(v)
+ p := C.sqlite3_value_blob(v)
+ return reflect.ValueOf(C.GoBytes(p, l)), nil
+ case C.SQLITE_TEXT:
+ l := C.sqlite3_value_bytes(v)
+ c := unsafe.Pointer(C.sqlite3_value_text(v))
+ return reflect.ValueOf(C.GoBytes(c, l)), nil
+ default:
+ return reflect.Value{}, fmt.Errorf("argument must be BLOB or TEXT")
+ }
+}
+
+func callbackArgString(v *C.sqlite3_value) (reflect.Value, error) {
+ switch C.sqlite3_value_type(v) {
+ case C.SQLITE_BLOB:
+ l := C.sqlite3_value_bytes(v)
+ p := (*C.char)(C.sqlite3_value_blob(v))
+ return reflect.ValueOf(C.GoStringN(p, l)), nil
+ case C.SQLITE_TEXT:
+ c := (*C.char)(unsafe.Pointer(C.sqlite3_value_text(v)))
+ return reflect.ValueOf(C.GoString(c)), nil
+ default:
+ return reflect.Value{}, fmt.Errorf("argument must be BLOB or TEXT")
+ }
+}
+
+func callbackArgGeneric(v *C.sqlite3_value) (reflect.Value, error) {
+ switch C.sqlite3_value_type(v) {
+ case C.SQLITE_INTEGER:
+ return callbackArgInt64(v)
+ case C.SQLITE_FLOAT:
+ return callbackArgFloat64(v)
+ case C.SQLITE_TEXT:
+ return callbackArgString(v)
+ case C.SQLITE_BLOB:
+ return callbackArgBytes(v)
+ case C.SQLITE_NULL:
+ // Interpret NULL as a nil byte slice.
+ var ret []byte
+ return reflect.ValueOf(ret), nil
+ default:
+ panic("unreachable")
+ }
+}
+
+func callbackArg(typ reflect.Type) (callbackArgConverter, error) {
+ switch typ.Kind() {
+ case reflect.Interface:
+ if typ.NumMethod() != 0 {
+ return nil, errors.New("the only supported interface type is interface{}")
+ }
+ return callbackArgGeneric, nil
+ case reflect.Slice:
+ if typ.Elem().Kind() != reflect.Uint8 {
+ return nil, errors.New("the only supported slice type is []byte")
+ }
+ return callbackArgBytes, nil
+ case reflect.String:
+ return callbackArgString, nil
+ case reflect.Bool:
+ return callbackArgBool, nil
+ case reflect.Int64:
+ return callbackArgInt64, nil
+ case reflect.Int8, reflect.Int16, reflect.Int32, reflect.Uint8, reflect.Uint16, reflect.Uint32, reflect.Uint64, reflect.Int, reflect.Uint:
+ c := callbackArgCast{callbackArgInt64, typ}
+ return c.Run, nil
+ case reflect.Float64:
+ return callbackArgFloat64, nil
+ case reflect.Float32:
+ c := callbackArgCast{callbackArgFloat64, typ}
+ return c.Run, nil
+ default:
+ return nil, fmt.Errorf("don't know how to convert to %s", typ)
+ }
+}
+
+func callbackConvertArgs(argv []*C.sqlite3_value, converters []callbackArgConverter, variadic callbackArgConverter) ([]reflect.Value, error) {
+ var args []reflect.Value
+
+ if len(argv) < len(converters) {
+ return nil, fmt.Errorf("function requires at least %d arguments", len(converters))
+ }
+
+ for i, arg := range argv[:len(converters)] {
+ v, err := converters[i](arg)
+ if err != nil {
+ return nil, err
+ }
+ args = append(args, v)
+ }
+
+ if variadic != nil {
+ for _, arg := range argv[len(converters):] {
+ v, err := variadic(arg)
+ if err != nil {
+ return nil, err
+ }
+ args = append(args, v)
+ }
+ }
+ return args, nil
+}
+
+type callbackRetConverter func(*C.sqlite3_context, reflect.Value) error
+
+func callbackRetInteger(ctx *C.sqlite3_context, v reflect.Value) error {
+ switch v.Type().Kind() {
+ case reflect.Int64:
+ case reflect.Int8, reflect.Int16, reflect.Int32, reflect.Uint8, reflect.Uint16, reflect.Uint32, reflect.Uint64, reflect.Int, reflect.Uint:
+ v = v.Convert(reflect.TypeOf(int64(0)))
+ case reflect.Bool:
+ b := v.Interface().(bool)
+ if b {
+ v = reflect.ValueOf(int64(1))
+ } else {
+ v = reflect.ValueOf(int64(0))
+ }
+ default:
+ return fmt.Errorf("cannot convert %s to INTEGER", v.Type())
+ }
+
+ C.sqlite3_result_int64(ctx, C.sqlite3_int64(v.Interface().(int64)))
+ return nil
+}
+
+func callbackRetFloat(ctx *C.sqlite3_context, v reflect.Value) error {
+ switch v.Type().Kind() {
+ case reflect.Float64:
+ case reflect.Float32:
+ v = v.Convert(reflect.TypeOf(float64(0)))
+ default:
+ return fmt.Errorf("cannot convert %s to FLOAT", v.Type())
+ }
+
+ C.sqlite3_result_double(ctx, C.double(v.Interface().(float64)))
+ return nil
+}
+
+func callbackRetBlob(ctx *C.sqlite3_context, v reflect.Value) error {
+ if v.Type().Kind() != reflect.Slice || v.Type().Elem().Kind() != reflect.Uint8 {
+ return fmt.Errorf("cannot convert %s to BLOB", v.Type())
+ }
+ i := v.Interface()
+ if i == nil || len(i.([]byte)) == 0 {
+ C.sqlite3_result_null(ctx)
+ } else {
+ bs := i.([]byte)
+ C._sqlite3_result_blob(ctx, unsafe.Pointer(&bs[0]), C.int(len(bs)))
+ }
+ return nil
+}
+
+func callbackRetText(ctx *C.sqlite3_context, v reflect.Value) error {
+ if v.Type().Kind() != reflect.String {
+ return fmt.Errorf("cannot convert %s to TEXT", v.Type())
+ }
+ C._sqlite3_result_text(ctx, C.CString(v.Interface().(string)))
+ return nil
+}
+
+func callbackRetNil(ctx *C.sqlite3_context, v reflect.Value) error {
+ return nil
+}
+
+func callbackRet(typ reflect.Type) (callbackRetConverter, error) {
+ switch typ.Kind() {
+ case reflect.Interface:
+ errorInterface := reflect.TypeOf((*error)(nil)).Elem()
+ if typ.Implements(errorInterface) {
+ return callbackRetNil, nil
+ }
+ fallthrough
+ case reflect.Slice:
+ if typ.Elem().Kind() != reflect.Uint8 {
+ return nil, errors.New("the only supported slice type is []byte")
+ }
+ return callbackRetBlob, nil
+ case reflect.String:
+ return callbackRetText, nil
+ case reflect.Bool, reflect.Int8, reflect.Int16, reflect.Int32, reflect.Int64, reflect.Uint8, reflect.Uint16, reflect.Uint32, reflect.Uint64, reflect.Int, reflect.Uint:
+ return callbackRetInteger, nil
+ case reflect.Float32, reflect.Float64:
+ return callbackRetFloat, nil
+ default:
+ return nil, fmt.Errorf("don't know how to convert to %s", typ)
+ }
+}
+
+func callbackError(ctx *C.sqlite3_context, err error) {
+ cstr := C.CString(err.Error())
+ defer C.free(unsafe.Pointer(cstr))
+ C.sqlite3_result_error(ctx, cstr, C.int(-1))
+}
+
+// Test support code. Tests are not allowed to import "C", so we can't
+// declare any functions that use C.sqlite3_value.
+func callbackSyntheticForTests(v reflect.Value, err error) callbackArgConverter {
+ return func(*C.sqlite3_value) (reflect.Value, error) {
+ return v, err
+ }
+}
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/convert.go b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/convert.go
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0385073
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/convert.go
@@ -0,0 +1,299 @@
+// Extracted from Go database/sql source code
+
+// Copyright 2011 The Go Authors. All rights reserved.
+// Use of this source code is governed by a BSD-style
+// license that can be found in the LICENSE file.
+
+// Type conversions for Scan.
+
+package sqlite3
+
+import (
+ "database/sql"
+ "database/sql/driver"
+ "errors"
+ "fmt"
+ "reflect"
+ "strconv"
+ "time"
+)
+
+var errNilPtr = errors.New("destination pointer is nil") // embedded in descriptive error
+
+// convertAssign copies to dest the value in src, converting it if possible.
+// An error is returned if the copy would result in loss of information.
+// dest should be a pointer type.
+func convertAssign(dest, src interface{}) error {
+ // Common cases, without reflect.
+ switch s := src.(type) {
+ case string:
+ switch d := dest.(type) {
+ case *string:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = s
+ return nil
+ case *[]byte:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = []byte(s)
+ return nil
+ case *sql.RawBytes:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = append((*d)[:0], s...)
+ return nil
+ }
+ case []byte:
+ switch d := dest.(type) {
+ case *string:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = string(s)
+ return nil
+ case *interface{}:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = cloneBytes(s)
+ return nil
+ case *[]byte:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = cloneBytes(s)
+ return nil
+ case *sql.RawBytes:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = s
+ return nil
+ }
+ case time.Time:
+ switch d := dest.(type) {
+ case *time.Time:
+ *d = s
+ return nil
+ case *string:
+ *d = s.Format(time.RFC3339Nano)
+ return nil
+ case *[]byte:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = []byte(s.Format(time.RFC3339Nano))
+ return nil
+ case *sql.RawBytes:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = s.AppendFormat((*d)[:0], time.RFC3339Nano)
+ return nil
+ }
+ case nil:
+ switch d := dest.(type) {
+ case *interface{}:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = nil
+ return nil
+ case *[]byte:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = nil
+ return nil
+ case *sql.RawBytes:
+ if d == nil {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+ *d = nil
+ return nil
+ }
+ }
+
+ var sv reflect.Value
+
+ switch d := dest.(type) {
+ case *string:
+ sv = reflect.ValueOf(src)
+ switch sv.Kind() {
+ case reflect.Bool,
+ reflect.Int, reflect.Int8, reflect.Int16, reflect.Int32, reflect.Int64,
+ reflect.Uint, reflect.Uint8, reflect.Uint16, reflect.Uint32, reflect.Uint64,
+ reflect.Float32, reflect.Float64:
+ *d = asString(src)
+ return nil
+ }
+ case *[]byte:
+ sv = reflect.ValueOf(src)
+ if b, ok := asBytes(nil, sv); ok {
+ *d = b
+ return nil
+ }
+ case *sql.RawBytes:
+ sv = reflect.ValueOf(src)
+ if b, ok := asBytes([]byte(*d)[:0], sv); ok {
+ *d = sql.RawBytes(b)
+ return nil
+ }
+ case *bool:
+ bv, err := driver.Bool.ConvertValue(src)
+ if err == nil {
+ *d = bv.(bool)
+ }
+ return err
+ case *interface{}:
+ *d = src
+ return nil
+ }
+
+ if scanner, ok := dest.(sql.Scanner); ok {
+ return scanner.Scan(src)
+ }
+
+ dpv := reflect.ValueOf(dest)
+ if dpv.Kind() != reflect.Ptr {
+ return errors.New("destination not a pointer")
+ }
+ if dpv.IsNil() {
+ return errNilPtr
+ }
+
+ if !sv.IsValid() {
+ sv = reflect.ValueOf(src)
+ }
+
+ dv := reflect.Indirect(dpv)
+ if sv.IsValid() && sv.Type().AssignableTo(dv.Type()) {
+ switch b := src.(type) {
+ case []byte:
+ dv.Set(reflect.ValueOf(cloneBytes(b)))
+ default:
+ dv.Set(sv)
+ }
+ return nil
+ }
+
+ if dv.Kind() == sv.Kind() && sv.Type().ConvertibleTo(dv.Type()) {
+ dv.Set(sv.Convert(dv.Type()))
+ return nil
+ }
+
+ // The following conversions use a string value as an intermediate representation
+ // to convert between various numeric types.
+ //
+ // This also allows scanning into user defined types such as "type Int int64".
+ // For symmetry, also check for string destination types.
+ switch dv.Kind() {
+ case reflect.Ptr:
+ if src == nil {
+ dv.Set(reflect.Zero(dv.Type()))
+ return nil
+ }
+ dv.Set(reflect.New(dv.Type().Elem()))
+ return convertAssign(dv.Interface(), src)
+ case reflect.Int, reflect.Int8, reflect.Int16, reflect.Int32, reflect.Int64:
+ s := asString(src)
+ i64, err := strconv.ParseInt(s, 10, dv.Type().Bits())
+ if err != nil {
+ err = strconvErr(err)
+ return fmt.Errorf("converting driver.Value type %T (%q) to a %s: %v", src, s, dv.Kind(), err)
+ }
+ dv.SetInt(i64)
+ return nil
+ case reflect.Uint, reflect.Uint8, reflect.Uint16, reflect.Uint32, reflect.Uint64:
+ s := asString(src)
+ u64, err := strconv.ParseUint(s, 10, dv.Type().Bits())
+ if err != nil {
+ err = strconvErr(err)
+ return fmt.Errorf("converting driver.Value type %T (%q) to a %s: %v", src, s, dv.Kind(), err)
+ }
+ dv.SetUint(u64)
+ return nil
+ case reflect.Float32, reflect.Float64:
+ s := asString(src)
+ f64, err := strconv.ParseFloat(s, dv.Type().Bits())
+ if err != nil {
+ err = strconvErr(err)
+ return fmt.Errorf("converting driver.Value type %T (%q) to a %s: %v", src, s, dv.Kind(), err)
+ }
+ dv.SetFloat(f64)
+ return nil
+ case reflect.String:
+ switch v := src.(type) {
+ case string:
+ dv.SetString(v)
+ return nil
+ case []byte:
+ dv.SetString(string(v))
+ return nil
+ }
+ }
+
+ return fmt.Errorf("unsupported Scan, storing driver.Value type %T into type %T", src, dest)
+}
+
+func strconvErr(err error) error {
+ if ne, ok := err.(*strconv.NumError); ok {
+ return ne.Err
+ }
+ return err
+}
+
+func cloneBytes(b []byte) []byte {
+ if b == nil {
+ return nil
+ }
+ c := make([]byte, len(b))
+ copy(c, b)
+ return c
+}
+
+func asString(src interface{}) string {
+ switch v := src.(type) {
+ case string:
+ return v
+ case []byte:
+ return string(v)
+ }
+ rv := reflect.ValueOf(src)
+ switch rv.Kind() {
+ case reflect.Int, reflect.Int8, reflect.Int16, reflect.Int32, reflect.Int64:
+ return strconv.FormatInt(rv.Int(), 10)
+ case reflect.Uint, reflect.Uint8, reflect.Uint16, reflect.Uint32, reflect.Uint64:
+ return strconv.FormatUint(rv.Uint(), 10)
+ case reflect.Float64:
+ return strconv.FormatFloat(rv.Float(), 'g', -1, 64)
+ case reflect.Float32:
+ return strconv.FormatFloat(rv.Float(), 'g', -1, 32)
+ case reflect.Bool:
+ return strconv.FormatBool(rv.Bool())
+ }
+ return fmt.Sprintf("%v", src)
+}
+
+func asBytes(buf []byte, rv reflect.Value) (b []byte, ok bool) {
+ switch rv.Kind() {
+ case reflect.Int, reflect.Int8, reflect.Int16, reflect.Int32, reflect.Int64:
+ return strconv.AppendInt(buf, rv.Int(), 10), true
+ case reflect.Uint, reflect.Uint8, reflect.Uint16, reflect.Uint32, reflect.Uint64:
+ return strconv.AppendUint(buf, rv.Uint(), 10), true
+ case reflect.Float32:
+ return strconv.AppendFloat(buf, rv.Float(), 'g', -1, 32), true
+ case reflect.Float64:
+ return strconv.AppendFloat(buf, rv.Float(), 'g', -1, 64), true
+ case reflect.Bool:
+ return strconv.AppendBool(buf, rv.Bool()), true
+ case reflect.String:
+ s := rv.String()
+ return append(buf, s...), true
+ }
+ return
+}
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/doc.go b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/doc.go
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ac27633
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/doc.go
@@ -0,0 +1,135 @@
+/*
+Package sqlite3 provides interface to SQLite3 databases.
+
+This works as a driver for database/sql.
+
+Installation
+
+ go get github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3
+
+Supported Types
+
+Currently, go-sqlite3 supports the following data types.
+
+ +------------------------------+
+ |go | sqlite3 |
+ |----------|-------------------|
+ |nil | null |
+ |int | integer |
+ |int64 | integer |
+ |float64 | float |
+ |bool | integer |
+ |[]byte | blob |
+ |string | text |
+ |time.Time | timestamp/datetime|
+ +------------------------------+
+
+SQLite3 Extension
+
+You can write your own extension module for sqlite3. For example, below is an
+extension for a Regexp matcher operation.
+
+ #include
+ #include
+ #include
+ #include
+
+ SQLITE_EXTENSION_INIT1
+ static void regexp_func(sqlite3_context *context, int argc, sqlite3_value **argv) {
+ if (argc >= 2) {
+ const char *target = (const char *)sqlite3_value_text(argv[1]);
+ const char *pattern = (const char *)sqlite3_value_text(argv[0]);
+ const char* errstr = NULL;
+ int erroff = 0;
+ int vec[500];
+ int n, rc;
+ pcre* re = pcre_compile(pattern, 0, &errstr, &erroff, NULL);
+ rc = pcre_exec(re, NULL, target, strlen(target), 0, 0, vec, 500);
+ if (rc <= 0) {
+ sqlite3_result_error(context, errstr, 0);
+ return;
+ }
+ sqlite3_result_int(context, 1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ #ifdef _WIN32
+ __declspec(dllexport)
+ #endif
+ int sqlite3_extension_init(sqlite3 *db, char **errmsg,
+ const sqlite3_api_routines *api) {
+ SQLITE_EXTENSION_INIT2(api);
+ return sqlite3_create_function(db, "regexp", 2, SQLITE_UTF8,
+ (void*)db, regexp_func, NULL, NULL);
+ }
+
+It needs to be built as a so/dll shared library. And you need to register
+the extension module like below.
+
+ sql.Register("sqlite3_with_extensions",
+ &sqlite3.SQLiteDriver{
+ Extensions: []string{
+ "sqlite3_mod_regexp",
+ },
+ })
+
+Then, you can use this extension.
+
+ rows, err := db.Query("select text from mytable where name regexp '^golang'")
+
+Connection Hook
+
+You can hook and inject your code when the connection is established by setting
+ConnectHook to get the SQLiteConn.
+
+ sql.Register("sqlite3_with_hook_example",
+ &sqlite3.SQLiteDriver{
+ ConnectHook: func(conn *sqlite3.SQLiteConn) error {
+ sqlite3conn = append(sqlite3conn, conn)
+ return nil
+ },
+ })
+
+You can also use database/sql.Conn.Raw (Go >= 1.13):
+
+ conn, err := db.Conn(context.Background())
+ // if err != nil { ... }
+ defer conn.Close()
+ err = conn.Raw(func (driverConn interface{}) error {
+ sqliteConn := driverConn.(*sqlite3.SQLiteConn)
+ // ... use sqliteConn
+ })
+ // if err != nil { ... }
+
+Go SQlite3 Extensions
+
+If you want to register Go functions as SQLite extension functions
+you can make a custom driver by calling RegisterFunction from
+ConnectHook.
+
+ regex = func(re, s string) (bool, error) {
+ return regexp.MatchString(re, s)
+ }
+ sql.Register("sqlite3_extended",
+ &sqlite3.SQLiteDriver{
+ ConnectHook: func(conn *sqlite3.SQLiteConn) error {
+ return conn.RegisterFunc("regexp", regex, true)
+ },
+ })
+
+You can then use the custom driver by passing its name to sql.Open.
+
+ var i int
+ conn, err := sql.Open("sqlite3_extended", "./foo.db")
+ if err != nil {
+ panic(err)
+ }
+ err = db.QueryRow(`SELECT regexp("foo.*", "seafood")`).Scan(&i)
+ if err != nil {
+ panic(err)
+ }
+
+See the documentation of RegisterFunc for more details.
+
+*/
+package sqlite3
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/error.go b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/error.go
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..696281c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/error.go
@@ -0,0 +1,150 @@
+// Copyright (C) 2019 Yasuhiro Matsumoto .
+//
+// Use of this source code is governed by an MIT-style
+// license that can be found in the LICENSE file.
+
+package sqlite3
+
+/*
+#ifndef USE_LIBSQLITE3
+#include
+#else
+#include
+#endif
+*/
+import "C"
+import "syscall"
+
+// ErrNo inherit errno.
+type ErrNo int
+
+// ErrNoMask is mask code.
+const ErrNoMask C.int = 0xff
+
+// ErrNoExtended is extended errno.
+type ErrNoExtended int
+
+// Error implement sqlite error code.
+type Error struct {
+ Code ErrNo /* The error code returned by SQLite */
+ ExtendedCode ErrNoExtended /* The extended error code returned by SQLite */
+ SystemErrno syscall.Errno /* The system errno returned by the OS through SQLite, if applicable */
+ err string /* The error string returned by sqlite3_errmsg(),
+ this usually contains more specific details. */
+}
+
+// result codes from http://www.sqlite.org/c3ref/c_abort.html
+var (
+ ErrError = ErrNo(1) /* SQL error or missing database */
+ ErrInternal = ErrNo(2) /* Internal logic error in SQLite */
+ ErrPerm = ErrNo(3) /* Access permission denied */
+ ErrAbort = ErrNo(4) /* Callback routine requested an abort */
+ ErrBusy = ErrNo(5) /* The database file is locked */
+ ErrLocked = ErrNo(6) /* A table in the database is locked */
+ ErrNomem = ErrNo(7) /* A malloc() failed */
+ ErrReadonly = ErrNo(8) /* Attempt to write a readonly database */
+ ErrInterrupt = ErrNo(9) /* Operation terminated by sqlite3_interrupt() */
+ ErrIoErr = ErrNo(10) /* Some kind of disk I/O error occurred */
+ ErrCorrupt = ErrNo(11) /* The database disk image is malformed */
+ ErrNotFound = ErrNo(12) /* Unknown opcode in sqlite3_file_control() */
+ ErrFull = ErrNo(13) /* Insertion failed because database is full */
+ ErrCantOpen = ErrNo(14) /* Unable to open the database file */
+ ErrProtocol = ErrNo(15) /* Database lock protocol error */
+ ErrEmpty = ErrNo(16) /* Database is empty */
+ ErrSchema = ErrNo(17) /* The database schema changed */
+ ErrTooBig = ErrNo(18) /* String or BLOB exceeds size limit */
+ ErrConstraint = ErrNo(19) /* Abort due to constraint violation */
+ ErrMismatch = ErrNo(20) /* Data type mismatch */
+ ErrMisuse = ErrNo(21) /* Library used incorrectly */
+ ErrNoLFS = ErrNo(22) /* Uses OS features not supported on host */
+ ErrAuth = ErrNo(23) /* Authorization denied */
+ ErrFormat = ErrNo(24) /* Auxiliary database format error */
+ ErrRange = ErrNo(25) /* 2nd parameter to sqlite3_bind out of range */
+ ErrNotADB = ErrNo(26) /* File opened that is not a database file */
+ ErrNotice = ErrNo(27) /* Notifications from sqlite3_log() */
+ ErrWarning = ErrNo(28) /* Warnings from sqlite3_log() */
+)
+
+// Error return error message from errno.
+func (err ErrNo) Error() string {
+ return Error{Code: err}.Error()
+}
+
+// Extend return extended errno.
+func (err ErrNo) Extend(by int) ErrNoExtended {
+ return ErrNoExtended(int(err) | (by << 8))
+}
+
+// Error return error message that is extended code.
+func (err ErrNoExtended) Error() string {
+ return Error{Code: ErrNo(C.int(err) & ErrNoMask), ExtendedCode: err}.Error()
+}
+
+func (err Error) Error() string {
+ var str string
+ if err.err != "" {
+ str = err.err
+ } else {
+ str = C.GoString(C.sqlite3_errstr(C.int(err.Code)))
+ }
+ if err.SystemErrno != 0 {
+ str += ": " + err.SystemErrno.Error()
+ }
+ return str
+}
+
+// result codes from http://www.sqlite.org/c3ref/c_abort_rollback.html
+var (
+ ErrIoErrRead = ErrIoErr.Extend(1)
+ ErrIoErrShortRead = ErrIoErr.Extend(2)
+ ErrIoErrWrite = ErrIoErr.Extend(3)
+ ErrIoErrFsync = ErrIoErr.Extend(4)
+ ErrIoErrDirFsync = ErrIoErr.Extend(5)
+ ErrIoErrTruncate = ErrIoErr.Extend(6)
+ ErrIoErrFstat = ErrIoErr.Extend(7)
+ ErrIoErrUnlock = ErrIoErr.Extend(8)
+ ErrIoErrRDlock = ErrIoErr.Extend(9)
+ ErrIoErrDelete = ErrIoErr.Extend(10)
+ ErrIoErrBlocked = ErrIoErr.Extend(11)
+ ErrIoErrNoMem = ErrIoErr.Extend(12)
+ ErrIoErrAccess = ErrIoErr.Extend(13)
+ ErrIoErrCheckReservedLock = ErrIoErr.Extend(14)
+ ErrIoErrLock = ErrIoErr.Extend(15)
+ ErrIoErrClose = ErrIoErr.Extend(16)
+ ErrIoErrDirClose = ErrIoErr.Extend(17)
+ ErrIoErrSHMOpen = ErrIoErr.Extend(18)
+ ErrIoErrSHMSize = ErrIoErr.Extend(19)
+ ErrIoErrSHMLock = ErrIoErr.Extend(20)
+ ErrIoErrSHMMap = ErrIoErr.Extend(21)
+ ErrIoErrSeek = ErrIoErr.Extend(22)
+ ErrIoErrDeleteNoent = ErrIoErr.Extend(23)
+ ErrIoErrMMap = ErrIoErr.Extend(24)
+ ErrIoErrGetTempPath = ErrIoErr.Extend(25)
+ ErrIoErrConvPath = ErrIoErr.Extend(26)
+ ErrLockedSharedCache = ErrLocked.Extend(1)
+ ErrBusyRecovery = ErrBusy.Extend(1)
+ ErrBusySnapshot = ErrBusy.Extend(2)
+ ErrCantOpenNoTempDir = ErrCantOpen.Extend(1)
+ ErrCantOpenIsDir = ErrCantOpen.Extend(2)
+ ErrCantOpenFullPath = ErrCantOpen.Extend(3)
+ ErrCantOpenConvPath = ErrCantOpen.Extend(4)
+ ErrCorruptVTab = ErrCorrupt.Extend(1)
+ ErrReadonlyRecovery = ErrReadonly.Extend(1)
+ ErrReadonlyCantLock = ErrReadonly.Extend(2)
+ ErrReadonlyRollback = ErrReadonly.Extend(3)
+ ErrReadonlyDbMoved = ErrReadonly.Extend(4)
+ ErrAbortRollback = ErrAbort.Extend(2)
+ ErrConstraintCheck = ErrConstraint.Extend(1)
+ ErrConstraintCommitHook = ErrConstraint.Extend(2)
+ ErrConstraintForeignKey = ErrConstraint.Extend(3)
+ ErrConstraintFunction = ErrConstraint.Extend(4)
+ ErrConstraintNotNull = ErrConstraint.Extend(5)
+ ErrConstraintPrimaryKey = ErrConstraint.Extend(6)
+ ErrConstraintTrigger = ErrConstraint.Extend(7)
+ ErrConstraintUnique = ErrConstraint.Extend(8)
+ ErrConstraintVTab = ErrConstraint.Extend(9)
+ ErrConstraintRowID = ErrConstraint.Extend(10)
+ ErrNoticeRecoverWAL = ErrNotice.Extend(1)
+ ErrNoticeRecoverRollback = ErrNotice.Extend(2)
+ ErrWarningAutoIndex = ErrWarning.Extend(1)
+)
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/go.mod b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/go.mod
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5e56bb9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/go.mod
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+module github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3
+
+go 1.10
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/go.sum b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/go.sum
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e69de29
diff --git a/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3-binding.c b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3-binding.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a5c272c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/vendor/github.com/mattn/go-sqlite3/sqlite3-binding.c
@@ -0,0 +1,230877 @@
+#ifndef USE_LIBSQLITE3
+/******************************************************************************
+** This file is an amalgamation of many separate C source files from SQLite
+** version 3.33.0. By combining all the individual C code files into this
+** single large file, the entire code can be compiled as a single translation
+** unit. This allows many compilers to do optimizations that would not be
+** possible if the files were compiled separately. Performance improvements
+** of 5% or more are commonly seen when SQLite is compiled as a single
+** translation unit.
+**
+** This file is all you need to compile SQLite. To use SQLite in other
+** programs, you need this file and the "sqlite3.h" header file that defines
+** the programming interface to the SQLite library. (If you do not have
+** the "sqlite3.h" header file at hand, you will find a copy embedded within
+** the text of this file. Search for "Begin file sqlite3.h" to find the start
+** of the embedded sqlite3.h header file.) Additional code files may be needed
+** if you want a wrapper to interface SQLite with your choice of programming
+** language. The code for the "sqlite3" command-line shell is also in a
+** separate file. This file contains only code for the core SQLite library.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_CORE 1
+#define SQLITE_AMALGAMATION 1
+#ifndef SQLITE_PRIVATE
+# define SQLITE_PRIVATE static
+#endif
+/************** Begin file ctime.c *******************************************/
+/*
+** 2010 February 23
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This file implements routines used to report what compile-time options
+** SQLite was built with.
+*/
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_COMPILEOPTION_DIAGS /* IMP: R-16824-07538 */
+
+/*
+** Include the configuration header output by 'configure' if we're using the
+** autoconf-based build
+*/
+#if defined(_HAVE_SQLITE_CONFIG_H) && !defined(SQLITECONFIG_H)
+#include "config.h"
+#define SQLITECONFIG_H 1
+#endif
+
+/* These macros are provided to "stringify" the value of the define
+** for those options in which the value is meaningful. */
+#define CTIMEOPT_VAL_(opt) #opt
+#define CTIMEOPT_VAL(opt) CTIMEOPT_VAL_(opt)
+
+/* Like CTIMEOPT_VAL, but especially for SQLITE_DEFAULT_LOOKASIDE. This
+** option requires a separate macro because legal values contain a single
+** comma. e.g. (-DSQLITE_DEFAULT_LOOKASIDE="100,100") */
+#define CTIMEOPT_VAL2_(opt1,opt2) #opt1 "," #opt2
+#define CTIMEOPT_VAL2(opt) CTIMEOPT_VAL2_(opt)
+
+/*
+** An array of names of all compile-time options. This array should
+** be sorted A-Z.
+**
+** This array looks large, but in a typical installation actually uses
+** only a handful of compile-time options, so most times this array is usually
+** rather short and uses little memory space.
+*/
+static const char * const sqlite3azCompileOpt[] = {
+
+/*
+** BEGIN CODE GENERATED BY tool/mkctime.tcl
+*/
+#if SQLITE_32BIT_ROWID
+ "32BIT_ROWID",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_4_BYTE_ALIGNED_MALLOC
+ "4_BYTE_ALIGNED_MALLOC",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_64BIT_STATS
+ "64BIT_STATS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ALLOW_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN
+ "ALLOW_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ALLOW_URI_AUTHORITY
+ "ALLOW_URI_AUTHORITY",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_BITMASK_TYPE
+ "BITMASK_TYPE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_BITMASK_TYPE),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_BUG_COMPATIBLE_20160819
+ "BUG_COMPATIBLE_20160819",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_CASE_SENSITIVE_LIKE
+ "CASE_SENSITIVE_LIKE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES
+ "CHECK_PAGES",
+#endif
+#if defined(__clang__) && defined(__clang_major__)
+ "COMPILER=clang-" CTIMEOPT_VAL(__clang_major__) "."
+ CTIMEOPT_VAL(__clang_minor__) "."
+ CTIMEOPT_VAL(__clang_patchlevel__),
+#elif defined(_MSC_VER)
+ "COMPILER=msvc-" CTIMEOPT_VAL(_MSC_VER),
+#elif defined(__GNUC__) && defined(__VERSION__)
+ "COMPILER=gcc-" __VERSION__,
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_COVERAGE_TEST
+ "COVERAGE_TEST",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DEBUG
+ "DEBUG",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DEFAULT_AUTOMATIC_INDEX
+ "DEFAULT_AUTOMATIC_INDEX",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DEFAULT_AUTOVACUUM
+ "DEFAULT_AUTOVACUUM",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE
+ "DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DEFAULT_CKPTFULLFSYNC
+ "DEFAULT_CKPTFULLFSYNC",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_FORMAT
+ "DEFAULT_FILE_FORMAT=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_FORMAT),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_PERMISSIONS
+ "DEFAULT_FILE_PERMISSIONS=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_PERMISSIONS),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DEFAULT_FOREIGN_KEYS
+ "DEFAULT_FOREIGN_KEYS",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_JOURNAL_SIZE_LIMIT
+ "DEFAULT_JOURNAL_SIZE_LIMIT=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_JOURNAL_SIZE_LIMIT),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_LOCKING_MODE
+ "DEFAULT_LOCKING_MODE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_LOCKING_MODE),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_LOOKASIDE
+ "DEFAULT_LOOKASIDE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL2(SQLITE_DEFAULT_LOOKASIDE),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DEFAULT_MEMSTATUS
+ "DEFAULT_MEMSTATUS",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_MMAP_SIZE
+ "DEFAULT_MMAP_SIZE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_MMAP_SIZE),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE
+ "DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_PCACHE_INITSZ
+ "DEFAULT_PCACHE_INITSZ=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_PCACHE_INITSZ),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_PROXYDIR_PERMISSIONS
+ "DEFAULT_PROXYDIR_PERMISSIONS=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_PROXYDIR_PERMISSIONS),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DEFAULT_RECURSIVE_TRIGGERS
+ "DEFAULT_RECURSIVE_TRIGGERS",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_ROWEST
+ "DEFAULT_ROWEST=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_ROWEST),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE
+ "DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS
+ "DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_AUTOCHECKPOINT
+ "DEFAULT_WAL_AUTOCHECKPOINT=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_AUTOCHECKPOINT),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_SYNCHRONOUS
+ "DEFAULT_WAL_SYNCHRONOUS=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_SYNCHRONOUS),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEFAULT_WORKER_THREADS
+ "DEFAULT_WORKER_THREADS=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_DEFAULT_WORKER_THREADS),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DIRECT_OVERFLOW_READ
+ "DIRECT_OVERFLOW_READ",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DISABLE_DIRSYNC
+ "DISABLE_DIRSYNC",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DISABLE_FTS3_UNICODE
+ "DISABLE_FTS3_UNICODE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DISABLE_FTS4_DEFERRED
+ "DISABLE_FTS4_DEFERRED",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DISABLE_INTRINSIC
+ "DISABLE_INTRINSIC",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DISABLE_LFS
+ "DISABLE_LFS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DISABLE_PAGECACHE_OVERFLOW_STATS
+ "DISABLE_PAGECACHE_OVERFLOW_STATS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DISABLE_SKIPAHEAD_DISTINCT
+ "DISABLE_SKIPAHEAD_DISTINCT",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_8_3_NAMES
+ "ENABLE_8_3_NAMES=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_ENABLE_8_3_NAMES),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ "ENABLE_API_ARMOR",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_ATOMIC_WRITE
+ "ENABLE_ATOMIC_WRITE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE
+ "ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_BYTECODE_VTAB
+ "ENABLE_BYTECODE_VTAB",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_CEROD
+ "ENABLE_CEROD=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_ENABLE_CEROD),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_COLUMN_METADATA
+ "ENABLE_COLUMN_METADATA",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_COLUMN_USED_MASK
+ "ENABLE_COLUMN_USED_MASK",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_COSTMULT
+ "ENABLE_COSTMULT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_CURSOR_HINTS
+ "ENABLE_CURSOR_HINTS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_DBSTAT_VTAB
+ "ENABLE_DBSTAT_VTAB",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_EXPENSIVE_ASSERT
+ "ENABLE_EXPENSIVE_ASSERT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS1
+ "ENABLE_FTS1",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS2
+ "ENABLE_FTS2",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS3
+ "ENABLE_FTS3",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS3_PARENTHESIS
+ "ENABLE_FTS3_PARENTHESIS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS3_TOKENIZER
+ "ENABLE_FTS3_TOKENIZER",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS4
+ "ENABLE_FTS4",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS5
+ "ENABLE_FTS5",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_GEOPOLY
+ "ENABLE_GEOPOLY",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_HIDDEN_COLUMNS
+ "ENABLE_HIDDEN_COLUMNS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_ICU
+ "ENABLE_ICU",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_IOTRACE
+ "ENABLE_IOTRACE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_JSON1
+ "ENABLE_JSON1",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOAD_EXTENSION
+ "ENABLE_LOAD_EXTENSION",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ "ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT
+ "ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS3
+ "ENABLE_MEMSYS3",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS5
+ "ENABLE_MEMSYS5",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_MULTIPLEX
+ "ENABLE_MULTIPLEX",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_NORMALIZE
+ "ENABLE_NORMALIZE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_NULL_TRIM
+ "ENABLE_NULL_TRIM",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_OVERSIZE_CELL_CHECK
+ "ENABLE_OVERSIZE_CELL_CHECK",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_PREUPDATE_HOOK
+ "ENABLE_PREUPDATE_HOOK",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_QPSG
+ "ENABLE_QPSG",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_RBU
+ "ENABLE_RBU",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_RTREE
+ "ENABLE_RTREE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_SELECTTRACE
+ "ENABLE_SELECTTRACE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_SESSION
+ "ENABLE_SESSION",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_SNAPSHOT
+ "ENABLE_SNAPSHOT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_SORTER_REFERENCES
+ "ENABLE_SORTER_REFERENCES",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_SQLLOG
+ "ENABLE_SQLLOG",
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT4)
+ "ENABLE_STAT4",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_STMTVTAB
+ "ENABLE_STMTVTAB",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_STMT_SCANSTATUS
+ "ENABLE_STMT_SCANSTATUS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_UNKNOWN_SQL_FUNCTION
+ "ENABLE_UNKNOWN_SQL_FUNCTION",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_UNLOCK_NOTIFY
+ "ENABLE_UNLOCK_NOTIFY",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_UPDATE_DELETE_LIMIT
+ "ENABLE_UPDATE_DELETE_LIMIT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_URI_00_ERROR
+ "ENABLE_URI_00_ERROR",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_VFSTRACE
+ "ENABLE_VFSTRACE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_WHERETRACE
+ "ENABLE_WHERETRACE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_ZIPVFS
+ "ENABLE_ZIPVFS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_EXPLAIN_ESTIMATED_ROWS
+ "EXPLAIN_ESTIMATED_ROWS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_EXTRA_IFNULLROW
+ "EXTRA_IFNULLROW",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_EXTRA_INIT
+ "EXTRA_INIT=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_EXTRA_INIT),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_EXTRA_SHUTDOWN
+ "EXTRA_SHUTDOWN=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_EXTRA_SHUTDOWN),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_FTS3_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH
+ "FTS3_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_FTS3_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_FTS5_ENABLE_TEST_MI
+ "FTS5_ENABLE_TEST_MI",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_FTS5_NO_WITHOUT_ROWID
+ "FTS5_NO_WITHOUT_ROWID",
+#endif
+#if HAVE_ISNAN || SQLITE_HAVE_ISNAN
+ "HAVE_ISNAN",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_HOMEGROWN_RECURSIVE_MUTEX
+ "HOMEGROWN_RECURSIVE_MUTEX",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_IGNORE_AFP_LOCK_ERRORS
+ "IGNORE_AFP_LOCK_ERRORS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_IGNORE_FLOCK_LOCK_ERRORS
+ "IGNORE_FLOCK_LOCK_ERRORS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_INLINE_MEMCPY
+ "INLINE_MEMCPY",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_INT64_TYPE
+ "INT64_TYPE",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_INTEGRITY_CHECK_ERROR_MAX
+ "INTEGRITY_CHECK_ERROR_MAX=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_INTEGRITY_CHECK_ERROR_MAX),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_LIKE_DOESNT_MATCH_BLOBS
+ "LIKE_DOESNT_MATCH_BLOBS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_LOCK_TRACE
+ "LOCK_TRACE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_LOG_CACHE_SPILL
+ "LOG_CACHE_SPILL",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MALLOC_SOFT_LIMIT
+ "MALLOC_SOFT_LIMIT=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MALLOC_SOFT_LIMIT),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_ATTACHED
+ "MAX_ATTACHED=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_ATTACHED),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_COLUMN
+ "MAX_COLUMN=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_COLUMN),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT
+ "MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE
+ "MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH
+ "MAX_EXPR_DEPTH=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_FUNCTION_ARG
+ "MAX_FUNCTION_ARG=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_FUNCTION_ARG),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH
+ "MAX_LENGTH=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH
+ "MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_MEMORY
+ "MAX_MEMORY=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_MEMORY),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE
+ "MAX_MMAP_SIZE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE_
+ "MAX_MMAP_SIZE_=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE_),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_COUNT
+ "MAX_PAGE_COUNT=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_COUNT),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE
+ "MAX_PAGE_SIZE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_SCHEMA_RETRY
+ "MAX_SCHEMA_RETRY=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_SCHEMA_RETRY),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_SQL_LENGTH
+ "MAX_SQL_LENGTH=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_SQL_LENGTH),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_TRIGGER_DEPTH
+ "MAX_TRIGGER_DEPTH=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_TRIGGER_DEPTH),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER
+ "MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_VDBE_OP
+ "MAX_VDBE_OP=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_VDBE_OP),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS
+ "MAX_WORKER_THREADS=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MEMDEBUG
+ "MEMDEBUG",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MIXED_ENDIAN_64BIT_FLOAT
+ "MIXED_ENDIAN_64BIT_FLOAT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MMAP_READWRITE
+ "MMAP_READWRITE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP
+ "MUTEX_NOOP",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF
+ "MUTEX_NREF",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT
+ "MUTEX_OMIT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS
+ "MUTEX_PTHREADS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_W32
+ "MUTEX_W32",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_NEED_ERR_NAME
+ "NEED_ERR_NAME",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_NOINLINE
+ "NOINLINE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_NO_SYNC
+ "NO_SYNC",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_ALTERTABLE
+ "OMIT_ALTERTABLE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_ANALYZE
+ "OMIT_ANALYZE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_ATTACH
+ "OMIT_ATTACH",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
+ "OMIT_AUTHORIZATION",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINCREMENT
+ "OMIT_AUTOINCREMENT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ "OMIT_AUTOINIT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOMATIC_INDEX
+ "OMIT_AUTOMATIC_INDEX",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_AUTORESET
+ "OMIT_AUTORESET",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOVACUUM
+ "OMIT_AUTOVACUUM",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_BETWEEN_OPTIMIZATION
+ "OMIT_BETWEEN_OPTIMIZATION",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_BLOB_LITERAL
+ "OMIT_BLOB_LITERAL",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_CAST
+ "OMIT_CAST",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_CHECK
+ "OMIT_CHECK",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_COMPLETE
+ "OMIT_COMPLETE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_COMPOUND_SELECT
+ "OMIT_COMPOUND_SELECT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_CONFLICT_CLAUSE
+ "OMIT_CONFLICT_CLAUSE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_CTE
+ "OMIT_CTE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS
+ "OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_DECLTYPE
+ "OMIT_DECLTYPE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_DEPRECATED
+ "OMIT_DEPRECATED",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_DISKIO
+ "OMIT_DISKIO",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN
+ "OMIT_EXPLAIN",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_FLAG_PRAGMAS
+ "OMIT_FLAG_PRAGMAS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+ "OMIT_FLOATING_POINT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_FOREIGN_KEY
+ "OMIT_FOREIGN_KEY",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_GET_TABLE
+ "OMIT_GET_TABLE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_HEX_INTEGER
+ "OMIT_HEX_INTEGER",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_INCRBLOB
+ "OMIT_INCRBLOB",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_INTEGRITY_CHECK
+ "OMIT_INTEGRITY_CHECK",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_LIKE_OPTIMIZATION
+ "OMIT_LIKE_OPTIMIZATION",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION
+ "OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_LOCALTIME
+ "OMIT_LOCALTIME",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_LOOKASIDE
+ "OMIT_LOOKASIDE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_MEMORYDB
+ "OMIT_MEMORYDB",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_OR_OPTIMIZATION
+ "OMIT_OR_OPTIMIZATION",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_PAGER_PRAGMAS
+ "OMIT_PAGER_PRAGMAS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_PARSER_TRACE
+ "OMIT_PARSER_TRACE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_POPEN
+ "OMIT_POPEN",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_PRAGMA
+ "OMIT_PRAGMA",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_PROGRESS_CALLBACK
+ "OMIT_PROGRESS_CALLBACK",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_QUICKBALANCE
+ "OMIT_QUICKBALANCE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_REINDEX
+ "OMIT_REINDEX",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_SCHEMA_PRAGMAS
+ "OMIT_SCHEMA_PRAGMAS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_SCHEMA_VERSION_PRAGMAS
+ "OMIT_SCHEMA_VERSION_PRAGMAS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE
+ "OMIT_SHARED_CACHE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_SHUTDOWN_DIRECTORIES
+ "OMIT_SHUTDOWN_DIRECTORIES",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_SUBQUERY
+ "OMIT_SUBQUERY",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_TCL_VARIABLE
+ "OMIT_TCL_VARIABLE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_TEMPDB
+ "OMIT_TEMPDB",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_TEST_CONTROL
+ "OMIT_TEST_CONTROL",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_TRACE
+ "OMIT_TRACE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_TRIGGER
+ "OMIT_TRIGGER",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_TRUNCATE_OPTIMIZATION
+ "OMIT_TRUNCATE_OPTIMIZATION",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_UTF16
+ "OMIT_UTF16",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_VACUUM
+ "OMIT_VACUUM",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_VIEW
+ "OMIT_VIEW",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+ "OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ "OMIT_WAL",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_WSD
+ "OMIT_WSD",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OMIT_XFER_OPT
+ "OMIT_XFER_OPT",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_PCACHE_SEPARATE_HEADER
+ "PCACHE_SEPARATE_HEADER",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_PERFORMANCE_TRACE
+ "PERFORMANCE_TRACE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE
+ "POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_PREFER_PROXY_LOCKING
+ "PREFER_PROXY_LOCKING",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_PROXY_DEBUG
+ "PROXY_DEBUG",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_REVERSE_UNORDERED_SELECTS
+ "REVERSE_UNORDERED_SELECTS",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_RTREE_INT_ONLY
+ "RTREE_INT_ONLY",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_SECURE_DELETE
+ "SECURE_DELETE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_SMALL_STACK
+ "SMALL_STACK",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_SORTER_PMASZ
+ "SORTER_PMASZ=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_SORTER_PMASZ),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_SOUNDEX
+ "SOUNDEX",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_STAT4_SAMPLES
+ "STAT4_SAMPLES=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_STAT4_SAMPLES),
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_STMTJRNL_SPILL
+ "STMTJRNL_SPILL=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_STMTJRNL_SPILL),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_SUBSTR_COMPATIBILITY
+ "SUBSTR_COMPATIBILITY",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC
+ "SYSTEM_MALLOC",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_TCL
+ "TCL",
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEMP_STORE
+ "TEMP_STORE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_TEMP_STORE),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_TEST
+ "TEST",
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_THREADSAFE)
+ "THREADSAFE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(SQLITE_THREADSAFE),
+#elif defined(THREADSAFE)
+ "THREADSAFE=" CTIMEOPT_VAL(THREADSAFE),
+#else
+ "THREADSAFE=1",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_UNLINK_AFTER_CLOSE
+ "UNLINK_AFTER_CLOSE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+ "UNTESTABLE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_USER_AUTHENTICATION
+ "USER_AUTHENTICATION",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_USE_ALLOCA
+ "USE_ALLOCA",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_USE_FCNTL_TRACE
+ "USE_FCNTL_TRACE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_USE_URI
+ "USE_URI",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_VDBE_COVERAGE
+ "VDBE_COVERAGE",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC
+ "WIN32_MALLOC",
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ZERO_MALLOC
+ "ZERO_MALLOC",
+#endif
+/*
+** END CODE GENERATED BY tool/mkctime.tcl
+*/
+};
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char **sqlite3CompileOptions(int *pnOpt){
+ *pnOpt = sizeof(sqlite3azCompileOpt) / sizeof(sqlite3azCompileOpt[0]);
+ return (const char**)sqlite3azCompileOpt;
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_COMPILEOPTION_DIAGS */
+
+/************** End of ctime.c ***********************************************/
+/************** Begin file sqliteInt.h ***************************************/
+/*
+** 2001 September 15
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** Internal interface definitions for SQLite.
+**
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITEINT_H
+#define SQLITEINT_H
+
+/* Special Comments:
+**
+** Some comments have special meaning to the tools that measure test
+** coverage:
+**
+** NO_TEST - The branches on this line are not
+** measured by branch coverage. This is
+** used on lines of code that actually
+** implement parts of coverage testing.
+**
+** OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE - This branch is allowed to alway be false
+** and the correct answer is still obtained,
+** though perhaps more slowly.
+**
+** OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE - This branch is allowed to alway be true
+** and the correct answer is still obtained,
+** though perhaps more slowly.
+**
+** PREVENTS-HARMLESS-OVERREAD - This branch prevents a buffer overread
+** that would be harmless and undetectable
+** if it did occur.
+**
+** In all cases, the special comment must be enclosed in the usual
+** slash-asterisk...asterisk-slash comment marks, with no spaces between the
+** asterisks and the comment text.
+*/
+
+/*
+** Make sure the Tcl calling convention macro is defined. This macro is
+** only used by test code and Tcl integration code.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_TCLAPI
+# define SQLITE_TCLAPI
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Include the header file used to customize the compiler options for MSVC.
+** This should be done first so that it can successfully prevent spurious
+** compiler warnings due to subsequent content in this file and other files
+** that are included by this file.
+*/
+/************** Include msvc.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ******************/
+/************** Begin file msvc.h ********************************************/
+/*
+** 2015 January 12
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains code that is specific to MSVC.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MSVC_H
+#define SQLITE_MSVC_H
+
+#if defined(_MSC_VER)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4054)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4055)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4100)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4127)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4130)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4152)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4189)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4206)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4210)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4232)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4244)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4305)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4306)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4702)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4706)
+#endif /* defined(_MSC_VER) */
+
+#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_WIN64)
+#undef SQLITE_4_BYTE_ALIGNED_MALLOC
+#define SQLITE_4_BYTE_ALIGNED_MALLOC
+#endif /* defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_WIN64) */
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_MSVC_H */
+
+/************** End of msvc.h ************************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+
+/*
+** Special setup for VxWorks
+*/
+/************** Include vxworks.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ***************/
+/************** Begin file vxworks.h *****************************************/
+/*
+** 2015-03-02
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains code that is specific to Wind River's VxWorks
+*/
+#if defined(__RTP__) || defined(_WRS_KERNEL)
+/* This is VxWorks. Set up things specially for that OS
+*/
+#include
+#include /* amalgamator: dontcache */
+#define OS_VXWORKS 1
+#define SQLITE_OS_OTHER 0
+#define SQLITE_HOMEGROWN_RECURSIVE_MUTEX 1
+#define SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION 1
+#define SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE 0
+#define HAVE_UTIME 1
+#else
+/* This is not VxWorks. */
+#define OS_VXWORKS 0
+#define HAVE_FCHOWN 1
+#define HAVE_READLINK 1
+#define HAVE_LSTAT 1
+#endif /* defined(_WRS_KERNEL) */
+
+/************** End of vxworks.h *********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+
+/*
+** These #defines should enable >2GB file support on POSIX if the
+** underlying operating system supports it. If the OS lacks
+** large file support, or if the OS is windows, these should be no-ops.
+**
+** Ticket #2739: The _LARGEFILE_SOURCE macro must appear before any
+** system #includes. Hence, this block of code must be the very first
+** code in all source files.
+**
+** Large file support can be disabled using the -DSQLITE_DISABLE_LFS switch
+** on the compiler command line. This is necessary if you are compiling
+** on a recent machine (ex: Red Hat 7.2) but you want your code to work
+** on an older machine (ex: Red Hat 6.0). If you compile on Red Hat 7.2
+** without this option, LFS is enable. But LFS does not exist in the kernel
+** in Red Hat 6.0, so the code won't work. Hence, for maximum binary
+** portability you should omit LFS.
+**
+** The previous paragraph was written in 2005. (This paragraph is written
+** on 2008-11-28.) These days, all Linux kernels support large files, so
+** you should probably leave LFS enabled. But some embedded platforms might
+** lack LFS in which case the SQLITE_DISABLE_LFS macro might still be useful.
+**
+** Similar is true for Mac OS X. LFS is only supported on Mac OS X 9 and later.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DISABLE_LFS
+# define _LARGE_FILE 1
+# ifndef _FILE_OFFSET_BITS
+# define _FILE_OFFSET_BITS 64
+# endif
+# define _LARGEFILE_SOURCE 1
+#endif
+
+/* The GCC_VERSION and MSVC_VERSION macros are used to
+** conditionally include optimizations for each of these compilers. A
+** value of 0 means that compiler is not being used. The
+** SQLITE_DISABLE_INTRINSIC macro means do not use any compiler-specific
+** optimizations, and hence set all compiler macros to 0
+**
+** There was once also a CLANG_VERSION macro. However, we learn that the
+** version numbers in clang are for "marketing" only and are inconsistent
+** and unreliable. Fortunately, all versions of clang also recognize the
+** gcc version numbers and have reasonable settings for gcc version numbers,
+** so the GCC_VERSION macro will be set to a correct non-zero value even
+** when compiling with clang.
+*/
+#if defined(__GNUC__) && !defined(SQLITE_DISABLE_INTRINSIC)
+# define GCC_VERSION (__GNUC__*1000000+__GNUC_MINOR__*1000+__GNUC_PATCHLEVEL__)
+#else
+# define GCC_VERSION 0
+#endif
+#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(SQLITE_DISABLE_INTRINSIC)
+# define MSVC_VERSION _MSC_VER
+#else
+# define MSVC_VERSION 0
+#endif
+
+/* Needed for various definitions... */
+#if defined(__GNUC__) && !defined(_GNU_SOURCE)
+# define _GNU_SOURCE
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__OpenBSD__) && !defined(_BSD_SOURCE)
+# define _BSD_SOURCE
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Macro to disable warnings about missing "break" at the end of a "case".
+*/
+#if GCC_VERSION>=7000000
+# define deliberate_fall_through __attribute__((fallthrough));
+#else
+# define deliberate_fall_through
+#endif
+
+/*
+** For MinGW, check to see if we can include the header file containing its
+** version information, among other things. Normally, this internal MinGW
+** header file would [only] be included automatically by other MinGW header
+** files; however, the contained version information is now required by this
+** header file to work around binary compatibility issues (see below) and
+** this is the only known way to reliably obtain it. This entire #if block
+** would be completely unnecessary if there was any other way of detecting
+** MinGW via their preprocessor (e.g. if they customized their GCC to define
+** some MinGW-specific macros). When compiling for MinGW, either the
+** _HAVE_MINGW_H or _HAVE__MINGW_H (note the extra underscore) macro must be
+** defined; otherwise, detection of conditions specific to MinGW will be
+** disabled.
+*/
+#if defined(_HAVE_MINGW_H)
+# include "mingw.h"
+#elif defined(_HAVE__MINGW_H)
+# include "_mingw.h"
+#endif
+
+/*
+** For MinGW version 4.x (and higher), check to see if the _USE_32BIT_TIME_T
+** define is required to maintain binary compatibility with the MSVC runtime
+** library in use (e.g. for Windows XP).
+*/
+#if !defined(_USE_32BIT_TIME_T) && !defined(_USE_64BIT_TIME_T) && \
+ defined(_WIN32) && !defined(_WIN64) && \
+ defined(__MINGW_MAJOR_VERSION) && __MINGW_MAJOR_VERSION >= 4 && \
+ defined(__MSVCRT__)
+# define _USE_32BIT_TIME_T
+#endif
+
+/* The public SQLite interface. The _FILE_OFFSET_BITS macro must appear
+** first in QNX. Also, the _USE_32BIT_TIME_T macro must appear first for
+** MinGW.
+*/
+/************** Include sqlite3.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ***************/
+/************** Begin file sqlite3.h *****************************************/
+/*
+** 2001-09-15
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This header file defines the interface that the SQLite library
+** presents to client programs. If a C-function, structure, datatype,
+** or constant definition does not appear in this file, then it is
+** not a published API of SQLite, is subject to change without
+** notice, and should not be referenced by programs that use SQLite.
+**
+** Some of the definitions that are in this file are marked as
+** "experimental". Experimental interfaces are normally new
+** features recently added to SQLite. We do not anticipate changes
+** to experimental interfaces but reserve the right to make minor changes
+** if experience from use "in the wild" suggest such changes are prudent.
+**
+** The official C-language API documentation for SQLite is derived
+** from comments in this file. This file is the authoritative source
+** on how SQLite interfaces are supposed to operate.
+**
+** The name of this file under configuration management is "sqlite.h.in".
+** The makefile makes some minor changes to this file (such as inserting
+** the version number) and changes its name to "sqlite3.h" as
+** part of the build process.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE3_H
+#define SQLITE3_H
+#include /* Needed for the definition of va_list */
+
+/*
+** Make sure we can call this stuff from C++.
+*/
+#if 0
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+** Provide the ability to override linkage features of the interface.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_EXTERN
+# define SQLITE_EXTERN extern
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_API
+# define SQLITE_API
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_CDECL
+# define SQLITE_CDECL
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_APICALL
+# define SQLITE_APICALL
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_STDCALL
+# define SQLITE_STDCALL SQLITE_APICALL
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_CALLBACK
+# define SQLITE_CALLBACK
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_SYSAPI
+# define SQLITE_SYSAPI
+#endif
+
+/*
+** These no-op macros are used in front of interfaces to mark those
+** interfaces as either deprecated or experimental. New applications
+** should not use deprecated interfaces - they are supported for backwards
+** compatibility only. Application writers should be aware that
+** experimental interfaces are subject to change in point releases.
+**
+** These macros used to resolve to various kinds of compiler magic that
+** would generate warning messages when they were used. But that
+** compiler magic ended up generating such a flurry of bug reports
+** that we have taken it all out and gone back to using simple
+** noop macros.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_DEPRECATED
+#define SQLITE_EXPERIMENTAL
+
+/*
+** Ensure these symbols were not defined by some previous header file.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_VERSION
+# undef SQLITE_VERSION
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER
+# undef SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER
+#endif
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Compile-Time Library Version Numbers
+**
+** ^(The [SQLITE_VERSION] C preprocessor macro in the sqlite3.h header
+** evaluates to a string literal that is the SQLite version in the
+** format "X.Y.Z" where X is the major version number (always 3 for
+** SQLite3) and Y is the minor version number and Z is the release number.)^
+** ^(The [SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER] C preprocessor macro resolves to an integer
+** with the value (X*1000000 + Y*1000 + Z) where X, Y, and Z are the same
+** numbers used in [SQLITE_VERSION].)^
+** The SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER for any given release of SQLite will also
+** be larger than the release from which it is derived. Either Y will
+** be held constant and Z will be incremented or else Y will be incremented
+** and Z will be reset to zero.
+**
+** Since [version 3.6.18] ([dateof:3.6.18]),
+** SQLite source code has been stored in the
+** Fossil configuration management
+** system. ^The SQLITE_SOURCE_ID macro evaluates to
+** a string which identifies a particular check-in of SQLite
+** within its configuration management system. ^The SQLITE_SOURCE_ID
+** string contains the date and time of the check-in (UTC) and a SHA1
+** or SHA3-256 hash of the entire source tree. If the source code has
+** been edited in any way since it was last checked in, then the last
+** four hexadecimal digits of the hash may be modified.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_libversion()],
+** [sqlite3_libversion_number()], [sqlite3_sourceid()],
+** [sqlite_version()] and [sqlite_source_id()].
+*/
+#define SQLITE_VERSION "3.33.0"
+#define SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER 3033000
+#define SQLITE_SOURCE_ID "2020-08-14 13:23:32 fca8dc8b578f215a969cd899336378966156154710873e68b3d9ac5881b0ff3f"
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Run-Time Library Version Numbers
+** KEYWORDS: sqlite3_version sqlite3_sourceid
+**
+** These interfaces provide the same information as the [SQLITE_VERSION],
+** [SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER], and [SQLITE_SOURCE_ID] C preprocessor macros
+** but are associated with the library instead of the header file. ^(Cautious
+** programmers might include assert() statements in their application to
+** verify that values returned by these interfaces match the macros in
+** the header, and thus ensure that the application is
+** compiled with matching library and header files.
+**
+**
)^
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_version[] string constant contains the text of [SQLITE_VERSION]
+** macro. ^The sqlite3_libversion() function returns a pointer to the
+** to the sqlite3_version[] string constant. The sqlite3_libversion()
+** function is provided for use in DLLs since DLL users usually do not have
+** direct access to string constants within the DLL. ^The
+** sqlite3_libversion_number() function returns an integer equal to
+** [SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER]. ^(The sqlite3_sourceid() function returns
+** a pointer to a string constant whose value is the same as the
+** [SQLITE_SOURCE_ID] C preprocessor macro. Except if SQLite is built
+** using an edited copy of [the amalgamation], then the last four characters
+** of the hash might be different from [SQLITE_SOURCE_ID].)^
+**
+** See also: [sqlite_version()] and [sqlite_source_id()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API const char sqlite3_version[] = SQLITE_VERSION;
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_libversion(void);
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_sourceid(void);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_libversion_number(void);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Run-Time Library Compilation Options Diagnostics
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_compileoption_used() function returns 0 or 1
+** indicating whether the specified option was defined at
+** compile time. ^The SQLITE_ prefix may be omitted from the
+** option name passed to sqlite3_compileoption_used().
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_compileoption_get() function allows iterating
+** over the list of options that were defined at compile time by
+** returning the N-th compile time option string. ^If N is out of range,
+** sqlite3_compileoption_get() returns a NULL pointer. ^The SQLITE_
+** prefix is omitted from any strings returned by
+** sqlite3_compileoption_get().
+**
+** ^Support for the diagnostic functions sqlite3_compileoption_used()
+** and sqlite3_compileoption_get() may be omitted by specifying the
+** [SQLITE_OMIT_COMPILEOPTION_DIAGS] option at compile time.
+**
+** See also: SQL functions [sqlite_compileoption_used()] and
+** [sqlite_compileoption_get()] and the [compile_options pragma].
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_COMPILEOPTION_DIAGS
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_compileoption_used(const char *zOptName);
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_compileoption_get(int N);
+#else
+# define sqlite3_compileoption_used(X) 0
+# define sqlite3_compileoption_get(X) ((void*)0)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Test To See If The Library Is Threadsafe
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_threadsafe() function returns zero if and only if
+** SQLite was compiled with mutexing code omitted due to the
+** [SQLITE_THREADSAFE] compile-time option being set to 0.
+**
+** SQLite can be compiled with or without mutexes. When
+** the [SQLITE_THREADSAFE] C preprocessor macro is 1 or 2, mutexes
+** are enabled and SQLite is threadsafe. When the
+** [SQLITE_THREADSAFE] macro is 0,
+** the mutexes are omitted. Without the mutexes, it is not safe
+** to use SQLite concurrently from more than one thread.
+**
+** Enabling mutexes incurs a measurable performance penalty.
+** So if speed is of utmost importance, it makes sense to disable
+** the mutexes. But for maximum safety, mutexes should be enabled.
+** ^The default behavior is for mutexes to be enabled.
+**
+** This interface can be used by an application to make sure that the
+** version of SQLite that it is linking against was compiled with
+** the desired setting of the [SQLITE_THREADSAFE] macro.
+**
+** This interface only reports on the compile-time mutex setting
+** of the [SQLITE_THREADSAFE] flag. If SQLite is compiled with
+** SQLITE_THREADSAFE=1 or =2 then mutexes are enabled by default but
+** can be fully or partially disabled using a call to [sqlite3_config()]
+** with the verbs [SQLITE_CONFIG_SINGLETHREAD], [SQLITE_CONFIG_MULTITHREAD],
+** or [SQLITE_CONFIG_SERIALIZED]. ^(The return value of the
+** sqlite3_threadsafe() function shows only the compile-time setting of
+** thread safety, not any run-time changes to that setting made by
+** sqlite3_config(). In other words, the return value from sqlite3_threadsafe()
+** is unchanged by calls to sqlite3_config().)^
+**
+** See the [threading mode] documentation for additional information.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_threadsafe(void);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Database Connection Handle
+** KEYWORDS: {database connection} {database connections}
+**
+** Each open SQLite database is represented by a pointer to an instance of
+** the opaque structure named "sqlite3". It is useful to think of an sqlite3
+** pointer as an object. The [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open16()], and
+** [sqlite3_open_v2()] interfaces are its constructors, and [sqlite3_close()]
+** and [sqlite3_close_v2()] are its destructors. There are many other
+** interfaces (such as
+** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()], [sqlite3_create_function()], and
+** [sqlite3_busy_timeout()] to name but three) that are methods on an
+** sqlite3 object.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3 sqlite3;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: 64-Bit Integer Types
+** KEYWORDS: sqlite_int64 sqlite_uint64
+**
+** Because there is no cross-platform way to specify 64-bit integer types
+** SQLite includes typedefs for 64-bit signed and unsigned integers.
+**
+** The sqlite3_int64 and sqlite3_uint64 are the preferred type definitions.
+** The sqlite_int64 and sqlite_uint64 types are supported for backwards
+** compatibility only.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_int64 and sqlite_int64 types can store integer values
+** between -9223372036854775808 and +9223372036854775807 inclusive. ^The
+** sqlite3_uint64 and sqlite_uint64 types can store integer values
+** between 0 and +18446744073709551615 inclusive.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_INT64_TYPE
+ typedef SQLITE_INT64_TYPE sqlite_int64;
+# ifdef SQLITE_UINT64_TYPE
+ typedef SQLITE_UINT64_TYPE sqlite_uint64;
+# else
+ typedef unsigned SQLITE_INT64_TYPE sqlite_uint64;
+# endif
+#elif defined(_MSC_VER) || defined(__BORLANDC__)
+ typedef __int64 sqlite_int64;
+ typedef unsigned __int64 sqlite_uint64;
+#else
+ typedef long long int sqlite_int64;
+ typedef unsigned long long int sqlite_uint64;
+#endif
+typedef sqlite_int64 sqlite3_int64;
+typedef sqlite_uint64 sqlite3_uint64;
+
+/*
+** If compiling for a processor that lacks floating point support,
+** substitute integer for floating-point.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+# define double sqlite3_int64
+#endif
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Closing A Database Connection
+** DESTRUCTOR: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_close() and sqlite3_close_v2() routines are destructors
+** for the [sqlite3] object.
+** ^Calls to sqlite3_close() and sqlite3_close_v2() return [SQLITE_OK] if
+** the [sqlite3] object is successfully destroyed and all associated
+** resources are deallocated.
+**
+** Ideally, applications should [sqlite3_finalize | finalize] all
+** [prepared statements], [sqlite3_blob_close | close] all [BLOB handles], and
+** [sqlite3_backup_finish | finish] all [sqlite3_backup] objects associated
+** with the [sqlite3] object prior to attempting to close the object.
+** ^If the database connection is associated with unfinalized prepared
+** statements, BLOB handlers, and/or unfinished sqlite3_backup objects then
+** sqlite3_close() will leave the database connection open and return
+** [SQLITE_BUSY]. ^If sqlite3_close_v2() is called with unfinalized prepared
+** statements, unclosed BLOB handlers, and/or unfinished sqlite3_backups,
+** it returns [SQLITE_OK] regardless, but instead of deallocating the database
+** connection immediately, it marks the database connection as an unusable
+** "zombie" and makes arrangements to automatically deallocate the database
+** connection after all prepared statements are finalized, all BLOB handles
+** are closed, and all backups have finished. The sqlite3_close_v2() interface
+** is intended for use with host languages that are garbage collected, and
+** where the order in which destructors are called is arbitrary.
+**
+** ^If an [sqlite3] object is destroyed while a transaction is open,
+** the transaction is automatically rolled back.
+**
+** The C parameter to [sqlite3_close(C)] and [sqlite3_close_v2(C)]
+** must be either a NULL
+** pointer or an [sqlite3] object pointer obtained
+** from [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open16()], or
+** [sqlite3_open_v2()], and not previously closed.
+** ^Calling sqlite3_close() or sqlite3_close_v2() with a NULL pointer
+** argument is a harmless no-op.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_close(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_close_v2(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** The type for a callback function.
+** This is legacy and deprecated. It is included for historical
+** compatibility and is not documented.
+*/
+typedef int (*sqlite3_callback)(void*,int,char**, char**);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: One-Step Query Execution Interface
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** The sqlite3_exec() interface is a convenience wrapper around
+** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()], [sqlite3_step()], and [sqlite3_finalize()],
+** that allows an application to run multiple statements of SQL
+** without having to use a lot of C code.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_exec() interface runs zero or more UTF-8 encoded,
+** semicolon-separate SQL statements passed into its 2nd argument,
+** in the context of the [database connection] passed in as its 1st
+** argument. ^If the callback function of the 3rd argument to
+** sqlite3_exec() is not NULL, then it is invoked for each result row
+** coming out of the evaluated SQL statements. ^The 4th argument to
+** sqlite3_exec() is relayed through to the 1st argument of each
+** callback invocation. ^If the callback pointer to sqlite3_exec()
+** is NULL, then no callback is ever invoked and result rows are
+** ignored.
+**
+** ^If an error occurs while evaluating the SQL statements passed into
+** sqlite3_exec(), then execution of the current statement stops and
+** subsequent statements are skipped. ^If the 5th parameter to sqlite3_exec()
+** is not NULL then any error message is written into memory obtained
+** from [sqlite3_malloc()] and passed back through the 5th parameter.
+** To avoid memory leaks, the application should invoke [sqlite3_free()]
+** on error message strings returned through the 5th parameter of
+** sqlite3_exec() after the error message string is no longer needed.
+** ^If the 5th parameter to sqlite3_exec() is not NULL and no errors
+** occur, then sqlite3_exec() sets the pointer in its 5th parameter to
+** NULL before returning.
+**
+** ^If an sqlite3_exec() callback returns non-zero, the sqlite3_exec()
+** routine returns SQLITE_ABORT without invoking the callback again and
+** without running any subsequent SQL statements.
+**
+** ^The 2nd argument to the sqlite3_exec() callback function is the
+** number of columns in the result. ^The 3rd argument to the sqlite3_exec()
+** callback is an array of pointers to strings obtained as if from
+** [sqlite3_column_text()], one for each column. ^If an element of a
+** result row is NULL then the corresponding string pointer for the
+** sqlite3_exec() callback is a NULL pointer. ^The 4th argument to the
+** sqlite3_exec() callback is an array of pointers to strings where each
+** entry represents the name of corresponding result column as obtained
+** from [sqlite3_column_name()].
+**
+** ^If the 2nd parameter to sqlite3_exec() is a NULL pointer, a pointer
+** to an empty string, or a pointer that contains only whitespace and/or
+** SQL comments, then no SQL statements are evaluated and the database
+** is not changed.
+**
+** Restrictions:
+**
+**
+**
The application must ensure that the 1st parameter to sqlite3_exec()
+** is a valid and open [database connection].
+**
The application must not close the [database connection] specified by
+** the 1st parameter to sqlite3_exec() while sqlite3_exec() is running.
+**
The application must not modify the SQL statement text passed into
+** the 2nd parameter of sqlite3_exec() while sqlite3_exec() is running.
+**
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_exec(
+ sqlite3*, /* An open database */
+ const char *sql, /* SQL to be evaluated */
+ int (*callback)(void*,int,char**,char**), /* Callback function */
+ void *, /* 1st argument to callback */
+ char **errmsg /* Error msg written here */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Result Codes
+** KEYWORDS: {result code definitions}
+**
+** Many SQLite functions return an integer result code from the set shown
+** here in order to indicate success or failure.
+**
+** New error codes may be added in future versions of SQLite.
+**
+** See also: [extended result code definitions]
+*/
+#define SQLITE_OK 0 /* Successful result */
+/* beginning-of-error-codes */
+#define SQLITE_ERROR 1 /* Generic error */
+#define SQLITE_INTERNAL 2 /* Internal logic error in SQLite */
+#define SQLITE_PERM 3 /* Access permission denied */
+#define SQLITE_ABORT 4 /* Callback routine requested an abort */
+#define SQLITE_BUSY 5 /* The database file is locked */
+#define SQLITE_LOCKED 6 /* A table in the database is locked */
+#define SQLITE_NOMEM 7 /* A malloc() failed */
+#define SQLITE_READONLY 8 /* Attempt to write a readonly database */
+#define SQLITE_INTERRUPT 9 /* Operation terminated by sqlite3_interrupt()*/
+#define SQLITE_IOERR 10 /* Some kind of disk I/O error occurred */
+#define SQLITE_CORRUPT 11 /* The database disk image is malformed */
+#define SQLITE_NOTFOUND 12 /* Unknown opcode in sqlite3_file_control() */
+#define SQLITE_FULL 13 /* Insertion failed because database is full */
+#define SQLITE_CANTOPEN 14 /* Unable to open the database file */
+#define SQLITE_PROTOCOL 15 /* Database lock protocol error */
+#define SQLITE_EMPTY 16 /* Internal use only */
+#define SQLITE_SCHEMA 17 /* The database schema changed */
+#define SQLITE_TOOBIG 18 /* String or BLOB exceeds size limit */
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT 19 /* Abort due to constraint violation */
+#define SQLITE_MISMATCH 20 /* Data type mismatch */
+#define SQLITE_MISUSE 21 /* Library used incorrectly */
+#define SQLITE_NOLFS 22 /* Uses OS features not supported on host */
+#define SQLITE_AUTH 23 /* Authorization denied */
+#define SQLITE_FORMAT 24 /* Not used */
+#define SQLITE_RANGE 25 /* 2nd parameter to sqlite3_bind out of range */
+#define SQLITE_NOTADB 26 /* File opened that is not a database file */
+#define SQLITE_NOTICE 27 /* Notifications from sqlite3_log() */
+#define SQLITE_WARNING 28 /* Warnings from sqlite3_log() */
+#define SQLITE_ROW 100 /* sqlite3_step() has another row ready */
+#define SQLITE_DONE 101 /* sqlite3_step() has finished executing */
+/* end-of-error-codes */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Extended Result Codes
+** KEYWORDS: {extended result code definitions}
+**
+** In its default configuration, SQLite API routines return one of 30 integer
+** [result codes]. However, experience has shown that many of
+** these result codes are too coarse-grained. They do not provide as
+** much information about problems as programmers might like. In an effort to
+** address this, newer versions of SQLite (version 3.3.8 [dateof:3.3.8]
+** and later) include
+** support for additional result codes that provide more detailed information
+** about errors. These [extended result codes] are enabled or disabled
+** on a per database connection basis using the
+** [sqlite3_extended_result_codes()] API. Or, the extended code for
+** the most recent error can be obtained using
+** [sqlite3_extended_errcode()].
+*/
+#define SQLITE_ERROR_MISSING_COLLSEQ (SQLITE_ERROR | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_ERROR_RETRY (SQLITE_ERROR | (2<<8))
+#define SQLITE_ERROR_SNAPSHOT (SQLITE_ERROR | (3<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_READ (SQLITE_IOERR | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ (SQLITE_IOERR | (2<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_WRITE (SQLITE_IOERR | (3<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_FSYNC (SQLITE_IOERR | (4<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_DIR_FSYNC (SQLITE_IOERR | (5<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_TRUNCATE (SQLITE_IOERR | (6<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT (SQLITE_IOERR | (7<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK (SQLITE_IOERR | (8<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_RDLOCK (SQLITE_IOERR | (9<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE (SQLITE_IOERR | (10<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_BLOCKED (SQLITE_IOERR | (11<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM (SQLITE_IOERR | (12<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_ACCESS (SQLITE_IOERR | (13<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_CHECKRESERVEDLOCK (SQLITE_IOERR | (14<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK (SQLITE_IOERR | (15<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_CLOSE (SQLITE_IOERR | (16<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_DIR_CLOSE (SQLITE_IOERR | (17<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_SHMOPEN (SQLITE_IOERR | (18<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_SHMSIZE (SQLITE_IOERR | (19<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_SHMLOCK (SQLITE_IOERR | (20<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_SHMMAP (SQLITE_IOERR | (21<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_SEEK (SQLITE_IOERR | (22<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE_NOENT (SQLITE_IOERR | (23<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_MMAP (SQLITE_IOERR | (24<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_GETTEMPPATH (SQLITE_IOERR | (25<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_CONVPATH (SQLITE_IOERR | (26<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_VNODE (SQLITE_IOERR | (27<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_AUTH (SQLITE_IOERR | (28<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_BEGIN_ATOMIC (SQLITE_IOERR | (29<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_COMMIT_ATOMIC (SQLITE_IOERR | (30<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_ROLLBACK_ATOMIC (SQLITE_IOERR | (31<<8))
+#define SQLITE_IOERR_DATA (SQLITE_IOERR | (32<<8))
+#define SQLITE_LOCKED_SHAREDCACHE (SQLITE_LOCKED | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_LOCKED_VTAB (SQLITE_LOCKED | (2<<8))
+#define SQLITE_BUSY_RECOVERY (SQLITE_BUSY | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_BUSY_SNAPSHOT (SQLITE_BUSY | (2<<8))
+#define SQLITE_BUSY_TIMEOUT (SQLITE_BUSY | (3<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CANTOPEN_NOTEMPDIR (SQLITE_CANTOPEN | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CANTOPEN_ISDIR (SQLITE_CANTOPEN | (2<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CANTOPEN_FULLPATH (SQLITE_CANTOPEN | (3<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CANTOPEN_CONVPATH (SQLITE_CANTOPEN | (4<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CANTOPEN_DIRTYWAL (SQLITE_CANTOPEN | (5<<8)) /* Not Used */
+#define SQLITE_CANTOPEN_SYMLINK (SQLITE_CANTOPEN | (6<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CORRUPT_VTAB (SQLITE_CORRUPT | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CORRUPT_SEQUENCE (SQLITE_CORRUPT | (2<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CORRUPT_INDEX (SQLITE_CORRUPT | (3<<8))
+#define SQLITE_READONLY_RECOVERY (SQLITE_READONLY | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_READONLY_CANTLOCK (SQLITE_READONLY | (2<<8))
+#define SQLITE_READONLY_ROLLBACK (SQLITE_READONLY | (3<<8))
+#define SQLITE_READONLY_DBMOVED (SQLITE_READONLY | (4<<8))
+#define SQLITE_READONLY_CANTINIT (SQLITE_READONLY | (5<<8))
+#define SQLITE_READONLY_DIRECTORY (SQLITE_READONLY | (6<<8))
+#define SQLITE_ABORT_ROLLBACK (SQLITE_ABORT | (2<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_CHECK (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_COMMITHOOK (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT | (2<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_FOREIGNKEY (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT | (3<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_FUNCTION (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT | (4<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_NOTNULL (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT | (5<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_PRIMARYKEY (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT | (6<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_TRIGGER (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT | (7<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_UNIQUE (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT | (8<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_VTAB (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT | (9<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_ROWID (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT |(10<<8))
+#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT_PINNED (SQLITE_CONSTRAINT |(11<<8))
+#define SQLITE_NOTICE_RECOVER_WAL (SQLITE_NOTICE | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_NOTICE_RECOVER_ROLLBACK (SQLITE_NOTICE | (2<<8))
+#define SQLITE_WARNING_AUTOINDEX (SQLITE_WARNING | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_AUTH_USER (SQLITE_AUTH | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_OK_LOAD_PERMANENTLY (SQLITE_OK | (1<<8))
+#define SQLITE_OK_SYMLINK (SQLITE_OK | (2<<8))
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Flags For File Open Operations
+**
+** These bit values are intended for use in the
+** 3rd parameter to the [sqlite3_open_v2()] interface and
+** in the 4th parameter to the [sqlite3_vfs.xOpen] method.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY 0x00000001 /* Ok for sqlite3_open_v2() */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE 0x00000002 /* Ok for sqlite3_open_v2() */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE 0x00000004 /* Ok for sqlite3_open_v2() */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE 0x00000008 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE 0x00000010 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_AUTOPROXY 0x00000020 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_URI 0x00000040 /* Ok for sqlite3_open_v2() */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_MEMORY 0x00000080 /* Ok for sqlite3_open_v2() */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB 0x00000100 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_DB 0x00000200 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_TRANSIENT_DB 0x00000400 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL 0x00000800 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_JOURNAL 0x00001000 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_SUBJOURNAL 0x00002000 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_SUPER_JOURNAL 0x00004000 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_NOMUTEX 0x00008000 /* Ok for sqlite3_open_v2() */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_FULLMUTEX 0x00010000 /* Ok for sqlite3_open_v2() */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_SHAREDCACHE 0x00020000 /* Ok for sqlite3_open_v2() */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_PRIVATECACHE 0x00040000 /* Ok for sqlite3_open_v2() */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_WAL 0x00080000 /* VFS only */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_NOFOLLOW 0x01000000 /* Ok for sqlite3_open_v2() */
+
+/* Reserved: 0x00F00000 */
+/* Legacy compatibility: */
+#define SQLITE_OPEN_MASTER_JOURNAL 0x00004000 /* VFS only */
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Device Characteristics
+**
+** The xDeviceCharacteristics method of the [sqlite3_io_methods]
+** object returns an integer which is a vector of these
+** bit values expressing I/O characteristics of the mass storage
+** device that holds the file that the [sqlite3_io_methods]
+** refers to.
+**
+** The SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC property means that all writes of
+** any size are atomic. The SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMICnnn values
+** mean that writes of blocks that are nnn bytes in size and
+** are aligned to an address which is an integer multiple of
+** nnn are atomic. The SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND value means
+** that when data is appended to a file, the data is appended
+** first then the size of the file is extended, never the other
+** way around. The SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL property means that
+** information is written to disk in the same order as calls
+** to xWrite(). The SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE property means that
+** after reboot following a crash or power loss, the only bytes in a
+** file that were written at the application level might have changed
+** and that adjacent bytes, even bytes within the same sector are
+** guaranteed to be unchanged. The SQLITE_IOCAP_UNDELETABLE_WHEN_OPEN
+** flag indicates that a file cannot be deleted when open. The
+** SQLITE_IOCAP_IMMUTABLE flag indicates that the file is on
+** read-only media and cannot be changed even by processes with
+** elevated privileges.
+**
+** The SQLITE_IOCAP_BATCH_ATOMIC property means that the underlying
+** filesystem supports doing multiple write operations atomically when those
+** write operations are bracketed by [SQLITE_FCNTL_BEGIN_ATOMIC_WRITE] and
+** [SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_ATOMIC_WRITE].
+*/
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC 0x00000001
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC512 0x00000002
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC1K 0x00000004
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC2K 0x00000008
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC4K 0x00000010
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC8K 0x00000020
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC16K 0x00000040
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC32K 0x00000080
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC64K 0x00000100
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND 0x00000200
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL 0x00000400
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_UNDELETABLE_WHEN_OPEN 0x00000800
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE 0x00001000
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_IMMUTABLE 0x00002000
+#define SQLITE_IOCAP_BATCH_ATOMIC 0x00004000
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: File Locking Levels
+**
+** SQLite uses one of these integer values as the second
+** argument to calls it makes to the xLock() and xUnlock() methods
+** of an [sqlite3_io_methods] object.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_LOCK_NONE 0
+#define SQLITE_LOCK_SHARED 1
+#define SQLITE_LOCK_RESERVED 2
+#define SQLITE_LOCK_PENDING 3
+#define SQLITE_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE 4
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Synchronization Type Flags
+**
+** When SQLite invokes the xSync() method of an
+** [sqlite3_io_methods] object it uses a combination of
+** these integer values as the second argument.
+**
+** When the SQLITE_SYNC_DATAONLY flag is used, it means that the
+** sync operation only needs to flush data to mass storage. Inode
+** information need not be flushed. If the lower four bits of the flag
+** equal SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL, that means to use normal fsync() semantics.
+** If the lower four bits equal SQLITE_SYNC_FULL, that means
+** to use Mac OS X style fullsync instead of fsync().
+**
+** Do not confuse the SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL and SQLITE_SYNC_FULL flags
+** with the [PRAGMA synchronous]=NORMAL and [PRAGMA synchronous]=FULL
+** settings. The [synchronous pragma] determines when calls to the
+** xSync VFS method occur and applies uniformly across all platforms.
+** The SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL and SQLITE_SYNC_FULL flags determine how
+** energetic or rigorous or forceful the sync operations are and
+** only make a difference on Mac OSX for the default SQLite code.
+** (Third-party VFS implementations might also make the distinction
+** between SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL and SQLITE_SYNC_FULL, but among the
+** operating systems natively supported by SQLite, only Mac OSX
+** cares about the difference.)
+*/
+#define SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL 0x00002
+#define SQLITE_SYNC_FULL 0x00003
+#define SQLITE_SYNC_DATAONLY 0x00010
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: OS Interface Open File Handle
+**
+** An [sqlite3_file] object represents an open file in the
+** [sqlite3_vfs | OS interface layer]. Individual OS interface
+** implementations will
+** want to subclass this object by appending additional fields
+** for their own use. The pMethods entry is a pointer to an
+** [sqlite3_io_methods] object that defines methods for performing
+** I/O operations on the open file.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_file sqlite3_file;
+struct sqlite3_file {
+ const struct sqlite3_io_methods *pMethods; /* Methods for an open file */
+};
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: OS Interface File Virtual Methods Object
+**
+** Every file opened by the [sqlite3_vfs.xOpen] method populates an
+** [sqlite3_file] object (or, more commonly, a subclass of the
+** [sqlite3_file] object) with a pointer to an instance of this object.
+** This object defines the methods used to perform various operations
+** against the open file represented by the [sqlite3_file] object.
+**
+** If the [sqlite3_vfs.xOpen] method sets the sqlite3_file.pMethods element
+** to a non-NULL pointer, then the sqlite3_io_methods.xClose method
+** may be invoked even if the [sqlite3_vfs.xOpen] reported that it failed. The
+** only way to prevent a call to xClose following a failed [sqlite3_vfs.xOpen]
+** is for the [sqlite3_vfs.xOpen] to set the sqlite3_file.pMethods element
+** to NULL.
+**
+** The flags argument to xSync may be one of [SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL] or
+** [SQLITE_SYNC_FULL]. The first choice is the normal fsync().
+** The second choice is a Mac OS X style fullsync. The [SQLITE_SYNC_DATAONLY]
+** flag may be ORed in to indicate that only the data of the file
+** and not its inode needs to be synced.
+**
+** The integer values to xLock() and xUnlock() are one of
+**
+**
[SQLITE_LOCK_NONE],
+**
[SQLITE_LOCK_SHARED],
+**
[SQLITE_LOCK_RESERVED],
+**
[SQLITE_LOCK_PENDING], or
+**
[SQLITE_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE].
+**
+** xLock() increases the lock. xUnlock() decreases the lock.
+** The xCheckReservedLock() method checks whether any database connection,
+** either in this process or in some other process, is holding a RESERVED,
+** PENDING, or EXCLUSIVE lock on the file. It returns true
+** if such a lock exists and false otherwise.
+**
+** The xFileControl() method is a generic interface that allows custom
+** VFS implementations to directly control an open file using the
+** [sqlite3_file_control()] interface. The second "op" argument is an
+** integer opcode. The third argument is a generic pointer intended to
+** point to a structure that may contain arguments or space in which to
+** write return values. Potential uses for xFileControl() might be
+** functions to enable blocking locks with timeouts, to change the
+** locking strategy (for example to use dot-file locks), to inquire
+** about the status of a lock, or to break stale locks. The SQLite
+** core reserves all opcodes less than 100 for its own use.
+** A [file control opcodes | list of opcodes] less than 100 is available.
+** Applications that define a custom xFileControl method should use opcodes
+** greater than 100 to avoid conflicts. VFS implementations should
+** return [SQLITE_NOTFOUND] for file control opcodes that they do not
+** recognize.
+**
+** The xSectorSize() method returns the sector size of the
+** device that underlies the file. The sector size is the
+** minimum write that can be performed without disturbing
+** other bytes in the file. The xDeviceCharacteristics()
+** method returns a bit vector describing behaviors of the
+** underlying device:
+**
+**
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC512]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC1K]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC2K]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC4K]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC8K]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC16K]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC32K]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC64K]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_UNDELETABLE_WHEN_OPEN]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_IMMUTABLE]
+**
[SQLITE_IOCAP_BATCH_ATOMIC]
+**
+**
+** The SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC property means that all writes of
+** any size are atomic. The SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMICnnn values
+** mean that writes of blocks that are nnn bytes in size and
+** are aligned to an address which is an integer multiple of
+** nnn are atomic. The SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND value means
+** that when data is appended to a file, the data is appended
+** first then the size of the file is extended, never the other
+** way around. The SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL property means that
+** information is written to disk in the same order as calls
+** to xWrite().
+**
+** If xRead() returns SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ it must also fill
+** in the unread portions of the buffer with zeros. A VFS that
+** fails to zero-fill short reads might seem to work. However,
+** failure to zero-fill short reads will eventually lead to
+** database corruption.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_io_methods sqlite3_io_methods;
+struct sqlite3_io_methods {
+ int iVersion;
+ int (*xClose)(sqlite3_file*);
+ int (*xRead)(sqlite3_file*, void*, int iAmt, sqlite3_int64 iOfst);
+ int (*xWrite)(sqlite3_file*, const void*, int iAmt, sqlite3_int64 iOfst);
+ int (*xTruncate)(sqlite3_file*, sqlite3_int64 size);
+ int (*xSync)(sqlite3_file*, int flags);
+ int (*xFileSize)(sqlite3_file*, sqlite3_int64 *pSize);
+ int (*xLock)(sqlite3_file*, int);
+ int (*xUnlock)(sqlite3_file*, int);
+ int (*xCheckReservedLock)(sqlite3_file*, int *pResOut);
+ int (*xFileControl)(sqlite3_file*, int op, void *pArg);
+ int (*xSectorSize)(sqlite3_file*);
+ int (*xDeviceCharacteristics)(sqlite3_file*);
+ /* Methods above are valid for version 1 */
+ int (*xShmMap)(sqlite3_file*, int iPg, int pgsz, int, void volatile**);
+ int (*xShmLock)(sqlite3_file*, int offset, int n, int flags);
+ void (*xShmBarrier)(sqlite3_file*);
+ int (*xShmUnmap)(sqlite3_file*, int deleteFlag);
+ /* Methods above are valid for version 2 */
+ int (*xFetch)(sqlite3_file*, sqlite3_int64 iOfst, int iAmt, void **pp);
+ int (*xUnfetch)(sqlite3_file*, sqlite3_int64 iOfst, void *p);
+ /* Methods above are valid for version 3 */
+ /* Additional methods may be added in future releases */
+};
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Standard File Control Opcodes
+** KEYWORDS: {file control opcodes} {file control opcode}
+**
+** These integer constants are opcodes for the xFileControl method
+** of the [sqlite3_io_methods] object and for the [sqlite3_file_control()]
+** interface.
+**
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCKSTATE]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCKSTATE] opcode is used for debugging. This
+** opcode causes the xFileControl method to write the current state of
+** the lock (one of [SQLITE_LOCK_NONE], [SQLITE_LOCK_SHARED],
+** [SQLITE_LOCK_RESERVED], [SQLITE_LOCK_PENDING], or [SQLITE_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE])
+** into an integer that the pArg argument points to. This capability
+** is used during testing and is only available when the SQLITE_TEST
+** compile-time option is used.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_HINT]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_HINT] opcode is used by SQLite to give the VFS
+** layer a hint of how large the database file will grow to be during the
+** current transaction. This hint is not guaranteed to be accurate but it
+** is often close. The underlying VFS might choose to preallocate database
+** file space based on this hint in order to help writes to the database
+** file run faster.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_LIMIT]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_LIMIT] opcode is used by in-memory VFS that
+** implements [sqlite3_deserialize()] to set an upper bound on the size
+** of the in-memory database. The argument is a pointer to a [sqlite3_int64].
+** If the integer pointed to is negative, then it is filled in with the
+** current limit. Otherwise the limit is set to the larger of the value
+** of the integer pointed to and the current database size. The integer
+** pointed to is set to the new limit.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_CHUNK_SIZE]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_CHUNK_SIZE] opcode is used to request that the VFS
+** extends and truncates the database file in chunks of a size specified
+** by the user. The fourth argument to [sqlite3_file_control()] should
+** point to an integer (type int) containing the new chunk-size to use
+** for the nominated database. Allocating database file space in large
+** chunks (say 1MB at a time), may reduce file-system fragmentation and
+** improve performance on some systems.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_FILE_POINTER]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_FILE_POINTER] opcode is used to obtain a pointer
+** to the [sqlite3_file] object associated with a particular database
+** connection. See also [SQLITE_FCNTL_JOURNAL_POINTER].
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_JOURNAL_POINTER]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_JOURNAL_POINTER] opcode is used to obtain a pointer
+** to the [sqlite3_file] object associated with the journal file (either
+** the [rollback journal] or the [write-ahead log]) for a particular database
+** connection. See also [SQLITE_FCNTL_FILE_POINTER].
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_SYNC_OMITTED]]
+** No longer in use.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_SYNC]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_SYNC] opcode is generated internally by SQLite and
+** sent to the VFS immediately before the xSync method is invoked on a
+** database file descriptor. Or, if the xSync method is not invoked
+** because the user has configured SQLite with
+** [PRAGMA synchronous | PRAGMA synchronous=OFF] it is invoked in place
+** of the xSync method. In most cases, the pointer argument passed with
+** this file-control is NULL. However, if the database file is being synced
+** as part of a multi-database commit, the argument points to a nul-terminated
+** string containing the transactions super-journal file name. VFSes that
+** do not need this signal should silently ignore this opcode. Applications
+** should not call [sqlite3_file_control()] with this opcode as doing so may
+** disrupt the operation of the specialized VFSes that do require it.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_PHASETWO]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_PHASETWO] opcode is generated internally by SQLite
+** and sent to the VFS after a transaction has been committed immediately
+** but before the database is unlocked. VFSes that do not need this signal
+** should silently ignore this opcode. Applications should not call
+** [sqlite3_file_control()] with this opcode as doing so may disrupt the
+** operation of the specialized VFSes that do require it.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_AV_RETRY]]
+** ^The [SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_AV_RETRY] opcode is used to configure automatic
+** retry counts and intervals for certain disk I/O operations for the
+** windows [VFS] in order to provide robustness in the presence of
+** anti-virus programs. By default, the windows VFS will retry file read,
+** file write, and file delete operations up to 10 times, with a delay
+** of 25 milliseconds before the first retry and with the delay increasing
+** by an additional 25 milliseconds with each subsequent retry. This
+** opcode allows these two values (10 retries and 25 milliseconds of delay)
+** to be adjusted. The values are changed for all database connections
+** within the same process. The argument is a pointer to an array of two
+** integers where the first integer is the new retry count and the second
+** integer is the delay. If either integer is negative, then the setting
+** is not changed but instead the prior value of that setting is written
+** into the array entry, allowing the current retry settings to be
+** interrogated. The zDbName parameter is ignored.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_PERSIST_WAL]]
+** ^The [SQLITE_FCNTL_PERSIST_WAL] opcode is used to set or query the
+** persistent [WAL | Write Ahead Log] setting. By default, the auxiliary
+** write ahead log ([WAL file]) and shared memory
+** files used for transaction control
+** are automatically deleted when the latest connection to the database
+** closes. Setting persistent WAL mode causes those files to persist after
+** close. Persisting the files is useful when other processes that do not
+** have write permission on the directory containing the database file want
+** to read the database file, as the WAL and shared memory files must exist
+** in order for the database to be readable. The fourth parameter to
+** [sqlite3_file_control()] for this opcode should be a pointer to an integer.
+** That integer is 0 to disable persistent WAL mode or 1 to enable persistent
+** WAL mode. If the integer is -1, then it is overwritten with the current
+** WAL persistence setting.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE]]
+** ^The [SQLITE_FCNTL_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE] opcode is used to set or query the
+** persistent "powersafe-overwrite" or "PSOW" setting. The PSOW setting
+** determines the [SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE] bit of the
+** xDeviceCharacteristics methods. The fourth parameter to
+** [sqlite3_file_control()] for this opcode should be a pointer to an integer.
+** That integer is 0 to disable zero-damage mode or 1 to enable zero-damage
+** mode. If the integer is -1, then it is overwritten with the current
+** zero-damage mode setting.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_OVERWRITE]]
+** ^The [SQLITE_FCNTL_OVERWRITE] opcode is invoked by SQLite after opening
+** a write transaction to indicate that, unless it is rolled back for some
+** reason, the entire database file will be overwritten by the current
+** transaction. This is used by VACUUM operations.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_VFSNAME]]
+** ^The [SQLITE_FCNTL_VFSNAME] opcode can be used to obtain the names of
+** all [VFSes] in the VFS stack. The names are of all VFS shims and the
+** final bottom-level VFS are written into memory obtained from
+** [sqlite3_malloc()] and the result is stored in the char* variable
+** that the fourth parameter of [sqlite3_file_control()] points to.
+** The caller is responsible for freeing the memory when done. As with
+** all file-control actions, there is no guarantee that this will actually
+** do anything. Callers should initialize the char* variable to a NULL
+** pointer in case this file-control is not implemented. This file-control
+** is intended for diagnostic use only.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_VFS_POINTER]]
+** ^The [SQLITE_FCNTL_VFS_POINTER] opcode finds a pointer to the top-level
+** [VFSes] currently in use. ^(The argument X in
+** sqlite3_file_control(db,SQLITE_FCNTL_VFS_POINTER,X) must be
+** of type "[sqlite3_vfs] **". This opcodes will set *X
+** to a pointer to the top-level VFS.)^
+** ^When there are multiple VFS shims in the stack, this opcode finds the
+** upper-most shim only.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_PRAGMA]]
+** ^Whenever a [PRAGMA] statement is parsed, an [SQLITE_FCNTL_PRAGMA]
+** file control is sent to the open [sqlite3_file] object corresponding
+** to the database file to which the pragma statement refers. ^The argument
+** to the [SQLITE_FCNTL_PRAGMA] file control is an array of
+** pointers to strings (char**) in which the second element of the array
+** is the name of the pragma and the third element is the argument to the
+** pragma or NULL if the pragma has no argument. ^The handler for an
+** [SQLITE_FCNTL_PRAGMA] file control can optionally make the first element
+** of the char** argument point to a string obtained from [sqlite3_mprintf()]
+** or the equivalent and that string will become the result of the pragma or
+** the error message if the pragma fails. ^If the
+** [SQLITE_FCNTL_PRAGMA] file control returns [SQLITE_NOTFOUND], then normal
+** [PRAGMA] processing continues. ^If the [SQLITE_FCNTL_PRAGMA]
+** file control returns [SQLITE_OK], then the parser assumes that the
+** VFS has handled the PRAGMA itself and the parser generates a no-op
+** prepared statement if result string is NULL, or that returns a copy
+** of the result string if the string is non-NULL.
+** ^If the [SQLITE_FCNTL_PRAGMA] file control returns
+** any result code other than [SQLITE_OK] or [SQLITE_NOTFOUND], that means
+** that the VFS encountered an error while handling the [PRAGMA] and the
+** compilation of the PRAGMA fails with an error. ^The [SQLITE_FCNTL_PRAGMA]
+** file control occurs at the beginning of pragma statement analysis and so
+** it is able to override built-in [PRAGMA] statements.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_BUSYHANDLER]]
+** ^The [SQLITE_FCNTL_BUSYHANDLER]
+** file-control may be invoked by SQLite on the database file handle
+** shortly after it is opened in order to provide a custom VFS with access
+** to the connection's busy-handler callback. The argument is of type (void**)
+** - an array of two (void *) values. The first (void *) actually points
+** to a function of type (int (*)(void *)). In order to invoke the connection's
+** busy-handler, this function should be invoked with the second (void *) in
+** the array as the only argument. If it returns non-zero, then the operation
+** should be retried. If it returns zero, the custom VFS should abandon the
+** current operation.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_TEMPFILENAME]]
+** ^Applications can invoke the [SQLITE_FCNTL_TEMPFILENAME] file-control
+** to have SQLite generate a
+** temporary filename using the same algorithm that is followed to generate
+** temporary filenames for TEMP tables and other internal uses. The
+** argument should be a char** which will be filled with the filename
+** written into memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc()]. The caller should
+** invoke [sqlite3_free()] on the result to avoid a memory leak.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE] file control is used to query or set the
+** maximum number of bytes that will be used for memory-mapped I/O.
+** The argument is a pointer to a value of type sqlite3_int64 that
+** is an advisory maximum number of bytes in the file to memory map. The
+** pointer is overwritten with the old value. The limit is not changed if
+** the value originally pointed to is negative, and so the current limit
+** can be queried by passing in a pointer to a negative number. This
+** file-control is used internally to implement [PRAGMA mmap_size].
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_TRACE]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_TRACE] file control provides advisory information
+** to the VFS about what the higher layers of the SQLite stack are doing.
+** This file control is used by some VFS activity tracing [shims].
+** The argument is a zero-terminated string. Higher layers in the
+** SQLite stack may generate instances of this file control if
+** the [SQLITE_USE_FCNTL_TRACE] compile-time option is enabled.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_HAS_MOVED]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_HAS_MOVED] file control interprets its argument as a
+** pointer to an integer and it writes a boolean into that integer depending
+** on whether or not the file has been renamed, moved, or deleted since it
+** was first opened.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_GET_HANDLE]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_GET_HANDLE] opcode can be used to obtain the
+** underlying native file handle associated with a file handle. This file
+** control interprets its argument as a pointer to a native file handle and
+** writes the resulting value there.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_SET_HANDLE]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_SET_HANDLE] opcode is used for debugging. This
+** opcode causes the xFileControl method to swap the file handle with the one
+** pointed to by the pArg argument. This capability is used during testing
+** and only needs to be supported when SQLITE_TEST is defined.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_WAL_BLOCK]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_WAL_BLOCK] is a signal to the VFS layer that it might
+** be advantageous to block on the next WAL lock if the lock is not immediately
+** available. The WAL subsystem issues this signal during rare
+** circumstances in order to fix a problem with priority inversion.
+** Applications should not use this file-control.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_ZIPVFS]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_ZIPVFS] opcode is implemented by zipvfs only. All other
+** VFS should return SQLITE_NOTFOUND for this opcode.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_RBU]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_RBU] opcode is implemented by the special VFS used by
+** the RBU extension only. All other VFS should return SQLITE_NOTFOUND for
+** this opcode.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_BEGIN_ATOMIC_WRITE]]
+** If the [SQLITE_FCNTL_BEGIN_ATOMIC_WRITE] opcode returns SQLITE_OK, then
+** the file descriptor is placed in "batch write mode", which
+** means all subsequent write operations will be deferred and done
+** atomically at the next [SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_ATOMIC_WRITE]. Systems
+** that do not support batch atomic writes will return SQLITE_NOTFOUND.
+** ^Following a successful SQLITE_FCNTL_BEGIN_ATOMIC_WRITE and prior to
+** the closing [SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_ATOMIC_WRITE] or
+** [SQLITE_FCNTL_ROLLBACK_ATOMIC_WRITE], SQLite will make
+** no VFS interface calls on the same [sqlite3_file] file descriptor
+** except for calls to the xWrite method and the xFileControl method
+** with [SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_HINT].
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_ATOMIC_WRITE]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_ATOMIC_WRITE] opcode causes all write
+** operations since the previous successful call to
+** [SQLITE_FCNTL_BEGIN_ATOMIC_WRITE] to be performed atomically.
+** This file control returns [SQLITE_OK] if and only if the writes were
+** all performed successfully and have been committed to persistent storage.
+** ^Regardless of whether or not it is successful, this file control takes
+** the file descriptor out of batch write mode so that all subsequent
+** write operations are independent.
+** ^SQLite will never invoke SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_ATOMIC_WRITE without
+** a prior successful call to [SQLITE_FCNTL_BEGIN_ATOMIC_WRITE].
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_ROLLBACK_ATOMIC_WRITE]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_ROLLBACK_ATOMIC_WRITE] opcode causes all write
+** operations since the previous successful call to
+** [SQLITE_FCNTL_BEGIN_ATOMIC_WRITE] to be rolled back.
+** ^This file control takes the file descriptor out of batch write mode
+** so that all subsequent write operations are independent.
+** ^SQLite will never invoke SQLITE_FCNTL_ROLLBACK_ATOMIC_WRITE without
+** a prior successful call to [SQLITE_FCNTL_BEGIN_ATOMIC_WRITE].
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCK_TIMEOUT]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCK_TIMEOUT] opcode is used to configure a VFS
+** to block for up to M milliseconds before failing when attempting to
+** obtain a file lock using the xLock or xShmLock methods of the VFS.
+** The parameter is a pointer to a 32-bit signed integer that contains
+** the value that M is to be set to. Before returning, the 32-bit signed
+** integer is overwritten with the previous value of M.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_DATA_VERSION]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_DATA_VERSION] opcode is used to detect changes to
+** a database file. The argument is a pointer to a 32-bit unsigned integer.
+** The "data version" for the pager is written into the pointer. The
+** "data version" changes whenever any change occurs to the corresponding
+** database file, either through SQL statements on the same database
+** connection or through transactions committed by separate database
+** connections possibly in other processes. The [sqlite3_total_changes()]
+** interface can be used to find if any database on the connection has changed,
+** but that interface responds to changes on TEMP as well as MAIN and does
+** not provide a mechanism to detect changes to MAIN only. Also, the
+** [sqlite3_total_changes()] interface responds to internal changes only and
+** omits changes made by other database connections. The
+** [PRAGMA data_version] command provides a mechanism to detect changes to
+** a single attached database that occur due to other database connections,
+** but omits changes implemented by the database connection on which it is
+** called. This file control is the only mechanism to detect changes that
+** happen either internally or externally and that are associated with
+** a particular attached database.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_CKPT_START]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_CKPT_START] opcode is invoked from within a checkpoint
+** in wal mode before the client starts to copy pages from the wal
+** file to the database file.
+**
+**
[[SQLITE_FCNTL_CKPT_DONE]]
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_CKPT_DONE] opcode is invoked from within a checkpoint
+** in wal mode after the client has finished copying pages from the wal
+** file to the database file, but before the *-shm file is updated to
+** record the fact that the pages have been checkpointed.
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCKSTATE 1
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_GET_LOCKPROXYFILE 2
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_SET_LOCKPROXYFILE 3
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_LAST_ERRNO 4
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_HINT 5
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_CHUNK_SIZE 6
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_FILE_POINTER 7
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_SYNC_OMITTED 8
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_AV_RETRY 9
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_PERSIST_WAL 10
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_OVERWRITE 11
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_VFSNAME 12
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE 13
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_PRAGMA 14
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_BUSYHANDLER 15
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_TEMPFILENAME 16
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE 18
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_TRACE 19
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_HAS_MOVED 20
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_SYNC 21
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_PHASETWO 22
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_SET_HANDLE 23
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_WAL_BLOCK 24
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_ZIPVFS 25
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_RBU 26
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_VFS_POINTER 27
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_JOURNAL_POINTER 28
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_GET_HANDLE 29
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_PDB 30
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_BEGIN_ATOMIC_WRITE 31
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_ATOMIC_WRITE 32
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_ROLLBACK_ATOMIC_WRITE 33
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCK_TIMEOUT 34
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_DATA_VERSION 35
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_LIMIT 36
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_CKPT_DONE 37
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_RESERVE_BYTES 38
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_CKPT_START 39
+
+/* deprecated names */
+#define SQLITE_GET_LOCKPROXYFILE SQLITE_FCNTL_GET_LOCKPROXYFILE
+#define SQLITE_SET_LOCKPROXYFILE SQLITE_FCNTL_SET_LOCKPROXYFILE
+#define SQLITE_LAST_ERRNO SQLITE_FCNTL_LAST_ERRNO
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Mutex Handle
+**
+** The mutex module within SQLite defines [sqlite3_mutex] to be an
+** abstract type for a mutex object. The SQLite core never looks
+** at the internal representation of an [sqlite3_mutex]. It only
+** deals with pointers to the [sqlite3_mutex] object.
+**
+** Mutexes are created using [sqlite3_mutex_alloc()].
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_mutex sqlite3_mutex;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Loadable Extension Thunk
+**
+** A pointer to the opaque sqlite3_api_routines structure is passed as
+** the third parameter to entry points of [loadable extensions]. This
+** structure must be typedefed in order to work around compiler warnings
+** on some platforms.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_api_routines sqlite3_api_routines;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: OS Interface Object
+**
+** An instance of the sqlite3_vfs object defines the interface between
+** the SQLite core and the underlying operating system. The "vfs"
+** in the name of the object stands for "virtual file system". See
+** the [VFS | VFS documentation] for further information.
+**
+** The VFS interface is sometimes extended by adding new methods onto
+** the end. Each time such an extension occurs, the iVersion field
+** is incremented. The iVersion value started out as 1 in
+** SQLite [version 3.5.0] on [dateof:3.5.0], then increased to 2
+** with SQLite [version 3.7.0] on [dateof:3.7.0], and then increased
+** to 3 with SQLite [version 3.7.6] on [dateof:3.7.6]. Additional fields
+** may be appended to the sqlite3_vfs object and the iVersion value
+** may increase again in future versions of SQLite.
+** Note that due to an oversight, the structure
+** of the sqlite3_vfs object changed in the transition from
+** SQLite [version 3.5.9] to [version 3.6.0] on [dateof:3.6.0]
+** and yet the iVersion field was not increased.
+**
+** The szOsFile field is the size of the subclassed [sqlite3_file]
+** structure used by this VFS. mxPathname is the maximum length of
+** a pathname in this VFS.
+**
+** Registered sqlite3_vfs objects are kept on a linked list formed by
+** the pNext pointer. The [sqlite3_vfs_register()]
+** and [sqlite3_vfs_unregister()] interfaces manage this list
+** in a thread-safe way. The [sqlite3_vfs_find()] interface
+** searches the list. Neither the application code nor the VFS
+** implementation should use the pNext pointer.
+**
+** The pNext field is the only field in the sqlite3_vfs
+** structure that SQLite will ever modify. SQLite will only access
+** or modify this field while holding a particular static mutex.
+** The application should never modify anything within the sqlite3_vfs
+** object once the object has been registered.
+**
+** The zName field holds the name of the VFS module. The name must
+** be unique across all VFS modules.
+**
+** [[sqlite3_vfs.xOpen]]
+** ^SQLite guarantees that the zFilename parameter to xOpen
+** is either a NULL pointer or string obtained
+** from xFullPathname() with an optional suffix added.
+** ^If a suffix is added to the zFilename parameter, it will
+** consist of a single "-" character followed by no more than
+** 11 alphanumeric and/or "-" characters.
+** ^SQLite further guarantees that
+** the string will be valid and unchanged until xClose() is
+** called. Because of the previous sentence,
+** the [sqlite3_file] can safely store a pointer to the
+** filename if it needs to remember the filename for some reason.
+** If the zFilename parameter to xOpen is a NULL pointer then xOpen
+** must invent its own temporary name for the file. ^Whenever the
+** xFilename parameter is NULL it will also be the case that the
+** flags parameter will include [SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE].
+**
+** The flags argument to xOpen() includes all bits set in
+** the flags argument to [sqlite3_open_v2()]. Or if [sqlite3_open()]
+** or [sqlite3_open16()] is used, then flags includes at least
+** [SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE] | [SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE].
+** If xOpen() opens a file read-only then it sets *pOutFlags to
+** include [SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY]. Other bits in *pOutFlags may be set.
+**
+** ^(SQLite will also add one of the following flags to the xOpen()
+** call, depending on the object being opened:
+**
+**
+**
[SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB]
+**
[SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL]
+**
[SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_DB]
+**
[SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_JOURNAL]
+**
[SQLITE_OPEN_TRANSIENT_DB]
+**
[SQLITE_OPEN_SUBJOURNAL]
+**
[SQLITE_OPEN_SUPER_JOURNAL]
+**
[SQLITE_OPEN_WAL]
+**
)^
+**
+** The file I/O implementation can use the object type flags to
+** change the way it deals with files. For example, an application
+** that does not care about crash recovery or rollback might make
+** the open of a journal file a no-op. Writes to this journal would
+** also be no-ops, and any attempt to read the journal would return
+** SQLITE_IOERR. Or the implementation might recognize that a database
+** file will be doing page-aligned sector reads and writes in a random
+** order and set up its I/O subsystem accordingly.
+**
+** SQLite might also add one of the following flags to the xOpen method:
+**
+**
+**
[SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE]
+**
[SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE]
+**
+**
+** The [SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE] flag means the file should be
+** deleted when it is closed. ^The [SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE]
+** will be set for TEMP databases and their journals, transient
+** databases, and subjournals.
+**
+** ^The [SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE] flag is always used in conjunction
+** with the [SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE] flag, which are both directly
+** analogous to the O_EXCL and O_CREAT flags of the POSIX open()
+** API. The SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE flag, when paired with the
+** SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE, is used to indicate that file should always
+** be created, and that it is an error if it already exists.
+** It is not used to indicate the file should be opened
+** for exclusive access.
+**
+** ^At least szOsFile bytes of memory are allocated by SQLite
+** to hold the [sqlite3_file] structure passed as the third
+** argument to xOpen. The xOpen method does not have to
+** allocate the structure; it should just fill it in. Note that
+** the xOpen method must set the sqlite3_file.pMethods to either
+** a valid [sqlite3_io_methods] object or to NULL. xOpen must do
+** this even if the open fails. SQLite expects that the sqlite3_file.pMethods
+** element will be valid after xOpen returns regardless of the success
+** or failure of the xOpen call.
+**
+** [[sqlite3_vfs.xAccess]]
+** ^The flags argument to xAccess() may be [SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS]
+** to test for the existence of a file, or [SQLITE_ACCESS_READWRITE] to
+** test whether a file is readable and writable, or [SQLITE_ACCESS_READ]
+** to test whether a file is at least readable. The SQLITE_ACCESS_READ
+** flag is never actually used and is not implemented in the built-in
+** VFSes of SQLite. The file is named by the second argument and can be a
+** directory. The xAccess method returns [SQLITE_OK] on success or some
+** non-zero error code if there is an I/O error or if the name of
+** the file given in the second argument is illegal. If SQLITE_OK
+** is returned, then non-zero or zero is written into *pResOut to indicate
+** whether or not the file is accessible.
+**
+** ^SQLite will always allocate at least mxPathname+1 bytes for the
+** output buffer xFullPathname. The exact size of the output buffer
+** is also passed as a parameter to both methods. If the output buffer
+** is not large enough, [SQLITE_CANTOPEN] should be returned. Since this is
+** handled as a fatal error by SQLite, vfs implementations should endeavor
+** to prevent this by setting mxPathname to a sufficiently large value.
+**
+** The xRandomness(), xSleep(), xCurrentTime(), and xCurrentTimeInt64()
+** interfaces are not strictly a part of the filesystem, but they are
+** included in the VFS structure for completeness.
+** The xRandomness() function attempts to return nBytes bytes
+** of good-quality randomness into zOut. The return value is
+** the actual number of bytes of randomness obtained.
+** The xSleep() method causes the calling thread to sleep for at
+** least the number of microseconds given. ^The xCurrentTime()
+** method returns a Julian Day Number for the current date and time as
+** a floating point value.
+** ^The xCurrentTimeInt64() method returns, as an integer, the Julian
+** Day Number multiplied by 86400000 (the number of milliseconds in
+** a 24-hour day).
+** ^SQLite will use the xCurrentTimeInt64() method to get the current
+** date and time if that method is available (if iVersion is 2 or
+** greater and the function pointer is not NULL) and will fall back
+** to xCurrentTime() if xCurrentTimeInt64() is unavailable.
+**
+** ^The xSetSystemCall(), xGetSystemCall(), and xNestSystemCall() interfaces
+** are not used by the SQLite core. These optional interfaces are provided
+** by some VFSes to facilitate testing of the VFS code. By overriding
+** system calls with functions under its control, a test program can
+** simulate faults and error conditions that would otherwise be difficult
+** or impossible to induce. The set of system calls that can be overridden
+** varies from one VFS to another, and from one version of the same VFS to the
+** next. Applications that use these interfaces must be prepared for any
+** or all of these interfaces to be NULL or for their behavior to change
+** from one release to the next. Applications must not attempt to access
+** any of these methods if the iVersion of the VFS is less than 3.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_vfs sqlite3_vfs;
+typedef void (*sqlite3_syscall_ptr)(void);
+struct sqlite3_vfs {
+ int iVersion; /* Structure version number (currently 3) */
+ int szOsFile; /* Size of subclassed sqlite3_file */
+ int mxPathname; /* Maximum file pathname length */
+ sqlite3_vfs *pNext; /* Next registered VFS */
+ const char *zName; /* Name of this virtual file system */
+ void *pAppData; /* Pointer to application-specific data */
+ int (*xOpen)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, sqlite3_file*,
+ int flags, int *pOutFlags);
+ int (*xDelete)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, int syncDir);
+ int (*xAccess)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, int flags, int *pResOut);
+ int (*xFullPathname)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, int nOut, char *zOut);
+ void *(*xDlOpen)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zFilename);
+ void (*xDlError)(sqlite3_vfs*, int nByte, char *zErrMsg);
+ void (*(*xDlSym)(sqlite3_vfs*,void*, const char *zSymbol))(void);
+ void (*xDlClose)(sqlite3_vfs*, void*);
+ int (*xRandomness)(sqlite3_vfs*, int nByte, char *zOut);
+ int (*xSleep)(sqlite3_vfs*, int microseconds);
+ int (*xCurrentTime)(sqlite3_vfs*, double*);
+ int (*xGetLastError)(sqlite3_vfs*, int, char *);
+ /*
+ ** The methods above are in version 1 of the sqlite_vfs object
+ ** definition. Those that follow are added in version 2 or later
+ */
+ int (*xCurrentTimeInt64)(sqlite3_vfs*, sqlite3_int64*);
+ /*
+ ** The methods above are in versions 1 and 2 of the sqlite_vfs object.
+ ** Those below are for version 3 and greater.
+ */
+ int (*xSetSystemCall)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, sqlite3_syscall_ptr);
+ sqlite3_syscall_ptr (*xGetSystemCall)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName);
+ const char *(*xNextSystemCall)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName);
+ /*
+ ** The methods above are in versions 1 through 3 of the sqlite_vfs object.
+ ** New fields may be appended in future versions. The iVersion
+ ** value will increment whenever this happens.
+ */
+};
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Flags for the xAccess VFS method
+**
+** These integer constants can be used as the third parameter to
+** the xAccess method of an [sqlite3_vfs] object. They determine
+** what kind of permissions the xAccess method is looking for.
+** With SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS, the xAccess method
+** simply checks whether the file exists.
+** With SQLITE_ACCESS_READWRITE, the xAccess method
+** checks whether the named directory is both readable and writable
+** (in other words, if files can be added, removed, and renamed within
+** the directory).
+** The SQLITE_ACCESS_READWRITE constant is currently used only by the
+** [temp_store_directory pragma], though this could change in a future
+** release of SQLite.
+** With SQLITE_ACCESS_READ, the xAccess method
+** checks whether the file is readable. The SQLITE_ACCESS_READ constant is
+** currently unused, though it might be used in a future release of
+** SQLite.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS 0
+#define SQLITE_ACCESS_READWRITE 1 /* Used by PRAGMA temp_store_directory */
+#define SQLITE_ACCESS_READ 2 /* Unused */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Flags for the xShmLock VFS method
+**
+** These integer constants define the various locking operations
+** allowed by the xShmLock method of [sqlite3_io_methods]. The
+** following are the only legal combinations of flags to the
+** xShmLock method:
+**
+**
+**
SQLITE_SHM_LOCK | SQLITE_SHM_SHARED
+**
SQLITE_SHM_LOCK | SQLITE_SHM_EXCLUSIVE
+**
SQLITE_SHM_UNLOCK | SQLITE_SHM_SHARED
+**
SQLITE_SHM_UNLOCK | SQLITE_SHM_EXCLUSIVE
+**
+**
+** When unlocking, the same SHARED or EXCLUSIVE flag must be supplied as
+** was given on the corresponding lock.
+**
+** The xShmLock method can transition between unlocked and SHARED or
+** between unlocked and EXCLUSIVE. It cannot transition between SHARED
+** and EXCLUSIVE.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_SHM_UNLOCK 1
+#define SQLITE_SHM_LOCK 2
+#define SQLITE_SHM_SHARED 4
+#define SQLITE_SHM_EXCLUSIVE 8
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Maximum xShmLock index
+**
+** The xShmLock method on [sqlite3_io_methods] may use values
+** between 0 and this upper bound as its "offset" argument.
+** The SQLite core will never attempt to acquire or release a
+** lock outside of this range
+*/
+#define SQLITE_SHM_NLOCK 8
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Initialize The SQLite Library
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_initialize() routine initializes the
+** SQLite library. ^The sqlite3_shutdown() routine
+** deallocates any resources that were allocated by sqlite3_initialize().
+** These routines are designed to aid in process initialization and
+** shutdown on embedded systems. Workstation applications using
+** SQLite normally do not need to invoke either of these routines.
+**
+** A call to sqlite3_initialize() is an "effective" call if it is
+** the first time sqlite3_initialize() is invoked during the lifetime of
+** the process, or if it is the first time sqlite3_initialize() is invoked
+** following a call to sqlite3_shutdown(). ^(Only an effective call
+** of sqlite3_initialize() does any initialization. All other calls
+** are harmless no-ops.)^
+**
+** A call to sqlite3_shutdown() is an "effective" call if it is the first
+** call to sqlite3_shutdown() since the last sqlite3_initialize(). ^(Only
+** an effective call to sqlite3_shutdown() does any deinitialization.
+** All other valid calls to sqlite3_shutdown() are harmless no-ops.)^
+**
+** The sqlite3_initialize() interface is threadsafe, but sqlite3_shutdown()
+** is not. The sqlite3_shutdown() interface must only be called from a
+** single thread. All open [database connections] must be closed and all
+** other SQLite resources must be deallocated prior to invoking
+** sqlite3_shutdown().
+**
+** Among other things, ^sqlite3_initialize() will invoke
+** sqlite3_os_init(). Similarly, ^sqlite3_shutdown()
+** will invoke sqlite3_os_end().
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_initialize() routine returns [SQLITE_OK] on success.
+** ^If for some reason, sqlite3_initialize() is unable to initialize
+** the library (perhaps it is unable to allocate a needed resource such
+** as a mutex) it returns an [error code] other than [SQLITE_OK].
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_initialize() routine is called internally by many other
+** SQLite interfaces so that an application usually does not need to
+** invoke sqlite3_initialize() directly. For example, [sqlite3_open()]
+** calls sqlite3_initialize() so the SQLite library will be automatically
+** initialized when [sqlite3_open()] is called if it has not be initialized
+** already. ^However, if SQLite is compiled with the [SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT]
+** compile-time option, then the automatic calls to sqlite3_initialize()
+** are omitted and the application must call sqlite3_initialize() directly
+** prior to using any other SQLite interface. For maximum portability,
+** it is recommended that applications always invoke sqlite3_initialize()
+** directly prior to using any other SQLite interface. Future releases
+** of SQLite may require this. In other words, the behavior exhibited
+** when SQLite is compiled with [SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT] might become the
+** default behavior in some future release of SQLite.
+**
+** The sqlite3_os_init() routine does operating-system specific
+** initialization of the SQLite library. The sqlite3_os_end()
+** routine undoes the effect of sqlite3_os_init(). Typical tasks
+** performed by these routines include allocation or deallocation
+** of static resources, initialization of global variables,
+** setting up a default [sqlite3_vfs] module, or setting up
+** a default configuration using [sqlite3_config()].
+**
+** The application should never invoke either sqlite3_os_init()
+** or sqlite3_os_end() directly. The application should only invoke
+** sqlite3_initialize() and sqlite3_shutdown(). The sqlite3_os_init()
+** interface is called automatically by sqlite3_initialize() and
+** sqlite3_os_end() is called by sqlite3_shutdown(). Appropriate
+** implementations for sqlite3_os_init() and sqlite3_os_end()
+** are built into SQLite when it is compiled for Unix, Windows, or OS/2.
+** When [custom builds | built for other platforms]
+** (using the [SQLITE_OS_OTHER=1] compile-time
+** option) the application must supply a suitable implementation for
+** sqlite3_os_init() and sqlite3_os_end(). An application-supplied
+** implementation of sqlite3_os_init() or sqlite3_os_end()
+** must return [SQLITE_OK] on success and some other [error code] upon
+** failure.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_initialize(void);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_shutdown(void);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_os_init(void);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_os_end(void);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Configuring The SQLite Library
+**
+** The sqlite3_config() interface is used to make global configuration
+** changes to SQLite in order to tune SQLite to the specific needs of
+** the application. The default configuration is recommended for most
+** applications and so this routine is usually not necessary. It is
+** provided to support rare applications with unusual needs.
+**
+** The sqlite3_config() interface is not threadsafe. The application
+** must ensure that no other SQLite interfaces are invoked by other
+** threads while sqlite3_config() is running.
+**
+** The sqlite3_config() interface
+** may only be invoked prior to library initialization using
+** [sqlite3_initialize()] or after shutdown by [sqlite3_shutdown()].
+** ^If sqlite3_config() is called after [sqlite3_initialize()] and before
+** [sqlite3_shutdown()] then it will return SQLITE_MISUSE.
+** Note, however, that ^sqlite3_config() can be called as part of the
+** implementation of an application-defined [sqlite3_os_init()].
+**
+** The first argument to sqlite3_config() is an integer
+** [configuration option] that determines
+** what property of SQLite is to be configured. Subsequent arguments
+** vary depending on the [configuration option]
+** in the first argument.
+**
+** ^When a configuration option is set, sqlite3_config() returns [SQLITE_OK].
+** ^If the option is unknown or SQLite is unable to set the option
+** then this routine returns a non-zero [error code].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_config(int, ...);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Configure database connections
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** The sqlite3_db_config() interface is used to make configuration
+** changes to a [database connection]. The interface is similar to
+** [sqlite3_config()] except that the changes apply to a single
+** [database connection] (specified in the first argument).
+**
+** The second argument to sqlite3_db_config(D,V,...) is the
+** [SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LOOKASIDE | configuration verb] - an integer code
+** that indicates what aspect of the [database connection] is being configured.
+** Subsequent arguments vary depending on the configuration verb.
+**
+** ^Calls to sqlite3_db_config() return SQLITE_OK if and only if
+** the call is considered successful.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_db_config(sqlite3*, int op, ...);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Memory Allocation Routines
+**
+** An instance of this object defines the interface between SQLite
+** and low-level memory allocation routines.
+**
+** This object is used in only one place in the SQLite interface.
+** A pointer to an instance of this object is the argument to
+** [sqlite3_config()] when the configuration option is
+** [SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC] or [SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMALLOC].
+** By creating an instance of this object
+** and passing it to [sqlite3_config]([SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC])
+** during configuration, an application can specify an alternative
+** memory allocation subsystem for SQLite to use for all of its
+** dynamic memory needs.
+**
+** Note that SQLite comes with several [built-in memory allocators]
+** that are perfectly adequate for the overwhelming majority of applications
+** and that this object is only useful to a tiny minority of applications
+** with specialized memory allocation requirements. This object is
+** also used during testing of SQLite in order to specify an alternative
+** memory allocator that simulates memory out-of-memory conditions in
+** order to verify that SQLite recovers gracefully from such
+** conditions.
+**
+** The xMalloc, xRealloc, and xFree methods must work like the
+** malloc(), realloc() and free() functions from the standard C library.
+** ^SQLite guarantees that the second argument to
+** xRealloc is always a value returned by a prior call to xRoundup.
+**
+** xSize should return the allocated size of a memory allocation
+** previously obtained from xMalloc or xRealloc. The allocated size
+** is always at least as big as the requested size but may be larger.
+**
+** The xRoundup method returns what would be the allocated size of
+** a memory allocation given a particular requested size. Most memory
+** allocators round up memory allocations at least to the next multiple
+** of 8. Some allocators round up to a larger multiple or to a power of 2.
+** Every memory allocation request coming in through [sqlite3_malloc()]
+** or [sqlite3_realloc()] first calls xRoundup. If xRoundup returns 0,
+** that causes the corresponding memory allocation to fail.
+**
+** The xInit method initializes the memory allocator. For example,
+** it might allocate any required mutexes or initialize internal data
+** structures. The xShutdown method is invoked (indirectly) by
+** [sqlite3_shutdown()] and should deallocate any resources acquired
+** by xInit. The pAppData pointer is used as the only parameter to
+** xInit and xShutdown.
+**
+** SQLite holds the [SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN] mutex when it invokes
+** the xInit method, so the xInit method need not be threadsafe. The
+** xShutdown method is only called from [sqlite3_shutdown()] so it does
+** not need to be threadsafe either. For all other methods, SQLite
+** holds the [SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM] mutex as long as the
+** [SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMSTATUS] configuration option is turned on (which
+** it is by default) and so the methods are automatically serialized.
+** However, if [SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMSTATUS] is disabled, then the other
+** methods must be threadsafe or else make their own arrangements for
+** serialization.
+**
+** SQLite will never invoke xInit() more than once without an intervening
+** call to xShutdown().
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_mem_methods sqlite3_mem_methods;
+struct sqlite3_mem_methods {
+ void *(*xMalloc)(int); /* Memory allocation function */
+ void (*xFree)(void*); /* Free a prior allocation */
+ void *(*xRealloc)(void*,int); /* Resize an allocation */
+ int (*xSize)(void*); /* Return the size of an allocation */
+ int (*xRoundup)(int); /* Round up request size to allocation size */
+ int (*xInit)(void*); /* Initialize the memory allocator */
+ void (*xShutdown)(void*); /* Deinitialize the memory allocator */
+ void *pAppData; /* Argument to xInit() and xShutdown() */
+};
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Configuration Options
+** KEYWORDS: {configuration option}
+**
+** These constants are the available integer configuration options that
+** can be passed as the first argument to the [sqlite3_config()] interface.
+**
+** New configuration options may be added in future releases of SQLite.
+** Existing configuration options might be discontinued. Applications
+** should check the return code from [sqlite3_config()] to make sure that
+** the call worked. The [sqlite3_config()] interface will return a
+** non-zero [error code] if a discontinued or unsupported configuration option
+** is invoked.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_SINGLETHREAD]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_SINGLETHREAD
+**
There are no arguments to this option. ^This option sets the
+** [threading mode] to Single-thread. In other words, it disables
+** all mutexing and puts SQLite into a mode where it can only be used
+** by a single thread. ^If SQLite is compiled with
+** the [SQLITE_THREADSAFE | SQLITE_THREADSAFE=0] compile-time option then
+** it is not possible to change the [threading mode] from its default
+** value of Single-thread and so [sqlite3_config()] will return
+** [SQLITE_ERROR] if called with the SQLITE_CONFIG_SINGLETHREAD
+** configuration option.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_MULTITHREAD]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_MULTITHREAD
+**
There are no arguments to this option. ^This option sets the
+** [threading mode] to Multi-thread. In other words, it disables
+** mutexing on [database connection] and [prepared statement] objects.
+** The application is responsible for serializing access to
+** [database connections] and [prepared statements]. But other mutexes
+** are enabled so that SQLite will be safe to use in a multi-threaded
+** environment as long as no two threads attempt to use the same
+** [database connection] at the same time. ^If SQLite is compiled with
+** the [SQLITE_THREADSAFE | SQLITE_THREADSAFE=0] compile-time option then
+** it is not possible to set the Multi-thread [threading mode] and
+** [sqlite3_config()] will return [SQLITE_ERROR] if called with the
+** SQLITE_CONFIG_MULTITHREAD configuration option.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_SERIALIZED]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_SERIALIZED
+**
There are no arguments to this option. ^This option sets the
+** [threading mode] to Serialized. In other words, this option enables
+** all mutexes including the recursive
+** mutexes on [database connection] and [prepared statement] objects.
+** In this mode (which is the default when SQLite is compiled with
+** [SQLITE_THREADSAFE=1]) the SQLite library will itself serialize access
+** to [database connections] and [prepared statements] so that the
+** application is free to use the same [database connection] or the
+** same [prepared statement] in different threads at the same time.
+** ^If SQLite is compiled with
+** the [SQLITE_THREADSAFE | SQLITE_THREADSAFE=0] compile-time option then
+** it is not possible to set the Serialized [threading mode] and
+** [sqlite3_config()] will return [SQLITE_ERROR] if called with the
+** SQLITE_CONFIG_SERIALIZED configuration option.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC
+**
^(The SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC option takes a single argument which is
+** a pointer to an instance of the [sqlite3_mem_methods] structure.
+** The argument specifies
+** alternative low-level memory allocation routines to be used in place of
+** the memory allocation routines built into SQLite.)^ ^SQLite makes
+** its own private copy of the content of the [sqlite3_mem_methods] structure
+** before the [sqlite3_config()] call returns.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMALLOC]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMALLOC
+**
^(The SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMALLOC option takes a single argument which
+** is a pointer to an instance of the [sqlite3_mem_methods] structure.
+** The [sqlite3_mem_methods]
+** structure is filled with the currently defined memory allocation routines.)^
+** This option can be used to overload the default memory allocation
+** routines with a wrapper that simulations memory allocation failure or
+** tracks memory usage, for example.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_SMALL_MALLOC]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_SMALL_MALLOC
+**
^The SQLITE_CONFIG_SMALL_MALLOC option takes single argument of
+** type int, interpreted as a boolean, which if true provides a hint to
+** SQLite that it should avoid large memory allocations if possible.
+** SQLite will run faster if it is free to make large memory allocations,
+** but some application might prefer to run slower in exchange for
+** guarantees about memory fragmentation that are possible if large
+** allocations are avoided. This hint is normally off.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMSTATUS]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMSTATUS
+**
^The SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMSTATUS option takes single argument of type int,
+** interpreted as a boolean, which enables or disables the collection of
+** memory allocation statistics. ^(When memory allocation statistics are
+** disabled, the following SQLite interfaces become non-operational:
+**
+**
[sqlite3_hard_heap_limit64()]
+**
[sqlite3_memory_used()]
+**
[sqlite3_memory_highwater()]
+**
[sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64()]
+**
[sqlite3_status64()]
+**
)^
+** ^Memory allocation statistics are enabled by default unless SQLite is
+** compiled with [SQLITE_DEFAULT_MEMSTATUS]=0 in which case memory
+** allocation statistics are disabled by default.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_SCRATCH]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_SCRATCH
+**
The SQLITE_CONFIG_SCRATCH option is no longer used.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE
+**
^The SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE option specifies a memory pool
+** that SQLite can use for the database page cache with the default page
+** cache implementation.
+** This configuration option is a no-op if an application-defined page
+** cache implementation is loaded using the [SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE2].
+** ^There are three arguments to SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE: A pointer to
+** 8-byte aligned memory (pMem), the size of each page cache line (sz),
+** and the number of cache lines (N).
+** The sz argument should be the size of the largest database page
+** (a power of two between 512 and 65536) plus some extra bytes for each
+** page header. ^The number of extra bytes needed by the page header
+** can be determined using [SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE_HDRSZ].
+** ^It is harmless, apart from the wasted memory,
+** for the sz parameter to be larger than necessary. The pMem
+** argument must be either a NULL pointer or a pointer to an 8-byte
+** aligned block of memory of at least sz*N bytes, otherwise
+** subsequent behavior is undefined.
+** ^When pMem is not NULL, SQLite will strive to use the memory provided
+** to satisfy page cache needs, falling back to [sqlite3_malloc()] if
+** a page cache line is larger than sz bytes or if all of the pMem buffer
+** is exhausted.
+** ^If pMem is NULL and N is non-zero, then each database connection
+** does an initial bulk allocation for page cache memory
+** from [sqlite3_malloc()] sufficient for N cache lines if N is positive or
+** of -1024*N bytes if N is negative, . ^If additional
+** page cache memory is needed beyond what is provided by the initial
+** allocation, then SQLite goes to [sqlite3_malloc()] separately for each
+** additional cache line.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_HEAP]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_HEAP
+**
^The SQLITE_CONFIG_HEAP option specifies a static memory buffer
+** that SQLite will use for all of its dynamic memory allocation needs
+** beyond those provided for by [SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE].
+** ^The SQLITE_CONFIG_HEAP option is only available if SQLite is compiled
+** with either [SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS3] or [SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS5] and returns
+** [SQLITE_ERROR] if invoked otherwise.
+** ^There are three arguments to SQLITE_CONFIG_HEAP:
+** An 8-byte aligned pointer to the memory,
+** the number of bytes in the memory buffer, and the minimum allocation size.
+** ^If the first pointer (the memory pointer) is NULL, then SQLite reverts
+** to using its default memory allocator (the system malloc() implementation),
+** undoing any prior invocation of [SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC]. ^If the
+** memory pointer is not NULL then the alternative memory
+** allocator is engaged to handle all of SQLites memory allocation needs.
+** The first pointer (the memory pointer) must be aligned to an 8-byte
+** boundary or subsequent behavior of SQLite will be undefined.
+** The minimum allocation size is capped at 2**12. Reasonable values
+** for the minimum allocation size are 2**5 through 2**8.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_MUTEX]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_MUTEX
+**
^(The SQLITE_CONFIG_MUTEX option takes a single argument which is a
+** pointer to an instance of the [sqlite3_mutex_methods] structure.
+** The argument specifies alternative low-level mutex routines to be used
+** in place the mutex routines built into SQLite.)^ ^SQLite makes a copy of
+** the content of the [sqlite3_mutex_methods] structure before the call to
+** [sqlite3_config()] returns. ^If SQLite is compiled with
+** the [SQLITE_THREADSAFE | SQLITE_THREADSAFE=0] compile-time option then
+** the entire mutexing subsystem is omitted from the build and hence calls to
+** [sqlite3_config()] with the SQLITE_CONFIG_MUTEX configuration option will
+** return [SQLITE_ERROR].
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMUTEX]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMUTEX
+**
^(The SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMUTEX option takes a single argument which
+** is a pointer to an instance of the [sqlite3_mutex_methods] structure. The
+** [sqlite3_mutex_methods]
+** structure is filled with the currently defined mutex routines.)^
+** This option can be used to overload the default mutex allocation
+** routines with a wrapper used to track mutex usage for performance
+** profiling or testing, for example. ^If SQLite is compiled with
+** the [SQLITE_THREADSAFE | SQLITE_THREADSAFE=0] compile-time option then
+** the entire mutexing subsystem is omitted from the build and hence calls to
+** [sqlite3_config()] with the SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMUTEX configuration option will
+** return [SQLITE_ERROR].
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_LOOKASIDE]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_LOOKASIDE
+**
^(The SQLITE_CONFIG_LOOKASIDE option takes two arguments that determine
+** the default size of lookaside memory on each [database connection].
+** The first argument is the
+** size of each lookaside buffer slot and the second is the number of
+** slots allocated to each database connection.)^ ^(SQLITE_CONFIG_LOOKASIDE
+** sets the default lookaside size. The [SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LOOKASIDE]
+** option to [sqlite3_db_config()] can be used to change the lookaside
+** configuration on individual connections.)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE2]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE2
+**
^(The SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE2 option takes a single argument which is
+** a pointer to an [sqlite3_pcache_methods2] object. This object specifies
+** the interface to a custom page cache implementation.)^
+** ^SQLite makes a copy of the [sqlite3_pcache_methods2] object.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_GETPCACHE2]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_GETPCACHE2
+**
^(The SQLITE_CONFIG_GETPCACHE2 option takes a single argument which
+** is a pointer to an [sqlite3_pcache_methods2] object. SQLite copies of
+** the current page cache implementation into that object.)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_LOG]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_LOG
+**
The SQLITE_CONFIG_LOG option is used to configure the SQLite
+** global [error log].
+** (^The SQLITE_CONFIG_LOG option takes two arguments: a pointer to a
+** function with a call signature of void(*)(void*,int,const char*),
+** and a pointer to void. ^If the function pointer is not NULL, it is
+** invoked by [sqlite3_log()] to process each logging event. ^If the
+** function pointer is NULL, the [sqlite3_log()] interface becomes a no-op.
+** ^The void pointer that is the second argument to SQLITE_CONFIG_LOG is
+** passed through as the first parameter to the application-defined logger
+** function whenever that function is invoked. ^The second parameter to
+** the logger function is a copy of the first parameter to the corresponding
+** [sqlite3_log()] call and is intended to be a [result code] or an
+** [extended result code]. ^The third parameter passed to the logger is
+** log message after formatting via [sqlite3_snprintf()].
+** The SQLite logging interface is not reentrant; the logger function
+** supplied by the application must not invoke any SQLite interface.
+** In a multi-threaded application, the application-defined logger
+** function must be threadsafe.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_URI]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_URI
+**
^(The SQLITE_CONFIG_URI option takes a single argument of type int.
+** If non-zero, then URI handling is globally enabled. If the parameter is zero,
+** then URI handling is globally disabled.)^ ^If URI handling is globally
+** enabled, all filenames passed to [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open_v2()],
+** [sqlite3_open16()] or
+** specified as part of [ATTACH] commands are interpreted as URIs, regardless
+** of whether or not the [SQLITE_OPEN_URI] flag is set when the database
+** connection is opened. ^If it is globally disabled, filenames are
+** only interpreted as URIs if the SQLITE_OPEN_URI flag is set when the
+** database connection is opened. ^(By default, URI handling is globally
+** disabled. The default value may be changed by compiling with the
+** [SQLITE_USE_URI] symbol defined.)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN]]
SQLITE_CONFIG_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN
+**
^The SQLITE_CONFIG_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN option takes a single integer
+** argument which is interpreted as a boolean in order to enable or disable
+** the use of covering indices for full table scans in the query optimizer.
+** ^The default setting is determined
+** by the [SQLITE_ALLOW_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN] compile-time option, or is "on"
+** if that compile-time option is omitted.
+** The ability to disable the use of covering indices for full table scans
+** is because some incorrectly coded legacy applications might malfunction
+** when the optimization is enabled. Providing the ability to
+** disable the optimization allows the older, buggy application code to work
+** without change even with newer versions of SQLite.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE]] [[SQLITE_CONFIG_GETPCACHE]]
+**
SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE and SQLITE_CONFIG_GETPCACHE
+**
These options are obsolete and should not be used by new code.
+** They are retained for backwards compatibility but are now no-ops.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_SQLLOG]]
+**
SQLITE_CONFIG_SQLLOG
+**
This option is only available if sqlite is compiled with the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_SQLLOG] pre-processor macro defined. The first argument should
+** be a pointer to a function of type void(*)(void*,sqlite3*,const char*, int).
+** The second should be of type (void*). The callback is invoked by the library
+** in three separate circumstances, identified by the value passed as the
+** fourth parameter. If the fourth parameter is 0, then the database connection
+** passed as the second argument has just been opened. The third argument
+** points to a buffer containing the name of the main database file. If the
+** fourth parameter is 1, then the SQL statement that the third parameter
+** points to has just been executed. Or, if the fourth parameter is 2, then
+** the connection being passed as the second parameter is being closed. The
+** third parameter is passed NULL In this case. An example of using this
+** configuration option can be seen in the "test_sqllog.c" source file in
+** the canonical SQLite source tree.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_MMAP_SIZE]]
+**
SQLITE_CONFIG_MMAP_SIZE
+**
^SQLITE_CONFIG_MMAP_SIZE takes two 64-bit integer (sqlite3_int64) values
+** that are the default mmap size limit (the default setting for
+** [PRAGMA mmap_size]) and the maximum allowed mmap size limit.
+** ^The default setting can be overridden by each database connection using
+** either the [PRAGMA mmap_size] command, or by using the
+** [SQLITE_FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE] file control. ^(The maximum allowed mmap size
+** will be silently truncated if necessary so that it does not exceed the
+** compile-time maximum mmap size set by the
+** [SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE] compile-time option.)^
+** ^If either argument to this option is negative, then that argument is
+** changed to its compile-time default.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_WIN32_HEAPSIZE]]
+**
SQLITE_CONFIG_WIN32_HEAPSIZE
+**
^The SQLITE_CONFIG_WIN32_HEAPSIZE option is only available if SQLite is
+** compiled for Windows with the [SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC] pre-processor macro
+** defined. ^SQLITE_CONFIG_WIN32_HEAPSIZE takes a 32-bit unsigned integer value
+** that specifies the maximum size of the created heap.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE_HDRSZ]]
+**
SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE_HDRSZ
+**
^The SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE_HDRSZ option takes a single parameter which
+** is a pointer to an integer and writes into that integer the number of extra
+** bytes per page required for each page in [SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE].
+** The amount of extra space required can change depending on the compiler,
+** target platform, and SQLite version.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_PMASZ]]
+**
SQLITE_CONFIG_PMASZ
+**
^The SQLITE_CONFIG_PMASZ option takes a single parameter which
+** is an unsigned integer and sets the "Minimum PMA Size" for the multithreaded
+** sorter to that integer. The default minimum PMA Size is set by the
+** [SQLITE_SORTER_PMASZ] compile-time option. New threads are launched
+** to help with sort operations when multithreaded sorting
+** is enabled (using the [PRAGMA threads] command) and the amount of content
+** to be sorted exceeds the page size times the minimum of the
+** [PRAGMA cache_size] setting and this value.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_STMTJRNL_SPILL]]
+**
SQLITE_CONFIG_STMTJRNL_SPILL
+**
^The SQLITE_CONFIG_STMTJRNL_SPILL option takes a single parameter which
+** becomes the [statement journal] spill-to-disk threshold.
+** [Statement journals] are held in memory until their size (in bytes)
+** exceeds this threshold, at which point they are written to disk.
+** Or if the threshold is -1, statement journals are always held
+** exclusively in memory.
+** Since many statement journals never become large, setting the spill
+** threshold to a value such as 64KiB can greatly reduce the amount of
+** I/O required to support statement rollback.
+** The default value for this setting is controlled by the
+** [SQLITE_STMTJRNL_SPILL] compile-time option.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_SORTERREF_SIZE]]
+**
SQLITE_CONFIG_SORTERREF_SIZE
+**
The SQLITE_CONFIG_SORTERREF_SIZE option accepts a single parameter
+** of type (int) - the new value of the sorter-reference size threshold.
+** Usually, when SQLite uses an external sort to order records according
+** to an ORDER BY clause, all fields required by the caller are present in the
+** sorted records. However, if SQLite determines based on the declared type
+** of a table column that its values are likely to be very large - larger
+** than the configured sorter-reference size threshold - then a reference
+** is stored in each sorted record and the required column values loaded
+** from the database as records are returned in sorted order. The default
+** value for this option is to never use this optimization. Specifying a
+** negative value for this option restores the default behaviour.
+** This option is only available if SQLite is compiled with the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_SORTER_REFERENCES] compile-time option.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMDB_MAXSIZE]]
+**
SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMDB_MAXSIZE
+**
The SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMDB_MAXSIZE option accepts a single parameter
+** [sqlite3_int64] parameter which is the default maximum size for an in-memory
+** database created using [sqlite3_deserialize()]. This default maximum
+** size can be adjusted up or down for individual databases using the
+** [SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_LIMIT] [sqlite3_file_control|file-control]. If this
+** configuration setting is never used, then the default maximum is determined
+** by the [SQLITE_MEMDB_DEFAULT_MAXSIZE] compile-time option. If that
+** compile-time option is not set, then the default maximum is 1073741824.
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_SINGLETHREAD 1 /* nil */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_MULTITHREAD 2 /* nil */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_SERIALIZED 3 /* nil */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC 4 /* sqlite3_mem_methods* */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMALLOC 5 /* sqlite3_mem_methods* */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_SCRATCH 6 /* No longer used */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE 7 /* void*, int sz, int N */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_HEAP 8 /* void*, int nByte, int min */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMSTATUS 9 /* boolean */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_MUTEX 10 /* sqlite3_mutex_methods* */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMUTEX 11 /* sqlite3_mutex_methods* */
+/* previously SQLITE_CONFIG_CHUNKALLOC 12 which is now unused. */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_LOOKASIDE 13 /* int int */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE 14 /* no-op */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_GETPCACHE 15 /* no-op */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_LOG 16 /* xFunc, void* */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_URI 17 /* int */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE2 18 /* sqlite3_pcache_methods2* */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_GETPCACHE2 19 /* sqlite3_pcache_methods2* */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN 20 /* int */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_SQLLOG 21 /* xSqllog, void* */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_MMAP_SIZE 22 /* sqlite3_int64, sqlite3_int64 */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_WIN32_HEAPSIZE 23 /* int nByte */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE_HDRSZ 24 /* int *psz */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_PMASZ 25 /* unsigned int szPma */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_STMTJRNL_SPILL 26 /* int nByte */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_SMALL_MALLOC 27 /* boolean */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_SORTERREF_SIZE 28 /* int nByte */
+#define SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMDB_MAXSIZE 29 /* sqlite3_int64 */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Database Connection Configuration Options
+**
+** These constants are the available integer configuration options that
+** can be passed as the second argument to the [sqlite3_db_config()] interface.
+**
+** New configuration options may be added in future releases of SQLite.
+** Existing configuration options might be discontinued. Applications
+** should check the return code from [sqlite3_db_config()] to make sure that
+** the call worked. ^The [sqlite3_db_config()] interface will return a
+** non-zero [error code] if a discontinued or unsupported configuration option
+** is invoked.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LOOKASIDE]]
+**
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LOOKASIDE
+**
^This option takes three additional arguments that determine the
+** [lookaside memory allocator] configuration for the [database connection].
+** ^The first argument (the third parameter to [sqlite3_db_config()] is a
+** pointer to a memory buffer to use for lookaside memory.
+** ^The first argument after the SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LOOKASIDE verb
+** may be NULL in which case SQLite will allocate the
+** lookaside buffer itself using [sqlite3_malloc()]. ^The second argument is the
+** size of each lookaside buffer slot. ^The third argument is the number of
+** slots. The size of the buffer in the first argument must be greater than
+** or equal to the product of the second and third arguments. The buffer
+** must be aligned to an 8-byte boundary. ^If the second argument to
+** SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LOOKASIDE is not a multiple of 8, it is internally
+** rounded down to the next smaller multiple of 8. ^(The lookaside memory
+** configuration for a database connection can only be changed when that
+** connection is not currently using lookaside memory, or in other words
+** when the "current value" returned by
+** [sqlite3_db_status](D,[SQLITE_CONFIG_LOOKASIDE],...) is zero.
+** Any attempt to change the lookaside memory configuration when lookaside
+** memory is in use leaves the configuration unchanged and returns
+** [SQLITE_BUSY].)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_FKEY]]
+**
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_FKEY
+**
^This option is used to enable or disable the enforcement of
+** [foreign key constraints]. There should be two additional arguments.
+** The first argument is an integer which is 0 to disable FK enforcement,
+** positive to enable FK enforcement or negative to leave FK enforcement
+** unchanged. The second parameter is a pointer to an integer into which
+** is written 0 or 1 to indicate whether FK enforcement is off or on
+** following this call. The second parameter may be a NULL pointer, in
+** which case the FK enforcement setting is not reported back.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_TRIGGER]]
+**
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_TRIGGER
+**
^This option is used to enable or disable [CREATE TRIGGER | triggers].
+** There should be two additional arguments.
+** The first argument is an integer which is 0 to disable triggers,
+** positive to enable triggers or negative to leave the setting unchanged.
+** The second parameter is a pointer to an integer into which
+** is written 0 or 1 to indicate whether triggers are disabled or enabled
+** following this call. The second parameter may be a NULL pointer, in
+** which case the trigger setting is not reported back.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_VIEW]]
+**
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_VIEW
+**
^This option is used to enable or disable [CREATE VIEW | views].
+** There should be two additional arguments.
+** The first argument is an integer which is 0 to disable views,
+** positive to enable views or negative to leave the setting unchanged.
+** The second parameter is a pointer to an integer into which
+** is written 0 or 1 to indicate whether views are disabled or enabled
+** following this call. The second parameter may be a NULL pointer, in
+** which case the view setting is not reported back.
^This option is used to enable or disable the
+** [fts3_tokenizer()] function which is part of the
+** [FTS3] full-text search engine extension.
+** There should be two additional arguments.
+** The first argument is an integer which is 0 to disable fts3_tokenizer() or
+** positive to enable fts3_tokenizer() or negative to leave the setting
+** unchanged.
+** The second parameter is a pointer to an integer into which
+** is written 0 or 1 to indicate whether fts3_tokenizer is disabled or enabled
+** following this call. The second parameter may be a NULL pointer, in
+** which case the new setting is not reported back.
^This option is used to enable or disable the [sqlite3_load_extension()]
+** interface independently of the [load_extension()] SQL function.
+** The [sqlite3_enable_load_extension()] API enables or disables both the
+** C-API [sqlite3_load_extension()] and the SQL function [load_extension()].
+** There should be two additional arguments.
+** When the first argument to this interface is 1, then only the C-API is
+** enabled and the SQL function remains disabled. If the first argument to
+** this interface is 0, then both the C-API and the SQL function are disabled.
+** If the first argument is -1, then no changes are made to state of either the
+** C-API or the SQL function.
+** The second parameter is a pointer to an integer into which
+** is written 0 or 1 to indicate whether [sqlite3_load_extension()] interface
+** is disabled or enabled following this call. The second parameter may
+** be a NULL pointer, in which case the new setting is not reported back.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_MAINDBNAME]]
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_MAINDBNAME
+**
^This option is used to change the name of the "main" database
+** schema. ^The sole argument is a pointer to a constant UTF8 string
+** which will become the new schema name in place of "main". ^SQLite
+** does not make a copy of the new main schema name string, so the application
+** must ensure that the argument passed into this DBCONFIG option is unchanged
+** until after the database connection closes.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_NO_CKPT_ON_CLOSE]]
+**
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_NO_CKPT_ON_CLOSE
+**
Usually, when a database in wal mode is closed or detached from a
+** database handle, SQLite checks if this will mean that there are now no
+** connections at all to the database. If so, it performs a checkpoint
+** operation before closing the connection. This option may be used to
+** override this behaviour. The first parameter passed to this operation
+** is an integer - positive to disable checkpoints-on-close, or zero (the
+** default) to enable them, and negative to leave the setting unchanged.
+** The second parameter is a pointer to an integer
+** into which is written 0 or 1 to indicate whether checkpoints-on-close
+** have been disabled - 0 if they are not disabled, 1 if they are.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_QPSG]]
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_QPSG
+**
^(The SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_QPSG option activates or deactivates
+** the [query planner stability guarantee] (QPSG). When the QPSG is active,
+** a single SQL query statement will always use the same algorithm regardless
+** of values of [bound parameters].)^ The QPSG disables some query optimizations
+** that look at the values of bound parameters, which can make some queries
+** slower. But the QPSG has the advantage of more predictable behavior. With
+** the QPSG active, SQLite will always use the same query plan in the field as
+** was used during testing in the lab.
+** The first argument to this setting is an integer which is 0 to disable
+** the QPSG, positive to enable QPSG, or negative to leave the setting
+** unchanged. The second parameter is a pointer to an integer into which
+** is written 0 or 1 to indicate whether the QPSG is disabled or enabled
+** following this call.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_TRIGGER_EQP]]
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_TRIGGER_EQP
+**
By default, the output of EXPLAIN QUERY PLAN commands does not
+** include output for any operations performed by trigger programs. This
+** option is used to set or clear (the default) a flag that governs this
+** behavior. The first parameter passed to this operation is an integer -
+** positive to enable output for trigger programs, or zero to disable it,
+** or negative to leave the setting unchanged.
+** The second parameter is a pointer to an integer into which is written
+** 0 or 1 to indicate whether output-for-triggers has been disabled - 0 if
+** it is not disabled, 1 if it is.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_RESET_DATABASE]]
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_RESET_DATABASE
+**
Set the SQLITE_DBCONFIG_RESET_DATABASE flag and then run
+** [VACUUM] in order to reset a database back to an empty database
+** with no schema and no content. The following process works even for
+** a badly corrupted database file:
+**
+**
If the database connection is newly opened, make sure it has read the
+** database schema by preparing then discarding some query against the
+** database, or calling sqlite3_table_column_metadata(), ignoring any
+** errors. This step is only necessary if the application desires to keep
+** the database in WAL mode after the reset if it was in WAL mode before
+** the reset.
+**
+** Because resetting a database is destructive and irreversible, the
+** process requires the use of this obscure API and multiple steps to help
+** ensure that it does not happen by accident.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DEFENSIVE]]
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DEFENSIVE
+**
The SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DEFENSIVE option activates or deactivates the
+** "defensive" flag for a database connection. When the defensive
+** flag is enabled, language features that allow ordinary SQL to
+** deliberately corrupt the database file are disabled. The disabled
+** features include but are not limited to the following:
+**
+**
The [PRAGMA writable_schema=ON] statement.
+**
The [PRAGMA journal_mode=OFF] statement.
+**
Writes to the [sqlite_dbpage] virtual table.
+**
Direct writes to [shadow tables].
+**
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_WRITABLE_SCHEMA]]
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_WRITABLE_SCHEMA
+**
The SQLITE_DBCONFIG_WRITABLE_SCHEMA option activates or deactivates the
+** "writable_schema" flag. This has the same effect and is logically equivalent
+** to setting [PRAGMA writable_schema=ON] or [PRAGMA writable_schema=OFF].
+** The first argument to this setting is an integer which is 0 to disable
+** the writable_schema, positive to enable writable_schema, or negative to
+** leave the setting unchanged. The second parameter is a pointer to an
+** integer into which is written 0 or 1 to indicate whether the writable_schema
+** is enabled or disabled following this call.
+**
The SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LEGACY_ALTER_TABLE option activates or deactivates
+** the legacy behavior of the [ALTER TABLE RENAME] command such it
+** behaves as it did prior to [version 3.24.0] (2018-06-04). See the
+** "Compatibility Notice" on the [ALTER TABLE RENAME documentation] for
+** additional information. This feature can also be turned on and off
+** using the [PRAGMA legacy_alter_table] statement.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DQS_DML]]
+**
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DQS_DML
+**
The SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DQS_DML option activates or deactivates
+** the legacy [double-quoted string literal] misfeature for DML statements
+** only, that is DELETE, INSERT, SELECT, and UPDATE statements. The
+** default value of this setting is determined by the [-DSQLITE_DQS]
+** compile-time option.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DQS_DDL]]
+**
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DQS_DDL
+**
The SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DQS option activates or deactivates
+** the legacy [double-quoted string literal] misfeature for DDL statements,
+** such as CREATE TABLE and CREATE INDEX. The
+** default value of this setting is determined by the [-DSQLITE_DQS]
+** compile-time option.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_TRUSTED_SCHEMA]]
+**
SQLITE_DBCONFIG_TRUSTED_SCHEMA
+**
The SQLITE_DBCONFIG_TRUSTED_SCHEMA option tells SQLite to
+** assume that database schemas are untainted by malicious content.
+** When the SQLITE_DBCONFIG_TRUSTED_SCHEMA option is disabled, SQLite
+** takes additional defensive steps to protect the application from harm
+** including:
+**
+**
Prohibit the use of SQL functions inside triggers, views,
+** CHECK constraints, DEFAULT clauses, expression indexes,
+** partial indexes, or generated columns
+** unless those functions are tagged with [SQLITE_INNOCUOUS].
+**
Prohibit the use of virtual tables inside of triggers or views
+** unless those virtual tables are tagged with [SQLITE_VTAB_INNOCUOUS].
+**
+** This setting defaults to "on" for legacy compatibility, however
+** all applications are advised to turn it off if possible. This setting
+** can also be controlled using the [PRAGMA trusted_schema] statement.
+**
The SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LEGACY_FILE_FORMAT option activates or deactivates
+** the legacy file format flag. When activated, this flag causes all newly
+** created database file to have a schema format version number (the 4-byte
+** integer found at offset 44 into the database header) of 1. This in turn
+** means that the resulting database file will be readable and writable by
+** any SQLite version back to 3.0.0 ([dateof:3.0.0]). Without this setting,
+** newly created databases are generally not understandable by SQLite versions
+** prior to 3.3.0 ([dateof:3.3.0]). As these words are written, there
+** is now scarcely any need to generated database files that are compatible
+** all the way back to version 3.0.0, and so this setting is of little
+** practical use, but is provided so that SQLite can continue to claim the
+** ability to generate new database files that are compatible with version
+** 3.0.0.
+**
Note that when the SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LEGACY_FILE_FORMAT setting is on,
+** the [VACUUM] command will fail with an obscure error when attempting to
+** process a table with generated columns and a descending index. This is
+** not considered a bug since SQLite versions 3.3.0 and earlier do not support
+** either generated columns or decending indexes.
+**
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_MAINDBNAME 1000 /* const char* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LOOKASIDE 1001 /* void* int int */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_FKEY 1002 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_TRIGGER 1003 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_FTS3_TOKENIZER 1004 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_LOAD_EXTENSION 1005 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_NO_CKPT_ON_CLOSE 1006 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_QPSG 1007 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_TRIGGER_EQP 1008 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_RESET_DATABASE 1009 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DEFENSIVE 1010 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_WRITABLE_SCHEMA 1011 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LEGACY_ALTER_TABLE 1012 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DQS_DML 1013 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_DQS_DDL 1014 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_VIEW 1015 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LEGACY_FILE_FORMAT 1016 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_TRUSTED_SCHEMA 1017 /* int int* */
+#define SQLITE_DBCONFIG_MAX 1017 /* Largest DBCONFIG */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Enable Or Disable Extended Result Codes
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_extended_result_codes() routine enables or disables the
+** [extended result codes] feature of SQLite. ^The extended result
+** codes are disabled by default for historical compatibility.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_extended_result_codes(sqlite3*, int onoff);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Last Insert Rowid
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^Each entry in most SQLite tables (except for [WITHOUT ROWID] tables)
+** has a unique 64-bit signed
+** integer key called the [ROWID | "rowid"]. ^The rowid is always available
+** as an undeclared column named ROWID, OID, or _ROWID_ as long as those
+** names are not also used by explicitly declared columns. ^If
+** the table has a column of type [INTEGER PRIMARY KEY] then that column
+** is another alias for the rowid.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_last_insert_rowid(D) interface usually returns the [rowid] of
+** the most recent successful [INSERT] into a rowid table or [virtual table]
+** on database connection D. ^Inserts into [WITHOUT ROWID] tables are not
+** recorded. ^If no successful [INSERT]s into rowid tables have ever occurred
+** on the database connection D, then sqlite3_last_insert_rowid(D) returns
+** zero.
+**
+** As well as being set automatically as rows are inserted into database
+** tables, the value returned by this function may be set explicitly by
+** [sqlite3_set_last_insert_rowid()]
+**
+** Some virtual table implementations may INSERT rows into rowid tables as
+** part of committing a transaction (e.g. to flush data accumulated in memory
+** to disk). In this case subsequent calls to this function return the rowid
+** associated with these internal INSERT operations, which leads to
+** unintuitive results. Virtual table implementations that do write to rowid
+** tables in this way can avoid this problem by restoring the original
+** rowid value using [sqlite3_set_last_insert_rowid()] before returning
+** control to the user.
+**
+** ^(If an [INSERT] occurs within a trigger then this routine will
+** return the [rowid] of the inserted row as long as the trigger is
+** running. Once the trigger program ends, the value returned
+** by this routine reverts to what it was before the trigger was fired.)^
+**
+** ^An [INSERT] that fails due to a constraint violation is not a
+** successful [INSERT] and does not change the value returned by this
+** routine. ^Thus INSERT OR FAIL, INSERT OR IGNORE, INSERT OR ROLLBACK,
+** and INSERT OR ABORT make no changes to the return value of this
+** routine when their insertion fails. ^(When INSERT OR REPLACE
+** encounters a constraint violation, it does not fail. The
+** INSERT continues to completion after deleting rows that caused
+** the constraint problem so INSERT OR REPLACE will always change
+** the return value of this interface.)^
+**
+** ^For the purposes of this routine, an [INSERT] is considered to
+** be successful even if it is subsequently rolled back.
+**
+** This function is accessible to SQL statements via the
+** [last_insert_rowid() SQL function].
+**
+** If a separate thread performs a new [INSERT] on the same
+** database connection while the [sqlite3_last_insert_rowid()]
+** function is running and thus changes the last insert [rowid],
+** then the value returned by [sqlite3_last_insert_rowid()] is
+** unpredictable and might not equal either the old or the new
+** last insert [rowid].
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_last_insert_rowid(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Set the Last Insert Rowid value.
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** The sqlite3_set_last_insert_rowid(D, R) method allows the application to
+** set the value returned by calling sqlite3_last_insert_rowid(D) to R
+** without inserting a row into the database.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_set_last_insert_rowid(sqlite3*,sqlite3_int64);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Count The Number Of Rows Modified
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^This function returns the number of rows modified, inserted or
+** deleted by the most recently completed INSERT, UPDATE or DELETE
+** statement on the database connection specified by the only parameter.
+** ^Executing any other type of SQL statement does not modify the value
+** returned by this function.
+**
+** ^Only changes made directly by the INSERT, UPDATE or DELETE statement are
+** considered - auxiliary changes caused by [CREATE TRIGGER | triggers],
+** [foreign key actions] or [REPLACE] constraint resolution are not counted.
+**
+** Changes to a view that are intercepted by
+** [INSTEAD OF trigger | INSTEAD OF triggers] are not counted. ^The value
+** returned by sqlite3_changes() immediately after an INSERT, UPDATE or
+** DELETE statement run on a view is always zero. Only changes made to real
+** tables are counted.
+**
+** Things are more complicated if the sqlite3_changes() function is
+** executed while a trigger program is running. This may happen if the
+** program uses the [changes() SQL function], or if some other callback
+** function invokes sqlite3_changes() directly. Essentially:
+**
+**
+**
^(Before entering a trigger program the value returned by
+** sqlite3_changes() function is saved. After the trigger program
+** has finished, the original value is restored.)^
+**
+**
^(Within a trigger program each INSERT, UPDATE and DELETE
+** statement sets the value returned by sqlite3_changes()
+** upon completion as normal. Of course, this value will not include
+** any changes performed by sub-triggers, as the sqlite3_changes()
+** value will be saved and restored after each sub-trigger has run.)^
+**
+**
+** ^This means that if the changes() SQL function (or similar) is used
+** by the first INSERT, UPDATE or DELETE statement within a trigger, it
+** returns the value as set when the calling statement began executing.
+** ^If it is used by the second or subsequent such statement within a trigger
+** program, the value returned reflects the number of rows modified by the
+** previous INSERT, UPDATE or DELETE statement within the same trigger.
+**
+** If a separate thread makes changes on the same database connection
+** while [sqlite3_changes()] is running then the value returned
+** is unpredictable and not meaningful.
+**
+** See also:
+**
+**
the [sqlite3_total_changes()] interface
+**
the [count_changes pragma]
+**
the [changes() SQL function]
+**
the [data_version pragma]
+**
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_changes(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Total Number Of Rows Modified
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^This function returns the total number of rows inserted, modified or
+** deleted by all [INSERT], [UPDATE] or [DELETE] statements completed
+** since the database connection was opened, including those executed as
+** part of trigger programs. ^Executing any other type of SQL statement
+** does not affect the value returned by sqlite3_total_changes().
+**
+** ^Changes made as part of [foreign key actions] are included in the
+** count, but those made as part of REPLACE constraint resolution are
+** not. ^Changes to a view that are intercepted by INSTEAD OF triggers
+** are not counted.
+**
+** The [sqlite3_total_changes(D)] interface only reports the number
+** of rows that changed due to SQL statement run against database
+** connection D. Any changes by other database connections are ignored.
+** To detect changes against a database file from other database
+** connections use the [PRAGMA data_version] command or the
+** [SQLITE_FCNTL_DATA_VERSION] [file control].
+**
+** If a separate thread makes changes on the same database connection
+** while [sqlite3_total_changes()] is running then the value
+** returned is unpredictable and not meaningful.
+**
+** See also:
+**
+**
the [sqlite3_changes()] interface
+**
the [count_changes pragma]
+**
the [changes() SQL function]
+**
the [data_version pragma]
+**
the [SQLITE_FCNTL_DATA_VERSION] [file control]
+**
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_total_changes(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Interrupt A Long-Running Query
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^This function causes any pending database operation to abort and
+** return at its earliest opportunity. This routine is typically
+** called in response to a user action such as pressing "Cancel"
+** or Ctrl-C where the user wants a long query operation to halt
+** immediately.
+**
+** ^It is safe to call this routine from a thread different from the
+** thread that is currently running the database operation. But it
+** is not safe to call this routine with a [database connection] that
+** is closed or might close before sqlite3_interrupt() returns.
+**
+** ^If an SQL operation is very nearly finished at the time when
+** sqlite3_interrupt() is called, then it might not have an opportunity
+** to be interrupted and might continue to completion.
+**
+** ^An SQL operation that is interrupted will return [SQLITE_INTERRUPT].
+** ^If the interrupted SQL operation is an INSERT, UPDATE, or DELETE
+** that is inside an explicit transaction, then the entire transaction
+** will be rolled back automatically.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_interrupt(D) call is in effect until all currently running
+** SQL statements on [database connection] D complete. ^Any new SQL statements
+** that are started after the sqlite3_interrupt() call and before the
+** running statement count reaches zero are interrupted as if they had been
+** running prior to the sqlite3_interrupt() call. ^New SQL statements
+** that are started after the running statement count reaches zero are
+** not effected by the sqlite3_interrupt().
+** ^A call to sqlite3_interrupt(D) that occurs when there are no running
+** SQL statements is a no-op and has no effect on SQL statements
+** that are started after the sqlite3_interrupt() call returns.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_interrupt(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Determine If An SQL Statement Is Complete
+**
+** These routines are useful during command-line input to determine if the
+** currently entered text seems to form a complete SQL statement or
+** if additional input is needed before sending the text into
+** SQLite for parsing. ^These routines return 1 if the input string
+** appears to be a complete SQL statement. ^A statement is judged to be
+** complete if it ends with a semicolon token and is not a prefix of a
+** well-formed CREATE TRIGGER statement. ^Semicolons that are embedded within
+** string literals or quoted identifier names or comments are not
+** independent tokens (they are part of the token in which they are
+** embedded) and thus do not count as a statement terminator. ^Whitespace
+** and comments that follow the final semicolon are ignored.
+**
+** ^These routines return 0 if the statement is incomplete. ^If a
+** memory allocation fails, then SQLITE_NOMEM is returned.
+**
+** ^These routines do not parse the SQL statements thus
+** will not detect syntactically incorrect SQL.
+**
+** ^(If SQLite has not been initialized using [sqlite3_initialize()] prior
+** to invoking sqlite3_complete16() then sqlite3_initialize() is invoked
+** automatically by sqlite3_complete16(). If that initialization fails,
+** then the return value from sqlite3_complete16() will be non-zero
+** regardless of whether or not the input SQL is complete.)^
+**
+** The input to [sqlite3_complete()] must be a zero-terminated
+** UTF-8 string.
+**
+** The input to [sqlite3_complete16()] must be a zero-terminated
+** UTF-16 string in native byte order.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_complete(const char *sql);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_complete16(const void *sql);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Register A Callback To Handle SQLITE_BUSY Errors
+** KEYWORDS: {busy-handler callback} {busy handler}
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_busy_handler(D,X,P) routine sets a callback function X
+** that might be invoked with argument P whenever
+** an attempt is made to access a database table associated with
+** [database connection] D when another thread
+** or process has the table locked.
+** The sqlite3_busy_handler() interface is used to implement
+** [sqlite3_busy_timeout()] and [PRAGMA busy_timeout].
+**
+** ^If the busy callback is NULL, then [SQLITE_BUSY]
+** is returned immediately upon encountering the lock. ^If the busy callback
+** is not NULL, then the callback might be invoked with two arguments.
+**
+** ^The first argument to the busy handler is a copy of the void* pointer which
+** is the third argument to sqlite3_busy_handler(). ^The second argument to
+** the busy handler callback is the number of times that the busy handler has
+** been invoked previously for the same locking event. ^If the
+** busy callback returns 0, then no additional attempts are made to
+** access the database and [SQLITE_BUSY] is returned
+** to the application.
+** ^If the callback returns non-zero, then another attempt
+** is made to access the database and the cycle repeats.
+**
+** The presence of a busy handler does not guarantee that it will be invoked
+** when there is lock contention. ^If SQLite determines that invoking the busy
+** handler could result in a deadlock, it will go ahead and return [SQLITE_BUSY]
+** to the application instead of invoking the
+** busy handler.
+** Consider a scenario where one process is holding a read lock that
+** it is trying to promote to a reserved lock and
+** a second process is holding a reserved lock that it is trying
+** to promote to an exclusive lock. The first process cannot proceed
+** because it is blocked by the second and the second process cannot
+** proceed because it is blocked by the first. If both processes
+** invoke the busy handlers, neither will make any progress. Therefore,
+** SQLite returns [SQLITE_BUSY] for the first process, hoping that this
+** will induce the first process to release its read lock and allow
+** the second process to proceed.
+**
+** ^The default busy callback is NULL.
+**
+** ^(There can only be a single busy handler defined for each
+** [database connection]. Setting a new busy handler clears any
+** previously set handler.)^ ^Note that calling [sqlite3_busy_timeout()]
+** or evaluating [PRAGMA busy_timeout=N] will change the
+** busy handler and thus clear any previously set busy handler.
+**
+** The busy callback should not take any actions which modify the
+** database connection that invoked the busy handler. In other words,
+** the busy handler is not reentrant. Any such actions
+** result in undefined behavior.
+**
+** A busy handler must not close the database connection
+** or [prepared statement] that invoked the busy handler.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_busy_handler(sqlite3*,int(*)(void*,int),void*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Set A Busy Timeout
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^This routine sets a [sqlite3_busy_handler | busy handler] that sleeps
+** for a specified amount of time when a table is locked. ^The handler
+** will sleep multiple times until at least "ms" milliseconds of sleeping
+** have accumulated. ^After at least "ms" milliseconds of sleeping,
+** the handler returns 0 which causes [sqlite3_step()] to return
+** [SQLITE_BUSY].
+**
+** ^Calling this routine with an argument less than or equal to zero
+** turns off all busy handlers.
+**
+** ^(There can only be a single busy handler for a particular
+** [database connection] at any given moment. If another busy handler
+** was defined (using [sqlite3_busy_handler()]) prior to calling
+** this routine, that other busy handler is cleared.)^
+**
+** See also: [PRAGMA busy_timeout]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_busy_timeout(sqlite3*, int ms);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Convenience Routines For Running Queries
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** This is a legacy interface that is preserved for backwards compatibility.
+** Use of this interface is not recommended.
+**
+** Definition: A result table is memory data structure created by the
+** [sqlite3_get_table()] interface. A result table records the
+** complete query results from one or more queries.
+**
+** The table conceptually has a number of rows and columns. But
+** these numbers are not part of the result table itself. These
+** numbers are obtained separately. Let N be the number of rows
+** and M be the number of columns.
+**
+** A result table is an array of pointers to zero-terminated UTF-8 strings.
+** There are (N+1)*M elements in the array. The first M pointers point
+** to zero-terminated strings that contain the names of the columns.
+** The remaining entries all point to query results. NULL values result
+** in NULL pointers. All other values are in their UTF-8 zero-terminated
+** string representation as returned by [sqlite3_column_text()].
+**
+** A result table might consist of one or more memory allocations.
+** It is not safe to pass a result table directly to [sqlite3_free()].
+** A result table should be deallocated using [sqlite3_free_table()].
+**
+** ^(As an example of the result table format, suppose a query result
+** is as follows:
+**
+**
+** Name | Age
+** -----------------------
+** Alice | 43
+** Bob | 28
+** Cindy | 21
+**
+**
+** There are two columns (M==2) and three rows (N==3). Thus the
+** result table has 8 entries. Suppose the result table is stored
+** in an array named azResult. Then azResult holds this content:
+**
+**
)^
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_get_table() function evaluates one or more
+** semicolon-separated SQL statements in the zero-terminated UTF-8
+** string of its 2nd parameter and returns a result table to the
+** pointer given in its 3rd parameter.
+**
+** After the application has finished with the result from sqlite3_get_table(),
+** it must pass the result table pointer to sqlite3_free_table() in order to
+** release the memory that was malloced. Because of the way the
+** [sqlite3_malloc()] happens within sqlite3_get_table(), the calling
+** function must not try to call [sqlite3_free()] directly. Only
+** [sqlite3_free_table()] is able to release the memory properly and safely.
+**
+** The sqlite3_get_table() interface is implemented as a wrapper around
+** [sqlite3_exec()]. The sqlite3_get_table() routine does not have access
+** to any internal data structures of SQLite. It uses only the public
+** interface defined here. As a consequence, errors that occur in the
+** wrapper layer outside of the internal [sqlite3_exec()] call are not
+** reflected in subsequent calls to [sqlite3_errcode()] or
+** [sqlite3_errmsg()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_get_table(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* An open database */
+ const char *zSql, /* SQL to be evaluated */
+ char ***pazResult, /* Results of the query */
+ int *pnRow, /* Number of result rows written here */
+ int *pnColumn, /* Number of result columns written here */
+ char **pzErrmsg /* Error msg written here */
+);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_free_table(char **result);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Formatted String Printing Functions
+**
+** These routines are work-alikes of the "printf()" family of functions
+** from the standard C library.
+** These routines understand most of the common formatting options from
+** the standard library printf()
+** plus some additional non-standard formats ([%q], [%Q], [%w], and [%z]).
+** See the [built-in printf()] documentation for details.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_mprintf() and sqlite3_vmprintf() routines write their
+** results into memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc64()].
+** The strings returned by these two routines should be
+** released by [sqlite3_free()]. ^Both routines return a
+** NULL pointer if [sqlite3_malloc64()] is unable to allocate enough
+** memory to hold the resulting string.
+**
+** ^(The sqlite3_snprintf() routine is similar to "snprintf()" from
+** the standard C library. The result is written into the
+** buffer supplied as the second parameter whose size is given by
+** the first parameter. Note that the order of the
+** first two parameters is reversed from snprintf().)^ This is an
+** historical accident that cannot be fixed without breaking
+** backwards compatibility. ^(Note also that sqlite3_snprintf()
+** returns a pointer to its buffer instead of the number of
+** characters actually written into the buffer.)^ We admit that
+** the number of characters written would be a more useful return
+** value but we cannot change the implementation of sqlite3_snprintf()
+** now without breaking compatibility.
+**
+** ^As long as the buffer size is greater than zero, sqlite3_snprintf()
+** guarantees that the buffer is always zero-terminated. ^The first
+** parameter "n" is the total size of the buffer, including space for
+** the zero terminator. So the longest string that can be completely
+** written will be n-1 characters.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_vsnprintf() routine is a varargs version of sqlite3_snprintf().
+**
+** See also: [built-in printf()], [printf() SQL function]
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_mprintf(const char*,...);
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_vmprintf(const char*, va_list);
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_snprintf(int,char*,const char*, ...);
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_vsnprintf(int,char*,const char*, va_list);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Memory Allocation Subsystem
+**
+** The SQLite core uses these three routines for all of its own
+** internal memory allocation needs. "Core" in the previous sentence
+** does not include operating-system specific [VFS] implementation. The
+** Windows VFS uses native malloc() and free() for some operations.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_malloc() routine returns a pointer to a block
+** of memory at least N bytes in length, where N is the parameter.
+** ^If sqlite3_malloc() is unable to obtain sufficient free
+** memory, it returns a NULL pointer. ^If the parameter N to
+** sqlite3_malloc() is zero or negative then sqlite3_malloc() returns
+** a NULL pointer.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_malloc64(N) routine works just like
+** sqlite3_malloc(N) except that N is an unsigned 64-bit integer instead
+** of a signed 32-bit integer.
+**
+** ^Calling sqlite3_free() with a pointer previously returned
+** by sqlite3_malloc() or sqlite3_realloc() releases that memory so
+** that it might be reused. ^The sqlite3_free() routine is
+** a no-op if is called with a NULL pointer. Passing a NULL pointer
+** to sqlite3_free() is harmless. After being freed, memory
+** should neither be read nor written. Even reading previously freed
+** memory might result in a segmentation fault or other severe error.
+** Memory corruption, a segmentation fault, or other severe error
+** might result if sqlite3_free() is called with a non-NULL pointer that
+** was not obtained from sqlite3_malloc() or sqlite3_realloc().
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_realloc(X,N) interface attempts to resize a
+** prior memory allocation X to be at least N bytes.
+** ^If the X parameter to sqlite3_realloc(X,N)
+** is a NULL pointer then its behavior is identical to calling
+** sqlite3_malloc(N).
+** ^If the N parameter to sqlite3_realloc(X,N) is zero or
+** negative then the behavior is exactly the same as calling
+** sqlite3_free(X).
+** ^sqlite3_realloc(X,N) returns a pointer to a memory allocation
+** of at least N bytes in size or NULL if insufficient memory is available.
+** ^If M is the size of the prior allocation, then min(N,M) bytes
+** of the prior allocation are copied into the beginning of buffer returned
+** by sqlite3_realloc(X,N) and the prior allocation is freed.
+** ^If sqlite3_realloc(X,N) returns NULL and N is positive, then the
+** prior allocation is not freed.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_realloc64(X,N) interfaces works the same as
+** sqlite3_realloc(X,N) except that N is a 64-bit unsigned integer instead
+** of a 32-bit signed integer.
+**
+** ^If X is a memory allocation previously obtained from sqlite3_malloc(),
+** sqlite3_malloc64(), sqlite3_realloc(), or sqlite3_realloc64(), then
+** sqlite3_msize(X) returns the size of that memory allocation in bytes.
+** ^The value returned by sqlite3_msize(X) might be larger than the number
+** of bytes requested when X was allocated. ^If X is a NULL pointer then
+** sqlite3_msize(X) returns zero. If X points to something that is not
+** the beginning of memory allocation, or if it points to a formerly
+** valid memory allocation that has now been freed, then the behavior
+** of sqlite3_msize(X) is undefined and possibly harmful.
+**
+** ^The memory returned by sqlite3_malloc(), sqlite3_realloc(),
+** sqlite3_malloc64(), and sqlite3_realloc64()
+** is always aligned to at least an 8 byte boundary, or to a
+** 4 byte boundary if the [SQLITE_4_BYTE_ALIGNED_MALLOC] compile-time
+** option is used.
+**
+** The pointer arguments to [sqlite3_free()] and [sqlite3_realloc()]
+** must be either NULL or else pointers obtained from a prior
+** invocation of [sqlite3_malloc()] or [sqlite3_realloc()] that have
+** not yet been released.
+**
+** The application must not read or write any part of
+** a block of memory after it has been released using
+** [sqlite3_free()] or [sqlite3_realloc()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_malloc(int);
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_malloc64(sqlite3_uint64);
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_realloc(void*, int);
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_realloc64(void*, sqlite3_uint64);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_free(void*);
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_uint64 sqlite3_msize(void*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Memory Allocator Statistics
+**
+** SQLite provides these two interfaces for reporting on the status
+** of the [sqlite3_malloc()], [sqlite3_free()], and [sqlite3_realloc()]
+** routines, which form the built-in memory allocation subsystem.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_memory_used()] routine returns the number of bytes
+** of memory currently outstanding (malloced but not freed).
+** ^The [sqlite3_memory_highwater()] routine returns the maximum
+** value of [sqlite3_memory_used()] since the high-water mark
+** was last reset. ^The values returned by [sqlite3_memory_used()] and
+** [sqlite3_memory_highwater()] include any overhead
+** added by SQLite in its implementation of [sqlite3_malloc()],
+** but not overhead added by the any underlying system library
+** routines that [sqlite3_malloc()] may call.
+**
+** ^The memory high-water mark is reset to the current value of
+** [sqlite3_memory_used()] if and only if the parameter to
+** [sqlite3_memory_highwater()] is true. ^The value returned
+** by [sqlite3_memory_highwater(1)] is the high-water mark
+** prior to the reset.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_memory_used(void);
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_memory_highwater(int resetFlag);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Pseudo-Random Number Generator
+**
+** SQLite contains a high-quality pseudo-random number generator (PRNG) used to
+** select random [ROWID | ROWIDs] when inserting new records into a table that
+** already uses the largest possible [ROWID]. The PRNG is also used for
+** the built-in random() and randomblob() SQL functions. This interface allows
+** applications to access the same PRNG for other purposes.
+**
+** ^A call to this routine stores N bytes of randomness into buffer P.
+** ^The P parameter can be a NULL pointer.
+**
+** ^If this routine has not been previously called or if the previous
+** call had N less than one or a NULL pointer for P, then the PRNG is
+** seeded using randomness obtained from the xRandomness method of
+** the default [sqlite3_vfs] object.
+** ^If the previous call to this routine had an N of 1 or more and a
+** non-NULL P then the pseudo-randomness is generated
+** internally and without recourse to the [sqlite3_vfs] xRandomness
+** method.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_randomness(int N, void *P);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Compile-Time Authorization Callbacks
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+** KEYWORDS: {authorizer callback}
+**
+** ^This routine registers an authorizer callback with a particular
+** [database connection], supplied in the first argument.
+** ^The authorizer callback is invoked as SQL statements are being compiled
+** by [sqlite3_prepare()] or its variants [sqlite3_prepare_v2()],
+** [sqlite3_prepare_v3()], [sqlite3_prepare16()], [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()],
+** and [sqlite3_prepare16_v3()]. ^At various
+** points during the compilation process, as logic is being created
+** to perform various actions, the authorizer callback is invoked to
+** see if those actions are allowed. ^The authorizer callback should
+** return [SQLITE_OK] to allow the action, [SQLITE_IGNORE] to disallow the
+** specific action but allow the SQL statement to continue to be
+** compiled, or [SQLITE_DENY] to cause the entire SQL statement to be
+** rejected with an error. ^If the authorizer callback returns
+** any value other than [SQLITE_IGNORE], [SQLITE_OK], or [SQLITE_DENY]
+** then the [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or equivalent call that triggered
+** the authorizer will fail with an error message.
+**
+** When the callback returns [SQLITE_OK], that means the operation
+** requested is ok. ^When the callback returns [SQLITE_DENY], the
+** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or equivalent call that triggered the
+** authorizer will fail with an error message explaining that
+** access is denied.
+**
+** ^The first parameter to the authorizer callback is a copy of the third
+** parameter to the sqlite3_set_authorizer() interface. ^The second parameter
+** to the callback is an integer [SQLITE_COPY | action code] that specifies
+** the particular action to be authorized. ^The third through sixth parameters
+** to the callback are either NULL pointers or zero-terminated strings
+** that contain additional details about the action to be authorized.
+** Applications must always be prepared to encounter a NULL pointer in any
+** of the third through the sixth parameters of the authorization callback.
+**
+** ^If the action code is [SQLITE_READ]
+** and the callback returns [SQLITE_IGNORE] then the
+** [prepared statement] statement is constructed to substitute
+** a NULL value in place of the table column that would have
+** been read if [SQLITE_OK] had been returned. The [SQLITE_IGNORE]
+** return can be used to deny an untrusted user access to individual
+** columns of a table.
+** ^When a table is referenced by a [SELECT] but no column values are
+** extracted from that table (for example in a query like
+** "SELECT count(*) FROM tab") then the [SQLITE_READ] authorizer callback
+** is invoked once for that table with a column name that is an empty string.
+** ^If the action code is [SQLITE_DELETE] and the callback returns
+** [SQLITE_IGNORE] then the [DELETE] operation proceeds but the
+** [truncate optimization] is disabled and all rows are deleted individually.
+**
+** An authorizer is used when [sqlite3_prepare | preparing]
+** SQL statements from an untrusted source, to ensure that the SQL statements
+** do not try to access data they are not allowed to see, or that they do not
+** try to execute malicious statements that damage the database. For
+** example, an application may allow a user to enter arbitrary
+** SQL queries for evaluation by a database. But the application does
+** not want the user to be able to make arbitrary changes to the
+** database. An authorizer could then be put in place while the
+** user-entered SQL is being [sqlite3_prepare | prepared] that
+** disallows everything except [SELECT] statements.
+**
+** Applications that need to process SQL from untrusted sources
+** might also consider lowering resource limits using [sqlite3_limit()]
+** and limiting database size using the [max_page_count] [PRAGMA]
+** in addition to using an authorizer.
+**
+** ^(Only a single authorizer can be in place on a database connection
+** at a time. Each call to sqlite3_set_authorizer overrides the
+** previous call.)^ ^Disable the authorizer by installing a NULL callback.
+** The authorizer is disabled by default.
+**
+** The authorizer callback must not do anything that will modify
+** the database connection that invoked the authorizer callback.
+** Note that [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] and [sqlite3_step()] both modify their
+** database connections for the meaning of "modify" in this paragraph.
+**
+** ^When [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] is used to prepare a statement, the
+** statement might be re-prepared during [sqlite3_step()] due to a
+** schema change. Hence, the application should ensure that the
+** correct authorizer callback remains in place during the [sqlite3_step()].
+**
+** ^Note that the authorizer callback is invoked only during
+** [sqlite3_prepare()] or its variants. Authorization is not
+** performed during statement evaluation in [sqlite3_step()], unless
+** as stated in the previous paragraph, sqlite3_step() invokes
+** sqlite3_prepare_v2() to reprepare a statement after a schema change.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_set_authorizer(
+ sqlite3*,
+ int (*xAuth)(void*,int,const char*,const char*,const char*,const char*),
+ void *pUserData
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Authorizer Return Codes
+**
+** The [sqlite3_set_authorizer | authorizer callback function] must
+** return either [SQLITE_OK] or one of these two constants in order
+** to signal SQLite whether or not the action is permitted. See the
+** [sqlite3_set_authorizer | authorizer documentation] for additional
+** information.
+**
+** Note that SQLITE_IGNORE is also used as a [conflict resolution mode]
+** returned from the [sqlite3_vtab_on_conflict()] interface.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_DENY 1 /* Abort the SQL statement with an error */
+#define SQLITE_IGNORE 2 /* Don't allow access, but don't generate an error */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Authorizer Action Codes
+**
+** The [sqlite3_set_authorizer()] interface registers a callback function
+** that is invoked to authorize certain SQL statement actions. The
+** second parameter to the callback is an integer code that specifies
+** what action is being authorized. These are the integer action codes that
+** the authorizer callback may be passed.
+**
+** These action code values signify what kind of operation is to be
+** authorized. The 3rd and 4th parameters to the authorization
+** callback function will be parameters or NULL depending on which of these
+** codes is used as the second parameter. ^(The 5th parameter to the
+** authorizer callback is the name of the database ("main", "temp",
+** etc.) if applicable.)^ ^The 6th parameter to the authorizer callback
+** is the name of the inner-most trigger or view that is responsible for
+** the access attempt or NULL if this access attempt is directly from
+** top-level SQL code.
+*/
+/******************************************* 3rd ************ 4th ***********/
+#define SQLITE_CREATE_INDEX 1 /* Index Name Table Name */
+#define SQLITE_CREATE_TABLE 2 /* Table Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_INDEX 3 /* Index Name Table Name */
+#define SQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_TABLE 4 /* Table Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_TRIGGER 5 /* Trigger Name Table Name */
+#define SQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_VIEW 6 /* View Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_CREATE_TRIGGER 7 /* Trigger Name Table Name */
+#define SQLITE_CREATE_VIEW 8 /* View Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_DELETE 9 /* Table Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_DROP_INDEX 10 /* Index Name Table Name */
+#define SQLITE_DROP_TABLE 11 /* Table Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_DROP_TEMP_INDEX 12 /* Index Name Table Name */
+#define SQLITE_DROP_TEMP_TABLE 13 /* Table Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_DROP_TEMP_TRIGGER 14 /* Trigger Name Table Name */
+#define SQLITE_DROP_TEMP_VIEW 15 /* View Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_DROP_TRIGGER 16 /* Trigger Name Table Name */
+#define SQLITE_DROP_VIEW 17 /* View Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_INSERT 18 /* Table Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_PRAGMA 19 /* Pragma Name 1st arg or NULL */
+#define SQLITE_READ 20 /* Table Name Column Name */
+#define SQLITE_SELECT 21 /* NULL NULL */
+#define SQLITE_TRANSACTION 22 /* Operation NULL */
+#define SQLITE_UPDATE 23 /* Table Name Column Name */
+#define SQLITE_ATTACH 24 /* Filename NULL */
+#define SQLITE_DETACH 25 /* Database Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_ALTER_TABLE 26 /* Database Name Table Name */
+#define SQLITE_REINDEX 27 /* Index Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_ANALYZE 28 /* Table Name NULL */
+#define SQLITE_CREATE_VTABLE 29 /* Table Name Module Name */
+#define SQLITE_DROP_VTABLE 30 /* Table Name Module Name */
+#define SQLITE_FUNCTION 31 /* NULL Function Name */
+#define SQLITE_SAVEPOINT 32 /* Operation Savepoint Name */
+#define SQLITE_COPY 0 /* No longer used */
+#define SQLITE_RECURSIVE 33 /* NULL NULL */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Tracing And Profiling Functions
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** These routines are deprecated. Use the [sqlite3_trace_v2()] interface
+** instead of the routines described here.
+**
+** These routines register callback functions that can be used for
+** tracing and profiling the execution of SQL statements.
+**
+** ^The callback function registered by sqlite3_trace() is invoked at
+** various times when an SQL statement is being run by [sqlite3_step()].
+** ^The sqlite3_trace() callback is invoked with a UTF-8 rendering of the
+** SQL statement text as the statement first begins executing.
+** ^(Additional sqlite3_trace() callbacks might occur
+** as each triggered subprogram is entered. The callbacks for triggers
+** contain a UTF-8 SQL comment that identifies the trigger.)^
+**
+** The [SQLITE_TRACE_SIZE_LIMIT] compile-time option can be used to limit
+** the length of [bound parameter] expansion in the output of sqlite3_trace().
+**
+** ^The callback function registered by sqlite3_profile() is invoked
+** as each SQL statement finishes. ^The profile callback contains
+** the original statement text and an estimate of wall-clock time
+** of how long that statement took to run. ^The profile callback
+** time is in units of nanoseconds, however the current implementation
+** is only capable of millisecond resolution so the six least significant
+** digits in the time are meaningless. Future versions of SQLite
+** might provide greater resolution on the profiler callback. Invoking
+** either [sqlite3_trace()] or [sqlite3_trace_v2()] will cancel the
+** profile callback.
+*/
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_DEPRECATED void *sqlite3_trace(sqlite3*,
+ void(*xTrace)(void*,const char*), void*);
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_DEPRECATED void *sqlite3_profile(sqlite3*,
+ void(*xProfile)(void*,const char*,sqlite3_uint64), void*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: SQL Trace Event Codes
+** KEYWORDS: SQLITE_TRACE
+**
+** These constants identify classes of events that can be monitored
+** using the [sqlite3_trace_v2()] tracing logic. The M argument
+** to [sqlite3_trace_v2(D,M,X,P)] is an OR-ed combination of one or more of
+** the following constants. ^The first argument to the trace callback
+** is one of the following constants.
+**
+** New tracing constants may be added in future releases.
+**
+** ^A trace callback has four arguments: xCallback(T,C,P,X).
+** ^The T argument is one of the integer type codes above.
+** ^The C argument is a copy of the context pointer passed in as the
+** fourth argument to [sqlite3_trace_v2()].
+** The P and X arguments are pointers whose meanings depend on T.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_TRACE_STMT]]
SQLITE_TRACE_STMT
+**
^An SQLITE_TRACE_STMT callback is invoked when a prepared statement
+** first begins running and possibly at other times during the
+** execution of the prepared statement, such as at the start of each
+** trigger subprogram. ^The P argument is a pointer to the
+** [prepared statement]. ^The X argument is a pointer to a string which
+** is the unexpanded SQL text of the prepared statement or an SQL comment
+** that indicates the invocation of a trigger. ^The callback can compute
+** the same text that would have been returned by the legacy [sqlite3_trace()]
+** interface by using the X argument when X begins with "--" and invoking
+** [sqlite3_expanded_sql(P)] otherwise.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_TRACE_PROFILE]]
SQLITE_TRACE_PROFILE
+**
^An SQLITE_TRACE_PROFILE callback provides approximately the same
+** information as is provided by the [sqlite3_profile()] callback.
+** ^The P argument is a pointer to the [prepared statement] and the
+** X argument points to a 64-bit integer which is the estimated of
+** the number of nanosecond that the prepared statement took to run.
+** ^The SQLITE_TRACE_PROFILE callback is invoked when the statement finishes.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_TRACE_ROW]]
SQLITE_TRACE_ROW
+**
^An SQLITE_TRACE_ROW callback is invoked whenever a prepared
+** statement generates a single row of result.
+** ^The P argument is a pointer to the [prepared statement] and the
+** X argument is unused.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_TRACE_CLOSE]]
SQLITE_TRACE_CLOSE
+**
^An SQLITE_TRACE_CLOSE callback is invoked when a database
+** connection closes.
+** ^The P argument is a pointer to the [database connection] object
+** and the X argument is unused.
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_TRACE_STMT 0x01
+#define SQLITE_TRACE_PROFILE 0x02
+#define SQLITE_TRACE_ROW 0x04
+#define SQLITE_TRACE_CLOSE 0x08
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: SQL Trace Hook
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_trace_v2(D,M,X,P) interface registers a trace callback
+** function X against [database connection] D, using property mask M
+** and context pointer P. ^If the X callback is
+** NULL or if the M mask is zero, then tracing is disabled. The
+** M argument should be the bitwise OR-ed combination of
+** zero or more [SQLITE_TRACE] constants.
+**
+** ^Each call to either sqlite3_trace() or sqlite3_trace_v2() overrides
+** (cancels) any prior calls to sqlite3_trace() or sqlite3_trace_v2().
+**
+** ^The X callback is invoked whenever any of the events identified by
+** mask M occur. ^The integer return value from the callback is currently
+** ignored, though this may change in future releases. Callback
+** implementations should return zero to ensure future compatibility.
+**
+** ^A trace callback is invoked with four arguments: callback(T,C,P,X).
+** ^The T argument is one of the [SQLITE_TRACE]
+** constants to indicate why the callback was invoked.
+** ^The C argument is a copy of the context pointer.
+** The P and X arguments are pointers whose meanings depend on T.
+**
+** The sqlite3_trace_v2() interface is intended to replace the legacy
+** interfaces [sqlite3_trace()] and [sqlite3_profile()], both of which
+** are deprecated.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_trace_v2(
+ sqlite3*,
+ unsigned uMask,
+ int(*xCallback)(unsigned,void*,void*,void*),
+ void *pCtx
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Query Progress Callbacks
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_progress_handler(D,N,X,P) interface causes the callback
+** function X to be invoked periodically during long running calls to
+** [sqlite3_exec()], [sqlite3_step()] and [sqlite3_get_table()] for
+** database connection D. An example use for this
+** interface is to keep a GUI updated during a large query.
+**
+** ^The parameter P is passed through as the only parameter to the
+** callback function X. ^The parameter N is the approximate number of
+** [virtual machine instructions] that are evaluated between successive
+** invocations of the callback X. ^If N is less than one then the progress
+** handler is disabled.
+**
+** ^Only a single progress handler may be defined at one time per
+** [database connection]; setting a new progress handler cancels the
+** old one. ^Setting parameter X to NULL disables the progress handler.
+** ^The progress handler is also disabled by setting N to a value less
+** than 1.
+**
+** ^If the progress callback returns non-zero, the operation is
+** interrupted. This feature can be used to implement a
+** "Cancel" button on a GUI progress dialog box.
+**
+** The progress handler callback must not do anything that will modify
+** the database connection that invoked the progress handler.
+** Note that [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] and [sqlite3_step()] both modify their
+** database connections for the meaning of "modify" in this paragraph.
+**
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_progress_handler(sqlite3*, int, int(*)(void*), void*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Opening A New Database Connection
+** CONSTRUCTOR: sqlite3
+**
+** ^These routines open an SQLite database file as specified by the
+** filename argument. ^The filename argument is interpreted as UTF-8 for
+** sqlite3_open() and sqlite3_open_v2() and as UTF-16 in the native byte
+** order for sqlite3_open16(). ^(A [database connection] handle is usually
+** returned in *ppDb, even if an error occurs. The only exception is that
+** if SQLite is unable to allocate memory to hold the [sqlite3] object,
+** a NULL will be written into *ppDb instead of a pointer to the [sqlite3]
+** object.)^ ^(If the database is opened (and/or created) successfully, then
+** [SQLITE_OK] is returned. Otherwise an [error code] is returned.)^ ^The
+** [sqlite3_errmsg()] or [sqlite3_errmsg16()] routines can be used to obtain
+** an English language description of the error following a failure of any
+** of the sqlite3_open() routines.
+**
+** ^The default encoding will be UTF-8 for databases created using
+** sqlite3_open() or sqlite3_open_v2(). ^The default encoding for databases
+** created using sqlite3_open16() will be UTF-16 in the native byte order.
+**
+** Whether or not an error occurs when it is opened, resources
+** associated with the [database connection] handle should be released by
+** passing it to [sqlite3_close()] when it is no longer required.
+**
+** The sqlite3_open_v2() interface works like sqlite3_open()
+** except that it accepts two additional parameters for additional control
+** over the new database connection. ^(The flags parameter to
+** sqlite3_open_v2() must include, at a minimum, one of the following
+** three flag combinations:)^
+**
+**
+** ^(
[SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY]
+**
The database is opened in read-only mode. If the database does not
+** already exist, an error is returned.
)^
+**
+** ^(
[SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE]
+**
The database is opened for reading and writing if possible, or reading
+** only if the file is write protected by the operating system. In either
+** case the database must already exist, otherwise an error is returned.
)^
+**
+** ^(
[SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE] | [SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE]
+**
The database is opened for reading and writing, and is created if
+** it does not already exist. This is the behavior that is always used for
+** sqlite3_open() and sqlite3_open16().
)^
+**
+**
+** In addition to the required flags, the following optional flags are
+** also supported:
+**
+**
+** ^(
[SQLITE_OPEN_URI]
+**
The filename can be interpreted as a URI if this flag is set.
)^
+**
+** ^(
[SQLITE_OPEN_MEMORY]
+**
The database will be opened as an in-memory database. The database
+** is named by the "filename" argument for the purposes of cache-sharing,
+** if shared cache mode is enabled, but the "filename" is otherwise ignored.
+**
)^
+**
+** ^(
[SQLITE_OPEN_NOMUTEX]
+**
The new database connection will use the "multi-thread"
+** [threading mode].)^ This means that separate threads are allowed
+** to use SQLite at the same time, as long as each thread is using
+** a different [database connection].
+**
+** ^(
[SQLITE_OPEN_FULLMUTEX]
+**
The new database connection will use the "serialized"
+** [threading mode].)^ This means the multiple threads can safely
+** attempt to use the same database connection at the same time.
+** (Mutexes will block any actual concurrency, but in this mode
+** there is no harm in trying.)
+**
+** ^(
[SQLITE_OPEN_SHAREDCACHE]
+**
The database is opened [shared cache] enabled, overriding
+** the default shared cache setting provided by
+** [sqlite3_enable_shared_cache()].)^
+**
+** ^(
[SQLITE_OPEN_PRIVATECACHE]
+**
The database is opened [shared cache] disabled, overriding
+** the default shared cache setting provided by
+** [sqlite3_enable_shared_cache()].)^
+**
+** [[OPEN_NOFOLLOW]] ^(
[SQLITE_OPEN_NOFOLLOW]
+**
The database filename is not allowed to be a symbolic link
+**
)^
+**
+** If the 3rd parameter to sqlite3_open_v2() is not one of the
+** required combinations shown above optionally combined with other
+** [SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY | SQLITE_OPEN_* bits]
+** then the behavior is undefined.
+**
+** ^The fourth parameter to sqlite3_open_v2() is the name of the
+** [sqlite3_vfs] object that defines the operating system interface that
+** the new database connection should use. ^If the fourth parameter is
+** a NULL pointer then the default [sqlite3_vfs] object is used.
+**
+** ^If the filename is ":memory:", then a private, temporary in-memory database
+** is created for the connection. ^This in-memory database will vanish when
+** the database connection is closed. Future versions of SQLite might
+** make use of additional special filenames that begin with the ":" character.
+** It is recommended that when a database filename actually does begin with
+** a ":" character you should prefix the filename with a pathname such as
+** "./" to avoid ambiguity.
+**
+** ^If the filename is an empty string, then a private, temporary
+** on-disk database will be created. ^This private database will be
+** automatically deleted as soon as the database connection is closed.
+**
+** [[URI filenames in sqlite3_open()]]
URI Filenames
+**
+** ^If [URI filename] interpretation is enabled, and the filename argument
+** begins with "file:", then the filename is interpreted as a URI. ^URI
+** filename interpretation is enabled if the [SQLITE_OPEN_URI] flag is
+** set in the third argument to sqlite3_open_v2(), or if it has
+** been enabled globally using the [SQLITE_CONFIG_URI] option with the
+** [sqlite3_config()] method or by the [SQLITE_USE_URI] compile-time option.
+** URI filename interpretation is turned off
+** by default, but future releases of SQLite might enable URI filename
+** interpretation by default. See "[URI filenames]" for additional
+** information.
+**
+** URI filenames are parsed according to RFC 3986. ^If the URI contains an
+** authority, then it must be either an empty string or the string
+** "localhost". ^If the authority is not an empty string or "localhost", an
+** error is returned to the caller. ^The fragment component of a URI, if
+** present, is ignored.
+**
+** ^SQLite uses the path component of the URI as the name of the disk file
+** which contains the database. ^If the path begins with a '/' character,
+** then it is interpreted as an absolute path. ^If the path does not begin
+** with a '/' (meaning that the authority section is omitted from the URI)
+** then the path is interpreted as a relative path.
+** ^(On windows, the first component of an absolute path
+** is a drive specification (e.g. "C:").)^
+**
+** [[core URI query parameters]]
+** The query component of a URI may contain parameters that are interpreted
+** either by SQLite itself, or by a [VFS | custom VFS implementation].
+** SQLite and its built-in [VFSes] interpret the
+** following query parameters:
+**
+**
+**
vfs: ^The "vfs" parameter may be used to specify the name of
+** a VFS object that provides the operating system interface that should
+** be used to access the database file on disk. ^If this option is set to
+** an empty string the default VFS object is used. ^Specifying an unknown
+** VFS is an error. ^If sqlite3_open_v2() is used and the vfs option is
+** present, then the VFS specified by the option takes precedence over
+** the value passed as the fourth parameter to sqlite3_open_v2().
+**
+**
mode: ^(The mode parameter may be set to either "ro", "rw",
+** "rwc", or "memory". Attempting to set it to any other value is
+** an error)^.
+** ^If "ro" is specified, then the database is opened for read-only
+** access, just as if the [SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY] flag had been set in the
+** third argument to sqlite3_open_v2(). ^If the mode option is set to
+** "rw", then the database is opened for read-write (but not create)
+** access, as if SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE (but not SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE) had
+** been set. ^Value "rwc" is equivalent to setting both
+** SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE and SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE. ^If the mode option is
+** set to "memory" then a pure [in-memory database] that never reads
+** or writes from disk is used. ^It is an error to specify a value for
+** the mode parameter that is less restrictive than that specified by
+** the flags passed in the third parameter to sqlite3_open_v2().
+**
+**
cache: ^The cache parameter may be set to either "shared" or
+** "private". ^Setting it to "shared" is equivalent to setting the
+** SQLITE_OPEN_SHAREDCACHE bit in the flags argument passed to
+** sqlite3_open_v2(). ^Setting the cache parameter to "private" is
+** equivalent to setting the SQLITE_OPEN_PRIVATECACHE bit.
+** ^If sqlite3_open_v2() is used and the "cache" parameter is present in
+** a URI filename, its value overrides any behavior requested by setting
+** SQLITE_OPEN_PRIVATECACHE or SQLITE_OPEN_SHAREDCACHE flag.
+**
+**
psow: ^The psow parameter indicates whether or not the
+** [powersafe overwrite] property does or does not apply to the
+** storage media on which the database file resides.
+**
+**
nolock: ^The nolock parameter is a boolean query parameter
+** which if set disables file locking in rollback journal modes. This
+** is useful for accessing a database on a filesystem that does not
+** support locking. Caution: Database corruption might result if two
+** or more processes write to the same database and any one of those
+** processes uses nolock=1.
+**
+**
immutable: ^The immutable parameter is a boolean query
+** parameter that indicates that the database file is stored on
+** read-only media. ^When immutable is set, SQLite assumes that the
+** database file cannot be changed, even by a process with higher
+** privilege, and so the database is opened read-only and all locking
+** and change detection is disabled. Caution: Setting the immutable
+** property on a database file that does in fact change can result
+** in incorrect query results and/or [SQLITE_CORRUPT] errors.
+** See also: [SQLITE_IOCAP_IMMUTABLE].
+**
+**
+**
+** ^Specifying an unknown parameter in the query component of a URI is not an
+** error. Future versions of SQLite might understand additional query
+** parameters. See "[query parameters with special meaning to SQLite]" for
+** additional information.
+**
+** [[URI filename examples]]
URI filename examples
+**
+**
+**
URI filenames
Results
+**
file:data.db
+** Open the file "data.db" in the current directory.
+**
Windows only: Open the file "data.db" on fred's desktop on drive
+** C:. Note that the %20 escaping in this example is not strictly
+** necessary - space characters can be used literally
+** in URI filenames.
+**
file:data.db?mode=ro&cache=private
+** Open file "data.db" in the current directory for read-only access.
+** Regardless of whether or not shared-cache mode is enabled by
+** default, use a private cache.
+**
file:/home/fred/data.db?vfs=unix-dotfile
+** Open file "/home/fred/data.db". Use the special VFS "unix-dotfile"
+** that uses dot-files in place of posix advisory locking.
+**
file:data.db?mode=readonly
+** An error. "readonly" is not a valid option for the "mode" parameter.
+**
+**
+** ^URI hexadecimal escape sequences (%HH) are supported within the path and
+** query components of a URI. A hexadecimal escape sequence consists of a
+** percent sign - "%" - followed by exactly two hexadecimal digits
+** specifying an octet value. ^Before the path or query components of a
+** URI filename are interpreted, they are encoded using UTF-8 and all
+** hexadecimal escape sequences replaced by a single byte containing the
+** corresponding octet. If this process generates an invalid UTF-8 encoding,
+** the results are undefined.
+**
+** Note to Windows users: The encoding used for the filename argument
+** of sqlite3_open() and sqlite3_open_v2() must be UTF-8, not whatever
+** codepage is currently defined. Filenames containing international
+** characters must be converted to UTF-8 prior to passing them into
+** sqlite3_open() or sqlite3_open_v2().
+**
+** Note to Windows Runtime users: The temporary directory must be set
+** prior to calling sqlite3_open() or sqlite3_open_v2(). Otherwise, various
+** features that require the use of temporary files may fail.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_temp_directory]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_open(
+ const char *filename, /* Database filename (UTF-8) */
+ sqlite3 **ppDb /* OUT: SQLite db handle */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_open16(
+ const void *filename, /* Database filename (UTF-16) */
+ sqlite3 **ppDb /* OUT: SQLite db handle */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_open_v2(
+ const char *filename, /* Database filename (UTF-8) */
+ sqlite3 **ppDb, /* OUT: SQLite db handle */
+ int flags, /* Flags */
+ const char *zVfs /* Name of VFS module to use */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Obtain Values For URI Parameters
+**
+** These are utility routines, useful to [VFS|custom VFS implementations],
+** that check if a database file was a URI that contained a specific query
+** parameter, and if so obtains the value of that query parameter.
+**
+** The first parameter to these interfaces (hereafter referred to
+** as F) must be one of:
+**
+**
A database filename pointer created by the SQLite core and
+** passed into the xOpen() method of a VFS implemention, or
+**
A filename obtained from [sqlite3_db_filename()], or
+**
A new filename constructed using [sqlite3_create_filename()].
+**
+** If the F parameter is not one of the above, then the behavior is
+** undefined and probably undesirable. Older versions of SQLite were
+** more tolerant of invalid F parameters than newer versions.
+**
+** If F is a suitable filename (as described in the previous paragraph)
+** and if P is the name of the query parameter, then
+** sqlite3_uri_parameter(F,P) returns the value of the P
+** parameter if it exists or a NULL pointer if P does not appear as a
+** query parameter on F. If P is a query parameter of F and it
+** has no explicit value, then sqlite3_uri_parameter(F,P) returns
+** a pointer to an empty string.
+**
+** The sqlite3_uri_boolean(F,P,B) routine assumes that P is a boolean
+** parameter and returns true (1) or false (0) according to the value
+** of P. The sqlite3_uri_boolean(F,P,B) routine returns true (1) if the
+** value of query parameter P is one of "yes", "true", or "on" in any
+** case or if the value begins with a non-zero number. The
+** sqlite3_uri_boolean(F,P,B) routines returns false (0) if the value of
+** query parameter P is one of "no", "false", or "off" in any case or
+** if the value begins with a numeric zero. If P is not a query
+** parameter on F or if the value of P does not match any of the
+** above, then sqlite3_uri_boolean(F,P,B) returns (B!=0).
+**
+** The sqlite3_uri_int64(F,P,D) routine converts the value of P into a
+** 64-bit signed integer and returns that integer, or D if P does not
+** exist. If the value of P is something other than an integer, then
+** zero is returned.
+**
+** The sqlite3_uri_key(F,N) returns a pointer to the name (not
+** the value) of the N-th query parameter for filename F, or a NULL
+** pointer if N is less than zero or greater than the number of query
+** parameters minus 1. The N value is zero-based so N should be 0 to obtain
+** the name of the first query parameter, 1 for the second parameter, and
+** so forth.
+**
+** If F is a NULL pointer, then sqlite3_uri_parameter(F,P) returns NULL and
+** sqlite3_uri_boolean(F,P,B) returns B. If F is not a NULL pointer and
+** is not a database file pathname pointer that the SQLite core passed
+** into the xOpen VFS method, then the behavior of this routine is undefined
+** and probably undesirable.
+**
+** Beginning with SQLite [version 3.31.0] ([dateof:3.31.0]) the input F
+** parameter can also be the name of a rollback journal file or WAL file
+** in addition to the main database file. Prior to version 3.31.0, these
+** routines would only work if F was the name of the main database file.
+** When the F parameter is the name of the rollback journal or WAL file,
+** it has access to all the same query parameters as were found on the
+** main database file.
+**
+** See the [URI filename] documentation for additional information.
+*/
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_uri_parameter(const char *zFilename, const char *zParam);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_uri_boolean(const char *zFile, const char *zParam, int bDefault);
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_uri_int64(const char*, const char*, sqlite3_int64);
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_uri_key(const char *zFilename, int N);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Translate filenames
+**
+** These routines are available to [VFS|custom VFS implementations] for
+** translating filenames between the main database file, the journal file,
+** and the WAL file.
+**
+** If F is the name of an sqlite database file, journal file, or WAL file
+** passed by the SQLite core into the VFS, then sqlite3_filename_database(F)
+** returns the name of the corresponding database file.
+**
+** If F is the name of an sqlite database file, journal file, or WAL file
+** passed by the SQLite core into the VFS, or if F is a database filename
+** obtained from [sqlite3_db_filename()], then sqlite3_filename_journal(F)
+** returns the name of the corresponding rollback journal file.
+**
+** If F is the name of an sqlite database file, journal file, or WAL file
+** that was passed by the SQLite core into the VFS, or if F is a database
+** filename obtained from [sqlite3_db_filename()], then
+** sqlite3_filename_wal(F) returns the name of the corresponding
+** WAL file.
+**
+** In all of the above, if F is not the name of a database, journal or WAL
+** filename passed into the VFS from the SQLite core and F is not the
+** return value from [sqlite3_db_filename()], then the result is
+** undefined and is likely a memory access violation.
+*/
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_filename_database(const char*);
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_filename_journal(const char*);
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_filename_wal(const char*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Database File Corresponding To A Journal
+**
+** ^If X is the name of a rollback or WAL-mode journal file that is
+** passed into the xOpen method of [sqlite3_vfs], then
+** sqlite3_database_file_object(X) returns a pointer to the [sqlite3_file]
+** object that represents the main database file.
+**
+** This routine is intended for use in custom [VFS] implementations
+** only. It is not a general-purpose interface.
+** The argument sqlite3_file_object(X) must be a filename pointer that
+** has been passed into [sqlite3_vfs].xOpen method where the
+** flags parameter to xOpen contains one of the bits
+** [SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL] or [SQLITE_OPEN_WAL]. Any other use
+** of this routine results in undefined and probably undesirable
+** behavior.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_file *sqlite3_database_file_object(const char*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Create and Destroy VFS Filenames
+**
+** These interfces are provided for use by [VFS shim] implementations and
+** are not useful outside of that context.
+**
+** The sqlite3_create_filename(D,J,W,N,P) allocates memory to hold a version of
+** database filename D with corresponding journal file J and WAL file W and
+** with N URI parameters key/values pairs in the array P. The result from
+** sqlite3_create_filename(D,J,W,N,P) is a pointer to a database filename that
+** is safe to pass to routines like:
+**
+**
[sqlite3_uri_parameter()],
+**
[sqlite3_uri_boolean()],
+**
[sqlite3_uri_int64()],
+**
[sqlite3_uri_key()],
+**
[sqlite3_filename_database()],
+**
[sqlite3_filename_journal()], or
+**
[sqlite3_filename_wal()].
+**
+** If a memory allocation error occurs, sqlite3_create_filename() might
+** return a NULL pointer. The memory obtained from sqlite3_create_filename(X)
+** must be released by a corresponding call to sqlite3_free_filename(Y).
+**
+** The P parameter in sqlite3_create_filename(D,J,W,N,P) should be an array
+** of 2*N pointers to strings. Each pair of pointers in this array corresponds
+** to a key and value for a query parameter. The P parameter may be a NULL
+** pointer if N is zero. None of the 2*N pointers in the P array may be
+** NULL pointers and key pointers should not be empty strings.
+** None of the D, J, or W parameters to sqlite3_create_filename(D,J,W,N,P) may
+** be NULL pointers, though they can be empty strings.
+**
+** The sqlite3_free_filename(Y) routine releases a memory allocation
+** previously obtained from sqlite3_create_filename(). Invoking
+** sqlite3_free_filename(Y) where Y is a NULL pointer is a harmless no-op.
+**
+** If the Y parameter to sqlite3_free_filename(Y) is anything other
+** than a NULL pointer or a pointer previously acquired from
+** sqlite3_create_filename(), then bad things such as heap
+** corruption or segfaults may occur. The value Y should be
+** used again after sqlite3_free_filename(Y) has been called. This means
+** that if the [sqlite3_vfs.xOpen()] method of a VFS has been called using Y,
+** then the corresponding [sqlite3_module.xClose() method should also be
+** invoked prior to calling sqlite3_free_filename(Y).
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_create_filename(
+ const char *zDatabase,
+ const char *zJournal,
+ const char *zWal,
+ int nParam,
+ const char **azParam
+);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_free_filename(char*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Error Codes And Messages
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^If the most recent sqlite3_* API call associated with
+** [database connection] D failed, then the sqlite3_errcode(D) interface
+** returns the numeric [result code] or [extended result code] for that
+** API call.
+** ^The sqlite3_extended_errcode()
+** interface is the same except that it always returns the
+** [extended result code] even when extended result codes are
+** disabled.
+**
+** The values returned by sqlite3_errcode() and/or
+** sqlite3_extended_errcode() might change with each API call.
+** Except, there are some interfaces that are guaranteed to never
+** change the value of the error code. The error-code preserving
+** interfaces are:
+**
+**
+**
sqlite3_errcode()
+**
sqlite3_extended_errcode()
+**
sqlite3_errmsg()
+**
sqlite3_errmsg16()
+**
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_errmsg() and sqlite3_errmsg16() return English-language
+** text that describes the error, as either UTF-8 or UTF-16 respectively.
+** ^(Memory to hold the error message string is managed internally.
+** The application does not need to worry about freeing the result.
+** However, the error string might be overwritten or deallocated by
+** subsequent calls to other SQLite interface functions.)^
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_errstr() interface returns the English-language text
+** that describes the [result code], as UTF-8.
+** ^(Memory to hold the error message string is managed internally
+** and must not be freed by the application)^.
+**
+** When the serialized [threading mode] is in use, it might be the
+** case that a second error occurs on a separate thread in between
+** the time of the first error and the call to these interfaces.
+** When that happens, the second error will be reported since these
+** interfaces always report the most recent result. To avoid
+** this, each thread can obtain exclusive use of the [database connection] D
+** by invoking [sqlite3_mutex_enter]([sqlite3_db_mutex](D)) before beginning
+** to use D and invoking [sqlite3_mutex_leave]([sqlite3_db_mutex](D)) after
+** all calls to the interfaces listed here are completed.
+**
+** If an interface fails with SQLITE_MISUSE, that means the interface
+** was invoked incorrectly by the application. In that case, the
+** error code and message may or may not be set.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_errcode(sqlite3 *db);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_extended_errcode(sqlite3 *db);
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_errmsg(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_errmsg16(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_errstr(int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Prepared Statement Object
+** KEYWORDS: {prepared statement} {prepared statements}
+**
+** An instance of this object represents a single SQL statement that
+** has been compiled into binary form and is ready to be evaluated.
+**
+** Think of each SQL statement as a separate computer program. The
+** original SQL text is source code. A prepared statement object
+** is the compiled object code. All SQL must be converted into a
+** prepared statement before it can be run.
+**
+** The life-cycle of a prepared statement object usually goes like this:
+**
+**
+**
Create the prepared statement object using [sqlite3_prepare_v2()].
+**
Bind values to [parameters] using the sqlite3_bind_*()
+** interfaces.
+**
Run the SQL by calling [sqlite3_step()] one or more times.
+**
Reset the prepared statement using [sqlite3_reset()] then go back
+** to step 2. Do this zero or more times.
+**
Destroy the object using [sqlite3_finalize()].
+**
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_stmt sqlite3_stmt;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Run-time Limits
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^(This interface allows the size of various constructs to be limited
+** on a connection by connection basis. The first parameter is the
+** [database connection] whose limit is to be set or queried. The
+** second parameter is one of the [limit categories] that define a
+** class of constructs to be size limited. The third parameter is the
+** new limit for that construct.)^
+**
+** ^If the new limit is a negative number, the limit is unchanged.
+** ^(For each limit category SQLITE_LIMIT_NAME there is a
+** [limits | hard upper bound]
+** set at compile-time by a C preprocessor macro called
+** [limits | SQLITE_MAX_NAME].
+** (The "_LIMIT_" in the name is changed to "_MAX_".))^
+** ^Attempts to increase a limit above its hard upper bound are
+** silently truncated to the hard upper bound.
+**
+** ^Regardless of whether or not the limit was changed, the
+** [sqlite3_limit()] interface returns the prior value of the limit.
+** ^Hence, to find the current value of a limit without changing it,
+** simply invoke this interface with the third parameter set to -1.
+**
+** Run-time limits are intended for use in applications that manage
+** both their own internal database and also databases that are controlled
+** by untrusted external sources. An example application might be a
+** web browser that has its own databases for storing history and
+** separate databases controlled by JavaScript applications downloaded
+** off the Internet. The internal databases can be given the
+** large, default limits. Databases managed by external sources can
+** be given much smaller limits designed to prevent a denial of service
+** attack. Developers might also want to use the [sqlite3_set_authorizer()]
+** interface to further control untrusted SQL. The size of the database
+** created by an untrusted script can be contained using the
+** [max_page_count] [PRAGMA].
+**
+** New run-time limit categories may be added in future releases.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_limit(sqlite3*, int id, int newVal);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Run-Time Limit Categories
+** KEYWORDS: {limit category} {*limit categories}
+**
+** These constants define various performance limits
+** that can be lowered at run-time using [sqlite3_limit()].
+** The synopsis of the meanings of the various limits is shown below.
+** Additional information is available at [limits | Limits in SQLite].
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH]] ^(
SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH
+**
The maximum size of any string or BLOB or table row, in bytes.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_LIMIT_SQL_LENGTH]] ^(
SQLITE_LIMIT_SQL_LENGTH
+**
The maximum length of an SQL statement, in bytes.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_LIMIT_COLUMN]] ^(
SQLITE_LIMIT_COLUMN
+**
The maximum number of columns in a table definition or in the
+** result set of a [SELECT] or the maximum number of columns in an index
+** or in an ORDER BY or GROUP BY clause.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_LIMIT_EXPR_DEPTH]] ^(
SQLITE_LIMIT_EXPR_DEPTH
+**
The maximum depth of the parse tree on any expression.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_LIMIT_COMPOUND_SELECT]] ^(
SQLITE_LIMIT_COMPOUND_SELECT
+**
The maximum number of terms in a compound SELECT statement.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_LIMIT_VDBE_OP]] ^(
SQLITE_LIMIT_VDBE_OP
+**
The maximum number of instructions in a virtual machine program
+** used to implement an SQL statement. If [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or
+** the equivalent tries to allocate space for more than this many opcodes
+** in a single prepared statement, an SQLITE_NOMEM error is returned.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_LIMIT_FUNCTION_ARG]] ^(
SQLITE_LIMIT_FUNCTION_ARG
+**
The maximum number of arguments on a function.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_LIMIT_ATTACHED]] ^(
SQLITE_LIMIT_ATTACHED
+**
The maximum number of [ATTACH | attached databases].)^
The maximum index number of any [parameter] in an SQL statement.)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_LIMIT_TRIGGER_DEPTH]] ^(
SQLITE_LIMIT_TRIGGER_DEPTH
+**
The maximum depth of recursion for triggers.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_LIMIT_WORKER_THREADS]] ^(
SQLITE_LIMIT_WORKER_THREADS
+**
The maximum number of auxiliary worker threads that a single
+** [prepared statement] may start.
)^
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH 0
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_SQL_LENGTH 1
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_COLUMN 2
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_EXPR_DEPTH 3
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_COMPOUND_SELECT 4
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_VDBE_OP 5
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_FUNCTION_ARG 6
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_ATTACHED 7
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH 8
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_VARIABLE_NUMBER 9
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_TRIGGER_DEPTH 10
+#define SQLITE_LIMIT_WORKER_THREADS 11
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Prepare Flags
+**
+** These constants define various flags that can be passed into
+** "prepFlags" parameter of the [sqlite3_prepare_v3()] and
+** [sqlite3_prepare16_v3()] interfaces.
+**
+** New flags may be added in future releases of SQLite.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_PREPARE_PERSISTENT]] ^(
SQLITE_PREPARE_PERSISTENT
+**
The SQLITE_PREPARE_PERSISTENT flag is a hint to the query planner
+** that the prepared statement will be retained for a long time and
+** probably reused many times.)^ ^Without this flag, [sqlite3_prepare_v3()]
+** and [sqlite3_prepare16_v3()] assume that the prepared statement will
+** be used just once or at most a few times and then destroyed using
+** [sqlite3_finalize()] relatively soon. The current implementation acts
+** on this hint by avoiding the use of [lookaside memory] so as not to
+** deplete the limited store of lookaside memory. Future versions of
+** SQLite may act on this hint differently.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_PREPARE_NORMALIZE]]
SQLITE_PREPARE_NORMALIZE
+**
The SQLITE_PREPARE_NORMALIZE flag is a no-op. This flag used
+** to be required for any prepared statement that wanted to use the
+** [sqlite3_normalized_sql()] interface. However, the
+** [sqlite3_normalized_sql()] interface is now available to all
+** prepared statements, regardless of whether or not they use this
+** flag.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_PREPARE_NO_VTAB]]
SQLITE_PREPARE_NO_VTAB
+**
The SQLITE_PREPARE_NO_VTAB flag causes the SQL compiler
+** to return an error (error code SQLITE_ERROR) if the statement uses
+** any virtual tables.
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_PREPARE_PERSISTENT 0x01
+#define SQLITE_PREPARE_NORMALIZE 0x02
+#define SQLITE_PREPARE_NO_VTAB 0x04
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Compiling An SQL Statement
+** KEYWORDS: {SQL statement compiler}
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+** CONSTRUCTOR: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** To execute an SQL statement, it must first be compiled into a byte-code
+** program using one of these routines. Or, in other words, these routines
+** are constructors for the [prepared statement] object.
+**
+** The preferred routine to use is [sqlite3_prepare_v2()]. The
+** [sqlite3_prepare()] interface is legacy and should be avoided.
+** [sqlite3_prepare_v3()] has an extra "prepFlags" option that is used
+** for special purposes.
+**
+** The use of the UTF-8 interfaces is preferred, as SQLite currently
+** does all parsing using UTF-8. The UTF-16 interfaces are provided
+** as a convenience. The UTF-16 interfaces work by converting the
+** input text into UTF-8, then invoking the corresponding UTF-8 interface.
+**
+** The first argument, "db", is a [database connection] obtained from a
+** prior successful call to [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open_v2()] or
+** [sqlite3_open16()]. The database connection must not have been closed.
+**
+** The second argument, "zSql", is the statement to be compiled, encoded
+** as either UTF-8 or UTF-16. The sqlite3_prepare(), sqlite3_prepare_v2(),
+** and sqlite3_prepare_v3()
+** interfaces use UTF-8, and sqlite3_prepare16(), sqlite3_prepare16_v2(),
+** and sqlite3_prepare16_v3() use UTF-16.
+**
+** ^If the nByte argument is negative, then zSql is read up to the
+** first zero terminator. ^If nByte is positive, then it is the
+** number of bytes read from zSql. ^If nByte is zero, then no prepared
+** statement is generated.
+** If the caller knows that the supplied string is nul-terminated, then
+** there is a small performance advantage to passing an nByte parameter that
+** is the number of bytes in the input string including
+** the nul-terminator.
+**
+** ^If pzTail is not NULL then *pzTail is made to point to the first byte
+** past the end of the first SQL statement in zSql. These routines only
+** compile the first statement in zSql, so *pzTail is left pointing to
+** what remains uncompiled.
+**
+** ^*ppStmt is left pointing to a compiled [prepared statement] that can be
+** executed using [sqlite3_step()]. ^If there is an error, *ppStmt is set
+** to NULL. ^If the input text contains no SQL (if the input is an empty
+** string or a comment) then *ppStmt is set to NULL.
+** The calling procedure is responsible for deleting the compiled
+** SQL statement using [sqlite3_finalize()] after it has finished with it.
+** ppStmt may not be NULL.
+**
+** ^On success, the sqlite3_prepare() family of routines return [SQLITE_OK];
+** otherwise an [error code] is returned.
+**
+** The sqlite3_prepare_v2(), sqlite3_prepare_v3(), sqlite3_prepare16_v2(),
+** and sqlite3_prepare16_v3() interfaces are recommended for all new programs.
+** The older interfaces (sqlite3_prepare() and sqlite3_prepare16())
+** are retained for backwards compatibility, but their use is discouraged.
+** ^In the "vX" interfaces, the prepared statement
+** that is returned (the [sqlite3_stmt] object) contains a copy of the
+** original SQL text. This causes the [sqlite3_step()] interface to
+** behave differently in three ways:
+**
+**
+**
+** ^If the database schema changes, instead of returning [SQLITE_SCHEMA] as it
+** always used to do, [sqlite3_step()] will automatically recompile the SQL
+** statement and try to run it again. As many as [SQLITE_MAX_SCHEMA_RETRY]
+** retries will occur before sqlite3_step() gives up and returns an error.
+**
+**
+**
+** ^When an error occurs, [sqlite3_step()] will return one of the detailed
+** [error codes] or [extended error codes]. ^The legacy behavior was that
+** [sqlite3_step()] would only return a generic [SQLITE_ERROR] result code
+** and the application would have to make a second call to [sqlite3_reset()]
+** in order to find the underlying cause of the problem. With the "v2" prepare
+** interfaces, the underlying reason for the error is returned immediately.
+**
+**
+**
+** ^If the specific value bound to a [parameter | host parameter] in the
+** WHERE clause might influence the choice of query plan for a statement,
+** then the statement will be automatically recompiled, as if there had been
+** a schema change, on the first [sqlite3_step()] call following any change
+** to the [sqlite3_bind_text | bindings] of that [parameter].
+** ^The specific value of a WHERE-clause [parameter] might influence the
+** choice of query plan if the parameter is the left-hand side of a [LIKE]
+** or [GLOB] operator or if the parameter is compared to an indexed column
+** and the [SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT4] compile-time option is enabled.
+**
+**
+**
+**
^sqlite3_prepare_v3() differs from sqlite3_prepare_v2() only in having
+** the extra prepFlags parameter, which is a bit array consisting of zero or
+** more of the [SQLITE_PREPARE_PERSISTENT|SQLITE_PREPARE_*] flags. ^The
+** sqlite3_prepare_v2() interface works exactly the same as
+** sqlite3_prepare_v3() with a zero prepFlags parameter.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_prepare(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */
+ const char *zSql, /* SQL statement, UTF-8 encoded */
+ int nByte, /* Maximum length of zSql in bytes. */
+ sqlite3_stmt **ppStmt, /* OUT: Statement handle */
+ const char **pzTail /* OUT: Pointer to unused portion of zSql */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_prepare_v2(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */
+ const char *zSql, /* SQL statement, UTF-8 encoded */
+ int nByte, /* Maximum length of zSql in bytes. */
+ sqlite3_stmt **ppStmt, /* OUT: Statement handle */
+ const char **pzTail /* OUT: Pointer to unused portion of zSql */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_prepare_v3(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */
+ const char *zSql, /* SQL statement, UTF-8 encoded */
+ int nByte, /* Maximum length of zSql in bytes. */
+ unsigned int prepFlags, /* Zero or more SQLITE_PREPARE_ flags */
+ sqlite3_stmt **ppStmt, /* OUT: Statement handle */
+ const char **pzTail /* OUT: Pointer to unused portion of zSql */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_prepare16(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */
+ const void *zSql, /* SQL statement, UTF-16 encoded */
+ int nByte, /* Maximum length of zSql in bytes. */
+ sqlite3_stmt **ppStmt, /* OUT: Statement handle */
+ const void **pzTail /* OUT: Pointer to unused portion of zSql */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_prepare16_v2(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */
+ const void *zSql, /* SQL statement, UTF-16 encoded */
+ int nByte, /* Maximum length of zSql in bytes. */
+ sqlite3_stmt **ppStmt, /* OUT: Statement handle */
+ const void **pzTail /* OUT: Pointer to unused portion of zSql */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_prepare16_v3(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */
+ const void *zSql, /* SQL statement, UTF-16 encoded */
+ int nByte, /* Maximum length of zSql in bytes. */
+ unsigned int prepFlags, /* Zero or more SQLITE_PREPARE_ flags */
+ sqlite3_stmt **ppStmt, /* OUT: Statement handle */
+ const void **pzTail /* OUT: Pointer to unused portion of zSql */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Retrieving Statement SQL
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_sql(P) interface returns a pointer to a copy of the UTF-8
+** SQL text used to create [prepared statement] P if P was
+** created by [sqlite3_prepare_v2()], [sqlite3_prepare_v3()],
+** [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()], or [sqlite3_prepare16_v3()].
+** ^The sqlite3_expanded_sql(P) interface returns a pointer to a UTF-8
+** string containing the SQL text of prepared statement P with
+** [bound parameters] expanded.
+** ^The sqlite3_normalized_sql(P) interface returns a pointer to a UTF-8
+** string containing the normalized SQL text of prepared statement P. The
+** semantics used to normalize a SQL statement are unspecified and subject
+** to change. At a minimum, literal values will be replaced with suitable
+** placeholders.
+**
+** ^(For example, if a prepared statement is created using the SQL
+** text "SELECT $abc,:xyz" and if parameter $abc is bound to integer 2345
+** and parameter :xyz is unbound, then sqlite3_sql() will return
+** the original string, "SELECT $abc,:xyz" but sqlite3_expanded_sql()
+** will return "SELECT 2345,NULL".)^
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_expanded_sql() interface returns NULL if insufficient memory
+** is available to hold the result, or if the result would exceed the
+** the maximum string length determined by the [SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH].
+**
+** ^The [SQLITE_TRACE_SIZE_LIMIT] compile-time option limits the size of
+** bound parameter expansions. ^The [SQLITE_OMIT_TRACE] compile-time
+** option causes sqlite3_expanded_sql() to always return NULL.
+**
+** ^The strings returned by sqlite3_sql(P) and sqlite3_normalized_sql(P)
+** are managed by SQLite and are automatically freed when the prepared
+** statement is finalized.
+** ^The string returned by sqlite3_expanded_sql(P), on the other hand,
+** is obtained from [sqlite3_malloc()] and must be free by the application
+** by passing it to [sqlite3_free()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_sql(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt);
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_expanded_sql(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt);
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_normalized_sql(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Determine If An SQL Statement Writes The Database
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_stmt_readonly(X) interface returns true (non-zero) if
+** and only if the [prepared statement] X makes no direct changes to
+** the content of the database file.
+**
+** Note that [application-defined SQL functions] or
+** [virtual tables] might change the database indirectly as a side effect.
+** ^(For example, if an application defines a function "eval()" that
+** calls [sqlite3_exec()], then the following SQL statement would
+** change the database file through side-effects:
+**
+**
+** SELECT eval('DELETE FROM t1') FROM t2;
+**
+**
+** But because the [SELECT] statement does not change the database file
+** directly, sqlite3_stmt_readonly() would still return true.)^
+**
+** ^Transaction control statements such as [BEGIN], [COMMIT], [ROLLBACK],
+** [SAVEPOINT], and [RELEASE] cause sqlite3_stmt_readonly() to return true,
+** since the statements themselves do not actually modify the database but
+** rather they control the timing of when other statements modify the
+** database. ^The [ATTACH] and [DETACH] statements also cause
+** sqlite3_stmt_readonly() to return true since, while those statements
+** change the configuration of a database connection, they do not make
+** changes to the content of the database files on disk.
+** ^The sqlite3_stmt_readonly() interface returns true for [BEGIN] since
+** [BEGIN] merely sets internal flags, but the [BEGIN|BEGIN IMMEDIATE] and
+** [BEGIN|BEGIN EXCLUSIVE] commands do touch the database and so
+** sqlite3_stmt_readonly() returns false for those commands.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_stmt_readonly(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Query The EXPLAIN Setting For A Prepared Statement
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_stmt_isexplain(S) interface returns 1 if the
+** prepared statement S is an EXPLAIN statement, or 2 if the
+** statement S is an EXPLAIN QUERY PLAN.
+** ^The sqlite3_stmt_isexplain(S) interface returns 0 if S is
+** an ordinary statement or a NULL pointer.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_stmt_isexplain(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Determine If A Prepared Statement Has Been Reset
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_stmt_busy(S) interface returns true (non-zero) if the
+** [prepared statement] S has been stepped at least once using
+** [sqlite3_step(S)] but has neither run to completion (returned
+** [SQLITE_DONE] from [sqlite3_step(S)]) nor
+** been reset using [sqlite3_reset(S)]. ^The sqlite3_stmt_busy(S)
+** interface returns false if S is a NULL pointer. If S is not a
+** NULL pointer and is not a pointer to a valid [prepared statement]
+** object, then the behavior is undefined and probably undesirable.
+**
+** This interface can be used in combination [sqlite3_next_stmt()]
+** to locate all prepared statements associated with a database
+** connection that are in need of being reset. This can be used,
+** for example, in diagnostic routines to search for prepared
+** statements that are holding a transaction open.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_stmt_busy(sqlite3_stmt*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Dynamically Typed Value Object
+** KEYWORDS: {protected sqlite3_value} {unprotected sqlite3_value}
+**
+** SQLite uses the sqlite3_value object to represent all values
+** that can be stored in a database table. SQLite uses dynamic typing
+** for the values it stores. ^Values stored in sqlite3_value objects
+** can be integers, floating point values, strings, BLOBs, or NULL.
+**
+** An sqlite3_value object may be either "protected" or "unprotected".
+** Some interfaces require a protected sqlite3_value. Other interfaces
+** will accept either a protected or an unprotected sqlite3_value.
+** Every interface that accepts sqlite3_value arguments specifies
+** whether or not it requires a protected sqlite3_value. The
+** [sqlite3_value_dup()] interface can be used to construct a new
+** protected sqlite3_value from an unprotected sqlite3_value.
+**
+** The terms "protected" and "unprotected" refer to whether or not
+** a mutex is held. An internal mutex is held for a protected
+** sqlite3_value object but no mutex is held for an unprotected
+** sqlite3_value object. If SQLite is compiled to be single-threaded
+** (with [SQLITE_THREADSAFE=0] and with [sqlite3_threadsafe()] returning 0)
+** or if SQLite is run in one of reduced mutex modes
+** [SQLITE_CONFIG_SINGLETHREAD] or [SQLITE_CONFIG_MULTITHREAD]
+** then there is no distinction between protected and unprotected
+** sqlite3_value objects and they can be used interchangeably. However,
+** for maximum code portability it is recommended that applications
+** still make the distinction between protected and unprotected
+** sqlite3_value objects even when not strictly required.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_value objects that are passed as parameters into the
+** implementation of [application-defined SQL functions] are protected.
+** ^The sqlite3_value object returned by
+** [sqlite3_column_value()] is unprotected.
+** Unprotected sqlite3_value objects may only be used as arguments
+** to [sqlite3_result_value()], [sqlite3_bind_value()], and
+** [sqlite3_value_dup()].
+** The [sqlite3_value_blob | sqlite3_value_type()] family of
+** interfaces require protected sqlite3_value objects.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_value sqlite3_value;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: SQL Function Context Object
+**
+** The context in which an SQL function executes is stored in an
+** sqlite3_context object. ^A pointer to an sqlite3_context object
+** is always first parameter to [application-defined SQL functions].
+** The application-defined SQL function implementation will pass this
+** pointer through into calls to [sqlite3_result_int | sqlite3_result()],
+** [sqlite3_aggregate_context()], [sqlite3_user_data()],
+** [sqlite3_context_db_handle()], [sqlite3_get_auxdata()],
+** and/or [sqlite3_set_auxdata()].
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_context sqlite3_context;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Binding Values To Prepared Statements
+** KEYWORDS: {host parameter} {host parameters} {host parameter name}
+** KEYWORDS: {SQL parameter} {SQL parameters} {parameter binding}
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^(In the SQL statement text input to [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] and its variants,
+** literals may be replaced by a [parameter] that matches one of following
+** templates:
+**
+**
+**
?
+**
?NNN
+**
:VVV
+**
@VVV
+**
$VVV
+**
+**
+** In the templates above, NNN represents an integer literal,
+** and VVV represents an alphanumeric identifier.)^ ^The values of these
+** parameters (also called "host parameter names" or "SQL parameters")
+** can be set using the sqlite3_bind_*() routines defined here.
+**
+** ^The first argument to the sqlite3_bind_*() routines is always
+** a pointer to the [sqlite3_stmt] object returned from
+** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or its variants.
+**
+** ^The second argument is the index of the SQL parameter to be set.
+** ^The leftmost SQL parameter has an index of 1. ^When the same named
+** SQL parameter is used more than once, second and subsequent
+** occurrences have the same index as the first occurrence.
+** ^The index for named parameters can be looked up using the
+** [sqlite3_bind_parameter_index()] API if desired. ^The index
+** for "?NNN" parameters is the value of NNN.
+** ^The NNN value must be between 1 and the [sqlite3_limit()]
+** parameter [SQLITE_LIMIT_VARIABLE_NUMBER] (default value: 32766).
+**
+** ^The third argument is the value to bind to the parameter.
+** ^If the third parameter to sqlite3_bind_text() or sqlite3_bind_text16()
+** or sqlite3_bind_blob() is a NULL pointer then the fourth parameter
+** is ignored and the end result is the same as sqlite3_bind_null().
+** ^If the third parameter to sqlite3_bind_text() is not NULL, then
+** it should be a pointer to well-formed UTF8 text.
+** ^If the third parameter to sqlite3_bind_text16() is not NULL, then
+** it should be a pointer to well-formed UTF16 text.
+** ^If the third parameter to sqlite3_bind_text64() is not NULL, then
+** it should be a pointer to a well-formed unicode string that is
+** either UTF8 if the sixth parameter is SQLITE_UTF8, or UTF16
+** otherwise.
+**
+** [[byte-order determination rules]] ^The byte-order of
+** UTF16 input text is determined by the byte-order mark (BOM, U+FEFF)
+** found in first character, which is removed, or in the absence of a BOM
+** the byte order is the native byte order of the host
+** machine for sqlite3_bind_text16() or the byte order specified in
+** the 6th parameter for sqlite3_bind_text64().)^
+** ^If UTF16 input text contains invalid unicode
+** characters, then SQLite might change those invalid characters
+** into the unicode replacement character: U+FFFD.
+**
+** ^(In those routines that have a fourth argument, its value is the
+** number of bytes in the parameter. To be clear: the value is the
+** number of bytes in the value, not the number of characters.)^
+** ^If the fourth parameter to sqlite3_bind_text() or sqlite3_bind_text16()
+** is negative, then the length of the string is
+** the number of bytes up to the first zero terminator.
+** If the fourth parameter to sqlite3_bind_blob() is negative, then
+** the behavior is undefined.
+** If a non-negative fourth parameter is provided to sqlite3_bind_text()
+** or sqlite3_bind_text16() or sqlite3_bind_text64() then
+** that parameter must be the byte offset
+** where the NUL terminator would occur assuming the string were NUL
+** terminated. If any NUL characters occurs at byte offsets less than
+** the value of the fourth parameter then the resulting string value will
+** contain embedded NULs. The result of expressions involving strings
+** with embedded NULs is undefined.
+**
+** ^The fifth argument to the BLOB and string binding interfaces
+** is a destructor used to dispose of the BLOB or
+** string after SQLite has finished with it. ^The destructor is called
+** to dispose of the BLOB or string even if the call to the bind API fails,
+** except the destructor is not called if the third parameter is a NULL
+** pointer or the fourth parameter is negative.
+** ^If the fifth argument is
+** the special value [SQLITE_STATIC], then SQLite assumes that the
+** information is in static, unmanaged space and does not need to be freed.
+** ^If the fifth argument has the value [SQLITE_TRANSIENT], then
+** SQLite makes its own private copy of the data immediately, before
+** the sqlite3_bind_*() routine returns.
+**
+** ^The sixth argument to sqlite3_bind_text64() must be one of
+** [SQLITE_UTF8], [SQLITE_UTF16], [SQLITE_UTF16BE], or [SQLITE_UTF16LE]
+** to specify the encoding of the text in the third parameter. If
+** the sixth argument to sqlite3_bind_text64() is not one of the
+** allowed values shown above, or if the text encoding is different
+** from the encoding specified by the sixth parameter, then the behavior
+** is undefined.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_bind_zeroblob() routine binds a BLOB of length N that
+** is filled with zeroes. ^A zeroblob uses a fixed amount of memory
+** (just an integer to hold its size) while it is being processed.
+** Zeroblobs are intended to serve as placeholders for BLOBs whose
+** content is later written using
+** [sqlite3_blob_open | incremental BLOB I/O] routines.
+** ^A negative value for the zeroblob results in a zero-length BLOB.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_bind_pointer(S,I,P,T,D) routine causes the I-th parameter in
+** [prepared statement] S to have an SQL value of NULL, but to also be
+** associated with the pointer P of type T. ^D is either a NULL pointer or
+** a pointer to a destructor function for P. ^SQLite will invoke the
+** destructor D with a single argument of P when it is finished using
+** P. The T parameter should be a static string, preferably a string
+** literal. The sqlite3_bind_pointer() routine is part of the
+** [pointer passing interface] added for SQLite 3.20.0.
+**
+** ^If any of the sqlite3_bind_*() routines are called with a NULL pointer
+** for the [prepared statement] or with a prepared statement for which
+** [sqlite3_step()] has been called more recently than [sqlite3_reset()],
+** then the call will return [SQLITE_MISUSE]. If any sqlite3_bind_()
+** routine is passed a [prepared statement] that has been finalized, the
+** result is undefined and probably harmful.
+**
+** ^Bindings are not cleared by the [sqlite3_reset()] routine.
+** ^Unbound parameters are interpreted as NULL.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_bind_* routines return [SQLITE_OK] on success or an
+** [error code] if anything goes wrong.
+** ^[SQLITE_TOOBIG] might be returned if the size of a string or BLOB
+** exceeds limits imposed by [sqlite3_limit]([SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH]) or
+** [SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH].
+** ^[SQLITE_RANGE] is returned if the parameter
+** index is out of range. ^[SQLITE_NOMEM] is returned if malloc() fails.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_bind_parameter_count()],
+** [sqlite3_bind_parameter_name()], and [sqlite3_bind_parameter_index()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_blob(sqlite3_stmt*, int, const void*, int n, void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_blob64(sqlite3_stmt*, int, const void*, sqlite3_uint64,
+ void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_double(sqlite3_stmt*, int, double);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_int(sqlite3_stmt*, int, int);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_int64(sqlite3_stmt*, int, sqlite3_int64);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_null(sqlite3_stmt*, int);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_text(sqlite3_stmt*,int,const char*,int,void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_text16(sqlite3_stmt*, int, const void*, int, void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_text64(sqlite3_stmt*, int, const char*, sqlite3_uint64,
+ void(*)(void*), unsigned char encoding);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_value(sqlite3_stmt*, int, const sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_pointer(sqlite3_stmt*, int, void*, const char*,void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_zeroblob(sqlite3_stmt*, int, int n);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_zeroblob64(sqlite3_stmt*, int, sqlite3_uint64);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Number Of SQL Parameters
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^This routine can be used to find the number of [SQL parameters]
+** in a [prepared statement]. SQL parameters are tokens of the
+** form "?", "?NNN", ":AAA", "$AAA", or "@AAA" that serve as
+** placeholders for values that are [sqlite3_bind_blob | bound]
+** to the parameters at a later time.
+**
+** ^(This routine actually returns the index of the largest (rightmost)
+** parameter. For all forms except ?NNN, this will correspond to the
+** number of unique parameters. If parameters of the ?NNN form are used,
+** there may be gaps in the list.)^
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_bind_blob|sqlite3_bind()],
+** [sqlite3_bind_parameter_name()], and
+** [sqlite3_bind_parameter_index()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_parameter_count(sqlite3_stmt*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Name Of A Host Parameter
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_bind_parameter_name(P,N) interface returns
+** the name of the N-th [SQL parameter] in the [prepared statement] P.
+** ^(SQL parameters of the form "?NNN" or ":AAA" or "@AAA" or "$AAA"
+** have a name which is the string "?NNN" or ":AAA" or "@AAA" or "$AAA"
+** respectively.
+** In other words, the initial ":" or "$" or "@" or "?"
+** is included as part of the name.)^
+** ^Parameters of the form "?" without a following integer have no name
+** and are referred to as "nameless" or "anonymous parameters".
+**
+** ^The first host parameter has an index of 1, not 0.
+**
+** ^If the value N is out of range or if the N-th parameter is
+** nameless, then NULL is returned. ^The returned string is
+** always in UTF-8 encoding even if the named parameter was
+** originally specified as UTF-16 in [sqlite3_prepare16()],
+** [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()], or [sqlite3_prepare16_v3()].
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_bind_blob|sqlite3_bind()],
+** [sqlite3_bind_parameter_count()], and
+** [sqlite3_bind_parameter_index()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_bind_parameter_name(sqlite3_stmt*, int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Index Of A Parameter With A Given Name
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^Return the index of an SQL parameter given its name. ^The
+** index value returned is suitable for use as the second
+** parameter to [sqlite3_bind_blob|sqlite3_bind()]. ^A zero
+** is returned if no matching parameter is found. ^The parameter
+** name must be given in UTF-8 even if the original statement
+** was prepared from UTF-16 text using [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()] or
+** [sqlite3_prepare16_v3()].
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_bind_blob|sqlite3_bind()],
+** [sqlite3_bind_parameter_count()], and
+** [sqlite3_bind_parameter_name()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_parameter_index(sqlite3_stmt*, const char *zName);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Reset All Bindings On A Prepared Statement
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^Contrary to the intuition of many, [sqlite3_reset()] does not reset
+** the [sqlite3_bind_blob | bindings] on a [prepared statement].
+** ^Use this routine to reset all host parameters to NULL.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_clear_bindings(sqlite3_stmt*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Number Of Columns In A Result Set
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^Return the number of columns in the result set returned by the
+** [prepared statement]. ^If this routine returns 0, that means the
+** [prepared statement] returns no data (for example an [UPDATE]).
+** ^However, just because this routine returns a positive number does not
+** mean that one or more rows of data will be returned. ^A SELECT statement
+** will always have a positive sqlite3_column_count() but depending on the
+** WHERE clause constraints and the table content, it might return no rows.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_data_count()]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_column_count(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Column Names In A Result Set
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^These routines return the name assigned to a particular column
+** in the result set of a [SELECT] statement. ^The sqlite3_column_name()
+** interface returns a pointer to a zero-terminated UTF-8 string
+** and sqlite3_column_name16() returns a pointer to a zero-terminated
+** UTF-16 string. ^The first parameter is the [prepared statement]
+** that implements the [SELECT] statement. ^The second parameter is the
+** column number. ^The leftmost column is number 0.
+**
+** ^The returned string pointer is valid until either the [prepared statement]
+** is destroyed by [sqlite3_finalize()] or until the statement is automatically
+** reprepared by the first call to [sqlite3_step()] for a particular run
+** or until the next call to
+** sqlite3_column_name() or sqlite3_column_name16() on the same column.
+**
+** ^If sqlite3_malloc() fails during the processing of either routine
+** (for example during a conversion from UTF-8 to UTF-16) then a
+** NULL pointer is returned.
+**
+** ^The name of a result column is the value of the "AS" clause for
+** that column, if there is an AS clause. If there is no AS clause
+** then the name of the column is unspecified and may change from
+** one release of SQLite to the next.
+*/
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_column_name(sqlite3_stmt*, int N);
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_name16(sqlite3_stmt*, int N);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Source Of Data In A Query Result
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^These routines provide a means to determine the database, table, and
+** table column that is the origin of a particular result column in
+** [SELECT] statement.
+** ^The name of the database or table or column can be returned as
+** either a UTF-8 or UTF-16 string. ^The _database_ routines return
+** the database name, the _table_ routines return the table name, and
+** the origin_ routines return the column name.
+** ^The returned string is valid until the [prepared statement] is destroyed
+** using [sqlite3_finalize()] or until the statement is automatically
+** reprepared by the first call to [sqlite3_step()] for a particular run
+** or until the same information is requested
+** again in a different encoding.
+**
+** ^The names returned are the original un-aliased names of the
+** database, table, and column.
+**
+** ^The first argument to these interfaces is a [prepared statement].
+** ^These functions return information about the Nth result column returned by
+** the statement, where N is the second function argument.
+** ^The left-most column is column 0 for these routines.
+**
+** ^If the Nth column returned by the statement is an expression or
+** subquery and is not a column value, then all of these functions return
+** NULL. ^These routines might also return NULL if a memory allocation error
+** occurs. ^Otherwise, they return the name of the attached database, table,
+** or column that query result column was extracted from.
+**
+** ^As with all other SQLite APIs, those whose names end with "16" return
+** UTF-16 encoded strings and the other functions return UTF-8.
+**
+** ^These APIs are only available if the library was compiled with the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_COLUMN_METADATA] C-preprocessor symbol.
+**
+** If two or more threads call one or more
+** [sqlite3_column_database_name | column metadata interfaces]
+** for the same [prepared statement] and result column
+** at the same time then the results are undefined.
+*/
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_column_database_name(sqlite3_stmt*,int);
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_database_name16(sqlite3_stmt*,int);
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_column_table_name(sqlite3_stmt*,int);
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_table_name16(sqlite3_stmt*,int);
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_column_origin_name(sqlite3_stmt*,int);
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_origin_name16(sqlite3_stmt*,int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Declared Datatype Of A Query Result
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^(The first parameter is a [prepared statement].
+** If this statement is a [SELECT] statement and the Nth column of the
+** returned result set of that [SELECT] is a table column (not an
+** expression or subquery) then the declared type of the table
+** column is returned.)^ ^If the Nth column of the result set is an
+** expression or subquery, then a NULL pointer is returned.
+** ^The returned string is always UTF-8 encoded.
+**
+** ^(For example, given the database schema:
+**
+** CREATE TABLE t1(c1 VARIANT);
+**
+** and the following statement to be compiled:
+**
+** SELECT c1 + 1, c1 FROM t1;
+**
+** this routine would return the string "VARIANT" for the second result
+** column (i==1), and a NULL pointer for the first result column (i==0).)^
+**
+** ^SQLite uses dynamic run-time typing. ^So just because a column
+** is declared to contain a particular type does not mean that the
+** data stored in that column is of the declared type. SQLite is
+** strongly typed, but the typing is dynamic not static. ^Type
+** is associated with individual values, not with the containers
+** used to hold those values.
+*/
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_column_decltype(sqlite3_stmt*,int);
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_decltype16(sqlite3_stmt*,int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Evaluate An SQL Statement
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** After a [prepared statement] has been prepared using any of
+** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()], [sqlite3_prepare_v3()], [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()],
+** or [sqlite3_prepare16_v3()] or one of the legacy
+** interfaces [sqlite3_prepare()] or [sqlite3_prepare16()], this function
+** must be called one or more times to evaluate the statement.
+**
+** The details of the behavior of the sqlite3_step() interface depend
+** on whether the statement was prepared using the newer "vX" interfaces
+** [sqlite3_prepare_v3()], [sqlite3_prepare_v2()], [sqlite3_prepare16_v3()],
+** [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()] or the older legacy
+** interfaces [sqlite3_prepare()] and [sqlite3_prepare16()]. The use of the
+** new "vX" interface is recommended for new applications but the legacy
+** interface will continue to be supported.
+**
+** ^In the legacy interface, the return value will be either [SQLITE_BUSY],
+** [SQLITE_DONE], [SQLITE_ROW], [SQLITE_ERROR], or [SQLITE_MISUSE].
+** ^With the "v2" interface, any of the other [result codes] or
+** [extended result codes] might be returned as well.
+**
+** ^[SQLITE_BUSY] means that the database engine was unable to acquire the
+** database locks it needs to do its job. ^If the statement is a [COMMIT]
+** or occurs outside of an explicit transaction, then you can retry the
+** statement. If the statement is not a [COMMIT] and occurs within an
+** explicit transaction then you should rollback the transaction before
+** continuing.
+**
+** ^[SQLITE_DONE] means that the statement has finished executing
+** successfully. sqlite3_step() should not be called again on this virtual
+** machine without first calling [sqlite3_reset()] to reset the virtual
+** machine back to its initial state.
+**
+** ^If the SQL statement being executed returns any data, then [SQLITE_ROW]
+** is returned each time a new row of data is ready for processing by the
+** caller. The values may be accessed using the [column access functions].
+** sqlite3_step() is called again to retrieve the next row of data.
+**
+** ^[SQLITE_ERROR] means that a run-time error (such as a constraint
+** violation) has occurred. sqlite3_step() should not be called again on
+** the VM. More information may be found by calling [sqlite3_errmsg()].
+** ^With the legacy interface, a more specific error code (for example,
+** [SQLITE_INTERRUPT], [SQLITE_SCHEMA], [SQLITE_CORRUPT], and so forth)
+** can be obtained by calling [sqlite3_reset()] on the
+** [prepared statement]. ^In the "v2" interface,
+** the more specific error code is returned directly by sqlite3_step().
+**
+** [SQLITE_MISUSE] means that the this routine was called inappropriately.
+** Perhaps it was called on a [prepared statement] that has
+** already been [sqlite3_finalize | finalized] or on one that had
+** previously returned [SQLITE_ERROR] or [SQLITE_DONE]. Or it could
+** be the case that the same database connection is being used by two or
+** more threads at the same moment in time.
+**
+** For all versions of SQLite up to and including 3.6.23.1, a call to
+** [sqlite3_reset()] was required after sqlite3_step() returned anything
+** other than [SQLITE_ROW] before any subsequent invocation of
+** sqlite3_step(). Failure to reset the prepared statement using
+** [sqlite3_reset()] would result in an [SQLITE_MISUSE] return from
+** sqlite3_step(). But after [version 3.6.23.1] ([dateof:3.6.23.1],
+** sqlite3_step() began
+** calling [sqlite3_reset()] automatically in this circumstance rather
+** than returning [SQLITE_MISUSE]. This is not considered a compatibility
+** break because any application that ever receives an SQLITE_MISUSE error
+** is broken by definition. The [SQLITE_OMIT_AUTORESET] compile-time option
+** can be used to restore the legacy behavior.
+**
+** Goofy Interface Alert: In the legacy interface, the sqlite3_step()
+** API always returns a generic error code, [SQLITE_ERROR], following any
+** error other than [SQLITE_BUSY] and [SQLITE_MISUSE]. You must call
+** [sqlite3_reset()] or [sqlite3_finalize()] in order to find one of the
+** specific [error codes] that better describes the error.
+** We admit that this is a goofy design. The problem has been fixed
+** with the "v2" interface. If you prepare all of your SQL statements
+** using [sqlite3_prepare_v3()] or [sqlite3_prepare_v2()]
+** or [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()] or [sqlite3_prepare16_v3()] instead
+** of the legacy [sqlite3_prepare()] and [sqlite3_prepare16()] interfaces,
+** then the more specific [error codes] are returned directly
+** by sqlite3_step(). The use of the "vX" interfaces is recommended.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_step(sqlite3_stmt*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Number of columns in a result set
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_data_count(P) interface returns the number of columns in the
+** current row of the result set of [prepared statement] P.
+** ^If prepared statement P does not have results ready to return
+** (via calls to the [sqlite3_column_int | sqlite3_column()] family of
+** interfaces) then sqlite3_data_count(P) returns 0.
+** ^The sqlite3_data_count(P) routine also returns 0 if P is a NULL pointer.
+** ^The sqlite3_data_count(P) routine returns 0 if the previous call to
+** [sqlite3_step](P) returned [SQLITE_DONE]. ^The sqlite3_data_count(P)
+** will return non-zero if previous call to [sqlite3_step](P) returned
+** [SQLITE_ROW], except in the case of the [PRAGMA incremental_vacuum]
+** where it always returns zero since each step of that multi-step
+** pragma returns 0 columns of data.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_column_count()]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_data_count(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Fundamental Datatypes
+** KEYWORDS: SQLITE_TEXT
+**
+** ^(Every value in SQLite has one of five fundamental datatypes:
+**
+**
+**
64-bit signed integer
+**
64-bit IEEE floating point number
+**
string
+**
BLOB
+**
NULL
+**
)^
+**
+** These constants are codes for each of those types.
+**
+** Note that the SQLITE_TEXT constant was also used in SQLite version 2
+** for a completely different meaning. Software that links against both
+** SQLite version 2 and SQLite version 3 should use SQLITE3_TEXT, not
+** SQLITE_TEXT.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_INTEGER 1
+#define SQLITE_FLOAT 2
+#define SQLITE_BLOB 4
+#define SQLITE_NULL 5
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEXT
+# undef SQLITE_TEXT
+#else
+# define SQLITE_TEXT 3
+#endif
+#define SQLITE3_TEXT 3
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Result Values From A Query
+** KEYWORDS: {column access functions}
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** Summary:
+**
+**
sqlite3_column_blob
→
BLOB result
+**
sqlite3_column_double
→
REAL result
+**
sqlite3_column_int
→
32-bit INTEGER result
+**
sqlite3_column_int64
→
64-bit INTEGER result
+**
sqlite3_column_text
→
UTF-8 TEXT result
+**
sqlite3_column_text16
→
UTF-16 TEXT result
+**
sqlite3_column_value
→
The result as an
+** [sqlite3_value|unprotected sqlite3_value] object.
+**
+**
sqlite3_column_bytes
→
Size of a BLOB
+** or a UTF-8 TEXT result in bytes
+**
sqlite3_column_bytes16
+**
→
Size of UTF-16
+** TEXT in bytes
+**
sqlite3_column_type
→
Default
+** datatype of the result
+**
+**
+** Details:
+**
+** ^These routines return information about a single column of the current
+** result row of a query. ^In every case the first argument is a pointer
+** to the [prepared statement] that is being evaluated (the [sqlite3_stmt*]
+** that was returned from [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or one of its variants)
+** and the second argument is the index of the column for which information
+** should be returned. ^The leftmost column of the result set has the index 0.
+** ^The number of columns in the result can be determined using
+** [sqlite3_column_count()].
+**
+** If the SQL statement does not currently point to a valid row, or if the
+** column index is out of range, the result is undefined.
+** These routines may only be called when the most recent call to
+** [sqlite3_step()] has returned [SQLITE_ROW] and neither
+** [sqlite3_reset()] nor [sqlite3_finalize()] have been called subsequently.
+** If any of these routines are called after [sqlite3_reset()] or
+** [sqlite3_finalize()] or after [sqlite3_step()] has returned
+** something other than [SQLITE_ROW], the results are undefined.
+** If [sqlite3_step()] or [sqlite3_reset()] or [sqlite3_finalize()]
+** are called from a different thread while any of these routines
+** are pending, then the results are undefined.
+**
+** The first six interfaces (_blob, _double, _int, _int64, _text, and _text16)
+** each return the value of a result column in a specific data format. If
+** the result column is not initially in the requested format (for example,
+** if the query returns an integer but the sqlite3_column_text() interface
+** is used to extract the value) then an automatic type conversion is performed.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_column_type() routine returns the
+** [SQLITE_INTEGER | datatype code] for the initial data type
+** of the result column. ^The returned value is one of [SQLITE_INTEGER],
+** [SQLITE_FLOAT], [SQLITE_TEXT], [SQLITE_BLOB], or [SQLITE_NULL].
+** The return value of sqlite3_column_type() can be used to decide which
+** of the first six interface should be used to extract the column value.
+** The value returned by sqlite3_column_type() is only meaningful if no
+** automatic type conversions have occurred for the value in question.
+** After a type conversion, the result of calling sqlite3_column_type()
+** is undefined, though harmless. Future
+** versions of SQLite may change the behavior of sqlite3_column_type()
+** following a type conversion.
+**
+** If the result is a BLOB or a TEXT string, then the sqlite3_column_bytes()
+** or sqlite3_column_bytes16() interfaces can be used to determine the size
+** of that BLOB or string.
+**
+** ^If the result is a BLOB or UTF-8 string then the sqlite3_column_bytes()
+** routine returns the number of bytes in that BLOB or string.
+** ^If the result is a UTF-16 string, then sqlite3_column_bytes() converts
+** the string to UTF-8 and then returns the number of bytes.
+** ^If the result is a numeric value then sqlite3_column_bytes() uses
+** [sqlite3_snprintf()] to convert that value to a UTF-8 string and returns
+** the number of bytes in that string.
+** ^If the result is NULL, then sqlite3_column_bytes() returns zero.
+**
+** ^If the result is a BLOB or UTF-16 string then the sqlite3_column_bytes16()
+** routine returns the number of bytes in that BLOB or string.
+** ^If the result is a UTF-8 string, then sqlite3_column_bytes16() converts
+** the string to UTF-16 and then returns the number of bytes.
+** ^If the result is a numeric value then sqlite3_column_bytes16() uses
+** [sqlite3_snprintf()] to convert that value to a UTF-16 string and returns
+** the number of bytes in that string.
+** ^If the result is NULL, then sqlite3_column_bytes16() returns zero.
+**
+** ^The values returned by [sqlite3_column_bytes()] and
+** [sqlite3_column_bytes16()] do not include the zero terminators at the end
+** of the string. ^For clarity: the values returned by
+** [sqlite3_column_bytes()] and [sqlite3_column_bytes16()] are the number of
+** bytes in the string, not the number of characters.
+**
+** ^Strings returned by sqlite3_column_text() and sqlite3_column_text16(),
+** even empty strings, are always zero-terminated. ^The return
+** value from sqlite3_column_blob() for a zero-length BLOB is a NULL pointer.
+**
+** Warning: ^The object returned by [sqlite3_column_value()] is an
+** [unprotected sqlite3_value] object. In a multithreaded environment,
+** an unprotected sqlite3_value object may only be used safely with
+** [sqlite3_bind_value()] and [sqlite3_result_value()].
+** If the [unprotected sqlite3_value] object returned by
+** [sqlite3_column_value()] is used in any other way, including calls
+** to routines like [sqlite3_value_int()], [sqlite3_value_text()],
+** or [sqlite3_value_bytes()], the behavior is not threadsafe.
+** Hence, the sqlite3_column_value() interface
+** is normally only useful within the implementation of
+** [application-defined SQL functions] or [virtual tables], not within
+** top-level application code.
+**
+** The these routines may attempt to convert the datatype of the result.
+** ^For example, if the internal representation is FLOAT and a text result
+** is requested, [sqlite3_snprintf()] is used internally to perform the
+** conversion automatically. ^(The following table details the conversions
+** that are applied:
+**
+**
+**
+**
Internal Type
Requested Type
Conversion
+**
+**
NULL
INTEGER
Result is 0
+**
NULL
FLOAT
Result is 0.0
+**
NULL
TEXT
Result is a NULL pointer
+**
NULL
BLOB
Result is a NULL pointer
+**
INTEGER
FLOAT
Convert from integer to float
+**
INTEGER
TEXT
ASCII rendering of the integer
+**
INTEGER
BLOB
Same as INTEGER->TEXT
+**
FLOAT
INTEGER
[CAST] to INTEGER
+**
FLOAT
TEXT
ASCII rendering of the float
+**
FLOAT
BLOB
[CAST] to BLOB
+**
TEXT
INTEGER
[CAST] to INTEGER
+**
TEXT
FLOAT
[CAST] to REAL
+**
TEXT
BLOB
No change
+**
BLOB
INTEGER
[CAST] to INTEGER
+**
BLOB
FLOAT
[CAST] to REAL
+**
BLOB
TEXT
Add a zero terminator if needed
+**
+**
)^
+**
+** Note that when type conversions occur, pointers returned by prior
+** calls to sqlite3_column_blob(), sqlite3_column_text(), and/or
+** sqlite3_column_text16() may be invalidated.
+** Type conversions and pointer invalidations might occur
+** in the following cases:
+**
+**
+**
The initial content is a BLOB and sqlite3_column_text() or
+** sqlite3_column_text16() is called. A zero-terminator might
+** need to be added to the string.
+**
The initial content is UTF-8 text and sqlite3_column_bytes16() or
+** sqlite3_column_text16() is called. The content must be converted
+** to UTF-16.
+**
The initial content is UTF-16 text and sqlite3_column_bytes() or
+** sqlite3_column_text() is called. The content must be converted
+** to UTF-8.
+**
+**
+** ^Conversions between UTF-16be and UTF-16le are always done in place and do
+** not invalidate a prior pointer, though of course the content of the buffer
+** that the prior pointer references will have been modified. Other kinds
+** of conversion are done in place when it is possible, but sometimes they
+** are not possible and in those cases prior pointers are invalidated.
+**
+** The safest policy is to invoke these routines
+** in one of the following ways:
+**
+**
+**
sqlite3_column_text() followed by sqlite3_column_bytes()
+**
sqlite3_column_blob() followed by sqlite3_column_bytes()
+**
sqlite3_column_text16() followed by sqlite3_column_bytes16()
+**
+**
+** In other words, you should call sqlite3_column_text(),
+** sqlite3_column_blob(), or sqlite3_column_text16() first to force the result
+** into the desired format, then invoke sqlite3_column_bytes() or
+** sqlite3_column_bytes16() to find the size of the result. Do not mix calls
+** to sqlite3_column_text() or sqlite3_column_blob() with calls to
+** sqlite3_column_bytes16(), and do not mix calls to sqlite3_column_text16()
+** with calls to sqlite3_column_bytes().
+**
+** ^The pointers returned are valid until a type conversion occurs as
+** described above, or until [sqlite3_step()] or [sqlite3_reset()] or
+** [sqlite3_finalize()] is called. ^The memory space used to hold strings
+** and BLOBs is freed automatically. Do not pass the pointers returned
+** from [sqlite3_column_blob()], [sqlite3_column_text()], etc. into
+** [sqlite3_free()].
+**
+** As long as the input parameters are correct, these routines will only
+** fail if an out-of-memory error occurs during a format conversion.
+** Only the following subset of interfaces are subject to out-of-memory
+** errors:
+**
+**
+**
sqlite3_column_blob()
+**
sqlite3_column_text()
+**
sqlite3_column_text16()
+**
sqlite3_column_bytes()
+**
sqlite3_column_bytes16()
+**
+**
+** If an out-of-memory error occurs, then the return value from these
+** routines is the same as if the column had contained an SQL NULL value.
+** Valid SQL NULL returns can be distinguished from out-of-memory errors
+** by invoking the [sqlite3_errcode()] immediately after the suspect
+** return value is obtained and before any
+** other SQLite interface is called on the same [database connection].
+*/
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_blob(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol);
+SQLITE_API double sqlite3_column_double(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_column_int(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol);
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_column_int64(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol);
+SQLITE_API const unsigned char *sqlite3_column_text(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol);
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_text16(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol);
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_value *sqlite3_column_value(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_column_bytes(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_column_bytes16(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_column_type(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Destroy A Prepared Statement Object
+** DESTRUCTOR: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_finalize() function is called to delete a [prepared statement].
+** ^If the most recent evaluation of the statement encountered no errors
+** or if the statement is never been evaluated, then sqlite3_finalize() returns
+** SQLITE_OK. ^If the most recent evaluation of statement S failed, then
+** sqlite3_finalize(S) returns the appropriate [error code] or
+** [extended error code].
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_finalize(S) routine can be called at any point during
+** the life cycle of [prepared statement] S:
+** before statement S is ever evaluated, after
+** one or more calls to [sqlite3_reset()], or after any call
+** to [sqlite3_step()] regardless of whether or not the statement has
+** completed execution.
+**
+** ^Invoking sqlite3_finalize() on a NULL pointer is a harmless no-op.
+**
+** The application must finalize every [prepared statement] in order to avoid
+** resource leaks. It is a grievous error for the application to try to use
+** a prepared statement after it has been finalized. Any use of a prepared
+** statement after it has been finalized can result in undefined and
+** undesirable behavior such as segfaults and heap corruption.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_finalize(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Reset A Prepared Statement Object
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** The sqlite3_reset() function is called to reset a [prepared statement]
+** object back to its initial state, ready to be re-executed.
+** ^Any SQL statement variables that had values bound to them using
+** the [sqlite3_bind_blob | sqlite3_bind_*() API] retain their values.
+** Use [sqlite3_clear_bindings()] to reset the bindings.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_reset(S)] interface resets the [prepared statement] S
+** back to the beginning of its program.
+**
+** ^If the most recent call to [sqlite3_step(S)] for the
+** [prepared statement] S returned [SQLITE_ROW] or [SQLITE_DONE],
+** or if [sqlite3_step(S)] has never before been called on S,
+** then [sqlite3_reset(S)] returns [SQLITE_OK].
+**
+** ^If the most recent call to [sqlite3_step(S)] for the
+** [prepared statement] S indicated an error, then
+** [sqlite3_reset(S)] returns an appropriate [error code].
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_reset(S)] interface does not change the values
+** of any [sqlite3_bind_blob|bindings] on the [prepared statement] S.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_reset(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Create Or Redefine SQL Functions
+** KEYWORDS: {function creation routines}
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^These functions (collectively known as "function creation routines")
+** are used to add SQL functions or aggregates or to redefine the behavior
+** of existing SQL functions or aggregates. The only differences between
+** the three "sqlite3_create_function*" routines are the text encoding
+** expected for the second parameter (the name of the function being
+** created) and the presence or absence of a destructor callback for
+** the application data pointer. Function sqlite3_create_window_function()
+** is similar, but allows the user to supply the extra callback functions
+** needed by [aggregate window functions].
+**
+** ^The first parameter is the [database connection] to which the SQL
+** function is to be added. ^If an application uses more than one database
+** connection then application-defined SQL functions must be added
+** to each database connection separately.
+**
+** ^The second parameter is the name of the SQL function to be created or
+** redefined. ^The length of the name is limited to 255 bytes in a UTF-8
+** representation, exclusive of the zero-terminator. ^Note that the name
+** length limit is in UTF-8 bytes, not characters nor UTF-16 bytes.
+** ^Any attempt to create a function with a longer name
+** will result in [SQLITE_MISUSE] being returned.
+**
+** ^The third parameter (nArg)
+** is the number of arguments that the SQL function or
+** aggregate takes. ^If this parameter is -1, then the SQL function or
+** aggregate may take any number of arguments between 0 and the limit
+** set by [sqlite3_limit]([SQLITE_LIMIT_FUNCTION_ARG]). If the third
+** parameter is less than -1 or greater than 127 then the behavior is
+** undefined.
+**
+** ^The fourth parameter, eTextRep, specifies what
+** [SQLITE_UTF8 | text encoding] this SQL function prefers for
+** its parameters. The application should set this parameter to
+** [SQLITE_UTF16LE] if the function implementation invokes
+** [sqlite3_value_text16le()] on an input, or [SQLITE_UTF16BE] if the
+** implementation invokes [sqlite3_value_text16be()] on an input, or
+** [SQLITE_UTF16] if [sqlite3_value_text16()] is used, or [SQLITE_UTF8]
+** otherwise. ^The same SQL function may be registered multiple times using
+** different preferred text encodings, with different implementations for
+** each encoding.
+** ^When multiple implementations of the same function are available, SQLite
+** will pick the one that involves the least amount of data conversion.
+**
+** ^The fourth parameter may optionally be ORed with [SQLITE_DETERMINISTIC]
+** to signal that the function will always return the same result given
+** the same inputs within a single SQL statement. Most SQL functions are
+** deterministic. The built-in [random()] SQL function is an example of a
+** function that is not deterministic. The SQLite query planner is able to
+** perform additional optimizations on deterministic functions, so use
+** of the [SQLITE_DETERMINISTIC] flag is recommended where possible.
+**
+** ^The fourth parameter may also optionally include the [SQLITE_DIRECTONLY]
+** flag, which if present prevents the function from being invoked from
+** within VIEWs, TRIGGERs, CHECK constraints, generated column expressions,
+** index expressions, or the WHERE clause of partial indexes.
+**
+**
+** For best security, the [SQLITE_DIRECTONLY] flag is recommended for
+** all application-defined SQL functions that do not need to be
+** used inside of triggers, view, CHECK constraints, or other elements of
+** the database schema. This flags is especially recommended for SQL
+** functions that have side effects or reveal internal application state.
+** Without this flag, an attacker might be able to modify the schema of
+** a database file to include invocations of the function with parameters
+** chosen by the attacker, which the application will then execute when
+** the database file is opened and read.
+**
+**
+** ^(The fifth parameter is an arbitrary pointer. The implementation of the
+** function can gain access to this pointer using [sqlite3_user_data()].)^
+**
+** ^The sixth, seventh and eighth parameters passed to the three
+** "sqlite3_create_function*" functions, xFunc, xStep and xFinal, are
+** pointers to C-language functions that implement the SQL function or
+** aggregate. ^A scalar SQL function requires an implementation of the xFunc
+** callback only; NULL pointers must be passed as the xStep and xFinal
+** parameters. ^An aggregate SQL function requires an implementation of xStep
+** and xFinal and NULL pointer must be passed for xFunc. ^To delete an existing
+** SQL function or aggregate, pass NULL pointers for all three function
+** callbacks.
+**
+** ^The sixth, seventh, eighth and ninth parameters (xStep, xFinal, xValue
+** and xInverse) passed to sqlite3_create_window_function are pointers to
+** C-language callbacks that implement the new function. xStep and xFinal
+** must both be non-NULL. xValue and xInverse may either both be NULL, in
+** which case a regular aggregate function is created, or must both be
+** non-NULL, in which case the new function may be used as either an aggregate
+** or aggregate window function. More details regarding the implementation
+** of aggregate window functions are
+** [user-defined window functions|available here].
+**
+** ^(If the final parameter to sqlite3_create_function_v2() or
+** sqlite3_create_window_function() is not NULL, then it is destructor for
+** the application data pointer. The destructor is invoked when the function
+** is deleted, either by being overloaded or when the database connection
+** closes.)^ ^The destructor is also invoked if the call to
+** sqlite3_create_function_v2() fails. ^When the destructor callback is
+** invoked, it is passed a single argument which is a copy of the application
+** data pointer which was the fifth parameter to sqlite3_create_function_v2().
+**
+** ^It is permitted to register multiple implementations of the same
+** functions with the same name but with either differing numbers of
+** arguments or differing preferred text encodings. ^SQLite will use
+** the implementation that most closely matches the way in which the
+** SQL function is used. ^A function implementation with a non-negative
+** nArg parameter is a better match than a function implementation with
+** a negative nArg. ^A function where the preferred text encoding
+** matches the database encoding is a better
+** match than a function where the encoding is different.
+** ^A function where the encoding difference is between UTF16le and UTF16be
+** is a closer match than a function where the encoding difference is
+** between UTF8 and UTF16.
+**
+** ^Built-in functions may be overloaded by new application-defined functions.
+**
+** ^An application-defined function is permitted to call other
+** SQLite interfaces. However, such calls must not
+** close the database connection nor finalize or reset the prepared
+** statement in which the function is running.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_function(
+ sqlite3 *db,
+ const char *zFunctionName,
+ int nArg,
+ int eTextRep,
+ void *pApp,
+ void (*xFunc)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**),
+ void (*xStep)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**),
+ void (*xFinal)(sqlite3_context*)
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_function16(
+ sqlite3 *db,
+ const void *zFunctionName,
+ int nArg,
+ int eTextRep,
+ void *pApp,
+ void (*xFunc)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**),
+ void (*xStep)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**),
+ void (*xFinal)(sqlite3_context*)
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_function_v2(
+ sqlite3 *db,
+ const char *zFunctionName,
+ int nArg,
+ int eTextRep,
+ void *pApp,
+ void (*xFunc)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**),
+ void (*xStep)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**),
+ void (*xFinal)(sqlite3_context*),
+ void(*xDestroy)(void*)
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_window_function(
+ sqlite3 *db,
+ const char *zFunctionName,
+ int nArg,
+ int eTextRep,
+ void *pApp,
+ void (*xStep)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**),
+ void (*xFinal)(sqlite3_context*),
+ void (*xValue)(sqlite3_context*),
+ void (*xInverse)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**),
+ void(*xDestroy)(void*)
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Text Encodings
+**
+** These constant define integer codes that represent the various
+** text encodings supported by SQLite.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_UTF8 1 /* IMP: R-37514-35566 */
+#define SQLITE_UTF16LE 2 /* IMP: R-03371-37637 */
+#define SQLITE_UTF16BE 3 /* IMP: R-51971-34154 */
+#define SQLITE_UTF16 4 /* Use native byte order */
+#define SQLITE_ANY 5 /* Deprecated */
+#define SQLITE_UTF16_ALIGNED 8 /* sqlite3_create_collation only */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Function Flags
+**
+** These constants may be ORed together with the
+** [SQLITE_UTF8 | preferred text encoding] as the fourth argument
+** to [sqlite3_create_function()], [sqlite3_create_function16()], or
+** [sqlite3_create_function_v2()].
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DETERMINISTIC]]
SQLITE_DETERMINISTIC
+** The SQLITE_DETERMINISTIC flag means that the new function always gives
+** the same output when the input parameters are the same.
+** The [abs|abs() function] is deterministic, for example, but
+** [randomblob|randomblob()] is not. Functions must
+** be deterministic in order to be used in certain contexts such as
+** with the WHERE clause of [partial indexes] or in [generated columns].
+** SQLite might also optimize deterministic functions by factoring them
+** out of inner loops.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DIRECTONLY]]
SQLITE_DIRECTONLY
+** The SQLITE_DIRECTONLY flag means that the function may only be invoked
+** from top-level SQL, and cannot be used in VIEWs or TRIGGERs nor in
+** schema structures such as [CHECK constraints], [DEFAULT clauses],
+** [expression indexes], [partial indexes], or [generated columns].
+** The SQLITE_DIRECTONLY flags is a security feature which is recommended
+** for all [application-defined SQL functions], and especially for functions
+** that have side-effects or that could potentially leak sensitive
+** information.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_INNOCUOUS]]
SQLITE_INNOCUOUS
+** The SQLITE_INNOCUOUS flag means that the function is unlikely
+** to cause problems even if misused. An innocuous function should have
+** no side effects and should not depend on any values other than its
+** input parameters. The [abs|abs() function] is an example of an
+** innocuous function.
+** The [load_extension() SQL function] is not innocuous because of its
+** side effects.
+**
SQLITE_INNOCUOUS is similar to SQLITE_DETERMINISTIC, but is not
+** exactly the same. The [random|random() function] is an example of a
+** function that is innocuous but not deterministic.
+**
Some heightened security settings
+** ([SQLITE_DBCONFIG_TRUSTED_SCHEMA] and [PRAGMA trusted_schema=OFF])
+** disable the use of SQL functions inside views and triggers and in
+** schema structures such as [CHECK constraints], [DEFAULT clauses],
+** [expression indexes], [partial indexes], and [generated columns] unless
+** the function is tagged with SQLITE_INNOCUOUS. Most built-in functions
+** are innocuous. Developers are advised to avoid using the
+** SQLITE_INNOCUOUS flag for application-defined functions unless the
+** function has been carefully audited and found to be free of potentially
+** security-adverse side-effects and information-leaks.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_SUBTYPE]]
SQLITE_SUBTYPE
+** The SQLITE_SUBTYPE flag indicates to SQLite that a function may call
+** [sqlite3_value_subtype()] to inspect the sub-types of its arguments.
+** Specifying this flag makes no difference for scalar or aggregate user
+** functions. However, if it is not specified for a user-defined window
+** function, then any sub-types belonging to arguments passed to the window
+** function may be discarded before the window function is called (i.e.
+** sqlite3_value_subtype() will always return 0).
+**
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_DETERMINISTIC 0x000000800
+#define SQLITE_DIRECTONLY 0x000080000
+#define SQLITE_SUBTYPE 0x000100000
+#define SQLITE_INNOCUOUS 0x000200000
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Deprecated Functions
+** DEPRECATED
+**
+** These functions are [deprecated]. In order to maintain
+** backwards compatibility with older code, these functions continue
+** to be supported. However, new applications should avoid
+** the use of these functions. To encourage programmers to avoid
+** these functions, we will not explain what they do.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_DEPRECATED
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_DEPRECATED int sqlite3_aggregate_count(sqlite3_context*);
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_DEPRECATED int sqlite3_expired(sqlite3_stmt*);
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_DEPRECATED int sqlite3_transfer_bindings(sqlite3_stmt*, sqlite3_stmt*);
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_DEPRECATED int sqlite3_global_recover(void);
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_DEPRECATED void sqlite3_thread_cleanup(void);
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_DEPRECATED int sqlite3_memory_alarm(void(*)(void*,sqlite3_int64,int),
+ void*,sqlite3_int64);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Obtaining SQL Values
+** METHOD: sqlite3_value
+**
+** Summary:
+**
+**
sqlite3_value_blob
→
BLOB value
+**
sqlite3_value_double
→
REAL value
+**
sqlite3_value_int
→
32-bit INTEGER value
+**
sqlite3_value_int64
→
64-bit INTEGER value
+**
sqlite3_value_pointer
→
Pointer value
+**
sqlite3_value_text
→
UTF-8 TEXT value
+**
sqlite3_value_text16
→
UTF-16 TEXT value in
+** the native byteorder
+**
sqlite3_value_text16be
→
UTF-16be TEXT value
+**
sqlite3_value_text16le
→
UTF-16le TEXT value
+**
+**
sqlite3_value_bytes
→
Size of a BLOB
+** or a UTF-8 TEXT in bytes
+**
sqlite3_value_bytes16
+**
→
Size of UTF-16
+** TEXT in bytes
+**
sqlite3_value_type
→
Default
+** datatype of the value
+**
sqlite3_value_numeric_type
+**
→
Best numeric datatype of the value
+**
sqlite3_value_nochange
+**
→
True if the column is unchanged in an UPDATE
+** against a virtual table.
+**
sqlite3_value_frombind
+**
→
True if value originated from a [bound parameter]
+**
+**
+** Details:
+**
+** These routines extract type, size, and content information from
+** [protected sqlite3_value] objects. Protected sqlite3_value objects
+** are used to pass parameter information into the functions that
+** implement [application-defined SQL functions] and [virtual tables].
+**
+** These routines work only with [protected sqlite3_value] objects.
+** Any attempt to use these routines on an [unprotected sqlite3_value]
+** is not threadsafe.
+**
+** ^These routines work just like the corresponding [column access functions]
+** except that these routines take a single [protected sqlite3_value] object
+** pointer instead of a [sqlite3_stmt*] pointer and an integer column number.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_value_text16() interface extracts a UTF-16 string
+** in the native byte-order of the host machine. ^The
+** sqlite3_value_text16be() and sqlite3_value_text16le() interfaces
+** extract UTF-16 strings as big-endian and little-endian respectively.
+**
+** ^If [sqlite3_value] object V was initialized
+** using [sqlite3_bind_pointer(S,I,P,X,D)] or [sqlite3_result_pointer(C,P,X,D)]
+** and if X and Y are strings that compare equal according to strcmp(X,Y),
+** then sqlite3_value_pointer(V,Y) will return the pointer P. ^Otherwise,
+** sqlite3_value_pointer(V,Y) returns a NULL. The sqlite3_bind_pointer()
+** routine is part of the [pointer passing interface] added for SQLite 3.20.0.
+**
+** ^(The sqlite3_value_type(V) interface returns the
+** [SQLITE_INTEGER | datatype code] for the initial datatype of the
+** [sqlite3_value] object V. The returned value is one of [SQLITE_INTEGER],
+** [SQLITE_FLOAT], [SQLITE_TEXT], [SQLITE_BLOB], or [SQLITE_NULL].)^
+** Other interfaces might change the datatype for an sqlite3_value object.
+** For example, if the datatype is initially SQLITE_INTEGER and
+** sqlite3_value_text(V) is called to extract a text value for that
+** integer, then subsequent calls to sqlite3_value_type(V) might return
+** SQLITE_TEXT. Whether or not a persistent internal datatype conversion
+** occurs is undefined and may change from one release of SQLite to the next.
+**
+** ^(The sqlite3_value_numeric_type() interface attempts to apply
+** numeric affinity to the value. This means that an attempt is
+** made to convert the value to an integer or floating point. If
+** such a conversion is possible without loss of information (in other
+** words, if the value is a string that looks like a number)
+** then the conversion is performed. Otherwise no conversion occurs.
+** The [SQLITE_INTEGER | datatype] after conversion is returned.)^
+**
+** ^Within the [xUpdate] method of a [virtual table], the
+** sqlite3_value_nochange(X) interface returns true if and only if
+** the column corresponding to X is unchanged by the UPDATE operation
+** that the xUpdate method call was invoked to implement and if
+** and the prior [xColumn] method call that was invoked to extracted
+** the value for that column returned without setting a result (probably
+** because it queried [sqlite3_vtab_nochange()] and found that the column
+** was unchanging). ^Within an [xUpdate] method, any value for which
+** sqlite3_value_nochange(X) is true will in all other respects appear
+** to be a NULL value. If sqlite3_value_nochange(X) is invoked anywhere other
+** than within an [xUpdate] method call for an UPDATE statement, then
+** the return value is arbitrary and meaningless.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_value_frombind(X) interface returns non-zero if the
+** value X originated from one of the [sqlite3_bind_int|sqlite3_bind()]
+** interfaces. ^If X comes from an SQL literal value, or a table column,
+** or an expression, then sqlite3_value_frombind(X) returns zero.
+**
+** Please pay particular attention to the fact that the pointer returned
+** from [sqlite3_value_blob()], [sqlite3_value_text()], or
+** [sqlite3_value_text16()] can be invalidated by a subsequent call to
+** [sqlite3_value_bytes()], [sqlite3_value_bytes16()], [sqlite3_value_text()],
+** or [sqlite3_value_text16()].
+**
+** These routines must be called from the same thread as
+** the SQL function that supplied the [sqlite3_value*] parameters.
+**
+** As long as the input parameter is correct, these routines can only
+** fail if an out-of-memory error occurs during a format conversion.
+** Only the following subset of interfaces are subject to out-of-memory
+** errors:
+**
+**
+**
sqlite3_value_blob()
+**
sqlite3_value_text()
+**
sqlite3_value_text16()
+**
sqlite3_value_text16le()
+**
sqlite3_value_text16be()
+**
sqlite3_value_bytes()
+**
sqlite3_value_bytes16()
+**
+**
+** If an out-of-memory error occurs, then the return value from these
+** routines is the same as if the column had contained an SQL NULL value.
+** Valid SQL NULL returns can be distinguished from out-of-memory errors
+** by invoking the [sqlite3_errcode()] immediately after the suspect
+** return value is obtained and before any
+** other SQLite interface is called on the same [database connection].
+*/
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_value_blob(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API double sqlite3_value_double(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_int(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_value_int64(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_value_pointer(sqlite3_value*, const char*);
+SQLITE_API const unsigned char *sqlite3_value_text(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_value_text16(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_value_text16le(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_value_text16be(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_bytes(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_bytes16(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_type(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_numeric_type(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_nochange(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_frombind(sqlite3_value*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Finding The Subtype Of SQL Values
+** METHOD: sqlite3_value
+**
+** The sqlite3_value_subtype(V) function returns the subtype for
+** an [application-defined SQL function] argument V. The subtype
+** information can be used to pass a limited amount of context from
+** one SQL function to another. Use the [sqlite3_result_subtype()]
+** routine to set the subtype for the return value of an SQL function.
+*/
+SQLITE_API unsigned int sqlite3_value_subtype(sqlite3_value*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Copy And Free SQL Values
+** METHOD: sqlite3_value
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_value_dup(V) interface makes a copy of the [sqlite3_value]
+** object D and returns a pointer to that copy. ^The [sqlite3_value] returned
+** is a [protected sqlite3_value] object even if the input is not.
+** ^The sqlite3_value_dup(V) interface returns NULL if V is NULL or if a
+** memory allocation fails.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_value_free(V) interface frees an [sqlite3_value] object
+** previously obtained from [sqlite3_value_dup()]. ^If V is a NULL pointer
+** then sqlite3_value_free(V) is a harmless no-op.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_value *sqlite3_value_dup(const sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_value_free(sqlite3_value*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Obtain Aggregate Function Context
+** METHOD: sqlite3_context
+**
+** Implementations of aggregate SQL functions use this
+** routine to allocate memory for storing their state.
+**
+** ^The first time the sqlite3_aggregate_context(C,N) routine is called
+** for a particular aggregate function, SQLite allocates
+** N bytes of memory, zeroes out that memory, and returns a pointer
+** to the new memory. ^On second and subsequent calls to
+** sqlite3_aggregate_context() for the same aggregate function instance,
+** the same buffer is returned. Sqlite3_aggregate_context() is normally
+** called once for each invocation of the xStep callback and then one
+** last time when the xFinal callback is invoked. ^(When no rows match
+** an aggregate query, the xStep() callback of the aggregate function
+** implementation is never called and xFinal() is called exactly once.
+** In those cases, sqlite3_aggregate_context() might be called for the
+** first time from within xFinal().)^
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_aggregate_context(C,N) routine returns a NULL pointer
+** when first called if N is less than or equal to zero or if a memory
+** allocate error occurs.
+**
+** ^(The amount of space allocated by sqlite3_aggregate_context(C,N) is
+** determined by the N parameter on first successful call. Changing the
+** value of N in any subsequent call to sqlite3_aggregate_context() within
+** the same aggregate function instance will not resize the memory
+** allocation.)^ Within the xFinal callback, it is customary to set
+** N=0 in calls to sqlite3_aggregate_context(C,N) so that no
+** pointless memory allocations occur.
+**
+** ^SQLite automatically frees the memory allocated by
+** sqlite3_aggregate_context() when the aggregate query concludes.
+**
+** The first parameter must be a copy of the
+** [sqlite3_context | SQL function context] that is the first parameter
+** to the xStep or xFinal callback routine that implements the aggregate
+** function.
+**
+** This routine must be called from the same thread in which
+** the aggregate SQL function is running.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_aggregate_context(sqlite3_context*, int nBytes);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: User Data For Functions
+** METHOD: sqlite3_context
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_user_data() interface returns a copy of
+** the pointer that was the pUserData parameter (the 5th parameter)
+** of the [sqlite3_create_function()]
+** and [sqlite3_create_function16()] routines that originally
+** registered the application defined function.
+**
+** This routine must be called from the same thread in which
+** the application-defined function is running.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_user_data(sqlite3_context*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Database Connection For Functions
+** METHOD: sqlite3_context
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_context_db_handle() interface returns a copy of
+** the pointer to the [database connection] (the 1st parameter)
+** of the [sqlite3_create_function()]
+** and [sqlite3_create_function16()] routines that originally
+** registered the application defined function.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3 *sqlite3_context_db_handle(sqlite3_context*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Function Auxiliary Data
+** METHOD: sqlite3_context
+**
+** These functions may be used by (non-aggregate) SQL functions to
+** associate metadata with argument values. If the same value is passed to
+** multiple invocations of the same SQL function during query execution, under
+** some circumstances the associated metadata may be preserved. An example
+** of where this might be useful is in a regular-expression matching
+** function. The compiled version of the regular expression can be stored as
+** metadata associated with the pattern string.
+** Then as long as the pattern string remains the same,
+** the compiled regular expression can be reused on multiple
+** invocations of the same function.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_get_auxdata(C,N) interface returns a pointer to the metadata
+** associated by the sqlite3_set_auxdata(C,N,P,X) function with the Nth argument
+** value to the application-defined function. ^N is zero for the left-most
+** function argument. ^If there is no metadata
+** associated with the function argument, the sqlite3_get_auxdata(C,N) interface
+** returns a NULL pointer.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_set_auxdata(C,N,P,X) interface saves P as metadata for the N-th
+** argument of the application-defined function. ^Subsequent
+** calls to sqlite3_get_auxdata(C,N) return P from the most recent
+** sqlite3_set_auxdata(C,N,P,X) call if the metadata is still valid or
+** NULL if the metadata has been discarded.
+** ^After each call to sqlite3_set_auxdata(C,N,P,X) where X is not NULL,
+** SQLite will invoke the destructor function X with parameter P exactly
+** once, when the metadata is discarded.
+** SQLite is free to discard the metadata at any time, including:
+**
^(when the corresponding function parameter changes)^, or
+**
^(when [sqlite3_reset()] or [sqlite3_finalize()] is called for the
+** SQL statement)^, or
+**
^(when sqlite3_set_auxdata() is invoked again on the same
+** parameter)^, or
+**
^(during the original sqlite3_set_auxdata() call when a memory
+** allocation error occurs.)^
+**
+** Note the last bullet in particular. The destructor X in
+** sqlite3_set_auxdata(C,N,P,X) might be called immediately, before the
+** sqlite3_set_auxdata() interface even returns. Hence sqlite3_set_auxdata()
+** should be called near the end of the function implementation and the
+** function implementation should not make any use of P after
+** sqlite3_set_auxdata() has been called.
+**
+** ^(In practice, metadata is preserved between function calls for
+** function parameters that are compile-time constants, including literal
+** values and [parameters] and expressions composed from the same.)^
+**
+** The value of the N parameter to these interfaces should be non-negative.
+** Future enhancements may make use of negative N values to define new
+** kinds of function caching behavior.
+**
+** These routines must be called from the same thread in which
+** the SQL function is running.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_get_auxdata(sqlite3_context*, int N);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_set_auxdata(sqlite3_context*, int N, void*, void (*)(void*));
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Constants Defining Special Destructor Behavior
+**
+** These are special values for the destructor that is passed in as the
+** final argument to routines like [sqlite3_result_blob()]. ^If the destructor
+** argument is SQLITE_STATIC, it means that the content pointer is constant
+** and will never change. It does not need to be destroyed. ^The
+** SQLITE_TRANSIENT value means that the content will likely change in
+** the near future and that SQLite should make its own private copy of
+** the content before returning.
+**
+** The typedef is necessary to work around problems in certain
+** C++ compilers.
+*/
+typedef void (*sqlite3_destructor_type)(void*);
+#define SQLITE_STATIC ((sqlite3_destructor_type)0)
+#define SQLITE_TRANSIENT ((sqlite3_destructor_type)-1)
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Setting The Result Of An SQL Function
+** METHOD: sqlite3_context
+**
+** These routines are used by the xFunc or xFinal callbacks that
+** implement SQL functions and aggregates. See
+** [sqlite3_create_function()] and [sqlite3_create_function16()]
+** for additional information.
+**
+** These functions work very much like the [parameter binding] family of
+** functions used to bind values to host parameters in prepared statements.
+** Refer to the [SQL parameter] documentation for additional information.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_blob() interface sets the result from
+** an application-defined function to be the BLOB whose content is pointed
+** to by the second parameter and which is N bytes long where N is the
+** third parameter.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_zeroblob(C,N) and sqlite3_result_zeroblob64(C,N)
+** interfaces set the result of the application-defined function to be
+** a BLOB containing all zero bytes and N bytes in size.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_double() interface sets the result from
+** an application-defined function to be a floating point value specified
+** by its 2nd argument.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_error() and sqlite3_result_error16() functions
+** cause the implemented SQL function to throw an exception.
+** ^SQLite uses the string pointed to by the
+** 2nd parameter of sqlite3_result_error() or sqlite3_result_error16()
+** as the text of an error message. ^SQLite interprets the error
+** message string from sqlite3_result_error() as UTF-8. ^SQLite
+** interprets the string from sqlite3_result_error16() as UTF-16 using
+** the same [byte-order determination rules] as [sqlite3_bind_text16()].
+** ^If the third parameter to sqlite3_result_error()
+** or sqlite3_result_error16() is negative then SQLite takes as the error
+** message all text up through the first zero character.
+** ^If the third parameter to sqlite3_result_error() or
+** sqlite3_result_error16() is non-negative then SQLite takes that many
+** bytes (not characters) from the 2nd parameter as the error message.
+** ^The sqlite3_result_error() and sqlite3_result_error16()
+** routines make a private copy of the error message text before
+** they return. Hence, the calling function can deallocate or
+** modify the text after they return without harm.
+** ^The sqlite3_result_error_code() function changes the error code
+** returned by SQLite as a result of an error in a function. ^By default,
+** the error code is SQLITE_ERROR. ^A subsequent call to sqlite3_result_error()
+** or sqlite3_result_error16() resets the error code to SQLITE_ERROR.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_error_toobig() interface causes SQLite to throw an
+** error indicating that a string or BLOB is too long to represent.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_error_nomem() interface causes SQLite to throw an
+** error indicating that a memory allocation failed.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_int() interface sets the return value
+** of the application-defined function to be the 32-bit signed integer
+** value given in the 2nd argument.
+** ^The sqlite3_result_int64() interface sets the return value
+** of the application-defined function to be the 64-bit signed integer
+** value given in the 2nd argument.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_null() interface sets the return value
+** of the application-defined function to be NULL.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_text(), sqlite3_result_text16(),
+** sqlite3_result_text16le(), and sqlite3_result_text16be() interfaces
+** set the return value of the application-defined function to be
+** a text string which is represented as UTF-8, UTF-16 native byte order,
+** UTF-16 little endian, or UTF-16 big endian, respectively.
+** ^The sqlite3_result_text64() interface sets the return value of an
+** application-defined function to be a text string in an encoding
+** specified by the fifth (and last) parameter, which must be one
+** of [SQLITE_UTF8], [SQLITE_UTF16], [SQLITE_UTF16BE], or [SQLITE_UTF16LE].
+** ^SQLite takes the text result from the application from
+** the 2nd parameter of the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces.
+** ^If the 3rd parameter to the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces
+** is negative, then SQLite takes result text from the 2nd parameter
+** through the first zero character.
+** ^If the 3rd parameter to the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces
+** is non-negative, then as many bytes (not characters) of the text
+** pointed to by the 2nd parameter are taken as the application-defined
+** function result. If the 3rd parameter is non-negative, then it
+** must be the byte offset into the string where the NUL terminator would
+** appear if the string where NUL terminated. If any NUL characters occur
+** in the string at a byte offset that is less than the value of the 3rd
+** parameter, then the resulting string will contain embedded NULs and the
+** result of expressions operating on strings with embedded NULs is undefined.
+** ^If the 4th parameter to the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces
+** or sqlite3_result_blob is a non-NULL pointer, then SQLite calls that
+** function as the destructor on the text or BLOB result when it has
+** finished using that result.
+** ^If the 4th parameter to the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces or to
+** sqlite3_result_blob is the special constant SQLITE_STATIC, then SQLite
+** assumes that the text or BLOB result is in constant space and does not
+** copy the content of the parameter nor call a destructor on the content
+** when it has finished using that result.
+** ^If the 4th parameter to the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces
+** or sqlite3_result_blob is the special constant SQLITE_TRANSIENT
+** then SQLite makes a copy of the result into space obtained
+** from [sqlite3_malloc()] before it returns.
+**
+** ^For the sqlite3_result_text16(), sqlite3_result_text16le(), and
+** sqlite3_result_text16be() routines, and for sqlite3_result_text64()
+** when the encoding is not UTF8, if the input UTF16 begins with a
+** byte-order mark (BOM, U+FEFF) then the BOM is removed from the
+** string and the rest of the string is interpreted according to the
+** byte-order specified by the BOM. ^The byte-order specified by
+** the BOM at the beginning of the text overrides the byte-order
+** specified by the interface procedure. ^So, for example, if
+** sqlite3_result_text16le() is invoked with text that begins
+** with bytes 0xfe, 0xff (a big-endian byte-order mark) then the
+** first two bytes of input are skipped and the remaining input
+** is interpreted as UTF16BE text.
+**
+** ^For UTF16 input text to the sqlite3_result_text16(),
+** sqlite3_result_text16be(), sqlite3_result_text16le(), and
+** sqlite3_result_text64() routines, if the text contains invalid
+** UTF16 characters, the invalid characters might be converted
+** into the unicode replacement character, U+FFFD.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_value() interface sets the result of
+** the application-defined function to be a copy of the
+** [unprotected sqlite3_value] object specified by the 2nd parameter. ^The
+** sqlite3_result_value() interface makes a copy of the [sqlite3_value]
+** so that the [sqlite3_value] specified in the parameter may change or
+** be deallocated after sqlite3_result_value() returns without harm.
+** ^A [protected sqlite3_value] object may always be used where an
+** [unprotected sqlite3_value] object is required, so either
+** kind of [sqlite3_value] object can be used with this interface.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_result_pointer(C,P,T,D) interface sets the result to an
+** SQL NULL value, just like [sqlite3_result_null(C)], except that it
+** also associates the host-language pointer P or type T with that
+** NULL value such that the pointer can be retrieved within an
+** [application-defined SQL function] using [sqlite3_value_pointer()].
+** ^If the D parameter is not NULL, then it is a pointer to a destructor
+** for the P parameter. ^SQLite invokes D with P as its only argument
+** when SQLite is finished with P. The T parameter should be a static
+** string and preferably a string literal. The sqlite3_result_pointer()
+** routine is part of the [pointer passing interface] added for SQLite 3.20.0.
+**
+** If these routines are called from within the different thread
+** than the one containing the application-defined function that received
+** the [sqlite3_context] pointer, the results are undefined.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_blob(sqlite3_context*, const void*, int, void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_blob64(sqlite3_context*,const void*,
+ sqlite3_uint64,void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_double(sqlite3_context*, double);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_error(sqlite3_context*, const char*, int);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_error16(sqlite3_context*, const void*, int);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_error_toobig(sqlite3_context*);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_error_nomem(sqlite3_context*);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_error_code(sqlite3_context*, int);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_int(sqlite3_context*, int);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_int64(sqlite3_context*, sqlite3_int64);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_null(sqlite3_context*);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_text(sqlite3_context*, const char*, int, void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_text64(sqlite3_context*, const char*,sqlite3_uint64,
+ void(*)(void*), unsigned char encoding);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_text16(sqlite3_context*, const void*, int, void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_text16le(sqlite3_context*, const void*, int,void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_text16be(sqlite3_context*, const void*, int,void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_value(sqlite3_context*, sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_pointer(sqlite3_context*, void*,const char*,void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_zeroblob(sqlite3_context*, int n);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_result_zeroblob64(sqlite3_context*, sqlite3_uint64 n);
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Setting The Subtype Of An SQL Function
+** METHOD: sqlite3_context
+**
+** The sqlite3_result_subtype(C,T) function causes the subtype of
+** the result from the [application-defined SQL function] with
+** [sqlite3_context] C to be the value T. Only the lower 8 bits
+** of the subtype T are preserved in current versions of SQLite;
+** higher order bits are discarded.
+** The number of subtype bytes preserved by SQLite might increase
+** in future releases of SQLite.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_subtype(sqlite3_context*,unsigned int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Define New Collating Sequences
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^These functions add, remove, or modify a [collation] associated
+** with the [database connection] specified as the first argument.
+**
+** ^The name of the collation is a UTF-8 string
+** for sqlite3_create_collation() and sqlite3_create_collation_v2()
+** and a UTF-16 string in native byte order for sqlite3_create_collation16().
+** ^Collation names that compare equal according to [sqlite3_strnicmp()] are
+** considered to be the same name.
+**
+** ^(The third argument (eTextRep) must be one of the constants:
+**
+**
[SQLITE_UTF8],
+**
[SQLITE_UTF16LE],
+**
[SQLITE_UTF16BE],
+**
[SQLITE_UTF16], or
+**
[SQLITE_UTF16_ALIGNED].
+**
)^
+** ^The eTextRep argument determines the encoding of strings passed
+** to the collating function callback, xCompare.
+** ^The [SQLITE_UTF16] and [SQLITE_UTF16_ALIGNED] values for eTextRep
+** force strings to be UTF16 with native byte order.
+** ^The [SQLITE_UTF16_ALIGNED] value for eTextRep forces strings to begin
+** on an even byte address.
+**
+** ^The fourth argument, pArg, is an application data pointer that is passed
+** through as the first argument to the collating function callback.
+**
+** ^The fifth argument, xCompare, is a pointer to the collating function.
+** ^Multiple collating functions can be registered using the same name but
+** with different eTextRep parameters and SQLite will use whichever
+** function requires the least amount of data transformation.
+** ^If the xCompare argument is NULL then the collating function is
+** deleted. ^When all collating functions having the same name are deleted,
+** that collation is no longer usable.
+**
+** ^The collating function callback is invoked with a copy of the pArg
+** application data pointer and with two strings in the encoding specified
+** by the eTextRep argument. The two integer parameters to the collating
+** function callback are the length of the two strings, in bytes. The collating
+** function must return an integer that is negative, zero, or positive
+** if the first string is less than, equal to, or greater than the second,
+** respectively. A collating function must always return the same answer
+** given the same inputs. If two or more collating functions are registered
+** to the same collation name (using different eTextRep values) then all
+** must give an equivalent answer when invoked with equivalent strings.
+** The collating function must obey the following properties for all
+** strings A, B, and C:
+**
+**
+**
If A==B then B==A.
+**
If A==B and B==C then A==C.
+**
If A<B THEN B>A.
+**
If A<B and B<C then A<C.
+**
+**
+** If a collating function fails any of the above constraints and that
+** collating function is registered and used, then the behavior of SQLite
+** is undefined.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_create_collation_v2() works like sqlite3_create_collation()
+** with the addition that the xDestroy callback is invoked on pArg when
+** the collating function is deleted.
+** ^Collating functions are deleted when they are overridden by later
+** calls to the collation creation functions or when the
+** [database connection] is closed using [sqlite3_close()].
+**
+** ^The xDestroy callback is not called if the
+** sqlite3_create_collation_v2() function fails. Applications that invoke
+** sqlite3_create_collation_v2() with a non-NULL xDestroy argument should
+** check the return code and dispose of the application data pointer
+** themselves rather than expecting SQLite to deal with it for them.
+** This is different from every other SQLite interface. The inconsistency
+** is unfortunate but cannot be changed without breaking backwards
+** compatibility.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_collation_needed()] and [sqlite3_collation_needed16()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_collation(
+ sqlite3*,
+ const char *zName,
+ int eTextRep,
+ void *pArg,
+ int(*xCompare)(void*,int,const void*,int,const void*)
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_collation_v2(
+ sqlite3*,
+ const char *zName,
+ int eTextRep,
+ void *pArg,
+ int(*xCompare)(void*,int,const void*,int,const void*),
+ void(*xDestroy)(void*)
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_collation16(
+ sqlite3*,
+ const void *zName,
+ int eTextRep,
+ void *pArg,
+ int(*xCompare)(void*,int,const void*,int,const void*)
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Collation Needed Callbacks
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^To avoid having to register all collation sequences before a database
+** can be used, a single callback function may be registered with the
+** [database connection] to be invoked whenever an undefined collation
+** sequence is required.
+**
+** ^If the function is registered using the sqlite3_collation_needed() API,
+** then it is passed the names of undefined collation sequences as strings
+** encoded in UTF-8. ^If sqlite3_collation_needed16() is used,
+** the names are passed as UTF-16 in machine native byte order.
+** ^A call to either function replaces the existing collation-needed callback.
+**
+** ^(When the callback is invoked, the first argument passed is a copy
+** of the second argument to sqlite3_collation_needed() or
+** sqlite3_collation_needed16(). The second argument is the database
+** connection. The third argument is one of [SQLITE_UTF8], [SQLITE_UTF16BE],
+** or [SQLITE_UTF16LE], indicating the most desirable form of the collation
+** sequence function required. The fourth parameter is the name of the
+** required collation sequence.)^
+**
+** The callback function should register the desired collation using
+** [sqlite3_create_collation()], [sqlite3_create_collation16()], or
+** [sqlite3_create_collation_v2()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_collation_needed(
+ sqlite3*,
+ void*,
+ void(*)(void*,sqlite3*,int eTextRep,const char*)
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_collation_needed16(
+ sqlite3*,
+ void*,
+ void(*)(void*,sqlite3*,int eTextRep,const void*)
+);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_CEROD
+/*
+** Specify the activation key for a CEROD database. Unless
+** activated, none of the CEROD routines will work.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_activate_cerod(
+ const char *zPassPhrase /* Activation phrase */
+);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Suspend Execution For A Short Time
+**
+** The sqlite3_sleep() function causes the current thread to suspend execution
+** for at least a number of milliseconds specified in its parameter.
+**
+** If the operating system does not support sleep requests with
+** millisecond time resolution, then the time will be rounded up to
+** the nearest second. The number of milliseconds of sleep actually
+** requested from the operating system is returned.
+**
+** ^SQLite implements this interface by calling the xSleep()
+** method of the default [sqlite3_vfs] object. If the xSleep() method
+** of the default VFS is not implemented correctly, or not implemented at
+** all, then the behavior of sqlite3_sleep() may deviate from the description
+** in the previous paragraphs.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_sleep(int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Name Of The Folder Holding Temporary Files
+**
+** ^(If this global variable is made to point to a string which is
+** the name of a folder (a.k.a. directory), then all temporary files
+** created by SQLite when using a built-in [sqlite3_vfs | VFS]
+** will be placed in that directory.)^ ^If this variable
+** is a NULL pointer, then SQLite performs a search for an appropriate
+** temporary file directory.
+**
+** Applications are strongly discouraged from using this global variable.
+** It is required to set a temporary folder on Windows Runtime (WinRT).
+** But for all other platforms, it is highly recommended that applications
+** neither read nor write this variable. This global variable is a relic
+** that exists for backwards compatibility of legacy applications and should
+** be avoided in new projects.
+**
+** It is not safe to read or modify this variable in more than one
+** thread at a time. It is not safe to read or modify this variable
+** if a [database connection] is being used at the same time in a separate
+** thread.
+** It is intended that this variable be set once
+** as part of process initialization and before any SQLite interface
+** routines have been called and that this variable remain unchanged
+** thereafter.
+**
+** ^The [temp_store_directory pragma] may modify this variable and cause
+** it to point to memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc]. ^Furthermore,
+** the [temp_store_directory pragma] always assumes that any string
+** that this variable points to is held in memory obtained from
+** [sqlite3_malloc] and the pragma may attempt to free that memory
+** using [sqlite3_free].
+** Hence, if this variable is modified directly, either it should be
+** made NULL or made to point to memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc]
+** or else the use of the [temp_store_directory pragma] should be avoided.
+** Except when requested by the [temp_store_directory pragma], SQLite
+** does not free the memory that sqlite3_temp_directory points to. If
+** the application wants that memory to be freed, it must do
+** so itself, taking care to only do so after all [database connection]
+** objects have been destroyed.
+**
+** Note to Windows Runtime users: The temporary directory must be set
+** prior to calling [sqlite3_open] or [sqlite3_open_v2]. Otherwise, various
+** features that require the use of temporary files may fail. Here is an
+** example of how to do this using C++ with the Windows Runtime:
+**
+**
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_temp_directory;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Name Of The Folder Holding Database Files
+**
+** ^(If this global variable is made to point to a string which is
+** the name of a folder (a.k.a. directory), then all database files
+** specified with a relative pathname and created or accessed by
+** SQLite when using a built-in windows [sqlite3_vfs | VFS] will be assumed
+** to be relative to that directory.)^ ^If this variable is a NULL
+** pointer, then SQLite assumes that all database files specified
+** with a relative pathname are relative to the current directory
+** for the process. Only the windows VFS makes use of this global
+** variable; it is ignored by the unix VFS.
+**
+** Changing the value of this variable while a database connection is
+** open can result in a corrupt database.
+**
+** It is not safe to read or modify this variable in more than one
+** thread at a time. It is not safe to read or modify this variable
+** if a [database connection] is being used at the same time in a separate
+** thread.
+** It is intended that this variable be set once
+** as part of process initialization and before any SQLite interface
+** routines have been called and that this variable remain unchanged
+** thereafter.
+**
+** ^The [data_store_directory pragma] may modify this variable and cause
+** it to point to memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc]. ^Furthermore,
+** the [data_store_directory pragma] always assumes that any string
+** that this variable points to is held in memory obtained from
+** [sqlite3_malloc] and the pragma may attempt to free that memory
+** using [sqlite3_free].
+** Hence, if this variable is modified directly, either it should be
+** made NULL or made to point to memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc]
+** or else the use of the [data_store_directory pragma] should be avoided.
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_data_directory;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Win32 Specific Interface
+**
+** These interfaces are available only on Windows. The
+** [sqlite3_win32_set_directory] interface is used to set the value associated
+** with the [sqlite3_temp_directory] or [sqlite3_data_directory] variable, to
+** zValue, depending on the value of the type parameter. The zValue parameter
+** should be NULL to cause the previous value to be freed via [sqlite3_free];
+** a non-NULL value will be copied into memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc]
+** prior to being used. The [sqlite3_win32_set_directory] interface returns
+** [SQLITE_OK] to indicate success, [SQLITE_ERROR] if the type is unsupported,
+** or [SQLITE_NOMEM] if memory could not be allocated. The value of the
+** [sqlite3_data_directory] variable is intended to act as a replacement for
+** the current directory on the sub-platforms of Win32 where that concept is
+** not present, e.g. WinRT and UWP. The [sqlite3_win32_set_directory8] and
+** [sqlite3_win32_set_directory16] interfaces behave exactly the same as the
+** sqlite3_win32_set_directory interface except the string parameter must be
+** UTF-8 or UTF-16, respectively.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_win32_set_directory(
+ unsigned long type, /* Identifier for directory being set or reset */
+ void *zValue /* New value for directory being set or reset */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_win32_set_directory8(unsigned long type, const char *zValue);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_win32_set_directory16(unsigned long type, const void *zValue);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Win32 Directory Types
+**
+** These macros are only available on Windows. They define the allowed values
+** for the type argument to the [sqlite3_win32_set_directory] interface.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_WIN32_DATA_DIRECTORY_TYPE 1
+#define SQLITE_WIN32_TEMP_DIRECTORY_TYPE 2
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Test For Auto-Commit Mode
+** KEYWORDS: {autocommit mode}
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_get_autocommit() interface returns non-zero or
+** zero if the given database connection is or is not in autocommit mode,
+** respectively. ^Autocommit mode is on by default.
+** ^Autocommit mode is disabled by a [BEGIN] statement.
+** ^Autocommit mode is re-enabled by a [COMMIT] or [ROLLBACK].
+**
+** If certain kinds of errors occur on a statement within a multi-statement
+** transaction (errors including [SQLITE_FULL], [SQLITE_IOERR],
+** [SQLITE_NOMEM], [SQLITE_BUSY], and [SQLITE_INTERRUPT]) then the
+** transaction might be rolled back automatically. The only way to
+** find out whether SQLite automatically rolled back the transaction after
+** an error is to use this function.
+**
+** If another thread changes the autocommit status of the database
+** connection while this routine is running, then the return value
+** is undefined.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_get_autocommit(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Find The Database Handle Of A Prepared Statement
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_db_handle interface returns the [database connection] handle
+** to which a [prepared statement] belongs. ^The [database connection]
+** returned by sqlite3_db_handle is the same [database connection]
+** that was the first argument
+** to the [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] call (or its variants) that was used to
+** create the statement in the first place.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3 *sqlite3_db_handle(sqlite3_stmt*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Return The Filename For A Database Connection
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_db_filename(D,N) interface returns a pointer to the filename
+** associated with database N of connection D.
+** ^If there is no attached database N on the database
+** connection D, or if database N is a temporary or in-memory database, then
+** this function will return either a NULL pointer or an empty string.
+**
+** ^The string value returned by this routine is owned and managed by
+** the database connection. ^The value will be valid until the database N
+** is [DETACH]-ed or until the database connection closes.
+**
+** ^The filename returned by this function is the output of the
+** xFullPathname method of the [VFS]. ^In other words, the filename
+** will be an absolute pathname, even if the filename used
+** to open the database originally was a URI or relative pathname.
+**
+** If the filename pointer returned by this routine is not NULL, then it
+** can be used as the filename input parameter to these routines:
+**
+**
[sqlite3_uri_parameter()]
+**
[sqlite3_uri_boolean()]
+**
[sqlite3_uri_int64()]
+**
[sqlite3_filename_database()]
+**
[sqlite3_filename_journal()]
+**
[sqlite3_filename_wal()]
+**
+*/
+SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_db_filename(sqlite3 *db, const char *zDbName);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Determine if a database is read-only
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_db_readonly(D,N) interface returns 1 if the database N
+** of connection D is read-only, 0 if it is read/write, or -1 if N is not
+** the name of a database on connection D.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_db_readonly(sqlite3 *db, const char *zDbName);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Find the next prepared statement
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^This interface returns a pointer to the next [prepared statement] after
+** pStmt associated with the [database connection] pDb. ^If pStmt is NULL
+** then this interface returns a pointer to the first prepared statement
+** associated with the database connection pDb. ^If no prepared statement
+** satisfies the conditions of this routine, it returns NULL.
+**
+** The [database connection] pointer D in a call to
+** [sqlite3_next_stmt(D,S)] must refer to an open database
+** connection and in particular must not be a NULL pointer.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_stmt *sqlite3_next_stmt(sqlite3 *pDb, sqlite3_stmt *pStmt);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Commit And Rollback Notification Callbacks
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_commit_hook() interface registers a callback
+** function to be invoked whenever a transaction is [COMMIT | committed].
+** ^Any callback set by a previous call to sqlite3_commit_hook()
+** for the same database connection is overridden.
+** ^The sqlite3_rollback_hook() interface registers a callback
+** function to be invoked whenever a transaction is [ROLLBACK | rolled back].
+** ^Any callback set by a previous call to sqlite3_rollback_hook()
+** for the same database connection is overridden.
+** ^The pArg argument is passed through to the callback.
+** ^If the callback on a commit hook function returns non-zero,
+** then the commit is converted into a rollback.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_commit_hook(D,C,P) and sqlite3_rollback_hook(D,C,P) functions
+** return the P argument from the previous call of the same function
+** on the same [database connection] D, or NULL for
+** the first call for each function on D.
+**
+** The commit and rollback hook callbacks are not reentrant.
+** The callback implementation must not do anything that will modify
+** the database connection that invoked the callback. Any actions
+** to modify the database connection must be deferred until after the
+** completion of the [sqlite3_step()] call that triggered the commit
+** or rollback hook in the first place.
+** Note that running any other SQL statements, including SELECT statements,
+** or merely calling [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] and [sqlite3_step()] will modify
+** the database connections for the meaning of "modify" in this paragraph.
+**
+** ^Registering a NULL function disables the callback.
+**
+** ^When the commit hook callback routine returns zero, the [COMMIT]
+** operation is allowed to continue normally. ^If the commit hook
+** returns non-zero, then the [COMMIT] is converted into a [ROLLBACK].
+** ^The rollback hook is invoked on a rollback that results from a commit
+** hook returning non-zero, just as it would be with any other rollback.
+**
+** ^For the purposes of this API, a transaction is said to have been
+** rolled back if an explicit "ROLLBACK" statement is executed, or
+** an error or constraint causes an implicit rollback to occur.
+** ^The rollback callback is not invoked if a transaction is
+** automatically rolled back because the database connection is closed.
+**
+** See also the [sqlite3_update_hook()] interface.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_commit_hook(sqlite3*, int(*)(void*), void*);
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_rollback_hook(sqlite3*, void(*)(void *), void*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Data Change Notification Callbacks
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_update_hook() interface registers a callback function
+** with the [database connection] identified by the first argument
+** to be invoked whenever a row is updated, inserted or deleted in
+** a [rowid table].
+** ^Any callback set by a previous call to this function
+** for the same database connection is overridden.
+**
+** ^The second argument is a pointer to the function to invoke when a
+** row is updated, inserted or deleted in a rowid table.
+** ^The first argument to the callback is a copy of the third argument
+** to sqlite3_update_hook().
+** ^The second callback argument is one of [SQLITE_INSERT], [SQLITE_DELETE],
+** or [SQLITE_UPDATE], depending on the operation that caused the callback
+** to be invoked.
+** ^The third and fourth arguments to the callback contain pointers to the
+** database and table name containing the affected row.
+** ^The final callback parameter is the [rowid] of the row.
+** ^In the case of an update, this is the [rowid] after the update takes place.
+**
+** ^(The update hook is not invoked when internal system tables are
+** modified (i.e. sqlite_sequence).)^
+** ^The update hook is not invoked when [WITHOUT ROWID] tables are modified.
+**
+** ^In the current implementation, the update hook
+** is not invoked when conflicting rows are deleted because of an
+** [ON CONFLICT | ON CONFLICT REPLACE] clause. ^Nor is the update hook
+** invoked when rows are deleted using the [truncate optimization].
+** The exceptions defined in this paragraph might change in a future
+** release of SQLite.
+**
+** The update hook implementation must not do anything that will modify
+** the database connection that invoked the update hook. Any actions
+** to modify the database connection must be deferred until after the
+** completion of the [sqlite3_step()] call that triggered the update hook.
+** Note that [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] and [sqlite3_step()] both modify their
+** database connections for the meaning of "modify" in this paragraph.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_update_hook(D,C,P) function
+** returns the P argument from the previous call
+** on the same [database connection] D, or NULL for
+** the first call on D.
+**
+** See also the [sqlite3_commit_hook()], [sqlite3_rollback_hook()],
+** and [sqlite3_preupdate_hook()] interfaces.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_update_hook(
+ sqlite3*,
+ void(*)(void *,int ,char const *,char const *,sqlite3_int64),
+ void*
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Enable Or Disable Shared Pager Cache
+**
+** ^(This routine enables or disables the sharing of the database cache
+** and schema data structures between [database connection | connections]
+** to the same database. Sharing is enabled if the argument is true
+** and disabled if the argument is false.)^
+**
+** ^Cache sharing is enabled and disabled for an entire process.
+** This is a change as of SQLite [version 3.5.0] ([dateof:3.5.0]).
+** In prior versions of SQLite,
+** sharing was enabled or disabled for each thread separately.
+**
+** ^(The cache sharing mode set by this interface effects all subsequent
+** calls to [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open_v2()], and [sqlite3_open16()].
+** Existing database connections continue to use the sharing mode
+** that was in effect at the time they were opened.)^
+**
+** ^(This routine returns [SQLITE_OK] if shared cache was enabled or disabled
+** successfully. An [error code] is returned otherwise.)^
+**
+** ^Shared cache is disabled by default. It is recommended that it stay
+** that way. In other words, do not use this routine. This interface
+** continues to be provided for historical compatibility, but its use is
+** discouraged. Any use of shared cache is discouraged. If shared cache
+** must be used, it is recommended that shared cache only be enabled for
+** individual database connections using the [sqlite3_open_v2()] interface
+** with the [SQLITE_OPEN_SHAREDCACHE] flag.
+**
+** Note: This method is disabled on MacOS X 10.7 and iOS version 5.0
+** and will always return SQLITE_MISUSE. On those systems,
+** shared cache mode should be enabled per-database connection via
+** [sqlite3_open_v2()] with [SQLITE_OPEN_SHAREDCACHE].
+**
+** This interface is threadsafe on processors where writing a
+** 32-bit integer is atomic.
+**
+** See Also: [SQLite Shared-Cache Mode]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_enable_shared_cache(int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Attempt To Free Heap Memory
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_release_memory() interface attempts to free N bytes
+** of heap memory by deallocating non-essential memory allocations
+** held by the database library. Memory used to cache database
+** pages to improve performance is an example of non-essential memory.
+** ^sqlite3_release_memory() returns the number of bytes actually freed,
+** which might be more or less than the amount requested.
+** ^The sqlite3_release_memory() routine is a no-op returning zero
+** if SQLite is not compiled with [SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT].
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_db_release_memory()]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_release_memory(int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Free Memory Used By A Database Connection
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_db_release_memory(D) interface attempts to free as much heap
+** memory as possible from database connection D. Unlike the
+** [sqlite3_release_memory()] interface, this interface is in effect even
+** when the [SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT] compile-time option is
+** omitted.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_release_memory()]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_db_release_memory(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Impose A Limit On Heap Size
+**
+** These interfaces impose limits on the amount of heap memory that will be
+** by all database connections within a single process.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64() interface sets and/or queries the
+** soft limit on the amount of heap memory that may be allocated by SQLite.
+** ^SQLite strives to keep heap memory utilization below the soft heap
+** limit by reducing the number of pages held in the page cache
+** as heap memory usages approaches the limit.
+** ^The soft heap limit is "soft" because even though SQLite strives to stay
+** below the limit, it will exceed the limit rather than generate
+** an [SQLITE_NOMEM] error. In other words, the soft heap limit
+** is advisory only.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_hard_heap_limit64(N) interface sets a hard upper bound of
+** N bytes on the amount of memory that will be allocated. ^The
+** sqlite3_hard_heap_limit64(N) interface is similar to
+** sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64(N) except that memory allocations will fail
+** when the hard heap limit is reached.
+**
+** ^The return value from both sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64() and
+** sqlite3_hard_heap_limit64() is the size of
+** the heap limit prior to the call, or negative in the case of an
+** error. ^If the argument N is negative
+** then no change is made to the heap limit. Hence, the current
+** size of heap limits can be determined by invoking
+** sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64(-1) or sqlite3_hard_heap_limit(-1).
+**
+** ^Setting the heap limits to zero disables the heap limiter mechanism.
+**
+** ^The soft heap limit may not be greater than the hard heap limit.
+** ^If the hard heap limit is enabled and if sqlite3_soft_heap_limit(N)
+** is invoked with a value of N that is greater than the hard heap limit,
+** the the soft heap limit is set to the value of the hard heap limit.
+** ^The soft heap limit is automatically enabled whenever the hard heap
+** limit is enabled. ^When sqlite3_hard_heap_limit64(N) is invoked and
+** the soft heap limit is outside the range of 1..N, then the soft heap
+** limit is set to N. ^Invoking sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64(0) when the
+** hard heap limit is enabled makes the soft heap limit equal to the
+** hard heap limit.
+**
+** The memory allocation limits can also be adjusted using
+** [PRAGMA soft_heap_limit] and [PRAGMA hard_heap_limit].
+**
+** ^(The heap limits are not enforced in the current implementation
+** if one or more of following conditions are true:
+**
+**
+**
The limit value is set to zero.
+**
Memory accounting is disabled using a combination of the
+** [sqlite3_config]([SQLITE_CONFIG_MEMSTATUS],...) start-time option and
+** the [SQLITE_DEFAULT_MEMSTATUS] compile-time option.
+**
An alternative page cache implementation is specified using
+** [sqlite3_config]([SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE2],...).
+**
The page cache allocates from its own memory pool supplied
+** by [sqlite3_config]([SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE],...) rather than
+** from the heap.
+**
)^
+**
+** The circumstances under which SQLite will enforce the heap limits may
+** changes in future releases of SQLite.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64(sqlite3_int64 N);
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_hard_heap_limit64(sqlite3_int64 N);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Deprecated Soft Heap Limit Interface
+** DEPRECATED
+**
+** This is a deprecated version of the [sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64()]
+** interface. This routine is provided for historical compatibility
+** only. All new applications should use the
+** [sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64()] interface rather than this one.
+*/
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_DEPRECATED void sqlite3_soft_heap_limit(int N);
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Extract Metadata About A Column Of A Table
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^(The sqlite3_table_column_metadata(X,D,T,C,....) routine returns
+** information about column C of table T in database D
+** on [database connection] X.)^ ^The sqlite3_table_column_metadata()
+** interface returns SQLITE_OK and fills in the non-NULL pointers in
+** the final five arguments with appropriate values if the specified
+** column exists. ^The sqlite3_table_column_metadata() interface returns
+** SQLITE_ERROR if the specified column does not exist.
+** ^If the column-name parameter to sqlite3_table_column_metadata() is a
+** NULL pointer, then this routine simply checks for the existence of the
+** table and returns SQLITE_OK if the table exists and SQLITE_ERROR if it
+** does not. If the table name parameter T in a call to
+** sqlite3_table_column_metadata(X,D,T,C,...) is NULL then the result is
+** undefined behavior.
+**
+** ^The column is identified by the second, third and fourth parameters to
+** this function. ^(The second parameter is either the name of the database
+** (i.e. "main", "temp", or an attached database) containing the specified
+** table or NULL.)^ ^If it is NULL, then all attached databases are searched
+** for the table using the same algorithm used by the database engine to
+** resolve unqualified table references.
+**
+** ^The third and fourth parameters to this function are the table and column
+** name of the desired column, respectively.
+**
+** ^Metadata is returned by writing to the memory locations passed as the 5th
+** and subsequent parameters to this function. ^Any of these arguments may be
+** NULL, in which case the corresponding element of metadata is omitted.
+**
+** ^(
+**
+**
Parameter
Output Type
Description
+**
+**
5th
const char*
Data type
+**
6th
const char*
Name of default collation sequence
+**
7th
int
True if column has a NOT NULL constraint
+**
8th
int
True if column is part of the PRIMARY KEY
+**
9th
int
True if column is [AUTOINCREMENT]
+**
+**
)^
+**
+** ^The memory pointed to by the character pointers returned for the
+** declaration type and collation sequence is valid until the next
+** call to any SQLite API function.
+**
+** ^If the specified table is actually a view, an [error code] is returned.
+**
+** ^If the specified column is "rowid", "oid" or "_rowid_" and the table
+** is not a [WITHOUT ROWID] table and an
+** [INTEGER PRIMARY KEY] column has been explicitly declared, then the output
+** parameters are set for the explicitly declared column. ^(If there is no
+** [INTEGER PRIMARY KEY] column, then the outputs
+** for the [rowid] are set as follows:
+**
+**
+** data type: "INTEGER"
+** collation sequence: "BINARY"
+** not null: 0
+** primary key: 1
+** auto increment: 0
+**
)^
+**
+** ^This function causes all database schemas to be read from disk and
+** parsed, if that has not already been done, and returns an error if
+** any errors are encountered while loading the schema.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_table_column_metadata(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Connection handle */
+ const char *zDbName, /* Database name or NULL */
+ const char *zTableName, /* Table name */
+ const char *zColumnName, /* Column name */
+ char const **pzDataType, /* OUTPUT: Declared data type */
+ char const **pzCollSeq, /* OUTPUT: Collation sequence name */
+ int *pNotNull, /* OUTPUT: True if NOT NULL constraint exists */
+ int *pPrimaryKey, /* OUTPUT: True if column part of PK */
+ int *pAutoinc /* OUTPUT: True if column is auto-increment */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Load An Extension
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^This interface loads an SQLite extension library from the named file.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_load_extension() interface attempts to load an
+** [SQLite extension] library contained in the file zFile. If
+** the file cannot be loaded directly, attempts are made to load
+** with various operating-system specific extensions added.
+** So for example, if "samplelib" cannot be loaded, then names like
+** "samplelib.so" or "samplelib.dylib" or "samplelib.dll" might
+** be tried also.
+**
+** ^The entry point is zProc.
+** ^(zProc may be 0, in which case SQLite will try to come up with an
+** entry point name on its own. It first tries "sqlite3_extension_init".
+** If that does not work, it constructs a name "sqlite3_X_init" where the
+** X is consists of the lower-case equivalent of all ASCII alphabetic
+** characters in the filename from the last "/" to the first following
+** "." and omitting any initial "lib".)^
+** ^The sqlite3_load_extension() interface returns
+** [SQLITE_OK] on success and [SQLITE_ERROR] if something goes wrong.
+** ^If an error occurs and pzErrMsg is not 0, then the
+** [sqlite3_load_extension()] interface shall attempt to
+** fill *pzErrMsg with error message text stored in memory
+** obtained from [sqlite3_malloc()]. The calling function
+** should free this memory by calling [sqlite3_free()].
+**
+** ^Extension loading must be enabled using
+** [sqlite3_enable_load_extension()] or
+** [sqlite3_db_config](db,[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_LOAD_EXTENSION],1,NULL)
+** prior to calling this API,
+** otherwise an error will be returned.
+**
+** Security warning: It is recommended that the
+** [SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_LOAD_EXTENSION] method be used to enable only this
+** interface. The use of the [sqlite3_enable_load_extension()] interface
+** should be avoided. This will keep the SQL function [load_extension()]
+** disabled and prevent SQL injections from giving attackers
+** access to extension loading capabilities.
+**
+** See also the [load_extension() SQL function].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_load_extension(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Load the extension into this database connection */
+ const char *zFile, /* Name of the shared library containing extension */
+ const char *zProc, /* Entry point. Derived from zFile if 0 */
+ char **pzErrMsg /* Put error message here if not 0 */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Enable Or Disable Extension Loading
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^So as not to open security holes in older applications that are
+** unprepared to deal with [extension loading], and as a means of disabling
+** [extension loading] while evaluating user-entered SQL, the following API
+** is provided to turn the [sqlite3_load_extension()] mechanism on and off.
+**
+** ^Extension loading is off by default.
+** ^Call the sqlite3_enable_load_extension() routine with onoff==1
+** to turn extension loading on and call it with onoff==0 to turn
+** it back off again.
+**
+** ^This interface enables or disables both the C-API
+** [sqlite3_load_extension()] and the SQL function [load_extension()].
+** ^(Use [sqlite3_db_config](db,[SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_LOAD_EXTENSION],..)
+** to enable or disable only the C-API.)^
+**
+** Security warning: It is recommended that extension loading
+** be enabled using the [SQLITE_DBCONFIG_ENABLE_LOAD_EXTENSION] method
+** rather than this interface, so the [load_extension()] SQL function
+** remains disabled. This will prevent SQL injections from giving attackers
+** access to extension loading capabilities.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_enable_load_extension(sqlite3 *db, int onoff);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Automatically Load Statically Linked Extensions
+**
+** ^This interface causes the xEntryPoint() function to be invoked for
+** each new [database connection] that is created. The idea here is that
+** xEntryPoint() is the entry point for a statically linked [SQLite extension]
+** that is to be automatically loaded into all new database connections.
+**
+** ^(Even though the function prototype shows that xEntryPoint() takes
+** no arguments and returns void, SQLite invokes xEntryPoint() with three
+** arguments and expects an integer result as if the signature of the
+** entry point where as follows:
+**
+**
)^
+**
+** If the xEntryPoint routine encounters an error, it should make *pzErrMsg
+** point to an appropriate error message (obtained from [sqlite3_mprintf()])
+** and return an appropriate [error code]. ^SQLite ensures that *pzErrMsg
+** is NULL before calling the xEntryPoint(). ^SQLite will invoke
+** [sqlite3_free()] on *pzErrMsg after xEntryPoint() returns. ^If any
+** xEntryPoint() returns an error, the [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open16()],
+** or [sqlite3_open_v2()] call that provoked the xEntryPoint() will fail.
+**
+** ^Calling sqlite3_auto_extension(X) with an entry point X that is already
+** on the list of automatic extensions is a harmless no-op. ^No entry point
+** will be called more than once for each database connection that is opened.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_reset_auto_extension()]
+** and [sqlite3_cancel_auto_extension()]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_auto_extension(void(*xEntryPoint)(void));
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Cancel Automatic Extension Loading
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_cancel_auto_extension(X)] interface unregisters the
+** initialization routine X that was registered using a prior call to
+** [sqlite3_auto_extension(X)]. ^The [sqlite3_cancel_auto_extension(X)]
+** routine returns 1 if initialization routine X was successfully
+** unregistered and it returns 0 if X was not on the list of initialization
+** routines.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_cancel_auto_extension(void(*xEntryPoint)(void));
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Reset Automatic Extension Loading
+**
+** ^This interface disables all automatic extensions previously
+** registered using [sqlite3_auto_extension()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_reset_auto_extension(void);
+
+/*
+** The interface to the virtual-table mechanism is currently considered
+** to be experimental. The interface might change in incompatible ways.
+** If this is a problem for you, do not use the interface at this time.
+**
+** When the virtual-table mechanism stabilizes, we will declare the
+** interface fixed, support it indefinitely, and remove this comment.
+*/
+
+/*
+** Structures used by the virtual table interface
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_vtab sqlite3_vtab;
+typedef struct sqlite3_index_info sqlite3_index_info;
+typedef struct sqlite3_vtab_cursor sqlite3_vtab_cursor;
+typedef struct sqlite3_module sqlite3_module;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Virtual Table Object
+** KEYWORDS: sqlite3_module {virtual table module}
+**
+** This structure, sometimes called a "virtual table module",
+** defines the implementation of a [virtual table].
+** This structure consists mostly of methods for the module.
+**
+** ^A virtual table module is created by filling in a persistent
+** instance of this structure and passing a pointer to that instance
+** to [sqlite3_create_module()] or [sqlite3_create_module_v2()].
+** ^The registration remains valid until it is replaced by a different
+** module or until the [database connection] closes. The content
+** of this structure must not change while it is registered with
+** any database connection.
+*/
+struct sqlite3_module {
+ int iVersion;
+ int (*xCreate)(sqlite3*, void *pAux,
+ int argc, const char *const*argv,
+ sqlite3_vtab **ppVTab, char**);
+ int (*xConnect)(sqlite3*, void *pAux,
+ int argc, const char *const*argv,
+ sqlite3_vtab **ppVTab, char**);
+ int (*xBestIndex)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab, sqlite3_index_info*);
+ int (*xDisconnect)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab);
+ int (*xDestroy)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab);
+ int (*xOpen)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab, sqlite3_vtab_cursor **ppCursor);
+ int (*xClose)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*);
+ int (*xFilter)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*, int idxNum, const char *idxStr,
+ int argc, sqlite3_value **argv);
+ int (*xNext)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*);
+ int (*xEof)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*);
+ int (*xColumn)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*, sqlite3_context*, int);
+ int (*xRowid)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*, sqlite3_int64 *pRowid);
+ int (*xUpdate)(sqlite3_vtab *, int, sqlite3_value **, sqlite3_int64 *);
+ int (*xBegin)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab);
+ int (*xSync)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab);
+ int (*xCommit)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab);
+ int (*xRollback)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab);
+ int (*xFindFunction)(sqlite3_vtab *pVtab, int nArg, const char *zName,
+ void (**pxFunc)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**),
+ void **ppArg);
+ int (*xRename)(sqlite3_vtab *pVtab, const char *zNew);
+ /* The methods above are in version 1 of the sqlite_module object. Those
+ ** below are for version 2 and greater. */
+ int (*xSavepoint)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab, int);
+ int (*xRelease)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab, int);
+ int (*xRollbackTo)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab, int);
+ /* The methods above are in versions 1 and 2 of the sqlite_module object.
+ ** Those below are for version 3 and greater. */
+ int (*xShadowName)(const char*);
+};
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Virtual Table Indexing Information
+** KEYWORDS: sqlite3_index_info
+**
+** The sqlite3_index_info structure and its substructures is used as part
+** of the [virtual table] interface to
+** pass information into and receive the reply from the [xBestIndex]
+** method of a [virtual table module]. The fields under **Inputs** are the
+** inputs to xBestIndex and are read-only. xBestIndex inserts its
+** results into the **Outputs** fields.
+**
+** ^(The aConstraint[] array records WHERE clause constraints of the form:
+**
+**
column OP expr
+**
+** where OP is =, <, <=, >, or >=.)^ ^(The particular operator is
+** stored in aConstraint[].op using one of the
+** [SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_EQ | SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_ values].)^
+** ^(The index of the column is stored in
+** aConstraint[].iColumn.)^ ^(aConstraint[].usable is TRUE if the
+** expr on the right-hand side can be evaluated (and thus the constraint
+** is usable) and false if it cannot.)^
+**
+** ^The optimizer automatically inverts terms of the form "expr OP column"
+** and makes other simplifications to the WHERE clause in an attempt to
+** get as many WHERE clause terms into the form shown above as possible.
+** ^The aConstraint[] array only reports WHERE clause terms that are
+** relevant to the particular virtual table being queried.
+**
+** ^Information about the ORDER BY clause is stored in aOrderBy[].
+** ^Each term of aOrderBy records a column of the ORDER BY clause.
+**
+** The colUsed field indicates which columns of the virtual table may be
+** required by the current scan. Virtual table columns are numbered from
+** zero in the order in which they appear within the CREATE TABLE statement
+** passed to sqlite3_declare_vtab(). For the first 63 columns (columns 0-62),
+** the corresponding bit is set within the colUsed mask if the column may be
+** required by SQLite. If the table has at least 64 columns and any column
+** to the right of the first 63 is required, then bit 63 of colUsed is also
+** set. In other words, column iCol may be required if the expression
+** (colUsed & ((sqlite3_uint64)1 << (iCol>=63 ? 63 : iCol))) evaluates to
+** non-zero.
+**
+** The [xBestIndex] method must fill aConstraintUsage[] with information
+** about what parameters to pass to xFilter. ^If argvIndex>0 then
+** the right-hand side of the corresponding aConstraint[] is evaluated
+** and becomes the argvIndex-th entry in argv. ^(If aConstraintUsage[].omit
+** is true, then the constraint is assumed to be fully handled by the
+** virtual table and might not be checked again by the byte code.)^ ^(The
+** aConstraintUsage[].omit flag is an optimization hint. When the omit flag
+** is left in its default setting of false, the constraint will always be
+** checked separately in byte code. If the omit flag is change to true, then
+** the constraint may or may not be checked in byte code. In other words,
+** when the omit flag is true there is no guarantee that the constraint will
+** not be checked again using byte code.)^
+**
+** ^The idxNum and idxPtr values are recorded and passed into the
+** [xFilter] method.
+** ^[sqlite3_free()] is used to free idxPtr if and only if
+** needToFreeIdxPtr is true.
+**
+** ^The orderByConsumed means that output from [xFilter]/[xNext] will occur in
+** the correct order to satisfy the ORDER BY clause so that no separate
+** sorting step is required.
+**
+** ^The estimatedCost value is an estimate of the cost of a particular
+** strategy. A cost of N indicates that the cost of the strategy is similar
+** to a linear scan of an SQLite table with N rows. A cost of log(N)
+** indicates that the expense of the operation is similar to that of a
+** binary search on a unique indexed field of an SQLite table with N rows.
+**
+** ^The estimatedRows value is an estimate of the number of rows that
+** will be returned by the strategy.
+**
+** The xBestIndex method may optionally populate the idxFlags field with a
+** mask of SQLITE_INDEX_SCAN_* flags. Currently there is only one such flag -
+** SQLITE_INDEX_SCAN_UNIQUE. If the xBestIndex method sets this flag, SQLite
+** assumes that the strategy may visit at most one row.
+**
+** Additionally, if xBestIndex sets the SQLITE_INDEX_SCAN_UNIQUE flag, then
+** SQLite also assumes that if a call to the xUpdate() method is made as
+** part of the same statement to delete or update a virtual table row and the
+** implementation returns SQLITE_CONSTRAINT, then there is no need to rollback
+** any database changes. In other words, if the xUpdate() returns
+** SQLITE_CONSTRAINT, the database contents must be exactly as they were
+** before xUpdate was called. By contrast, if SQLITE_INDEX_SCAN_UNIQUE is not
+** set and xUpdate returns SQLITE_CONSTRAINT, any database changes made by
+** the xUpdate method are automatically rolled back by SQLite.
+**
+** IMPORTANT: The estimatedRows field was added to the sqlite3_index_info
+** structure for SQLite [version 3.8.2] ([dateof:3.8.2]).
+** If a virtual table extension is
+** used with an SQLite version earlier than 3.8.2, the results of attempting
+** to read or write the estimatedRows field are undefined (but are likely
+** to include crashing the application). The estimatedRows field should
+** therefore only be used if [sqlite3_libversion_number()] returns a
+** value greater than or equal to 3008002. Similarly, the idxFlags field
+** was added for [version 3.9.0] ([dateof:3.9.0]).
+** It may therefore only be used if
+** sqlite3_libversion_number() returns a value greater than or equal to
+** 3009000.
+*/
+struct sqlite3_index_info {
+ /* Inputs */
+ int nConstraint; /* Number of entries in aConstraint */
+ struct sqlite3_index_constraint {
+ int iColumn; /* Column constrained. -1 for ROWID */
+ unsigned char op; /* Constraint operator */
+ unsigned char usable; /* True if this constraint is usable */
+ int iTermOffset; /* Used internally - xBestIndex should ignore */
+ } *aConstraint; /* Table of WHERE clause constraints */
+ int nOrderBy; /* Number of terms in the ORDER BY clause */
+ struct sqlite3_index_orderby {
+ int iColumn; /* Column number */
+ unsigned char desc; /* True for DESC. False for ASC. */
+ } *aOrderBy; /* The ORDER BY clause */
+ /* Outputs */
+ struct sqlite3_index_constraint_usage {
+ int argvIndex; /* if >0, constraint is part of argv to xFilter */
+ unsigned char omit; /* Do not code a test for this constraint */
+ } *aConstraintUsage;
+ int idxNum; /* Number used to identify the index */
+ char *idxStr; /* String, possibly obtained from sqlite3_malloc */
+ int needToFreeIdxStr; /* Free idxStr using sqlite3_free() if true */
+ int orderByConsumed; /* True if output is already ordered */
+ double estimatedCost; /* Estimated cost of using this index */
+ /* Fields below are only available in SQLite 3.8.2 and later */
+ sqlite3_int64 estimatedRows; /* Estimated number of rows returned */
+ /* Fields below are only available in SQLite 3.9.0 and later */
+ int idxFlags; /* Mask of SQLITE_INDEX_SCAN_* flags */
+ /* Fields below are only available in SQLite 3.10.0 and later */
+ sqlite3_uint64 colUsed; /* Input: Mask of columns used by statement */
+};
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Virtual Table Scan Flags
+**
+** Virtual table implementations are allowed to set the
+** [sqlite3_index_info].idxFlags field to some combination of
+** these bits.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_SCAN_UNIQUE 1 /* Scan visits at most 1 row */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Virtual Table Constraint Operator Codes
+**
+** These macros define the allowed values for the
+** [sqlite3_index_info].aConstraint[].op field. Each value represents
+** an operator that is part of a constraint term in the wHERE clause of
+** a query that uses a [virtual table].
+*/
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_EQ 2
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_GT 4
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_LE 8
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_LT 16
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_GE 32
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_MATCH 64
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_LIKE 65
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_GLOB 66
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_REGEXP 67
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_NE 68
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_ISNOT 69
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_ISNOTNULL 70
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_ISNULL 71
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_IS 72
+#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_FUNCTION 150
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Register A Virtual Table Implementation
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^These routines are used to register a new [virtual table module] name.
+** ^Module names must be registered before
+** creating a new [virtual table] using the module and before using a
+** preexisting [virtual table] for the module.
+**
+** ^The module name is registered on the [database connection] specified
+** by the first parameter. ^The name of the module is given by the
+** second parameter. ^The third parameter is a pointer to
+** the implementation of the [virtual table module]. ^The fourth
+** parameter is an arbitrary client data pointer that is passed through
+** into the [xCreate] and [xConnect] methods of the virtual table module
+** when a new virtual table is be being created or reinitialized.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_create_module_v2() interface has a fifth parameter which
+** is a pointer to a destructor for the pClientData. ^SQLite will
+** invoke the destructor function (if it is not NULL) when SQLite
+** no longer needs the pClientData pointer. ^The destructor will also
+** be invoked if the call to sqlite3_create_module_v2() fails.
+** ^The sqlite3_create_module()
+** interface is equivalent to sqlite3_create_module_v2() with a NULL
+** destructor.
+**
+** ^If the third parameter (the pointer to the sqlite3_module object) is
+** NULL then no new module is create and any existing modules with the
+** same name are dropped.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_drop_modules()]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_module(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* SQLite connection to register module with */
+ const char *zName, /* Name of the module */
+ const sqlite3_module *p, /* Methods for the module */
+ void *pClientData /* Client data for xCreate/xConnect */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_module_v2(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* SQLite connection to register module with */
+ const char *zName, /* Name of the module */
+ const sqlite3_module *p, /* Methods for the module */
+ void *pClientData, /* Client data for xCreate/xConnect */
+ void(*xDestroy)(void*) /* Module destructor function */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Remove Unnecessary Virtual Table Implementations
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_drop_modules(D,L) interface removes all virtual
+** table modules from database connection D except those named on list L.
+** The L parameter must be either NULL or a pointer to an array of pointers
+** to strings where the array is terminated by a single NULL pointer.
+** ^If the L parameter is NULL, then all virtual table modules are removed.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_create_module()]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_drop_modules(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Remove modules from this connection */
+ const char **azKeep /* Except, do not remove the ones named here */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Virtual Table Instance Object
+** KEYWORDS: sqlite3_vtab
+**
+** Every [virtual table module] implementation uses a subclass
+** of this object to describe a particular instance
+** of the [virtual table]. Each subclass will
+** be tailored to the specific needs of the module implementation.
+** The purpose of this superclass is to define certain fields that are
+** common to all module implementations.
+**
+** ^Virtual tables methods can set an error message by assigning a
+** string obtained from [sqlite3_mprintf()] to zErrMsg. The method should
+** take care that any prior string is freed by a call to [sqlite3_free()]
+** prior to assigning a new string to zErrMsg. ^After the error message
+** is delivered up to the client application, the string will be automatically
+** freed by sqlite3_free() and the zErrMsg field will be zeroed.
+*/
+struct sqlite3_vtab {
+ const sqlite3_module *pModule; /* The module for this virtual table */
+ int nRef; /* Number of open cursors */
+ char *zErrMsg; /* Error message from sqlite3_mprintf() */
+ /* Virtual table implementations will typically add additional fields */
+};
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Virtual Table Cursor Object
+** KEYWORDS: sqlite3_vtab_cursor {virtual table cursor}
+**
+** Every [virtual table module] implementation uses a subclass of the
+** following structure to describe cursors that point into the
+** [virtual table] and are used
+** to loop through the virtual table. Cursors are created using the
+** [sqlite3_module.xOpen | xOpen] method of the module and are destroyed
+** by the [sqlite3_module.xClose | xClose] method. Cursors are used
+** by the [xFilter], [xNext], [xEof], [xColumn], and [xRowid] methods
+** of the module. Each module implementation will define
+** the content of a cursor structure to suit its own needs.
+**
+** This superclass exists in order to define fields of the cursor that
+** are common to all implementations.
+*/
+struct sqlite3_vtab_cursor {
+ sqlite3_vtab *pVtab; /* Virtual table of this cursor */
+ /* Virtual table implementations will typically add additional fields */
+};
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Declare The Schema Of A Virtual Table
+**
+** ^The [xCreate] and [xConnect] methods of a
+** [virtual table module] call this interface
+** to declare the format (the names and datatypes of the columns) of
+** the virtual tables they implement.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_declare_vtab(sqlite3*, const char *zSQL);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Overload A Function For A Virtual Table
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^(Virtual tables can provide alternative implementations of functions
+** using the [xFindFunction] method of the [virtual table module].
+** But global versions of those functions
+** must exist in order to be overloaded.)^
+**
+** ^(This API makes sure a global version of a function with a particular
+** name and number of parameters exists. If no such function exists
+** before this API is called, a new function is created.)^ ^The implementation
+** of the new function always causes an exception to be thrown. So
+** the new function is not good for anything by itself. Its only
+** purpose is to be a placeholder function that can be overloaded
+** by a [virtual table].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_overload_function(sqlite3*, const char *zFuncName, int nArg);
+
+/*
+** The interface to the virtual-table mechanism defined above (back up
+** to a comment remarkably similar to this one) is currently considered
+** to be experimental. The interface might change in incompatible ways.
+** If this is a problem for you, do not use the interface at this time.
+**
+** When the virtual-table mechanism stabilizes, we will declare the
+** interface fixed, support it indefinitely, and remove this comment.
+*/
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: A Handle To An Open BLOB
+** KEYWORDS: {BLOB handle} {BLOB handles}
+**
+** An instance of this object represents an open BLOB on which
+** [sqlite3_blob_open | incremental BLOB I/O] can be performed.
+** ^Objects of this type are created by [sqlite3_blob_open()]
+** and destroyed by [sqlite3_blob_close()].
+** ^The [sqlite3_blob_read()] and [sqlite3_blob_write()] interfaces
+** can be used to read or write small subsections of the BLOB.
+** ^The [sqlite3_blob_bytes()] interface returns the size of the BLOB in bytes.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_blob sqlite3_blob;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Open A BLOB For Incremental I/O
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+** CONSTRUCTOR: sqlite3_blob
+**
+** ^(This interfaces opens a [BLOB handle | handle] to the BLOB located
+** in row iRow, column zColumn, table zTable in database zDb;
+** in other words, the same BLOB that would be selected by:
+**
+**
+** SELECT zColumn FROM zDb.zTable WHERE [rowid] = iRow;
+**
)^
+**
+** ^(Parameter zDb is not the filename that contains the database, but
+** rather the symbolic name of the database. For attached databases, this is
+** the name that appears after the AS keyword in the [ATTACH] statement.
+** For the main database file, the database name is "main". For TEMP
+** tables, the database name is "temp".)^
+**
+** ^If the flags parameter is non-zero, then the BLOB is opened for read
+** and write access. ^If the flags parameter is zero, the BLOB is opened for
+** read-only access.
+**
+** ^(On success, [SQLITE_OK] is returned and the new [BLOB handle] is stored
+** in *ppBlob. Otherwise an [error code] is returned and, unless the error
+** code is SQLITE_MISUSE, *ppBlob is set to NULL.)^ ^This means that, provided
+** the API is not misused, it is always safe to call [sqlite3_blob_close()]
+** on *ppBlob after this function it returns.
+**
+** This function fails with SQLITE_ERROR if any of the following are true:
+**
+**
^(Database zDb does not exist)^,
+**
^(Table zTable does not exist within database zDb)^,
+**
^(Table zTable is a WITHOUT ROWID table)^,
+**
^(Column zColumn does not exist)^,
+**
^(Row iRow is not present in the table)^,
+**
^(The specified column of row iRow contains a value that is not
+** a TEXT or BLOB value)^,
+**
^(Column zColumn is part of an index, PRIMARY KEY or UNIQUE
+** constraint and the blob is being opened for read/write access)^,
+**
^([foreign key constraints | Foreign key constraints] are enabled,
+** column zColumn is part of a [child key] definition and the blob is
+** being opened for read/write access)^.
+**
+**
+** ^Unless it returns SQLITE_MISUSE, this function sets the
+** [database connection] error code and message accessible via
+** [sqlite3_errcode()] and [sqlite3_errmsg()] and related functions.
+**
+** A BLOB referenced by sqlite3_blob_open() may be read using the
+** [sqlite3_blob_read()] interface and modified by using
+** [sqlite3_blob_write()]. The [BLOB handle] can be moved to a
+** different row of the same table using the [sqlite3_blob_reopen()]
+** interface. However, the column, table, or database of a [BLOB handle]
+** cannot be changed after the [BLOB handle] is opened.
+**
+** ^(If the row that a BLOB handle points to is modified by an
+** [UPDATE], [DELETE], or by [ON CONFLICT] side-effects
+** then the BLOB handle is marked as "expired".
+** This is true if any column of the row is changed, even a column
+** other than the one the BLOB handle is open on.)^
+** ^Calls to [sqlite3_blob_read()] and [sqlite3_blob_write()] for
+** an expired BLOB handle fail with a return code of [SQLITE_ABORT].
+** ^(Changes written into a BLOB prior to the BLOB expiring are not
+** rolled back by the expiration of the BLOB. Such changes will eventually
+** commit if the transaction continues to completion.)^
+**
+** ^Use the [sqlite3_blob_bytes()] interface to determine the size of
+** the opened blob. ^The size of a blob may not be changed by this
+** interface. Use the [UPDATE] SQL command to change the size of a
+** blob.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_bind_zeroblob()] and [sqlite3_result_zeroblob()] interfaces
+** and the built-in [zeroblob] SQL function may be used to create a
+** zero-filled blob to read or write using the incremental-blob interface.
+**
+** To avoid a resource leak, every open [BLOB handle] should eventually
+** be released by a call to [sqlite3_blob_close()].
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_blob_close()],
+** [sqlite3_blob_reopen()], [sqlite3_blob_read()],
+** [sqlite3_blob_bytes()], [sqlite3_blob_write()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_open(
+ sqlite3*,
+ const char *zDb,
+ const char *zTable,
+ const char *zColumn,
+ sqlite3_int64 iRow,
+ int flags,
+ sqlite3_blob **ppBlob
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Move a BLOB Handle to a New Row
+** METHOD: sqlite3_blob
+**
+** ^This function is used to move an existing [BLOB handle] so that it points
+** to a different row of the same database table. ^The new row is identified
+** by the rowid value passed as the second argument. Only the row can be
+** changed. ^The database, table and column on which the blob handle is open
+** remain the same. Moving an existing [BLOB handle] to a new row is
+** faster than closing the existing handle and opening a new one.
+**
+** ^(The new row must meet the same criteria as for [sqlite3_blob_open()] -
+** it must exist and there must be either a blob or text value stored in
+** the nominated column.)^ ^If the new row is not present in the table, or if
+** it does not contain a blob or text value, or if another error occurs, an
+** SQLite error code is returned and the blob handle is considered aborted.
+** ^All subsequent calls to [sqlite3_blob_read()], [sqlite3_blob_write()] or
+** [sqlite3_blob_reopen()] on an aborted blob handle immediately return
+** SQLITE_ABORT. ^Calling [sqlite3_blob_bytes()] on an aborted blob handle
+** always returns zero.
+**
+** ^This function sets the database handle error code and message.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_reopen(sqlite3_blob *, sqlite3_int64);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Close A BLOB Handle
+** DESTRUCTOR: sqlite3_blob
+**
+** ^This function closes an open [BLOB handle]. ^(The BLOB handle is closed
+** unconditionally. Even if this routine returns an error code, the
+** handle is still closed.)^
+**
+** ^If the blob handle being closed was opened for read-write access, and if
+** the database is in auto-commit mode and there are no other open read-write
+** blob handles or active write statements, the current transaction is
+** committed. ^If an error occurs while committing the transaction, an error
+** code is returned and the transaction rolled back.
+**
+** Calling this function with an argument that is not a NULL pointer or an
+** open blob handle results in undefined behaviour. ^Calling this routine
+** with a null pointer (such as would be returned by a failed call to
+** [sqlite3_blob_open()]) is a harmless no-op. ^Otherwise, if this function
+** is passed a valid open blob handle, the values returned by the
+** sqlite3_errcode() and sqlite3_errmsg() functions are set before returning.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_close(sqlite3_blob *);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Return The Size Of An Open BLOB
+** METHOD: sqlite3_blob
+**
+** ^Returns the size in bytes of the BLOB accessible via the
+** successfully opened [BLOB handle] in its only argument. ^The
+** incremental blob I/O routines can only read or overwriting existing
+** blob content; they cannot change the size of a blob.
+**
+** This routine only works on a [BLOB handle] which has been created
+** by a prior successful call to [sqlite3_blob_open()] and which has not
+** been closed by [sqlite3_blob_close()]. Passing any other pointer in
+** to this routine results in undefined and probably undesirable behavior.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_bytes(sqlite3_blob *);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Read Data From A BLOB Incrementally
+** METHOD: sqlite3_blob
+**
+** ^(This function is used to read data from an open [BLOB handle] into a
+** caller-supplied buffer. N bytes of data are copied into buffer Z
+** from the open BLOB, starting at offset iOffset.)^
+**
+** ^If offset iOffset is less than N bytes from the end of the BLOB,
+** [SQLITE_ERROR] is returned and no data is read. ^If N or iOffset is
+** less than zero, [SQLITE_ERROR] is returned and no data is read.
+** ^The size of the blob (and hence the maximum value of N+iOffset)
+** can be determined using the [sqlite3_blob_bytes()] interface.
+**
+** ^An attempt to read from an expired [BLOB handle] fails with an
+** error code of [SQLITE_ABORT].
+**
+** ^(On success, sqlite3_blob_read() returns SQLITE_OK.
+** Otherwise, an [error code] or an [extended error code] is returned.)^
+**
+** This routine only works on a [BLOB handle] which has been created
+** by a prior successful call to [sqlite3_blob_open()] and which has not
+** been closed by [sqlite3_blob_close()]. Passing any other pointer in
+** to this routine results in undefined and probably undesirable behavior.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_blob_write()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_read(sqlite3_blob *, void *Z, int N, int iOffset);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Write Data Into A BLOB Incrementally
+** METHOD: sqlite3_blob
+**
+** ^(This function is used to write data into an open [BLOB handle] from a
+** caller-supplied buffer. N bytes of data are copied from the buffer Z
+** into the open BLOB, starting at offset iOffset.)^
+**
+** ^(On success, sqlite3_blob_write() returns SQLITE_OK.
+** Otherwise, an [error code] or an [extended error code] is returned.)^
+** ^Unless SQLITE_MISUSE is returned, this function sets the
+** [database connection] error code and message accessible via
+** [sqlite3_errcode()] and [sqlite3_errmsg()] and related functions.
+**
+** ^If the [BLOB handle] passed as the first argument was not opened for
+** writing (the flags parameter to [sqlite3_blob_open()] was zero),
+** this function returns [SQLITE_READONLY].
+**
+** This function may only modify the contents of the BLOB; it is
+** not possible to increase the size of a BLOB using this API.
+** ^If offset iOffset is less than N bytes from the end of the BLOB,
+** [SQLITE_ERROR] is returned and no data is written. The size of the
+** BLOB (and hence the maximum value of N+iOffset) can be determined
+** using the [sqlite3_blob_bytes()] interface. ^If N or iOffset are less
+** than zero [SQLITE_ERROR] is returned and no data is written.
+**
+** ^An attempt to write to an expired [BLOB handle] fails with an
+** error code of [SQLITE_ABORT]. ^Writes to the BLOB that occurred
+** before the [BLOB handle] expired are not rolled back by the
+** expiration of the handle, though of course those changes might
+** have been overwritten by the statement that expired the BLOB handle
+** or by other independent statements.
+**
+** This routine only works on a [BLOB handle] which has been created
+** by a prior successful call to [sqlite3_blob_open()] and which has not
+** been closed by [sqlite3_blob_close()]. Passing any other pointer in
+** to this routine results in undefined and probably undesirable behavior.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_blob_read()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_write(sqlite3_blob *, const void *z, int n, int iOffset);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Virtual File System Objects
+**
+** A virtual filesystem (VFS) is an [sqlite3_vfs] object
+** that SQLite uses to interact
+** with the underlying operating system. Most SQLite builds come with a
+** single default VFS that is appropriate for the host computer.
+** New VFSes can be registered and existing VFSes can be unregistered.
+** The following interfaces are provided.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_vfs_find() interface returns a pointer to a VFS given its name.
+** ^Names are case sensitive.
+** ^Names are zero-terminated UTF-8 strings.
+** ^If there is no match, a NULL pointer is returned.
+** ^If zVfsName is NULL then the default VFS is returned.
+**
+** ^New VFSes are registered with sqlite3_vfs_register().
+** ^Each new VFS becomes the default VFS if the makeDflt flag is set.
+** ^The same VFS can be registered multiple times without injury.
+** ^To make an existing VFS into the default VFS, register it again
+** with the makeDflt flag set. If two different VFSes with the
+** same name are registered, the behavior is undefined. If a
+** VFS is registered with a name that is NULL or an empty string,
+** then the behavior is undefined.
+**
+** ^Unregister a VFS with the sqlite3_vfs_unregister() interface.
+** ^(If the default VFS is unregistered, another VFS is chosen as
+** the default. The choice for the new VFS is arbitrary.)^
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_vfs *sqlite3_vfs_find(const char *zVfsName);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_vfs_register(sqlite3_vfs*, int makeDflt);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_vfs_unregister(sqlite3_vfs*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Mutexes
+**
+** The SQLite core uses these routines for thread
+** synchronization. Though they are intended for internal
+** use by SQLite, code that links against SQLite is
+** permitted to use any of these routines.
+**
+** The SQLite source code contains multiple implementations
+** of these mutex routines. An appropriate implementation
+** is selected automatically at compile-time. The following
+** implementations are available in the SQLite core:
+**
+**
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_W32
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP
+**
+**
+** The SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP implementation is a set of routines
+** that does no real locking and is appropriate for use in
+** a single-threaded application. The SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS and
+** SQLITE_MUTEX_W32 implementations are appropriate for use on Unix
+** and Windows.
+**
+** If SQLite is compiled with the SQLITE_MUTEX_APPDEF preprocessor
+** macro defined (with "-DSQLITE_MUTEX_APPDEF=1"), then no mutex
+** implementation is included with the library. In this case the
+** application must supply a custom mutex implementation using the
+** [SQLITE_CONFIG_MUTEX] option of the sqlite3_config() function
+** before calling sqlite3_initialize() or any other public sqlite3_
+** function that calls sqlite3_initialize().
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_mutex_alloc() routine allocates a new
+** mutex and returns a pointer to it. ^The sqlite3_mutex_alloc()
+** routine returns NULL if it is unable to allocate the requested
+** mutex. The argument to sqlite3_mutex_alloc() must one of these
+** integer constants:
+**
+**
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_OPEN
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PRNG
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_LRU
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PMEM
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP1
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP2
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP3
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS1
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS2
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS3
+**
+**
+** ^The first two constants (SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST and SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE)
+** cause sqlite3_mutex_alloc() to create
+** a new mutex. ^The new mutex is recursive when SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE
+** is used but not necessarily so when SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST is used.
+** The mutex implementation does not need to make a distinction
+** between SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE and SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST if it does
+** not want to. SQLite will only request a recursive mutex in
+** cases where it really needs one. If a faster non-recursive mutex
+** implementation is available on the host platform, the mutex subsystem
+** might return such a mutex in response to SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST.
+**
+** ^The other allowed parameters to sqlite3_mutex_alloc() (anything other
+** than SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST and SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE) each return
+** a pointer to a static preexisting mutex. ^Nine static mutexes are
+** used by the current version of SQLite. Future versions of SQLite
+** may add additional static mutexes. Static mutexes are for internal
+** use by SQLite only. Applications that use SQLite mutexes should
+** use only the dynamic mutexes returned by SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST or
+** SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE.
+**
+** ^Note that if one of the dynamic mutex parameters (SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST
+** or SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE) is used then sqlite3_mutex_alloc()
+** returns a different mutex on every call. ^For the static
+** mutex types, the same mutex is returned on every call that has
+** the same type number.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_mutex_free() routine deallocates a previously
+** allocated dynamic mutex. Attempting to deallocate a static
+** mutex results in undefined behavior.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_mutex_enter() and sqlite3_mutex_try() routines attempt
+** to enter a mutex. ^If another thread is already within the mutex,
+** sqlite3_mutex_enter() will block and sqlite3_mutex_try() will return
+** SQLITE_BUSY. ^The sqlite3_mutex_try() interface returns [SQLITE_OK]
+** upon successful entry. ^(Mutexes created using
+** SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE can be entered multiple times by the same thread.
+** In such cases, the
+** mutex must be exited an equal number of times before another thread
+** can enter.)^ If the same thread tries to enter any mutex other
+** than an SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE more than once, the behavior is undefined.
+**
+** ^(Some systems (for example, Windows 95) do not support the operation
+** implemented by sqlite3_mutex_try(). On those systems, sqlite3_mutex_try()
+** will always return SQLITE_BUSY. The SQLite core only ever uses
+** sqlite3_mutex_try() as an optimization so this is acceptable
+** behavior.)^
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_mutex_leave() routine exits a mutex that was
+** previously entered by the same thread. The behavior
+** is undefined if the mutex is not currently entered by the
+** calling thread or is not currently allocated.
+**
+** ^If the argument to sqlite3_mutex_enter(), sqlite3_mutex_try(), or
+** sqlite3_mutex_leave() is a NULL pointer, then all three routines
+** behave as no-ops.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_mutex_held()] and [sqlite3_mutex_notheld()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_mutex *sqlite3_mutex_alloc(int);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_mutex_free(sqlite3_mutex*);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_mutex_enter(sqlite3_mutex*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_mutex_try(sqlite3_mutex*);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_mutex_leave(sqlite3_mutex*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Mutex Methods Object
+**
+** An instance of this structure defines the low-level routines
+** used to allocate and use mutexes.
+**
+** Usually, the default mutex implementations provided by SQLite are
+** sufficient, however the application has the option of substituting a custom
+** implementation for specialized deployments or systems for which SQLite
+** does not provide a suitable implementation. In this case, the application
+** creates and populates an instance of this structure to pass
+** to sqlite3_config() along with the [SQLITE_CONFIG_MUTEX] option.
+** Additionally, an instance of this structure can be used as an
+** output variable when querying the system for the current mutex
+** implementation, using the [SQLITE_CONFIG_GETMUTEX] option.
+**
+** ^The xMutexInit method defined by this structure is invoked as
+** part of system initialization by the sqlite3_initialize() function.
+** ^The xMutexInit routine is called by SQLite exactly once for each
+** effective call to [sqlite3_initialize()].
+**
+** ^The xMutexEnd method defined by this structure is invoked as
+** part of system shutdown by the sqlite3_shutdown() function. The
+** implementation of this method is expected to release all outstanding
+** resources obtained by the mutex methods implementation, especially
+** those obtained by the xMutexInit method. ^The xMutexEnd()
+** interface is invoked exactly once for each call to [sqlite3_shutdown()].
+**
+** ^(The remaining seven methods defined by this structure (xMutexAlloc,
+** xMutexFree, xMutexEnter, xMutexTry, xMutexLeave, xMutexHeld and
+** xMutexNotheld) implement the following interfaces (respectively):
+**
+**
+**
[sqlite3_mutex_alloc()]
+**
[sqlite3_mutex_free()]
+**
[sqlite3_mutex_enter()]
+**
[sqlite3_mutex_try()]
+**
[sqlite3_mutex_leave()]
+**
[sqlite3_mutex_held()]
+**
[sqlite3_mutex_notheld()]
+**
)^
+**
+** The only difference is that the public sqlite3_XXX functions enumerated
+** above silently ignore any invocations that pass a NULL pointer instead
+** of a valid mutex handle. The implementations of the methods defined
+** by this structure are not required to handle this case. The results
+** of passing a NULL pointer instead of a valid mutex handle are undefined
+** (i.e. it is acceptable to provide an implementation that segfaults if
+** it is passed a NULL pointer).
+**
+** The xMutexInit() method must be threadsafe. It must be harmless to
+** invoke xMutexInit() multiple times within the same process and without
+** intervening calls to xMutexEnd(). Second and subsequent calls to
+** xMutexInit() must be no-ops.
+**
+** xMutexInit() must not use SQLite memory allocation ([sqlite3_malloc()]
+** and its associates). Similarly, xMutexAlloc() must not use SQLite memory
+** allocation for a static mutex. ^However xMutexAlloc() may use SQLite
+** memory allocation for a fast or recursive mutex.
+**
+** ^SQLite will invoke the xMutexEnd() method when [sqlite3_shutdown()] is
+** called, but only if the prior call to xMutexInit returned SQLITE_OK.
+** If xMutexInit fails in any way, it is expected to clean up after itself
+** prior to returning.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_mutex_methods sqlite3_mutex_methods;
+struct sqlite3_mutex_methods {
+ int (*xMutexInit)(void);
+ int (*xMutexEnd)(void);
+ sqlite3_mutex *(*xMutexAlloc)(int);
+ void (*xMutexFree)(sqlite3_mutex *);
+ void (*xMutexEnter)(sqlite3_mutex *);
+ int (*xMutexTry)(sqlite3_mutex *);
+ void (*xMutexLeave)(sqlite3_mutex *);
+ int (*xMutexHeld)(sqlite3_mutex *);
+ int (*xMutexNotheld)(sqlite3_mutex *);
+};
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Mutex Verification Routines
+**
+** The sqlite3_mutex_held() and sqlite3_mutex_notheld() routines
+** are intended for use inside assert() statements. The SQLite core
+** never uses these routines except inside an assert() and applications
+** are advised to follow the lead of the core. The SQLite core only
+** provides implementations for these routines when it is compiled
+** with the SQLITE_DEBUG flag. External mutex implementations
+** are only required to provide these routines if SQLITE_DEBUG is
+** defined and if NDEBUG is not defined.
+**
+** These routines should return true if the mutex in their argument
+** is held or not held, respectively, by the calling thread.
+**
+** The implementation is not required to provide versions of these
+** routines that actually work. If the implementation does not provide working
+** versions of these routines, it should at least provide stubs that always
+** return true so that one does not get spurious assertion failures.
+**
+** If the argument to sqlite3_mutex_held() is a NULL pointer then
+** the routine should return 1. This seems counter-intuitive since
+** clearly the mutex cannot be held if it does not exist. But
+** the reason the mutex does not exist is because the build is not
+** using mutexes. And we do not want the assert() containing the
+** call to sqlite3_mutex_held() to fail, so a non-zero return is
+** the appropriate thing to do. The sqlite3_mutex_notheld()
+** interface should also return 1 when given a NULL pointer.
+*/
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_mutex_held(sqlite3_mutex*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_mutex_notheld(sqlite3_mutex*);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Mutex Types
+**
+** The [sqlite3_mutex_alloc()] interface takes a single argument
+** which is one of these integer constants.
+**
+** The set of static mutexes may change from one SQLite release to the
+** next. Applications that override the built-in mutex logic must be
+** prepared to accommodate additional static mutexes.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST 0
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE 1
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN 2
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM 3 /* sqlite3_malloc() */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM2 4 /* NOT USED */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_OPEN 4 /* sqlite3BtreeOpen() */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PRNG 5 /* sqlite3_randomness() */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_LRU 6 /* lru page list */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_LRU2 7 /* NOT USED */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PMEM 7 /* sqlite3PageMalloc() */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP1 8 /* For use by application */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP2 9 /* For use by application */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP3 10 /* For use by application */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS1 11 /* For use by built-in VFS */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS2 12 /* For use by extension VFS */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS3 13 /* For use by application VFS */
+
+/* Legacy compatibility: */
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MASTER 2
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Retrieve the mutex for a database connection
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^This interface returns a pointer the [sqlite3_mutex] object that
+** serializes access to the [database connection] given in the argument
+** when the [threading mode] is Serialized.
+** ^If the [threading mode] is Single-thread or Multi-thread then this
+** routine returns a NULL pointer.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_mutex *sqlite3_db_mutex(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Low-Level Control Of Database Files
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+** KEYWORDS: {file control}
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_file_control()] interface makes a direct call to the
+** xFileControl method for the [sqlite3_io_methods] object associated
+** with a particular database identified by the second argument. ^The
+** name of the database is "main" for the main database or "temp" for the
+** TEMP database, or the name that appears after the AS keyword for
+** databases that are added using the [ATTACH] SQL command.
+** ^A NULL pointer can be used in place of "main" to refer to the
+** main database file.
+** ^The third and fourth parameters to this routine
+** are passed directly through to the second and third parameters of
+** the xFileControl method. ^The return value of the xFileControl
+** method becomes the return value of this routine.
+**
+** A few opcodes for [sqlite3_file_control()] are handled directly
+** by the SQLite core and never invoke the
+** sqlite3_io_methods.xFileControl method.
+** ^The [SQLITE_FCNTL_FILE_POINTER] value for the op parameter causes
+** a pointer to the underlying [sqlite3_file] object to be written into
+** the space pointed to by the 4th parameter. The
+** [SQLITE_FCNTL_JOURNAL_POINTER] works similarly except that it returns
+** the [sqlite3_file] object associated with the journal file instead of
+** the main database. The [SQLITE_FCNTL_VFS_POINTER] opcode returns
+** a pointer to the underlying [sqlite3_vfs] object for the file.
+** The [SQLITE_FCNTL_DATA_VERSION] returns the data version counter
+** from the pager.
+**
+** ^If the second parameter (zDbName) does not match the name of any
+** open database file, then SQLITE_ERROR is returned. ^This error
+** code is not remembered and will not be recalled by [sqlite3_errcode()]
+** or [sqlite3_errmsg()]. The underlying xFileControl method might
+** also return SQLITE_ERROR. There is no way to distinguish between
+** an incorrect zDbName and an SQLITE_ERROR return from the underlying
+** xFileControl method.
+**
+** See also: [file control opcodes]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_file_control(sqlite3*, const char *zDbName, int op, void*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Testing Interface
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_test_control() interface is used to read out internal
+** state of SQLite and to inject faults into SQLite for testing
+** purposes. ^The first parameter is an operation code that determines
+** the number, meaning, and operation of all subsequent parameters.
+**
+** This interface is not for use by applications. It exists solely
+** for verifying the correct operation of the SQLite library. Depending
+** on how the SQLite library is compiled, this interface might not exist.
+**
+** The details of the operation codes, their meanings, the parameters
+** they take, and what they do are all subject to change without notice.
+** Unlike most of the SQLite API, this function is not guaranteed to
+** operate consistently from one release to the next.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_test_control(int op, ...);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Testing Interface Operation Codes
+**
+** These constants are the valid operation code parameters used
+** as the first argument to [sqlite3_test_control()].
+**
+** These parameters and their meanings are subject to change
+** without notice. These values are for testing purposes only.
+** Applications should not use any of these parameters or the
+** [sqlite3_test_control()] interface.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_FIRST 5
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_PRNG_SAVE 5
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_PRNG_RESTORE 6
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_PRNG_RESET 7 /* NOT USED */
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_BITVEC_TEST 8
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_FAULT_INSTALL 9
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_BENIGN_MALLOC_HOOKS 10
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_PENDING_BYTE 11
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_ASSERT 12
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_ALWAYS 13
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_RESERVE 14 /* NOT USED */
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_OPTIMIZATIONS 15
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_ISKEYWORD 16 /* NOT USED */
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_SCRATCHMALLOC 17 /* NOT USED */
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_INTERNAL_FUNCTIONS 17
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_LOCALTIME_FAULT 18
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_EXPLAIN_STMT 19 /* NOT USED */
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_ONCE_RESET_THRESHOLD 19
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_NEVER_CORRUPT 20
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_VDBE_COVERAGE 21
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_BYTEORDER 22
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_ISINIT 23
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_SORTER_MMAP 24
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_IMPOSTER 25
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_PARSER_COVERAGE 26
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_RESULT_INTREAL 27
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_PRNG_SEED 28
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_EXTRA_SCHEMA_CHECKS 29
+#define SQLITE_TESTCTRL_LAST 29 /* Largest TESTCTRL */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: SQL Keyword Checking
+**
+** These routines provide access to the set of SQL language keywords
+** recognized by SQLite. Applications can uses these routines to determine
+** whether or not a specific identifier needs to be escaped (for example,
+** by enclosing in double-quotes) so as not to confuse the parser.
+**
+** The sqlite3_keyword_count() interface returns the number of distinct
+** keywords understood by SQLite.
+**
+** The sqlite3_keyword_name(N,Z,L) interface finds the N-th keyword and
+** makes *Z point to that keyword expressed as UTF8 and writes the number
+** of bytes in the keyword into *L. The string that *Z points to is not
+** zero-terminated. The sqlite3_keyword_name(N,Z,L) routine returns
+** SQLITE_OK if N is within bounds and SQLITE_ERROR if not. If either Z
+** or L are NULL or invalid pointers then calls to
+** sqlite3_keyword_name(N,Z,L) result in undefined behavior.
+**
+** The sqlite3_keyword_check(Z,L) interface checks to see whether or not
+** the L-byte UTF8 identifier that Z points to is a keyword, returning non-zero
+** if it is and zero if not.
+**
+** The parser used by SQLite is forgiving. It is often possible to use
+** a keyword as an identifier as long as such use does not result in a
+** parsing ambiguity. For example, the statement
+** "CREATE TABLE BEGIN(REPLACE,PRAGMA,END);" is accepted by SQLite, and
+** creates a new table named "BEGIN" with three columns named
+** "REPLACE", "PRAGMA", and "END". Nevertheless, best practice is to avoid
+** using keywords as identifiers. Common techniques used to avoid keyword
+** name collisions include:
+**
+**
Put all identifier names inside double-quotes. This is the official
+** SQL way to escape identifier names.
+**
Put identifier names inside [...]. This is not standard SQL,
+** but it is what SQL Server does and so lots of programmers use this
+** technique.
+**
Begin every identifier with the letter "Z" as no SQL keywords start
+** with "Z".
+**
Include a digit somewhere in every identifier name.
+**
+**
+** Note that the number of keywords understood by SQLite can depend on
+** compile-time options. For example, "VACUUM" is not a keyword if
+** SQLite is compiled with the [-DSQLITE_OMIT_VACUUM] option. Also,
+** new keywords may be added to future releases of SQLite.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_keyword_count(void);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_keyword_name(int,const char**,int*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_keyword_check(const char*,int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Dynamic String Object
+** KEYWORDS: {dynamic string}
+**
+** An instance of the sqlite3_str object contains a dynamically-sized
+** string under construction.
+**
+** The lifecycle of an sqlite3_str object is as follows:
+**
+**
^The sqlite3_str object is created using [sqlite3_str_new()].
+**
^Text is appended to the sqlite3_str object using various
+** methods, such as [sqlite3_str_appendf()].
+**
^The sqlite3_str object is destroyed and the string it created
+** is returned using the [sqlite3_str_finish()] interface.
+**
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_str sqlite3_str;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Create A New Dynamic String Object
+** CONSTRUCTOR: sqlite3_str
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_new(D)] interface allocates and initializes
+** a new [sqlite3_str] object. To avoid memory leaks, the object returned by
+** [sqlite3_str_new()] must be freed by a subsequent call to
+** [sqlite3_str_finish(X)].
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_new(D)] interface always returns a pointer to a
+** valid [sqlite3_str] object, though in the event of an out-of-memory
+** error the returned object might be a special singleton that will
+** silently reject new text, always return SQLITE_NOMEM from
+** [sqlite3_str_errcode()], always return 0 for
+** [sqlite3_str_length()], and always return NULL from
+** [sqlite3_str_finish(X)]. It is always safe to use the value
+** returned by [sqlite3_str_new(D)] as the sqlite3_str parameter
+** to any of the other [sqlite3_str] methods.
+**
+** The D parameter to [sqlite3_str_new(D)] may be NULL. If the
+** D parameter in [sqlite3_str_new(D)] is not NULL, then the maximum
+** length of the string contained in the [sqlite3_str] object will be
+** the value set for [sqlite3_limit](D,[SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH]) instead
+** of [SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH].
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_str *sqlite3_str_new(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Finalize A Dynamic String
+** DESTRUCTOR: sqlite3_str
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_finish(X)] interface destroys the sqlite3_str object X
+** and returns a pointer to a memory buffer obtained from [sqlite3_malloc64()]
+** that contains the constructed string. The calling application should
+** pass the returned value to [sqlite3_free()] to avoid a memory leak.
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_finish(X)] interface may return a NULL pointer if any
+** errors were encountered during construction of the string. ^The
+** [sqlite3_str_finish(X)] interface will also return a NULL pointer if the
+** string in [sqlite3_str] object X is zero bytes long.
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_str_finish(sqlite3_str*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Add Content To A Dynamic String
+** METHOD: sqlite3_str
+**
+** These interfaces add content to an sqlite3_str object previously obtained
+** from [sqlite3_str_new()].
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_appendf(X,F,...)] and
+** [sqlite3_str_vappendf(X,F,V)] interfaces uses the [built-in printf]
+** functionality of SQLite to append formatted text onto the end of
+** [sqlite3_str] object X.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_append(X,S,N)] method appends exactly N bytes from string S
+** onto the end of the [sqlite3_str] object X. N must be non-negative.
+** S must contain at least N non-zero bytes of content. To append a
+** zero-terminated string in its entirety, use the [sqlite3_str_appendall()]
+** method instead.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_appendall(X,S)] method appends the complete content of
+** zero-terminated string S onto the end of [sqlite3_str] object X.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_appendchar(X,N,C)] method appends N copies of the
+** single-byte character C onto the end of [sqlite3_str] object X.
+** ^This method can be used, for example, to add whitespace indentation.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_reset(X)] method resets the string under construction
+** inside [sqlite3_str] object X back to zero bytes in length.
+**
+** These methods do not return a result code. ^If an error occurs, that fact
+** is recorded in the [sqlite3_str] object and can be recovered by a
+** subsequent call to [sqlite3_str_errcode(X)].
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_appendf(sqlite3_str*, const char *zFormat, ...);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_vappendf(sqlite3_str*, const char *zFormat, va_list);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_append(sqlite3_str*, const char *zIn, int N);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_appendall(sqlite3_str*, const char *zIn);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_appendchar(sqlite3_str*, int N, char C);
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_reset(sqlite3_str*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Status Of A Dynamic String
+** METHOD: sqlite3_str
+**
+** These interfaces return the current status of an [sqlite3_str] object.
+**
+** ^If any prior errors have occurred while constructing the dynamic string
+** in sqlite3_str X, then the [sqlite3_str_errcode(X)] method will return
+** an appropriate error code. ^The [sqlite3_str_errcode(X)] method returns
+** [SQLITE_NOMEM] following any out-of-memory error, or
+** [SQLITE_TOOBIG] if the size of the dynamic string exceeds
+** [SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH], or [SQLITE_OK] if there have been no errors.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_length(X)] method returns the current length, in bytes,
+** of the dynamic string under construction in [sqlite3_str] object X.
+** ^The length returned by [sqlite3_str_length(X)] does not include the
+** zero-termination byte.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_str_value(X)] method returns a pointer to the current
+** content of the dynamic string under construction in X. The value
+** returned by [sqlite3_str_value(X)] is managed by the sqlite3_str object X
+** and might be freed or altered by any subsequent method on the same
+** [sqlite3_str] object. Applications must not used the pointer returned
+** [sqlite3_str_value(X)] after any subsequent method call on the same
+** object. ^Applications may change the content of the string returned
+** by [sqlite3_str_value(X)] as long as they do not write into any bytes
+** outside the range of 0 to [sqlite3_str_length(X)] and do not read or
+** write any byte after any subsequent sqlite3_str method call.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_str_errcode(sqlite3_str*);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_str_length(sqlite3_str*);
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_str_value(sqlite3_str*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: SQLite Runtime Status
+**
+** ^These interfaces are used to retrieve runtime status information
+** about the performance of SQLite, and optionally to reset various
+** highwater marks. ^The first argument is an integer code for
+** the specific parameter to measure. ^(Recognized integer codes
+** are of the form [status parameters | SQLITE_STATUS_...].)^
+** ^The current value of the parameter is returned into *pCurrent.
+** ^The highest recorded value is returned in *pHighwater. ^If the
+** resetFlag is true, then the highest record value is reset after
+** *pHighwater is written. ^(Some parameters do not record the highest
+** value. For those parameters
+** nothing is written into *pHighwater and the resetFlag is ignored.)^
+** ^(Other parameters record only the highwater mark and not the current
+** value. For these latter parameters nothing is written into *pCurrent.)^
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_status() and sqlite3_status64() routines return
+** SQLITE_OK on success and a non-zero [error code] on failure.
+**
+** If either the current value or the highwater mark is too large to
+** be represented by a 32-bit integer, then the values returned by
+** sqlite3_status() are undefined.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_db_status()]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_status(int op, int *pCurrent, int *pHighwater, int resetFlag);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_status64(
+ int op,
+ sqlite3_int64 *pCurrent,
+ sqlite3_int64 *pHighwater,
+ int resetFlag
+);
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Status Parameters
+** KEYWORDS: {status parameters}
+**
+** These integer constants designate various run-time status parameters
+** that can be returned by [sqlite3_status()].
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED]] ^(
SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED
+**
This parameter is the current amount of memory checked out
+** using [sqlite3_malloc()], either directly or indirectly. The
+** figure includes calls made to [sqlite3_malloc()] by the application
+** and internal memory usage by the SQLite library. Auxiliary page-cache
+** memory controlled by [SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE] is not included in
+** this parameter. The amount returned is the sum of the allocation
+** sizes as reported by the xSize method in [sqlite3_mem_methods].
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_SIZE]] ^(
SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_SIZE
+**
This parameter records the largest memory allocation request
+** handed to [sqlite3_malloc()] or [sqlite3_realloc()] (or their
+** internal equivalents). Only the value returned in the
+** *pHighwater parameter to [sqlite3_status()] is of interest.
+** The value written into the *pCurrent parameter is undefined.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_COUNT]] ^(
SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_COUNT
+**
This parameter records the number of separate memory allocations
+** currently checked out.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_USED]] ^(
SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_USED
+**
This parameter returns the number of pages used out of the
+** [pagecache memory allocator] that was configured using
+** [SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE]. The
+** value returned is in pages, not in bytes.
This parameter returns the number of bytes of page cache
+** allocation which could not be satisfied by the [SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE]
+** buffer and where forced to overflow to [sqlite3_malloc()]. The
+** returned value includes allocations that overflowed because they
+** where too large (they were larger than the "sz" parameter to
+** [SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE]) and allocations that overflowed because
+** no space was left in the page cache.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_SIZE]] ^(
SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_SIZE
+**
This parameter records the largest memory allocation request
+** handed to the [pagecache memory allocator]. Only the value returned in the
+** *pHighwater parameter to [sqlite3_status()] is of interest.
+** The value written into the *pCurrent parameter is undefined.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_USED]]
SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_USED
+**
No longer used.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_OVERFLOW]] ^(
SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_OVERFLOW
+**
No longer used.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_SIZE]]
SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_SIZE
+**
No longer used.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STATUS_PARSER_STACK]] ^(
SQLITE_STATUS_PARSER_STACK
+**
The *pHighwater parameter records the deepest parser stack.
+** The *pCurrent value is undefined. The *pHighwater value is only
+** meaningful if SQLite is compiled with [YYTRACKMAXSTACKDEPTH].
)^
+**
+**
+** New status parameters may be added from time to time.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED 0
+#define SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_USED 1
+#define SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_OVERFLOW 2
+#define SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_USED 3 /* NOT USED */
+#define SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_OVERFLOW 4 /* NOT USED */
+#define SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_SIZE 5
+#define SQLITE_STATUS_PARSER_STACK 6
+#define SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_SIZE 7
+#define SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_SIZE 8 /* NOT USED */
+#define SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_COUNT 9
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Database Connection Status
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^This interface is used to retrieve runtime status information
+** about a single [database connection]. ^The first argument is the
+** database connection object to be interrogated. ^The second argument
+** is an integer constant, taken from the set of
+** [SQLITE_DBSTATUS options], that
+** determines the parameter to interrogate. The set of
+** [SQLITE_DBSTATUS options] is likely
+** to grow in future releases of SQLite.
+**
+** ^The current value of the requested parameter is written into *pCur
+** and the highest instantaneous value is written into *pHiwtr. ^If
+** the resetFlg is true, then the highest instantaneous value is
+** reset back down to the current value.
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_db_status() routine returns SQLITE_OK on success and a
+** non-zero [error code] on failure.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_status()] and [sqlite3_stmt_status()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_db_status(sqlite3*, int op, int *pCur, int *pHiwtr, int resetFlg);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Status Parameters for database connections
+** KEYWORDS: {SQLITE_DBSTATUS options}
+**
+** These constants are the available integer "verbs" that can be passed as
+** the second argument to the [sqlite3_db_status()] interface.
+**
+** New verbs may be added in future releases of SQLite. Existing verbs
+** might be discontinued. Applications should check the return code from
+** [sqlite3_db_status()] to make sure that the call worked.
+** The [sqlite3_db_status()] interface will return a non-zero error code
+** if a discontinued or unsupported verb is invoked.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_USED]] ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_USED
+**
This parameter returns the number of lookaside memory slots currently
+** checked out.
)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_HIT]] ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_HIT
+**
This parameter returns the number of malloc attempts that were
+** satisfied using lookaside memory. Only the high-water value is meaningful;
+** the current value is always zero.)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_MISS_SIZE]]
+** ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_MISS_SIZE
+**
This parameter returns the number malloc attempts that might have
+** been satisfied using lookaside memory but failed due to the amount of
+** memory requested being larger than the lookaside slot size.
+** Only the high-water value is meaningful;
+** the current value is always zero.)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_MISS_FULL]]
+** ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_MISS_FULL
+**
This parameter returns the number malloc attempts that might have
+** been satisfied using lookaside memory but failed due to all lookaside
+** memory already being in use.
+** Only the high-water value is meaningful;
+** the current value is always zero.)^
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED]] ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED
+**
This parameter returns the approximate number of bytes of heap
+** memory used by all pager caches associated with the database connection.)^
+** ^The highwater mark associated with SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED is always 0.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED_SHARED]]
+** ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED_SHARED
+**
This parameter is similar to DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED, except that if a
+** pager cache is shared between two or more connections the bytes of heap
+** memory used by that pager cache is divided evenly between the attached
+** connections.)^ In other words, if none of the pager caches associated
+** with the database connection are shared, this request returns the same
+** value as DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED. Or, if one or more or the pager caches are
+** shared, the value returned by this call will be smaller than that returned
+** by DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED. ^The highwater mark associated with
+** SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED_SHARED is always 0.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_SCHEMA_USED]] ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_SCHEMA_USED
+**
This parameter returns the approximate number of bytes of heap
+** memory used to store the schema for all databases associated
+** with the connection - main, temp, and any [ATTACH]-ed databases.)^
+** ^The full amount of memory used by the schemas is reported, even if the
+** schema memory is shared with other database connections due to
+** [shared cache mode] being enabled.
+** ^The highwater mark associated with SQLITE_DBSTATUS_SCHEMA_USED is always 0.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_STMT_USED]] ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_STMT_USED
+**
This parameter returns the approximate number of bytes of heap
+** and lookaside memory used by all prepared statements associated with
+** the database connection.)^
+** ^The highwater mark associated with SQLITE_DBSTATUS_STMT_USED is always 0.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_HIT]] ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_HIT
+**
This parameter returns the number of pager cache hits that have
+** occurred.)^ ^The highwater mark associated with SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_HIT
+** is always 0.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_MISS]] ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_MISS
+**
This parameter returns the number of pager cache misses that have
+** occurred.)^ ^The highwater mark associated with SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_MISS
+** is always 0.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_WRITE]] ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_WRITE
+**
This parameter returns the number of dirty cache entries that have
+** been written to disk. Specifically, the number of pages written to the
+** wal file in wal mode databases, or the number of pages written to the
+** database file in rollback mode databases. Any pages written as part of
+** transaction rollback or database recovery operations are not included.
+** If an IO or other error occurs while writing a page to disk, the effect
+** on subsequent SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_WRITE requests is undefined.)^ ^The
+** highwater mark associated with SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_WRITE is always 0.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_SPILL]] ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_SPILL
+**
This parameter returns the number of dirty cache entries that have
+** been written to disk in the middle of a transaction due to the page
+** cache overflowing. Transactions are more efficient if they are written
+** to disk all at once. When pages spill mid-transaction, that introduces
+** additional overhead. This parameter can be used help identify
+** inefficiencies that can be resolved by increasing the cache size.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_DBSTATUS_DEFERRED_FKS]] ^(
SQLITE_DBSTATUS_DEFERRED_FKS
+**
This parameter returns zero for the current value if and only if
+** all foreign key constraints (deferred or immediate) have been
+** resolved.)^ ^The highwater mark is always 0.
+**
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_USED 0
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED 1
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_SCHEMA_USED 2
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_STMT_USED 3
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_HIT 4
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_MISS_SIZE 5
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_MISS_FULL 6
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_HIT 7
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_MISS 8
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_WRITE 9
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_DEFERRED_FKS 10
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED_SHARED 11
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_SPILL 12
+#define SQLITE_DBSTATUS_MAX 12 /* Largest defined DBSTATUS */
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Prepared Statement Status
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^(Each prepared statement maintains various
+** [SQLITE_STMTSTATUS counters] that measure the number
+** of times it has performed specific operations.)^ These counters can
+** be used to monitor the performance characteristics of the prepared
+** statements. For example, if the number of table steps greatly exceeds
+** the number of table searches or result rows, that would tend to indicate
+** that the prepared statement is using a full table scan rather than
+** an index.
+**
+** ^(This interface is used to retrieve and reset counter values from
+** a [prepared statement]. The first argument is the prepared statement
+** object to be interrogated. The second argument
+** is an integer code for a specific [SQLITE_STMTSTATUS counter]
+** to be interrogated.)^
+** ^The current value of the requested counter is returned.
+** ^If the resetFlg is true, then the counter is reset to zero after this
+** interface call returns.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_status()] and [sqlite3_db_status()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_stmt_status(sqlite3_stmt*, int op,int resetFlg);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Status Parameters for prepared statements
+** KEYWORDS: {SQLITE_STMTSTATUS counter} {SQLITE_STMTSTATUS counters}
+**
+** These preprocessor macros define integer codes that name counter
+** values associated with the [sqlite3_stmt_status()] interface.
+** The meanings of the various counters are as follows:
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_FULLSCAN_STEP]]
SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_FULLSCAN_STEP
+**
^This is the number of times that SQLite has stepped forward in
+** a table as part of a full table scan. Large numbers for this counter
+** may indicate opportunities for performance improvement through
+** careful use of indices.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_SORT]]
SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_SORT
+**
^This is the number of sort operations that have occurred.
+** A non-zero value in this counter may indicate an opportunity to
+** improvement performance through careful use of indices.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_AUTOINDEX]]
SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_AUTOINDEX
+**
^This is the number of rows inserted into transient indices that
+** were created automatically in order to help joins run faster.
+** A non-zero value in this counter may indicate an opportunity to
+** improvement performance by adding permanent indices that do not
+** need to be reinitialized each time the statement is run.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_VM_STEP]]
SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_VM_STEP
+**
^This is the number of virtual machine operations executed
+** by the prepared statement if that number is less than or equal
+** to 2147483647. The number of virtual machine operations can be
+** used as a proxy for the total work done by the prepared statement.
+** If the number of virtual machine operations exceeds 2147483647
+** then the value returned by this statement status code is undefined.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_REPREPARE]]
SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_REPREPARE
+**
^This is the number of times that the prepare statement has been
+** automatically regenerated due to schema changes or changes to
+** [bound parameters] that might affect the query plan.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_RUN]]
SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_RUN
+**
^This is the number of times that the prepared statement has
+** been run. A single "run" for the purposes of this counter is one
+** or more calls to [sqlite3_step()] followed by a call to [sqlite3_reset()].
+** The counter is incremented on the first [sqlite3_step()] call of each
+** cycle.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_MEMUSED]]
SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_MEMUSED
+**
^This is the approximate number of bytes of heap memory
+** used to store the prepared statement. ^This value is not actually
+** a counter, and so the resetFlg parameter to sqlite3_stmt_status()
+** is ignored when the opcode is SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_MEMUSED.
+**
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_FULLSCAN_STEP 1
+#define SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_SORT 2
+#define SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_AUTOINDEX 3
+#define SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_VM_STEP 4
+#define SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_REPREPARE 5
+#define SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_RUN 6
+#define SQLITE_STMTSTATUS_MEMUSED 99
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Custom Page Cache Object
+**
+** The sqlite3_pcache type is opaque. It is implemented by
+** the pluggable module. The SQLite core has no knowledge of
+** its size or internal structure and never deals with the
+** sqlite3_pcache object except by holding and passing pointers
+** to the object.
+**
+** See [sqlite3_pcache_methods2] for additional information.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_pcache sqlite3_pcache;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Custom Page Cache Object
+**
+** The sqlite3_pcache_page object represents a single page in the
+** page cache. The page cache will allocate instances of this
+** object. Various methods of the page cache use pointers to instances
+** of this object as parameters or as their return value.
+**
+** See [sqlite3_pcache_methods2] for additional information.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_pcache_page sqlite3_pcache_page;
+struct sqlite3_pcache_page {
+ void *pBuf; /* The content of the page */
+ void *pExtra; /* Extra information associated with the page */
+};
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Application Defined Page Cache.
+** KEYWORDS: {page cache}
+**
+** ^(The [sqlite3_config]([SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE2], ...) interface can
+** register an alternative page cache implementation by passing in an
+** instance of the sqlite3_pcache_methods2 structure.)^
+** In many applications, most of the heap memory allocated by
+** SQLite is used for the page cache.
+** By implementing a
+** custom page cache using this API, an application can better control
+** the amount of memory consumed by SQLite, the way in which
+** that memory is allocated and released, and the policies used to
+** determine exactly which parts of a database file are cached and for
+** how long.
+**
+** The alternative page cache mechanism is an
+** extreme measure that is only needed by the most demanding applications.
+** The built-in page cache is recommended for most uses.
+**
+** ^(The contents of the sqlite3_pcache_methods2 structure are copied to an
+** internal buffer by SQLite within the call to [sqlite3_config]. Hence
+** the application may discard the parameter after the call to
+** [sqlite3_config()] returns.)^
+**
+** [[the xInit() page cache method]]
+** ^(The xInit() method is called once for each effective
+** call to [sqlite3_initialize()])^
+** (usually only once during the lifetime of the process). ^(The xInit()
+** method is passed a copy of the sqlite3_pcache_methods2.pArg value.)^
+** The intent of the xInit() method is to set up global data structures
+** required by the custom page cache implementation.
+** ^(If the xInit() method is NULL, then the
+** built-in default page cache is used instead of the application defined
+** page cache.)^
+**
+** [[the xShutdown() page cache method]]
+** ^The xShutdown() method is called by [sqlite3_shutdown()].
+** It can be used to clean up
+** any outstanding resources before process shutdown, if required.
+** ^The xShutdown() method may be NULL.
+**
+** ^SQLite automatically serializes calls to the xInit method,
+** so the xInit method need not be threadsafe. ^The
+** xShutdown method is only called from [sqlite3_shutdown()] so it does
+** not need to be threadsafe either. All other methods must be threadsafe
+** in multithreaded applications.
+**
+** ^SQLite will never invoke xInit() more than once without an intervening
+** call to xShutdown().
+**
+** [[the xCreate() page cache methods]]
+** ^SQLite invokes the xCreate() method to construct a new cache instance.
+** SQLite will typically create one cache instance for each open database file,
+** though this is not guaranteed. ^The
+** first parameter, szPage, is the size in bytes of the pages that must
+** be allocated by the cache. ^szPage will always a power of two. ^The
+** second parameter szExtra is a number of bytes of extra storage
+** associated with each page cache entry. ^The szExtra parameter will
+** a number less than 250. SQLite will use the
+** extra szExtra bytes on each page to store metadata about the underlying
+** database page on disk. The value passed into szExtra depends
+** on the SQLite version, the target platform, and how SQLite was compiled.
+** ^The third argument to xCreate(), bPurgeable, is true if the cache being
+** created will be used to cache database pages of a file stored on disk, or
+** false if it is used for an in-memory database. The cache implementation
+** does not have to do anything special based with the value of bPurgeable;
+** it is purely advisory. ^On a cache where bPurgeable is false, SQLite will
+** never invoke xUnpin() except to deliberately delete a page.
+** ^In other words, calls to xUnpin() on a cache with bPurgeable set to
+** false will always have the "discard" flag set to true.
+** ^Hence, a cache created with bPurgeable false will
+** never contain any unpinned pages.
+**
+** [[the xCachesize() page cache method]]
+** ^(The xCachesize() method may be called at any time by SQLite to set the
+** suggested maximum cache-size (number of pages stored by) the cache
+** instance passed as the first argument. This is the value configured using
+** the SQLite "[PRAGMA cache_size]" command.)^ As with the bPurgeable
+** parameter, the implementation is not required to do anything with this
+** value; it is advisory only.
+**
+** [[the xPagecount() page cache methods]]
+** The xPagecount() method must return the number of pages currently
+** stored in the cache, both pinned and unpinned.
+**
+** [[the xFetch() page cache methods]]
+** The xFetch() method locates a page in the cache and returns a pointer to
+** an sqlite3_pcache_page object associated with that page, or a NULL pointer.
+** The pBuf element of the returned sqlite3_pcache_page object will be a
+** pointer to a buffer of szPage bytes used to store the content of a
+** single database page. The pExtra element of sqlite3_pcache_page will be
+** a pointer to the szExtra bytes of extra storage that SQLite has requested
+** for each entry in the page cache.
+**
+** The page to be fetched is determined by the key. ^The minimum key value
+** is 1. After it has been retrieved using xFetch, the page is considered
+** to be "pinned".
+**
+** If the requested page is already in the page cache, then the page cache
+** implementation must return a pointer to the page buffer with its content
+** intact. If the requested page is not already in the cache, then the
+** cache implementation should use the value of the createFlag
+** parameter to help it determined what action to take:
+**
+**
+**
createFlag
Behavior when page is not already in cache
+**
0
Do not allocate a new page. Return NULL.
+**
1
Allocate a new page if it easy and convenient to do so.
+** Otherwise return NULL.
+**
2
Make every effort to allocate a new page. Only return
+** NULL if allocating a new page is effectively impossible.
+**
+**
+** ^(SQLite will normally invoke xFetch() with a createFlag of 0 or 1. SQLite
+** will only use a createFlag of 2 after a prior call with a createFlag of 1
+** failed.)^ In between the xFetch() calls, SQLite may
+** attempt to unpin one or more cache pages by spilling the content of
+** pinned pages to disk and synching the operating system disk cache.
+**
+** [[the xUnpin() page cache method]]
+** ^xUnpin() is called by SQLite with a pointer to a currently pinned page
+** as its second argument. If the third parameter, discard, is non-zero,
+** then the page must be evicted from the cache.
+** ^If the discard parameter is
+** zero, then the page may be discarded or retained at the discretion of
+** page cache implementation. ^The page cache implementation
+** may choose to evict unpinned pages at any time.
+**
+** The cache must not perform any reference counting. A single
+** call to xUnpin() unpins the page regardless of the number of prior calls
+** to xFetch().
+**
+** [[the xRekey() page cache methods]]
+** The xRekey() method is used to change the key value associated with the
+** page passed as the second argument. If the cache
+** previously contains an entry associated with newKey, it must be
+** discarded. ^Any prior cache entry associated with newKey is guaranteed not
+** to be pinned.
+**
+** When SQLite calls the xTruncate() method, the cache must discard all
+** existing cache entries with page numbers (keys) greater than or equal
+** to the value of the iLimit parameter passed to xTruncate(). If any
+** of these pages are pinned, they are implicitly unpinned, meaning that
+** they can be safely discarded.
+**
+** [[the xDestroy() page cache method]]
+** ^The xDestroy() method is used to delete a cache allocated by xCreate().
+** All resources associated with the specified cache should be freed. ^After
+** calling the xDestroy() method, SQLite considers the [sqlite3_pcache*]
+** handle invalid, and will not use it with any other sqlite3_pcache_methods2
+** functions.
+**
+** [[the xShrink() page cache method]]
+** ^SQLite invokes the xShrink() method when it wants the page cache to
+** free up as much of heap memory as possible. The page cache implementation
+** is not obligated to free any memory, but well-behaved implementations should
+** do their best.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_pcache_methods2 sqlite3_pcache_methods2;
+struct sqlite3_pcache_methods2 {
+ int iVersion;
+ void *pArg;
+ int (*xInit)(void*);
+ void (*xShutdown)(void*);
+ sqlite3_pcache *(*xCreate)(int szPage, int szExtra, int bPurgeable);
+ void (*xCachesize)(sqlite3_pcache*, int nCachesize);
+ int (*xPagecount)(sqlite3_pcache*);
+ sqlite3_pcache_page *(*xFetch)(sqlite3_pcache*, unsigned key, int createFlag);
+ void (*xUnpin)(sqlite3_pcache*, sqlite3_pcache_page*, int discard);
+ void (*xRekey)(sqlite3_pcache*, sqlite3_pcache_page*,
+ unsigned oldKey, unsigned newKey);
+ void (*xTruncate)(sqlite3_pcache*, unsigned iLimit);
+ void (*xDestroy)(sqlite3_pcache*);
+ void (*xShrink)(sqlite3_pcache*);
+};
+
+/*
+** This is the obsolete pcache_methods object that has now been replaced
+** by sqlite3_pcache_methods2. This object is not used by SQLite. It is
+** retained in the header file for backwards compatibility only.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_pcache_methods sqlite3_pcache_methods;
+struct sqlite3_pcache_methods {
+ void *pArg;
+ int (*xInit)(void*);
+ void (*xShutdown)(void*);
+ sqlite3_pcache *(*xCreate)(int szPage, int bPurgeable);
+ void (*xCachesize)(sqlite3_pcache*, int nCachesize);
+ int (*xPagecount)(sqlite3_pcache*);
+ void *(*xFetch)(sqlite3_pcache*, unsigned key, int createFlag);
+ void (*xUnpin)(sqlite3_pcache*, void*, int discard);
+ void (*xRekey)(sqlite3_pcache*, void*, unsigned oldKey, unsigned newKey);
+ void (*xTruncate)(sqlite3_pcache*, unsigned iLimit);
+ void (*xDestroy)(sqlite3_pcache*);
+};
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Online Backup Object
+**
+** The sqlite3_backup object records state information about an ongoing
+** online backup operation. ^The sqlite3_backup object is created by
+** a call to [sqlite3_backup_init()] and is destroyed by a call to
+** [sqlite3_backup_finish()].
+**
+** See Also: [Using the SQLite Online Backup API]
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_backup sqlite3_backup;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Online Backup API.
+**
+** The backup API copies the content of one database into another.
+** It is useful either for creating backups of databases or
+** for copying in-memory databases to or from persistent files.
+**
+** See Also: [Using the SQLite Online Backup API]
+**
+** ^SQLite holds a write transaction open on the destination database file
+** for the duration of the backup operation.
+** ^The source database is read-locked only while it is being read;
+** it is not locked continuously for the entire backup operation.
+** ^Thus, the backup may be performed on a live source database without
+** preventing other database connections from
+** reading or writing to the source database while the backup is underway.
+**
+** ^(To perform a backup operation:
+**
+**
sqlite3_backup_init() is called once to initialize the
+** backup,
+**
sqlite3_backup_step() is called one or more times to transfer
+** the data between the two databases, and finally
+**
sqlite3_backup_finish() is called to release all resources
+** associated with the backup operation.
+**
)^
+** There should be exactly one call to sqlite3_backup_finish() for each
+** successful call to sqlite3_backup_init().
+**
+** [[sqlite3_backup_init()]] sqlite3_backup_init()
+**
+** ^The D and N arguments to sqlite3_backup_init(D,N,S,M) are the
+** [database connection] associated with the destination database
+** and the database name, respectively.
+** ^The database name is "main" for the main database, "temp" for the
+** temporary database, or the name specified after the AS keyword in
+** an [ATTACH] statement for an attached database.
+** ^The S and M arguments passed to
+** sqlite3_backup_init(D,N,S,M) identify the [database connection]
+** and database name of the source database, respectively.
+** ^The source and destination [database connections] (parameters S and D)
+** must be different or else sqlite3_backup_init(D,N,S,M) will fail with
+** an error.
+**
+** ^A call to sqlite3_backup_init() will fail, returning NULL, if
+** there is already a read or read-write transaction open on the
+** destination database.
+**
+** ^If an error occurs within sqlite3_backup_init(D,N,S,M), then NULL is
+** returned and an error code and error message are stored in the
+** destination [database connection] D.
+** ^The error code and message for the failed call to sqlite3_backup_init()
+** can be retrieved using the [sqlite3_errcode()], [sqlite3_errmsg()], and/or
+** [sqlite3_errmsg16()] functions.
+** ^A successful call to sqlite3_backup_init() returns a pointer to an
+** [sqlite3_backup] object.
+** ^The [sqlite3_backup] object may be used with the sqlite3_backup_step() and
+** sqlite3_backup_finish() functions to perform the specified backup
+** operation.
+**
+** [[sqlite3_backup_step()]] sqlite3_backup_step()
+**
+** ^Function sqlite3_backup_step(B,N) will copy up to N pages between
+** the source and destination databases specified by [sqlite3_backup] object B.
+** ^If N is negative, all remaining source pages are copied.
+** ^If sqlite3_backup_step(B,N) successfully copies N pages and there
+** are still more pages to be copied, then the function returns [SQLITE_OK].
+** ^If sqlite3_backup_step(B,N) successfully finishes copying all pages
+** from source to destination, then it returns [SQLITE_DONE].
+** ^If an error occurs while running sqlite3_backup_step(B,N),
+** then an [error code] is returned. ^As well as [SQLITE_OK] and
+** [SQLITE_DONE], a call to sqlite3_backup_step() may return [SQLITE_READONLY],
+** [SQLITE_NOMEM], [SQLITE_BUSY], [SQLITE_LOCKED], or an
+** [SQLITE_IOERR_ACCESS | SQLITE_IOERR_XXX] extended error code.
+**
+** ^(The sqlite3_backup_step() might return [SQLITE_READONLY] if
+**
+**
the destination database was opened read-only, or
+**
the destination database is using write-ahead-log journaling
+** and the destination and source page sizes differ, or
+**
the destination database is an in-memory database and the
+** destination and source page sizes differ.
+**
)^
+**
+** ^If sqlite3_backup_step() cannot obtain a required file-system lock, then
+** the [sqlite3_busy_handler | busy-handler function]
+** is invoked (if one is specified). ^If the
+** busy-handler returns non-zero before the lock is available, then
+** [SQLITE_BUSY] is returned to the caller. ^In this case the call to
+** sqlite3_backup_step() can be retried later. ^If the source
+** [database connection]
+** is being used to write to the source database when sqlite3_backup_step()
+** is called, then [SQLITE_LOCKED] is returned immediately. ^Again, in this
+** case the call to sqlite3_backup_step() can be retried later on. ^(If
+** [SQLITE_IOERR_ACCESS | SQLITE_IOERR_XXX], [SQLITE_NOMEM], or
+** [SQLITE_READONLY] is returned, then
+** there is no point in retrying the call to sqlite3_backup_step(). These
+** errors are considered fatal.)^ The application must accept
+** that the backup operation has failed and pass the backup operation handle
+** to the sqlite3_backup_finish() to release associated resources.
+**
+** ^The first call to sqlite3_backup_step() obtains an exclusive lock
+** on the destination file. ^The exclusive lock is not released until either
+** sqlite3_backup_finish() is called or the backup operation is complete
+** and sqlite3_backup_step() returns [SQLITE_DONE]. ^Every call to
+** sqlite3_backup_step() obtains a [shared lock] on the source database that
+** lasts for the duration of the sqlite3_backup_step() call.
+** ^Because the source database is not locked between calls to
+** sqlite3_backup_step(), the source database may be modified mid-way
+** through the backup process. ^If the source database is modified by an
+** external process or via a database connection other than the one being
+** used by the backup operation, then the backup will be automatically
+** restarted by the next call to sqlite3_backup_step(). ^If the source
+** database is modified by the using the same database connection as is used
+** by the backup operation, then the backup database is automatically
+** updated at the same time.
+**
+** [[sqlite3_backup_finish()]] sqlite3_backup_finish()
+**
+** When sqlite3_backup_step() has returned [SQLITE_DONE], or when the
+** application wishes to abandon the backup operation, the application
+** should destroy the [sqlite3_backup] by passing it to sqlite3_backup_finish().
+** ^The sqlite3_backup_finish() interfaces releases all
+** resources associated with the [sqlite3_backup] object.
+** ^If sqlite3_backup_step() has not yet returned [SQLITE_DONE], then any
+** active write-transaction on the destination database is rolled back.
+** The [sqlite3_backup] object is invalid
+** and may not be used following a call to sqlite3_backup_finish().
+**
+** ^The value returned by sqlite3_backup_finish is [SQLITE_OK] if no
+** sqlite3_backup_step() errors occurred, regardless or whether or not
+** sqlite3_backup_step() completed.
+** ^If an out-of-memory condition or IO error occurred during any prior
+** sqlite3_backup_step() call on the same [sqlite3_backup] object, then
+** sqlite3_backup_finish() returns the corresponding [error code].
+**
+** ^A return of [SQLITE_BUSY] or [SQLITE_LOCKED] from sqlite3_backup_step()
+** is not a permanent error and does not affect the return value of
+** sqlite3_backup_finish().
+**
+** [[sqlite3_backup_remaining()]] [[sqlite3_backup_pagecount()]]
+** sqlite3_backup_remaining() and sqlite3_backup_pagecount()
+**
+** ^The sqlite3_backup_remaining() routine returns the number of pages still
+** to be backed up at the conclusion of the most recent sqlite3_backup_step().
+** ^The sqlite3_backup_pagecount() routine returns the total number of pages
+** in the source database at the conclusion of the most recent
+** sqlite3_backup_step().
+** ^(The values returned by these functions are only updated by
+** sqlite3_backup_step(). If the source database is modified in a way that
+** changes the size of the source database or the number of pages remaining,
+** those changes are not reflected in the output of sqlite3_backup_pagecount()
+** and sqlite3_backup_remaining() until after the next
+** sqlite3_backup_step().)^
+**
+** Concurrent Usage of Database Handles
+**
+** ^The source [database connection] may be used by the application for other
+** purposes while a backup operation is underway or being initialized.
+** ^If SQLite is compiled and configured to support threadsafe database
+** connections, then the source database connection may be used concurrently
+** from within other threads.
+**
+** However, the application must guarantee that the destination
+** [database connection] is not passed to any other API (by any thread) after
+** sqlite3_backup_init() is called and before the corresponding call to
+** sqlite3_backup_finish(). SQLite does not currently check to see
+** if the application incorrectly accesses the destination [database connection]
+** and so no error code is reported, but the operations may malfunction
+** nevertheless. Use of the destination database connection while a
+** backup is in progress might also also cause a mutex deadlock.
+**
+** If running in [shared cache mode], the application must
+** guarantee that the shared cache used by the destination database
+** is not accessed while the backup is running. In practice this means
+** that the application must guarantee that the disk file being
+** backed up to is not accessed by any connection within the process,
+** not just the specific connection that was passed to sqlite3_backup_init().
+**
+** The [sqlite3_backup] object itself is partially threadsafe. Multiple
+** threads may safely make multiple concurrent calls to sqlite3_backup_step().
+** However, the sqlite3_backup_remaining() and sqlite3_backup_pagecount()
+** APIs are not strictly speaking threadsafe. If they are invoked at the
+** same time as another thread is invoking sqlite3_backup_step() it is
+** possible that they return invalid values.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_backup *sqlite3_backup_init(
+ sqlite3 *pDest, /* Destination database handle */
+ const char *zDestName, /* Destination database name */
+ sqlite3 *pSource, /* Source database handle */
+ const char *zSourceName /* Source database name */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_backup_step(sqlite3_backup *p, int nPage);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_backup_finish(sqlite3_backup *p);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_backup_remaining(sqlite3_backup *p);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_backup_pagecount(sqlite3_backup *p);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Unlock Notification
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^When running in shared-cache mode, a database operation may fail with
+** an [SQLITE_LOCKED] error if the required locks on the shared-cache or
+** individual tables within the shared-cache cannot be obtained. See
+** [SQLite Shared-Cache Mode] for a description of shared-cache locking.
+** ^This API may be used to register a callback that SQLite will invoke
+** when the connection currently holding the required lock relinquishes it.
+** ^This API is only available if the library was compiled with the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_UNLOCK_NOTIFY] C-preprocessor symbol defined.
+**
+** See Also: [Using the SQLite Unlock Notification Feature].
+**
+** ^Shared-cache locks are released when a database connection concludes
+** its current transaction, either by committing it or rolling it back.
+**
+** ^When a connection (known as the blocked connection) fails to obtain a
+** shared-cache lock and SQLITE_LOCKED is returned to the caller, the
+** identity of the database connection (the blocking connection) that
+** has locked the required resource is stored internally. ^After an
+** application receives an SQLITE_LOCKED error, it may call the
+** sqlite3_unlock_notify() method with the blocked connection handle as
+** the first argument to register for a callback that will be invoked
+** when the blocking connections current transaction is concluded. ^The
+** callback is invoked from within the [sqlite3_step] or [sqlite3_close]
+** call that concludes the blocking connection's transaction.
+**
+** ^(If sqlite3_unlock_notify() is called in a multi-threaded application,
+** there is a chance that the blocking connection will have already
+** concluded its transaction by the time sqlite3_unlock_notify() is invoked.
+** If this happens, then the specified callback is invoked immediately,
+** from within the call to sqlite3_unlock_notify().)^
+**
+** ^If the blocked connection is attempting to obtain a write-lock on a
+** shared-cache table, and more than one other connection currently holds
+** a read-lock on the same table, then SQLite arbitrarily selects one of
+** the other connections to use as the blocking connection.
+**
+** ^(There may be at most one unlock-notify callback registered by a
+** blocked connection. If sqlite3_unlock_notify() is called when the
+** blocked connection already has a registered unlock-notify callback,
+** then the new callback replaces the old.)^ ^If sqlite3_unlock_notify() is
+** called with a NULL pointer as its second argument, then any existing
+** unlock-notify callback is canceled. ^The blocked connections
+** unlock-notify callback may also be canceled by closing the blocked
+** connection using [sqlite3_close()].
+**
+** The unlock-notify callback is not reentrant. If an application invokes
+** any sqlite3_xxx API functions from within an unlock-notify callback, a
+** crash or deadlock may be the result.
+**
+** ^Unless deadlock is detected (see below), sqlite3_unlock_notify() always
+** returns SQLITE_OK.
+**
+** Callback Invocation Details
+**
+** When an unlock-notify callback is registered, the application provides a
+** single void* pointer that is passed to the callback when it is invoked.
+** However, the signature of the callback function allows SQLite to pass
+** it an array of void* context pointers. The first argument passed to
+** an unlock-notify callback is a pointer to an array of void* pointers,
+** and the second is the number of entries in the array.
+**
+** When a blocking connection's transaction is concluded, there may be
+** more than one blocked connection that has registered for an unlock-notify
+** callback. ^If two or more such blocked connections have specified the
+** same callback function, then instead of invoking the callback function
+** multiple times, it is invoked once with the set of void* context pointers
+** specified by the blocked connections bundled together into an array.
+** This gives the application an opportunity to prioritize any actions
+** related to the set of unblocked database connections.
+**
+** Deadlock Detection
+**
+** Assuming that after registering for an unlock-notify callback a
+** database waits for the callback to be issued before taking any further
+** action (a reasonable assumption), then using this API may cause the
+** application to deadlock. For example, if connection X is waiting for
+** connection Y's transaction to be concluded, and similarly connection
+** Y is waiting on connection X's transaction, then neither connection
+** will proceed and the system may remain deadlocked indefinitely.
+**
+** To avoid this scenario, the sqlite3_unlock_notify() performs deadlock
+** detection. ^If a given call to sqlite3_unlock_notify() would put the
+** system in a deadlocked state, then SQLITE_LOCKED is returned and no
+** unlock-notify callback is registered. The system is said to be in
+** a deadlocked state if connection A has registered for an unlock-notify
+** callback on the conclusion of connection B's transaction, and connection
+** B has itself registered for an unlock-notify callback when connection
+** A's transaction is concluded. ^Indirect deadlock is also detected, so
+** the system is also considered to be deadlocked if connection B has
+** registered for an unlock-notify callback on the conclusion of connection
+** C's transaction, where connection C is waiting on connection A. ^Any
+** number of levels of indirection are allowed.
+**
+** The "DROP TABLE" Exception
+**
+** When a call to [sqlite3_step()] returns SQLITE_LOCKED, it is almost
+** always appropriate to call sqlite3_unlock_notify(). There is however,
+** one exception. When executing a "DROP TABLE" or "DROP INDEX" statement,
+** SQLite checks if there are any currently executing SELECT statements
+** that belong to the same connection. If there are, SQLITE_LOCKED is
+** returned. In this case there is no "blocking connection", so invoking
+** sqlite3_unlock_notify() results in the unlock-notify callback being
+** invoked immediately. If the application then re-attempts the "DROP TABLE"
+** or "DROP INDEX" query, an infinite loop might be the result.
+**
+** One way around this problem is to check the extended error code returned
+** by an sqlite3_step() call. ^(If there is a blocking connection, then the
+** extended error code is set to SQLITE_LOCKED_SHAREDCACHE. Otherwise, in
+** the special "DROP TABLE/INDEX" case, the extended error code is just
+** SQLITE_LOCKED.)^
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_unlock_notify(
+ sqlite3 *pBlocked, /* Waiting connection */
+ void (*xNotify)(void **apArg, int nArg), /* Callback function to invoke */
+ void *pNotifyArg /* Argument to pass to xNotify */
+);
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: String Comparison
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_stricmp()] and [sqlite3_strnicmp()] APIs allow applications
+** and extensions to compare the contents of two buffers containing UTF-8
+** strings in a case-independent fashion, using the same definition of "case
+** independence" that SQLite uses internally when comparing identifiers.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_stricmp(const char *, const char *);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_strnicmp(const char *, const char *, int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: String Globbing
+*
+** ^The [sqlite3_strglob(P,X)] interface returns zero if and only if
+** string X matches the [GLOB] pattern P.
+** ^The definition of [GLOB] pattern matching used in
+** [sqlite3_strglob(P,X)] is the same as for the "X GLOB P" operator in the
+** SQL dialect understood by SQLite. ^The [sqlite3_strglob(P,X)] function
+** is case sensitive.
+**
+** Note that this routine returns zero on a match and non-zero if the strings
+** do not match, the same as [sqlite3_stricmp()] and [sqlite3_strnicmp()].
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_strlike()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_strglob(const char *zGlob, const char *zStr);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: String LIKE Matching
+*
+** ^The [sqlite3_strlike(P,X,E)] interface returns zero if and only if
+** string X matches the [LIKE] pattern P with escape character E.
+** ^The definition of [LIKE] pattern matching used in
+** [sqlite3_strlike(P,X,E)] is the same as for the "X LIKE P ESCAPE E"
+** operator in the SQL dialect understood by SQLite. ^For "X LIKE P" without
+** the ESCAPE clause, set the E parameter of [sqlite3_strlike(P,X,E)] to 0.
+** ^As with the LIKE operator, the [sqlite3_strlike(P,X,E)] function is case
+** insensitive - equivalent upper and lower case ASCII characters match
+** one another.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_strlike(P,X,E)] function matches Unicode characters, though
+** only ASCII characters are case folded.
+**
+** Note that this routine returns zero on a match and non-zero if the strings
+** do not match, the same as [sqlite3_stricmp()] and [sqlite3_strnicmp()].
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_strglob()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_strlike(const char *zGlob, const char *zStr, unsigned int cEsc);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Error Logging Interface
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_log()] interface writes a message into the [error log]
+** established by the [SQLITE_CONFIG_LOG] option to [sqlite3_config()].
+** ^If logging is enabled, the zFormat string and subsequent arguments are
+** used with [sqlite3_snprintf()] to generate the final output string.
+**
+** The sqlite3_log() interface is intended for use by extensions such as
+** virtual tables, collating functions, and SQL functions. While there is
+** nothing to prevent an application from calling sqlite3_log(), doing so
+** is considered bad form.
+**
+** The zFormat string must not be NULL.
+**
+** To avoid deadlocks and other threading problems, the sqlite3_log() routine
+** will not use dynamically allocated memory. The log message is stored in
+** a fixed-length buffer on the stack. If the log message is longer than
+** a few hundred characters, it will be truncated to the length of the
+** buffer.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_log(int iErrCode, const char *zFormat, ...);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Write-Ahead Log Commit Hook
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_wal_hook()] function is used to register a callback that
+** is invoked each time data is committed to a database in wal mode.
+**
+** ^(The callback is invoked by SQLite after the commit has taken place and
+** the associated write-lock on the database released)^, so the implementation
+** may read, write or [checkpoint] the database as required.
+**
+** ^The first parameter passed to the callback function when it is invoked
+** is a copy of the third parameter passed to sqlite3_wal_hook() when
+** registering the callback. ^The second is a copy of the database handle.
+** ^The third parameter is the name of the database that was written to -
+** either "main" or the name of an [ATTACH]-ed database. ^The fourth parameter
+** is the number of pages currently in the write-ahead log file,
+** including those that were just committed.
+**
+** The callback function should normally return [SQLITE_OK]. ^If an error
+** code is returned, that error will propagate back up through the
+** SQLite code base to cause the statement that provoked the callback
+** to report an error, though the commit will have still occurred. If the
+** callback returns [SQLITE_ROW] or [SQLITE_DONE], or if it returns a value
+** that does not correspond to any valid SQLite error code, the results
+** are undefined.
+**
+** A single database handle may have at most a single write-ahead log callback
+** registered at one time. ^Calling [sqlite3_wal_hook()] replaces any
+** previously registered write-ahead log callback. ^Note that the
+** [sqlite3_wal_autocheckpoint()] interface and the
+** [wal_autocheckpoint pragma] both invoke [sqlite3_wal_hook()] and will
+** overwrite any prior [sqlite3_wal_hook()] settings.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_wal_hook(
+ sqlite3*,
+ int(*)(void *,sqlite3*,const char*,int),
+ void*
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Configure an auto-checkpoint
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_wal_autocheckpoint(D,N)] is a wrapper around
+** [sqlite3_wal_hook()] that causes any database on [database connection] D
+** to automatically [checkpoint]
+** after committing a transaction if there are N or
+** more frames in the [write-ahead log] file. ^Passing zero or
+** a negative value as the nFrame parameter disables automatic
+** checkpoints entirely.
+**
+** ^The callback registered by this function replaces any existing callback
+** registered using [sqlite3_wal_hook()]. ^Likewise, registering a callback
+** using [sqlite3_wal_hook()] disables the automatic checkpoint mechanism
+** configured by this function.
+**
+** ^The [wal_autocheckpoint pragma] can be used to invoke this interface
+** from SQL.
+**
+** ^Checkpoints initiated by this mechanism are
+** [sqlite3_wal_checkpoint_v2|PASSIVE].
+**
+** ^Every new [database connection] defaults to having the auto-checkpoint
+** enabled with a threshold of 1000 or [SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_AUTOCHECKPOINT]
+** pages. The use of this interface
+** is only necessary if the default setting is found to be suboptimal
+** for a particular application.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_wal_autocheckpoint(sqlite3 *db, int N);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Checkpoint a database
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^(The sqlite3_wal_checkpoint(D,X) is equivalent to
+** [sqlite3_wal_checkpoint_v2](D,X,[SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_PASSIVE],0,0).)^
+**
+** In brief, sqlite3_wal_checkpoint(D,X) causes the content in the
+** [write-ahead log] for database X on [database connection] D to be
+** transferred into the database file and for the write-ahead log to
+** be reset. See the [checkpointing] documentation for addition
+** information.
+**
+** This interface used to be the only way to cause a checkpoint to
+** occur. But then the newer and more powerful [sqlite3_wal_checkpoint_v2()]
+** interface was added. This interface is retained for backwards
+** compatibility and as a convenience for applications that need to manually
+** start a callback but which do not need the full power (and corresponding
+** complication) of [sqlite3_wal_checkpoint_v2()].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_wal_checkpoint(sqlite3 *db, const char *zDb);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Checkpoint a database
+** METHOD: sqlite3
+**
+** ^(The sqlite3_wal_checkpoint_v2(D,X,M,L,C) interface runs a checkpoint
+** operation on database X of [database connection] D in mode M. Status
+** information is written back into integers pointed to by L and C.)^
+** ^(The M parameter must be a valid [checkpoint mode]:)^
+**
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_PASSIVE
+** ^Checkpoint as many frames as possible without waiting for any database
+** readers or writers to finish, then sync the database file if all frames
+** in the log were checkpointed. ^The [busy-handler callback]
+** is never invoked in the SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_PASSIVE mode.
+** ^On the other hand, passive mode might leave the checkpoint unfinished
+** if there are concurrent readers or writers.
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_FULL
+** ^This mode blocks (it invokes the
+** [sqlite3_busy_handler|busy-handler callback]) until there is no
+** database writer and all readers are reading from the most recent database
+** snapshot. ^It then checkpoints all frames in the log file and syncs the
+** database file. ^This mode blocks new database writers while it is pending,
+** but new database readers are allowed to continue unimpeded.
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_RESTART
+** ^This mode works the same way as SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_FULL with the addition
+** that after checkpointing the log file it blocks (calls the
+** [busy-handler callback])
+** until all readers are reading from the database file only. ^This ensures
+** that the next writer will restart the log file from the beginning.
+** ^Like SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_FULL, this mode blocks new
+** database writer attempts while it is pending, but does not impede readers.
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_TRUNCATE
+** ^This mode works the same way as SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_RESTART with the
+** addition that it also truncates the log file to zero bytes just prior
+** to a successful return.
+**
+**
+** ^If pnLog is not NULL, then *pnLog is set to the total number of frames in
+** the log file or to -1 if the checkpoint could not run because
+** of an error or because the database is not in [WAL mode]. ^If pnCkpt is not
+** NULL,then *pnCkpt is set to the total number of checkpointed frames in the
+** log file (including any that were already checkpointed before the function
+** was called) or to -1 if the checkpoint could not run due to an error or
+** because the database is not in WAL mode. ^Note that upon successful
+** completion of an SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_TRUNCATE, the log file will have been
+** truncated to zero bytes and so both *pnLog and *pnCkpt will be set to zero.
+**
+** ^All calls obtain an exclusive "checkpoint" lock on the database file. ^If
+** any other process is running a checkpoint operation at the same time, the
+** lock cannot be obtained and SQLITE_BUSY is returned. ^Even if there is a
+** busy-handler configured, it will not be invoked in this case.
+**
+** ^The SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_FULL, RESTART and TRUNCATE modes also obtain the
+** exclusive "writer" lock on the database file. ^If the writer lock cannot be
+** obtained immediately, and a busy-handler is configured, it is invoked and
+** the writer lock retried until either the busy-handler returns 0 or the lock
+** is successfully obtained. ^The busy-handler is also invoked while waiting for
+** database readers as described above. ^If the busy-handler returns 0 before
+** the writer lock is obtained or while waiting for database readers, the
+** checkpoint operation proceeds from that point in the same way as
+** SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_PASSIVE - checkpointing as many frames as possible
+** without blocking any further. ^SQLITE_BUSY is returned in this case.
+**
+** ^If parameter zDb is NULL or points to a zero length string, then the
+** specified operation is attempted on all WAL databases [attached] to
+** [database connection] db. In this case the
+** values written to output parameters *pnLog and *pnCkpt are undefined. ^If
+** an SQLITE_BUSY error is encountered when processing one or more of the
+** attached WAL databases, the operation is still attempted on any remaining
+** attached databases and SQLITE_BUSY is returned at the end. ^If any other
+** error occurs while processing an attached database, processing is abandoned
+** and the error code is returned to the caller immediately. ^If no error
+** (SQLITE_BUSY or otherwise) is encountered while processing the attached
+** databases, SQLITE_OK is returned.
+**
+** ^If database zDb is the name of an attached database that is not in WAL
+** mode, SQLITE_OK is returned and both *pnLog and *pnCkpt set to -1. ^If
+** zDb is not NULL (or a zero length string) and is not the name of any
+** attached database, SQLITE_ERROR is returned to the caller.
+**
+** ^Unless it returns SQLITE_MISUSE,
+** the sqlite3_wal_checkpoint_v2() interface
+** sets the error information that is queried by
+** [sqlite3_errcode()] and [sqlite3_errmsg()].
+**
+** ^The [PRAGMA wal_checkpoint] command can be used to invoke this interface
+** from SQL.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_wal_checkpoint_v2(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */
+ const char *zDb, /* Name of attached database (or NULL) */
+ int eMode, /* SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_* value */
+ int *pnLog, /* OUT: Size of WAL log in frames */
+ int *pnCkpt /* OUT: Total number of frames checkpointed */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Checkpoint Mode Values
+** KEYWORDS: {checkpoint mode}
+**
+** These constants define all valid values for the "checkpoint mode" passed
+** as the third parameter to the [sqlite3_wal_checkpoint_v2()] interface.
+** See the [sqlite3_wal_checkpoint_v2()] documentation for details on the
+** meaning of each of these checkpoint modes.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_PASSIVE 0 /* Do as much as possible w/o blocking */
+#define SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_FULL 1 /* Wait for writers, then checkpoint */
+#define SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_RESTART 2 /* Like FULL but wait for for readers */
+#define SQLITE_CHECKPOINT_TRUNCATE 3 /* Like RESTART but also truncate WAL */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Virtual Table Interface Configuration
+**
+** This function may be called by either the [xConnect] or [xCreate] method
+** of a [virtual table] implementation to configure
+** various facets of the virtual table interface.
+**
+** If this interface is invoked outside the context of an xConnect or
+** xCreate virtual table method then the behavior is undefined.
+**
+** In the call sqlite3_vtab_config(D,C,...) the D parameter is the
+** [database connection] in which the virtual table is being created and
+** which is passed in as the first argument to the [xConnect] or [xCreate]
+** method that is invoking sqlite3_vtab_config(). The C parameter is one
+** of the [virtual table configuration options]. The presence and meaning
+** of parameters after C depend on which [virtual table configuration option]
+** is used.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_vtab_config(sqlite3*, int op, ...);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Virtual Table Configuration Options
+** KEYWORDS: {virtual table configuration options}
+** KEYWORDS: {virtual table configuration option}
+**
+** These macros define the various options to the
+** [sqlite3_vtab_config()] interface that [virtual table] implementations
+** can use to customize and optimize their behavior.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_VTAB_CONSTRAINT_SUPPORT]]
+**
SQLITE_VTAB_CONSTRAINT_SUPPORT
+**
Calls of the form
+** [sqlite3_vtab_config](db,SQLITE_VTAB_CONSTRAINT_SUPPORT,X) are supported,
+** where X is an integer. If X is zero, then the [virtual table] whose
+** [xCreate] or [xConnect] method invoked [sqlite3_vtab_config()] does not
+** support constraints. In this configuration (which is the default) if
+** a call to the [xUpdate] method returns [SQLITE_CONSTRAINT], then the entire
+** statement is rolled back as if [ON CONFLICT | OR ABORT] had been
+** specified as part of the users SQL statement, regardless of the actual
+** ON CONFLICT mode specified.
+**
+** If X is non-zero, then the virtual table implementation guarantees
+** that if [xUpdate] returns [SQLITE_CONSTRAINT], it will do so before
+** any modifications to internal or persistent data structures have been made.
+** If the [ON CONFLICT] mode is ABORT, FAIL, IGNORE or ROLLBACK, SQLite
+** is able to roll back a statement or database transaction, and abandon
+** or continue processing the current SQL statement as appropriate.
+** If the ON CONFLICT mode is REPLACE and the [xUpdate] method returns
+** [SQLITE_CONSTRAINT], SQLite handles this as if the ON CONFLICT mode
+** had been ABORT.
+**
+** Virtual table implementations that are required to handle OR REPLACE
+** must do so within the [xUpdate] method. If a call to the
+** [sqlite3_vtab_on_conflict()] function indicates that the current ON
+** CONFLICT policy is REPLACE, the virtual table implementation should
+** silently replace the appropriate rows within the xUpdate callback and
+** return SQLITE_OK. Or, if this is not possible, it may return
+** SQLITE_CONSTRAINT, in which case SQLite falls back to OR ABORT
+** constraint handling.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_VTAB_DIRECTONLY]]
SQLITE_VTAB_DIRECTONLY
+**
Calls of the form
+** [sqlite3_vtab_config](db,SQLITE_VTAB_DIRECTONLY) from within the
+** the [xConnect] or [xCreate] methods of a [virtual table] implmentation
+** prohibits that virtual table from being used from within triggers and
+** views.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_VTAB_INNOCUOUS]]
SQLITE_VTAB_INNOCUOUS
+**
Calls of the form
+** [sqlite3_vtab_config](db,SQLITE_VTAB_INNOCUOUS) from within the
+** the [xConnect] or [xCreate] methods of a [virtual table] implmentation
+** identify that virtual table as being safe to use from within triggers
+** and views. Conceptually, the SQLITE_VTAB_INNOCUOUS tag means that the
+** virtual table can do no serious harm even if it is controlled by a
+** malicious hacker. Developers should avoid setting the SQLITE_VTAB_INNOCUOUS
+** flag unless absolutely necessary.
+**
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_VTAB_CONSTRAINT_SUPPORT 1
+#define SQLITE_VTAB_INNOCUOUS 2
+#define SQLITE_VTAB_DIRECTONLY 3
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Determine The Virtual Table Conflict Policy
+**
+** This function may only be called from within a call to the [xUpdate] method
+** of a [virtual table] implementation for an INSERT or UPDATE operation. ^The
+** value returned is one of [SQLITE_ROLLBACK], [SQLITE_IGNORE], [SQLITE_FAIL],
+** [SQLITE_ABORT], or [SQLITE_REPLACE], according to the [ON CONFLICT] mode
+** of the SQL statement that triggered the call to the [xUpdate] method of the
+** [virtual table].
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_vtab_on_conflict(sqlite3 *);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Determine If Virtual Table Column Access Is For UPDATE
+**
+** If the sqlite3_vtab_nochange(X) routine is called within the [xColumn]
+** method of a [virtual table], then it returns true if and only if the
+** column is being fetched as part of an UPDATE operation during which the
+** column value will not change. Applications might use this to substitute
+** a return value that is less expensive to compute and that the corresponding
+** [xUpdate] method understands as a "no-change" value.
+**
+** If the [xColumn] method calls sqlite3_vtab_nochange() and finds that
+** the column is not changed by the UPDATE statement, then the xColumn
+** method can optionally return without setting a result, without calling
+** any of the [sqlite3_result_int|sqlite3_result_xxxxx() interfaces].
+** In that case, [sqlite3_value_nochange(X)] will return true for the
+** same column in the [xUpdate] method.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_vtab_nochange(sqlite3_context*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Determine The Collation For a Virtual Table Constraint
+**
+** This function may only be called from within a call to the [xBestIndex]
+** method of a [virtual table].
+**
+** The first argument must be the sqlite3_index_info object that is the
+** first parameter to the xBestIndex() method. The second argument must be
+** an index into the aConstraint[] array belonging to the sqlite3_index_info
+** structure passed to xBestIndex. This function returns a pointer to a buffer
+** containing the name of the collation sequence for the corresponding
+** constraint.
+*/
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_EXPERIMENTAL const char *sqlite3_vtab_collation(sqlite3_index_info*,int);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Conflict resolution modes
+** KEYWORDS: {conflict resolution mode}
+**
+** These constants are returned by [sqlite3_vtab_on_conflict()] to
+** inform a [virtual table] implementation what the [ON CONFLICT] mode
+** is for the SQL statement being evaluated.
+**
+** Note that the [SQLITE_IGNORE] constant is also used as a potential
+** return value from the [sqlite3_set_authorizer()] callback and that
+** [SQLITE_ABORT] is also a [result code].
+*/
+#define SQLITE_ROLLBACK 1
+/* #define SQLITE_IGNORE 2 // Also used by sqlite3_authorizer() callback */
+#define SQLITE_FAIL 3
+/* #define SQLITE_ABORT 4 // Also an error code */
+#define SQLITE_REPLACE 5
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Prepared Statement Scan Status Opcodes
+** KEYWORDS: {scanstatus options}
+**
+** The following constants can be used for the T parameter to the
+** [sqlite3_stmt_scanstatus(S,X,T,V)] interface. Each constant designates a
+** different metric for sqlite3_stmt_scanstatus() to return.
+**
+** When the value returned to V is a string, space to hold that string is
+** managed by the prepared statement S and will be automatically freed when
+** S is finalized.
+**
+**
+** [[SQLITE_SCANSTAT_NLOOP]]
SQLITE_SCANSTAT_NLOOP
+**
^The [sqlite3_int64] variable pointed to by the V parameter will be
+** set to the total number of times that the X-th loop has run.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_SCANSTAT_NVISIT]]
SQLITE_SCANSTAT_NVISIT
+**
^The [sqlite3_int64] variable pointed to by the V parameter will be set
+** to the total number of rows examined by all iterations of the X-th loop.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_SCANSTAT_EST]]
SQLITE_SCANSTAT_EST
+**
^The "double" variable pointed to by the V parameter will be set to the
+** query planner's estimate for the average number of rows output from each
+** iteration of the X-th loop. If the query planner's estimates was accurate,
+** then this value will approximate the quotient NVISIT/NLOOP and the
+** product of this value for all prior loops with the same SELECTID will
+** be the NLOOP value for the current loop.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_SCANSTAT_NAME]]
SQLITE_SCANSTAT_NAME
+**
^The "const char *" variable pointed to by the V parameter will be set
+** to a zero-terminated UTF-8 string containing the name of the index or table
+** used for the X-th loop.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_SCANSTAT_EXPLAIN]]
SQLITE_SCANSTAT_EXPLAIN
+**
^The "const char *" variable pointed to by the V parameter will be set
+** to a zero-terminated UTF-8 string containing the [EXPLAIN QUERY PLAN]
+** description for the X-th loop.
+**
+** [[SQLITE_SCANSTAT_SELECTID]]
SQLITE_SCANSTAT_SELECT
+**
^The "int" variable pointed to by the V parameter will be set to the
+** "select-id" for the X-th loop. The select-id identifies which query or
+** subquery the loop is part of. The main query has a select-id of zero.
+** The select-id is the same value as is output in the first column
+** of an [EXPLAIN QUERY PLAN] query.
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_SCANSTAT_NLOOP 0
+#define SQLITE_SCANSTAT_NVISIT 1
+#define SQLITE_SCANSTAT_EST 2
+#define SQLITE_SCANSTAT_NAME 3
+#define SQLITE_SCANSTAT_EXPLAIN 4
+#define SQLITE_SCANSTAT_SELECTID 5
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Prepared Statement Scan Status
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** This interface returns information about the predicted and measured
+** performance for pStmt. Advanced applications can use this
+** interface to compare the predicted and the measured performance and
+** issue warnings and/or rerun [ANALYZE] if discrepancies are found.
+**
+** Since this interface is expected to be rarely used, it is only
+** available if SQLite is compiled using the [SQLITE_ENABLE_STMT_SCANSTATUS]
+** compile-time option.
+**
+** The "iScanStatusOp" parameter determines which status information to return.
+** The "iScanStatusOp" must be one of the [scanstatus options] or the behavior
+** of this interface is undefined.
+** ^The requested measurement is written into a variable pointed to by
+** the "pOut" parameter.
+** Parameter "idx" identifies the specific loop to retrieve statistics for.
+** Loops are numbered starting from zero. ^If idx is out of range - less than
+** zero or greater than or equal to the total number of loops used to implement
+** the statement - a non-zero value is returned and the variable that pOut
+** points to is unchanged.
+**
+** ^Statistics might not be available for all loops in all statements. ^In cases
+** where there exist loops with no available statistics, this function behaves
+** as if the loop did not exist - it returns non-zero and leave the variable
+** that pOut points to unchanged.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_stmt_scanstatus_reset()]
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_stmt_scanstatus(
+ sqlite3_stmt *pStmt, /* Prepared statement for which info desired */
+ int idx, /* Index of loop to report on */
+ int iScanStatusOp, /* Information desired. SQLITE_SCANSTAT_* */
+ void *pOut /* Result written here */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Zero Scan-Status Counters
+** METHOD: sqlite3_stmt
+**
+** ^Zero all [sqlite3_stmt_scanstatus()] related event counters.
+**
+** This API is only available if the library is built with pre-processor
+** symbol [SQLITE_ENABLE_STMT_SCANSTATUS] defined.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_stmt_scanstatus_reset(sqlite3_stmt*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Flush caches to disk mid-transaction
+**
+** ^If a write-transaction is open on [database connection] D when the
+** [sqlite3_db_cacheflush(D)] interface invoked, any dirty
+** pages in the pager-cache that are not currently in use are written out
+** to disk. A dirty page may be in use if a database cursor created by an
+** active SQL statement is reading from it, or if it is page 1 of a database
+** file (page 1 is always "in use"). ^The [sqlite3_db_cacheflush(D)]
+** interface flushes caches for all schemas - "main", "temp", and
+** any [attached] databases.
+**
+** ^If this function needs to obtain extra database locks before dirty pages
+** can be flushed to disk, it does so. ^If those locks cannot be obtained
+** immediately and there is a busy-handler callback configured, it is invoked
+** in the usual manner. ^If the required lock still cannot be obtained, then
+** the database is skipped and an attempt made to flush any dirty pages
+** belonging to the next (if any) database. ^If any databases are skipped
+** because locks cannot be obtained, but no other error occurs, this
+** function returns SQLITE_BUSY.
+**
+** ^If any other error occurs while flushing dirty pages to disk (for
+** example an IO error or out-of-memory condition), then processing is
+** abandoned and an SQLite [error code] is returned to the caller immediately.
+**
+** ^Otherwise, if no error occurs, [sqlite3_db_cacheflush()] returns SQLITE_OK.
+**
+** ^This function does not set the database handle error code or message
+** returned by the [sqlite3_errcode()] and [sqlite3_errmsg()] functions.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_db_cacheflush(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: The pre-update hook.
+**
+** ^These interfaces are only available if SQLite is compiled using the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_PREUPDATE_HOOK] compile-time option.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_preupdate_hook()] interface registers a callback function
+** that is invoked prior to each [INSERT], [UPDATE], and [DELETE] operation
+** on a database table.
+** ^At most one preupdate hook may be registered at a time on a single
+** [database connection]; each call to [sqlite3_preupdate_hook()] overrides
+** the previous setting.
+** ^The preupdate hook is disabled by invoking [sqlite3_preupdate_hook()]
+** with a NULL pointer as the second parameter.
+** ^The third parameter to [sqlite3_preupdate_hook()] is passed through as
+** the first parameter to callbacks.
+**
+** ^The preupdate hook only fires for changes to real database tables; the
+** preupdate hook is not invoked for changes to [virtual tables] or to
+** system tables like sqlite_sequence or sqlite_stat1.
+**
+** ^The second parameter to the preupdate callback is a pointer to
+** the [database connection] that registered the preupdate hook.
+** ^The third parameter to the preupdate callback is one of the constants
+** [SQLITE_INSERT], [SQLITE_DELETE], or [SQLITE_UPDATE] to identify the
+** kind of update operation that is about to occur.
+** ^(The fourth parameter to the preupdate callback is the name of the
+** database within the database connection that is being modified. This
+** will be "main" for the main database or "temp" for TEMP tables or
+** the name given after the AS keyword in the [ATTACH] statement for attached
+** databases.)^
+** ^The fifth parameter to the preupdate callback is the name of the
+** table that is being modified.
+**
+** For an UPDATE or DELETE operation on a [rowid table], the sixth
+** parameter passed to the preupdate callback is the initial [rowid] of the
+** row being modified or deleted. For an INSERT operation on a rowid table,
+** or any operation on a WITHOUT ROWID table, the value of the sixth
+** parameter is undefined. For an INSERT or UPDATE on a rowid table the
+** seventh parameter is the final rowid value of the row being inserted
+** or updated. The value of the seventh parameter passed to the callback
+** function is not defined for operations on WITHOUT ROWID tables, or for
+** INSERT operations on rowid tables.
+**
+** The [sqlite3_preupdate_old()], [sqlite3_preupdate_new()],
+** [sqlite3_preupdate_count()], and [sqlite3_preupdate_depth()] interfaces
+** provide additional information about a preupdate event. These routines
+** may only be called from within a preupdate callback. Invoking any of
+** these routines from outside of a preupdate callback or with a
+** [database connection] pointer that is different from the one supplied
+** to the preupdate callback results in undefined and probably undesirable
+** behavior.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_preupdate_count(D)] interface returns the number of columns
+** in the row that is being inserted, updated, or deleted.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_preupdate_old(D,N,P)] interface writes into P a pointer to
+** a [protected sqlite3_value] that contains the value of the Nth column of
+** the table row before it is updated. The N parameter must be between 0
+** and one less than the number of columns or the behavior will be
+** undefined. This must only be used within SQLITE_UPDATE and SQLITE_DELETE
+** preupdate callbacks; if it is used by an SQLITE_INSERT callback then the
+** behavior is undefined. The [sqlite3_value] that P points to
+** will be destroyed when the preupdate callback returns.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_preupdate_new(D,N,P)] interface writes into P a pointer to
+** a [protected sqlite3_value] that contains the value of the Nth column of
+** the table row after it is updated. The N parameter must be between 0
+** and one less than the number of columns or the behavior will be
+** undefined. This must only be used within SQLITE_INSERT and SQLITE_UPDATE
+** preupdate callbacks; if it is used by an SQLITE_DELETE callback then the
+** behavior is undefined. The [sqlite3_value] that P points to
+** will be destroyed when the preupdate callback returns.
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_preupdate_depth(D)] interface returns 0 if the preupdate
+** callback was invoked as a result of a direct insert, update, or delete
+** operation; or 1 for inserts, updates, or deletes invoked by top-level
+** triggers; or 2 for changes resulting from triggers called by top-level
+** triggers; and so forth.
+**
+** See also: [sqlite3_update_hook()]
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_PREUPDATE_HOOK)
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_preupdate_hook(
+ sqlite3 *db,
+ void(*xPreUpdate)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of third arg to preupdate_hook() */
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */
+ int op, /* SQLITE_UPDATE, DELETE or INSERT */
+ char const *zDb, /* Database name */
+ char const *zName, /* Table name */
+ sqlite3_int64 iKey1, /* Rowid of row about to be deleted/updated */
+ sqlite3_int64 iKey2 /* New rowid value (for a rowid UPDATE) */
+ ),
+ void*
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_preupdate_old(sqlite3 *, int, sqlite3_value **);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_preupdate_count(sqlite3 *);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_preupdate_depth(sqlite3 *);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_preupdate_new(sqlite3 *, int, sqlite3_value **);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Low-level system error code
+**
+** ^Attempt to return the underlying operating system error code or error
+** number that caused the most recent I/O error or failure to open a file.
+** The return value is OS-dependent. For example, on unix systems, after
+** [sqlite3_open_v2()] returns [SQLITE_CANTOPEN], this interface could be
+** called to get back the underlying "errno" that caused the problem, such
+** as ENOSPC, EAUTH, EISDIR, and so forth.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_system_errno(sqlite3*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Database Snapshot
+** KEYWORDS: {snapshot} {sqlite3_snapshot}
+**
+** An instance of the snapshot object records the state of a [WAL mode]
+** database for some specific point in history.
+**
+** In [WAL mode], multiple [database connections] that are open on the
+** same database file can each be reading a different historical version
+** of the database file. When a [database connection] begins a read
+** transaction, that connection sees an unchanging copy of the database
+** as it existed for the point in time when the transaction first started.
+** Subsequent changes to the database from other connections are not seen
+** by the reader until a new read transaction is started.
+**
+** The sqlite3_snapshot object records state information about an historical
+** version of the database file so that it is possible to later open a new read
+** transaction that sees that historical version of the database rather than
+** the most recent version.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_snapshot {
+ unsigned char hidden[48];
+} sqlite3_snapshot;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Record A Database Snapshot
+** CONSTRUCTOR: sqlite3_snapshot
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_snapshot_get(D,S,P)] interface attempts to make a
+** new [sqlite3_snapshot] object that records the current state of
+** schema S in database connection D. ^On success, the
+** [sqlite3_snapshot_get(D,S,P)] interface writes a pointer to the newly
+** created [sqlite3_snapshot] object into *P and returns SQLITE_OK.
+** If there is not already a read-transaction open on schema S when
+** this function is called, one is opened automatically.
+**
+** The following must be true for this function to succeed. If any of
+** the following statements are false when sqlite3_snapshot_get() is
+** called, SQLITE_ERROR is returned. The final value of *P is undefined
+** in this case.
+**
+**
+**
The database handle must not be in [autocommit mode].
+**
+**
Schema S of [database connection] D must be a [WAL mode] database.
+**
+**
There must not be a write transaction open on schema S of database
+** connection D.
+**
+**
One or more transactions must have been written to the current wal
+** file since it was created on disk (by any connection). This means
+** that a snapshot cannot be taken on a wal mode database with no wal
+** file immediately after it is first opened. At least one transaction
+** must be written to it first.
+**
+**
+** This function may also return SQLITE_NOMEM. If it is called with the
+** database handle in autocommit mode but fails for some other reason,
+** whether or not a read transaction is opened on schema S is undefined.
+**
+** The [sqlite3_snapshot] object returned from a successful call to
+** [sqlite3_snapshot_get()] must be freed using [sqlite3_snapshot_free()]
+** to avoid a memory leak.
+**
+** The [sqlite3_snapshot_get()] interface is only available when the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_SNAPSHOT] compile-time option is used.
+*/
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_EXPERIMENTAL int sqlite3_snapshot_get(
+ sqlite3 *db,
+ const char *zSchema,
+ sqlite3_snapshot **ppSnapshot
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Start a read transaction on an historical snapshot
+** METHOD: sqlite3_snapshot
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_snapshot_open(D,S,P)] interface either starts a new read
+** transaction or upgrades an existing one for schema S of
+** [database connection] D such that the read transaction refers to
+** historical [snapshot] P, rather than the most recent change to the
+** database. ^The [sqlite3_snapshot_open()] interface returns SQLITE_OK
+** on success or an appropriate [error code] if it fails.
+**
+** ^In order to succeed, the database connection must not be in
+** [autocommit mode] when [sqlite3_snapshot_open(D,S,P)] is called. If there
+** is already a read transaction open on schema S, then the database handle
+** must have no active statements (SELECT statements that have been passed
+** to sqlite3_step() but not sqlite3_reset() or sqlite3_finalize()).
+** SQLITE_ERROR is returned if either of these conditions is violated, or
+** if schema S does not exist, or if the snapshot object is invalid.
+**
+** ^A call to sqlite3_snapshot_open() will fail to open if the specified
+** snapshot has been overwritten by a [checkpoint]. In this case
+** SQLITE_ERROR_SNAPSHOT is returned.
+**
+** If there is already a read transaction open when this function is
+** invoked, then the same read transaction remains open (on the same
+** database snapshot) if SQLITE_ERROR, SQLITE_BUSY or SQLITE_ERROR_SNAPSHOT
+** is returned. If another error code - for example SQLITE_PROTOCOL or an
+** SQLITE_IOERR error code - is returned, then the final state of the
+** read transaction is undefined. If SQLITE_OK is returned, then the
+** read transaction is now open on database snapshot P.
+**
+** ^(A call to [sqlite3_snapshot_open(D,S,P)] will fail if the
+** database connection D does not know that the database file for
+** schema S is in [WAL mode]. A database connection might not know
+** that the database file is in [WAL mode] if there has been no prior
+** I/O on that database connection, or if the database entered [WAL mode]
+** after the most recent I/O on the database connection.)^
+** (Hint: Run "[PRAGMA application_id]" against a newly opened
+** database connection in order to make it ready to use snapshots.)
+**
+** The [sqlite3_snapshot_open()] interface is only available when the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_SNAPSHOT] compile-time option is used.
+*/
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_EXPERIMENTAL int sqlite3_snapshot_open(
+ sqlite3 *db,
+ const char *zSchema,
+ sqlite3_snapshot *pSnapshot
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Destroy a snapshot
+** DESTRUCTOR: sqlite3_snapshot
+**
+** ^The [sqlite3_snapshot_free(P)] interface destroys [sqlite3_snapshot] P.
+** The application must eventually free every [sqlite3_snapshot] object
+** using this routine to avoid a memory leak.
+**
+** The [sqlite3_snapshot_free()] interface is only available when the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_SNAPSHOT] compile-time option is used.
+*/
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_EXPERIMENTAL void sqlite3_snapshot_free(sqlite3_snapshot*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Compare the ages of two snapshot handles.
+** METHOD: sqlite3_snapshot
+**
+** The sqlite3_snapshot_cmp(P1, P2) interface is used to compare the ages
+** of two valid snapshot handles.
+**
+** If the two snapshot handles are not associated with the same database
+** file, the result of the comparison is undefined.
+**
+** Additionally, the result of the comparison is only valid if both of the
+** snapshot handles were obtained by calling sqlite3_snapshot_get() since the
+** last time the wal file was deleted. The wal file is deleted when the
+** database is changed back to rollback mode or when the number of database
+** clients drops to zero. If either snapshot handle was obtained before the
+** wal file was last deleted, the value returned by this function
+** is undefined.
+**
+** Otherwise, this API returns a negative value if P1 refers to an older
+** snapshot than P2, zero if the two handles refer to the same database
+** snapshot, and a positive value if P1 is a newer snapshot than P2.
+**
+** This interface is only available if SQLite is compiled with the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_SNAPSHOT] option.
+*/
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_EXPERIMENTAL int sqlite3_snapshot_cmp(
+ sqlite3_snapshot *p1,
+ sqlite3_snapshot *p2
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Recover snapshots from a wal file
+** METHOD: sqlite3_snapshot
+**
+** If a [WAL file] remains on disk after all database connections close
+** (either through the use of the [SQLITE_FCNTL_PERSIST_WAL] [file control]
+** or because the last process to have the database opened exited without
+** calling [sqlite3_close()]) and a new connection is subsequently opened
+** on that database and [WAL file], the [sqlite3_snapshot_open()] interface
+** will only be able to open the last transaction added to the WAL file
+** even though the WAL file contains other valid transactions.
+**
+** This function attempts to scan the WAL file associated with database zDb
+** of database handle db and make all valid snapshots available to
+** sqlite3_snapshot_open(). It is an error if there is already a read
+** transaction open on the database, or if the database is not a WAL mode
+** database.
+**
+** SQLITE_OK is returned if successful, or an SQLite error code otherwise.
+**
+** This interface is only available if SQLite is compiled with the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_SNAPSHOT] option.
+*/
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_EXPERIMENTAL int sqlite3_snapshot_recover(sqlite3 *db, const char *zDb);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Serialize a database
+**
+** The sqlite3_serialize(D,S,P,F) interface returns a pointer to memory
+** that is a serialization of the S database on [database connection] D.
+** If P is not a NULL pointer, then the size of the database in bytes
+** is written into *P.
+**
+** For an ordinary on-disk database file, the serialization is just a
+** copy of the disk file. For an in-memory database or a "TEMP" database,
+** the serialization is the same sequence of bytes which would be written
+** to disk if that database where backed up to disk.
+**
+** The usual case is that sqlite3_serialize() copies the serialization of
+** the database into memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc64()] and returns
+** a pointer to that memory. The caller is responsible for freeing the
+** returned value to avoid a memory leak. However, if the F argument
+** contains the SQLITE_SERIALIZE_NOCOPY bit, then no memory allocations
+** are made, and the sqlite3_serialize() function will return a pointer
+** to the contiguous memory representation of the database that SQLite
+** is currently using for that database, or NULL if the no such contiguous
+** memory representation of the database exists. A contiguous memory
+** representation of the database will usually only exist if there has
+** been a prior call to [sqlite3_deserialize(D,S,...)] with the same
+** values of D and S.
+** The size of the database is written into *P even if the
+** SQLITE_SERIALIZE_NOCOPY bit is set but no contiguous copy
+** of the database exists.
+**
+** A call to sqlite3_serialize(D,S,P,F) might return NULL even if the
+** SQLITE_SERIALIZE_NOCOPY bit is omitted from argument F if a memory
+** allocation error occurs.
+**
+** This interface is only available if SQLite is compiled with the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_DESERIALIZE] option.
+*/
+SQLITE_API unsigned char *sqlite3_serialize(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* The database connection */
+ const char *zSchema, /* Which DB to serialize. ex: "main", "temp", ... */
+ sqlite3_int64 *piSize, /* Write size of the DB here, if not NULL */
+ unsigned int mFlags /* Zero or more SQLITE_SERIALIZE_* flags */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Flags for sqlite3_serialize
+**
+** Zero or more of the following constants can be OR-ed together for
+** the F argument to [sqlite3_serialize(D,S,P,F)].
+**
+** SQLITE_SERIALIZE_NOCOPY means that [sqlite3_serialize()] will return
+** a pointer to contiguous in-memory database that it is currently using,
+** without making a copy of the database. If SQLite is not currently using
+** a contiguous in-memory database, then this option causes
+** [sqlite3_serialize()] to return a NULL pointer. SQLite will only be
+** using a contiguous in-memory database if it has been initialized by a
+** prior call to [sqlite3_deserialize()].
+*/
+#define SQLITE_SERIALIZE_NOCOPY 0x001 /* Do no memory allocations */
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Deserialize a database
+**
+** The sqlite3_deserialize(D,S,P,N,M,F) interface causes the
+** [database connection] D to disconnect from database S and then
+** reopen S as an in-memory database based on the serialization contained
+** in P. The serialized database P is N bytes in size. M is the size of
+** the buffer P, which might be larger than N. If M is larger than N, and
+** the SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_READONLY bit is not set in F, then SQLite is
+** permitted to add content to the in-memory database as long as the total
+** size does not exceed M bytes.
+**
+** If the SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_FREEONCLOSE bit is set in F, then SQLite will
+** invoke sqlite3_free() on the serialization buffer when the database
+** connection closes. If the SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_RESIZEABLE bit is set, then
+** SQLite will try to increase the buffer size using sqlite3_realloc64()
+** if writes on the database cause it to grow larger than M bytes.
+**
+** The sqlite3_deserialize() interface will fail with SQLITE_BUSY if the
+** database is currently in a read transaction or is involved in a backup
+** operation.
+**
+** If sqlite3_deserialize(D,S,P,N,M,F) fails for any reason and if the
+** SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_FREEONCLOSE bit is set in argument F, then
+** [sqlite3_free()] is invoked on argument P prior to returning.
+**
+** This interface is only available if SQLite is compiled with the
+** [SQLITE_ENABLE_DESERIALIZE] option.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_deserialize(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* The database connection */
+ const char *zSchema, /* Which DB to reopen with the deserialization */
+ unsigned char *pData, /* The serialized database content */
+ sqlite3_int64 szDb, /* Number bytes in the deserialization */
+ sqlite3_int64 szBuf, /* Total size of buffer pData[] */
+ unsigned mFlags /* Zero or more SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_* flags */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Flags for sqlite3_deserialize()
+**
+** The following are allowed values for 6th argument (the F argument) to
+** the [sqlite3_deserialize(D,S,P,N,M,F)] interface.
+**
+** The SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_FREEONCLOSE means that the database serialization
+** in the P argument is held in memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc64()]
+** and that SQLite should take ownership of this memory and automatically
+** free it when it has finished using it. Without this flag, the caller
+** is responsible for freeing any dynamically allocated memory.
+**
+** The SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_RESIZEABLE flag means that SQLite is allowed to
+** grow the size of the database using calls to [sqlite3_realloc64()]. This
+** flag should only be used if SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_FREEONCLOSE is also used.
+** Without this flag, the deserialized database cannot increase in size beyond
+** the number of bytes specified by the M parameter.
+**
+** The SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_READONLY flag means that the deserialized database
+** should be treated as read-only.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_FREEONCLOSE 1 /* Call sqlite3_free() on close */
+#define SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_RESIZEABLE 2 /* Resize using sqlite3_realloc64() */
+#define SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_READONLY 4 /* Database is read-only */
+
+/*
+** Undo the hack that converts floating point types to integer for
+** builds on processors without floating point support.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+# undef double
+#endif
+
+#if 0
+} /* End of the 'extern "C"' block */
+#endif
+#endif /* SQLITE3_H */
+
+/******** Begin file sqlite3rtree.h *********/
+/*
+** 2010 August 30
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+*/
+
+#ifndef _SQLITE3RTREE_H_
+#define _SQLITE3RTREE_H_
+
+
+#if 0
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+typedef struct sqlite3_rtree_geometry sqlite3_rtree_geometry;
+typedef struct sqlite3_rtree_query_info sqlite3_rtree_query_info;
+
+/* The double-precision datatype used by RTree depends on the
+** SQLITE_RTREE_INT_ONLY compile-time option.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_RTREE_INT_ONLY
+ typedef sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_rtree_dbl;
+#else
+ typedef double sqlite3_rtree_dbl;
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Register a geometry callback named zGeom that can be used as part of an
+** R-Tree geometry query as follows:
+**
+** SELECT ... FROM WHERE MATCH $zGeom(... params ...)
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_rtree_geometry_callback(
+ sqlite3 *db,
+ const char *zGeom,
+ int (*xGeom)(sqlite3_rtree_geometry*, int, sqlite3_rtree_dbl*,int*),
+ void *pContext
+);
+
+
+/*
+** A pointer to a structure of the following type is passed as the first
+** argument to callbacks registered using rtree_geometry_callback().
+*/
+struct sqlite3_rtree_geometry {
+ void *pContext; /* Copy of pContext passed to s_r_g_c() */
+ int nParam; /* Size of array aParam[] */
+ sqlite3_rtree_dbl *aParam; /* Parameters passed to SQL geom function */
+ void *pUser; /* Callback implementation user data */
+ void (*xDelUser)(void *); /* Called by SQLite to clean up pUser */
+};
+
+/*
+** Register a 2nd-generation geometry callback named zScore that can be
+** used as part of an R-Tree geometry query as follows:
+**
+** SELECT ... FROM WHERE MATCH $zQueryFunc(... params ...)
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_rtree_query_callback(
+ sqlite3 *db,
+ const char *zQueryFunc,
+ int (*xQueryFunc)(sqlite3_rtree_query_info*),
+ void *pContext,
+ void (*xDestructor)(void*)
+);
+
+
+/*
+** A pointer to a structure of the following type is passed as the
+** argument to scored geometry callback registered using
+** sqlite3_rtree_query_callback().
+**
+** Note that the first 5 fields of this structure are identical to
+** sqlite3_rtree_geometry. This structure is a subclass of
+** sqlite3_rtree_geometry.
+*/
+struct sqlite3_rtree_query_info {
+ void *pContext; /* pContext from when function registered */
+ int nParam; /* Number of function parameters */
+ sqlite3_rtree_dbl *aParam; /* value of function parameters */
+ void *pUser; /* callback can use this, if desired */
+ void (*xDelUser)(void*); /* function to free pUser */
+ sqlite3_rtree_dbl *aCoord; /* Coordinates of node or entry to check */
+ unsigned int *anQueue; /* Number of pending entries in the queue */
+ int nCoord; /* Number of coordinates */
+ int iLevel; /* Level of current node or entry */
+ int mxLevel; /* The largest iLevel value in the tree */
+ sqlite3_int64 iRowid; /* Rowid for current entry */
+ sqlite3_rtree_dbl rParentScore; /* Score of parent node */
+ int eParentWithin; /* Visibility of parent node */
+ int eWithin; /* OUT: Visibility */
+ sqlite3_rtree_dbl rScore; /* OUT: Write the score here */
+ /* The following fields are only available in 3.8.11 and later */
+ sqlite3_value **apSqlParam; /* Original SQL values of parameters */
+};
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for sqlite3_rtree_query.eWithin and .eParentWithin.
+*/
+#define NOT_WITHIN 0 /* Object completely outside of query region */
+#define PARTLY_WITHIN 1 /* Object partially overlaps query region */
+#define FULLY_WITHIN 2 /* Object fully contained within query region */
+
+
+#if 0
+} /* end of the 'extern "C"' block */
+#endif
+
+#endif /* ifndef _SQLITE3RTREE_H_ */
+
+/******** End of sqlite3rtree.h *********/
+/******** Begin file sqlite3session.h *********/
+
+#if !defined(__SQLITESESSION_H_) && defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_SESSION)
+#define __SQLITESESSION_H_ 1
+
+/*
+** Make sure we can call this stuff from C++.
+*/
+#if 0
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Session Object Handle
+**
+** An instance of this object is a [session] that can be used to
+** record changes to a database.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_session sqlite3_session;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Changeset Iterator Handle
+**
+** An instance of this object acts as a cursor for iterating
+** over the elements of a [changeset] or [patchset].
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_changeset_iter sqlite3_changeset_iter;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Create A New Session Object
+** CONSTRUCTOR: sqlite3_session
+**
+** Create a new session object attached to database handle db. If successful,
+** a pointer to the new object is written to *ppSession and SQLITE_OK is
+** returned. If an error occurs, *ppSession is set to NULL and an SQLite
+** error code (e.g. SQLITE_NOMEM) is returned.
+**
+** It is possible to create multiple session objects attached to a single
+** database handle.
+**
+** Session objects created using this function should be deleted using the
+** [sqlite3session_delete()] function before the database handle that they
+** are attached to is itself closed. If the database handle is closed before
+** the session object is deleted, then the results of calling any session
+** module function, including [sqlite3session_delete()] on the session object
+** are undefined.
+**
+** Because the session module uses the [sqlite3_preupdate_hook()] API, it
+** is not possible for an application to register a pre-update hook on a
+** database handle that has one or more session objects attached. Nor is
+** it possible to create a session object attached to a database handle for
+** which a pre-update hook is already defined. The results of attempting
+** either of these things are undefined.
+**
+** The session object will be used to create changesets for tables in
+** database zDb, where zDb is either "main", or "temp", or the name of an
+** attached database. It is not an error if database zDb is not attached
+** to the database when the session object is created.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_create(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */
+ const char *zDb, /* Name of db (e.g. "main") */
+ sqlite3_session **ppSession /* OUT: New session object */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Delete A Session Object
+** DESTRUCTOR: sqlite3_session
+**
+** Delete a session object previously allocated using
+** [sqlite3session_create()]. Once a session object has been deleted, the
+** results of attempting to use pSession with any other session module
+** function are undefined.
+**
+** Session objects must be deleted before the database handle to which they
+** are attached is closed. Refer to the documentation for
+** [sqlite3session_create()] for details.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3session_delete(sqlite3_session *pSession);
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Enable Or Disable A Session Object
+** METHOD: sqlite3_session
+**
+** Enable or disable the recording of changes by a session object. When
+** enabled, a session object records changes made to the database. When
+** disabled - it does not. A newly created session object is enabled.
+** Refer to the documentation for [sqlite3session_changeset()] for further
+** details regarding how enabling and disabling a session object affects
+** the eventual changesets.
+**
+** Passing zero to this function disables the session. Passing a value
+** greater than zero enables it. Passing a value less than zero is a
+** no-op, and may be used to query the current state of the session.
+**
+** The return value indicates the final state of the session object: 0 if
+** the session is disabled, or 1 if it is enabled.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_enable(sqlite3_session *pSession, int bEnable);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Set Or Clear the Indirect Change Flag
+** METHOD: sqlite3_session
+**
+** Each change recorded by a session object is marked as either direct or
+** indirect. A change is marked as indirect if either:
+**
+**
+**
The session object "indirect" flag is set when the change is
+** made, or
+**
The change is made by an SQL trigger or foreign key action
+** instead of directly as a result of a users SQL statement.
+**
+**
+** If a single row is affected by more than one operation within a session,
+** then the change is considered indirect if all operations meet the criteria
+** for an indirect change above, or direct otherwise.
+**
+** This function is used to set, clear or query the session object indirect
+** flag. If the second argument passed to this function is zero, then the
+** indirect flag is cleared. If it is greater than zero, the indirect flag
+** is set. Passing a value less than zero does not modify the current value
+** of the indirect flag, and may be used to query the current state of the
+** indirect flag for the specified session object.
+**
+** The return value indicates the final state of the indirect flag: 0 if
+** it is clear, or 1 if it is set.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_indirect(sqlite3_session *pSession, int bIndirect);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Attach A Table To A Session Object
+** METHOD: sqlite3_session
+**
+** If argument zTab is not NULL, then it is the name of a table to attach
+** to the session object passed as the first argument. All subsequent changes
+** made to the table while the session object is enabled will be recorded. See
+** documentation for [sqlite3session_changeset()] for further details.
+**
+** Or, if argument zTab is NULL, then changes are recorded for all tables
+** in the database. If additional tables are added to the database (by
+** executing "CREATE TABLE" statements) after this call is made, changes for
+** the new tables are also recorded.
+**
+** Changes can only be recorded for tables that have a PRIMARY KEY explicitly
+** defined as part of their CREATE TABLE statement. It does not matter if the
+** PRIMARY KEY is an "INTEGER PRIMARY KEY" (rowid alias) or not. The PRIMARY
+** KEY may consist of a single column, or may be a composite key.
+**
+** It is not an error if the named table does not exist in the database. Nor
+** is it an error if the named table does not have a PRIMARY KEY. However,
+** no changes will be recorded in either of these scenarios.
+**
+** Changes are not recorded for individual rows that have NULL values stored
+** in one or more of their PRIMARY KEY columns.
+**
+** SQLITE_OK is returned if the call completes without error. Or, if an error
+** occurs, an SQLite error code (e.g. SQLITE_NOMEM) is returned.
+**
+**
Special sqlite_stat1 Handling
+**
+** As of SQLite version 3.22.0, the "sqlite_stat1" table is an exception to
+** some of the rules above. In SQLite, the schema of sqlite_stat1 is:
+**
+** CREATE TABLE sqlite_stat1(tbl,idx,stat)
+**
+**
+** Even though sqlite_stat1 does not have a PRIMARY KEY, changes are
+** recorded for it as if the PRIMARY KEY is (tbl,idx). Additionally, changes
+** are recorded for rows for which (idx IS NULL) is true. However, for such
+** rows a zero-length blob (SQL value X'') is stored in the changeset or
+** patchset instead of a NULL value. This allows such changesets to be
+** manipulated by legacy implementations of sqlite3changeset_invert(),
+** concat() and similar.
+**
+** The sqlite3changeset_apply() function automatically converts the
+** zero-length blob back to a NULL value when updating the sqlite_stat1
+** table. However, if the application calls sqlite3changeset_new(),
+** sqlite3changeset_old() or sqlite3changeset_conflict on a changeset
+** iterator directly (including on a changeset iterator passed to a
+** conflict-handler callback) then the X'' value is returned. The application
+** must translate X'' to NULL itself if required.
+**
+** Legacy (older than 3.22.0) versions of the sessions module cannot capture
+** changes made to the sqlite_stat1 table. Legacy versions of the
+** sqlite3changeset_apply() function silently ignore any modifications to the
+** sqlite_stat1 table that are part of a changeset or patchset.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_attach(
+ sqlite3_session *pSession, /* Session object */
+ const char *zTab /* Table name */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Set a table filter on a Session Object.
+** METHOD: sqlite3_session
+**
+** The second argument (xFilter) is the "filter callback". For changes to rows
+** in tables that are not attached to the Session object, the filter is called
+** to determine whether changes to the table's rows should be tracked or not.
+** If xFilter returns 0, changes are not tracked. Note that once a table is
+** attached, xFilter will not be called again.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3session_table_filter(
+ sqlite3_session *pSession, /* Session object */
+ int(*xFilter)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of third arg to _filter_table() */
+ const char *zTab /* Table name */
+ ),
+ void *pCtx /* First argument passed to xFilter */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Generate A Changeset From A Session Object
+** METHOD: sqlite3_session
+**
+** Obtain a changeset containing changes to the tables attached to the
+** session object passed as the first argument. If successful,
+** set *ppChangeset to point to a buffer containing the changeset
+** and *pnChangeset to the size of the changeset in bytes before returning
+** SQLITE_OK. If an error occurs, set both *ppChangeset and *pnChangeset to
+** zero and return an SQLite error code.
+**
+** A changeset consists of zero or more INSERT, UPDATE and/or DELETE changes,
+** each representing a change to a single row of an attached table. An INSERT
+** change contains the values of each field of a new database row. A DELETE
+** contains the original values of each field of a deleted database row. An
+** UPDATE change contains the original values of each field of an updated
+** database row along with the updated values for each updated non-primary-key
+** column. It is not possible for an UPDATE change to represent a change that
+** modifies the values of primary key columns. If such a change is made, it
+** is represented in a changeset as a DELETE followed by an INSERT.
+**
+** Changes are not recorded for rows that have NULL values stored in one or
+** more of their PRIMARY KEY columns. If such a row is inserted or deleted,
+** no corresponding change is present in the changesets returned by this
+** function. If an existing row with one or more NULL values stored in
+** PRIMARY KEY columns is updated so that all PRIMARY KEY columns are non-NULL,
+** only an INSERT is appears in the changeset. Similarly, if an existing row
+** with non-NULL PRIMARY KEY values is updated so that one or more of its
+** PRIMARY KEY columns are set to NULL, the resulting changeset contains a
+** DELETE change only.
+**
+** The contents of a changeset may be traversed using an iterator created
+** using the [sqlite3changeset_start()] API. A changeset may be applied to
+** a database with a compatible schema using the [sqlite3changeset_apply()]
+** API.
+**
+** Within a changeset generated by this function, all changes related to a
+** single table are grouped together. In other words, when iterating through
+** a changeset or when applying a changeset to a database, all changes related
+** to a single table are processed before moving on to the next table. Tables
+** are sorted in the same order in which they were attached (or auto-attached)
+** to the sqlite3_session object. The order in which the changes related to
+** a single table are stored is undefined.
+**
+** Following a successful call to this function, it is the responsibility of
+** the caller to eventually free the buffer that *ppChangeset points to using
+** [sqlite3_free()].
+**
+**
Changeset Generation
+**
+** Once a table has been attached to a session object, the session object
+** records the primary key values of all new rows inserted into the table.
+** It also records the original primary key and other column values of any
+** deleted or updated rows. For each unique primary key value, data is only
+** recorded once - the first time a row with said primary key is inserted,
+** updated or deleted in the lifetime of the session.
+**
+** There is one exception to the previous paragraph: when a row is inserted,
+** updated or deleted, if one or more of its primary key columns contain a
+** NULL value, no record of the change is made.
+**
+** The session object therefore accumulates two types of records - those
+** that consist of primary key values only (created when the user inserts
+** a new record) and those that consist of the primary key values and the
+** original values of other table columns (created when the users deletes
+** or updates a record).
+**
+** When this function is called, the requested changeset is created using
+** both the accumulated records and the current contents of the database
+** file. Specifically:
+**
+**
+**
For each record generated by an insert, the database is queried
+** for a row with a matching primary key. If one is found, an INSERT
+** change is added to the changeset. If no such row is found, no change
+** is added to the changeset.
+**
+**
For each record generated by an update or delete, the database is
+** queried for a row with a matching primary key. If such a row is
+** found and one or more of the non-primary key fields have been
+** modified from their original values, an UPDATE change is added to
+** the changeset. Or, if no such row is found in the table, a DELETE
+** change is added to the changeset. If there is a row with a matching
+** primary key in the database, but all fields contain their original
+** values, no change is added to the changeset.
+**
+**
+** This means, amongst other things, that if a row is inserted and then later
+** deleted while a session object is active, neither the insert nor the delete
+** will be present in the changeset. Or if a row is deleted and then later a
+** row with the same primary key values inserted while a session object is
+** active, the resulting changeset will contain an UPDATE change instead of
+** a DELETE and an INSERT.
+**
+** When a session object is disabled (see the [sqlite3session_enable()] API),
+** it does not accumulate records when rows are inserted, updated or deleted.
+** This may appear to have some counter-intuitive effects if a single row
+** is written to more than once during a session. For example, if a row
+** is inserted while a session object is enabled, then later deleted while
+** the same session object is disabled, no INSERT record will appear in the
+** changeset, even though the delete took place while the session was disabled.
+** Or, if one field of a row is updated while a session is disabled, and
+** another field of the same row is updated while the session is enabled, the
+** resulting changeset will contain an UPDATE change that updates both fields.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_changeset(
+ sqlite3_session *pSession, /* Session object */
+ int *pnChangeset, /* OUT: Size of buffer at *ppChangeset */
+ void **ppChangeset /* OUT: Buffer containing changeset */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Load The Difference Between Tables Into A Session
+** METHOD: sqlite3_session
+**
+** If it is not already attached to the session object passed as the first
+** argument, this function attaches table zTbl in the same manner as the
+** [sqlite3session_attach()] function. If zTbl does not exist, or if it
+** does not have a primary key, this function is a no-op (but does not return
+** an error).
+**
+** Argument zFromDb must be the name of a database ("main", "temp" etc.)
+** attached to the same database handle as the session object that contains
+** a table compatible with the table attached to the session by this function.
+** A table is considered compatible if it:
+**
+**
+**
Has the same name,
+**
Has the same set of columns declared in the same order, and
+**
Has the same PRIMARY KEY definition.
+**
+**
+** If the tables are not compatible, SQLITE_SCHEMA is returned. If the tables
+** are compatible but do not have any PRIMARY KEY columns, it is not an error
+** but no changes are added to the session object. As with other session
+** APIs, tables without PRIMARY KEYs are simply ignored.
+**
+** This function adds a set of changes to the session object that could be
+** used to update the table in database zFrom (call this the "from-table")
+** so that its content is the same as the table attached to the session
+** object (call this the "to-table"). Specifically:
+**
+**
+**
For each row (primary key) that exists in the to-table but not in
+** the from-table, an INSERT record is added to the session object.
+**
+**
For each row (primary key) that exists in the to-table but not in
+** the from-table, a DELETE record is added to the session object.
+**
+**
For each row (primary key) that exists in both tables, but features
+** different non-PK values in each, an UPDATE record is added to the
+** session.
+**
+**
+** To clarify, if this function is called and then a changeset constructed
+** using [sqlite3session_changeset()], then after applying that changeset to
+** database zFrom the contents of the two compatible tables would be
+** identical.
+**
+** It an error if database zFrom does not exist or does not contain the
+** required compatible table.
+**
+** If the operation is successful, SQLITE_OK is returned. Otherwise, an SQLite
+** error code. In this case, if argument pzErrMsg is not NULL, *pzErrMsg
+** may be set to point to a buffer containing an English language error
+** message. It is the responsibility of the caller to free this buffer using
+** sqlite3_free().
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_diff(
+ sqlite3_session *pSession,
+ const char *zFromDb,
+ const char *zTbl,
+ char **pzErrMsg
+);
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Generate A Patchset From A Session Object
+** METHOD: sqlite3_session
+**
+** The differences between a patchset and a changeset are that:
+**
+**
+**
DELETE records consist of the primary key fields only. The
+** original values of other fields are omitted.
+**
The original values of any modified fields are omitted from
+** UPDATE records.
+**
+**
+** A patchset blob may be used with up to date versions of all
+** sqlite3changeset_xxx API functions except for sqlite3changeset_invert(),
+** which returns SQLITE_CORRUPT if it is passed a patchset. Similarly,
+** attempting to use a patchset blob with old versions of the
+** sqlite3changeset_xxx APIs also provokes an SQLITE_CORRUPT error.
+**
+** Because the non-primary key "old.*" fields are omitted, no
+** SQLITE_CHANGESET_DATA conflicts can be detected or reported if a patchset
+** is passed to the sqlite3changeset_apply() API. Other conflict types work
+** in the same way as for changesets.
+**
+** Changes within a patchset are ordered in the same way as for changesets
+** generated by the sqlite3session_changeset() function (i.e. all changes for
+** a single table are grouped together, tables appear in the order in which
+** they were attached to the session object).
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_patchset(
+ sqlite3_session *pSession, /* Session object */
+ int *pnPatchset, /* OUT: Size of buffer at *ppPatchset */
+ void **ppPatchset /* OUT: Buffer containing patchset */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Test if a changeset has recorded any changes.
+**
+** Return non-zero if no changes to attached tables have been recorded by
+** the session object passed as the first argument. Otherwise, if one or
+** more changes have been recorded, return zero.
+**
+** Even if this function returns zero, it is possible that calling
+** [sqlite3session_changeset()] on the session handle may still return a
+** changeset that contains no changes. This can happen when a row in
+** an attached table is modified and then later on the original values
+** are restored. However, if this function returns non-zero, then it is
+** guaranteed that a call to sqlite3session_changeset() will return a
+** changeset containing zero changes.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_isempty(sqlite3_session *pSession);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Create An Iterator To Traverse A Changeset
+** CONSTRUCTOR: sqlite3_changeset_iter
+**
+** Create an iterator used to iterate through the contents of a changeset.
+** If successful, *pp is set to point to the iterator handle and SQLITE_OK
+** is returned. Otherwise, if an error occurs, *pp is set to zero and an
+** SQLite error code is returned.
+**
+** The following functions can be used to advance and query a changeset
+** iterator created by this function:
+**
+**
+**
[sqlite3changeset_next()]
+**
[sqlite3changeset_op()]
+**
[sqlite3changeset_new()]
+**
[sqlite3changeset_old()]
+**
+**
+** It is the responsibility of the caller to eventually destroy the iterator
+** by passing it to [sqlite3changeset_finalize()]. The buffer containing the
+** changeset (pChangeset) must remain valid until after the iterator is
+** destroyed.
+**
+** Assuming the changeset blob was created by one of the
+** [sqlite3session_changeset()], [sqlite3changeset_concat()] or
+** [sqlite3changeset_invert()] functions, all changes within the changeset
+** that apply to a single table are grouped together. This means that when
+** an application iterates through a changeset using an iterator created by
+** this function, all changes that relate to a single table are visited
+** consecutively. There is no chance that the iterator will visit a change
+** the applies to table X, then one for table Y, and then later on visit
+** another change for table X.
+**
+** The behavior of sqlite3changeset_start_v2() and its streaming equivalent
+** may be modified by passing a combination of
+** [SQLITE_CHANGESETSTART_INVERT | supported flags] as the 4th parameter.
+**
+** Note that the sqlite3changeset_start_v2() API is still experimental
+** and therefore subject to change.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_start(
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter **pp, /* OUT: New changeset iterator handle */
+ int nChangeset, /* Size of changeset blob in bytes */
+ void *pChangeset /* Pointer to blob containing changeset */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_start_v2(
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter **pp, /* OUT: New changeset iterator handle */
+ int nChangeset, /* Size of changeset blob in bytes */
+ void *pChangeset, /* Pointer to blob containing changeset */
+ int flags /* SESSION_CHANGESETSTART_* flags */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Flags for sqlite3changeset_start_v2
+**
+** The following flags may passed via the 4th parameter to
+** [sqlite3changeset_start_v2] and [sqlite3changeset_start_v2_strm]:
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESETAPPLY_INVERT
+** Invert the changeset while iterating through it. This is equivalent to
+** inverting a changeset using sqlite3changeset_invert() before applying it.
+** It is an error to specify this flag with a patchset.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESETSTART_INVERT 0x0002
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Advance A Changeset Iterator
+** METHOD: sqlite3_changeset_iter
+**
+** This function may only be used with iterators created by the function
+** [sqlite3changeset_start()]. If it is called on an iterator passed to
+** a conflict-handler callback by [sqlite3changeset_apply()], SQLITE_MISUSE
+** is returned and the call has no effect.
+**
+** Immediately after an iterator is created by sqlite3changeset_start(), it
+** does not point to any change in the changeset. Assuming the changeset
+** is not empty, the first call to this function advances the iterator to
+** point to the first change in the changeset. Each subsequent call advances
+** the iterator to point to the next change in the changeset (if any). If
+** no error occurs and the iterator points to a valid change after a call
+** to sqlite3changeset_next() has advanced it, SQLITE_ROW is returned.
+** Otherwise, if all changes in the changeset have already been visited,
+** SQLITE_DONE is returned.
+**
+** If an error occurs, an SQLite error code is returned. Possible error
+** codes include SQLITE_CORRUPT (if the changeset buffer is corrupt) or
+** SQLITE_NOMEM.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_next(sqlite3_changeset_iter *pIter);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Obtain The Current Operation From A Changeset Iterator
+** METHOD: sqlite3_changeset_iter
+**
+** The pIter argument passed to this function may either be an iterator
+** passed to a conflict-handler by [sqlite3changeset_apply()], or an iterator
+** created by [sqlite3changeset_start()]. In the latter case, the most recent
+** call to [sqlite3changeset_next()] must have returned [SQLITE_ROW]. If this
+** is not the case, this function returns [SQLITE_MISUSE].
+**
+** If argument pzTab is not NULL, then *pzTab is set to point to a
+** nul-terminated utf-8 encoded string containing the name of the table
+** affected by the current change. The buffer remains valid until either
+** sqlite3changeset_next() is called on the iterator or until the
+** conflict-handler function returns. If pnCol is not NULL, then *pnCol is
+** set to the number of columns in the table affected by the change. If
+** pbIndirect is not NULL, then *pbIndirect is set to true (1) if the change
+** is an indirect change, or false (0) otherwise. See the documentation for
+** [sqlite3session_indirect()] for a description of direct and indirect
+** changes. Finally, if pOp is not NULL, then *pOp is set to one of
+** [SQLITE_INSERT], [SQLITE_DELETE] or [SQLITE_UPDATE], depending on the
+** type of change that the iterator currently points to.
+**
+** If no error occurs, SQLITE_OK is returned. If an error does occur, an
+** SQLite error code is returned. The values of the output variables may not
+** be trusted in this case.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_op(
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter *pIter, /* Iterator object */
+ const char **pzTab, /* OUT: Pointer to table name */
+ int *pnCol, /* OUT: Number of columns in table */
+ int *pOp, /* OUT: SQLITE_INSERT, DELETE or UPDATE */
+ int *pbIndirect /* OUT: True for an 'indirect' change */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Obtain The Primary Key Definition Of A Table
+** METHOD: sqlite3_changeset_iter
+**
+** For each modified table, a changeset includes the following:
+**
+**
+**
The number of columns in the table, and
+**
Which of those columns make up the tables PRIMARY KEY.
+**
+**
+** This function is used to find which columns comprise the PRIMARY KEY of
+** the table modified by the change that iterator pIter currently points to.
+** If successful, *pabPK is set to point to an array of nCol entries, where
+** nCol is the number of columns in the table. Elements of *pabPK are set to
+** 0x01 if the corresponding column is part of the tables primary key, or
+** 0x00 if it is not.
+**
+** If argument pnCol is not NULL, then *pnCol is set to the number of columns
+** in the table.
+**
+** If this function is called when the iterator does not point to a valid
+** entry, SQLITE_MISUSE is returned and the output variables zeroed. Otherwise,
+** SQLITE_OK is returned and the output variables populated as described
+** above.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_pk(
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter *pIter, /* Iterator object */
+ unsigned char **pabPK, /* OUT: Array of boolean - true for PK cols */
+ int *pnCol /* OUT: Number of entries in output array */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Obtain old.* Values From A Changeset Iterator
+** METHOD: sqlite3_changeset_iter
+**
+** The pIter argument passed to this function may either be an iterator
+** passed to a conflict-handler by [sqlite3changeset_apply()], or an iterator
+** created by [sqlite3changeset_start()]. In the latter case, the most recent
+** call to [sqlite3changeset_next()] must have returned SQLITE_ROW.
+** Furthermore, it may only be called if the type of change that the iterator
+** currently points to is either [SQLITE_DELETE] or [SQLITE_UPDATE]. Otherwise,
+** this function returns [SQLITE_MISUSE] and sets *ppValue to NULL.
+**
+** Argument iVal must be greater than or equal to 0, and less than the number
+** of columns in the table affected by the current change. Otherwise,
+** [SQLITE_RANGE] is returned and *ppValue is set to NULL.
+**
+** If successful, this function sets *ppValue to point to a protected
+** sqlite3_value object containing the iVal'th value from the vector of
+** original row values stored as part of the UPDATE or DELETE change and
+** returns SQLITE_OK. The name of the function comes from the fact that this
+** is similar to the "old.*" columns available to update or delete triggers.
+**
+** If some other error occurs (e.g. an OOM condition), an SQLite error code
+** is returned and *ppValue is set to NULL.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_old(
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter *pIter, /* Changeset iterator */
+ int iVal, /* Column number */
+ sqlite3_value **ppValue /* OUT: Old value (or NULL pointer) */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Obtain new.* Values From A Changeset Iterator
+** METHOD: sqlite3_changeset_iter
+**
+** The pIter argument passed to this function may either be an iterator
+** passed to a conflict-handler by [sqlite3changeset_apply()], or an iterator
+** created by [sqlite3changeset_start()]. In the latter case, the most recent
+** call to [sqlite3changeset_next()] must have returned SQLITE_ROW.
+** Furthermore, it may only be called if the type of change that the iterator
+** currently points to is either [SQLITE_UPDATE] or [SQLITE_INSERT]. Otherwise,
+** this function returns [SQLITE_MISUSE] and sets *ppValue to NULL.
+**
+** Argument iVal must be greater than or equal to 0, and less than the number
+** of columns in the table affected by the current change. Otherwise,
+** [SQLITE_RANGE] is returned and *ppValue is set to NULL.
+**
+** If successful, this function sets *ppValue to point to a protected
+** sqlite3_value object containing the iVal'th value from the vector of
+** new row values stored as part of the UPDATE or INSERT change and
+** returns SQLITE_OK. If the change is an UPDATE and does not include
+** a new value for the requested column, *ppValue is set to NULL and
+** SQLITE_OK returned. The name of the function comes from the fact that
+** this is similar to the "new.*" columns available to update or delete
+** triggers.
+**
+** If some other error occurs (e.g. an OOM condition), an SQLite error code
+** is returned and *ppValue is set to NULL.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_new(
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter *pIter, /* Changeset iterator */
+ int iVal, /* Column number */
+ sqlite3_value **ppValue /* OUT: New value (or NULL pointer) */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Obtain Conflicting Row Values From A Changeset Iterator
+** METHOD: sqlite3_changeset_iter
+**
+** This function should only be used with iterator objects passed to a
+** conflict-handler callback by [sqlite3changeset_apply()] with either
+** [SQLITE_CHANGESET_DATA] or [SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONFLICT]. If this function
+** is called on any other iterator, [SQLITE_MISUSE] is returned and *ppValue
+** is set to NULL.
+**
+** Argument iVal must be greater than or equal to 0, and less than the number
+** of columns in the table affected by the current change. Otherwise,
+** [SQLITE_RANGE] is returned and *ppValue is set to NULL.
+**
+** If successful, this function sets *ppValue to point to a protected
+** sqlite3_value object containing the iVal'th value from the
+** "conflicting row" associated with the current conflict-handler callback
+** and returns SQLITE_OK.
+**
+** If some other error occurs (e.g. an OOM condition), an SQLite error code
+** is returned and *ppValue is set to NULL.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_conflict(
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter *pIter, /* Changeset iterator */
+ int iVal, /* Column number */
+ sqlite3_value **ppValue /* OUT: Value from conflicting row */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Determine The Number Of Foreign Key Constraint Violations
+** METHOD: sqlite3_changeset_iter
+**
+** This function may only be called with an iterator passed to an
+** SQLITE_CHANGESET_FOREIGN_KEY conflict handler callback. In this case
+** it sets the output variable to the total number of known foreign key
+** violations in the destination database and returns SQLITE_OK.
+**
+** In all other cases this function returns SQLITE_MISUSE.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_fk_conflicts(
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter *pIter, /* Changeset iterator */
+ int *pnOut /* OUT: Number of FK violations */
+);
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Finalize A Changeset Iterator
+** METHOD: sqlite3_changeset_iter
+**
+** This function is used to finalize an iterator allocated with
+** [sqlite3changeset_start()].
+**
+** This function should only be called on iterators created using the
+** [sqlite3changeset_start()] function. If an application calls this
+** function with an iterator passed to a conflict-handler by
+** [sqlite3changeset_apply()], [SQLITE_MISUSE] is immediately returned and the
+** call has no effect.
+**
+** If an error was encountered within a call to an sqlite3changeset_xxx()
+** function (for example an [SQLITE_CORRUPT] in [sqlite3changeset_next()] or an
+** [SQLITE_NOMEM] in [sqlite3changeset_new()]) then an error code corresponding
+** to that error is returned by this function. Otherwise, SQLITE_OK is
+** returned. This is to allow the following pattern (pseudo-code):
+**
+**
+** sqlite3changeset_start();
+** while( SQLITE_ROW==sqlite3changeset_next() ){
+** // Do something with change.
+** }
+** rc = sqlite3changeset_finalize();
+** if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+** // An error has occurred
+** }
+**
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_finalize(sqlite3_changeset_iter *pIter);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Invert A Changeset
+**
+** This function is used to "invert" a changeset object. Applying an inverted
+** changeset to a database reverses the effects of applying the uninverted
+** changeset. Specifically:
+**
+**
+**
Each DELETE change is changed to an INSERT, and
+**
Each INSERT change is changed to a DELETE, and
+**
For each UPDATE change, the old.* and new.* values are exchanged.
+**
+**
+** This function does not change the order in which changes appear within
+** the changeset. It merely reverses the sense of each individual change.
+**
+** If successful, a pointer to a buffer containing the inverted changeset
+** is stored in *ppOut, the size of the same buffer is stored in *pnOut, and
+** SQLITE_OK is returned. If an error occurs, both *pnOut and *ppOut are
+** zeroed and an SQLite error code returned.
+**
+** It is the responsibility of the caller to eventually call sqlite3_free()
+** on the *ppOut pointer to free the buffer allocation following a successful
+** call to this function.
+**
+** WARNING/TODO: This function currently assumes that the input is a valid
+** changeset. If it is not, the results are undefined.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_invert(
+ int nIn, const void *pIn, /* Input changeset */
+ int *pnOut, void **ppOut /* OUT: Inverse of input */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Concatenate Two Changeset Objects
+**
+** This function is used to concatenate two changesets, A and B, into a
+** single changeset. The result is a changeset equivalent to applying
+** changeset A followed by changeset B.
+**
+** This function combines the two input changesets using an
+** sqlite3_changegroup object. Calling it produces similar results as the
+** following code fragment:
+**
+**
+**
+** Refer to the sqlite3_changegroup documentation below for details.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_concat(
+ int nA, /* Number of bytes in buffer pA */
+ void *pA, /* Pointer to buffer containing changeset A */
+ int nB, /* Number of bytes in buffer pB */
+ void *pB, /* Pointer to buffer containing changeset B */
+ int *pnOut, /* OUT: Number of bytes in output changeset */
+ void **ppOut /* OUT: Buffer containing output changeset */
+);
+
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Changegroup Handle
+**
+** A changegroup is an object used to combine two or more
+** [changesets] or [patchsets]
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_changegroup sqlite3_changegroup;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Create A New Changegroup Object
+** CONSTRUCTOR: sqlite3_changegroup
+**
+** An sqlite3_changegroup object is used to combine two or more changesets
+** (or patchsets) into a single changeset (or patchset). A single changegroup
+** object may combine changesets or patchsets, but not both. The output is
+** always in the same format as the input.
+**
+** If successful, this function returns SQLITE_OK and populates (*pp) with
+** a pointer to a new sqlite3_changegroup object before returning. The caller
+** should eventually free the returned object using a call to
+** sqlite3changegroup_delete(). If an error occurs, an SQLite error code
+** (i.e. SQLITE_NOMEM) is returned and *pp is set to NULL.
+**
+** The usual usage pattern for an sqlite3_changegroup object is as follows:
+**
+**
+**
It is created using a call to sqlite3changegroup_new().
+**
+**
Zero or more changesets (or patchsets) are added to the object
+** by calling sqlite3changegroup_add().
+**
+**
The result of combining all input changesets together is obtained
+** by the application via a call to sqlite3changegroup_output().
+**
+**
The object is deleted using a call to sqlite3changegroup_delete().
+**
+**
+** Any number of calls to add() and output() may be made between the calls to
+** new() and delete(), and in any order.
+**
+** As well as the regular sqlite3changegroup_add() and
+** sqlite3changegroup_output() functions, also available are the streaming
+** versions sqlite3changegroup_add_strm() and sqlite3changegroup_output_strm().
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changegroup_new(sqlite3_changegroup **pp);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Add A Changeset To A Changegroup
+** METHOD: sqlite3_changegroup
+**
+** Add all changes within the changeset (or patchset) in buffer pData (size
+** nData bytes) to the changegroup.
+**
+** If the buffer contains a patchset, then all prior calls to this function
+** on the same changegroup object must also have specified patchsets. Or, if
+** the buffer contains a changeset, so must have the earlier calls to this
+** function. Otherwise, SQLITE_ERROR is returned and no changes are added
+** to the changegroup.
+**
+** Rows within the changeset and changegroup are identified by the values in
+** their PRIMARY KEY columns. A change in the changeset is considered to
+** apply to the same row as a change already present in the changegroup if
+** the two rows have the same primary key.
+**
+** Changes to rows that do not already appear in the changegroup are
+** simply copied into it. Or, if both the new changeset and the changegroup
+** contain changes that apply to a single row, the final contents of the
+** changegroup depends on the type of each change, as follows:
+**
+**
+**
Existing Change
+**
New Change
+**
Output Change
+**
INSERT
INSERT
+** The new change is ignored. This case does not occur if the new
+** changeset was recorded immediately after the changesets already
+** added to the changegroup.
+**
INSERT
UPDATE
+** The INSERT change remains in the changegroup. The values in the
+** INSERT change are modified as if the row was inserted by the
+** existing change and then updated according to the new change.
+**
INSERT
DELETE
+** The existing INSERT is removed from the changegroup. The DELETE is
+** not added.
+**
UPDATE
INSERT
+** The new change is ignored. This case does not occur if the new
+** changeset was recorded immediately after the changesets already
+** added to the changegroup.
+**
UPDATE
UPDATE
+** The existing UPDATE remains within the changegroup. It is amended
+** so that the accompanying values are as if the row was updated once
+** by the existing change and then again by the new change.
+**
UPDATE
DELETE
+** The existing UPDATE is replaced by the new DELETE within the
+** changegroup.
+**
DELETE
INSERT
+** If one or more of the column values in the row inserted by the
+** new change differ from those in the row deleted by the existing
+** change, the existing DELETE is replaced by an UPDATE within the
+** changegroup. Otherwise, if the inserted row is exactly the same
+** as the deleted row, the existing DELETE is simply discarded.
+**
DELETE
UPDATE
+** The new change is ignored. This case does not occur if the new
+** changeset was recorded immediately after the changesets already
+** added to the changegroup.
+**
DELETE
DELETE
+** The new change is ignored. This case does not occur if the new
+** changeset was recorded immediately after the changesets already
+** added to the changegroup.
+**
+**
+** If the new changeset contains changes to a table that is already present
+** in the changegroup, then the number of columns and the position of the
+** primary key columns for the table must be consistent. If this is not the
+** case, this function fails with SQLITE_SCHEMA. If the input changeset
+** appears to be corrupt and the corruption is detected, SQLITE_CORRUPT is
+** returned. Or, if an out-of-memory condition occurs during processing, this
+** function returns SQLITE_NOMEM. In all cases, if an error occurs the state
+** of the final contents of the changegroup is undefined.
+**
+** If no error occurs, SQLITE_OK is returned.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changegroup_add(sqlite3_changegroup*, int nData, void *pData);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Obtain A Composite Changeset From A Changegroup
+** METHOD: sqlite3_changegroup
+**
+** Obtain a buffer containing a changeset (or patchset) representing the
+** current contents of the changegroup. If the inputs to the changegroup
+** were themselves changesets, the output is a changeset. Or, if the
+** inputs were patchsets, the output is also a patchset.
+**
+** As with the output of the sqlite3session_changeset() and
+** sqlite3session_patchset() functions, all changes related to a single
+** table are grouped together in the output of this function. Tables appear
+** in the same order as for the very first changeset added to the changegroup.
+** If the second or subsequent changesets added to the changegroup contain
+** changes for tables that do not appear in the first changeset, they are
+** appended onto the end of the output changeset, again in the order in
+** which they are first encountered.
+**
+** If an error occurs, an SQLite error code is returned and the output
+** variables (*pnData) and (*ppData) are set to 0. Otherwise, SQLITE_OK
+** is returned and the output variables are set to the size of and a
+** pointer to the output buffer, respectively. In this case it is the
+** responsibility of the caller to eventually free the buffer using a
+** call to sqlite3_free().
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changegroup_output(
+ sqlite3_changegroup*,
+ int *pnData, /* OUT: Size of output buffer in bytes */
+ void **ppData /* OUT: Pointer to output buffer */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Delete A Changegroup Object
+** DESTRUCTOR: sqlite3_changegroup
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3changegroup_delete(sqlite3_changegroup*);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Apply A Changeset To A Database
+**
+** Apply a changeset or patchset to a database. These functions attempt to
+** update the "main" database attached to handle db with the changes found in
+** the changeset passed via the second and third arguments.
+**
+** The fourth argument (xFilter) passed to these functions is the "filter
+** callback". If it is not NULL, then for each table affected by at least one
+** change in the changeset, the filter callback is invoked with
+** the table name as the second argument, and a copy of the context pointer
+** passed as the sixth argument as the first. If the "filter callback"
+** returns zero, then no attempt is made to apply any changes to the table.
+** Otherwise, if the return value is non-zero or the xFilter argument to
+** is NULL, all changes related to the table are attempted.
+**
+** For each table that is not excluded by the filter callback, this function
+** tests that the target database contains a compatible table. A table is
+** considered compatible if all of the following are true:
+**
+**
+**
The table has the same name as the name recorded in the
+** changeset, and
+**
The table has at least as many columns as recorded in the
+** changeset, and
+**
The table has primary key columns in the same position as
+** recorded in the changeset.
+**
+**
+** If there is no compatible table, it is not an error, but none of the
+** changes associated with the table are applied. A warning message is issued
+** via the sqlite3_log() mechanism with the error code SQLITE_SCHEMA. At most
+** one such warning is issued for each table in the changeset.
+**
+** For each change for which there is a compatible table, an attempt is made
+** to modify the table contents according to the UPDATE, INSERT or DELETE
+** change. If a change cannot be applied cleanly, the conflict handler
+** function passed as the fifth argument to sqlite3changeset_apply() may be
+** invoked. A description of exactly when the conflict handler is invoked for
+** each type of change is below.
+**
+** Unlike the xFilter argument, xConflict may not be passed NULL. The results
+** of passing anything other than a valid function pointer as the xConflict
+** argument are undefined.
+**
+** Each time the conflict handler function is invoked, it must return one
+** of [SQLITE_CHANGESET_OMIT], [SQLITE_CHANGESET_ABORT] or
+** [SQLITE_CHANGESET_REPLACE]. SQLITE_CHANGESET_REPLACE may only be returned
+** if the second argument passed to the conflict handler is either
+** SQLITE_CHANGESET_DATA or SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONFLICT. If the conflict-handler
+** returns an illegal value, any changes already made are rolled back and
+** the call to sqlite3changeset_apply() returns SQLITE_MISUSE. Different
+** actions are taken by sqlite3changeset_apply() depending on the value
+** returned by each invocation of the conflict-handler function. Refer to
+** the documentation for the three
+** [SQLITE_CHANGESET_OMIT|available return values] for details.
+**
+**
+**
DELETE Changes
+** For each DELETE change, the function checks if the target database
+** contains a row with the same primary key value (or values) as the
+** original row values stored in the changeset. If it does, and the values
+** stored in all non-primary key columns also match the values stored in
+** the changeset the row is deleted from the target database.
+**
+** If a row with matching primary key values is found, but one or more of
+** the non-primary key fields contains a value different from the original
+** row value stored in the changeset, the conflict-handler function is
+** invoked with [SQLITE_CHANGESET_DATA] as the second argument. If the
+** database table has more columns than are recorded in the changeset,
+** only the values of those non-primary key fields are compared against
+** the current database contents - any trailing database table columns
+** are ignored.
+**
+** If no row with matching primary key values is found in the database,
+** the conflict-handler function is invoked with [SQLITE_CHANGESET_NOTFOUND]
+** passed as the second argument.
+**
+** If the DELETE operation is attempted, but SQLite returns SQLITE_CONSTRAINT
+** (which can only happen if a foreign key constraint is violated), the
+** conflict-handler function is invoked with [SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONSTRAINT]
+** passed as the second argument. This includes the case where the DELETE
+** operation is attempted because an earlier call to the conflict handler
+** function returned [SQLITE_CHANGESET_REPLACE].
+**
+**
INSERT Changes
+** For each INSERT change, an attempt is made to insert the new row into
+** the database. If the changeset row contains fewer fields than the
+** database table, the trailing fields are populated with their default
+** values.
+**
+** If the attempt to insert the row fails because the database already
+** contains a row with the same primary key values, the conflict handler
+** function is invoked with the second argument set to
+** [SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONFLICT].
+**
+** If the attempt to insert the row fails because of some other constraint
+** violation (e.g. NOT NULL or UNIQUE), the conflict handler function is
+** invoked with the second argument set to [SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONSTRAINT].
+** This includes the case where the INSERT operation is re-attempted because
+** an earlier call to the conflict handler function returned
+** [SQLITE_CHANGESET_REPLACE].
+**
+**
UPDATE Changes
+** For each UPDATE change, the function checks if the target database
+** contains a row with the same primary key value (or values) as the
+** original row values stored in the changeset. If it does, and the values
+** stored in all modified non-primary key columns also match the values
+** stored in the changeset the row is updated within the target database.
+**
+** If a row with matching primary key values is found, but one or more of
+** the modified non-primary key fields contains a value different from an
+** original row value stored in the changeset, the conflict-handler function
+** is invoked with [SQLITE_CHANGESET_DATA] as the second argument. Since
+** UPDATE changes only contain values for non-primary key fields that are
+** to be modified, only those fields need to match the original values to
+** avoid the SQLITE_CHANGESET_DATA conflict-handler callback.
+**
+** If no row with matching primary key values is found in the database,
+** the conflict-handler function is invoked with [SQLITE_CHANGESET_NOTFOUND]
+** passed as the second argument.
+**
+** If the UPDATE operation is attempted, but SQLite returns
+** SQLITE_CONSTRAINT, the conflict-handler function is invoked with
+** [SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONSTRAINT] passed as the second argument.
+** This includes the case where the UPDATE operation is attempted after
+** an earlier call to the conflict handler function returned
+** [SQLITE_CHANGESET_REPLACE].
+**
+**
+** It is safe to execute SQL statements, including those that write to the
+** table that the callback related to, from within the xConflict callback.
+** This can be used to further customize the application's conflict
+** resolution strategy.
+**
+** All changes made by these functions are enclosed in a savepoint transaction.
+** If any other error (aside from a constraint failure when attempting to
+** write to the target database) occurs, then the savepoint transaction is
+** rolled back, restoring the target database to its original state, and an
+** SQLite error code returned.
+**
+** If the output parameters (ppRebase) and (pnRebase) are non-NULL and
+** the input is a changeset (not a patchset), then sqlite3changeset_apply_v2()
+** may set (*ppRebase) to point to a "rebase" that may be used with the
+** sqlite3_rebaser APIs buffer before returning. In this case (*pnRebase)
+** is set to the size of the buffer in bytes. It is the responsibility of the
+** caller to eventually free any such buffer using sqlite3_free(). The buffer
+** is only allocated and populated if one or more conflicts were encountered
+** while applying the patchset. See comments surrounding the sqlite3_rebaser
+** APIs for further details.
+**
+** The behavior of sqlite3changeset_apply_v2() and its streaming equivalent
+** may be modified by passing a combination of
+** [SQLITE_CHANGESETAPPLY_NOSAVEPOINT | supported flags] as the 9th parameter.
+**
+** Note that the sqlite3changeset_apply_v2() API is still experimental
+** and therefore subject to change.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_apply(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Apply change to "main" db of this handle */
+ int nChangeset, /* Size of changeset in bytes */
+ void *pChangeset, /* Changeset blob */
+ int(*xFilter)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of sixth arg to _apply() */
+ const char *zTab /* Table name */
+ ),
+ int(*xConflict)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of sixth arg to _apply() */
+ int eConflict, /* DATA, MISSING, CONFLICT, CONSTRAINT */
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter *p /* Handle describing change and conflict */
+ ),
+ void *pCtx /* First argument passed to xConflict */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_apply_v2(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Apply change to "main" db of this handle */
+ int nChangeset, /* Size of changeset in bytes */
+ void *pChangeset, /* Changeset blob */
+ int(*xFilter)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of sixth arg to _apply() */
+ const char *zTab /* Table name */
+ ),
+ int(*xConflict)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of sixth arg to _apply() */
+ int eConflict, /* DATA, MISSING, CONFLICT, CONSTRAINT */
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter *p /* Handle describing change and conflict */
+ ),
+ void *pCtx, /* First argument passed to xConflict */
+ void **ppRebase, int *pnRebase, /* OUT: Rebase data */
+ int flags /* SESSION_CHANGESETAPPLY_* flags */
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Flags for sqlite3changeset_apply_v2
+**
+** The following flags may passed via the 9th parameter to
+** [sqlite3changeset_apply_v2] and [sqlite3changeset_apply_v2_strm]:
+**
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESETAPPLY_NOSAVEPOINT
+** Usually, the sessions module encloses all operations performed by
+** a single call to apply_v2() or apply_v2_strm() in a [SAVEPOINT]. The
+** SAVEPOINT is committed if the changeset or patchset is successfully
+** applied, or rolled back if an error occurs. Specifying this flag
+** causes the sessions module to omit this savepoint. In this case, if the
+** caller has an open transaction or savepoint when apply_v2() is called,
+** it may revert the partially applied changeset by rolling it back.
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESETAPPLY_INVERT
+** Invert the changeset before applying it. This is equivalent to inverting
+** a changeset using sqlite3changeset_invert() before applying it. It is
+** an error to specify this flag with a patchset.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESETAPPLY_NOSAVEPOINT 0x0001
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESETAPPLY_INVERT 0x0002
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Constants Passed To The Conflict Handler
+**
+** Values that may be passed as the second argument to a conflict-handler.
+**
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESET_DATA
+** The conflict handler is invoked with CHANGESET_DATA as the second argument
+** when processing a DELETE or UPDATE change if a row with the required
+** PRIMARY KEY fields is present in the database, but one or more other
+** (non primary-key) fields modified by the update do not contain the
+** expected "before" values.
+**
+** The conflicting row, in this case, is the database row with the matching
+** primary key.
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESET_NOTFOUND
+** The conflict handler is invoked with CHANGESET_NOTFOUND as the second
+** argument when processing a DELETE or UPDATE change if a row with the
+** required PRIMARY KEY fields is not present in the database.
+**
+** There is no conflicting row in this case. The results of invoking the
+** sqlite3changeset_conflict() API are undefined.
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONFLICT
+** CHANGESET_CONFLICT is passed as the second argument to the conflict
+** handler while processing an INSERT change if the operation would result
+** in duplicate primary key values.
+**
+** The conflicting row in this case is the database row with the matching
+** primary key.
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESET_FOREIGN_KEY
+** If foreign key handling is enabled, and applying a changeset leaves the
+** database in a state containing foreign key violations, the conflict
+** handler is invoked with CHANGESET_FOREIGN_KEY as the second argument
+** exactly once before the changeset is committed. If the conflict handler
+** returns CHANGESET_OMIT, the changes, including those that caused the
+** foreign key constraint violation, are committed. Or, if it returns
+** CHANGESET_ABORT, the changeset is rolled back.
+**
+** No current or conflicting row information is provided. The only function
+** it is possible to call on the supplied sqlite3_changeset_iter handle
+** is sqlite3changeset_fk_conflicts().
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONSTRAINT
+** If any other constraint violation occurs while applying a change (i.e.
+** a UNIQUE, CHECK or NOT NULL constraint), the conflict handler is
+** invoked with CHANGESET_CONSTRAINT as the second argument.
+**
+** There is no conflicting row in this case. The results of invoking the
+** sqlite3changeset_conflict() API are undefined.
+**
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESET_DATA 1
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESET_NOTFOUND 2
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONFLICT 3
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONSTRAINT 4
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESET_FOREIGN_KEY 5
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Constants Returned By The Conflict Handler
+**
+** A conflict handler callback must return one of the following three values.
+**
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESET_OMIT
+** If a conflict handler returns this value no special action is taken. The
+** change that caused the conflict is not applied. The session module
+** continues to the next change in the changeset.
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESET_REPLACE
+** This value may only be returned if the second argument to the conflict
+** handler was SQLITE_CHANGESET_DATA or SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONFLICT. If this
+** is not the case, any changes applied so far are rolled back and the
+** call to sqlite3changeset_apply() returns SQLITE_MISUSE.
+**
+** If CHANGESET_REPLACE is returned by an SQLITE_CHANGESET_DATA conflict
+** handler, then the conflicting row is either updated or deleted, depending
+** on the type of change.
+**
+** If CHANGESET_REPLACE is returned by an SQLITE_CHANGESET_CONFLICT conflict
+** handler, then the conflicting row is removed from the database and a
+** second attempt to apply the change is made. If this second attempt fails,
+** the original row is restored to the database before continuing.
+**
+**
SQLITE_CHANGESET_ABORT
+** If this value is returned, any changes applied so far are rolled back
+** and the call to sqlite3changeset_apply() returns SQLITE_ABORT.
+**
+*/
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESET_OMIT 0
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESET_REPLACE 1
+#define SQLITE_CHANGESET_ABORT 2
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Rebasing changesets
+** EXPERIMENTAL
+**
+** Suppose there is a site hosting a database in state S0. And that
+** modifications are made that move that database to state S1 and a
+** changeset recorded (the "local" changeset). Then, a changeset based
+** on S0 is received from another site (the "remote" changeset) and
+** applied to the database. The database is then in state
+** (S1+"remote"), where the exact state depends on any conflict
+** resolution decisions (OMIT or REPLACE) made while applying "remote".
+** Rebasing a changeset is to update it to take those conflict
+** resolution decisions into account, so that the same conflicts
+** do not have to be resolved elsewhere in the network.
+**
+** For example, if both the local and remote changesets contain an
+** INSERT of the same key on "CREATE TABLE t1(a PRIMARY KEY, b)":
+**
+** local: INSERT INTO t1 VALUES(1, 'v1');
+** remote: INSERT INTO t1 VALUES(1, 'v2');
+**
+** and the conflict resolution is REPLACE, then the INSERT change is
+** removed from the local changeset (it was overridden). Or, if the
+** conflict resolution was "OMIT", then the local changeset is modified
+** to instead contain:
+**
+** UPDATE t1 SET b = 'v2' WHERE a=1;
+**
+** Changes within the local changeset are rebased as follows:
+**
+**
+**
Local INSERT
+** This may only conflict with a remote INSERT. If the conflict
+** resolution was OMIT, then add an UPDATE change to the rebased
+** changeset. Or, if the conflict resolution was REPLACE, add
+** nothing to the rebased changeset.
+**
+**
Local DELETE
+** This may conflict with a remote UPDATE or DELETE. In both cases the
+** only possible resolution is OMIT. If the remote operation was a
+** DELETE, then add no change to the rebased changeset. If the remote
+** operation was an UPDATE, then the old.* fields of change are updated
+** to reflect the new.* values in the UPDATE.
+**
+**
Local UPDATE
+** This may conflict with a remote UPDATE or DELETE. If it conflicts
+** with a DELETE, and the conflict resolution was OMIT, then the update
+** is changed into an INSERT. Any undefined values in the new.* record
+** from the update change are filled in using the old.* values from
+** the conflicting DELETE. Or, if the conflict resolution was REPLACE,
+** the UPDATE change is simply omitted from the rebased changeset.
+**
+** If conflict is with a remote UPDATE and the resolution is OMIT, then
+** the old.* values are rebased using the new.* values in the remote
+** change. Or, if the resolution is REPLACE, then the change is copied
+** into the rebased changeset with updates to columns also updated by
+** the conflicting remote UPDATE removed. If this means no columns would
+** be updated, the change is omitted.
+**
+**
+** A local change may be rebased against multiple remote changes
+** simultaneously. If a single key is modified by multiple remote
+** changesets, they are combined as follows before the local changeset
+** is rebased:
+**
+**
+**
If there has been one or more REPLACE resolutions on a
+** key, it is rebased according to a REPLACE.
+**
+**
If there have been no REPLACE resolutions on a key, then
+** the local changeset is rebased according to the most recent
+** of the OMIT resolutions.
+**
+**
+** Note that conflict resolutions from multiple remote changesets are
+** combined on a per-field basis, not per-row. This means that in the
+** case of multiple remote UPDATE operations, some fields of a single
+** local change may be rebased for REPLACE while others are rebased for
+** OMIT.
+**
+** In order to rebase a local changeset, the remote changeset must first
+** be applied to the local database using sqlite3changeset_apply_v2() and
+** the buffer of rebase information captured. Then:
+**
+**
+**
An sqlite3_rebaser object is created by calling
+** sqlite3rebaser_create().
+**
The new object is configured with the rebase buffer obtained from
+** sqlite3changeset_apply_v2() by calling sqlite3rebaser_configure().
+** If the local changeset is to be rebased against multiple remote
+** changesets, then sqlite3rebaser_configure() should be called
+** multiple times, in the same order that the multiple
+** sqlite3changeset_apply_v2() calls were made.
+**
Each local changeset is rebased by calling sqlite3rebaser_rebase().
+**
The sqlite3_rebaser object is deleted by calling
+** sqlite3rebaser_delete().
+**
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_rebaser sqlite3_rebaser;
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Create a changeset rebaser object.
+** EXPERIMENTAL
+**
+** Allocate a new changeset rebaser object. If successful, set (*ppNew) to
+** point to the new object and return SQLITE_OK. Otherwise, if an error
+** occurs, return an SQLite error code (e.g. SQLITE_NOMEM) and set (*ppNew)
+** to NULL.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3rebaser_create(sqlite3_rebaser **ppNew);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Configure a changeset rebaser object.
+** EXPERIMENTAL
+**
+** Configure the changeset rebaser object to rebase changesets according
+** to the conflict resolutions described by buffer pRebase (size nRebase
+** bytes), which must have been obtained from a previous call to
+** sqlite3changeset_apply_v2().
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3rebaser_configure(
+ sqlite3_rebaser*,
+ int nRebase, const void *pRebase
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Rebase a changeset
+** EXPERIMENTAL
+**
+** Argument pIn must point to a buffer containing a changeset nIn bytes
+** in size. This function allocates and populates a buffer with a copy
+** of the changeset rebased according to the configuration of the
+** rebaser object passed as the first argument. If successful, (*ppOut)
+** is set to point to the new buffer containing the rebased changeset and
+** (*pnOut) to its size in bytes and SQLITE_OK returned. It is the
+** responsibility of the caller to eventually free the new buffer using
+** sqlite3_free(). Otherwise, if an error occurs, (*ppOut) and (*pnOut)
+** are set to zero and an SQLite error code returned.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3rebaser_rebase(
+ sqlite3_rebaser*,
+ int nIn, const void *pIn,
+ int *pnOut, void **ppOut
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Delete a changeset rebaser object.
+** EXPERIMENTAL
+**
+** Delete the changeset rebaser object and all associated resources. There
+** should be one call to this function for each successful invocation
+** of sqlite3rebaser_create().
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3rebaser_delete(sqlite3_rebaser *p);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Streaming Versions of API functions.
+**
+** The six streaming API xxx_strm() functions serve similar purposes to the
+** corresponding non-streaming API functions:
+**
+**
+**
Streaming function
Non-streaming equivalent
+**
sqlite3changeset_apply_strm
[sqlite3changeset_apply]
+**
sqlite3changeset_apply_strm_v2
[sqlite3changeset_apply_v2]
+**
sqlite3changeset_concat_strm
[sqlite3changeset_concat]
+**
sqlite3changeset_invert_strm
[sqlite3changeset_invert]
+**
sqlite3changeset_start_strm
[sqlite3changeset_start]
+**
sqlite3session_changeset_strm
[sqlite3session_changeset]
+**
sqlite3session_patchset_strm
[sqlite3session_patchset]
+**
+**
+** Non-streaming functions that accept changesets (or patchsets) as input
+** require that the entire changeset be stored in a single buffer in memory.
+** Similarly, those that return a changeset or patchset do so by returning
+** a pointer to a single large buffer allocated using sqlite3_malloc().
+** Normally this is convenient. However, if an application running in a
+** low-memory environment is required to handle very large changesets, the
+** large contiguous memory allocations required can become onerous.
+**
+** In order to avoid this problem, instead of a single large buffer, input
+** is passed to a streaming API functions by way of a callback function that
+** the sessions module invokes to incrementally request input data as it is
+** required. In all cases, a pair of API function parameters such as
+**
+**
+** int nChangeset,
+** void *pChangeset,
+**
+**
+** Is replaced by:
+**
+**
+** int (*xInput)(void *pIn, void *pData, int *pnData),
+** void *pIn,
+**
+**
+** Each time the xInput callback is invoked by the sessions module, the first
+** argument passed is a copy of the supplied pIn context pointer. The second
+** argument, pData, points to a buffer (*pnData) bytes in size. Assuming no
+** error occurs the xInput method should copy up to (*pnData) bytes of data
+** into the buffer and set (*pnData) to the actual number of bytes copied
+** before returning SQLITE_OK. If the input is completely exhausted, (*pnData)
+** should be set to zero to indicate this. Or, if an error occurs, an SQLite
+** error code should be returned. In all cases, if an xInput callback returns
+** an error, all processing is abandoned and the streaming API function
+** returns a copy of the error code to the caller.
+**
+** In the case of sqlite3changeset_start_strm(), the xInput callback may be
+** invoked by the sessions module at any point during the lifetime of the
+** iterator. If such an xInput callback returns an error, the iterator enters
+** an error state, whereby all subsequent calls to iterator functions
+** immediately fail with the same error code as returned by xInput.
+**
+** Similarly, streaming API functions that return changesets (or patchsets)
+** return them in chunks by way of a callback function instead of via a
+** pointer to a single large buffer. In this case, a pair of parameters such
+** as:
+**
+**
+** int *pnChangeset,
+** void **ppChangeset,
+**
+**
+** Is replaced by:
+**
+**
+** int (*xOutput)(void *pOut, const void *pData, int nData),
+** void *pOut
+**
+**
+** The xOutput callback is invoked zero or more times to return data to
+** the application. The first parameter passed to each call is a copy of the
+** pOut pointer supplied by the application. The second parameter, pData,
+** points to a buffer nData bytes in size containing the chunk of output
+** data being returned. If the xOutput callback successfully processes the
+** supplied data, it should return SQLITE_OK to indicate success. Otherwise,
+** it should return some other SQLite error code. In this case processing
+** is immediately abandoned and the streaming API function returns a copy
+** of the xOutput error code to the application.
+**
+** The sessions module never invokes an xOutput callback with the third
+** parameter set to a value less than or equal to zero. Other than this,
+** no guarantees are made as to the size of the chunks of data returned.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_apply_strm(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Apply change to "main" db of this handle */
+ int (*xInput)(void *pIn, void *pData, int *pnData), /* Input function */
+ void *pIn, /* First arg for xInput */
+ int(*xFilter)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of sixth arg to _apply() */
+ const char *zTab /* Table name */
+ ),
+ int(*xConflict)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of sixth arg to _apply() */
+ int eConflict, /* DATA, MISSING, CONFLICT, CONSTRAINT */
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter *p /* Handle describing change and conflict */
+ ),
+ void *pCtx /* First argument passed to xConflict */
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_apply_v2_strm(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Apply change to "main" db of this handle */
+ int (*xInput)(void *pIn, void *pData, int *pnData), /* Input function */
+ void *pIn, /* First arg for xInput */
+ int(*xFilter)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of sixth arg to _apply() */
+ const char *zTab /* Table name */
+ ),
+ int(*xConflict)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of sixth arg to _apply() */
+ int eConflict, /* DATA, MISSING, CONFLICT, CONSTRAINT */
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter *p /* Handle describing change and conflict */
+ ),
+ void *pCtx, /* First argument passed to xConflict */
+ void **ppRebase, int *pnRebase,
+ int flags
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_concat_strm(
+ int (*xInputA)(void *pIn, void *pData, int *pnData),
+ void *pInA,
+ int (*xInputB)(void *pIn, void *pData, int *pnData),
+ void *pInB,
+ int (*xOutput)(void *pOut, const void *pData, int nData),
+ void *pOut
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_invert_strm(
+ int (*xInput)(void *pIn, void *pData, int *pnData),
+ void *pIn,
+ int (*xOutput)(void *pOut, const void *pData, int nData),
+ void *pOut
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_start_strm(
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter **pp,
+ int (*xInput)(void *pIn, void *pData, int *pnData),
+ void *pIn
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changeset_start_v2_strm(
+ sqlite3_changeset_iter **pp,
+ int (*xInput)(void *pIn, void *pData, int *pnData),
+ void *pIn,
+ int flags
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_changeset_strm(
+ sqlite3_session *pSession,
+ int (*xOutput)(void *pOut, const void *pData, int nData),
+ void *pOut
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_patchset_strm(
+ sqlite3_session *pSession,
+ int (*xOutput)(void *pOut, const void *pData, int nData),
+ void *pOut
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changegroup_add_strm(sqlite3_changegroup*,
+ int (*xInput)(void *pIn, void *pData, int *pnData),
+ void *pIn
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3changegroup_output_strm(sqlite3_changegroup*,
+ int (*xOutput)(void *pOut, const void *pData, int nData),
+ void *pOut
+);
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3rebaser_rebase_strm(
+ sqlite3_rebaser *pRebaser,
+ int (*xInput)(void *pIn, void *pData, int *pnData),
+ void *pIn,
+ int (*xOutput)(void *pOut, const void *pData, int nData),
+ void *pOut
+);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Configure global parameters
+**
+** The sqlite3session_config() interface is used to make global configuration
+** changes to the sessions module in order to tune it to the specific needs
+** of the application.
+**
+** The sqlite3session_config() interface is not threadsafe. If it is invoked
+** while any other thread is inside any other sessions method then the
+** results are undefined. Furthermore, if it is invoked after any sessions
+** related objects have been created, the results are also undefined.
+**
+** The first argument to the sqlite3session_config() function must be one
+** of the SQLITE_SESSION_CONFIG_XXX constants defined below. The
+** interpretation of the (void*) value passed as the second parameter and
+** the effect of calling this function depends on the value of the first
+** parameter.
+**
+**
+**
SQLITE_SESSION_CONFIG_STRMSIZE
+** By default, the sessions module streaming interfaces attempt to input
+** and output data in approximately 1 KiB chunks. This operand may be used
+** to set and query the value of this configuration setting. The pointer
+** passed as the second argument must point to a value of type (int).
+** If this value is greater than 0, it is used as the new streaming data
+** chunk size for both input and output. Before returning, the (int) value
+** pointed to by pArg is set to the final value of the streaming interface
+** chunk size.
+**
+**
+** This function returns SQLITE_OK if successful, or an SQLite error code
+** otherwise.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3session_config(int op, void *pArg);
+
+/*
+** CAPI3REF: Values for sqlite3session_config().
+*/
+#define SQLITE_SESSION_CONFIG_STRMSIZE 1
+
+/*
+** Make sure we can call this stuff from C++.
+*/
+#if 0
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* !defined(__SQLITESESSION_H_) && defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_SESSION) */
+
+/******** End of sqlite3session.h *********/
+/******** Begin file fts5.h *********/
+/*
+** 2014 May 31
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** Interfaces to extend FTS5. Using the interfaces defined in this file,
+** FTS5 may be extended with:
+**
+** * custom tokenizers, and
+** * custom auxiliary functions.
+*/
+
+
+#ifndef _FTS5_H
+#define _FTS5_H
+
+
+#if 0
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+/*************************************************************************
+** CUSTOM AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS
+**
+** Virtual table implementations may overload SQL functions by implementing
+** the sqlite3_module.xFindFunction() method.
+*/
+
+typedef struct Fts5ExtensionApi Fts5ExtensionApi;
+typedef struct Fts5Context Fts5Context;
+typedef struct Fts5PhraseIter Fts5PhraseIter;
+
+typedef void (*fts5_extension_function)(
+ const Fts5ExtensionApi *pApi, /* API offered by current FTS version */
+ Fts5Context *pFts, /* First arg to pass to pApi functions */
+ sqlite3_context *pCtx, /* Context for returning result/error */
+ int nVal, /* Number of values in apVal[] array */
+ sqlite3_value **apVal /* Array of trailing arguments */
+);
+
+struct Fts5PhraseIter {
+ const unsigned char *a;
+ const unsigned char *b;
+};
+
+/*
+** EXTENSION API FUNCTIONS
+**
+** xUserData(pFts):
+** Return a copy of the context pointer the extension function was
+** registered with.
+**
+** xColumnTotalSize(pFts, iCol, pnToken):
+** If parameter iCol is less than zero, set output variable *pnToken
+** to the total number of tokens in the FTS5 table. Or, if iCol is
+** non-negative but less than the number of columns in the table, return
+** the total number of tokens in column iCol, considering all rows in
+** the FTS5 table.
+**
+** If parameter iCol is greater than or equal to the number of columns
+** in the table, SQLITE_RANGE is returned. Or, if an error occurs (e.g.
+** an OOM condition or IO error), an appropriate SQLite error code is
+** returned.
+**
+** xColumnCount(pFts):
+** Return the number of columns in the table.
+**
+** xColumnSize(pFts, iCol, pnToken):
+** If parameter iCol is less than zero, set output variable *pnToken
+** to the total number of tokens in the current row. Or, if iCol is
+** non-negative but less than the number of columns in the table, set
+** *pnToken to the number of tokens in column iCol of the current row.
+**
+** If parameter iCol is greater than or equal to the number of columns
+** in the table, SQLITE_RANGE is returned. Or, if an error occurs (e.g.
+** an OOM condition or IO error), an appropriate SQLite error code is
+** returned.
+**
+** This function may be quite inefficient if used with an FTS5 table
+** created with the "columnsize=0" option.
+**
+** xColumnText:
+** This function attempts to retrieve the text of column iCol of the
+** current document. If successful, (*pz) is set to point to a buffer
+** containing the text in utf-8 encoding, (*pn) is set to the size in bytes
+** (not characters) of the buffer and SQLITE_OK is returned. Otherwise,
+** if an error occurs, an SQLite error code is returned and the final values
+** of (*pz) and (*pn) are undefined.
+**
+** xPhraseCount:
+** Returns the number of phrases in the current query expression.
+**
+** xPhraseSize:
+** Returns the number of tokens in phrase iPhrase of the query. Phrases
+** are numbered starting from zero.
+**
+** xInstCount:
+** Set *pnInst to the total number of occurrences of all phrases within
+** the query within the current row. Return SQLITE_OK if successful, or
+** an error code (i.e. SQLITE_NOMEM) if an error occurs.
+**
+** This API can be quite slow if used with an FTS5 table created with the
+** "detail=none" or "detail=column" option. If the FTS5 table is created
+** with either "detail=none" or "detail=column" and "content=" option
+** (i.e. if it is a contentless table), then this API always returns 0.
+**
+** xInst:
+** Query for the details of phrase match iIdx within the current row.
+** Phrase matches are numbered starting from zero, so the iIdx argument
+** should be greater than or equal to zero and smaller than the value
+** output by xInstCount().
+**
+** Usually, output parameter *piPhrase is set to the phrase number, *piCol
+** to the column in which it occurs and *piOff the token offset of the
+** first token of the phrase. Returns SQLITE_OK if successful, or an error
+** code (i.e. SQLITE_NOMEM) if an error occurs.
+**
+** This API can be quite slow if used with an FTS5 table created with the
+** "detail=none" or "detail=column" option.
+**
+** xRowid:
+** Returns the rowid of the current row.
+**
+** xTokenize:
+** Tokenize text using the tokenizer belonging to the FTS5 table.
+**
+** xQueryPhrase(pFts5, iPhrase, pUserData, xCallback):
+** This API function is used to query the FTS table for phrase iPhrase
+** of the current query. Specifically, a query equivalent to:
+**
+** ... FROM ftstable WHERE ftstable MATCH $p ORDER BY rowid
+**
+** with $p set to a phrase equivalent to the phrase iPhrase of the
+** current query is executed. Any column filter that applies to
+** phrase iPhrase of the current query is included in $p. For each
+** row visited, the callback function passed as the fourth argument
+** is invoked. The context and API objects passed to the callback
+** function may be used to access the properties of each matched row.
+** Invoking Api.xUserData() returns a copy of the pointer passed as
+** the third argument to pUserData.
+**
+** If the callback function returns any value other than SQLITE_OK, the
+** query is abandoned and the xQueryPhrase function returns immediately.
+** If the returned value is SQLITE_DONE, xQueryPhrase returns SQLITE_OK.
+** Otherwise, the error code is propagated upwards.
+**
+** If the query runs to completion without incident, SQLITE_OK is returned.
+** Or, if some error occurs before the query completes or is aborted by
+** the callback, an SQLite error code is returned.
+**
+**
+** xSetAuxdata(pFts5, pAux, xDelete)
+**
+** Save the pointer passed as the second argument as the extension function's
+** "auxiliary data". The pointer may then be retrieved by the current or any
+** future invocation of the same fts5 extension function made as part of
+** the same MATCH query using the xGetAuxdata() API.
+**
+** Each extension function is allocated a single auxiliary data slot for
+** each FTS query (MATCH expression). If the extension function is invoked
+** more than once for a single FTS query, then all invocations share a
+** single auxiliary data context.
+**
+** If there is already an auxiliary data pointer when this function is
+** invoked, then it is replaced by the new pointer. If an xDelete callback
+** was specified along with the original pointer, it is invoked at this
+** point.
+**
+** The xDelete callback, if one is specified, is also invoked on the
+** auxiliary data pointer after the FTS5 query has finished.
+**
+** If an error (e.g. an OOM condition) occurs within this function,
+** the auxiliary data is set to NULL and an error code returned. If the
+** xDelete parameter was not NULL, it is invoked on the auxiliary data
+** pointer before returning.
+**
+**
+** xGetAuxdata(pFts5, bClear)
+**
+** Returns the current auxiliary data pointer for the fts5 extension
+** function. See the xSetAuxdata() method for details.
+**
+** If the bClear argument is non-zero, then the auxiliary data is cleared
+** (set to NULL) before this function returns. In this case the xDelete,
+** if any, is not invoked.
+**
+**
+** xRowCount(pFts5, pnRow)
+**
+** This function is used to retrieve the total number of rows in the table.
+** In other words, the same value that would be returned by:
+**
+** SELECT count(*) FROM ftstable;
+**
+** xPhraseFirst()
+** This function is used, along with type Fts5PhraseIter and the xPhraseNext
+** method, to iterate through all instances of a single query phrase within
+** the current row. This is the same information as is accessible via the
+** xInstCount/xInst APIs. While the xInstCount/xInst APIs are more convenient
+** to use, this API may be faster under some circumstances. To iterate
+** through instances of phrase iPhrase, use the following code:
+**
+** Fts5PhraseIter iter;
+** int iCol, iOff;
+** for(pApi->xPhraseFirst(pFts, iPhrase, &iter, &iCol, &iOff);
+** iCol>=0;
+** pApi->xPhraseNext(pFts, &iter, &iCol, &iOff)
+** ){
+** // An instance of phrase iPhrase at offset iOff of column iCol
+** }
+**
+** The Fts5PhraseIter structure is defined above. Applications should not
+** modify this structure directly - it should only be used as shown above
+** with the xPhraseFirst() and xPhraseNext() API methods (and by
+** xPhraseFirstColumn() and xPhraseNextColumn() as illustrated below).
+**
+** This API can be quite slow if used with an FTS5 table created with the
+** "detail=none" or "detail=column" option. If the FTS5 table is created
+** with either "detail=none" or "detail=column" and "content=" option
+** (i.e. if it is a contentless table), then this API always iterates
+** through an empty set (all calls to xPhraseFirst() set iCol to -1).
+**
+** xPhraseNext()
+** See xPhraseFirst above.
+**
+** xPhraseFirstColumn()
+** This function and xPhraseNextColumn() are similar to the xPhraseFirst()
+** and xPhraseNext() APIs described above. The difference is that instead
+** of iterating through all instances of a phrase in the current row, these
+** APIs are used to iterate through the set of columns in the current row
+** that contain one or more instances of a specified phrase. For example:
+**
+** Fts5PhraseIter iter;
+** int iCol;
+** for(pApi->xPhraseFirstColumn(pFts, iPhrase, &iter, &iCol);
+** iCol>=0;
+** pApi->xPhraseNextColumn(pFts, &iter, &iCol)
+** ){
+** // Column iCol contains at least one instance of phrase iPhrase
+** }
+**
+** This API can be quite slow if used with an FTS5 table created with the
+** "detail=none" option. If the FTS5 table is created with either
+** "detail=none" "content=" option (i.e. if it is a contentless table),
+** then this API always iterates through an empty set (all calls to
+** xPhraseFirstColumn() set iCol to -1).
+**
+** The information accessed using this API and its companion
+** xPhraseFirstColumn() may also be obtained using xPhraseFirst/xPhraseNext
+** (or xInst/xInstCount). The chief advantage of this API is that it is
+** significantly more efficient than those alternatives when used with
+** "detail=column" tables.
+**
+** xPhraseNextColumn()
+** See xPhraseFirstColumn above.
+*/
+struct Fts5ExtensionApi {
+ int iVersion; /* Currently always set to 3 */
+
+ void *(*xUserData)(Fts5Context*);
+
+ int (*xColumnCount)(Fts5Context*);
+ int (*xRowCount)(Fts5Context*, sqlite3_int64 *pnRow);
+ int (*xColumnTotalSize)(Fts5Context*, int iCol, sqlite3_int64 *pnToken);
+
+ int (*xTokenize)(Fts5Context*,
+ const char *pText, int nText, /* Text to tokenize */
+ void *pCtx, /* Context passed to xToken() */
+ int (*xToken)(void*, int, const char*, int, int, int) /* Callback */
+ );
+
+ int (*xPhraseCount)(Fts5Context*);
+ int (*xPhraseSize)(Fts5Context*, int iPhrase);
+
+ int (*xInstCount)(Fts5Context*, int *pnInst);
+ int (*xInst)(Fts5Context*, int iIdx, int *piPhrase, int *piCol, int *piOff);
+
+ sqlite3_int64 (*xRowid)(Fts5Context*);
+ int (*xColumnText)(Fts5Context*, int iCol, const char **pz, int *pn);
+ int (*xColumnSize)(Fts5Context*, int iCol, int *pnToken);
+
+ int (*xQueryPhrase)(Fts5Context*, int iPhrase, void *pUserData,
+ int(*)(const Fts5ExtensionApi*,Fts5Context*,void*)
+ );
+ int (*xSetAuxdata)(Fts5Context*, void *pAux, void(*xDelete)(void*));
+ void *(*xGetAuxdata)(Fts5Context*, int bClear);
+
+ int (*xPhraseFirst)(Fts5Context*, int iPhrase, Fts5PhraseIter*, int*, int*);
+ void (*xPhraseNext)(Fts5Context*, Fts5PhraseIter*, int *piCol, int *piOff);
+
+ int (*xPhraseFirstColumn)(Fts5Context*, int iPhrase, Fts5PhraseIter*, int*);
+ void (*xPhraseNextColumn)(Fts5Context*, Fts5PhraseIter*, int *piCol);
+};
+
+/*
+** CUSTOM AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS
+*************************************************************************/
+
+/*************************************************************************
+** CUSTOM TOKENIZERS
+**
+** Applications may also register custom tokenizer types. A tokenizer
+** is registered by providing fts5 with a populated instance of the
+** following structure. All structure methods must be defined, setting
+** any member of the fts5_tokenizer struct to NULL leads to undefined
+** behaviour. The structure methods are expected to function as follows:
+**
+** xCreate:
+** This function is used to allocate and initialize a tokenizer instance.
+** A tokenizer instance is required to actually tokenize text.
+**
+** The first argument passed to this function is a copy of the (void*)
+** pointer provided by the application when the fts5_tokenizer object
+** was registered with FTS5 (the third argument to xCreateTokenizer()).
+** The second and third arguments are an array of nul-terminated strings
+** containing the tokenizer arguments, if any, specified following the
+** tokenizer name as part of the CREATE VIRTUAL TABLE statement used
+** to create the FTS5 table.
+**
+** The final argument is an output variable. If successful, (*ppOut)
+** should be set to point to the new tokenizer handle and SQLITE_OK
+** returned. If an error occurs, some value other than SQLITE_OK should
+** be returned. In this case, fts5 assumes that the final value of *ppOut
+** is undefined.
+**
+** xDelete:
+** This function is invoked to delete a tokenizer handle previously
+** allocated using xCreate(). Fts5 guarantees that this function will
+** be invoked exactly once for each successful call to xCreate().
+**
+** xTokenize:
+** This function is expected to tokenize the nText byte string indicated
+** by argument pText. pText may or may not be nul-terminated. The first
+** argument passed to this function is a pointer to an Fts5Tokenizer object
+** returned by an earlier call to xCreate().
+**
+** The second argument indicates the reason that FTS5 is requesting
+** tokenization of the supplied text. This is always one of the following
+** four values:
+**
+**
FTS5_TOKENIZE_DOCUMENT - A document is being inserted into
+** or removed from the FTS table. The tokenizer is being invoked to
+** determine the set of tokens to add to (or delete from) the
+** FTS index.
+**
+**
FTS5_TOKENIZE_QUERY - A MATCH query is being executed
+** against the FTS index. The tokenizer is being called to tokenize
+** a bareword or quoted string specified as part of the query.
+**
+**
(FTS5_TOKENIZE_QUERY | FTS5_TOKENIZE_PREFIX) - Same as
+** FTS5_TOKENIZE_QUERY, except that the bareword or quoted string is
+** followed by a "*" character, indicating that the last token
+** returned by the tokenizer will be treated as a token prefix.
+**
+**
FTS5_TOKENIZE_AUX - The tokenizer is being invoked to
+** satisfy an fts5_api.xTokenize() request made by an auxiliary
+** function. Or an fts5_api.xColumnSize() request made by the same
+** on a columnsize=0 database.
+**
+**
+** For each token in the input string, the supplied callback xToken() must
+** be invoked. The first argument to it should be a copy of the pointer
+** passed as the second argument to xTokenize(). The third and fourth
+** arguments are a pointer to a buffer containing the token text, and the
+** size of the token in bytes. The 4th and 5th arguments are the byte offsets
+** of the first byte of and first byte immediately following the text from
+** which the token is derived within the input.
+**
+** The second argument passed to the xToken() callback ("tflags") should
+** normally be set to 0. The exception is if the tokenizer supports
+** synonyms. In this case see the discussion below for details.
+**
+** FTS5 assumes the xToken() callback is invoked for each token in the
+** order that they occur within the input text.
+**
+** If an xToken() callback returns any value other than SQLITE_OK, then
+** the tokenization should be abandoned and the xTokenize() method should
+** immediately return a copy of the xToken() return value. Or, if the
+** input buffer is exhausted, xTokenize() should return SQLITE_OK. Finally,
+** if an error occurs with the xTokenize() implementation itself, it
+** may abandon the tokenization and return any error code other than
+** SQLITE_OK or SQLITE_DONE.
+**
+** SYNONYM SUPPORT
+**
+** Custom tokenizers may also support synonyms. Consider a case in which a
+** user wishes to query for a phrase such as "first place". Using the
+** built-in tokenizers, the FTS5 query 'first + place' will match instances
+** of "first place" within the document set, but not alternative forms
+** such as "1st place". In some applications, it would be better to match
+** all instances of "first place" or "1st place" regardless of which form
+** the user specified in the MATCH query text.
+**
+** There are several ways to approach this in FTS5:
+**
+**
By mapping all synonyms to a single token. In this case, using
+** the above example, this means that the tokenizer returns the
+** same token for inputs "first" and "1st". Say that token is in
+** fact "first", so that when the user inserts the document "I won
+** 1st place" entries are added to the index for tokens "i", "won",
+** "first" and "place". If the user then queries for '1st + place',
+** the tokenizer substitutes "first" for "1st" and the query works
+** as expected.
+**
+**
By querying the index for all synonyms of each query term
+** separately. In this case, when tokenizing query text, the
+** tokenizer may provide multiple synonyms for a single term
+** within the document. FTS5 then queries the index for each
+** synonym individually. For example, faced with the query:
+**
+**
+** ... MATCH 'first place'
+**
+** the tokenizer offers both "1st" and "first" as synonyms for the
+** first token in the MATCH query and FTS5 effectively runs a query
+** similar to:
+**
+**
+** ... MATCH '(first OR 1st) place'
+**
+** except that, for the purposes of auxiliary functions, the query
+** still appears to contain just two phrases - "(first OR 1st)"
+** being treated as a single phrase.
+**
+**
By adding multiple synonyms for a single term to the FTS index.
+** Using this method, when tokenizing document text, the tokenizer
+** provides multiple synonyms for each token. So that when a
+** document such as "I won first place" is tokenized, entries are
+** added to the FTS index for "i", "won", "first", "1st" and
+** "place".
+**
+** This way, even if the tokenizer does not provide synonyms
+** when tokenizing query text (it should not - to do so would be
+** inefficient), it doesn't matter if the user queries for
+** 'first + place' or '1st + place', as there are entries in the
+** FTS index corresponding to both forms of the first token.
+**
+**
+** Whether it is parsing document or query text, any call to xToken that
+** specifies a tflags argument with the FTS5_TOKEN_COLOCATED bit
+** is considered to supply a synonym for the previous token. For example,
+** when parsing the document "I won first place", a tokenizer that supports
+** synonyms would call xToken() 5 times, as follows:
+**
+**
+** xToken(pCtx, 0, "i", 1, 0, 1);
+** xToken(pCtx, 0, "won", 3, 2, 5);
+** xToken(pCtx, 0, "first", 5, 6, 11);
+** xToken(pCtx, FTS5_TOKEN_COLOCATED, "1st", 3, 6, 11);
+** xToken(pCtx, 0, "place", 5, 12, 17);
+**
+**
+** It is an error to specify the FTS5_TOKEN_COLOCATED flag the first time
+** xToken() is called. Multiple synonyms may be specified for a single token
+** by making multiple calls to xToken(FTS5_TOKEN_COLOCATED) in sequence.
+** There is no limit to the number of synonyms that may be provided for a
+** single token.
+**
+** In many cases, method (1) above is the best approach. It does not add
+** extra data to the FTS index or require FTS5 to query for multiple terms,
+** so it is efficient in terms of disk space and query speed. However, it
+** does not support prefix queries very well. If, as suggested above, the
+** token "first" is substituted for "1st" by the tokenizer, then the query:
+**
+**
+** ... MATCH '1s*'
+**
+** will not match documents that contain the token "1st" (as the tokenizer
+** will probably not map "1s" to any prefix of "first").
+**
+** For full prefix support, method (3) may be preferred. In this case,
+** because the index contains entries for both "first" and "1st", prefix
+** queries such as 'fi*' or '1s*' will match correctly. However, because
+** extra entries are added to the FTS index, this method uses more space
+** within the database.
+**
+** Method (2) offers a midpoint between (1) and (3). Using this method,
+** a query such as '1s*' will match documents that contain the literal
+** token "1st", but not "first" (assuming the tokenizer is not able to
+** provide synonyms for prefixes). However, a non-prefix query like '1st'
+** will match against "1st" and "first". This method does not require
+** extra disk space, as no extra entries are added to the FTS index.
+** On the other hand, it may require more CPU cycles to run MATCH queries,
+** as separate queries of the FTS index are required for each synonym.
+**
+** When using methods (2) or (3), it is important that the tokenizer only
+** provide synonyms when tokenizing document text (method (2)) or query
+** text (method (3)), not both. Doing so will not cause any errors, but is
+** inefficient.
+*/
+typedef struct Fts5Tokenizer Fts5Tokenizer;
+typedef struct fts5_tokenizer fts5_tokenizer;
+struct fts5_tokenizer {
+ int (*xCreate)(void*, const char **azArg, int nArg, Fts5Tokenizer **ppOut);
+ void (*xDelete)(Fts5Tokenizer*);
+ int (*xTokenize)(Fts5Tokenizer*,
+ void *pCtx,
+ int flags, /* Mask of FTS5_TOKENIZE_* flags */
+ const char *pText, int nText,
+ int (*xToken)(
+ void *pCtx, /* Copy of 2nd argument to xTokenize() */
+ int tflags, /* Mask of FTS5_TOKEN_* flags */
+ const char *pToken, /* Pointer to buffer containing token */
+ int nToken, /* Size of token in bytes */
+ int iStart, /* Byte offset of token within input text */
+ int iEnd /* Byte offset of end of token within input text */
+ )
+ );
+};
+
+/* Flags that may be passed as the third argument to xTokenize() */
+#define FTS5_TOKENIZE_QUERY 0x0001
+#define FTS5_TOKENIZE_PREFIX 0x0002
+#define FTS5_TOKENIZE_DOCUMENT 0x0004
+#define FTS5_TOKENIZE_AUX 0x0008
+
+/* Flags that may be passed by the tokenizer implementation back to FTS5
+** as the third argument to the supplied xToken callback. */
+#define FTS5_TOKEN_COLOCATED 0x0001 /* Same position as prev. token */
+
+/*
+** END OF CUSTOM TOKENIZERS
+*************************************************************************/
+
+/*************************************************************************
+** FTS5 EXTENSION REGISTRATION API
+*/
+typedef struct fts5_api fts5_api;
+struct fts5_api {
+ int iVersion; /* Currently always set to 2 */
+
+ /* Create a new tokenizer */
+ int (*xCreateTokenizer)(
+ fts5_api *pApi,
+ const char *zName,
+ void *pContext,
+ fts5_tokenizer *pTokenizer,
+ void (*xDestroy)(void*)
+ );
+
+ /* Find an existing tokenizer */
+ int (*xFindTokenizer)(
+ fts5_api *pApi,
+ const char *zName,
+ void **ppContext,
+ fts5_tokenizer *pTokenizer
+ );
+
+ /* Create a new auxiliary function */
+ int (*xCreateFunction)(
+ fts5_api *pApi,
+ const char *zName,
+ void *pContext,
+ fts5_extension_function xFunction,
+ void (*xDestroy)(void*)
+ );
+};
+
+/*
+** END OF REGISTRATION API
+*************************************************************************/
+
+#if 0
+} /* end of the 'extern "C"' block */
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _FTS5_H */
+
+/******** End of fts5.h *********/
+
+/************** End of sqlite3.h *********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+
+/*
+** Include the configuration header output by 'configure' if we're using the
+** autoconf-based build
+*/
+#if defined(_HAVE_SQLITE_CONFIG_H) && !defined(SQLITECONFIG_H)
+/* #include "config.h" */
+#define SQLITECONFIG_H 1
+#endif
+
+/************** Include sqliteLimit.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ***********/
+/************** Begin file sqliteLimit.h *************************************/
+/*
+** 2007 May 7
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This file defines various limits of what SQLite can process.
+*/
+
+/*
+** The maximum length of a TEXT or BLOB in bytes. This also
+** limits the size of a row in a table or index.
+**
+** The hard limit is the ability of a 32-bit signed integer
+** to count the size: 2^31-1 or 2147483647.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH
+# define SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH 1000000000
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This is the maximum number of
+**
+** * Columns in a table
+** * Columns in an index
+** * Columns in a view
+** * Terms in the SET clause of an UPDATE statement
+** * Terms in the result set of a SELECT statement
+** * Terms in the GROUP BY or ORDER BY clauses of a SELECT statement.
+** * Terms in the VALUES clause of an INSERT statement
+**
+** The hard upper limit here is 32676. Most database people will
+** tell you that in a well-normalized database, you usually should
+** not have more than a dozen or so columns in any table. And if
+** that is the case, there is no point in having more than a few
+** dozen values in any of the other situations described above.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_COLUMN
+# define SQLITE_MAX_COLUMN 2000
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The maximum length of a single SQL statement in bytes.
+**
+** It used to be the case that setting this value to zero would
+** turn the limit off. That is no longer true. It is not possible
+** to turn this limit off.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_SQL_LENGTH
+# define SQLITE_MAX_SQL_LENGTH 1000000000
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The maximum depth of an expression tree. This is limited to
+** some extent by SQLITE_MAX_SQL_LENGTH. But sometime you might
+** want to place more severe limits on the complexity of an
+** expression.
+**
+** A value of 0 used to mean that the limit was not enforced.
+** But that is no longer true. The limit is now strictly enforced
+** at all times.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH
+# define SQLITE_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH 1000
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The maximum number of terms in a compound SELECT statement.
+** The code generator for compound SELECT statements does one
+** level of recursion for each term. A stack overflow can result
+** if the number of terms is too large. In practice, most SQL
+** never has more than 3 or 4 terms. Use a value of 0 to disable
+** any limit on the number of terms in a compount SELECT.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT
+# define SQLITE_MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT 500
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The maximum number of opcodes in a VDBE program.
+** Not currently enforced.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_VDBE_OP
+# define SQLITE_MAX_VDBE_OP 250000000
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The maximum number of arguments to an SQL function.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_FUNCTION_ARG
+# define SQLITE_MAX_FUNCTION_ARG 127
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The suggested maximum number of in-memory pages to use for
+** the main database table and for temporary tables.
+**
+** IMPLEMENTATION-OF: R-30185-15359 The default suggested cache size is -2000,
+** which means the cache size is limited to 2048000 bytes of memory.
+** IMPLEMENTATION-OF: R-48205-43578 The default suggested cache size can be
+** altered using the SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE compile-time options.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE -2000
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The default number of frames to accumulate in the log file before
+** checkpointing the database in WAL mode.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_AUTOCHECKPOINT
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_AUTOCHECKPOINT 1000
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The maximum number of attached databases. This must be between 0
+** and 125. The upper bound of 125 is because the attached databases are
+** counted using a signed 8-bit integer which has a maximum value of 127
+** and we have to allow 2 extra counts for the "main" and "temp" databases.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_ATTACHED
+# define SQLITE_MAX_ATTACHED 10
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+** The maximum value of a ?nnn wildcard that the parser will accept.
+** If the value exceeds 32767 then extra space is required for the Expr
+** structure. But otherwise, we believe that the number can be as large
+** as a signed 32-bit integer can hold.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER
+# define SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER 32766
+#endif
+
+/* Maximum page size. The upper bound on this value is 65536. This a limit
+** imposed by the use of 16-bit offsets within each page.
+**
+** Earlier versions of SQLite allowed the user to change this value at
+** compile time. This is no longer permitted, on the grounds that it creates
+** a library that is technically incompatible with an SQLite library
+** compiled with a different limit. If a process operating on a database
+** with a page-size of 65536 bytes crashes, then an instance of SQLite
+** compiled with the default page-size limit will not be able to rollback
+** the aborted transaction. This could lead to database corruption.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE
+# undef SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE
+#endif
+#define SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE 65536
+
+
+/*
+** The default size of a database page.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE 4096
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE>SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE
+# undef SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Ordinarily, if no value is explicitly provided, SQLite creates databases
+** with page size SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE. However, based on certain
+** device characteristics (sector-size and atomic write() support),
+** SQLite may choose a larger value. This constant is the maximum value
+** SQLite will choose on its own.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE 8192
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE>SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE
+# undef SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+** Maximum number of pages in one database file.
+**
+** This is really just the default value for the max_page_count pragma.
+** This value can be lowered (or raised) at run-time using that the
+** max_page_count macro.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_COUNT
+# define SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_COUNT 1073741823
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Maximum length (in bytes) of the pattern in a LIKE or GLOB
+** operator.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH
+# define SQLITE_MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH 50000
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Maximum depth of recursion for triggers.
+**
+** A value of 1 means that a trigger program will not be able to itself
+** fire any triggers. A value of 0 means that no trigger programs at all
+** may be executed.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_TRIGGER_DEPTH
+# define SQLITE_MAX_TRIGGER_DEPTH 1000
+#endif
+
+/************** End of sqliteLimit.h *****************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+
+/* Disable nuisance warnings on Borland compilers */
+#if defined(__BORLANDC__)
+#pragma warn -rch /* unreachable code */
+#pragma warn -ccc /* Condition is always true or false */
+#pragma warn -aus /* Assigned value is never used */
+#pragma warn -csu /* Comparing signed and unsigned */
+#pragma warn -spa /* Suspicious pointer arithmetic */
+#endif
+
+/*
+** WAL mode depends on atomic aligned 32-bit loads and stores in a few
+** places. The following macros try to make this explicit.
+*/
+#ifndef __has_extension
+# define __has_extension(x) 0 /* compatibility with non-clang compilers */
+#endif
+#if GCC_VERSION>=4007000 || __has_extension(c_atomic)
+# define AtomicLoad(PTR) __atomic_load_n((PTR),__ATOMIC_RELAXED)
+# define AtomicStore(PTR,VAL) __atomic_store_n((PTR),(VAL),__ATOMIC_RELAXED)
+#else
+# define AtomicLoad(PTR) (*(PTR))
+# define AtomicStore(PTR,VAL) (*(PTR) = (VAL))
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Include standard header files as necessary
+*/
+#ifdef HAVE_STDINT_H
+#include
+#endif
+#ifdef HAVE_INTTYPES_H
+#include
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The following macros are used to cast pointers to integers and
+** integers to pointers. The way you do this varies from one compiler
+** to the next, so we have developed the following set of #if statements
+** to generate appropriate macros for a wide range of compilers.
+**
+** The correct "ANSI" way to do this is to use the intptr_t type.
+** Unfortunately, that typedef is not available on all compilers, or
+** if it is available, it requires an #include of specific headers
+** that vary from one machine to the next.
+**
+** Ticket #3860: The llvm-gcc-4.2 compiler from Apple chokes on
+** the ((void*)&((char*)0)[X]) construct. But MSVC chokes on ((void*)(X)).
+** So we have to define the macros in different ways depending on the
+** compiler.
+*/
+#if defined(HAVE_STDINT_H) /* Use this case if we have ANSI headers */
+# define SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(X) ((void*)(intptr_t)(X))
+# define SQLITE_PTR_TO_INT(X) ((int)(intptr_t)(X))
+#elif defined(__PTRDIFF_TYPE__) /* This case should work for GCC */
+# define SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(X) ((void*)(__PTRDIFF_TYPE__)(X))
+# define SQLITE_PTR_TO_INT(X) ((int)(__PTRDIFF_TYPE__)(X))
+#elif !defined(__GNUC__) /* Works for compilers other than LLVM */
+# define SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(X) ((void*)&((char*)0)[X])
+# define SQLITE_PTR_TO_INT(X) ((int)(((char*)X)-(char*)0))
+#else /* Generates a warning - but it always works */
+# define SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(X) ((void*)(X))
+# define SQLITE_PTR_TO_INT(X) ((int)(X))
+#endif
+
+/*
+** A macro to hint to the compiler that a function should not be
+** inlined.
+*/
+#if defined(__GNUC__)
+# define SQLITE_NOINLINE __attribute__((noinline))
+#elif defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER>=1310
+# define SQLITE_NOINLINE __declspec(noinline)
+#else
+# define SQLITE_NOINLINE
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Make sure that the compiler intrinsics we desire are enabled when
+** compiling with an appropriate version of MSVC unless prevented by
+** the SQLITE_DISABLE_INTRINSIC define.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_DISABLE_INTRINSIC)
+# if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER>=1400
+# if !defined(_WIN32_WCE)
+# include
+# pragma intrinsic(_byteswap_ushort)
+# pragma intrinsic(_byteswap_ulong)
+# pragma intrinsic(_byteswap_uint64)
+# pragma intrinsic(_ReadWriteBarrier)
+# else
+# include
+# endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The SQLITE_THREADSAFE macro must be defined as 0, 1, or 2.
+** 0 means mutexes are permanently disable and the library is never
+** threadsafe. 1 means the library is serialized which is the highest
+** level of threadsafety. 2 means the library is multithreaded - multiple
+** threads can use SQLite as long as no two threads try to use the same
+** database connection at the same time.
+**
+** Older versions of SQLite used an optional THREADSAFE macro.
+** We support that for legacy.
+**
+** To ensure that the correct value of "THREADSAFE" is reported when querying
+** for compile-time options at runtime (e.g. "PRAGMA compile_options"), this
+** logic is partially replicated in ctime.c. If it is updated here, it should
+** also be updated there.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_THREADSAFE)
+# if defined(THREADSAFE)
+# define SQLITE_THREADSAFE THREADSAFE
+# else
+# define SQLITE_THREADSAFE 1 /* IMP: R-07272-22309 */
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Powersafe overwrite is on by default. But can be turned off using
+** the -DSQLITE_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE=0 command-line option.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE
+# define SQLITE_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** EVIDENCE-OF: R-25715-37072 Memory allocation statistics are enabled by
+** default unless SQLite is compiled with SQLITE_DEFAULT_MEMSTATUS=0 in
+** which case memory allocation statistics are disabled by default.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_DEFAULT_MEMSTATUS)
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_MEMSTATUS 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Exactly one of the following macros must be defined in order to
+** specify which memory allocation subsystem to use.
+**
+** SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC // Use normal system malloc()
+** SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC // Use Win32 native heap API
+** SQLITE_ZERO_MALLOC // Use a stub allocator that always fails
+** SQLITE_MEMDEBUG // Debugging version of system malloc()
+**
+** On Windows, if the SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC_VALIDATE macro is defined and the
+** assert() macro is enabled, each call into the Win32 native heap subsystem
+** will cause HeapValidate to be called. If heap validation should fail, an
+** assertion will be triggered.
+**
+** If none of the above are defined, then set SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC as
+** the default.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC) \
+ + defined(SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC) \
+ + defined(SQLITE_ZERO_MALLOC) \
+ + defined(SQLITE_MEMDEBUG)>1
+# error "Two or more of the following compile-time configuration options\
+ are defined but at most one is allowed:\
+ SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC, SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC, SQLITE_MEMDEBUG,\
+ SQLITE_ZERO_MALLOC"
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC) \
+ + defined(SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC) \
+ + defined(SQLITE_ZERO_MALLOC) \
+ + defined(SQLITE_MEMDEBUG)==0
+# define SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** If SQLITE_MALLOC_SOFT_LIMIT is not zero, then try to keep the
+** sizes of memory allocations below this value where possible.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_MALLOC_SOFT_LIMIT)
+# define SQLITE_MALLOC_SOFT_LIMIT 1024
+#endif
+
+/*
+** We need to define _XOPEN_SOURCE as follows in order to enable
+** recursive mutexes on most Unix systems and fchmod() on OpenBSD.
+** But _XOPEN_SOURCE define causes problems for Mac OS X, so omit
+** it.
+*/
+#if !defined(_XOPEN_SOURCE) && !defined(__DARWIN__) && !defined(__APPLE__)
+# define _XOPEN_SOURCE 600
+#endif
+
+/*
+** NDEBUG and SQLITE_DEBUG are opposites. It should always be true that
+** defined(NDEBUG)==!defined(SQLITE_DEBUG). If this is not currently true,
+** make it true by defining or undefining NDEBUG.
+**
+** Setting NDEBUG makes the code smaller and faster by disabling the
+** assert() statements in the code. So we want the default action
+** to be for NDEBUG to be set and NDEBUG to be undefined only if SQLITE_DEBUG
+** is set. Thus NDEBUG becomes an opt-in rather than an opt-out
+** feature.
+*/
+#if !defined(NDEBUG) && !defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+# define NDEBUG 1
+#endif
+#if defined(NDEBUG) && defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+# undef NDEBUG
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Enable SQLITE_ENABLE_EXPLAIN_COMMENTS if SQLITE_DEBUG is turned on.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_EXPLAIN_COMMENTS) && defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+# define SQLITE_ENABLE_EXPLAIN_COMMENTS 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The testcase() macro is used to aid in coverage testing. When
+** doing coverage testing, the condition inside the argument to
+** testcase() must be evaluated both true and false in order to
+** get full branch coverage. The testcase() macro is inserted
+** to help ensure adequate test coverage in places where simple
+** condition/decision coverage is inadequate. For example, testcase()
+** can be used to make sure boundary values are tested. For
+** bitmask tests, testcase() can be used to make sure each bit
+** is significant and used at least once. On switch statements
+** where multiple cases go to the same block of code, testcase()
+** can insure that all cases are evaluated.
+**
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_COVERAGE_TEST
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Coverage(int);
+# define testcase(X) if( X ){ sqlite3Coverage(__LINE__); }
+#else
+# define testcase(X)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The TESTONLY macro is used to enclose variable declarations or
+** other bits of code that are needed to support the arguments
+** within testcase() and assert() macros.
+*/
+#if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_COVERAGE_TEST)
+# define TESTONLY(X) X
+#else
+# define TESTONLY(X)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Sometimes we need a small amount of code such as a variable initialization
+** to setup for a later assert() statement. We do not want this code to
+** appear when assert() is disabled. The following macro is therefore
+** used to contain that setup code. The "VVA" acronym stands for
+** "Verification, Validation, and Accreditation". In other words, the
+** code within VVA_ONLY() will only run during verification processes.
+*/
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+# define VVA_ONLY(X) X
+#else
+# define VVA_ONLY(X)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The ALWAYS and NEVER macros surround boolean expressions which
+** are intended to always be true or false, respectively. Such
+** expressions could be omitted from the code completely. But they
+** are included in a few cases in order to enhance the resilience
+** of SQLite to unexpected behavior - to make the code "self-healing"
+** or "ductile" rather than being "brittle" and crashing at the first
+** hint of unplanned behavior.
+**
+** In other words, ALWAYS and NEVER are added for defensive code.
+**
+** When doing coverage testing ALWAYS and NEVER are hard-coded to
+** be true and false so that the unreachable code they specify will
+** not be counted as untested code.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_COVERAGE_TEST) || defined(SQLITE_MUTATION_TEST)
+# define ALWAYS(X) (1)
+# define NEVER(X) (0)
+#elif !defined(NDEBUG)
+# define ALWAYS(X) ((X)?1:(assert(0),0))
+# define NEVER(X) ((X)?(assert(0),1):0)
+#else
+# define ALWAYS(X) (X)
+# define NEVER(X) (X)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The harmless(X) macro indicates that expression X is usually false
+** but can be true without causing any problems, but we don't know of
+** any way to cause X to be true.
+**
+** In debugging and testing builds, this macro will abort if X is ever
+** true. In this way, developers are alerted to a possible test case
+** that causes X to be true. If a harmless macro ever fails, that is
+** an opportunity to change the macro into a testcase() and add a new
+** test case to the test suite.
+**
+** For normal production builds, harmless(X) is a no-op, since it does
+** not matter whether expression X is true or false.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+# define harmless(X) assert(!(X));
+#else
+# define harmless(X)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Some conditionals are optimizations only. In other words, if the
+** conditionals are replaced with a constant 1 (true) or 0 (false) then
+** the correct answer is still obtained, though perhaps not as quickly.
+**
+** The following macros mark these optimizations conditionals.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_MUTATION_TEST)
+# define OK_IF_ALWAYS_TRUE(X) (1)
+# define OK_IF_ALWAYS_FALSE(X) (0)
+#else
+# define OK_IF_ALWAYS_TRUE(X) (X)
+# define OK_IF_ALWAYS_FALSE(X) (X)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Some malloc failures are only possible if SQLITE_TEST_REALLOC_STRESS is
+** defined. We need to defend against those failures when testing with
+** SQLITE_TEST_REALLOC_STRESS, but we don't want the unreachable branches
+** during a normal build. The following macro can be used to disable tests
+** that are always false except when SQLITE_TEST_REALLOC_STRESS is set.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST_REALLOC_STRESS)
+# define ONLY_IF_REALLOC_STRESS(X) (X)
+#elif !defined(NDEBUG)
+# define ONLY_IF_REALLOC_STRESS(X) ((X)?(assert(0),1):0)
+#else
+# define ONLY_IF_REALLOC_STRESS(X) (0)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Declarations used for tracing the operating system interfaces.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_FORCE_OS_TRACE) || defined(SQLITE_TEST) || \
+ (defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) && SQLITE_OS_WIN)
+ extern int sqlite3OSTrace;
+# define OSTRACE(X) if( sqlite3OSTrace ) sqlite3DebugPrintf X
+# define SQLITE_HAVE_OS_TRACE
+#else
+# define OSTRACE(X)
+# undef SQLITE_HAVE_OS_TRACE
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Is the sqlite3ErrName() function needed in the build? Currently,
+** it is needed by "mutex_w32.c" (when debugging), "os_win.c" (when
+** OSTRACE is enabled), and by several "test*.c" files (which are
+** compiled using SQLITE_TEST).
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_HAVE_OS_TRACE) || defined(SQLITE_TEST) || \
+ (defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) && SQLITE_OS_WIN)
+# define SQLITE_NEED_ERR_NAME
+#else
+# undef SQLITE_NEED_ERR_NAME
+#endif
+
+/*
+** SQLITE_ENABLE_EXPLAIN_COMMENTS is incompatible with SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN
+# undef SQLITE_ENABLE_EXPLAIN_COMMENTS
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Return true (non-zero) if the input is an integer that is too large
+** to fit in 32-bits. This macro is used inside of various testcase()
+** macros to verify that we have tested SQLite for large-file support.
+*/
+#define IS_BIG_INT(X) (((X)&~(i64)0xffffffff)!=0)
+
+/*
+** The macro unlikely() is a hint that surrounds a boolean
+** expression that is usually false. Macro likely() surrounds
+** a boolean expression that is usually true. These hints could,
+** in theory, be used by the compiler to generate better code, but
+** currently they are just comments for human readers.
+*/
+#define likely(X) (X)
+#define unlikely(X) (X)
+
+/************** Include hash.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ******************/
+/************** Begin file hash.h ********************************************/
+/*
+** 2001 September 22
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This is the header file for the generic hash-table implementation
+** used in SQLite.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_HASH_H
+#define SQLITE_HASH_H
+
+/* Forward declarations of structures. */
+typedef struct Hash Hash;
+typedef struct HashElem HashElem;
+
+/* A complete hash table is an instance of the following structure.
+** The internals of this structure are intended to be opaque -- client
+** code should not attempt to access or modify the fields of this structure
+** directly. Change this structure only by using the routines below.
+** However, some of the "procedures" and "functions" for modifying and
+** accessing this structure are really macros, so we can't really make
+** this structure opaque.
+**
+** All elements of the hash table are on a single doubly-linked list.
+** Hash.first points to the head of this list.
+**
+** There are Hash.htsize buckets. Each bucket points to a spot in
+** the global doubly-linked list. The contents of the bucket are the
+** element pointed to plus the next _ht.count-1 elements in the list.
+**
+** Hash.htsize and Hash.ht may be zero. In that case lookup is done
+** by a linear search of the global list. For small tables, the
+** Hash.ht table is never allocated because if there are few elements
+** in the table, it is faster to do a linear search than to manage
+** the hash table.
+*/
+struct Hash {
+ unsigned int htsize; /* Number of buckets in the hash table */
+ unsigned int count; /* Number of entries in this table */
+ HashElem *first; /* The first element of the array */
+ struct _ht { /* the hash table */
+ unsigned int count; /* Number of entries with this hash */
+ HashElem *chain; /* Pointer to first entry with this hash */
+ } *ht;
+};
+
+/* Each element in the hash table is an instance of the following
+** structure. All elements are stored on a single doubly-linked list.
+**
+** Again, this structure is intended to be opaque, but it can't really
+** be opaque because it is used by macros.
+*/
+struct HashElem {
+ HashElem *next, *prev; /* Next and previous elements in the table */
+ void *data; /* Data associated with this element */
+ const char *pKey; /* Key associated with this element */
+};
+
+/*
+** Access routines. To delete, insert a NULL pointer.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3HashInit(Hash*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3HashInsert(Hash*, const char *pKey, void *pData);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3HashFind(const Hash*, const char *pKey);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3HashClear(Hash*);
+
+/*
+** Macros for looping over all elements of a hash table. The idiom is
+** like this:
+**
+** Hash h;
+** HashElem *p;
+** ...
+** for(p=sqliteHashFirst(&h); p; p=sqliteHashNext(p)){
+** SomeStructure *pData = sqliteHashData(p);
+** // do something with pData
+** }
+*/
+#define sqliteHashFirst(H) ((H)->first)
+#define sqliteHashNext(E) ((E)->next)
+#define sqliteHashData(E) ((E)->data)
+/* #define sqliteHashKey(E) ((E)->pKey) // NOT USED */
+/* #define sqliteHashKeysize(E) ((E)->nKey) // NOT USED */
+
+/*
+** Number of entries in a hash table
+*/
+/* #define sqliteHashCount(H) ((H)->count) // NOT USED */
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_HASH_H */
+
+/************** End of hash.h ************************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+/************** Include parse.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h *****************/
+/************** Begin file parse.h *******************************************/
+#define TK_SEMI 1
+#define TK_EXPLAIN 2
+#define TK_QUERY 3
+#define TK_PLAN 4
+#define TK_BEGIN 5
+#define TK_TRANSACTION 6
+#define TK_DEFERRED 7
+#define TK_IMMEDIATE 8
+#define TK_EXCLUSIVE 9
+#define TK_COMMIT 10
+#define TK_END 11
+#define TK_ROLLBACK 12
+#define TK_SAVEPOINT 13
+#define TK_RELEASE 14
+#define TK_TO 15
+#define TK_TABLE 16
+#define TK_CREATE 17
+#define TK_IF 18
+#define TK_NOT 19
+#define TK_EXISTS 20
+#define TK_TEMP 21
+#define TK_LP 22
+#define TK_RP 23
+#define TK_AS 24
+#define TK_WITHOUT 25
+#define TK_COMMA 26
+#define TK_ABORT 27
+#define TK_ACTION 28
+#define TK_AFTER 29
+#define TK_ANALYZE 30
+#define TK_ASC 31
+#define TK_ATTACH 32
+#define TK_BEFORE 33
+#define TK_BY 34
+#define TK_CASCADE 35
+#define TK_CAST 36
+#define TK_CONFLICT 37
+#define TK_DATABASE 38
+#define TK_DESC 39
+#define TK_DETACH 40
+#define TK_EACH 41
+#define TK_FAIL 42
+#define TK_OR 43
+#define TK_AND 44
+#define TK_IS 45
+#define TK_MATCH 46
+#define TK_LIKE_KW 47
+#define TK_BETWEEN 48
+#define TK_IN 49
+#define TK_ISNULL 50
+#define TK_NOTNULL 51
+#define TK_NE 52
+#define TK_EQ 53
+#define TK_GT 54
+#define TK_LE 55
+#define TK_LT 56
+#define TK_GE 57
+#define TK_ESCAPE 58
+#define TK_ID 59
+#define TK_COLUMNKW 60
+#define TK_DO 61
+#define TK_FOR 62
+#define TK_IGNORE 63
+#define TK_INITIALLY 64
+#define TK_INSTEAD 65
+#define TK_NO 66
+#define TK_KEY 67
+#define TK_OF 68
+#define TK_OFFSET 69
+#define TK_PRAGMA 70
+#define TK_RAISE 71
+#define TK_RECURSIVE 72
+#define TK_REPLACE 73
+#define TK_RESTRICT 74
+#define TK_ROW 75
+#define TK_ROWS 76
+#define TK_TRIGGER 77
+#define TK_VACUUM 78
+#define TK_VIEW 79
+#define TK_VIRTUAL 80
+#define TK_WITH 81
+#define TK_NULLS 82
+#define TK_FIRST 83
+#define TK_LAST 84
+#define TK_CURRENT 85
+#define TK_FOLLOWING 86
+#define TK_PARTITION 87
+#define TK_PRECEDING 88
+#define TK_RANGE 89
+#define TK_UNBOUNDED 90
+#define TK_EXCLUDE 91
+#define TK_GROUPS 92
+#define TK_OTHERS 93
+#define TK_TIES 94
+#define TK_GENERATED 95
+#define TK_ALWAYS 96
+#define TK_REINDEX 97
+#define TK_RENAME 98
+#define TK_CTIME_KW 99
+#define TK_ANY 100
+#define TK_BITAND 101
+#define TK_BITOR 102
+#define TK_LSHIFT 103
+#define TK_RSHIFT 104
+#define TK_PLUS 105
+#define TK_MINUS 106
+#define TK_STAR 107
+#define TK_SLASH 108
+#define TK_REM 109
+#define TK_CONCAT 110
+#define TK_COLLATE 111
+#define TK_BITNOT 112
+#define TK_ON 113
+#define TK_INDEXED 114
+#define TK_STRING 115
+#define TK_JOIN_KW 116
+#define TK_CONSTRAINT 117
+#define TK_DEFAULT 118
+#define TK_NULL 119
+#define TK_PRIMARY 120
+#define TK_UNIQUE 121
+#define TK_CHECK 122
+#define TK_REFERENCES 123
+#define TK_AUTOINCR 124
+#define TK_INSERT 125
+#define TK_DELETE 126
+#define TK_UPDATE 127
+#define TK_SET 128
+#define TK_DEFERRABLE 129
+#define TK_FOREIGN 130
+#define TK_DROP 131
+#define TK_UNION 132
+#define TK_ALL 133
+#define TK_EXCEPT 134
+#define TK_INTERSECT 135
+#define TK_SELECT 136
+#define TK_VALUES 137
+#define TK_DISTINCT 138
+#define TK_DOT 139
+#define TK_FROM 140
+#define TK_JOIN 141
+#define TK_USING 142
+#define TK_ORDER 143
+#define TK_GROUP 144
+#define TK_HAVING 145
+#define TK_LIMIT 146
+#define TK_WHERE 147
+#define TK_INTO 148
+#define TK_NOTHING 149
+#define TK_FLOAT 150
+#define TK_BLOB 151
+#define TK_INTEGER 152
+#define TK_VARIABLE 153
+#define TK_CASE 154
+#define TK_WHEN 155
+#define TK_THEN 156
+#define TK_ELSE 157
+#define TK_INDEX 158
+#define TK_ALTER 159
+#define TK_ADD 160
+#define TK_WINDOW 161
+#define TK_OVER 162
+#define TK_FILTER 163
+#define TK_COLUMN 164
+#define TK_AGG_FUNCTION 165
+#define TK_AGG_COLUMN 166
+#define TK_TRUEFALSE 167
+#define TK_ISNOT 168
+#define TK_FUNCTION 169
+#define TK_UMINUS 170
+#define TK_UPLUS 171
+#define TK_TRUTH 172
+#define TK_REGISTER 173
+#define TK_VECTOR 174
+#define TK_SELECT_COLUMN 175
+#define TK_IF_NULL_ROW 176
+#define TK_ASTERISK 177
+#define TK_SPAN 178
+#define TK_SPACE 179
+#define TK_ILLEGAL 180
+
+/************** End of parse.h ***********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+#include
+#include
+#include
+#include
+#include
+
+/*
+** Use a macro to replace memcpy() if compiled with SQLITE_INLINE_MEMCPY.
+** This allows better measurements of where memcpy() is used when running
+** cachegrind. But this macro version of memcpy() is very slow so it
+** should not be used in production. This is a performance measurement
+** hack only.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_INLINE_MEMCPY
+# define memcpy(D,S,N) {char*xxd=(char*)(D);const char*xxs=(const char*)(S);\
+ int xxn=(N);while(xxn-->0)*(xxd++)=*(xxs++);}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** If compiling for a processor that lacks floating point support,
+** substitute integer for floating-point
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+# define double sqlite_int64
+# define float sqlite_int64
+# define LONGDOUBLE_TYPE sqlite_int64
+# ifndef SQLITE_BIG_DBL
+# define SQLITE_BIG_DBL (((sqlite3_int64)1)<<50)
+# endif
+# define SQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS 1
+# define SQLITE_OMIT_TRACE 1
+# undef SQLITE_MIXED_ENDIAN_64BIT_FLOAT
+# undef SQLITE_HAVE_ISNAN
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_BIG_DBL
+# define SQLITE_BIG_DBL (1e99)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** OMIT_TEMPDB is set to 1 if SQLITE_OMIT_TEMPDB is defined, or 0
+** afterward. Having this macro allows us to cause the C compiler
+** to omit code used by TEMP tables without messy #ifndef statements.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_TEMPDB
+#define OMIT_TEMPDB 1
+#else
+#define OMIT_TEMPDB 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The "file format" number is an integer that is incremented whenever
+** the VDBE-level file format changes. The following macros define the
+** the default file format for new databases and the maximum file format
+** that the library can read.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_MAX_FILE_FORMAT 4
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_FORMAT
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_FORMAT 4
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Determine whether triggers are recursive by default. This can be
+** changed at run-time using a pragma.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_RECURSIVE_TRIGGERS
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_RECURSIVE_TRIGGERS 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Provide a default value for SQLITE_TEMP_STORE in case it is not specified
+** on the command-line
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_TEMP_STORE
+# define SQLITE_TEMP_STORE 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** If no value has been provided for SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS, or if
+** SQLITE_TEMP_STORE is set to 3 (never use temporary files), set it
+** to zero.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_TEMP_STORE==3 || SQLITE_THREADSAFE==0
+# undef SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS
+# define SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS 0
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS
+# define SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS 8
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_WORKER_THREADS
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_WORKER_THREADS 0
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DEFAULT_WORKER_THREADS>SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS
+# undef SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS
+# define SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS SQLITE_DEFAULT_WORKER_THREADS
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The default initial allocation for the pagecache when using separate
+** pagecaches for each database connection. A positive number is the
+** number of pages. A negative number N translations means that a buffer
+** of -1024*N bytes is allocated and used for as many pages as it will hold.
+**
+** The default value of "20" was choosen to minimize the run-time of the
+** speedtest1 test program with options: --shrink-memory --reprepare
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_PCACHE_INITSZ
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_PCACHE_INITSZ 20
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Default value for the SQLITE_CONFIG_SORTERREF_SIZE option.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_SORTERREF_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_SORTERREF_SIZE 0x7fffffff
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The compile-time options SQLITE_MMAP_READWRITE and
+** SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE are not compatible with one another.
+** You must choose one or the other (or neither) but not both.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_MMAP_READWRITE) && defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE)
+#error Cannot use both SQLITE_MMAP_READWRITE and SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE
+#endif
+
+/*
+** GCC does not define the offsetof() macro so we'll have to do it
+** ourselves.
+*/
+#ifndef offsetof
+#define offsetof(STRUCTURE,FIELD) ((int)((char*)&((STRUCTURE*)0)->FIELD))
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Macros to compute minimum and maximum of two numbers.
+*/
+#ifndef MIN
+# define MIN(A,B) ((A)<(B)?(A):(B))
+#endif
+#ifndef MAX
+# define MAX(A,B) ((A)>(B)?(A):(B))
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Swap two objects of type TYPE.
+*/
+#define SWAP(TYPE,A,B) {TYPE t=A; A=B; B=t;}
+
+/*
+** Check to see if this machine uses EBCDIC. (Yes, believe it or
+** not, there are still machines out there that use EBCDIC.)
+*/
+#if 'A' == '\301'
+# define SQLITE_EBCDIC 1
+#else
+# define SQLITE_ASCII 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Integers of known sizes. These typedefs might change for architectures
+** where the sizes very. Preprocessor macros are available so that the
+** types can be conveniently redefined at compile-type. Like this:
+**
+** cc '-DUINTPTR_TYPE=long long int' ...
+*/
+#ifndef UINT32_TYPE
+# ifdef HAVE_UINT32_T
+# define UINT32_TYPE uint32_t
+# else
+# define UINT32_TYPE unsigned int
+# endif
+#endif
+#ifndef UINT16_TYPE
+# ifdef HAVE_UINT16_T
+# define UINT16_TYPE uint16_t
+# else
+# define UINT16_TYPE unsigned short int
+# endif
+#endif
+#ifndef INT16_TYPE
+# ifdef HAVE_INT16_T
+# define INT16_TYPE int16_t
+# else
+# define INT16_TYPE short int
+# endif
+#endif
+#ifndef UINT8_TYPE
+# ifdef HAVE_UINT8_T
+# define UINT8_TYPE uint8_t
+# else
+# define UINT8_TYPE unsigned char
+# endif
+#endif
+#ifndef INT8_TYPE
+# ifdef HAVE_INT8_T
+# define INT8_TYPE int8_t
+# else
+# define INT8_TYPE signed char
+# endif
+#endif
+#ifndef LONGDOUBLE_TYPE
+# define LONGDOUBLE_TYPE long double
+#endif
+typedef sqlite_int64 i64; /* 8-byte signed integer */
+typedef sqlite_uint64 u64; /* 8-byte unsigned integer */
+typedef UINT32_TYPE u32; /* 4-byte unsigned integer */
+typedef UINT16_TYPE u16; /* 2-byte unsigned integer */
+typedef INT16_TYPE i16; /* 2-byte signed integer */
+typedef UINT8_TYPE u8; /* 1-byte unsigned integer */
+typedef INT8_TYPE i8; /* 1-byte signed integer */
+
+/*
+** SQLITE_MAX_U32 is a u64 constant that is the maximum u64 value
+** that can be stored in a u32 without loss of data. The value
+** is 0x00000000ffffffff. But because of quirks of some compilers, we
+** have to specify the value in the less intuitive manner shown:
+*/
+#define SQLITE_MAX_U32 ((((u64)1)<<32)-1)
+
+/*
+** The datatype used to store estimates of the number of rows in a
+** table or index. This is an unsigned integer type. For 99.9% of
+** the world, a 32-bit integer is sufficient. But a 64-bit integer
+** can be used at compile-time if desired.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_64BIT_STATS
+ typedef u64 tRowcnt; /* 64-bit only if requested at compile-time */
+#else
+ typedef u32 tRowcnt; /* 32-bit is the default */
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Estimated quantities used for query planning are stored as 16-bit
+** logarithms. For quantity X, the value stored is 10*log2(X). This
+** gives a possible range of values of approximately 1.0e986 to 1e-986.
+** But the allowed values are "grainy". Not every value is representable.
+** For example, quantities 16 and 17 are both represented by a LogEst
+** of 40. However, since LogEst quantities are suppose to be estimates,
+** not exact values, this imprecision is not a problem.
+**
+** "LogEst" is short for "Logarithmic Estimate".
+**
+** Examples:
+** 1 -> 0 20 -> 43 10000 -> 132
+** 2 -> 10 25 -> 46 25000 -> 146
+** 3 -> 16 100 -> 66 1000000 -> 199
+** 4 -> 20 1000 -> 99 1048576 -> 200
+** 10 -> 33 1024 -> 100 4294967296 -> 320
+**
+** The LogEst can be negative to indicate fractional values.
+** Examples:
+**
+** 0.5 -> -10 0.1 -> -33 0.0625 -> -40
+*/
+typedef INT16_TYPE LogEst;
+
+/*
+** Set the SQLITE_PTRSIZE macro to the number of bytes in a pointer
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_PTRSIZE
+# if defined(__SIZEOF_POINTER__)
+# define SQLITE_PTRSIZE __SIZEOF_POINTER__
+# elif defined(i386) || defined(__i386__) || defined(_M_IX86) || \
+ defined(_M_ARM) || defined(__arm__) || defined(__x86) || \
+ (defined(__TOS_AIX__) && !defined(__64BIT__))
+# define SQLITE_PTRSIZE 4
+# else
+# define SQLITE_PTRSIZE 8
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* The uptr type is an unsigned integer large enough to hold a pointer
+*/
+#if defined(HAVE_STDINT_H)
+ typedef uintptr_t uptr;
+#elif SQLITE_PTRSIZE==4
+ typedef u32 uptr;
+#else
+ typedef u64 uptr;
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The SQLITE_WITHIN(P,S,E) macro checks to see if pointer P points to
+** something between S (inclusive) and E (exclusive).
+**
+** In other words, S is a buffer and E is a pointer to the first byte after
+** the end of buffer S. This macro returns true if P points to something
+** contained within the buffer S.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_WITHIN(P,S,E) (((uptr)(P)>=(uptr)(S))&&((uptr)(P)<(uptr)(E)))
+
+
+/*
+** Macros to determine whether the machine is big or little endian,
+** and whether or not that determination is run-time or compile-time.
+**
+** For best performance, an attempt is made to guess at the byte-order
+** using C-preprocessor macros. If that is unsuccessful, or if
+** -DSQLITE_BYTEORDER=0 is set, then byte-order is determined
+** at run-time.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_BYTEORDER
+# if defined(i386) || defined(__i386__) || defined(_M_IX86) || \
+ defined(__x86_64) || defined(__x86_64__) || defined(_M_X64) || \
+ defined(_M_AMD64) || defined(_M_ARM) || defined(__x86) || \
+ defined(__ARMEL__) || defined(__AARCH64EL__) || defined(_M_ARM64)
+# define SQLITE_BYTEORDER 1234
+# elif defined(sparc) || defined(__ppc__) || \
+ defined(__ARMEB__) || defined(__AARCH64EB__)
+# define SQLITE_BYTEORDER 4321
+# else
+# define SQLITE_BYTEORDER 0
+# endif
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_BYTEORDER==4321
+# define SQLITE_BIGENDIAN 1
+# define SQLITE_LITTLEENDIAN 0
+# define SQLITE_UTF16NATIVE SQLITE_UTF16BE
+#elif SQLITE_BYTEORDER==1234
+# define SQLITE_BIGENDIAN 0
+# define SQLITE_LITTLEENDIAN 1
+# define SQLITE_UTF16NATIVE SQLITE_UTF16LE
+#else
+# ifdef SQLITE_AMALGAMATION
+ const int sqlite3one = 1;
+# else
+ extern const int sqlite3one;
+# endif
+# define SQLITE_BIGENDIAN (*(char *)(&sqlite3one)==0)
+# define SQLITE_LITTLEENDIAN (*(char *)(&sqlite3one)==1)
+# define SQLITE_UTF16NATIVE (SQLITE_BIGENDIAN?SQLITE_UTF16BE:SQLITE_UTF16LE)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Constants for the largest and smallest possible 64-bit signed integers.
+** These macros are designed to work correctly on both 32-bit and 64-bit
+** compilers.
+*/
+#define LARGEST_INT64 (0xffffffff|(((i64)0x7fffffff)<<32))
+#define LARGEST_UINT64 (0xffffffff|(((u64)0xffffffff)<<32))
+#define SMALLEST_INT64 (((i64)-1) - LARGEST_INT64)
+
+/*
+** Round up a number to the next larger multiple of 8. This is used
+** to force 8-byte alignment on 64-bit architectures.
+*/
+#define ROUND8(x) (((x)+7)&~7)
+
+/*
+** Round down to the nearest multiple of 8
+*/
+#define ROUNDDOWN8(x) ((x)&~7)
+
+/*
+** Assert that the pointer X is aligned to an 8-byte boundary. This
+** macro is used only within assert() to verify that the code gets
+** all alignment restrictions correct.
+**
+** Except, if SQLITE_4_BYTE_ALIGNED_MALLOC is defined, then the
+** underlying malloc() implementation might return us 4-byte aligned
+** pointers. In that case, only verify 4-byte alignment.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_4_BYTE_ALIGNED_MALLOC
+# define EIGHT_BYTE_ALIGNMENT(X) ((((char*)(X) - (char*)0)&3)==0)
+#else
+# define EIGHT_BYTE_ALIGNMENT(X) ((((char*)(X) - (char*)0)&7)==0)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Disable MMAP on platforms where it is known to not work
+*/
+#if defined(__OpenBSD__) || defined(__QNXNTO__)
+# undef SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Default maximum size of memory used by memory-mapped I/O in the VFS
+*/
+#ifdef __APPLE__
+# include
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE
+# if defined(__linux__) \
+ || defined(_WIN32) \
+ || (defined(__APPLE__) && defined(__MACH__)) \
+ || defined(__sun) \
+ || defined(__FreeBSD__) \
+ || defined(__DragonFly__)
+# define SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE 0x7fff0000 /* 2147418112 */
+# else
+# define SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE 0
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The default MMAP_SIZE is zero on all platforms. Or, even if a larger
+** default MMAP_SIZE is specified at compile-time, make sure that it does
+** not exceed the maximum mmap size.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_MMAP_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_MMAP_SIZE 0
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_DEFAULT_MMAP_SIZE>SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE
+# undef SQLITE_DEFAULT_MMAP_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_MMAP_SIZE SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE
+#endif
+
+/*
+** SELECTTRACE_ENABLED will be either 1 or 0 depending on whether or not
+** the Select query generator tracing logic is turned on.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_SELECTTRACE)
+# define SELECTTRACE_ENABLED 1
+#else
+# define SELECTTRACE_ENABLED 0
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_SELECTTRACE)
+# define SELECTTRACE_ENABLED 1
+# define SELECTTRACE(K,P,S,X) \
+ if(sqlite3_unsupported_selecttrace&(K)) \
+ sqlite3DebugPrintf("%u/%d/%p: ",(S)->selId,(P)->addrExplain,(S)),\
+ sqlite3DebugPrintf X
+#else
+# define SELECTTRACE(K,P,S,X)
+# define SELECTTRACE_ENABLED 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** An instance of the following structure is used to store the busy-handler
+** callback for a given sqlite handle.
+**
+** The sqlite.busyHandler member of the sqlite struct contains the busy
+** callback for the database handle. Each pager opened via the sqlite
+** handle is passed a pointer to sqlite.busyHandler. The busy-handler
+** callback is currently invoked only from within pager.c.
+*/
+typedef struct BusyHandler BusyHandler;
+struct BusyHandler {
+ int (*xBusyHandler)(void *,int); /* The busy callback */
+ void *pBusyArg; /* First arg to busy callback */
+ int nBusy; /* Incremented with each busy call */
+};
+
+/*
+** Name of table that holds the database schema.
+*/
+#define DFLT_SCHEMA_TABLE "sqlite_master"
+#define DFLT_TEMP_SCHEMA_TABLE "sqlite_temp_master"
+#define ALT_SCHEMA_TABLE "sqlite_schema"
+#define ALT_TEMP_SCHEMA_TABLE "sqlite_temp_schema"
+
+
+/*
+** The root-page of the schema table.
+*/
+#define SCHEMA_ROOT 1
+
+/*
+** The name of the schema table. The name is different for TEMP.
+*/
+#define SCHEMA_TABLE(x) \
+ ((!OMIT_TEMPDB)&&(x==1)?DFLT_TEMP_SCHEMA_TABLE:DFLT_SCHEMA_TABLE)
+
+/*
+** A convenience macro that returns the number of elements in
+** an array.
+*/
+#define ArraySize(X) ((int)(sizeof(X)/sizeof(X[0])))
+
+/*
+** Determine if the argument is a power of two
+*/
+#define IsPowerOfTwo(X) (((X)&((X)-1))==0)
+
+/*
+** The following value as a destructor means to use sqlite3DbFree().
+** The sqlite3DbFree() routine requires two parameters instead of the
+** one parameter that destructors normally want. So we have to introduce
+** this magic value that the code knows to handle differently. Any
+** pointer will work here as long as it is distinct from SQLITE_STATIC
+** and SQLITE_TRANSIENT.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_DYNAMIC ((sqlite3_destructor_type)sqlite3OomFault)
+
+/*
+** When SQLITE_OMIT_WSD is defined, it means that the target platform does
+** not support Writable Static Data (WSD) such as global and static variables.
+** All variables must either be on the stack or dynamically allocated from
+** the heap. When WSD is unsupported, the variable declarations scattered
+** throughout the SQLite code must become constants instead. The SQLITE_WSD
+** macro is used for this purpose. And instead of referencing the variable
+** directly, we use its constant as a key to lookup the run-time allocated
+** buffer that holds real variable. The constant is also the initializer
+** for the run-time allocated buffer.
+**
+** In the usual case where WSD is supported, the SQLITE_WSD and GLOBAL
+** macros become no-ops and have zero performance impact.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_WSD
+ #define SQLITE_WSD const
+ #define GLOBAL(t,v) (*(t*)sqlite3_wsd_find((void*)&(v), sizeof(v)))
+ #define sqlite3GlobalConfig GLOBAL(struct Sqlite3Config, sqlite3Config)
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_wsd_init(int N, int J);
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_wsd_find(void *K, int L);
+#else
+ #define SQLITE_WSD
+ #define GLOBAL(t,v) v
+ #define sqlite3GlobalConfig sqlite3Config
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The following macros are used to suppress compiler warnings and to
+** make it clear to human readers when a function parameter is deliberately
+** left unused within the body of a function. This usually happens when
+** a function is called via a function pointer. For example the
+** implementation of an SQL aggregate step callback may not use the
+** parameter indicating the number of arguments passed to the aggregate,
+** if it knows that this is enforced elsewhere.
+**
+** When a function parameter is not used at all within the body of a function,
+** it is generally named "NotUsed" or "NotUsed2" to make things even clearer.
+** However, these macros may also be used to suppress warnings related to
+** parameters that may or may not be used depending on compilation options.
+** For example those parameters only used in assert() statements. In these
+** cases the parameters are named as per the usual conventions.
+*/
+#define UNUSED_PARAMETER(x) (void)(x)
+#define UNUSED_PARAMETER2(x,y) UNUSED_PARAMETER(x),UNUSED_PARAMETER(y)
+
+/*
+** Forward references to structures
+*/
+typedef struct AggInfo AggInfo;
+typedef struct AuthContext AuthContext;
+typedef struct AutoincInfo AutoincInfo;
+typedef struct Bitvec Bitvec;
+typedef struct CollSeq CollSeq;
+typedef struct Column Column;
+typedef struct Db Db;
+typedef struct Schema Schema;
+typedef struct Expr Expr;
+typedef struct ExprList ExprList;
+typedef struct FKey FKey;
+typedef struct FuncDestructor FuncDestructor;
+typedef struct FuncDef FuncDef;
+typedef struct FuncDefHash FuncDefHash;
+typedef struct IdList IdList;
+typedef struct Index Index;
+typedef struct IndexSample IndexSample;
+typedef struct KeyClass KeyClass;
+typedef struct KeyInfo KeyInfo;
+typedef struct Lookaside Lookaside;
+typedef struct LookasideSlot LookasideSlot;
+typedef struct Module Module;
+typedef struct NameContext NameContext;
+typedef struct Parse Parse;
+typedef struct PreUpdate PreUpdate;
+typedef struct PrintfArguments PrintfArguments;
+typedef struct RenameToken RenameToken;
+typedef struct RowSet RowSet;
+typedef struct Savepoint Savepoint;
+typedef struct Select Select;
+typedef struct SQLiteThread SQLiteThread;
+typedef struct SelectDest SelectDest;
+typedef struct SrcList SrcList;
+typedef struct sqlite3_str StrAccum; /* Internal alias for sqlite3_str */
+typedef struct Table Table;
+typedef struct TableLock TableLock;
+typedef struct Token Token;
+typedef struct TreeView TreeView;
+typedef struct Trigger Trigger;
+typedef struct TriggerPrg TriggerPrg;
+typedef struct TriggerStep TriggerStep;
+typedef struct UnpackedRecord UnpackedRecord;
+typedef struct Upsert Upsert;
+typedef struct VTable VTable;
+typedef struct VtabCtx VtabCtx;
+typedef struct Walker Walker;
+typedef struct WhereInfo WhereInfo;
+typedef struct Window Window;
+typedef struct With With;
+
+
+/*
+** The bitmask datatype defined below is used for various optimizations.
+**
+** Changing this from a 64-bit to a 32-bit type limits the number of
+** tables in a join to 32 instead of 64. But it also reduces the size
+** of the library by 738 bytes on ix86.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_BITMASK_TYPE
+ typedef SQLITE_BITMASK_TYPE Bitmask;
+#else
+ typedef u64 Bitmask;
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The number of bits in a Bitmask. "BMS" means "BitMask Size".
+*/
+#define BMS ((int)(sizeof(Bitmask)*8))
+
+/*
+** A bit in a Bitmask
+*/
+#define MASKBIT(n) (((Bitmask)1)<<(n))
+#define MASKBIT64(n) (((u64)1)<<(n))
+#define MASKBIT32(n) (((unsigned int)1)<<(n))
+#define ALLBITS ((Bitmask)-1)
+
+/* A VList object records a mapping between parameters/variables/wildcards
+** in the SQL statement (such as $abc, @pqr, or :xyz) and the integer
+** variable number associated with that parameter. See the format description
+** on the sqlite3VListAdd() routine for more information. A VList is really
+** just an array of integers.
+*/
+typedef int VList;
+
+/*
+** Defer sourcing vdbe.h and btree.h until after the "u8" and
+** "BusyHandler" typedefs. vdbe.h also requires a few of the opaque
+** pointer types (i.e. FuncDef) defined above.
+*/
+/************** Include pager.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h *****************/
+/************** Begin file pager.h *******************************************/
+/*
+** 2001 September 15
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This header file defines the interface that the sqlite page cache
+** subsystem. The page cache subsystem reads and writes a file a page
+** at a time and provides a journal for rollback.
+*/
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_PAGER_H
+#define SQLITE_PAGER_H
+
+/*
+** Default maximum size for persistent journal files. A negative
+** value means no limit. This value may be overridden using the
+** sqlite3PagerJournalSizeLimit() API. See also "PRAGMA journal_size_limit".
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_JOURNAL_SIZE_LIMIT
+ #define SQLITE_DEFAULT_JOURNAL_SIZE_LIMIT -1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The type used to represent a page number. The first page in a file
+** is called page 1. 0 is used to represent "not a page".
+*/
+typedef u32 Pgno;
+
+/*
+** Each open file is managed by a separate instance of the "Pager" structure.
+*/
+typedef struct Pager Pager;
+
+/*
+** Handle type for pages.
+*/
+typedef struct PgHdr DbPage;
+
+/*
+** Page number PAGER_MJ_PGNO is never used in an SQLite database (it is
+** reserved for working around a windows/posix incompatibility). It is
+** used in the journal to signify that the remainder of the journal file
+** is devoted to storing a super-journal name - there are no more pages to
+** roll back. See comments for function writeSuperJournal() in pager.c
+** for details.
+*/
+#define PAGER_MJ_PGNO(x) ((Pgno)((PENDING_BYTE/((x)->pageSize))+1))
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for the flags parameter to sqlite3PagerOpen().
+**
+** NOTE: These values must match the corresponding BTREE_ values in btree.h.
+*/
+#define PAGER_OMIT_JOURNAL 0x0001 /* Do not use a rollback journal */
+#define PAGER_MEMORY 0x0002 /* In-memory database */
+
+/*
+** Valid values for the second argument to sqlite3PagerLockingMode().
+*/
+#define PAGER_LOCKINGMODE_QUERY -1
+#define PAGER_LOCKINGMODE_NORMAL 0
+#define PAGER_LOCKINGMODE_EXCLUSIVE 1
+
+/*
+** Numeric constants that encode the journalmode.
+**
+** The numeric values encoded here (other than PAGER_JOURNALMODE_QUERY)
+** are exposed in the API via the "PRAGMA journal_mode" command and
+** therefore cannot be changed without a compatibility break.
+*/
+#define PAGER_JOURNALMODE_QUERY (-1) /* Query the value of journalmode */
+#define PAGER_JOURNALMODE_DELETE 0 /* Commit by deleting journal file */
+#define PAGER_JOURNALMODE_PERSIST 1 /* Commit by zeroing journal header */
+#define PAGER_JOURNALMODE_OFF 2 /* Journal omitted. */
+#define PAGER_JOURNALMODE_TRUNCATE 3 /* Commit by truncating journal */
+#define PAGER_JOURNALMODE_MEMORY 4 /* In-memory journal file */
+#define PAGER_JOURNALMODE_WAL 5 /* Use write-ahead logging */
+
+/*
+** Flags that make up the mask passed to sqlite3PagerGet().
+*/
+#define PAGER_GET_NOCONTENT 0x01 /* Do not load data from disk */
+#define PAGER_GET_READONLY 0x02 /* Read-only page is acceptable */
+
+/*
+** Flags for sqlite3PagerSetFlags()
+**
+** Value constraints (enforced via assert()):
+** PAGER_FULLFSYNC == SQLITE_FullFSync
+** PAGER_CKPT_FULLFSYNC == SQLITE_CkptFullFSync
+** PAGER_CACHE_SPILL == SQLITE_CacheSpill
+*/
+#define PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_OFF 0x01 /* PRAGMA synchronous=OFF */
+#define PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_NORMAL 0x02 /* PRAGMA synchronous=NORMAL */
+#define PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_FULL 0x03 /* PRAGMA synchronous=FULL */
+#define PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_EXTRA 0x04 /* PRAGMA synchronous=EXTRA */
+#define PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_MASK 0x07 /* Mask for four values above */
+#define PAGER_FULLFSYNC 0x08 /* PRAGMA fullfsync=ON */
+#define PAGER_CKPT_FULLFSYNC 0x10 /* PRAGMA checkpoint_fullfsync=ON */
+#define PAGER_CACHESPILL 0x20 /* PRAGMA cache_spill=ON */
+#define PAGER_FLAGS_MASK 0x38 /* All above except SYNCHRONOUS */
+
+/*
+** The remainder of this file contains the declarations of the functions
+** that make up the Pager sub-system API. See source code comments for
+** a detailed description of each routine.
+*/
+
+/* Open and close a Pager connection. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerOpen(
+ sqlite3_vfs*,
+ Pager **ppPager,
+ const char*,
+ int,
+ int,
+ int,
+ void(*)(DbPage*)
+);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerClose(Pager *pPager, sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerReadFileheader(Pager*, int, unsigned char*);
+
+/* Functions used to configure a Pager object. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetBusyHandler(Pager*, int(*)(void *), void *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSetPagesize(Pager*, u32*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Pgno sqlite3PagerMaxPageCount(Pager*, Pgno);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetCachesize(Pager*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSetSpillsize(Pager*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetMmapLimit(Pager *, sqlite3_int64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerShrink(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetFlags(Pager*,unsigned);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerLockingMode(Pager *, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSetJournalMode(Pager *, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerGetJournalMode(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerOkToChangeJournalMode(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE i64 sqlite3PagerJournalSizeLimit(Pager *, i64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_backup **sqlite3PagerBackupPtr(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerFlush(Pager*);
+
+/* Functions used to obtain and release page references. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerGet(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno, DbPage **ppPage, int clrFlag);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE DbPage *sqlite3PagerLookup(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerRef(DbPage*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerUnref(DbPage*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerUnrefNotNull(DbPage*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerUnrefPageOne(DbPage*);
+
+/* Operations on page references. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerWrite(DbPage*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerDontWrite(DbPage*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerMovepage(Pager*,DbPage*,Pgno,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerPageRefcount(DbPage*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3PagerGetData(DbPage *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3PagerGetExtra(DbPage *);
+
+/* Functions used to manage pager transactions and savepoints. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerPagecount(Pager*, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerBegin(Pager*, int exFlag, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerCommitPhaseOne(Pager*,const char *zSuper, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerExclusiveLock(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSync(Pager *pPager, const char *zSuper);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerCommitPhaseTwo(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerRollback(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerOpenSavepoint(Pager *pPager, int n);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSavepoint(Pager *pPager, int op, int iSavepoint);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSharedLock(Pager *pPager);
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerCheckpoint(Pager *pPager, sqlite3*, int, int*, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerWalSupported(Pager *pPager);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerWalCallback(Pager *pPager);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerOpenWal(Pager *pPager, int *pisOpen);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerCloseWal(Pager *pPager, sqlite3*);
+# ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_SNAPSHOT
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSnapshotGet(Pager*, sqlite3_snapshot **ppSnapshot);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSnapshotOpen(Pager*, sqlite3_snapshot *pSnapshot);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSnapshotRecover(Pager *pPager);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSnapshotCheck(Pager *pPager, sqlite3_snapshot *pSnapshot);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSnapshotUnlock(Pager *pPager);
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) && defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_SETLK_TIMEOUT)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerWalWriteLock(Pager*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerWalDb(Pager*, sqlite3*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3PagerWalWriteLock(y,z) SQLITE_OK
+# define sqlite3PagerWalDb(x,y)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DIRECT_OVERFLOW_READ
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerDirectReadOk(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_ZIPVFS
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerWalFramesize(Pager *pPager);
+#endif
+
+/* Functions used to query pager state and configuration. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3PagerIsreadonly(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3PagerDataVersion(Pager*);
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerRefcount(Pager*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerMemUsed(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3PagerFilename(const Pager*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_vfs *sqlite3PagerVfs(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_file *sqlite3PagerFile(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_file *sqlite3PagerJrnlFile(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3PagerJournalname(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3PagerTempSpace(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerIsMemdb(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerCacheStat(Pager *, int, int, int *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerClearCache(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SectorSize(sqlite3_file *);
+
+/* Functions used to truncate the database file. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerTruncateImage(Pager*,Pgno);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerRekey(DbPage*, Pgno, u16);
+
+/* Functions to support testing and debugging. */
+#if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Pgno sqlite3PagerPagenumber(DbPage*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerIswriteable(DbPage*);
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int *sqlite3PagerStats(Pager*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerRefdump(Pager*);
+ void disable_simulated_io_errors(void);
+ void enable_simulated_io_errors(void);
+#else
+# define disable_simulated_io_errors()
+# define enable_simulated_io_errors()
+#endif
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_PAGER_H */
+
+/************** End of pager.h ***********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+/************** Include btree.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h *****************/
+/************** Begin file btree.h *******************************************/
+/*
+** 2001 September 15
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This header file defines the interface that the sqlite B-Tree file
+** subsystem. See comments in the source code for a detailed description
+** of what each interface routine does.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_BTREE_H
+#define SQLITE_BTREE_H
+
+/* TODO: This definition is just included so other modules compile. It
+** needs to be revisited.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_N_BTREE_META 16
+
+/*
+** If defined as non-zero, auto-vacuum is enabled by default. Otherwise
+** it must be turned on for each database using "PRAGMA auto_vacuum = 1".
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_AUTOVACUUM
+ #define SQLITE_DEFAULT_AUTOVACUUM 0
+#endif
+
+#define BTREE_AUTOVACUUM_NONE 0 /* Do not do auto-vacuum */
+#define BTREE_AUTOVACUUM_FULL 1 /* Do full auto-vacuum */
+#define BTREE_AUTOVACUUM_INCR 2 /* Incremental vacuum */
+
+/*
+** Forward declarations of structure
+*/
+typedef struct Btree Btree;
+typedef struct BtCursor BtCursor;
+typedef struct BtShared BtShared;
+typedef struct BtreePayload BtreePayload;
+
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeOpen(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, /* VFS to use with this b-tree */
+ const char *zFilename, /* Name of database file to open */
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Associated database connection */
+ Btree **ppBtree, /* Return open Btree* here */
+ int flags, /* Flags */
+ int vfsFlags /* Flags passed through to VFS open */
+);
+
+/* The flags parameter to sqlite3BtreeOpen can be the bitwise or of the
+** following values.
+**
+** NOTE: These values must match the corresponding PAGER_ values in
+** pager.h.
+*/
+#define BTREE_OMIT_JOURNAL 1 /* Do not create or use a rollback journal */
+#define BTREE_MEMORY 2 /* This is an in-memory DB */
+#define BTREE_SINGLE 4 /* The file contains at most 1 b-tree */
+#define BTREE_UNORDERED 8 /* Use of a hash implementation is OK */
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeClose(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetCacheSize(Btree*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetSpillSize(Btree*,int);
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetMmapLimit(Btree*,sqlite3_int64);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetPagerFlags(Btree*,unsigned);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetPageSize(Btree *p, int nPagesize, int nReserve, int eFix);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeGetPageSize(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Pgno sqlite3BtreeMaxPageCount(Btree*,Pgno);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Pgno sqlite3BtreeLastPage(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSecureDelete(Btree*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeGetRequestedReserve(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeGetReserveNoMutex(Btree *p);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetAutoVacuum(Btree *, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeGetAutoVacuum(Btree *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeBeginTrans(Btree*,int,int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseOne(Btree*, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseTwo(Btree*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCommit(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeRollback(Btree*,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeBeginStmt(Btree*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCreateTable(Btree*, Pgno*, int flags);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeIsInTrans(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeIsInReadTrans(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeIsInBackup(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3BtreeSchema(Btree *, int, void(*)(void *));
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSchemaLocked(Btree *pBtree);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeLockTable(Btree *pBtree, int iTab, u8 isWriteLock);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSavepoint(Btree *, int, int);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3BtreeGetFilename(Btree *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3BtreeGetJournalname(Btree *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCopyFile(Btree *, Btree *);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeIncrVacuum(Btree *);
+
+/* The flags parameter to sqlite3BtreeCreateTable can be the bitwise OR
+** of the flags shown below.
+**
+** Every SQLite table must have either BTREE_INTKEY or BTREE_BLOBKEY set.
+** With BTREE_INTKEY, the table key is a 64-bit integer and arbitrary data
+** is stored in the leaves. (BTREE_INTKEY is used for SQL tables.) With
+** BTREE_BLOBKEY, the key is an arbitrary BLOB and no content is stored
+** anywhere - the key is the content. (BTREE_BLOBKEY is used for SQL
+** indices.)
+*/
+#define BTREE_INTKEY 1 /* Table has only 64-bit signed integer keys */
+#define BTREE_BLOBKEY 2 /* Table has keys only - no data */
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeDropTable(Btree*, int, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeClearTable(Btree*, int, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeClearTableOfCursor(BtCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeTripAllCursors(Btree*, int, int);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeGetMeta(Btree *pBtree, int idx, u32 *pValue);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeUpdateMeta(Btree*, int idx, u32 value);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeNewDb(Btree *p);
+
+/*
+** The second parameter to sqlite3BtreeGetMeta or sqlite3BtreeUpdateMeta
+** should be one of the following values. The integer values are assigned
+** to constants so that the offset of the corresponding field in an
+** SQLite database header may be found using the following formula:
+**
+** offset = 36 + (idx * 4)
+**
+** For example, the free-page-count field is located at byte offset 36 of
+** the database file header. The incr-vacuum-flag field is located at
+** byte offset 64 (== 36+4*7).
+**
+** The BTREE_DATA_VERSION value is not really a value stored in the header.
+** It is a read-only number computed by the pager. But we merge it with
+** the header value access routines since its access pattern is the same.
+** Call it a "virtual meta value".
+*/
+#define BTREE_FREE_PAGE_COUNT 0
+#define BTREE_SCHEMA_VERSION 1
+#define BTREE_FILE_FORMAT 2
+#define BTREE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE 3
+#define BTREE_LARGEST_ROOT_PAGE 4
+#define BTREE_TEXT_ENCODING 5
+#define BTREE_USER_VERSION 6
+#define BTREE_INCR_VACUUM 7
+#define BTREE_APPLICATION_ID 8
+#define BTREE_DATA_VERSION 15 /* A virtual meta-value */
+
+/*
+** Kinds of hints that can be passed into the sqlite3BtreeCursorHint()
+** interface.
+**
+** BTREE_HINT_RANGE (arguments: Expr*, Mem*)
+**
+** The first argument is an Expr* (which is guaranteed to be constant for
+** the lifetime of the cursor) that defines constraints on which rows
+** might be fetched with this cursor. The Expr* tree may contain
+** TK_REGISTER nodes that refer to values stored in the array of registers
+** passed as the second parameter. In other words, if Expr.op==TK_REGISTER
+** then the value of the node is the value in Mem[pExpr.iTable]. Any
+** TK_COLUMN node in the expression tree refers to the Expr.iColumn-th
+** column of the b-tree of the cursor. The Expr tree will not contain
+** any function calls nor subqueries nor references to b-trees other than
+** the cursor being hinted.
+**
+** The design of the _RANGE hint is aid b-tree implementations that try
+** to prefetch content from remote machines - to provide those
+** implementations with limits on what needs to be prefetched and thereby
+** reduce network bandwidth.
+**
+** Note that BTREE_HINT_FLAGS with BTREE_BULKLOAD is the only hint used by
+** standard SQLite. The other hints are provided for extentions that use
+** the SQLite parser and code generator but substitute their own storage
+** engine.
+*/
+#define BTREE_HINT_RANGE 0 /* Range constraints on queries */
+
+/*
+** Values that may be OR'd together to form the argument to the
+** BTREE_HINT_FLAGS hint for sqlite3BtreeCursorHint():
+**
+** The BTREE_BULKLOAD flag is set on index cursors when the index is going
+** to be filled with content that is already in sorted order.
+**
+** The BTREE_SEEK_EQ flag is set on cursors that will get OP_SeekGE or
+** OP_SeekLE opcodes for a range search, but where the range of entries
+** selected will all have the same key. In other words, the cursor will
+** be used only for equality key searches.
+**
+*/
+#define BTREE_BULKLOAD 0x00000001 /* Used to full index in sorted order */
+#define BTREE_SEEK_EQ 0x00000002 /* EQ seeks only - no range seeks */
+
+/*
+** Flags passed as the third argument to sqlite3BtreeCursor().
+**
+** For read-only cursors the wrFlag argument is always zero. For read-write
+** cursors it may be set to either (BTREE_WRCSR|BTREE_FORDELETE) or just
+** (BTREE_WRCSR). If the BTREE_FORDELETE bit is set, then the cursor will
+** only be used by SQLite for the following:
+**
+** * to seek to and then delete specific entries, and/or
+**
+** * to read values that will be used to create keys that other
+** BTREE_FORDELETE cursors will seek to and delete.
+**
+** The BTREE_FORDELETE flag is an optimization hint. It is not used by
+** by this, the native b-tree engine of SQLite, but it is available to
+** alternative storage engines that might be substituted in place of this
+** b-tree system. For alternative storage engines in which a delete of
+** the main table row automatically deletes corresponding index rows,
+** the FORDELETE flag hint allows those alternative storage engines to
+** skip a lot of work. Namely: FORDELETE cursors may treat all SEEK
+** and DELETE operations as no-ops, and any READ operation against a
+** FORDELETE cursor may return a null row: 0x01 0x00.
+*/
+#define BTREE_WRCSR 0x00000004 /* read-write cursor */
+#define BTREE_FORDELETE 0x00000008 /* Cursor is for seek/delete only */
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCursor(
+ Btree*, /* BTree containing table to open */
+ Pgno iTable, /* Index of root page */
+ int wrFlag, /* 1 for writing. 0 for read-only */
+ struct KeyInfo*, /* First argument to compare function */
+ BtCursor *pCursor /* Space to write cursor structure */
+);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE BtCursor *sqlite3BtreeFakeValidCursor(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCursorSize(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeCursorZero(BtCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeCursorHintFlags(BtCursor*, unsigned);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_CURSOR_HINTS
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeCursorHint(BtCursor*, int, ...);
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCloseCursor(BtCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeMovetoUnpacked(
+ BtCursor*,
+ UnpackedRecord *pUnKey,
+ i64 intKey,
+ int bias,
+ int *pRes
+);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCursorHasMoved(BtCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCursorRestore(BtCursor*, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeDelete(BtCursor*, u8 flags);
+
+/* Allowed flags for sqlite3BtreeDelete() and sqlite3BtreeInsert() */
+#define BTREE_SAVEPOSITION 0x02 /* Leave cursor pointing at NEXT or PREV */
+#define BTREE_AUXDELETE 0x04 /* not the primary delete operation */
+#define BTREE_APPEND 0x08 /* Insert is likely an append */
+
+/* An instance of the BtreePayload object describes the content of a single
+** entry in either an index or table btree.
+**
+** Index btrees (used for indexes and also WITHOUT ROWID tables) contain
+** an arbitrary key and no data. These btrees have pKey,nKey set to the
+** key and the pData,nData,nZero fields are uninitialized. The aMem,nMem
+** fields give an array of Mem objects that are a decomposition of the key.
+** The nMem field might be zero, indicating that no decomposition is available.
+**
+** Table btrees (used for rowid tables) contain an integer rowid used as
+** the key and passed in the nKey field. The pKey field is zero.
+** pData,nData hold the content of the new entry. nZero extra zero bytes
+** are appended to the end of the content when constructing the entry.
+** The aMem,nMem fields are uninitialized for table btrees.
+**
+** Field usage summary:
+**
+** Table BTrees Index Btrees
+**
+** pKey always NULL encoded key
+** nKey the ROWID length of pKey
+** pData data not used
+** aMem not used decomposed key value
+** nMem not used entries in aMem
+** nData length of pData not used
+** nZero extra zeros after pData not used
+**
+** This object is used to pass information into sqlite3BtreeInsert(). The
+** same information used to be passed as five separate parameters. But placing
+** the information into this object helps to keep the interface more
+** organized and understandable, and it also helps the resulting code to
+** run a little faster by using fewer registers for parameter passing.
+*/
+struct BtreePayload {
+ const void *pKey; /* Key content for indexes. NULL for tables */
+ sqlite3_int64 nKey; /* Size of pKey for indexes. PRIMARY KEY for tabs */
+ const void *pData; /* Data for tables. */
+ sqlite3_value *aMem; /* First of nMem value in the unpacked pKey */
+ u16 nMem; /* Number of aMem[] value. Might be zero */
+ int nData; /* Size of pData. 0 if none. */
+ int nZero; /* Extra zero data appended after pData,nData */
+};
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeInsert(BtCursor*, const BtreePayload *pPayload,
+ int flags, int seekResult);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeFirst(BtCursor*, int *pRes);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeLast(BtCursor*, int *pRes);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeNext(BtCursor*, int flags);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeEof(BtCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreePrevious(BtCursor*, int flags);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE i64 sqlite3BtreeIntegerKey(BtCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeCursorPin(BtCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeCursorUnpin(BtCursor*);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_OFFSET_SQL_FUNC
+SQLITE_PRIVATE i64 sqlite3BtreeOffset(BtCursor*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreePayload(BtCursor*, u32 offset, u32 amt, void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const void *sqlite3BtreePayloadFetch(BtCursor*, u32 *pAmt);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3BtreePayloadSize(BtCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_int64 sqlite3BtreeMaxRecordSize(BtCursor*);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3BtreeIntegrityCheck(sqlite3*,Btree*,Pgno*aRoot,int nRoot,int,int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE struct Pager *sqlite3BtreePager(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE i64 sqlite3BtreeRowCountEst(BtCursor*);
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_INCRBLOB
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreePayloadChecked(BtCursor*, u32 offset, u32 amt, void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreePutData(BtCursor*, u32 offset, u32 amt, void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeIncrblobCursor(BtCursor *);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeClearCursor(BtCursor *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetVersion(Btree *pBt, int iVersion);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCursorHasHint(BtCursor*, unsigned int mask);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeIsReadonly(Btree *pBt);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3HeaderSizeBtree(void);
+
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCursorIsValid(BtCursor*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCursorIsValidNN(BtCursor*);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCount(sqlite3*, BtCursor*, i64*);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCursorInfo(BtCursor*, int*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeCursorList(Btree*);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCheckpoint(Btree*, int, int *, int *);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** If we are not using shared cache, then there is no need to
+** use mutexes to access the BtShared structures. So make the
+** Enter and Leave procedures no-ops.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeEnter(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeEnterAll(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSharable(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeEnterCursor(BtCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeConnectionCount(Btree*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3BtreeEnter(X)
+# define sqlite3BtreeEnterAll(X)
+# define sqlite3BtreeSharable(X) 0
+# define sqlite3BtreeEnterCursor(X)
+# define sqlite3BtreeConnectionCount(X) 1
+#endif
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE) && SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeLeave(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeLeaveCursor(BtCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeLeaveAll(sqlite3*);
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+ /* These routines are used inside assert() statements only. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(Btree*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeHoldsAllMutexes(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SchemaMutexHeld(sqlite3*,int,Schema*);
+#endif
+#else
+
+# define sqlite3BtreeLeave(X)
+# define sqlite3BtreeLeaveCursor(X)
+# define sqlite3BtreeLeaveAll(X)
+
+# define sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(X) 1
+# define sqlite3BtreeHoldsAllMutexes(X) 1
+# define sqlite3SchemaMutexHeld(X,Y,Z) 1
+#endif
+
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_BTREE_H */
+
+/************** End of btree.h ***********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+/************** Include vdbe.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ******************/
+/************** Begin file vdbe.h ********************************************/
+/*
+** 2001 September 15
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** Header file for the Virtual DataBase Engine (VDBE)
+**
+** This header defines the interface to the virtual database engine
+** or VDBE. The VDBE implements an abstract machine that runs a
+** simple program to access and modify the underlying database.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_VDBE_H
+#define SQLITE_VDBE_H
+/* #include */
+
+/*
+** A single VDBE is an opaque structure named "Vdbe". Only routines
+** in the source file sqliteVdbe.c are allowed to see the insides
+** of this structure.
+*/
+typedef struct Vdbe Vdbe;
+
+/*
+** The names of the following types declared in vdbeInt.h are required
+** for the VdbeOp definition.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_value Mem;
+typedef struct SubProgram SubProgram;
+
+/*
+** A single instruction of the virtual machine has an opcode
+** and as many as three operands. The instruction is recorded
+** as an instance of the following structure:
+*/
+struct VdbeOp {
+ u8 opcode; /* What operation to perform */
+ signed char p4type; /* One of the P4_xxx constants for p4 */
+ u16 p5; /* Fifth parameter is an unsigned 16-bit integer */
+ int p1; /* First operand */
+ int p2; /* Second parameter (often the jump destination) */
+ int p3; /* The third parameter */
+ union p4union { /* fourth parameter */
+ int i; /* Integer value if p4type==P4_INT32 */
+ void *p; /* Generic pointer */
+ char *z; /* Pointer to data for string (char array) types */
+ i64 *pI64; /* Used when p4type is P4_INT64 */
+ double *pReal; /* Used when p4type is P4_REAL */
+ FuncDef *pFunc; /* Used when p4type is P4_FUNCDEF */
+ sqlite3_context *pCtx; /* Used when p4type is P4_FUNCCTX */
+ CollSeq *pColl; /* Used when p4type is P4_COLLSEQ */
+ Mem *pMem; /* Used when p4type is P4_MEM */
+ VTable *pVtab; /* Used when p4type is P4_VTAB */
+ KeyInfo *pKeyInfo; /* Used when p4type is P4_KEYINFO */
+ u32 *ai; /* Used when p4type is P4_INTARRAY */
+ SubProgram *pProgram; /* Used when p4type is P4_SUBPROGRAM */
+ Table *pTab; /* Used when p4type is P4_TABLE */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_CURSOR_HINTS
+ Expr *pExpr; /* Used when p4type is P4_EXPR */
+#endif
+ int (*xAdvance)(BtCursor *, int);
+ } p4;
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_EXPLAIN_COMMENTS
+ char *zComment; /* Comment to improve readability */
+#endif
+#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE
+ u32 cnt; /* Number of times this instruction was executed */
+ u64 cycles; /* Total time spent executing this instruction */
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_VDBE_COVERAGE
+ u32 iSrcLine; /* Source-code line that generated this opcode
+ ** with flags in the upper 8 bits */
+#endif
+};
+typedef struct VdbeOp VdbeOp;
+
+
+/*
+** A sub-routine used to implement a trigger program.
+*/
+struct SubProgram {
+ VdbeOp *aOp; /* Array of opcodes for sub-program */
+ int nOp; /* Elements in aOp[] */
+ int nMem; /* Number of memory cells required */
+ int nCsr; /* Number of cursors required */
+ u8 *aOnce; /* Array of OP_Once flags */
+ void *token; /* id that may be used to recursive triggers */
+ SubProgram *pNext; /* Next sub-program already visited */
+};
+
+/*
+** A smaller version of VdbeOp used for the VdbeAddOpList() function because
+** it takes up less space.
+*/
+struct VdbeOpList {
+ u8 opcode; /* What operation to perform */
+ signed char p1; /* First operand */
+ signed char p2; /* Second parameter (often the jump destination) */
+ signed char p3; /* Third parameter */
+};
+typedef struct VdbeOpList VdbeOpList;
+
+/*
+** Allowed values of VdbeOp.p4type
+*/
+#define P4_NOTUSED 0 /* The P4 parameter is not used */
+#define P4_TRANSIENT 0 /* P4 is a pointer to a transient string */
+#define P4_STATIC (-1) /* Pointer to a static string */
+#define P4_COLLSEQ (-2) /* P4 is a pointer to a CollSeq structure */
+#define P4_INT32 (-3) /* P4 is a 32-bit signed integer */
+#define P4_SUBPROGRAM (-4) /* P4 is a pointer to a SubProgram structure */
+#define P4_ADVANCE (-5) /* P4 is a pointer to BtreeNext() or BtreePrev() */
+#define P4_TABLE (-6) /* P4 is a pointer to a Table structure */
+/* Above do not own any resources. Must free those below */
+#define P4_FREE_IF_LE (-7)
+#define P4_DYNAMIC (-7) /* Pointer to memory from sqliteMalloc() */
+#define P4_FUNCDEF (-8) /* P4 is a pointer to a FuncDef structure */
+#define P4_KEYINFO (-9) /* P4 is a pointer to a KeyInfo structure */
+#define P4_EXPR (-10) /* P4 is a pointer to an Expr tree */
+#define P4_MEM (-11) /* P4 is a pointer to a Mem* structure */
+#define P4_VTAB (-12) /* P4 is a pointer to an sqlite3_vtab structure */
+#define P4_REAL (-13) /* P4 is a 64-bit floating point value */
+#define P4_INT64 (-14) /* P4 is a 64-bit signed integer */
+#define P4_INTARRAY (-15) /* P4 is a vector of 32-bit integers */
+#define P4_FUNCCTX (-16) /* P4 is a pointer to an sqlite3_context object */
+#define P4_DYNBLOB (-17) /* Pointer to memory from sqliteMalloc() */
+
+/* Error message codes for OP_Halt */
+#define P5_ConstraintNotNull 1
+#define P5_ConstraintUnique 2
+#define P5_ConstraintCheck 3
+#define P5_ConstraintFK 4
+
+/*
+** The Vdbe.aColName array contains 5n Mem structures, where n is the
+** number of columns of data returned by the statement.
+*/
+#define COLNAME_NAME 0
+#define COLNAME_DECLTYPE 1
+#define COLNAME_DATABASE 2
+#define COLNAME_TABLE 3
+#define COLNAME_COLUMN 4
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_COLUMN_METADATA
+# define COLNAME_N 5 /* Number of COLNAME_xxx symbols */
+#else
+# ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_DECLTYPE
+# define COLNAME_N 1 /* Store only the name */
+# else
+# define COLNAME_N 2 /* Store the name and decltype */
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The following macro converts a label returned by sqlite3VdbeMakeLabel()
+** into an index into the Parse.aLabel[] array that contains the resolved
+** address of that label.
+*/
+#define ADDR(X) (~(X))
+
+/*
+** The makefile scans the vdbe.c source file and creates the "opcodes.h"
+** header file that defines a number for each opcode used by the VDBE.
+*/
+/************** Include opcodes.h in the middle of vdbe.h ********************/
+/************** Begin file opcodes.h *****************************************/
+/* Automatically generated. Do not edit */
+/* See the tool/mkopcodeh.tcl script for details */
+#define OP_Savepoint 0
+#define OP_AutoCommit 1
+#define OP_Transaction 2
+#define OP_SorterNext 3 /* jump */
+#define OP_Prev 4 /* jump */
+#define OP_Next 5 /* jump */
+#define OP_Checkpoint 6
+#define OP_JournalMode 7
+#define OP_Vacuum 8
+#define OP_VFilter 9 /* jump, synopsis: iplan=r[P3] zplan='P4' */
+#define OP_VUpdate 10 /* synopsis: data=r[P3@P2] */
+#define OP_Goto 11 /* jump */
+#define OP_Gosub 12 /* jump */
+#define OP_InitCoroutine 13 /* jump */
+#define OP_Yield 14 /* jump */
+#define OP_MustBeInt 15 /* jump */
+#define OP_Jump 16 /* jump */
+#define OP_Once 17 /* jump */
+#define OP_If 18 /* jump */
+#define OP_Not 19 /* same as TK_NOT, synopsis: r[P2]= !r[P1] */
+#define OP_IfNot 20 /* jump */
+#define OP_IfNullRow 21 /* jump, synopsis: if P1.nullRow then r[P3]=NULL, goto P2 */
+#define OP_SeekLT 22 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_SeekLE 23 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_SeekGE 24 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_SeekGT 25 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_IfNotOpen 26 /* jump, synopsis: if( !csr[P1] ) goto P2 */
+#define OP_IfNoHope 27 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_NoConflict 28 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_NotFound 29 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_Found 30 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_SeekRowid 31 /* jump, synopsis: intkey=r[P3] */
+#define OP_NotExists 32 /* jump, synopsis: intkey=r[P3] */
+#define OP_Last 33 /* jump */
+#define OP_IfSmaller 34 /* jump */
+#define OP_SorterSort 35 /* jump */
+#define OP_Sort 36 /* jump */
+#define OP_Rewind 37 /* jump */
+#define OP_IdxLE 38 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_IdxGT 39 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_IdxLT 40 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_IdxGE 41 /* jump, synopsis: key=r[P3@P4] */
+#define OP_RowSetRead 42 /* jump, synopsis: r[P3]=rowset(P1) */
+#define OP_Or 43 /* same as TK_OR, synopsis: r[P3]=(r[P1] || r[P2]) */
+#define OP_And 44 /* same as TK_AND, synopsis: r[P3]=(r[P1] && r[P2]) */
+#define OP_RowSetTest 45 /* jump, synopsis: if r[P3] in rowset(P1) goto P2 */
+#define OP_Program 46 /* jump */
+#define OP_FkIfZero 47 /* jump, synopsis: if fkctr[P1]==0 goto P2 */
+#define OP_IfPos 48 /* jump, synopsis: if r[P1]>0 then r[P1]-=P3, goto P2 */
+#define OP_IfNotZero 49 /* jump, synopsis: if r[P1]!=0 then r[P1]--, goto P2 */
+#define OP_IsNull 50 /* jump, same as TK_ISNULL, synopsis: if r[P1]==NULL goto P2 */
+#define OP_NotNull 51 /* jump, same as TK_NOTNULL, synopsis: if r[P1]!=NULL goto P2 */
+#define OP_Ne 52 /* jump, same as TK_NE, synopsis: IF r[P3]!=r[P1] */
+#define OP_Eq 53 /* jump, same as TK_EQ, synopsis: IF r[P3]==r[P1] */
+#define OP_Gt 54 /* jump, same as TK_GT, synopsis: IF r[P3]>r[P1] */
+#define OP_Le 55 /* jump, same as TK_LE, synopsis: IF r[P3]<=r[P1] */
+#define OP_Lt 56 /* jump, same as TK_LT, synopsis: IF r[P3]=r[P1] */
+#define OP_ElseNotEq 58 /* jump, same as TK_ESCAPE */
+#define OP_DecrJumpZero 59 /* jump, synopsis: if (--r[P1])==0 goto P2 */
+#define OP_IncrVacuum 60 /* jump */
+#define OP_VNext 61 /* jump */
+#define OP_Init 62 /* jump, synopsis: Start at P2 */
+#define OP_PureFunc 63 /* synopsis: r[P3]=func(r[P2@NP]) */
+#define OP_Function 64 /* synopsis: r[P3]=func(r[P2@NP]) */
+#define OP_Return 65
+#define OP_EndCoroutine 66
+#define OP_HaltIfNull 67 /* synopsis: if r[P3]=null halt */
+#define OP_Halt 68
+#define OP_Integer 69 /* synopsis: r[P2]=P1 */
+#define OP_Int64 70 /* synopsis: r[P2]=P4 */
+#define OP_String 71 /* synopsis: r[P2]='P4' (len=P1) */
+#define OP_Null 72 /* synopsis: r[P2..P3]=NULL */
+#define OP_SoftNull 73 /* synopsis: r[P1]=NULL */
+#define OP_Blob 74 /* synopsis: r[P2]=P4 (len=P1) */
+#define OP_Variable 75 /* synopsis: r[P2]=parameter(P1,P4) */
+#define OP_Move 76 /* synopsis: r[P2@P3]=r[P1@P3] */
+#define OP_Copy 77 /* synopsis: r[P2@P3+1]=r[P1@P3+1] */
+#define OP_SCopy 78 /* synopsis: r[P2]=r[P1] */
+#define OP_IntCopy 79 /* synopsis: r[P2]=r[P1] */
+#define OP_ResultRow 80 /* synopsis: output=r[P1@P2] */
+#define OP_CollSeq 81
+#define OP_AddImm 82 /* synopsis: r[P1]=r[P1]+P2 */
+#define OP_RealAffinity 83
+#define OP_Cast 84 /* synopsis: affinity(r[P1]) */
+#define OP_Permutation 85
+#define OP_Compare 86 /* synopsis: r[P1@P3] <-> r[P2@P3] */
+#define OP_IsTrue 87 /* synopsis: r[P2] = coalesce(r[P1]==TRUE,P3) ^ P4 */
+#define OP_Offset 88 /* synopsis: r[P3] = sqlite_offset(P1) */
+#define OP_Column 89 /* synopsis: r[P3]=PX */
+#define OP_Affinity 90 /* synopsis: affinity(r[P1@P2]) */
+#define OP_MakeRecord 91 /* synopsis: r[P3]=mkrec(r[P1@P2]) */
+#define OP_Count 92 /* synopsis: r[P2]=count() */
+#define OP_ReadCookie 93
+#define OP_SetCookie 94
+#define OP_ReopenIdx 95 /* synopsis: root=P2 iDb=P3 */
+#define OP_OpenRead 96 /* synopsis: root=P2 iDb=P3 */
+#define OP_OpenWrite 97 /* synopsis: root=P2 iDb=P3 */
+#define OP_OpenDup 98
+#define OP_OpenAutoindex 99 /* synopsis: nColumn=P2 */
+#define OP_OpenEphemeral 100 /* synopsis: nColumn=P2 */
+#define OP_BitAnd 101 /* same as TK_BITAND, synopsis: r[P3]=r[P1]&r[P2] */
+#define OP_BitOr 102 /* same as TK_BITOR, synopsis: r[P3]=r[P1]|r[P2] */
+#define OP_ShiftLeft 103 /* same as TK_LSHIFT, synopsis: r[P3]=r[P2]<>r[P1] */
+#define OP_Add 105 /* same as TK_PLUS, synopsis: r[P3]=r[P1]+r[P2] */
+#define OP_Subtract 106 /* same as TK_MINUS, synopsis: r[P3]=r[P2]-r[P1] */
+#define OP_Multiply 107 /* same as TK_STAR, synopsis: r[P3]=r[P1]*r[P2] */
+#define OP_Divide 108 /* same as TK_SLASH, synopsis: r[P3]=r[P2]/r[P1] */
+#define OP_Remainder 109 /* same as TK_REM, synopsis: r[P3]=r[P2]%r[P1] */
+#define OP_Concat 110 /* same as TK_CONCAT, synopsis: r[P3]=r[P2]+r[P1] */
+#define OP_SorterOpen 111
+#define OP_BitNot 112 /* same as TK_BITNOT, synopsis: r[P2]= ~r[P1] */
+#define OP_SequenceTest 113 /* synopsis: if( cursor[P1].ctr++ ) pc = P2 */
+#define OP_OpenPseudo 114 /* synopsis: P3 columns in r[P2] */
+#define OP_String8 115 /* same as TK_STRING, synopsis: r[P2]='P4' */
+#define OP_Close 116
+#define OP_ColumnsUsed 117
+#define OP_SeekHit 118 /* synopsis: seekHit=P2 */
+#define OP_Sequence 119 /* synopsis: r[P2]=cursor[P1].ctr++ */
+#define OP_NewRowid 120 /* synopsis: r[P2]=rowid */
+#define OP_Insert 121 /* synopsis: intkey=r[P3] data=r[P2] */
+#define OP_Delete 122
+#define OP_ResetCount 123
+#define OP_SorterCompare 124 /* synopsis: if key(P1)!=trim(r[P3],P4) goto P2 */
+#define OP_SorterData 125 /* synopsis: r[P2]=data */
+#define OP_RowData 126 /* synopsis: r[P2]=data */
+#define OP_Rowid 127 /* synopsis: r[P2]=rowid */
+#define OP_NullRow 128
+#define OP_SeekEnd 129
+#define OP_IdxInsert 130 /* synopsis: key=r[P2] */
+#define OP_SorterInsert 131 /* synopsis: key=r[P2] */
+#define OP_IdxDelete 132 /* synopsis: key=r[P2@P3] */
+#define OP_DeferredSeek 133 /* synopsis: Move P3 to P1.rowid if needed */
+#define OP_IdxRowid 134 /* synopsis: r[P2]=rowid */
+#define OP_FinishSeek 135
+#define OP_Destroy 136
+#define OP_Clear 137
+#define OP_ResetSorter 138
+#define OP_CreateBtree 139 /* synopsis: r[P2]=root iDb=P1 flags=P3 */
+#define OP_SqlExec 140
+#define OP_ParseSchema 141
+#define OP_LoadAnalysis 142
+#define OP_DropTable 143
+#define OP_DropIndex 144
+#define OP_DropTrigger 145
+#define OP_IntegrityCk 146
+#define OP_RowSetAdd 147 /* synopsis: rowset(P1)=r[P2] */
+#define OP_Param 148
+#define OP_FkCounter 149 /* synopsis: fkctr[P1]+=P2 */
+#define OP_Real 150 /* same as TK_FLOAT, synopsis: r[P2]=P4 */
+#define OP_MemMax 151 /* synopsis: r[P1]=max(r[P1],r[P2]) */
+#define OP_OffsetLimit 152 /* synopsis: if r[P1]>0 then r[P2]=r[P1]+max(0,r[P3]) else r[P2]=(-1) */
+#define OP_AggInverse 153 /* synopsis: accum=r[P3] inverse(r[P2@P5]) */
+#define OP_AggStep 154 /* synopsis: accum=r[P3] step(r[P2@P5]) */
+#define OP_AggStep1 155 /* synopsis: accum=r[P3] step(r[P2@P5]) */
+#define OP_AggValue 156 /* synopsis: r[P3]=value N=P2 */
+#define OP_AggFinal 157 /* synopsis: accum=r[P1] N=P2 */
+#define OP_Expire 158
+#define OP_CursorLock 159
+#define OP_CursorUnlock 160
+#define OP_TableLock 161 /* synopsis: iDb=P1 root=P2 write=P3 */
+#define OP_VBegin 162
+#define OP_VCreate 163
+#define OP_VDestroy 164
+#define OP_VOpen 165
+#define OP_VColumn 166 /* synopsis: r[P3]=vcolumn(P2) */
+#define OP_VRename 167
+#define OP_Pagecount 168
+#define OP_MaxPgcnt 169
+#define OP_Trace 170
+#define OP_CursorHint 171
+#define OP_ReleaseReg 172 /* synopsis: release r[P1@P2] mask P3 */
+#define OP_Noop 173
+#define OP_Explain 174
+#define OP_Abortable 175
+
+/* Properties such as "out2" or "jump" that are specified in
+** comments following the "case" for each opcode in the vdbe.c
+** are encoded into bitvectors as follows:
+*/
+#define OPFLG_JUMP 0x01 /* jump: P2 holds jmp target */
+#define OPFLG_IN1 0x02 /* in1: P1 is an input */
+#define OPFLG_IN2 0x04 /* in2: P2 is an input */
+#define OPFLG_IN3 0x08 /* in3: P3 is an input */
+#define OPFLG_OUT2 0x10 /* out2: P2 is an output */
+#define OPFLG_OUT3 0x20 /* out3: P3 is an output */
+#define OPFLG_INITIALIZER {\
+/* 0 */ 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01, 0x00, 0x10,\
+/* 8 */ 0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01, 0x03, 0x03,\
+/* 16 */ 0x01, 0x01, 0x03, 0x12, 0x03, 0x01, 0x09, 0x09,\
+/* 24 */ 0x09, 0x09, 0x01, 0x09, 0x09, 0x09, 0x09, 0x09,\
+/* 32 */ 0x09, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01,\
+/* 40 */ 0x01, 0x01, 0x23, 0x26, 0x26, 0x0b, 0x01, 0x01,\
+/* 48 */ 0x03, 0x03, 0x03, 0x03, 0x0b, 0x0b, 0x0b, 0x0b,\
+/* 56 */ 0x0b, 0x0b, 0x01, 0x03, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01, 0x00,\
+/* 64 */ 0x00, 0x02, 0x02, 0x08, 0x00, 0x10, 0x10, 0x10,\
+/* 72 */ 0x10, 0x00, 0x10, 0x10, 0x00, 0x00, 0x10, 0x10,\
+/* 80 */ 0x00, 0x00, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x00, 0x00, 0x12,\
+/* 88 */ 0x20, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x10, 0x10, 0x00, 0x00,\
+/* 96 */ 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x26, 0x26, 0x26,\
+/* 104 */ 0x26, 0x26, 0x26, 0x26, 0x26, 0x26, 0x26, 0x00,\
+/* 112 */ 0x12, 0x00, 0x00, 0x10, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x10,\
+/* 120 */ 0x10, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x10,\
+/* 128 */ 0x00, 0x00, 0x04, 0x04, 0x00, 0x00, 0x10, 0x00,\
+/* 136 */ 0x10, 0x00, 0x00, 0x10, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00,\
+/* 144 */ 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x06, 0x10, 0x00, 0x10, 0x04,\
+/* 152 */ 0x1a, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00,\
+/* 160 */ 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00,\
+/* 168 */ 0x10, 0x10, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00,\
+}
+
+/* The sqlite3P2Values() routine is able to run faster if it knows
+** the value of the largest JUMP opcode. The smaller the maximum
+** JUMP opcode the better, so the mkopcodeh.tcl script that
+** generated this include file strives to group all JUMP opcodes
+** together near the beginning of the list.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_MX_JUMP_OPCODE 62 /* Maximum JUMP opcode */
+
+/************** End of opcodes.h *********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in vdbe.h ***********************/
+
+/*
+** Additional non-public SQLITE_PREPARE_* flags
+*/
+#define SQLITE_PREPARE_SAVESQL 0x80 /* Preserve SQL text */
+#define SQLITE_PREPARE_MASK 0x0f /* Mask of public flags */
+
+/*
+** Prototypes for the VDBE interface. See comments on the implementation
+** for a description of what each of these routines does.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Vdbe *sqlite3VdbeCreate(Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Parse *sqlite3VdbeParser(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAddOp0(Vdbe*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAddOp1(Vdbe*,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAddOp2(Vdbe*,int,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeGoto(Vdbe*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeLoadString(Vdbe*,int,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMultiLoad(Vdbe*,int,const char*,...);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAddOp3(Vdbe*,int,int,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAddOp4(Vdbe*,int,int,int,int,const char *zP4,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAddOp4Dup8(Vdbe*,int,int,int,int,const u8*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAddOp4Int(Vdbe*,int,int,int,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAddFunctionCall(Parse*,int,int,int,int,const FuncDef*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeEndCoroutine(Vdbe*,int);
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) && !defined(SQLITE_TEST_REALLOC_STRESS)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeVerifyNoMallocRequired(Vdbe *p, int N);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeVerifyNoResultRow(Vdbe *p);
+#else
+# define sqlite3VdbeVerifyNoMallocRequired(A,B)
+# define sqlite3VdbeVerifyNoResultRow(A)
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeVerifyAbortable(Vdbe *p, int);
+#else
+# define sqlite3VdbeVerifyAbortable(A,B)
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE VdbeOp *sqlite3VdbeAddOpList(Vdbe*, int nOp, VdbeOpList const *aOp,int iLineno);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeExplain(Parse*,u8,const char*,...);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeExplainPop(Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeExplainParent(Parse*);
+# define ExplainQueryPlan(P) sqlite3VdbeExplain P
+# define ExplainQueryPlanPop(P) sqlite3VdbeExplainPop(P)
+# define ExplainQueryPlanParent(P) sqlite3VdbeExplainParent(P)
+#else
+# define ExplainQueryPlan(P)
+# define ExplainQueryPlanPop(P)
+# define ExplainQueryPlanParent(P) 0
+# define sqlite3ExplainBreakpoint(A,B) /*no-op*/
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExplainBreakpoint(const char*,const char*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3ExplainBreakpoint(A,B) /*no-op*/
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeAddParseSchemaOp(Vdbe*,int,char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeChangeOpcode(Vdbe*, int addr, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeChangeP1(Vdbe*, int addr, int P1);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeChangeP2(Vdbe*, int addr, int P2);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeChangeP3(Vdbe*, int addr, int P3);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeChangeP5(Vdbe*, u16 P5);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeJumpHere(Vdbe*, int addr);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeJumpHereOrPopInst(Vdbe*, int addr);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeChangeToNoop(Vdbe*, int addr);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeDeletePriorOpcode(Vdbe*, u8 op);
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeReleaseRegisters(Parse*,int addr, int n, u32 mask, int);
+#else
+# define sqlite3VdbeReleaseRegisters(P,A,N,M,F)
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeChangeP4(Vdbe*, int addr, const char *zP4, int N);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeAppendP4(Vdbe*, void *pP4, int p4type);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSetP4KeyInfo(Parse*, Index*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeUsesBtree(Vdbe*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE VdbeOp *sqlite3VdbeGetOp(Vdbe*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMakeLabel(Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeRunOnlyOnce(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeReusable(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeDelete(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeClearObject(sqlite3*,Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMakeReady(Vdbe*,Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeFinalize(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeResolveLabel(Vdbe*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeCurrentAddr(Vdbe*);
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAssertMayAbort(Vdbe *, int);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeResetStepResult(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeRewind(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeReset(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSetNumCols(Vdbe*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeSetColName(Vdbe*, int, int, const char *, void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeCountChanges(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3 *sqlite3VdbeDb(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3VdbePrepareFlags(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSetSql(Vdbe*, const char *z, int n, u8);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_NORMALIZE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeAddDblquoteStr(sqlite3*,Vdbe*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeUsesDoubleQuotedString(Vdbe*,const char*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSwap(Vdbe*,Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE VdbeOp *sqlite3VdbeTakeOpArray(Vdbe*, int*, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_value *sqlite3VdbeGetBoundValue(Vdbe*, int, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSetVarmask(Vdbe*, int);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TRACE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3VdbeExpandSql(Vdbe*, const char*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MemCompare(const Mem*, const Mem*, const CollSeq*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BlobCompare(const Mem*, const Mem*);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeRecordUnpack(KeyInfo*,int,const void*,UnpackedRecord*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeRecordCompare(int,const void*,UnpackedRecord*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeRecordCompareWithSkip(int, const void *, UnpackedRecord *, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE UnpackedRecord *sqlite3VdbeAllocUnpackedRecord(KeyInfo*);
+
+typedef int (*RecordCompare)(int,const void*,UnpackedRecord*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE RecordCompare sqlite3VdbeFindCompare(UnpackedRecord*);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeLinkSubProgram(Vdbe *, SubProgram *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeHasSubProgram(Vdbe*);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3NotPureFunc(sqlite3_context*);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_BYTECODE_VTAB
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeBytecodeVtabInit(sqlite3*);
+#endif
+
+/* Use SQLITE_ENABLE_COMMENTS to enable generation of extra comments on
+** each VDBE opcode.
+**
+** Use the SQLITE_ENABLE_MODULE_COMMENTS macro to see some extra no-op
+** comments in VDBE programs that show key decision points in the code
+** generator.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_EXPLAIN_COMMENTS
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeComment(Vdbe*, const char*, ...);
+# define VdbeComment(X) sqlite3VdbeComment X
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeNoopComment(Vdbe*, const char*, ...);
+# define VdbeNoopComment(X) sqlite3VdbeNoopComment X
+# ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MODULE_COMMENTS
+# define VdbeModuleComment(X) sqlite3VdbeNoopComment X
+# else
+# define VdbeModuleComment(X)
+# endif
+#else
+# define VdbeComment(X)
+# define VdbeNoopComment(X)
+# define VdbeModuleComment(X)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The VdbeCoverage macros are used to set a coverage testing point
+** for VDBE branch instructions. The coverage testing points are line
+** numbers in the sqlite3.c source file. VDBE branch coverage testing
+** only works with an amalagmation build. That's ok since a VDBE branch
+** coverage build designed for testing the test suite only. No application
+** should ever ship with VDBE branch coverage measuring turned on.
+**
+** VdbeCoverage(v) // Mark the previously coded instruction
+** // as a branch
+**
+** VdbeCoverageIf(v, conditional) // Mark previous if conditional true
+**
+** VdbeCoverageAlwaysTaken(v) // Previous branch is always taken
+**
+** VdbeCoverageNeverTaken(v) // Previous branch is never taken
+**
+** VdbeCoverageNeverNull(v) // Previous three-way branch is only
+** // taken on the first two ways. The
+** // NULL option is not possible
+**
+** VdbeCoverageEqNe(v) // Previous OP_Jump is only interested
+** // in distingishing equal and not-equal.
+**
+** Every VDBE branch operation must be tagged with one of the macros above.
+** If not, then when "make test" is run with -DSQLITE_VDBE_COVERAGE and
+** -DSQLITE_DEBUG then an ALWAYS() will fail in the vdbeTakeBranch()
+** routine in vdbe.c, alerting the developer to the missed tag.
+**
+** During testing, the test application will invoke
+** sqlite3_test_control(SQLITE_TESTCTRL_VDBE_COVERAGE,...) to set a callback
+** routine that is invoked as each bytecode branch is taken. The callback
+** contains the sqlite3.c source line number ov the VdbeCoverage macro and
+** flags to indicate whether or not the branch was taken. The test application
+** is responsible for keeping track of this and reporting byte-code branches
+** that are never taken.
+**
+** See the VdbeBranchTaken() macro and vdbeTakeBranch() function in the
+** vdbe.c source file for additional information.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_VDBE_COVERAGE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSetLineNumber(Vdbe*,int);
+# define VdbeCoverage(v) sqlite3VdbeSetLineNumber(v,__LINE__)
+# define VdbeCoverageIf(v,x) if(x)sqlite3VdbeSetLineNumber(v,__LINE__)
+# define VdbeCoverageAlwaysTaken(v) \
+ sqlite3VdbeSetLineNumber(v,__LINE__|0x5000000);
+# define VdbeCoverageNeverTaken(v) \
+ sqlite3VdbeSetLineNumber(v,__LINE__|0x6000000);
+# define VdbeCoverageNeverNull(v) \
+ sqlite3VdbeSetLineNumber(v,__LINE__|0x4000000);
+# define VdbeCoverageNeverNullIf(v,x) \
+ if(x)sqlite3VdbeSetLineNumber(v,__LINE__|0x4000000);
+# define VdbeCoverageEqNe(v) \
+ sqlite3VdbeSetLineNumber(v,__LINE__|0x8000000);
+# define VDBE_OFFSET_LINENO(x) (__LINE__+x)
+#else
+# define VdbeCoverage(v)
+# define VdbeCoverageIf(v,x)
+# define VdbeCoverageAlwaysTaken(v)
+# define VdbeCoverageNeverTaken(v)
+# define VdbeCoverageNeverNull(v)
+# define VdbeCoverageNeverNullIf(v,x)
+# define VdbeCoverageEqNe(v)
+# define VDBE_OFFSET_LINENO(x) 0
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_STMT_SCANSTATUS
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeScanStatus(Vdbe*, int, int, int, LogEst, const char*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3VdbeScanStatus(a,b,c,d,e)
+#endif
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(VDBE_PROFILE)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbePrintOp(FILE*, int, VdbeOp*);
+#endif
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_VDBE_H */
+
+/************** End of vdbe.h ************************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+/************** Include pcache.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ****************/
+/************** Begin file pcache.h ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 August 05
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This header file defines the interface that the sqlite page cache
+** subsystem.
+*/
+
+#ifndef _PCACHE_H_
+
+typedef struct PgHdr PgHdr;
+typedef struct PCache PCache;
+
+/*
+** Every page in the cache is controlled by an instance of the following
+** structure.
+*/
+struct PgHdr {
+ sqlite3_pcache_page *pPage; /* Pcache object page handle */
+ void *pData; /* Page data */
+ void *pExtra; /* Extra content */
+ PCache *pCache; /* PRIVATE: Cache that owns this page */
+ PgHdr *pDirty; /* Transient list of dirty sorted by pgno */
+ Pager *pPager; /* The pager this page is part of */
+ Pgno pgno; /* Page number for this page */
+#ifdef SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES
+ u32 pageHash; /* Hash of page content */
+#endif
+ u16 flags; /* PGHDR flags defined below */
+
+ /**********************************************************************
+ ** Elements above, except pCache, are public. All that follow are
+ ** private to pcache.c and should not be accessed by other modules.
+ ** pCache is grouped with the public elements for efficiency.
+ */
+ i16 nRef; /* Number of users of this page */
+ PgHdr *pDirtyNext; /* Next element in list of dirty pages */
+ PgHdr *pDirtyPrev; /* Previous element in list of dirty pages */
+ /* NB: pDirtyNext and pDirtyPrev are undefined if the
+ ** PgHdr object is not dirty */
+};
+
+/* Bit values for PgHdr.flags */
+#define PGHDR_CLEAN 0x001 /* Page not on the PCache.pDirty list */
+#define PGHDR_DIRTY 0x002 /* Page is on the PCache.pDirty list */
+#define PGHDR_WRITEABLE 0x004 /* Journaled and ready to modify */
+#define PGHDR_NEED_SYNC 0x008 /* Fsync the rollback journal before
+ ** writing this page to the database */
+#define PGHDR_DONT_WRITE 0x010 /* Do not write content to disk */
+#define PGHDR_MMAP 0x020 /* This is an mmap page object */
+
+#define PGHDR_WAL_APPEND 0x040 /* Appended to wal file */
+
+/* Initialize and shutdown the page cache subsystem */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheInitialize(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheShutdown(void);
+
+/* Page cache buffer management:
+** These routines implement SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PCacheBufferSetup(void *, int sz, int n);
+
+/* Create a new pager cache.
+** Under memory stress, invoke xStress to try to make pages clean.
+** Only clean and unpinned pages can be reclaimed.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheOpen(
+ int szPage, /* Size of every page */
+ int szExtra, /* Extra space associated with each page */
+ int bPurgeable, /* True if pages are on backing store */
+ int (*xStress)(void*, PgHdr*), /* Call to try to make pages clean */
+ void *pStress, /* Argument to xStress */
+ PCache *pToInit /* Preallocated space for the PCache */
+);
+
+/* Modify the page-size after the cache has been created. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheSetPageSize(PCache *, int);
+
+/* Return the size in bytes of a PCache object. Used to preallocate
+** storage space.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheSize(void);
+
+/* One release per successful fetch. Page is pinned until released.
+** Reference counted.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_pcache_page *sqlite3PcacheFetch(PCache*, Pgno, int createFlag);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheFetchStress(PCache*, Pgno, sqlite3_pcache_page**);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE PgHdr *sqlite3PcacheFetchFinish(PCache*, Pgno, sqlite3_pcache_page *pPage);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheRelease(PgHdr*);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheDrop(PgHdr*); /* Remove page from cache */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheMakeDirty(PgHdr*); /* Make sure page is marked dirty */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheMakeClean(PgHdr*); /* Mark a single page as clean */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheCleanAll(PCache*); /* Mark all dirty list pages as clean */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheClearWritable(PCache*);
+
+/* Change a page number. Used by incr-vacuum. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheMove(PgHdr*, Pgno);
+
+/* Remove all pages with pgno>x. Reset the cache if x==0 */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheTruncate(PCache*, Pgno x);
+
+/* Get a list of all dirty pages in the cache, sorted by page number */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE PgHdr *sqlite3PcacheDirtyList(PCache*);
+
+/* Reset and close the cache object */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheClose(PCache*);
+
+/* Clear flags from pages of the page cache */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheClearSyncFlags(PCache *);
+
+/* Discard the contents of the cache */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheClear(PCache*);
+
+/* Return the total number of outstanding page references */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheRefCount(PCache*);
+
+/* Increment the reference count of an existing page */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheRef(PgHdr*);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcachePageRefcount(PgHdr*);
+
+/* Return the total number of pages stored in the cache */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcachePagecount(PCache*);
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES) || defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+/* Iterate through all dirty pages currently stored in the cache. This
+** interface is only available if SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES is defined when the
+** library is built.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheIterateDirty(PCache *pCache, void (*xIter)(PgHdr *));
+#endif
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+/* Check invariants on a PgHdr object */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcachePageSanity(PgHdr*);
+#endif
+
+/* Set and get the suggested cache-size for the specified pager-cache.
+**
+** If no global maximum is configured, then the system attempts to limit
+** the total number of pages cached by purgeable pager-caches to the sum
+** of the suggested cache-sizes.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheSetCachesize(PCache *, int);
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheGetCachesize(PCache *);
+#endif
+
+/* Set or get the suggested spill-size for the specified pager-cache.
+**
+** The spill-size is the minimum number of pages in cache before the cache
+** will attempt to spill dirty pages by calling xStress.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheSetSpillsize(PCache *, int);
+
+/* Free up as much memory as possible from the page cache */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheShrink(PCache*);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT
+/* Try to return memory used by the pcache module to the main memory heap */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheReleaseMemory(int);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheStats(int*,int*,int*,int*);
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PCacheSetDefault(void);
+
+/* Return the header size */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3HeaderSizePcache(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3HeaderSizePcache1(void);
+
+/* Number of dirty pages as a percentage of the configured cache size */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PCachePercentDirty(PCache*);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DIRECT_OVERFLOW_READ
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PCacheIsDirty(PCache *pCache);
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _PCACHE_H_ */
+
+/************** End of pcache.h **********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+/************** Include os.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ********************/
+/************** Begin file os.h **********************************************/
+/*
+** 2001 September 16
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This header file (together with is companion C source-code file
+** "os.c") attempt to abstract the underlying operating system so that
+** the SQLite library will work on both POSIX and windows systems.
+**
+** This header file is #include-ed by sqliteInt.h and thus ends up
+** being included by every source file.
+*/
+#ifndef _SQLITE_OS_H_
+#define _SQLITE_OS_H_
+
+/*
+** Attempt to automatically detect the operating system and setup the
+** necessary pre-processor macros for it.
+*/
+/************** Include os_setup.h in the middle of os.h *********************/
+/************** Begin file os_setup.h ****************************************/
+/*
+** 2013 November 25
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains pre-processor directives related to operating system
+** detection and/or setup.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OS_SETUP_H
+#define SQLITE_OS_SETUP_H
+
+/*
+** Figure out if we are dealing with Unix, Windows, or some other operating
+** system.
+**
+** After the following block of preprocess macros, all of SQLITE_OS_UNIX,
+** SQLITE_OS_WIN, and SQLITE_OS_OTHER will defined to either 1 or 0. One of
+** the three will be 1. The other two will be 0.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_OS_OTHER)
+# if SQLITE_OS_OTHER==1
+# undef SQLITE_OS_UNIX
+# define SQLITE_OS_UNIX 0
+# undef SQLITE_OS_WIN
+# define SQLITE_OS_WIN 0
+# else
+# undef SQLITE_OS_OTHER
+# endif
+#endif
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OS_UNIX) && !defined(SQLITE_OS_OTHER)
+# define SQLITE_OS_OTHER 0
+# ifndef SQLITE_OS_WIN
+# if defined(_WIN32) || defined(WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__) || \
+ defined(__MINGW32__) || defined(__BORLANDC__)
+# define SQLITE_OS_WIN 1
+# define SQLITE_OS_UNIX 0
+# else
+# define SQLITE_OS_WIN 0
+# define SQLITE_OS_UNIX 1
+# endif
+# else
+# define SQLITE_OS_UNIX 0
+# endif
+#else
+# ifndef SQLITE_OS_WIN
+# define SQLITE_OS_WIN 0
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_OS_SETUP_H */
+
+/************** End of os_setup.h ********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in os.h *************************/
+
+/* If the SET_FULLSYNC macro is not defined above, then make it
+** a no-op
+*/
+#ifndef SET_FULLSYNC
+# define SET_FULLSYNC(x,y)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The default size of a disk sector
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE 4096
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Temporary files are named starting with this prefix followed by 16 random
+** alphanumeric characters, and no file extension. They are stored in the
+** OS's standard temporary file directory, and are deleted prior to exit.
+** If sqlite is being embedded in another program, you may wish to change the
+** prefix to reflect your program's name, so that if your program exits
+** prematurely, old temporary files can be easily identified. This can be done
+** using -DSQLITE_TEMP_FILE_PREFIX=myprefix_ on the compiler command line.
+**
+** 2006-10-31: The default prefix used to be "sqlite_". But then
+** Mcafee started using SQLite in their anti-virus product and it
+** started putting files with the "sqlite" name in the c:/temp folder.
+** This annoyed many windows users. Those users would then do a
+** Google search for "sqlite", find the telephone numbers of the
+** developers and call to wake them up at night and complain.
+** For this reason, the default name prefix is changed to be "sqlite"
+** spelled backwards. So the temp files are still identified, but
+** anybody smart enough to figure out the code is also likely smart
+** enough to know that calling the developer will not help get rid
+** of the file.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_TEMP_FILE_PREFIX
+# define SQLITE_TEMP_FILE_PREFIX "etilqs_"
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The following values may be passed as the second argument to
+** sqlite3OsLock(). The various locks exhibit the following semantics:
+**
+** SHARED: Any number of processes may hold a SHARED lock simultaneously.
+** RESERVED: A single process may hold a RESERVED lock on a file at
+** any time. Other processes may hold and obtain new SHARED locks.
+** PENDING: A single process may hold a PENDING lock on a file at
+** any one time. Existing SHARED locks may persist, but no new
+** SHARED locks may be obtained by other processes.
+** EXCLUSIVE: An EXCLUSIVE lock precludes all other locks.
+**
+** PENDING_LOCK may not be passed directly to sqlite3OsLock(). Instead, a
+** process that requests an EXCLUSIVE lock may actually obtain a PENDING
+** lock. This can be upgraded to an EXCLUSIVE lock by a subsequent call to
+** sqlite3OsLock().
+*/
+#define NO_LOCK 0
+#define SHARED_LOCK 1
+#define RESERVED_LOCK 2
+#define PENDING_LOCK 3
+#define EXCLUSIVE_LOCK 4
+
+/*
+** File Locking Notes: (Mostly about windows but also some info for Unix)
+**
+** We cannot use LockFileEx() or UnlockFileEx() on Win95/98/ME because
+** those functions are not available. So we use only LockFile() and
+** UnlockFile().
+**
+** LockFile() prevents not just writing but also reading by other processes.
+** A SHARED_LOCK is obtained by locking a single randomly-chosen
+** byte out of a specific range of bytes. The lock byte is obtained at
+** random so two separate readers can probably access the file at the
+** same time, unless they are unlucky and choose the same lock byte.
+** An EXCLUSIVE_LOCK is obtained by locking all bytes in the range.
+** There can only be one writer. A RESERVED_LOCK is obtained by locking
+** a single byte of the file that is designated as the reserved lock byte.
+** A PENDING_LOCK is obtained by locking a designated byte different from
+** the RESERVED_LOCK byte.
+**
+** On WinNT/2K/XP systems, LockFileEx() and UnlockFileEx() are available,
+** which means we can use reader/writer locks. When reader/writer locks
+** are used, the lock is placed on the same range of bytes that is used
+** for probabilistic locking in Win95/98/ME. Hence, the locking scheme
+** will support two or more Win95 readers or two or more WinNT readers.
+** But a single Win95 reader will lock out all WinNT readers and a single
+** WinNT reader will lock out all other Win95 readers.
+**
+** The following #defines specify the range of bytes used for locking.
+** SHARED_SIZE is the number of bytes available in the pool from which
+** a random byte is selected for a shared lock. The pool of bytes for
+** shared locks begins at SHARED_FIRST.
+**
+** The same locking strategy and
+** byte ranges are used for Unix. This leaves open the possibility of having
+** clients on win95, winNT, and unix all talking to the same shared file
+** and all locking correctly. To do so would require that samba (or whatever
+** tool is being used for file sharing) implements locks correctly between
+** windows and unix. I'm guessing that isn't likely to happen, but by
+** using the same locking range we are at least open to the possibility.
+**
+** Locking in windows is manditory. For this reason, we cannot store
+** actual data in the bytes used for locking. The pager never allocates
+** the pages involved in locking therefore. SHARED_SIZE is selected so
+** that all locks will fit on a single page even at the minimum page size.
+** PENDING_BYTE defines the beginning of the locks. By default PENDING_BYTE
+** is set high so that we don't have to allocate an unused page except
+** for very large databases. But one should test the page skipping logic
+** by setting PENDING_BYTE low and running the entire regression suite.
+**
+** Changing the value of PENDING_BYTE results in a subtly incompatible
+** file format. Depending on how it is changed, you might not notice
+** the incompatibility right away, even running a full regression test.
+** The default location of PENDING_BYTE is the first byte past the
+** 1GB boundary.
+**
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_WSD
+# define PENDING_BYTE (0x40000000)
+#else
+# define PENDING_BYTE sqlite3PendingByte
+#endif
+#define RESERVED_BYTE (PENDING_BYTE+1)
+#define SHARED_FIRST (PENDING_BYTE+2)
+#define SHARED_SIZE 510
+
+/*
+** Wrapper around OS specific sqlite3_os_init() function.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsInit(void);
+
+/*
+** Functions for accessing sqlite3_file methods
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsClose(sqlite3_file*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsRead(sqlite3_file*, void*, int amt, i64 offset);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsWrite(sqlite3_file*, const void*, int amt, i64 offset);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsTruncate(sqlite3_file*, i64 size);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsSync(sqlite3_file*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFileSize(sqlite3_file*, i64 *pSize);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsLock(sqlite3_file*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsUnlock(sqlite3_file*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id, int *pResOut);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFileControl(sqlite3_file*,int,void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsFileControlHint(sqlite3_file*,int,void*);
+#define SQLITE_FCNTL_DB_UNCHANGED 0xca093fa0
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsSectorSize(sqlite3_file *id);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsDeviceCharacteristics(sqlite3_file *id);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsShmMap(sqlite3_file *,int,int,int,void volatile **);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsShmLock(sqlite3_file *id, int, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsShmBarrier(sqlite3_file *id);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsShmUnmap(sqlite3_file *id, int);
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_WAL */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFetch(sqlite3_file *id, i64, int, void **);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsUnfetch(sqlite3_file *, i64, void *);
+
+
+/*
+** Functions for accessing sqlite3_vfs methods
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsOpen(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, sqlite3_file*, int, int *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsDelete(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsAccess(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, int, int *pResOut);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFullPathname(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, int, char *);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3OsDlOpen(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsDlError(sqlite3_vfs *, int, char *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void (*sqlite3OsDlSym(sqlite3_vfs *, void *, const char *))(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsDlClose(sqlite3_vfs *, void *);
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsRandomness(sqlite3_vfs *, int, char *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsSleep(sqlite3_vfs *, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsGetLastError(sqlite3_vfs*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsCurrentTimeInt64(sqlite3_vfs *, sqlite3_int64*);
+
+/*
+** Convenience functions for opening and closing files using
+** sqlite3_malloc() to obtain space for the file-handle structure.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsOpenMalloc(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, sqlite3_file **, int,int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsCloseFree(sqlite3_file *);
+
+#endif /* _SQLITE_OS_H_ */
+
+/************** End of os.h **************************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+/************** Include mutex.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h *****************/
+/************** Begin file mutex.h *******************************************/
+/*
+** 2007 August 28
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains the common header for all mutex implementations.
+** The sqliteInt.h header #includes this file so that it is available
+** to all source files. We break it out in an effort to keep the code
+** better organized.
+**
+** NOTE: source files should *not* #include this header file directly.
+** Source files should #include the sqliteInt.h file and let that file
+** include this one indirectly.
+*/
+
+
+/*
+** Figure out what version of the code to use. The choices are
+**
+** SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT No mutex logic. Not even stubs. The
+** mutexes implementation cannot be overridden
+** at start-time.
+**
+** SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP For single-threaded applications. No
+** mutual exclusion is provided. But this
+** implementation can be overridden at
+** start-time.
+**
+** SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS For multi-threaded applications on Unix.
+**
+** SQLITE_MUTEX_W32 For multi-threaded applications on Win32.
+*/
+#if !SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+# define SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_THREADSAFE && !defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP)
+# if SQLITE_OS_UNIX
+# define SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS
+# elif SQLITE_OS_WIN
+# define SQLITE_MUTEX_W32
+# else
+# define SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT
+/*
+** If this is a no-op implementation, implement everything as macros.
+*/
+#define sqlite3_mutex_alloc(X) ((sqlite3_mutex*)8)
+#define sqlite3_mutex_free(X)
+#define sqlite3_mutex_enter(X)
+#define sqlite3_mutex_try(X) SQLITE_OK
+#define sqlite3_mutex_leave(X)
+#define sqlite3_mutex_held(X) ((void)(X),1)
+#define sqlite3_mutex_notheld(X) ((void)(X),1)
+#define sqlite3MutexAlloc(X) ((sqlite3_mutex*)8)
+#define sqlite3MutexInit() SQLITE_OK
+#define sqlite3MutexEnd()
+#define MUTEX_LOGIC(X)
+#else
+#define MUTEX_LOGIC(X) X
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_mutex_held(sqlite3_mutex*);
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT) */
+
+/************** End of mutex.h ***********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/
+
+/* The SQLITE_EXTRA_DURABLE compile-time option used to set the default
+** synchronous setting to EXTRA. It is no longer supported.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_EXTRA_DURABLE
+# warning Use SQLITE_DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS=3 instead of SQLITE_EXTRA_DURABLE
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS 3
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Default synchronous levels.
+**
+** Note that (for historcal reasons) the PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_* macros differ
+** from the SQLITE_DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS value by 1.
+**
+** PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS
+** OFF 1 0
+** NORMAL 2 1
+** FULL 3 2
+** EXTRA 4 3
+**
+** The "PRAGMA synchronous" statement also uses the zero-based numbers.
+** In other words, the zero-based numbers are used for all external interfaces
+** and the one-based values are used internally.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS 2
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_SYNCHRONOUS
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_WAL_SYNCHRONOUS SQLITE_DEFAULT_SYNCHRONOUS
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Each database file to be accessed by the system is an instance
+** of the following structure. There are normally two of these structures
+** in the sqlite.aDb[] array. aDb[0] is the main database file and
+** aDb[1] is the database file used to hold temporary tables. Additional
+** databases may be attached.
+*/
+struct Db {
+ char *zDbSName; /* Name of this database. (schema name, not filename) */
+ Btree *pBt; /* The B*Tree structure for this database file */
+ u8 safety_level; /* How aggressive at syncing data to disk */
+ u8 bSyncSet; /* True if "PRAGMA synchronous=N" has been run */
+ Schema *pSchema; /* Pointer to database schema (possibly shared) */
+};
+
+/*
+** An instance of the following structure stores a database schema.
+**
+** Most Schema objects are associated with a Btree. The exception is
+** the Schema for the TEMP databaes (sqlite3.aDb[1]) which is free-standing.
+** In shared cache mode, a single Schema object can be shared by multiple
+** Btrees that refer to the same underlying BtShared object.
+**
+** Schema objects are automatically deallocated when the last Btree that
+** references them is destroyed. The TEMP Schema is manually freed by
+** sqlite3_close().
+*
+** A thread must be holding a mutex on the corresponding Btree in order
+** to access Schema content. This implies that the thread must also be
+** holding a mutex on the sqlite3 connection pointer that owns the Btree.
+** For a TEMP Schema, only the connection mutex is required.
+*/
+struct Schema {
+ int schema_cookie; /* Database schema version number for this file */
+ int iGeneration; /* Generation counter. Incremented with each change */
+ Hash tblHash; /* All tables indexed by name */
+ Hash idxHash; /* All (named) indices indexed by name */
+ Hash trigHash; /* All triggers indexed by name */
+ Hash fkeyHash; /* All foreign keys by referenced table name */
+ Table *pSeqTab; /* The sqlite_sequence table used by AUTOINCREMENT */
+ u8 file_format; /* Schema format version for this file */
+ u8 enc; /* Text encoding used by this database */
+ u16 schemaFlags; /* Flags associated with this schema */
+ int cache_size; /* Number of pages to use in the cache */
+};
+
+/*
+** These macros can be used to test, set, or clear bits in the
+** Db.pSchema->flags field.
+*/
+#define DbHasProperty(D,I,P) (((D)->aDb[I].pSchema->schemaFlags&(P))==(P))
+#define DbHasAnyProperty(D,I,P) (((D)->aDb[I].pSchema->schemaFlags&(P))!=0)
+#define DbSetProperty(D,I,P) (D)->aDb[I].pSchema->schemaFlags|=(P)
+#define DbClearProperty(D,I,P) (D)->aDb[I].pSchema->schemaFlags&=~(P)
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for the DB.pSchema->flags field.
+**
+** The DB_SchemaLoaded flag is set after the database schema has been
+** read into internal hash tables.
+**
+** DB_UnresetViews means that one or more views have column names that
+** have been filled out. If the schema changes, these column names might
+** changes and so the view will need to be reset.
+*/
+#define DB_SchemaLoaded 0x0001 /* The schema has been loaded */
+#define DB_UnresetViews 0x0002 /* Some views have defined column names */
+#define DB_ResetWanted 0x0008 /* Reset the schema when nSchemaLock==0 */
+
+/*
+** The number of different kinds of things that can be limited
+** using the sqlite3_limit() interface.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_N_LIMIT (SQLITE_LIMIT_WORKER_THREADS+1)
+
+/*
+** Lookaside malloc is a set of fixed-size buffers that can be used
+** to satisfy small transient memory allocation requests for objects
+** associated with a particular database connection. The use of
+** lookaside malloc provides a significant performance enhancement
+** (approx 10%) by avoiding numerous malloc/free requests while parsing
+** SQL statements.
+**
+** The Lookaside structure holds configuration information about the
+** lookaside malloc subsystem. Each available memory allocation in
+** the lookaside subsystem is stored on a linked list of LookasideSlot
+** objects.
+**
+** Lookaside allocations are only allowed for objects that are associated
+** with a particular database connection. Hence, schema information cannot
+** be stored in lookaside because in shared cache mode the schema information
+** is shared by multiple database connections. Therefore, while parsing
+** schema information, the Lookaside.bEnabled flag is cleared so that
+** lookaside allocations are not used to construct the schema objects.
+**
+** New lookaside allocations are only allowed if bDisable==0. When
+** bDisable is greater than zero, sz is set to zero which effectively
+** disables lookaside without adding a new test for the bDisable flag
+** in a performance-critical path. sz should be set by to szTrue whenever
+** bDisable changes back to zero.
+**
+** Lookaside buffers are initially held on the pInit list. As they are
+** used and freed, they are added back to the pFree list. New allocations
+** come off of pFree first, then pInit as a fallback. This dual-list
+** allows use to compute a high-water mark - the maximum number of allocations
+** outstanding at any point in the past - by subtracting the number of
+** allocations on the pInit list from the total number of allocations.
+**
+** Enhancement on 2019-12-12: Two-size-lookaside
+** The default lookaside configuration is 100 slots of 1200 bytes each.
+** The larger slot sizes are important for performance, but they waste
+** a lot of space, as most lookaside allocations are less than 128 bytes.
+** The two-size-lookaside enhancement breaks up the lookaside allocation
+** into two pools: One of 128-byte slots and the other of the default size
+** (1200-byte) slots. Allocations are filled from the small-pool first,
+** failing over to the full-size pool if that does not work. Thus more
+** lookaside slots are available while also using less memory.
+** This enhancement can be omitted by compiling with
+** SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE.
+*/
+struct Lookaside {
+ u32 bDisable; /* Only operate the lookaside when zero */
+ u16 sz; /* Size of each buffer in bytes */
+ u16 szTrue; /* True value of sz, even if disabled */
+ u8 bMalloced; /* True if pStart obtained from sqlite3_malloc() */
+ u32 nSlot; /* Number of lookaside slots allocated */
+ u32 anStat[3]; /* 0: hits. 1: size misses. 2: full misses */
+ LookasideSlot *pInit; /* List of buffers not previously used */
+ LookasideSlot *pFree; /* List of available buffers */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE
+ LookasideSlot *pSmallInit; /* List of small buffers not prediously used */
+ LookasideSlot *pSmallFree; /* List of available small buffers */
+ void *pMiddle; /* First byte past end of full-size buffers and
+ ** the first byte of LOOKASIDE_SMALL buffers */
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE */
+ void *pStart; /* First byte of available memory space */
+ void *pEnd; /* First byte past end of available space */
+};
+struct LookasideSlot {
+ LookasideSlot *pNext; /* Next buffer in the list of free buffers */
+};
+
+#define DisableLookaside db->lookaside.bDisable++;db->lookaside.sz=0
+#define EnableLookaside db->lookaside.bDisable--;\
+ db->lookaside.sz=db->lookaside.bDisable?0:db->lookaside.szTrue
+
+/* Size of the smaller allocations in two-size lookside */
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE
+# define LOOKASIDE_SMALL 0
+#else
+# define LOOKASIDE_SMALL 128
+#endif
+
+/*
+** A hash table for built-in function definitions. (Application-defined
+** functions use a regular table table from hash.h.)
+**
+** Hash each FuncDef structure into one of the FuncDefHash.a[] slots.
+** Collisions are on the FuncDef.u.pHash chain. Use the SQLITE_FUNC_HASH()
+** macro to compute a hash on the function name.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_HASH_SZ 23
+struct FuncDefHash {
+ FuncDef *a[SQLITE_FUNC_HASH_SZ]; /* Hash table for functions */
+};
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_HASH(C,L) (((C)+(L))%SQLITE_FUNC_HASH_SZ)
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_USER_AUTHENTICATION
+/*
+** Information held in the "sqlite3" database connection object and used
+** to manage user authentication.
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_userauth sqlite3_userauth;
+struct sqlite3_userauth {
+ u8 authLevel; /* Current authentication level */
+ int nAuthPW; /* Size of the zAuthPW in bytes */
+ char *zAuthPW; /* Password used to authenticate */
+ char *zAuthUser; /* User name used to authenticate */
+};
+
+/* Allowed values for sqlite3_userauth.authLevel */
+#define UAUTH_Unknown 0 /* Authentication not yet checked */
+#define UAUTH_Fail 1 /* User authentication failed */
+#define UAUTH_User 2 /* Authenticated as a normal user */
+#define UAUTH_Admin 3 /* Authenticated as an administrator */
+
+/* Functions used only by user authorization logic */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3UserAuthTable(const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3UserAuthCheckLogin(sqlite3*,const char*,u8*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3UserAuthInit(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CryptFunc(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**);
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_USER_AUTHENTICATION */
+
+/*
+** typedef for the authorization callback function.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_USER_AUTHENTICATION
+ typedef int (*sqlite3_xauth)(void*,int,const char*,const char*,const char*,
+ const char*, const char*);
+#else
+ typedef int (*sqlite3_xauth)(void*,int,const char*,const char*,const char*,
+ const char*);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_DEPRECATED
+/* This is an extra SQLITE_TRACE macro that indicates "legacy" tracing
+** in the style of sqlite3_trace()
+*/
+#define SQLITE_TRACE_LEGACY 0x40 /* Use the legacy xTrace */
+#define SQLITE_TRACE_XPROFILE 0x80 /* Use the legacy xProfile */
+#else
+#define SQLITE_TRACE_LEGACY 0
+#define SQLITE_TRACE_XPROFILE 0
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_DEPRECATED */
+#define SQLITE_TRACE_NONLEGACY_MASK 0x0f /* Normal flags */
+
+
+/*
+** Each database connection is an instance of the following structure.
+*/
+struct sqlite3 {
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs; /* OS Interface */
+ struct Vdbe *pVdbe; /* List of active virtual machines */
+ CollSeq *pDfltColl; /* BINARY collseq for the database encoding */
+ sqlite3_mutex *mutex; /* Connection mutex */
+ Db *aDb; /* All backends */
+ int nDb; /* Number of backends currently in use */
+ u32 mDbFlags; /* flags recording internal state */
+ u64 flags; /* flags settable by pragmas. See below */
+ i64 lastRowid; /* ROWID of most recent insert (see above) */
+ i64 szMmap; /* Default mmap_size setting */
+ u32 nSchemaLock; /* Do not reset the schema when non-zero */
+ unsigned int openFlags; /* Flags passed to sqlite3_vfs.xOpen() */
+ int errCode; /* Most recent error code (SQLITE_*) */
+ int errMask; /* & result codes with this before returning */
+ int iSysErrno; /* Errno value from last system error */
+ u16 dbOptFlags; /* Flags to enable/disable optimizations */
+ u8 enc; /* Text encoding */
+ u8 autoCommit; /* The auto-commit flag. */
+ u8 temp_store; /* 1: file 2: memory 0: default */
+ u8 mallocFailed; /* True if we have seen a malloc failure */
+ u8 bBenignMalloc; /* Do not require OOMs if true */
+ u8 dfltLockMode; /* Default locking-mode for attached dbs */
+ signed char nextAutovac; /* Autovac setting after VACUUM if >=0 */
+ u8 suppressErr; /* Do not issue error messages if true */
+ u8 vtabOnConflict; /* Value to return for s3_vtab_on_conflict() */
+ u8 isTransactionSavepoint; /* True if the outermost savepoint is a TS */
+ u8 mTrace; /* zero or more SQLITE_TRACE flags */
+ u8 noSharedCache; /* True if no shared-cache backends */
+ u8 nSqlExec; /* Number of pending OP_SqlExec opcodes */
+ int nextPagesize; /* Pagesize after VACUUM if >0 */
+ u32 magic; /* Magic number for detect library misuse */
+ int nChange; /* Value returned by sqlite3_changes() */
+ int nTotalChange; /* Value returned by sqlite3_total_changes() */
+ int aLimit[SQLITE_N_LIMIT]; /* Limits */
+ int nMaxSorterMmap; /* Maximum size of regions mapped by sorter */
+ struct sqlite3InitInfo { /* Information used during initialization */
+ Pgno newTnum; /* Rootpage of table being initialized */
+ u8 iDb; /* Which db file is being initialized */
+ u8 busy; /* TRUE if currently initializing */
+ unsigned orphanTrigger : 1; /* Last statement is orphaned TEMP trigger */
+ unsigned imposterTable : 1; /* Building an imposter table */
+ unsigned reopenMemdb : 1; /* ATTACH is really a reopen using MemDB */
+ char **azInit; /* "type", "name", and "tbl_name" columns */
+ } init;
+ int nVdbeActive; /* Number of VDBEs currently running */
+ int nVdbeRead; /* Number of active VDBEs that read or write */
+ int nVdbeWrite; /* Number of active VDBEs that read and write */
+ int nVdbeExec; /* Number of nested calls to VdbeExec() */
+ int nVDestroy; /* Number of active OP_VDestroy operations */
+ int nExtension; /* Number of loaded extensions */
+ void **aExtension; /* Array of shared library handles */
+ union {
+ void (*xLegacy)(void*,const char*); /* Legacy trace function */
+ int (*xV2)(u32,void*,void*,void*); /* V2 Trace function */
+ } trace;
+ void *pTraceArg; /* Argument to the trace function */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_DEPRECATED
+ void (*xProfile)(void*,const char*,u64); /* Profiling function */
+ void *pProfileArg; /* Argument to profile function */
+#endif
+ void *pCommitArg; /* Argument to xCommitCallback() */
+ int (*xCommitCallback)(void*); /* Invoked at every commit. */
+ void *pRollbackArg; /* Argument to xRollbackCallback() */
+ void (*xRollbackCallback)(void*); /* Invoked at every commit. */
+ void *pUpdateArg;
+ void (*xUpdateCallback)(void*,int, const char*,const char*,sqlite_int64);
+ Parse *pParse; /* Current parse */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_PREUPDATE_HOOK
+ void *pPreUpdateArg; /* First argument to xPreUpdateCallback */
+ void (*xPreUpdateCallback)( /* Registered using sqlite3_preupdate_hook() */
+ void*,sqlite3*,int,char const*,char const*,sqlite3_int64,sqlite3_int64
+ );
+ PreUpdate *pPreUpdate; /* Context for active pre-update callback */
+#endif /* SQLITE_ENABLE_PREUPDATE_HOOK */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ int (*xWalCallback)(void *, sqlite3 *, const char *, int);
+ void *pWalArg;
+#endif
+ void(*xCollNeeded)(void*,sqlite3*,int eTextRep,const char*);
+ void(*xCollNeeded16)(void*,sqlite3*,int eTextRep,const void*);
+ void *pCollNeededArg;
+ sqlite3_value *pErr; /* Most recent error message */
+ union {
+ volatile int isInterrupted; /* True if sqlite3_interrupt has been called */
+ double notUsed1; /* Spacer */
+ } u1;
+ Lookaside lookaside; /* Lookaside malloc configuration */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
+ sqlite3_xauth xAuth; /* Access authorization function */
+ void *pAuthArg; /* 1st argument to the access auth function */
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_PROGRESS_CALLBACK
+ int (*xProgress)(void *); /* The progress callback */
+ void *pProgressArg; /* Argument to the progress callback */
+ unsigned nProgressOps; /* Number of opcodes for progress callback */
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+ int nVTrans; /* Allocated size of aVTrans */
+ Hash aModule; /* populated by sqlite3_create_module() */
+ VtabCtx *pVtabCtx; /* Context for active vtab connect/create */
+ VTable **aVTrans; /* Virtual tables with open transactions */
+ VTable *pDisconnect; /* Disconnect these in next sqlite3_prepare() */
+#endif
+ Hash aFunc; /* Hash table of connection functions */
+ Hash aCollSeq; /* All collating sequences */
+ BusyHandler busyHandler; /* Busy callback */
+ Db aDbStatic[2]; /* Static space for the 2 default backends */
+ Savepoint *pSavepoint; /* List of active savepoints */
+ int nAnalysisLimit; /* Number of index rows to ANALYZE */
+ int busyTimeout; /* Busy handler timeout, in msec */
+ int nSavepoint; /* Number of non-transaction savepoints */
+ int nStatement; /* Number of nested statement-transactions */
+ i64 nDeferredCons; /* Net deferred constraints this transaction. */
+ i64 nDeferredImmCons; /* Net deferred immediate constraints */
+ int *pnBytesFreed; /* If not NULL, increment this in DbFree() */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_UNLOCK_NOTIFY
+ /* The following variables are all protected by the STATIC_MAIN
+ ** mutex, not by sqlite3.mutex. They are used by code in notify.c.
+ **
+ ** When X.pUnlockConnection==Y, that means that X is waiting for Y to
+ ** unlock so that it can proceed.
+ **
+ ** When X.pBlockingConnection==Y, that means that something that X tried
+ ** tried to do recently failed with an SQLITE_LOCKED error due to locks
+ ** held by Y.
+ */
+ sqlite3 *pBlockingConnection; /* Connection that caused SQLITE_LOCKED */
+ sqlite3 *pUnlockConnection; /* Connection to watch for unlock */
+ void *pUnlockArg; /* Argument to xUnlockNotify */
+ void (*xUnlockNotify)(void **, int); /* Unlock notify callback */
+ sqlite3 *pNextBlocked; /* Next in list of all blocked connections */
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_USER_AUTHENTICATION
+ sqlite3_userauth auth; /* User authentication information */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** A macro to discover the encoding of a database.
+*/
+#define SCHEMA_ENC(db) ((db)->aDb[0].pSchema->enc)
+#define ENC(db) ((db)->enc)
+
+/*
+** A u64 constant where the lower 32 bits are all zeros. Only the
+** upper 32 bits are included in the argument. Necessary because some
+** C-compilers still do not accept LL integer literals.
+*/
+#define HI(X) ((u64)(X)<<32)
+
+/*
+** Possible values for the sqlite3.flags.
+**
+** Value constraints (enforced via assert()):
+** SQLITE_FullFSync == PAGER_FULLFSYNC
+** SQLITE_CkptFullFSync == PAGER_CKPT_FULLFSYNC
+** SQLITE_CacheSpill == PAGER_CACHE_SPILL
+*/
+#define SQLITE_WriteSchema 0x00000001 /* OK to update SQLITE_SCHEMA */
+#define SQLITE_LegacyFileFmt 0x00000002 /* Create new databases in format 1 */
+#define SQLITE_FullColNames 0x00000004 /* Show full column names on SELECT */
+#define SQLITE_FullFSync 0x00000008 /* Use full fsync on the backend */
+#define SQLITE_CkptFullFSync 0x00000010 /* Use full fsync for checkpoint */
+#define SQLITE_CacheSpill 0x00000020 /* OK to spill pager cache */
+#define SQLITE_ShortColNames 0x00000040 /* Show short columns names */
+#define SQLITE_TrustedSchema 0x00000080 /* Allow unsafe functions and
+ ** vtabs in the schema definition */
+#define SQLITE_NullCallback 0x00000100 /* Invoke the callback once if the */
+ /* result set is empty */
+#define SQLITE_IgnoreChecks 0x00000200 /* Do not enforce check constraints */
+#define SQLITE_ReadUncommit 0x00000400 /* READ UNCOMMITTED in shared-cache */
+#define SQLITE_NoCkptOnClose 0x00000800 /* No checkpoint on close()/DETACH */
+#define SQLITE_ReverseOrder 0x00001000 /* Reverse unordered SELECTs */
+#define SQLITE_RecTriggers 0x00002000 /* Enable recursive triggers */
+#define SQLITE_ForeignKeys 0x00004000 /* Enforce foreign key constraints */
+#define SQLITE_AutoIndex 0x00008000 /* Enable automatic indexes */
+#define SQLITE_LoadExtension 0x00010000 /* Enable load_extension */
+#define SQLITE_LoadExtFunc 0x00020000 /* Enable load_extension() SQL func */
+#define SQLITE_EnableTrigger 0x00040000 /* True to enable triggers */
+#define SQLITE_DeferFKs 0x00080000 /* Defer all FK constraints */
+#define SQLITE_QueryOnly 0x00100000 /* Disable database changes */
+#define SQLITE_CellSizeCk 0x00200000 /* Check btree cell sizes on load */
+#define SQLITE_Fts3Tokenizer 0x00400000 /* Enable fts3_tokenizer(2) */
+#define SQLITE_EnableQPSG 0x00800000 /* Query Planner Stability Guarantee*/
+#define SQLITE_TriggerEQP 0x01000000 /* Show trigger EXPLAIN QUERY PLAN */
+#define SQLITE_ResetDatabase 0x02000000 /* Reset the database */
+#define SQLITE_LegacyAlter 0x04000000 /* Legacy ALTER TABLE behaviour */
+#define SQLITE_NoSchemaError 0x08000000 /* Do not report schema parse errors*/
+#define SQLITE_Defensive 0x10000000 /* Input SQL is likely hostile */
+#define SQLITE_DqsDDL 0x20000000 /* dbl-quoted strings allowed in DDL*/
+#define SQLITE_DqsDML 0x40000000 /* dbl-quoted strings allowed in DML*/
+#define SQLITE_EnableView 0x80000000 /* Enable the use of views */
+#define SQLITE_CountRows HI(0x00001) /* Count rows changed by INSERT, */
+ /* DELETE, or UPDATE and return */
+ /* the count using a callback. */
+
+/* Flags used only if debugging */
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+#define SQLITE_SqlTrace HI(0x0100000) /* Debug print SQL as it executes */
+#define SQLITE_VdbeListing HI(0x0200000) /* Debug listings of VDBE progs */
+#define SQLITE_VdbeTrace HI(0x0400000) /* True to trace VDBE execution */
+#define SQLITE_VdbeAddopTrace HI(0x0800000) /* Trace sqlite3VdbeAddOp() calls */
+#define SQLITE_VdbeEQP HI(0x1000000) /* Debug EXPLAIN QUERY PLAN */
+#define SQLITE_ParserTrace HI(0x2000000) /* PRAGMA parser_trace=ON */
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for sqlite3.mDbFlags
+*/
+#define DBFLAG_SchemaChange 0x0001 /* Uncommitted Hash table changes */
+#define DBFLAG_PreferBuiltin 0x0002 /* Preference to built-in funcs */
+#define DBFLAG_Vacuum 0x0004 /* Currently in a VACUUM */
+#define DBFLAG_VacuumInto 0x0008 /* Currently running VACUUM INTO */
+#define DBFLAG_SchemaKnownOk 0x0010 /* Schema is known to be valid */
+#define DBFLAG_InternalFunc 0x0020 /* Allow use of internal functions */
+#define DBFLAG_EncodingFixed 0x0040 /* No longer possible to change enc. */
+
+/*
+** Bits of the sqlite3.dbOptFlags field that are used by the
+** sqlite3_test_control(SQLITE_TESTCTRL_OPTIMIZATIONS,...) interface to
+** selectively disable various optimizations.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_QueryFlattener 0x0001 /* Query flattening */
+#define SQLITE_WindowFunc 0x0002 /* Use xInverse for window functions */
+#define SQLITE_GroupByOrder 0x0004 /* GROUPBY cover of ORDERBY */
+#define SQLITE_FactorOutConst 0x0008 /* Constant factoring */
+#define SQLITE_DistinctOpt 0x0010 /* DISTINCT using indexes */
+#define SQLITE_CoverIdxScan 0x0020 /* Covering index scans */
+#define SQLITE_OrderByIdxJoin 0x0040 /* ORDER BY of joins via index */
+#define SQLITE_Transitive 0x0080 /* Transitive constraints */
+#define SQLITE_OmitNoopJoin 0x0100 /* Omit unused tables in joins */
+#define SQLITE_CountOfView 0x0200 /* The count-of-view optimization */
+#define SQLITE_CursorHints 0x0400 /* Add OP_CursorHint opcodes */
+#define SQLITE_Stat4 0x0800 /* Use STAT4 data */
+ /* TH3 expects the Stat4 ^^^^^^ value to be 0x0800. Don't change it */
+#define SQLITE_PushDown 0x1000 /* The push-down optimization */
+#define SQLITE_SimplifyJoin 0x2000 /* Convert LEFT JOIN to JOIN */
+#define SQLITE_SkipScan 0x4000 /* Skip-scans */
+#define SQLITE_PropagateConst 0x8000 /* The constant propagation opt */
+#define SQLITE_AllOpts 0xffff /* All optimizations */
+
+/*
+** Macros for testing whether or not optimizations are enabled or disabled.
+*/
+#define OptimizationDisabled(db, mask) (((db)->dbOptFlags&(mask))!=0)
+#define OptimizationEnabled(db, mask) (((db)->dbOptFlags&(mask))==0)
+
+/*
+** Return true if it OK to factor constant expressions into the initialization
+** code. The argument is a Parse object for the code generator.
+*/
+#define ConstFactorOk(P) ((P)->okConstFactor)
+
+/*
+** Possible values for the sqlite.magic field.
+** The numbers are obtained at random and have no special meaning, other
+** than being distinct from one another.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN 0xa029a697 /* Database is open */
+#define SQLITE_MAGIC_CLOSED 0x9f3c2d33 /* Database is closed */
+#define SQLITE_MAGIC_SICK 0x4b771290 /* Error and awaiting close */
+#define SQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY 0xf03b7906 /* Database currently in use */
+#define SQLITE_MAGIC_ERROR 0xb5357930 /* An SQLITE_MISUSE error occurred */
+#define SQLITE_MAGIC_ZOMBIE 0x64cffc7f /* Close with last statement close */
+
+/*
+** Each SQL function is defined by an instance of the following
+** structure. For global built-in functions (ex: substr(), max(), count())
+** a pointer to this structure is held in the sqlite3BuiltinFunctions object.
+** For per-connection application-defined functions, a pointer to this
+** structure is held in the db->aHash hash table.
+**
+** The u.pHash field is used by the global built-ins. The u.pDestructor
+** field is used by per-connection app-def functions.
+*/
+struct FuncDef {
+ i8 nArg; /* Number of arguments. -1 means unlimited */
+ u32 funcFlags; /* Some combination of SQLITE_FUNC_* */
+ void *pUserData; /* User data parameter */
+ FuncDef *pNext; /* Next function with same name */
+ void (*xSFunc)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**); /* func or agg-step */
+ void (*xFinalize)(sqlite3_context*); /* Agg finalizer */
+ void (*xValue)(sqlite3_context*); /* Current agg value */
+ void (*xInverse)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**); /* inverse agg-step */
+ const char *zName; /* SQL name of the function. */
+ union {
+ FuncDef *pHash; /* Next with a different name but the same hash */
+ FuncDestructor *pDestructor; /* Reference counted destructor function */
+ } u;
+};
+
+/*
+** This structure encapsulates a user-function destructor callback (as
+** configured using create_function_v2()) and a reference counter. When
+** create_function_v2() is called to create a function with a destructor,
+** a single object of this type is allocated. FuncDestructor.nRef is set to
+** the number of FuncDef objects created (either 1 or 3, depending on whether
+** or not the specified encoding is SQLITE_ANY). The FuncDef.pDestructor
+** member of each of the new FuncDef objects is set to point to the allocated
+** FuncDestructor.
+**
+** Thereafter, when one of the FuncDef objects is deleted, the reference
+** count on this object is decremented. When it reaches 0, the destructor
+** is invoked and the FuncDestructor structure freed.
+*/
+struct FuncDestructor {
+ int nRef;
+ void (*xDestroy)(void *);
+ void *pUserData;
+};
+
+/*
+** Possible values for FuncDef.flags. Note that the _LENGTH and _TYPEOF
+** values must correspond to OPFLAG_LENGTHARG and OPFLAG_TYPEOFARG. And
+** SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT must be the same as SQLITE_DETERMINISTIC. There
+** are assert() statements in the code to verify this.
+**
+** Value constraints (enforced via assert()):
+** SQLITE_FUNC_MINMAX == NC_MinMaxAgg == SF_MinMaxAgg
+** SQLITE_FUNC_LENGTH == OPFLAG_LENGTHARG
+** SQLITE_FUNC_TYPEOF == OPFLAG_TYPEOFARG
+** SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT == SQLITE_DETERMINISTIC from the API
+** SQLITE_FUNC_DIRECT == SQLITE_DIRECTONLY from the API
+** SQLITE_FUNC_UNSAFE == SQLITE_INNOCUOUS
+** SQLITE_FUNC_ENCMASK depends on SQLITE_UTF* macros in the API
+*/
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_ENCMASK 0x0003 /* SQLITE_UTF8, SQLITE_UTF16BE or UTF16LE */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_LIKE 0x0004 /* Candidate for the LIKE optimization */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_CASE 0x0008 /* Case-sensitive LIKE-type function */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_EPHEM 0x0010 /* Ephemeral. Delete with VDBE */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_NEEDCOLL 0x0020 /* sqlite3GetFuncCollSeq() might be called*/
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_LENGTH 0x0040 /* Built-in length() function */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_TYPEOF 0x0080 /* Built-in typeof() function */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_COUNT 0x0100 /* Built-in count(*) aggregate */
+/* 0x0200 -- available for reuse */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_UNLIKELY 0x0400 /* Built-in unlikely() function */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT 0x0800 /* Constant inputs give a constant output */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_MINMAX 0x1000 /* True for min() and max() aggregates */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_SLOCHNG 0x2000 /* "Slow Change". Value constant during a
+ ** single query - might change over time */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_TEST 0x4000 /* Built-in testing functions */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_OFFSET 0x8000 /* Built-in sqlite_offset() function */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_WINDOW 0x00010000 /* Built-in window-only function */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_INTERNAL 0x00040000 /* For use by NestedParse() only */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_DIRECT 0x00080000 /* Not for use in TRIGGERs or VIEWs */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_SUBTYPE 0x00100000 /* Result likely to have sub-type */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_UNSAFE 0x00200000 /* Function has side effects */
+#define SQLITE_FUNC_INLINE 0x00400000 /* Functions implemented in-line */
+
+/* Identifier numbers for each in-line function */
+#define INLINEFUNC_coalesce 0
+#define INLINEFUNC_implies_nonnull_row 1
+#define INLINEFUNC_expr_implies_expr 2
+#define INLINEFUNC_expr_compare 3
+#define INLINEFUNC_affinity 4
+#define INLINEFUNC_iif 5
+#define INLINEFUNC_unlikely 99 /* Default case */
+
+/*
+** The following three macros, FUNCTION(), LIKEFUNC() and AGGREGATE() are
+** used to create the initializers for the FuncDef structures.
+**
+** FUNCTION(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc)
+** Used to create a scalar function definition of a function zName
+** implemented by C function xFunc that accepts nArg arguments. The
+** value passed as iArg is cast to a (void*) and made available
+** as the user-data (sqlite3_user_data()) for the function. If
+** argument bNC is true, then the SQLITE_FUNC_NEEDCOLL flag is set.
+**
+** VFUNCTION(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc)
+** Like FUNCTION except it omits the SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT flag.
+**
+** SFUNCTION(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc)
+** Like FUNCTION except it omits the SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT flag and
+** adds the SQLITE_DIRECTONLY flag.
+**
+** INLINE_FUNC(zName, nArg, iFuncId, mFlags)
+** zName is the name of a function that is implemented by in-line
+** byte code rather than by the usual callbacks. The iFuncId
+** parameter determines the function id. The mFlags parameter is
+** optional SQLITE_FUNC_ flags for this function.
+**
+** TEST_FUNC(zName, nArg, iFuncId, mFlags)
+** zName is the name of a test-only function implemented by in-line
+** byte code rather than by the usual callbacks. The iFuncId
+** parameter determines the function id. The mFlags parameter is
+** optional SQLITE_FUNC_ flags for this function.
+**
+** DFUNCTION(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc)
+** Like FUNCTION except it omits the SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT flag and
+** adds the SQLITE_FUNC_SLOCHNG flag. Used for date & time functions
+** and functions like sqlite_version() that can change, but not during
+** a single query. The iArg is ignored. The user-data is always set
+** to a NULL pointer. The bNC parameter is not used.
+**
+** PURE_DATE(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc)
+** Used for "pure" date/time functions, this macro is like DFUNCTION
+** except that it does set the SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT flags. iArg is
+** ignored and the user-data for these functions is set to an
+** arbitrary non-NULL pointer. The bNC parameter is not used.
+**
+** AGGREGATE(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xStep, xFinal)
+** Used to create an aggregate function definition implemented by
+** the C functions xStep and xFinal. The first four parameters
+** are interpreted in the same way as the first 4 parameters to
+** FUNCTION().
+**
+** WFUNCTION(zName, nArg, iArg, xStep, xFinal, xValue, xInverse)
+** Used to create an aggregate function definition implemented by
+** the C functions xStep and xFinal. The first four parameters
+** are interpreted in the same way as the first 4 parameters to
+** FUNCTION().
+**
+** LIKEFUNC(zName, nArg, pArg, flags)
+** Used to create a scalar function definition of a function zName
+** that accepts nArg arguments and is implemented by a call to C
+** function likeFunc. Argument pArg is cast to a (void *) and made
+** available as the function user-data (sqlite3_user_data()). The
+** FuncDef.flags variable is set to the value passed as the flags
+** parameter.
+*/
+#define FUNCTION(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT|SQLITE_UTF8|(bNC*SQLITE_FUNC_NEEDCOLL), \
+ SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(iArg), 0, xFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, {0} }
+#define VFUNCTION(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_UTF8|(bNC*SQLITE_FUNC_NEEDCOLL), \
+ SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(iArg), 0, xFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, {0} }
+#define SFUNCTION(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_UTF8|SQLITE_DIRECTONLY|SQLITE_FUNC_UNSAFE, \
+ SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(iArg), 0, xFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, {0} }
+#define INLINE_FUNC(zName, nArg, iArg, mFlags) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_UTF8|SQLITE_FUNC_INLINE|SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT|(mFlags), \
+ SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(iArg), 0, noopFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, {0} }
+#define TEST_FUNC(zName, nArg, iArg, mFlags) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_UTF8|SQLITE_FUNC_INTERNAL|SQLITE_FUNC_TEST| \
+ SQLITE_FUNC_INLINE|SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT|(mFlags), \
+ SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(iArg), 0, noopFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, {0} }
+#define DFUNCTION(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_FUNC_SLOCHNG|SQLITE_UTF8, \
+ 0, 0, xFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, {0} }
+#define PURE_DATE(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_FUNC_SLOCHNG|SQLITE_UTF8|SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT, \
+ (void*)&sqlite3Config, 0, xFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, {0} }
+#define FUNCTION2(zName, nArg, iArg, bNC, xFunc, extraFlags) \
+ {nArg,SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT|SQLITE_UTF8|(bNC*SQLITE_FUNC_NEEDCOLL)|extraFlags,\
+ SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(iArg), 0, xFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, {0} }
+#define STR_FUNCTION(zName, nArg, pArg, bNC, xFunc) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_FUNC_SLOCHNG|SQLITE_UTF8|(bNC*SQLITE_FUNC_NEEDCOLL), \
+ pArg, 0, xFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, }
+#define LIKEFUNC(zName, nArg, arg, flags) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT|SQLITE_UTF8|flags, \
+ (void *)arg, 0, likeFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, {0} }
+#define WAGGREGATE(zName, nArg, arg, nc, xStep, xFinal, xValue, xInverse, f) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_UTF8|(nc*SQLITE_FUNC_NEEDCOLL)|f, \
+ SQLITE_INT_TO_PTR(arg), 0, xStep,xFinal,xValue,xInverse,#zName, {0}}
+#define INTERNAL_FUNCTION(zName, nArg, xFunc) \
+ {nArg, SQLITE_FUNC_INTERNAL|SQLITE_UTF8|SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT, \
+ 0, 0, xFunc, 0, 0, 0, #zName, {0} }
+
+
+/*
+** All current savepoints are stored in a linked list starting at
+** sqlite3.pSavepoint. The first element in the list is the most recently
+** opened savepoint. Savepoints are added to the list by the vdbe
+** OP_Savepoint instruction.
+*/
+struct Savepoint {
+ char *zName; /* Savepoint name (nul-terminated) */
+ i64 nDeferredCons; /* Number of deferred fk violations */
+ i64 nDeferredImmCons; /* Number of deferred imm fk. */
+ Savepoint *pNext; /* Parent savepoint (if any) */
+};
+
+/*
+** The following are used as the second parameter to sqlite3Savepoint(),
+** and as the P1 argument to the OP_Savepoint instruction.
+*/
+#define SAVEPOINT_BEGIN 0
+#define SAVEPOINT_RELEASE 1
+#define SAVEPOINT_ROLLBACK 2
+
+
+/*
+** Each SQLite module (virtual table definition) is defined by an
+** instance of the following structure, stored in the sqlite3.aModule
+** hash table.
+*/
+struct Module {
+ const sqlite3_module *pModule; /* Callback pointers */
+ const char *zName; /* Name passed to create_module() */
+ int nRefModule; /* Number of pointers to this object */
+ void *pAux; /* pAux passed to create_module() */
+ void (*xDestroy)(void *); /* Module destructor function */
+ Table *pEpoTab; /* Eponymous table for this module */
+};
+
+/*
+** Information about each column of an SQL table is held in an instance
+** of the Column structure, in the Table.aCol[] array.
+**
+** Definitions:
+**
+** "table column index" This is the index of the column in the
+** Table.aCol[] array, and also the index of
+** the column in the original CREATE TABLE stmt.
+**
+** "storage column index" This is the index of the column in the
+** record BLOB generated by the OP_MakeRecord
+** opcode. The storage column index is less than
+** or equal to the table column index. It is
+** equal if and only if there are no VIRTUAL
+** columns to the left.
+*/
+struct Column {
+ char *zName; /* Name of this column, \000, then the type */
+ Expr *pDflt; /* Default value or GENERATED ALWAYS AS value */
+ char *zColl; /* Collating sequence. If NULL, use the default */
+ u8 notNull; /* An OE_ code for handling a NOT NULL constraint */
+ char affinity; /* One of the SQLITE_AFF_... values */
+ u8 szEst; /* Estimated size of value in this column. sizeof(INT)==1 */
+ u8 hName; /* Column name hash for faster lookup */
+ u16 colFlags; /* Boolean properties. See COLFLAG_ defines below */
+};
+
+/* Allowed values for Column.colFlags:
+*/
+#define COLFLAG_PRIMKEY 0x0001 /* Column is part of the primary key */
+#define COLFLAG_HIDDEN 0x0002 /* A hidden column in a virtual table */
+#define COLFLAG_HASTYPE 0x0004 /* Type name follows column name */
+#define COLFLAG_UNIQUE 0x0008 /* Column def contains "UNIQUE" or "PK" */
+#define COLFLAG_SORTERREF 0x0010 /* Use sorter-refs with this column */
+#define COLFLAG_VIRTUAL 0x0020 /* GENERATED ALWAYS AS ... VIRTUAL */
+#define COLFLAG_STORED 0x0040 /* GENERATED ALWAYS AS ... STORED */
+#define COLFLAG_NOTAVAIL 0x0080 /* STORED column not yet calculated */
+#define COLFLAG_BUSY 0x0100 /* Blocks recursion on GENERATED columns */
+#define COLFLAG_GENERATED 0x0060 /* Combo: _STORED, _VIRTUAL */
+#define COLFLAG_NOINSERT 0x0062 /* Combo: _HIDDEN, _STORED, _VIRTUAL */
+
+/*
+** A "Collating Sequence" is defined by an instance of the following
+** structure. Conceptually, a collating sequence consists of a name and
+** a comparison routine that defines the order of that sequence.
+**
+** If CollSeq.xCmp is NULL, it means that the
+** collating sequence is undefined. Indices built on an undefined
+** collating sequence may not be read or written.
+*/
+struct CollSeq {
+ char *zName; /* Name of the collating sequence, UTF-8 encoded */
+ u8 enc; /* Text encoding handled by xCmp() */
+ void *pUser; /* First argument to xCmp() */
+ int (*xCmp)(void*,int, const void*, int, const void*);
+ void (*xDel)(void*); /* Destructor for pUser */
+};
+
+/*
+** A sort order can be either ASC or DESC.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_SO_ASC 0 /* Sort in ascending order */
+#define SQLITE_SO_DESC 1 /* Sort in ascending order */
+#define SQLITE_SO_UNDEFINED -1 /* No sort order specified */
+
+/*
+** Column affinity types.
+**
+** These used to have mnemonic name like 'i' for SQLITE_AFF_INTEGER and
+** 't' for SQLITE_AFF_TEXT. But we can save a little space and improve
+** the speed a little by numbering the values consecutively.
+**
+** But rather than start with 0 or 1, we begin with 'A'. That way,
+** when multiple affinity types are concatenated into a string and
+** used as the P4 operand, they will be more readable.
+**
+** Note also that the numeric types are grouped together so that testing
+** for a numeric type is a single comparison. And the BLOB type is first.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_AFF_NONE 0x40 /* '@' */
+#define SQLITE_AFF_BLOB 0x41 /* 'A' */
+#define SQLITE_AFF_TEXT 0x42 /* 'B' */
+#define SQLITE_AFF_NUMERIC 0x43 /* 'C' */
+#define SQLITE_AFF_INTEGER 0x44 /* 'D' */
+#define SQLITE_AFF_REAL 0x45 /* 'E' */
+
+#define sqlite3IsNumericAffinity(X) ((X)>=SQLITE_AFF_NUMERIC)
+
+/*
+** The SQLITE_AFF_MASK values masks off the significant bits of an
+** affinity value.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_AFF_MASK 0x47
+
+/*
+** Additional bit values that can be ORed with an affinity without
+** changing the affinity.
+**
+** The SQLITE_NOTNULL flag is a combination of NULLEQ and JUMPIFNULL.
+** It causes an assert() to fire if either operand to a comparison
+** operator is NULL. It is added to certain comparison operators to
+** prove that the operands are always NOT NULL.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_KEEPNULL 0x08 /* Used by vector == or <> */
+#define SQLITE_JUMPIFNULL 0x10 /* jumps if either operand is NULL */
+#define SQLITE_STOREP2 0x20 /* Store result in reg[P2] rather than jump */
+#define SQLITE_NULLEQ 0x80 /* NULL=NULL */
+#define SQLITE_NOTNULL 0x90 /* Assert that operands are never NULL */
+
+/*
+** An object of this type is created for each virtual table present in
+** the database schema.
+**
+** If the database schema is shared, then there is one instance of this
+** structure for each database connection (sqlite3*) that uses the shared
+** schema. This is because each database connection requires its own unique
+** instance of the sqlite3_vtab* handle used to access the virtual table
+** implementation. sqlite3_vtab* handles can not be shared between
+** database connections, even when the rest of the in-memory database
+** schema is shared, as the implementation often stores the database
+** connection handle passed to it via the xConnect() or xCreate() method
+** during initialization internally. This database connection handle may
+** then be used by the virtual table implementation to access real tables
+** within the database. So that they appear as part of the callers
+** transaction, these accesses need to be made via the same database
+** connection as that used to execute SQL operations on the virtual table.
+**
+** All VTable objects that correspond to a single table in a shared
+** database schema are initially stored in a linked-list pointed to by
+** the Table.pVTable member variable of the corresponding Table object.
+** When an sqlite3_prepare() operation is required to access the virtual
+** table, it searches the list for the VTable that corresponds to the
+** database connection doing the preparing so as to use the correct
+** sqlite3_vtab* handle in the compiled query.
+**
+** When an in-memory Table object is deleted (for example when the
+** schema is being reloaded for some reason), the VTable objects are not
+** deleted and the sqlite3_vtab* handles are not xDisconnect()ed
+** immediately. Instead, they are moved from the Table.pVTable list to
+** another linked list headed by the sqlite3.pDisconnect member of the
+** corresponding sqlite3 structure. They are then deleted/xDisconnected
+** next time a statement is prepared using said sqlite3*. This is done
+** to avoid deadlock issues involving multiple sqlite3.mutex mutexes.
+** Refer to comments above function sqlite3VtabUnlockList() for an
+** explanation as to why it is safe to add an entry to an sqlite3.pDisconnect
+** list without holding the corresponding sqlite3.mutex mutex.
+**
+** The memory for objects of this type is always allocated by
+** sqlite3DbMalloc(), using the connection handle stored in VTable.db as
+** the first argument.
+*/
+struct VTable {
+ sqlite3 *db; /* Database connection associated with this table */
+ Module *pMod; /* Pointer to module implementation */
+ sqlite3_vtab *pVtab; /* Pointer to vtab instance */
+ int nRef; /* Number of pointers to this structure */
+ u8 bConstraint; /* True if constraints are supported */
+ u8 eVtabRisk; /* Riskiness of allowing hacker access */
+ int iSavepoint; /* Depth of the SAVEPOINT stack */
+ VTable *pNext; /* Next in linked list (see above) */
+};
+
+/* Allowed values for VTable.eVtabRisk
+*/
+#define SQLITE_VTABRISK_Low 0
+#define SQLITE_VTABRISK_Normal 1
+#define SQLITE_VTABRISK_High 2
+
+/*
+** The schema for each SQL table and view is represented in memory
+** by an instance of the following structure.
+*/
+struct Table {
+ char *zName; /* Name of the table or view */
+ Column *aCol; /* Information about each column */
+ Index *pIndex; /* List of SQL indexes on this table. */
+ Select *pSelect; /* NULL for tables. Points to definition if a view. */
+ FKey *pFKey; /* Linked list of all foreign keys in this table */
+ char *zColAff; /* String defining the affinity of each column */
+ ExprList *pCheck; /* All CHECK constraints */
+ /* ... also used as column name list in a VIEW */
+ Pgno tnum; /* Root BTree page for this table */
+ u32 nTabRef; /* Number of pointers to this Table */
+ u32 tabFlags; /* Mask of TF_* values */
+ i16 iPKey; /* If not negative, use aCol[iPKey] as the rowid */
+ i16 nCol; /* Number of columns in this table */
+ i16 nNVCol; /* Number of columns that are not VIRTUAL */
+ LogEst nRowLogEst; /* Estimated rows in table - from sqlite_stat1 table */
+ LogEst szTabRow; /* Estimated size of each table row in bytes */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_COSTMULT
+ LogEst costMult; /* Cost multiplier for using this table */
+#endif
+ u8 keyConf; /* What to do in case of uniqueness conflict on iPKey */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_ALTERTABLE
+ int addColOffset; /* Offset in CREATE TABLE stmt to add a new column */
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+ int nModuleArg; /* Number of arguments to the module */
+ char **azModuleArg; /* 0: module 1: schema 2: vtab name 3...: args */
+ VTable *pVTable; /* List of VTable objects. */
+#endif
+ Trigger *pTrigger; /* List of triggers stored in pSchema */
+ Schema *pSchema; /* Schema that contains this table */
+ Table *pNextZombie; /* Next on the Parse.pZombieTab list */
+};
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for Table.tabFlags.
+**
+** TF_OOOHidden applies to tables or view that have hidden columns that are
+** followed by non-hidden columns. Example: "CREATE VIRTUAL TABLE x USING
+** vtab1(a HIDDEN, b);". Since "b" is a non-hidden column but "a" is hidden,
+** the TF_OOOHidden attribute would apply in this case. Such tables require
+** special handling during INSERT processing. The "OOO" means "Out Of Order".
+**
+** Constraints:
+**
+** TF_HasVirtual == COLFLAG_Virtual
+** TF_HasStored == COLFLAG_Stored
+*/
+#define TF_Readonly 0x0001 /* Read-only system table */
+#define TF_Ephemeral 0x0002 /* An ephemeral table */
+#define TF_HasPrimaryKey 0x0004 /* Table has a primary key */
+#define TF_Autoincrement 0x0008 /* Integer primary key is autoincrement */
+#define TF_HasStat1 0x0010 /* nRowLogEst set from sqlite_stat1 */
+#define TF_HasVirtual 0x0020 /* Has one or more VIRTUAL columns */
+#define TF_HasStored 0x0040 /* Has one or more STORED columns */
+#define TF_HasGenerated 0x0060 /* Combo: HasVirtual + HasStored */
+#define TF_WithoutRowid 0x0080 /* No rowid. PRIMARY KEY is the key */
+#define TF_StatsUsed 0x0100 /* Query planner decisions affected by
+ ** Index.aiRowLogEst[] values */
+#define TF_NoVisibleRowid 0x0200 /* No user-visible "rowid" column */
+#define TF_OOOHidden 0x0400 /* Out-of-Order hidden columns */
+#define TF_HasNotNull 0x0800 /* Contains NOT NULL constraints */
+#define TF_Shadow 0x1000 /* True for a shadow table */
+
+/*
+** Test to see whether or not a table is a virtual table. This is
+** done as a macro so that it will be optimized out when virtual
+** table support is omitted from the build.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+# define IsVirtual(X) ((X)->nModuleArg)
+# define ExprIsVtab(X) \
+ ((X)->op==TK_COLUMN && (X)->y.pTab!=0 && (X)->y.pTab->nModuleArg)
+#else
+# define IsVirtual(X) 0
+# define ExprIsVtab(X) 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Macros to determine if a column is hidden. IsOrdinaryHiddenColumn()
+** only works for non-virtual tables (ordinary tables and views) and is
+** always false unless SQLITE_ENABLE_HIDDEN_COLUMNS is defined. The
+** IsHiddenColumn() macro is general purpose.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_HIDDEN_COLUMNS)
+# define IsHiddenColumn(X) (((X)->colFlags & COLFLAG_HIDDEN)!=0)
+# define IsOrdinaryHiddenColumn(X) (((X)->colFlags & COLFLAG_HIDDEN)!=0)
+#elif !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE)
+# define IsHiddenColumn(X) (((X)->colFlags & COLFLAG_HIDDEN)!=0)
+# define IsOrdinaryHiddenColumn(X) 0
+#else
+# define IsHiddenColumn(X) 0
+# define IsOrdinaryHiddenColumn(X) 0
+#endif
+
+
+/* Does the table have a rowid */
+#define HasRowid(X) (((X)->tabFlags & TF_WithoutRowid)==0)
+#define VisibleRowid(X) (((X)->tabFlags & TF_NoVisibleRowid)==0)
+
+/*
+** Each foreign key constraint is an instance of the following structure.
+**
+** A foreign key is associated with two tables. The "from" table is
+** the table that contains the REFERENCES clause that creates the foreign
+** key. The "to" table is the table that is named in the REFERENCES clause.
+** Consider this example:
+**
+** CREATE TABLE ex1(
+** a INTEGER PRIMARY KEY,
+** b INTEGER CONSTRAINT fk1 REFERENCES ex2(x)
+** );
+**
+** For foreign key "fk1", the from-table is "ex1" and the to-table is "ex2".
+** Equivalent names:
+**
+** from-table == child-table
+** to-table == parent-table
+**
+** Each REFERENCES clause generates an instance of the following structure
+** which is attached to the from-table. The to-table need not exist when
+** the from-table is created. The existence of the to-table is not checked.
+**
+** The list of all parents for child Table X is held at X.pFKey.
+**
+** A list of all children for a table named Z (which might not even exist)
+** is held in Schema.fkeyHash with a hash key of Z.
+*/
+struct FKey {
+ Table *pFrom; /* Table containing the REFERENCES clause (aka: Child) */
+ FKey *pNextFrom; /* Next FKey with the same in pFrom. Next parent of pFrom */
+ char *zTo; /* Name of table that the key points to (aka: Parent) */
+ FKey *pNextTo; /* Next with the same zTo. Next child of zTo. */
+ FKey *pPrevTo; /* Previous with the same zTo */
+ int nCol; /* Number of columns in this key */
+ /* EV: R-30323-21917 */
+ u8 isDeferred; /* True if constraint checking is deferred till COMMIT */
+ u8 aAction[2]; /* ON DELETE and ON UPDATE actions, respectively */
+ Trigger *apTrigger[2];/* Triggers for aAction[] actions */
+ struct sColMap { /* Mapping of columns in pFrom to columns in zTo */
+ int iFrom; /* Index of column in pFrom */
+ char *zCol; /* Name of column in zTo. If NULL use PRIMARY KEY */
+ } aCol[1]; /* One entry for each of nCol columns */
+};
+
+/*
+** SQLite supports many different ways to resolve a constraint
+** error. ROLLBACK processing means that a constraint violation
+** causes the operation in process to fail and for the current transaction
+** to be rolled back. ABORT processing means the operation in process
+** fails and any prior changes from that one operation are backed out,
+** but the transaction is not rolled back. FAIL processing means that
+** the operation in progress stops and returns an error code. But prior
+** changes due to the same operation are not backed out and no rollback
+** occurs. IGNORE means that the particular row that caused the constraint
+** error is not inserted or updated. Processing continues and no error
+** is returned. REPLACE means that preexisting database rows that caused
+** a UNIQUE constraint violation are removed so that the new insert or
+** update can proceed. Processing continues and no error is reported.
+**
+** RESTRICT, SETNULL, and CASCADE actions apply only to foreign keys.
+** RESTRICT is the same as ABORT for IMMEDIATE foreign keys and the
+** same as ROLLBACK for DEFERRED keys. SETNULL means that the foreign
+** key is set to NULL. CASCADE means that a DELETE or UPDATE of the
+** referenced table row is propagated into the row that holds the
+** foreign key.
+**
+** The following symbolic values are used to record which type
+** of action to take.
+*/
+#define OE_None 0 /* There is no constraint to check */
+#define OE_Rollback 1 /* Fail the operation and rollback the transaction */
+#define OE_Abort 2 /* Back out changes but do no rollback transaction */
+#define OE_Fail 3 /* Stop the operation but leave all prior changes */
+#define OE_Ignore 4 /* Ignore the error. Do not do the INSERT or UPDATE */
+#define OE_Replace 5 /* Delete existing record, then do INSERT or UPDATE */
+#define OE_Update 6 /* Process as a DO UPDATE in an upsert */
+#define OE_Restrict 7 /* OE_Abort for IMMEDIATE, OE_Rollback for DEFERRED */
+#define OE_SetNull 8 /* Set the foreign key value to NULL */
+#define OE_SetDflt 9 /* Set the foreign key value to its default */
+#define OE_Cascade 10 /* Cascade the changes */
+#define OE_Default 11 /* Do whatever the default action is */
+
+
+/*
+** An instance of the following structure is passed as the first
+** argument to sqlite3VdbeKeyCompare and is used to control the
+** comparison of the two index keys.
+**
+** Note that aSortOrder[] and aColl[] have nField+1 slots. There
+** are nField slots for the columns of an index then one extra slot
+** for the rowid at the end.
+*/
+struct KeyInfo {
+ u32 nRef; /* Number of references to this KeyInfo object */
+ u8 enc; /* Text encoding - one of the SQLITE_UTF* values */
+ u16 nKeyField; /* Number of key columns in the index */
+ u16 nAllField; /* Total columns, including key plus others */
+ sqlite3 *db; /* The database connection */
+ u8 *aSortFlags; /* Sort order for each column. */
+ CollSeq *aColl[1]; /* Collating sequence for each term of the key */
+};
+
+/*
+** Allowed bit values for entries in the KeyInfo.aSortFlags[] array.
+*/
+#define KEYINFO_ORDER_DESC 0x01 /* DESC sort order */
+#define KEYINFO_ORDER_BIGNULL 0x02 /* NULL is larger than any other value */
+
+/*
+** This object holds a record which has been parsed out into individual
+** fields, for the purposes of doing a comparison.
+**
+** A record is an object that contains one or more fields of data.
+** Records are used to store the content of a table row and to store
+** the key of an index. A blob encoding of a record is created by
+** the OP_MakeRecord opcode of the VDBE and is disassembled by the
+** OP_Column opcode.
+**
+** An instance of this object serves as a "key" for doing a search on
+** an index b+tree. The goal of the search is to find the entry that
+** is closed to the key described by this object. This object might hold
+** just a prefix of the key. The number of fields is given by
+** pKeyInfo->nField.
+**
+** The r1 and r2 fields are the values to return if this key is less than
+** or greater than a key in the btree, respectively. These are normally
+** -1 and +1 respectively, but might be inverted to +1 and -1 if the b-tree
+** is in DESC order.
+**
+** The key comparison functions actually return default_rc when they find
+** an equals comparison. default_rc can be -1, 0, or +1. If there are
+** multiple entries in the b-tree with the same key (when only looking
+** at the first pKeyInfo->nFields,) then default_rc can be set to -1 to
+** cause the search to find the last match, or +1 to cause the search to
+** find the first match.
+**
+** The key comparison functions will set eqSeen to true if they ever
+** get and equal results when comparing this structure to a b-tree record.
+** When default_rc!=0, the search might end up on the record immediately
+** before the first match or immediately after the last match. The
+** eqSeen field will indicate whether or not an exact match exists in the
+** b-tree.
+*/
+struct UnpackedRecord {
+ KeyInfo *pKeyInfo; /* Collation and sort-order information */
+ Mem *aMem; /* Values */
+ u16 nField; /* Number of entries in apMem[] */
+ i8 default_rc; /* Comparison result if keys are equal */
+ u8 errCode; /* Error detected by xRecordCompare (CORRUPT or NOMEM) */
+ i8 r1; /* Value to return if (lhs < rhs) */
+ i8 r2; /* Value to return if (lhs > rhs) */
+ u8 eqSeen; /* True if an equality comparison has been seen */
+};
+
+
+/*
+** Each SQL index is represented in memory by an
+** instance of the following structure.
+**
+** The columns of the table that are to be indexed are described
+** by the aiColumn[] field of this structure. For example, suppose
+** we have the following table and index:
+**
+** CREATE TABLE Ex1(c1 int, c2 int, c3 text);
+** CREATE INDEX Ex2 ON Ex1(c3,c1);
+**
+** In the Table structure describing Ex1, nCol==3 because there are
+** three columns in the table. In the Index structure describing
+** Ex2, nColumn==2 since 2 of the 3 columns of Ex1 are indexed.
+** The value of aiColumn is {2, 0}. aiColumn[0]==2 because the
+** first column to be indexed (c3) has an index of 2 in Ex1.aCol[].
+** The second column to be indexed (c1) has an index of 0 in
+** Ex1.aCol[], hence Ex2.aiColumn[1]==0.
+**
+** The Index.onError field determines whether or not the indexed columns
+** must be unique and what to do if they are not. When Index.onError=OE_None,
+** it means this is not a unique index. Otherwise it is a unique index
+** and the value of Index.onError indicate the which conflict resolution
+** algorithm to employ whenever an attempt is made to insert a non-unique
+** element.
+**
+** While parsing a CREATE TABLE or CREATE INDEX statement in order to
+** generate VDBE code (as opposed to parsing one read from an sqlite_schema
+** table as part of parsing an existing database schema), transient instances
+** of this structure may be created. In this case the Index.tnum variable is
+** used to store the address of a VDBE instruction, not a database page
+** number (it cannot - the database page is not allocated until the VDBE
+** program is executed). See convertToWithoutRowidTable() for details.
+*/
+struct Index {
+ char *zName; /* Name of this index */
+ i16 *aiColumn; /* Which columns are used by this index. 1st is 0 */
+ LogEst *aiRowLogEst; /* From ANALYZE: Est. rows selected by each column */
+ Table *pTable; /* The SQL table being indexed */
+ char *zColAff; /* String defining the affinity of each column */
+ Index *pNext; /* The next index associated with the same table */
+ Schema *pSchema; /* Schema containing this index */
+ u8 *aSortOrder; /* for each column: True==DESC, False==ASC */
+ const char **azColl; /* Array of collation sequence names for index */
+ Expr *pPartIdxWhere; /* WHERE clause for partial indices */
+ ExprList *aColExpr; /* Column expressions */
+ Pgno tnum; /* DB Page containing root of this index */
+ LogEst szIdxRow; /* Estimated average row size in bytes */
+ u16 nKeyCol; /* Number of columns forming the key */
+ u16 nColumn; /* Number of columns stored in the index */
+ u8 onError; /* OE_Abort, OE_Ignore, OE_Replace, or OE_None */
+ unsigned idxType:2; /* 0:Normal 1:UNIQUE, 2:PRIMARY KEY, 3:IPK */
+ unsigned bUnordered:1; /* Use this index for == or IN queries only */
+ unsigned uniqNotNull:1; /* True if UNIQUE and NOT NULL for all columns */
+ unsigned isResized:1; /* True if resizeIndexObject() has been called */
+ unsigned isCovering:1; /* True if this is a covering index */
+ unsigned noSkipScan:1; /* Do not try to use skip-scan if true */
+ unsigned hasStat1:1; /* aiRowLogEst values come from sqlite_stat1 */
+ unsigned bNoQuery:1; /* Do not use this index to optimize queries */
+ unsigned bAscKeyBug:1; /* True if the bba7b69f9849b5bf bug applies */
+ unsigned bHasVCol:1; /* Index references one or more VIRTUAL columns */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT4
+ int nSample; /* Number of elements in aSample[] */
+ int nSampleCol; /* Size of IndexSample.anEq[] and so on */
+ tRowcnt *aAvgEq; /* Average nEq values for keys not in aSample */
+ IndexSample *aSample; /* Samples of the left-most key */
+ tRowcnt *aiRowEst; /* Non-logarithmic stat1 data for this index */
+ tRowcnt nRowEst0; /* Non-logarithmic number of rows in the index */
+#endif
+ Bitmask colNotIdxed; /* 0 for unindexed columns in pTab */
+};
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for Index.idxType
+*/
+#define SQLITE_IDXTYPE_APPDEF 0 /* Created using CREATE INDEX */
+#define SQLITE_IDXTYPE_UNIQUE 1 /* Implements a UNIQUE constraint */
+#define SQLITE_IDXTYPE_PRIMARYKEY 2 /* Is the PRIMARY KEY for the table */
+#define SQLITE_IDXTYPE_IPK 3 /* INTEGER PRIMARY KEY index */
+
+/* Return true if index X is a PRIMARY KEY index */
+#define IsPrimaryKeyIndex(X) ((X)->idxType==SQLITE_IDXTYPE_PRIMARYKEY)
+
+/* Return true if index X is a UNIQUE index */
+#define IsUniqueIndex(X) ((X)->onError!=OE_None)
+
+/* The Index.aiColumn[] values are normally positive integer. But
+** there are some negative values that have special meaning:
+*/
+#define XN_ROWID (-1) /* Indexed column is the rowid */
+#define XN_EXPR (-2) /* Indexed column is an expression */
+
+/*
+** Each sample stored in the sqlite_stat4 table is represented in memory
+** using a structure of this type. See documentation at the top of the
+** analyze.c source file for additional information.
+*/
+struct IndexSample {
+ void *p; /* Pointer to sampled record */
+ int n; /* Size of record in bytes */
+ tRowcnt *anEq; /* Est. number of rows where the key equals this sample */
+ tRowcnt *anLt; /* Est. number of rows where key is less than this sample */
+ tRowcnt *anDLt; /* Est. number of distinct keys less than this sample */
+};
+
+/*
+** Possible values to use within the flags argument to sqlite3GetToken().
+*/
+#define SQLITE_TOKEN_QUOTED 0x1 /* Token is a quoted identifier. */
+#define SQLITE_TOKEN_KEYWORD 0x2 /* Token is a keyword. */
+
+/*
+** Each token coming out of the lexer is an instance of
+** this structure. Tokens are also used as part of an expression.
+**
+** The memory that "z" points to is owned by other objects. Take care
+** that the owner of the "z" string does not deallocate the string before
+** the Token goes out of scope! Very often, the "z" points to some place
+** in the middle of the Parse.zSql text. But it might also point to a
+** static string.
+*/
+struct Token {
+ const char *z; /* Text of the token. Not NULL-terminated! */
+ unsigned int n; /* Number of characters in this token */
+};
+
+/*
+** An instance of this structure contains information needed to generate
+** code for a SELECT that contains aggregate functions.
+**
+** If Expr.op==TK_AGG_COLUMN or TK_AGG_FUNCTION then Expr.pAggInfo is a
+** pointer to this structure. The Expr.iAgg field is the index in
+** AggInfo.aCol[] or AggInfo.aFunc[] of information needed to generate
+** code for that node.
+**
+** AggInfo.pGroupBy and AggInfo.aFunc.pExpr point to fields within the
+** original Select structure that describes the SELECT statement. These
+** fields do not need to be freed when deallocating the AggInfo structure.
+*/
+struct AggInfo {
+ u8 directMode; /* Direct rendering mode means take data directly
+ ** from source tables rather than from accumulators */
+ u8 useSortingIdx; /* In direct mode, reference the sorting index rather
+ ** than the source table */
+ int sortingIdx; /* Cursor number of the sorting index */
+ int sortingIdxPTab; /* Cursor number of pseudo-table */
+ int nSortingColumn; /* Number of columns in the sorting index */
+ int mnReg, mxReg; /* Range of registers allocated for aCol and aFunc */
+ ExprList *pGroupBy; /* The group by clause */
+ struct AggInfo_col { /* For each column used in source tables */
+ Table *pTab; /* Source table */
+ Expr *pCExpr; /* The original expression */
+ int iTable; /* Cursor number of the source table */
+ int iMem; /* Memory location that acts as accumulator */
+ i16 iColumn; /* Column number within the source table */
+ i16 iSorterColumn; /* Column number in the sorting index */
+ } *aCol;
+ int nColumn; /* Number of used entries in aCol[] */
+ int nAccumulator; /* Number of columns that show through to the output.
+ ** Additional columns are used only as parameters to
+ ** aggregate functions */
+ struct AggInfo_func { /* For each aggregate function */
+ Expr *pFExpr; /* Expression encoding the function */
+ FuncDef *pFunc; /* The aggregate function implementation */
+ int iMem; /* Memory location that acts as accumulator */
+ int iDistinct; /* Ephemeral table used to enforce DISTINCT */
+ } *aFunc;
+ int nFunc; /* Number of entries in aFunc[] */
+ u32 selId; /* Select to which this AggInfo belongs */
+ AggInfo *pNext; /* Next in list of them all */
+};
+
+/*
+** The datatype ynVar is a signed integer, either 16-bit or 32-bit.
+** Usually it is 16-bits. But if SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER is greater
+** than 32767 we have to make it 32-bit. 16-bit is preferred because
+** it uses less memory in the Expr object, which is a big memory user
+** in systems with lots of prepared statements. And few applications
+** need more than about 10 or 20 variables. But some extreme users want
+** to have prepared statements with over 32766 variables, and for them
+** the option is available (at compile-time).
+*/
+#if SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER<32767
+typedef i16 ynVar;
+#else
+typedef int ynVar;
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Each node of an expression in the parse tree is an instance
+** of this structure.
+**
+** Expr.op is the opcode. The integer parser token codes are reused
+** as opcodes here. For example, the parser defines TK_GE to be an integer
+** code representing the ">=" operator. This same integer code is reused
+** to represent the greater-than-or-equal-to operator in the expression
+** tree.
+**
+** If the expression is an SQL literal (TK_INTEGER, TK_FLOAT, TK_BLOB,
+** or TK_STRING), then Expr.token contains the text of the SQL literal. If
+** the expression is a variable (TK_VARIABLE), then Expr.token contains the
+** variable name. Finally, if the expression is an SQL function (TK_FUNCTION),
+** then Expr.token contains the name of the function.
+**
+** Expr.pRight and Expr.pLeft are the left and right subexpressions of a
+** binary operator. Either or both may be NULL.
+**
+** Expr.x.pList is a list of arguments if the expression is an SQL function,
+** a CASE expression or an IN expression of the form " IN (, ...)".
+** Expr.x.pSelect is used if the expression is a sub-select or an expression of
+** the form " IN (SELECT ...)". If the EP_xIsSelect bit is set in the
+** Expr.flags mask, then Expr.x.pSelect is valid. Otherwise, Expr.x.pList is
+** valid.
+**
+** An expression of the form ID or ID.ID refers to a column in a table.
+** For such expressions, Expr.op is set to TK_COLUMN and Expr.iTable is
+** the integer cursor number of a VDBE cursor pointing to that table and
+** Expr.iColumn is the column number for the specific column. If the
+** expression is used as a result in an aggregate SELECT, then the
+** value is also stored in the Expr.iAgg column in the aggregate so that
+** it can be accessed after all aggregates are computed.
+**
+** If the expression is an unbound variable marker (a question mark
+** character '?' in the original SQL) then the Expr.iTable holds the index
+** number for that variable.
+**
+** If the expression is a subquery then Expr.iColumn holds an integer
+** register number containing the result of the subquery. If the
+** subquery gives a constant result, then iTable is -1. If the subquery
+** gives a different answer at different times during statement processing
+** then iTable is the address of a subroutine that computes the subquery.
+**
+** If the Expr is of type OP_Column, and the table it is selecting from
+** is a disk table or the "old.*" pseudo-table, then pTab points to the
+** corresponding table definition.
+**
+** ALLOCATION NOTES:
+**
+** Expr objects can use a lot of memory space in database schema. To
+** help reduce memory requirements, sometimes an Expr object will be
+** truncated. And to reduce the number of memory allocations, sometimes
+** two or more Expr objects will be stored in a single memory allocation,
+** together with Expr.zToken strings.
+**
+** If the EP_Reduced and EP_TokenOnly flags are set when
+** an Expr object is truncated. When EP_Reduced is set, then all
+** the child Expr objects in the Expr.pLeft and Expr.pRight subtrees
+** are contained within the same memory allocation. Note, however, that
+** the subtrees in Expr.x.pList or Expr.x.pSelect are always separately
+** allocated, regardless of whether or not EP_Reduced is set.
+*/
+struct Expr {
+ u8 op; /* Operation performed by this node */
+ char affExpr; /* affinity, or RAISE type */
+ u8 op2; /* TK_REGISTER/TK_TRUTH: original value of Expr.op
+ ** TK_COLUMN: the value of p5 for OP_Column
+ ** TK_AGG_FUNCTION: nesting depth
+ ** TK_FUNCTION: NC_SelfRef flag if needs OP_PureFunc */
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ u8 vvaFlags; /* Verification flags. */
+#endif
+ u32 flags; /* Various flags. EP_* See below */
+ union {
+ char *zToken; /* Token value. Zero terminated and dequoted */
+ int iValue; /* Non-negative integer value if EP_IntValue */
+ } u;
+
+ /* If the EP_TokenOnly flag is set in the Expr.flags mask, then no
+ ** space is allocated for the fields below this point. An attempt to
+ ** access them will result in a segfault or malfunction.
+ *********************************************************************/
+
+ Expr *pLeft; /* Left subnode */
+ Expr *pRight; /* Right subnode */
+ union {
+ ExprList *pList; /* op = IN, EXISTS, SELECT, CASE, FUNCTION, BETWEEN */
+ Select *pSelect; /* EP_xIsSelect and op = IN, EXISTS, SELECT */
+ } x;
+
+ /* If the EP_Reduced flag is set in the Expr.flags mask, then no
+ ** space is allocated for the fields below this point. An attempt to
+ ** access them will result in a segfault or malfunction.
+ *********************************************************************/
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH>0
+ int nHeight; /* Height of the tree headed by this node */
+#endif
+ int iTable; /* TK_COLUMN: cursor number of table holding column
+ ** TK_REGISTER: register number
+ ** TK_TRIGGER: 1 -> new, 0 -> old
+ ** EP_Unlikely: 134217728 times likelihood
+ ** TK_IN: ephemerial table holding RHS
+ ** TK_SELECT_COLUMN: Number of columns on the LHS
+ ** TK_SELECT: 1st register of result vector */
+ ynVar iColumn; /* TK_COLUMN: column index. -1 for rowid.
+ ** TK_VARIABLE: variable number (always >= 1).
+ ** TK_SELECT_COLUMN: column of the result vector */
+ i16 iAgg; /* Which entry in pAggInfo->aCol[] or ->aFunc[] */
+ i16 iRightJoinTable; /* If EP_FromJoin, the right table of the join */
+ AggInfo *pAggInfo; /* Used by TK_AGG_COLUMN and TK_AGG_FUNCTION */
+ union {
+ Table *pTab; /* TK_COLUMN: Table containing column. Can be NULL
+ ** for a column of an index on an expression */
+ Window *pWin; /* EP_WinFunc: Window/Filter defn for a function */
+ struct { /* TK_IN, TK_SELECT, and TK_EXISTS */
+ int iAddr; /* Subroutine entry address */
+ int regReturn; /* Register used to hold return address */
+ } sub;
+ } y;
+};
+
+/*
+** The following are the meanings of bits in the Expr.flags field.
+** Value restrictions:
+**
+** EP_Agg == NC_HasAgg == SF_HasAgg
+** EP_Win == NC_HasWin
+*/
+#define EP_FromJoin 0x000001 /* Originates in ON/USING clause of outer join */
+#define EP_Distinct 0x000002 /* Aggregate function with DISTINCT keyword */
+#define EP_HasFunc 0x000004 /* Contains one or more functions of any kind */
+#define EP_FixedCol 0x000008 /* TK_Column with a known fixed value */
+#define EP_Agg 0x000010 /* Contains one or more aggregate functions */
+#define EP_VarSelect 0x000020 /* pSelect is correlated, not constant */
+#define EP_DblQuoted 0x000040 /* token.z was originally in "..." */
+#define EP_InfixFunc 0x000080 /* True for an infix function: LIKE, GLOB, etc */
+#define EP_Collate 0x000100 /* Tree contains a TK_COLLATE operator */
+#define EP_Commuted 0x000200 /* Comparison operator has been commuted */
+#define EP_IntValue 0x000400 /* Integer value contained in u.iValue */
+#define EP_xIsSelect 0x000800 /* x.pSelect is valid (otherwise x.pList is) */
+#define EP_Skip 0x001000 /* Operator does not contribute to affinity */
+#define EP_Reduced 0x002000 /* Expr struct EXPR_REDUCEDSIZE bytes only */
+#define EP_TokenOnly 0x004000 /* Expr struct EXPR_TOKENONLYSIZE bytes only */
+#define EP_Win 0x008000 /* Contains window functions */
+#define EP_MemToken 0x010000 /* Need to sqlite3DbFree() Expr.zToken */
+ /* 0x020000 // available for reuse */
+#define EP_Unlikely 0x040000 /* unlikely() or likelihood() function */
+#define EP_ConstFunc 0x080000 /* A SQLITE_FUNC_CONSTANT or _SLOCHNG function */
+#define EP_CanBeNull 0x100000 /* Can be null despite NOT NULL constraint */
+#define EP_Subquery 0x200000 /* Tree contains a TK_SELECT operator */
+#define EP_Alias 0x400000 /* Is an alias for a result set column */
+#define EP_Leaf 0x800000 /* Expr.pLeft, .pRight, .u.pSelect all NULL */
+#define EP_WinFunc 0x1000000 /* TK_FUNCTION with Expr.y.pWin set */
+#define EP_Subrtn 0x2000000 /* Uses Expr.y.sub. TK_IN, _SELECT, or _EXISTS */
+#define EP_Quoted 0x4000000 /* TK_ID was originally quoted */
+#define EP_Static 0x8000000 /* Held in memory not obtained from malloc() */
+#define EP_IsTrue 0x10000000 /* Always has boolean value of TRUE */
+#define EP_IsFalse 0x20000000 /* Always has boolean value of FALSE */
+#define EP_FromDDL 0x40000000 /* Originates from sqlite_schema */
+ /* 0x80000000 // Available */
+
+/*
+** The EP_Propagate mask is a set of properties that automatically propagate
+** upwards into parent nodes.
+*/
+#define EP_Propagate (EP_Collate|EP_Subquery|EP_HasFunc)
+
+/*
+** These macros can be used to test, set, or clear bits in the
+** Expr.flags field.
+*/
+#define ExprHasProperty(E,P) (((E)->flags&(P))!=0)
+#define ExprHasAllProperty(E,P) (((E)->flags&(P))==(P))
+#define ExprSetProperty(E,P) (E)->flags|=(P)
+#define ExprClearProperty(E,P) (E)->flags&=~(P)
+#define ExprAlwaysTrue(E) (((E)->flags&(EP_FromJoin|EP_IsTrue))==EP_IsTrue)
+#define ExprAlwaysFalse(E) (((E)->flags&(EP_FromJoin|EP_IsFalse))==EP_IsFalse)
+
+
+/* Flags for use with Expr.vvaFlags
+*/
+#define EP_NoReduce 0x01 /* Cannot EXPRDUP_REDUCE this Expr */
+#define EP_Immutable 0x02 /* Do not change this Expr node */
+
+/* The ExprSetVVAProperty() macro is used for Verification, Validation,
+** and Accreditation only. It works like ExprSetProperty() during VVA
+** processes but is a no-op for delivery.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+# define ExprSetVVAProperty(E,P) (E)->vvaFlags|=(P)
+# define ExprHasVVAProperty(E,P) (((E)->vvaFlags&(P))!=0)
+# define ExprClearVVAProperties(E) (E)->vvaFlags = 0
+#else
+# define ExprSetVVAProperty(E,P)
+# define ExprHasVVAProperty(E,P) 0
+# define ExprClearVVAProperties(E)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Macros to determine the number of bytes required by a normal Expr
+** struct, an Expr struct with the EP_Reduced flag set in Expr.flags
+** and an Expr struct with the EP_TokenOnly flag set.
+*/
+#define EXPR_FULLSIZE sizeof(Expr) /* Full size */
+#define EXPR_REDUCEDSIZE offsetof(Expr,iTable) /* Common features */
+#define EXPR_TOKENONLYSIZE offsetof(Expr,pLeft) /* Fewer features */
+
+/*
+** Flags passed to the sqlite3ExprDup() function. See the header comment
+** above sqlite3ExprDup() for details.
+*/
+#define EXPRDUP_REDUCE 0x0001 /* Used reduced-size Expr nodes */
+
+/*
+** True if the expression passed as an argument was a function with
+** an OVER() clause (a window function).
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+# define IsWindowFunc(p) 0
+#else
+# define IsWindowFunc(p) ( \
+ ExprHasProperty((p), EP_WinFunc) && p->y.pWin->eFrmType!=TK_FILTER \
+ )
+#endif
+
+/*
+** A list of expressions. Each expression may optionally have a
+** name. An expr/name combination can be used in several ways, such
+** as the list of "expr AS ID" fields following a "SELECT" or in the
+** list of "ID = expr" items in an UPDATE. A list of expressions can
+** also be used as the argument to a function, in which case the a.zName
+** field is not used.
+**
+** In order to try to keep memory usage down, the Expr.a.zEName field
+** is used for multiple purposes:
+**
+** eEName Usage
+** ---------- -------------------------
+** ENAME_NAME (1) the AS of result set column
+** (2) COLUMN= of an UPDATE
+**
+** ENAME_TAB DB.TABLE.NAME used to resolve names
+** of subqueries
+**
+** ENAME_SPAN Text of the original result set
+** expression.
+*/
+struct ExprList {
+ int nExpr; /* Number of expressions on the list */
+ struct ExprList_item { /* For each expression in the list */
+ Expr *pExpr; /* The parse tree for this expression */
+ char *zEName; /* Token associated with this expression */
+ u8 sortFlags; /* Mask of KEYINFO_ORDER_* flags */
+ unsigned eEName :2; /* Meaning of zEName */
+ unsigned done :1; /* A flag to indicate when processing is finished */
+ unsigned reusable :1; /* Constant expression is reusable */
+ unsigned bSorterRef :1; /* Defer evaluation until after sorting */
+ unsigned bNulls: 1; /* True if explicit "NULLS FIRST/LAST" */
+ union {
+ struct {
+ u16 iOrderByCol; /* For ORDER BY, column number in result set */
+ u16 iAlias; /* Index into Parse.aAlias[] for zName */
+ } x;
+ int iConstExprReg; /* Register in which Expr value is cached */
+ } u;
+ } a[1]; /* One slot for each expression in the list */
+};
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for Expr.a.eEName
+*/
+#define ENAME_NAME 0 /* The AS clause of a result set */
+#define ENAME_SPAN 1 /* Complete text of the result set expression */
+#define ENAME_TAB 2 /* "DB.TABLE.NAME" for the result set */
+
+/*
+** An instance of this structure can hold a simple list of identifiers,
+** such as the list "a,b,c" in the following statements:
+**
+** INSERT INTO t(a,b,c) VALUES ...;
+** CREATE INDEX idx ON t(a,b,c);
+** CREATE TRIGGER trig BEFORE UPDATE ON t(a,b,c) ...;
+**
+** The IdList.a.idx field is used when the IdList represents the list of
+** column names after a table name in an INSERT statement. In the statement
+**
+** INSERT INTO t(a,b,c) ...
+**
+** If "a" is the k-th column of table "t", then IdList.a[0].idx==k.
+*/
+struct IdList {
+ struct IdList_item {
+ char *zName; /* Name of the identifier */
+ int idx; /* Index in some Table.aCol[] of a column named zName */
+ } *a;
+ int nId; /* Number of identifiers on the list */
+};
+
+/*
+** The following structure describes the FROM clause of a SELECT statement.
+** Each table or subquery in the FROM clause is a separate element of
+** the SrcList.a[] array.
+**
+** With the addition of multiple database support, the following structure
+** can also be used to describe a particular table such as the table that
+** is modified by an INSERT, DELETE, or UPDATE statement. In standard SQL,
+** such a table must be a simple name: ID. But in SQLite, the table can
+** now be identified by a database name, a dot, then the table name: ID.ID.
+**
+** The jointype starts out showing the join type between the current table
+** and the next table on the list. The parser builds the list this way.
+** But sqlite3SrcListShiftJoinType() later shifts the jointypes so that each
+** jointype expresses the join between the table and the previous table.
+**
+** In the colUsed field, the high-order bit (bit 63) is set if the table
+** contains more than 63 columns and the 64-th or later column is used.
+*/
+struct SrcList {
+ int nSrc; /* Number of tables or subqueries in the FROM clause */
+ u32 nAlloc; /* Number of entries allocated in a[] below */
+ struct SrcList_item {
+ Schema *pSchema; /* Schema to which this item is fixed */
+ char *zDatabase; /* Name of database holding this table */
+ char *zName; /* Name of the table */
+ char *zAlias; /* The "B" part of a "A AS B" phrase. zName is the "A" */
+ Table *pTab; /* An SQL table corresponding to zName */
+ Select *pSelect; /* A SELECT statement used in place of a table name */
+ int addrFillSub; /* Address of subroutine to manifest a subquery */
+ int regReturn; /* Register holding return address of addrFillSub */
+ int regResult; /* Registers holding results of a co-routine */
+ struct {
+ u8 jointype; /* Type of join between this table and the previous */
+ unsigned notIndexed :1; /* True if there is a NOT INDEXED clause */
+ unsigned isIndexedBy :1; /* True if there is an INDEXED BY clause */
+ unsigned isTabFunc :1; /* True if table-valued-function syntax */
+ unsigned isCorrelated :1; /* True if sub-query is correlated */
+ unsigned viaCoroutine :1; /* Implemented as a co-routine */
+ unsigned isRecursive :1; /* True for recursive reference in WITH */
+ unsigned fromDDL :1; /* Comes from sqlite_schema */
+ } fg;
+ int iCursor; /* The VDBE cursor number used to access this table */
+ Expr *pOn; /* The ON clause of a join */
+ IdList *pUsing; /* The USING clause of a join */
+ Bitmask colUsed; /* Bit N (1<" clause */
+ ExprList *pFuncArg; /* Arguments to table-valued-function */
+ } u1;
+ Index *pIBIndex; /* Index structure corresponding to u1.zIndexedBy */
+ } a[1]; /* One entry for each identifier on the list */
+};
+
+/*
+** Permitted values of the SrcList.a.jointype field
+*/
+#define JT_INNER 0x0001 /* Any kind of inner or cross join */
+#define JT_CROSS 0x0002 /* Explicit use of the CROSS keyword */
+#define JT_NATURAL 0x0004 /* True for a "natural" join */
+#define JT_LEFT 0x0008 /* Left outer join */
+#define JT_RIGHT 0x0010 /* Right outer join */
+#define JT_OUTER 0x0020 /* The "OUTER" keyword is present */
+#define JT_ERROR 0x0040 /* unknown or unsupported join type */
+
+
+/*
+** Flags appropriate for the wctrlFlags parameter of sqlite3WhereBegin()
+** and the WhereInfo.wctrlFlags member.
+**
+** Value constraints (enforced via assert()):
+** WHERE_USE_LIMIT == SF_FixedLimit
+*/
+#define WHERE_ORDERBY_NORMAL 0x0000 /* No-op */
+#define WHERE_ORDERBY_MIN 0x0001 /* ORDER BY processing for min() func */
+#define WHERE_ORDERBY_MAX 0x0002 /* ORDER BY processing for max() func */
+#define WHERE_ONEPASS_DESIRED 0x0004 /* Want to do one-pass UPDATE/DELETE */
+#define WHERE_ONEPASS_MULTIROW 0x0008 /* ONEPASS is ok with multiple rows */
+#define WHERE_DUPLICATES_OK 0x0010 /* Ok to return a row more than once */
+#define WHERE_OR_SUBCLAUSE 0x0020 /* Processing a sub-WHERE as part of
+ ** the OR optimization */
+#define WHERE_GROUPBY 0x0040 /* pOrderBy is really a GROUP BY */
+#define WHERE_DISTINCTBY 0x0080 /* pOrderby is really a DISTINCT clause */
+#define WHERE_WANT_DISTINCT 0x0100 /* All output needs to be distinct */
+#define WHERE_SORTBYGROUP 0x0200 /* Support sqlite3WhereIsSorted() */
+#define WHERE_SEEK_TABLE 0x0400 /* Do not defer seeks on main table */
+#define WHERE_ORDERBY_LIMIT 0x0800 /* ORDERBY+LIMIT on the inner loop */
+#define WHERE_SEEK_UNIQ_TABLE 0x1000 /* Do not defer seeks if unique */
+ /* 0x2000 not currently used */
+#define WHERE_USE_LIMIT 0x4000 /* Use the LIMIT in cost estimates */
+ /* 0x8000 not currently used */
+
+/* Allowed return values from sqlite3WhereIsDistinct()
+*/
+#define WHERE_DISTINCT_NOOP 0 /* DISTINCT keyword not used */
+#define WHERE_DISTINCT_UNIQUE 1 /* No duplicates */
+#define WHERE_DISTINCT_ORDERED 2 /* All duplicates are adjacent */
+#define WHERE_DISTINCT_UNORDERED 3 /* Duplicates are scattered */
+
+/*
+** A NameContext defines a context in which to resolve table and column
+** names. The context consists of a list of tables (the pSrcList) field and
+** a list of named expression (pEList). The named expression list may
+** be NULL. The pSrc corresponds to the FROM clause of a SELECT or
+** to the table being operated on by INSERT, UPDATE, or DELETE. The
+** pEList corresponds to the result set of a SELECT and is NULL for
+** other statements.
+**
+** NameContexts can be nested. When resolving names, the inner-most
+** context is searched first. If no match is found, the next outer
+** context is checked. If there is still no match, the next context
+** is checked. This process continues until either a match is found
+** or all contexts are check. When a match is found, the nRef member of
+** the context containing the match is incremented.
+**
+** Each subquery gets a new NameContext. The pNext field points to the
+** NameContext in the parent query. Thus the process of scanning the
+** NameContext list corresponds to searching through successively outer
+** subqueries looking for a match.
+*/
+struct NameContext {
+ Parse *pParse; /* The parser */
+ SrcList *pSrcList; /* One or more tables used to resolve names */
+ union {
+ ExprList *pEList; /* Optional list of result-set columns */
+ AggInfo *pAggInfo; /* Information about aggregates at this level */
+ Upsert *pUpsert; /* ON CONFLICT clause information from an upsert */
+ } uNC;
+ NameContext *pNext; /* Next outer name context. NULL for outermost */
+ int nRef; /* Number of names resolved by this context */
+ int nErr; /* Number of errors encountered while resolving names */
+ int ncFlags; /* Zero or more NC_* flags defined below */
+ Select *pWinSelect; /* SELECT statement for any window functions */
+};
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for the NameContext, ncFlags field.
+**
+** Value constraints (all checked via assert()):
+** NC_HasAgg == SF_HasAgg == EP_Agg
+** NC_MinMaxAgg == SF_MinMaxAgg == SQLITE_FUNC_MINMAX
+** NC_HasWin == EP_Win
+**
+*/
+#define NC_AllowAgg 0x00001 /* Aggregate functions are allowed here */
+#define NC_PartIdx 0x00002 /* True if resolving a partial index WHERE */
+#define NC_IsCheck 0x00004 /* True if resolving a CHECK constraint */
+#define NC_GenCol 0x00008 /* True for a GENERATED ALWAYS AS clause */
+#define NC_HasAgg 0x00010 /* One or more aggregate functions seen */
+#define NC_IdxExpr 0x00020 /* True if resolving columns of CREATE INDEX */
+#define NC_SelfRef 0x0002e /* Combo: PartIdx, isCheck, GenCol, and IdxExpr */
+#define NC_VarSelect 0x00040 /* A correlated subquery has been seen */
+#define NC_UEList 0x00080 /* True if uNC.pEList is used */
+#define NC_UAggInfo 0x00100 /* True if uNC.pAggInfo is used */
+#define NC_UUpsert 0x00200 /* True if uNC.pUpsert is used */
+#define NC_MinMaxAgg 0x01000 /* min/max aggregates seen. See note above */
+#define NC_Complex 0x02000 /* True if a function or subquery seen */
+#define NC_AllowWin 0x04000 /* Window functions are allowed here */
+#define NC_HasWin 0x08000 /* One or more window functions seen */
+#define NC_IsDDL 0x10000 /* Resolving names in a CREATE statement */
+#define NC_InAggFunc 0x20000 /* True if analyzing arguments to an agg func */
+#define NC_FromDDL 0x40000 /* SQL text comes from sqlite_schema */
+
+/*
+** An instance of the following object describes a single ON CONFLICT
+** clause in an upsert.
+**
+** The pUpsertTarget field is only set if the ON CONFLICT clause includes
+** conflict-target clause. (In "ON CONFLICT(a,b)" the "(a,b)" is the
+** conflict-target clause.) The pUpsertTargetWhere is the optional
+** WHERE clause used to identify partial unique indexes.
+**
+** pUpsertSet is the list of column=expr terms of the UPDATE statement.
+** The pUpsertSet field is NULL for a ON CONFLICT DO NOTHING. The
+** pUpsertWhere is the WHERE clause for the UPDATE and is NULL if the
+** WHERE clause is omitted.
+*/
+struct Upsert {
+ ExprList *pUpsertTarget; /* Optional description of conflicting index */
+ Expr *pUpsertTargetWhere; /* WHERE clause for partial index targets */
+ ExprList *pUpsertSet; /* The SET clause from an ON CONFLICT UPDATE */
+ Expr *pUpsertWhere; /* WHERE clause for the ON CONFLICT UPDATE */
+ /* The fields above comprise the parse tree for the upsert clause.
+ ** The fields below are used to transfer information from the INSERT
+ ** processing down into the UPDATE processing while generating code.
+ ** Upsert owns the memory allocated above, but not the memory below. */
+ Index *pUpsertIdx; /* Constraint that pUpsertTarget identifies */
+ SrcList *pUpsertSrc; /* Table to be updated */
+ int regData; /* First register holding array of VALUES */
+ int iDataCur; /* Index of the data cursor */
+ int iIdxCur; /* Index of the first index cursor */
+};
+
+/*
+** An instance of the following structure contains all information
+** needed to generate code for a single SELECT statement.
+**
+** See the header comment on the computeLimitRegisters() routine for a
+** detailed description of the meaning of the iLimit and iOffset fields.
+**
+** addrOpenEphm[] entries contain the address of OP_OpenEphemeral opcodes.
+** These addresses must be stored so that we can go back and fill in
+** the P4_KEYINFO and P2 parameters later. Neither the KeyInfo nor
+** the number of columns in P2 can be computed at the same time
+** as the OP_OpenEphm instruction is coded because not
+** enough information about the compound query is known at that point.
+** The KeyInfo for addrOpenTran[0] and [1] contains collating sequences
+** for the result set. The KeyInfo for addrOpenEphm[2] contains collating
+** sequences for the ORDER BY clause.
+*/
+struct Select {
+ u8 op; /* One of: TK_UNION TK_ALL TK_INTERSECT TK_EXCEPT */
+ LogEst nSelectRow; /* Estimated number of result rows */
+ u32 selFlags; /* Various SF_* values */
+ int iLimit, iOffset; /* Memory registers holding LIMIT & OFFSET counters */
+ u32 selId; /* Unique identifier number for this SELECT */
+ int addrOpenEphm[2]; /* OP_OpenEphem opcodes related to this select */
+ ExprList *pEList; /* The fields of the result */
+ SrcList *pSrc; /* The FROM clause */
+ Expr *pWhere; /* The WHERE clause */
+ ExprList *pGroupBy; /* The GROUP BY clause */
+ Expr *pHaving; /* The HAVING clause */
+ ExprList *pOrderBy; /* The ORDER BY clause */
+ Select *pPrior; /* Prior select in a compound select statement */
+ Select *pNext; /* Next select to the left in a compound */
+ Expr *pLimit; /* LIMIT expression. NULL means not used. */
+ With *pWith; /* WITH clause attached to this select. Or NULL. */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+ Window *pWin; /* List of window functions */
+ Window *pWinDefn; /* List of named window definitions */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for Select.selFlags. The "SF" prefix stands for
+** "Select Flag".
+**
+** Value constraints (all checked via assert())
+** SF_HasAgg == NC_HasAgg
+** SF_MinMaxAgg == NC_MinMaxAgg == SQLITE_FUNC_MINMAX
+** SF_FixedLimit == WHERE_USE_LIMIT
+*/
+#define SF_Distinct 0x0000001 /* Output should be DISTINCT */
+#define SF_All 0x0000002 /* Includes the ALL keyword */
+#define SF_Resolved 0x0000004 /* Identifiers have been resolved */
+#define SF_Aggregate 0x0000008 /* Contains agg functions or a GROUP BY */
+#define SF_HasAgg 0x0000010 /* Contains aggregate functions */
+#define SF_UsesEphemeral 0x0000020 /* Uses the OpenEphemeral opcode */
+#define SF_Expanded 0x0000040 /* sqlite3SelectExpand() called on this */
+#define SF_HasTypeInfo 0x0000080 /* FROM subqueries have Table metadata */
+#define SF_Compound 0x0000100 /* Part of a compound query */
+#define SF_Values 0x0000200 /* Synthesized from VALUES clause */
+#define SF_MultiValue 0x0000400 /* Single VALUES term with multiple rows */
+#define SF_NestedFrom 0x0000800 /* Part of a parenthesized FROM clause */
+#define SF_MinMaxAgg 0x0001000 /* Aggregate containing min() or max() */
+#define SF_Recursive 0x0002000 /* The recursive part of a recursive CTE */
+#define SF_FixedLimit 0x0004000 /* nSelectRow set by a constant LIMIT */
+#define SF_MaybeConvert 0x0008000 /* Need convertCompoundSelectToSubquery() */
+#define SF_Converted 0x0010000 /* By convertCompoundSelectToSubquery() */
+#define SF_IncludeHidden 0x0020000 /* Include hidden columns in output */
+#define SF_ComplexResult 0x0040000 /* Result contains subquery or function */
+#define SF_WhereBegin 0x0080000 /* Really a WhereBegin() call. Debug Only */
+#define SF_WinRewrite 0x0100000 /* Window function rewrite accomplished */
+#define SF_View 0x0200000 /* SELECT statement is a view */
+#define SF_NoopOrderBy 0x0400000 /* ORDER BY is ignored for this query */
+#define SF_UpdateFrom 0x0800000 /* Statement is an UPDATE...FROM */
+
+/*
+** The results of a SELECT can be distributed in several ways, as defined
+** by one of the following macros. The "SRT" prefix means "SELECT Result
+** Type".
+**
+** SRT_Union Store results as a key in a temporary index
+** identified by pDest->iSDParm.
+**
+** SRT_Except Remove results from the temporary index pDest->iSDParm.
+**
+** SRT_Exists Store a 1 in memory cell pDest->iSDParm if the result
+** set is not empty.
+**
+** SRT_Discard Throw the results away. This is used by SELECT
+** statements within triggers whose only purpose is
+** the side-effects of functions.
+**
+** All of the above are free to ignore their ORDER BY clause. Those that
+** follow must honor the ORDER BY clause.
+**
+** SRT_Output Generate a row of output (using the OP_ResultRow
+** opcode) for each row in the result set.
+**
+** SRT_Mem Only valid if the result is a single column.
+** Store the first column of the first result row
+** in register pDest->iSDParm then abandon the rest
+** of the query. This destination implies "LIMIT 1".
+**
+** SRT_Set The result must be a single column. Store each
+** row of result as the key in table pDest->iSDParm.
+** Apply the affinity pDest->affSdst before storing
+** results. Used to implement "IN (SELECT ...)".
+**
+** SRT_EphemTab Create an temporary table pDest->iSDParm and store
+** the result there. The cursor is left open after
+** returning. This is like SRT_Table except that
+** this destination uses OP_OpenEphemeral to create
+** the table first.
+**
+** SRT_Coroutine Generate a co-routine that returns a new row of
+** results each time it is invoked. The entry point
+** of the co-routine is stored in register pDest->iSDParm
+** and the result row is stored in pDest->nDest registers
+** starting with pDest->iSdst.
+**
+** SRT_Table Store results in temporary table pDest->iSDParm.
+** SRT_Fifo This is like SRT_EphemTab except that the table
+** is assumed to already be open. SRT_Fifo has
+** the additional property of being able to ignore
+** the ORDER BY clause.
+**
+** SRT_DistFifo Store results in a temporary table pDest->iSDParm.
+** But also use temporary table pDest->iSDParm+1 as
+** a record of all prior results and ignore any duplicate
+** rows. Name means: "Distinct Fifo".
+**
+** SRT_Queue Store results in priority queue pDest->iSDParm (really
+** an index). Append a sequence number so that all entries
+** are distinct.
+**
+** SRT_DistQueue Store results in priority queue pDest->iSDParm only if
+** the same record has never been stored before. The
+** index at pDest->iSDParm+1 hold all prior stores.
+**
+** SRT_Upfrom Store results in the temporary table already opened by
+** pDest->iSDParm. If (pDest->iSDParm<0), then the temp
+** table is an intkey table - in this case the first
+** column returned by the SELECT is used as the integer
+** key. If (pDest->iSDParm>0), then the table is an index
+** table. (pDest->iSDParm) is the number of key columns in
+** each index record in this case.
+*/
+#define SRT_Union 1 /* Store result as keys in an index */
+#define SRT_Except 2 /* Remove result from a UNION index */
+#define SRT_Exists 3 /* Store 1 if the result is not empty */
+#define SRT_Discard 4 /* Do not save the results anywhere */
+#define SRT_Fifo 5 /* Store result as data with an automatic rowid */
+#define SRT_DistFifo 6 /* Like SRT_Fifo, but unique results only */
+#define SRT_Queue 7 /* Store result in an queue */
+#define SRT_DistQueue 8 /* Like SRT_Queue, but unique results only */
+
+/* The ORDER BY clause is ignored for all of the above */
+#define IgnorableOrderby(X) ((X->eDest)<=SRT_DistQueue)
+
+#define SRT_Output 9 /* Output each row of result */
+#define SRT_Mem 10 /* Store result in a memory cell */
+#define SRT_Set 11 /* Store results as keys in an index */
+#define SRT_EphemTab 12 /* Create transient tab and store like SRT_Table */
+#define SRT_Coroutine 13 /* Generate a single row of result */
+#define SRT_Table 14 /* Store result as data with an automatic rowid */
+#define SRT_Upfrom 15 /* Store result as data with rowid */
+
+/*
+** An instance of this object describes where to put of the results of
+** a SELECT statement.
+*/
+struct SelectDest {
+ u8 eDest; /* How to dispose of the results. One of SRT_* above. */
+ int iSDParm; /* A parameter used by the eDest disposal method */
+ int iSDParm2; /* A second parameter for the eDest disposal method */
+ int iSdst; /* Base register where results are written */
+ int nSdst; /* Number of registers allocated */
+ char *zAffSdst; /* Affinity used when eDest==SRT_Set */
+ ExprList *pOrderBy; /* Key columns for SRT_Queue and SRT_DistQueue */
+};
+
+/*
+** During code generation of statements that do inserts into AUTOINCREMENT
+** tables, the following information is attached to the Table.u.autoInc.p
+** pointer of each autoincrement table to record some side information that
+** the code generator needs. We have to keep per-table autoincrement
+** information in case inserts are done within triggers. Triggers do not
+** normally coordinate their activities, but we do need to coordinate the
+** loading and saving of autoincrement information.
+*/
+struct AutoincInfo {
+ AutoincInfo *pNext; /* Next info block in a list of them all */
+ Table *pTab; /* Table this info block refers to */
+ int iDb; /* Index in sqlite3.aDb[] of database holding pTab */
+ int regCtr; /* Memory register holding the rowid counter */
+};
+
+/*
+** At least one instance of the following structure is created for each
+** trigger that may be fired while parsing an INSERT, UPDATE or DELETE
+** statement. All such objects are stored in the linked list headed at
+** Parse.pTriggerPrg and deleted once statement compilation has been
+** completed.
+**
+** A Vdbe sub-program that implements the body and WHEN clause of trigger
+** TriggerPrg.pTrigger, assuming a default ON CONFLICT clause of
+** TriggerPrg.orconf, is stored in the TriggerPrg.pProgram variable.
+** The Parse.pTriggerPrg list never contains two entries with the same
+** values for both pTrigger and orconf.
+**
+** The TriggerPrg.aColmask[0] variable is set to a mask of old.* columns
+** accessed (or set to 0 for triggers fired as a result of INSERT
+** statements). Similarly, the TriggerPrg.aColmask[1] variable is set to
+** a mask of new.* columns used by the program.
+*/
+struct TriggerPrg {
+ Trigger *pTrigger; /* Trigger this program was coded from */
+ TriggerPrg *pNext; /* Next entry in Parse.pTriggerPrg list */
+ SubProgram *pProgram; /* Program implementing pTrigger/orconf */
+ int orconf; /* Default ON CONFLICT policy */
+ u32 aColmask[2]; /* Masks of old.*, new.* columns accessed */
+};
+
+/*
+** The yDbMask datatype for the bitmask of all attached databases.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_MAX_ATTACHED>30
+ typedef unsigned char yDbMask[(SQLITE_MAX_ATTACHED+9)/8];
+# define DbMaskTest(M,I) (((M)[(I)/8]&(1<<((I)&7)))!=0)
+# define DbMaskZero(M) memset((M),0,sizeof(M))
+# define DbMaskSet(M,I) (M)[(I)/8]|=(1<<((I)&7))
+# define DbMaskAllZero(M) sqlite3DbMaskAllZero(M)
+# define DbMaskNonZero(M) (sqlite3DbMaskAllZero(M)==0)
+#else
+ typedef unsigned int yDbMask;
+# define DbMaskTest(M,I) (((M)&(((yDbMask)1)<<(I)))!=0)
+# define DbMaskZero(M) (M)=0
+# define DbMaskSet(M,I) (M)|=(((yDbMask)1)<<(I))
+# define DbMaskAllZero(M) (M)==0
+# define DbMaskNonZero(M) (M)!=0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** An SQL parser context. A copy of this structure is passed through
+** the parser and down into all the parser action routine in order to
+** carry around information that is global to the entire parse.
+**
+** The structure is divided into two parts. When the parser and code
+** generate call themselves recursively, the first part of the structure
+** is constant but the second part is reset at the beginning and end of
+** each recursion.
+**
+** The nTableLock and aTableLock variables are only used if the shared-cache
+** feature is enabled (if sqlite3Tsd()->useSharedData is true). They are
+** used to store the set of table-locks required by the statement being
+** compiled. Function sqlite3TableLock() is used to add entries to the
+** list.
+*/
+struct Parse {
+ sqlite3 *db; /* The main database structure */
+ char *zErrMsg; /* An error message */
+ Vdbe *pVdbe; /* An engine for executing database bytecode */
+ int rc; /* Return code from execution */
+ u8 colNamesSet; /* TRUE after OP_ColumnName has been issued to pVdbe */
+ u8 checkSchema; /* Causes schema cookie check after an error */
+ u8 nested; /* Number of nested calls to the parser/code generator */
+ u8 nTempReg; /* Number of temporary registers in aTempReg[] */
+ u8 isMultiWrite; /* True if statement may modify/insert multiple rows */
+ u8 mayAbort; /* True if statement may throw an ABORT exception */
+ u8 hasCompound; /* Need to invoke convertCompoundSelectToSubquery() */
+ u8 okConstFactor; /* OK to factor out constants */
+ u8 disableLookaside; /* Number of times lookaside has been disabled */
+ u8 disableVtab; /* Disable all virtual tables for this parse */
+ int nRangeReg; /* Size of the temporary register block */
+ int iRangeReg; /* First register in temporary register block */
+ int nErr; /* Number of errors seen */
+ int nTab; /* Number of previously allocated VDBE cursors */
+ int nMem; /* Number of memory cells used so far */
+ int szOpAlloc; /* Bytes of memory space allocated for Vdbe.aOp[] */
+ int iSelfTab; /* Table associated with an index on expr, or negative
+ ** of the base register during check-constraint eval */
+ int nLabel; /* The *negative* of the number of labels used */
+ int nLabelAlloc; /* Number of slots in aLabel */
+ int *aLabel; /* Space to hold the labels */
+ ExprList *pConstExpr;/* Constant expressions */
+ Token constraintName;/* Name of the constraint currently being parsed */
+ yDbMask writeMask; /* Start a write transaction on these databases */
+ yDbMask cookieMask; /* Bitmask of schema verified databases */
+ int regRowid; /* Register holding rowid of CREATE TABLE entry */
+ int regRoot; /* Register holding root page number for new objects */
+ int nMaxArg; /* Max args passed to user function by sub-program */
+ int nSelect; /* Number of SELECT stmts. Counter for Select.selId */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE
+ int nTableLock; /* Number of locks in aTableLock */
+ TableLock *aTableLock; /* Required table locks for shared-cache mode */
+#endif
+ AutoincInfo *pAinc; /* Information about AUTOINCREMENT counters */
+ Parse *pToplevel; /* Parse structure for main program (or NULL) */
+ Table *pTriggerTab; /* Table triggers are being coded for */
+ Parse *pParentParse; /* Parent parser if this parser is nested */
+ AggInfo *pAggList; /* List of all AggInfo objects */
+ int addrCrTab; /* Address of OP_CreateBtree opcode on CREATE TABLE */
+ u32 nQueryLoop; /* Est number of iterations of a query (10*log2(N)) */
+ u32 oldmask; /* Mask of old.* columns referenced */
+ u32 newmask; /* Mask of new.* columns referenced */
+ u8 eTriggerOp; /* TK_UPDATE, TK_INSERT or TK_DELETE */
+ u8 eOrconf; /* Default ON CONFLICT policy for trigger steps */
+ u8 disableTriggers; /* True to disable triggers */
+
+ /**************************************************************************
+ ** Fields above must be initialized to zero. The fields that follow,
+ ** down to the beginning of the recursive section, do not need to be
+ ** initialized as they will be set before being used. The boundary is
+ ** determined by offsetof(Parse,aTempReg).
+ **************************************************************************/
+
+ int aTempReg[8]; /* Holding area for temporary registers */
+ Token sNameToken; /* Token with unqualified schema object name */
+
+ /************************************************************************
+ ** Above is constant between recursions. Below is reset before and after
+ ** each recursion. The boundary between these two regions is determined
+ ** using offsetof(Parse,sLastToken) so the sLastToken field must be the
+ ** first field in the recursive region.
+ ************************************************************************/
+
+ Token sLastToken; /* The last token parsed */
+ ynVar nVar; /* Number of '?' variables seen in the SQL so far */
+ u8 iPkSortOrder; /* ASC or DESC for INTEGER PRIMARY KEY */
+ u8 explain; /* True if the EXPLAIN flag is found on the query */
+ u8 eParseMode; /* PARSE_MODE_XXX constant */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+ int nVtabLock; /* Number of virtual tables to lock */
+#endif
+ int nHeight; /* Expression tree height of current sub-select */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN
+ int addrExplain; /* Address of current OP_Explain opcode */
+#endif
+ VList *pVList; /* Mapping between variable names and numbers */
+ Vdbe *pReprepare; /* VM being reprepared (sqlite3Reprepare()) */
+ const char *zTail; /* All SQL text past the last semicolon parsed */
+ Table *pNewTable; /* A table being constructed by CREATE TABLE */
+ Index *pNewIndex; /* An index being constructed by CREATE INDEX.
+ ** Also used to hold redundant UNIQUE constraints
+ ** during a RENAME COLUMN */
+ Trigger *pNewTrigger; /* Trigger under construct by a CREATE TRIGGER */
+ const char *zAuthContext; /* The 6th parameter to db->xAuth callbacks */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+ Token sArg; /* Complete text of a module argument */
+ Table **apVtabLock; /* Pointer to virtual tables needing locking */
+#endif
+ Table *pZombieTab; /* List of Table objects to delete after code gen */
+ TriggerPrg *pTriggerPrg; /* Linked list of coded triggers */
+ With *pWith; /* Current WITH clause, or NULL */
+ With *pWithToFree; /* Free this WITH object at the end of the parse */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_ALTERTABLE
+ RenameToken *pRename; /* Tokens subject to renaming by ALTER TABLE */
+#endif
+};
+
+#define PARSE_MODE_NORMAL 0
+#define PARSE_MODE_DECLARE_VTAB 1
+#define PARSE_MODE_RENAME 2
+#define PARSE_MODE_UNMAP 3
+
+/*
+** Sizes and pointers of various parts of the Parse object.
+*/
+#define PARSE_HDR_SZ offsetof(Parse,aTempReg) /* Recursive part w/o aColCache*/
+#define PARSE_RECURSE_SZ offsetof(Parse,sLastToken) /* Recursive part */
+#define PARSE_TAIL_SZ (sizeof(Parse)-PARSE_RECURSE_SZ) /* Non-recursive part */
+#define PARSE_TAIL(X) (((char*)(X))+PARSE_RECURSE_SZ) /* Pointer to tail */
+
+/*
+** Return true if currently inside an sqlite3_declare_vtab() call.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+ #define IN_DECLARE_VTAB 0
+#else
+ #define IN_DECLARE_VTAB (pParse->eParseMode==PARSE_MODE_DECLARE_VTAB)
+#endif
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_OMIT_ALTERTABLE)
+ #define IN_RENAME_OBJECT 0
+#else
+ #define IN_RENAME_OBJECT (pParse->eParseMode>=PARSE_MODE_RENAME)
+#endif
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE) && defined(SQLITE_OMIT_ALTERTABLE)
+ #define IN_SPECIAL_PARSE 0
+#else
+ #define IN_SPECIAL_PARSE (pParse->eParseMode!=PARSE_MODE_NORMAL)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** An instance of the following structure can be declared on a stack and used
+** to save the Parse.zAuthContext value so that it can be restored later.
+*/
+struct AuthContext {
+ const char *zAuthContext; /* Put saved Parse.zAuthContext here */
+ Parse *pParse; /* The Parse structure */
+};
+
+/*
+** Bitfield flags for P5 value in various opcodes.
+**
+** Value constraints (enforced via assert()):
+** OPFLAG_LENGTHARG == SQLITE_FUNC_LENGTH
+** OPFLAG_TYPEOFARG == SQLITE_FUNC_TYPEOF
+** OPFLAG_BULKCSR == BTREE_BULKLOAD
+** OPFLAG_SEEKEQ == BTREE_SEEK_EQ
+** OPFLAG_FORDELETE == BTREE_FORDELETE
+** OPFLAG_SAVEPOSITION == BTREE_SAVEPOSITION
+** OPFLAG_AUXDELETE == BTREE_AUXDELETE
+*/
+#define OPFLAG_NCHANGE 0x01 /* OP_Insert: Set to update db->nChange */
+ /* Also used in P2 (not P5) of OP_Delete */
+#define OPFLAG_NOCHNG 0x01 /* OP_VColumn nochange for UPDATE */
+#define OPFLAG_EPHEM 0x01 /* OP_Column: Ephemeral output is ok */
+#define OPFLAG_LASTROWID 0x20 /* Set to update db->lastRowid */
+#define OPFLAG_ISUPDATE 0x04 /* This OP_Insert is an sql UPDATE */
+#define OPFLAG_APPEND 0x08 /* This is likely to be an append */
+#define OPFLAG_USESEEKRESULT 0x10 /* Try to avoid a seek in BtreeInsert() */
+#define OPFLAG_ISNOOP 0x40 /* OP_Delete does pre-update-hook only */
+#define OPFLAG_LENGTHARG 0x40 /* OP_Column only used for length() */
+#define OPFLAG_TYPEOFARG 0x80 /* OP_Column only used for typeof() */
+#define OPFLAG_BULKCSR 0x01 /* OP_Open** used to open bulk cursor */
+#define OPFLAG_SEEKEQ 0x02 /* OP_Open** cursor uses EQ seek only */
+#define OPFLAG_FORDELETE 0x08 /* OP_Open should use BTREE_FORDELETE */
+#define OPFLAG_P2ISREG 0x10 /* P2 to OP_Open** is a register number */
+#define OPFLAG_PERMUTE 0x01 /* OP_Compare: use the permutation */
+#define OPFLAG_SAVEPOSITION 0x02 /* OP_Delete/Insert: save cursor pos */
+#define OPFLAG_AUXDELETE 0x04 /* OP_Delete: index in a DELETE op */
+#define OPFLAG_NOCHNG_MAGIC 0x6d /* OP_MakeRecord: serialtype 10 is ok */
+
+/*
+ * Each trigger present in the database schema is stored as an instance of
+ * struct Trigger.
+ *
+ * Pointers to instances of struct Trigger are stored in two ways.
+ * 1. In the "trigHash" hash table (part of the sqlite3* that represents the
+ * database). This allows Trigger structures to be retrieved by name.
+ * 2. All triggers associated with a single table form a linked list, using the
+ * pNext member of struct Trigger. A pointer to the first element of the
+ * linked list is stored as the "pTrigger" member of the associated
+ * struct Table.
+ *
+ * The "step_list" member points to the first element of a linked list
+ * containing the SQL statements specified as the trigger program.
+ */
+struct Trigger {
+ char *zName; /* The name of the trigger */
+ char *table; /* The table or view to which the trigger applies */
+ u8 op; /* One of TK_DELETE, TK_UPDATE, TK_INSERT */
+ u8 tr_tm; /* One of TRIGGER_BEFORE, TRIGGER_AFTER */
+ Expr *pWhen; /* The WHEN clause of the expression (may be NULL) */
+ IdList *pColumns; /* If this is an UPDATE OF trigger,
+ the is stored here */
+ Schema *pSchema; /* Schema containing the trigger */
+ Schema *pTabSchema; /* Schema containing the table */
+ TriggerStep *step_list; /* Link list of trigger program steps */
+ Trigger *pNext; /* Next trigger associated with the table */
+};
+
+/*
+** A trigger is either a BEFORE or an AFTER trigger. The following constants
+** determine which.
+**
+** If there are multiple triggers, you might of some BEFORE and some AFTER.
+** In that cases, the constants below can be ORed together.
+*/
+#define TRIGGER_BEFORE 1
+#define TRIGGER_AFTER 2
+
+/*
+ * An instance of struct TriggerStep is used to store a single SQL statement
+ * that is a part of a trigger-program.
+ *
+ * Instances of struct TriggerStep are stored in a singly linked list (linked
+ * using the "pNext" member) referenced by the "step_list" member of the
+ * associated struct Trigger instance. The first element of the linked list is
+ * the first step of the trigger-program.
+ *
+ * The "op" member indicates whether this is a "DELETE", "INSERT", "UPDATE" or
+ * "SELECT" statement. The meanings of the other members is determined by the
+ * value of "op" as follows:
+ *
+ * (op == TK_INSERT)
+ * orconf -> stores the ON CONFLICT algorithm
+ * pSelect -> If this is an INSERT INTO ... SELECT ... statement, then
+ * this stores a pointer to the SELECT statement. Otherwise NULL.
+ * zTarget -> Dequoted name of the table to insert into.
+ * pExprList -> If this is an INSERT INTO ... VALUES ... statement, then
+ * this stores values to be inserted. Otherwise NULL.
+ * pIdList -> If this is an INSERT INTO ... () VALUES ...
+ * statement, then this stores the column-names to be
+ * inserted into.
+ *
+ * (op == TK_DELETE)
+ * zTarget -> Dequoted name of the table to delete from.
+ * pWhere -> The WHERE clause of the DELETE statement if one is specified.
+ * Otherwise NULL.
+ *
+ * (op == TK_UPDATE)
+ * zTarget -> Dequoted name of the table to update.
+ * pWhere -> The WHERE clause of the UPDATE statement if one is specified.
+ * Otherwise NULL.
+ * pExprList -> A list of the columns to update and the expressions to update
+ * them to. See sqlite3Update() documentation of "pChanges"
+ * argument.
+ *
+ */
+struct TriggerStep {
+ u8 op; /* One of TK_DELETE, TK_UPDATE, TK_INSERT, TK_SELECT */
+ u8 orconf; /* OE_Rollback etc. */
+ Trigger *pTrig; /* The trigger that this step is a part of */
+ Select *pSelect; /* SELECT statement or RHS of INSERT INTO SELECT ... */
+ char *zTarget; /* Target table for DELETE, UPDATE, INSERT */
+ SrcList *pFrom; /* FROM clause for UPDATE statement (if any) */
+ Expr *pWhere; /* The WHERE clause for DELETE or UPDATE steps */
+ ExprList *pExprList; /* SET clause for UPDATE */
+ IdList *pIdList; /* Column names for INSERT */
+ Upsert *pUpsert; /* Upsert clauses on an INSERT */
+ char *zSpan; /* Original SQL text of this command */
+ TriggerStep *pNext; /* Next in the link-list */
+ TriggerStep *pLast; /* Last element in link-list. Valid for 1st elem only */
+};
+
+/*
+** The following structure contains information used by the sqliteFix...
+** routines as they walk the parse tree to make database references
+** explicit.
+*/
+typedef struct DbFixer DbFixer;
+struct DbFixer {
+ Parse *pParse; /* The parsing context. Error messages written here */
+ Schema *pSchema; /* Fix items to this schema */
+ u8 bTemp; /* True for TEMP schema entries */
+ const char *zDb; /* Make sure all objects are contained in this database */
+ const char *zType; /* Type of the container - used for error messages */
+ const Token *pName; /* Name of the container - used for error messages */
+};
+
+/*
+** An objected used to accumulate the text of a string where we
+** do not necessarily know how big the string will be in the end.
+*/
+struct sqlite3_str {
+ sqlite3 *db; /* Optional database for lookaside. Can be NULL */
+ char *zText; /* The string collected so far */
+ u32 nAlloc; /* Amount of space allocated in zText */
+ u32 mxAlloc; /* Maximum allowed allocation. 0 for no malloc usage */
+ u32 nChar; /* Length of the string so far */
+ u8 accError; /* SQLITE_NOMEM or SQLITE_TOOBIG */
+ u8 printfFlags; /* SQLITE_PRINTF flags below */
+};
+#define SQLITE_PRINTF_INTERNAL 0x01 /* Internal-use-only converters allowed */
+#define SQLITE_PRINTF_SQLFUNC 0x02 /* SQL function arguments to VXPrintf */
+#define SQLITE_PRINTF_MALLOCED 0x04 /* True if xText is allocated space */
+
+#define isMalloced(X) (((X)->printfFlags & SQLITE_PRINTF_MALLOCED)!=0)
+
+
+/*
+** A pointer to this structure is used to communicate information
+** from sqlite3Init and OP_ParseSchema into the sqlite3InitCallback.
+*/
+typedef struct {
+ sqlite3 *db; /* The database being initialized */
+ char **pzErrMsg; /* Error message stored here */
+ int iDb; /* 0 for main database. 1 for TEMP, 2.. for ATTACHed */
+ int rc; /* Result code stored here */
+ u32 mInitFlags; /* Flags controlling error messages */
+ u32 nInitRow; /* Number of rows processed */
+ Pgno mxPage; /* Maximum page number. 0 for no limit. */
+} InitData;
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for mInitFlags
+*/
+#define INITFLAG_AlterTable 0x0001 /* This is a reparse after ALTER TABLE */
+
+/*
+** Structure containing global configuration data for the SQLite library.
+**
+** This structure also contains some state information.
+*/
+struct Sqlite3Config {
+ int bMemstat; /* True to enable memory status */
+ u8 bCoreMutex; /* True to enable core mutexing */
+ u8 bFullMutex; /* True to enable full mutexing */
+ u8 bOpenUri; /* True to interpret filenames as URIs */
+ u8 bUseCis; /* Use covering indices for full-scans */
+ u8 bSmallMalloc; /* Avoid large memory allocations if true */
+ u8 bExtraSchemaChecks; /* Verify type,name,tbl_name in schema */
+ int mxStrlen; /* Maximum string length */
+ int neverCorrupt; /* Database is always well-formed */
+ int szLookaside; /* Default lookaside buffer size */
+ int nLookaside; /* Default lookaside buffer count */
+ int nStmtSpill; /* Stmt-journal spill-to-disk threshold */
+ sqlite3_mem_methods m; /* Low-level memory allocation interface */
+ sqlite3_mutex_methods mutex; /* Low-level mutex interface */
+ sqlite3_pcache_methods2 pcache2; /* Low-level page-cache interface */
+ void *pHeap; /* Heap storage space */
+ int nHeap; /* Size of pHeap[] */
+ int mnReq, mxReq; /* Min and max heap requests sizes */
+ sqlite3_int64 szMmap; /* mmap() space per open file */
+ sqlite3_int64 mxMmap; /* Maximum value for szMmap */
+ void *pPage; /* Page cache memory */
+ int szPage; /* Size of each page in pPage[] */
+ int nPage; /* Number of pages in pPage[] */
+ int mxParserStack; /* maximum depth of the parser stack */
+ int sharedCacheEnabled; /* true if shared-cache mode enabled */
+ u32 szPma; /* Maximum Sorter PMA size */
+ /* The above might be initialized to non-zero. The following need to always
+ ** initially be zero, however. */
+ int isInit; /* True after initialization has finished */
+ int inProgress; /* True while initialization in progress */
+ int isMutexInit; /* True after mutexes are initialized */
+ int isMallocInit; /* True after malloc is initialized */
+ int isPCacheInit; /* True after malloc is initialized */
+ int nRefInitMutex; /* Number of users of pInitMutex */
+ sqlite3_mutex *pInitMutex; /* Mutex used by sqlite3_initialize() */
+ void (*xLog)(void*,int,const char*); /* Function for logging */
+ void *pLogArg; /* First argument to xLog() */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_SQLLOG
+ void(*xSqllog)(void*,sqlite3*,const char*, int);
+ void *pSqllogArg;
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_VDBE_COVERAGE
+ /* The following callback (if not NULL) is invoked on every VDBE branch
+ ** operation. Set the callback using SQLITE_TESTCTRL_VDBE_COVERAGE.
+ */
+ void (*xVdbeBranch)(void*,unsigned iSrcLine,u8 eThis,u8 eMx); /* Callback */
+ void *pVdbeBranchArg; /* 1st argument */
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_DESERIALIZE
+ sqlite3_int64 mxMemdbSize; /* Default max memdb size */
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+ int (*xTestCallback)(int); /* Invoked by sqlite3FaultSim() */
+#endif
+ int bLocaltimeFault; /* True to fail localtime() calls */
+ int iOnceResetThreshold; /* When to reset OP_Once counters */
+ u32 szSorterRef; /* Min size in bytes to use sorter-refs */
+ unsigned int iPrngSeed; /* Alternative fixed seed for the PRNG */
+};
+
+/*
+** This macro is used inside of assert() statements to indicate that
+** the assert is only valid on a well-formed database. Instead of:
+**
+** assert( X );
+**
+** One writes:
+**
+** assert( X || CORRUPT_DB );
+**
+** CORRUPT_DB is true during normal operation. CORRUPT_DB does not indicate
+** that the database is definitely corrupt, only that it might be corrupt.
+** For most test cases, CORRUPT_DB is set to false using a special
+** sqlite3_test_control(). This enables assert() statements to prove
+** things that are always true for well-formed databases.
+*/
+#define CORRUPT_DB (sqlite3Config.neverCorrupt==0)
+
+/*
+** Context pointer passed down through the tree-walk.
+*/
+struct Walker {
+ Parse *pParse; /* Parser context. */
+ int (*xExprCallback)(Walker*, Expr*); /* Callback for expressions */
+ int (*xSelectCallback)(Walker*,Select*); /* Callback for SELECTs */
+ void (*xSelectCallback2)(Walker*,Select*);/* Second callback for SELECTs */
+ int walkerDepth; /* Number of subqueries */
+ u16 eCode; /* A small processing code */
+ union { /* Extra data for callback */
+ NameContext *pNC; /* Naming context */
+ int n; /* A counter */
+ int iCur; /* A cursor number */
+ SrcList *pSrcList; /* FROM clause */
+ struct SrcCount *pSrcCount; /* Counting column references */
+ struct CCurHint *pCCurHint; /* Used by codeCursorHint() */
+ int *aiCol; /* array of column indexes */
+ struct IdxCover *pIdxCover; /* Check for index coverage */
+ struct IdxExprTrans *pIdxTrans; /* Convert idxed expr to column */
+ ExprList *pGroupBy; /* GROUP BY clause */
+ Select *pSelect; /* HAVING to WHERE clause ctx */
+ struct WindowRewrite *pRewrite; /* Window rewrite context */
+ struct WhereConst *pConst; /* WHERE clause constants */
+ struct RenameCtx *pRename; /* RENAME COLUMN context */
+ struct Table *pTab; /* Table of generated column */
+ struct SrcList_item *pSrcItem; /* A single FROM clause item */
+ } u;
+};
+
+/* Forward declarations */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalkExpr(Walker*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalkExprList(Walker*, ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalkSelect(Walker*, Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalkSelectExpr(Walker*, Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalkSelectFrom(Walker*, Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprWalkNoop(Walker*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SelectWalkNoop(Walker*, Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SelectWalkFail(Walker*, Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalkerDepthIncrease(Walker*,Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WalkerDepthDecrease(Walker*,Select*);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SelectWalkAssert2(Walker*, Select*);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Return code from the parse-tree walking primitives and their
+** callbacks.
+*/
+#define WRC_Continue 0 /* Continue down into children */
+#define WRC_Prune 1 /* Omit children but continue walking siblings */
+#define WRC_Abort 2 /* Abandon the tree walk */
+
+/*
+** An instance of this structure represents a set of one or more CTEs
+** (common table expressions) created by a single WITH clause.
+*/
+struct With {
+ int nCte; /* Number of CTEs in the WITH clause */
+ With *pOuter; /* Containing WITH clause, or NULL */
+ struct Cte { /* For each CTE in the WITH clause.... */
+ char *zName; /* Name of this CTE */
+ ExprList *pCols; /* List of explicit column names, or NULL */
+ Select *pSelect; /* The definition of this CTE */
+ const char *zCteErr; /* Error message for circular references */
+ } a[1];
+};
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+/*
+** An instance of the TreeView object is used for printing the content of
+** data structures on sqlite3DebugPrintf() using a tree-like view.
+*/
+struct TreeView {
+ int iLevel; /* Which level of the tree we are on */
+ u8 bLine[100]; /* Draw vertical in column i if bLine[i] is true */
+};
+#endif /* SQLITE_DEBUG */
+
+/*
+** This object is used in various ways, most (but not all) related to window
+** functions.
+**
+** (1) A single instance of this structure is attached to the
+** the Expr.y.pWin field for each window function in an expression tree.
+** This object holds the information contained in the OVER clause,
+** plus additional fields used during code generation.
+**
+** (2) All window functions in a single SELECT form a linked-list
+** attached to Select.pWin. The Window.pFunc and Window.pExpr
+** fields point back to the expression that is the window function.
+**
+** (3) The terms of the WINDOW clause of a SELECT are instances of this
+** object on a linked list attached to Select.pWinDefn.
+**
+** (4) For an aggregate function with a FILTER clause, an instance
+** of this object is stored in Expr.y.pWin with eFrmType set to
+** TK_FILTER. In this case the only field used is Window.pFilter.
+**
+** The uses (1) and (2) are really the same Window object that just happens
+** to be accessible in two different ways. Use case (3) are separate objects.
+*/
+struct Window {
+ char *zName; /* Name of window (may be NULL) */
+ char *zBase; /* Name of base window for chaining (may be NULL) */
+ ExprList *pPartition; /* PARTITION BY clause */
+ ExprList *pOrderBy; /* ORDER BY clause */
+ u8 eFrmType; /* TK_RANGE, TK_GROUPS, TK_ROWS, or 0 */
+ u8 eStart; /* UNBOUNDED, CURRENT, PRECEDING or FOLLOWING */
+ u8 eEnd; /* UNBOUNDED, CURRENT, PRECEDING or FOLLOWING */
+ u8 bImplicitFrame; /* True if frame was implicitly specified */
+ u8 eExclude; /* TK_NO, TK_CURRENT, TK_TIES, TK_GROUP, or 0 */
+ Expr *pStart; /* Expression for " PRECEDING" */
+ Expr *pEnd; /* Expression for " FOLLOWING" */
+ Window **ppThis; /* Pointer to this object in Select.pWin list */
+ Window *pNextWin; /* Next window function belonging to this SELECT */
+ Expr *pFilter; /* The FILTER expression */
+ FuncDef *pFunc; /* The function */
+ int iEphCsr; /* Partition buffer or Peer buffer */
+ int regAccum; /* Accumulator */
+ int regResult; /* Interim result */
+ int csrApp; /* Function cursor (used by min/max) */
+ int regApp; /* Function register (also used by min/max) */
+ int regPart; /* Array of registers for PARTITION BY values */
+ Expr *pOwner; /* Expression object this window is attached to */
+ int nBufferCol; /* Number of columns in buffer table */
+ int iArgCol; /* Offset of first argument for this function */
+ int regOne; /* Register containing constant value 1 */
+ int regStartRowid;
+ int regEndRowid;
+ u8 bExprArgs; /* Defer evaluation of window function arguments
+ ** due to the SQLITE_SUBTYPE flag */
+};
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WindowDelete(sqlite3*, Window*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WindowUnlinkFromSelect(Window*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WindowListDelete(sqlite3 *db, Window *p);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Window *sqlite3WindowAlloc(Parse*, int, int, Expr*, int , Expr*, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WindowAttach(Parse*, Expr*, Window*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WindowLink(Select *pSel, Window *pWin);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WindowCompare(Parse*, Window*, Window*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WindowCodeInit(Parse*, Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WindowCodeStep(Parse*, Select*, WhereInfo*, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WindowRewrite(Parse*, Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExpandSubquery(Parse*, struct SrcList_item*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WindowUpdate(Parse*, Window*, Window*, FuncDef*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Window *sqlite3WindowDup(sqlite3 *db, Expr *pOwner, Window *p);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Window *sqlite3WindowListDup(sqlite3 *db, Window *p);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WindowFunctions(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WindowChain(Parse*, Window*, Window*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Window *sqlite3WindowAssemble(Parse*, Window*, ExprList*, ExprList*, Token*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3WindowDelete(a,b)
+# define sqlite3WindowFunctions()
+# define sqlite3WindowAttach(a,b,c)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Assuming zIn points to the first byte of a UTF-8 character,
+** advance zIn to point to the first byte of the next UTF-8 character.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_SKIP_UTF8(zIn) { \
+ if( (*(zIn++))>=0xc0 ){ \
+ while( (*zIn & 0xc0)==0x80 ){ zIn++; } \
+ } \
+}
+
+/*
+** The SQLITE_*_BKPT macros are substitutes for the error codes with
+** the same name but without the _BKPT suffix. These macros invoke
+** routines that report the line-number on which the error originated
+** using sqlite3_log(). The routines also provide a convenient place
+** to set a debugger breakpoint.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ReportError(int iErr, int lineno, const char *zType);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3CorruptError(int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MisuseError(int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3CantopenError(int);
+#define SQLITE_CORRUPT_BKPT sqlite3CorruptError(__LINE__)
+#define SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT sqlite3MisuseError(__LINE__)
+#define SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT sqlite3CantopenError(__LINE__)
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3NomemError(int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IoerrnomemError(int);
+# define SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT sqlite3NomemError(__LINE__)
+# define SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT sqlite3IoerrnomemError(__LINE__)
+#else
+# define SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT SQLITE_NOMEM
+# define SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_CORRUPT_PGNO)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3CorruptPgnoError(int,Pgno);
+# define SQLITE_CORRUPT_PGNO(P) sqlite3CorruptPgnoError(__LINE__,(P))
+#else
+# define SQLITE_CORRUPT_PGNO(P) sqlite3CorruptError(__LINE__)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** FTS3 and FTS4 both require virtual table support
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE)
+# undef SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS3
+# undef SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS4
+#endif
+
+/*
+** FTS4 is really an extension for FTS3. It is enabled using the
+** SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS3 macro. But to avoid confusion we also call
+** the SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS4 macro to serve as an alias for SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS3.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS4) && !defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS3)
+# define SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS3 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The ctype.h header is needed for non-ASCII systems. It is also
+** needed by FTS3 when FTS3 is included in the amalgamation.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_ASCII) || \
+ (defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_FTS3) && defined(SQLITE_AMALGAMATION))
+# include
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The following macros mimic the standard library functions toupper(),
+** isspace(), isalnum(), isdigit() and isxdigit(), respectively. The
+** sqlite versions only work for ASCII characters, regardless of locale.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_ASCII
+# define sqlite3Toupper(x) ((x)&~(sqlite3CtypeMap[(unsigned char)(x)]&0x20))
+# define sqlite3Isspace(x) (sqlite3CtypeMap[(unsigned char)(x)]&0x01)
+# define sqlite3Isalnum(x) (sqlite3CtypeMap[(unsigned char)(x)]&0x06)
+# define sqlite3Isalpha(x) (sqlite3CtypeMap[(unsigned char)(x)]&0x02)
+# define sqlite3Isdigit(x) (sqlite3CtypeMap[(unsigned char)(x)]&0x04)
+# define sqlite3Isxdigit(x) (sqlite3CtypeMap[(unsigned char)(x)]&0x08)
+# define sqlite3Tolower(x) (sqlite3UpperToLower[(unsigned char)(x)])
+# define sqlite3Isquote(x) (sqlite3CtypeMap[(unsigned char)(x)]&0x80)
+#else
+# define sqlite3Toupper(x) toupper((unsigned char)(x))
+# define sqlite3Isspace(x) isspace((unsigned char)(x))
+# define sqlite3Isalnum(x) isalnum((unsigned char)(x))
+# define sqlite3Isalpha(x) isalpha((unsigned char)(x))
+# define sqlite3Isdigit(x) isdigit((unsigned char)(x))
+# define sqlite3Isxdigit(x) isxdigit((unsigned char)(x))
+# define sqlite3Tolower(x) tolower((unsigned char)(x))
+# define sqlite3Isquote(x) ((x)=='"'||(x)=='\''||(x)=='['||(x)=='`')
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IsIdChar(u8);
+
+/*
+** Internal function prototypes
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3StrICmp(const char*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Strlen30(const char*);
+#define sqlite3Strlen30NN(C) (strlen(C)&0x3fffffff)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3ColumnType(Column*,char*);
+#define sqlite3StrNICmp sqlite3_strnicmp
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MallocInit(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MallocEnd(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3Malloc(u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3MallocZero(u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3DbMallocZero(sqlite3*, u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3DbMallocRaw(sqlite3*, u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3DbMallocRawNN(sqlite3*, u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3DbStrDup(sqlite3*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3DbStrNDup(sqlite3*,const char*, u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3DbSpanDup(sqlite3*,const char*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3Realloc(void*, u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3DbReallocOrFree(sqlite3 *, void *, u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3DbRealloc(sqlite3 *, void *, u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DbFree(sqlite3*, void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DbFreeNN(sqlite3*, void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MallocSize(void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3DbMallocSize(sqlite3*, void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3PageMalloc(int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PageFree(void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemSetDefault(void);
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BenignMallocHooks(void (*)(void), void (*)(void));
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3HeapNearlyFull(void);
+
+/*
+** On systems with ample stack space and that support alloca(), make
+** use of alloca() to obtain space for large automatic objects. By default,
+** obtain space from malloc().
+**
+** The alloca() routine never returns NULL. This will cause code paths
+** that deal with sqlite3StackAlloc() failures to be unreachable.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_USE_ALLOCA
+# define sqlite3StackAllocRaw(D,N) alloca(N)
+# define sqlite3StackAllocZero(D,N) memset(alloca(N), 0, N)
+# define sqlite3StackFree(D,P)
+#else
+# define sqlite3StackAllocRaw(D,N) sqlite3DbMallocRaw(D,N)
+# define sqlite3StackAllocZero(D,N) sqlite3DbMallocZero(D,N)
+# define sqlite3StackFree(D,P) sqlite3DbFree(D,P)
+#endif
+
+/* Do not allow both MEMSYS5 and MEMSYS3 to be defined together. If they
+** are, disable MEMSYS3
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS5
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const sqlite3_mem_methods *sqlite3MemGetMemsys5(void);
+#undef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS3
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS3
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const sqlite3_mem_methods *sqlite3MemGetMemsys3(void);
+#endif
+
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex_methods const *sqlite3DefaultMutex(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex_methods const *sqlite3NoopMutex(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex *sqlite3MutexAlloc(int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MutexInit(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MutexEnd(void);
+#endif
+#if !defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT) && !defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemoryBarrier(void);
+#else
+# define sqlite3MemoryBarrier()
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_int64 sqlite3StatusValue(int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3StatusUp(int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3StatusDown(int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3StatusHighwater(int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3LookasideUsed(sqlite3*,int*);
+
+/* Access to mutexes used by sqlite3_status() */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex *sqlite3Pcache1Mutex(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex *sqlite3MallocMutex(void);
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_MULTITHREADED_CHECKS) && !defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MutexWarnOnContention(sqlite3_mutex*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3MutexWarnOnContention(x)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+# define EXP754 (((u64)0x7ff)<<52)
+# define MAN754 ((((u64)1)<<52)-1)
+# define IsNaN(X) (((X)&EXP754)==EXP754 && ((X)&MAN754)!=0)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IsNaN(double);
+#else
+# define IsNaN(X) 0
+# define sqlite3IsNaN(X) 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** An instance of the following structure holds information about SQL
+** functions arguments that are the parameters to the printf() function.
+*/
+struct PrintfArguments {
+ int nArg; /* Total number of arguments */
+ int nUsed; /* Number of arguments used so far */
+ sqlite3_value **apArg; /* The argument values */
+};
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3MPrintf(sqlite3*,const char*, ...);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3VMPrintf(sqlite3*,const char*, va_list);
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_HAVE_OS_TRACE)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DebugPrintf(const char*, ...);
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3TestTextToPtr(const char*);
+#endif
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewExpr(TreeView*, const Expr*, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewBareExprList(TreeView*, const ExprList*, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewExprList(TreeView*, const ExprList*, u8, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewSrcList(TreeView*, const SrcList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewSelect(TreeView*, const Select*, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewWith(TreeView*, const With*, u8);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewWindow(TreeView*, const Window*, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewWinFunc(TreeView*, const Window*, u8);
+#endif
+#endif
+
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SetString(char **, sqlite3*, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ErrorMsg(Parse*, const char*, ...);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ErrorToParser(sqlite3*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Dequote(char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DequoteExpr(Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TokenInit(Token*,char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3KeywordCode(const unsigned char*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3RunParser(Parse*, const char*, char **);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3FinishCoding(Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3GetTempReg(Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ReleaseTempReg(Parse*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3GetTempRange(Parse*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ReleaseTempRange(Parse*,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ClearTempRegCache(Parse*);
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3NoTempsInRange(Parse*,int,int);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3ExprAlloc(sqlite3*,int,const Token*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3Expr(sqlite3*,int,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprAttachSubtrees(sqlite3*,Expr*,Expr*,Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3PExpr(Parse*, int, Expr*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PExprAddSelect(Parse*, Expr*, Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3ExprAnd(Parse*,Expr*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3ExprSimplifiedAndOr(Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3ExprFunction(Parse*,ExprList*, Token*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprFunctionUsable(Parse*,Expr*,FuncDef*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprAssignVarNumber(Parse*, Expr*, u32);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprDelete(sqlite3*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprUnmapAndDelete(Parse*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE ExprList *sqlite3ExprListAppend(Parse*,ExprList*,Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE ExprList *sqlite3ExprListAppendVector(Parse*,ExprList*,IdList*,Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprListSetSortOrder(ExprList*,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprListSetName(Parse*,ExprList*,Token*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprListSetSpan(Parse*,ExprList*,const char*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprListDelete(sqlite3*, ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3ExprListFlags(const ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IndexHasDuplicateRootPage(Index*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Init(sqlite3*, char**);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3InitCallback(void*, int, char**, char**);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3InitOne(sqlite3*, int, char**, u32);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Pragma(Parse*,Token*,Token*,Token*,int);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Module *sqlite3PragmaVtabRegister(sqlite3*,const char *zName);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ResetAllSchemasOfConnection(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ResetOneSchema(sqlite3*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CollapseDatabaseArray(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CommitInternalChanges(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DeleteColumnNames(sqlite3*,Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ColumnsFromExprList(Parse*,ExprList*,i16*,Column**);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SelectAddColumnTypeAndCollation(Parse*,Table*,Select*,char);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Table *sqlite3ResultSetOfSelect(Parse*,Select*,char);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OpenSchemaTable(Parse *, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Index *sqlite3PrimaryKeyIndex(Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE i16 sqlite3TableColumnToIndex(Index*, i16);
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_GENERATED_COLUMNS
+# define sqlite3TableColumnToStorage(T,X) (X) /* No-op pass-through */
+# define sqlite3StorageColumnToTable(T,X) (X) /* No-op pass-through */
+#else
+SQLITE_PRIVATE i16 sqlite3TableColumnToStorage(Table*, i16);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE i16 sqlite3StorageColumnToTable(Table*, i16);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3StartTable(Parse*,Token*,Token*,int,int,int,int);
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_HIDDEN_COLUMNS
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ColumnPropertiesFromName(Table*, Column*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3ColumnPropertiesFromName(T,C) /* no-op */
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AddColumn(Parse*,Token*,Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AddNotNull(Parse*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AddPrimaryKey(Parse*, ExprList*, int, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AddCheckConstraint(Parse*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AddDefaultValue(Parse*,Expr*,const char*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AddCollateType(Parse*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AddGenerated(Parse*,Expr*,Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3EndTable(Parse*,Token*,Token*,u8,Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ParseUri(const char*,const char*,unsigned int*,
+ sqlite3_vfs**,char**,char **);
+#define sqlite3CodecQueryParameters(A,B,C) 0
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Btree *sqlite3DbNameToBtree(sqlite3*,const char*);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+# define sqlite3FaultSim(X) SQLITE_OK
+#else
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FaultSim(int);
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Bitvec *sqlite3BitvecCreate(u32);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BitvecTest(Bitvec*, u32);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BitvecTestNotNull(Bitvec*, u32);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BitvecSet(Bitvec*, u32);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BitvecClear(Bitvec*, u32, void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BitvecDestroy(Bitvec*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3BitvecSize(Bitvec*);
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BitvecBuiltinTest(int,int*);
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE RowSet *sqlite3RowSetInit(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RowSetDelete(void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RowSetClear(void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RowSetInsert(RowSet*, i64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3RowSetTest(RowSet*, int iBatch, i64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3RowSetNext(RowSet*, i64*);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CreateView(Parse*,Token*,Token*,Token*,ExprList*,Select*,int,int);
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_VIEW) || !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ViewGetColumnNames(Parse*,Table*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3ViewGetColumnNames(A,B) 0
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_ATTACHED>30
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3DbMaskAllZero(yDbMask);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DropTable(Parse*, SrcList*, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CodeDropTable(Parse*, Table*, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DeleteTable(sqlite3*, Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3FreeIndex(sqlite3*, Index*);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINCREMENT
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AutoincrementBegin(Parse *pParse);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AutoincrementEnd(Parse *pParse);
+#else
+# define sqlite3AutoincrementBegin(X)
+# define sqlite3AutoincrementEnd(X)
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Insert(Parse*, SrcList*, Select*, IdList*, int, Upsert*);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_GENERATED_COLUMNS
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ComputeGeneratedColumns(Parse*, int, Table*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3ArrayAllocate(sqlite3*,void*,int,int*,int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE IdList *sqlite3IdListAppend(Parse*, IdList*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IdListIndex(IdList*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE SrcList *sqlite3SrcListEnlarge(Parse*, SrcList*, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE SrcList *sqlite3SrcListAppendList(Parse *pParse, SrcList *p1, SrcList *p2);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE SrcList *sqlite3SrcListAppend(Parse*, SrcList*, Token*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE SrcList *sqlite3SrcListAppendFromTerm(Parse*, SrcList*, Token*, Token*,
+ Token*, Select*, Expr*, IdList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SrcListIndexedBy(Parse *, SrcList *, Token *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SrcListFuncArgs(Parse*, SrcList*, ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IndexedByLookup(Parse *, struct SrcList_item *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SrcListShiftJoinType(SrcList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SrcListAssignCursors(Parse*, SrcList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3IdListDelete(sqlite3*, IdList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SrcListDelete(sqlite3*, SrcList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Index *sqlite3AllocateIndexObject(sqlite3*,i16,int,char**);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CreateIndex(Parse*,Token*,Token*,SrcList*,ExprList*,int,Token*,
+ Expr*, int, int, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DropIndex(Parse*, SrcList*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Select(Parse*, Select*, SelectDest*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Select *sqlite3SelectNew(Parse*,ExprList*,SrcList*,Expr*,ExprList*,
+ Expr*,ExprList*,u32,Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SelectDelete(sqlite3*, Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Table *sqlite3SrcListLookup(Parse*, SrcList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IsReadOnly(Parse*, Table*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OpenTable(Parse*, int iCur, int iDb, Table*, int);
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_UPDATE_DELETE_LIMIT) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_SUBQUERY)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3LimitWhere(Parse*,SrcList*,Expr*,ExprList*,Expr*,char*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DeleteFrom(Parse*, SrcList*, Expr*, ExprList*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Update(Parse*, SrcList*, ExprList*,Expr*,int,ExprList*,Expr*,
+ Upsert*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE WhereInfo *sqlite3WhereBegin(Parse*,SrcList*,Expr*,ExprList*,ExprList*,u16,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WhereEnd(WhereInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE LogEst sqlite3WhereOutputRowCount(WhereInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WhereIsDistinct(WhereInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WhereIsOrdered(WhereInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WhereOrderByLimitOptLabel(WhereInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WhereIsSorted(WhereInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WhereContinueLabel(WhereInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WhereBreakLabel(WhereInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WhereOkOnePass(WhereInfo*, int*);
+#define ONEPASS_OFF 0 /* Use of ONEPASS not allowed */
+#define ONEPASS_SINGLE 1 /* ONEPASS valid for a single row update */
+#define ONEPASS_MULTI 2 /* ONEPASS is valid for multiple rows */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WhereUsesDeferredSeek(WhereInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprCodeLoadIndexColumn(Parse*, Index*, int, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCodeGetColumn(Parse*, Table*, int, int, int, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprCodeGetColumnOfTable(Vdbe*, Table*, int, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprCodeMove(Parse*, int, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprCode(Parse*, Expr*, int);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_GENERATED_COLUMNS
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprCodeGeneratedColumn(Parse*, Column*, int);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprCodeCopy(Parse*, Expr*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprCodeFactorable(Parse*, Expr*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCodeRunJustOnce(Parse*, Expr*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCodeTemp(Parse*, Expr*, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCodeTarget(Parse*, Expr*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCodeExprList(Parse*, ExprList*, int, int, u8);
+#define SQLITE_ECEL_DUP 0x01 /* Deep, not shallow copies */
+#define SQLITE_ECEL_FACTOR 0x02 /* Factor out constant terms */
+#define SQLITE_ECEL_REF 0x04 /* Use ExprList.u.x.iOrderByCol */
+#define SQLITE_ECEL_OMITREF 0x08 /* Omit if ExprList.u.x.iOrderByCol */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprIfTrue(Parse*, Expr*, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprIfFalse(Parse*, Expr*, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprIfFalseDup(Parse*, Expr*, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Table *sqlite3FindTable(sqlite3*,const char*, const char*);
+#define LOCATE_VIEW 0x01
+#define LOCATE_NOERR 0x02
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Table *sqlite3LocateTable(Parse*,u32 flags,const char*, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Table *sqlite3LocateTableItem(Parse*,u32 flags,struct SrcList_item *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Index *sqlite3FindIndex(sqlite3*,const char*, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3UnlinkAndDeleteTable(sqlite3*,int,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3UnlinkAndDeleteIndex(sqlite3*,int,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Vacuum(Parse*,Token*,Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3RunVacuum(char**, sqlite3*, int, sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3NameFromToken(sqlite3*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCompare(Parse*,Expr*, Expr*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCompareSkip(Expr*, Expr*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprListCompare(ExprList*, ExprList*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprImpliesExpr(Parse*,Expr*, Expr*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprImpliesNonNullRow(Expr*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AggInfoPersistWalkerInit(Walker*,Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprAnalyzeAggregates(NameContext*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprAnalyzeAggList(NameContext*,ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCoveredByIndex(Expr*, int iCur, Index *pIdx);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FunctionUsesThisSrc(Expr*, SrcList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Vdbe *sqlite3GetVdbe(Parse*);
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PrngSaveState(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PrngRestoreState(void);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RollbackAll(sqlite3*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CodeVerifySchema(Parse*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CodeVerifyNamedSchema(Parse*, const char *zDb);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BeginTransaction(Parse*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3EndTransaction(Parse*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Savepoint(Parse*, int, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CloseSavepoints(sqlite3 *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3LeaveMutexAndCloseZombie(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3IsTrueOrFalse(const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprIdToTrueFalse(Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprTruthValue(const Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprIsConstant(Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprIsConstantNotJoin(Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprIsConstantOrFunction(Expr*, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprIsConstantOrGroupBy(Parse*, Expr*, ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprIsTableConstant(Expr*,int);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_CURSOR_HINTS
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprContainsSubquery(Expr*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprIsInteger(Expr*, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCanBeNull(const Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprNeedsNoAffinityChange(const Expr*, char);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IsRowid(const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3GenerateRowDelete(
+ Parse*,Table*,Trigger*,int,int,int,i16,u8,u8,u8,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3GenerateRowIndexDelete(Parse*, Table*, int, int, int*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3GenerateIndexKey(Parse*, Index*, int, int, int, int*,Index*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ResolvePartIdxLabel(Parse*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprReferencesUpdatedColumn(Expr*,int*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3GenerateConstraintChecks(Parse*,Table*,int*,int,int,int,int,
+ u8,u8,int,int*,int*,Upsert*);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_NULL_TRIM
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SetMakeRecordP5(Vdbe*,Table*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3SetMakeRecordP5(A,B)
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CompleteInsertion(Parse*,Table*,int,int,int,int*,int,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OpenTableAndIndices(Parse*, Table*, int, u8, int, u8*, int*, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BeginWriteOperation(Parse*, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MultiWrite(Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MayAbort(Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3HaltConstraint(Parse*, int, int, char*, i8, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3UniqueConstraint(Parse*, int, Index*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RowidConstraint(Parse*, int, Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3ExprDup(sqlite3*,Expr*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE ExprList *sqlite3ExprListDup(sqlite3*,ExprList*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE SrcList *sqlite3SrcListDup(sqlite3*,SrcList*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE IdList *sqlite3IdListDup(sqlite3*,IdList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Select *sqlite3SelectDup(sqlite3*,Select*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE FuncDef *sqlite3FunctionSearch(int,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3InsertBuiltinFuncs(FuncDef*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE FuncDef *sqlite3FindFunction(sqlite3*,const char*,int,u8,u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RegisterBuiltinFunctions(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RegisterDateTimeFunctions(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RegisterPerConnectionBuiltinFunctions(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SafetyCheckOk(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SafetyCheckSickOrOk(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ChangeCookie(Parse*, int);
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_VIEW) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_TRIGGER)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MaterializeView(Parse*, Table*, Expr*, ExprList*,Expr*,int);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TRIGGER
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BeginTrigger(Parse*, Token*,Token*,int,int,IdList*,SrcList*,
+ Expr*,int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3FinishTrigger(Parse*, TriggerStep*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DropTrigger(Parse*, SrcList*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DropTriggerPtr(Parse*, Trigger*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Trigger *sqlite3TriggersExist(Parse *, Table*, int, ExprList*, int *pMask);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Trigger *sqlite3TriggerList(Parse *, Table *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CodeRowTrigger(Parse*, Trigger *, int, ExprList*, int, Table *,
+ int, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CodeRowTriggerDirect(Parse *, Trigger *, Table *, int, int, int);
+ void sqliteViewTriggers(Parse*, Table*, Expr*, int, ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DeleteTriggerStep(sqlite3*, TriggerStep*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE TriggerStep *sqlite3TriggerSelectStep(sqlite3*,Select*,
+ const char*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE TriggerStep *sqlite3TriggerInsertStep(Parse*,Token*, IdList*,
+ Select*,u8,Upsert*,
+ const char*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE TriggerStep *sqlite3TriggerUpdateStep(Parse*,Token*,SrcList*,ExprList*,
+ Expr*, u8, const char*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE TriggerStep *sqlite3TriggerDeleteStep(Parse*,Token*, Expr*,
+ const char*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DeleteTrigger(sqlite3*, Trigger*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3UnlinkAndDeleteTrigger(sqlite3*,int,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3TriggerColmask(Parse*,Trigger*,ExprList*,int,int,Table*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE SrcList *sqlite3TriggerStepSrc(Parse*, TriggerStep*);
+# define sqlite3ParseToplevel(p) ((p)->pToplevel ? (p)->pToplevel : (p))
+# define sqlite3IsToplevel(p) ((p)->pToplevel==0)
+#else
+# define sqlite3TriggersExist(B,C,D,E,F) 0
+# define sqlite3DeleteTrigger(A,B)
+# define sqlite3DropTriggerPtr(A,B)
+# define sqlite3UnlinkAndDeleteTrigger(A,B,C)
+# define sqlite3CodeRowTrigger(A,B,C,D,E,F,G,H,I)
+# define sqlite3CodeRowTriggerDirect(A,B,C,D,E,F)
+# define sqlite3TriggerList(X, Y) 0
+# define sqlite3ParseToplevel(p) p
+# define sqlite3IsToplevel(p) 1
+# define sqlite3TriggerColmask(A,B,C,D,E,F,G) 0
+# define sqlite3TriggerStepSrc(A,B) 0
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3JoinType(Parse*, Token*, Token*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SetJoinExpr(Expr*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CreateForeignKey(Parse*, ExprList*, Token*, ExprList*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DeferForeignKey(Parse*, int);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AuthRead(Parse*,Expr*,Schema*,SrcList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3AuthCheck(Parse*,int, const char*, const char*, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AuthContextPush(Parse*, AuthContext*, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AuthContextPop(AuthContext*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3AuthReadCol(Parse*, const char *, const char *, int);
+#else
+# define sqlite3AuthRead(a,b,c,d)
+# define sqlite3AuthCheck(a,b,c,d,e) SQLITE_OK
+# define sqlite3AuthContextPush(a,b,c)
+# define sqlite3AuthContextPop(a) ((void)(a))
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3DbIsNamed(sqlite3 *db, int iDb, const char *zName);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Attach(Parse*, Expr*, Expr*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Detach(Parse*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3FixInit(DbFixer*, Parse*, int, const char*, const Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FixSrcList(DbFixer*, SrcList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FixSelect(DbFixer*, Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FixExpr(DbFixer*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FixExprList(DbFixer*, ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FixTriggerStep(DbFixer*, TriggerStep*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3RealSameAsInt(double,sqlite3_int64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Int64ToText(i64,char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3AtoF(const char *z, double*, int, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3GetInt32(const char *, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3GetUInt32(const char*, u32*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Atoi(const char*);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_UTF16
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Utf16ByteLen(const void *pData, int nChar);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Utf8CharLen(const char *pData, int nByte);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3Utf8Read(const u8**);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE LogEst sqlite3LogEst(u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE LogEst sqlite3LogEstAdd(LogEst,LogEst);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE LogEst sqlite3LogEstFromDouble(double);
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_STMT_SCANSTATUS) || \
+ defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT4) || \
+ defined(SQLITE_EXPLAIN_ESTIMATED_ROWS)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u64 sqlite3LogEstToInt(LogEst);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE VList *sqlite3VListAdd(sqlite3*,VList*,const char*,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3VListNumToName(VList*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VListNameToNum(VList*,const char*,int);
+
+/*
+** Routines to read and write variable-length integers. These used to
+** be defined locally, but now we use the varint routines in the util.c
+** file.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PutVarint(unsigned char*, u64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3GetVarint(const unsigned char *, u64 *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3GetVarint32(const unsigned char *, u32 *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VarintLen(u64 v);
+
+/*
+** The common case is for a varint to be a single byte. They following
+** macros handle the common case without a procedure call, but then call
+** the procedure for larger varints.
+*/
+#define getVarint32(A,B) \
+ (u8)((*(A)<(u8)0x80)?((B)=(u32)*(A)),1:sqlite3GetVarint32((A),(u32 *)&(B)))
+#define getVarint32NR(A,B) \
+ B=(u32)*(A);if(B>=0x80)sqlite3GetVarint32((A),(u32*)&(B))
+#define putVarint32(A,B) \
+ (u8)(((u32)(B)<(u32)0x80)?(*(A)=(unsigned char)(B)),1:\
+ sqlite3PutVarint((A),(B)))
+#define getVarint sqlite3GetVarint
+#define putVarint sqlite3PutVarint
+
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3IndexAffinityStr(sqlite3*, Index*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TableAffinity(Vdbe*, Table*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char sqlite3CompareAffinity(const Expr *pExpr, char aff2);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IndexAffinityOk(const Expr *pExpr, char idx_affinity);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char sqlite3TableColumnAffinity(Table*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char sqlite3ExprAffinity(const Expr *pExpr);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Atoi64(const char*, i64*, int, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3DecOrHexToI64(const char*, i64*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ErrorWithMsg(sqlite3*, int, const char*,...);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Error(sqlite3*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SystemError(sqlite3*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3HexToBlob(sqlite3*, const char *z, int n);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3HexToInt(int h);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3TwoPartName(Parse *, Token *, Token *, Token **);
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_NEED_ERR_NAME)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3ErrName(int);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_DESERIALIZE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MemdbInit(void);
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3ErrStr(int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ReadSchema(Parse *pParse);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE CollSeq *sqlite3FindCollSeq(sqlite3*,u8 enc, const char*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IsBinary(const CollSeq*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE CollSeq *sqlite3LocateCollSeq(Parse *pParse, const char*zName);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SetTextEncoding(sqlite3 *db, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE CollSeq *sqlite3ExprCollSeq(Parse *pParse, const Expr *pExpr);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE CollSeq *sqlite3ExprNNCollSeq(Parse *pParse, const Expr *pExpr);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCollSeqMatch(Parse*,const Expr*,const Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3ExprAddCollateToken(Parse *pParse, Expr*, const Token*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3ExprAddCollateString(Parse*,Expr*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3ExprSkipCollate(Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3ExprSkipCollateAndLikely(Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3CheckCollSeq(Parse *, CollSeq *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WritableSchema(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3CheckObjectName(Parse*, const char*,const char*,const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSetChanges(sqlite3 *, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3AddInt64(i64*,i64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SubInt64(i64*,i64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MulInt64(i64*,i64);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3AbsInt32(int);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_8_3_NAMES
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3FileSuffix3(const char*, char*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3FileSuffix3(X,Y)
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3GetBoolean(const char *z,u8);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const void *sqlite3ValueText(sqlite3_value*, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ValueBytes(sqlite3_value*, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ValueSetStr(sqlite3_value*, int, const void *,u8,
+ void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ValueSetNull(sqlite3_value*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ValueFree(sqlite3_value*);
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ResultIntReal(sqlite3_context*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_value *sqlite3ValueNew(sqlite3 *);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_UTF16
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3Utf16to8(sqlite3 *, const void*, int, u8);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ValueFromExpr(sqlite3 *, Expr *, u8, u8, sqlite3_value **);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ValueApplyAffinity(sqlite3_value *, u8, u8);
+#ifndef SQLITE_AMALGAMATION
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const unsigned char sqlite3OpcodeProperty[];
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char sqlite3StrBINARY[];
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const unsigned char sqlite3UpperToLower[];
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const unsigned char sqlite3CtypeMap[];
+SQLITE_PRIVATE SQLITE_WSD struct Sqlite3Config sqlite3Config;
+SQLITE_PRIVATE FuncDefHash sqlite3BuiltinFunctions;
+SQLITE_API extern u32 sqlite3_unsupported_selecttrace;
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WSD
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PendingByte;
+#endif
+#endif /* SQLITE_AMALGAMATION */
+#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_uint64 sqlite3NProfileCnt;
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RootPageMoved(sqlite3*, int, Pgno, Pgno);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Reindex(Parse*, Token*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AlterFunctions(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AlterRenameTable(Parse*, SrcList*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AlterRenameColumn(Parse*, SrcList*, Token*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3GetToken(const unsigned char *, int *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3NestedParse(Parse*, const char*, ...);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExpirePreparedStatements(sqlite3*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CodeRhsOfIN(Parse*, Expr*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3CodeSubselect(Parse*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SelectPrep(Parse*, Select*, NameContext*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SelectWrongNumTermsError(Parse *pParse, Select *p);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MatchEName(
+ const struct ExprList_item*,
+ const char*,
+ const char*,
+ const char*
+);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Bitmask sqlite3ExprColUsed(Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3StrIHash(const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ResolveExprNames(NameContext*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ResolveExprListNames(NameContext*, ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ResolveSelectNames(Parse*, Select*, NameContext*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ResolveSelfReference(Parse*,Table*,int,Expr*,ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ResolveOrderGroupBy(Parse*, Select*, ExprList*, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ColumnDefault(Vdbe *, Table *, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AlterFinishAddColumn(Parse *, Token *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AlterBeginAddColumn(Parse *, SrcList *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3RenameTokenMap(Parse*, void*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RenameTokenRemap(Parse*, void *pTo, void *pFrom);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RenameExprUnmap(Parse*, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RenameExprlistUnmap(Parse*, ExprList*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE CollSeq *sqlite3GetCollSeq(Parse*, u8, CollSeq *, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char sqlite3AffinityType(const char*, Column*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Analyze(Parse*, Token*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3InvokeBusyHandler(BusyHandler*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FindDb(sqlite3*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FindDbName(sqlite3 *, const char *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3AnalysisLoad(sqlite3*,int iDB);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DeleteIndexSamples(sqlite3*,Index*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DefaultRowEst(Index*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RegisterLikeFunctions(sqlite3*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IsLikeFunction(sqlite3*,Expr*,int*,char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SchemaClear(void *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Schema *sqlite3SchemaGet(sqlite3 *, Btree *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SchemaToIndex(sqlite3 *db, Schema *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE KeyInfo *sqlite3KeyInfoAlloc(sqlite3*,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3KeyInfoUnref(KeyInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE KeyInfo *sqlite3KeyInfoRef(KeyInfo*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE KeyInfo *sqlite3KeyInfoOfIndex(Parse*, Index*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE KeyInfo *sqlite3KeyInfoFromExprList(Parse*, ExprList*, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3HasExplicitNulls(Parse*, ExprList*);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3KeyInfoIsWriteable(KeyInfo*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3CreateFunc(sqlite3 *, const char *, int, int, void *,
+ void (*)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value **),
+ void (*)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value **),
+ void (*)(sqlite3_context*),
+ void (*)(sqlite3_context*),
+ void (*)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value **),
+ FuncDestructor *pDestructor
+);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3NoopDestructor(void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OomFault(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OomClear(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ApiExit(sqlite3 *db, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OpenTempDatabase(Parse *);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3StrAccumInit(StrAccum*, sqlite3*, char*, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3StrAccumFinish(StrAccum*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SelectDestInit(SelectDest*,int,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3CreateColumnExpr(sqlite3 *, SrcList *, int, int);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BackupRestart(sqlite3_backup *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BackupUpdate(sqlite3_backup *, Pgno, const u8 *);
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SUBQUERY
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCheckIN(Parse*, Expr*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3ExprCheckIN(x,y) SQLITE_OK
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT4
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Stat4ProbeSetValue(
+ Parse*,Index*,UnpackedRecord**,Expr*,int,int,int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Stat4ValueFromExpr(Parse*, Expr*, u8, sqlite3_value**);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Stat4ProbeFree(UnpackedRecord*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Stat4Column(sqlite3*, const void*, int, int, sqlite3_value**);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char sqlite3IndexColumnAffinity(sqlite3*, Index*, int);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The interface to the LEMON-generated parser
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_AMALGAMATION
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3ParserAlloc(void*(*)(u64), Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ParserFree(void*, void(*)(void*));
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Parser(void*, int, Token);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ParserFallback(int);
+#ifdef YYTRACKMAXSTACKDEPTH
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ParserStackPeak(void*);
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3AutoLoadExtensions(sqlite3*);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3CloseExtensions(sqlite3*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3CloseExtensions(X)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TableLock(Parse *, int, Pgno, u8, const char *);
+#else
+ #define sqlite3TableLock(v,w,x,y,z)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Utf8To8(unsigned char*);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+# define sqlite3VtabClear(Y)
+# define sqlite3VtabSync(X,Y) SQLITE_OK
+# define sqlite3VtabRollback(X)
+# define sqlite3VtabCommit(X)
+# define sqlite3VtabInSync(db) 0
+# define sqlite3VtabLock(X)
+# define sqlite3VtabUnlock(X)
+# define sqlite3VtabModuleUnref(D,X)
+# define sqlite3VtabUnlockList(X)
+# define sqlite3VtabSavepoint(X, Y, Z) SQLITE_OK
+# define sqlite3GetVTable(X,Y) ((VTable*)0)
+#else
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabClear(sqlite3 *db, Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabDisconnect(sqlite3 *db, Table *p);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VtabSync(sqlite3 *db, Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VtabRollback(sqlite3 *db);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VtabCommit(sqlite3 *db);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabLock(VTable *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabUnlock(VTable *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabModuleUnref(sqlite3*,Module*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabUnlockList(sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VtabSavepoint(sqlite3 *, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabImportErrmsg(Vdbe*, sqlite3_vtab*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE VTable *sqlite3GetVTable(sqlite3*, Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Module *sqlite3VtabCreateModule(
+ sqlite3*,
+ const char*,
+ const sqlite3_module*,
+ void*,
+ void(*)(void*)
+ );
+# define sqlite3VtabInSync(db) ((db)->nVTrans>0 && (db)->aVTrans==0)
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ReadOnlyShadowTables(sqlite3 *db);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ShadowTableName(sqlite3 *db, const char *zName);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IsShadowTableOf(sqlite3*,Table*,const char*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3ShadowTableName(A,B) 0
+# define sqlite3IsShadowTableOf(A,B,C) 0
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VtabEponymousTableInit(Parse*,Module*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabEponymousTableClear(sqlite3*,Module*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabMakeWritable(Parse*,Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabBeginParse(Parse*, Token*, Token*, Token*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabFinishParse(Parse*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabArgInit(Parse*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VtabArgExtend(Parse*, Token*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VtabCallCreate(sqlite3*, int, const char *, char **);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VtabCallConnect(Parse*, Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VtabCallDestroy(sqlite3*, int, const char *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VtabBegin(sqlite3 *, VTable *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE FuncDef *sqlite3VtabOverloadFunction(sqlite3 *,FuncDef*, int nArg, Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_int64 sqlite3StmtCurrentTime(sqlite3_context*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeParameterIndex(Vdbe*, const char*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3TransferBindings(sqlite3_stmt *, sqlite3_stmt *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ParserReset(Parse*);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_NORMALIZE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3Normalize(Vdbe*, const char*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Reprepare(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprListCheckLength(Parse*, ExprList*, const char*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE CollSeq *sqlite3ExprCompareCollSeq(Parse*,const Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE CollSeq *sqlite3BinaryCompareCollSeq(Parse *, const Expr*, const Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3TempInMemory(const sqlite3*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3JournalModename(int);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Checkpoint(sqlite3*, int, int, int*, int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalDefaultHook(void*,sqlite3*,const char*,int);
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_CTE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE With *sqlite3WithAdd(Parse*,With*,Token*,ExprList*,Select*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WithDelete(sqlite3*,With*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WithPush(Parse*, With*, u8);
+#else
+#define sqlite3WithPush(x,y,z)
+#define sqlite3WithDelete(x,y)
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_UPSERT
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Upsert *sqlite3UpsertNew(sqlite3*,ExprList*,Expr*,ExprList*,Expr*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3UpsertDelete(sqlite3*,Upsert*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Upsert *sqlite3UpsertDup(sqlite3*,Upsert*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3UpsertAnalyzeTarget(Parse*,SrcList*,Upsert*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3UpsertDoUpdate(Parse*,Upsert*,Table*,Index*,int);
+#else
+#define sqlite3UpsertNew(v,w,x,y,z) ((Upsert*)0)
+#define sqlite3UpsertDelete(x,y)
+#define sqlite3UpsertDup(x,y) ((Upsert*)0)
+#endif
+
+
+/* Declarations for functions in fkey.c. All of these are replaced by
+** no-op macros if OMIT_FOREIGN_KEY is defined. In this case no foreign
+** key functionality is available. If OMIT_TRIGGER is defined but
+** OMIT_FOREIGN_KEY is not, only some of the functions are no-oped. In
+** this case foreign keys are parsed, but no other functionality is
+** provided (enforcement of FK constraints requires the triggers sub-system).
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_FOREIGN_KEY) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_TRIGGER)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3FkCheck(Parse*, Table*, int, int, int*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3FkDropTable(Parse*, SrcList *, Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3FkActions(Parse*, Table*, ExprList*, int, int*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FkRequired(Parse*, Table*, int*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3FkOldmask(Parse*, Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE FKey *sqlite3FkReferences(Table *);
+#else
+ #define sqlite3FkActions(a,b,c,d,e,f)
+ #define sqlite3FkCheck(a,b,c,d,e,f)
+ #define sqlite3FkDropTable(a,b,c)
+ #define sqlite3FkOldmask(a,b) 0
+ #define sqlite3FkRequired(a,b,c,d) 0
+ #define sqlite3FkReferences(a) 0
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_FOREIGN_KEY
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3FkDelete(sqlite3 *, Table*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FkLocateIndex(Parse*,Table*,FKey*,Index**,int**);
+#else
+ #define sqlite3FkDelete(a,b)
+ #define sqlite3FkLocateIndex(a,b,c,d,e)
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+** Available fault injectors. Should be numbered beginning with 0.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_FAULTINJECTOR_MALLOC 0
+#define SQLITE_FAULTINJECTOR_COUNT 1
+
+/*
+** The interface to the code in fault.c used for identifying "benign"
+** malloc failures. This is only present if SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+** is not defined.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc(void);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3EndBenignMalloc(void);
+#else
+ #define sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc()
+ #define sqlite3EndBenignMalloc()
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Allowed return values from sqlite3FindInIndex()
+*/
+#define IN_INDEX_ROWID 1 /* Search the rowid of the table */
+#define IN_INDEX_EPH 2 /* Search an ephemeral b-tree */
+#define IN_INDEX_INDEX_ASC 3 /* Existing index ASCENDING */
+#define IN_INDEX_INDEX_DESC 4 /* Existing index DESCENDING */
+#define IN_INDEX_NOOP 5 /* No table available. Use comparisons */
+/*
+** Allowed flags for the 3rd parameter to sqlite3FindInIndex().
+*/
+#define IN_INDEX_NOOP_OK 0x0001 /* OK to return IN_INDEX_NOOP */
+#define IN_INDEX_MEMBERSHIP 0x0002 /* IN operator used for membership test */
+#define IN_INDEX_LOOP 0x0004 /* IN operator used as a loop */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FindInIndex(Parse *, Expr *, u32, int*, int*, int*);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3JournalOpen(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, sqlite3_file *, int, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3JournalSize(sqlite3_vfs *);
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_ATOMIC_WRITE) \
+ || defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3JournalCreate(sqlite3_file *);
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3JournalIsInMemory(sqlite3_file *p);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemJournalOpen(sqlite3_file *);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ExprSetHeightAndFlags(Parse *pParse, Expr *p);
+#if SQLITE_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH>0
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SelectExprHeight(Select *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprCheckHeight(Parse*, int);
+#else
+ #define sqlite3SelectExprHeight(x) 0
+ #define sqlite3ExprCheckHeight(x,y)
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3Get4byte(const u8*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Put4byte(u8*, u32);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_UNLOCK_NOTIFY
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ConnectionBlocked(sqlite3 *, sqlite3 *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ConnectionUnlocked(sqlite3 *db);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ConnectionClosed(sqlite3 *db);
+#else
+ #define sqlite3ConnectionBlocked(x,y)
+ #define sqlite3ConnectionUnlocked(x)
+ #define sqlite3ConnectionClosed(x)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ParserTrace(FILE*, char *);
+#endif
+#if defined(YYCOVERAGE)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ParserCoverage(FILE*);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** If the SQLITE_ENABLE IOTRACE exists then the global variable
+** sqlite3IoTrace is a pointer to a printf-like routine used to
+** print I/O tracing messages.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_IOTRACE
+# define IOTRACE(A) if( sqlite3IoTrace ){ sqlite3IoTrace A; }
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeIOTraceSql(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_API SQLITE_EXTERN void (SQLITE_CDECL *sqlite3IoTrace)(const char*,...);
+#else
+# define IOTRACE(A)
+# define sqlite3VdbeIOTraceSql(X)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** These routines are available for the mem2.c debugging memory allocator
+** only. They are used to verify that different "types" of memory
+** allocations are properly tracked by the system.
+**
+** sqlite3MemdebugSetType() sets the "type" of an allocation to one of
+** the MEMTYPE_* macros defined below. The type must be a bitmask with
+** a single bit set.
+**
+** sqlite3MemdebugHasType() returns true if any of the bits in its second
+** argument match the type set by the previous sqlite3MemdebugSetType().
+** sqlite3MemdebugHasType() is intended for use inside assert() statements.
+**
+** sqlite3MemdebugNoType() returns true if none of the bits in its second
+** argument match the type set by the previous sqlite3MemdebugSetType().
+**
+** Perhaps the most important point is the difference between MEMTYPE_HEAP
+** and MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE. If an allocation is MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE, that means
+** it might have been allocated by lookaside, except the allocation was
+** too large or lookaside was already full. It is important to verify
+** that allocations that might have been satisfied by lookaside are not
+** passed back to non-lookaside free() routines. Asserts such as the
+** example above are placed on the non-lookaside free() routines to verify
+** this constraint.
+**
+** All of this is no-op for a production build. It only comes into
+** play when the SQLITE_MEMDEBUG compile-time option is used.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_MEMDEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemdebugSetType(void*,u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MemdebugHasType(void*,u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MemdebugNoType(void*,u8);
+#else
+# define sqlite3MemdebugSetType(X,Y) /* no-op */
+# define sqlite3MemdebugHasType(X,Y) 1
+# define sqlite3MemdebugNoType(X,Y) 1
+#endif
+#define MEMTYPE_HEAP 0x01 /* General heap allocations */
+#define MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE 0x02 /* Heap that might have been lookaside */
+#define MEMTYPE_PCACHE 0x04 /* Page cache allocations */
+
+/*
+** Threading interface
+*/
+#if SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS>0
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ThreadCreate(SQLiteThread**,void*(*)(void*),void*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ThreadJoin(SQLiteThread*, void**);
+#endif
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_DBPAGE_VTAB) || defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3DbpageRegister(sqlite3*);
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_DBSTAT_VTAB) || defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3DbstatRegister(sqlite3*);
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprVectorSize(Expr *pExpr);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ExprIsVector(Expr *pExpr);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3VectorFieldSubexpr(Expr*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Expr *sqlite3ExprForVectorField(Parse*,Expr*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VectorErrorMsg(Parse*, Expr*);
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_COMPILEOPTION_DIAGS
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char **sqlite3CompileOptions(int *pnOpt);
+#endif
+
+#endif /* SQLITEINT_H */
+
+/************** End of sqliteInt.h *******************************************/
+/************** Begin file global.c ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 June 13
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains definitions of global variables and constants.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+/* An array to map all upper-case characters into their corresponding
+** lower-case character.
+**
+** SQLite only considers US-ASCII (or EBCDIC) characters. We do not
+** handle case conversions for the UTF character set since the tables
+** involved are nearly as big or bigger than SQLite itself.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const unsigned char sqlite3UpperToLower[] = {
+#ifdef SQLITE_ASCII
+ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17,
+ 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35,
+ 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53,
+ 54, 55, 56, 57, 58, 59, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 97, 98, 99,100,101,102,103,
+ 104,105,106,107,108,109,110,111,112,113,114,115,116,117,118,119,120,121,
+ 122, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 99,100,101,102,103,104,105,106,107,
+ 108,109,110,111,112,113,114,115,116,117,118,119,120,121,122,123,124,125,
+ 126,127,128,129,130,131,132,133,134,135,136,137,138,139,140,141,142,143,
+ 144,145,146,147,148,149,150,151,152,153,154,155,156,157,158,159,160,161,
+ 162,163,164,165,166,167,168,169,170,171,172,173,174,175,176,177,178,179,
+ 180,181,182,183,184,185,186,187,188,189,190,191,192,193,194,195,196,197,
+ 198,199,200,201,202,203,204,205,206,207,208,209,210,211,212,213,214,215,
+ 216,217,218,219,220,221,222,223,224,225,226,227,228,229,230,231,232,233,
+ 234,235,236,237,238,239,240,241,242,243,244,245,246,247,248,249,250,251,
+ 252,253,254,255
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_EBCDIC
+ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, /* 0x */
+ 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, /* 1x */
+ 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, /* 2x */
+ 48, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53, 54, 55, 56, 57, 58, 59, 60, 61, 62, 63, /* 3x */
+ 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, /* 4x */
+ 80, 81, 82, 83, 84, 85, 86, 87, 88, 89, 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, /* 5x */
+ 96, 97, 98, 99,100,101,102,103,104,105,106,107,108,109,110,111, /* 6x */
+ 112,113,114,115,116,117,118,119,120,121,122,123,124,125,126,127, /* 7x */
+ 128,129,130,131,132,133,134,135,136,137,138,139,140,141,142,143, /* 8x */
+ 144,145,146,147,148,149,150,151,152,153,154,155,156,157,158,159, /* 9x */
+ 160,161,162,163,164,165,166,167,168,169,170,171,140,141,142,175, /* Ax */
+ 176,177,178,179,180,181,182,183,184,185,186,187,188,189,190,191, /* Bx */
+ 192,129,130,131,132,133,134,135,136,137,202,203,204,205,206,207, /* Cx */
+ 208,145,146,147,148,149,150,151,152,153,218,219,220,221,222,223, /* Dx */
+ 224,225,162,163,164,165,166,167,168,169,234,235,236,237,238,239, /* Ex */
+ 240,241,242,243,244,245,246,247,248,249,250,251,252,253,254,255, /* Fx */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** The following 256 byte lookup table is used to support SQLites built-in
+** equivalents to the following standard library functions:
+**
+** isspace() 0x01
+** isalpha() 0x02
+** isdigit() 0x04
+** isalnum() 0x06
+** isxdigit() 0x08
+** toupper() 0x20
+** SQLite identifier character 0x40
+** Quote character 0x80
+**
+** Bit 0x20 is set if the mapped character requires translation to upper
+** case. i.e. if the character is a lower-case ASCII character.
+** If x is a lower-case ASCII character, then its upper-case equivalent
+** is (x - 0x20). Therefore toupper() can be implemented as:
+**
+** (x & ~(map[x]&0x20))
+**
+** The equivalent of tolower() is implemented using the sqlite3UpperToLower[]
+** array. tolower() is used more often than toupper() by SQLite.
+**
+** Bit 0x40 is set if the character is non-alphanumeric and can be used in an
+** SQLite identifier. Identifiers are alphanumerics, "_", "$", and any
+** non-ASCII UTF character. Hence the test for whether or not a character is
+** part of an identifier is 0x46.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const unsigned char sqlite3CtypeMap[256] = {
+ 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, /* 00..07 ........ */
+ 0x00, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01, 0x01, 0x00, 0x00, /* 08..0f ........ */
+ 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, /* 10..17 ........ */
+ 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, /* 18..1f ........ */
+ 0x01, 0x00, 0x80, 0x00, 0x40, 0x00, 0x00, 0x80, /* 20..27 !"#$%&' */
+ 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, /* 28..2f ()*+,-./ */
+ 0x0c, 0x0c, 0x0c, 0x0c, 0x0c, 0x0c, 0x0c, 0x0c, /* 30..37 01234567 */
+ 0x0c, 0x0c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, /* 38..3f 89:;<=>? */
+
+ 0x00, 0x0a, 0x0a, 0x0a, 0x0a, 0x0a, 0x0a, 0x02, /* 40..47 @ABCDEFG */
+ 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, /* 48..4f HIJKLMNO */
+ 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, /* 50..57 PQRSTUVW */
+ 0x02, 0x02, 0x02, 0x80, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x40, /* 58..5f XYZ[\]^_ */
+ 0x80, 0x2a, 0x2a, 0x2a, 0x2a, 0x2a, 0x2a, 0x22, /* 60..67 `abcdefg */
+ 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, /* 68..6f hijklmno */
+ 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, /* 70..77 pqrstuvw */
+ 0x22, 0x22, 0x22, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, /* 78..7f xyz{|}~. */
+
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* 80..87 ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* 88..8f ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* 90..97 ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* 98..9f ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* a0..a7 ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* a8..af ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* b0..b7 ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* b8..bf ........ */
+
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* c0..c7 ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* c8..cf ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* d0..d7 ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* d8..df ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* e0..e7 ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* e8..ef ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, /* f0..f7 ........ */
+ 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40, 0x40 /* f8..ff ........ */
+};
+
+/* EVIDENCE-OF: R-02982-34736 In order to maintain full backwards
+** compatibility for legacy applications, the URI filename capability is
+** disabled by default.
+**
+** EVIDENCE-OF: R-38799-08373 URI filenames can be enabled or disabled
+** using the SQLITE_USE_URI=1 or SQLITE_USE_URI=0 compile-time options.
+**
+** EVIDENCE-OF: R-43642-56306 By default, URI handling is globally
+** disabled. The default value may be changed by compiling with the
+** SQLITE_USE_URI symbol defined.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_USE_URI
+# define SQLITE_USE_URI 0
+#endif
+
+/* EVIDENCE-OF: R-38720-18127 The default setting is determined by the
+** SQLITE_ALLOW_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN compile-time option, or is "on" if
+** that compile-time option is omitted.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_ALLOW_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN)
+# define SQLITE_ALLOW_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN 1
+#else
+# if !SQLITE_ALLOW_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN
+# error "Compile-time disabling of covering index scan using the\
+ -DSQLITE_ALLOW_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN=0 option is deprecated.\
+ Contact SQLite developers if this is a problem for you, and\
+ delete this #error macro to continue with your build."
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* The minimum PMA size is set to this value multiplied by the database
+** page size in bytes.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_SORTER_PMASZ
+# define SQLITE_SORTER_PMASZ 250
+#endif
+
+/* Statement journals spill to disk when their size exceeds the following
+** threshold (in bytes). 0 means that statement journals are created and
+** written to disk immediately (the default behavior for SQLite versions
+** before 3.12.0). -1 means always keep the entire statement journal in
+** memory. (The statement journal is also always held entirely in memory
+** if journal_mode=MEMORY or if temp_store=MEMORY, regardless of this
+** setting.)
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_STMTJRNL_SPILL
+# define SQLITE_STMTJRNL_SPILL (64*1024)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The default lookaside-configuration, the format "SZ,N". SZ is the
+** number of bytes in each lookaside slot (should be a multiple of 8)
+** and N is the number of slots. The lookaside-configuration can be
+** changed as start-time using sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_LOOKASIDE)
+** or at run-time for an individual database connection using
+** sqlite3_db_config(db, SQLITE_DBCONFIG_LOOKASIDE);
+**
+** With the two-size-lookaside enhancement, less lookaside is required.
+** The default configuration of 1200,40 actually provides 30 1200-byte slots
+** and 93 128-byte slots, which is more lookaside than is available
+** using the older 1200,100 configuration without two-size-lookaside.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_LOOKASIDE
+# ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_LOOKASIDE 1200,100 /* 120KB of memory */
+# else
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_LOOKASIDE 1200,40 /* 48KB of memory */
+# endif
+#endif
+
+
+/* The default maximum size of an in-memory database created using
+** sqlite3_deserialize()
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MEMDB_DEFAULT_MAXSIZE
+# define SQLITE_MEMDB_DEFAULT_MAXSIZE 1073741824
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The following singleton contains the global configuration for
+** the SQLite library.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE SQLITE_WSD struct Sqlite3Config sqlite3Config = {
+ SQLITE_DEFAULT_MEMSTATUS, /* bMemstat */
+ 1, /* bCoreMutex */
+ SQLITE_THREADSAFE==1, /* bFullMutex */
+ SQLITE_USE_URI, /* bOpenUri */
+ SQLITE_ALLOW_COVERING_INDEX_SCAN, /* bUseCis */
+ 0, /* bSmallMalloc */
+ 1, /* bExtraSchemaChecks */
+ 0x7ffffffe, /* mxStrlen */
+ 0, /* neverCorrupt */
+ SQLITE_DEFAULT_LOOKASIDE, /* szLookaside, nLookaside */
+ SQLITE_STMTJRNL_SPILL, /* nStmtSpill */
+ {0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0}, /* m */
+ {0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0}, /* mutex */
+ {0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0},/* pcache2 */
+ (void*)0, /* pHeap */
+ 0, /* nHeap */
+ 0, 0, /* mnHeap, mxHeap */
+ SQLITE_DEFAULT_MMAP_SIZE, /* szMmap */
+ SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE, /* mxMmap */
+ (void*)0, /* pPage */
+ 0, /* szPage */
+ SQLITE_DEFAULT_PCACHE_INITSZ, /* nPage */
+ 0, /* mxParserStack */
+ 0, /* sharedCacheEnabled */
+ SQLITE_SORTER_PMASZ, /* szPma */
+ /* All the rest should always be initialized to zero */
+ 0, /* isInit */
+ 0, /* inProgress */
+ 0, /* isMutexInit */
+ 0, /* isMallocInit */
+ 0, /* isPCacheInit */
+ 0, /* nRefInitMutex */
+ 0, /* pInitMutex */
+ 0, /* xLog */
+ 0, /* pLogArg */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_SQLLOG
+ 0, /* xSqllog */
+ 0, /* pSqllogArg */
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_VDBE_COVERAGE
+ 0, /* xVdbeBranch */
+ 0, /* pVbeBranchArg */
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_DESERIALIZE
+ SQLITE_MEMDB_DEFAULT_MAXSIZE, /* mxMemdbSize */
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+ 0, /* xTestCallback */
+#endif
+ 0, /* bLocaltimeFault */
+ 0x7ffffffe, /* iOnceResetThreshold */
+ SQLITE_DEFAULT_SORTERREF_SIZE, /* szSorterRef */
+ 0, /* iPrngSeed */
+};
+
+/*
+** Hash table for global functions - functions common to all
+** database connections. After initialization, this table is
+** read-only.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE FuncDefHash sqlite3BuiltinFunctions;
+
+#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE
+/*
+** The following performance counter can be used in place of
+** sqlite3Hwtime() for profiling. This is a no-op on standard builds.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_uint64 sqlite3NProfileCnt = 0;
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The value of the "pending" byte must be 0x40000000 (1 byte past the
+** 1-gibabyte boundary) in a compatible database. SQLite never uses
+** the database page that contains the pending byte. It never attempts
+** to read or write that page. The pending byte page is set aside
+** for use by the VFS layers as space for managing file locks.
+**
+** During testing, it is often desirable to move the pending byte to
+** a different position in the file. This allows code that has to
+** deal with the pending byte to run on files that are much smaller
+** than 1 GiB. The sqlite3_test_control() interface can be used to
+** move the pending byte.
+**
+** IMPORTANT: Changing the pending byte to any value other than
+** 0x40000000 results in an incompatible database file format!
+** Changing the pending byte during operation will result in undefined
+** and incorrect behavior.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WSD
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PendingByte = 0x40000000;
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Flags for select tracing and the ".selecttrace" macro of the CLI
+*/
+SQLITE_API u32 sqlite3_unsupported_selecttrace = 0;
+
+/* #include "opcodes.h" */
+/*
+** Properties of opcodes. The OPFLG_INITIALIZER macro is
+** created by mkopcodeh.awk during compilation. Data is obtained
+** from the comments following the "case OP_xxxx:" statements in
+** the vdbe.c file.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const unsigned char sqlite3OpcodeProperty[] = OPFLG_INITIALIZER;
+
+/*
+** Name of the default collating sequence
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char sqlite3StrBINARY[] = "BINARY";
+
+/************** End of global.c **********************************************/
+/************** Begin file status.c ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 June 18
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This module implements the sqlite3_status() interface and related
+** functionality.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+/************** Include vdbeInt.h in the middle of status.c ******************/
+/************** Begin file vdbeInt.h *****************************************/
+/*
+** 2003 September 6
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This is the header file for information that is private to the
+** VDBE. This information used to all be at the top of the single
+** source code file "vdbe.c". When that file became too big (over
+** 6000 lines long) it was split up into several smaller files and
+** this header information was factored out.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_VDBEINT_H
+#define SQLITE_VDBEINT_H
+
+/*
+** The maximum number of times that a statement will try to reparse
+** itself before giving up and returning SQLITE_SCHEMA.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_SCHEMA_RETRY
+# define SQLITE_MAX_SCHEMA_RETRY 50
+#endif
+
+/*
+** VDBE_DISPLAY_P4 is true or false depending on whether or not the
+** "explain" P4 display logic is enabled.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN) || !defined(NDEBUG) \
+ || defined(VDBE_PROFILE) || defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) \
+ || defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_BYTECODE_VTAB)
+# define VDBE_DISPLAY_P4 1
+#else
+# define VDBE_DISPLAY_P4 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** SQL is translated into a sequence of instructions to be
+** executed by a virtual machine. Each instruction is an instance
+** of the following structure.
+*/
+typedef struct VdbeOp Op;
+
+/*
+** Boolean values
+*/
+typedef unsigned Bool;
+
+/* Opaque type used by code in vdbesort.c */
+typedef struct VdbeSorter VdbeSorter;
+
+/* Elements of the linked list at Vdbe.pAuxData */
+typedef struct AuxData AuxData;
+
+/* Types of VDBE cursors */
+#define CURTYPE_BTREE 0
+#define CURTYPE_SORTER 1
+#define CURTYPE_VTAB 2
+#define CURTYPE_PSEUDO 3
+
+/*
+** A VdbeCursor is an superclass (a wrapper) for various cursor objects:
+**
+** * A b-tree cursor
+** - In the main database or in an ephemeral database
+** - On either an index or a table
+** * A sorter
+** * A virtual table
+** * A one-row "pseudotable" stored in a single register
+*/
+typedef struct VdbeCursor VdbeCursor;
+struct VdbeCursor {
+ u8 eCurType; /* One of the CURTYPE_* values above */
+ i8 iDb; /* Index of cursor database in db->aDb[] (or -1) */
+ u8 nullRow; /* True if pointing to a row with no data */
+ u8 deferredMoveto; /* A call to sqlite3BtreeMoveto() is needed */
+ u8 isTable; /* True for rowid tables. False for indexes */
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ u8 seekOp; /* Most recent seek operation on this cursor */
+ u8 wrFlag; /* The wrFlag argument to sqlite3BtreeCursor() */
+#endif
+ Bool isEphemeral:1; /* True for an ephemeral table */
+ Bool useRandomRowid:1; /* Generate new record numbers semi-randomly */
+ Bool isOrdered:1; /* True if the table is not BTREE_UNORDERED */
+ Bool seekHit:1; /* See the OP_SeekHit and OP_IfNoHope opcodes */
+ Btree *pBtx; /* Separate file holding temporary table */
+ i64 seqCount; /* Sequence counter */
+ u32 *aAltMap; /* Mapping from table to index column numbers */
+
+ /* Cached OP_Column parse information is only valid if cacheStatus matches
+ ** Vdbe.cacheCtr. Vdbe.cacheCtr will never take on the value of
+ ** CACHE_STALE (0) and so setting cacheStatus=CACHE_STALE guarantees that
+ ** the cache is out of date. */
+ u32 cacheStatus; /* Cache is valid if this matches Vdbe.cacheCtr */
+ int seekResult; /* Result of previous sqlite3BtreeMoveto() or 0
+ ** if there have been no prior seeks on the cursor. */
+ /* seekResult does not distinguish between "no seeks have ever occurred
+ ** on this cursor" and "the most recent seek was an exact match".
+ ** For CURTYPE_PSEUDO, seekResult is the register holding the record */
+
+ /* When a new VdbeCursor is allocated, only the fields above are zeroed.
+ ** The fields that follow are uninitialized, and must be individually
+ ** initialized prior to first use. */
+ VdbeCursor *pAltCursor; /* Associated index cursor from which to read */
+ union {
+ BtCursor *pCursor; /* CURTYPE_BTREE or _PSEUDO. Btree cursor */
+ sqlite3_vtab_cursor *pVCur; /* CURTYPE_VTAB. Vtab cursor */
+ VdbeSorter *pSorter; /* CURTYPE_SORTER. Sorter object */
+ } uc;
+ KeyInfo *pKeyInfo; /* Info about index keys needed by index cursors */
+ u32 iHdrOffset; /* Offset to next unparsed byte of the header */
+ Pgno pgnoRoot; /* Root page of the open btree cursor */
+ i16 nField; /* Number of fields in the header */
+ u16 nHdrParsed; /* Number of header fields parsed so far */
+ i64 movetoTarget; /* Argument to the deferred sqlite3BtreeMoveto() */
+ u32 *aOffset; /* Pointer to aType[nField] */
+ const u8 *aRow; /* Data for the current row, if all on one page */
+ u32 payloadSize; /* Total number of bytes in the record */
+ u32 szRow; /* Byte available in aRow */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_COLUMN_USED_MASK
+ u64 maskUsed; /* Mask of columns used by this cursor */
+#endif
+
+ /* 2*nField extra array elements allocated for aType[], beyond the one
+ ** static element declared in the structure. nField total array slots for
+ ** aType[] and nField+1 array slots for aOffset[] */
+ u32 aType[1]; /* Type values record decode. MUST BE LAST */
+};
+
+
+/*
+** A value for VdbeCursor.cacheStatus that means the cache is always invalid.
+*/
+#define CACHE_STALE 0
+
+/*
+** When a sub-program is executed (OP_Program), a structure of this type
+** is allocated to store the current value of the program counter, as
+** well as the current memory cell array and various other frame specific
+** values stored in the Vdbe struct. When the sub-program is finished,
+** these values are copied back to the Vdbe from the VdbeFrame structure,
+** restoring the state of the VM to as it was before the sub-program
+** began executing.
+**
+** The memory for a VdbeFrame object is allocated and managed by a memory
+** cell in the parent (calling) frame. When the memory cell is deleted or
+** overwritten, the VdbeFrame object is not freed immediately. Instead, it
+** is linked into the Vdbe.pDelFrame list. The contents of the Vdbe.pDelFrame
+** list is deleted when the VM is reset in VdbeHalt(). The reason for doing
+** this instead of deleting the VdbeFrame immediately is to avoid recursive
+** calls to sqlite3VdbeMemRelease() when the memory cells belonging to the
+** child frame are released.
+**
+** The currently executing frame is stored in Vdbe.pFrame. Vdbe.pFrame is
+** set to NULL if the currently executing frame is the main program.
+*/
+typedef struct VdbeFrame VdbeFrame;
+struct VdbeFrame {
+ Vdbe *v; /* VM this frame belongs to */
+ VdbeFrame *pParent; /* Parent of this frame, or NULL if parent is main */
+ Op *aOp; /* Program instructions for parent frame */
+ i64 *anExec; /* Event counters from parent frame */
+ Mem *aMem; /* Array of memory cells for parent frame */
+ VdbeCursor **apCsr; /* Array of Vdbe cursors for parent frame */
+ u8 *aOnce; /* Bitmask used by OP_Once */
+ void *token; /* Copy of SubProgram.token */
+ i64 lastRowid; /* Last insert rowid (sqlite3.lastRowid) */
+ AuxData *pAuxData; /* Linked list of auxdata allocations */
+#if SQLITE_DEBUG
+ u32 iFrameMagic; /* magic number for sanity checking */
+#endif
+ int nCursor; /* Number of entries in apCsr */
+ int pc; /* Program Counter in parent (calling) frame */
+ int nOp; /* Size of aOp array */
+ int nMem; /* Number of entries in aMem */
+ int nChildMem; /* Number of memory cells for child frame */
+ int nChildCsr; /* Number of cursors for child frame */
+ int nChange; /* Statement changes (Vdbe.nChange) */
+ int nDbChange; /* Value of db->nChange */
+};
+
+/* Magic number for sanity checking on VdbeFrame objects */
+#define SQLITE_FRAME_MAGIC 0x879fb71e
+
+/*
+** Return a pointer to the array of registers allocated for use
+** by a VdbeFrame.
+*/
+#define VdbeFrameMem(p) ((Mem *)&((u8 *)p)[ROUND8(sizeof(VdbeFrame))])
+
+/*
+** Internally, the vdbe manipulates nearly all SQL values as Mem
+** structures. Each Mem struct may cache multiple representations (string,
+** integer etc.) of the same value.
+*/
+struct sqlite3_value {
+ union MemValue {
+ double r; /* Real value used when MEM_Real is set in flags */
+ i64 i; /* Integer value used when MEM_Int is set in flags */
+ int nZero; /* Extra zero bytes when MEM_Zero and MEM_Blob set */
+ const char *zPType; /* Pointer type when MEM_Term|MEM_Subtype|MEM_Null */
+ FuncDef *pDef; /* Used only when flags==MEM_Agg */
+ } u;
+ u16 flags; /* Some combination of MEM_Null, MEM_Str, MEM_Dyn, etc. */
+ u8 enc; /* SQLITE_UTF8, SQLITE_UTF16BE, SQLITE_UTF16LE */
+ u8 eSubtype; /* Subtype for this value */
+ int n; /* Number of characters in string value, excluding '\0' */
+ char *z; /* String or BLOB value */
+ /* ShallowCopy only needs to copy the information above */
+ char *zMalloc; /* Space to hold MEM_Str or MEM_Blob if szMalloc>0 */
+ int szMalloc; /* Size of the zMalloc allocation */
+ u32 uTemp; /* Transient storage for serial_type in OP_MakeRecord */
+ sqlite3 *db; /* The associated database connection */
+ void (*xDel)(void*);/* Destructor for Mem.z - only valid if MEM_Dyn */
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ Mem *pScopyFrom; /* This Mem is a shallow copy of pScopyFrom */
+ u16 mScopyFlags; /* flags value immediately after the shallow copy */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** Size of struct Mem not including the Mem.zMalloc member or anything that
+** follows.
+*/
+#define MEMCELLSIZE offsetof(Mem,zMalloc)
+
+/* One or more of the following flags are set to indicate the validOK
+** representations of the value stored in the Mem struct.
+**
+** If the MEM_Null flag is set, then the value is an SQL NULL value.
+** For a pointer type created using sqlite3_bind_pointer() or
+** sqlite3_result_pointer() the MEM_Term and MEM_Subtype flags are also set.
+**
+** If the MEM_Str flag is set then Mem.z points at a string representation.
+** Usually this is encoded in the same unicode encoding as the main
+** database (see below for exceptions). If the MEM_Term flag is also
+** set, then the string is nul terminated. The MEM_Int and MEM_Real
+** flags may coexist with the MEM_Str flag.
+*/
+#define MEM_Null 0x0001 /* Value is NULL (or a pointer) */
+#define MEM_Str 0x0002 /* Value is a string */
+#define MEM_Int 0x0004 /* Value is an integer */
+#define MEM_Real 0x0008 /* Value is a real number */
+#define MEM_Blob 0x0010 /* Value is a BLOB */
+#define MEM_IntReal 0x0020 /* MEM_Int that stringifies like MEM_Real */
+#define MEM_AffMask 0x003f /* Mask of affinity bits */
+#define MEM_FromBind 0x0040 /* Value originates from sqlite3_bind() */
+#define MEM_Undefined 0x0080 /* Value is undefined */
+#define MEM_Cleared 0x0100 /* NULL set by OP_Null, not from data */
+#define MEM_TypeMask 0xc1bf /* Mask of type bits */
+
+
+/* Whenever Mem contains a valid string or blob representation, one of
+** the following flags must be set to determine the memory management
+** policy for Mem.z. The MEM_Term flag tells us whether or not the
+** string is \000 or \u0000 terminated
+*/
+#define MEM_Term 0x0200 /* String in Mem.z is zero terminated */
+#define MEM_Dyn 0x0400 /* Need to call Mem.xDel() on Mem.z */
+#define MEM_Static 0x0800 /* Mem.z points to a static string */
+#define MEM_Ephem 0x1000 /* Mem.z points to an ephemeral string */
+#define MEM_Agg 0x2000 /* Mem.z points to an agg function context */
+#define MEM_Zero 0x4000 /* Mem.i contains count of 0s appended to blob */
+#define MEM_Subtype 0x8000 /* Mem.eSubtype is valid */
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_INCRBLOB
+ #undef MEM_Zero
+ #define MEM_Zero 0x0000
+#endif
+
+/* Return TRUE if Mem X contains dynamically allocated content - anything
+** that needs to be deallocated to avoid a leak.
+*/
+#define VdbeMemDynamic(X) \
+ (((X)->flags&(MEM_Agg|MEM_Dyn))!=0)
+
+/*
+** Clear any existing type flags from a Mem and replace them with f
+*/
+#define MemSetTypeFlag(p, f) \
+ ((p)->flags = ((p)->flags&~(MEM_TypeMask|MEM_Zero))|f)
+
+/*
+** True if Mem X is a NULL-nochng type.
+*/
+#define MemNullNochng(X) \
+ (((X)->flags&MEM_TypeMask)==(MEM_Null|MEM_Zero) \
+ && (X)->n==0 && (X)->u.nZero==0)
+
+/*
+** Return true if a memory cell is not marked as invalid. This macro
+** is for use inside assert() statements only.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+#define memIsValid(M) ((M)->flags & MEM_Undefined)==0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Each auxiliary data pointer stored by a user defined function
+** implementation calling sqlite3_set_auxdata() is stored in an instance
+** of this structure. All such structures associated with a single VM
+** are stored in a linked list headed at Vdbe.pAuxData. All are destroyed
+** when the VM is halted (if not before).
+*/
+struct AuxData {
+ int iAuxOp; /* Instruction number of OP_Function opcode */
+ int iAuxArg; /* Index of function argument. */
+ void *pAux; /* Aux data pointer */
+ void (*xDeleteAux)(void*); /* Destructor for the aux data */
+ AuxData *pNextAux; /* Next element in list */
+};
+
+/*
+** The "context" argument for an installable function. A pointer to an
+** instance of this structure is the first argument to the routines used
+** implement the SQL functions.
+**
+** There is a typedef for this structure in sqlite.h. So all routines,
+** even the public interface to SQLite, can use a pointer to this structure.
+** But this file is the only place where the internal details of this
+** structure are known.
+**
+** This structure is defined inside of vdbeInt.h because it uses substructures
+** (Mem) which are only defined there.
+*/
+struct sqlite3_context {
+ Mem *pOut; /* The return value is stored here */
+ FuncDef *pFunc; /* Pointer to function information */
+ Mem *pMem; /* Memory cell used to store aggregate context */
+ Vdbe *pVdbe; /* The VM that owns this context */
+ int iOp; /* Instruction number of OP_Function */
+ int isError; /* Error code returned by the function. */
+ u8 skipFlag; /* Skip accumulator loading if true */
+ u8 argc; /* Number of arguments */
+ sqlite3_value *argv[1]; /* Argument set */
+};
+
+/* A bitfield type for use inside of structures. Always follow with :N where
+** N is the number of bits.
+*/
+typedef unsigned bft; /* Bit Field Type */
+
+/* The ScanStatus object holds a single value for the
+** sqlite3_stmt_scanstatus() interface.
+*/
+typedef struct ScanStatus ScanStatus;
+struct ScanStatus {
+ int addrExplain; /* OP_Explain for loop */
+ int addrLoop; /* Address of "loops" counter */
+ int addrVisit; /* Address of "rows visited" counter */
+ int iSelectID; /* The "Select-ID" for this loop */
+ LogEst nEst; /* Estimated output rows per loop */
+ char *zName; /* Name of table or index */
+};
+
+/* The DblquoteStr object holds the text of a double-quoted
+** string for a prepared statement. A linked list of these objects
+** is constructed during statement parsing and is held on Vdbe.pDblStr.
+** When computing a normalized SQL statement for an SQL statement, that
+** list is consulted for each double-quoted identifier to see if the
+** identifier should really be a string literal.
+*/
+typedef struct DblquoteStr DblquoteStr;
+struct DblquoteStr {
+ DblquoteStr *pNextStr; /* Next string literal in the list */
+ char z[8]; /* Dequoted value for the string */
+};
+
+/*
+** An instance of the virtual machine. This structure contains the complete
+** state of the virtual machine.
+**
+** The "sqlite3_stmt" structure pointer that is returned by sqlite3_prepare()
+** is really a pointer to an instance of this structure.
+*/
+struct Vdbe {
+ sqlite3 *db; /* The database connection that owns this statement */
+ Vdbe *pPrev,*pNext; /* Linked list of VDBEs with the same Vdbe.db */
+ Parse *pParse; /* Parsing context used to create this Vdbe */
+ ynVar nVar; /* Number of entries in aVar[] */
+ u32 magic; /* Magic number for sanity checking */
+ int nMem; /* Number of memory locations currently allocated */
+ int nCursor; /* Number of slots in apCsr[] */
+ u32 cacheCtr; /* VdbeCursor row cache generation counter */
+ int pc; /* The program counter */
+ int rc; /* Value to return */
+ int nChange; /* Number of db changes made since last reset */
+ int iStatement; /* Statement number (or 0 if has no opened stmt) */
+ i64 iCurrentTime; /* Value of julianday('now') for this statement */
+ i64 nFkConstraint; /* Number of imm. FK constraints this VM */
+ i64 nStmtDefCons; /* Number of def. constraints when stmt started */
+ i64 nStmtDefImmCons; /* Number of def. imm constraints when stmt started */
+ Mem *aMem; /* The memory locations */
+ Mem **apArg; /* Arguments to currently executing user function */
+ VdbeCursor **apCsr; /* One element of this array for each open cursor */
+ Mem *aVar; /* Values for the OP_Variable opcode. */
+
+ /* When allocating a new Vdbe object, all of the fields below should be
+ ** initialized to zero or NULL */
+
+ Op *aOp; /* Space to hold the virtual machine's program */
+ int nOp; /* Number of instructions in the program */
+ int nOpAlloc; /* Slots allocated for aOp[] */
+ Mem *aColName; /* Column names to return */
+ Mem *pResultSet; /* Pointer to an array of results */
+ char *zErrMsg; /* Error message written here */
+ VList *pVList; /* Name of variables */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TRACE
+ i64 startTime; /* Time when query started - used for profiling */
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ int rcApp; /* errcode set by sqlite3_result_error_code() */
+ u32 nWrite; /* Number of write operations that have occurred */
+#endif
+ u16 nResColumn; /* Number of columns in one row of the result set */
+ u8 errorAction; /* Recovery action to do in case of an error */
+ u8 minWriteFileFormat; /* Minimum file format for writable database files */
+ u8 prepFlags; /* SQLITE_PREPARE_* flags */
+ u8 doingRerun; /* True if rerunning after an auto-reprepare */
+ bft expired:2; /* 1: recompile VM immediately 2: when convenient */
+ bft explain:2; /* True if EXPLAIN present on SQL command */
+ bft changeCntOn:1; /* True to update the change-counter */
+ bft runOnlyOnce:1; /* Automatically expire on reset */
+ bft usesStmtJournal:1; /* True if uses a statement journal */
+ bft readOnly:1; /* True for statements that do not write */
+ bft bIsReader:1; /* True for statements that read */
+ yDbMask btreeMask; /* Bitmask of db->aDb[] entries referenced */
+ yDbMask lockMask; /* Subset of btreeMask that requires a lock */
+ u32 aCounter[7]; /* Counters used by sqlite3_stmt_status() */
+ char *zSql; /* Text of the SQL statement that generated this */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_NORMALIZE
+ char *zNormSql; /* Normalization of the associated SQL statement */
+ DblquoteStr *pDblStr; /* List of double-quoted string literals */
+#endif
+ void *pFree; /* Free this when deleting the vdbe */
+ VdbeFrame *pFrame; /* Parent frame */
+ VdbeFrame *pDelFrame; /* List of frame objects to free on VM reset */
+ int nFrame; /* Number of frames in pFrame list */
+ u32 expmask; /* Binding to these vars invalidates VM */
+ SubProgram *pProgram; /* Linked list of all sub-programs used by VM */
+ AuxData *pAuxData; /* Linked list of auxdata allocations */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_STMT_SCANSTATUS
+ i64 *anExec; /* Number of times each op has been executed */
+ int nScan; /* Entries in aScan[] */
+ ScanStatus *aScan; /* Scan definitions for sqlite3_stmt_scanstatus() */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** The following are allowed values for Vdbe.magic
+*/
+#define VDBE_MAGIC_INIT 0x16bceaa5 /* Building a VDBE program */
+#define VDBE_MAGIC_RUN 0x2df20da3 /* VDBE is ready to execute */
+#define VDBE_MAGIC_HALT 0x319c2973 /* VDBE has completed execution */
+#define VDBE_MAGIC_RESET 0x48fa9f76 /* Reset and ready to run again */
+#define VDBE_MAGIC_DEAD 0x5606c3c8 /* The VDBE has been deallocated */
+
+/*
+** Structure used to store the context required by the
+** sqlite3_preupdate_*() API functions.
+*/
+struct PreUpdate {
+ Vdbe *v;
+ VdbeCursor *pCsr; /* Cursor to read old values from */
+ int op; /* One of SQLITE_INSERT, UPDATE, DELETE */
+ u8 *aRecord; /* old.* database record */
+ KeyInfo keyinfo;
+ UnpackedRecord *pUnpacked; /* Unpacked version of aRecord[] */
+ UnpackedRecord *pNewUnpacked; /* Unpacked version of new.* record */
+ int iNewReg; /* Register for new.* values */
+ i64 iKey1; /* First key value passed to hook */
+ i64 iKey2; /* Second key value passed to hook */
+ Mem *aNew; /* Array of new.* values */
+ Table *pTab; /* Schema object being upated */
+ Index *pPk; /* PK index if pTab is WITHOUT ROWID */
+};
+
+/*
+** Function prototypes
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeError(Vdbe*, const char *, ...);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeFreeCursor(Vdbe *, VdbeCursor*);
+void sqliteVdbePopStack(Vdbe*,int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int SQLITE_NOINLINE sqlite3VdbeFinishMoveto(VdbeCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeCursorMoveto(VdbeCursor**, u32*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeCursorRestore(VdbeCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3VdbeSerialTypeLen(u32);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3VdbeOneByteSerialTypeLen(u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3VdbeSerialPut(unsigned char*, Mem*, u32);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3VdbeSerialGet(const unsigned char*, u32, Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeDeleteAuxData(sqlite3*, AuxData**, int, int);
+
+int sqlite2BtreeKeyCompare(BtCursor *, const void *, int, int, int *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeIdxKeyCompare(sqlite3*,VdbeCursor*,UnpackedRecord*,int*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeIdxRowid(sqlite3*, BtCursor*, i64*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeExec(Vdbe*);
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN) || defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_BYTECODE_VTAB)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeNextOpcode(Vdbe*,Mem*,int,int*,int*,Op**);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3VdbeDisplayP4(sqlite3*,Op*);
+#endif
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_EXPLAIN_COMMENTS)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3VdbeDisplayComment(sqlite3*,const Op*,const char*);
+#endif
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeList(Vdbe*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeHalt(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeChangeEncoding(Mem *, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemTooBig(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemCopy(Mem*, const Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemShallowCopy(Mem*, const Mem*, int);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemMove(Mem*, Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemNulTerminate(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemSetStr(Mem*, const char*, int, u8, void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemSetInt64(Mem*, i64);
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+# define sqlite3VdbeMemSetDouble sqlite3VdbeMemSetInt64
+#else
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemSetDouble(Mem*, double);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemSetPointer(Mem*, void*, const char*, void(*)(void*));
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemInit(Mem*,sqlite3*,u16);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemSetNull(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemSetZeroBlob(Mem*,int);
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemIsRowSet(const Mem*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemSetRowSet(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemMakeWriteable(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemStringify(Mem*, u8, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE i64 sqlite3VdbeIntValue(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemIntegerify(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE double sqlite3VdbeRealValue(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeBooleanValue(Mem*, int ifNull);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeIntegerAffinity(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemRealify(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemNumerify(Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemCast(Mem*,u8,u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemFromBtree(BtCursor*,u32,u32,Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemFromBtreeZeroOffset(BtCursor*,u32,Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemRelease(Mem *p);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemFinalize(Mem*, FuncDef*);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemAggValue(Mem*, Mem*, FuncDef*);
+#endif
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN) || defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_BYTECODE_VTAB)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3OpcodeName(int);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemGrow(Mem *pMem, int n, int preserve);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemClearAndResize(Mem *pMem, int n);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeCloseStatement(Vdbe *, int);
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeFrameIsValid(VdbeFrame*);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeFrameMemDel(void*); /* Destructor on Mem */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeFrameDelete(VdbeFrame*); /* Actually deletes the Frame */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeFrameRestore(VdbeFrame *);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_PREUPDATE_HOOK
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbePreUpdateHook(Vdbe*,VdbeCursor*,int,const char*,Table*,i64,int);
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeTransferError(Vdbe *p);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeSorterInit(sqlite3 *, int, VdbeCursor *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSorterReset(sqlite3 *, VdbeSorter *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSorterClose(sqlite3 *, VdbeCursor *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeSorterRowkey(const VdbeCursor *, Mem *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeSorterNext(sqlite3 *, const VdbeCursor *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeSorterRewind(const VdbeCursor *, int *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeSorterWrite(const VdbeCursor *, Mem *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeSorterCompare(const VdbeCursor *, Mem *, int, int *);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeIncrWriteCounter(Vdbe*, VdbeCursor*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeAssertAbortable(Vdbe*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3VdbeIncrWriteCounter(V,C)
+# define sqlite3VdbeAssertAbortable(V)
+#endif
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE)
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeEnter(Vdbe*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3VdbeEnter(X)
+#endif
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE) && SQLITE_THREADSAFE>0
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeLeave(Vdbe*);
+#else
+# define sqlite3VdbeLeave(X)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemAboutToChange(Vdbe*,Mem*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeCheckMemInvariants(Mem*);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_FOREIGN_KEY
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeCheckFk(Vdbe *, int);
+#else
+# define sqlite3VdbeCheckFk(p,i) 0
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbePrintSql(Vdbe*);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMemPrettyPrint(Mem *pMem, StrAccum *pStr);
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_UTF16
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemTranslate(Mem*, u8);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemHandleBom(Mem *pMem);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_INCRBLOB
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemExpandBlob(Mem *);
+ #define ExpandBlob(P) (((P)->flags&MEM_Zero)?sqlite3VdbeMemExpandBlob(P):0)
+#else
+ #define sqlite3VdbeMemExpandBlob(x) SQLITE_OK
+ #define ExpandBlob(P) SQLITE_OK
+#endif
+
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_VDBEINT_H) */
+
+/************** End of vdbeInt.h *********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in status.c *********************/
+
+/*
+** Variables in which to record status information.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_PTRSIZE>4
+typedef sqlite3_int64 sqlite3StatValueType;
+#else
+typedef u32 sqlite3StatValueType;
+#endif
+typedef struct sqlite3StatType sqlite3StatType;
+static SQLITE_WSD struct sqlite3StatType {
+ sqlite3StatValueType nowValue[10]; /* Current value */
+ sqlite3StatValueType mxValue[10]; /* Maximum value */
+} sqlite3Stat = { {0,}, {0,} };
+
+/*
+** Elements of sqlite3Stat[] are protected by either the memory allocator
+** mutex, or by the pcache1 mutex. The following array determines which.
+*/
+static const char statMutex[] = {
+ 0, /* SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED */
+ 1, /* SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_USED */
+ 1, /* SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_OVERFLOW */
+ 0, /* SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_USED */
+ 0, /* SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_OVERFLOW */
+ 0, /* SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_SIZE */
+ 0, /* SQLITE_STATUS_PARSER_STACK */
+ 1, /* SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_SIZE */
+ 0, /* SQLITE_STATUS_SCRATCH_SIZE */
+ 0, /* SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_COUNT */
+};
+
+
+/* The "wsdStat" macro will resolve to the status information
+** state vector. If writable static data is unsupported on the target,
+** we have to locate the state vector at run-time. In the more common
+** case where writable static data is supported, wsdStat can refer directly
+** to the "sqlite3Stat" state vector declared above.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_WSD
+# define wsdStatInit sqlite3StatType *x = &GLOBAL(sqlite3StatType,sqlite3Stat)
+# define wsdStat x[0]
+#else
+# define wsdStatInit
+# define wsdStat sqlite3Stat
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Return the current value of a status parameter. The caller must
+** be holding the appropriate mutex.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_int64 sqlite3StatusValue(int op){
+ wsdStatInit;
+ assert( op>=0 && op=0 && op=0 && op=0 && opwsdStat.mxValue[op] ){
+ wsdStat.mxValue[op] = wsdStat.nowValue[op];
+ }
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3StatusDown(int op, int N){
+ wsdStatInit;
+ assert( N>=0 );
+ assert( op>=0 && op=0 && op=0 );
+ newValue = (sqlite3StatValueType)X;
+ assert( op>=0 && op=0 && opwsdStat.mxValue[op] ){
+ wsdStat.mxValue[op] = newValue;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Query status information.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_status64(
+ int op,
+ sqlite3_int64 *pCurrent,
+ sqlite3_int64 *pHighwater,
+ int resetFlag
+){
+ sqlite3_mutex *pMutex;
+ wsdStatInit;
+ if( op<0 || op>=ArraySize(wsdStat.nowValue) ){
+ return SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( pCurrent==0 || pHighwater==0 ) return SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+#endif
+ pMutex = statMutex[op] ? sqlite3Pcache1Mutex() : sqlite3MallocMutex();
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pMutex);
+ *pCurrent = wsdStat.nowValue[op];
+ *pHighwater = wsdStat.mxValue[op];
+ if( resetFlag ){
+ wsdStat.mxValue[op] = wsdStat.nowValue[op];
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pMutex);
+ (void)pMutex; /* Prevent warning when SQLITE_THREADSAFE=0 */
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_status(int op, int *pCurrent, int *pHighwater, int resetFlag){
+ sqlite3_int64 iCur = 0, iHwtr = 0;
+ int rc;
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( pCurrent==0 || pHighwater==0 ) return SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+#endif
+ rc = sqlite3_status64(op, &iCur, &iHwtr, resetFlag);
+ if( rc==0 ){
+ *pCurrent = (int)iCur;
+ *pHighwater = (int)iHwtr;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the number of LookasideSlot elements on the linked list
+*/
+static u32 countLookasideSlots(LookasideSlot *p){
+ u32 cnt = 0;
+ while( p ){
+ p = p->pNext;
+ cnt++;
+ }
+ return cnt;
+}
+
+/*
+** Count the number of slots of lookaside memory that are outstanding
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3LookasideUsed(sqlite3 *db, int *pHighwater){
+ u32 nInit = countLookasideSlots(db->lookaside.pInit);
+ u32 nFree = countLookasideSlots(db->lookaside.pFree);
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE
+ nInit += countLookasideSlots(db->lookaside.pSmallInit);
+ nFree += countLookasideSlots(db->lookaside.pSmallFree);
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE */
+ if( pHighwater ) *pHighwater = db->lookaside.nSlot - nInit;
+ return db->lookaside.nSlot - (nInit+nFree);
+}
+
+/*
+** Query status information for a single database connection
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_db_status(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* The database connection whose status is desired */
+ int op, /* Status verb */
+ int *pCurrent, /* Write current value here */
+ int *pHighwater, /* Write high-water mark here */
+ int resetFlag /* Reset high-water mark if true */
+){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Return code */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( !sqlite3SafetyCheckOk(db) || pCurrent==0|| pHighwater==0 ){
+ return SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ }
+#endif
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(db->mutex);
+ switch( op ){
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_USED: {
+ *pCurrent = sqlite3LookasideUsed(db, pHighwater);
+ if( resetFlag ){
+ LookasideSlot *p = db->lookaside.pFree;
+ if( p ){
+ while( p->pNext ) p = p->pNext;
+ p->pNext = db->lookaside.pInit;
+ db->lookaside.pInit = db->lookaside.pFree;
+ db->lookaside.pFree = 0;
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE
+ p = db->lookaside.pSmallFree;
+ if( p ){
+ while( p->pNext ) p = p->pNext;
+ p->pNext = db->lookaside.pSmallInit;
+ db->lookaside.pSmallInit = db->lookaside.pSmallFree;
+ db->lookaside.pSmallFree = 0;
+ }
+#endif
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_HIT:
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_MISS_SIZE:
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_MISS_FULL: {
+ testcase( op==SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_HIT );
+ testcase( op==SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_MISS_SIZE );
+ testcase( op==SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_MISS_FULL );
+ assert( (op-SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_HIT)>=0 );
+ assert( (op-SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_HIT)<3 );
+ *pCurrent = 0;
+ *pHighwater = db->lookaside.anStat[op - SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_HIT];
+ if( resetFlag ){
+ db->lookaside.anStat[op - SQLITE_DBSTATUS_LOOKASIDE_HIT] = 0;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ ** Return an approximation for the amount of memory currently used
+ ** by all pagers associated with the given database connection. The
+ ** highwater mark is meaningless and is returned as zero.
+ */
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED_SHARED:
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED: {
+ int totalUsed = 0;
+ int i;
+ sqlite3BtreeEnterAll(db);
+ for(i=0; inDb; i++){
+ Btree *pBt = db->aDb[i].pBt;
+ if( pBt ){
+ Pager *pPager = sqlite3BtreePager(pBt);
+ int nByte = sqlite3PagerMemUsed(pPager);
+ if( op==SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_USED_SHARED ){
+ nByte = nByte / sqlite3BtreeConnectionCount(pBt);
+ }
+ totalUsed += nByte;
+ }
+ }
+ sqlite3BtreeLeaveAll(db);
+ *pCurrent = totalUsed;
+ *pHighwater = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ ** *pCurrent gets an accurate estimate of the amount of memory used
+ ** to store the schema for all databases (main, temp, and any ATTACHed
+ ** databases. *pHighwater is set to zero.
+ */
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_SCHEMA_USED: {
+ int i; /* Used to iterate through schemas */
+ int nByte = 0; /* Used to accumulate return value */
+
+ sqlite3BtreeEnterAll(db);
+ db->pnBytesFreed = &nByte;
+ for(i=0; inDb; i++){
+ Schema *pSchema = db->aDb[i].pSchema;
+ if( ALWAYS(pSchema!=0) ){
+ HashElem *p;
+
+ nByte += sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xRoundup(sizeof(HashElem)) * (
+ pSchema->tblHash.count
+ + pSchema->trigHash.count
+ + pSchema->idxHash.count
+ + pSchema->fkeyHash.count
+ );
+ nByte += sqlite3_msize(pSchema->tblHash.ht);
+ nByte += sqlite3_msize(pSchema->trigHash.ht);
+ nByte += sqlite3_msize(pSchema->idxHash.ht);
+ nByte += sqlite3_msize(pSchema->fkeyHash.ht);
+
+ for(p=sqliteHashFirst(&pSchema->trigHash); p; p=sqliteHashNext(p)){
+ sqlite3DeleteTrigger(db, (Trigger*)sqliteHashData(p));
+ }
+ for(p=sqliteHashFirst(&pSchema->tblHash); p; p=sqliteHashNext(p)){
+ sqlite3DeleteTable(db, (Table *)sqliteHashData(p));
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ db->pnBytesFreed = 0;
+ sqlite3BtreeLeaveAll(db);
+
+ *pHighwater = 0;
+ *pCurrent = nByte;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ ** *pCurrent gets an accurate estimate of the amount of memory used
+ ** to store all prepared statements.
+ ** *pHighwater is set to zero.
+ */
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_STMT_USED: {
+ struct Vdbe *pVdbe; /* Used to iterate through VMs */
+ int nByte = 0; /* Used to accumulate return value */
+
+ db->pnBytesFreed = &nByte;
+ for(pVdbe=db->pVdbe; pVdbe; pVdbe=pVdbe->pNext){
+ sqlite3VdbeClearObject(db, pVdbe);
+ sqlite3DbFree(db, pVdbe);
+ }
+ db->pnBytesFreed = 0;
+
+ *pHighwater = 0; /* IMP: R-64479-57858 */
+ *pCurrent = nByte;
+
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ ** Set *pCurrent to the total cache hits or misses encountered by all
+ ** pagers the database handle is connected to. *pHighwater is always set
+ ** to zero.
+ */
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_SPILL:
+ op = SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_WRITE+1;
+ /* no break */ deliberate_fall_through
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_HIT:
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_MISS:
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_WRITE:{
+ int i;
+ int nRet = 0;
+ assert( SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_MISS==SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_HIT+1 );
+ assert( SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_WRITE==SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_HIT+2 );
+
+ for(i=0; inDb; i++){
+ if( db->aDb[i].pBt ){
+ Pager *pPager = sqlite3BtreePager(db->aDb[i].pBt);
+ sqlite3PagerCacheStat(pPager, op, resetFlag, &nRet);
+ }
+ }
+ *pHighwater = 0; /* IMP: R-42420-56072 */
+ /* IMP: R-54100-20147 */
+ /* IMP: R-29431-39229 */
+ *pCurrent = nRet;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* Set *pCurrent to non-zero if there are unresolved deferred foreign
+ ** key constraints. Set *pCurrent to zero if all foreign key constraints
+ ** have been satisfied. The *pHighwater is always set to zero.
+ */
+ case SQLITE_DBSTATUS_DEFERRED_FKS: {
+ *pHighwater = 0; /* IMP: R-11967-56545 */
+ *pCurrent = db->nDeferredImmCons>0 || db->nDeferredCons>0;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ default: {
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR;
+ }
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(db->mutex);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/************** End of status.c **********************************************/
+/************** Begin file date.c ********************************************/
+/*
+** 2003 October 31
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This file contains the C functions that implement date and time
+** functions for SQLite.
+**
+** There is only one exported symbol in this file - the function
+** sqlite3RegisterDateTimeFunctions() found at the bottom of the file.
+** All other code has file scope.
+**
+** SQLite processes all times and dates as julian day numbers. The
+** dates and times are stored as the number of days since noon
+** in Greenwich on November 24, 4714 B.C. according to the Gregorian
+** calendar system.
+**
+** 1970-01-01 00:00:00 is JD 2440587.5
+** 2000-01-01 00:00:00 is JD 2451544.5
+**
+** This implementation requires years to be expressed as a 4-digit number
+** which means that only dates between 0000-01-01 and 9999-12-31 can
+** be represented, even though julian day numbers allow a much wider
+** range of dates.
+**
+** The Gregorian calendar system is used for all dates and times,
+** even those that predate the Gregorian calendar. Historians usually
+** use the julian calendar for dates prior to 1582-10-15 and for some
+** dates afterwards, depending on locale. Beware of this difference.
+**
+** The conversion algorithms are implemented based on descriptions
+** in the following text:
+**
+** Jean Meeus
+** Astronomical Algorithms, 2nd Edition, 1998
+** ISBN 0-943396-61-1
+** Willmann-Bell, Inc
+** Richmond, Virginia (USA)
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+/* #include */
+/* #include */
+#include
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS
+
+/*
+** The MSVC CRT on Windows CE may not have a localtime() function.
+** So declare a substitute. The substitute function itself is
+** defined in "os_win.c".
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_LOCALTIME) && defined(_WIN32_WCE) && \
+ (!defined(SQLITE_MSVC_LOCALTIME_API) || !SQLITE_MSVC_LOCALTIME_API)
+struct tm *__cdecl localtime(const time_t *);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** A structure for holding a single date and time.
+*/
+typedef struct DateTime DateTime;
+struct DateTime {
+ sqlite3_int64 iJD; /* The julian day number times 86400000 */
+ int Y, M, D; /* Year, month, and day */
+ int h, m; /* Hour and minutes */
+ int tz; /* Timezone offset in minutes */
+ double s; /* Seconds */
+ char validJD; /* True (1) if iJD is valid */
+ char rawS; /* Raw numeric value stored in s */
+ char validYMD; /* True (1) if Y,M,D are valid */
+ char validHMS; /* True (1) if h,m,s are valid */
+ char validTZ; /* True (1) if tz is valid */
+ char tzSet; /* Timezone was set explicitly */
+ char isError; /* An overflow has occurred */
+};
+
+
+/*
+** Convert zDate into one or more integers according to the conversion
+** specifier zFormat.
+**
+** zFormat[] contains 4 characters for each integer converted, except for
+** the last integer which is specified by three characters. The meaning
+** of a four-character format specifiers ABCD is:
+**
+** A: number of digits to convert. Always "2" or "4".
+** B: minimum value. Always "0" or "1".
+** C: maximum value, decoded as:
+** a: 12
+** b: 14
+** c: 24
+** d: 31
+** e: 59
+** f: 9999
+** D: the separator character, or \000 to indicate this is the
+** last number to convert.
+**
+** Example: To translate an ISO-8601 date YYYY-MM-DD, the format would
+** be "40f-21a-20c". The "40f-" indicates the 4-digit year followed by "-".
+** The "21a-" indicates the 2-digit month followed by "-". The "20c" indicates
+** the 2-digit day which is the last integer in the set.
+**
+** The function returns the number of successful conversions.
+*/
+static int getDigits(const char *zDate, const char *zFormat, ...){
+ /* The aMx[] array translates the 3rd character of each format
+ ** spec into a max size: a b c d e f */
+ static const u16 aMx[] = { 12, 14, 24, 31, 59, 9999 };
+ va_list ap;
+ int cnt = 0;
+ char nextC;
+ va_start(ap, zFormat);
+ do{
+ char N = zFormat[0] - '0';
+ char min = zFormat[1] - '0';
+ int val = 0;
+ u16 max;
+
+ assert( zFormat[2]>='a' && zFormat[2]<='f' );
+ max = aMx[zFormat[2] - 'a'];
+ nextC = zFormat[3];
+ val = 0;
+ while( N-- ){
+ if( !sqlite3Isdigit(*zDate) ){
+ goto end_getDigits;
+ }
+ val = val*10 + *zDate - '0';
+ zDate++;
+ }
+ if( val<(int)min || val>(int)max || (nextC!=0 && nextC!=*zDate) ){
+ goto end_getDigits;
+ }
+ *va_arg(ap,int*) = val;
+ zDate++;
+ cnt++;
+ zFormat += 4;
+ }while( nextC );
+end_getDigits:
+ va_end(ap);
+ return cnt;
+}
+
+/*
+** Parse a timezone extension on the end of a date-time.
+** The extension is of the form:
+**
+** (+/-)HH:MM
+**
+** Or the "zulu" notation:
+**
+** Z
+**
+** If the parse is successful, write the number of minutes
+** of change in p->tz and return 0. If a parser error occurs,
+** return non-zero.
+**
+** A missing specifier is not considered an error.
+*/
+static int parseTimezone(const char *zDate, DateTime *p){
+ int sgn = 0;
+ int nHr, nMn;
+ int c;
+ while( sqlite3Isspace(*zDate) ){ zDate++; }
+ p->tz = 0;
+ c = *zDate;
+ if( c=='-' ){
+ sgn = -1;
+ }else if( c=='+' ){
+ sgn = +1;
+ }else if( c=='Z' || c=='z' ){
+ zDate++;
+ goto zulu_time;
+ }else{
+ return c!=0;
+ }
+ zDate++;
+ if( getDigits(zDate, "20b:20e", &nHr, &nMn)!=2 ){
+ return 1;
+ }
+ zDate += 5;
+ p->tz = sgn*(nMn + nHr*60);
+zulu_time:
+ while( sqlite3Isspace(*zDate) ){ zDate++; }
+ p->tzSet = 1;
+ return *zDate!=0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Parse times of the form HH:MM or HH:MM:SS or HH:MM:SS.FFFF.
+** The HH, MM, and SS must each be exactly 2 digits. The
+** fractional seconds FFFF can be one or more digits.
+**
+** Return 1 if there is a parsing error and 0 on success.
+*/
+static int parseHhMmSs(const char *zDate, DateTime *p){
+ int h, m, s;
+ double ms = 0.0;
+ if( getDigits(zDate, "20c:20e", &h, &m)!=2 ){
+ return 1;
+ }
+ zDate += 5;
+ if( *zDate==':' ){
+ zDate++;
+ if( getDigits(zDate, "20e", &s)!=1 ){
+ return 1;
+ }
+ zDate += 2;
+ if( *zDate=='.' && sqlite3Isdigit(zDate[1]) ){
+ double rScale = 1.0;
+ zDate++;
+ while( sqlite3Isdigit(*zDate) ){
+ ms = ms*10.0 + *zDate - '0';
+ rScale *= 10.0;
+ zDate++;
+ }
+ ms /= rScale;
+ }
+ }else{
+ s = 0;
+ }
+ p->validJD = 0;
+ p->rawS = 0;
+ p->validHMS = 1;
+ p->h = h;
+ p->m = m;
+ p->s = s + ms;
+ if( parseTimezone(zDate, p) ) return 1;
+ p->validTZ = (p->tz!=0)?1:0;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Put the DateTime object into its error state.
+*/
+static void datetimeError(DateTime *p){
+ memset(p, 0, sizeof(*p));
+ p->isError = 1;
+}
+
+/*
+** Convert from YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS to julian day. We always assume
+** that the YYYY-MM-DD is according to the Gregorian calendar.
+**
+** Reference: Meeus page 61
+*/
+static void computeJD(DateTime *p){
+ int Y, M, D, A, B, X1, X2;
+
+ if( p->validJD ) return;
+ if( p->validYMD ){
+ Y = p->Y;
+ M = p->M;
+ D = p->D;
+ }else{
+ Y = 2000; /* If no YMD specified, assume 2000-Jan-01 */
+ M = 1;
+ D = 1;
+ }
+ if( Y<-4713 || Y>9999 || p->rawS ){
+ datetimeError(p);
+ return;
+ }
+ if( M<=2 ){
+ Y--;
+ M += 12;
+ }
+ A = Y/100;
+ B = 2 - A + (A/4);
+ X1 = 36525*(Y+4716)/100;
+ X2 = 306001*(M+1)/10000;
+ p->iJD = (sqlite3_int64)((X1 + X2 + D + B - 1524.5 ) * 86400000);
+ p->validJD = 1;
+ if( p->validHMS ){
+ p->iJD += p->h*3600000 + p->m*60000 + (sqlite3_int64)(p->s*1000);
+ if( p->validTZ ){
+ p->iJD -= p->tz*60000;
+ p->validYMD = 0;
+ p->validHMS = 0;
+ p->validTZ = 0;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Parse dates of the form
+**
+** YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS.FFF
+** YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS
+** YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM
+** YYYY-MM-DD
+**
+** Write the result into the DateTime structure and return 0
+** on success and 1 if the input string is not a well-formed
+** date.
+*/
+static int parseYyyyMmDd(const char *zDate, DateTime *p){
+ int Y, M, D, neg;
+
+ if( zDate[0]=='-' ){
+ zDate++;
+ neg = 1;
+ }else{
+ neg = 0;
+ }
+ if( getDigits(zDate, "40f-21a-21d", &Y, &M, &D)!=3 ){
+ return 1;
+ }
+ zDate += 10;
+ while( sqlite3Isspace(*zDate) || 'T'==*(u8*)zDate ){ zDate++; }
+ if( parseHhMmSs(zDate, p)==0 ){
+ /* We got the time */
+ }else if( *zDate==0 ){
+ p->validHMS = 0;
+ }else{
+ return 1;
+ }
+ p->validJD = 0;
+ p->validYMD = 1;
+ p->Y = neg ? -Y : Y;
+ p->M = M;
+ p->D = D;
+ if( p->validTZ ){
+ computeJD(p);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the time to the current time reported by the VFS.
+**
+** Return the number of errors.
+*/
+static int setDateTimeToCurrent(sqlite3_context *context, DateTime *p){
+ p->iJD = sqlite3StmtCurrentTime(context);
+ if( p->iJD>0 ){
+ p->validJD = 1;
+ return 0;
+ }else{
+ return 1;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Input "r" is a numeric quantity which might be a julian day number,
+** or the number of seconds since 1970. If the value if r is within
+** range of a julian day number, install it as such and set validJD.
+** If the value is a valid unix timestamp, put it in p->s and set p->rawS.
+*/
+static void setRawDateNumber(DateTime *p, double r){
+ p->s = r;
+ p->rawS = 1;
+ if( r>=0.0 && r<5373484.5 ){
+ p->iJD = (sqlite3_int64)(r*86400000.0 + 0.5);
+ p->validJD = 1;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Attempt to parse the given string into a julian day number. Return
+** the number of errors.
+**
+** The following are acceptable forms for the input string:
+**
+** YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS.FFF +/-HH:MM
+** DDDD.DD
+** now
+**
+** In the first form, the +/-HH:MM is always optional. The fractional
+** seconds extension (the ".FFF") is optional. The seconds portion
+** (":SS.FFF") is option. The year and date can be omitted as long
+** as there is a time string. The time string can be omitted as long
+** as there is a year and date.
+*/
+static int parseDateOrTime(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ const char *zDate,
+ DateTime *p
+){
+ double r;
+ if( parseYyyyMmDd(zDate,p)==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }else if( parseHhMmSs(zDate, p)==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }else if( sqlite3StrICmp(zDate,"now")==0 && sqlite3NotPureFunc(context) ){
+ return setDateTimeToCurrent(context, p);
+ }else if( sqlite3AtoF(zDate, &r, sqlite3Strlen30(zDate), SQLITE_UTF8)>0 ){
+ setRawDateNumber(p, r);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* The julian day number for 9999-12-31 23:59:59.999 is 5373484.4999999.
+** Multiplying this by 86400000 gives 464269060799999 as the maximum value
+** for DateTime.iJD.
+**
+** But some older compilers (ex: gcc 4.2.1 on older Macs) cannot deal with
+** such a large integer literal, so we have to encode it.
+*/
+#define INT_464269060799999 ((((i64)0x1a640)<<32)|0x1072fdff)
+
+/*
+** Return TRUE if the given julian day number is within range.
+**
+** The input is the JulianDay times 86400000.
+*/
+static int validJulianDay(sqlite3_int64 iJD){
+ return iJD>=0 && iJD<=INT_464269060799999;
+}
+
+/*
+** Compute the Year, Month, and Day from the julian day number.
+*/
+static void computeYMD(DateTime *p){
+ int Z, A, B, C, D, E, X1;
+ if( p->validYMD ) return;
+ if( !p->validJD ){
+ p->Y = 2000;
+ p->M = 1;
+ p->D = 1;
+ }else if( !validJulianDay(p->iJD) ){
+ datetimeError(p);
+ return;
+ }else{
+ Z = (int)((p->iJD + 43200000)/86400000);
+ A = (int)((Z - 1867216.25)/36524.25);
+ A = Z + 1 + A - (A/4);
+ B = A + 1524;
+ C = (int)((B - 122.1)/365.25);
+ D = (36525*(C&32767))/100;
+ E = (int)((B-D)/30.6001);
+ X1 = (int)(30.6001*E);
+ p->D = B - D - X1;
+ p->M = E<14 ? E-1 : E-13;
+ p->Y = p->M>2 ? C - 4716 : C - 4715;
+ }
+ p->validYMD = 1;
+}
+
+/*
+** Compute the Hour, Minute, and Seconds from the julian day number.
+*/
+static void computeHMS(DateTime *p){
+ int s;
+ if( p->validHMS ) return;
+ computeJD(p);
+ s = (int)((p->iJD + 43200000) % 86400000);
+ p->s = s/1000.0;
+ s = (int)p->s;
+ p->s -= s;
+ p->h = s/3600;
+ s -= p->h*3600;
+ p->m = s/60;
+ p->s += s - p->m*60;
+ p->rawS = 0;
+ p->validHMS = 1;
+}
+
+/*
+** Compute both YMD and HMS
+*/
+static void computeYMD_HMS(DateTime *p){
+ computeYMD(p);
+ computeHMS(p);
+}
+
+/*
+** Clear the YMD and HMS and the TZ
+*/
+static void clearYMD_HMS_TZ(DateTime *p){
+ p->validYMD = 0;
+ p->validHMS = 0;
+ p->validTZ = 0;
+}
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOCALTIME
+/*
+** On recent Windows platforms, the localtime_s() function is available
+** as part of the "Secure CRT". It is essentially equivalent to
+** localtime_r() available under most POSIX platforms, except that the
+** order of the parameters is reversed.
+**
+** See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/a442x3ye(VS.80).aspx.
+**
+** If the user has not indicated to use localtime_r() or localtime_s()
+** already, check for an MSVC build environment that provides
+** localtime_s().
+*/
+#if !HAVE_LOCALTIME_R && !HAVE_LOCALTIME_S \
+ && defined(_MSC_VER) && defined(_CRT_INSECURE_DEPRECATE)
+#undef HAVE_LOCALTIME_S
+#define HAVE_LOCALTIME_S 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The following routine implements the rough equivalent of localtime_r()
+** using whatever operating-system specific localtime facility that
+** is available. This routine returns 0 on success and
+** non-zero on any kind of error.
+**
+** If the sqlite3GlobalConfig.bLocaltimeFault variable is true then this
+** routine will always fail.
+**
+** EVIDENCE-OF: R-62172-00036 In this implementation, the standard C
+** library function localtime_r() is used to assist in the calculation of
+** local time.
+*/
+static int osLocaltime(time_t *t, struct tm *pTm){
+ int rc;
+#if !HAVE_LOCALTIME_R && !HAVE_LOCALTIME_S
+ struct tm *pX;
+#if SQLITE_THREADSAFE>0
+ sqlite3_mutex *mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN);
+#endif
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mutex);
+ pX = localtime(t);
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bLocaltimeFault ) pX = 0;
+#endif
+ if( pX ) *pTm = *pX;
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutex);
+ rc = pX==0;
+#else
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bLocaltimeFault ) return 1;
+#endif
+#if HAVE_LOCALTIME_R
+ rc = localtime_r(t, pTm)==0;
+#else
+ rc = localtime_s(pTm, t);
+#endif /* HAVE_LOCALTIME_R */
+#endif /* HAVE_LOCALTIME_R || HAVE_LOCALTIME_S */
+ return rc;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_LOCALTIME */
+
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOCALTIME
+/*
+** Compute the difference (in milliseconds) between localtime and UTC
+** (a.k.a. GMT) for the time value p where p is in UTC. If no error occurs,
+** return this value and set *pRc to SQLITE_OK.
+**
+** Or, if an error does occur, set *pRc to SQLITE_ERROR. The returned value
+** is undefined in this case.
+*/
+static sqlite3_int64 localtimeOffset(
+ DateTime *p, /* Date at which to calculate offset */
+ sqlite3_context *pCtx, /* Write error here if one occurs */
+ int *pRc /* OUT: Error code. SQLITE_OK or ERROR */
+){
+ DateTime x, y;
+ time_t t;
+ struct tm sLocal;
+
+ /* Initialize the contents of sLocal to avoid a compiler warning. */
+ memset(&sLocal, 0, sizeof(sLocal));
+
+ x = *p;
+ computeYMD_HMS(&x);
+ if( x.Y<1971 || x.Y>=2038 ){
+ /* EVIDENCE-OF: R-55269-29598 The localtime_r() C function normally only
+ ** works for years between 1970 and 2037. For dates outside this range,
+ ** SQLite attempts to map the year into an equivalent year within this
+ ** range, do the calculation, then map the year back.
+ */
+ x.Y = 2000;
+ x.M = 1;
+ x.D = 1;
+ x.h = 0;
+ x.m = 0;
+ x.s = 0.0;
+ } else {
+ int s = (int)(x.s + 0.5);
+ x.s = s;
+ }
+ x.tz = 0;
+ x.validJD = 0;
+ computeJD(&x);
+ t = (time_t)(x.iJD/1000 - 21086676*(i64)10000);
+ if( osLocaltime(&t, &sLocal) ){
+ sqlite3_result_error(pCtx, "local time unavailable", -1);
+ *pRc = SQLITE_ERROR;
+ return 0;
+ }
+ y.Y = sLocal.tm_year + 1900;
+ y.M = sLocal.tm_mon + 1;
+ y.D = sLocal.tm_mday;
+ y.h = sLocal.tm_hour;
+ y.m = sLocal.tm_min;
+ y.s = sLocal.tm_sec;
+ y.validYMD = 1;
+ y.validHMS = 1;
+ y.validJD = 0;
+ y.rawS = 0;
+ y.validTZ = 0;
+ y.isError = 0;
+ computeJD(&y);
+ *pRc = SQLITE_OK;
+ return y.iJD - x.iJD;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_LOCALTIME */
+
+/*
+** The following table defines various date transformations of the form
+**
+** 'NNN days'
+**
+** Where NNN is an arbitrary floating-point number and "days" can be one
+** of several units of time.
+*/
+static const struct {
+ u8 eType; /* Transformation type code */
+ u8 nName; /* Length of th name */
+ char *zName; /* Name of the transformation */
+ double rLimit; /* Maximum NNN value for this transform */
+ double rXform; /* Constant used for this transform */
+} aXformType[] = {
+ { 0, 6, "second", 464269060800.0, 1000.0 },
+ { 0, 6, "minute", 7737817680.0, 60000.0 },
+ { 0, 4, "hour", 128963628.0, 3600000.0 },
+ { 0, 3, "day", 5373485.0, 86400000.0 },
+ { 1, 5, "month", 176546.0, 2592000000.0 },
+ { 2, 4, "year", 14713.0, 31536000000.0 },
+};
+
+/*
+** Process a modifier to a date-time stamp. The modifiers are
+** as follows:
+**
+** NNN days
+** NNN hours
+** NNN minutes
+** NNN.NNNN seconds
+** NNN months
+** NNN years
+** start of month
+** start of year
+** start of week
+** start of day
+** weekday N
+** unixepoch
+** localtime
+** utc
+**
+** Return 0 on success and 1 if there is any kind of error. If the error
+** is in a system call (i.e. localtime()), then an error message is written
+** to context pCtx. If the error is an unrecognized modifier, no error is
+** written to pCtx.
+*/
+static int parseModifier(
+ sqlite3_context *pCtx, /* Function context */
+ const char *z, /* The text of the modifier */
+ int n, /* Length of zMod in bytes */
+ DateTime *p /* The date/time value to be modified */
+){
+ int rc = 1;
+ double r;
+ switch(sqlite3UpperToLower[(u8)z[0]] ){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOCALTIME
+ case 'l': {
+ /* localtime
+ **
+ ** Assuming the current time value is UTC (a.k.a. GMT), shift it to
+ ** show local time.
+ */
+ if( sqlite3_stricmp(z, "localtime")==0 && sqlite3NotPureFunc(pCtx) ){
+ computeJD(p);
+ p->iJD += localtimeOffset(p, pCtx, &rc);
+ clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+#endif
+ case 'u': {
+ /*
+ ** unixepoch
+ **
+ ** Treat the current value of p->s as the number of
+ ** seconds since 1970. Convert to a real julian day number.
+ */
+ if( sqlite3_stricmp(z, "unixepoch")==0 && p->rawS ){
+ r = p->s*1000.0 + 210866760000000.0;
+ if( r>=0.0 && r<464269060800000.0 ){
+ clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
+ p->iJD = (sqlite3_int64)(r + 0.5);
+ p->validJD = 1;
+ p->rawS = 0;
+ rc = 0;
+ }
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOCALTIME
+ else if( sqlite3_stricmp(z, "utc")==0 && sqlite3NotPureFunc(pCtx) ){
+ if( p->tzSet==0 ){
+ sqlite3_int64 c1;
+ computeJD(p);
+ c1 = localtimeOffset(p, pCtx, &rc);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ p->iJD -= c1;
+ clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
+ p->iJD += c1 - localtimeOffset(p, pCtx, &rc);
+ }
+ p->tzSet = 1;
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ break;
+ }
+ case 'w': {
+ /*
+ ** weekday N
+ **
+ ** Move the date to the same time on the next occurrence of
+ ** weekday N where 0==Sunday, 1==Monday, and so forth. If the
+ ** date is already on the appropriate weekday, this is a no-op.
+ */
+ if( sqlite3_strnicmp(z, "weekday ", 8)==0
+ && sqlite3AtoF(&z[8], &r, sqlite3Strlen30(&z[8]), SQLITE_UTF8)>0
+ && (n=(int)r)==r && n>=0 && r<7 ){
+ sqlite3_int64 Z;
+ computeYMD_HMS(p);
+ p->validTZ = 0;
+ p->validJD = 0;
+ computeJD(p);
+ Z = ((p->iJD + 129600000)/86400000) % 7;
+ if( Z>n ) Z -= 7;
+ p->iJD += (n - Z)*86400000;
+ clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
+ rc = 0;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ case 's': {
+ /*
+ ** start of TTTTT
+ **
+ ** Move the date backwards to the beginning of the current day,
+ ** or month or year.
+ */
+ if( sqlite3_strnicmp(z, "start of ", 9)!=0 ) break;
+ if( !p->validJD && !p->validYMD && !p->validHMS ) break;
+ z += 9;
+ computeYMD(p);
+ p->validHMS = 1;
+ p->h = p->m = 0;
+ p->s = 0.0;
+ p->rawS = 0;
+ p->validTZ = 0;
+ p->validJD = 0;
+ if( sqlite3_stricmp(z,"month")==0 ){
+ p->D = 1;
+ rc = 0;
+ }else if( sqlite3_stricmp(z,"year")==0 ){
+ p->M = 1;
+ p->D = 1;
+ rc = 0;
+ }else if( sqlite3_stricmp(z,"day")==0 ){
+ rc = 0;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ case '+':
+ case '-':
+ case '0':
+ case '1':
+ case '2':
+ case '3':
+ case '4':
+ case '5':
+ case '6':
+ case '7':
+ case '8':
+ case '9': {
+ double rRounder;
+ int i;
+ for(n=1; z[n] && z[n]!=':' && !sqlite3Isspace(z[n]); n++){}
+ if( sqlite3AtoF(z, &r, n, SQLITE_UTF8)<=0 ){
+ rc = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ if( z[n]==':' ){
+ /* A modifier of the form (+|-)HH:MM:SS.FFF adds (or subtracts) the
+ ** specified number of hours, minutes, seconds, and fractional seconds
+ ** to the time. The ".FFF" may be omitted. The ":SS.FFF" may be
+ ** omitted.
+ */
+ const char *z2 = z;
+ DateTime tx;
+ sqlite3_int64 day;
+ if( !sqlite3Isdigit(*z2) ) z2++;
+ memset(&tx, 0, sizeof(tx));
+ if( parseHhMmSs(z2, &tx) ) break;
+ computeJD(&tx);
+ tx.iJD -= 43200000;
+ day = tx.iJD/86400000;
+ tx.iJD -= day*86400000;
+ if( z[0]=='-' ) tx.iJD = -tx.iJD;
+ computeJD(p);
+ clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
+ p->iJD += tx.iJD;
+ rc = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* If control reaches this point, it means the transformation is
+ ** one of the forms like "+NNN days". */
+ z += n;
+ while( sqlite3Isspace(*z) ) z++;
+ n = sqlite3Strlen30(z);
+ if( n>10 || n<3 ) break;
+ if( sqlite3UpperToLower[(u8)z[n-1]]=='s' ) n--;
+ computeJD(p);
+ rc = 1;
+ rRounder = r<0 ? -0.5 : +0.5;
+ for(i=0; i-aXformType[i].rLimit && rM += (int)r;
+ x = p->M>0 ? (p->M-1)/12 : (p->M-12)/12;
+ p->Y += x;
+ p->M -= x*12;
+ p->validJD = 0;
+ r -= (int)r;
+ break;
+ }
+ case 2: { /* Special processing to add years */
+ int y = (int)r;
+ computeYMD_HMS(p);
+ p->Y += y;
+ p->validJD = 0;
+ r -= (int)r;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ computeJD(p);
+ p->iJD += (sqlite3_int64)(r*aXformType[i].rXform + rRounder);
+ rc = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ clearYMD_HMS_TZ(p);
+ break;
+ }
+ default: {
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Process time function arguments. argv[0] is a date-time stamp.
+** argv[1] and following are modifiers. Parse them all and write
+** the resulting time into the DateTime structure p. Return 0
+** on success and 1 if there are any errors.
+**
+** If there are zero parameters (if even argv[0] is undefined)
+** then assume a default value of "now" for argv[0].
+*/
+static int isDate(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ int argc,
+ sqlite3_value **argv,
+ DateTime *p
+){
+ int i, n;
+ const unsigned char *z;
+ int eType;
+ memset(p, 0, sizeof(*p));
+ if( argc==0 ){
+ return setDateTimeToCurrent(context, p);
+ }
+ if( (eType = sqlite3_value_type(argv[0]))==SQLITE_FLOAT
+ || eType==SQLITE_INTEGER ){
+ setRawDateNumber(p, sqlite3_value_double(argv[0]));
+ }else{
+ z = sqlite3_value_text(argv[0]);
+ if( !z || parseDateOrTime(context, (char*)z, p) ){
+ return 1;
+ }
+ }
+ for(i=1; iisError || !validJulianDay(p->iJD) ) return 1;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** The following routines implement the various date and time functions
+** of SQLite.
+*/
+
+/*
+** julianday( TIMESTRING, MOD, MOD, ...)
+**
+** Return the julian day number of the date specified in the arguments
+*/
+static void juliandayFunc(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ int argc,
+ sqlite3_value **argv
+){
+ DateTime x;
+ if( isDate(context, argc, argv, &x)==0 ){
+ computeJD(&x);
+ sqlite3_result_double(context, x.iJD/86400000.0);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** datetime( TIMESTRING, MOD, MOD, ...)
+**
+** Return YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS
+*/
+static void datetimeFunc(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ int argc,
+ sqlite3_value **argv
+){
+ DateTime x;
+ if( isDate(context, argc, argv, &x)==0 ){
+ char zBuf[100];
+ computeYMD_HMS(&x);
+ sqlite3_snprintf(sizeof(zBuf), zBuf, "%04d-%02d-%02d %02d:%02d:%02d",
+ x.Y, x.M, x.D, x.h, x.m, (int)(x.s));
+ sqlite3_result_text(context, zBuf, -1, SQLITE_TRANSIENT);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** time( TIMESTRING, MOD, MOD, ...)
+**
+** Return HH:MM:SS
+*/
+static void timeFunc(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ int argc,
+ sqlite3_value **argv
+){
+ DateTime x;
+ if( isDate(context, argc, argv, &x)==0 ){
+ char zBuf[100];
+ computeHMS(&x);
+ sqlite3_snprintf(sizeof(zBuf), zBuf, "%02d:%02d:%02d", x.h, x.m, (int)x.s);
+ sqlite3_result_text(context, zBuf, -1, SQLITE_TRANSIENT);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** date( TIMESTRING, MOD, MOD, ...)
+**
+** Return YYYY-MM-DD
+*/
+static void dateFunc(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ int argc,
+ sqlite3_value **argv
+){
+ DateTime x;
+ if( isDate(context, argc, argv, &x)==0 ){
+ char zBuf[100];
+ computeYMD(&x);
+ sqlite3_snprintf(sizeof(zBuf), zBuf, "%04d-%02d-%02d", x.Y, x.M, x.D);
+ sqlite3_result_text(context, zBuf, -1, SQLITE_TRANSIENT);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** strftime( FORMAT, TIMESTRING, MOD, MOD, ...)
+**
+** Return a string described by FORMAT. Conversions as follows:
+**
+** %d day of month
+** %f ** fractional seconds SS.SSS
+** %H hour 00-24
+** %j day of year 000-366
+** %J ** julian day number
+** %m month 01-12
+** %M minute 00-59
+** %s seconds since 1970-01-01
+** %S seconds 00-59
+** %w day of week 0-6 sunday==0
+** %W week of year 00-53
+** %Y year 0000-9999
+** %% %
+*/
+static void strftimeFunc(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ int argc,
+ sqlite3_value **argv
+){
+ DateTime x;
+ u64 n;
+ size_t i,j;
+ char *z;
+ sqlite3 *db;
+ const char *zFmt;
+ char zBuf[100];
+ if( argc==0 ) return;
+ zFmt = (const char*)sqlite3_value_text(argv[0]);
+ if( zFmt==0 || isDate(context, argc-1, argv+1, &x) ) return;
+ db = sqlite3_context_db_handle(context);
+ for(i=0, n=1; zFmt[i]; i++, n++){
+ if( zFmt[i]=='%' ){
+ switch( zFmt[i+1] ){
+ case 'd':
+ case 'H':
+ case 'm':
+ case 'M':
+ case 'S':
+ case 'W':
+ n++;
+ /* fall thru */
+ case 'w':
+ case '%':
+ break;
+ case 'f':
+ n += 8;
+ break;
+ case 'j':
+ n += 3;
+ break;
+ case 'Y':
+ n += 8;
+ break;
+ case 's':
+ case 'J':
+ n += 50;
+ break;
+ default:
+ return; /* ERROR. return a NULL */
+ }
+ i++;
+ }
+ }
+ testcase( n==sizeof(zBuf)-1 );
+ testcase( n==sizeof(zBuf) );
+ testcase( n==(u64)db->aLimit[SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH]+1 );
+ testcase( n==(u64)db->aLimit[SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH] );
+ if( n(u64)db->aLimit[SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH] ){
+ sqlite3_result_error_toobig(context);
+ return;
+ }else{
+ z = sqlite3DbMallocRawNN(db, (int)n);
+ if( z==0 ){
+ sqlite3_result_error_nomem(context);
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ computeJD(&x);
+ computeYMD_HMS(&x);
+ for(i=j=0; zFmt[i]; i++){
+ if( zFmt[i]!='%' ){
+ z[j++] = zFmt[i];
+ }else{
+ i++;
+ switch( zFmt[i] ){
+ case 'd': sqlite3_snprintf(3, &z[j],"%02d",x.D); j+=2; break;
+ case 'f': {
+ double s = x.s;
+ if( s>59.999 ) s = 59.999;
+ sqlite3_snprintf(7, &z[j],"%06.3f", s);
+ j += sqlite3Strlen30(&z[j]);
+ break;
+ }
+ case 'H': sqlite3_snprintf(3, &z[j],"%02d",x.h); j+=2; break;
+ case 'W': /* Fall thru */
+ case 'j': {
+ int nDay; /* Number of days since 1st day of year */
+ DateTime y = x;
+ y.validJD = 0;
+ y.M = 1;
+ y.D = 1;
+ computeJD(&y);
+ nDay = (int)((x.iJD-y.iJD+43200000)/86400000);
+ if( zFmt[i]=='W' ){
+ int wd; /* 0=Monday, 1=Tuesday, ... 6=Sunday */
+ wd = (int)(((x.iJD+43200000)/86400000)%7);
+ sqlite3_snprintf(3, &z[j],"%02d",(nDay+7-wd)/7);
+ j += 2;
+ }else{
+ sqlite3_snprintf(4, &z[j],"%03d",nDay+1);
+ j += 3;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ case 'J': {
+ sqlite3_snprintf(20, &z[j],"%.16g",x.iJD/86400000.0);
+ j+=sqlite3Strlen30(&z[j]);
+ break;
+ }
+ case 'm': sqlite3_snprintf(3, &z[j],"%02d",x.M); j+=2; break;
+ case 'M': sqlite3_snprintf(3, &z[j],"%02d",x.m); j+=2; break;
+ case 's': {
+ i64 iS = (i64)(x.iJD/1000 - 21086676*(i64)10000);
+ sqlite3Int64ToText(iS, &z[j]);
+ j += sqlite3Strlen30(&z[j]);
+ break;
+ }
+ case 'S': sqlite3_snprintf(3,&z[j],"%02d",(int)x.s); j+=2; break;
+ case 'w': {
+ z[j++] = (char)(((x.iJD+129600000)/86400000) % 7) + '0';
+ break;
+ }
+ case 'Y': {
+ sqlite3_snprintf(5,&z[j],"%04d",x.Y); j+=sqlite3Strlen30(&z[j]);
+ break;
+ }
+ default: z[j++] = '%'; break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ z[j] = 0;
+ sqlite3_result_text(context, z, -1,
+ z==zBuf ? SQLITE_TRANSIENT : SQLITE_DYNAMIC);
+}
+
+/*
+** current_time()
+**
+** This function returns the same value as time('now').
+*/
+static void ctimeFunc(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ int NotUsed,
+ sqlite3_value **NotUsed2
+){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER2(NotUsed, NotUsed2);
+ timeFunc(context, 0, 0);
+}
+
+/*
+** current_date()
+**
+** This function returns the same value as date('now').
+*/
+static void cdateFunc(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ int NotUsed,
+ sqlite3_value **NotUsed2
+){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER2(NotUsed, NotUsed2);
+ dateFunc(context, 0, 0);
+}
+
+/*
+** current_timestamp()
+**
+** This function returns the same value as datetime('now').
+*/
+static void ctimestampFunc(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ int NotUsed,
+ sqlite3_value **NotUsed2
+){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER2(NotUsed, NotUsed2);
+ datetimeFunc(context, 0, 0);
+}
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS) */
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS
+/*
+** If the library is compiled to omit the full-scale date and time
+** handling (to get a smaller binary), the following minimal version
+** of the functions current_time(), current_date() and current_timestamp()
+** are included instead. This is to support column declarations that
+** include "DEFAULT CURRENT_TIME" etc.
+**
+** This function uses the C-library functions time(), gmtime()
+** and strftime(). The format string to pass to strftime() is supplied
+** as the user-data for the function.
+*/
+static void currentTimeFunc(
+ sqlite3_context *context,
+ int argc,
+ sqlite3_value **argv
+){
+ time_t t;
+ char *zFormat = (char *)sqlite3_user_data(context);
+ sqlite3_int64 iT;
+ struct tm *pTm;
+ struct tm sNow;
+ char zBuf[20];
+
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(argc);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(argv);
+
+ iT = sqlite3StmtCurrentTime(context);
+ if( iT<=0 ) return;
+ t = iT/1000 - 10000*(sqlite3_int64)21086676;
+#if HAVE_GMTIME_R
+ pTm = gmtime_r(&t, &sNow);
+#else
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN));
+ pTm = gmtime(&t);
+ if( pTm ) memcpy(&sNow, pTm, sizeof(sNow));
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN));
+#endif
+ if( pTm ){
+ strftime(zBuf, 20, zFormat, &sNow);
+ sqlite3_result_text(context, zBuf, -1, SQLITE_TRANSIENT);
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This function registered all of the above C functions as SQL
+** functions. This should be the only routine in this file with
+** external linkage.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RegisterDateTimeFunctions(void){
+ static FuncDef aDateTimeFuncs[] = {
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS
+ PURE_DATE(julianday, -1, 0, 0, juliandayFunc ),
+ PURE_DATE(date, -1, 0, 0, dateFunc ),
+ PURE_DATE(time, -1, 0, 0, timeFunc ),
+ PURE_DATE(datetime, -1, 0, 0, datetimeFunc ),
+ PURE_DATE(strftime, -1, 0, 0, strftimeFunc ),
+ DFUNCTION(current_time, 0, 0, 0, ctimeFunc ),
+ DFUNCTION(current_timestamp, 0, 0, 0, ctimestampFunc),
+ DFUNCTION(current_date, 0, 0, 0, cdateFunc ),
+#else
+ STR_FUNCTION(current_time, 0, "%H:%M:%S", 0, currentTimeFunc),
+ STR_FUNCTION(current_date, 0, "%Y-%m-%d", 0, currentTimeFunc),
+ STR_FUNCTION(current_timestamp, 0, "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S", 0, currentTimeFunc),
+#endif
+ };
+ sqlite3InsertBuiltinFuncs(aDateTimeFuncs, ArraySize(aDateTimeFuncs));
+}
+
+/************** End of date.c ************************************************/
+/************** Begin file os.c **********************************************/
+/*
+** 2005 November 29
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains OS interface code that is common to all
+** architectures.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+/*
+** If we compile with the SQLITE_TEST macro set, then the following block
+** of code will give us the ability to simulate a disk I/O error. This
+** is used for testing the I/O recovery logic.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_io_error_hit = 0; /* Total number of I/O Errors */
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_io_error_hardhit = 0; /* Number of non-benign errors */
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_io_error_pending = 0; /* Count down to first I/O error */
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_io_error_persist = 0; /* True if I/O errors persist */
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_io_error_benign = 0; /* True if errors are benign */
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_diskfull_pending = 0;
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_diskfull = 0;
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_TEST) */
+
+/*
+** When testing, also keep a count of the number of open files.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_open_file_count = 0;
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_TEST) */
+
+/*
+** The default SQLite sqlite3_vfs implementations do not allocate
+** memory (actually, os_unix.c allocates a small amount of memory
+** from within OsOpen()), but some third-party implementations may.
+** So we test the effects of a malloc() failing and the sqlite3OsXXX()
+** function returning SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM using the DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST macro.
+**
+** The following functions are instrumented for malloc() failure
+** testing:
+**
+** sqlite3OsRead()
+** sqlite3OsWrite()
+** sqlite3OsSync()
+** sqlite3OsFileSize()
+** sqlite3OsLock()
+** sqlite3OsCheckReservedLock()
+** sqlite3OsFileControl()
+** sqlite3OsShmMap()
+** sqlite3OsOpen()
+** sqlite3OsDelete()
+** sqlite3OsAccess()
+** sqlite3OsFullPathname()
+**
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_memdebug_vfs_oom_test = 1;
+ #define DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(x) \
+ if (sqlite3_memdebug_vfs_oom_test && (!x || !sqlite3JournalIsInMemory(x))) { \
+ void *pTstAlloc = sqlite3Malloc(10); \
+ if (!pTstAlloc) return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT; \
+ sqlite3_free(pTstAlloc); \
+ }
+#else
+ #define DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(x)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The following routines are convenience wrappers around methods
+** of the sqlite3_file object. This is mostly just syntactic sugar. All
+** of this would be completely automatic if SQLite were coded using
+** C++ instead of plain old C.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsClose(sqlite3_file *pId){
+ if( pId->pMethods ){
+ pId->pMethods->xClose(pId);
+ pId->pMethods = 0;
+ }
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsRead(sqlite3_file *id, void *pBuf, int amt, i64 offset){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(id);
+ return id->pMethods->xRead(id, pBuf, amt, offset);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsWrite(sqlite3_file *id, const void *pBuf, int amt, i64 offset){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(id);
+ return id->pMethods->xWrite(id, pBuf, amt, offset);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsTruncate(sqlite3_file *id, i64 size){
+ return id->pMethods->xTruncate(id, size);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsSync(sqlite3_file *id, int flags){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(id);
+ return flags ? id->pMethods->xSync(id, flags) : SQLITE_OK;
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFileSize(sqlite3_file *id, i64 *pSize){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(id);
+ return id->pMethods->xFileSize(id, pSize);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsLock(sqlite3_file *id, int lockType){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(id);
+ return id->pMethods->xLock(id, lockType);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int lockType){
+ return id->pMethods->xUnlock(id, lockType);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id, int *pResOut){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(id);
+ return id->pMethods->xCheckReservedLock(id, pResOut);
+}
+
+/*
+** Use sqlite3OsFileControl() when we are doing something that might fail
+** and we need to know about the failures. Use sqlite3OsFileControlHint()
+** when simply tossing information over the wall to the VFS and we do not
+** really care if the VFS receives and understands the information since it
+** is only a hint and can be safely ignored. The sqlite3OsFileControlHint()
+** routine has no return value since the return value would be meaningless.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFileControl(sqlite3_file *id, int op, void *pArg){
+ if( id->pMethods==0 ) return SQLITE_NOTFOUND;
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ if( op!=SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_PHASETWO
+ && op!=SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCK_TIMEOUT
+ ){
+ /* Faults are not injected into COMMIT_PHASETWO because, assuming SQLite
+ ** is using a regular VFS, it is called after the corresponding
+ ** transaction has been committed. Injecting a fault at this point
+ ** confuses the test scripts - the COMMIT comand returns SQLITE_NOMEM
+ ** but the transaction is committed anyway.
+ **
+ ** The core must call OsFileControl() though, not OsFileControlHint(),
+ ** as if a custom VFS (e.g. zipvfs) returns an error here, it probably
+ ** means the commit really has failed and an error should be returned
+ ** to the user. */
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(id);
+ }
+#endif
+ return id->pMethods->xFileControl(id, op, pArg);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsFileControlHint(sqlite3_file *id, int op, void *pArg){
+ if( id->pMethods ) (void)id->pMethods->xFileControl(id, op, pArg);
+}
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsSectorSize(sqlite3_file *id){
+ int (*xSectorSize)(sqlite3_file*) = id->pMethods->xSectorSize;
+ return (xSectorSize ? xSectorSize(id) : SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsDeviceCharacteristics(sqlite3_file *id){
+ return id->pMethods->xDeviceCharacteristics(id);
+}
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsShmLock(sqlite3_file *id, int offset, int n, int flags){
+ return id->pMethods->xShmLock(id, offset, n, flags);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsShmBarrier(sqlite3_file *id){
+ id->pMethods->xShmBarrier(id);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsShmUnmap(sqlite3_file *id, int deleteFlag){
+ return id->pMethods->xShmUnmap(id, deleteFlag);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsShmMap(
+ sqlite3_file *id, /* Database file handle */
+ int iPage,
+ int pgsz,
+ int bExtend, /* True to extend file if necessary */
+ void volatile **pp /* OUT: Pointer to mapping */
+){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(id);
+ return id->pMethods->xShmMap(id, iPage, pgsz, bExtend, pp);
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_WAL */
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+/* The real implementation of xFetch and xUnfetch */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFetch(sqlite3_file *id, i64 iOff, int iAmt, void **pp){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(id);
+ return id->pMethods->xFetch(id, iOff, iAmt, pp);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsUnfetch(sqlite3_file *id, i64 iOff, void *p){
+ return id->pMethods->xUnfetch(id, iOff, p);
+}
+#else
+/* No-op stubs to use when memory-mapped I/O is disabled */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFetch(sqlite3_file *id, i64 iOff, int iAmt, void **pp){
+ *pp = 0;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsUnfetch(sqlite3_file *id, i64 iOff, void *p){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The next group of routines are convenience wrappers around the
+** VFS methods.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsOpen(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs,
+ const char *zPath,
+ sqlite3_file *pFile,
+ int flags,
+ int *pFlagsOut
+){
+ int rc;
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(0);
+ /* 0x87f7f is a mask of SQLITE_OPEN_ flags that are valid to be passed
+ ** down into the VFS layer. Some SQLITE_OPEN_ flags (for example,
+ ** SQLITE_OPEN_FULLMUTEX or SQLITE_OPEN_SHAREDCACHE) are blocked before
+ ** reaching the VFS. */
+ rc = pVfs->xOpen(pVfs, zPath, pFile, flags & 0x1087f7f, pFlagsOut);
+ assert( rc==SQLITE_OK || pFile->pMethods==0 );
+ return rc;
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsDelete(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, const char *zPath, int dirSync){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(0);
+ assert( dirSync==0 || dirSync==1 );
+ return pVfs->xDelete(pVfs, zPath, dirSync);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsAccess(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs,
+ const char *zPath,
+ int flags,
+ int *pResOut
+){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(0);
+ return pVfs->xAccess(pVfs, zPath, flags, pResOut);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFullPathname(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs,
+ const char *zPath,
+ int nPathOut,
+ char *zPathOut
+){
+ DO_OS_MALLOC_TEST(0);
+ zPathOut[0] = 0;
+ return pVfs->xFullPathname(pVfs, zPath, nPathOut, zPathOut);
+}
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3OsDlOpen(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, const char *zPath){
+ return pVfs->xDlOpen(pVfs, zPath);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsDlError(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int nByte, char *zBufOut){
+ pVfs->xDlError(pVfs, nByte, zBufOut);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void (*sqlite3OsDlSym(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, void *pHdle, const char *zSym))(void){
+ return pVfs->xDlSym(pVfs, pHdle, zSym);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsDlClose(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, void *pHandle){
+ pVfs->xDlClose(pVfs, pHandle);
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsRandomness(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int nByte, char *zBufOut){
+ if( sqlite3Config.iPrngSeed ){
+ memset(zBufOut, 0, nByte);
+ if( ALWAYS(nByte>(signed)sizeof(unsigned)) ) nByte = sizeof(unsigned int);
+ memcpy(zBufOut, &sqlite3Config.iPrngSeed, nByte);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ return pVfs->xRandomness(pVfs, nByte, zBufOut);
+ }
+
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsSleep(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int nMicro){
+ return pVfs->xSleep(pVfs, nMicro);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsGetLastError(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs){
+ return pVfs->xGetLastError ? pVfs->xGetLastError(pVfs, 0, 0) : 0;
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsCurrentTimeInt64(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, sqlite3_int64 *pTimeOut){
+ int rc;
+ /* IMPLEMENTATION-OF: R-49045-42493 SQLite will use the xCurrentTimeInt64()
+ ** method to get the current date and time if that method is available
+ ** (if iVersion is 2 or greater and the function pointer is not NULL) and
+ ** will fall back to xCurrentTime() if xCurrentTimeInt64() is
+ ** unavailable.
+ */
+ if( pVfs->iVersion>=2 && pVfs->xCurrentTimeInt64 ){
+ rc = pVfs->xCurrentTimeInt64(pVfs, pTimeOut);
+ }else{
+ double r;
+ rc = pVfs->xCurrentTime(pVfs, &r);
+ *pTimeOut = (sqlite3_int64)(r*86400000.0);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsOpenMalloc(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs,
+ const char *zFile,
+ sqlite3_file **ppFile,
+ int flags,
+ int *pOutFlags
+){
+ int rc;
+ sqlite3_file *pFile;
+ pFile = (sqlite3_file *)sqlite3MallocZero(pVfs->szOsFile);
+ if( pFile ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsOpen(pVfs, zFile, pFile, flags, pOutFlags);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ sqlite3_free(pFile);
+ }else{
+ *ppFile = pFile;
+ }
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsCloseFree(sqlite3_file *pFile){
+ assert( pFile );
+ sqlite3OsClose(pFile);
+ sqlite3_free(pFile);
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is a wrapper around the OS specific implementation of
+** sqlite3_os_init(). The purpose of the wrapper is to provide the
+** ability to simulate a malloc failure, so that the handling of an
+** error in sqlite3_os_init() by the upper layers can be tested.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsInit(void){
+ void *p = sqlite3_malloc(10);
+ if( p==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ return sqlite3_os_init();
+}
+
+/*
+** The list of all registered VFS implementations.
+*/
+static sqlite3_vfs * SQLITE_WSD vfsList = 0;
+#define vfsList GLOBAL(sqlite3_vfs *, vfsList)
+
+/*
+** Locate a VFS by name. If no name is given, simply return the
+** first VFS on the list.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_vfs *sqlite3_vfs_find(const char *zVfs){
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs = 0;
+#if SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+ sqlite3_mutex *mutex;
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ int rc = sqlite3_initialize();
+ if( rc ) return 0;
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+ mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN);
+#endif
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mutex);
+ for(pVfs = vfsList; pVfs; pVfs=pVfs->pNext){
+ if( zVfs==0 ) break;
+ if( strcmp(zVfs, pVfs->zName)==0 ) break;
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutex);
+ return pVfs;
+}
+
+/*
+** Unlink a VFS from the linked list
+*/
+static void vfsUnlink(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs){
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN)) );
+ if( pVfs==0 ){
+ /* No-op */
+ }else if( vfsList==pVfs ){
+ vfsList = pVfs->pNext;
+ }else if( vfsList ){
+ sqlite3_vfs *p = vfsList;
+ while( p->pNext && p->pNext!=pVfs ){
+ p = p->pNext;
+ }
+ if( p->pNext==pVfs ){
+ p->pNext = pVfs->pNext;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Register a VFS with the system. It is harmless to register the same
+** VFS multiple times. The new VFS becomes the default if makeDflt is
+** true.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_vfs_register(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int makeDflt){
+ MUTEX_LOGIC(sqlite3_mutex *mutex;)
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ int rc = sqlite3_initialize();
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( pVfs==0 ) return SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+#endif
+
+ MUTEX_LOGIC( mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN); )
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mutex);
+ vfsUnlink(pVfs);
+ if( makeDflt || vfsList==0 ){
+ pVfs->pNext = vfsList;
+ vfsList = pVfs;
+ }else{
+ pVfs->pNext = vfsList->pNext;
+ vfsList->pNext = pVfs;
+ }
+ assert(vfsList);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutex);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Unregister a VFS so that it is no longer accessible.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_vfs_unregister(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs){
+ MUTEX_LOGIC(sqlite3_mutex *mutex;)
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ int rc = sqlite3_initialize();
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+#endif
+ MUTEX_LOGIC( mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN); )
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mutex);
+ vfsUnlink(pVfs);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutex);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/************** End of os.c **************************************************/
+/************** Begin file fault.c *******************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 Jan 22
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains code to support the concept of "benign"
+** malloc failures (when the xMalloc() or xRealloc() method of the
+** sqlite3_mem_methods structure fails to allocate a block of memory
+** and returns 0).
+**
+** Most malloc failures are non-benign. After they occur, SQLite
+** abandons the current operation and returns an error code (usually
+** SQLITE_NOMEM) to the user. However, sometimes a fault is not necessarily
+** fatal. For example, if a malloc fails while resizing a hash table, this
+** is completely recoverable simply by not carrying out the resize. The
+** hash table will continue to function normally. So a malloc failure
+** during a hash table resize is a benign fault.
+*/
+
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+
+/*
+** Global variables.
+*/
+typedef struct BenignMallocHooks BenignMallocHooks;
+static SQLITE_WSD struct BenignMallocHooks {
+ void (*xBenignBegin)(void);
+ void (*xBenignEnd)(void);
+} sqlite3Hooks = { 0, 0 };
+
+/* The "wsdHooks" macro will resolve to the appropriate BenignMallocHooks
+** structure. If writable static data is unsupported on the target,
+** we have to locate the state vector at run-time. In the more common
+** case where writable static data is supported, wsdHooks can refer directly
+** to the "sqlite3Hooks" state vector declared above.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_WSD
+# define wsdHooksInit \
+ BenignMallocHooks *x = &GLOBAL(BenignMallocHooks,sqlite3Hooks)
+# define wsdHooks x[0]
+#else
+# define wsdHooksInit
+# define wsdHooks sqlite3Hooks
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+** Register hooks to call when sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc() and
+** sqlite3EndBenignMalloc() are called, respectively.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BenignMallocHooks(
+ void (*xBenignBegin)(void),
+ void (*xBenignEnd)(void)
+){
+ wsdHooksInit;
+ wsdHooks.xBenignBegin = xBenignBegin;
+ wsdHooks.xBenignEnd = xBenignEnd;
+}
+
+/*
+** This (sqlite3EndBenignMalloc()) is called by SQLite code to indicate that
+** subsequent malloc failures are benign. A call to sqlite3EndBenignMalloc()
+** indicates that subsequent malloc failures are non-benign.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc(void){
+ wsdHooksInit;
+ if( wsdHooks.xBenignBegin ){
+ wsdHooks.xBenignBegin();
+ }
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3EndBenignMalloc(void){
+ wsdHooksInit;
+ if( wsdHooks.xBenignEnd ){
+ wsdHooks.xBenignEnd();
+ }
+}
+
+#endif /* #ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE */
+
+/************** End of fault.c ***********************************************/
+/************** Begin file mem0.c ********************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 October 28
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains a no-op memory allocation drivers for use when
+** SQLITE_ZERO_MALLOC is defined. The allocation drivers implemented
+** here always fail. SQLite will not operate with these drivers. These
+** are merely placeholders. Real drivers must be substituted using
+** sqlite3_config() before SQLite will operate.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+/*
+** This version of the memory allocator is the default. It is
+** used when no other memory allocator is specified using compile-time
+** macros.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_ZERO_MALLOC
+
+/*
+** No-op versions of all memory allocation routines
+*/
+static void *sqlite3MemMalloc(int nByte){ return 0; }
+static void sqlite3MemFree(void *pPrior){ return; }
+static void *sqlite3MemRealloc(void *pPrior, int nByte){ return 0; }
+static int sqlite3MemSize(void *pPrior){ return 0; }
+static int sqlite3MemRoundup(int n){ return n; }
+static int sqlite3MemInit(void *NotUsed){ return SQLITE_OK; }
+static void sqlite3MemShutdown(void *NotUsed){ return; }
+
+/*
+** This routine is the only routine in this file with external linkage.
+**
+** Populate the low-level memory allocation function pointers in
+** sqlite3GlobalConfig.m with pointers to the routines in this file.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemSetDefault(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mem_methods defaultMethods = {
+ sqlite3MemMalloc,
+ sqlite3MemFree,
+ sqlite3MemRealloc,
+ sqlite3MemSize,
+ sqlite3MemRoundup,
+ sqlite3MemInit,
+ sqlite3MemShutdown,
+ 0
+ };
+ sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC, &defaultMethods);
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_ZERO_MALLOC */
+
+/************** End of mem0.c ************************************************/
+/************** Begin file mem1.c ********************************************/
+/*
+** 2007 August 14
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains low-level memory allocation drivers for when
+** SQLite will use the standard C-library malloc/realloc/free interface
+** to obtain the memory it needs.
+**
+** This file contains implementations of the low-level memory allocation
+** routines specified in the sqlite3_mem_methods object. The content of
+** this file is only used if SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC is defined. The
+** SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC macro is defined automatically if neither the
+** SQLITE_MEMDEBUG nor the SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC macros are defined. The
+** default configuration is to use memory allocation routines in this
+** file.
+**
+** C-preprocessor macro summary:
+**
+** HAVE_MALLOC_USABLE_SIZE The configure script sets this symbol if
+** the malloc_usable_size() interface exists
+** on the target platform. Or, this symbol
+** can be set manually, if desired.
+** If an equivalent interface exists by
+** a different name, using a separate -D
+** option to rename it.
+**
+** SQLITE_WITHOUT_ZONEMALLOC Some older macs lack support for the zone
+** memory allocator. Set this symbol to enable
+** building on older macs.
+**
+** SQLITE_WITHOUT_MSIZE Set this symbol to disable the use of
+** _msize() on windows systems. This might
+** be necessary when compiling for Delphi,
+** for example.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+/*
+** This version of the memory allocator is the default. It is
+** used when no other memory allocator is specified using compile-time
+** macros.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && !defined(SQLITE_WITHOUT_ZONEMALLOC)
+
+/*
+** Use the zone allocator available on apple products unless the
+** SQLITE_WITHOUT_ZONEMALLOC symbol is defined.
+*/
+#include
+#include
+#ifdef SQLITE_MIGHT_BE_SINGLE_CORE
+#include
+#endif /* SQLITE_MIGHT_BE_SINGLE_CORE */
+static malloc_zone_t* _sqliteZone_;
+#define SQLITE_MALLOC(x) malloc_zone_malloc(_sqliteZone_, (x))
+#define SQLITE_FREE(x) malloc_zone_free(_sqliteZone_, (x));
+#define SQLITE_REALLOC(x,y) malloc_zone_realloc(_sqliteZone_, (x), (y))
+#define SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE(x) \
+ (_sqliteZone_ ? _sqliteZone_->size(_sqliteZone_,x) : malloc_size(x))
+
+#else /* if not __APPLE__ */
+
+/*
+** Use standard C library malloc and free on non-Apple systems.
+** Also used by Apple systems if SQLITE_WITHOUT_ZONEMALLOC is defined.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_MALLOC(x) malloc(x)
+#define SQLITE_FREE(x) free(x)
+#define SQLITE_REALLOC(x,y) realloc((x),(y))
+
+/*
+** The malloc.h header file is needed for malloc_usable_size() function
+** on some systems (e.g. Linux).
+*/
+#if HAVE_MALLOC_H && HAVE_MALLOC_USABLE_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_USE_MALLOC_H 1
+# define SQLITE_USE_MALLOC_USABLE_SIZE 1
+/*
+** The MSVCRT has malloc_usable_size(), but it is called _msize(). The
+** use of _msize() is automatic, but can be disabled by compiling with
+** -DSQLITE_WITHOUT_MSIZE. Using the _msize() function also requires
+** the malloc.h header file.
+*/
+#elif defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(SQLITE_WITHOUT_MSIZE)
+# define SQLITE_USE_MALLOC_H
+# define SQLITE_USE_MSIZE
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Include the malloc.h header file, if necessary. Also set define macro
+** SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE to the appropriate function name, which is _msize()
+** for MSVC and malloc_usable_size() for most other systems (e.g. Linux).
+** The memory size function can always be overridden manually by defining
+** the macro SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE to the desired function name.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_USE_MALLOC_H)
+# include
+# if defined(SQLITE_USE_MALLOC_USABLE_SIZE)
+# if !defined(SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE)
+# define SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE(x) malloc_usable_size(x)
+# endif
+# elif defined(SQLITE_USE_MSIZE)
+# if !defined(SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE)
+# define SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE _msize
+# endif
+# endif
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_USE_MALLOC_H) */
+
+#endif /* __APPLE__ or not __APPLE__ */
+
+/*
+** Like malloc(), but remember the size of the allocation
+** so that we can find it later using sqlite3MemSize().
+**
+** For this low-level routine, we are guaranteed that nByte>0 because
+** cases of nByte<=0 will be intercepted and dealt with by higher level
+** routines.
+*/
+static void *sqlite3MemMalloc(int nByte){
+#ifdef SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE
+ void *p;
+ testcase( ROUND8(nByte)==nByte );
+ p = SQLITE_MALLOC( nByte );
+ if( p==0 ){
+ testcase( sqlite3GlobalConfig.xLog!=0 );
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM, "failed to allocate %u bytes of memory", nByte);
+ }
+ return p;
+#else
+ sqlite3_int64 *p;
+ assert( nByte>0 );
+ testcase( ROUND8(nByte)!=nByte );
+ p = SQLITE_MALLOC( nByte+8 );
+ if( p ){
+ p[0] = nByte;
+ p++;
+ }else{
+ testcase( sqlite3GlobalConfig.xLog!=0 );
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM, "failed to allocate %u bytes of memory", nByte);
+ }
+ return (void *)p;
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Like free() but works for allocations obtained from sqlite3MemMalloc()
+** or sqlite3MemRealloc().
+**
+** For this low-level routine, we already know that pPrior!=0 since
+** cases where pPrior==0 will have been intecepted and dealt with
+** by higher-level routines.
+*/
+static void sqlite3MemFree(void *pPrior){
+#ifdef SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE
+ SQLITE_FREE(pPrior);
+#else
+ sqlite3_int64 *p = (sqlite3_int64*)pPrior;
+ assert( pPrior!=0 );
+ p--;
+ SQLITE_FREE(p);
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Report the allocated size of a prior return from xMalloc()
+** or xRealloc().
+*/
+static int sqlite3MemSize(void *pPrior){
+#ifdef SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE
+ assert( pPrior!=0 );
+ return (int)SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE(pPrior);
+#else
+ sqlite3_int64 *p;
+ assert( pPrior!=0 );
+ p = (sqlite3_int64*)pPrior;
+ p--;
+ return (int)p[0];
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Like realloc(). Resize an allocation previously obtained from
+** sqlite3MemMalloc().
+**
+** For this low-level interface, we know that pPrior!=0. Cases where
+** pPrior==0 while have been intercepted by higher-level routine and
+** redirected to xMalloc. Similarly, we know that nByte>0 because
+** cases where nByte<=0 will have been intercepted by higher-level
+** routines and redirected to xFree.
+*/
+static void *sqlite3MemRealloc(void *pPrior, int nByte){
+#ifdef SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE
+ void *p = SQLITE_REALLOC(pPrior, nByte);
+ if( p==0 ){
+ testcase( sqlite3GlobalConfig.xLog!=0 );
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM,
+ "failed memory resize %u to %u bytes",
+ SQLITE_MALLOCSIZE(pPrior), nByte);
+ }
+ return p;
+#else
+ sqlite3_int64 *p = (sqlite3_int64*)pPrior;
+ assert( pPrior!=0 && nByte>0 );
+ assert( nByte==ROUND8(nByte) ); /* EV: R-46199-30249 */
+ p--;
+ p = SQLITE_REALLOC(p, nByte+8 );
+ if( p ){
+ p[0] = nByte;
+ p++;
+ }else{
+ testcase( sqlite3GlobalConfig.xLog!=0 );
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM,
+ "failed memory resize %u to %u bytes",
+ sqlite3MemSize(pPrior), nByte);
+ }
+ return (void*)p;
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Round up a request size to the next valid allocation size.
+*/
+static int sqlite3MemRoundup(int n){
+ return ROUND8(n);
+}
+
+/*
+** Initialize this module.
+*/
+static int sqlite3MemInit(void *NotUsed){
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && !defined(SQLITE_WITHOUT_ZONEMALLOC)
+ int cpuCount;
+ size_t len;
+ if( _sqliteZone_ ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ len = sizeof(cpuCount);
+ /* One usually wants to use hw.acctivecpu for MT decisions, but not here */
+ sysctlbyname("hw.ncpu", &cpuCount, &len, NULL, 0);
+ if( cpuCount>1 ){
+ /* defer MT decisions to system malloc */
+ _sqliteZone_ = malloc_default_zone();
+ }else{
+ /* only 1 core, use our own zone to contention over global locks,
+ ** e.g. we have our own dedicated locks */
+ _sqliteZone_ = malloc_create_zone(4096, 0);
+ malloc_set_zone_name(_sqliteZone_, "Sqlite_Heap");
+ }
+#endif /* defined(__APPLE__) && !defined(SQLITE_WITHOUT_ZONEMALLOC) */
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Deinitialize this module.
+*/
+static void sqlite3MemShutdown(void *NotUsed){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+** This routine is the only routine in this file with external linkage.
+**
+** Populate the low-level memory allocation function pointers in
+** sqlite3GlobalConfig.m with pointers to the routines in this file.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemSetDefault(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mem_methods defaultMethods = {
+ sqlite3MemMalloc,
+ sqlite3MemFree,
+ sqlite3MemRealloc,
+ sqlite3MemSize,
+ sqlite3MemRoundup,
+ sqlite3MemInit,
+ sqlite3MemShutdown,
+ 0
+ };
+ sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC, &defaultMethods);
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_SYSTEM_MALLOC */
+
+/************** End of mem1.c ************************************************/
+/************** Begin file mem2.c ********************************************/
+/*
+** 2007 August 15
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains low-level memory allocation drivers for when
+** SQLite will use the standard C-library malloc/realloc/free interface
+** to obtain the memory it needs while adding lots of additional debugging
+** information to each allocation in order to help detect and fix memory
+** leaks and memory usage errors.
+**
+** This file contains implementations of the low-level memory allocation
+** routines specified in the sqlite3_mem_methods object.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+/*
+** This version of the memory allocator is used only if the
+** SQLITE_MEMDEBUG macro is defined
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_MEMDEBUG
+
+/*
+** The backtrace functionality is only available with GLIBC
+*/
+#ifdef __GLIBC__
+ extern int backtrace(void**,int);
+ extern void backtrace_symbols_fd(void*const*,int,int);
+#else
+# define backtrace(A,B) 1
+# define backtrace_symbols_fd(A,B,C)
+#endif
+/* #include */
+
+/*
+** Each memory allocation looks like this:
+**
+** ------------------------------------------------------------------------
+** | Title | backtrace pointers | MemBlockHdr | allocation | EndGuard |
+** ------------------------------------------------------------------------
+**
+** The application code sees only a pointer to the allocation. We have
+** to back up from the allocation pointer to find the MemBlockHdr. The
+** MemBlockHdr tells us the size of the allocation and the number of
+** backtrace pointers. There is also a guard word at the end of the
+** MemBlockHdr.
+*/
+struct MemBlockHdr {
+ i64 iSize; /* Size of this allocation */
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pNext, *pPrev; /* Linked list of all unfreed memory */
+ char nBacktrace; /* Number of backtraces on this alloc */
+ char nBacktraceSlots; /* Available backtrace slots */
+ u8 nTitle; /* Bytes of title; includes '\0' */
+ u8 eType; /* Allocation type code */
+ int iForeGuard; /* Guard word for sanity */
+};
+
+/*
+** Guard words
+*/
+#define FOREGUARD 0x80F5E153
+#define REARGUARD 0xE4676B53
+
+/*
+** Number of malloc size increments to track.
+*/
+#define NCSIZE 1000
+
+/*
+** All of the static variables used by this module are collected
+** into a single structure named "mem". This is to keep the
+** static variables organized and to reduce namespace pollution
+** when this module is combined with other in the amalgamation.
+*/
+static struct {
+
+ /*
+ ** Mutex to control access to the memory allocation subsystem.
+ */
+ sqlite3_mutex *mutex;
+
+ /*
+ ** Head and tail of a linked list of all outstanding allocations
+ */
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pFirst;
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pLast;
+
+ /*
+ ** The number of levels of backtrace to save in new allocations.
+ */
+ int nBacktrace;
+ void (*xBacktrace)(int, int, void **);
+
+ /*
+ ** Title text to insert in front of each block
+ */
+ int nTitle; /* Bytes of zTitle to save. Includes '\0' and padding */
+ char zTitle[100]; /* The title text */
+
+ /*
+ ** sqlite3MallocDisallow() increments the following counter.
+ ** sqlite3MallocAllow() decrements it.
+ */
+ int disallow; /* Do not allow memory allocation */
+
+ /*
+ ** Gather statistics on the sizes of memory allocations.
+ ** nAlloc[i] is the number of allocation attempts of i*8
+ ** bytes. i==NCSIZE is the number of allocation attempts for
+ ** sizes more than NCSIZE*8 bytes.
+ */
+ int nAlloc[NCSIZE]; /* Total number of allocations */
+ int nCurrent[NCSIZE]; /* Current number of allocations */
+ int mxCurrent[NCSIZE]; /* Highwater mark for nCurrent */
+
+} mem;
+
+
+/*
+** Adjust memory usage statistics
+*/
+static void adjustStats(int iSize, int increment){
+ int i = ROUND8(iSize)/8;
+ if( i>NCSIZE-1 ){
+ i = NCSIZE - 1;
+ }
+ if( increment>0 ){
+ mem.nAlloc[i]++;
+ mem.nCurrent[i]++;
+ if( mem.nCurrent[i]>mem.mxCurrent[i] ){
+ mem.mxCurrent[i] = mem.nCurrent[i];
+ }
+ }else{
+ mem.nCurrent[i]--;
+ assert( mem.nCurrent[i]>=0 );
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Given an allocation, find the MemBlockHdr for that allocation.
+**
+** This routine checks the guards at either end of the allocation and
+** if they are incorrect it asserts.
+*/
+static struct MemBlockHdr *sqlite3MemsysGetHeader(void *pAllocation){
+ struct MemBlockHdr *p;
+ int *pInt;
+ u8 *pU8;
+ int nReserve;
+
+ p = (struct MemBlockHdr*)pAllocation;
+ p--;
+ assert( p->iForeGuard==(int)FOREGUARD );
+ nReserve = ROUND8(p->iSize);
+ pInt = (int*)pAllocation;
+ pU8 = (u8*)pAllocation;
+ assert( pInt[nReserve/sizeof(int)]==(int)REARGUARD );
+ /* This checks any of the "extra" bytes allocated due
+ ** to rounding up to an 8 byte boundary to ensure
+ ** they haven't been overwritten.
+ */
+ while( nReserve-- > p->iSize ) assert( pU8[nReserve]==0x65 );
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the number of bytes currently allocated at address p.
+*/
+static int sqlite3MemSize(void *p){
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pHdr;
+ if( !p ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ pHdr = sqlite3MemsysGetHeader(p);
+ return (int)pHdr->iSize;
+}
+
+/*
+** Initialize the memory allocation subsystem.
+*/
+static int sqlite3MemInit(void *NotUsed){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ assert( (sizeof(struct MemBlockHdr)&7) == 0 );
+ if( !sqlite3GlobalConfig.bMemstat ){
+ /* If memory status is enabled, then the malloc.c wrapper will already
+ ** hold the STATIC_MEM mutex when the routines here are invoked. */
+ mem.mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM);
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Deinitialize the memory allocation subsystem.
+*/
+static void sqlite3MemShutdown(void *NotUsed){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ mem.mutex = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Round up a request size to the next valid allocation size.
+*/
+static int sqlite3MemRoundup(int n){
+ return ROUND8(n);
+}
+
+/*
+** Fill a buffer with pseudo-random bytes. This is used to preset
+** the content of a new memory allocation to unpredictable values and
+** to clear the content of a freed allocation to unpredictable values.
+*/
+static void randomFill(char *pBuf, int nByte){
+ unsigned int x, y, r;
+ x = SQLITE_PTR_TO_INT(pBuf);
+ y = nByte | 1;
+ while( nByte >= 4 ){
+ x = (x>>1) ^ (-(int)(x&1) & 0xd0000001);
+ y = y*1103515245 + 12345;
+ r = x ^ y;
+ *(int*)pBuf = r;
+ pBuf += 4;
+ nByte -= 4;
+ }
+ while( nByte-- > 0 ){
+ x = (x>>1) ^ (-(int)(x&1) & 0xd0000001);
+ y = y*1103515245 + 12345;
+ r = x ^ y;
+ *(pBuf++) = r & 0xff;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Allocate nByte bytes of memory.
+*/
+static void *sqlite3MemMalloc(int nByte){
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pHdr;
+ void **pBt;
+ char *z;
+ int *pInt;
+ void *p = 0;
+ int totalSize;
+ int nReserve;
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem.mutex);
+ assert( mem.disallow==0 );
+ nReserve = ROUND8(nByte);
+ totalSize = nReserve + sizeof(*pHdr) + sizeof(int) +
+ mem.nBacktrace*sizeof(void*) + mem.nTitle;
+ p = malloc(totalSize);
+ if( p ){
+ z = p;
+ pBt = (void**)&z[mem.nTitle];
+ pHdr = (struct MemBlockHdr*)&pBt[mem.nBacktrace];
+ pHdr->pNext = 0;
+ pHdr->pPrev = mem.pLast;
+ if( mem.pLast ){
+ mem.pLast->pNext = pHdr;
+ }else{
+ mem.pFirst = pHdr;
+ }
+ mem.pLast = pHdr;
+ pHdr->iForeGuard = FOREGUARD;
+ pHdr->eType = MEMTYPE_HEAP;
+ pHdr->nBacktraceSlots = mem.nBacktrace;
+ pHdr->nTitle = mem.nTitle;
+ if( mem.nBacktrace ){
+ void *aAddr[40];
+ pHdr->nBacktrace = backtrace(aAddr, mem.nBacktrace+1)-1;
+ memcpy(pBt, &aAddr[1], pHdr->nBacktrace*sizeof(void*));
+ assert(pBt[0]);
+ if( mem.xBacktrace ){
+ mem.xBacktrace(nByte, pHdr->nBacktrace-1, &aAddr[1]);
+ }
+ }else{
+ pHdr->nBacktrace = 0;
+ }
+ if( mem.nTitle ){
+ memcpy(z, mem.zTitle, mem.nTitle);
+ }
+ pHdr->iSize = nByte;
+ adjustStats(nByte, +1);
+ pInt = (int*)&pHdr[1];
+ pInt[nReserve/sizeof(int)] = REARGUARD;
+ randomFill((char*)pInt, nByte);
+ memset(((char*)pInt)+nByte, 0x65, nReserve-nByte);
+ p = (void*)pInt;
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem.mutex);
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free memory.
+*/
+static void sqlite3MemFree(void *pPrior){
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pHdr;
+ void **pBt;
+ char *z;
+ assert( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bMemstat || sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex==0
+ || mem.mutex!=0 );
+ pHdr = sqlite3MemsysGetHeader(pPrior);
+ pBt = (void**)pHdr;
+ pBt -= pHdr->nBacktraceSlots;
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem.mutex);
+ if( pHdr->pPrev ){
+ assert( pHdr->pPrev->pNext==pHdr );
+ pHdr->pPrev->pNext = pHdr->pNext;
+ }else{
+ assert( mem.pFirst==pHdr );
+ mem.pFirst = pHdr->pNext;
+ }
+ if( pHdr->pNext ){
+ assert( pHdr->pNext->pPrev==pHdr );
+ pHdr->pNext->pPrev = pHdr->pPrev;
+ }else{
+ assert( mem.pLast==pHdr );
+ mem.pLast = pHdr->pPrev;
+ }
+ z = (char*)pBt;
+ z -= pHdr->nTitle;
+ adjustStats((int)pHdr->iSize, -1);
+ randomFill(z, sizeof(void*)*pHdr->nBacktraceSlots + sizeof(*pHdr) +
+ (int)pHdr->iSize + sizeof(int) + pHdr->nTitle);
+ free(z);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem.mutex);
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the size of an existing memory allocation.
+**
+** For this debugging implementation, we *always* make a copy of the
+** allocation into a new place in memory. In this way, if the
+** higher level code is using pointer to the old allocation, it is
+** much more likely to break and we are much more liking to find
+** the error.
+*/
+static void *sqlite3MemRealloc(void *pPrior, int nByte){
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pOldHdr;
+ void *pNew;
+ assert( mem.disallow==0 );
+ assert( (nByte & 7)==0 ); /* EV: R-46199-30249 */
+ pOldHdr = sqlite3MemsysGetHeader(pPrior);
+ pNew = sqlite3MemMalloc(nByte);
+ if( pNew ){
+ memcpy(pNew, pPrior, (int)(nByteiSize ? nByte : pOldHdr->iSize));
+ if( nByte>pOldHdr->iSize ){
+ randomFill(&((char*)pNew)[pOldHdr->iSize], nByte - (int)pOldHdr->iSize);
+ }
+ sqlite3MemFree(pPrior);
+ }
+ return pNew;
+}
+
+/*
+** Populate the low-level memory allocation function pointers in
+** sqlite3GlobalConfig.m with pointers to the routines in this file.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemSetDefault(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mem_methods defaultMethods = {
+ sqlite3MemMalloc,
+ sqlite3MemFree,
+ sqlite3MemRealloc,
+ sqlite3MemSize,
+ sqlite3MemRoundup,
+ sqlite3MemInit,
+ sqlite3MemShutdown,
+ 0
+ };
+ sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC, &defaultMethods);
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the "type" of an allocation.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemdebugSetType(void *p, u8 eType){
+ if( p && sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xFree==sqlite3MemFree ){
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pHdr;
+ pHdr = sqlite3MemsysGetHeader(p);
+ assert( pHdr->iForeGuard==FOREGUARD );
+ pHdr->eType = eType;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Return TRUE if the mask of type in eType matches the type of the
+** allocation p. Also return true if p==NULL.
+**
+** This routine is designed for use within an assert() statement, to
+** verify the type of an allocation. For example:
+**
+** assert( sqlite3MemdebugHasType(p, MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MemdebugHasType(void *p, u8 eType){
+ int rc = 1;
+ if( p && sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xFree==sqlite3MemFree ){
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pHdr;
+ pHdr = sqlite3MemsysGetHeader(p);
+ assert( pHdr->iForeGuard==FOREGUARD ); /* Allocation is valid */
+ if( (pHdr->eType&eType)==0 ){
+ rc = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return TRUE if the mask of type in eType matches no bits of the type of the
+** allocation p. Also return true if p==NULL.
+**
+** This routine is designed for use within an assert() statement, to
+** verify the type of an allocation. For example:
+**
+** assert( sqlite3MemdebugNoType(p, MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE) );
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MemdebugNoType(void *p, u8 eType){
+ int rc = 1;
+ if( p && sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xFree==sqlite3MemFree ){
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pHdr;
+ pHdr = sqlite3MemsysGetHeader(p);
+ assert( pHdr->iForeGuard==FOREGUARD ); /* Allocation is valid */
+ if( (pHdr->eType&eType)!=0 ){
+ rc = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the number of backtrace levels kept for each allocation.
+** A value of zero turns off backtracing. The number is always rounded
+** up to a multiple of 2.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemdebugBacktrace(int depth){
+ if( depth<0 ){ depth = 0; }
+ if( depth>20 ){ depth = 20; }
+ depth = (depth+1)&0xfe;
+ mem.nBacktrace = depth;
+}
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemdebugBacktraceCallback(void (*xBacktrace)(int, int, void **)){
+ mem.xBacktrace = xBacktrace;
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the title string for subsequent allocations.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemdebugSettitle(const char *zTitle){
+ unsigned int n = sqlite3Strlen30(zTitle) + 1;
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem.mutex);
+ if( n>=sizeof(mem.zTitle) ) n = sizeof(mem.zTitle)-1;
+ memcpy(mem.zTitle, zTitle, n);
+ mem.zTitle[n] = 0;
+ mem.nTitle = ROUND8(n);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem.mutex);
+}
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemdebugSync(){
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pHdr;
+ for(pHdr=mem.pFirst; pHdr; pHdr=pHdr->pNext){
+ void **pBt = (void**)pHdr;
+ pBt -= pHdr->nBacktraceSlots;
+ mem.xBacktrace((int)pHdr->iSize, pHdr->nBacktrace-1, &pBt[1]);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Open the file indicated and write a log of all unfreed memory
+** allocations into that log.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemdebugDump(const char *zFilename){
+ FILE *out;
+ struct MemBlockHdr *pHdr;
+ void **pBt;
+ int i;
+ out = fopen(zFilename, "w");
+ if( out==0 ){
+ fprintf(stderr, "** Unable to output memory debug output log: %s **\n",
+ zFilename);
+ return;
+ }
+ for(pHdr=mem.pFirst; pHdr; pHdr=pHdr->pNext){
+ char *z = (char*)pHdr;
+ z -= pHdr->nBacktraceSlots*sizeof(void*) + pHdr->nTitle;
+ fprintf(out, "**** %lld bytes at %p from %s ****\n",
+ pHdr->iSize, &pHdr[1], pHdr->nTitle ? z : "???");
+ if( pHdr->nBacktrace ){
+ fflush(out);
+ pBt = (void**)pHdr;
+ pBt -= pHdr->nBacktraceSlots;
+ backtrace_symbols_fd(pBt, pHdr->nBacktrace, fileno(out));
+ fprintf(out, "\n");
+ }
+ }
+ fprintf(out, "COUNTS:\n");
+ for(i=0; i=1 );
+ size = mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x/4;
+ assert( size==mem3.aPool[i+size-1].u.hdr.prevSize );
+ assert( size>=2 );
+ if( size <= MX_SMALL ){
+ memsys3UnlinkFromList(i, &mem3.aiSmall[size-2]);
+ }else{
+ hash = size % N_HASH;
+ memsys3UnlinkFromList(i, &mem3.aiHash[hash]);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Link the chunk at mem3.aPool[i] so that is on the list rooted
+** at *pRoot.
+*/
+static void memsys3LinkIntoList(u32 i, u32 *pRoot){
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(mem3.mutex) );
+ mem3.aPool[i].u.list.next = *pRoot;
+ mem3.aPool[i].u.list.prev = 0;
+ if( *pRoot ){
+ mem3.aPool[*pRoot].u.list.prev = i;
+ }
+ *pRoot = i;
+}
+
+/*
+** Link the chunk at index i into either the appropriate
+** small chunk list, or into the large chunk hash table.
+*/
+static void memsys3Link(u32 i){
+ u32 size, hash;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(mem3.mutex) );
+ assert( i>=1 );
+ assert( (mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x & 1)==0 );
+ size = mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x/4;
+ assert( size==mem3.aPool[i+size-1].u.hdr.prevSize );
+ assert( size>=2 );
+ if( size <= MX_SMALL ){
+ memsys3LinkIntoList(i, &mem3.aiSmall[size-2]);
+ }else{
+ hash = size % N_HASH;
+ memsys3LinkIntoList(i, &mem3.aiHash[hash]);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** If the STATIC_MEM mutex is not already held, obtain it now. The mutex
+** will already be held (obtained by code in malloc.c) if
+** sqlite3GlobalConfig.bMemStat is true.
+*/
+static void memsys3Enter(void){
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bMemstat==0 && mem3.mutex==0 ){
+ mem3.mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM);
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem3.mutex);
+}
+static void memsys3Leave(void){
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem3.mutex);
+}
+
+/*
+** Called when we are unable to satisfy an allocation of nBytes.
+*/
+static void memsys3OutOfMemory(int nByte){
+ if( !mem3.alarmBusy ){
+ mem3.alarmBusy = 1;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(mem3.mutex) );
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem3.mutex);
+ sqlite3_release_memory(nByte);
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem3.mutex);
+ mem3.alarmBusy = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Chunk i is a free chunk that has been unlinked. Adjust its
+** size parameters for check-out and return a pointer to the
+** user portion of the chunk.
+*/
+static void *memsys3Checkout(u32 i, u32 nBlock){
+ u32 x;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(mem3.mutex) );
+ assert( i>=1 );
+ assert( mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x/4==nBlock );
+ assert( mem3.aPool[i+nBlock-1].u.hdr.prevSize==nBlock );
+ x = mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x;
+ mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x = nBlock*4 | 1 | (x&2);
+ mem3.aPool[i+nBlock-1].u.hdr.prevSize = nBlock;
+ mem3.aPool[i+nBlock-1].u.hdr.size4x |= 2;
+ return &mem3.aPool[i];
+}
+
+/*
+** Carve a piece off of the end of the mem3.iKeyBlk free chunk.
+** Return a pointer to the new allocation. Or, if the key chunk
+** is not large enough, return 0.
+*/
+static void *memsys3FromKeyBlk(u32 nBlock){
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(mem3.mutex) );
+ assert( mem3.szKeyBlk>=nBlock );
+ if( nBlock>=mem3.szKeyBlk-1 ){
+ /* Use the entire key chunk */
+ void *p = memsys3Checkout(mem3.iKeyBlk, mem3.szKeyBlk);
+ mem3.iKeyBlk = 0;
+ mem3.szKeyBlk = 0;
+ mem3.mnKeyBlk = 0;
+ return p;
+ }else{
+ /* Split the key block. Return the tail. */
+ u32 newi, x;
+ newi = mem3.iKeyBlk + mem3.szKeyBlk - nBlock;
+ assert( newi > mem3.iKeyBlk+1 );
+ mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk+mem3.szKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.prevSize = nBlock;
+ mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk+mem3.szKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.size4x |= 2;
+ mem3.aPool[newi-1].u.hdr.size4x = nBlock*4 + 1;
+ mem3.szKeyBlk -= nBlock;
+ mem3.aPool[newi-1].u.hdr.prevSize = mem3.szKeyBlk;
+ x = mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.size4x & 2;
+ mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.size4x = mem3.szKeyBlk*4 | x;
+ if( mem3.szKeyBlk < mem3.mnKeyBlk ){
+ mem3.mnKeyBlk = mem3.szKeyBlk;
+ }
+ return (void*)&mem3.aPool[newi];
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** *pRoot is the head of a list of free chunks of the same size
+** or same size hash. In other words, *pRoot is an entry in either
+** mem3.aiSmall[] or mem3.aiHash[].
+**
+** This routine examines all entries on the given list and tries
+** to coalesce each entries with adjacent free chunks.
+**
+** If it sees a chunk that is larger than mem3.iKeyBlk, it replaces
+** the current mem3.iKeyBlk with the new larger chunk. In order for
+** this mem3.iKeyBlk replacement to work, the key chunk must be
+** linked into the hash tables. That is not the normal state of
+** affairs, of course. The calling routine must link the key
+** chunk before invoking this routine, then must unlink the (possibly
+** changed) key chunk once this routine has finished.
+*/
+static void memsys3Merge(u32 *pRoot){
+ u32 iNext, prev, size, i, x;
+
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(mem3.mutex) );
+ for(i=*pRoot; i>0; i=iNext){
+ iNext = mem3.aPool[i].u.list.next;
+ size = mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x;
+ assert( (size&1)==0 );
+ if( (size&2)==0 ){
+ memsys3UnlinkFromList(i, pRoot);
+ assert( i > mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.prevSize );
+ prev = i - mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.prevSize;
+ if( prev==iNext ){
+ iNext = mem3.aPool[prev].u.list.next;
+ }
+ memsys3Unlink(prev);
+ size = i + size/4 - prev;
+ x = mem3.aPool[prev-1].u.hdr.size4x & 2;
+ mem3.aPool[prev-1].u.hdr.size4x = size*4 | x;
+ mem3.aPool[prev+size-1].u.hdr.prevSize = size;
+ memsys3Link(prev);
+ i = prev;
+ }else{
+ size /= 4;
+ }
+ if( size>mem3.szKeyBlk ){
+ mem3.iKeyBlk = i;
+ mem3.szKeyBlk = size;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Return a block of memory of at least nBytes in size.
+** Return NULL if unable.
+**
+** This function assumes that the necessary mutexes, if any, are
+** already held by the caller. Hence "Unsafe".
+*/
+static void *memsys3MallocUnsafe(int nByte){
+ u32 i;
+ u32 nBlock;
+ u32 toFree;
+
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(mem3.mutex) );
+ assert( sizeof(Mem3Block)==8 );
+ if( nByte<=12 ){
+ nBlock = 2;
+ }else{
+ nBlock = (nByte + 11)/8;
+ }
+ assert( nBlock>=2 );
+
+ /* STEP 1:
+ ** Look for an entry of the correct size in either the small
+ ** chunk table or in the large chunk hash table. This is
+ ** successful most of the time (about 9 times out of 10).
+ */
+ if( nBlock <= MX_SMALL ){
+ i = mem3.aiSmall[nBlock-2];
+ if( i>0 ){
+ memsys3UnlinkFromList(i, &mem3.aiSmall[nBlock-2]);
+ return memsys3Checkout(i, nBlock);
+ }
+ }else{
+ int hash = nBlock % N_HASH;
+ for(i=mem3.aiHash[hash]; i>0; i=mem3.aPool[i].u.list.next){
+ if( mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x/4==nBlock ){
+ memsys3UnlinkFromList(i, &mem3.aiHash[hash]);
+ return memsys3Checkout(i, nBlock);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* STEP 2:
+ ** Try to satisfy the allocation by carving a piece off of the end
+ ** of the key chunk. This step usually works if step 1 fails.
+ */
+ if( mem3.szKeyBlk>=nBlock ){
+ return memsys3FromKeyBlk(nBlock);
+ }
+
+
+ /* STEP 3:
+ ** Loop through the entire memory pool. Coalesce adjacent free
+ ** chunks. Recompute the key chunk as the largest free chunk.
+ ** Then try again to satisfy the allocation by carving a piece off
+ ** of the end of the key chunk. This step happens very
+ ** rarely (we hope!)
+ */
+ for(toFree=nBlock*16; toFree<(mem3.nPool*16); toFree *= 2){
+ memsys3OutOfMemory(toFree);
+ if( mem3.iKeyBlk ){
+ memsys3Link(mem3.iKeyBlk);
+ mem3.iKeyBlk = 0;
+ mem3.szKeyBlk = 0;
+ }
+ for(i=0; i=nBlock ){
+ return memsys3FromKeyBlk(nBlock);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If none of the above worked, then we fail. */
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free an outstanding memory allocation.
+**
+** This function assumes that the necessary mutexes, if any, are
+** already held by the caller. Hence "Unsafe".
+*/
+static void memsys3FreeUnsafe(void *pOld){
+ Mem3Block *p = (Mem3Block*)pOld;
+ int i;
+ u32 size, x;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(mem3.mutex) );
+ assert( p>mem3.aPool && p<&mem3.aPool[mem3.nPool] );
+ i = p - mem3.aPool;
+ assert( (mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x&1)==1 );
+ size = mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x/4;
+ assert( i+size<=mem3.nPool+1 );
+ mem3.aPool[i-1].u.hdr.size4x &= ~1;
+ mem3.aPool[i+size-1].u.hdr.prevSize = size;
+ mem3.aPool[i+size-1].u.hdr.size4x &= ~2;
+ memsys3Link(i);
+
+ /* Try to expand the key using the newly freed chunk */
+ if( mem3.iKeyBlk ){
+ while( (mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.size4x&2)==0 ){
+ size = mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.prevSize;
+ mem3.iKeyBlk -= size;
+ mem3.szKeyBlk += size;
+ memsys3Unlink(mem3.iKeyBlk);
+ x = mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.size4x & 2;
+ mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.size4x = mem3.szKeyBlk*4 | x;
+ mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk+mem3.szKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.prevSize = mem3.szKeyBlk;
+ }
+ x = mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.size4x & 2;
+ while( (mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk+mem3.szKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.size4x&1)==0 ){
+ memsys3Unlink(mem3.iKeyBlk+mem3.szKeyBlk);
+ mem3.szKeyBlk += mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk+mem3.szKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.size4x/4;
+ mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.size4x = mem3.szKeyBlk*4 | x;
+ mem3.aPool[mem3.iKeyBlk+mem3.szKeyBlk-1].u.hdr.prevSize = mem3.szKeyBlk;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the size of an outstanding allocation, in bytes. The
+** size returned omits the 8-byte header overhead. This only
+** works for chunks that are currently checked out.
+*/
+static int memsys3Size(void *p){
+ Mem3Block *pBlock;
+ assert( p!=0 );
+ pBlock = (Mem3Block*)p;
+ assert( (pBlock[-1].u.hdr.size4x&1)!=0 );
+ return (pBlock[-1].u.hdr.size4x&~3)*2 - 4;
+}
+
+/*
+** Round up a request size to the next valid allocation size.
+*/
+static int memsys3Roundup(int n){
+ if( n<=12 ){
+ return 12;
+ }else{
+ return ((n+11)&~7) - 4;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Allocate nBytes of memory.
+*/
+static void *memsys3Malloc(int nBytes){
+ sqlite3_int64 *p;
+ assert( nBytes>0 ); /* malloc.c filters out 0 byte requests */
+ memsys3Enter();
+ p = memsys3MallocUnsafe(nBytes);
+ memsys3Leave();
+ return (void*)p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free memory.
+*/
+static void memsys3Free(void *pPrior){
+ assert( pPrior );
+ memsys3Enter();
+ memsys3FreeUnsafe(pPrior);
+ memsys3Leave();
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the size of an existing memory allocation
+*/
+static void *memsys3Realloc(void *pPrior, int nBytes){
+ int nOld;
+ void *p;
+ if( pPrior==0 ){
+ return sqlite3_malloc(nBytes);
+ }
+ if( nBytes<=0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(pPrior);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ nOld = memsys3Size(pPrior);
+ if( nBytes<=nOld && nBytes>=nOld-128 ){
+ return pPrior;
+ }
+ memsys3Enter();
+ p = memsys3MallocUnsafe(nBytes);
+ if( p ){
+ if( nOld>1)!=(size&1) ){
+ fprintf(out, "%p tail checkout bit is incorrect\n", &mem3.aPool[i]);
+ assert( 0 );
+ break;
+ }
+ if( size&1 ){
+ fprintf(out, "%p %6d bytes checked out\n", &mem3.aPool[i], (size/4)*8-8);
+ }else{
+ fprintf(out, "%p %6d bytes free%s\n", &mem3.aPool[i], (size/4)*8-8,
+ i==mem3.iKeyBlk ? " **key**" : "");
+ }
+ }
+ for(i=0; i0; j=mem3.aPool[j].u.list.next){
+ fprintf(out, " %p(%d)", &mem3.aPool[j],
+ (mem3.aPool[j-1].u.hdr.size4x/4)*8-8);
+ }
+ fprintf(out, "\n");
+ }
+ for(i=0; i0; j=mem3.aPool[j].u.list.next){
+ fprintf(out, " %p(%d)", &mem3.aPool[j],
+ (mem3.aPool[j-1].u.hdr.size4x/4)*8-8);
+ }
+ fprintf(out, "\n");
+ }
+ fprintf(out, "key=%d\n", mem3.iKeyBlk);
+ fprintf(out, "nowUsed=%d\n", mem3.nPool*8 - mem3.szKeyBlk*8);
+ fprintf(out, "mxUsed=%d\n", mem3.nPool*8 - mem3.mnKeyBlk*8);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem3.mutex);
+ if( out==stdout ){
+ fflush(stdout);
+ }else{
+ fclose(out);
+ }
+#else
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(zFilename);
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** This routine is the only routine in this file with external
+** linkage.
+**
+** Populate the low-level memory allocation function pointers in
+** sqlite3GlobalConfig.m with pointers to the routines in this file. The
+** arguments specify the block of memory to manage.
+**
+** This routine is only called by sqlite3_config(), and therefore
+** is not required to be threadsafe (it is not).
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const sqlite3_mem_methods *sqlite3MemGetMemsys3(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mem_methods mempoolMethods = {
+ memsys3Malloc,
+ memsys3Free,
+ memsys3Realloc,
+ memsys3Size,
+ memsys3Roundup,
+ memsys3Init,
+ memsys3Shutdown,
+ 0
+ };
+ return &mempoolMethods;
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS3 */
+
+/************** End of mem3.c ************************************************/
+/************** Begin file mem5.c ********************************************/
+/*
+** 2007 October 14
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This file contains the C functions that implement a memory
+** allocation subsystem for use by SQLite.
+**
+** This version of the memory allocation subsystem omits all
+** use of malloc(). The application gives SQLite a block of memory
+** before calling sqlite3_initialize() from which allocations
+** are made and returned by the xMalloc() and xRealloc()
+** implementations. Once sqlite3_initialize() has been called,
+** the amount of memory available to SQLite is fixed and cannot
+** be changed.
+**
+** This version of the memory allocation subsystem is included
+** in the build only if SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS5 is defined.
+**
+** This memory allocator uses the following algorithm:
+**
+** 1. All memory allocation sizes are rounded up to a power of 2.
+**
+** 2. If two adjacent free blocks are the halves of a larger block,
+** then the two blocks are coalesced into the single larger block.
+**
+** 3. New memory is allocated from the first available free block.
+**
+** This algorithm is described in: J. M. Robson. "Bounds for Some Functions
+** Concerning Dynamic Storage Allocation". Journal of the Association for
+** Computing Machinery, Volume 21, Number 8, July 1974, pages 491-499.
+**
+** Let n be the size of the largest allocation divided by the minimum
+** allocation size (after rounding all sizes up to a power of 2.) Let M
+** be the maximum amount of memory ever outstanding at one time. Let
+** N be the total amount of memory available for allocation. Robson
+** proved that this memory allocator will never breakdown due to
+** fragmentation as long as the following constraint holds:
+**
+** N >= M*(1 + log2(n)/2) - n + 1
+**
+** The sqlite3_status() logic tracks the maximum values of n and M so
+** that an application can, at any time, verify this constraint.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+/*
+** This version of the memory allocator is used only when
+** SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS5 is defined.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS5
+
+/*
+** A minimum allocation is an instance of the following structure.
+** Larger allocations are an array of these structures where the
+** size of the array is a power of 2.
+**
+** The size of this object must be a power of two. That fact is
+** verified in memsys5Init().
+*/
+typedef struct Mem5Link Mem5Link;
+struct Mem5Link {
+ int next; /* Index of next free chunk */
+ int prev; /* Index of previous free chunk */
+};
+
+/*
+** Maximum size of any allocation is ((1<=0 && i=0 && iLogsize<=LOGMAX );
+ assert( (mem5.aCtrl[i] & CTRL_LOGSIZE)==iLogsize );
+
+ next = MEM5LINK(i)->next;
+ prev = MEM5LINK(i)->prev;
+ if( prev<0 ){
+ mem5.aiFreelist[iLogsize] = next;
+ }else{
+ MEM5LINK(prev)->next = next;
+ }
+ if( next>=0 ){
+ MEM5LINK(next)->prev = prev;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Link the chunk at mem5.aPool[i] so that is on the iLogsize
+** free list.
+*/
+static void memsys5Link(int i, int iLogsize){
+ int x;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(mem5.mutex) );
+ assert( i>=0 && i=0 && iLogsize<=LOGMAX );
+ assert( (mem5.aCtrl[i] & CTRL_LOGSIZE)==iLogsize );
+
+ x = MEM5LINK(i)->next = mem5.aiFreelist[iLogsize];
+ MEM5LINK(i)->prev = -1;
+ if( x>=0 ){
+ assert( xprev = i;
+ }
+ mem5.aiFreelist[iLogsize] = i;
+}
+
+/*
+** Obtain or release the mutex needed to access global data structures.
+*/
+static void memsys5Enter(void){
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem5.mutex);
+}
+static void memsys5Leave(void){
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem5.mutex);
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the size of an outstanding allocation, in bytes.
+** This only works for chunks that are currently checked out.
+*/
+static int memsys5Size(void *p){
+ int iSize, i;
+ assert( p!=0 );
+ i = (int)(((u8 *)p-mem5.zPool)/mem5.szAtom);
+ assert( i>=0 && i0 );
+
+ /* No more than 1GiB per allocation */
+ if( nByte > 0x40000000 ) return 0;
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+ /* Keep track of the maximum allocation request. Even unfulfilled
+ ** requests are counted */
+ if( (u32)nByte>mem5.maxRequest ){
+ mem5.maxRequest = nByte;
+ }
+#endif
+
+
+ /* Round nByte up to the next valid power of two */
+ for(iFullSz=mem5.szAtom,iLogsize=0; iFullSzLOGMAX ){
+ testcase( sqlite3GlobalConfig.xLog!=0 );
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM, "failed to allocate %u bytes", nByte);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ i = mem5.aiFreelist[iBin];
+ memsys5Unlink(i, iBin);
+ while( iBin>iLogsize ){
+ int newSize;
+
+ iBin--;
+ newSize = 1 << iBin;
+ mem5.aCtrl[i+newSize] = CTRL_FREE | iBin;
+ memsys5Link(i+newSize, iBin);
+ }
+ mem5.aCtrl[i] = iLogsize;
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+ /* Update allocator performance statistics. */
+ mem5.nAlloc++;
+ mem5.totalAlloc += iFullSz;
+ mem5.totalExcess += iFullSz - nByte;
+ mem5.currentCount++;
+ mem5.currentOut += iFullSz;
+ if( mem5.maxCount=0 && iBlock0 );
+ assert( mem5.currentOut>=(size*mem5.szAtom) );
+ mem5.currentCount--;
+ mem5.currentOut -= size*mem5.szAtom;
+ assert( mem5.currentOut>0 || mem5.currentCount==0 );
+ assert( mem5.currentCount>0 || mem5.currentOut==0 );
+#endif
+
+ mem5.aCtrl[iBlock] = CTRL_FREE | iLogsize;
+ while( ALWAYS(iLogsize>iLogsize) & 1 ){
+ iBuddy = iBlock - size;
+ assert( iBuddy>=0 );
+ }else{
+ iBuddy = iBlock + size;
+ if( iBuddy>=mem5.nBlock ) break;
+ }
+ if( mem5.aCtrl[iBuddy]!=(CTRL_FREE | iLogsize) ) break;
+ memsys5Unlink(iBuddy, iLogsize);
+ iLogsize++;
+ if( iBuddy0 ){
+ memsys5Enter();
+ p = memsys5MallocUnsafe(nBytes);
+ memsys5Leave();
+ }
+ return (void*)p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free memory.
+**
+** The outer layer memory allocator prevents this routine from
+** being called with pPrior==0.
+*/
+static void memsys5Free(void *pPrior){
+ assert( pPrior!=0 );
+ memsys5Enter();
+ memsys5FreeUnsafe(pPrior);
+ memsys5Leave();
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the size of an existing memory allocation.
+**
+** The outer layer memory allocator prevents this routine from
+** being called with pPrior==0.
+**
+** nBytes is always a value obtained from a prior call to
+** memsys5Round(). Hence nBytes is always a non-negative power
+** of two. If nBytes==0 that means that an oversize allocation
+** (an allocation larger than 0x40000000) was requested and this
+** routine should return 0 without freeing pPrior.
+*/
+static void *memsys5Realloc(void *pPrior, int nBytes){
+ int nOld;
+ void *p;
+ assert( pPrior!=0 );
+ assert( (nBytes&(nBytes-1))==0 ); /* EV: R-46199-30249 */
+ assert( nBytes>=0 );
+ if( nBytes==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ nOld = memsys5Size(pPrior);
+ if( nBytes<=nOld ){
+ return pPrior;
+ }
+ p = memsys5Malloc(nBytes);
+ if( p ){
+ memcpy(p, pPrior, nOld);
+ memsys5Free(pPrior);
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Round up a request size to the next valid allocation size. If
+** the allocation is too large to be handled by this allocation system,
+** return 0.
+**
+** All allocations must be a power of two and must be expressed by a
+** 32-bit signed integer. Hence the largest allocation is 0x40000000
+** or 1073741824 bytes.
+*/
+static int memsys5Roundup(int n){
+ int iFullSz;
+ if( n > 0x40000000 ) return 0;
+ for(iFullSz=mem5.szAtom; iFullSz 0
+** memsys5Log(2) -> 1
+** memsys5Log(4) -> 2
+** memsys5Log(5) -> 3
+** memsys5Log(8) -> 3
+** memsys5Log(9) -> 4
+*/
+static int memsys5Log(int iValue){
+ int iLog;
+ for(iLog=0; (iLog<(int)((sizeof(int)*8)-1)) && (1<mem5.szAtom ){
+ mem5.szAtom = mem5.szAtom << 1;
+ }
+
+ mem5.nBlock = (nByte / (mem5.szAtom+sizeof(u8)));
+ mem5.zPool = zByte;
+ mem5.aCtrl = (u8 *)&mem5.zPool[mem5.nBlock*mem5.szAtom];
+
+ for(ii=0; ii<=LOGMAX; ii++){
+ mem5.aiFreelist[ii] = -1;
+ }
+
+ iOffset = 0;
+ for(ii=LOGMAX; ii>=0; ii--){
+ int nAlloc = (1<mem5.nBlock);
+ }
+
+ /* If a mutex is required for normal operation, allocate one */
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bMemstat==0 ){
+ mem5.mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM);
+ }
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Deinitialize this module.
+*/
+static void memsys5Shutdown(void *NotUsed){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ mem5.mutex = 0;
+ return;
+}
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+/*
+** Open the file indicated and write a log of all unfreed memory
+** allocations into that log.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Memsys5Dump(const char *zFilename){
+ FILE *out;
+ int i, j, n;
+ int nMinLog;
+
+ if( zFilename==0 || zFilename[0]==0 ){
+ out = stdout;
+ }else{
+ out = fopen(zFilename, "w");
+ if( out==0 ){
+ fprintf(stderr, "** Unable to output memory debug output log: %s **\n",
+ zFilename);
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ memsys5Enter();
+ nMinLog = memsys5Log(mem5.szAtom);
+ for(i=0; i<=LOGMAX && i+nMinLog<32; i++){
+ for(n=0, j=mem5.aiFreelist[i]; j>=0; j = MEM5LINK(j)->next, n++){}
+ fprintf(out, "freelist items of size %d: %d\n", mem5.szAtom << i, n);
+ }
+ fprintf(out, "mem5.nAlloc = %llu\n", mem5.nAlloc);
+ fprintf(out, "mem5.totalAlloc = %llu\n", mem5.totalAlloc);
+ fprintf(out, "mem5.totalExcess = %llu\n", mem5.totalExcess);
+ fprintf(out, "mem5.currentOut = %u\n", mem5.currentOut);
+ fprintf(out, "mem5.currentCount = %u\n", mem5.currentCount);
+ fprintf(out, "mem5.maxOut = %u\n", mem5.maxOut);
+ fprintf(out, "mem5.maxCount = %u\n", mem5.maxCount);
+ fprintf(out, "mem5.maxRequest = %u\n", mem5.maxRequest);
+ memsys5Leave();
+ if( out==stdout ){
+ fflush(stdout);
+ }else{
+ fclose(out);
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This routine is the only routine in this file with external
+** linkage. It returns a pointer to a static sqlite3_mem_methods
+** struct populated with the memsys5 methods.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const sqlite3_mem_methods *sqlite3MemGetMemsys5(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mem_methods memsys5Methods = {
+ memsys5Malloc,
+ memsys5Free,
+ memsys5Realloc,
+ memsys5Size,
+ memsys5Roundup,
+ memsys5Init,
+ memsys5Shutdown,
+ 0
+ };
+ return &memsys5Methods;
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMSYS5 */
+
+/************** End of mem5.c ************************************************/
+/************** Begin file mutex.c *******************************************/
+/*
+** 2007 August 14
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This file contains the C functions that implement mutexes.
+**
+** This file contains code that is common across all mutex implementations.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) && !defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT)
+/*
+** For debugging purposes, record when the mutex subsystem is initialized
+** and uninitialized so that we can assert() if there is an attempt to
+** allocate a mutex while the system is uninitialized.
+*/
+static SQLITE_WSD int mutexIsInit = 0;
+#endif /* SQLITE_DEBUG && !defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT) */
+
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MULTITHREADED_CHECKS
+/*
+** This block (enclosed by SQLITE_ENABLE_MULTITHREADED_CHECKS) contains
+** the implementation of a wrapper around the system default mutex
+** implementation (sqlite3DefaultMutex()).
+**
+** Most calls are passed directly through to the underlying default
+** mutex implementation. Except, if a mutex is configured by calling
+** sqlite3MutexWarnOnContention() on it, then if contention is ever
+** encountered within xMutexEnter() a warning is emitted via sqlite3_log().
+**
+** This type of mutex is used as the database handle mutex when testing
+** apps that usually use SQLITE_CONFIG_MULTITHREAD mode.
+*/
+
+/*
+** Type for all mutexes used when SQLITE_ENABLE_MULTITHREADED_CHECKS
+** is defined. Variable CheckMutex.mutex is a pointer to the real mutex
+** allocated by the system mutex implementation. Variable iType is usually set
+** to the type of mutex requested - SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE, SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST
+** or one of the static mutex identifiers. Or, if this is a recursive mutex
+** that has been configured using sqlite3MutexWarnOnContention(), it is
+** set to SQLITE_MUTEX_WARNONCONTENTION.
+*/
+typedef struct CheckMutex CheckMutex;
+struct CheckMutex {
+ int iType;
+ sqlite3_mutex *mutex;
+};
+
+#define SQLITE_MUTEX_WARNONCONTENTION (-1)
+
+/*
+** Pointer to real mutex methods object used by the CheckMutex
+** implementation. Set by checkMutexInit().
+*/
+static SQLITE_WSD const sqlite3_mutex_methods *pGlobalMutexMethods;
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+static int checkMutexHeld(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ return pGlobalMutexMethods->xMutexHeld(((CheckMutex*)p)->mutex);
+}
+static int checkMutexNotheld(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ return pGlobalMutexMethods->xMutexNotheld(((CheckMutex*)p)->mutex);
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Initialize and deinitialize the mutex subsystem.
+*/
+static int checkMutexInit(void){
+ pGlobalMutexMethods = sqlite3DefaultMutex();
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+static int checkMutexEnd(void){
+ pGlobalMutexMethods = 0;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Allocate a mutex.
+*/
+static sqlite3_mutex *checkMutexAlloc(int iType){
+ static CheckMutex staticMutexes[] = {
+ {2, 0}, {3, 0}, {4, 0}, {5, 0},
+ {6, 0}, {7, 0}, {8, 0}, {9, 0},
+ {10, 0}, {11, 0}, {12, 0}, {13, 0}
+ };
+ CheckMutex *p = 0;
+
+ assert( SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE==1 && SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST==0 );
+ if( iType<2 ){
+ p = sqlite3MallocZero(sizeof(CheckMutex));
+ if( p==0 ) return 0;
+ p->iType = iType;
+ }else{
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( iType-2>=ArraySize(staticMutexes) ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+ p = &staticMutexes[iType-2];
+ }
+
+ if( p->mutex==0 ){
+ p->mutex = pGlobalMutexMethods->xMutexAlloc(iType);
+ if( p->mutex==0 ){
+ if( iType<2 ){
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ }
+ p = 0;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (sqlite3_mutex*)p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free a mutex.
+*/
+static void checkMutexFree(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ assert( SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE<2 );
+ assert( SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST<2 );
+ assert( SQLITE_MUTEX_WARNONCONTENTION<2 );
+
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( ((CheckMutex*)p)->iType<2 )
+#endif
+ {
+ CheckMutex *pCheck = (CheckMutex*)p;
+ pGlobalMutexMethods->xMutexFree(pCheck->mutex);
+ sqlite3_free(pCheck);
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ else{
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Enter the mutex.
+*/
+static void checkMutexEnter(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ CheckMutex *pCheck = (CheckMutex*)p;
+ if( pCheck->iType==SQLITE_MUTEX_WARNONCONTENTION ){
+ if( SQLITE_OK==pGlobalMutexMethods->xMutexTry(pCheck->mutex) ){
+ return;
+ }
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_MISUSE,
+ "illegal multi-threaded access to database connection"
+ );
+ }
+ pGlobalMutexMethods->xMutexEnter(pCheck->mutex);
+}
+
+/*
+** Enter the mutex (do not block).
+*/
+static int checkMutexTry(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ CheckMutex *pCheck = (CheckMutex*)p;
+ return pGlobalMutexMethods->xMutexTry(pCheck->mutex);
+}
+
+/*
+** Leave the mutex.
+*/
+static void checkMutexLeave(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ CheckMutex *pCheck = (CheckMutex*)p;
+ pGlobalMutexMethods->xMutexLeave(pCheck->mutex);
+}
+
+sqlite3_mutex_methods const *multiThreadedCheckMutex(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mutex_methods sMutex = {
+ checkMutexInit,
+ checkMutexEnd,
+ checkMutexAlloc,
+ checkMutexFree,
+ checkMutexEnter,
+ checkMutexTry,
+ checkMutexLeave,
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ checkMutexHeld,
+ checkMutexNotheld
+#else
+ 0,
+ 0
+#endif
+ };
+ return &sMutex;
+}
+
+/*
+** Mark the SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE mutex passed as the only argument as
+** one on which there should be no contention.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MutexWarnOnContention(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexAlloc==checkMutexAlloc ){
+ CheckMutex *pCheck = (CheckMutex*)p;
+ assert( pCheck->iType==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE );
+ pCheck->iType = SQLITE_MUTEX_WARNONCONTENTION;
+ }
+}
+#endif /* ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MULTITHREADED_CHECKS */
+
+/*
+** Initialize the mutex system.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MutexInit(void){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ if( !sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexAlloc ){
+ /* If the xMutexAlloc method has not been set, then the user did not
+ ** install a mutex implementation via sqlite3_config() prior to
+ ** sqlite3_initialize() being called. This block copies pointers to
+ ** the default implementation into the sqlite3GlobalConfig structure.
+ */
+ sqlite3_mutex_methods const *pFrom;
+ sqlite3_mutex_methods *pTo = &sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex;
+
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex ){
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MULTITHREADED_CHECKS
+ pFrom = multiThreadedCheckMutex();
+#else
+ pFrom = sqlite3DefaultMutex();
+#endif
+ }else{
+ pFrom = sqlite3NoopMutex();
+ }
+ pTo->xMutexInit = pFrom->xMutexInit;
+ pTo->xMutexEnd = pFrom->xMutexEnd;
+ pTo->xMutexFree = pFrom->xMutexFree;
+ pTo->xMutexEnter = pFrom->xMutexEnter;
+ pTo->xMutexTry = pFrom->xMutexTry;
+ pTo->xMutexLeave = pFrom->xMutexLeave;
+ pTo->xMutexHeld = pFrom->xMutexHeld;
+ pTo->xMutexNotheld = pFrom->xMutexNotheld;
+ sqlite3MemoryBarrier();
+ pTo->xMutexAlloc = pFrom->xMutexAlloc;
+ }
+ assert( sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexInit );
+ rc = sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexInit();
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ GLOBAL(int, mutexIsInit) = 1;
+#endif
+
+ sqlite3MemoryBarrier();
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Shutdown the mutex system. This call frees resources allocated by
+** sqlite3MutexInit().
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MutexEnd(void){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexEnd ){
+ rc = sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexEnd();
+ }
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ GLOBAL(int, mutexIsInit) = 0;
+#endif
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Retrieve a pointer to a static mutex or allocate a new dynamic one.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_mutex *sqlite3_mutex_alloc(int id){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( id<=SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE && sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+ if( id>SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE && sqlite3MutexInit() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ assert( sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexAlloc );
+ return sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexAlloc(id);
+}
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex *sqlite3MutexAlloc(int id){
+ if( !sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ assert( GLOBAL(int, mutexIsInit) );
+ assert( sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexAlloc );
+ return sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexAlloc(id);
+}
+
+/*
+** Free a dynamic mutex.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_mutex_free(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ if( p ){
+ assert( sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexFree );
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexFree(p);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Obtain the mutex p. If some other thread already has the mutex, block
+** until it can be obtained.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_mutex_enter(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ if( p ){
+ assert( sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexEnter );
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexEnter(p);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Obtain the mutex p. If successful, return SQLITE_OK. Otherwise, if another
+** thread holds the mutex and it cannot be obtained, return SQLITE_BUSY.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_mutex_try(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ if( p ){
+ assert( sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexTry );
+ return sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexTry(p);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_leave() routine exits a mutex that was previously
+** entered by the same thread. The behavior is undefined if the mutex
+** is not currently entered. If a NULL pointer is passed as an argument
+** this function is a no-op.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_mutex_leave(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ if( p ){
+ assert( sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexLeave );
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexLeave(p);
+ }
+}
+
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_held() and sqlite3_mutex_notheld() routine are
+** intended for use inside assert() statements.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_mutex_held(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ assert( p==0 || sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexHeld );
+ return p==0 || sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexHeld(p);
+}
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_mutex_notheld(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ assert( p==0 || sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexNotheld );
+ return p==0 || sqlite3GlobalConfig.mutex.xMutexNotheld(p);
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT) */
+
+/************** End of mutex.c ***********************************************/
+/************** Begin file mutex_noop.c **************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 October 07
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This file contains the C functions that implement mutexes.
+**
+** This implementation in this file does not provide any mutual
+** exclusion and is thus suitable for use only in applications
+** that use SQLite in a single thread. The routines defined
+** here are place-holders. Applications can substitute working
+** mutex routines at start-time using the
+**
+** sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_MUTEX,...)
+**
+** interface.
+**
+** If compiled with SQLITE_DEBUG, then additional logic is inserted
+** that does error checking on mutexes to make sure they are being
+** called correctly.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEBUG
+/*
+** Stub routines for all mutex methods.
+**
+** This routines provide no mutual exclusion or error checking.
+*/
+static int noopMutexInit(void){ return SQLITE_OK; }
+static int noopMutexEnd(void){ return SQLITE_OK; }
+static sqlite3_mutex *noopMutexAlloc(int id){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(id);
+ return (sqlite3_mutex*)8;
+}
+static void noopMutexFree(sqlite3_mutex *p){ UNUSED_PARAMETER(p); return; }
+static void noopMutexEnter(sqlite3_mutex *p){ UNUSED_PARAMETER(p); return; }
+static int noopMutexTry(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(p);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+static void noopMutexLeave(sqlite3_mutex *p){ UNUSED_PARAMETER(p); return; }
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex_methods const *sqlite3NoopMutex(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mutex_methods sMutex = {
+ noopMutexInit,
+ noopMutexEnd,
+ noopMutexAlloc,
+ noopMutexFree,
+ noopMutexEnter,
+ noopMutexTry,
+ noopMutexLeave,
+
+ 0,
+ 0,
+ };
+
+ return &sMutex;
+}
+#endif /* !SQLITE_DEBUG */
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+/*
+** In this implementation, error checking is provided for testing
+** and debugging purposes. The mutexes still do not provide any
+** mutual exclusion.
+*/
+
+/*
+** The mutex object
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_debug_mutex {
+ int id; /* The mutex type */
+ int cnt; /* Number of entries without a matching leave */
+} sqlite3_debug_mutex;
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_held() and sqlite3_mutex_notheld() routine are
+** intended for use inside assert() statements.
+*/
+static int debugMutexHeld(sqlite3_mutex *pX){
+ sqlite3_debug_mutex *p = (sqlite3_debug_mutex*)pX;
+ return p==0 || p->cnt>0;
+}
+static int debugMutexNotheld(sqlite3_mutex *pX){
+ sqlite3_debug_mutex *p = (sqlite3_debug_mutex*)pX;
+ return p==0 || p->cnt==0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Initialize and deinitialize the mutex subsystem.
+*/
+static int debugMutexInit(void){ return SQLITE_OK; }
+static int debugMutexEnd(void){ return SQLITE_OK; }
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_alloc() routine allocates a new
+** mutex and returns a pointer to it. If it returns NULL
+** that means that a mutex could not be allocated.
+*/
+static sqlite3_mutex *debugMutexAlloc(int id){
+ static sqlite3_debug_mutex aStatic[SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS3 - 1];
+ sqlite3_debug_mutex *pNew = 0;
+ switch( id ){
+ case SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST:
+ case SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE: {
+ pNew = sqlite3Malloc(sizeof(*pNew));
+ if( pNew ){
+ pNew->id = id;
+ pNew->cnt = 0;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ default: {
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( id-2<0 || id-2>=ArraySize(aStatic) ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+ pNew = &aStatic[id-2];
+ pNew->id = id;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ return (sqlite3_mutex*)pNew;
+}
+
+/*
+** This routine deallocates a previously allocated mutex.
+*/
+static void debugMutexFree(sqlite3_mutex *pX){
+ sqlite3_debug_mutex *p = (sqlite3_debug_mutex*)pX;
+ assert( p->cnt==0 );
+ if( p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE || p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST ){
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ }else{
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+#endif
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_enter() and sqlite3_mutex_try() routines attempt
+** to enter a mutex. If another thread is already within the mutex,
+** sqlite3_mutex_enter() will block and sqlite3_mutex_try() will return
+** SQLITE_BUSY. The sqlite3_mutex_try() interface returns SQLITE_OK
+** upon successful entry. Mutexes created using SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE can
+** be entered multiple times by the same thread. In such cases the,
+** mutex must be exited an equal number of times before another thread
+** can enter. If the same thread tries to enter any other kind of mutex
+** more than once, the behavior is undefined.
+*/
+static void debugMutexEnter(sqlite3_mutex *pX){
+ sqlite3_debug_mutex *p = (sqlite3_debug_mutex*)pX;
+ assert( p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE || debugMutexNotheld(pX) );
+ p->cnt++;
+}
+static int debugMutexTry(sqlite3_mutex *pX){
+ sqlite3_debug_mutex *p = (sqlite3_debug_mutex*)pX;
+ assert( p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE || debugMutexNotheld(pX) );
+ p->cnt++;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_leave() routine exits a mutex that was
+** previously entered by the same thread. The behavior
+** is undefined if the mutex is not currently entered or
+** is not currently allocated. SQLite will never do either.
+*/
+static void debugMutexLeave(sqlite3_mutex *pX){
+ sqlite3_debug_mutex *p = (sqlite3_debug_mutex*)pX;
+ assert( debugMutexHeld(pX) );
+ p->cnt--;
+ assert( p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE || debugMutexNotheld(pX) );
+}
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex_methods const *sqlite3NoopMutex(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mutex_methods sMutex = {
+ debugMutexInit,
+ debugMutexEnd,
+ debugMutexAlloc,
+ debugMutexFree,
+ debugMutexEnter,
+ debugMutexTry,
+ debugMutexLeave,
+
+ debugMutexHeld,
+ debugMutexNotheld
+ };
+
+ return &sMutex;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_DEBUG */
+
+/*
+** If compiled with SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP, then the no-op mutex implementation
+** is used regardless of the run-time threadsafety setting.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex_methods const *sqlite3DefaultMutex(void){
+ return sqlite3NoopMutex();
+}
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP) */
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_OMIT) */
+
+/************** End of mutex_noop.c ******************************************/
+/************** Begin file mutex_unix.c **************************************/
+/*
+** 2007 August 28
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This file contains the C functions that implement mutexes for pthreads
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+/*
+** The code in this file is only used if we are compiling threadsafe
+** under unix with pthreads.
+**
+** Note that this implementation requires a version of pthreads that
+** supports recursive mutexes.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS
+
+#include
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex.id, sqlite3_mutex.nRef, and sqlite3_mutex.owner fields
+** are necessary under two condidtions: (1) Debug builds and (2) using
+** home-grown mutexes. Encapsulate these conditions into a single #define.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_HOMEGROWN_RECURSIVE_MUTEX)
+# define SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF 1
+#else
+# define SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Each recursive mutex is an instance of the following structure.
+*/
+struct sqlite3_mutex {
+ pthread_mutex_t mutex; /* Mutex controlling the lock */
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF || defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR)
+ int id; /* Mutex type */
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF
+ volatile int nRef; /* Number of entrances */
+ volatile pthread_t owner; /* Thread that is within this mutex */
+ int trace; /* True to trace changes */
+#endif
+};
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF
+# define SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(id) \
+ {PTHREAD_MUTEX_INITIALIZER,id,0,(pthread_t)0,0}
+#elif defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR)
+# define SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(id) { PTHREAD_MUTEX_INITIALIZER, id }
+#else
+#define SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(id) { PTHREAD_MUTEX_INITIALIZER }
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_held() and sqlite3_mutex_notheld() routine are
+** intended for use only inside assert() statements. On some platforms,
+** there might be race conditions that can cause these routines to
+** deliver incorrect results. In particular, if pthread_equal() is
+** not an atomic operation, then these routines might delivery
+** incorrect results. On most platforms, pthread_equal() is a
+** comparison of two integers and is therefore atomic. But we are
+** told that HPUX is not such a platform. If so, then these routines
+** will not always work correctly on HPUX.
+**
+** On those platforms where pthread_equal() is not atomic, SQLite
+** should be compiled without -DSQLITE_DEBUG and with -DNDEBUG to
+** make sure no assert() statements are evaluated and hence these
+** routines are never called.
+*/
+#if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+static int pthreadMutexHeld(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ return (p->nRef!=0 && pthread_equal(p->owner, pthread_self()));
+}
+static int pthreadMutexNotheld(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ return p->nRef==0 || pthread_equal(p->owner, pthread_self())==0;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Try to provide a memory barrier operation, needed for initialization
+** and also for the implementation of xShmBarrier in the VFS in cases
+** where SQLite is compiled without mutexes.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemoryBarrier(void){
+#if defined(SQLITE_MEMORY_BARRIER)
+ SQLITE_MEMORY_BARRIER;
+#elif defined(__GNUC__) && GCC_VERSION>=4001000
+ __sync_synchronize();
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Initialize and deinitialize the mutex subsystem.
+*/
+static int pthreadMutexInit(void){ return SQLITE_OK; }
+static int pthreadMutexEnd(void){ return SQLITE_OK; }
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_alloc() routine allocates a new
+** mutex and returns a pointer to it. If it returns NULL
+** that means that a mutex could not be allocated. SQLite
+** will unwind its stack and return an error. The argument
+** to sqlite3_mutex_alloc() is one of these integer constants:
+**
+**
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_OPEN
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PRNG
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_LRU
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PMEM
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP1
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP2
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP3
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS1
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS2
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS3
+**
+**
+** The first two constants cause sqlite3_mutex_alloc() to create
+** a new mutex. The new mutex is recursive when SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE
+** is used but not necessarily so when SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST is used.
+** The mutex implementation does not need to make a distinction
+** between SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE and SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST if it does
+** not want to. But SQLite will only request a recursive mutex in
+** cases where it really needs one. If a faster non-recursive mutex
+** implementation is available on the host platform, the mutex subsystem
+** might return such a mutex in response to SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST.
+**
+** The other allowed parameters to sqlite3_mutex_alloc() each return
+** a pointer to a static preexisting mutex. Six static mutexes are
+** used by the current version of SQLite. Future versions of SQLite
+** may add additional static mutexes. Static mutexes are for internal
+** use by SQLite only. Applications that use SQLite mutexes should
+** use only the dynamic mutexes returned by SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST or
+** SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE.
+**
+** Note that if one of the dynamic mutex parameters (SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST
+** or SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE) is used then sqlite3_mutex_alloc()
+** returns a different mutex on every call. But for the static
+** mutex types, the same mutex is returned on every call that has
+** the same type number.
+*/
+static sqlite3_mutex *pthreadMutexAlloc(int iType){
+ static sqlite3_mutex staticMutexes[] = {
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(2),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(3),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(4),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(5),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(6),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(7),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(8),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(9),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(10),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(11),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(12),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(13)
+ };
+ sqlite3_mutex *p;
+ switch( iType ){
+ case SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE: {
+ p = sqlite3MallocZero( sizeof(*p) );
+ if( p ){
+#ifdef SQLITE_HOMEGROWN_RECURSIVE_MUTEX
+ /* If recursive mutexes are not available, we will have to
+ ** build our own. See below. */
+ pthread_mutex_init(&p->mutex, 0);
+#else
+ /* Use a recursive mutex if it is available */
+ pthread_mutexattr_t recursiveAttr;
+ pthread_mutexattr_init(&recursiveAttr);
+ pthread_mutexattr_settype(&recursiveAttr, PTHREAD_MUTEX_RECURSIVE);
+ pthread_mutex_init(&p->mutex, &recursiveAttr);
+ pthread_mutexattr_destroy(&recursiveAttr);
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF || defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR)
+ p->id = SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE;
+#endif
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST: {
+ p = sqlite3MallocZero( sizeof(*p) );
+ if( p ){
+ pthread_mutex_init(&p->mutex, 0);
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF || defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR)
+ p->id = SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST;
+#endif
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ default: {
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( iType-2<0 || iType-2>=ArraySize(staticMutexes) ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+ p = &staticMutexes[iType-2];
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF || defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR)
+ assert( p==0 || p->id==iType );
+#endif
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** This routine deallocates a previously
+** allocated mutex. SQLite is careful to deallocate every
+** mutex that it allocates.
+*/
+static void pthreadMutexFree(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ assert( p->nRef==0 );
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST || p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE )
+#endif
+ {
+ pthread_mutex_destroy(&p->mutex);
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ else{
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_enter() and sqlite3_mutex_try() routines attempt
+** to enter a mutex. If another thread is already within the mutex,
+** sqlite3_mutex_enter() will block and sqlite3_mutex_try() will return
+** SQLITE_BUSY. The sqlite3_mutex_try() interface returns SQLITE_OK
+** upon successful entry. Mutexes created using SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE can
+** be entered multiple times by the same thread. In such cases the,
+** mutex must be exited an equal number of times before another thread
+** can enter. If the same thread tries to enter any other kind of mutex
+** more than once, the behavior is undefined.
+*/
+static void pthreadMutexEnter(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ assert( p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE || pthreadMutexNotheld(p) );
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_HOMEGROWN_RECURSIVE_MUTEX
+ /* If recursive mutexes are not available, then we have to grow
+ ** our own. This implementation assumes that pthread_equal()
+ ** is atomic - that it cannot be deceived into thinking self
+ ** and p->owner are equal if p->owner changes between two values
+ ** that are not equal to self while the comparison is taking place.
+ ** This implementation also assumes a coherent cache - that
+ ** separate processes cannot read different values from the same
+ ** address at the same time. If either of these two conditions
+ ** are not met, then the mutexes will fail and problems will result.
+ */
+ {
+ pthread_t self = pthread_self();
+ if( p->nRef>0 && pthread_equal(p->owner, self) ){
+ p->nRef++;
+ }else{
+ pthread_mutex_lock(&p->mutex);
+ assert( p->nRef==0 );
+ p->owner = self;
+ p->nRef = 1;
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ /* Use the built-in recursive mutexes if they are available.
+ */
+ pthread_mutex_lock(&p->mutex);
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF
+ assert( p->nRef>0 || p->owner==0 );
+ p->owner = pthread_self();
+ p->nRef++;
+#endif
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ if( p->trace ){
+ printf("enter mutex %p (%d) with nRef=%d\n", p, p->trace, p->nRef);
+ }
+#endif
+}
+static int pthreadMutexTry(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ int rc;
+ assert( p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE || pthreadMutexNotheld(p) );
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_HOMEGROWN_RECURSIVE_MUTEX
+ /* If recursive mutexes are not available, then we have to grow
+ ** our own. This implementation assumes that pthread_equal()
+ ** is atomic - that it cannot be deceived into thinking self
+ ** and p->owner are equal if p->owner changes between two values
+ ** that are not equal to self while the comparison is taking place.
+ ** This implementation also assumes a coherent cache - that
+ ** separate processes cannot read different values from the same
+ ** address at the same time. If either of these two conditions
+ ** are not met, then the mutexes will fail and problems will result.
+ */
+ {
+ pthread_t self = pthread_self();
+ if( p->nRef>0 && pthread_equal(p->owner, self) ){
+ p->nRef++;
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else if( pthread_mutex_trylock(&p->mutex)==0 ){
+ assert( p->nRef==0 );
+ p->owner = self;
+ p->nRef = 1;
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ /* Use the built-in recursive mutexes if they are available.
+ */
+ if( pthread_mutex_trylock(&p->mutex)==0 ){
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF
+ p->owner = pthread_self();
+ p->nRef++;
+#endif
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && p->trace ){
+ printf("enter mutex %p (%d) with nRef=%d\n", p, p->trace, p->nRef);
+ }
+#endif
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_leave() routine exits a mutex that was
+** previously entered by the same thread. The behavior
+** is undefined if the mutex is not currently entered or
+** is not currently allocated. SQLite will never do either.
+*/
+static void pthreadMutexLeave(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ assert( pthreadMutexHeld(p) );
+#if SQLITE_MUTEX_NREF
+ p->nRef--;
+ if( p->nRef==0 ) p->owner = 0;
+#endif
+ assert( p->nRef==0 || p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE );
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_HOMEGROWN_RECURSIVE_MUTEX
+ if( p->nRef==0 ){
+ pthread_mutex_unlock(&p->mutex);
+ }
+#else
+ pthread_mutex_unlock(&p->mutex);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ if( p->trace ){
+ printf("leave mutex %p (%d) with nRef=%d\n", p, p->trace, p->nRef);
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex_methods const *sqlite3DefaultMutex(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mutex_methods sMutex = {
+ pthreadMutexInit,
+ pthreadMutexEnd,
+ pthreadMutexAlloc,
+ pthreadMutexFree,
+ pthreadMutexEnter,
+ pthreadMutexTry,
+ pthreadMutexLeave,
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ pthreadMutexHeld,
+ pthreadMutexNotheld
+#else
+ 0,
+ 0
+#endif
+ };
+
+ return &sMutex;
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS */
+
+/************** End of mutex_unix.c ******************************************/
+/************** Begin file mutex_w32.c ***************************************/
+/*
+** 2007 August 14
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This file contains the C functions that implement mutexes for Win32.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WIN
+/*
+** Include code that is common to all os_*.c files
+*/
+/************** Include os_common.h in the middle of mutex_w32.c *************/
+/************** Begin file os_common.h ***************************************/
+/*
+** 2004 May 22
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains macros and a little bit of code that is common to
+** all of the platform-specific files (os_*.c) and is #included into those
+** files.
+**
+** This file should be #included by the os_*.c files only. It is not a
+** general purpose header file.
+*/
+#ifndef _OS_COMMON_H_
+#define _OS_COMMON_H_
+
+/*
+** At least two bugs have slipped in because we changed the MEMORY_DEBUG
+** macro to SQLITE_DEBUG and some older makefiles have not yet made the
+** switch. The following code should catch this problem at compile-time.
+*/
+#ifdef MEMORY_DEBUG
+# error "The MEMORY_DEBUG macro is obsolete. Use SQLITE_DEBUG instead."
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Macros for performance tracing. Normally turned off. Only works
+** on i486 hardware.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_PERFORMANCE_TRACE
+
+/*
+** hwtime.h contains inline assembler code for implementing
+** high-performance timing routines.
+*/
+/************** Include hwtime.h in the middle of os_common.h ****************/
+/************** Begin file hwtime.h ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 May 27
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains inline asm code for retrieving "high-performance"
+** counters for x86 and x86_64 class CPUs.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_HWTIME_H
+#define SQLITE_HWTIME_H
+
+/*
+** The following routine only works on pentium-class (or newer) processors.
+** It uses the RDTSC opcode to read the cycle count value out of the
+** processor and returns that value. This can be used for high-res
+** profiling.
+*/
+#if !defined(__STRICT_ANSI__) && \
+ (defined(__GNUC__) || defined(_MSC_VER)) && \
+ (defined(i386) || defined(__i386__) || defined(_M_IX86))
+
+ #if defined(__GNUC__)
+
+ __inline__ sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ unsigned int lo, hi;
+ __asm__ __volatile__ ("rdtsc" : "=a" (lo), "=d" (hi));
+ return (sqlite_uint64)hi << 32 | lo;
+ }
+
+ #elif defined(_MSC_VER)
+
+ __declspec(naked) __inline sqlite_uint64 __cdecl sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ __asm {
+ rdtsc
+ ret ; return value at EDX:EAX
+ }
+ }
+
+ #endif
+
+#elif !defined(__STRICT_ANSI__) && (defined(__GNUC__) && defined(__x86_64__))
+
+ __inline__ sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ unsigned long val;
+ __asm__ __volatile__ ("rdtsc" : "=A" (val));
+ return val;
+ }
+
+#elif !defined(__STRICT_ANSI__) && (defined(__GNUC__) && defined(__ppc__))
+
+ __inline__ sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ unsigned long long retval;
+ unsigned long junk;
+ __asm__ __volatile__ ("\n\
+ 1: mftbu %1\n\
+ mftb %L0\n\
+ mftbu %0\n\
+ cmpw %0,%1\n\
+ bne 1b"
+ : "=r" (retval), "=r" (junk));
+ return retval;
+ }
+
+#else
+
+ /*
+ ** asm() is needed for hardware timing support. Without asm(),
+ ** disable the sqlite3Hwtime() routine.
+ **
+ ** sqlite3Hwtime() is only used for some obscure debugging
+ ** and analysis configurations, not in any deliverable, so this
+ ** should not be a great loss.
+ */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){ return ((sqlite_uint64)0); }
+
+#endif
+
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_HWTIME_H) */
+
+/************** End of hwtime.h **********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in os_common.h ******************/
+
+static sqlite_uint64 g_start;
+static sqlite_uint64 g_elapsed;
+#define TIMER_START g_start=sqlite3Hwtime()
+#define TIMER_END g_elapsed=sqlite3Hwtime()-g_start
+#define TIMER_ELAPSED g_elapsed
+#else
+#define TIMER_START
+#define TIMER_END
+#define TIMER_ELAPSED ((sqlite_uint64)0)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** If we compile with the SQLITE_TEST macro set, then the following block
+** of code will give us the ability to simulate a disk I/O error. This
+** is used for testing the I/O recovery logic.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_hit;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_hardhit;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_pending;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_persist;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_benign;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_diskfull_pending;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_diskfull;
+#define SimulateIOErrorBenign(X) sqlite3_io_error_benign=(X)
+#define SimulateIOError(CODE) \
+ if( (sqlite3_io_error_persist && sqlite3_io_error_hit) \
+ || sqlite3_io_error_pending-- == 1 ) \
+ { local_ioerr(); CODE; }
+static void local_ioerr(){
+ IOTRACE(("IOERR\n"));
+ sqlite3_io_error_hit++;
+ if( !sqlite3_io_error_benign ) sqlite3_io_error_hardhit++;
+}
+#define SimulateDiskfullError(CODE) \
+ if( sqlite3_diskfull_pending ){ \
+ if( sqlite3_diskfull_pending == 1 ){ \
+ local_ioerr(); \
+ sqlite3_diskfull = 1; \
+ sqlite3_io_error_hit = 1; \
+ CODE; \
+ }else{ \
+ sqlite3_diskfull_pending--; \
+ } \
+ }
+#else
+#define SimulateIOErrorBenign(X)
+#define SimulateIOError(A)
+#define SimulateDiskfullError(A)
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_TEST) */
+
+/*
+** When testing, keep a count of the number of open files.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_open_file_count;
+#define OpenCounter(X) sqlite3_open_file_count+=(X)
+#else
+#define OpenCounter(X)
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_TEST) */
+
+#endif /* !defined(_OS_COMMON_H_) */
+
+/************** End of os_common.h *******************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in mutex_w32.c ******************/
+
+/*
+** Include the header file for the Windows VFS.
+*/
+/************** Include os_win.h in the middle of mutex_w32.c ****************/
+/************** Begin file os_win.h ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2013 November 25
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains code that is specific to Windows.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OS_WIN_H
+#define SQLITE_OS_WIN_H
+
+/*
+** Include the primary Windows SDK header file.
+*/
+#include "windows.h"
+
+#ifdef __CYGWIN__
+# include
+# include /* amalgamator: dontcache */
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Determine if we are dealing with Windows NT.
+**
+** We ought to be able to determine if we are compiling for Windows 9x or
+** Windows NT using the _WIN32_WINNT macro as follows:
+**
+** #if defined(_WIN32_WINNT)
+** # define SQLITE_OS_WINNT 1
+** #else
+** # define SQLITE_OS_WINNT 0
+** #endif
+**
+** However, Visual Studio 2005 does not set _WIN32_WINNT by default, as
+** it ought to, so the above test does not work. We'll just assume that
+** everything is Windows NT unless the programmer explicitly says otherwise
+** by setting SQLITE_OS_WINNT to 0.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_OS_WIN && !defined(SQLITE_OS_WINNT)
+# define SQLITE_OS_WINNT 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Determine if we are dealing with Windows CE - which has a much reduced
+** API.
+*/
+#if defined(_WIN32_WCE)
+# define SQLITE_OS_WINCE 1
+#else
+# define SQLITE_OS_WINCE 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Determine if we are dealing with WinRT, which provides only a subset of
+** the full Win32 API.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OS_WINRT)
+# define SQLITE_OS_WINRT 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** For WinCE, some API function parameters do not appear to be declared as
+** volatile.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_VOLATILE
+#else
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_VOLATILE volatile
+#endif
+
+/*
+** For some Windows sub-platforms, the _beginthreadex() / _endthreadex()
+** functions are not available (e.g. those not using MSVC, Cygwin, etc).
+*/
+#if SQLITE_OS_WIN && !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && \
+ SQLITE_THREADSAFE>0 && !defined(__CYGWIN__)
+# define SQLITE_OS_WIN_THREADS 1
+#else
+# define SQLITE_OS_WIN_THREADS 0
+#endif
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_OS_WIN_H */
+
+/************** End of os_win.h **********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in mutex_w32.c ******************/
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The code in this file is only used if we are compiling multithreaded
+** on a Win32 system.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_MUTEX_W32
+
+/*
+** Each recursive mutex is an instance of the following structure.
+*/
+struct sqlite3_mutex {
+ CRITICAL_SECTION mutex; /* Mutex controlling the lock */
+ int id; /* Mutex type */
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ volatile int nRef; /* Number of enterances */
+ volatile DWORD owner; /* Thread holding this mutex */
+ volatile LONG trace; /* True to trace changes */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** These are the initializer values used when declaring a "static" mutex
+** on Win32. It should be noted that all mutexes require initialization
+** on the Win32 platform.
+*/
+#define SQLITE_W32_MUTEX_INITIALIZER { 0 }
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+#define SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(id) { SQLITE_W32_MUTEX_INITIALIZER, id, \
+ 0L, (DWORD)0, 0 }
+#else
+#define SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(id) { SQLITE_W32_MUTEX_INITIALIZER, id }
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_held() and sqlite3_mutex_notheld() routine are
+** intended for use only inside assert() statements.
+*/
+static int winMutexHeld(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ return p->nRef!=0 && p->owner==GetCurrentThreadId();
+}
+
+static int winMutexNotheld2(sqlite3_mutex *p, DWORD tid){
+ return p->nRef==0 || p->owner!=tid;
+}
+
+static int winMutexNotheld(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ DWORD tid = GetCurrentThreadId();
+ return winMutexNotheld2(p, tid);
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Try to provide a memory barrier operation, needed for initialization
+** and also for the xShmBarrier method of the VFS in cases when SQLite is
+** compiled without mutexes (SQLITE_THREADSAFE=0).
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemoryBarrier(void){
+#if defined(SQLITE_MEMORY_BARRIER)
+ SQLITE_MEMORY_BARRIER;
+#elif defined(__GNUC__)
+ __sync_synchronize();
+#elif MSVC_VERSION>=1300
+ _ReadWriteBarrier();
+#elif defined(MemoryBarrier)
+ MemoryBarrier();
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Initialize and deinitialize the mutex subsystem.
+*/
+static sqlite3_mutex winMutex_staticMutexes[] = {
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(2),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(3),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(4),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(5),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(6),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(7),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(8),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(9),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(10),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(11),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(12),
+ SQLITE3_MUTEX_INITIALIZER(13)
+};
+
+static int winMutex_isInit = 0;
+static int winMutex_isNt = -1; /* <0 means "need to query" */
+
+/* As the winMutexInit() and winMutexEnd() functions are called as part
+** of the sqlite3_initialize() and sqlite3_shutdown() processing, the
+** "interlocked" magic used here is probably not strictly necessary.
+*/
+static LONG SQLITE_WIN32_VOLATILE winMutex_lock = 0;
+
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_win32_is_nt(void); /* os_win.c */
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_win32_sleep(DWORD milliseconds); /* os_win.c */
+
+static int winMutexInit(void){
+ /* The first to increment to 1 does actual initialization */
+ if( InterlockedCompareExchange(&winMutex_lock, 1, 0)==0 ){
+ int i;
+ for(i=0; i
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MAIN
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_OPEN
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PRNG
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_LRU
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PMEM
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP1
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP2
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_APP3
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS1
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS2
+**
SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS3
+**
+**
+** The first two constants cause sqlite3_mutex_alloc() to create
+** a new mutex. The new mutex is recursive when SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE
+** is used but not necessarily so when SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST is used.
+** The mutex implementation does not need to make a distinction
+** between SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE and SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST if it does
+** not want to. But SQLite will only request a recursive mutex in
+** cases where it really needs one. If a faster non-recursive mutex
+** implementation is available on the host platform, the mutex subsystem
+** might return such a mutex in response to SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST.
+**
+** The other allowed parameters to sqlite3_mutex_alloc() each return
+** a pointer to a static preexisting mutex. Six static mutexes are
+** used by the current version of SQLite. Future versions of SQLite
+** may add additional static mutexes. Static mutexes are for internal
+** use by SQLite only. Applications that use SQLite mutexes should
+** use only the dynamic mutexes returned by SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST or
+** SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE.
+**
+** Note that if one of the dynamic mutex parameters (SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST
+** or SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE) is used then sqlite3_mutex_alloc()
+** returns a different mutex on every call. But for the static
+** mutex types, the same mutex is returned on every call that has
+** the same type number.
+*/
+static sqlite3_mutex *winMutexAlloc(int iType){
+ sqlite3_mutex *p;
+
+ switch( iType ){
+ case SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST:
+ case SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE: {
+ p = sqlite3MallocZero( sizeof(*p) );
+ if( p ){
+ p->id = iType;
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_MUTEX_TRACE_DYNAMIC
+ p->trace = 1;
+#endif
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ InitializeCriticalSectionEx(&p->mutex, 0, 0);
+#else
+ InitializeCriticalSection(&p->mutex);
+#endif
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ default: {
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( iType-2<0 || iType-2>=ArraySize(winMutex_staticMutexes) ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+ p = &winMutex_staticMutexes[iType-2];
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_MUTEX_TRACE_STATIC
+ InterlockedCompareExchange(&p->trace, 1, 0);
+#endif
+#endif
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ assert( p==0 || p->id==iType );
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** This routine deallocates a previously
+** allocated mutex. SQLite is careful to deallocate every
+** mutex that it allocates.
+*/
+static void winMutexFree(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+ assert( p );
+ assert( p->nRef==0 && p->owner==0 );
+ if( p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST || p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE ){
+ DeleteCriticalSection(&p->mutex);
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ }else{
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+#endif
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_enter() and sqlite3_mutex_try() routines attempt
+** to enter a mutex. If another thread is already within the mutex,
+** sqlite3_mutex_enter() will block and sqlite3_mutex_try() will return
+** SQLITE_BUSY. The sqlite3_mutex_try() interface returns SQLITE_OK
+** upon successful entry. Mutexes created using SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE can
+** be entered multiple times by the same thread. In such cases the,
+** mutex must be exited an equal number of times before another thread
+** can enter. If the same thread tries to enter any other kind of mutex
+** more than once, the behavior is undefined.
+*/
+static void winMutexEnter(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+ DWORD tid = GetCurrentThreadId();
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ assert( p );
+ assert( p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE || winMutexNotheld2(p, tid) );
+#else
+ assert( p );
+#endif
+ assert( winMutex_isInit==1 );
+ EnterCriticalSection(&p->mutex);
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ assert( p->nRef>0 || p->owner==0 );
+ p->owner = tid;
+ p->nRef++;
+ if( p->trace ){
+ OSTRACE(("ENTER-MUTEX tid=%lu, mutex(%d)=%p (%d), nRef=%d\n",
+ tid, p->id, p, p->trace, p->nRef));
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+static int winMutexTry(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+ DWORD tid = GetCurrentThreadId();
+#endif
+ int rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ assert( p );
+ assert( p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE || winMutexNotheld2(p, tid) );
+ /*
+ ** The sqlite3_mutex_try() routine is very rarely used, and when it
+ ** is used it is merely an optimization. So it is OK for it to always
+ ** fail.
+ **
+ ** The TryEnterCriticalSection() interface is only available on WinNT.
+ ** And some windows compilers complain if you try to use it without
+ ** first doing some #defines that prevent SQLite from building on Win98.
+ ** For that reason, we will omit this optimization for now. See
+ ** ticket #2685.
+ */
+#if defined(_WIN32_WINNT) && _WIN32_WINNT >= 0x0400
+ assert( winMutex_isInit==1 );
+ assert( winMutex_isNt>=-1 && winMutex_isNt<=1 );
+ if( winMutex_isNt<0 ){
+ winMutex_isNt = sqlite3_win32_is_nt();
+ }
+ assert( winMutex_isNt==0 || winMutex_isNt==1 );
+ if( winMutex_isNt && TryEnterCriticalSection(&p->mutex) ){
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ p->owner = tid;
+ p->nRef++;
+#endif
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+#else
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(p);
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ if( p->trace ){
+ OSTRACE(("TRY-MUTEX tid=%lu, mutex(%d)=%p (%d), owner=%lu, nRef=%d, rc=%s\n",
+ tid, p->id, p, p->trace, p->owner, p->nRef, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ }
+#endif
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** The sqlite3_mutex_leave() routine exits a mutex that was
+** previously entered by the same thread. The behavior
+** is undefined if the mutex is not currently entered or
+** is not currently allocated. SQLite will never do either.
+*/
+static void winMutexLeave(sqlite3_mutex *p){
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+ DWORD tid = GetCurrentThreadId();
+#endif
+ assert( p );
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ assert( p->nRef>0 );
+ assert( p->owner==tid );
+ p->nRef--;
+ if( p->nRef==0 ) p->owner = 0;
+ assert( p->nRef==0 || p->id==SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE );
+#endif
+ assert( winMutex_isInit==1 );
+ LeaveCriticalSection(&p->mutex);
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ if( p->trace ){
+ OSTRACE(("LEAVE-MUTEX tid=%lu, mutex(%d)=%p (%d), nRef=%d\n",
+ tid, p->id, p, p->trace, p->nRef));
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex_methods const *sqlite3DefaultMutex(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mutex_methods sMutex = {
+ winMutexInit,
+ winMutexEnd,
+ winMutexAlloc,
+ winMutexFree,
+ winMutexEnter,
+ winMutexTry,
+ winMutexLeave,
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ winMutexHeld,
+ winMutexNotheld
+#else
+ 0,
+ 0
+#endif
+ };
+ return &sMutex;
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_MUTEX_W32 */
+
+/************** End of mutex_w32.c *******************************************/
+/************** Begin file malloc.c ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2001 September 15
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** Memory allocation functions used throughout sqlite.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+/* #include */
+
+/*
+** Attempt to release up to n bytes of non-essential memory currently
+** held by SQLite. An example of non-essential memory is memory used to
+** cache database pages that are not currently in use.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_release_memory(int n){
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT
+ return sqlite3PcacheReleaseMemory(n);
+#else
+ /* IMPLEMENTATION-OF: R-34391-24921 The sqlite3_release_memory() routine
+ ** is a no-op returning zero if SQLite is not compiled with
+ ** SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT. */
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(n);
+ return 0;
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Default value of the hard heap limit. 0 means "no limit".
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_MEMORY
+# define SQLITE_MAX_MEMORY 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** State information local to the memory allocation subsystem.
+*/
+static SQLITE_WSD struct Mem0Global {
+ sqlite3_mutex *mutex; /* Mutex to serialize access */
+ sqlite3_int64 alarmThreshold; /* The soft heap limit */
+ sqlite3_int64 hardLimit; /* The hard upper bound on memory */
+
+ /*
+ ** True if heap is nearly "full" where "full" is defined by the
+ ** sqlite3_soft_heap_limit() setting.
+ */
+ int nearlyFull;
+} mem0 = { 0, SQLITE_MAX_MEMORY, SQLITE_MAX_MEMORY, 0 };
+
+#define mem0 GLOBAL(struct Mem0Global, mem0)
+
+/*
+** Return the memory allocator mutex. sqlite3_status() needs it.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex *sqlite3MallocMutex(void){
+ return mem0.mutex;
+}
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_DEPRECATED
+/*
+** Deprecated external interface. It used to set an alarm callback
+** that was invoked when memory usage grew too large. Now it is a
+** no-op.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_memory_alarm(
+ void(*xCallback)(void *pArg, sqlite3_int64 used,int N),
+ void *pArg,
+ sqlite3_int64 iThreshold
+){
+ (void)xCallback;
+ (void)pArg;
+ (void)iThreshold;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Set the soft heap-size limit for the library. An argument of
+** zero disables the limit. A negative argument is a no-op used to
+** obtain the return value.
+**
+** The return value is the value of the heap limit just before this
+** interface was called.
+**
+** If the hard heap limit is enabled, then the soft heap limit cannot
+** be disabled nor raised above the hard heap limit.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64(sqlite3_int64 n){
+ sqlite3_int64 priorLimit;
+ sqlite3_int64 excess;
+ sqlite3_int64 nUsed;
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ int rc = sqlite3_initialize();
+ if( rc ) return -1;
+#endif
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem0.mutex);
+ priorLimit = mem0.alarmThreshold;
+ if( n<0 ){
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem0.mutex);
+ return priorLimit;
+ }
+ if( mem0.hardLimit>0 && (n>mem0.hardLimit || n==0) ){
+ n = mem0.hardLimit;
+ }
+ mem0.alarmThreshold = n;
+ nUsed = sqlite3StatusValue(SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED);
+ AtomicStore(&mem0.nearlyFull, n>0 && n<=nUsed);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem0.mutex);
+ excess = sqlite3_memory_used() - n;
+ if( excess>0 ) sqlite3_release_memory((int)(excess & 0x7fffffff));
+ return priorLimit;
+}
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_soft_heap_limit(int n){
+ if( n<0 ) n = 0;
+ sqlite3_soft_heap_limit64(n);
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the hard heap-size limit for the library. An argument of zero
+** disables the hard heap limit. A negative argument is a no-op used
+** to obtain the return value without affecting the hard heap limit.
+**
+** The return value is the value of the hard heap limit just prior to
+** calling this interface.
+**
+** Setting the hard heap limit will also activate the soft heap limit
+** and constrain the soft heap limit to be no more than the hard heap
+** limit.
+*/
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_hard_heap_limit64(sqlite3_int64 n){
+ sqlite3_int64 priorLimit;
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ int rc = sqlite3_initialize();
+ if( rc ) return -1;
+#endif
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem0.mutex);
+ priorLimit = mem0.hardLimit;
+ if( n>=0 ){
+ mem0.hardLimit = n;
+ if( n0 );
+
+ /* In Firefox (circa 2017-02-08), xRoundup() is remapped to an internal
+ ** implementation of malloc_good_size(), which must be called in debug
+ ** mode and specifically when the DMD "Dark Matter Detector" is enabled
+ ** or else a crash results. Hence, do not attempt to optimize out the
+ ** following xRoundup() call. */
+ nFull = sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xRoundup(n);
+
+ sqlite3StatusHighwater(SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_SIZE, n);
+ if( mem0.alarmThreshold>0 ){
+ sqlite3_int64 nUsed = sqlite3StatusValue(SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED);
+ if( nUsed >= mem0.alarmThreshold - nFull ){
+ AtomicStore(&mem0.nearlyFull, 1);
+ sqlite3MallocAlarm(nFull);
+ if( mem0.hardLimit ){
+ nUsed = sqlite3StatusValue(SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED);
+ if( nUsed >= mem0.hardLimit - nFull ){
+ *pp = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ }else{
+ AtomicStore(&mem0.nearlyFull, 0);
+ }
+ }
+ p = sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xMalloc(nFull);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT
+ if( p==0 && mem0.alarmThreshold>0 ){
+ sqlite3MallocAlarm(nFull);
+ p = sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xMalloc(nFull);
+ }
+#endif
+ if( p ){
+ nFull = sqlite3MallocSize(p);
+ sqlite3StatusUp(SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED, nFull);
+ sqlite3StatusUp(SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_COUNT, 1);
+ }
+ *pp = p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Allocate memory. This routine is like sqlite3_malloc() except that it
+** assumes the memory subsystem has already been initialized.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3Malloc(u64 n){
+ void *p;
+ if( n==0 || n>=0x7fffff00 ){
+ /* A memory allocation of a number of bytes which is near the maximum
+ ** signed integer value might cause an integer overflow inside of the
+ ** xMalloc(). Hence we limit the maximum size to 0x7fffff00, giving
+ ** 255 bytes of overhead. SQLite itself will never use anything near
+ ** this amount. The only way to reach the limit is with sqlite3_malloc() */
+ p = 0;
+ }else if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bMemstat ){
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem0.mutex);
+ mallocWithAlarm((int)n, &p);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem0.mutex);
+ }else{
+ p = sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xMalloc((int)n);
+ }
+ assert( EIGHT_BYTE_ALIGNMENT(p) ); /* IMP: R-11148-40995 */
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** This version of the memory allocation is for use by the application.
+** First make sure the memory subsystem is initialized, then do the
+** allocation.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_malloc(int n){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ return n<=0 ? 0 : sqlite3Malloc(n);
+}
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_malloc64(sqlite3_uint64 n){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ return sqlite3Malloc(n);
+}
+
+/*
+** TRUE if p is a lookaside memory allocation from db
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOOKASIDE
+static int isLookaside(sqlite3 *db, void *p){
+ return SQLITE_WITHIN(p, db->lookaside.pStart, db->lookaside.pEnd);
+}
+#else
+#define isLookaside(A,B) 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Return the size of a memory allocation previously obtained from
+** sqlite3Malloc() or sqlite3_malloc().
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MallocSize(void *p){
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugHasType(p, MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+ return sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xSize(p);
+}
+static int lookasideMallocSize(sqlite3 *db, void *p){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE
+ return plookaside.pMiddle ? db->lookaside.szTrue : LOOKASIDE_SMALL;
+#else
+ return db->lookaside.szTrue;
+#endif
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3DbMallocSize(sqlite3 *db, void *p){
+ assert( p!=0 );
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ if( db==0 || !isLookaside(db,p) ){
+ if( db==0 ){
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugNoType(p, (u8)~MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugHasType(p, MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+ }else{
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugHasType(p, (MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE|MEMTYPE_HEAP)) );
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugNoType(p, (u8)~(MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE|MEMTYPE_HEAP)) );
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ if( db ){
+ if( ((uptr)p)<(uptr)(db->lookaside.pEnd) ){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE
+ if( ((uptr)p)>=(uptr)(db->lookaside.pMiddle) ){
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(db->mutex) );
+ return LOOKASIDE_SMALL;
+ }
+#endif
+ if( ((uptr)p)>=(uptr)(db->lookaside.pStart) ){
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(db->mutex) );
+ return db->lookaside.szTrue;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xSize(p);
+}
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_uint64 sqlite3_msize(void *p){
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugNoType(p, (u8)~MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugHasType(p, MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+ return p ? sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xSize(p) : 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free memory previously obtained from sqlite3Malloc().
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_free(void *p){
+ if( p==0 ) return; /* IMP: R-49053-54554 */
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugHasType(p, MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugNoType(p, (u8)~MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bMemstat ){
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem0.mutex);
+ sqlite3StatusDown(SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED, sqlite3MallocSize(p));
+ sqlite3StatusDown(SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_COUNT, 1);
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xFree(p);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem0.mutex);
+ }else{
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xFree(p);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Add the size of memory allocation "p" to the count in
+** *db->pnBytesFreed.
+*/
+static SQLITE_NOINLINE void measureAllocationSize(sqlite3 *db, void *p){
+ *db->pnBytesFreed += sqlite3DbMallocSize(db,p);
+}
+
+/*
+** Free memory that might be associated with a particular database
+** connection. Calling sqlite3DbFree(D,X) for X==0 is a harmless no-op.
+** The sqlite3DbFreeNN(D,X) version requires that X be non-NULL.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DbFreeNN(sqlite3 *db, void *p){
+ assert( db==0 || sqlite3_mutex_held(db->mutex) );
+ assert( p!=0 );
+ if( db ){
+ if( db->pnBytesFreed ){
+ measureAllocationSize(db, p);
+ return;
+ }
+ if( ((uptr)p)<(uptr)(db->lookaside.pEnd) ){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE
+ if( ((uptr)p)>=(uptr)(db->lookaside.pMiddle) ){
+ LookasideSlot *pBuf = (LookasideSlot*)p;
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ memset(p, 0xaa, LOOKASIDE_SMALL); /* Trash freed content */
+#endif
+ pBuf->pNext = db->lookaside.pSmallFree;
+ db->lookaside.pSmallFree = pBuf;
+ return;
+ }
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE */
+ if( ((uptr)p)>=(uptr)(db->lookaside.pStart) ){
+ LookasideSlot *pBuf = (LookasideSlot*)p;
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ memset(p, 0xaa, db->lookaside.szTrue); /* Trash freed content */
+#endif
+ pBuf->pNext = db->lookaside.pFree;
+ db->lookaside.pFree = pBuf;
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugHasType(p, (MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE|MEMTYPE_HEAP)) );
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugNoType(p, (u8)~(MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE|MEMTYPE_HEAP)) );
+ assert( db!=0 || sqlite3MemdebugNoType(p, MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE) );
+ sqlite3MemdebugSetType(p, MEMTYPE_HEAP);
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DbFree(sqlite3 *db, void *p){
+ assert( db==0 || sqlite3_mutex_held(db->mutex) );
+ if( p ) sqlite3DbFreeNN(db, p);
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the size of an existing memory allocation
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3Realloc(void *pOld, u64 nBytes){
+ int nOld, nNew, nDiff;
+ void *pNew;
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugHasType(pOld, MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugNoType(pOld, (u8)~MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+ if( pOld==0 ){
+ return sqlite3Malloc(nBytes); /* IMP: R-04300-56712 */
+ }
+ if( nBytes==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(pOld); /* IMP: R-26507-47431 */
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if( nBytes>=0x7fffff00 ){
+ /* The 0x7ffff00 limit term is explained in comments on sqlite3Malloc() */
+ return 0;
+ }
+ nOld = sqlite3MallocSize(pOld);
+ /* IMPLEMENTATION-OF: R-46199-30249 SQLite guarantees that the second
+ ** argument to xRealloc is always a value returned by a prior call to
+ ** xRoundup. */
+ nNew = sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xRoundup((int)nBytes);
+ if( nOld==nNew ){
+ pNew = pOld;
+ }else if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bMemstat ){
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mem0.mutex);
+ sqlite3StatusHighwater(SQLITE_STATUS_MALLOC_SIZE, (int)nBytes);
+ nDiff = nNew - nOld;
+ if( nDiff>0 && sqlite3StatusValue(SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED) >=
+ mem0.alarmThreshold-nDiff ){
+ sqlite3MallocAlarm(nDiff);
+ }
+ pNew = sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xRealloc(pOld, nNew);
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT
+ if( pNew==0 && mem0.alarmThreshold>0 ){
+ sqlite3MallocAlarm((int)nBytes);
+ pNew = sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xRealloc(pOld, nNew);
+ }
+#endif
+ if( pNew ){
+ nNew = sqlite3MallocSize(pNew);
+ sqlite3StatusUp(SQLITE_STATUS_MEMORY_USED, nNew-nOld);
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mem0.mutex);
+ }else{
+ pNew = sqlite3GlobalConfig.m.xRealloc(pOld, nNew);
+ }
+ assert( EIGHT_BYTE_ALIGNMENT(pNew) ); /* IMP: R-11148-40995 */
+ return pNew;
+}
+
+/*
+** The public interface to sqlite3Realloc. Make sure that the memory
+** subsystem is initialized prior to invoking sqliteRealloc.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_realloc(void *pOld, int n){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ if( n<0 ) n = 0; /* IMP: R-26507-47431 */
+ return sqlite3Realloc(pOld, n);
+}
+SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_realloc64(void *pOld, sqlite3_uint64 n){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ return sqlite3Realloc(pOld, n);
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Allocate and zero memory.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3MallocZero(u64 n){
+ void *p = sqlite3Malloc(n);
+ if( p ){
+ memset(p, 0, (size_t)n);
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Allocate and zero memory. If the allocation fails, make
+** the mallocFailed flag in the connection pointer.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3DbMallocZero(sqlite3 *db, u64 n){
+ void *p;
+ testcase( db==0 );
+ p = sqlite3DbMallocRaw(db, n);
+ if( p ) memset(p, 0, (size_t)n);
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/* Finish the work of sqlite3DbMallocRawNN for the unusual and
+** slower case when the allocation cannot be fulfilled using lookaside.
+*/
+static SQLITE_NOINLINE void *dbMallocRawFinish(sqlite3 *db, u64 n){
+ void *p;
+ assert( db!=0 );
+ p = sqlite3Malloc(n);
+ if( !p ) sqlite3OomFault(db);
+ sqlite3MemdebugSetType(p,
+ (db->lookaside.bDisable==0) ? MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE : MEMTYPE_HEAP);
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Allocate memory, either lookaside (if possible) or heap.
+** If the allocation fails, set the mallocFailed flag in
+** the connection pointer.
+**
+** If db!=0 and db->mallocFailed is true (indicating a prior malloc
+** failure on the same database connection) then always return 0.
+** Hence for a particular database connection, once malloc starts
+** failing, it fails consistently until mallocFailed is reset.
+** This is an important assumption. There are many places in the
+** code that do things like this:
+**
+** int *a = (int*)sqlite3DbMallocRaw(db, 100);
+** int *b = (int*)sqlite3DbMallocRaw(db, 200);
+** if( b ) a[10] = 9;
+**
+** In other words, if a subsequent malloc (ex: "b") worked, it is assumed
+** that all prior mallocs (ex: "a") worked too.
+**
+** The sqlite3MallocRawNN() variant guarantees that the "db" parameter is
+** not a NULL pointer.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3DbMallocRaw(sqlite3 *db, u64 n){
+ void *p;
+ if( db ) return sqlite3DbMallocRawNN(db, n);
+ p = sqlite3Malloc(n);
+ sqlite3MemdebugSetType(p, MEMTYPE_HEAP);
+ return p;
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3DbMallocRawNN(sqlite3 *db, u64 n){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOOKASIDE
+ LookasideSlot *pBuf;
+ assert( db!=0 );
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(db->mutex) );
+ assert( db->pnBytesFreed==0 );
+ if( n>db->lookaside.sz ){
+ if( !db->lookaside.bDisable ){
+ db->lookaside.anStat[1]++;
+ }else if( db->mallocFailed ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return dbMallocRawFinish(db, n);
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE
+ if( n<=LOOKASIDE_SMALL ){
+ if( (pBuf = db->lookaside.pSmallFree)!=0 ){
+ db->lookaside.pSmallFree = pBuf->pNext;
+ db->lookaside.anStat[0]++;
+ return (void*)pBuf;
+ }else if( (pBuf = db->lookaside.pSmallInit)!=0 ){
+ db->lookaside.pSmallInit = pBuf->pNext;
+ db->lookaside.anStat[0]++;
+ return (void*)pBuf;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ if( (pBuf = db->lookaside.pFree)!=0 ){
+ db->lookaside.pFree = pBuf->pNext;
+ db->lookaside.anStat[0]++;
+ return (void*)pBuf;
+ }else if( (pBuf = db->lookaside.pInit)!=0 ){
+ db->lookaside.pInit = pBuf->pNext;
+ db->lookaside.anStat[0]++;
+ return (void*)pBuf;
+ }else{
+ db->lookaside.anStat[2]++;
+ }
+#else
+ assert( db!=0 );
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(db->mutex) );
+ assert( db->pnBytesFreed==0 );
+ if( db->mallocFailed ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+ return dbMallocRawFinish(db, n);
+}
+
+/* Forward declaration */
+static SQLITE_NOINLINE void *dbReallocFinish(sqlite3 *db, void *p, u64 n);
+
+/*
+** Resize the block of memory pointed to by p to n bytes. If the
+** resize fails, set the mallocFailed flag in the connection object.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3DbRealloc(sqlite3 *db, void *p, u64 n){
+ assert( db!=0 );
+ if( p==0 ) return sqlite3DbMallocRawNN(db, n);
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(db->mutex) );
+ if( ((uptr)p)<(uptr)db->lookaside.pEnd ){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TWOSIZE_LOOKASIDE
+ if( ((uptr)p)>=(uptr)db->lookaside.pMiddle ){
+ if( n<=LOOKASIDE_SMALL ) return p;
+ }else
+#endif
+ if( ((uptr)p)>=(uptr)db->lookaside.pStart ){
+ if( n<=db->lookaside.szTrue ) return p;
+ }
+ }
+ return dbReallocFinish(db, p, n);
+}
+static SQLITE_NOINLINE void *dbReallocFinish(sqlite3 *db, void *p, u64 n){
+ void *pNew = 0;
+ assert( db!=0 );
+ assert( p!=0 );
+ if( db->mallocFailed==0 ){
+ if( isLookaside(db, p) ){
+ pNew = sqlite3DbMallocRawNN(db, n);
+ if( pNew ){
+ memcpy(pNew, p, lookasideMallocSize(db, p));
+ sqlite3DbFree(db, p);
+ }
+ }else{
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugHasType(p, (MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE|MEMTYPE_HEAP)) );
+ assert( sqlite3MemdebugNoType(p, (u8)~(MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE|MEMTYPE_HEAP)) );
+ sqlite3MemdebugSetType(p, MEMTYPE_HEAP);
+ pNew = sqlite3Realloc(p, n);
+ if( !pNew ){
+ sqlite3OomFault(db);
+ }
+ sqlite3MemdebugSetType(pNew,
+ (db->lookaside.bDisable==0 ? MEMTYPE_LOOKASIDE : MEMTYPE_HEAP));
+ }
+ }
+ return pNew;
+}
+
+/*
+** Attempt to reallocate p. If the reallocation fails, then free p
+** and set the mallocFailed flag in the database connection.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3DbReallocOrFree(sqlite3 *db, void *p, u64 n){
+ void *pNew;
+ pNew = sqlite3DbRealloc(db, p, n);
+ if( !pNew ){
+ sqlite3DbFree(db, p);
+ }
+ return pNew;
+}
+
+/*
+** Make a copy of a string in memory obtained from sqliteMalloc(). These
+** functions call sqlite3MallocRaw() directly instead of sqliteMalloc(). This
+** is because when memory debugging is turned on, these two functions are
+** called via macros that record the current file and line number in the
+** ThreadData structure.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3DbStrDup(sqlite3 *db, const char *z){
+ char *zNew;
+ size_t n;
+ if( z==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ n = strlen(z) + 1;
+ zNew = sqlite3DbMallocRaw(db, n);
+ if( zNew ){
+ memcpy(zNew, z, n);
+ }
+ return zNew;
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3DbStrNDup(sqlite3 *db, const char *z, u64 n){
+ char *zNew;
+ assert( db!=0 );
+ assert( z!=0 || n==0 );
+ assert( (n&0x7fffffff)==n );
+ zNew = z ? sqlite3DbMallocRawNN(db, n+1) : 0;
+ if( zNew ){
+ memcpy(zNew, z, (size_t)n);
+ zNew[n] = 0;
+ }
+ return zNew;
+}
+
+/*
+** The text between zStart and zEnd represents a phrase within a larger
+** SQL statement. Make a copy of this phrase in space obtained form
+** sqlite3DbMalloc(). Omit leading and trailing whitespace.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3DbSpanDup(sqlite3 *db, const char *zStart, const char *zEnd){
+ int n;
+ while( sqlite3Isspace(zStart[0]) ) zStart++;
+ n = (int)(zEnd - zStart);
+ while( ALWAYS(n>0) && sqlite3Isspace(zStart[n-1]) ) n--;
+ return sqlite3DbStrNDup(db, zStart, n);
+}
+
+/*
+** Free any prior content in *pz and replace it with a copy of zNew.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SetString(char **pz, sqlite3 *db, const char *zNew){
+ sqlite3DbFree(db, *pz);
+ *pz = sqlite3DbStrDup(db, zNew);
+}
+
+/*
+** Call this routine to record the fact that an OOM (out-of-memory) error
+** has happened. This routine will set db->mallocFailed, and also
+** temporarily disable the lookaside memory allocator and interrupt
+** any running VDBEs.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OomFault(sqlite3 *db){
+ if( db->mallocFailed==0 && db->bBenignMalloc==0 ){
+ db->mallocFailed = 1;
+ if( db->nVdbeExec>0 ){
+ AtomicStore(&db->u1.isInterrupted, 1);
+ }
+ DisableLookaside;
+ if( db->pParse ){
+ db->pParse->rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** This routine reactivates the memory allocator and clears the
+** db->mallocFailed flag as necessary.
+**
+** The memory allocator is not restarted if there are running
+** VDBEs.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OomClear(sqlite3 *db){
+ if( db->mallocFailed && db->nVdbeExec==0 ){
+ db->mallocFailed = 0;
+ AtomicStore(&db->u1.isInterrupted, 0);
+ assert( db->lookaside.bDisable>0 );
+ EnableLookaside;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Take actions at the end of an API call to indicate an OOM error
+*/
+static SQLITE_NOINLINE int apiOomError(sqlite3 *db){
+ sqlite3OomClear(db);
+ sqlite3Error(db, SQLITE_NOMEM);
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function must be called before exiting any API function (i.e.
+** returning control to the user) that has called sqlite3_malloc or
+** sqlite3_realloc.
+**
+** The returned value is normally a copy of the second argument to this
+** function. However, if a malloc() failure has occurred since the previous
+** invocation SQLITE_NOMEM is returned instead.
+**
+** If an OOM as occurred, then the connection error-code (the value
+** returned by sqlite3_errcode()) is set to SQLITE_NOMEM.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ApiExit(sqlite3* db, int rc){
+ /* If the db handle must hold the connection handle mutex here.
+ ** Otherwise the read (and possible write) of db->mallocFailed
+ ** is unsafe, as is the call to sqlite3Error().
+ */
+ assert( db!=0 );
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(db->mutex) );
+ if( db->mallocFailed || rc==SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM ){
+ return apiOomError(db);
+ }
+ return rc & db->errMask;
+}
+
+/************** End of malloc.c **********************************************/
+/************** Begin file printf.c ******************************************/
+/*
+** The "printf" code that follows dates from the 1980's. It is in
+** the public domain.
+**
+**************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains code for a set of "printf"-like routines. These
+** routines format strings much like the printf() from the standard C
+** library, though the implementation here has enhancements to support
+** SQLite.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+/*
+** Conversion types fall into various categories as defined by the
+** following enumeration.
+*/
+#define etRADIX 0 /* non-decimal integer types. %x %o */
+#define etFLOAT 1 /* Floating point. %f */
+#define etEXP 2 /* Exponentional notation. %e and %E */
+#define etGENERIC 3 /* Floating or exponential, depending on exponent. %g */
+#define etSIZE 4 /* Return number of characters processed so far. %n */
+#define etSTRING 5 /* Strings. %s */
+#define etDYNSTRING 6 /* Dynamically allocated strings. %z */
+#define etPERCENT 7 /* Percent symbol. %% */
+#define etCHARX 8 /* Characters. %c */
+/* The rest are extensions, not normally found in printf() */
+#define etSQLESCAPE 9 /* Strings with '\'' doubled. %q */
+#define etSQLESCAPE2 10 /* Strings with '\'' doubled and enclosed in '',
+ NULL pointers replaced by SQL NULL. %Q */
+#define etTOKEN 11 /* a pointer to a Token structure */
+#define etSRCLIST 12 /* a pointer to a SrcList */
+#define etPOINTER 13 /* The %p conversion */
+#define etSQLESCAPE3 14 /* %w -> Strings with '\"' doubled */
+#define etORDINAL 15 /* %r -> 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th, etc. English only */
+#define etDECIMAL 16 /* %d or %u, but not %x, %o */
+
+#define etINVALID 17 /* Any unrecognized conversion type */
+
+
+/*
+** An "etByte" is an 8-bit unsigned value.
+*/
+typedef unsigned char etByte;
+
+/*
+** Each builtin conversion character (ex: the 'd' in "%d") is described
+** by an instance of the following structure
+*/
+typedef struct et_info { /* Information about each format field */
+ char fmttype; /* The format field code letter */
+ etByte base; /* The base for radix conversion */
+ etByte flags; /* One or more of FLAG_ constants below */
+ etByte type; /* Conversion paradigm */
+ etByte charset; /* Offset into aDigits[] of the digits string */
+ etByte prefix; /* Offset into aPrefix[] of the prefix string */
+} et_info;
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for et_info.flags
+*/
+#define FLAG_SIGNED 1 /* True if the value to convert is signed */
+#define FLAG_STRING 4 /* Allow infinite precision */
+
+
+/*
+** The following table is searched linearly, so it is good to put the
+** most frequently used conversion types first.
+*/
+static const char aDigits[] = "0123456789ABCDEF0123456789abcdef";
+static const char aPrefix[] = "-x0\000X0";
+static const et_info fmtinfo[] = {
+ { 'd', 10, 1, etDECIMAL, 0, 0 },
+ { 's', 0, 4, etSTRING, 0, 0 },
+ { 'g', 0, 1, etGENERIC, 30, 0 },
+ { 'z', 0, 4, etDYNSTRING, 0, 0 },
+ { 'q', 0, 4, etSQLESCAPE, 0, 0 },
+ { 'Q', 0, 4, etSQLESCAPE2, 0, 0 },
+ { 'w', 0, 4, etSQLESCAPE3, 0, 0 },
+ { 'c', 0, 0, etCHARX, 0, 0 },
+ { 'o', 8, 0, etRADIX, 0, 2 },
+ { 'u', 10, 0, etDECIMAL, 0, 0 },
+ { 'x', 16, 0, etRADIX, 16, 1 },
+ { 'X', 16, 0, etRADIX, 0, 4 },
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+ { 'f', 0, 1, etFLOAT, 0, 0 },
+ { 'e', 0, 1, etEXP, 30, 0 },
+ { 'E', 0, 1, etEXP, 14, 0 },
+ { 'G', 0, 1, etGENERIC, 14, 0 },
+#endif
+ { 'i', 10, 1, etDECIMAL, 0, 0 },
+ { 'n', 0, 0, etSIZE, 0, 0 },
+ { '%', 0, 0, etPERCENT, 0, 0 },
+ { 'p', 16, 0, etPOINTER, 0, 1 },
+
+ /* All the rest are undocumented and are for internal use only */
+ { 'T', 0, 0, etTOKEN, 0, 0 },
+ { 'S', 0, 0, etSRCLIST, 0, 0 },
+ { 'r', 10, 1, etORDINAL, 0, 0 },
+};
+
+/* Floating point constants used for rounding */
+static const double arRound[] = {
+ 5.0e-01, 5.0e-02, 5.0e-03, 5.0e-04, 5.0e-05,
+ 5.0e-06, 5.0e-07, 5.0e-08, 5.0e-09, 5.0e-10,
+};
+
+/*
+** If SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT is defined, then none of the floating point
+** conversions will work.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+/*
+** "*val" is a double such that 0.1 <= *val < 10.0
+** Return the ascii code for the leading digit of *val, then
+** multiply "*val" by 10.0 to renormalize.
+**
+** Example:
+** input: *val = 3.14159
+** output: *val = 1.4159 function return = '3'
+**
+** The counter *cnt is incremented each time. After counter exceeds
+** 16 (the number of significant digits in a 64-bit float) '0' is
+** always returned.
+*/
+static char et_getdigit(LONGDOUBLE_TYPE *val, int *cnt){
+ int digit;
+ LONGDOUBLE_TYPE d;
+ if( (*cnt)<=0 ) return '0';
+ (*cnt)--;
+ digit = (int)*val;
+ d = digit;
+ digit += '0';
+ *val = (*val - d)*10.0;
+ return (char)digit;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT */
+
+/*
+** Set the StrAccum object to an error mode.
+*/
+static void setStrAccumError(StrAccum *p, u8 eError){
+ assert( eError==SQLITE_NOMEM || eError==SQLITE_TOOBIG );
+ p->accError = eError;
+ if( p->mxAlloc ) sqlite3_str_reset(p);
+ if( eError==SQLITE_TOOBIG ) sqlite3ErrorToParser(p->db, eError);
+}
+
+/*
+** Extra argument values from a PrintfArguments object
+*/
+static sqlite3_int64 getIntArg(PrintfArguments *p){
+ if( p->nArg<=p->nUsed ) return 0;
+ return sqlite3_value_int64(p->apArg[p->nUsed++]);
+}
+static double getDoubleArg(PrintfArguments *p){
+ if( p->nArg<=p->nUsed ) return 0.0;
+ return sqlite3_value_double(p->apArg[p->nUsed++]);
+}
+static char *getTextArg(PrintfArguments *p){
+ if( p->nArg<=p->nUsed ) return 0;
+ return (char*)sqlite3_value_text(p->apArg[p->nUsed++]);
+}
+
+/*
+** Allocate memory for a temporary buffer needed for printf rendering.
+**
+** If the requested size of the temp buffer is larger than the size
+** of the output buffer in pAccum, then cause an SQLITE_TOOBIG error.
+** Do the size check before the memory allocation to prevent rogue
+** SQL from requesting large allocations using the precision or width
+** field of the printf() function.
+*/
+static char *printfTempBuf(sqlite3_str *pAccum, sqlite3_int64 n){
+ char *z;
+ if( pAccum->accError ) return 0;
+ if( n>pAccum->nAlloc && n>pAccum->mxAlloc ){
+ setStrAccumError(pAccum, SQLITE_TOOBIG);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ z = sqlite3DbMallocRaw(pAccum->db, n);
+ if( z==0 ){
+ setStrAccumError(pAccum, SQLITE_NOMEM);
+ }
+ return z;
+}
+
+/*
+** On machines with a small stack size, you can redefine the
+** SQLITE_PRINT_BUF_SIZE to be something smaller, if desired.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_PRINT_BUF_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_PRINT_BUF_SIZE 70
+#endif
+#define etBUFSIZE SQLITE_PRINT_BUF_SIZE /* Size of the output buffer */
+
+/*
+** Hard limit on the precision of floating-point conversions.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_PRINTF_PRECISION_LIMIT
+# define SQLITE_FP_PRECISION_LIMIT 100000000
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Render a string given by "fmt" into the StrAccum object.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_vappendf(
+ sqlite3_str *pAccum, /* Accumulate results here */
+ const char *fmt, /* Format string */
+ va_list ap /* arguments */
+){
+ int c; /* Next character in the format string */
+ char *bufpt; /* Pointer to the conversion buffer */
+ int precision; /* Precision of the current field */
+ int length; /* Length of the field */
+ int idx; /* A general purpose loop counter */
+ int width; /* Width of the current field */
+ etByte flag_leftjustify; /* True if "-" flag is present */
+ etByte flag_prefix; /* '+' or ' ' or 0 for prefix */
+ etByte flag_alternateform; /* True if "#" flag is present */
+ etByte flag_altform2; /* True if "!" flag is present */
+ etByte flag_zeropad; /* True if field width constant starts with zero */
+ etByte flag_long; /* 1 for the "l" flag, 2 for "ll", 0 by default */
+ etByte done; /* Loop termination flag */
+ etByte cThousand; /* Thousands separator for %d and %u */
+ etByte xtype = etINVALID; /* Conversion paradigm */
+ u8 bArgList; /* True for SQLITE_PRINTF_SQLFUNC */
+ char prefix; /* Prefix character. "+" or "-" or " " or '\0'. */
+ sqlite_uint64 longvalue; /* Value for integer types */
+ LONGDOUBLE_TYPE realvalue; /* Value for real types */
+ const et_info *infop; /* Pointer to the appropriate info structure */
+ char *zOut; /* Rendering buffer */
+ int nOut; /* Size of the rendering buffer */
+ char *zExtra = 0; /* Malloced memory used by some conversion */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+ int exp, e2; /* exponent of real numbers */
+ int nsd; /* Number of significant digits returned */
+ double rounder; /* Used for rounding floating point values */
+ etByte flag_dp; /* True if decimal point should be shown */
+ etByte flag_rtz; /* True if trailing zeros should be removed */
+#endif
+ PrintfArguments *pArgList = 0; /* Arguments for SQLITE_PRINTF_SQLFUNC */
+ char buf[etBUFSIZE]; /* Conversion buffer */
+
+ /* pAccum never starts out with an empty buffer that was obtained from
+ ** malloc(). This precondition is required by the mprintf("%z...")
+ ** optimization. */
+ assert( pAccum->nChar>0 || (pAccum->printfFlags&SQLITE_PRINTF_MALLOCED)==0 );
+
+ bufpt = 0;
+ if( (pAccum->printfFlags & SQLITE_PRINTF_SQLFUNC)!=0 ){
+ pArgList = va_arg(ap, PrintfArguments*);
+ bArgList = 1;
+ }else{
+ bArgList = 0;
+ }
+ for(; (c=(*fmt))!=0; ++fmt){
+ if( c!='%' ){
+ bufpt = (char *)fmt;
+#if HAVE_STRCHRNUL
+ fmt = strchrnul(fmt, '%');
+#else
+ do{ fmt++; }while( *fmt && *fmt != '%' );
+#endif
+ sqlite3_str_append(pAccum, bufpt, (int)(fmt - bufpt));
+ if( *fmt==0 ) break;
+ }
+ if( (c=(*++fmt))==0 ){
+ sqlite3_str_append(pAccum, "%", 1);
+ break;
+ }
+ /* Find out what flags are present */
+ flag_leftjustify = flag_prefix = cThousand =
+ flag_alternateform = flag_altform2 = flag_zeropad = 0;
+ done = 0;
+ width = 0;
+ flag_long = 0;
+ precision = -1;
+ do{
+ switch( c ){
+ case '-': flag_leftjustify = 1; break;
+ case '+': flag_prefix = '+'; break;
+ case ' ': flag_prefix = ' '; break;
+ case '#': flag_alternateform = 1; break;
+ case '!': flag_altform2 = 1; break;
+ case '0': flag_zeropad = 1; break;
+ case ',': cThousand = ','; break;
+ default: done = 1; break;
+ case 'l': {
+ flag_long = 1;
+ c = *++fmt;
+ if( c=='l' ){
+ c = *++fmt;
+ flag_long = 2;
+ }
+ done = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': case '5':
+ case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9': {
+ unsigned wx = c - '0';
+ while( (c = *++fmt)>='0' && c<='9' ){
+ wx = wx*10 + c - '0';
+ }
+ testcase( wx>0x7fffffff );
+ width = wx & 0x7fffffff;
+#ifdef SQLITE_PRINTF_PRECISION_LIMIT
+ if( width>SQLITE_PRINTF_PRECISION_LIMIT ){
+ width = SQLITE_PRINTF_PRECISION_LIMIT;
+ }
+#endif
+ if( c!='.' && c!='l' ){
+ done = 1;
+ }else{
+ fmt--;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ case '*': {
+ if( bArgList ){
+ width = (int)getIntArg(pArgList);
+ }else{
+ width = va_arg(ap,int);
+ }
+ if( width<0 ){
+ flag_leftjustify = 1;
+ width = width >= -2147483647 ? -width : 0;
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_PRINTF_PRECISION_LIMIT
+ if( width>SQLITE_PRINTF_PRECISION_LIMIT ){
+ width = SQLITE_PRINTF_PRECISION_LIMIT;
+ }
+#endif
+ if( (c = fmt[1])!='.' && c!='l' ){
+ c = *++fmt;
+ done = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ case '.': {
+ c = *++fmt;
+ if( c=='*' ){
+ if( bArgList ){
+ precision = (int)getIntArg(pArgList);
+ }else{
+ precision = va_arg(ap,int);
+ }
+ if( precision<0 ){
+ precision = precision >= -2147483647 ? -precision : -1;
+ }
+ c = *++fmt;
+ }else{
+ unsigned px = 0;
+ while( c>='0' && c<='9' ){
+ px = px*10 + c - '0';
+ c = *++fmt;
+ }
+ testcase( px>0x7fffffff );
+ precision = px & 0x7fffffff;
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_PRINTF_PRECISION_LIMIT
+ if( precision>SQLITE_PRINTF_PRECISION_LIMIT ){
+ precision = SQLITE_PRINTF_PRECISION_LIMIT;
+ }
+#endif
+ if( c=='l' ){
+ --fmt;
+ }else{
+ done = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }while( !done && (c=(*++fmt))!=0 );
+
+ /* Fetch the info entry for the field */
+ infop = &fmtinfo[0];
+ xtype = etINVALID;
+ for(idx=0; idxtype;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ ** At this point, variables are initialized as follows:
+ **
+ ** flag_alternateform TRUE if a '#' is present.
+ ** flag_altform2 TRUE if a '!' is present.
+ ** flag_prefix '+' or ' ' or zero
+ ** flag_leftjustify TRUE if a '-' is present or if the
+ ** field width was negative.
+ ** flag_zeropad TRUE if the width began with 0.
+ ** flag_long 1 for "l", 2 for "ll"
+ ** width The specified field width. This is
+ ** always non-negative. Zero is the default.
+ ** precision The specified precision. The default
+ ** is -1.
+ ** xtype The class of the conversion.
+ ** infop Pointer to the appropriate info struct.
+ */
+ assert( width>=0 );
+ assert( precision>=(-1) );
+ switch( xtype ){
+ case etPOINTER:
+ flag_long = sizeof(char*)==sizeof(i64) ? 2 :
+ sizeof(char*)==sizeof(long int) ? 1 : 0;
+ /* no break */ deliberate_fall_through
+ case etORDINAL:
+ case etRADIX:
+ cThousand = 0;
+ /* no break */ deliberate_fall_through
+ case etDECIMAL:
+ if( infop->flags & FLAG_SIGNED ){
+ i64 v;
+ if( bArgList ){
+ v = getIntArg(pArgList);
+ }else if( flag_long ){
+ if( flag_long==2 ){
+ v = va_arg(ap,i64) ;
+ }else{
+ v = va_arg(ap,long int);
+ }
+ }else{
+ v = va_arg(ap,int);
+ }
+ if( v<0 ){
+ if( v==SMALLEST_INT64 ){
+ longvalue = ((u64)1)<<63;
+ }else{
+ longvalue = -v;
+ }
+ prefix = '-';
+ }else{
+ longvalue = v;
+ prefix = flag_prefix;
+ }
+ }else{
+ if( bArgList ){
+ longvalue = (u64)getIntArg(pArgList);
+ }else if( flag_long ){
+ if( flag_long==2 ){
+ longvalue = va_arg(ap,u64);
+ }else{
+ longvalue = va_arg(ap,unsigned long int);
+ }
+ }else{
+ longvalue = va_arg(ap,unsigned int);
+ }
+ prefix = 0;
+ }
+ if( longvalue==0 ) flag_alternateform = 0;
+ if( flag_zeropad && precision=4 || (longvalue/10)%10==1 ){
+ x = 0;
+ }
+ *(--bufpt) = zOrd[x*2+1];
+ *(--bufpt) = zOrd[x*2];
+ }
+ {
+ const char *cset = &aDigits[infop->charset];
+ u8 base = infop->base;
+ do{ /* Convert to ascii */
+ *(--bufpt) = cset[longvalue%base];
+ longvalue = longvalue/base;
+ }while( longvalue>0 );
+ }
+ length = (int)(&zOut[nOut-1]-bufpt);
+ while( precision>length ){
+ *(--bufpt) = '0'; /* Zero pad */
+ length++;
+ }
+ if( cThousand ){
+ int nn = (length - 1)/3; /* Number of "," to insert */
+ int ix = (length - 1)%3 + 1;
+ bufpt -= nn;
+ for(idx=0; nn>0; idx++){
+ bufpt[idx] = bufpt[idx+nn];
+ ix--;
+ if( ix==0 ){
+ bufpt[++idx] = cThousand;
+ nn--;
+ ix = 3;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ if( prefix ) *(--bufpt) = prefix; /* Add sign */
+ if( flag_alternateform && infop->prefix ){ /* Add "0" or "0x" */
+ const char *pre;
+ char x;
+ pre = &aPrefix[infop->prefix];
+ for(; (x=(*pre))!=0; pre++) *(--bufpt) = x;
+ }
+ length = (int)(&zOut[nOut-1]-bufpt);
+ break;
+ case etFLOAT:
+ case etEXP:
+ case etGENERIC:
+ if( bArgList ){
+ realvalue = getDoubleArg(pArgList);
+ }else{
+ realvalue = va_arg(ap,double);
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+ length = 0;
+#else
+ if( precision<0 ) precision = 6; /* Set default precision */
+#ifdef SQLITE_FP_PRECISION_LIMIT
+ if( precision>SQLITE_FP_PRECISION_LIMIT ){
+ precision = SQLITE_FP_PRECISION_LIMIT;
+ }
+#endif
+ if( realvalue<0.0 ){
+ realvalue = -realvalue;
+ prefix = '-';
+ }else{
+ prefix = flag_prefix;
+ }
+ if( xtype==etGENERIC && precision>0 ) precision--;
+ testcase( precision>0xfff );
+ idx = precision & 0xfff;
+ rounder = arRound[idx%10];
+ while( idx>=10 ){ rounder *= 1.0e-10; idx -= 10; }
+ if( xtype==etFLOAT ){
+ double rx = (double)realvalue;
+ sqlite3_uint64 u;
+ int ex;
+ memcpy(&u, &rx, sizeof(u));
+ ex = -1023 + (int)((u>>52)&0x7ff);
+ if( precision+(ex/3) < 15 ) rounder += realvalue*3e-16;
+ realvalue += rounder;
+ }
+ /* Normalize realvalue to within 10.0 > realvalue >= 1.0 */
+ exp = 0;
+ if( sqlite3IsNaN((double)realvalue) ){
+ bufpt = "NaN";
+ length = 3;
+ break;
+ }
+ if( realvalue>0.0 ){
+ LONGDOUBLE_TYPE scale = 1.0;
+ while( realvalue>=1e100*scale && exp<=350 ){ scale *= 1e100;exp+=100;}
+ while( realvalue>=1e10*scale && exp<=350 ){ scale *= 1e10; exp+=10; }
+ while( realvalue>=10.0*scale && exp<=350 ){ scale *= 10.0; exp++; }
+ realvalue /= scale;
+ while( realvalue<1e-8 ){ realvalue *= 1e8; exp-=8; }
+ while( realvalue<1.0 ){ realvalue *= 10.0; exp--; }
+ if( exp>350 ){
+ bufpt = buf;
+ buf[0] = prefix;
+ memcpy(buf+(prefix!=0),"Inf",4);
+ length = 3+(prefix!=0);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ bufpt = buf;
+ /*
+ ** If the field type is etGENERIC, then convert to either etEXP
+ ** or etFLOAT, as appropriate.
+ */
+ if( xtype!=etFLOAT ){
+ realvalue += rounder;
+ if( realvalue>=10.0 ){ realvalue *= 0.1; exp++; }
+ }
+ if( xtype==etGENERIC ){
+ flag_rtz = !flag_alternateform;
+ if( exp<-4 || exp>precision ){
+ xtype = etEXP;
+ }else{
+ precision = precision - exp;
+ xtype = etFLOAT;
+ }
+ }else{
+ flag_rtz = flag_altform2;
+ }
+ if( xtype==etEXP ){
+ e2 = 0;
+ }else{
+ e2 = exp;
+ }
+ {
+ i64 szBufNeeded; /* Size of a temporary buffer needed */
+ szBufNeeded = MAX(e2,0)+(i64)precision+(i64)width+15;
+ if( szBufNeeded > etBUFSIZE ){
+ bufpt = zExtra = printfTempBuf(pAccum, szBufNeeded);
+ if( bufpt==0 ) return;
+ }
+ }
+ zOut = bufpt;
+ nsd = 16 + flag_altform2*10;
+ flag_dp = (precision>0 ?1:0) | flag_alternateform | flag_altform2;
+ /* The sign in front of the number */
+ if( prefix ){
+ *(bufpt++) = prefix;
+ }
+ /* Digits prior to the decimal point */
+ if( e2<0 ){
+ *(bufpt++) = '0';
+ }else{
+ for(; e2>=0; e2--){
+ *(bufpt++) = et_getdigit(&realvalue,&nsd);
+ }
+ }
+ /* The decimal point */
+ if( flag_dp ){
+ *(bufpt++) = '.';
+ }
+ /* "0" digits after the decimal point but before the first
+ ** significant digit of the number */
+ for(e2++; e2<0; precision--, e2++){
+ assert( precision>0 );
+ *(bufpt++) = '0';
+ }
+ /* Significant digits after the decimal point */
+ while( (precision--)>0 ){
+ *(bufpt++) = et_getdigit(&realvalue,&nsd);
+ }
+ /* Remove trailing zeros and the "." if no digits follow the "." */
+ if( flag_rtz && flag_dp ){
+ while( bufpt[-1]=='0' ) *(--bufpt) = 0;
+ assert( bufpt>zOut );
+ if( bufpt[-1]=='.' ){
+ if( flag_altform2 ){
+ *(bufpt++) = '0';
+ }else{
+ *(--bufpt) = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ /* Add the "eNNN" suffix */
+ if( xtype==etEXP ){
+ *(bufpt++) = aDigits[infop->charset];
+ if( exp<0 ){
+ *(bufpt++) = '-'; exp = -exp;
+ }else{
+ *(bufpt++) = '+';
+ }
+ if( exp>=100 ){
+ *(bufpt++) = (char)((exp/100)+'0'); /* 100's digit */
+ exp %= 100;
+ }
+ *(bufpt++) = (char)(exp/10+'0'); /* 10's digit */
+ *(bufpt++) = (char)(exp%10+'0'); /* 1's digit */
+ }
+ *bufpt = 0;
+
+ /* The converted number is in buf[] and zero terminated. Output it.
+ ** Note that the number is in the usual order, not reversed as with
+ ** integer conversions. */
+ length = (int)(bufpt-zOut);
+ bufpt = zOut;
+
+ /* Special case: Add leading zeros if the flag_zeropad flag is
+ ** set and we are not left justified */
+ if( flag_zeropad && !flag_leftjustify && length < width){
+ int i;
+ int nPad = width - length;
+ for(i=width; i>=nPad; i--){
+ bufpt[i] = bufpt[i-nPad];
+ }
+ i = prefix!=0;
+ while( nPad-- ) bufpt[i++] = '0';
+ length = width;
+ }
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT) */
+ break;
+ case etSIZE:
+ if( !bArgList ){
+ *(va_arg(ap,int*)) = pAccum->nChar;
+ }
+ length = width = 0;
+ break;
+ case etPERCENT:
+ buf[0] = '%';
+ bufpt = buf;
+ length = 1;
+ break;
+ case etCHARX:
+ if( bArgList ){
+ bufpt = getTextArg(pArgList);
+ length = 1;
+ if( bufpt ){
+ buf[0] = c = *(bufpt++);
+ if( (c&0xc0)==0xc0 ){
+ while( length<4 && (bufpt[0]&0xc0)==0x80 ){
+ buf[length++] = *(bufpt++);
+ }
+ }
+ }else{
+ buf[0] = 0;
+ }
+ }else{
+ unsigned int ch = va_arg(ap,unsigned int);
+ if( ch<0x00080 ){
+ buf[0] = ch & 0xff;
+ length = 1;
+ }else if( ch<0x00800 ){
+ buf[0] = 0xc0 + (u8)((ch>>6)&0x1f);
+ buf[1] = 0x80 + (u8)(ch & 0x3f);
+ length = 2;
+ }else if( ch<0x10000 ){
+ buf[0] = 0xe0 + (u8)((ch>>12)&0x0f);
+ buf[1] = 0x80 + (u8)((ch>>6) & 0x3f);
+ buf[2] = 0x80 + (u8)(ch & 0x3f);
+ length = 3;
+ }else{
+ buf[0] = 0xf0 + (u8)((ch>>18) & 0x07);
+ buf[1] = 0x80 + (u8)((ch>>12) & 0x3f);
+ buf[2] = 0x80 + (u8)((ch>>6) & 0x3f);
+ buf[3] = 0x80 + (u8)(ch & 0x3f);
+ length = 4;
+ }
+ }
+ if( precision>1 ){
+ width -= precision-1;
+ if( width>1 && !flag_leftjustify ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendchar(pAccum, width-1, ' ');
+ width = 0;
+ }
+ while( precision-- > 1 ){
+ sqlite3_str_append(pAccum, buf, length);
+ }
+ }
+ bufpt = buf;
+ flag_altform2 = 1;
+ goto adjust_width_for_utf8;
+ case etSTRING:
+ case etDYNSTRING:
+ if( bArgList ){
+ bufpt = getTextArg(pArgList);
+ xtype = etSTRING;
+ }else{
+ bufpt = va_arg(ap,char*);
+ }
+ if( bufpt==0 ){
+ bufpt = "";
+ }else if( xtype==etDYNSTRING ){
+ if( pAccum->nChar==0
+ && pAccum->mxAlloc
+ && width==0
+ && precision<0
+ && pAccum->accError==0
+ ){
+ /* Special optimization for sqlite3_mprintf("%z..."):
+ ** Extend an existing memory allocation rather than creating
+ ** a new one. */
+ assert( (pAccum->printfFlags&SQLITE_PRINTF_MALLOCED)==0 );
+ pAccum->zText = bufpt;
+ pAccum->nAlloc = sqlite3DbMallocSize(pAccum->db, bufpt);
+ pAccum->nChar = 0x7fffffff & (int)strlen(bufpt);
+ pAccum->printfFlags |= SQLITE_PRINTF_MALLOCED;
+ length = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ zExtra = bufpt;
+ }
+ if( precision>=0 ){
+ if( flag_altform2 ){
+ /* Set length to the number of bytes needed in order to display
+ ** precision characters */
+ unsigned char *z = (unsigned char*)bufpt;
+ while( precision-- > 0 && z[0] ){
+ SQLITE_SKIP_UTF8(z);
+ }
+ length = (int)(z - (unsigned char*)bufpt);
+ }else{
+ for(length=0; length0 ){
+ /* Adjust width to account for extra bytes in UTF-8 characters */
+ int ii = length - 1;
+ while( ii>=0 ) if( (bufpt[ii--] & 0xc0)==0x80 ) width++;
+ }
+ break;
+ case etSQLESCAPE: /* %q: Escape ' characters */
+ case etSQLESCAPE2: /* %Q: Escape ' and enclose in '...' */
+ case etSQLESCAPE3: { /* %w: Escape " characters */
+ int i, j, k, n, isnull;
+ int needQuote;
+ char ch;
+ char q = ((xtype==etSQLESCAPE3)?'"':'\''); /* Quote character */
+ char *escarg;
+
+ if( bArgList ){
+ escarg = getTextArg(pArgList);
+ }else{
+ escarg = va_arg(ap,char*);
+ }
+ isnull = escarg==0;
+ if( isnull ) escarg = (xtype==etSQLESCAPE2 ? "NULL" : "(NULL)");
+ /* For %q, %Q, and %w, the precision is the number of bytes (or
+ ** characters if the ! flags is present) to use from the input.
+ ** Because of the extra quoting characters inserted, the number
+ ** of output characters may be larger than the precision.
+ */
+ k = precision;
+ for(i=n=0; k!=0 && (ch=escarg[i])!=0; i++, k--){
+ if( ch==q ) n++;
+ if( flag_altform2 && (ch&0xc0)==0xc0 ){
+ while( (escarg[i+1]&0xc0)==0x80 ){ i++; }
+ }
+ }
+ needQuote = !isnull && xtype==etSQLESCAPE2;
+ n += i + 3;
+ if( n>etBUFSIZE ){
+ bufpt = zExtra = printfTempBuf(pAccum, n);
+ if( bufpt==0 ) return;
+ }else{
+ bufpt = buf;
+ }
+ j = 0;
+ if( needQuote ) bufpt[j++] = q;
+ k = i;
+ for(i=0; iprintfFlags & SQLITE_PRINTF_INTERNAL)==0 ) return;
+ pToken = va_arg(ap, Token*);
+ assert( bArgList==0 );
+ if( pToken && pToken->n ){
+ sqlite3_str_append(pAccum, (const char*)pToken->z, pToken->n);
+ }
+ length = width = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ case etSRCLIST: {
+ SrcList *pSrc;
+ int k;
+ struct SrcList_item *pItem;
+ if( (pAccum->printfFlags & SQLITE_PRINTF_INTERNAL)==0 ) return;
+ pSrc = va_arg(ap, SrcList*);
+ k = va_arg(ap, int);
+ pItem = &pSrc->a[k];
+ assert( bArgList==0 );
+ assert( k>=0 && knSrc );
+ if( pItem->zDatabase ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendall(pAccum, pItem->zDatabase);
+ sqlite3_str_append(pAccum, ".", 1);
+ }
+ sqlite3_str_appendall(pAccum, pItem->zName);
+ length = width = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ default: {
+ assert( xtype==etINVALID );
+ return;
+ }
+ }/* End switch over the format type */
+ /*
+ ** The text of the conversion is pointed to by "bufpt" and is
+ ** "length" characters long. The field width is "width". Do
+ ** the output. Both length and width are in bytes, not characters,
+ ** at this point. If the "!" flag was present on string conversions
+ ** indicating that width and precision should be expressed in characters,
+ ** then the values have been translated prior to reaching this point.
+ */
+ width -= length;
+ if( width>0 ){
+ if( !flag_leftjustify ) sqlite3_str_appendchar(pAccum, width, ' ');
+ sqlite3_str_append(pAccum, bufpt, length);
+ if( flag_leftjustify ) sqlite3_str_appendchar(pAccum, width, ' ');
+ }else{
+ sqlite3_str_append(pAccum, bufpt, length);
+ }
+
+ if( zExtra ){
+ sqlite3DbFree(pAccum->db, zExtra);
+ zExtra = 0;
+ }
+ }/* End for loop over the format string */
+} /* End of function */
+
+/*
+** Enlarge the memory allocation on a StrAccum object so that it is
+** able to accept at least N more bytes of text.
+**
+** Return the number of bytes of text that StrAccum is able to accept
+** after the attempted enlargement. The value returned might be zero.
+*/
+static int sqlite3StrAccumEnlarge(StrAccum *p, int N){
+ char *zNew;
+ assert( p->nChar+(i64)N >= p->nAlloc ); /* Only called if really needed */
+ if( p->accError ){
+ testcase(p->accError==SQLITE_TOOBIG);
+ testcase(p->accError==SQLITE_NOMEM);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if( p->mxAlloc==0 ){
+ setStrAccumError(p, SQLITE_TOOBIG);
+ return p->nAlloc - p->nChar - 1;
+ }else{
+ char *zOld = isMalloced(p) ? p->zText : 0;
+ i64 szNew = p->nChar;
+ szNew += N + 1;
+ if( szNew+p->nChar<=p->mxAlloc ){
+ /* Force exponential buffer size growth as long as it does not overflow,
+ ** to avoid having to call this routine too often */
+ szNew += p->nChar;
+ }
+ if( szNew > p->mxAlloc ){
+ sqlite3_str_reset(p);
+ setStrAccumError(p, SQLITE_TOOBIG);
+ return 0;
+ }else{
+ p->nAlloc = (int)szNew;
+ }
+ if( p->db ){
+ zNew = sqlite3DbRealloc(p->db, zOld, p->nAlloc);
+ }else{
+ zNew = sqlite3Realloc(zOld, p->nAlloc);
+ }
+ if( zNew ){
+ assert( p->zText!=0 || p->nChar==0 );
+ if( !isMalloced(p) && p->nChar>0 ) memcpy(zNew, p->zText, p->nChar);
+ p->zText = zNew;
+ p->nAlloc = sqlite3DbMallocSize(p->db, zNew);
+ p->printfFlags |= SQLITE_PRINTF_MALLOCED;
+ }else{
+ sqlite3_str_reset(p);
+ setStrAccumError(p, SQLITE_NOMEM);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ }
+ return N;
+}
+
+/*
+** Append N copies of character c to the given string buffer.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_appendchar(sqlite3_str *p, int N, char c){
+ testcase( p->nChar + (i64)N > 0x7fffffff );
+ if( p->nChar+(i64)N >= p->nAlloc && (N = sqlite3StrAccumEnlarge(p, N))<=0 ){
+ return;
+ }
+ while( (N--)>0 ) p->zText[p->nChar++] = c;
+}
+
+/*
+** The StrAccum "p" is not large enough to accept N new bytes of z[].
+** So enlarge if first, then do the append.
+**
+** This is a helper routine to sqlite3_str_append() that does special-case
+** work (enlarging the buffer) using tail recursion, so that the
+** sqlite3_str_append() routine can use fast calling semantics.
+*/
+static void SQLITE_NOINLINE enlargeAndAppend(StrAccum *p, const char *z, int N){
+ N = sqlite3StrAccumEnlarge(p, N);
+ if( N>0 ){
+ memcpy(&p->zText[p->nChar], z, N);
+ p->nChar += N;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Append N bytes of text from z to the StrAccum object. Increase the
+** size of the memory allocation for StrAccum if necessary.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_append(sqlite3_str *p, const char *z, int N){
+ assert( z!=0 || N==0 );
+ assert( p->zText!=0 || p->nChar==0 || p->accError );
+ assert( N>=0 );
+ assert( p->accError==0 || p->nAlloc==0 || p->mxAlloc==0 );
+ if( p->nChar+N >= p->nAlloc ){
+ enlargeAndAppend(p,z,N);
+ }else if( N ){
+ assert( p->zText );
+ p->nChar += N;
+ memcpy(&p->zText[p->nChar-N], z, N);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Append the complete text of zero-terminated string z[] to the p string.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_appendall(sqlite3_str *p, const char *z){
+ sqlite3_str_append(p, z, sqlite3Strlen30(z));
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Finish off a string by making sure it is zero-terminated.
+** Return a pointer to the resulting string. Return a NULL
+** pointer if any kind of error was encountered.
+*/
+static SQLITE_NOINLINE char *strAccumFinishRealloc(StrAccum *p){
+ char *zText;
+ assert( p->mxAlloc>0 && !isMalloced(p) );
+ zText = sqlite3DbMallocRaw(p->db, p->nChar+1 );
+ if( zText ){
+ memcpy(zText, p->zText, p->nChar+1);
+ p->printfFlags |= SQLITE_PRINTF_MALLOCED;
+ }else{
+ setStrAccumError(p, SQLITE_NOMEM);
+ }
+ p->zText = zText;
+ return zText;
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3StrAccumFinish(StrAccum *p){
+ if( p->zText ){
+ p->zText[p->nChar] = 0;
+ if( p->mxAlloc>0 && !isMalloced(p) ){
+ return strAccumFinishRealloc(p);
+ }
+ }
+ return p->zText;
+}
+
+/*
+** This singleton is an sqlite3_str object that is returned if
+** sqlite3_malloc() fails to provide space for a real one. This
+** sqlite3_str object accepts no new text and always returns
+** an SQLITE_NOMEM error.
+*/
+static sqlite3_str sqlite3OomStr = {
+ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, SQLITE_NOMEM, 0
+};
+
+/* Finalize a string created using sqlite3_str_new().
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_str_finish(sqlite3_str *p){
+ char *z;
+ if( p!=0 && p!=&sqlite3OomStr ){
+ z = sqlite3StrAccumFinish(p);
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ }else{
+ z = 0;
+ }
+ return z;
+}
+
+/* Return any error code associated with p */
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_str_errcode(sqlite3_str *p){
+ return p ? p->accError : SQLITE_NOMEM;
+}
+
+/* Return the current length of p in bytes */
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_str_length(sqlite3_str *p){
+ return p ? p->nChar : 0;
+}
+
+/* Return the current value for p */
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_str_value(sqlite3_str *p){
+ if( p==0 || p->nChar==0 ) return 0;
+ p->zText[p->nChar] = 0;
+ return p->zText;
+}
+
+/*
+** Reset an StrAccum string. Reclaim all malloced memory.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_reset(StrAccum *p){
+ if( isMalloced(p) ){
+ sqlite3DbFree(p->db, p->zText);
+ p->printfFlags &= ~SQLITE_PRINTF_MALLOCED;
+ }
+ p->nAlloc = 0;
+ p->nChar = 0;
+ p->zText = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Initialize a string accumulator.
+**
+** p: The accumulator to be initialized.
+** db: Pointer to a database connection. May be NULL. Lookaside
+** memory is used if not NULL. db->mallocFailed is set appropriately
+** when not NULL.
+** zBase: An initial buffer. May be NULL in which case the initial buffer
+** is malloced.
+** n: Size of zBase in bytes. If total space requirements never exceed
+** n then no memory allocations ever occur.
+** mx: Maximum number of bytes to accumulate. If mx==0 then no memory
+** allocations will ever occur.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3StrAccumInit(StrAccum *p, sqlite3 *db, char *zBase, int n, int mx){
+ p->zText = zBase;
+ p->db = db;
+ p->nAlloc = n;
+ p->mxAlloc = mx;
+ p->nChar = 0;
+ p->accError = 0;
+ p->printfFlags = 0;
+}
+
+/* Allocate and initialize a new dynamic string object */
+SQLITE_API sqlite3_str *sqlite3_str_new(sqlite3 *db){
+ sqlite3_str *p = sqlite3_malloc64(sizeof(*p));
+ if( p ){
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(p, 0, 0, 0,
+ db ? db->aLimit[SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH] : SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH);
+ }else{
+ p = &sqlite3OomStr;
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Print into memory obtained from sqliteMalloc(). Use the internal
+** %-conversion extensions.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3VMPrintf(sqlite3 *db, const char *zFormat, va_list ap){
+ char *z;
+ char zBase[SQLITE_PRINT_BUF_SIZE];
+ StrAccum acc;
+ assert( db!=0 );
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&acc, db, zBase, sizeof(zBase),
+ db->aLimit[SQLITE_LIMIT_LENGTH]);
+ acc.printfFlags = SQLITE_PRINTF_INTERNAL;
+ sqlite3_str_vappendf(&acc, zFormat, ap);
+ z = sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&acc);
+ if( acc.accError==SQLITE_NOMEM ){
+ sqlite3OomFault(db);
+ }
+ return z;
+}
+
+/*
+** Print into memory obtained from sqliteMalloc(). Use the internal
+** %-conversion extensions.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3MPrintf(sqlite3 *db, const char *zFormat, ...){
+ va_list ap;
+ char *z;
+ va_start(ap, zFormat);
+ z = sqlite3VMPrintf(db, zFormat, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ return z;
+}
+
+/*
+** Print into memory obtained from sqlite3_malloc(). Omit the internal
+** %-conversion extensions.
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_vmprintf(const char *zFormat, va_list ap){
+ char *z;
+ char zBase[SQLITE_PRINT_BUF_SIZE];
+ StrAccum acc;
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( zFormat==0 ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&acc, 0, zBase, sizeof(zBase), SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH);
+ sqlite3_str_vappendf(&acc, zFormat, ap);
+ z = sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&acc);
+ return z;
+}
+
+/*
+** Print into memory obtained from sqlite3_malloc()(). Omit the internal
+** %-conversion extensions.
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_mprintf(const char *zFormat, ...){
+ va_list ap;
+ char *z;
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ va_start(ap, zFormat);
+ z = sqlite3_vmprintf(zFormat, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ return z;
+}
+
+/*
+** sqlite3_snprintf() works like snprintf() except that it ignores the
+** current locale settings. This is important for SQLite because we
+** are not able to use a "," as the decimal point in place of "." as
+** specified by some locales.
+**
+** Oops: The first two arguments of sqlite3_snprintf() are backwards
+** from the snprintf() standard. Unfortunately, it is too late to change
+** this without breaking compatibility, so we just have to live with the
+** mistake.
+**
+** sqlite3_vsnprintf() is the varargs version.
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_vsnprintf(int n, char *zBuf, const char *zFormat, va_list ap){
+ StrAccum acc;
+ if( n<=0 ) return zBuf;
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( zBuf==0 || zFormat==0 ) {
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ if( zBuf ) zBuf[0] = 0;
+ return zBuf;
+ }
+#endif
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&acc, 0, zBuf, n, 0);
+ sqlite3_str_vappendf(&acc, zFormat, ap);
+ zBuf[acc.nChar] = 0;
+ return zBuf;
+}
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_snprintf(int n, char *zBuf, const char *zFormat, ...){
+ char *z;
+ va_list ap;
+ va_start(ap,zFormat);
+ z = sqlite3_vsnprintf(n, zBuf, zFormat, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ return z;
+}
+
+/*
+** This is the routine that actually formats the sqlite3_log() message.
+** We house it in a separate routine from sqlite3_log() to avoid using
+** stack space on small-stack systems when logging is disabled.
+**
+** sqlite3_log() must render into a static buffer. It cannot dynamically
+** allocate memory because it might be called while the memory allocator
+** mutex is held.
+**
+** sqlite3_str_vappendf() might ask for *temporary* memory allocations for
+** certain format characters (%q) or for very large precisions or widths.
+** Care must be taken that any sqlite3_log() calls that occur while the
+** memory mutex is held do not use these mechanisms.
+*/
+static void renderLogMsg(int iErrCode, const char *zFormat, va_list ap){
+ StrAccum acc; /* String accumulator */
+ char zMsg[SQLITE_PRINT_BUF_SIZE*3]; /* Complete log message */
+
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&acc, 0, zMsg, sizeof(zMsg), 0);
+ sqlite3_str_vappendf(&acc, zFormat, ap);
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.xLog(sqlite3GlobalConfig.pLogArg, iErrCode,
+ sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&acc));
+}
+
+/*
+** Format and write a message to the log if logging is enabled.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_log(int iErrCode, const char *zFormat, ...){
+ va_list ap; /* Vararg list */
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.xLog ){
+ va_start(ap, zFormat);
+ renderLogMsg(iErrCode, zFormat, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ }
+}
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_HAVE_OS_TRACE)
+/*
+** A version of printf() that understands %lld. Used for debugging.
+** The printf() built into some versions of windows does not understand %lld
+** and segfaults if you give it a long long int.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DebugPrintf(const char *zFormat, ...){
+ va_list ap;
+ StrAccum acc;
+ char zBuf[SQLITE_PRINT_BUF_SIZE*10];
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&acc, 0, zBuf, sizeof(zBuf), 0);
+ va_start(ap,zFormat);
+ sqlite3_str_vappendf(&acc, zFormat, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&acc);
+#ifdef SQLITE_OS_TRACE_PROC
+ {
+ extern void SQLITE_OS_TRACE_PROC(const char *zBuf, int nBuf);
+ SQLITE_OS_TRACE_PROC(zBuf, sizeof(zBuf));
+ }
+#else
+ fprintf(stdout,"%s", zBuf);
+ fflush(stdout);
+#endif
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+** variable-argument wrapper around sqlite3_str_vappendf(). The bFlags argument
+** can contain the bit SQLITE_PRINTF_INTERNAL enable internal formats.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_str_appendf(StrAccum *p, const char *zFormat, ...){
+ va_list ap;
+ va_start(ap,zFormat);
+ sqlite3_str_vappendf(p, zFormat, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+
+/************** End of printf.c **********************************************/
+/************** Begin file treeview.c ****************************************/
+/*
+** 2015-06-08
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains C code to implement the TreeView debugging routines.
+** These routines print a parse tree to standard output for debugging and
+** analysis.
+**
+** The interfaces in this file is only available when compiling
+** with SQLITE_DEBUG.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+
+/*
+** Add a new subitem to the tree. The moreToFollow flag indicates that this
+** is not the last item in the tree.
+*/
+static TreeView *sqlite3TreeViewPush(TreeView *p, u8 moreToFollow){
+ if( p==0 ){
+ p = sqlite3_malloc64( sizeof(*p) );
+ if( p==0 ) return 0;
+ memset(p, 0, sizeof(*p));
+ }else{
+ p->iLevel++;
+ }
+ assert( moreToFollow==0 || moreToFollow==1 );
+ if( p->iLevelbLine) ) p->bLine[p->iLevel] = moreToFollow;
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Finished with one layer of the tree
+*/
+static void sqlite3TreeViewPop(TreeView *p){
+ if( p==0 ) return;
+ p->iLevel--;
+ if( p->iLevel<0 ) sqlite3_free(p);
+}
+
+/*
+** Generate a single line of output for the tree, with a prefix that contains
+** all the appropriate tree lines
+*/
+static void sqlite3TreeViewLine(TreeView *p, const char *zFormat, ...){
+ va_list ap;
+ int i;
+ StrAccum acc;
+ char zBuf[500];
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&acc, 0, zBuf, sizeof(zBuf), 0);
+ if( p ){
+ for(i=0; iiLevel && ibLine)-1; i++){
+ sqlite3_str_append(&acc, p->bLine[i] ? "| " : " ", 4);
+ }
+ sqlite3_str_append(&acc, p->bLine[i] ? "|-- " : "'-- ", 4);
+ }
+ if( zFormat!=0 ){
+ va_start(ap, zFormat);
+ sqlite3_str_vappendf(&acc, zFormat, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ assert( acc.nChar>0 || acc.accError );
+ sqlite3_str_append(&acc, "\n", 1);
+ }
+ sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&acc);
+ fprintf(stdout,"%s", zBuf);
+ fflush(stdout);
+}
+
+/*
+** Shorthand for starting a new tree item that consists of a single label
+*/
+static void sqlite3TreeViewItem(TreeView *p, const char *zLabel,u8 moreFollows){
+ p = sqlite3TreeViewPush(p, moreFollows);
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(p, "%s", zLabel);
+}
+
+/*
+** Generate a human-readable description of a WITH clause.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewWith(TreeView *pView, const With *pWith, u8 moreToFollow){
+ int i;
+ if( pWith==0 ) return;
+ if( pWith->nCte==0 ) return;
+ if( pWith->pOuter ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "WITH (0x%p, pOuter=0x%p)",pWith,pWith->pOuter);
+ }else{
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "WITH (0x%p)", pWith);
+ }
+ if( pWith->nCte>0 ){
+ pView = sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, 1);
+ for(i=0; inCte; i++){
+ StrAccum x;
+ char zLine[1000];
+ const struct Cte *pCte = &pWith->a[i];
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&x, 0, zLine, sizeof(zLine), 0);
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, "%s", pCte->zName);
+ if( pCte->pCols && pCte->pCols->nExpr>0 ){
+ char cSep = '(';
+ int j;
+ for(j=0; jpCols->nExpr; j++){
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, "%c%s", cSep, pCte->pCols->a[j].zEName);
+ cSep = ',';
+ }
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, ")");
+ }
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " AS");
+ sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&x);
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, zLine, inCte-1);
+ sqlite3TreeViewSelect(pView, pCte->pSelect, 0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Generate a human-readable description of a SrcList object.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewSrcList(TreeView *pView, const SrcList *pSrc){
+ int i;
+ for(i=0; inSrc; i++){
+ const struct SrcList_item *pItem = &pSrc->a[i];
+ StrAccum x;
+ char zLine[100];
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&x, 0, zLine, sizeof(zLine), 0);
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, "{%d:*}", pItem->iCursor);
+ if( pItem->zDatabase ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " %s.%s", pItem->zDatabase, pItem->zName);
+ }else if( pItem->zName ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " %s", pItem->zName);
+ }
+ if( pItem->pTab ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " tab=%Q nCol=%d ptr=%p used=%llx",
+ pItem->pTab->zName, pItem->pTab->nCol, pItem->pTab, pItem->colUsed);
+ }
+ if( pItem->zAlias ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " (AS %s)", pItem->zAlias);
+ }
+ if( pItem->fg.jointype & JT_LEFT ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " LEFT-JOIN");
+ }
+ if( pItem->fg.fromDDL ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " DDL");
+ }
+ sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&x);
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, zLine, inSrc-1);
+ if( pItem->pSelect ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewSelect(pView, pItem->pSelect, 0);
+ }
+ if( pItem->fg.isTabFunc ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewExprList(pView, pItem->u1.pFuncArg, 0, "func-args:");
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Generate a human-readable description of a Select object.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewSelect(TreeView *pView, const Select *p, u8 moreToFollow){
+ int n = 0;
+ int cnt = 0;
+ if( p==0 ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "nil-SELECT");
+ return;
+ }
+ pView = sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, moreToFollow);
+ if( p->pWith ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewWith(pView, p->pWith, 1);
+ cnt = 1;
+ sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, 1);
+ }
+ do{
+ if( p->selFlags & SF_WhereBegin ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "sqlite3WhereBegin()");
+ }else{
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView,
+ "SELECT%s%s (%u/%p) selFlags=0x%x nSelectRow=%d",
+ ((p->selFlags & SF_Distinct) ? " DISTINCT" : ""),
+ ((p->selFlags & SF_Aggregate) ? " agg_flag" : ""),
+ p->selId, p, p->selFlags,
+ (int)p->nSelectRow
+ );
+ }
+ if( cnt++ ) sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ if( p->pPrior ){
+ n = 1000;
+ }else{
+ n = 0;
+ if( p->pSrc && p->pSrc->nSrc ) n++;
+ if( p->pWhere ) n++;
+ if( p->pGroupBy ) n++;
+ if( p->pHaving ) n++;
+ if( p->pOrderBy ) n++;
+ if( p->pLimit ) n++;
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+ if( p->pWin ) n++;
+ if( p->pWinDefn ) n++;
+#endif
+ }
+ if( p->pEList ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewExprList(pView, p->pEList, n>0, "result-set");
+ }
+ n--;
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+ if( p->pWin ){
+ Window *pX;
+ pView = sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, (n--)>0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "window-functions");
+ for(pX=p->pWin; pX; pX=pX->pNextWin){
+ sqlite3TreeViewWinFunc(pView, pX, pX->pNextWin!=0);
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+#endif
+ if( p->pSrc && p->pSrc->nSrc ){
+ pView = sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, (n--)>0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "FROM");
+ sqlite3TreeViewSrcList(pView, p->pSrc);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+ if( p->pWhere ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, "WHERE", (n--)>0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, p->pWhere, 0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+ if( p->pGroupBy ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewExprList(pView, p->pGroupBy, (n--)>0, "GROUPBY");
+ }
+ if( p->pHaving ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, "HAVING", (n--)>0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, p->pHaving, 0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+ if( p->pWinDefn ){
+ Window *pX;
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, "WINDOW", (n--)>0);
+ for(pX=p->pWinDefn; pX; pX=pX->pNextWin){
+ sqlite3TreeViewWindow(pView, pX, pX->pNextWin!=0);
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+#endif
+ if( p->pOrderBy ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewExprList(pView, p->pOrderBy, (n--)>0, "ORDERBY");
+ }
+ if( p->pLimit ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, "LIMIT", (n--)>0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, p->pLimit->pLeft, p->pLimit->pRight!=0);
+ if( p->pLimit->pRight ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, "OFFSET", (n--)>0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, p->pLimit->pRight, 0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+ if( p->pPrior ){
+ const char *zOp = "UNION";
+ switch( p->op ){
+ case TK_ALL: zOp = "UNION ALL"; break;
+ case TK_INTERSECT: zOp = "INTERSECT"; break;
+ case TK_EXCEPT: zOp = "EXCEPT"; break;
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, zOp, 1);
+ }
+ p = p->pPrior;
+ }while( p!=0 );
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+}
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+/*
+** Generate a description of starting or stopping bounds
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewBound(
+ TreeView *pView, /* View context */
+ u8 eBound, /* UNBOUNDED, CURRENT, PRECEDING, FOLLOWING */
+ Expr *pExpr, /* Value for PRECEDING or FOLLOWING */
+ u8 moreToFollow /* True if more to follow */
+){
+ switch( eBound ){
+ case TK_UNBOUNDED: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, "UNBOUNDED", moreToFollow);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_CURRENT: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, "CURRENT", moreToFollow);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_PRECEDING: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, "PRECEDING", moreToFollow);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr, 0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_FOLLOWING: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, "FOLLOWING", moreToFollow);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr, 0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC */
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+/*
+** Generate a human-readable explanation for a Window object
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewWindow(TreeView *pView, const Window *pWin, u8 more){
+ int nElement = 0;
+ if( pWin->pFilter ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, "FILTER", 1);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pWin->pFilter, 0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+ pView = sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, more);
+ if( pWin->zName ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "OVER %s (%p)", pWin->zName, pWin);
+ }else{
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "OVER (%p)", pWin);
+ }
+ if( pWin->zBase ) nElement++;
+ if( pWin->pOrderBy ) nElement++;
+ if( pWin->eFrmType ) nElement++;
+ if( pWin->eExclude ) nElement++;
+ if( pWin->zBase ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, (--nElement)>0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "window: %s", pWin->zBase);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+ if( pWin->pPartition ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewExprList(pView, pWin->pPartition, nElement>0,"PARTITION-BY");
+ }
+ if( pWin->pOrderBy ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewExprList(pView, pWin->pOrderBy, (--nElement)>0, "ORDER-BY");
+ }
+ if( pWin->eFrmType ){
+ char zBuf[30];
+ const char *zFrmType = "ROWS";
+ if( pWin->eFrmType==TK_RANGE ) zFrmType = "RANGE";
+ if( pWin->eFrmType==TK_GROUPS ) zFrmType = "GROUPS";
+ sqlite3_snprintf(sizeof(zBuf),zBuf,"%s%s",zFrmType,
+ pWin->bImplicitFrame ? " (implied)" : "");
+ sqlite3TreeViewItem(pView, zBuf, (--nElement)>0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewBound(pView, pWin->eStart, pWin->pStart, 1);
+ sqlite3TreeViewBound(pView, pWin->eEnd, pWin->pEnd, 0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+ if( pWin->eExclude ){
+ char zBuf[30];
+ const char *zExclude;
+ switch( pWin->eExclude ){
+ case TK_NO: zExclude = "NO OTHERS"; break;
+ case TK_CURRENT: zExclude = "CURRENT ROW"; break;
+ case TK_GROUP: zExclude = "GROUP"; break;
+ case TK_TIES: zExclude = "TIES"; break;
+ default:
+ sqlite3_snprintf(sizeof(zBuf),zBuf,"invalid(%d)", pWin->eExclude);
+ zExclude = zBuf;
+ break;
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, 0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "EXCLUDE %s", zExclude);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC */
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+/*
+** Generate a human-readable explanation for a Window Function object
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewWinFunc(TreeView *pView, const Window *pWin, u8 more){
+ pView = sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, more);
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "WINFUNC %s(%d)",
+ pWin->pFunc->zName, pWin->pFunc->nArg);
+ sqlite3TreeViewWindow(pView, pWin, 0);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC */
+
+/*
+** Generate a human-readable explanation of an expression tree.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewExpr(TreeView *pView, const Expr *pExpr, u8 moreToFollow){
+ const char *zBinOp = 0; /* Binary operator */
+ const char *zUniOp = 0; /* Unary operator */
+ char zFlgs[200];
+ pView = sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, moreToFollow);
+ if( pExpr==0 ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "nil");
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ return;
+ }
+ if( pExpr->flags || pExpr->affExpr || pExpr->vvaFlags ){
+ StrAccum x;
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&x, 0, zFlgs, sizeof(zFlgs), 0);
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " fg.af=%x.%c",
+ pExpr->flags, pExpr->affExpr ? pExpr->affExpr : 'n');
+ if( ExprHasProperty(pExpr, EP_FromJoin) ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " iRJT=%d", pExpr->iRightJoinTable);
+ }
+ if( ExprHasProperty(pExpr, EP_FromDDL) ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " DDL");
+ }
+ if( ExprHasVVAProperty(pExpr, EP_Immutable) ){
+ sqlite3_str_appendf(&x, " IMMUTABLE");
+ }
+ sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&x);
+ }else{
+ zFlgs[0] = 0;
+ }
+ switch( pExpr->op ){
+ case TK_AGG_COLUMN: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "AGG{%d:%d}%s",
+ pExpr->iTable, pExpr->iColumn, zFlgs);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_COLUMN: {
+ if( pExpr->iTable<0 ){
+ /* This only happens when coding check constraints */
+ char zOp2[16];
+ if( pExpr->op2 ){
+ sqlite3_snprintf(sizeof(zOp2),zOp2," op2=0x%02x",pExpr->op2);
+ }else{
+ zOp2[0] = 0;
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "COLUMN(%d)%s%s",
+ pExpr->iColumn, zFlgs, zOp2);
+ }else{
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "{%d:%d} pTab=%p%s",
+ pExpr->iTable, pExpr->iColumn,
+ pExpr->y.pTab, zFlgs);
+ }
+ if( ExprHasProperty(pExpr, EP_FixedCol) ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pLeft, 0);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_INTEGER: {
+ if( pExpr->flags & EP_IntValue ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "%d", pExpr->u.iValue);
+ }else{
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "%s", pExpr->u.zToken);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+ case TK_FLOAT: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView,"%s", pExpr->u.zToken);
+ break;
+ }
+#endif
+ case TK_STRING: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView,"%Q", pExpr->u.zToken);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_NULL: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView,"NULL");
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_TRUEFALSE: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView,
+ sqlite3ExprTruthValue(pExpr) ? "TRUE" : "FALSE");
+ break;
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_BLOB_LITERAL
+ case TK_BLOB: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView,"%s", pExpr->u.zToken);
+ break;
+ }
+#endif
+ case TK_VARIABLE: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView,"VARIABLE(%s,%d)",
+ pExpr->u.zToken, pExpr->iColumn);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_REGISTER: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView,"REGISTER(%d)", pExpr->iTable);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_ID: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView,"ID \"%w\"", pExpr->u.zToken);
+ break;
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_CAST
+ case TK_CAST: {
+ /* Expressions of the form: CAST(pLeft AS token) */
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView,"CAST %Q", pExpr->u.zToken);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pLeft, 0);
+ break;
+ }
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_CAST */
+ case TK_LT: zBinOp = "LT"; break;
+ case TK_LE: zBinOp = "LE"; break;
+ case TK_GT: zBinOp = "GT"; break;
+ case TK_GE: zBinOp = "GE"; break;
+ case TK_NE: zBinOp = "NE"; break;
+ case TK_EQ: zBinOp = "EQ"; break;
+ case TK_IS: zBinOp = "IS"; break;
+ case TK_ISNOT: zBinOp = "ISNOT"; break;
+ case TK_AND: zBinOp = "AND"; break;
+ case TK_OR: zBinOp = "OR"; break;
+ case TK_PLUS: zBinOp = "ADD"; break;
+ case TK_STAR: zBinOp = "MUL"; break;
+ case TK_MINUS: zBinOp = "SUB"; break;
+ case TK_REM: zBinOp = "REM"; break;
+ case TK_BITAND: zBinOp = "BITAND"; break;
+ case TK_BITOR: zBinOp = "BITOR"; break;
+ case TK_SLASH: zBinOp = "DIV"; break;
+ case TK_LSHIFT: zBinOp = "LSHIFT"; break;
+ case TK_RSHIFT: zBinOp = "RSHIFT"; break;
+ case TK_CONCAT: zBinOp = "CONCAT"; break;
+ case TK_DOT: zBinOp = "DOT"; break;
+ case TK_LIMIT: zBinOp = "LIMIT"; break;
+
+ case TK_UMINUS: zUniOp = "UMINUS"; break;
+ case TK_UPLUS: zUniOp = "UPLUS"; break;
+ case TK_BITNOT: zUniOp = "BITNOT"; break;
+ case TK_NOT: zUniOp = "NOT"; break;
+ case TK_ISNULL: zUniOp = "ISNULL"; break;
+ case TK_NOTNULL: zUniOp = "NOTNULL"; break;
+
+ case TK_TRUTH: {
+ int x;
+ const char *azOp[] = {
+ "IS-FALSE", "IS-TRUE", "IS-NOT-FALSE", "IS-NOT-TRUE"
+ };
+ assert( pExpr->op2==TK_IS || pExpr->op2==TK_ISNOT );
+ assert( pExpr->pRight );
+ assert( sqlite3ExprSkipCollate(pExpr->pRight)->op==TK_TRUEFALSE );
+ x = (pExpr->op2==TK_ISNOT)*2 + sqlite3ExprTruthValue(pExpr->pRight);
+ zUniOp = azOp[x];
+ break;
+ }
+
+ case TK_SPAN: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "SPAN %Q", pExpr->u.zToken);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pLeft, 0);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ case TK_COLLATE: {
+ /* COLLATE operators without the EP_Collate flag are intended to
+ ** emulate collation associated with a table column. These show
+ ** up in the treeview output as "SOFT-COLLATE". Explicit COLLATE
+ ** operators that appear in the original SQL always have the
+ ** EP_Collate bit set and appear in treeview output as just "COLLATE" */
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "%sCOLLATE %Q%s",
+ !ExprHasProperty(pExpr, EP_Collate) ? "SOFT-" : "",
+ pExpr->u.zToken, zFlgs);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pLeft, 0);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ case TK_AGG_FUNCTION:
+ case TK_FUNCTION: {
+ ExprList *pFarg; /* List of function arguments */
+ Window *pWin;
+ if( ExprHasProperty(pExpr, EP_TokenOnly) ){
+ pFarg = 0;
+ pWin = 0;
+ }else{
+ pFarg = pExpr->x.pList;
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+ pWin = ExprHasProperty(pExpr, EP_WinFunc) ? pExpr->y.pWin : 0;
+#else
+ pWin = 0;
+#endif
+ }
+ if( pExpr->op==TK_AGG_FUNCTION ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "AGG_FUNCTION%d %Q%s agg=%d[%d]/%p",
+ pExpr->op2, pExpr->u.zToken, zFlgs,
+ pExpr->pAggInfo ? pExpr->pAggInfo->selId : 0,
+ pExpr->iAgg, pExpr->pAggInfo);
+ }else if( pExpr->op2!=0 ){
+ const char *zOp2;
+ char zBuf[8];
+ sqlite3_snprintf(sizeof(zBuf),zBuf,"0x%02x",pExpr->op2);
+ zOp2 = zBuf;
+ if( pExpr->op2==NC_IsCheck ) zOp2 = "NC_IsCheck";
+ if( pExpr->op2==NC_IdxExpr ) zOp2 = "NC_IdxExpr";
+ if( pExpr->op2==NC_PartIdx ) zOp2 = "NC_PartIdx";
+ if( pExpr->op2==NC_GenCol ) zOp2 = "NC_GenCol";
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "FUNCTION %Q%s op2=%s",
+ pExpr->u.zToken, zFlgs, zOp2);
+ }else{
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "FUNCTION %Q%s", pExpr->u.zToken, zFlgs);
+ }
+ if( pFarg ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewExprList(pView, pFarg, pWin!=0, 0);
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WINDOWFUNC
+ if( pWin ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewWindow(pView, pWin, 0);
+ }
+#endif
+ break;
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_SUBQUERY
+ case TK_EXISTS: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "EXISTS-expr flags=0x%x", pExpr->flags);
+ sqlite3TreeViewSelect(pView, pExpr->x.pSelect, 0);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_SELECT: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "subquery-expr flags=0x%x", pExpr->flags);
+ sqlite3TreeViewSelect(pView, pExpr->x.pSelect, 0);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_IN: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "IN flags=0x%x", pExpr->flags);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pLeft, 1);
+ if( ExprHasProperty(pExpr, EP_xIsSelect) ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewSelect(pView, pExpr->x.pSelect, 0);
+ }else{
+ sqlite3TreeViewExprList(pView, pExpr->x.pList, 0, 0);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_SUBQUERY */
+
+ /*
+ ** x BETWEEN y AND z
+ **
+ ** This is equivalent to
+ **
+ ** x>=y AND x<=z
+ **
+ ** X is stored in pExpr->pLeft.
+ ** Y is stored in pExpr->pList->a[0].pExpr.
+ ** Z is stored in pExpr->pList->a[1].pExpr.
+ */
+ case TK_BETWEEN: {
+ Expr *pX = pExpr->pLeft;
+ Expr *pY = pExpr->x.pList->a[0].pExpr;
+ Expr *pZ = pExpr->x.pList->a[1].pExpr;
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "BETWEEN");
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pX, 1);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pY, 1);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pZ, 0);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_TRIGGER: {
+ /* If the opcode is TK_TRIGGER, then the expression is a reference
+ ** to a column in the new.* or old.* pseudo-tables available to
+ ** trigger programs. In this case Expr.iTable is set to 1 for the
+ ** new.* pseudo-table, or 0 for the old.* pseudo-table. Expr.iColumn
+ ** is set to the column of the pseudo-table to read, or to -1 to
+ ** read the rowid field.
+ */
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "%s(%d)",
+ pExpr->iTable ? "NEW" : "OLD", pExpr->iColumn);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_CASE: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "CASE");
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pLeft, 1);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExprList(pView, pExpr->x.pList, 0, 0);
+ break;
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_TRIGGER
+ case TK_RAISE: {
+ const char *zType = "unk";
+ switch( pExpr->affExpr ){
+ case OE_Rollback: zType = "rollback"; break;
+ case OE_Abort: zType = "abort"; break;
+ case OE_Fail: zType = "fail"; break;
+ case OE_Ignore: zType = "ignore"; break;
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "RAISE %s(%Q)", zType, pExpr->u.zToken);
+ break;
+ }
+#endif
+ case TK_MATCH: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "MATCH {%d:%d}%s",
+ pExpr->iTable, pExpr->iColumn, zFlgs);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pRight, 0);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_VECTOR: {
+ char *z = sqlite3_mprintf("VECTOR%s",zFlgs);
+ sqlite3TreeViewBareExprList(pView, pExpr->x.pList, z);
+ sqlite3_free(z);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_SELECT_COLUMN: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "SELECT-COLUMN %d", pExpr->iColumn);
+ sqlite3TreeViewSelect(pView, pExpr->pLeft->x.pSelect, 0);
+ break;
+ }
+ case TK_IF_NULL_ROW: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "IF-NULL-ROW %d", pExpr->iTable);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pLeft, 0);
+ break;
+ }
+ default: {
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "op=%d", pExpr->op);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if( zBinOp ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "%s%s", zBinOp, zFlgs);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pLeft, 1);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pRight, 0);
+ }else if( zUniOp ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "%s%s", zUniOp, zFlgs);
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pExpr->pLeft, 0);
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Generate a human-readable explanation of an expression list.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewBareExprList(
+ TreeView *pView,
+ const ExprList *pList,
+ const char *zLabel
+){
+ if( zLabel==0 || zLabel[0]==0 ) zLabel = "LIST";
+ if( pList==0 ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "%s (empty)", zLabel);
+ }else{
+ int i;
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, "%s", zLabel);
+ for(i=0; inExpr; i++){
+ int j = pList->a[i].u.x.iOrderByCol;
+ char *zName = pList->a[i].zEName;
+ int moreToFollow = inExpr - 1;
+ if( pList->a[i].eEName!=ENAME_NAME ) zName = 0;
+ if( j || zName ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, moreToFollow);
+ moreToFollow = 0;
+ sqlite3TreeViewLine(pView, 0);
+ if( zName ){
+ fprintf(stdout, "AS %s ", zName);
+ }
+ if( j ){
+ fprintf(stdout, "iOrderByCol=%d", j);
+ }
+ fprintf(stdout, "\n");
+ fflush(stdout);
+ }
+ sqlite3TreeViewExpr(pView, pList->a[i].pExpr, moreToFollow);
+ if( j || zName ){
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TreeViewExprList(
+ TreeView *pView,
+ const ExprList *pList,
+ u8 moreToFollow,
+ const char *zLabel
+){
+ pView = sqlite3TreeViewPush(pView, moreToFollow);
+ sqlite3TreeViewBareExprList(pView, pList, zLabel);
+ sqlite3TreeViewPop(pView);
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_DEBUG */
+
+/************** End of treeview.c ********************************************/
+/************** Begin file random.c ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2001 September 15
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This file contains code to implement a pseudo-random number
+** generator (PRNG) for SQLite.
+**
+** Random numbers are used by some of the database backends in order
+** to generate random integer keys for tables or random filenames.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+
+/* All threads share a single random number generator.
+** This structure is the current state of the generator.
+*/
+static SQLITE_WSD struct sqlite3PrngType {
+ unsigned char isInit; /* True if initialized */
+ unsigned char i, j; /* State variables */
+ unsigned char s[256]; /* State variables */
+} sqlite3Prng;
+
+/*
+** Return N random bytes.
+*/
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_randomness(int N, void *pBuf){
+ unsigned char t;
+ unsigned char *zBuf = pBuf;
+
+ /* The "wsdPrng" macro will resolve to the pseudo-random number generator
+ ** state vector. If writable static data is unsupported on the target,
+ ** we have to locate the state vector at run-time. In the more common
+ ** case where writable static data is supported, wsdPrng can refer directly
+ ** to the "sqlite3Prng" state vector declared above.
+ */
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_WSD
+ struct sqlite3PrngType *p = &GLOBAL(struct sqlite3PrngType, sqlite3Prng);
+# define wsdPrng p[0]
+#else
+# define wsdPrng sqlite3Prng
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+ sqlite3_mutex *mutex;
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return;
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+ mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PRNG);
+#endif
+
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(mutex);
+ if( N<=0 || pBuf==0 ){
+ wsdPrng.isInit = 0;
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutex);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* Initialize the state of the random number generator once,
+ ** the first time this routine is called. The seed value does
+ ** not need to contain a lot of randomness since we are not
+ ** trying to do secure encryption or anything like that...
+ **
+ ** Nothing in this file or anywhere else in SQLite does any kind of
+ ** encryption. The RC4 algorithm is being used as a PRNG (pseudo-random
+ ** number generator) not as an encryption device.
+ */
+ if( !wsdPrng.isInit ){
+ int i;
+ char k[256];
+ wsdPrng.j = 0;
+ wsdPrng.i = 0;
+ sqlite3OsRandomness(sqlite3_vfs_find(0), 256, k);
+ for(i=0; i<256; i++){
+ wsdPrng.s[i] = (u8)i;
+ }
+ for(i=0; i<256; i++){
+ wsdPrng.j += wsdPrng.s[i] + k[i];
+ t = wsdPrng.s[wsdPrng.j];
+ wsdPrng.s[wsdPrng.j] = wsdPrng.s[i];
+ wsdPrng.s[i] = t;
+ }
+ wsdPrng.isInit = 1;
+ }
+
+ assert( N>0 );
+ do{
+ wsdPrng.i++;
+ t = wsdPrng.s[wsdPrng.i];
+ wsdPrng.j += t;
+ wsdPrng.s[wsdPrng.i] = wsdPrng.s[wsdPrng.j];
+ wsdPrng.s[wsdPrng.j] = t;
+ t += wsdPrng.s[wsdPrng.i];
+ *(zBuf++) = wsdPrng.s[t];
+ }while( --N );
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(mutex);
+}
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+/*
+** For testing purposes, we sometimes want to preserve the state of
+** PRNG and restore the PRNG to its saved state at a later time, or
+** to reset the PRNG to its initial state. These routines accomplish
+** those tasks.
+**
+** The sqlite3_test_control() interface calls these routines to
+** control the PRNG.
+*/
+static SQLITE_WSD struct sqlite3PrngType sqlite3SavedPrng;
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PrngSaveState(void){
+ memcpy(
+ &GLOBAL(struct sqlite3PrngType, sqlite3SavedPrng),
+ &GLOBAL(struct sqlite3PrngType, sqlite3Prng),
+ sizeof(sqlite3Prng)
+ );
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PrngRestoreState(void){
+ memcpy(
+ &GLOBAL(struct sqlite3PrngType, sqlite3Prng),
+ &GLOBAL(struct sqlite3PrngType, sqlite3SavedPrng),
+ sizeof(sqlite3Prng)
+ );
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_UNTESTABLE */
+
+/************** End of random.c **********************************************/
+/************** Begin file threads.c *****************************************/
+/*
+** 2012 July 21
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file presents a simple cross-platform threading interface for
+** use internally by SQLite.
+**
+** A "thread" can be created using sqlite3ThreadCreate(). This thread
+** runs independently of its creator until it is joined using
+** sqlite3ThreadJoin(), at which point it terminates.
+**
+** Threads do not have to be real. It could be that the work of the
+** "thread" is done by the main thread at either the sqlite3ThreadCreate()
+** or sqlite3ThreadJoin() call. This is, in fact, what happens in
+** single threaded systems. Nothing in SQLite requires multiple threads.
+** This interface exists so that applications that want to take advantage
+** of multiple cores can do so, while also allowing applications to stay
+** single-threaded if desired.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+#if SQLITE_OS_WIN
+/* # include "os_win.h" */
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS>0
+
+/********************************* Unix Pthreads ****************************/
+#if SQLITE_OS_UNIX && defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS) && SQLITE_THREADSAFE>0
+
+#define SQLITE_THREADS_IMPLEMENTED 1 /* Prevent the single-thread code below */
+/* #include */
+
+/* A running thread */
+struct SQLiteThread {
+ pthread_t tid; /* Thread ID */
+ int done; /* Set to true when thread finishes */
+ void *pOut; /* Result returned by the thread */
+ void *(*xTask)(void*); /* The thread routine */
+ void *pIn; /* Argument to the thread */
+};
+
+/* Create a new thread */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ThreadCreate(
+ SQLiteThread **ppThread, /* OUT: Write the thread object here */
+ void *(*xTask)(void*), /* Routine to run in a separate thread */
+ void *pIn /* Argument passed into xTask() */
+){
+ SQLiteThread *p;
+ int rc;
+
+ assert( ppThread!=0 );
+ assert( xTask!=0 );
+ /* This routine is never used in single-threaded mode */
+ assert( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex!=0 );
+
+ *ppThread = 0;
+ p = sqlite3Malloc(sizeof(*p));
+ if( p==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ memset(p, 0, sizeof(*p));
+ p->xTask = xTask;
+ p->pIn = pIn;
+ /* If the SQLITE_TESTCTRL_FAULT_INSTALL callback is registered to a
+ ** function that returns SQLITE_ERROR when passed the argument 200, that
+ ** forces worker threads to run sequentially and deterministically
+ ** for testing purposes. */
+ if( sqlite3FaultSim(200) ){
+ rc = 1;
+ }else{
+ rc = pthread_create(&p->tid, 0, xTask, pIn);
+ }
+ if( rc ){
+ p->done = 1;
+ p->pOut = xTask(pIn);
+ }
+ *ppThread = p;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/* Get the results of the thread */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ThreadJoin(SQLiteThread *p, void **ppOut){
+ int rc;
+
+ assert( ppOut!=0 );
+ if( NEVER(p==0) ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ if( p->done ){
+ *ppOut = p->pOut;
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ rc = pthread_join(p->tid, ppOut) ? SQLITE_ERROR : SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_OS_UNIX && defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS) */
+/******************************** End Unix Pthreads *************************/
+
+
+/********************************* Win32 Threads ****************************/
+#if SQLITE_OS_WIN_THREADS
+
+#define SQLITE_THREADS_IMPLEMENTED 1 /* Prevent the single-thread code below */
+#include
+
+/* A running thread */
+struct SQLiteThread {
+ void *tid; /* The thread handle */
+ unsigned id; /* The thread identifier */
+ void *(*xTask)(void*); /* The routine to run as a thread */
+ void *pIn; /* Argument to xTask */
+ void *pResult; /* Result of xTask */
+};
+
+/* Thread procedure Win32 compatibility shim */
+static unsigned __stdcall sqlite3ThreadProc(
+ void *pArg /* IN: Pointer to the SQLiteThread structure */
+){
+ SQLiteThread *p = (SQLiteThread *)pArg;
+
+ assert( p!=0 );
+#if 0
+ /*
+ ** This assert appears to trigger spuriously on certain
+ ** versions of Windows, possibly due to _beginthreadex()
+ ** and/or CreateThread() not fully setting their thread
+ ** ID parameter before starting the thread.
+ */
+ assert( p->id==GetCurrentThreadId() );
+#endif
+ assert( p->xTask!=0 );
+ p->pResult = p->xTask(p->pIn);
+
+ _endthreadex(0);
+ return 0; /* NOT REACHED */
+}
+
+/* Create a new thread */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ThreadCreate(
+ SQLiteThread **ppThread, /* OUT: Write the thread object here */
+ void *(*xTask)(void*), /* Routine to run in a separate thread */
+ void *pIn /* Argument passed into xTask() */
+){
+ SQLiteThread *p;
+
+ assert( ppThread!=0 );
+ assert( xTask!=0 );
+ *ppThread = 0;
+ p = sqlite3Malloc(sizeof(*p));
+ if( p==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ /* If the SQLITE_TESTCTRL_FAULT_INSTALL callback is registered to a
+ ** function that returns SQLITE_ERROR when passed the argument 200, that
+ ** forces worker threads to run sequentially and deterministically
+ ** (via the sqlite3FaultSim() term of the conditional) for testing
+ ** purposes. */
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex==0 || sqlite3FaultSim(200) ){
+ memset(p, 0, sizeof(*p));
+ }else{
+ p->xTask = xTask;
+ p->pIn = pIn;
+ p->tid = (void*)_beginthreadex(0, 0, sqlite3ThreadProc, p, 0, &p->id);
+ if( p->tid==0 ){
+ memset(p, 0, sizeof(*p));
+ }
+ }
+ if( p->xTask==0 ){
+ p->id = GetCurrentThreadId();
+ p->pResult = xTask(pIn);
+ }
+ *ppThread = p;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE DWORD sqlite3Win32Wait(HANDLE hObject); /* os_win.c */
+
+/* Get the results of the thread */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ThreadJoin(SQLiteThread *p, void **ppOut){
+ DWORD rc;
+ BOOL bRc;
+
+ assert( ppOut!=0 );
+ if( NEVER(p==0) ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ if( p->xTask==0 ){
+ /* assert( p->id==GetCurrentThreadId() ); */
+ rc = WAIT_OBJECT_0;
+ assert( p->tid==0 );
+ }else{
+ assert( p->id!=0 && p->id!=GetCurrentThreadId() );
+ rc = sqlite3Win32Wait((HANDLE)p->tid);
+ assert( rc!=WAIT_IO_COMPLETION );
+ bRc = CloseHandle((HANDLE)p->tid);
+ assert( bRc );
+ }
+ if( rc==WAIT_OBJECT_0 ) *ppOut = p->pResult;
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ return (rc==WAIT_OBJECT_0) ? SQLITE_OK : SQLITE_ERROR;
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_OS_WIN_THREADS */
+/******************************** End Win32 Threads *************************/
+
+
+/********************************* Single-Threaded **************************/
+#ifndef SQLITE_THREADS_IMPLEMENTED
+/*
+** This implementation does not actually create a new thread. It does the
+** work of the thread in the main thread, when either the thread is created
+** or when it is joined
+*/
+
+/* A running thread */
+struct SQLiteThread {
+ void *(*xTask)(void*); /* The routine to run as a thread */
+ void *pIn; /* Argument to xTask */
+ void *pResult; /* Result of xTask */
+};
+
+/* Create a new thread */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ThreadCreate(
+ SQLiteThread **ppThread, /* OUT: Write the thread object here */
+ void *(*xTask)(void*), /* Routine to run in a separate thread */
+ void *pIn /* Argument passed into xTask() */
+){
+ SQLiteThread *p;
+
+ assert( ppThread!=0 );
+ assert( xTask!=0 );
+ *ppThread = 0;
+ p = sqlite3Malloc(sizeof(*p));
+ if( p==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ if( (SQLITE_PTR_TO_INT(p)/17)&1 ){
+ p->xTask = xTask;
+ p->pIn = pIn;
+ }else{
+ p->xTask = 0;
+ p->pResult = xTask(pIn);
+ }
+ *ppThread = p;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/* Get the results of the thread */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ThreadJoin(SQLiteThread *p, void **ppOut){
+
+ assert( ppOut!=0 );
+ if( NEVER(p==0) ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ if( p->xTask ){
+ *ppOut = p->xTask(p->pIn);
+ }else{
+ *ppOut = p->pResult;
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+ {
+ void *pTstAlloc = sqlite3Malloc(10);
+ if (!pTstAlloc) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ sqlite3_free(pTstAlloc);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_THREADS_IMPLEMENTED) */
+/****************************** End Single-Threaded *************************/
+#endif /* SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS>0 */
+
+/************** End of threads.c *********************************************/
+/************** Begin file utf.c *********************************************/
+/*
+** 2004 April 13
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This file contains routines used to translate between UTF-8,
+** UTF-16, UTF-16BE, and UTF-16LE.
+**
+** Notes on UTF-8:
+**
+** Byte-0 Byte-1 Byte-2 Byte-3 Value
+** 0xxxxxxx 00000000 00000000 0xxxxxxx
+** 110yyyyy 10xxxxxx 00000000 00000yyy yyxxxxxx
+** 1110zzzz 10yyyyyy 10xxxxxx 00000000 zzzzyyyy yyxxxxxx
+** 11110uuu 10uuzzzz 10yyyyyy 10xxxxxx 000uuuuu zzzzyyyy yyxxxxxx
+**
+**
+** Notes on UTF-16: (with wwww+1==uuuuu)
+**
+** Word-0 Word-1 Value
+** 110110ww wwzzzzyy 110111yy yyxxxxxx 000uuuuu zzzzyyyy yyxxxxxx
+** zzzzyyyy yyxxxxxx 00000000 zzzzyyyy yyxxxxxx
+**
+**
+** BOM or Byte Order Mark:
+** 0xff 0xfe little-endian utf-16 follows
+** 0xfe 0xff big-endian utf-16 follows
+**
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+/* #include */
+/* #include "vdbeInt.h" */
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_AMALGAMATION) && SQLITE_BYTEORDER==0
+/*
+** The following constant value is used by the SQLITE_BIGENDIAN and
+** SQLITE_LITTLEENDIAN macros.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const int sqlite3one = 1;
+#endif /* SQLITE_AMALGAMATION && SQLITE_BYTEORDER==0 */
+
+/*
+** This lookup table is used to help decode the first byte of
+** a multi-byte UTF8 character.
+*/
+static const unsigned char sqlite3Utf8Trans1[] = {
+ 0x00, 0x01, 0x02, 0x03, 0x04, 0x05, 0x06, 0x07,
+ 0x08, 0x09, 0x0a, 0x0b, 0x0c, 0x0d, 0x0e, 0x0f,
+ 0x10, 0x11, 0x12, 0x13, 0x14, 0x15, 0x16, 0x17,
+ 0x18, 0x19, 0x1a, 0x1b, 0x1c, 0x1d, 0x1e, 0x1f,
+ 0x00, 0x01, 0x02, 0x03, 0x04, 0x05, 0x06, 0x07,
+ 0x08, 0x09, 0x0a, 0x0b, 0x0c, 0x0d, 0x0e, 0x0f,
+ 0x00, 0x01, 0x02, 0x03, 0x04, 0x05, 0x06, 0x07,
+ 0x00, 0x01, 0x02, 0x03, 0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x00,
+};
+
+
+#define WRITE_UTF8(zOut, c) { \
+ if( c<0x00080 ){ \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(c&0xFF); \
+ } \
+ else if( c<0x00800 ){ \
+ *zOut++ = 0xC0 + (u8)((c>>6)&0x1F); \
+ *zOut++ = 0x80 + (u8)(c & 0x3F); \
+ } \
+ else if( c<0x10000 ){ \
+ *zOut++ = 0xE0 + (u8)((c>>12)&0x0F); \
+ *zOut++ = 0x80 + (u8)((c>>6) & 0x3F); \
+ *zOut++ = 0x80 + (u8)(c & 0x3F); \
+ }else{ \
+ *zOut++ = 0xF0 + (u8)((c>>18) & 0x07); \
+ *zOut++ = 0x80 + (u8)((c>>12) & 0x3F); \
+ *zOut++ = 0x80 + (u8)((c>>6) & 0x3F); \
+ *zOut++ = 0x80 + (u8)(c & 0x3F); \
+ } \
+}
+
+#define WRITE_UTF16LE(zOut, c) { \
+ if( c<=0xFFFF ){ \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(c&0x00FF); \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)((c>>8)&0x00FF); \
+ }else{ \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(((c>>10)&0x003F) + (((c-0x10000)>>10)&0x00C0)); \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(0x00D8 + (((c-0x10000)>>18)&0x03)); \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(c&0x00FF); \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(0x00DC + ((c>>8)&0x03)); \
+ } \
+}
+
+#define WRITE_UTF16BE(zOut, c) { \
+ if( c<=0xFFFF ){ \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)((c>>8)&0x00FF); \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(c&0x00FF); \
+ }else{ \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(0x00D8 + (((c-0x10000)>>18)&0x03)); \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(((c>>10)&0x003F) + (((c-0x10000)>>10)&0x00C0)); \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(0x00DC + ((c>>8)&0x03)); \
+ *zOut++ = (u8)(c&0x00FF); \
+ } \
+}
+
+/*
+** Translate a single UTF-8 character. Return the unicode value.
+**
+** During translation, assume that the byte that zTerm points
+** is a 0x00.
+**
+** Write a pointer to the next unread byte back into *pzNext.
+**
+** Notes On Invalid UTF-8:
+**
+** * This routine never allows a 7-bit character (0x00 through 0x7f) to
+** be encoded as a multi-byte character. Any multi-byte character that
+** attempts to encode a value between 0x00 and 0x7f is rendered as 0xfffd.
+**
+** * This routine never allows a UTF16 surrogate value to be encoded.
+** If a multi-byte character attempts to encode a value between
+** 0xd800 and 0xe000 then it is rendered as 0xfffd.
+**
+** * Bytes in the range of 0x80 through 0xbf which occur as the first
+** byte of a character are interpreted as single-byte characters
+** and rendered as themselves even though they are technically
+** invalid characters.
+**
+** * This routine accepts over-length UTF8 encodings
+** for unicode values 0x80 and greater. It does not change over-length
+** encodings to 0xfffd as some systems recommend.
+*/
+#define READ_UTF8(zIn, zTerm, c) \
+ c = *(zIn++); \
+ if( c>=0xc0 ){ \
+ c = sqlite3Utf8Trans1[c-0xc0]; \
+ while( zIn!=zTerm && (*zIn & 0xc0)==0x80 ){ \
+ c = (c<<6) + (0x3f & *(zIn++)); \
+ } \
+ if( c<0x80 \
+ || (c&0xFFFFF800)==0xD800 \
+ || (c&0xFFFFFFFE)==0xFFFE ){ c = 0xFFFD; } \
+ }
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3Utf8Read(
+ const unsigned char **pz /* Pointer to string from which to read char */
+){
+ unsigned int c;
+
+ /* Same as READ_UTF8() above but without the zTerm parameter.
+ ** For this routine, we assume the UTF8 string is always zero-terminated.
+ */
+ c = *((*pz)++);
+ if( c>=0xc0 ){
+ c = sqlite3Utf8Trans1[c-0xc0];
+ while( (*(*pz) & 0xc0)==0x80 ){
+ c = (c<<6) + (0x3f & *((*pz)++));
+ }
+ if( c<0x80
+ || (c&0xFFFFF800)==0xD800
+ || (c&0xFFFFFFFE)==0xFFFE ){ c = 0xFFFD; }
+ }
+ return c;
+}
+
+
+
+
+/*
+** If the TRANSLATE_TRACE macro is defined, the value of each Mem is
+** printed on stderr on the way into and out of sqlite3VdbeMemTranslate().
+*/
+/* #define TRANSLATE_TRACE 1 */
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_UTF16
+/*
+** This routine transforms the internal text encoding used by pMem to
+** desiredEnc. It is an error if the string is already of the desired
+** encoding, or if *pMem does not contain a string value.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE SQLITE_NOINLINE int sqlite3VdbeMemTranslate(Mem *pMem, u8 desiredEnc){
+ sqlite3_int64 len; /* Maximum length of output string in bytes */
+ unsigned char *zOut; /* Output buffer */
+ unsigned char *zIn; /* Input iterator */
+ unsigned char *zTerm; /* End of input */
+ unsigned char *z; /* Output iterator */
+ unsigned int c;
+
+ assert( pMem->db==0 || sqlite3_mutex_held(pMem->db->mutex) );
+ assert( pMem->flags&MEM_Str );
+ assert( pMem->enc!=desiredEnc );
+ assert( pMem->enc!=0 );
+ assert( pMem->n>=0 );
+
+#if defined(TRANSLATE_TRACE) && defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+ {
+ StrAccum acc;
+ char zBuf[1000];
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&acc, 0, zBuf, sizeof(zBuf), 0);
+ sqlite3VdbeMemPrettyPrint(pMem, &acc);
+ fprintf(stderr, "INPUT: %s\n", sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&acc));
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* If the translation is between UTF-16 little and big endian, then
+ ** all that is required is to swap the byte order. This case is handled
+ ** differently from the others.
+ */
+ if( pMem->enc!=SQLITE_UTF8 && desiredEnc!=SQLITE_UTF8 ){
+ u8 temp;
+ int rc;
+ rc = sqlite3VdbeMemMakeWriteable(pMem);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ assert( rc==SQLITE_NOMEM );
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ zIn = (u8*)pMem->z;
+ zTerm = &zIn[pMem->n&~1];
+ while( zInenc = desiredEnc;
+ goto translate_out;
+ }
+
+ /* Set len to the maximum number of bytes required in the output buffer. */
+ if( desiredEnc==SQLITE_UTF8 ){
+ /* When converting from UTF-16, the maximum growth results from
+ ** translating a 2-byte character to a 4-byte UTF-8 character.
+ ** A single byte is required for the output string
+ ** nul-terminator.
+ */
+ pMem->n &= ~1;
+ len = 2 * (sqlite3_int64)pMem->n + 1;
+ }else{
+ /* When converting from UTF-8 to UTF-16 the maximum growth is caused
+ ** when a 1-byte UTF-8 character is translated into a 2-byte UTF-16
+ ** character. Two bytes are required in the output buffer for the
+ ** nul-terminator.
+ */
+ len = 2 * (sqlite3_int64)pMem->n + 2;
+ }
+
+ /* Set zIn to point at the start of the input buffer and zTerm to point 1
+ ** byte past the end.
+ **
+ ** Variable zOut is set to point at the output buffer, space obtained
+ ** from sqlite3_malloc().
+ */
+ zIn = (u8*)pMem->z;
+ zTerm = &zIn[pMem->n];
+ zOut = sqlite3DbMallocRaw(pMem->db, len);
+ if( !zOut ){
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ z = zOut;
+
+ if( pMem->enc==SQLITE_UTF8 ){
+ if( desiredEnc==SQLITE_UTF16LE ){
+ /* UTF-8 -> UTF-16 Little-endian */
+ while( zIn UTF-16 Big-endian */
+ while( zInn = (int)(z - zOut);
+ *z++ = 0;
+ }else{
+ assert( desiredEnc==SQLITE_UTF8 );
+ if( pMem->enc==SQLITE_UTF16LE ){
+ /* UTF-16 Little-endian -> UTF-8 */
+ while( zIn=0xd800 && c<0xe000 ){
+#ifdef SQLITE_REPLACE_INVALID_UTF
+ if( c>=0xdc00 || zIn>=zTerm ){
+ c = 0xfffd;
+ }else{
+ int c2 = *(zIn++);
+ c2 += (*(zIn++))<<8;
+ if( c2<0xdc00 || c2>=0xe000 ){
+ zIn -= 2;
+ c = 0xfffd;
+ }else{
+ c = ((c&0x3ff)<<10) + (c2&0x3ff) + 0x10000;
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ if( zIn UTF-8 */
+ while( zIn=0xd800 && c<0xe000 ){
+#ifdef SQLITE_REPLACE_INVALID_UTF
+ if( c>=0xdc00 || zIn>=zTerm ){
+ c = 0xfffd;
+ }else{
+ int c2 = (*(zIn++))<<8;
+ c2 += *(zIn++);
+ if( c2<0xdc00 || c2>=0xe000 ){
+ zIn -= 2;
+ c = 0xfffd;
+ }else{
+ c = ((c&0x3ff)<<10) + (c2&0x3ff) + 0x10000;
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ if( zInn = (int)(z - zOut);
+ }
+ *z = 0;
+ assert( (pMem->n+(desiredEnc==SQLITE_UTF8?1:2))<=len );
+
+ c = MEM_Str|MEM_Term|(pMem->flags&(MEM_AffMask|MEM_Subtype));
+ sqlite3VdbeMemRelease(pMem);
+ pMem->flags = c;
+ pMem->enc = desiredEnc;
+ pMem->z = (char*)zOut;
+ pMem->zMalloc = pMem->z;
+ pMem->szMalloc = sqlite3DbMallocSize(pMem->db, pMem->z);
+
+translate_out:
+#if defined(TRANSLATE_TRACE) && defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+ {
+ StrAccum acc;
+ char zBuf[1000];
+ sqlite3StrAccumInit(&acc, 0, zBuf, sizeof(zBuf), 0);
+ sqlite3VdbeMemPrettyPrint(pMem, &acc);
+ fprintf(stderr, "OUTPUT: %s\n", sqlite3StrAccumFinish(&acc));
+ }
+#endif
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_UTF16 */
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_UTF16
+/*
+** This routine checks for a byte-order mark at the beginning of the
+** UTF-16 string stored in *pMem. If one is present, it is removed and
+** the encoding of the Mem adjusted. This routine does not do any
+** byte-swapping, it just sets Mem.enc appropriately.
+**
+** The allocation (static, dynamic etc.) and encoding of the Mem may be
+** changed by this function.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMemHandleBom(Mem *pMem){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ u8 bom = 0;
+
+ assert( pMem->n>=0 );
+ if( pMem->n>1 ){
+ u8 b1 = *(u8 *)pMem->z;
+ u8 b2 = *(((u8 *)pMem->z) + 1);
+ if( b1==0xFE && b2==0xFF ){
+ bom = SQLITE_UTF16BE;
+ }
+ if( b1==0xFF && b2==0xFE ){
+ bom = SQLITE_UTF16LE;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if( bom ){
+ rc = sqlite3VdbeMemMakeWriteable(pMem);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pMem->n -= 2;
+ memmove(pMem->z, &pMem->z[2], pMem->n);
+ pMem->z[pMem->n] = '\0';
+ pMem->z[pMem->n+1] = '\0';
+ pMem->flags |= MEM_Term;
+ pMem->enc = bom;
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_UTF16 */
+
+/*
+** pZ is a UTF-8 encoded unicode string. If nByte is less than zero,
+** return the number of unicode characters in pZ up to (but not including)
+** the first 0x00 byte. If nByte is not less than zero, return the
+** number of unicode characters in the first nByte of pZ (or up to
+** the first 0x00, whichever comes first).
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Utf8CharLen(const char *zIn, int nByte){
+ int r = 0;
+ const u8 *z = (const u8*)zIn;
+ const u8 *zTerm;
+ if( nByte>=0 ){
+ zTerm = &z[nByte];
+ }else{
+ zTerm = (const u8*)(-1);
+ }
+ assert( z<=zTerm );
+ while( *z!=0 && zmallocFailed ){
+ sqlite3VdbeMemRelease(&m);
+ m.z = 0;
+ }
+ assert( (m.flags & MEM_Term)!=0 || db->mallocFailed );
+ assert( (m.flags & MEM_Str)!=0 || db->mallocFailed );
+ assert( m.z || db->mallocFailed );
+ return m.z;
+}
+
+/*
+** zIn is a UTF-16 encoded unicode string at least nChar characters long.
+** Return the number of bytes in the first nChar unicode characters
+** in pZ. nChar must be non-negative.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Utf16ByteLen(const void *zIn, int nChar){
+ int c;
+ unsigned char const *z = zIn;
+ int n = 0;
+
+ if( SQLITE_UTF16NATIVE==SQLITE_UTF16LE ) z++;
+ while( n=0xd8 && c<0xdc && z[0]>=0xdc && z[0]<0xe0 ) z += 2;
+ n++;
+ }
+ return (int)(z-(unsigned char const *)zIn)
+ - (SQLITE_UTF16NATIVE==SQLITE_UTF16LE);
+}
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+/*
+** This routine is called from the TCL test function "translate_selftest".
+** It checks that the primitives for serializing and deserializing
+** characters in each encoding are inverses of each other.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3UtfSelfTest(void){
+ unsigned int i, t;
+ unsigned char zBuf[20];
+ unsigned char *z;
+ int n;
+ unsigned int c;
+
+ for(i=0; i<0x00110000; i++){
+ z = zBuf;
+ WRITE_UTF8(z, i);
+ n = (int)(z-zBuf);
+ assert( n>0 && n<=4 );
+ z[0] = 0;
+ z = zBuf;
+ c = sqlite3Utf8Read((const u8**)&z);
+ t = i;
+ if( i>=0xD800 && i<=0xDFFF ) t = 0xFFFD;
+ if( (i&0xFFFFFFFE)==0xFFFE ) t = 0xFFFD;
+ assert( c==t );
+ assert( (z-zBuf)==n );
+ }
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_TEST */
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_UTF16 */
+
+/************** End of utf.c *************************************************/
+/************** Begin file util.c ********************************************/
+/*
+** 2001 September 15
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** Utility functions used throughout sqlite.
+**
+** This file contains functions for allocating memory, comparing
+** strings, and stuff like that.
+**
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+/* #include */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+#include
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Routine needed to support the testcase() macro.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_COVERAGE_TEST
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Coverage(int x){
+ static unsigned dummy = 0;
+ dummy += (unsigned)x;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Calls to sqlite3FaultSim() are used to simulate a failure during testing,
+** or to bypass normal error detection during testing in order to let
+** execute proceed futher downstream.
+**
+** In deployment, sqlite3FaultSim() *always* return SQLITE_OK (0). The
+** sqlite3FaultSim() function only returns non-zero during testing.
+**
+** During testing, if the test harness has set a fault-sim callback using
+** a call to sqlite3_test_control(SQLITE_TESTCTRL_FAULT_INSTALL), then
+** each call to sqlite3FaultSim() is relayed to that application-supplied
+** callback and the integer return value form the application-supplied
+** callback is returned by sqlite3FaultSim().
+**
+** The integer argument to sqlite3FaultSim() is a code to identify which
+** sqlite3FaultSim() instance is being invoked. Each call to sqlite3FaultSim()
+** should have a unique code. To prevent legacy testing applications from
+** breaking, the codes should not be changed or reused.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3FaultSim(int iTest){
+ int (*xCallback)(int) = sqlite3GlobalConfig.xTestCallback;
+ return xCallback ? xCallback(iTest) : SQLITE_OK;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+/*
+** Return true if the floating point value is Not a Number (NaN).
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3IsNaN(double x){
+ u64 y;
+ memcpy(&y,&x,sizeof(y));
+ return IsNaN(y);
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT */
+
+/*
+** Compute a string length that is limited to what can be stored in
+** lower 30 bits of a 32-bit signed integer.
+**
+** The value returned will never be negative. Nor will it ever be greater
+** than the actual length of the string. For very long strings (greater
+** than 1GiB) the value returned might be less than the true string length.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Strlen30(const char *z){
+ if( z==0 ) return 0;
+ return 0x3fffffff & (int)strlen(z);
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the declared type of a column. Or return zDflt if the column
+** has no declared type.
+**
+** The column type is an extra string stored after the zero-terminator on
+** the column name if and only if the COLFLAG_HASTYPE flag is set.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3ColumnType(Column *pCol, char *zDflt){
+ if( (pCol->colFlags & COLFLAG_HASTYPE)==0 ) return zDflt;
+ return pCol->zName + strlen(pCol->zName) + 1;
+}
+
+/*
+** Helper function for sqlite3Error() - called rarely. Broken out into
+** a separate routine to avoid unnecessary register saves on entry to
+** sqlite3Error().
+*/
+static SQLITE_NOINLINE void sqlite3ErrorFinish(sqlite3 *db, int err_code){
+ if( db->pErr ) sqlite3ValueSetNull(db->pErr);
+ sqlite3SystemError(db, err_code);
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the current error code to err_code and clear any prior error message.
+** Also set iSysErrno (by calling sqlite3System) if the err_code indicates
+** that would be appropriate.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Error(sqlite3 *db, int err_code){
+ assert( db!=0 );
+ db->errCode = err_code;
+ if( err_code || db->pErr ) sqlite3ErrorFinish(db, err_code);
+}
+
+/*
+** Load the sqlite3.iSysErrno field if that is an appropriate thing
+** to do based on the SQLite error code in rc.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3SystemError(sqlite3 *db, int rc){
+ if( rc==SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM ) return;
+ rc &= 0xff;
+ if( rc==SQLITE_CANTOPEN || rc==SQLITE_IOERR ){
+ db->iSysErrno = sqlite3OsGetLastError(db->pVfs);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the most recent error code and error string for the sqlite
+** handle "db". The error code is set to "err_code".
+**
+** If it is not NULL, string zFormat specifies the format of the
+** error string in the style of the printf functions: The following
+** format characters are allowed:
+**
+** %s Insert a string
+** %z A string that should be freed after use
+** %d Insert an integer
+** %T Insert a token
+** %S Insert the first element of a SrcList
+**
+** zFormat and any string tokens that follow it are assumed to be
+** encoded in UTF-8.
+**
+** To clear the most recent error for sqlite handle "db", sqlite3Error
+** should be called with err_code set to SQLITE_OK and zFormat set
+** to NULL.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ErrorWithMsg(sqlite3 *db, int err_code, const char *zFormat, ...){
+ assert( db!=0 );
+ db->errCode = err_code;
+ sqlite3SystemError(db, err_code);
+ if( zFormat==0 ){
+ sqlite3Error(db, err_code);
+ }else if( db->pErr || (db->pErr = sqlite3ValueNew(db))!=0 ){
+ char *z;
+ va_list ap;
+ va_start(ap, zFormat);
+ z = sqlite3VMPrintf(db, zFormat, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ sqlite3ValueSetStr(db->pErr, -1, z, SQLITE_UTF8, SQLITE_DYNAMIC);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Add an error message to pParse->zErrMsg and increment pParse->nErr.
+** The following formatting characters are allowed:
+**
+** %s Insert a string
+** %z A string that should be freed after use
+** %d Insert an integer
+** %T Insert a token
+** %S Insert the first element of a SrcList
+**
+** This function should be used to report any error that occurs while
+** compiling an SQL statement (i.e. within sqlite3_prepare()). The
+** last thing the sqlite3_prepare() function does is copy the error
+** stored by this function into the database handle using sqlite3Error().
+** Functions sqlite3Error() or sqlite3ErrorWithMsg() should be used
+** during statement execution (sqlite3_step() etc.).
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3ErrorMsg(Parse *pParse, const char *zFormat, ...){
+ char *zMsg;
+ va_list ap;
+ sqlite3 *db = pParse->db;
+ va_start(ap, zFormat);
+ zMsg = sqlite3VMPrintf(db, zFormat, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ if( db->suppressErr ){
+ sqlite3DbFree(db, zMsg);
+ }else{
+ pParse->nErr++;
+ sqlite3DbFree(db, pParse->zErrMsg);
+ pParse->zErrMsg = zMsg;
+ pParse->rc = SQLITE_ERROR;
+ pParse->pWith = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** If database connection db is currently parsing SQL, then transfer
+** error code errCode to that parser if the parser has not already
+** encountered some other kind of error.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3ErrorToParser(sqlite3 *db, int errCode){
+ Parse *pParse;
+ if( db==0 || (pParse = db->pParse)==0 ) return errCode;
+ pParse->rc = errCode;
+ pParse->nErr++;
+ return errCode;
+}
+
+/*
+** Convert an SQL-style quoted string into a normal string by removing
+** the quote characters. The conversion is done in-place. If the
+** input does not begin with a quote character, then this routine
+** is a no-op.
+**
+** The input string must be zero-terminated. A new zero-terminator
+** is added to the dequoted string.
+**
+** The return value is -1 if no dequoting occurs or the length of the
+** dequoted string, exclusive of the zero terminator, if dequoting does
+** occur.
+**
+** 2002-02-14: This routine is extended to remove MS-Access style
+** brackets from around identifiers. For example: "[a-b-c]" becomes
+** "a-b-c".
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Dequote(char *z){
+ char quote;
+ int i, j;
+ if( z==0 ) return;
+ quote = z[0];
+ if( !sqlite3Isquote(quote) ) return;
+ if( quote=='[' ) quote = ']';
+ for(i=1, j=0;; i++){
+ assert( z[i] );
+ if( z[i]==quote ){
+ if( z[i+1]==quote ){
+ z[j++] = quote;
+ i++;
+ }else{
+ break;
+ }
+ }else{
+ z[j++] = z[i];
+ }
+ }
+ z[j] = 0;
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3DequoteExpr(Expr *p){
+ assert( sqlite3Isquote(p->u.zToken[0]) );
+ p->flags |= p->u.zToken[0]=='"' ? EP_Quoted|EP_DblQuoted : EP_Quoted;
+ sqlite3Dequote(p->u.zToken);
+}
+
+/*
+** Generate a Token object from a string
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3TokenInit(Token *p, char *z){
+ p->z = z;
+ p->n = sqlite3Strlen30(z);
+}
+
+/* Convenient short-hand */
+#define UpperToLower sqlite3UpperToLower
+
+/*
+** Some systems have stricmp(). Others have strcasecmp(). Because
+** there is no consistency, we will define our own.
+**
+** IMPLEMENTATION-OF: R-30243-02494 The sqlite3_stricmp() and
+** sqlite3_strnicmp() APIs allow applications and extensions to compare
+** the contents of two buffers containing UTF-8 strings in a
+** case-independent fashion, using the same definition of "case
+** independence" that SQLite uses internally when comparing identifiers.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_stricmp(const char *zLeft, const char *zRight){
+ if( zLeft==0 ){
+ return zRight ? -1 : 0;
+ }else if( zRight==0 ){
+ return 1;
+ }
+ return sqlite3StrICmp(zLeft, zRight);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3StrICmp(const char *zLeft, const char *zRight){
+ unsigned char *a, *b;
+ int c, x;
+ a = (unsigned char *)zLeft;
+ b = (unsigned char *)zRight;
+ for(;;){
+ c = *a;
+ x = *b;
+ if( c==x ){
+ if( c==0 ) break;
+ }else{
+ c = (int)UpperToLower[c] - (int)UpperToLower[x];
+ if( c ) break;
+ }
+ a++;
+ b++;
+ }
+ return c;
+}
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_strnicmp(const char *zLeft, const char *zRight, int N){
+ register unsigned char *a, *b;
+ if( zLeft==0 ){
+ return zRight ? -1 : 0;
+ }else if( zRight==0 ){
+ return 1;
+ }
+ a = (unsigned char *)zLeft;
+ b = (unsigned char *)zRight;
+ while( N-- > 0 && *a!=0 && UpperToLower[*a]==UpperToLower[*b]){ a++; b++; }
+ return N<0 ? 0 : UpperToLower[*a] - UpperToLower[*b];
+}
+
+/*
+** Compute an 8-bit hash on a string that is insensitive to case differences
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3StrIHash(const char *z){
+ u8 h = 0;
+ if( z==0 ) return 0;
+ while( z[0] ){
+ h += UpperToLower[(unsigned char)z[0]];
+ z++;
+ }
+ return h;
+}
+
+/*
+** Compute 10 to the E-th power. Examples: E==1 results in 10.
+** E==2 results in 100. E==50 results in 1.0e50.
+**
+** This routine only works for values of E between 1 and 341.
+*/
+static LONGDOUBLE_TYPE sqlite3Pow10(int E){
+#if defined(_MSC_VER)
+ static const LONGDOUBLE_TYPE x[] = {
+ 1.0e+001L,
+ 1.0e+002L,
+ 1.0e+004L,
+ 1.0e+008L,
+ 1.0e+016L,
+ 1.0e+032L,
+ 1.0e+064L,
+ 1.0e+128L,
+ 1.0e+256L
+ };
+ LONGDOUBLE_TYPE r = 1.0;
+ int i;
+ assert( E>=0 && E<=307 );
+ for(i=0; E!=0; i++, E >>=1){
+ if( E & 1 ) r *= x[i];
+ }
+ return r;
+#else
+ LONGDOUBLE_TYPE x = 10.0;
+ LONGDOUBLE_TYPE r = 1.0;
+ while(1){
+ if( E & 1 ) r *= x;
+ E >>= 1;
+ if( E==0 ) break;
+ x *= x;
+ }
+ return r;
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** The string z[] is an text representation of a real number.
+** Convert this string to a double and write it into *pResult.
+**
+** The string z[] is length bytes in length (bytes, not characters) and
+** uses the encoding enc. The string is not necessarily zero-terminated.
+**
+** Return TRUE if the result is a valid real number (or integer) and FALSE
+** if the string is empty or contains extraneous text. More specifically
+** return
+** 1 => The input string is a pure integer
+** 2 or more => The input has a decimal point or eNNN clause
+** 0 or less => The input string is not a valid number
+** -1 => Not a valid number, but has a valid prefix which
+** includes a decimal point and/or an eNNN clause
+**
+** Valid numbers are in one of these formats:
+**
+** [+-]digits[E[+-]digits]
+** [+-]digits.[digits][E[+-]digits]
+** [+-].digits[E[+-]digits]
+**
+** Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored for the purpose of determining
+** validity.
+**
+** If some prefix of the input string is a valid number, this routine
+** returns FALSE but it still converts the prefix and writes the result
+** into *pResult.
+*/
+#if defined(_MSC_VER)
+#pragma warning(disable : 4756)
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3AtoF(const char *z, double *pResult, int length, u8 enc){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT
+ int incr;
+ const char *zEnd;
+ /* sign * significand * (10 ^ (esign * exponent)) */
+ int sign = 1; /* sign of significand */
+ i64 s = 0; /* significand */
+ int d = 0; /* adjust exponent for shifting decimal point */
+ int esign = 1; /* sign of exponent */
+ int e = 0; /* exponent */
+ int eValid = 1; /* True exponent is either not used or is well-formed */
+ double result;
+ int nDigit = 0; /* Number of digits processed */
+ int eType = 1; /* 1: pure integer, 2+: fractional -1 or less: bad UTF16 */
+
+ assert( enc==SQLITE_UTF8 || enc==SQLITE_UTF16LE || enc==SQLITE_UTF16BE );
+ *pResult = 0.0; /* Default return value, in case of an error */
+ if( length==0 ) return 0;
+
+ if( enc==SQLITE_UTF8 ){
+ incr = 1;
+ zEnd = z + length;
+ }else{
+ int i;
+ incr = 2;
+ length &= ~1;
+ assert( SQLITE_UTF16LE==2 && SQLITE_UTF16BE==3 );
+ testcase( enc==SQLITE_UTF16LE );
+ testcase( enc==SQLITE_UTF16BE );
+ for(i=3-enc; i=zEnd ) return 0;
+
+ /* get sign of significand */
+ if( *z=='-' ){
+ sign = -1;
+ z+=incr;
+ }else if( *z=='+' ){
+ z+=incr;
+ }
+
+ /* copy max significant digits to significand */
+ while( z=((LARGEST_INT64-9)/10) ){
+ /* skip non-significant significand digits
+ ** (increase exponent by d to shift decimal left) */
+ while( z=zEnd ) goto do_atof_calc;
+
+ /* if decimal point is present */
+ if( *z=='.' ){
+ z+=incr;
+ eType++;
+ /* copy digits from after decimal to significand
+ ** (decrease exponent by d to shift decimal right) */
+ while( z=zEnd ) goto do_atof_calc;
+
+ /* if exponent is present */
+ if( *z=='e' || *z=='E' ){
+ z+=incr;
+ eValid = 0;
+ eType++;
+
+ /* This branch is needed to avoid a (harmless) buffer overread. The
+ ** special comment alerts the mutation tester that the correct answer
+ ** is obtained even if the branch is omitted */
+ if( z>=zEnd ) goto do_atof_calc; /*PREVENTS-HARMLESS-OVERREAD*/
+
+ /* get sign of exponent */
+ if( *z=='-' ){
+ esign = -1;
+ z+=incr;
+ }else if( *z=='+' ){
+ z+=incr;
+ }
+ /* copy digits to exponent */
+ while( z0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ if( esign>0 ){
+ if( s>=(LARGEST_INT64/10) ) break; /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ s *= 10;
+ }else{
+ if( s%10!=0 ) break; /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ s /= 10;
+ }
+ e--;
+ }
+
+ /* adjust the sign of significand */
+ s = sign<0 ? -s : s;
+
+ if( e==0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ result = (double)s;
+ }else{
+ /* attempt to handle extremely small/large numbers better */
+ if( e>307 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ if( e<342 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ LONGDOUBLE_TYPE scale = sqlite3Pow10(e-308);
+ if( esign<0 ){
+ result = s / scale;
+ result /= 1.0e+308;
+ }else{
+ result = s * scale;
+ result *= 1.0e+308;
+ }
+ }else{ assert( e>=342 );
+ if( esign<0 ){
+ result = 0.0*s;
+ }else{
+#ifdef INFINITY
+ result = INFINITY*s;
+#else
+ result = 1e308*1e308*s; /* Infinity */
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+ }else{
+ LONGDOUBLE_TYPE scale = sqlite3Pow10(e);
+ if( esign<0 ){
+ result = s / scale;
+ }else{
+ result = s * scale;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* store the result */
+ *pResult = result;
+
+ /* return true if number and no extra non-whitespace chracters after */
+ if( z==zEnd && nDigit>0 && eValid && eType>0 ){
+ return eType;
+ }else if( eType>=2 && (eType==3 || eValid) && nDigit>0 ){
+ return -1;
+ }else{
+ return 0;
+ }
+#else
+ return !sqlite3Atoi64(z, pResult, length, enc);
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT */
+}
+#if defined(_MSC_VER)
+#pragma warning(default : 4756)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Render an signed 64-bit integer as text. Store the result in zOut[].
+**
+** The caller must ensure that zOut[] is at least 21 bytes in size.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Int64ToText(i64 v, char *zOut){
+ int i;
+ u64 x;
+ char zTemp[22];
+ if( v<0 ){
+ x = (v==SMALLEST_INT64) ? ((u64)1)<<63 : (u64)-v;
+ }else{
+ x = v;
+ }
+ i = sizeof(zTemp)-2;
+ zTemp[sizeof(zTemp)-1] = 0;
+ do{
+ zTemp[i--] = (x%10) + '0';
+ x = x/10;
+ }while( x );
+ if( v<0 ) zTemp[i--] = '-';
+ memcpy(zOut, &zTemp[i+1], sizeof(zTemp)-1-i);
+}
+
+/*
+** Compare the 19-character string zNum against the text representation
+** value 2^63: 9223372036854775808. Return negative, zero, or positive
+** if zNum is less than, equal to, or greater than the string.
+** Note that zNum must contain exactly 19 characters.
+**
+** Unlike memcmp() this routine is guaranteed to return the difference
+** in the values of the last digit if the only difference is in the
+** last digit. So, for example,
+**
+** compare2pow63("9223372036854775800", 1)
+**
+** will return -8.
+*/
+static int compare2pow63(const char *zNum, int incr){
+ int c = 0;
+ int i;
+ /* 012345678901234567 */
+ const char *pow63 = "922337203685477580";
+ for(i=0; c==0 && i<18; i++){
+ c = (zNum[i*incr]-pow63[i])*10;
+ }
+ if( c==0 ){
+ c = zNum[18*incr] - '8';
+ testcase( c==(-1) );
+ testcase( c==0 );
+ testcase( c==(+1) );
+ }
+ return c;
+}
+
+/*
+** Convert zNum to a 64-bit signed integer. zNum must be decimal. This
+** routine does *not* accept hexadecimal notation.
+**
+** Returns:
+**
+** -1 Not even a prefix of the input text looks like an integer
+** 0 Successful transformation. Fits in a 64-bit signed integer.
+** 1 Excess non-space text after the integer value
+** 2 Integer too large for a 64-bit signed integer or is malformed
+** 3 Special case of 9223372036854775808
+**
+** length is the number of bytes in the string (bytes, not characters).
+** The string is not necessarily zero-terminated. The encoding is
+** given by enc.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Atoi64(const char *zNum, i64 *pNum, int length, u8 enc){
+ int incr;
+ u64 u = 0;
+ int neg = 0; /* assume positive */
+ int i;
+ int c = 0;
+ int nonNum = 0; /* True if input contains UTF16 with high byte non-zero */
+ int rc; /* Baseline return code */
+ const char *zStart;
+ const char *zEnd = zNum + length;
+ assert( enc==SQLITE_UTF8 || enc==SQLITE_UTF16LE || enc==SQLITE_UTF16BE );
+ if( enc==SQLITE_UTF8 ){
+ incr = 1;
+ }else{
+ incr = 2;
+ assert( SQLITE_UTF16LE==2 && SQLITE_UTF16BE==3 );
+ for(i=3-enc; i='0' && c<='9'; i+=incr){
+ u = u*10 + c - '0';
+ }
+ testcase( i==18*incr );
+ testcase( i==19*incr );
+ testcase( i==20*incr );
+ if( u>LARGEST_INT64 ){
+ /* This test and assignment is needed only to suppress UB warnings
+ ** from clang and -fsanitize=undefined. This test and assignment make
+ ** the code a little larger and slower, and no harm comes from omitting
+ ** them, but we must appaise the undefined-behavior pharisees. */
+ *pNum = neg ? SMALLEST_INT64 : LARGEST_INT64;
+ }else if( neg ){
+ *pNum = -(i64)u;
+ }else{
+ *pNum = (i64)u;
+ }
+ rc = 0;
+ if( i==0 && zStart==zNum ){ /* No digits */
+ rc = -1;
+ }else if( nonNum ){ /* UTF16 with high-order bytes non-zero */
+ rc = 1;
+ }else if( &zNum[i]19*incr ? 1 : compare2pow63(zNum, incr);
+ if( c<0 ){
+ /* zNum is less than 9223372036854775808 so it fits */
+ assert( u<=LARGEST_INT64 );
+ return rc;
+ }else{
+ *pNum = neg ? SMALLEST_INT64 : LARGEST_INT64;
+ if( c>0 ){
+ /* zNum is greater than 9223372036854775808 so it overflows */
+ return 2;
+ }else{
+ /* zNum is exactly 9223372036854775808. Fits if negative. The
+ ** special case 2 overflow if positive */
+ assert( u-1==LARGEST_INT64 );
+ return neg ? rc : 3;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Transform a UTF-8 integer literal, in either decimal or hexadecimal,
+** into a 64-bit signed integer. This routine accepts hexadecimal literals,
+** whereas sqlite3Atoi64() does not.
+**
+** Returns:
+**
+** 0 Successful transformation. Fits in a 64-bit signed integer.
+** 1 Excess text after the integer value
+** 2 Integer too large for a 64-bit signed integer or is malformed
+** 3 Special case of 9223372036854775808
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3DecOrHexToI64(const char *z, i64 *pOut){
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_HEX_INTEGER
+ if( z[0]=='0'
+ && (z[1]=='x' || z[1]=='X')
+ ){
+ u64 u = 0;
+ int i, k;
+ for(i=2; z[i]=='0'; i++){}
+ for(k=i; sqlite3Isxdigit(z[k]); k++){
+ u = u*16 + sqlite3HexToInt(z[k]);
+ }
+ memcpy(pOut, &u, 8);
+ return (z[k]==0 && k-i<=16) ? 0 : 2;
+ }else
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_HEX_INTEGER */
+ {
+ return sqlite3Atoi64(z, pOut, sqlite3Strlen30(z), SQLITE_UTF8);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** If zNum represents an integer that will fit in 32-bits, then set
+** *pValue to that integer and return true. Otherwise return false.
+**
+** This routine accepts both decimal and hexadecimal notation for integers.
+**
+** Any non-numeric characters that following zNum are ignored.
+** This is different from sqlite3Atoi64() which requires the
+** input number to be zero-terminated.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3GetInt32(const char *zNum, int *pValue){
+ sqlite_int64 v = 0;
+ int i, c;
+ int neg = 0;
+ if( zNum[0]=='-' ){
+ neg = 1;
+ zNum++;
+ }else if( zNum[0]=='+' ){
+ zNum++;
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_HEX_INTEGER
+ else if( zNum[0]=='0'
+ && (zNum[1]=='x' || zNum[1]=='X')
+ && sqlite3Isxdigit(zNum[2])
+ ){
+ u32 u = 0;
+ zNum += 2;
+ while( zNum[0]=='0' ) zNum++;
+ for(i=0; sqlite3Isxdigit(zNum[i]) && i<8; i++){
+ u = u*16 + sqlite3HexToInt(zNum[i]);
+ }
+ if( (u&0x80000000)==0 && sqlite3Isxdigit(zNum[i])==0 ){
+ memcpy(pValue, &u, 4);
+ return 1;
+ }else{
+ return 0;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ if( !sqlite3Isdigit(zNum[0]) ) return 0;
+ while( zNum[0]=='0' ) zNum++;
+ for(i=0; i<11 && (c = zNum[i] - '0')>=0 && c<=9; i++){
+ v = v*10 + c;
+ }
+
+ /* The longest decimal representation of a 32 bit integer is 10 digits:
+ **
+ ** 1234567890
+ ** 2^31 -> 2147483648
+ */
+ testcase( i==10 );
+ if( i>10 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ testcase( v-neg==2147483647 );
+ if( v-neg>2147483647 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if( neg ){
+ v = -v;
+ }
+ *pValue = (int)v;
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return a 32-bit integer value extracted from a string. If the
+** string is not an integer, just return 0.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3Atoi(const char *z){
+ int x = 0;
+ sqlite3GetInt32(z, &x);
+ return x;
+}
+
+/*
+** Try to convert z into an unsigned 32-bit integer. Return true on
+** success and false if there is an error.
+**
+** Only decimal notation is accepted.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3GetUInt32(const char *z, u32 *pI){
+ u64 v = 0;
+ int i;
+ for(i=0; sqlite3Isdigit(z[i]); i++){
+ v = v*10 + z[i] - '0';
+ if( v>4294967296LL ){ *pI = 0; return 0; }
+ }
+ if( i==0 || z[i]!=0 ){ *pI = 0; return 0; }
+ *pI = (u32)v;
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/*
+** The variable-length integer encoding is as follows:
+**
+** KEY:
+** A = 0xxxxxxx 7 bits of data and one flag bit
+** B = 1xxxxxxx 7 bits of data and one flag bit
+** C = xxxxxxxx 8 bits of data
+**
+** 7 bits - A
+** 14 bits - BA
+** 21 bits - BBA
+** 28 bits - BBBA
+** 35 bits - BBBBA
+** 42 bits - BBBBBA
+** 49 bits - BBBBBBA
+** 56 bits - BBBBBBBA
+** 64 bits - BBBBBBBBC
+*/
+
+/*
+** Write a 64-bit variable-length integer to memory starting at p[0].
+** The length of data write will be between 1 and 9 bytes. The number
+** of bytes written is returned.
+**
+** A variable-length integer consists of the lower 7 bits of each byte
+** for all bytes that have the 8th bit set and one byte with the 8th
+** bit clear. Except, if we get to the 9th byte, it stores the full
+** 8 bits and is the last byte.
+*/
+static int SQLITE_NOINLINE putVarint64(unsigned char *p, u64 v){
+ int i, j, n;
+ u8 buf[10];
+ if( v & (((u64)0xff000000)<<32) ){
+ p[8] = (u8)v;
+ v >>= 8;
+ for(i=7; i>=0; i--){
+ p[i] = (u8)((v & 0x7f) | 0x80);
+ v >>= 7;
+ }
+ return 9;
+ }
+ n = 0;
+ do{
+ buf[n++] = (u8)((v & 0x7f) | 0x80);
+ v >>= 7;
+ }while( v!=0 );
+ buf[0] &= 0x7f;
+ assert( n<=9 );
+ for(i=0, j=n-1; j>=0; j--, i++){
+ p[i] = buf[j];
+ }
+ return n;
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PutVarint(unsigned char *p, u64 v){
+ if( v<=0x7f ){
+ p[0] = v&0x7f;
+ return 1;
+ }
+ if( v<=0x3fff ){
+ p[0] = ((v>>7)&0x7f)|0x80;
+ p[1] = v&0x7f;
+ return 2;
+ }
+ return putVarint64(p,v);
+}
+
+/*
+** Bitmasks used by sqlite3GetVarint(). These precomputed constants
+** are defined here rather than simply putting the constant expressions
+** inline in order to work around bugs in the RVT compiler.
+**
+** SLOT_2_0 A mask for (0x7f<<14) | 0x7f
+**
+** SLOT_4_2_0 A mask for (0x7f<<28) | SLOT_2_0
+*/
+#define SLOT_2_0 0x001fc07f
+#define SLOT_4_2_0 0xf01fc07f
+
+
+/*
+** Read a 64-bit variable-length integer from memory starting at p[0].
+** Return the number of bytes read. The value is stored in *v.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3GetVarint(const unsigned char *p, u64 *v){
+ u32 a,b,s;
+
+ if( ((signed char*)p)[0]>=0 ){
+ *v = *p;
+ return 1;
+ }
+ if( ((signed char*)p)[1]>=0 ){
+ *v = ((u32)(p[0]&0x7f)<<7) | p[1];
+ return 2;
+ }
+
+ /* Verify that constants are precomputed correctly */
+ assert( SLOT_2_0 == ((0x7f<<14) | (0x7f)) );
+ assert( SLOT_4_2_0 == ((0xfU<<28) | (0x7f<<14) | (0x7f)) );
+
+ a = ((u32)p[0])<<14;
+ b = p[1];
+ p += 2;
+ a |= *p;
+ /* a: p0<<14 | p2 (unmasked) */
+ if (!(a&0x80))
+ {
+ a &= SLOT_2_0;
+ b &= 0x7f;
+ b = b<<7;
+ a |= b;
+ *v = a;
+ return 3;
+ }
+
+ /* CSE1 from below */
+ a &= SLOT_2_0;
+ p++;
+ b = b<<14;
+ b |= *p;
+ /* b: p1<<14 | p3 (unmasked) */
+ if (!(b&0x80))
+ {
+ b &= SLOT_2_0;
+ /* moved CSE1 up */
+ /* a &= (0x7f<<14)|(0x7f); */
+ a = a<<7;
+ a |= b;
+ *v = a;
+ return 4;
+ }
+
+ /* a: p0<<14 | p2 (masked) */
+ /* b: p1<<14 | p3 (unmasked) */
+ /* 1:save off p0<<21 | p1<<14 | p2<<7 | p3 (masked) */
+ /* moved CSE1 up */
+ /* a &= (0x7f<<14)|(0x7f); */
+ b &= SLOT_2_0;
+ s = a;
+ /* s: p0<<14 | p2 (masked) */
+
+ p++;
+ a = a<<14;
+ a |= *p;
+ /* a: p0<<28 | p2<<14 | p4 (unmasked) */
+ if (!(a&0x80))
+ {
+ /* we can skip these cause they were (effectively) done above
+ ** while calculating s */
+ /* a &= (0x7f<<28)|(0x7f<<14)|(0x7f); */
+ /* b &= (0x7f<<14)|(0x7f); */
+ b = b<<7;
+ a |= b;
+ s = s>>18;
+ *v = ((u64)s)<<32 | a;
+ return 5;
+ }
+
+ /* 2:save off p0<<21 | p1<<14 | p2<<7 | p3 (masked) */
+ s = s<<7;
+ s |= b;
+ /* s: p0<<21 | p1<<14 | p2<<7 | p3 (masked) */
+
+ p++;
+ b = b<<14;
+ b |= *p;
+ /* b: p1<<28 | p3<<14 | p5 (unmasked) */
+ if (!(b&0x80))
+ {
+ /* we can skip this cause it was (effectively) done above in calc'ing s */
+ /* b &= (0x7f<<28)|(0x7f<<14)|(0x7f); */
+ a &= SLOT_2_0;
+ a = a<<7;
+ a |= b;
+ s = s>>18;
+ *v = ((u64)s)<<32 | a;
+ return 6;
+ }
+
+ p++;
+ a = a<<14;
+ a |= *p;
+ /* a: p2<<28 | p4<<14 | p6 (unmasked) */
+ if (!(a&0x80))
+ {
+ a &= SLOT_4_2_0;
+ b &= SLOT_2_0;
+ b = b<<7;
+ a |= b;
+ s = s>>11;
+ *v = ((u64)s)<<32 | a;
+ return 7;
+ }
+
+ /* CSE2 from below */
+ a &= SLOT_2_0;
+ p++;
+ b = b<<14;
+ b |= *p;
+ /* b: p3<<28 | p5<<14 | p7 (unmasked) */
+ if (!(b&0x80))
+ {
+ b &= SLOT_4_2_0;
+ /* moved CSE2 up */
+ /* a &= (0x7f<<14)|(0x7f); */
+ a = a<<7;
+ a |= b;
+ s = s>>4;
+ *v = ((u64)s)<<32 | a;
+ return 8;
+ }
+
+ p++;
+ a = a<<15;
+ a |= *p;
+ /* a: p4<<29 | p6<<15 | p8 (unmasked) */
+
+ /* moved CSE2 up */
+ /* a &= (0x7f<<29)|(0x7f<<15)|(0xff); */
+ b &= SLOT_2_0;
+ b = b<<8;
+ a |= b;
+
+ s = s<<4;
+ b = p[-4];
+ b &= 0x7f;
+ b = b>>3;
+ s |= b;
+
+ *v = ((u64)s)<<32 | a;
+
+ return 9;
+}
+
+/*
+** Read a 32-bit variable-length integer from memory starting at p[0].
+** Return the number of bytes read. The value is stored in *v.
+**
+** If the varint stored in p[0] is larger than can fit in a 32-bit unsigned
+** integer, then set *v to 0xffffffff.
+**
+** A MACRO version, getVarint32, is provided which inlines the
+** single-byte case. All code should use the MACRO version as
+** this function assumes the single-byte case has already been handled.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3GetVarint32(const unsigned char *p, u32 *v){
+ u32 a,b;
+
+ /* The 1-byte case. Overwhelmingly the most common. Handled inline
+ ** by the getVarin32() macro */
+ a = *p;
+ /* a: p0 (unmasked) */
+#ifndef getVarint32
+ if (!(a&0x80))
+ {
+ /* Values between 0 and 127 */
+ *v = a;
+ return 1;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* The 2-byte case */
+ p++;
+ b = *p;
+ /* b: p1 (unmasked) */
+ if (!(b&0x80))
+ {
+ /* Values between 128 and 16383 */
+ a &= 0x7f;
+ a = a<<7;
+ *v = a | b;
+ return 2;
+ }
+
+ /* The 3-byte case */
+ p++;
+ a = a<<14;
+ a |= *p;
+ /* a: p0<<14 | p2 (unmasked) */
+ if (!(a&0x80))
+ {
+ /* Values between 16384 and 2097151 */
+ a &= (0x7f<<14)|(0x7f);
+ b &= 0x7f;
+ b = b<<7;
+ *v = a | b;
+ return 3;
+ }
+
+ /* A 32-bit varint is used to store size information in btrees.
+ ** Objects are rarely larger than 2MiB limit of a 3-byte varint.
+ ** A 3-byte varint is sufficient, for example, to record the size
+ ** of a 1048569-byte BLOB or string.
+ **
+ ** We only unroll the first 1-, 2-, and 3- byte cases. The very
+ ** rare larger cases can be handled by the slower 64-bit varint
+ ** routine.
+ */
+#if 1
+ {
+ u64 v64;
+ u8 n;
+
+ n = sqlite3GetVarint(p-2, &v64);
+ assert( n>3 && n<=9 );
+ if( (v64 & SQLITE_MAX_U32)!=v64 ){
+ *v = 0xffffffff;
+ }else{
+ *v = (u32)v64;
+ }
+ return n;
+ }
+
+#else
+ /* For following code (kept for historical record only) shows an
+ ** unrolling for the 3- and 4-byte varint cases. This code is
+ ** slightly faster, but it is also larger and much harder to test.
+ */
+ p++;
+ b = b<<14;
+ b |= *p;
+ /* b: p1<<14 | p3 (unmasked) */
+ if (!(b&0x80))
+ {
+ /* Values between 2097152 and 268435455 */
+ b &= (0x7f<<14)|(0x7f);
+ a &= (0x7f<<14)|(0x7f);
+ a = a<<7;
+ *v = a | b;
+ return 4;
+ }
+
+ p++;
+ a = a<<14;
+ a |= *p;
+ /* a: p0<<28 | p2<<14 | p4 (unmasked) */
+ if (!(a&0x80))
+ {
+ /* Values between 268435456 and 34359738367 */
+ a &= SLOT_4_2_0;
+ b &= SLOT_4_2_0;
+ b = b<<7;
+ *v = a | b;
+ return 5;
+ }
+
+ /* We can only reach this point when reading a corrupt database
+ ** file. In that case we are not in any hurry. Use the (relatively
+ ** slow) general-purpose sqlite3GetVarint() routine to extract the
+ ** value. */
+ {
+ u64 v64;
+ u8 n;
+
+ p -= 4;
+ n = sqlite3GetVarint(p, &v64);
+ assert( n>5 && n<=9 );
+ *v = (u32)v64;
+ return n;
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the number of bytes that will be needed to store the given
+** 64-bit integer.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VarintLen(u64 v){
+ int i;
+ for(i=1; (v >>= 7)!=0; i++){ assert( i<10 ); }
+ return i;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Read or write a four-byte big-endian integer value.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3Get4byte(const u8 *p){
+#if SQLITE_BYTEORDER==4321
+ u32 x;
+ memcpy(&x,p,4);
+ return x;
+#elif SQLITE_BYTEORDER==1234 && GCC_VERSION>=4003000
+ u32 x;
+ memcpy(&x,p,4);
+ return __builtin_bswap32(x);
+#elif SQLITE_BYTEORDER==1234 && MSVC_VERSION>=1300
+ u32 x;
+ memcpy(&x,p,4);
+ return _byteswap_ulong(x);
+#else
+ testcase( p[0]&0x80 );
+ return ((unsigned)p[0]<<24) | (p[1]<<16) | (p[2]<<8) | p[3];
+#endif
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3Put4byte(unsigned char *p, u32 v){
+#if SQLITE_BYTEORDER==4321
+ memcpy(p,&v,4);
+#elif SQLITE_BYTEORDER==1234 && GCC_VERSION>=4003000
+ u32 x = __builtin_bswap32(v);
+ memcpy(p,&x,4);
+#elif SQLITE_BYTEORDER==1234 && MSVC_VERSION>=1300
+ u32 x = _byteswap_ulong(v);
+ memcpy(p,&x,4);
+#else
+ p[0] = (u8)(v>>24);
+ p[1] = (u8)(v>>16);
+ p[2] = (u8)(v>>8);
+ p[3] = (u8)v;
+#endif
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+** Translate a single byte of Hex into an integer.
+** This routine only works if h really is a valid hexadecimal
+** character: 0..9a..fA..F
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u8 sqlite3HexToInt(int h){
+ assert( (h>='0' && h<='9') || (h>='a' && h<='f') || (h>='A' && h<='F') );
+#ifdef SQLITE_ASCII
+ h += 9*(1&(h>>6));
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_EBCDIC
+ h += 9*(1&~(h>>4));
+#endif
+ return (u8)(h & 0xf);
+}
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_BLOB_LITERAL)
+/*
+** Convert a BLOB literal of the form "x'hhhhhh'" into its binary
+** value. Return a pointer to its binary value. Space to hold the
+** binary value has been obtained from malloc and must be freed by
+** the calling routine.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3HexToBlob(sqlite3 *db, const char *z, int n){
+ char *zBlob;
+ int i;
+
+ zBlob = (char *)sqlite3DbMallocRawNN(db, n/2 + 1);
+ n--;
+ if( zBlob ){
+ for(i=0; imagic;
+ if( magic!=SQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN ){
+ if( sqlite3SafetyCheckSickOrOk(db) ){
+ testcase( sqlite3GlobalConfig.xLog!=0 );
+ logBadConnection("unopened");
+ }
+ return 0;
+ }else{
+ return 1;
+ }
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SafetyCheckSickOrOk(sqlite3 *db){
+ u32 magic;
+ magic = db->magic;
+ if( magic!=SQLITE_MAGIC_SICK &&
+ magic!=SQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN &&
+ magic!=SQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY ){
+ testcase( sqlite3GlobalConfig.xLog!=0 );
+ logBadConnection("invalid");
+ return 0;
+ }else{
+ return 1;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Attempt to add, substract, or multiply the 64-bit signed value iB against
+** the other 64-bit signed integer at *pA and store the result in *pA.
+** Return 0 on success. Or if the operation would have resulted in an
+** overflow, leave *pA unchanged and return 1.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3AddInt64(i64 *pA, i64 iB){
+#if GCC_VERSION>=5004000 && !defined(__INTEL_COMPILER)
+ return __builtin_add_overflow(*pA, iB, pA);
+#else
+ i64 iA = *pA;
+ testcase( iA==0 ); testcase( iA==1 );
+ testcase( iB==-1 ); testcase( iB==0 );
+ if( iB>=0 ){
+ testcase( iA>0 && LARGEST_INT64 - iA == iB );
+ testcase( iA>0 && LARGEST_INT64 - iA == iB - 1 );
+ if( iA>0 && LARGEST_INT64 - iA < iB ) return 1;
+ }else{
+ testcase( iA<0 && -(iA + LARGEST_INT64) == iB + 1 );
+ testcase( iA<0 && -(iA + LARGEST_INT64) == iB + 2 );
+ if( iA<0 && -(iA + LARGEST_INT64) > iB + 1 ) return 1;
+ }
+ *pA += iB;
+ return 0;
+#endif
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SubInt64(i64 *pA, i64 iB){
+#if GCC_VERSION>=5004000 && !defined(__INTEL_COMPILER)
+ return __builtin_sub_overflow(*pA, iB, pA);
+#else
+ testcase( iB==SMALLEST_INT64+1 );
+ if( iB==SMALLEST_INT64 ){
+ testcase( (*pA)==(-1) ); testcase( (*pA)==0 );
+ if( (*pA)>=0 ) return 1;
+ *pA -= iB;
+ return 0;
+ }else{
+ return sqlite3AddInt64(pA, -iB);
+ }
+#endif
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MulInt64(i64 *pA, i64 iB){
+#if GCC_VERSION>=5004000 && !defined(__INTEL_COMPILER)
+ return __builtin_mul_overflow(*pA, iB, pA);
+#else
+ i64 iA = *pA;
+ if( iB>0 ){
+ if( iA>LARGEST_INT64/iB ) return 1;
+ if( iA0 ){
+ if( iBLARGEST_INT64/-iB ) return 1;
+ }
+ }
+ *pA = iA*iB;
+ return 0;
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Compute the absolute value of a 32-bit signed integer, of possible. Or
+** if the integer has a value of -2147483648, return +2147483647
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3AbsInt32(int x){
+ if( x>=0 ) return x;
+ if( x==(int)0x80000000 ) return 0x7fffffff;
+ return -x;
+}
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_8_3_NAMES
+/*
+** If SQLITE_ENABLE_8_3_NAMES is set at compile-time and if the database
+** filename in zBaseFilename is a URI with the "8_3_names=1" parameter and
+** if filename in z[] has a suffix (a.k.a. "extension") that is longer than
+** three characters, then shorten the suffix on z[] to be the last three
+** characters of the original suffix.
+**
+** If SQLITE_ENABLE_8_3_NAMES is set to 2 at compile-time, then always
+** do the suffix shortening regardless of URI parameter.
+**
+** Examples:
+**
+** test.db-journal => test.nal
+** test.db-wal => test.wal
+** test.db-shm => test.shm
+** test.db-mj7f3319fa => test.9fa
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3FileSuffix3(const char *zBaseFilename, char *z){
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_8_3_NAMES<2
+ if( sqlite3_uri_boolean(zBaseFilename, "8_3_names", 0) )
+#endif
+ {
+ int i, sz;
+ sz = sqlite3Strlen30(z);
+ for(i=sz-1; i>0 && z[i]!='/' && z[i]!='.'; i--){}
+ if( z[i]=='.' && ALWAYS(sz>i+4) ) memmove(&z[i+1], &z[sz-3], 4);
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Find (an approximate) sum of two LogEst values. This computation is
+** not a simple "+" operator because LogEst is stored as a logarithmic
+** value.
+**
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE LogEst sqlite3LogEstAdd(LogEst a, LogEst b){
+ static const unsigned char x[] = {
+ 10, 10, /* 0,1 */
+ 9, 9, /* 2,3 */
+ 8, 8, /* 4,5 */
+ 7, 7, 7, /* 6,7,8 */
+ 6, 6, 6, /* 9,10,11 */
+ 5, 5, 5, /* 12-14 */
+ 4, 4, 4, 4, /* 15-18 */
+ 3, 3, 3, 3, 3, 3, /* 19-24 */
+ 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, /* 25-31 */
+ };
+ if( a>=b ){
+ if( a>b+49 ) return a;
+ if( a>b+31 ) return a+1;
+ return a+x[a-b];
+ }else{
+ if( b>a+49 ) return b;
+ if( b>a+31 ) return b+1;
+ return b+x[b-a];
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Convert an integer into a LogEst. In other words, compute an
+** approximation for 10*log2(x).
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE LogEst sqlite3LogEst(u64 x){
+ static LogEst a[] = { 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 };
+ LogEst y = 40;
+ if( x<8 ){
+ if( x<2 ) return 0;
+ while( x<8 ){ y -= 10; x <<= 1; }
+ }else{
+#if GCC_VERSION>=5004000
+ int i = 60 - __builtin_clzll(x);
+ y += i*10;
+ x >>= i;
+#else
+ while( x>255 ){ y += 40; x >>= 4; } /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ while( x>15 ){ y += 10; x >>= 1; }
+#endif
+ }
+ return a[x&7] + y - 10;
+}
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE
+/*
+** Convert a double into a LogEst
+** In other words, compute an approximation for 10*log2(x).
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE LogEst sqlite3LogEstFromDouble(double x){
+ u64 a;
+ LogEst e;
+ assert( sizeof(x)==8 && sizeof(a)==8 );
+ if( x<=1 ) return 0;
+ if( x<=2000000000 ) return sqlite3LogEst((u64)x);
+ memcpy(&a, &x, 8);
+ e = (a>>52) - 1022;
+ return e*10;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE */
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_STMT_SCANSTATUS) || \
+ defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT4) || \
+ defined(SQLITE_EXPLAIN_ESTIMATED_ROWS)
+/*
+** Convert a LogEst into an integer.
+**
+** Note that this routine is only used when one or more of various
+** non-standard compile-time options is enabled.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u64 sqlite3LogEstToInt(LogEst x){
+ u64 n;
+ n = x%10;
+ x /= 10;
+ if( n>=5 ) n -= 2;
+ else if( n>=1 ) n -= 1;
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_STMT_SCANSTATUS) || \
+ defined(SQLITE_EXPLAIN_ESTIMATED_ROWS)
+ if( x>60 ) return (u64)LARGEST_INT64;
+#else
+ /* If only SQLITE_ENABLE_STAT4 is on, then the largest input
+ ** possible to this routine is 310, resulting in a maximum x of 31 */
+ assert( x<=60 );
+#endif
+ return x>=3 ? (n+8)<<(x-3) : (n+8)>>(3-x);
+}
+#endif /* defined SCANSTAT or STAT4 or ESTIMATED_ROWS */
+
+/*
+** Add a new name/number pair to a VList. This might require that the
+** VList object be reallocated, so return the new VList. If an OOM
+** error occurs, the original VList returned and the
+** db->mallocFailed flag is set.
+**
+** A VList is really just an array of integers. To destroy a VList,
+** simply pass it to sqlite3DbFree().
+**
+** The first integer is the number of integers allocated for the whole
+** VList. The second integer is the number of integers actually used.
+** Each name/number pair is encoded by subsequent groups of 3 or more
+** integers.
+**
+** Each name/number pair starts with two integers which are the numeric
+** value for the pair and the size of the name/number pair, respectively.
+** The text name overlays one or more following integers. The text name
+** is always zero-terminated.
+**
+** Conceptually:
+**
+** struct VList {
+** int nAlloc; // Number of allocated slots
+** int nUsed; // Number of used slots
+** struct VListEntry {
+** int iValue; // Value for this entry
+** int nSlot; // Slots used by this entry
+** // ... variable name goes here
+** } a[0];
+** }
+**
+** During code generation, pointers to the variable names within the
+** VList are taken. When that happens, nAlloc is set to zero as an
+** indication that the VList may never again be enlarged, since the
+** accompanying realloc() would invalidate the pointers.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE VList *sqlite3VListAdd(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* The database connection used for malloc() */
+ VList *pIn, /* The input VList. Might be NULL */
+ const char *zName, /* Name of symbol to add */
+ int nName, /* Bytes of text in zName */
+ int iVal /* Value to associate with zName */
+){
+ int nInt; /* number of sizeof(int) objects needed for zName */
+ char *z; /* Pointer to where zName will be stored */
+ int i; /* Index in pIn[] where zName is stored */
+
+ nInt = nName/4 + 3;
+ assert( pIn==0 || pIn[0]>=3 ); /* Verify ok to add new elements */
+ if( pIn==0 || pIn[1]+nInt > pIn[0] ){
+ /* Enlarge the allocation */
+ sqlite3_int64 nAlloc = (pIn ? 2*(sqlite3_int64)pIn[0] : 10) + nInt;
+ VList *pOut = sqlite3DbRealloc(db, pIn, nAlloc*sizeof(int));
+ if( pOut==0 ) return pIn;
+ if( pIn==0 ) pOut[1] = 2;
+ pIn = pOut;
+ pIn[0] = nAlloc;
+ }
+ i = pIn[1];
+ pIn[i] = iVal;
+ pIn[i+1] = nInt;
+ z = (char*)&pIn[i+2];
+ pIn[1] = i+nInt;
+ assert( pIn[1]<=pIn[0] );
+ memcpy(z, zName, nName);
+ z[nName] = 0;
+ return pIn;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return a pointer to the name of a variable in the given VList that
+** has the value iVal. Or return a NULL if there is no such variable in
+** the list
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3VListNumToName(VList *pIn, int iVal){
+ int i, mx;
+ if( pIn==0 ) return 0;
+ mx = pIn[1];
+ i = 2;
+ do{
+ if( pIn[i]==iVal ) return (char*)&pIn[i+2];
+ i += pIn[i+1];
+ }while( i */
+
+/* Turn bulk memory into a hash table object by initializing the
+** fields of the Hash structure.
+**
+** "pNew" is a pointer to the hash table that is to be initialized.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3HashInit(Hash *pNew){
+ assert( pNew!=0 );
+ pNew->first = 0;
+ pNew->count = 0;
+ pNew->htsize = 0;
+ pNew->ht = 0;
+}
+
+/* Remove all entries from a hash table. Reclaim all memory.
+** Call this routine to delete a hash table or to reset a hash table
+** to the empty state.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3HashClear(Hash *pH){
+ HashElem *elem; /* For looping over all elements of the table */
+
+ assert( pH!=0 );
+ elem = pH->first;
+ pH->first = 0;
+ sqlite3_free(pH->ht);
+ pH->ht = 0;
+ pH->htsize = 0;
+ while( elem ){
+ HashElem *next_elem = elem->next;
+ sqlite3_free(elem);
+ elem = next_elem;
+ }
+ pH->count = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** The hashing function.
+*/
+static unsigned int strHash(const char *z){
+ unsigned int h = 0;
+ unsigned char c;
+ while( (c = (unsigned char)*z++)!=0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ /* Knuth multiplicative hashing. (Sorting & Searching, p. 510).
+ ** 0x9e3779b1 is 2654435761 which is the closest prime number to
+ ** (2**32)*golden_ratio, where golden_ratio = (sqrt(5) - 1)/2. */
+ h += sqlite3UpperToLower[c];
+ h *= 0x9e3779b1;
+ }
+ return h;
+}
+
+
+/* Link pNew element into the hash table pH. If pEntry!=0 then also
+** insert pNew into the pEntry hash bucket.
+*/
+static void insertElement(
+ Hash *pH, /* The complete hash table */
+ struct _ht *pEntry, /* The entry into which pNew is inserted */
+ HashElem *pNew /* The element to be inserted */
+){
+ HashElem *pHead; /* First element already in pEntry */
+ if( pEntry ){
+ pHead = pEntry->count ? pEntry->chain : 0;
+ pEntry->count++;
+ pEntry->chain = pNew;
+ }else{
+ pHead = 0;
+ }
+ if( pHead ){
+ pNew->next = pHead;
+ pNew->prev = pHead->prev;
+ if( pHead->prev ){ pHead->prev->next = pNew; }
+ else { pH->first = pNew; }
+ pHead->prev = pNew;
+ }else{
+ pNew->next = pH->first;
+ if( pH->first ){ pH->first->prev = pNew; }
+ pNew->prev = 0;
+ pH->first = pNew;
+ }
+}
+
+
+/* Resize the hash table so that it cantains "new_size" buckets.
+**
+** The hash table might fail to resize if sqlite3_malloc() fails or
+** if the new size is the same as the prior size.
+** Return TRUE if the resize occurs and false if not.
+*/
+static int rehash(Hash *pH, unsigned int new_size){
+ struct _ht *new_ht; /* The new hash table */
+ HashElem *elem, *next_elem; /* For looping over existing elements */
+
+#if SQLITE_MALLOC_SOFT_LIMIT>0
+ if( new_size*sizeof(struct _ht)>SQLITE_MALLOC_SOFT_LIMIT ){
+ new_size = SQLITE_MALLOC_SOFT_LIMIT/sizeof(struct _ht);
+ }
+ if( new_size==pH->htsize ) return 0;
+#endif
+
+ /* The inability to allocates space for a larger hash table is
+ ** a performance hit but it is not a fatal error. So mark the
+ ** allocation as a benign. Use sqlite3Malloc()/memset(0) instead of
+ ** sqlite3MallocZero() to make the allocation, as sqlite3MallocZero()
+ ** only zeroes the requested number of bytes whereas this module will
+ ** use the actual amount of space allocated for the hash table (which
+ ** may be larger than the requested amount).
+ */
+ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc();
+ new_ht = (struct _ht *)sqlite3Malloc( new_size*sizeof(struct _ht) );
+ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc();
+
+ if( new_ht==0 ) return 0;
+ sqlite3_free(pH->ht);
+ pH->ht = new_ht;
+ pH->htsize = new_size = sqlite3MallocSize(new_ht)/sizeof(struct _ht);
+ memset(new_ht, 0, new_size*sizeof(struct _ht));
+ for(elem=pH->first, pH->first=0; elem; elem = next_elem){
+ unsigned int h = strHash(elem->pKey) % new_size;
+ next_elem = elem->next;
+ insertElement(pH, &new_ht[h], elem);
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/* This function (for internal use only) locates an element in an
+** hash table that matches the given key. If no element is found,
+** a pointer to a static null element with HashElem.data==0 is returned.
+** If pH is not NULL, then the hash for this key is written to *pH.
+*/
+static HashElem *findElementWithHash(
+ const Hash *pH, /* The pH to be searched */
+ const char *pKey, /* The key we are searching for */
+ unsigned int *pHash /* Write the hash value here */
+){
+ HashElem *elem; /* Used to loop thru the element list */
+ unsigned int count; /* Number of elements left to test */
+ unsigned int h; /* The computed hash */
+ static HashElem nullElement = { 0, 0, 0, 0 };
+
+ if( pH->ht ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ struct _ht *pEntry;
+ h = strHash(pKey) % pH->htsize;
+ pEntry = &pH->ht[h];
+ elem = pEntry->chain;
+ count = pEntry->count;
+ }else{
+ h = 0;
+ elem = pH->first;
+ count = pH->count;
+ }
+ if( pHash ) *pHash = h;
+ while( count-- ){
+ assert( elem!=0 );
+ if( sqlite3StrICmp(elem->pKey,pKey)==0 ){
+ return elem;
+ }
+ elem = elem->next;
+ }
+ return &nullElement;
+}
+
+/* Remove a single entry from the hash table given a pointer to that
+** element and a hash on the element's key.
+*/
+static void removeElementGivenHash(
+ Hash *pH, /* The pH containing "elem" */
+ HashElem* elem, /* The element to be removed from the pH */
+ unsigned int h /* Hash value for the element */
+){
+ struct _ht *pEntry;
+ if( elem->prev ){
+ elem->prev->next = elem->next;
+ }else{
+ pH->first = elem->next;
+ }
+ if( elem->next ){
+ elem->next->prev = elem->prev;
+ }
+ if( pH->ht ){
+ pEntry = &pH->ht[h];
+ if( pEntry->chain==elem ){
+ pEntry->chain = elem->next;
+ }
+ assert( pEntry->count>0 );
+ pEntry->count--;
+ }
+ sqlite3_free( elem );
+ pH->count--;
+ if( pH->count==0 ){
+ assert( pH->first==0 );
+ assert( pH->count==0 );
+ sqlite3HashClear(pH);
+ }
+}
+
+/* Attempt to locate an element of the hash table pH with a key
+** that matches pKey. Return the data for this element if it is
+** found, or NULL if there is no match.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3HashFind(const Hash *pH, const char *pKey){
+ assert( pH!=0 );
+ assert( pKey!=0 );
+ return findElementWithHash(pH, pKey, 0)->data;
+}
+
+/* Insert an element into the hash table pH. The key is pKey
+** and the data is "data".
+**
+** If no element exists with a matching key, then a new
+** element is created and NULL is returned.
+**
+** If another element already exists with the same key, then the
+** new data replaces the old data and the old data is returned.
+** The key is not copied in this instance. If a malloc fails, then
+** the new data is returned and the hash table is unchanged.
+**
+** If the "data" parameter to this function is NULL, then the
+** element corresponding to "key" is removed from the hash table.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3HashInsert(Hash *pH, const char *pKey, void *data){
+ unsigned int h; /* the hash of the key modulo hash table size */
+ HashElem *elem; /* Used to loop thru the element list */
+ HashElem *new_elem; /* New element added to the pH */
+
+ assert( pH!=0 );
+ assert( pKey!=0 );
+ elem = findElementWithHash(pH,pKey,&h);
+ if( elem->data ){
+ void *old_data = elem->data;
+ if( data==0 ){
+ removeElementGivenHash(pH,elem,h);
+ }else{
+ elem->data = data;
+ elem->pKey = pKey;
+ }
+ return old_data;
+ }
+ if( data==0 ) return 0;
+ new_elem = (HashElem*)sqlite3Malloc( sizeof(HashElem) );
+ if( new_elem==0 ) return data;
+ new_elem->pKey = pKey;
+ new_elem->data = data;
+ pH->count++;
+ if( pH->count>=10 && pH->count > 2*pH->htsize ){
+ if( rehash(pH, pH->count*2) ){
+ assert( pH->htsize>0 );
+ h = strHash(pKey) % pH->htsize;
+ }
+ }
+ insertElement(pH, pH->ht ? &pH->ht[h] : 0, new_elem);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/************** End of hash.c ************************************************/
+/************** Begin file opcodes.c *****************************************/
+/* Automatically generated. Do not edit */
+/* See the tool/mkopcodec.tcl script for details. */
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_EXPLAIN) \
+ || defined(VDBE_PROFILE) \
+ || defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_EXPLAIN_COMMENTS) || defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+# define OpHelp(X) "\0" X
+#else
+# define OpHelp(X)
+#endif
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3OpcodeName(int i){
+ static const char *const azName[] = {
+ /* 0 */ "Savepoint" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 1 */ "AutoCommit" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 2 */ "Transaction" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 3 */ "SorterNext" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 4 */ "Prev" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 5 */ "Next" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 6 */ "Checkpoint" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 7 */ "JournalMode" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 8 */ "Vacuum" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 9 */ "VFilter" OpHelp("iplan=r[P3] zplan='P4'"),
+ /* 10 */ "VUpdate" OpHelp("data=r[P3@P2]"),
+ /* 11 */ "Goto" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 12 */ "Gosub" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 13 */ "InitCoroutine" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 14 */ "Yield" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 15 */ "MustBeInt" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 16 */ "Jump" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 17 */ "Once" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 18 */ "If" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 19 */ "Not" OpHelp("r[P2]= !r[P1]"),
+ /* 20 */ "IfNot" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 21 */ "IfNullRow" OpHelp("if P1.nullRow then r[P3]=NULL, goto P2"),
+ /* 22 */ "SeekLT" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 23 */ "SeekLE" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 24 */ "SeekGE" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 25 */ "SeekGT" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 26 */ "IfNotOpen" OpHelp("if( !csr[P1] ) goto P2"),
+ /* 27 */ "IfNoHope" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 28 */ "NoConflict" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 29 */ "NotFound" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 30 */ "Found" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 31 */ "SeekRowid" OpHelp("intkey=r[P3]"),
+ /* 32 */ "NotExists" OpHelp("intkey=r[P3]"),
+ /* 33 */ "Last" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 34 */ "IfSmaller" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 35 */ "SorterSort" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 36 */ "Sort" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 37 */ "Rewind" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 38 */ "IdxLE" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 39 */ "IdxGT" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 40 */ "IdxLT" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 41 */ "IdxGE" OpHelp("key=r[P3@P4]"),
+ /* 42 */ "RowSetRead" OpHelp("r[P3]=rowset(P1)"),
+ /* 43 */ "Or" OpHelp("r[P3]=(r[P1] || r[P2])"),
+ /* 44 */ "And" OpHelp("r[P3]=(r[P1] && r[P2])"),
+ /* 45 */ "RowSetTest" OpHelp("if r[P3] in rowset(P1) goto P2"),
+ /* 46 */ "Program" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 47 */ "FkIfZero" OpHelp("if fkctr[P1]==0 goto P2"),
+ /* 48 */ "IfPos" OpHelp("if r[P1]>0 then r[P1]-=P3, goto P2"),
+ /* 49 */ "IfNotZero" OpHelp("if r[P1]!=0 then r[P1]--, goto P2"),
+ /* 50 */ "IsNull" OpHelp("if r[P1]==NULL goto P2"),
+ /* 51 */ "NotNull" OpHelp("if r[P1]!=NULL goto P2"),
+ /* 52 */ "Ne" OpHelp("IF r[P3]!=r[P1]"),
+ /* 53 */ "Eq" OpHelp("IF r[P3]==r[P1]"),
+ /* 54 */ "Gt" OpHelp("IF r[P3]>r[P1]"),
+ /* 55 */ "Le" OpHelp("IF r[P3]<=r[P1]"),
+ /* 56 */ "Lt" OpHelp("IF r[P3]=r[P1]"),
+ /* 58 */ "ElseNotEq" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 59 */ "DecrJumpZero" OpHelp("if (--r[P1])==0 goto P2"),
+ /* 60 */ "IncrVacuum" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 61 */ "VNext" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 62 */ "Init" OpHelp("Start at P2"),
+ /* 63 */ "PureFunc" OpHelp("r[P3]=func(r[P2@NP])"),
+ /* 64 */ "Function" OpHelp("r[P3]=func(r[P2@NP])"),
+ /* 65 */ "Return" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 66 */ "EndCoroutine" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 67 */ "HaltIfNull" OpHelp("if r[P3]=null halt"),
+ /* 68 */ "Halt" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 69 */ "Integer" OpHelp("r[P2]=P1"),
+ /* 70 */ "Int64" OpHelp("r[P2]=P4"),
+ /* 71 */ "String" OpHelp("r[P2]='P4' (len=P1)"),
+ /* 72 */ "Null" OpHelp("r[P2..P3]=NULL"),
+ /* 73 */ "SoftNull" OpHelp("r[P1]=NULL"),
+ /* 74 */ "Blob" OpHelp("r[P2]=P4 (len=P1)"),
+ /* 75 */ "Variable" OpHelp("r[P2]=parameter(P1,P4)"),
+ /* 76 */ "Move" OpHelp("r[P2@P3]=r[P1@P3]"),
+ /* 77 */ "Copy" OpHelp("r[P2@P3+1]=r[P1@P3+1]"),
+ /* 78 */ "SCopy" OpHelp("r[P2]=r[P1]"),
+ /* 79 */ "IntCopy" OpHelp("r[P2]=r[P1]"),
+ /* 80 */ "ResultRow" OpHelp("output=r[P1@P2]"),
+ /* 81 */ "CollSeq" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 82 */ "AddImm" OpHelp("r[P1]=r[P1]+P2"),
+ /* 83 */ "RealAffinity" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 84 */ "Cast" OpHelp("affinity(r[P1])"),
+ /* 85 */ "Permutation" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 86 */ "Compare" OpHelp("r[P1@P3] <-> r[P2@P3]"),
+ /* 87 */ "IsTrue" OpHelp("r[P2] = coalesce(r[P1]==TRUE,P3) ^ P4"),
+ /* 88 */ "Offset" OpHelp("r[P3] = sqlite_offset(P1)"),
+ /* 89 */ "Column" OpHelp("r[P3]=PX"),
+ /* 90 */ "Affinity" OpHelp("affinity(r[P1@P2])"),
+ /* 91 */ "MakeRecord" OpHelp("r[P3]=mkrec(r[P1@P2])"),
+ /* 92 */ "Count" OpHelp("r[P2]=count()"),
+ /* 93 */ "ReadCookie" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 94 */ "SetCookie" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 95 */ "ReopenIdx" OpHelp("root=P2 iDb=P3"),
+ /* 96 */ "OpenRead" OpHelp("root=P2 iDb=P3"),
+ /* 97 */ "OpenWrite" OpHelp("root=P2 iDb=P3"),
+ /* 98 */ "OpenDup" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 99 */ "OpenAutoindex" OpHelp("nColumn=P2"),
+ /* 100 */ "OpenEphemeral" OpHelp("nColumn=P2"),
+ /* 101 */ "BitAnd" OpHelp("r[P3]=r[P1]&r[P2]"),
+ /* 102 */ "BitOr" OpHelp("r[P3]=r[P1]|r[P2]"),
+ /* 103 */ "ShiftLeft" OpHelp("r[P3]=r[P2]<>r[P1]"),
+ /* 105 */ "Add" OpHelp("r[P3]=r[P1]+r[P2]"),
+ /* 106 */ "Subtract" OpHelp("r[P3]=r[P2]-r[P1]"),
+ /* 107 */ "Multiply" OpHelp("r[P3]=r[P1]*r[P2]"),
+ /* 108 */ "Divide" OpHelp("r[P3]=r[P2]/r[P1]"),
+ /* 109 */ "Remainder" OpHelp("r[P3]=r[P2]%r[P1]"),
+ /* 110 */ "Concat" OpHelp("r[P3]=r[P2]+r[P1]"),
+ /* 111 */ "SorterOpen" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 112 */ "BitNot" OpHelp("r[P2]= ~r[P1]"),
+ /* 113 */ "SequenceTest" OpHelp("if( cursor[P1].ctr++ ) pc = P2"),
+ /* 114 */ "OpenPseudo" OpHelp("P3 columns in r[P2]"),
+ /* 115 */ "String8" OpHelp("r[P2]='P4'"),
+ /* 116 */ "Close" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 117 */ "ColumnsUsed" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 118 */ "SeekHit" OpHelp("seekHit=P2"),
+ /* 119 */ "Sequence" OpHelp("r[P2]=cursor[P1].ctr++"),
+ /* 120 */ "NewRowid" OpHelp("r[P2]=rowid"),
+ /* 121 */ "Insert" OpHelp("intkey=r[P3] data=r[P2]"),
+ /* 122 */ "Delete" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 123 */ "ResetCount" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 124 */ "SorterCompare" OpHelp("if key(P1)!=trim(r[P3],P4) goto P2"),
+ /* 125 */ "SorterData" OpHelp("r[P2]=data"),
+ /* 126 */ "RowData" OpHelp("r[P2]=data"),
+ /* 127 */ "Rowid" OpHelp("r[P2]=rowid"),
+ /* 128 */ "NullRow" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 129 */ "SeekEnd" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 130 */ "IdxInsert" OpHelp("key=r[P2]"),
+ /* 131 */ "SorterInsert" OpHelp("key=r[P2]"),
+ /* 132 */ "IdxDelete" OpHelp("key=r[P2@P3]"),
+ /* 133 */ "DeferredSeek" OpHelp("Move P3 to P1.rowid if needed"),
+ /* 134 */ "IdxRowid" OpHelp("r[P2]=rowid"),
+ /* 135 */ "FinishSeek" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 136 */ "Destroy" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 137 */ "Clear" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 138 */ "ResetSorter" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 139 */ "CreateBtree" OpHelp("r[P2]=root iDb=P1 flags=P3"),
+ /* 140 */ "SqlExec" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 141 */ "ParseSchema" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 142 */ "LoadAnalysis" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 143 */ "DropTable" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 144 */ "DropIndex" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 145 */ "DropTrigger" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 146 */ "IntegrityCk" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 147 */ "RowSetAdd" OpHelp("rowset(P1)=r[P2]"),
+ /* 148 */ "Param" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 149 */ "FkCounter" OpHelp("fkctr[P1]+=P2"),
+ /* 150 */ "Real" OpHelp("r[P2]=P4"),
+ /* 151 */ "MemMax" OpHelp("r[P1]=max(r[P1],r[P2])"),
+ /* 152 */ "OffsetLimit" OpHelp("if r[P1]>0 then r[P2]=r[P1]+max(0,r[P3]) else r[P2]=(-1)"),
+ /* 153 */ "AggInverse" OpHelp("accum=r[P3] inverse(r[P2@P5])"),
+ /* 154 */ "AggStep" OpHelp("accum=r[P3] step(r[P2@P5])"),
+ /* 155 */ "AggStep1" OpHelp("accum=r[P3] step(r[P2@P5])"),
+ /* 156 */ "AggValue" OpHelp("r[P3]=value N=P2"),
+ /* 157 */ "AggFinal" OpHelp("accum=r[P1] N=P2"),
+ /* 158 */ "Expire" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 159 */ "CursorLock" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 160 */ "CursorUnlock" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 161 */ "TableLock" OpHelp("iDb=P1 root=P2 write=P3"),
+ /* 162 */ "VBegin" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 163 */ "VCreate" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 164 */ "VDestroy" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 165 */ "VOpen" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 166 */ "VColumn" OpHelp("r[P3]=vcolumn(P2)"),
+ /* 167 */ "VRename" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 168 */ "Pagecount" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 169 */ "MaxPgcnt" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 170 */ "Trace" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 171 */ "CursorHint" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 172 */ "ReleaseReg" OpHelp("release r[P1@P2] mask P3"),
+ /* 173 */ "Noop" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 174 */ "Explain" OpHelp(""),
+ /* 175 */ "Abortable" OpHelp(""),
+ };
+ return azName[i];
+}
+#endif
+
+/************** End of opcodes.c *********************************************/
+/************** Begin file os_unix.c *****************************************/
+/*
+** 2004 May 22
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains the VFS implementation for unix-like operating systems
+** include Linux, MacOSX, *BSD, QNX, VxWorks, AIX, HPUX, and others.
+**
+** There are actually several different VFS implementations in this file.
+** The differences are in the way that file locking is done. The default
+** implementation uses Posix Advisory Locks. Alternative implementations
+** use flock(), dot-files, various proprietary locking schemas, or simply
+** skip locking all together.
+**
+** This source file is organized into divisions where the logic for various
+** subfunctions is contained within the appropriate division. PLEASE
+** KEEP THE STRUCTURE OF THIS FILE INTACT. New code should be placed
+** in the correct division and should be clearly labeled.
+**
+** The layout of divisions is as follows:
+**
+** * General-purpose declarations and utility functions.
+** * Unique file ID logic used by VxWorks.
+** * Various locking primitive implementations (all except proxy locking):
+** + for Posix Advisory Locks
+** + for no-op locks
+** + for dot-file locks
+** + for flock() locking
+** + for named semaphore locks (VxWorks only)
+** + for AFP filesystem locks (MacOSX only)
+** * sqlite3_file methods not associated with locking.
+** * Definitions of sqlite3_io_methods objects for all locking
+** methods plus "finder" functions for each locking method.
+** * sqlite3_vfs method implementations.
+** * Locking primitives for the proxy uber-locking-method. (MacOSX only)
+** * Definitions of sqlite3_vfs objects for all locking methods
+** plus implementations of sqlite3_os_init() and sqlite3_os_end().
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+#if SQLITE_OS_UNIX /* This file is used on unix only */
+
+/*
+** There are various methods for file locking used for concurrency
+** control:
+**
+** 1. POSIX locking (the default),
+** 2. No locking,
+** 3. Dot-file locking,
+** 4. flock() locking,
+** 5. AFP locking (OSX only),
+** 6. Named POSIX semaphores (VXWorks only),
+** 7. proxy locking. (OSX only)
+**
+** Styles 4, 5, and 7 are only available of SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+** is defined to 1. The SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE also enables automatic
+** selection of the appropriate locking style based on the filesystem
+** where the database is located.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE)
+# if defined(__APPLE__)
+# define SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE 1
+# else
+# define SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE 0
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/* Use pread() and pwrite() if they are available */
+#if defined(__APPLE__)
+# define HAVE_PREAD 1
+# define HAVE_PWRITE 1
+#endif
+#if defined(HAVE_PREAD64) && defined(HAVE_PWRITE64)
+# undef USE_PREAD
+# define USE_PREAD64 1
+#elif defined(HAVE_PREAD) && defined(HAVE_PWRITE)
+# undef USE_PREAD64
+# define USE_PREAD 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** standard include files.
+*/
+#include
+#include
+#include
+#include
+#include
+/* #include */
+#include
+#include
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+# include
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+/* # include */
+# include
+# include
+#endif /* SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE */
+
+/*
+** Try to determine if gethostuuid() is available based on standard
+** macros. This might sometimes compute the wrong value for some
+** obscure platforms. For those cases, simply compile with one of
+** the following:
+**
+** -DHAVE_GETHOSTUUID=0
+** -DHAVE_GETHOSTUUID=1
+**
+** None if this matters except when building on Apple products with
+** -DSQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE.
+*/
+#ifndef HAVE_GETHOSTUUID
+# define HAVE_GETHOSTUUID 0
+# if defined(__APPLE__) && ((__MAC_OS_X_VERSION_MIN_REQUIRED > 1050) || \
+ (__IPHONE_OS_VERSION_MIN_REQUIRED > 2000))
+# if (!defined(TARGET_OS_EMBEDDED) || (TARGET_OS_EMBEDDED==0)) \
+ && (!defined(TARGET_IPHONE_SIMULATOR) || (TARGET_IPHONE_SIMULATOR==0))
+# undef HAVE_GETHOSTUUID
+# define HAVE_GETHOSTUUID 1
+# else
+# warning "gethostuuid() is disabled."
+# endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+/* # include */
+# include
+# include
+#endif /* OS_VXWORKS */
+
+#if defined(__APPLE__) || SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+# include
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_UTIME
+# include
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Allowed values of unixFile.fsFlags
+*/
+#define SQLITE_FSFLAGS_IS_MSDOS 0x1
+
+/*
+** If we are to be thread-safe, include the pthreads header.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+/* # include */
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Default permissions when creating a new file
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_PERMISSIONS
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_PERMISSIONS 0644
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Default permissions when creating auto proxy dir
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_PROXYDIR_PERMISSIONS
+# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_PROXYDIR_PERMISSIONS 0755
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Maximum supported path-length.
+*/
+#define MAX_PATHNAME 512
+
+/*
+** Maximum supported symbolic links
+*/
+#define SQLITE_MAX_SYMLINKS 100
+
+/* Always cast the getpid() return type for compatibility with
+** kernel modules in VxWorks. */
+#define osGetpid(X) (pid_t)getpid()
+
+/*
+** Only set the lastErrno if the error code is a real error and not
+** a normal expected return code of SQLITE_BUSY or SQLITE_OK
+*/
+#define IS_LOCK_ERROR(x) ((x != SQLITE_OK) && (x != SQLITE_BUSY))
+
+/* Forward references */
+typedef struct unixShm unixShm; /* Connection shared memory */
+typedef struct unixShmNode unixShmNode; /* Shared memory instance */
+typedef struct unixInodeInfo unixInodeInfo; /* An i-node */
+typedef struct UnixUnusedFd UnixUnusedFd; /* An unused file descriptor */
+
+/*
+** Sometimes, after a file handle is closed by SQLite, the file descriptor
+** cannot be closed immediately. In these cases, instances of the following
+** structure are used to store the file descriptor while waiting for an
+** opportunity to either close or reuse it.
+*/
+struct UnixUnusedFd {
+ int fd; /* File descriptor to close */
+ int flags; /* Flags this file descriptor was opened with */
+ UnixUnusedFd *pNext; /* Next unused file descriptor on same file */
+};
+
+/*
+** The unixFile structure is subclass of sqlite3_file specific to the unix
+** VFS implementations.
+*/
+typedef struct unixFile unixFile;
+struct unixFile {
+ sqlite3_io_methods const *pMethod; /* Always the first entry */
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs; /* The VFS that created this unixFile */
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode; /* Info about locks on this inode */
+ int h; /* The file descriptor */
+ unsigned char eFileLock; /* The type of lock held on this fd */
+ unsigned short int ctrlFlags; /* Behavioral bits. UNIXFILE_* flags */
+ int lastErrno; /* The unix errno from last I/O error */
+ void *lockingContext; /* Locking style specific state */
+ UnixUnusedFd *pPreallocatedUnused; /* Pre-allocated UnixUnusedFd */
+ const char *zPath; /* Name of the file */
+ unixShm *pShm; /* Shared memory segment information */
+ int szChunk; /* Configured by FCNTL_CHUNK_SIZE */
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ int nFetchOut; /* Number of outstanding xFetch refs */
+ sqlite3_int64 mmapSize; /* Usable size of mapping at pMapRegion */
+ sqlite3_int64 mmapSizeActual; /* Actual size of mapping at pMapRegion */
+ sqlite3_int64 mmapSizeMax; /* Configured FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE value */
+ void *pMapRegion; /* Memory mapped region */
+#endif
+ int sectorSize; /* Device sector size */
+ int deviceCharacteristics; /* Precomputed device characteristics */
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ int openFlags; /* The flags specified at open() */
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE || defined(__APPLE__)
+ unsigned fsFlags; /* cached details from statfs() */
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_SETLK_TIMEOUT
+ unsigned iBusyTimeout; /* Wait this many millisec on locks */
+#endif
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ struct vxworksFileId *pId; /* Unique file ID */
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ /* The next group of variables are used to track whether or not the
+ ** transaction counter in bytes 24-27 of database files are updated
+ ** whenever any part of the database changes. An assertion fault will
+ ** occur if a file is updated without also updating the transaction
+ ** counter. This test is made to avoid new problems similar to the
+ ** one described by ticket #3584.
+ */
+ unsigned char transCntrChng; /* True if the transaction counter changed */
+ unsigned char dbUpdate; /* True if any part of database file changed */
+ unsigned char inNormalWrite; /* True if in a normal write operation */
+
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ /* In test mode, increase the size of this structure a bit so that
+ ** it is larger than the struct CrashFile defined in test6.c.
+ */
+ char aPadding[32];
+#endif
+};
+
+/* This variable holds the process id (pid) from when the xRandomness()
+** method was called. If xOpen() is called from a different process id,
+** indicating that a fork() has occurred, the PRNG will be reset.
+*/
+static pid_t randomnessPid = 0;
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for the unixFile.ctrlFlags bitmask:
+*/
+#define UNIXFILE_EXCL 0x01 /* Connections from one process only */
+#define UNIXFILE_RDONLY 0x02 /* Connection is read only */
+#define UNIXFILE_PERSIST_WAL 0x04 /* Persistent WAL mode */
+#ifndef SQLITE_DISABLE_DIRSYNC
+# define UNIXFILE_DIRSYNC 0x08 /* Directory sync needed */
+#else
+# define UNIXFILE_DIRSYNC 0x00
+#endif
+#define UNIXFILE_PSOW 0x10 /* SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE */
+#define UNIXFILE_DELETE 0x20 /* Delete on close */
+#define UNIXFILE_URI 0x40 /* Filename might have query parameters */
+#define UNIXFILE_NOLOCK 0x80 /* Do no file locking */
+
+/*
+** Include code that is common to all os_*.c files
+*/
+/************** Include os_common.h in the middle of os_unix.c ***************/
+/************** Begin file os_common.h ***************************************/
+/*
+** 2004 May 22
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains macros and a little bit of code that is common to
+** all of the platform-specific files (os_*.c) and is #included into those
+** files.
+**
+** This file should be #included by the os_*.c files only. It is not a
+** general purpose header file.
+*/
+#ifndef _OS_COMMON_H_
+#define _OS_COMMON_H_
+
+/*
+** At least two bugs have slipped in because we changed the MEMORY_DEBUG
+** macro to SQLITE_DEBUG and some older makefiles have not yet made the
+** switch. The following code should catch this problem at compile-time.
+*/
+#ifdef MEMORY_DEBUG
+# error "The MEMORY_DEBUG macro is obsolete. Use SQLITE_DEBUG instead."
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Macros for performance tracing. Normally turned off. Only works
+** on i486 hardware.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_PERFORMANCE_TRACE
+
+/*
+** hwtime.h contains inline assembler code for implementing
+** high-performance timing routines.
+*/
+/************** Include hwtime.h in the middle of os_common.h ****************/
+/************** Begin file hwtime.h ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 May 27
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains inline asm code for retrieving "high-performance"
+** counters for x86 and x86_64 class CPUs.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_HWTIME_H
+#define SQLITE_HWTIME_H
+
+/*
+** The following routine only works on pentium-class (or newer) processors.
+** It uses the RDTSC opcode to read the cycle count value out of the
+** processor and returns that value. This can be used for high-res
+** profiling.
+*/
+#if !defined(__STRICT_ANSI__) && \
+ (defined(__GNUC__) || defined(_MSC_VER)) && \
+ (defined(i386) || defined(__i386__) || defined(_M_IX86))
+
+ #if defined(__GNUC__)
+
+ __inline__ sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ unsigned int lo, hi;
+ __asm__ __volatile__ ("rdtsc" : "=a" (lo), "=d" (hi));
+ return (sqlite_uint64)hi << 32 | lo;
+ }
+
+ #elif defined(_MSC_VER)
+
+ __declspec(naked) __inline sqlite_uint64 __cdecl sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ __asm {
+ rdtsc
+ ret ; return value at EDX:EAX
+ }
+ }
+
+ #endif
+
+#elif !defined(__STRICT_ANSI__) && (defined(__GNUC__) && defined(__x86_64__))
+
+ __inline__ sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ unsigned long val;
+ __asm__ __volatile__ ("rdtsc" : "=A" (val));
+ return val;
+ }
+
+#elif !defined(__STRICT_ANSI__) && (defined(__GNUC__) && defined(__ppc__))
+
+ __inline__ sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ unsigned long long retval;
+ unsigned long junk;
+ __asm__ __volatile__ ("\n\
+ 1: mftbu %1\n\
+ mftb %L0\n\
+ mftbu %0\n\
+ cmpw %0,%1\n\
+ bne 1b"
+ : "=r" (retval), "=r" (junk));
+ return retval;
+ }
+
+#else
+
+ /*
+ ** asm() is needed for hardware timing support. Without asm(),
+ ** disable the sqlite3Hwtime() routine.
+ **
+ ** sqlite3Hwtime() is only used for some obscure debugging
+ ** and analysis configurations, not in any deliverable, so this
+ ** should not be a great loss.
+ */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){ return ((sqlite_uint64)0); }
+
+#endif
+
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_HWTIME_H) */
+
+/************** End of hwtime.h **********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in os_common.h ******************/
+
+static sqlite_uint64 g_start;
+static sqlite_uint64 g_elapsed;
+#define TIMER_START g_start=sqlite3Hwtime()
+#define TIMER_END g_elapsed=sqlite3Hwtime()-g_start
+#define TIMER_ELAPSED g_elapsed
+#else
+#define TIMER_START
+#define TIMER_END
+#define TIMER_ELAPSED ((sqlite_uint64)0)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** If we compile with the SQLITE_TEST macro set, then the following block
+** of code will give us the ability to simulate a disk I/O error. This
+** is used for testing the I/O recovery logic.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_hit;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_hardhit;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_pending;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_persist;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_benign;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_diskfull_pending;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_diskfull;
+#define SimulateIOErrorBenign(X) sqlite3_io_error_benign=(X)
+#define SimulateIOError(CODE) \
+ if( (sqlite3_io_error_persist && sqlite3_io_error_hit) \
+ || sqlite3_io_error_pending-- == 1 ) \
+ { local_ioerr(); CODE; }
+static void local_ioerr(){
+ IOTRACE(("IOERR\n"));
+ sqlite3_io_error_hit++;
+ if( !sqlite3_io_error_benign ) sqlite3_io_error_hardhit++;
+}
+#define SimulateDiskfullError(CODE) \
+ if( sqlite3_diskfull_pending ){ \
+ if( sqlite3_diskfull_pending == 1 ){ \
+ local_ioerr(); \
+ sqlite3_diskfull = 1; \
+ sqlite3_io_error_hit = 1; \
+ CODE; \
+ }else{ \
+ sqlite3_diskfull_pending--; \
+ } \
+ }
+#else
+#define SimulateIOErrorBenign(X)
+#define SimulateIOError(A)
+#define SimulateDiskfullError(A)
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_TEST) */
+
+/*
+** When testing, keep a count of the number of open files.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_open_file_count;
+#define OpenCounter(X) sqlite3_open_file_count+=(X)
+#else
+#define OpenCounter(X)
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_TEST) */
+
+#endif /* !defined(_OS_COMMON_H_) */
+
+/************** End of os_common.h *******************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in os_unix.c ********************/
+
+/*
+** Define various macros that are missing from some systems.
+*/
+#ifndef O_LARGEFILE
+# define O_LARGEFILE 0
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DISABLE_LFS
+# undef O_LARGEFILE
+# define O_LARGEFILE 0
+#endif
+#ifndef O_NOFOLLOW
+# define O_NOFOLLOW 0
+#endif
+#ifndef O_BINARY
+# define O_BINARY 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The threadid macro resolves to the thread-id or to 0. Used for
+** testing and debugging only.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+#define threadid pthread_self()
+#else
+#define threadid 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** HAVE_MREMAP defaults to true on Linux and false everywhere else.
+*/
+#if !defined(HAVE_MREMAP)
+# if defined(__linux__) && defined(_GNU_SOURCE)
+# define HAVE_MREMAP 1
+# else
+# define HAVE_MREMAP 0
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Explicitly call the 64-bit version of lseek() on Android. Otherwise, lseek()
+** is the 32-bit version, even if _FILE_OFFSET_BITS=64 is defined.
+*/
+#ifdef __ANDROID__
+# define lseek lseek64
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __linux__
+/*
+** Linux-specific IOCTL magic numbers used for controlling F2FS
+*/
+#define F2FS_IOCTL_MAGIC 0xf5
+#define F2FS_IOC_START_ATOMIC_WRITE _IO(F2FS_IOCTL_MAGIC, 1)
+#define F2FS_IOC_COMMIT_ATOMIC_WRITE _IO(F2FS_IOCTL_MAGIC, 2)
+#define F2FS_IOC_START_VOLATILE_WRITE _IO(F2FS_IOCTL_MAGIC, 3)
+#define F2FS_IOC_ABORT_VOLATILE_WRITE _IO(F2FS_IOCTL_MAGIC, 5)
+#define F2FS_IOC_GET_FEATURES _IOR(F2FS_IOCTL_MAGIC, 12, u32)
+#define F2FS_FEATURE_ATOMIC_WRITE 0x0004
+#endif /* __linux__ */
+
+
+/*
+** Different Unix systems declare open() in different ways. Same use
+** open(const char*,int,mode_t). Others use open(const char*,int,...).
+** The difference is important when using a pointer to the function.
+**
+** The safest way to deal with the problem is to always use this wrapper
+** which always has the same well-defined interface.
+*/
+static int posixOpen(const char *zFile, int flags, int mode){
+ return open(zFile, flags, mode);
+}
+
+/* Forward reference */
+static int openDirectory(const char*, int*);
+static int unixGetpagesize(void);
+
+/*
+** Many system calls are accessed through pointer-to-functions so that
+** they may be overridden at runtime to facilitate fault injection during
+** testing and sandboxing. The following array holds the names and pointers
+** to all overrideable system calls.
+*/
+static struct unix_syscall {
+ const char *zName; /* Name of the system call */
+ sqlite3_syscall_ptr pCurrent; /* Current value of the system call */
+ sqlite3_syscall_ptr pDefault; /* Default value */
+} aSyscall[] = {
+ { "open", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)posixOpen, 0 },
+#define osOpen ((int(*)(const char*,int,int))aSyscall[0].pCurrent)
+
+ { "close", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)close, 0 },
+#define osClose ((int(*)(int))aSyscall[1].pCurrent)
+
+ { "access", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)access, 0 },
+#define osAccess ((int(*)(const char*,int))aSyscall[2].pCurrent)
+
+ { "getcwd", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)getcwd, 0 },
+#define osGetcwd ((char*(*)(char*,size_t))aSyscall[3].pCurrent)
+
+ { "stat", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)stat, 0 },
+#define osStat ((int(*)(const char*,struct stat*))aSyscall[4].pCurrent)
+
+/*
+** The DJGPP compiler environment looks mostly like Unix, but it
+** lacks the fcntl() system call. So redefine fcntl() to be something
+** that always succeeds. This means that locking does not occur under
+** DJGPP. But it is DOS - what did you expect?
+*/
+#ifdef __DJGPP__
+ { "fstat", 0, 0 },
+#define osFstat(a,b,c) 0
+#else
+ { "fstat", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)fstat, 0 },
+#define osFstat ((int(*)(int,struct stat*))aSyscall[5].pCurrent)
+#endif
+
+ { "ftruncate", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)ftruncate, 0 },
+#define osFtruncate ((int(*)(int,off_t))aSyscall[6].pCurrent)
+
+ { "fcntl", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)fcntl, 0 },
+#define osFcntl ((int(*)(int,int,...))aSyscall[7].pCurrent)
+
+ { "read", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)read, 0 },
+#define osRead ((ssize_t(*)(int,void*,size_t))aSyscall[8].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(USE_PREAD) || SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ { "pread", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)pread, 0 },
+#else
+ { "pread", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osPread ((ssize_t(*)(int,void*,size_t,off_t))aSyscall[9].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(USE_PREAD64)
+ { "pread64", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)pread64, 0 },
+#else
+ { "pread64", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osPread64 ((ssize_t(*)(int,void*,size_t,off64_t))aSyscall[10].pCurrent)
+
+ { "write", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)write, 0 },
+#define osWrite ((ssize_t(*)(int,const void*,size_t))aSyscall[11].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(USE_PREAD) || SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ { "pwrite", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)pwrite, 0 },
+#else
+ { "pwrite", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osPwrite ((ssize_t(*)(int,const void*,size_t,off_t))\
+ aSyscall[12].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(USE_PREAD64)
+ { "pwrite64", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)pwrite64, 0 },
+#else
+ { "pwrite64", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osPwrite64 ((ssize_t(*)(int,const void*,size_t,off64_t))\
+ aSyscall[13].pCurrent)
+
+ { "fchmod", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)fchmod, 0 },
+#define osFchmod ((int(*)(int,mode_t))aSyscall[14].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(HAVE_POSIX_FALLOCATE) && HAVE_POSIX_FALLOCATE
+ { "fallocate", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)posix_fallocate, 0 },
+#else
+ { "fallocate", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osFallocate ((int(*)(int,off_t,off_t))aSyscall[15].pCurrent)
+
+ { "unlink", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)unlink, 0 },
+#define osUnlink ((int(*)(const char*))aSyscall[16].pCurrent)
+
+ { "openDirectory", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)openDirectory, 0 },
+#define osOpenDirectory ((int(*)(const char*,int*))aSyscall[17].pCurrent)
+
+ { "mkdir", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)mkdir, 0 },
+#define osMkdir ((int(*)(const char*,mode_t))aSyscall[18].pCurrent)
+
+ { "rmdir", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)rmdir, 0 },
+#define osRmdir ((int(*)(const char*))aSyscall[19].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(HAVE_FCHOWN)
+ { "fchown", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)fchown, 0 },
+#else
+ { "fchown", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osFchown ((int(*)(int,uid_t,gid_t))aSyscall[20].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(HAVE_FCHOWN)
+ { "geteuid", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)geteuid, 0 },
+#else
+ { "geteuid", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osGeteuid ((uid_t(*)(void))aSyscall[21].pCurrent)
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ { "mmap", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)mmap, 0 },
+#else
+ { "mmap", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osMmap ((void*(*)(void*,size_t,int,int,int,off_t))aSyscall[22].pCurrent)
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ { "munmap", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)munmap, 0 },
+#else
+ { "munmap", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osMunmap ((int(*)(void*,size_t))aSyscall[23].pCurrent)
+
+#if HAVE_MREMAP && (!defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0)
+ { "mremap", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)mremap, 0 },
+#else
+ { "mremap", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osMremap ((void*(*)(void*,size_t,size_t,int,...))aSyscall[24].pCurrent)
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ { "getpagesize", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)unixGetpagesize, 0 },
+#else
+ { "getpagesize", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osGetpagesize ((int(*)(void))aSyscall[25].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(HAVE_READLINK)
+ { "readlink", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)readlink, 0 },
+#else
+ { "readlink", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osReadlink ((ssize_t(*)(const char*,char*,size_t))aSyscall[26].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(HAVE_LSTAT)
+ { "lstat", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)lstat, 0 },
+#else
+ { "lstat", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+#define osLstat ((int(*)(const char*,struct stat*))aSyscall[27].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(__linux__) && defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE)
+# ifdef __ANDROID__
+ { "ioctl", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)(int(*)(int, int, ...))ioctl, 0 },
+#define osIoctl ((int(*)(int,int,...))aSyscall[28].pCurrent)
+# else
+ { "ioctl", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)ioctl, 0 },
+#define osIoctl ((int(*)(int,unsigned long,...))aSyscall[28].pCurrent)
+# endif
+#else
+ { "ioctl", (sqlite3_syscall_ptr)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+}; /* End of the overrideable system calls */
+
+
+/*
+** On some systems, calls to fchown() will trigger a message in a security
+** log if they come from non-root processes. So avoid calling fchown() if
+** we are not running as root.
+*/
+static int robustFchown(int fd, uid_t uid, gid_t gid){
+#if defined(HAVE_FCHOWN)
+ return osGeteuid() ? 0 : osFchown(fd,uid,gid);
+#else
+ return 0;
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** This is the xSetSystemCall() method of sqlite3_vfs for all of the
+** "unix" VFSes. Return SQLITE_OK opon successfully updating the
+** system call pointer, or SQLITE_NOTFOUND if there is no configurable
+** system call named zName.
+*/
+static int unixSetSystemCall(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pNotUsed, /* The VFS pointer. Not used */
+ const char *zName, /* Name of system call to override */
+ sqlite3_syscall_ptr pNewFunc /* Pointer to new system call value */
+){
+ unsigned int i;
+ int rc = SQLITE_NOTFOUND;
+
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pNotUsed);
+ if( zName==0 ){
+ /* If no zName is given, restore all system calls to their default
+ ** settings and return NULL
+ */
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ for(i=0; i=SQLITE_MINIMUM_FILE_DESCRIPTOR ) break;
+ osClose(fd);
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_WARNING,
+ "attempt to open \"%s\" as file descriptor %d", z, fd);
+ fd = -1;
+ if( osOpen("/dev/null", O_RDONLY, m)<0 ) break;
+ }
+ if( fd>=0 ){
+ if( m!=0 ){
+ struct stat statbuf;
+ if( osFstat(fd, &statbuf)==0
+ && statbuf.st_size==0
+ && (statbuf.st_mode&0777)!=m
+ ){
+ osFchmod(fd, m);
+ }
+ }
+#if defined(FD_CLOEXEC) && (!defined(O_CLOEXEC) || O_CLOEXEC==0)
+ osFcntl(fd, F_SETFD, osFcntl(fd, F_GETFD, 0) | FD_CLOEXEC);
+#endif
+ }
+ return fd;
+}
+
+/*
+** Helper functions to obtain and relinquish the global mutex. The
+** global mutex is used to protect the unixInodeInfo and
+** vxworksFileId objects used by this file, all of which may be
+** shared by multiple threads.
+**
+** Function unixMutexHeld() is used to assert() that the global mutex
+** is held when required. This function is only used as part of assert()
+** statements. e.g.
+**
+** unixEnterMutex()
+** assert( unixMutexHeld() );
+** unixEnterLeave()
+**
+** To prevent deadlock, the global unixBigLock must must be acquired
+** before the unixInodeInfo.pLockMutex mutex, if both are held. It is
+** OK to get the pLockMutex without holding unixBigLock first, but if
+** that happens, the unixBigLock mutex must not be acquired until after
+** pLockMutex is released.
+**
+** OK: enter(unixBigLock), enter(pLockInfo)
+** OK: enter(unixBigLock)
+** OK: enter(pLockInfo)
+** ERROR: enter(pLockInfo), enter(unixBigLock)
+*/
+static sqlite3_mutex *unixBigLock = 0;
+static void unixEnterMutex(void){
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_notheld(unixBigLock) ); /* Not a recursive mutex */
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(unixBigLock);
+}
+static void unixLeaveMutex(void){
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(unixBigLock) );
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(unixBigLock);
+}
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+static int unixMutexHeld(void) {
+ return sqlite3_mutex_held(unixBigLock);
+}
+#endif
+
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_HAVE_OS_TRACE
+/*
+** Helper function for printing out trace information from debugging
+** binaries. This returns the string representation of the supplied
+** integer lock-type.
+*/
+static const char *azFileLock(int eFileLock){
+ switch( eFileLock ){
+ case NO_LOCK: return "NONE";
+ case SHARED_LOCK: return "SHARED";
+ case RESERVED_LOCK: return "RESERVED";
+ case PENDING_LOCK: return "PENDING";
+ case EXCLUSIVE_LOCK: return "EXCLUSIVE";
+ }
+ return "ERROR";
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_LOCK_TRACE
+/*
+** Print out information about all locking operations.
+**
+** This routine is used for troubleshooting locks on multithreaded
+** platforms. Enable by compiling with the -DSQLITE_LOCK_TRACE
+** command-line option on the compiler. This code is normally
+** turned off.
+*/
+static int lockTrace(int fd, int op, struct flock *p){
+ char *zOpName, *zType;
+ int s;
+ int savedErrno;
+ if( op==F_GETLK ){
+ zOpName = "GETLK";
+ }else if( op==F_SETLK ){
+ zOpName = "SETLK";
+ }else{
+ s = osFcntl(fd, op, p);
+ sqlite3DebugPrintf("fcntl unknown %d %d %d\n", fd, op, s);
+ return s;
+ }
+ if( p->l_type==F_RDLCK ){
+ zType = "RDLCK";
+ }else if( p->l_type==F_WRLCK ){
+ zType = "WRLCK";
+ }else if( p->l_type==F_UNLCK ){
+ zType = "UNLCK";
+ }else{
+ assert( 0 );
+ }
+ assert( p->l_whence==SEEK_SET );
+ s = osFcntl(fd, op, p);
+ savedErrno = errno;
+ sqlite3DebugPrintf("fcntl %d %d %s %s %d %d %d %d\n",
+ threadid, fd, zOpName, zType, (int)p->l_start, (int)p->l_len,
+ (int)p->l_pid, s);
+ if( s==(-1) && op==F_SETLK && (p->l_type==F_RDLCK || p->l_type==F_WRLCK) ){
+ struct flock l2;
+ l2 = *p;
+ osFcntl(fd, F_GETLK, &l2);
+ if( l2.l_type==F_RDLCK ){
+ zType = "RDLCK";
+ }else if( l2.l_type==F_WRLCK ){
+ zType = "WRLCK";
+ }else if( l2.l_type==F_UNLCK ){
+ zType = "UNLCK";
+ }else{
+ assert( 0 );
+ }
+ sqlite3DebugPrintf("fcntl-failure-reason: %s %d %d %d\n",
+ zType, (int)l2.l_start, (int)l2.l_len, (int)l2.l_pid);
+ }
+ errno = savedErrno;
+ return s;
+}
+#undef osFcntl
+#define osFcntl lockTrace
+#endif /* SQLITE_LOCK_TRACE */
+
+/*
+** Retry ftruncate() calls that fail due to EINTR
+**
+** All calls to ftruncate() within this file should be made through
+** this wrapper. On the Android platform, bypassing the logic below
+** could lead to a corrupt database.
+*/
+static int robust_ftruncate(int h, sqlite3_int64 sz){
+ int rc;
+#ifdef __ANDROID__
+ /* On Android, ftruncate() always uses 32-bit offsets, even if
+ ** _FILE_OFFSET_BITS=64 is defined. This means it is unsafe to attempt to
+ ** truncate a file to any size larger than 2GiB. Silently ignore any
+ ** such attempts. */
+ if( sz>(sqlite3_int64)0x7FFFFFFF ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else
+#endif
+ do{ rc = osFtruncate(h,sz); }while( rc<0 && errno==EINTR );
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This routine translates a standard POSIX errno code into something
+** useful to the clients of the sqlite3 functions. Specifically, it is
+** intended to translate a variety of "try again" errors into SQLITE_BUSY
+** and a variety of "please close the file descriptor NOW" errors into
+** SQLITE_IOERR
+**
+** Errors during initialization of locks, or file system support for locks,
+** should handle ENOLCK, ENOTSUP, EOPNOTSUPP separately.
+*/
+static int sqliteErrorFromPosixError(int posixError, int sqliteIOErr) {
+ assert( (sqliteIOErr == SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK) ||
+ (sqliteIOErr == SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK) ||
+ (sqliteIOErr == SQLITE_IOERR_RDLOCK) ||
+ (sqliteIOErr == SQLITE_IOERR_CHECKRESERVEDLOCK) );
+ switch (posixError) {
+ case EACCES:
+ case EAGAIN:
+ case ETIMEDOUT:
+ case EBUSY:
+ case EINTR:
+ case ENOLCK:
+ /* random NFS retry error, unless during file system support
+ * introspection, in which it actually means what it says */
+ return SQLITE_BUSY;
+
+ case EPERM:
+ return SQLITE_PERM;
+
+ default:
+ return sqliteIOErr;
+ }
+}
+
+
+/******************************************************************************
+****************** Begin Unique File ID Utility Used By VxWorks ***************
+**
+** On most versions of unix, we can get a unique ID for a file by concatenating
+** the device number and the inode number. But this does not work on VxWorks.
+** On VxWorks, a unique file id must be based on the canonical filename.
+**
+** A pointer to an instance of the following structure can be used as a
+** unique file ID in VxWorks. Each instance of this structure contains
+** a copy of the canonical filename. There is also a reference count.
+** The structure is reclaimed when the number of pointers to it drops to
+** zero.
+**
+** There are never very many files open at one time and lookups are not
+** a performance-critical path, so it is sufficient to put these
+** structures on a linked list.
+*/
+struct vxworksFileId {
+ struct vxworksFileId *pNext; /* Next in a list of them all */
+ int nRef; /* Number of references to this one */
+ int nName; /* Length of the zCanonicalName[] string */
+ char *zCanonicalName; /* Canonical filename */
+};
+
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+/*
+** All unique filenames are held on a linked list headed by this
+** variable:
+*/
+static struct vxworksFileId *vxworksFileList = 0;
+
+/*
+** Simplify a filename into its canonical form
+** by making the following changes:
+**
+** * removing any trailing and duplicate /
+** * convert /./ into just /
+** * convert /A/../ where A is any simple name into just /
+**
+** Changes are made in-place. Return the new name length.
+**
+** The original filename is in z[0..n-1]. Return the number of
+** characters in the simplified name.
+*/
+static int vxworksSimplifyName(char *z, int n){
+ int i, j;
+ while( n>1 && z[n-1]=='/' ){ n--; }
+ for(i=j=0; i0 && z[j-1]!='/' ){ j--; }
+ if( j>0 ){ j--; }
+ i += 2;
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+ z[j++] = z[i];
+ }
+ z[j] = 0;
+ return j;
+}
+
+/*
+** Find a unique file ID for the given absolute pathname. Return
+** a pointer to the vxworksFileId object. This pointer is the unique
+** file ID.
+**
+** The nRef field of the vxworksFileId object is incremented before
+** the object is returned. A new vxworksFileId object is created
+** and added to the global list if necessary.
+**
+** If a memory allocation error occurs, return NULL.
+*/
+static struct vxworksFileId *vxworksFindFileId(const char *zAbsoluteName){
+ struct vxworksFileId *pNew; /* search key and new file ID */
+ struct vxworksFileId *pCandidate; /* For looping over existing file IDs */
+ int n; /* Length of zAbsoluteName string */
+
+ assert( zAbsoluteName[0]=='/' );
+ n = (int)strlen(zAbsoluteName);
+ pNew = sqlite3_malloc64( sizeof(*pNew) + (n+1) );
+ if( pNew==0 ) return 0;
+ pNew->zCanonicalName = (char*)&pNew[1];
+ memcpy(pNew->zCanonicalName, zAbsoluteName, n+1);
+ n = vxworksSimplifyName(pNew->zCanonicalName, n);
+
+ /* Search for an existing entry that matching the canonical name.
+ ** If found, increment the reference count and return a pointer to
+ ** the existing file ID.
+ */
+ unixEnterMutex();
+ for(pCandidate=vxworksFileList; pCandidate; pCandidate=pCandidate->pNext){
+ if( pCandidate->nName==n
+ && memcmp(pCandidate->zCanonicalName, pNew->zCanonicalName, n)==0
+ ){
+ sqlite3_free(pNew);
+ pCandidate->nRef++;
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+ return pCandidate;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* No match was found. We will make a new file ID */
+ pNew->nRef = 1;
+ pNew->nName = n;
+ pNew->pNext = vxworksFileList;
+ vxworksFileList = pNew;
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+ return pNew;
+}
+
+/*
+** Decrement the reference count on a vxworksFileId object. Free
+** the object when the reference count reaches zero.
+*/
+static void vxworksReleaseFileId(struct vxworksFileId *pId){
+ unixEnterMutex();
+ assert( pId->nRef>0 );
+ pId->nRef--;
+ if( pId->nRef==0 ){
+ struct vxworksFileId **pp;
+ for(pp=&vxworksFileList; *pp && *pp!=pId; pp = &((*pp)->pNext)){}
+ assert( *pp==pId );
+ *pp = pId->pNext;
+ sqlite3_free(pId);
+ }
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+}
+#endif /* OS_VXWORKS */
+/*************** End of Unique File ID Utility Used By VxWorks ****************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+
+/******************************************************************************
+*************************** Posix Advisory Locking ****************************
+**
+** POSIX advisory locks are broken by design. ANSI STD 1003.1 (1996)
+** section 6.5.2.2 lines 483 through 490 specify that when a process
+** sets or clears a lock, that operation overrides any prior locks set
+** by the same process. It does not explicitly say so, but this implies
+** that it overrides locks set by the same process using a different
+** file descriptor. Consider this test case:
+**
+** int fd1 = open("./file1", O_RDWR|O_CREAT, 0644);
+** int fd2 = open("./file2", O_RDWR|O_CREAT, 0644);
+**
+** Suppose ./file1 and ./file2 are really the same file (because
+** one is a hard or symbolic link to the other) then if you set
+** an exclusive lock on fd1, then try to get an exclusive lock
+** on fd2, it works. I would have expected the second lock to
+** fail since there was already a lock on the file due to fd1.
+** But not so. Since both locks came from the same process, the
+** second overrides the first, even though they were on different
+** file descriptors opened on different file names.
+**
+** This means that we cannot use POSIX locks to synchronize file access
+** among competing threads of the same process. POSIX locks will work fine
+** to synchronize access for threads in separate processes, but not
+** threads within the same process.
+**
+** To work around the problem, SQLite has to manage file locks internally
+** on its own. Whenever a new database is opened, we have to find the
+** specific inode of the database file (the inode is determined by the
+** st_dev and st_ino fields of the stat structure that fstat() fills in)
+** and check for locks already existing on that inode. When locks are
+** created or removed, we have to look at our own internal record of the
+** locks to see if another thread has previously set a lock on that same
+** inode.
+**
+** (Aside: The use of inode numbers as unique IDs does not work on VxWorks.
+** For VxWorks, we have to use the alternative unique ID system based on
+** canonical filename and implemented in the previous division.)
+**
+** The sqlite3_file structure for POSIX is no longer just an integer file
+** descriptor. It is now a structure that holds the integer file
+** descriptor and a pointer to a structure that describes the internal
+** locks on the corresponding inode. There is one locking structure
+** per inode, so if the same inode is opened twice, both unixFile structures
+** point to the same locking structure. The locking structure keeps
+** a reference count (so we will know when to delete it) and a "cnt"
+** field that tells us its internal lock status. cnt==0 means the
+** file is unlocked. cnt==-1 means the file has an exclusive lock.
+** cnt>0 means there are cnt shared locks on the file.
+**
+** Any attempt to lock or unlock a file first checks the locking
+** structure. The fcntl() system call is only invoked to set a
+** POSIX lock if the internal lock structure transitions between
+** a locked and an unlocked state.
+**
+** But wait: there are yet more problems with POSIX advisory locks.
+**
+** If you close a file descriptor that points to a file that has locks,
+** all locks on that file that are owned by the current process are
+** released. To work around this problem, each unixInodeInfo object
+** maintains a count of the number of pending locks on tha inode.
+** When an attempt is made to close an unixFile, if there are
+** other unixFile open on the same inode that are holding locks, the call
+** to close() the file descriptor is deferred until all of the locks clear.
+** The unixInodeInfo structure keeps a list of file descriptors that need to
+** be closed and that list is walked (and cleared) when the last lock
+** clears.
+**
+** Yet another problem: LinuxThreads do not play well with posix locks.
+**
+** Many older versions of linux use the LinuxThreads library which is
+** not posix compliant. Under LinuxThreads, a lock created by thread
+** A cannot be modified or overridden by a different thread B.
+** Only thread A can modify the lock. Locking behavior is correct
+** if the appliation uses the newer Native Posix Thread Library (NPTL)
+** on linux - with NPTL a lock created by thread A can override locks
+** in thread B. But there is no way to know at compile-time which
+** threading library is being used. So there is no way to know at
+** compile-time whether or not thread A can override locks on thread B.
+** One has to do a run-time check to discover the behavior of the
+** current process.
+**
+** SQLite used to support LinuxThreads. But support for LinuxThreads
+** was dropped beginning with version 3.7.0. SQLite will still work with
+** LinuxThreads provided that (1) there is no more than one connection
+** per database file in the same process and (2) database connections
+** do not move across threads.
+*/
+
+/*
+** An instance of the following structure serves as the key used
+** to locate a particular unixInodeInfo object.
+*/
+struct unixFileId {
+ dev_t dev; /* Device number */
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ struct vxworksFileId *pId; /* Unique file ID for vxworks. */
+#else
+ /* We are told that some versions of Android contain a bug that
+ ** sizes ino_t at only 32-bits instead of 64-bits. (See
+ ** https://android-review.googlesource.com/#/c/115351/3/dist/sqlite3.c)
+ ** To work around this, always allocate 64-bits for the inode number.
+ ** On small machines that only have 32-bit inodes, this wastes 4 bytes,
+ ** but that should not be a big deal. */
+ /* WAS: ino_t ino; */
+ u64 ino; /* Inode number */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** An instance of the following structure is allocated for each open
+** inode.
+**
+** A single inode can have multiple file descriptors, so each unixFile
+** structure contains a pointer to an instance of this object and this
+** object keeps a count of the number of unixFile pointing to it.
+**
+** Mutex rules:
+**
+** (1) Only the pLockMutex mutex must be held in order to read or write
+** any of the locking fields:
+** nShared, nLock, eFileLock, bProcessLock, pUnused
+**
+** (2) When nRef>0, then the following fields are unchanging and can
+** be read (but not written) without holding any mutex:
+** fileId, pLockMutex
+**
+** (3) With the exceptions above, all the fields may only be read
+** or written while holding the global unixBigLock mutex.
+**
+** Deadlock prevention: The global unixBigLock mutex may not
+** be acquired while holding the pLockMutex mutex. If both unixBigLock
+** and pLockMutex are needed, then unixBigLock must be acquired first.
+*/
+struct unixInodeInfo {
+ struct unixFileId fileId; /* The lookup key */
+ sqlite3_mutex *pLockMutex; /* Hold this mutex for... */
+ int nShared; /* Number of SHARED locks held */
+ int nLock; /* Number of outstanding file locks */
+ unsigned char eFileLock; /* One of SHARED_LOCK, RESERVED_LOCK etc. */
+ unsigned char bProcessLock; /* An exclusive process lock is held */
+ UnixUnusedFd *pUnused; /* Unused file descriptors to close */
+ int nRef; /* Number of pointers to this structure */
+ unixShmNode *pShmNode; /* Shared memory associated with this inode */
+ unixInodeInfo *pNext; /* List of all unixInodeInfo objects */
+ unixInodeInfo *pPrev; /* .... doubly linked */
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ unsigned long long sharedByte; /* for AFP simulated shared lock */
+#endif
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ sem_t *pSem; /* Named POSIX semaphore */
+ char aSemName[MAX_PATHNAME+2]; /* Name of that semaphore */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** A lists of all unixInodeInfo objects.
+**
+** Must hold unixBigLock in order to read or write this variable.
+*/
+static unixInodeInfo *inodeList = 0; /* All unixInodeInfo objects */
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+/*
+** True if the inode mutex (on the unixFile.pFileMutex field) is held, or not.
+** This routine is used only within assert() to help verify correct mutex
+** usage.
+*/
+int unixFileMutexHeld(unixFile *pFile){
+ assert( pFile->pInode );
+ return sqlite3_mutex_held(pFile->pInode->pLockMutex);
+}
+int unixFileMutexNotheld(unixFile *pFile){
+ assert( pFile->pInode );
+ return sqlite3_mutex_notheld(pFile->pInode->pLockMutex);
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+**
+** This function - unixLogErrorAtLine(), is only ever called via the macro
+** unixLogError().
+**
+** It is invoked after an error occurs in an OS function and errno has been
+** set. It logs a message using sqlite3_log() containing the current value of
+** errno and, if possible, the human-readable equivalent from strerror() or
+** strerror_r().
+**
+** The first argument passed to the macro should be the error code that
+** will be returned to SQLite (e.g. SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE, SQLITE_CANTOPEN).
+** The two subsequent arguments should be the name of the OS function that
+** failed (e.g. "unlink", "open") and the associated file-system path,
+** if any.
+*/
+#define unixLogError(a,b,c) unixLogErrorAtLine(a,b,c,__LINE__)
+static int unixLogErrorAtLine(
+ int errcode, /* SQLite error code */
+ const char *zFunc, /* Name of OS function that failed */
+ const char *zPath, /* File path associated with error */
+ int iLine /* Source line number where error occurred */
+){
+ char *zErr; /* Message from strerror() or equivalent */
+ int iErrno = errno; /* Saved syscall error number */
+
+ /* If this is not a threadsafe build (SQLITE_THREADSAFE==0), then use
+ ** the strerror() function to obtain the human-readable error message
+ ** equivalent to errno. Otherwise, use strerror_r().
+ */
+#if SQLITE_THREADSAFE && defined(HAVE_STRERROR_R)
+ char aErr[80];
+ memset(aErr, 0, sizeof(aErr));
+ zErr = aErr;
+
+ /* If STRERROR_R_CHAR_P (set by autoconf scripts) or __USE_GNU is defined,
+ ** assume that the system provides the GNU version of strerror_r() that
+ ** returns a pointer to a buffer containing the error message. That pointer
+ ** may point to aErr[], or it may point to some static storage somewhere.
+ ** Otherwise, assume that the system provides the POSIX version of
+ ** strerror_r(), which always writes an error message into aErr[].
+ **
+ ** If the code incorrectly assumes that it is the POSIX version that is
+ ** available, the error message will often be an empty string. Not a
+ ** huge problem. Incorrectly concluding that the GNU version is available
+ ** could lead to a segfault though.
+ */
+#if defined(STRERROR_R_CHAR_P) || defined(__USE_GNU)
+ zErr =
+# endif
+ strerror_r(iErrno, aErr, sizeof(aErr)-1);
+
+#elif SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+ /* This is a threadsafe build, but strerror_r() is not available. */
+ zErr = "";
+#else
+ /* Non-threadsafe build, use strerror(). */
+ zErr = strerror(iErrno);
+#endif
+
+ if( zPath==0 ) zPath = "";
+ sqlite3_log(errcode,
+ "os_unix.c:%d: (%d) %s(%s) - %s",
+ iLine, iErrno, zFunc, zPath, zErr
+ );
+
+ return errcode;
+}
+
+/*
+** Close a file descriptor.
+**
+** We assume that close() almost always works, since it is only in a
+** very sick application or on a very sick platform that it might fail.
+** If it does fail, simply leak the file descriptor, but do log the
+** error.
+**
+** Note that it is not safe to retry close() after EINTR since the
+** file descriptor might have already been reused by another thread.
+** So we don't even try to recover from an EINTR. Just log the error
+** and move on.
+*/
+static void robust_close(unixFile *pFile, int h, int lineno){
+ if( osClose(h) ){
+ unixLogErrorAtLine(SQLITE_IOERR_CLOSE, "close",
+ pFile ? pFile->zPath : 0, lineno);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the pFile->lastErrno. Do this in a subroutine as that provides
+** a convenient place to set a breakpoint.
+*/
+static void storeLastErrno(unixFile *pFile, int error){
+ pFile->lastErrno = error;
+}
+
+/*
+** Close all file descriptors accumuated in the unixInodeInfo->pUnused list.
+*/
+static void closePendingFds(unixFile *pFile){
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode = pFile->pInode;
+ UnixUnusedFd *p;
+ UnixUnusedFd *pNext;
+ assert( unixFileMutexHeld(pFile) );
+ for(p=pInode->pUnused; p; p=pNext){
+ pNext = p->pNext;
+ robust_close(pFile, p->fd, __LINE__);
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ }
+ pInode->pUnused = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Release a unixInodeInfo structure previously allocated by findInodeInfo().
+**
+** The global mutex must be held when this routine is called, but the mutex
+** on the inode being deleted must NOT be held.
+*/
+static void releaseInodeInfo(unixFile *pFile){
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode = pFile->pInode;
+ assert( unixMutexHeld() );
+ assert( unixFileMutexNotheld(pFile) );
+ if( ALWAYS(pInode) ){
+ pInode->nRef--;
+ if( pInode->nRef==0 ){
+ assert( pInode->pShmNode==0 );
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ closePendingFds(pFile);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ if( pInode->pPrev ){
+ assert( pInode->pPrev->pNext==pInode );
+ pInode->pPrev->pNext = pInode->pNext;
+ }else{
+ assert( inodeList==pInode );
+ inodeList = pInode->pNext;
+ }
+ if( pInode->pNext ){
+ assert( pInode->pNext->pPrev==pInode );
+ pInode->pNext->pPrev = pInode->pPrev;
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_free(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ sqlite3_free(pInode);
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Given a file descriptor, locate the unixInodeInfo object that
+** describes that file descriptor. Create a new one if necessary. The
+** return value might be uninitialized if an error occurs.
+**
+** The global mutex must held when calling this routine.
+**
+** Return an appropriate error code.
+*/
+static int findInodeInfo(
+ unixFile *pFile, /* Unix file with file desc used in the key */
+ unixInodeInfo **ppInode /* Return the unixInodeInfo object here */
+){
+ int rc; /* System call return code */
+ int fd; /* The file descriptor for pFile */
+ struct unixFileId fileId; /* Lookup key for the unixInodeInfo */
+ struct stat statbuf; /* Low-level file information */
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode = 0; /* Candidate unixInodeInfo object */
+
+ assert( unixMutexHeld() );
+
+ /* Get low-level information about the file that we can used to
+ ** create a unique name for the file.
+ */
+ fd = pFile->h;
+ rc = osFstat(fd, &statbuf);
+ if( rc!=0 ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+#if defined(EOVERFLOW) && defined(SQLITE_DISABLE_LFS)
+ if( pFile->lastErrno==EOVERFLOW ) return SQLITE_NOLFS;
+#endif
+ return SQLITE_IOERR;
+ }
+
+#ifdef __APPLE__
+ /* On OS X on an msdos filesystem, the inode number is reported
+ ** incorrectly for zero-size files. See ticket #3260. To work
+ ** around this problem (we consider it a bug in OS X, not SQLite)
+ ** we always increase the file size to 1 by writing a single byte
+ ** prior to accessing the inode number. The one byte written is
+ ** an ASCII 'S' character which also happens to be the first byte
+ ** in the header of every SQLite database. In this way, if there
+ ** is a race condition such that another thread has already populated
+ ** the first page of the database, no damage is done.
+ */
+ if( statbuf.st_size==0 && (pFile->fsFlags & SQLITE_FSFLAGS_IS_MSDOS)!=0 ){
+ do{ rc = osWrite(fd, "S", 1); }while( rc<0 && errno==EINTR );
+ if( rc!=1 ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR;
+ }
+ rc = osFstat(fd, &statbuf);
+ if( rc!=0 ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ memset(&fileId, 0, sizeof(fileId));
+ fileId.dev = statbuf.st_dev;
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ fileId.pId = pFile->pId;
+#else
+ fileId.ino = (u64)statbuf.st_ino;
+#endif
+ assert( unixMutexHeld() );
+ pInode = inodeList;
+ while( pInode && memcmp(&fileId, &pInode->fileId, sizeof(fileId)) ){
+ pInode = pInode->pNext;
+ }
+ if( pInode==0 ){
+ pInode = sqlite3_malloc64( sizeof(*pInode) );
+ if( pInode==0 ){
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ memset(pInode, 0, sizeof(*pInode));
+ memcpy(&pInode->fileId, &fileId, sizeof(fileId));
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex ){
+ pInode->pLockMutex = sqlite3_mutex_alloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST);
+ if( pInode->pLockMutex==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(pInode);
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ }
+ pInode->nRef = 1;
+ assert( unixMutexHeld() );
+ pInode->pNext = inodeList;
+ pInode->pPrev = 0;
+ if( inodeList ) inodeList->pPrev = pInode;
+ inodeList = pInode;
+ }else{
+ pInode->nRef++;
+ }
+ *ppInode = pInode;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return TRUE if pFile has been renamed or unlinked since it was first opened.
+*/
+static int fileHasMoved(unixFile *pFile){
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ return pFile->pInode!=0 && pFile->pId!=pFile->pInode->fileId.pId;
+#else
+ struct stat buf;
+ return pFile->pInode!=0 &&
+ (osStat(pFile->zPath, &buf)!=0
+ || (u64)buf.st_ino!=pFile->pInode->fileId.ino);
+#endif
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Check a unixFile that is a database. Verify the following:
+**
+** (1) There is exactly one hard link on the file
+** (2) The file is not a symbolic link
+** (3) The file has not been renamed or unlinked
+**
+** Issue sqlite3_log(SQLITE_WARNING,...) messages if anything is not right.
+*/
+static void verifyDbFile(unixFile *pFile){
+ struct stat buf;
+ int rc;
+
+ /* These verifications occurs for the main database only */
+ if( pFile->ctrlFlags & UNIXFILE_NOLOCK ) return;
+
+ rc = osFstat(pFile->h, &buf);
+ if( rc!=0 ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_WARNING, "cannot fstat db file %s", pFile->zPath);
+ return;
+ }
+ if( buf.st_nlink==0 ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_WARNING, "file unlinked while open: %s", pFile->zPath);
+ return;
+ }
+ if( buf.st_nlink>1 ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_WARNING, "multiple links to file: %s", pFile->zPath);
+ return;
+ }
+ if( fileHasMoved(pFile) ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_WARNING, "file renamed while open: %s", pFile->zPath);
+ return;
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+** This routine checks if there is a RESERVED lock held on the specified
+** file by this or any other process. If such a lock is held, set *pResOut
+** to a non-zero value otherwise *pResOut is set to zero. The return value
+** is set to SQLITE_OK unless an I/O error occurs during lock checking.
+*/
+static int unixCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id, int *pResOut){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int reserved = 0;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_IOERR_CHECKRESERVEDLOCK; );
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ assert( pFile->eFileLock<=SHARED_LOCK );
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pFile->pInode->pLockMutex);
+
+ /* Check if a thread in this process holds such a lock */
+ if( pFile->pInode->eFileLock>SHARED_LOCK ){
+ reserved = 1;
+ }
+
+ /* Otherwise see if some other process holds it.
+ */
+#ifndef __DJGPP__
+ if( !reserved && !pFile->pInode->bProcessLock ){
+ struct flock lock;
+ lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lock.l_start = RESERVED_BYTE;
+ lock.l_len = 1;
+ lock.l_type = F_WRLCK;
+ if( osFcntl(pFile->h, F_GETLK, &lock) ){
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_CHECKRESERVEDLOCK;
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ } else if( lock.l_type!=F_UNLCK ){
+ reserved = 1;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pFile->pInode->pLockMutex);
+ OSTRACE(("TEST WR-LOCK %d %d %d (unix)\n", pFile->h, rc, reserved));
+
+ *pResOut = reserved;
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Set a posix-advisory-lock.
+**
+** There are two versions of this routine. If compiled with
+** SQLITE_ENABLE_SETLK_TIMEOUT then the routine has an extra parameter
+** which is a pointer to a unixFile. If the unixFile->iBusyTimeout
+** value is set, then it is the number of milliseconds to wait before
+** failing the lock. The iBusyTimeout value is always reset back to
+** zero on each call.
+**
+** If SQLITE_ENABLE_SETLK_TIMEOUT is not defined, then do a non-blocking
+** attempt to set the lock.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_ENABLE_SETLK_TIMEOUT
+# define osSetPosixAdvisoryLock(h,x,t) osFcntl(h,F_SETLK,x)
+#else
+static int osSetPosixAdvisoryLock(
+ int h, /* The file descriptor on which to take the lock */
+ struct flock *pLock, /* The description of the lock */
+ unixFile *pFile /* Structure holding timeout value */
+){
+ int tm = pFile->iBusyTimeout;
+ int rc = osFcntl(h,F_SETLK,pLock);
+ while( rc<0 && tm>0 ){
+ /* On systems that support some kind of blocking file lock with a timeout,
+ ** make appropriate changes here to invoke that blocking file lock. On
+ ** generic posix, however, there is no such API. So we simply try the
+ ** lock once every millisecond until either the timeout expires, or until
+ ** the lock is obtained. */
+ usleep(1000);
+ rc = osFcntl(h,F_SETLK,pLock);
+ tm--;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_ENABLE_SETLK_TIMEOUT */
+
+
+/*
+** Attempt to set a system-lock on the file pFile. The lock is
+** described by pLock.
+**
+** If the pFile was opened read/write from unix-excl, then the only lock
+** ever obtained is an exclusive lock, and it is obtained exactly once
+** the first time any lock is attempted. All subsequent system locking
+** operations become no-ops. Locking operations still happen internally,
+** in order to coordinate access between separate database connections
+** within this process, but all of that is handled in memory and the
+** operating system does not participate.
+**
+** This function is a pass-through to fcntl(F_SETLK) if pFile is using
+** any VFS other than "unix-excl" or if pFile is opened on "unix-excl"
+** and is read-only.
+**
+** Zero is returned if the call completes successfully, or -1 if a call
+** to fcntl() fails. In this case, errno is set appropriately (by fcntl()).
+*/
+static int unixFileLock(unixFile *pFile, struct flock *pLock){
+ int rc;
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode = pFile->pInode;
+ assert( pInode!=0 );
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pInode->pLockMutex) );
+ if( (pFile->ctrlFlags & (UNIXFILE_EXCL|UNIXFILE_RDONLY))==UNIXFILE_EXCL ){
+ if( pInode->bProcessLock==0 ){
+ struct flock lock;
+ assert( pInode->nLock==0 );
+ lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lock.l_start = SHARED_FIRST;
+ lock.l_len = SHARED_SIZE;
+ lock.l_type = F_WRLCK;
+ rc = osSetPosixAdvisoryLock(pFile->h, &lock, pFile);
+ if( rc<0 ) return rc;
+ pInode->bProcessLock = 1;
+ pInode->nLock++;
+ }else{
+ rc = 0;
+ }
+ }else{
+ rc = osSetPosixAdvisoryLock(pFile->h, pLock, pFile);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lock the file with the lock specified by parameter eFileLock - one
+** of the following:
+**
+** (1) SHARED_LOCK
+** (2) RESERVED_LOCK
+** (3) PENDING_LOCK
+** (4) EXCLUSIVE_LOCK
+**
+** Sometimes when requesting one lock state, additional lock states
+** are inserted in between. The locking might fail on one of the later
+** transitions leaving the lock state different from what it started but
+** still short of its goal. The following chart shows the allowed
+** transitions and the inserted intermediate states:
+**
+** UNLOCKED -> SHARED
+** SHARED -> RESERVED
+** SHARED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** RESERVED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** PENDING -> EXCLUSIVE
+**
+** This routine will only increase a lock. Use the sqlite3OsUnlock()
+** routine to lower a locking level.
+*/
+static int unixLock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock){
+ /* The following describes the implementation of the various locks and
+ ** lock transitions in terms of the POSIX advisory shared and exclusive
+ ** lock primitives (called read-locks and write-locks below, to avoid
+ ** confusion with SQLite lock names). The algorithms are complicated
+ ** slightly in order to be compatible with Windows95 systems simultaneously
+ ** accessing the same database file, in case that is ever required.
+ **
+ ** Symbols defined in os.h indentify the 'pending byte' and the 'reserved
+ ** byte', each single bytes at well known offsets, and the 'shared byte
+ ** range', a range of 510 bytes at a well known offset.
+ **
+ ** To obtain a SHARED lock, a read-lock is obtained on the 'pending
+ ** byte'. If this is successful, 'shared byte range' is read-locked
+ ** and the lock on the 'pending byte' released. (Legacy note: When
+ ** SQLite was first developed, Windows95 systems were still very common,
+ ** and Widnows95 lacks a shared-lock capability. So on Windows95, a
+ ** single randomly selected by from the 'shared byte range' is locked.
+ ** Windows95 is now pretty much extinct, but this work-around for the
+ ** lack of shared-locks on Windows95 lives on, for backwards
+ ** compatibility.)
+ **
+ ** A process may only obtain a RESERVED lock after it has a SHARED lock.
+ ** A RESERVED lock is implemented by grabbing a write-lock on the
+ ** 'reserved byte'.
+ **
+ ** A process may only obtain a PENDING lock after it has obtained a
+ ** SHARED lock. A PENDING lock is implemented by obtaining a write-lock
+ ** on the 'pending byte'. This ensures that no new SHARED locks can be
+ ** obtained, but existing SHARED locks are allowed to persist. A process
+ ** does not have to obtain a RESERVED lock on the way to a PENDING lock.
+ ** This property is used by the algorithm for rolling back a journal file
+ ** after a crash.
+ **
+ ** An EXCLUSIVE lock, obtained after a PENDING lock is held, is
+ ** implemented by obtaining a write-lock on the entire 'shared byte
+ ** range'. Since all other locks require a read-lock on one of the bytes
+ ** within this range, this ensures that no other locks are held on the
+ ** database.
+ */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode;
+ struct flock lock;
+ int tErrno = 0;
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK %d %s was %s(%s,%d) pid=%d (unix)\n", pFile->h,
+ azFileLock(eFileLock), azFileLock(pFile->eFileLock),
+ azFileLock(pFile->pInode->eFileLock), pFile->pInode->nShared,
+ osGetpid(0)));
+
+ /* If there is already a lock of this type or more restrictive on the
+ ** unixFile, do nothing. Don't use the end_lock: exit path, as
+ ** unixEnterMutex() hasn't been called yet.
+ */
+ if( pFile->eFileLock>=eFileLock ){
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK %d %s ok (already held) (unix)\n", pFile->h,
+ azFileLock(eFileLock)));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* Make sure the locking sequence is correct.
+ ** (1) We never move from unlocked to anything higher than shared lock.
+ ** (2) SQLite never explicitly requests a pendig lock.
+ ** (3) A shared lock is always held when a reserve lock is requested.
+ */
+ assert( pFile->eFileLock!=NO_LOCK || eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK );
+ assert( eFileLock!=PENDING_LOCK );
+ assert( eFileLock!=RESERVED_LOCK || pFile->eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK );
+
+ /* This mutex is needed because pFile->pInode is shared across threads
+ */
+ pInode = pFile->pInode;
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pInode->pLockMutex);
+
+ /* If some thread using this PID has a lock via a different unixFile*
+ ** handle that precludes the requested lock, return BUSY.
+ */
+ if( (pFile->eFileLock!=pInode->eFileLock &&
+ (pInode->eFileLock>=PENDING_LOCK || eFileLock>SHARED_LOCK))
+ ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ goto end_lock;
+ }
+
+ /* If a SHARED lock is requested, and some thread using this PID already
+ ** has a SHARED or RESERVED lock, then increment reference counts and
+ ** return SQLITE_OK.
+ */
+ if( eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK &&
+ (pInode->eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK || pInode->eFileLock==RESERVED_LOCK) ){
+ assert( eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK );
+ assert( pFile->eFileLock==0 );
+ assert( pInode->nShared>0 );
+ pFile->eFileLock = SHARED_LOCK;
+ pInode->nShared++;
+ pInode->nLock++;
+ goto end_lock;
+ }
+
+
+ /* A PENDING lock is needed before acquiring a SHARED lock and before
+ ** acquiring an EXCLUSIVE lock. For the SHARED lock, the PENDING will
+ ** be released.
+ */
+ lock.l_len = 1L;
+ lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ if( eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK
+ || (eFileLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK && pFile->eFileLocknShared==0 );
+ assert( pInode->eFileLock==0 );
+ assert( rc==SQLITE_OK );
+
+ /* Now get the read-lock */
+ lock.l_start = SHARED_FIRST;
+ lock.l_len = SHARED_SIZE;
+ if( unixFileLock(pFile, &lock) ){
+ tErrno = errno;
+ rc = sqliteErrorFromPosixError(tErrno, SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK);
+ }
+
+ /* Drop the temporary PENDING lock */
+ lock.l_start = PENDING_BYTE;
+ lock.l_len = 1L;
+ lock.l_type = F_UNLCK;
+ if( unixFileLock(pFile, &lock) && rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ /* This could happen with a network mount */
+ tErrno = errno;
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK;
+ }
+
+ if( rc ){
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_BUSY ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ }
+ goto end_lock;
+ }else{
+ pFile->eFileLock = SHARED_LOCK;
+ pInode->nLock++;
+ pInode->nShared = 1;
+ }
+ }else if( eFileLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK && pInode->nShared>1 ){
+ /* We are trying for an exclusive lock but another thread in this
+ ** same process is still holding a shared lock. */
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }else{
+ /* The request was for a RESERVED or EXCLUSIVE lock. It is
+ ** assumed that there is a SHARED or greater lock on the file
+ ** already.
+ */
+ assert( 0!=pFile->eFileLock );
+ lock.l_type = F_WRLCK;
+
+ assert( eFileLock==RESERVED_LOCK || eFileLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK );
+ if( eFileLock==RESERVED_LOCK ){
+ lock.l_start = RESERVED_BYTE;
+ lock.l_len = 1L;
+ }else{
+ lock.l_start = SHARED_FIRST;
+ lock.l_len = SHARED_SIZE;
+ }
+
+ if( unixFileLock(pFile, &lock) ){
+ tErrno = errno;
+ rc = sqliteErrorFromPosixError(tErrno, SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_BUSY ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ /* Set up the transaction-counter change checking flags when
+ ** transitioning from a SHARED to a RESERVED lock. The change
+ ** from SHARED to RESERVED marks the beginning of a normal
+ ** write operation (not a hot journal rollback).
+ */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK
+ && pFile->eFileLock<=SHARED_LOCK
+ && eFileLock==RESERVED_LOCK
+ ){
+ pFile->transCntrChng = 0;
+ pFile->dbUpdate = 0;
+ pFile->inNormalWrite = 1;
+ }
+#endif
+
+
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ pInode->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ }else if( eFileLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK ){
+ pFile->eFileLock = PENDING_LOCK;
+ pInode->eFileLock = PENDING_LOCK;
+ }
+
+end_lock:
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK %d %s %s (unix)\n", pFile->h, azFileLock(eFileLock),
+ rc==SQLITE_OK ? "ok" : "failed"));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Add the file descriptor used by file handle pFile to the corresponding
+** pUnused list.
+*/
+static void setPendingFd(unixFile *pFile){
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode = pFile->pInode;
+ UnixUnusedFd *p = pFile->pPreallocatedUnused;
+ assert( unixFileMutexHeld(pFile) );
+ p->pNext = pInode->pUnused;
+ pInode->pUnused = p;
+ pFile->h = -1;
+ pFile->pPreallocatedUnused = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lower the locking level on file descriptor pFile to eFileLock. eFileLock
+** must be either NO_LOCK or SHARED_LOCK.
+**
+** If the locking level of the file descriptor is already at or below
+** the requested locking level, this routine is a no-op.
+**
+** If handleNFSUnlock is true, then on downgrading an EXCLUSIVE_LOCK to SHARED
+** the byte range is divided into 2 parts and the first part is unlocked then
+** set to a read lock, then the other part is simply unlocked. This works
+** around a bug in BSD NFS lockd (also seen on MacOSX 10.3+) that fails to
+** remove the write lock on a region when a read lock is set.
+*/
+static int posixUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock, int handleNFSUnlock){
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode;
+ struct flock lock;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ OSTRACE(("UNLOCK %d %d was %d(%d,%d) pid=%d (unix)\n", pFile->h, eFileLock,
+ pFile->eFileLock, pFile->pInode->eFileLock, pFile->pInode->nShared,
+ osGetpid(0)));
+
+ assert( eFileLock<=SHARED_LOCK );
+ if( pFile->eFileLock<=eFileLock ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ pInode = pFile->pInode;
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ assert( pInode->nShared!=0 );
+ if( pFile->eFileLock>SHARED_LOCK ){
+ assert( pInode->eFileLock==pFile->eFileLock );
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ /* When reducing a lock such that other processes can start
+ ** reading the database file again, make sure that the
+ ** transaction counter was updated if any part of the database
+ ** file changed. If the transaction counter is not updated,
+ ** other connections to the same file might not realize that
+ ** the file has changed and hence might not know to flush their
+ ** cache. The use of a stale cache can lead to database corruption.
+ */
+ pFile->inNormalWrite = 0;
+#endif
+
+ /* downgrading to a shared lock on NFS involves clearing the write lock
+ ** before establishing the readlock - to avoid a race condition we downgrade
+ ** the lock in 2 blocks, so that part of the range will be covered by a
+ ** write lock until the rest is covered by a read lock:
+ ** 1: [WWWWW]
+ ** 2: [....W]
+ ** 3: [RRRRW]
+ ** 4: [RRRR.]
+ */
+ if( eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK ){
+#if !defined(__APPLE__) || !SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ (void)handleNFSUnlock;
+ assert( handleNFSUnlock==0 );
+#endif
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ if( handleNFSUnlock ){
+ int tErrno; /* Error code from system call errors */
+ off_t divSize = SHARED_SIZE - 1;
+
+ lock.l_type = F_UNLCK;
+ lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lock.l_start = SHARED_FIRST;
+ lock.l_len = divSize;
+ if( unixFileLock(pFile, &lock)==(-1) ){
+ tErrno = errno;
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK;
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ goto end_unlock;
+ }
+ lock.l_type = F_RDLCK;
+ lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lock.l_start = SHARED_FIRST;
+ lock.l_len = divSize;
+ if( unixFileLock(pFile, &lock)==(-1) ){
+ tErrno = errno;
+ rc = sqliteErrorFromPosixError(tErrno, SQLITE_IOERR_RDLOCK);
+ if( IS_LOCK_ERROR(rc) ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ }
+ goto end_unlock;
+ }
+ lock.l_type = F_UNLCK;
+ lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lock.l_start = SHARED_FIRST+divSize;
+ lock.l_len = SHARED_SIZE-divSize;
+ if( unixFileLock(pFile, &lock)==(-1) ){
+ tErrno = errno;
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK;
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ goto end_unlock;
+ }
+ }else
+#endif /* defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE */
+ {
+ lock.l_type = F_RDLCK;
+ lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lock.l_start = SHARED_FIRST;
+ lock.l_len = SHARED_SIZE;
+ if( unixFileLock(pFile, &lock) ){
+ /* In theory, the call to unixFileLock() cannot fail because another
+ ** process is holding an incompatible lock. If it does, this
+ ** indicates that the other process is not following the locking
+ ** protocol. If this happens, return SQLITE_IOERR_RDLOCK. Returning
+ ** SQLITE_BUSY would confuse the upper layer (in practice it causes
+ ** an assert to fail). */
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_RDLOCK;
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ goto end_unlock;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ lock.l_type = F_UNLCK;
+ lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lock.l_start = PENDING_BYTE;
+ lock.l_len = 2L; assert( PENDING_BYTE+1==RESERVED_BYTE );
+ if( unixFileLock(pFile, &lock)==0 ){
+ pInode->eFileLock = SHARED_LOCK;
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK;
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ goto end_unlock;
+ }
+ }
+ if( eFileLock==NO_LOCK ){
+ /* Decrement the shared lock counter. Release the lock using an
+ ** OS call only when all threads in this same process have released
+ ** the lock.
+ */
+ pInode->nShared--;
+ if( pInode->nShared==0 ){
+ lock.l_type = F_UNLCK;
+ lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lock.l_start = lock.l_len = 0L;
+ if( unixFileLock(pFile, &lock)==0 ){
+ pInode->eFileLock = NO_LOCK;
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK;
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ pInode->eFileLock = NO_LOCK;
+ pFile->eFileLock = NO_LOCK;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Decrement the count of locks against this same file. When the
+ ** count reaches zero, close any other file descriptors whose close
+ ** was deferred because of outstanding locks.
+ */
+ pInode->nLock--;
+ assert( pInode->nLock>=0 );
+ if( pInode->nLock==0 ) closePendingFds(pFile);
+ }
+
+end_unlock:
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lower the locking level on file descriptor pFile to eFileLock. eFileLock
+** must be either NO_LOCK or SHARED_LOCK.
+**
+** If the locking level of the file descriptor is already at or below
+** the requested locking level, this routine is a no-op.
+*/
+static int unixUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock){
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ assert( eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK || ((unixFile *)id)->nFetchOut==0 );
+#endif
+ return posixUnlock(id, eFileLock, 0);
+}
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+static int unixMapfile(unixFile *pFd, i64 nByte);
+static void unixUnmapfile(unixFile *pFd);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This function performs the parts of the "close file" operation
+** common to all locking schemes. It closes the directory and file
+** handles, if they are valid, and sets all fields of the unixFile
+** structure to 0.
+**
+** It is *not* necessary to hold the mutex when this routine is called,
+** even on VxWorks. A mutex will be acquired on VxWorks by the
+** vxworksReleaseFileId() routine.
+*/
+static int closeUnixFile(sqlite3_file *id){
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ unixUnmapfile(pFile);
+#endif
+ if( pFile->h>=0 ){
+ robust_close(pFile, pFile->h, __LINE__);
+ pFile->h = -1;
+ }
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ if( pFile->pId ){
+ if( pFile->ctrlFlags & UNIXFILE_DELETE ){
+ osUnlink(pFile->pId->zCanonicalName);
+ }
+ vxworksReleaseFileId(pFile->pId);
+ pFile->pId = 0;
+ }
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_UNLINK_AFTER_CLOSE
+ if( pFile->ctrlFlags & UNIXFILE_DELETE ){
+ osUnlink(pFile->zPath);
+ sqlite3_free(*(char**)&pFile->zPath);
+ pFile->zPath = 0;
+ }
+#endif
+ OSTRACE(("CLOSE %-3d\n", pFile->h));
+ OpenCounter(-1);
+ sqlite3_free(pFile->pPreallocatedUnused);
+ memset(pFile, 0, sizeof(unixFile));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Close a file.
+*/
+static int unixClose(sqlite3_file *id){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile *)id;
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode = pFile->pInode;
+
+ assert( pInode!=0 );
+ verifyDbFile(pFile);
+ unixUnlock(id, NO_LOCK);
+ assert( unixFileMutexNotheld(pFile) );
+ unixEnterMutex();
+
+ /* unixFile.pInode is always valid here. Otherwise, a different close
+ ** routine (e.g. nolockClose()) would be called instead.
+ */
+ assert( pFile->pInode->nLock>0 || pFile->pInode->bProcessLock==0 );
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ if( pInode->nLock ){
+ /* If there are outstanding locks, do not actually close the file just
+ ** yet because that would clear those locks. Instead, add the file
+ ** descriptor to pInode->pUnused list. It will be automatically closed
+ ** when the last lock is cleared.
+ */
+ setPendingFd(pFile);
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ releaseInodeInfo(pFile);
+ rc = closeUnixFile(id);
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/************** End of the posix advisory lock implementation *****************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/******************************************************************************
+****************************** No-op Locking **********************************
+**
+** Of the various locking implementations available, this is by far the
+** simplest: locking is ignored. No attempt is made to lock the database
+** file for reading or writing.
+**
+** This locking mode is appropriate for use on read-only databases
+** (ex: databases that are burned into CD-ROM, for example.) It can
+** also be used if the application employs some external mechanism to
+** prevent simultaneous access of the same database by two or more
+** database connections. But there is a serious risk of database
+** corruption if this locking mode is used in situations where multiple
+** database connections are accessing the same database file at the same
+** time and one or more of those connections are writing.
+*/
+
+static int nolockCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *NotUsed, int *pResOut){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ *pResOut = 0;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+static int nolockLock(sqlite3_file *NotUsed, int NotUsed2){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER2(NotUsed, NotUsed2);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+static int nolockUnlock(sqlite3_file *NotUsed, int NotUsed2){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER2(NotUsed, NotUsed2);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Close the file.
+*/
+static int nolockClose(sqlite3_file *id) {
+ return closeUnixFile(id);
+}
+
+/******************* End of the no-op lock implementation *********************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/******************************************************************************
+************************* Begin dot-file Locking ******************************
+**
+** The dotfile locking implementation uses the existence of separate lock
+** files (really a directory) to control access to the database. This works
+** on just about every filesystem imaginable. But there are serious downsides:
+**
+** (1) There is zero concurrency. A single reader blocks all other
+** connections from reading or writing the database.
+**
+** (2) An application crash or power loss can leave stale lock files
+** sitting around that need to be cleared manually.
+**
+** Nevertheless, a dotlock is an appropriate locking mode for use if no
+** other locking strategy is available.
+**
+** Dotfile locking works by creating a subdirectory in the same directory as
+** the database and with the same name but with a ".lock" extension added.
+** The existence of a lock directory implies an EXCLUSIVE lock. All other
+** lock types (SHARED, RESERVED, PENDING) are mapped into EXCLUSIVE.
+*/
+
+/*
+** The file suffix added to the data base filename in order to create the
+** lock directory.
+*/
+#define DOTLOCK_SUFFIX ".lock"
+
+/*
+** This routine checks if there is a RESERVED lock held on the specified
+** file by this or any other process. If such a lock is held, set *pResOut
+** to a non-zero value otherwise *pResOut is set to zero. The return value
+** is set to SQLITE_OK unless an I/O error occurs during lock checking.
+**
+** In dotfile locking, either a lock exists or it does not. So in this
+** variation of CheckReservedLock(), *pResOut is set to true if any lock
+** is held on the file and false if the file is unlocked.
+*/
+static int dotlockCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id, int *pResOut) {
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int reserved = 0;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_IOERR_CHECKRESERVEDLOCK; );
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ reserved = osAccess((const char*)pFile->lockingContext, 0)==0;
+ OSTRACE(("TEST WR-LOCK %d %d %d (dotlock)\n", pFile->h, rc, reserved));
+ *pResOut = reserved;
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lock the file with the lock specified by parameter eFileLock - one
+** of the following:
+**
+** (1) SHARED_LOCK
+** (2) RESERVED_LOCK
+** (3) PENDING_LOCK
+** (4) EXCLUSIVE_LOCK
+**
+** Sometimes when requesting one lock state, additional lock states
+** are inserted in between. The locking might fail on one of the later
+** transitions leaving the lock state different from what it started but
+** still short of its goal. The following chart shows the allowed
+** transitions and the inserted intermediate states:
+**
+** UNLOCKED -> SHARED
+** SHARED -> RESERVED
+** SHARED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** RESERVED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** PENDING -> EXCLUSIVE
+**
+** This routine will only increase a lock. Use the sqlite3OsUnlock()
+** routine to lower a locking level.
+**
+** With dotfile locking, we really only support state (4): EXCLUSIVE.
+** But we track the other locking levels internally.
+*/
+static int dotlockLock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock) {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ char *zLockFile = (char *)pFile->lockingContext;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+
+ /* If we have any lock, then the lock file already exists. All we have
+ ** to do is adjust our internal record of the lock level.
+ */
+ if( pFile->eFileLock > NO_LOCK ){
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ /* Always update the timestamp on the old file */
+#ifdef HAVE_UTIME
+ utime(zLockFile, NULL);
+#else
+ utimes(zLockFile, NULL);
+#endif
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* grab an exclusive lock */
+ rc = osMkdir(zLockFile, 0777);
+ if( rc<0 ){
+ /* failed to open/create the lock directory */
+ int tErrno = errno;
+ if( EEXIST == tErrno ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ } else {
+ rc = sqliteErrorFromPosixError(tErrno, SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_BUSY ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+ }
+
+ /* got it, set the type and return ok */
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lower the locking level on file descriptor pFile to eFileLock. eFileLock
+** must be either NO_LOCK or SHARED_LOCK.
+**
+** If the locking level of the file descriptor is already at or below
+** the requested locking level, this routine is a no-op.
+**
+** When the locking level reaches NO_LOCK, delete the lock file.
+*/
+static int dotlockUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock) {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ char *zLockFile = (char *)pFile->lockingContext;
+ int rc;
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ OSTRACE(("UNLOCK %d %d was %d pid=%d (dotlock)\n", pFile->h, eFileLock,
+ pFile->eFileLock, osGetpid(0)));
+ assert( eFileLock<=SHARED_LOCK );
+
+ /* no-op if possible */
+ if( pFile->eFileLock==eFileLock ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* To downgrade to shared, simply update our internal notion of the
+ ** lock state. No need to mess with the file on disk.
+ */
+ if( eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK ){
+ pFile->eFileLock = SHARED_LOCK;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* To fully unlock the database, delete the lock file */
+ assert( eFileLock==NO_LOCK );
+ rc = osRmdir(zLockFile);
+ if( rc<0 ){
+ int tErrno = errno;
+ if( tErrno==ENOENT ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK;
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ }
+ return rc;
+ }
+ pFile->eFileLock = NO_LOCK;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Close a file. Make sure the lock has been released before closing.
+*/
+static int dotlockClose(sqlite3_file *id) {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ assert( id!=0 );
+ dotlockUnlock(id, NO_LOCK);
+ sqlite3_free(pFile->lockingContext);
+ return closeUnixFile(id);
+}
+/****************** End of the dot-file lock implementation *******************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/******************************************************************************
+************************** Begin flock Locking ********************************
+**
+** Use the flock() system call to do file locking.
+**
+** flock() locking is like dot-file locking in that the various
+** fine-grain locking levels supported by SQLite are collapsed into
+** a single exclusive lock. In other words, SHARED, RESERVED, and
+** PENDING locks are the same thing as an EXCLUSIVE lock. SQLite
+** still works when you do this, but concurrency is reduced since
+** only a single process can be reading the database at a time.
+**
+** Omit this section if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE is turned off
+*/
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+
+/*
+** Retry flock() calls that fail with EINTR
+*/
+#ifdef EINTR
+static int robust_flock(int fd, int op){
+ int rc;
+ do{ rc = flock(fd,op); }while( rc<0 && errno==EINTR );
+ return rc;
+}
+#else
+# define robust_flock(a,b) flock(a,b)
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+** This routine checks if there is a RESERVED lock held on the specified
+** file by this or any other process. If such a lock is held, set *pResOut
+** to a non-zero value otherwise *pResOut is set to zero. The return value
+** is set to SQLITE_OK unless an I/O error occurs during lock checking.
+*/
+static int flockCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id, int *pResOut){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int reserved = 0;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_IOERR_CHECKRESERVEDLOCK; );
+
+ assert( pFile );
+
+ /* Check if a thread in this process holds such a lock */
+ if( pFile->eFileLock>SHARED_LOCK ){
+ reserved = 1;
+ }
+
+ /* Otherwise see if some other process holds it. */
+ if( !reserved ){
+ /* attempt to get the lock */
+ int lrc = robust_flock(pFile->h, LOCK_EX | LOCK_NB);
+ if( !lrc ){
+ /* got the lock, unlock it */
+ lrc = robust_flock(pFile->h, LOCK_UN);
+ if ( lrc ) {
+ int tErrno = errno;
+ /* unlock failed with an error */
+ lrc = SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK;
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ rc = lrc;
+ }
+ } else {
+ int tErrno = errno;
+ reserved = 1;
+ /* someone else might have it reserved */
+ lrc = sqliteErrorFromPosixError(tErrno, SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK);
+ if( IS_LOCK_ERROR(lrc) ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ rc = lrc;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("TEST WR-LOCK %d %d %d (flock)\n", pFile->h, rc, reserved));
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_IGNORE_FLOCK_LOCK_ERRORS
+ if( (rc & 0xff) == SQLITE_IOERR ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ reserved=1;
+ }
+#endif /* SQLITE_IGNORE_FLOCK_LOCK_ERRORS */
+ *pResOut = reserved;
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lock the file with the lock specified by parameter eFileLock - one
+** of the following:
+**
+** (1) SHARED_LOCK
+** (2) RESERVED_LOCK
+** (3) PENDING_LOCK
+** (4) EXCLUSIVE_LOCK
+**
+** Sometimes when requesting one lock state, additional lock states
+** are inserted in between. The locking might fail on one of the later
+** transitions leaving the lock state different from what it started but
+** still short of its goal. The following chart shows the allowed
+** transitions and the inserted intermediate states:
+**
+** UNLOCKED -> SHARED
+** SHARED -> RESERVED
+** SHARED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** RESERVED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** PENDING -> EXCLUSIVE
+**
+** flock() only really support EXCLUSIVE locks. We track intermediate
+** lock states in the sqlite3_file structure, but all locks SHARED or
+** above are really EXCLUSIVE locks and exclude all other processes from
+** access the file.
+**
+** This routine will only increase a lock. Use the sqlite3OsUnlock()
+** routine to lower a locking level.
+*/
+static int flockLock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock) {
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+
+ assert( pFile );
+
+ /* if we already have a lock, it is exclusive.
+ ** Just adjust level and punt on outta here. */
+ if (pFile->eFileLock > NO_LOCK) {
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* grab an exclusive lock */
+
+ if (robust_flock(pFile->h, LOCK_EX | LOCK_NB)) {
+ int tErrno = errno;
+ /* didn't get, must be busy */
+ rc = sqliteErrorFromPosixError(tErrno, SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK);
+ if( IS_LOCK_ERROR(rc) ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ }
+ } else {
+ /* got it, set the type and return ok */
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK %d %s %s (flock)\n", pFile->h, azFileLock(eFileLock),
+ rc==SQLITE_OK ? "ok" : "failed"));
+#ifdef SQLITE_IGNORE_FLOCK_LOCK_ERRORS
+ if( (rc & 0xff) == SQLITE_IOERR ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+#endif /* SQLITE_IGNORE_FLOCK_LOCK_ERRORS */
+ return rc;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Lower the locking level on file descriptor pFile to eFileLock. eFileLock
+** must be either NO_LOCK or SHARED_LOCK.
+**
+** If the locking level of the file descriptor is already at or below
+** the requested locking level, this routine is a no-op.
+*/
+static int flockUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock) {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ OSTRACE(("UNLOCK %d %d was %d pid=%d (flock)\n", pFile->h, eFileLock,
+ pFile->eFileLock, osGetpid(0)));
+ assert( eFileLock<=SHARED_LOCK );
+
+ /* no-op if possible */
+ if( pFile->eFileLock==eFileLock ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* shared can just be set because we always have an exclusive */
+ if (eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK) {
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* no, really, unlock. */
+ if( robust_flock(pFile->h, LOCK_UN) ){
+#ifdef SQLITE_IGNORE_FLOCK_LOCK_ERRORS
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+#endif /* SQLITE_IGNORE_FLOCK_LOCK_ERRORS */
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK;
+ }else{
+ pFile->eFileLock = NO_LOCK;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Close a file.
+*/
+static int flockClose(sqlite3_file *id) {
+ assert( id!=0 );
+ flockUnlock(id, NO_LOCK);
+ return closeUnixFile(id);
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE && !OS_VXWORK */
+
+/******************* End of the flock lock implementation *********************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/******************************************************************************
+************************ Begin Named Semaphore Locking ************************
+**
+** Named semaphore locking is only supported on VxWorks.
+**
+** Semaphore locking is like dot-lock and flock in that it really only
+** supports EXCLUSIVE locking. Only a single process can read or write
+** the database file at a time. This reduces potential concurrency, but
+** makes the lock implementation much easier.
+*/
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+
+/*
+** This routine checks if there is a RESERVED lock held on the specified
+** file by this or any other process. If such a lock is held, set *pResOut
+** to a non-zero value otherwise *pResOut is set to zero. The return value
+** is set to SQLITE_OK unless an I/O error occurs during lock checking.
+*/
+static int semXCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id, int *pResOut) {
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int reserved = 0;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_IOERR_CHECKRESERVEDLOCK; );
+
+ assert( pFile );
+
+ /* Check if a thread in this process holds such a lock */
+ if( pFile->eFileLock>SHARED_LOCK ){
+ reserved = 1;
+ }
+
+ /* Otherwise see if some other process holds it. */
+ if( !reserved ){
+ sem_t *pSem = pFile->pInode->pSem;
+
+ if( sem_trywait(pSem)==-1 ){
+ int tErrno = errno;
+ if( EAGAIN != tErrno ){
+ rc = sqliteErrorFromPosixError(tErrno, SQLITE_IOERR_CHECKRESERVEDLOCK);
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ } else {
+ /* someone else has the lock when we are in NO_LOCK */
+ reserved = (pFile->eFileLock < SHARED_LOCK);
+ }
+ }else{
+ /* we could have it if we want it */
+ sem_post(pSem);
+ }
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("TEST WR-LOCK %d %d %d (sem)\n", pFile->h, rc, reserved));
+
+ *pResOut = reserved;
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lock the file with the lock specified by parameter eFileLock - one
+** of the following:
+**
+** (1) SHARED_LOCK
+** (2) RESERVED_LOCK
+** (3) PENDING_LOCK
+** (4) EXCLUSIVE_LOCK
+**
+** Sometimes when requesting one lock state, additional lock states
+** are inserted in between. The locking might fail on one of the later
+** transitions leaving the lock state different from what it started but
+** still short of its goal. The following chart shows the allowed
+** transitions and the inserted intermediate states:
+**
+** UNLOCKED -> SHARED
+** SHARED -> RESERVED
+** SHARED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** RESERVED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** PENDING -> EXCLUSIVE
+**
+** Semaphore locks only really support EXCLUSIVE locks. We track intermediate
+** lock states in the sqlite3_file structure, but all locks SHARED or
+** above are really EXCLUSIVE locks and exclude all other processes from
+** access the file.
+**
+** This routine will only increase a lock. Use the sqlite3OsUnlock()
+** routine to lower a locking level.
+*/
+static int semXLock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock) {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ sem_t *pSem = pFile->pInode->pSem;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ /* if we already have a lock, it is exclusive.
+ ** Just adjust level and punt on outta here. */
+ if (pFile->eFileLock > NO_LOCK) {
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ goto sem_end_lock;
+ }
+
+ /* lock semaphore now but bail out when already locked. */
+ if( sem_trywait(pSem)==-1 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ goto sem_end_lock;
+ }
+
+ /* got it, set the type and return ok */
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+
+ sem_end_lock:
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lower the locking level on file descriptor pFile to eFileLock. eFileLock
+** must be either NO_LOCK or SHARED_LOCK.
+**
+** If the locking level of the file descriptor is already at or below
+** the requested locking level, this routine is a no-op.
+*/
+static int semXUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock) {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ sem_t *pSem = pFile->pInode->pSem;
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ assert( pSem );
+ OSTRACE(("UNLOCK %d %d was %d pid=%d (sem)\n", pFile->h, eFileLock,
+ pFile->eFileLock, osGetpid(0)));
+ assert( eFileLock<=SHARED_LOCK );
+
+ /* no-op if possible */
+ if( pFile->eFileLock==eFileLock ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* shared can just be set because we always have an exclusive */
+ if (eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK) {
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* no, really unlock. */
+ if ( sem_post(pSem)==-1 ) {
+ int rc, tErrno = errno;
+ rc = sqliteErrorFromPosixError(tErrno, SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK);
+ if( IS_LOCK_ERROR(rc) ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ }
+ return rc;
+ }
+ pFile->eFileLock = NO_LOCK;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+ ** Close a file.
+ */
+static int semXClose(sqlite3_file *id) {
+ if( id ){
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ semXUnlock(id, NO_LOCK);
+ assert( pFile );
+ assert( unixFileMutexNotheld(pFile) );
+ unixEnterMutex();
+ releaseInodeInfo(pFile);
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+ closeUnixFile(id);
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#endif /* OS_VXWORKS */
+/*
+** Named semaphore locking is only available on VxWorks.
+**
+*************** End of the named semaphore lock implementation ****************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+
+/******************************************************************************
+*************************** Begin AFP Locking *********************************
+**
+** AFP is the Apple Filing Protocol. AFP is a network filesystem found
+** on Apple Macintosh computers - both OS9 and OSX.
+**
+** Third-party implementations of AFP are available. But this code here
+** only works on OSX.
+*/
+
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+/*
+** The afpLockingContext structure contains all afp lock specific state
+*/
+typedef struct afpLockingContext afpLockingContext;
+struct afpLockingContext {
+ int reserved;
+ const char *dbPath; /* Name of the open file */
+};
+
+struct ByteRangeLockPB2
+{
+ unsigned long long offset; /* offset to first byte to lock */
+ unsigned long long length; /* nbr of bytes to lock */
+ unsigned long long retRangeStart; /* nbr of 1st byte locked if successful */
+ unsigned char unLockFlag; /* 1 = unlock, 0 = lock */
+ unsigned char startEndFlag; /* 1=rel to end of fork, 0=rel to start */
+ int fd; /* file desc to assoc this lock with */
+};
+
+#define afpfsByteRangeLock2FSCTL _IOWR('z', 23, struct ByteRangeLockPB2)
+
+/*
+** This is a utility for setting or clearing a bit-range lock on an
+** AFP filesystem.
+**
+** Return SQLITE_OK on success, SQLITE_BUSY on failure.
+*/
+static int afpSetLock(
+ const char *path, /* Name of the file to be locked or unlocked */
+ unixFile *pFile, /* Open file descriptor on path */
+ unsigned long long offset, /* First byte to be locked */
+ unsigned long long length, /* Number of bytes to lock */
+ int setLockFlag /* True to set lock. False to clear lock */
+){
+ struct ByteRangeLockPB2 pb;
+ int err;
+
+ pb.unLockFlag = setLockFlag ? 0 : 1;
+ pb.startEndFlag = 0;
+ pb.offset = offset;
+ pb.length = length;
+ pb.fd = pFile->h;
+
+ OSTRACE(("AFPSETLOCK [%s] for %d%s in range %llx:%llx\n",
+ (setLockFlag?"ON":"OFF"), pFile->h, (pb.fd==-1?"[testval-1]":""),
+ offset, length));
+ err = fsctl(path, afpfsByteRangeLock2FSCTL, &pb, 0);
+ if ( err==-1 ) {
+ int rc;
+ int tErrno = errno;
+ OSTRACE(("AFPSETLOCK failed to fsctl() '%s' %d %s\n",
+ path, tErrno, strerror(tErrno)));
+#ifdef SQLITE_IGNORE_AFP_LOCK_ERRORS
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+#else
+ rc = sqliteErrorFromPosixError(tErrno,
+ setLockFlag ? SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK : SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK);
+#endif /* SQLITE_IGNORE_AFP_LOCK_ERRORS */
+ if( IS_LOCK_ERROR(rc) ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, tErrno);
+ }
+ return rc;
+ } else {
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** This routine checks if there is a RESERVED lock held on the specified
+** file by this or any other process. If such a lock is held, set *pResOut
+** to a non-zero value otherwise *pResOut is set to zero. The return value
+** is set to SQLITE_OK unless an I/O error occurs during lock checking.
+*/
+static int afpCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id, int *pResOut){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int reserved = 0;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ afpLockingContext *context;
+
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_IOERR_CHECKRESERVEDLOCK; );
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ context = (afpLockingContext *) pFile->lockingContext;
+ if( context->reserved ){
+ *pResOut = 1;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pFile->pInode->pLockMutex);
+ /* Check if a thread in this process holds such a lock */
+ if( pFile->pInode->eFileLock>SHARED_LOCK ){
+ reserved = 1;
+ }
+
+ /* Otherwise see if some other process holds it.
+ */
+ if( !reserved ){
+ /* lock the RESERVED byte */
+ int lrc = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, RESERVED_BYTE, 1,1);
+ if( SQLITE_OK==lrc ){
+ /* if we succeeded in taking the reserved lock, unlock it to restore
+ ** the original state */
+ lrc = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, RESERVED_BYTE, 1, 0);
+ } else {
+ /* if we failed to get the lock then someone else must have it */
+ reserved = 1;
+ }
+ if( IS_LOCK_ERROR(lrc) ){
+ rc=lrc;
+ }
+ }
+
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pFile->pInode->pLockMutex);
+ OSTRACE(("TEST WR-LOCK %d %d %d (afp)\n", pFile->h, rc, reserved));
+
+ *pResOut = reserved;
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lock the file with the lock specified by parameter eFileLock - one
+** of the following:
+**
+** (1) SHARED_LOCK
+** (2) RESERVED_LOCK
+** (3) PENDING_LOCK
+** (4) EXCLUSIVE_LOCK
+**
+** Sometimes when requesting one lock state, additional lock states
+** are inserted in between. The locking might fail on one of the later
+** transitions leaving the lock state different from what it started but
+** still short of its goal. The following chart shows the allowed
+** transitions and the inserted intermediate states:
+**
+** UNLOCKED -> SHARED
+** SHARED -> RESERVED
+** SHARED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** RESERVED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** PENDING -> EXCLUSIVE
+**
+** This routine will only increase a lock. Use the sqlite3OsUnlock()
+** routine to lower a locking level.
+*/
+static int afpLock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode = pFile->pInode;
+ afpLockingContext *context = (afpLockingContext *) pFile->lockingContext;
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK %d %s was %s(%s,%d) pid=%d (afp)\n", pFile->h,
+ azFileLock(eFileLock), azFileLock(pFile->eFileLock),
+ azFileLock(pInode->eFileLock), pInode->nShared , osGetpid(0)));
+
+ /* If there is already a lock of this type or more restrictive on the
+ ** unixFile, do nothing. Don't use the afp_end_lock: exit path, as
+ ** unixEnterMutex() hasn't been called yet.
+ */
+ if( pFile->eFileLock>=eFileLock ){
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK %d %s ok (already held) (afp)\n", pFile->h,
+ azFileLock(eFileLock)));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* Make sure the locking sequence is correct
+ ** (1) We never move from unlocked to anything higher than shared lock.
+ ** (2) SQLite never explicitly requests a pendig lock.
+ ** (3) A shared lock is always held when a reserve lock is requested.
+ */
+ assert( pFile->eFileLock!=NO_LOCK || eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK );
+ assert( eFileLock!=PENDING_LOCK );
+ assert( eFileLock!=RESERVED_LOCK || pFile->eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK );
+
+ /* This mutex is needed because pFile->pInode is shared across threads
+ */
+ pInode = pFile->pInode;
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pInode->pLockMutex);
+
+ /* If some thread using this PID has a lock via a different unixFile*
+ ** handle that precludes the requested lock, return BUSY.
+ */
+ if( (pFile->eFileLock!=pInode->eFileLock &&
+ (pInode->eFileLock>=PENDING_LOCK || eFileLock>SHARED_LOCK))
+ ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ goto afp_end_lock;
+ }
+
+ /* If a SHARED lock is requested, and some thread using this PID already
+ ** has a SHARED or RESERVED lock, then increment reference counts and
+ ** return SQLITE_OK.
+ */
+ if( eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK &&
+ (pInode->eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK || pInode->eFileLock==RESERVED_LOCK) ){
+ assert( eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK );
+ assert( pFile->eFileLock==0 );
+ assert( pInode->nShared>0 );
+ pFile->eFileLock = SHARED_LOCK;
+ pInode->nShared++;
+ pInode->nLock++;
+ goto afp_end_lock;
+ }
+
+ /* A PENDING lock is needed before acquiring a SHARED lock and before
+ ** acquiring an EXCLUSIVE lock. For the SHARED lock, the PENDING will
+ ** be released.
+ */
+ if( eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK
+ || (eFileLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK && pFile->eFileLockdbPath, pFile, PENDING_BYTE, 1, 1);
+ if (failed) {
+ rc = failed;
+ goto afp_end_lock;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If control gets to this point, then actually go ahead and make
+ ** operating system calls for the specified lock.
+ */
+ if( eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK ){
+ int lrc1, lrc2, lrc1Errno = 0;
+ long lk, mask;
+
+ assert( pInode->nShared==0 );
+ assert( pInode->eFileLock==0 );
+
+ mask = (sizeof(long)==8) ? LARGEST_INT64 : 0x7fffffff;
+ /* Now get the read-lock SHARED_LOCK */
+ /* note that the quality of the randomness doesn't matter that much */
+ lk = random();
+ pInode->sharedByte = (lk & mask)%(SHARED_SIZE - 1);
+ lrc1 = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile,
+ SHARED_FIRST+pInode->sharedByte, 1, 1);
+ if( IS_LOCK_ERROR(lrc1) ){
+ lrc1Errno = pFile->lastErrno;
+ }
+ /* Drop the temporary PENDING lock */
+ lrc2 = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, PENDING_BYTE, 1, 0);
+
+ if( IS_LOCK_ERROR(lrc1) ) {
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, lrc1Errno);
+ rc = lrc1;
+ goto afp_end_lock;
+ } else if( IS_LOCK_ERROR(lrc2) ){
+ rc = lrc2;
+ goto afp_end_lock;
+ } else if( lrc1 != SQLITE_OK ) {
+ rc = lrc1;
+ } else {
+ pFile->eFileLock = SHARED_LOCK;
+ pInode->nLock++;
+ pInode->nShared = 1;
+ }
+ }else if( eFileLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK && pInode->nShared>1 ){
+ /* We are trying for an exclusive lock but another thread in this
+ ** same process is still holding a shared lock. */
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }else{
+ /* The request was for a RESERVED or EXCLUSIVE lock. It is
+ ** assumed that there is a SHARED or greater lock on the file
+ ** already.
+ */
+ int failed = 0;
+ assert( 0!=pFile->eFileLock );
+ if (eFileLock >= RESERVED_LOCK && pFile->eFileLock < RESERVED_LOCK) {
+ /* Acquire a RESERVED lock */
+ failed = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, RESERVED_BYTE, 1,1);
+ if( !failed ){
+ context->reserved = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ if (!failed && eFileLock == EXCLUSIVE_LOCK) {
+ /* Acquire an EXCLUSIVE lock */
+
+ /* Remove the shared lock before trying the range. we'll need to
+ ** reestablish the shared lock if we can't get the afpUnlock
+ */
+ if( !(failed = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, SHARED_FIRST +
+ pInode->sharedByte, 1, 0)) ){
+ int failed2 = SQLITE_OK;
+ /* now attemmpt to get the exclusive lock range */
+ failed = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, SHARED_FIRST,
+ SHARED_SIZE, 1);
+ if( failed && (failed2 = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile,
+ SHARED_FIRST + pInode->sharedByte, 1, 1)) ){
+ /* Can't reestablish the shared lock. Sqlite can't deal, this is
+ ** a critical I/O error
+ */
+ rc = ((failed & 0xff) == SQLITE_IOERR) ? failed2 :
+ SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK;
+ goto afp_end_lock;
+ }
+ }else{
+ rc = failed;
+ }
+ }
+ if( failed ){
+ rc = failed;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ pInode->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ }else if( eFileLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK ){
+ pFile->eFileLock = PENDING_LOCK;
+ pInode->eFileLock = PENDING_LOCK;
+ }
+
+afp_end_lock:
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK %d %s %s (afp)\n", pFile->h, azFileLock(eFileLock),
+ rc==SQLITE_OK ? "ok" : "failed"));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lower the locking level on file descriptor pFile to eFileLock. eFileLock
+** must be either NO_LOCK or SHARED_LOCK.
+**
+** If the locking level of the file descriptor is already at or below
+** the requested locking level, this routine is a no-op.
+*/
+static int afpUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock) {
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode;
+ afpLockingContext *context = (afpLockingContext *) pFile->lockingContext;
+ int skipShared = 0;
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ int h = pFile->h;
+#endif
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ OSTRACE(("UNLOCK %d %d was %d(%d,%d) pid=%d (afp)\n", pFile->h, eFileLock,
+ pFile->eFileLock, pFile->pInode->eFileLock, pFile->pInode->nShared,
+ osGetpid(0)));
+
+ assert( eFileLock<=SHARED_LOCK );
+ if( pFile->eFileLock<=eFileLock ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ pInode = pFile->pInode;
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ assert( pInode->nShared!=0 );
+ if( pFile->eFileLock>SHARED_LOCK ){
+ assert( pInode->eFileLock==pFile->eFileLock );
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(1);
+ SimulateIOError( h=(-1) )
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(0);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ /* When reducing a lock such that other processes can start
+ ** reading the database file again, make sure that the
+ ** transaction counter was updated if any part of the database
+ ** file changed. If the transaction counter is not updated,
+ ** other connections to the same file might not realize that
+ ** the file has changed and hence might not know to flush their
+ ** cache. The use of a stale cache can lead to database corruption.
+ */
+ assert( pFile->inNormalWrite==0
+ || pFile->dbUpdate==0
+ || pFile->transCntrChng==1 );
+ pFile->inNormalWrite = 0;
+#endif
+
+ if( pFile->eFileLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK ){
+ rc = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, SHARED_FIRST, SHARED_SIZE, 0);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && (eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK || pInode->nShared>1) ){
+ /* only re-establish the shared lock if necessary */
+ int sharedLockByte = SHARED_FIRST+pInode->sharedByte;
+ rc = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, sharedLockByte, 1, 1);
+ } else {
+ skipShared = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && pFile->eFileLock>=PENDING_LOCK ){
+ rc = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, PENDING_BYTE, 1, 0);
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && pFile->eFileLock>=RESERVED_LOCK && context->reserved ){
+ rc = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, RESERVED_BYTE, 1, 0);
+ if( !rc ){
+ context->reserved = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && (eFileLock==SHARED_LOCK || pInode->nShared>1)){
+ pInode->eFileLock = SHARED_LOCK;
+ }
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && eFileLock==NO_LOCK ){
+
+ /* Decrement the shared lock counter. Release the lock using an
+ ** OS call only when all threads in this same process have released
+ ** the lock.
+ */
+ unsigned long long sharedLockByte = SHARED_FIRST+pInode->sharedByte;
+ pInode->nShared--;
+ if( pInode->nShared==0 ){
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(1);
+ SimulateIOError( h=(-1) )
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(0);
+ if( !skipShared ){
+ rc = afpSetLock(context->dbPath, pFile, sharedLockByte, 1, 0);
+ }
+ if( !rc ){
+ pInode->eFileLock = NO_LOCK;
+ pFile->eFileLock = NO_LOCK;
+ }
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pInode->nLock--;
+ assert( pInode->nLock>=0 );
+ if( pInode->nLock==0 ) closePendingFds(pFile);
+ }
+ }
+
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pFile->eFileLock = eFileLock;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Close a file & cleanup AFP specific locking context
+*/
+static int afpClose(sqlite3_file *id) {
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ assert( id!=0 );
+ afpUnlock(id, NO_LOCK);
+ assert( unixFileMutexNotheld(pFile) );
+ unixEnterMutex();
+ if( pFile->pInode ){
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode = pFile->pInode;
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ if( pInode->nLock ){
+ /* If there are outstanding locks, do not actually close the file just
+ ** yet because that would clear those locks. Instead, add the file
+ ** descriptor to pInode->aPending. It will be automatically closed when
+ ** the last lock is cleared.
+ */
+ setPendingFd(pFile);
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ }
+ releaseInodeInfo(pFile);
+ sqlite3_free(pFile->lockingContext);
+ rc = closeUnixFile(id);
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+ return rc;
+}
+
+#endif /* defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE */
+/*
+** The code above is the AFP lock implementation. The code is specific
+** to MacOSX and does not work on other unix platforms. No alternative
+** is available. If you don't compile for a mac, then the "unix-afp"
+** VFS is not available.
+**
+********************* End of the AFP lock implementation **********************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/******************************************************************************
+*************************** Begin NFS Locking ********************************/
+
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+/*
+ ** Lower the locking level on file descriptor pFile to eFileLock. eFileLock
+ ** must be either NO_LOCK or SHARED_LOCK.
+ **
+ ** If the locking level of the file descriptor is already at or below
+ ** the requested locking level, this routine is a no-op.
+ */
+static int nfsUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock){
+ return posixUnlock(id, eFileLock, 1);
+}
+
+#endif /* defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE */
+/*
+** The code above is the NFS lock implementation. The code is specific
+** to MacOSX and does not work on other unix platforms. No alternative
+** is available.
+**
+********************* End of the NFS lock implementation **********************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/******************************************************************************
+**************** Non-locking sqlite3_file methods *****************************
+**
+** The next division contains implementations for all methods of the
+** sqlite3_file object other than the locking methods. The locking
+** methods were defined in divisions above (one locking method per
+** division). Those methods that are common to all locking modes
+** are gather together into this division.
+*/
+
+/*
+** Seek to the offset passed as the second argument, then read cnt
+** bytes into pBuf. Return the number of bytes actually read.
+**
+** NB: If you define USE_PREAD or USE_PREAD64, then it might also
+** be necessary to define _XOPEN_SOURCE to be 500. This varies from
+** one system to another. Since SQLite does not define USE_PREAD
+** in any form by default, we will not attempt to define _XOPEN_SOURCE.
+** See tickets #2741 and #2681.
+**
+** To avoid stomping the errno value on a failed read the lastErrno value
+** is set before returning.
+*/
+static int seekAndRead(unixFile *id, sqlite3_int64 offset, void *pBuf, int cnt){
+ int got;
+ int prior = 0;
+#if (!defined(USE_PREAD) && !defined(USE_PREAD64))
+ i64 newOffset;
+#endif
+ TIMER_START;
+ assert( cnt==(cnt&0x1ffff) );
+ assert( id->h>2 );
+ do{
+#if defined(USE_PREAD)
+ got = osPread(id->h, pBuf, cnt, offset);
+ SimulateIOError( got = -1 );
+#elif defined(USE_PREAD64)
+ got = osPread64(id->h, pBuf, cnt, offset);
+ SimulateIOError( got = -1 );
+#else
+ newOffset = lseek(id->h, offset, SEEK_SET);
+ SimulateIOError( newOffset = -1 );
+ if( newOffset<0 ){
+ storeLastErrno((unixFile*)id, errno);
+ return -1;
+ }
+ got = osRead(id->h, pBuf, cnt);
+#endif
+ if( got==cnt ) break;
+ if( got<0 ){
+ if( errno==EINTR ){ got = 1; continue; }
+ prior = 0;
+ storeLastErrno((unixFile*)id, errno);
+ break;
+ }else if( got>0 ){
+ cnt -= got;
+ offset += got;
+ prior += got;
+ pBuf = (void*)(got + (char*)pBuf);
+ }
+ }while( got>0 );
+ TIMER_END;
+ OSTRACE(("READ %-3d %5d %7lld %llu\n",
+ id->h, got+prior, offset-prior, TIMER_ELAPSED));
+ return got+prior;
+}
+
+/*
+** Read data from a file into a buffer. Return SQLITE_OK if all
+** bytes were read successfully and SQLITE_IOERR if anything goes
+** wrong.
+*/
+static int unixRead(
+ sqlite3_file *id,
+ void *pBuf,
+ int amt,
+ sqlite3_int64 offset
+){
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile *)id;
+ int got;
+ assert( id );
+ assert( offset>=0 );
+ assert( amt>0 );
+
+ /* If this is a database file (not a journal, super-journal or temp
+ ** file), the bytes in the locking range should never be read or written. */
+#if 0
+ assert( pFile->pPreallocatedUnused==0
+ || offset>=PENDING_BYTE+512
+ || offset+amt<=PENDING_BYTE
+ );
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ /* Deal with as much of this read request as possible by transfering
+ ** data from the memory mapping using memcpy(). */
+ if( offsetmmapSize ){
+ if( offset+amt <= pFile->mmapSize ){
+ memcpy(pBuf, &((u8 *)(pFile->pMapRegion))[offset], amt);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ int nCopy = pFile->mmapSize - offset;
+ memcpy(pBuf, &((u8 *)(pFile->pMapRegion))[offset], nCopy);
+ pBuf = &((u8 *)pBuf)[nCopy];
+ amt -= nCopy;
+ offset += nCopy;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ got = seekAndRead(pFile, offset, pBuf, amt);
+ if( got==amt ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }else if( got<0 ){
+ /* lastErrno set by seekAndRead */
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_READ;
+ }else{
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, 0); /* not a system error */
+ /* Unread parts of the buffer must be zero-filled */
+ memset(&((char*)pBuf)[got], 0, amt-got);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Attempt to seek the file-descriptor passed as the first argument to
+** absolute offset iOff, then attempt to write nBuf bytes of data from
+** pBuf to it. If an error occurs, return -1 and set *piErrno. Otherwise,
+** return the actual number of bytes written (which may be less than
+** nBuf).
+*/
+static int seekAndWriteFd(
+ int fd, /* File descriptor to write to */
+ i64 iOff, /* File offset to begin writing at */
+ const void *pBuf, /* Copy data from this buffer to the file */
+ int nBuf, /* Size of buffer pBuf in bytes */
+ int *piErrno /* OUT: Error number if error occurs */
+){
+ int rc = 0; /* Value returned by system call */
+
+ assert( nBuf==(nBuf&0x1ffff) );
+ assert( fd>2 );
+ assert( piErrno!=0 );
+ nBuf &= 0x1ffff;
+ TIMER_START;
+
+#if defined(USE_PREAD)
+ do{ rc = (int)osPwrite(fd, pBuf, nBuf, iOff); }while( rc<0 && errno==EINTR );
+#elif defined(USE_PREAD64)
+ do{ rc = (int)osPwrite64(fd, pBuf, nBuf, iOff);}while( rc<0 && errno==EINTR);
+#else
+ do{
+ i64 iSeek = lseek(fd, iOff, SEEK_SET);
+ SimulateIOError( iSeek = -1 );
+ if( iSeek<0 ){
+ rc = -1;
+ break;
+ }
+ rc = osWrite(fd, pBuf, nBuf);
+ }while( rc<0 && errno==EINTR );
+#endif
+
+ TIMER_END;
+ OSTRACE(("WRITE %-3d %5d %7lld %llu\n", fd, rc, iOff, TIMER_ELAPSED));
+
+ if( rc<0 ) *piErrno = errno;
+ return rc;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Seek to the offset in id->offset then read cnt bytes into pBuf.
+** Return the number of bytes actually read. Update the offset.
+**
+** To avoid stomping the errno value on a failed write the lastErrno value
+** is set before returning.
+*/
+static int seekAndWrite(unixFile *id, i64 offset, const void *pBuf, int cnt){
+ return seekAndWriteFd(id->h, offset, pBuf, cnt, &id->lastErrno);
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Write data from a buffer into a file. Return SQLITE_OK on success
+** or some other error code on failure.
+*/
+static int unixWrite(
+ sqlite3_file *id,
+ const void *pBuf,
+ int amt,
+ sqlite3_int64 offset
+){
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ int wrote = 0;
+ assert( id );
+ assert( amt>0 );
+
+ /* If this is a database file (not a journal, super-journal or temp
+ ** file), the bytes in the locking range should never be read or written. */
+#if 0
+ assert( pFile->pPreallocatedUnused==0
+ || offset>=PENDING_BYTE+512
+ || offset+amt<=PENDING_BYTE
+ );
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ /* If we are doing a normal write to a database file (as opposed to
+ ** doing a hot-journal rollback or a write to some file other than a
+ ** normal database file) then record the fact that the database
+ ** has changed. If the transaction counter is modified, record that
+ ** fact too.
+ */
+ if( pFile->inNormalWrite ){
+ pFile->dbUpdate = 1; /* The database has been modified */
+ if( offset<=24 && offset+amt>=27 ){
+ int rc;
+ char oldCntr[4];
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(1);
+ rc = seekAndRead(pFile, 24, oldCntr, 4);
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(0);
+ if( rc!=4 || memcmp(oldCntr, &((char*)pBuf)[24-offset], 4)!=0 ){
+ pFile->transCntrChng = 1; /* The transaction counter has changed */
+ }
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_MMAP_READWRITE) && SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ /* Deal with as much of this write request as possible by transfering
+ ** data from the memory mapping using memcpy(). */
+ if( offsetmmapSize ){
+ if( offset+amt <= pFile->mmapSize ){
+ memcpy(&((u8 *)(pFile->pMapRegion))[offset], pBuf, amt);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ int nCopy = pFile->mmapSize - offset;
+ memcpy(&((u8 *)(pFile->pMapRegion))[offset], pBuf, nCopy);
+ pBuf = &((u8 *)pBuf)[nCopy];
+ amt -= nCopy;
+ offset += nCopy;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ while( (wrote = seekAndWrite(pFile, offset, pBuf, amt))0 ){
+ amt -= wrote;
+ offset += wrote;
+ pBuf = &((char*)pBuf)[wrote];
+ }
+ SimulateIOError(( wrote=(-1), amt=1 ));
+ SimulateDiskfullError(( wrote=0, amt=1 ));
+
+ if( amt>wrote ){
+ if( wrote<0 && pFile->lastErrno!=ENOSPC ){
+ /* lastErrno set by seekAndWrite */
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_WRITE;
+ }else{
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, 0); /* not a system error */
+ return SQLITE_FULL;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+/*
+** Count the number of fullsyncs and normal syncs. This is used to test
+** that syncs and fullsyncs are occurring at the right times.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_sync_count = 0;
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_fullsync_count = 0;
+#endif
+
+/*
+** We do not trust systems to provide a working fdatasync(). Some do.
+** Others do no. To be safe, we will stick with the (slightly slower)
+** fsync(). If you know that your system does support fdatasync() correctly,
+** then simply compile with -Dfdatasync=fdatasync or -DHAVE_FDATASYNC
+*/
+#if !defined(fdatasync) && !HAVE_FDATASYNC
+# define fdatasync fsync
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Define HAVE_FULLFSYNC to 0 or 1 depending on whether or not
+** the F_FULLFSYNC macro is defined. F_FULLFSYNC is currently
+** only available on Mac OS X. But that could change.
+*/
+#ifdef F_FULLFSYNC
+# define HAVE_FULLFSYNC 1
+#else
+# define HAVE_FULLFSYNC 0
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+** The fsync() system call does not work as advertised on many
+** unix systems. The following procedure is an attempt to make
+** it work better.
+**
+** The SQLITE_NO_SYNC macro disables all fsync()s. This is useful
+** for testing when we want to run through the test suite quickly.
+** You are strongly advised *not* to deploy with SQLITE_NO_SYNC
+** enabled, however, since with SQLITE_NO_SYNC enabled, an OS crash
+** or power failure will likely corrupt the database file.
+**
+** SQLite sets the dataOnly flag if the size of the file is unchanged.
+** The idea behind dataOnly is that it should only write the file content
+** to disk, not the inode. We only set dataOnly if the file size is
+** unchanged since the file size is part of the inode. However,
+** Ted Ts'o tells us that fdatasync() will also write the inode if the
+** file size has changed. The only real difference between fdatasync()
+** and fsync(), Ted tells us, is that fdatasync() will not flush the
+** inode if the mtime or owner or other inode attributes have changed.
+** We only care about the file size, not the other file attributes, so
+** as far as SQLite is concerned, an fdatasync() is always adequate.
+** So, we always use fdatasync() if it is available, regardless of
+** the value of the dataOnly flag.
+*/
+static int full_fsync(int fd, int fullSync, int dataOnly){
+ int rc;
+
+ /* The following "ifdef/elif/else/" block has the same structure as
+ ** the one below. It is replicated here solely to avoid cluttering
+ ** up the real code with the UNUSED_PARAMETER() macros.
+ */
+#ifdef SQLITE_NO_SYNC
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(fd);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(fullSync);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(dataOnly);
+#elif HAVE_FULLFSYNC
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(dataOnly);
+#else
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(fullSync);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(dataOnly);
+#endif
+
+ /* Record the number of times that we do a normal fsync() and
+ ** FULLSYNC. This is used during testing to verify that this procedure
+ ** gets called with the correct arguments.
+ */
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ if( fullSync ) sqlite3_fullsync_count++;
+ sqlite3_sync_count++;
+#endif
+
+ /* If we compiled with the SQLITE_NO_SYNC flag, then syncing is a
+ ** no-op. But go ahead and call fstat() to validate the file
+ ** descriptor as we need a method to provoke a failure during
+ ** coverate testing.
+ */
+#ifdef SQLITE_NO_SYNC
+ {
+ struct stat buf;
+ rc = osFstat(fd, &buf);
+ }
+#elif HAVE_FULLFSYNC
+ if( fullSync ){
+ rc = osFcntl(fd, F_FULLFSYNC, 0);
+ }else{
+ rc = 1;
+ }
+ /* If the FULLFSYNC failed, fall back to attempting an fsync().
+ ** It shouldn't be possible for fullfsync to fail on the local
+ ** file system (on OSX), so failure indicates that FULLFSYNC
+ ** isn't supported for this file system. So, attempt an fsync
+ ** and (for now) ignore the overhead of a superfluous fcntl call.
+ ** It'd be better to detect fullfsync support once and avoid
+ ** the fcntl call every time sync is called.
+ */
+ if( rc ) rc = fsync(fd);
+
+#elif defined(__APPLE__)
+ /* fdatasync() on HFS+ doesn't yet flush the file size if it changed correctly
+ ** so currently we default to the macro that redefines fdatasync to fsync
+ */
+ rc = fsync(fd);
+#else
+ rc = fdatasync(fd);
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ if( rc==-1 && errno==ENOTSUP ){
+ rc = fsync(fd);
+ }
+#endif /* OS_VXWORKS */
+#endif /* ifdef SQLITE_NO_SYNC elif HAVE_FULLFSYNC */
+
+ if( OS_VXWORKS && rc!= -1 ){
+ rc = 0;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Open a file descriptor to the directory containing file zFilename.
+** If successful, *pFd is set to the opened file descriptor and
+** SQLITE_OK is returned. If an error occurs, either SQLITE_NOMEM
+** or SQLITE_CANTOPEN is returned and *pFd is set to an undefined
+** value.
+**
+** The directory file descriptor is used for only one thing - to
+** fsync() a directory to make sure file creation and deletion events
+** are flushed to disk. Such fsyncs are not needed on newer
+** journaling filesystems, but are required on older filesystems.
+**
+** This routine can be overridden using the xSetSysCall interface.
+** The ability to override this routine was added in support of the
+** chromium sandbox. Opening a directory is a security risk (we are
+** told) so making it overrideable allows the chromium sandbox to
+** replace this routine with a harmless no-op. To make this routine
+** a no-op, replace it with a stub that returns SQLITE_OK but leaves
+** *pFd set to a negative number.
+**
+** If SQLITE_OK is returned, the caller is responsible for closing
+** the file descriptor *pFd using close().
+*/
+static int openDirectory(const char *zFilename, int *pFd){
+ int ii;
+ int fd = -1;
+ char zDirname[MAX_PATHNAME+1];
+
+ sqlite3_snprintf(MAX_PATHNAME, zDirname, "%s", zFilename);
+ for(ii=(int)strlen(zDirname); ii>0 && zDirname[ii]!='/'; ii--);
+ if( ii>0 ){
+ zDirname[ii] = '\0';
+ }else{
+ if( zDirname[0]!='/' ) zDirname[0] = '.';
+ zDirname[1] = 0;
+ }
+ fd = robust_open(zDirname, O_RDONLY|O_BINARY, 0);
+ if( fd>=0 ){
+ OSTRACE(("OPENDIR %-3d %s\n", fd, zDirname));
+ }
+ *pFd = fd;
+ if( fd>=0 ) return SQLITE_OK;
+ return unixLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT, "openDirectory", zDirname);
+}
+
+/*
+** Make sure all writes to a particular file are committed to disk.
+**
+** If dataOnly==0 then both the file itself and its metadata (file
+** size, access time, etc) are synced. If dataOnly!=0 then only the
+** file data is synced.
+**
+** Under Unix, also make sure that the directory entry for the file
+** has been created by fsync-ing the directory that contains the file.
+** If we do not do this and we encounter a power failure, the directory
+** entry for the journal might not exist after we reboot. The next
+** SQLite to access the file will not know that the journal exists (because
+** the directory entry for the journal was never created) and the transaction
+** will not roll back - possibly leading to database corruption.
+*/
+static int unixSync(sqlite3_file *id, int flags){
+ int rc;
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+
+ int isDataOnly = (flags&SQLITE_SYNC_DATAONLY);
+ int isFullsync = (flags&0x0F)==SQLITE_SYNC_FULL;
+
+ /* Check that one of SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL or FULL was passed */
+ assert((flags&0x0F)==SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL
+ || (flags&0x0F)==SQLITE_SYNC_FULL
+ );
+
+ /* Unix cannot, but some systems may return SQLITE_FULL from here. This
+ ** line is to test that doing so does not cause any problems.
+ */
+ SimulateDiskfullError( return SQLITE_FULL );
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ OSTRACE(("SYNC %-3d\n", pFile->h));
+ rc = full_fsync(pFile->h, isFullsync, isDataOnly);
+ SimulateIOError( rc=1 );
+ if( rc ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ return unixLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_FSYNC, "full_fsync", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+
+ /* Also fsync the directory containing the file if the DIRSYNC flag
+ ** is set. This is a one-time occurrence. Many systems (examples: AIX)
+ ** are unable to fsync a directory, so ignore errors on the fsync.
+ */
+ if( pFile->ctrlFlags & UNIXFILE_DIRSYNC ){
+ int dirfd;
+ OSTRACE(("DIRSYNC %s (have_fullfsync=%d fullsync=%d)\n", pFile->zPath,
+ HAVE_FULLFSYNC, isFullsync));
+ rc = osOpenDirectory(pFile->zPath, &dirfd);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ full_fsync(dirfd, 0, 0);
+ robust_close(pFile, dirfd, __LINE__);
+ }else{
+ assert( rc==SQLITE_CANTOPEN );
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ pFile->ctrlFlags &= ~UNIXFILE_DIRSYNC;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Truncate an open file to a specified size
+*/
+static int unixTruncate(sqlite3_file *id, i64 nByte){
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile *)id;
+ int rc;
+ assert( pFile );
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_IOERR_TRUNCATE );
+
+ /* If the user has configured a chunk-size for this file, truncate the
+ ** file so that it consists of an integer number of chunks (i.e. the
+ ** actual file size after the operation may be larger than the requested
+ ** size).
+ */
+ if( pFile->szChunk>0 ){
+ nByte = ((nByte + pFile->szChunk - 1)/pFile->szChunk) * pFile->szChunk;
+ }
+
+ rc = robust_ftruncate(pFile->h, nByte);
+ if( rc ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ return unixLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_TRUNCATE, "ftruncate", pFile->zPath);
+ }else{
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ /* If we are doing a normal write to a database file (as opposed to
+ ** doing a hot-journal rollback or a write to some file other than a
+ ** normal database file) and we truncate the file to zero length,
+ ** that effectively updates the change counter. This might happen
+ ** when restoring a database using the backup API from a zero-length
+ ** source.
+ */
+ if( pFile->inNormalWrite && nByte==0 ){
+ pFile->transCntrChng = 1;
+ }
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ /* If the file was just truncated to a size smaller than the currently
+ ** mapped region, reduce the effective mapping size as well. SQLite will
+ ** use read() and write() to access data beyond this point from now on.
+ */
+ if( nBytemmapSize ){
+ pFile->mmapSize = nByte;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Determine the current size of a file in bytes
+*/
+static int unixFileSize(sqlite3_file *id, i64 *pSize){
+ int rc;
+ struct stat buf;
+ assert( id );
+ rc = osFstat(((unixFile*)id)->h, &buf);
+ SimulateIOError( rc=1 );
+ if( rc!=0 ){
+ storeLastErrno((unixFile*)id, errno);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT;
+ }
+ *pSize = buf.st_size;
+
+ /* When opening a zero-size database, the findInodeInfo() procedure
+ ** writes a single byte into that file in order to work around a bug
+ ** in the OS-X msdos filesystem. In order to avoid problems with upper
+ ** layers, we need to report this file size as zero even though it is
+ ** really 1. Ticket #3260.
+ */
+ if( *pSize==1 ) *pSize = 0;
+
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE && defined(__APPLE__)
+/*
+** Handler for proxy-locking file-control verbs. Defined below in the
+** proxying locking division.
+*/
+static int proxyFileControl(sqlite3_file*,int,void*);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This function is called to handle the SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_HINT
+** file-control operation. Enlarge the database to nBytes in size
+** (rounded up to the next chunk-size). If the database is already
+** nBytes or larger, this routine is a no-op.
+*/
+static int fcntlSizeHint(unixFile *pFile, i64 nByte){
+ if( pFile->szChunk>0 ){
+ i64 nSize; /* Required file size */
+ struct stat buf; /* Used to hold return values of fstat() */
+
+ if( osFstat(pFile->h, &buf) ){
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT;
+ }
+
+ nSize = ((nByte+pFile->szChunk-1) / pFile->szChunk) * pFile->szChunk;
+ if( nSize>(i64)buf.st_size ){
+
+#if defined(HAVE_POSIX_FALLOCATE) && HAVE_POSIX_FALLOCATE
+ /* The code below is handling the return value of osFallocate()
+ ** correctly. posix_fallocate() is defined to "returns zero on success,
+ ** or an error number on failure". See the manpage for details. */
+ int err;
+ do{
+ err = osFallocate(pFile->h, buf.st_size, nSize-buf.st_size);
+ }while( err==EINTR );
+ if( err && err!=EINVAL ) return SQLITE_IOERR_WRITE;
+#else
+ /* If the OS does not have posix_fallocate(), fake it. Write a
+ ** single byte to the last byte in each block that falls entirely
+ ** within the extended region. Then, if required, a single byte
+ ** at offset (nSize-1), to set the size of the file correctly.
+ ** This is a similar technique to that used by glibc on systems
+ ** that do not have a real fallocate() call.
+ */
+ int nBlk = buf.st_blksize; /* File-system block size */
+ int nWrite = 0; /* Number of bytes written by seekAndWrite */
+ i64 iWrite; /* Next offset to write to */
+
+ iWrite = (buf.st_size/nBlk)*nBlk + nBlk - 1;
+ assert( iWrite>=buf.st_size );
+ assert( ((iWrite+1)%nBlk)==0 );
+ for(/*no-op*/; iWrite=nSize ) iWrite = nSize - 1;
+ nWrite = seekAndWrite(pFile, iWrite, "", 1);
+ if( nWrite!=1 ) return SQLITE_IOERR_WRITE;
+ }
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ if( pFile->mmapSizeMax>0 && nByte>pFile->mmapSize ){
+ int rc;
+ if( pFile->szChunk<=0 ){
+ if( robust_ftruncate(pFile->h, nByte) ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ return unixLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_TRUNCATE, "ftruncate", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+ }
+
+ rc = unixMapfile(pFile, nByte);
+ return rc;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** If *pArg is initially negative then this is a query. Set *pArg to
+** 1 or 0 depending on whether or not bit mask of pFile->ctrlFlags is set.
+**
+** If *pArg is 0 or 1, then clear or set the mask bit of pFile->ctrlFlags.
+*/
+static void unixModeBit(unixFile *pFile, unsigned char mask, int *pArg){
+ if( *pArg<0 ){
+ *pArg = (pFile->ctrlFlags & mask)!=0;
+ }else if( (*pArg)==0 ){
+ pFile->ctrlFlags &= ~mask;
+ }else{
+ pFile->ctrlFlags |= mask;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Forward declaration */
+static int unixGetTempname(int nBuf, char *zBuf);
+
+/*
+** Information and control of an open file handle.
+*/
+static int unixFileControl(sqlite3_file *id, int op, void *pArg){
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ switch( op ){
+#if defined(__linux__) && defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE)
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_BEGIN_ATOMIC_WRITE: {
+ int rc = osIoctl(pFile->h, F2FS_IOC_START_ATOMIC_WRITE);
+ return rc ? SQLITE_IOERR_BEGIN_ATOMIC : SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_ATOMIC_WRITE: {
+ int rc = osIoctl(pFile->h, F2FS_IOC_COMMIT_ATOMIC_WRITE);
+ return rc ? SQLITE_IOERR_COMMIT_ATOMIC : SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_ROLLBACK_ATOMIC_WRITE: {
+ int rc = osIoctl(pFile->h, F2FS_IOC_ABORT_VOLATILE_WRITE);
+ return rc ? SQLITE_IOERR_ROLLBACK_ATOMIC : SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+#endif /* __linux__ && SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE */
+
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCKSTATE: {
+ *(int*)pArg = pFile->eFileLock;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_LAST_ERRNO: {
+ *(int*)pArg = pFile->lastErrno;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_CHUNK_SIZE: {
+ pFile->szChunk = *(int *)pArg;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_HINT: {
+ int rc;
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(1);
+ rc = fcntlSizeHint(pFile, *(i64 *)pArg);
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(0);
+ return rc;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_PERSIST_WAL: {
+ unixModeBit(pFile, UNIXFILE_PERSIST_WAL, (int*)pArg);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE: {
+ unixModeBit(pFile, UNIXFILE_PSOW, (int*)pArg);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_VFSNAME: {
+ *(char**)pArg = sqlite3_mprintf("%s", pFile->pVfs->zName);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_TEMPFILENAME: {
+ char *zTFile = sqlite3_malloc64( pFile->pVfs->mxPathname );
+ if( zTFile ){
+ unixGetTempname(pFile->pVfs->mxPathname, zTFile);
+ *(char**)pArg = zTFile;
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_HAS_MOVED: {
+ *(int*)pArg = fileHasMoved(pFile);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_SETLK_TIMEOUT
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCK_TIMEOUT: {
+ int iOld = pFile->iBusyTimeout;
+ pFile->iBusyTimeout = *(int*)pArg;
+ *(int*)pArg = iOld;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE: {
+ i64 newLimit = *(i64*)pArg;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ if( newLimit>sqlite3GlobalConfig.mxMmap ){
+ newLimit = sqlite3GlobalConfig.mxMmap;
+ }
+
+ /* The value of newLimit may be eventually cast to (size_t) and passed
+ ** to mmap(). Restrict its value to 2GB if (size_t) is not at least a
+ ** 64-bit type. */
+ if( newLimit>0 && sizeof(size_t)<8 ){
+ newLimit = (newLimit & 0x7FFFFFFF);
+ }
+
+ *(i64*)pArg = pFile->mmapSizeMax;
+ if( newLimit>=0 && newLimit!=pFile->mmapSizeMax && pFile->nFetchOut==0 ){
+ pFile->mmapSizeMax = newLimit;
+ if( pFile->mmapSize>0 ){
+ unixUnmapfile(pFile);
+ rc = unixMapfile(pFile, -1);
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+ }
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ /* The pager calls this method to signal that it has done
+ ** a rollback and that the database is therefore unchanged and
+ ** it hence it is OK for the transaction change counter to be
+ ** unchanged.
+ */
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_DB_UNCHANGED: {
+ ((unixFile*)id)->dbUpdate = 0;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE && defined(__APPLE__)
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_SET_LOCKPROXYFILE:
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_GET_LOCKPROXYFILE: {
+ return proxyFileControl(id,op,pArg);
+ }
+#endif /* SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE && defined(__APPLE__) */
+ }
+ return SQLITE_NOTFOUND;
+}
+
+/*
+** If pFd->sectorSize is non-zero when this function is called, it is a
+** no-op. Otherwise, the values of pFd->sectorSize and
+** pFd->deviceCharacteristics are set according to the file-system
+** characteristics.
+**
+** There are two versions of this function. One for QNX and one for all
+** other systems.
+*/
+#ifndef __QNXNTO__
+static void setDeviceCharacteristics(unixFile *pFd){
+ assert( pFd->deviceCharacteristics==0 || pFd->sectorSize!=0 );
+ if( pFd->sectorSize==0 ){
+#if defined(__linux__) && defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE)
+ int res;
+ u32 f = 0;
+
+ /* Check for support for F2FS atomic batch writes. */
+ res = osIoctl(pFd->h, F2FS_IOC_GET_FEATURES, &f);
+ if( res==0 && (f & F2FS_FEATURE_ATOMIC_WRITE) ){
+ pFd->deviceCharacteristics = SQLITE_IOCAP_BATCH_ATOMIC;
+ }
+#endif /* __linux__ && SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE */
+
+ /* Set the POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE flag if requested. */
+ if( pFd->ctrlFlags & UNIXFILE_PSOW ){
+ pFd->deviceCharacteristics |= SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE;
+ }
+
+ pFd->sectorSize = SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE;
+ }
+}
+#else
+#include
+#include
+static void setDeviceCharacteristics(unixFile *pFile){
+ if( pFile->sectorSize == 0 ){
+ struct statvfs fsInfo;
+
+ /* Set defaults for non-supported filesystems */
+ pFile->sectorSize = SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE;
+ pFile->deviceCharacteristics = 0;
+ if( fstatvfs(pFile->h, &fsInfo) == -1 ) {
+ return;
+ }
+
+ if( !strcmp(fsInfo.f_basetype, "tmp") ) {
+ pFile->sectorSize = fsInfo.f_bsize;
+ pFile->deviceCharacteristics =
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC4K | /* All ram filesystem writes are atomic */
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND | /* growing the file does not occur until
+ ** the write succeeds */
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL | /* The ram filesystem has no write behind
+ ** so it is ordered */
+ 0;
+ }else if( strstr(fsInfo.f_basetype, "etfs") ){
+ pFile->sectorSize = fsInfo.f_bsize;
+ pFile->deviceCharacteristics =
+ /* etfs cluster size writes are atomic */
+ (pFile->sectorSize / 512 * SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC512) |
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND | /* growing the file does not occur until
+ ** the write succeeds */
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL | /* The ram filesystem has no write behind
+ ** so it is ordered */
+ 0;
+ }else if( !strcmp(fsInfo.f_basetype, "qnx6") ){
+ pFile->sectorSize = fsInfo.f_bsize;
+ pFile->deviceCharacteristics =
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC | /* All filesystem writes are atomic */
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND | /* growing the file does not occur until
+ ** the write succeeds */
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL | /* The ram filesystem has no write behind
+ ** so it is ordered */
+ 0;
+ }else if( !strcmp(fsInfo.f_basetype, "qnx4") ){
+ pFile->sectorSize = fsInfo.f_bsize;
+ pFile->deviceCharacteristics =
+ /* full bitset of atomics from max sector size and smaller */
+ ((pFile->sectorSize / 512 * SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC512) << 1) - 2 |
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL | /* The ram filesystem has no write behind
+ ** so it is ordered */
+ 0;
+ }else if( strstr(fsInfo.f_basetype, "dos") ){
+ pFile->sectorSize = fsInfo.f_bsize;
+ pFile->deviceCharacteristics =
+ /* full bitset of atomics from max sector size and smaller */
+ ((pFile->sectorSize / 512 * SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC512) << 1) - 2 |
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL | /* The ram filesystem has no write behind
+ ** so it is ordered */
+ 0;
+ }else{
+ pFile->deviceCharacteristics =
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC512 | /* blocks are atomic */
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND | /* growing the file does not occur until
+ ** the write succeeds */
+ 0;
+ }
+ }
+ /* Last chance verification. If the sector size isn't a multiple of 512
+ ** then it isn't valid.*/
+ if( pFile->sectorSize % 512 != 0 ){
+ pFile->deviceCharacteristics = 0;
+ pFile->sectorSize = SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE;
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Return the sector size in bytes of the underlying block device for
+** the specified file. This is almost always 512 bytes, but may be
+** larger for some devices.
+**
+** SQLite code assumes this function cannot fail. It also assumes that
+** if two files are created in the same file-system directory (i.e.
+** a database and its journal file) that the sector size will be the
+** same for both.
+*/
+static int unixSectorSize(sqlite3_file *id){
+ unixFile *pFd = (unixFile*)id;
+ setDeviceCharacteristics(pFd);
+ return pFd->sectorSize;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the device characteristics for the file.
+**
+** This VFS is set up to return SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE by default.
+** However, that choice is controversial since technically the underlying
+** file system does not always provide powersafe overwrites. (In other
+** words, after a power-loss event, parts of the file that were never
+** written might end up being altered.) However, non-PSOW behavior is very,
+** very rare. And asserting PSOW makes a large reduction in the amount
+** of required I/O for journaling, since a lot of padding is eliminated.
+** Hence, while POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE is on by default, there is a file-control
+** available to turn it off and URI query parameter available to turn it off.
+*/
+static int unixDeviceCharacteristics(sqlite3_file *id){
+ unixFile *pFd = (unixFile*)id;
+ setDeviceCharacteristics(pFd);
+ return pFd->deviceCharacteristics;
+}
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+
+/*
+** Return the system page size.
+**
+** This function should not be called directly by other code in this file.
+** Instead, it should be called via macro osGetpagesize().
+*/
+static int unixGetpagesize(void){
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ return 1024;
+#elif defined(_BSD_SOURCE)
+ return getpagesize();
+#else
+ return (int)sysconf(_SC_PAGESIZE);
+#endif
+}
+
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0 */
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+
+/*
+** Object used to represent an shared memory buffer.
+**
+** When multiple threads all reference the same wal-index, each thread
+** has its own unixShm object, but they all point to a single instance
+** of this unixShmNode object. In other words, each wal-index is opened
+** only once per process.
+**
+** Each unixShmNode object is connected to a single unixInodeInfo object.
+** We could coalesce this object into unixInodeInfo, but that would mean
+** every open file that does not use shared memory (in other words, most
+** open files) would have to carry around this extra information. So
+** the unixInodeInfo object contains a pointer to this unixShmNode object
+** and the unixShmNode object is created only when needed.
+**
+** unixMutexHeld() must be true when creating or destroying
+** this object or while reading or writing the following fields:
+**
+** nRef
+**
+** The following fields are read-only after the object is created:
+**
+** hShm
+** zFilename
+**
+** Either unixShmNode.pShmMutex must be held or unixShmNode.nRef==0 and
+** unixMutexHeld() is true when reading or writing any other field
+** in this structure.
+*/
+struct unixShmNode {
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode; /* unixInodeInfo that owns this SHM node */
+ sqlite3_mutex *pShmMutex; /* Mutex to access this object */
+ char *zFilename; /* Name of the mmapped file */
+ int hShm; /* Open file descriptor */
+ int szRegion; /* Size of shared-memory regions */
+ u16 nRegion; /* Size of array apRegion */
+ u8 isReadonly; /* True if read-only */
+ u8 isUnlocked; /* True if no DMS lock held */
+ char **apRegion; /* Array of mapped shared-memory regions */
+ int nRef; /* Number of unixShm objects pointing to this */
+ unixShm *pFirst; /* All unixShm objects pointing to this */
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ u8 exclMask; /* Mask of exclusive locks held */
+ u8 sharedMask; /* Mask of shared locks held */
+ u8 nextShmId; /* Next available unixShm.id value */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** Structure used internally by this VFS to record the state of an
+** open shared memory connection.
+**
+** The following fields are initialized when this object is created and
+** are read-only thereafter:
+**
+** unixShm.pShmNode
+** unixShm.id
+**
+** All other fields are read/write. The unixShm.pShmNode->pShmMutex must
+** be held while accessing any read/write fields.
+*/
+struct unixShm {
+ unixShmNode *pShmNode; /* The underlying unixShmNode object */
+ unixShm *pNext; /* Next unixShm with the same unixShmNode */
+ u8 hasMutex; /* True if holding the unixShmNode->pShmMutex */
+ u8 id; /* Id of this connection within its unixShmNode */
+ u16 sharedMask; /* Mask of shared locks held */
+ u16 exclMask; /* Mask of exclusive locks held */
+};
+
+/*
+** Constants used for locking
+*/
+#define UNIX_SHM_BASE ((22+SQLITE_SHM_NLOCK)*4) /* first lock byte */
+#define UNIX_SHM_DMS (UNIX_SHM_BASE+SQLITE_SHM_NLOCK) /* deadman switch */
+
+/*
+** Apply posix advisory locks for all bytes from ofst through ofst+n-1.
+**
+** Locks block if the mask is exactly UNIX_SHM_C and are non-blocking
+** otherwise.
+*/
+static int unixShmSystemLock(
+ unixFile *pFile, /* Open connection to the WAL file */
+ int lockType, /* F_UNLCK, F_RDLCK, or F_WRLCK */
+ int ofst, /* First byte of the locking range */
+ int n /* Number of bytes to lock */
+){
+ unixShmNode *pShmNode; /* Apply locks to this open shared-memory segment */
+ struct flock f; /* The posix advisory locking structure */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Result code form fcntl() */
+
+ /* Access to the unixShmNode object is serialized by the caller */
+ pShmNode = pFile->pInode->pShmNode;
+ assert( pShmNode->nRef==0 || sqlite3_mutex_held(pShmNode->pShmMutex) );
+ assert( pShmNode->nRef>0 || unixMutexHeld() );
+
+ /* Shared locks never span more than one byte */
+ assert( n==1 || lockType!=F_RDLCK );
+
+ /* Locks are within range */
+ assert( n>=1 && n<=SQLITE_SHM_NLOCK );
+
+ if( pShmNode->hShm>=0 ){
+ int res;
+ /* Initialize the locking parameters */
+ f.l_type = lockType;
+ f.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ f.l_start = ofst;
+ f.l_len = n;
+ res = osSetPosixAdvisoryLock(pShmNode->hShm, &f, pFile);
+ if( res==-1 ){
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_SETLK_TIMEOUT
+ rc = (pFile->iBusyTimeout ? SQLITE_BUSY_TIMEOUT : SQLITE_BUSY);
+#else
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Update the global lock state and do debug tracing */
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ { u16 mask;
+ OSTRACE(("SHM-LOCK "));
+ mask = ofst>31 ? 0xffff : (1<<(ofst+n)) - (1<exclMask &= ~mask;
+ pShmNode->sharedMask &= ~mask;
+ }else if( lockType==F_RDLCK ){
+ OSTRACE(("read-lock %d ok", ofst));
+ pShmNode->exclMask &= ~mask;
+ pShmNode->sharedMask |= mask;
+ }else{
+ assert( lockType==F_WRLCK );
+ OSTRACE(("write-lock %d ok", ofst));
+ pShmNode->exclMask |= mask;
+ pShmNode->sharedMask &= ~mask;
+ }
+ }else{
+ if( lockType==F_UNLCK ){
+ OSTRACE(("unlock %d failed", ofst));
+ }else if( lockType==F_RDLCK ){
+ OSTRACE(("read-lock failed"));
+ }else{
+ assert( lockType==F_WRLCK );
+ OSTRACE(("write-lock %d failed", ofst));
+ }
+ }
+ OSTRACE((" - afterwards %03x,%03x\n",
+ pShmNode->sharedMask, pShmNode->exclMask));
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the minimum number of 32KB shm regions that should be mapped at
+** a time, assuming that each mapping must be an integer multiple of the
+** current system page-size.
+**
+** Usually, this is 1. The exception seems to be systems that are configured
+** to use 64KB pages - in this case each mapping must cover at least two
+** shm regions.
+*/
+static int unixShmRegionPerMap(void){
+ int shmsz = 32*1024; /* SHM region size */
+ int pgsz = osGetpagesize(); /* System page size */
+ assert( ((pgsz-1)&pgsz)==0 ); /* Page size must be a power of 2 */
+ if( pgszpInode->pShmNode;
+ assert( unixMutexHeld() );
+ if( p && ALWAYS(p->nRef==0) ){
+ int nShmPerMap = unixShmRegionPerMap();
+ int i;
+ assert( p->pInode==pFd->pInode );
+ sqlite3_mutex_free(p->pShmMutex);
+ for(i=0; inRegion; i+=nShmPerMap){
+ if( p->hShm>=0 ){
+ osMunmap(p->apRegion[i], p->szRegion);
+ }else{
+ sqlite3_free(p->apRegion[i]);
+ }
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(p->apRegion);
+ if( p->hShm>=0 ){
+ robust_close(pFd, p->hShm, __LINE__);
+ p->hShm = -1;
+ }
+ p->pInode->pShmNode = 0;
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** The DMS lock has not yet been taken on shm file pShmNode. Attempt to
+** take it now. Return SQLITE_OK if successful, or an SQLite error
+** code otherwise.
+**
+** If the DMS cannot be locked because this is a readonly_shm=1
+** connection and no other process already holds a lock, return
+** SQLITE_READONLY_CANTINIT and set pShmNode->isUnlocked=1.
+*/
+static int unixLockSharedMemory(unixFile *pDbFd, unixShmNode *pShmNode){
+ struct flock lock;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ /* Use F_GETLK to determine the locks other processes are holding
+ ** on the DMS byte. If it indicates that another process is holding
+ ** a SHARED lock, then this process may also take a SHARED lock
+ ** and proceed with opening the *-shm file.
+ **
+ ** Or, if no other process is holding any lock, then this process
+ ** is the first to open it. In this case take an EXCLUSIVE lock on the
+ ** DMS byte and truncate the *-shm file to zero bytes in size. Then
+ ** downgrade to a SHARED lock on the DMS byte.
+ **
+ ** If another process is holding an EXCLUSIVE lock on the DMS byte,
+ ** return SQLITE_BUSY to the caller (it will try again). An earlier
+ ** version of this code attempted the SHARED lock at this point. But
+ ** this introduced a subtle race condition: if the process holding
+ ** EXCLUSIVE failed just before truncating the *-shm file, then this
+ ** process might open and use the *-shm file without truncating it.
+ ** And if the *-shm file has been corrupted by a power failure or
+ ** system crash, the database itself may also become corrupt. */
+ lock.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lock.l_start = UNIX_SHM_DMS;
+ lock.l_len = 1;
+ lock.l_type = F_WRLCK;
+ if( osFcntl(pShmNode->hShm, F_GETLK, &lock)!=0 ) {
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK;
+ }else if( lock.l_type==F_UNLCK ){
+ if( pShmNode->isReadonly ){
+ pShmNode->isUnlocked = 1;
+ rc = SQLITE_READONLY_CANTINIT;
+ }else{
+ rc = unixShmSystemLock(pDbFd, F_WRLCK, UNIX_SHM_DMS, 1);
+ /* The first connection to attach must truncate the -shm file. We
+ ** truncate to 3 bytes (an arbitrary small number, less than the
+ ** -shm header size) rather than 0 as a system debugging aid, to
+ ** help detect if a -shm file truncation is legitimate or is the work
+ ** or a rogue process. */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && robust_ftruncate(pShmNode->hShm, 3) ){
+ rc = unixLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_SHMOPEN,"ftruncate",pShmNode->zFilename);
+ }
+ }
+ }else if( lock.l_type==F_WRLCK ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ assert( lock.l_type==F_UNLCK || lock.l_type==F_RDLCK );
+ rc = unixShmSystemLock(pDbFd, F_RDLCK, UNIX_SHM_DMS, 1);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Open a shared-memory area associated with open database file pDbFd.
+** This particular implementation uses mmapped files.
+**
+** The file used to implement shared-memory is in the same directory
+** as the open database file and has the same name as the open database
+** file with the "-shm" suffix added. For example, if the database file
+** is "/home/user1/config.db" then the file that is created and mmapped
+** for shared memory will be called "/home/user1/config.db-shm".
+**
+** Another approach to is to use files in /dev/shm or /dev/tmp or an
+** some other tmpfs mount. But if a file in a different directory
+** from the database file is used, then differing access permissions
+** or a chroot() might cause two different processes on the same
+** database to end up using different files for shared memory -
+** meaning that their memory would not really be shared - resulting
+** in database corruption. Nevertheless, this tmpfs file usage
+** can be enabled at compile-time using -DSQLITE_SHM_DIRECTORY="/dev/shm"
+** or the equivalent. The use of the SQLITE_SHM_DIRECTORY compile-time
+** option results in an incompatible build of SQLite; builds of SQLite
+** that with differing SQLITE_SHM_DIRECTORY settings attempt to use the
+** same database file at the same time, database corruption will likely
+** result. The SQLITE_SHM_DIRECTORY compile-time option is considered
+** "unsupported" and may go away in a future SQLite release.
+**
+** When opening a new shared-memory file, if no other instances of that
+** file are currently open, in this process or in other processes, then
+** the file must be truncated to zero length or have its header cleared.
+**
+** If the original database file (pDbFd) is using the "unix-excl" VFS
+** that means that an exclusive lock is held on the database file and
+** that no other processes are able to read or write the database. In
+** that case, we do not really need shared memory. No shared memory
+** file is created. The shared memory will be simulated with heap memory.
+*/
+static int unixOpenSharedMemory(unixFile *pDbFd){
+ struct unixShm *p = 0; /* The connection to be opened */
+ struct unixShmNode *pShmNode; /* The underlying mmapped file */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Result code */
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode; /* The inode of fd */
+ char *zShm; /* Name of the file used for SHM */
+ int nShmFilename; /* Size of the SHM filename in bytes */
+
+ /* Allocate space for the new unixShm object. */
+ p = sqlite3_malloc64( sizeof(*p) );
+ if( p==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ memset(p, 0, sizeof(*p));
+ assert( pDbFd->pShm==0 );
+
+ /* Check to see if a unixShmNode object already exists. Reuse an existing
+ ** one if present. Create a new one if necessary.
+ */
+ assert( unixFileMutexNotheld(pDbFd) );
+ unixEnterMutex();
+ pInode = pDbFd->pInode;
+ pShmNode = pInode->pShmNode;
+ if( pShmNode==0 ){
+ struct stat sStat; /* fstat() info for database file */
+#ifndef SQLITE_SHM_DIRECTORY
+ const char *zBasePath = pDbFd->zPath;
+#endif
+
+ /* Call fstat() to figure out the permissions on the database file. If
+ ** a new *-shm file is created, an attempt will be made to create it
+ ** with the same permissions.
+ */
+ if( osFstat(pDbFd->h, &sStat) ){
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT;
+ goto shm_open_err;
+ }
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_SHM_DIRECTORY
+ nShmFilename = sizeof(SQLITE_SHM_DIRECTORY) + 31;
+#else
+ nShmFilename = 6 + (int)strlen(zBasePath);
+#endif
+ pShmNode = sqlite3_malloc64( sizeof(*pShmNode) + nShmFilename );
+ if( pShmNode==0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ goto shm_open_err;
+ }
+ memset(pShmNode, 0, sizeof(*pShmNode)+nShmFilename);
+ zShm = pShmNode->zFilename = (char*)&pShmNode[1];
+#ifdef SQLITE_SHM_DIRECTORY
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nShmFilename, zShm,
+ SQLITE_SHM_DIRECTORY "/sqlite-shm-%x-%x",
+ (u32)sStat.st_ino, (u32)sStat.st_dev);
+#else
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nShmFilename, zShm, "%s-shm", zBasePath);
+ sqlite3FileSuffix3(pDbFd->zPath, zShm);
+#endif
+ pShmNode->hShm = -1;
+ pDbFd->pInode->pShmNode = pShmNode;
+ pShmNode->pInode = pDbFd->pInode;
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex ){
+ pShmNode->pShmMutex = sqlite3_mutex_alloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST);
+ if( pShmNode->pShmMutex==0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ goto shm_open_err;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if( pInode->bProcessLock==0 ){
+ if( 0==sqlite3_uri_boolean(pDbFd->zPath, "readonly_shm", 0) ){
+ pShmNode->hShm = robust_open(zShm, O_RDWR|O_CREAT|O_NOFOLLOW,
+ (sStat.st_mode&0777));
+ }
+ if( pShmNode->hShm<0 ){
+ pShmNode->hShm = robust_open(zShm, O_RDONLY|O_NOFOLLOW,
+ (sStat.st_mode&0777));
+ if( pShmNode->hShm<0 ){
+ rc = unixLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT, "open", zShm);
+ goto shm_open_err;
+ }
+ pShmNode->isReadonly = 1;
+ }
+
+ /* If this process is running as root, make sure that the SHM file
+ ** is owned by the same user that owns the original database. Otherwise,
+ ** the original owner will not be able to connect.
+ */
+ robustFchown(pShmNode->hShm, sStat.st_uid, sStat.st_gid);
+
+ rc = unixLockSharedMemory(pDbFd, pShmNode);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK && rc!=SQLITE_READONLY_CANTINIT ) goto shm_open_err;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Make the new connection a child of the unixShmNode */
+ p->pShmNode = pShmNode;
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ p->id = pShmNode->nextShmId++;
+#endif
+ pShmNode->nRef++;
+ pDbFd->pShm = p;
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+
+ /* The reference count on pShmNode has already been incremented under
+ ** the cover of the unixEnterMutex() mutex and the pointer from the
+ ** new (struct unixShm) object to the pShmNode has been set. All that is
+ ** left to do is to link the new object into the linked list starting
+ ** at pShmNode->pFirst. This must be done while holding the
+ ** pShmNode->pShmMutex.
+ */
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pShmNode->pShmMutex);
+ p->pNext = pShmNode->pFirst;
+ pShmNode->pFirst = p;
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pShmNode->pShmMutex);
+ return rc;
+
+ /* Jump here on any error */
+shm_open_err:
+ unixShmPurge(pDbFd); /* This call frees pShmNode if required */
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is called to obtain a pointer to region iRegion of the
+** shared-memory associated with the database file fd. Shared-memory regions
+** are numbered starting from zero. Each shared-memory region is szRegion
+** bytes in size.
+**
+** If an error occurs, an error code is returned and *pp is set to NULL.
+**
+** Otherwise, if the bExtend parameter is 0 and the requested shared-memory
+** region has not been allocated (by any client, including one running in a
+** separate process), then *pp is set to NULL and SQLITE_OK returned. If
+** bExtend is non-zero and the requested shared-memory region has not yet
+** been allocated, it is allocated by this function.
+**
+** If the shared-memory region has already been allocated or is allocated by
+** this call as described above, then it is mapped into this processes
+** address space (if it is not already), *pp is set to point to the mapped
+** memory and SQLITE_OK returned.
+*/
+static int unixShmMap(
+ sqlite3_file *fd, /* Handle open on database file */
+ int iRegion, /* Region to retrieve */
+ int szRegion, /* Size of regions */
+ int bExtend, /* True to extend file if necessary */
+ void volatile **pp /* OUT: Mapped memory */
+){
+ unixFile *pDbFd = (unixFile*)fd;
+ unixShm *p;
+ unixShmNode *pShmNode;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int nShmPerMap = unixShmRegionPerMap();
+ int nReqRegion;
+
+ /* If the shared-memory file has not yet been opened, open it now. */
+ if( pDbFd->pShm==0 ){
+ rc = unixOpenSharedMemory(pDbFd);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) return rc;
+ }
+
+ p = pDbFd->pShm;
+ pShmNode = p->pShmNode;
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pShmNode->pShmMutex);
+ if( pShmNode->isUnlocked ){
+ rc = unixLockSharedMemory(pDbFd, pShmNode);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) goto shmpage_out;
+ pShmNode->isUnlocked = 0;
+ }
+ assert( szRegion==pShmNode->szRegion || pShmNode->nRegion==0 );
+ assert( pShmNode->pInode==pDbFd->pInode );
+ assert( pShmNode->hShm>=0 || pDbFd->pInode->bProcessLock==1 );
+ assert( pShmNode->hShm<0 || pDbFd->pInode->bProcessLock==0 );
+
+ /* Minimum number of regions required to be mapped. */
+ nReqRegion = ((iRegion+nShmPerMap) / nShmPerMap) * nShmPerMap;
+
+ if( pShmNode->nRegionszRegion = szRegion;
+
+ if( pShmNode->hShm>=0 ){
+ /* The requested region is not mapped into this processes address space.
+ ** Check to see if it has been allocated (i.e. if the wal-index file is
+ ** large enough to contain the requested region).
+ */
+ if( osFstat(pShmNode->hShm, &sStat) ){
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_SHMSIZE;
+ goto shmpage_out;
+ }
+
+ if( sStat.st_sizehShm, iPg*pgsz + pgsz-1,"",1,&x)!=1 ){
+ const char *zFile = pShmNode->zFilename;
+ rc = unixLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_SHMSIZE, "write", zFile);
+ goto shmpage_out;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Map the requested memory region into this processes address space. */
+ apNew = (char **)sqlite3_realloc(
+ pShmNode->apRegion, nReqRegion*sizeof(char *)
+ );
+ if( !apNew ){
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ goto shmpage_out;
+ }
+ pShmNode->apRegion = apNew;
+ while( pShmNode->nRegionhShm>=0 ){
+ pMem = osMmap(0, nMap,
+ pShmNode->isReadonly ? PROT_READ : PROT_READ|PROT_WRITE,
+ MAP_SHARED, pShmNode->hShm, szRegion*(i64)pShmNode->nRegion
+ );
+ if( pMem==MAP_FAILED ){
+ rc = unixLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_SHMMAP, "mmap", pShmNode->zFilename);
+ goto shmpage_out;
+ }
+ }else{
+ pMem = sqlite3_malloc64(nMap);
+ if( pMem==0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ goto shmpage_out;
+ }
+ memset(pMem, 0, nMap);
+ }
+
+ for(i=0; iapRegion[pShmNode->nRegion+i] = &((char*)pMem)[szRegion*i];
+ }
+ pShmNode->nRegion += nShmPerMap;
+ }
+ }
+
+shmpage_out:
+ if( pShmNode->nRegion>iRegion ){
+ *pp = pShmNode->apRegion[iRegion];
+ }else{
+ *pp = 0;
+ }
+ if( pShmNode->isReadonly && rc==SQLITE_OK ) rc = SQLITE_READONLY;
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pShmNode->pShmMutex);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the lock state for a shared-memory segment.
+**
+** Note that the relationship between SHAREd and EXCLUSIVE locks is a little
+** different here than in posix. In xShmLock(), one can go from unlocked
+** to shared and back or from unlocked to exclusive and back. But one may
+** not go from shared to exclusive or from exclusive to shared.
+*/
+static int unixShmLock(
+ sqlite3_file *fd, /* Database file holding the shared memory */
+ int ofst, /* First lock to acquire or release */
+ int n, /* Number of locks to acquire or release */
+ int flags /* What to do with the lock */
+){
+ unixFile *pDbFd = (unixFile*)fd; /* Connection holding shared memory */
+ unixShm *p = pDbFd->pShm; /* The shared memory being locked */
+ unixShm *pX; /* For looping over all siblings */
+ unixShmNode *pShmNode = p->pShmNode; /* The underlying file iNode */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Result code */
+ u16 mask; /* Mask of locks to take or release */
+
+ assert( pShmNode==pDbFd->pInode->pShmNode );
+ assert( pShmNode->pInode==pDbFd->pInode );
+ assert( ofst>=0 && ofst+n<=SQLITE_SHM_NLOCK );
+ assert( n>=1 );
+ assert( flags==(SQLITE_SHM_LOCK | SQLITE_SHM_SHARED)
+ || flags==(SQLITE_SHM_LOCK | SQLITE_SHM_EXCLUSIVE)
+ || flags==(SQLITE_SHM_UNLOCK | SQLITE_SHM_SHARED)
+ || flags==(SQLITE_SHM_UNLOCK | SQLITE_SHM_EXCLUSIVE) );
+ assert( n==1 || (flags & SQLITE_SHM_EXCLUSIVE)!=0 );
+ assert( pShmNode->hShm>=0 || pDbFd->pInode->bProcessLock==1 );
+ assert( pShmNode->hShm<0 || pDbFd->pInode->bProcessLock==0 );
+
+ /* Check that, if this to be a blocking lock, no locks that occur later
+ ** in the following list than the lock being obtained are already held:
+ **
+ ** 1. Checkpointer lock (ofst==1).
+ ** 2. Write lock (ofst==0).
+ ** 3. Read locks (ofst>=3 && ofstiBusyTimeout==0 || (
+ (ofst!=2) /* not RECOVER */
+ && (ofst!=1 || (p->exclMask|p->sharedMask)==0)
+ && (ofst!=0 || (p->exclMask|p->sharedMask)<3)
+ && (ofst<3 || (p->exclMask|p->sharedMask)<(1<1 || mask==(1<pShmMutex);
+ if( flags & SQLITE_SHM_UNLOCK ){
+ u16 allMask = 0; /* Mask of locks held by siblings */
+
+ /* See if any siblings hold this same lock */
+ for(pX=pShmNode->pFirst; pX; pX=pX->pNext){
+ if( pX==p ) continue;
+ assert( (pX->exclMask & (p->exclMask|p->sharedMask))==0 );
+ allMask |= pX->sharedMask;
+ }
+
+ /* Unlock the system-level locks */
+ if( (mask & allMask)==0 ){
+ rc = unixShmSystemLock(pDbFd, F_UNLCK, ofst+UNIX_SHM_BASE, n);
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* Undo the local locks */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ p->exclMask &= ~mask;
+ p->sharedMask &= ~mask;
+ }
+ }else if( flags & SQLITE_SHM_SHARED ){
+ u16 allShared = 0; /* Union of locks held by connections other than "p" */
+
+ /* Find out which shared locks are already held by sibling connections.
+ ** If any sibling already holds an exclusive lock, go ahead and return
+ ** SQLITE_BUSY.
+ */
+ for(pX=pShmNode->pFirst; pX; pX=pX->pNext){
+ if( (pX->exclMask & mask)!=0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ break;
+ }
+ allShared |= pX->sharedMask;
+ }
+
+ /* Get shared locks at the system level, if necessary */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ if( (allShared & mask)==0 ){
+ rc = unixShmSystemLock(pDbFd, F_RDLCK, ofst+UNIX_SHM_BASE, n);
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Get the local shared locks */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ p->sharedMask |= mask;
+ }
+ }else{
+ /* Make sure no sibling connections hold locks that will block this
+ ** lock. If any do, return SQLITE_BUSY right away.
+ */
+ for(pX=pShmNode->pFirst; pX; pX=pX->pNext){
+ if( (pX->exclMask & mask)!=0 || (pX->sharedMask & mask)!=0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Get the exclusive locks at the system level. Then if successful
+ ** also mark the local connection as being locked.
+ */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ rc = unixShmSystemLock(pDbFd, F_WRLCK, ofst+UNIX_SHM_BASE, n);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ assert( (p->sharedMask & mask)==0 );
+ p->exclMask |= mask;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pShmNode->pShmMutex);
+ OSTRACE(("SHM-LOCK shmid-%d, pid-%d got %03x,%03x\n",
+ p->id, osGetpid(0), p->sharedMask, p->exclMask));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Implement a memory barrier or memory fence on shared memory.
+**
+** All loads and stores begun before the barrier must complete before
+** any load or store begun after the barrier.
+*/
+static void unixShmBarrier(
+ sqlite3_file *fd /* Database file holding the shared memory */
+){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(fd);
+ sqlite3MemoryBarrier(); /* compiler-defined memory barrier */
+ assert( fd->pMethods->xLock==nolockLock
+ || unixFileMutexNotheld((unixFile*)fd)
+ );
+ unixEnterMutex(); /* Also mutex, for redundancy */
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+}
+
+/*
+** Close a connection to shared-memory. Delete the underlying
+** storage if deleteFlag is true.
+**
+** If there is no shared memory associated with the connection then this
+** routine is a harmless no-op.
+*/
+static int unixShmUnmap(
+ sqlite3_file *fd, /* The underlying database file */
+ int deleteFlag /* Delete shared-memory if true */
+){
+ unixShm *p; /* The connection to be closed */
+ unixShmNode *pShmNode; /* The underlying shared-memory file */
+ unixShm **pp; /* For looping over sibling connections */
+ unixFile *pDbFd; /* The underlying database file */
+
+ pDbFd = (unixFile*)fd;
+ p = pDbFd->pShm;
+ if( p==0 ) return SQLITE_OK;
+ pShmNode = p->pShmNode;
+
+ assert( pShmNode==pDbFd->pInode->pShmNode );
+ assert( pShmNode->pInode==pDbFd->pInode );
+
+ /* Remove connection p from the set of connections associated
+ ** with pShmNode */
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pShmNode->pShmMutex);
+ for(pp=&pShmNode->pFirst; (*pp)!=p; pp = &(*pp)->pNext){}
+ *pp = p->pNext;
+
+ /* Free the connection p */
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ pDbFd->pShm = 0;
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pShmNode->pShmMutex);
+
+ /* If pShmNode->nRef has reached 0, then close the underlying
+ ** shared-memory file, too */
+ assert( unixFileMutexNotheld(pDbFd) );
+ unixEnterMutex();
+ assert( pShmNode->nRef>0 );
+ pShmNode->nRef--;
+ if( pShmNode->nRef==0 ){
+ if( deleteFlag && pShmNode->hShm>=0 ){
+ osUnlink(pShmNode->zFilename);
+ }
+ unixShmPurge(pDbFd);
+ }
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+
+#else
+# define unixShmMap 0
+# define unixShmLock 0
+# define unixShmBarrier 0
+# define unixShmUnmap 0
+#endif /* #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL */
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+/*
+** If it is currently memory mapped, unmap file pFd.
+*/
+static void unixUnmapfile(unixFile *pFd){
+ assert( pFd->nFetchOut==0 );
+ if( pFd->pMapRegion ){
+ osMunmap(pFd->pMapRegion, pFd->mmapSizeActual);
+ pFd->pMapRegion = 0;
+ pFd->mmapSize = 0;
+ pFd->mmapSizeActual = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Attempt to set the size of the memory mapping maintained by file
+** descriptor pFd to nNew bytes. Any existing mapping is discarded.
+**
+** If successful, this function sets the following variables:
+**
+** unixFile.pMapRegion
+** unixFile.mmapSize
+** unixFile.mmapSizeActual
+**
+** If unsuccessful, an error message is logged via sqlite3_log() and
+** the three variables above are zeroed. In this case SQLite should
+** continue accessing the database using the xRead() and xWrite()
+** methods.
+*/
+static void unixRemapfile(
+ unixFile *pFd, /* File descriptor object */
+ i64 nNew /* Required mapping size */
+){
+ const char *zErr = "mmap";
+ int h = pFd->h; /* File descriptor open on db file */
+ u8 *pOrig = (u8 *)pFd->pMapRegion; /* Pointer to current file mapping */
+ i64 nOrig = pFd->mmapSizeActual; /* Size of pOrig region in bytes */
+ u8 *pNew = 0; /* Location of new mapping */
+ int flags = PROT_READ; /* Flags to pass to mmap() */
+
+ assert( pFd->nFetchOut==0 );
+ assert( nNew>pFd->mmapSize );
+ assert( nNew<=pFd->mmapSizeMax );
+ assert( nNew>0 );
+ assert( pFd->mmapSizeActual>=pFd->mmapSize );
+ assert( MAP_FAILED!=0 );
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_MMAP_READWRITE
+ if( (pFd->ctrlFlags & UNIXFILE_RDONLY)==0 ) flags |= PROT_WRITE;
+#endif
+
+ if( pOrig ){
+#if HAVE_MREMAP
+ i64 nReuse = pFd->mmapSize;
+#else
+ const int szSyspage = osGetpagesize();
+ i64 nReuse = (pFd->mmapSize & ~(szSyspage-1));
+#endif
+ u8 *pReq = &pOrig[nReuse];
+
+ /* Unmap any pages of the existing mapping that cannot be reused. */
+ if( nReuse!=nOrig ){
+ osMunmap(pReq, nOrig-nReuse);
+ }
+
+#if HAVE_MREMAP
+ pNew = osMremap(pOrig, nReuse, nNew, MREMAP_MAYMOVE);
+ zErr = "mremap";
+#else
+ pNew = osMmap(pReq, nNew-nReuse, flags, MAP_SHARED, h, nReuse);
+ if( pNew!=MAP_FAILED ){
+ if( pNew!=pReq ){
+ osMunmap(pNew, nNew - nReuse);
+ pNew = 0;
+ }else{
+ pNew = pOrig;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* The attempt to extend the existing mapping failed. Free it. */
+ if( pNew==MAP_FAILED || pNew==0 ){
+ osMunmap(pOrig, nReuse);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If pNew is still NULL, try to create an entirely new mapping. */
+ if( pNew==0 ){
+ pNew = osMmap(0, nNew, flags, MAP_SHARED, h, 0);
+ }
+
+ if( pNew==MAP_FAILED ){
+ pNew = 0;
+ nNew = 0;
+ unixLogError(SQLITE_OK, zErr, pFd->zPath);
+
+ /* If the mmap() above failed, assume that all subsequent mmap() calls
+ ** will probably fail too. Fall back to using xRead/xWrite exclusively
+ ** in this case. */
+ pFd->mmapSizeMax = 0;
+ }
+ pFd->pMapRegion = (void *)pNew;
+ pFd->mmapSize = pFd->mmapSizeActual = nNew;
+}
+
+/*
+** Memory map or remap the file opened by file-descriptor pFd (if the file
+** is already mapped, the existing mapping is replaced by the new). Or, if
+** there already exists a mapping for this file, and there are still
+** outstanding xFetch() references to it, this function is a no-op.
+**
+** If parameter nByte is non-negative, then it is the requested size of
+** the mapping to create. Otherwise, if nByte is less than zero, then the
+** requested size is the size of the file on disk. The actual size of the
+** created mapping is either the requested size or the value configured
+** using SQLITE_FCNTL_MMAP_LIMIT, whichever is smaller.
+**
+** SQLITE_OK is returned if no error occurs (even if the mapping is not
+** recreated as a result of outstanding references) or an SQLite error
+** code otherwise.
+*/
+static int unixMapfile(unixFile *pFd, i64 nMap){
+ assert( nMap>=0 || pFd->nFetchOut==0 );
+ assert( nMap>0 || (pFd->mmapSize==0 && pFd->pMapRegion==0) );
+ if( pFd->nFetchOut>0 ) return SQLITE_OK;
+
+ if( nMap<0 ){
+ struct stat statbuf; /* Low-level file information */
+ if( osFstat(pFd->h, &statbuf) ){
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT;
+ }
+ nMap = statbuf.st_size;
+ }
+ if( nMap>pFd->mmapSizeMax ){
+ nMap = pFd->mmapSizeMax;
+ }
+
+ assert( nMap>0 || (pFd->mmapSize==0 && pFd->pMapRegion==0) );
+ if( nMap!=pFd->mmapSize ){
+ unixRemapfile(pFd, nMap);
+ }
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0 */
+
+/*
+** If possible, return a pointer to a mapping of file fd starting at offset
+** iOff. The mapping must be valid for at least nAmt bytes.
+**
+** If such a pointer can be obtained, store it in *pp and return SQLITE_OK.
+** Or, if one cannot but no error occurs, set *pp to 0 and return SQLITE_OK.
+** Finally, if an error does occur, return an SQLite error code. The final
+** value of *pp is undefined in this case.
+**
+** If this function does return a pointer, the caller must eventually
+** release the reference by calling unixUnfetch().
+*/
+static int unixFetch(sqlite3_file *fd, i64 iOff, int nAmt, void **pp){
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ unixFile *pFd = (unixFile *)fd; /* The underlying database file */
+#endif
+ *pp = 0;
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ if( pFd->mmapSizeMax>0 ){
+ if( pFd->pMapRegion==0 ){
+ int rc = unixMapfile(pFd, -1);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) return rc;
+ }
+ if( pFd->mmapSize >= iOff+nAmt ){
+ *pp = &((u8 *)pFd->pMapRegion)[iOff];
+ pFd->nFetchOut++;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** If the third argument is non-NULL, then this function releases a
+** reference obtained by an earlier call to unixFetch(). The second
+** argument passed to this function must be the same as the corresponding
+** argument that was passed to the unixFetch() invocation.
+**
+** Or, if the third argument is NULL, then this function is being called
+** to inform the VFS layer that, according to POSIX, any existing mapping
+** may now be invalid and should be unmapped.
+*/
+static int unixUnfetch(sqlite3_file *fd, i64 iOff, void *p){
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ unixFile *pFd = (unixFile *)fd; /* The underlying database file */
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(iOff);
+
+ /* If p==0 (unmap the entire file) then there must be no outstanding
+ ** xFetch references. Or, if p!=0 (meaning it is an xFetch reference),
+ ** then there must be at least one outstanding. */
+ assert( (p==0)==(pFd->nFetchOut==0) );
+
+ /* If p!=0, it must match the iOff value. */
+ assert( p==0 || p==&((u8 *)pFd->pMapRegion)[iOff] );
+
+ if( p ){
+ pFd->nFetchOut--;
+ }else{
+ unixUnmapfile(pFd);
+ }
+
+ assert( pFd->nFetchOut>=0 );
+#else
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(fd);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(p);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(iOff);
+#endif
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Here ends the implementation of all sqlite3_file methods.
+**
+********************** End sqlite3_file Methods *******************************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/*
+** This division contains definitions of sqlite3_io_methods objects that
+** implement various file locking strategies. It also contains definitions
+** of "finder" functions. A finder-function is used to locate the appropriate
+** sqlite3_io_methods object for a particular database file. The pAppData
+** field of the sqlite3_vfs VFS objects are initialized to be pointers to
+** the correct finder-function for that VFS.
+**
+** Most finder functions return a pointer to a fixed sqlite3_io_methods
+** object. The only interesting finder-function is autolockIoFinder, which
+** looks at the filesystem type and tries to guess the best locking
+** strategy from that.
+**
+** For finder-function F, two objects are created:
+**
+** (1) The real finder-function named "FImpt()".
+**
+** (2) A constant pointer to this function named just "F".
+**
+**
+** A pointer to the F pointer is used as the pAppData value for VFS
+** objects. We have to do this instead of letting pAppData point
+** directly at the finder-function since C90 rules prevent a void*
+** from be cast into a function pointer.
+**
+**
+** Each instance of this macro generates two objects:
+**
+** * A constant sqlite3_io_methods object call METHOD that has locking
+** methods CLOSE, LOCK, UNLOCK, CKRESLOCK.
+**
+** * An I/O method finder function called FINDER that returns a pointer
+** to the METHOD object in the previous bullet.
+*/
+#define IOMETHODS(FINDER,METHOD,VERSION,CLOSE,LOCK,UNLOCK,CKLOCK,SHMMAP) \
+static const sqlite3_io_methods METHOD = { \
+ VERSION, /* iVersion */ \
+ CLOSE, /* xClose */ \
+ unixRead, /* xRead */ \
+ unixWrite, /* xWrite */ \
+ unixTruncate, /* xTruncate */ \
+ unixSync, /* xSync */ \
+ unixFileSize, /* xFileSize */ \
+ LOCK, /* xLock */ \
+ UNLOCK, /* xUnlock */ \
+ CKLOCK, /* xCheckReservedLock */ \
+ unixFileControl, /* xFileControl */ \
+ unixSectorSize, /* xSectorSize */ \
+ unixDeviceCharacteristics, /* xDeviceCapabilities */ \
+ SHMMAP, /* xShmMap */ \
+ unixShmLock, /* xShmLock */ \
+ unixShmBarrier, /* xShmBarrier */ \
+ unixShmUnmap, /* xShmUnmap */ \
+ unixFetch, /* xFetch */ \
+ unixUnfetch, /* xUnfetch */ \
+}; \
+static const sqlite3_io_methods *FINDER##Impl(const char *z, unixFile *p){ \
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(z); UNUSED_PARAMETER(p); \
+ return &METHOD; \
+} \
+static const sqlite3_io_methods *(*const FINDER)(const char*,unixFile *p) \
+ = FINDER##Impl;
+
+/*
+** Here are all of the sqlite3_io_methods objects for each of the
+** locking strategies. Functions that return pointers to these methods
+** are also created.
+*/
+IOMETHODS(
+ posixIoFinder, /* Finder function name */
+ posixIoMethods, /* sqlite3_io_methods object name */
+ 3, /* shared memory and mmap are enabled */
+ unixClose, /* xClose method */
+ unixLock, /* xLock method */
+ unixUnlock, /* xUnlock method */
+ unixCheckReservedLock, /* xCheckReservedLock method */
+ unixShmMap /* xShmMap method */
+)
+IOMETHODS(
+ nolockIoFinder, /* Finder function name */
+ nolockIoMethods, /* sqlite3_io_methods object name */
+ 3, /* shared memory and mmap are enabled */
+ nolockClose, /* xClose method */
+ nolockLock, /* xLock method */
+ nolockUnlock, /* xUnlock method */
+ nolockCheckReservedLock, /* xCheckReservedLock method */
+ 0 /* xShmMap method */
+)
+IOMETHODS(
+ dotlockIoFinder, /* Finder function name */
+ dotlockIoMethods, /* sqlite3_io_methods object name */
+ 1, /* shared memory is disabled */
+ dotlockClose, /* xClose method */
+ dotlockLock, /* xLock method */
+ dotlockUnlock, /* xUnlock method */
+ dotlockCheckReservedLock, /* xCheckReservedLock method */
+ 0 /* xShmMap method */
+)
+
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+IOMETHODS(
+ flockIoFinder, /* Finder function name */
+ flockIoMethods, /* sqlite3_io_methods object name */
+ 1, /* shared memory is disabled */
+ flockClose, /* xClose method */
+ flockLock, /* xLock method */
+ flockUnlock, /* xUnlock method */
+ flockCheckReservedLock, /* xCheckReservedLock method */
+ 0 /* xShmMap method */
+)
+#endif
+
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+IOMETHODS(
+ semIoFinder, /* Finder function name */
+ semIoMethods, /* sqlite3_io_methods object name */
+ 1, /* shared memory is disabled */
+ semXClose, /* xClose method */
+ semXLock, /* xLock method */
+ semXUnlock, /* xUnlock method */
+ semXCheckReservedLock, /* xCheckReservedLock method */
+ 0 /* xShmMap method */
+)
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+IOMETHODS(
+ afpIoFinder, /* Finder function name */
+ afpIoMethods, /* sqlite3_io_methods object name */
+ 1, /* shared memory is disabled */
+ afpClose, /* xClose method */
+ afpLock, /* xLock method */
+ afpUnlock, /* xUnlock method */
+ afpCheckReservedLock, /* xCheckReservedLock method */
+ 0 /* xShmMap method */
+)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The proxy locking method is a "super-method" in the sense that it
+** opens secondary file descriptors for the conch and lock files and
+** it uses proxy, dot-file, AFP, and flock() locking methods on those
+** secondary files. For this reason, the division that implements
+** proxy locking is located much further down in the file. But we need
+** to go ahead and define the sqlite3_io_methods and finder function
+** for proxy locking here. So we forward declare the I/O methods.
+*/
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+static int proxyClose(sqlite3_file*);
+static int proxyLock(sqlite3_file*, int);
+static int proxyUnlock(sqlite3_file*, int);
+static int proxyCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file*, int*);
+IOMETHODS(
+ proxyIoFinder, /* Finder function name */
+ proxyIoMethods, /* sqlite3_io_methods object name */
+ 1, /* shared memory is disabled */
+ proxyClose, /* xClose method */
+ proxyLock, /* xLock method */
+ proxyUnlock, /* xUnlock method */
+ proxyCheckReservedLock, /* xCheckReservedLock method */
+ 0 /* xShmMap method */
+)
+#endif
+
+/* nfs lockd on OSX 10.3+ doesn't clear write locks when a read lock is set */
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+IOMETHODS(
+ nfsIoFinder, /* Finder function name */
+ nfsIoMethods, /* sqlite3_io_methods object name */
+ 1, /* shared memory is disabled */
+ unixClose, /* xClose method */
+ unixLock, /* xLock method */
+ nfsUnlock, /* xUnlock method */
+ unixCheckReservedLock, /* xCheckReservedLock method */
+ 0 /* xShmMap method */
+)
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+/*
+** This "finder" function attempts to determine the best locking strategy
+** for the database file "filePath". It then returns the sqlite3_io_methods
+** object that implements that strategy.
+**
+** This is for MacOSX only.
+*/
+static const sqlite3_io_methods *autolockIoFinderImpl(
+ const char *filePath, /* name of the database file */
+ unixFile *pNew /* open file object for the database file */
+){
+ static const struct Mapping {
+ const char *zFilesystem; /* Filesystem type name */
+ const sqlite3_io_methods *pMethods; /* Appropriate locking method */
+ } aMap[] = {
+ { "hfs", &posixIoMethods },
+ { "ufs", &posixIoMethods },
+ { "afpfs", &afpIoMethods },
+ { "smbfs", &afpIoMethods },
+ { "webdav", &nolockIoMethods },
+ { 0, 0 }
+ };
+ int i;
+ struct statfs fsInfo;
+ struct flock lockInfo;
+
+ if( !filePath ){
+ /* If filePath==NULL that means we are dealing with a transient file
+ ** that does not need to be locked. */
+ return &nolockIoMethods;
+ }
+ if( statfs(filePath, &fsInfo) != -1 ){
+ if( fsInfo.f_flags & MNT_RDONLY ){
+ return &nolockIoMethods;
+ }
+ for(i=0; aMap[i].zFilesystem; i++){
+ if( strcmp(fsInfo.f_fstypename, aMap[i].zFilesystem)==0 ){
+ return aMap[i].pMethods;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Default case. Handles, amongst others, "nfs".
+ ** Test byte-range lock using fcntl(). If the call succeeds,
+ ** assume that the file-system supports POSIX style locks.
+ */
+ lockInfo.l_len = 1;
+ lockInfo.l_start = 0;
+ lockInfo.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lockInfo.l_type = F_RDLCK;
+ if( osFcntl(pNew->h, F_GETLK, &lockInfo)!=-1 ) {
+ if( strcmp(fsInfo.f_fstypename, "nfs")==0 ){
+ return &nfsIoMethods;
+ } else {
+ return &posixIoMethods;
+ }
+ }else{
+ return &dotlockIoMethods;
+ }
+}
+static const sqlite3_io_methods
+ *(*const autolockIoFinder)(const char*,unixFile*) = autolockIoFinderImpl;
+
+#endif /* defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE */
+
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+/*
+** This "finder" function for VxWorks checks to see if posix advisory
+** locking works. If it does, then that is what is used. If it does not
+** work, then fallback to named semaphore locking.
+*/
+static const sqlite3_io_methods *vxworksIoFinderImpl(
+ const char *filePath, /* name of the database file */
+ unixFile *pNew /* the open file object */
+){
+ struct flock lockInfo;
+
+ if( !filePath ){
+ /* If filePath==NULL that means we are dealing with a transient file
+ ** that does not need to be locked. */
+ return &nolockIoMethods;
+ }
+
+ /* Test if fcntl() is supported and use POSIX style locks.
+ ** Otherwise fall back to the named semaphore method.
+ */
+ lockInfo.l_len = 1;
+ lockInfo.l_start = 0;
+ lockInfo.l_whence = SEEK_SET;
+ lockInfo.l_type = F_RDLCK;
+ if( osFcntl(pNew->h, F_GETLK, &lockInfo)!=-1 ) {
+ return &posixIoMethods;
+ }else{
+ return &semIoMethods;
+ }
+}
+static const sqlite3_io_methods
+ *(*const vxworksIoFinder)(const char*,unixFile*) = vxworksIoFinderImpl;
+
+#endif /* OS_VXWORKS */
+
+/*
+** An abstract type for a pointer to an IO method finder function:
+*/
+typedef const sqlite3_io_methods *(*finder_type)(const char*,unixFile*);
+
+
+/****************************************************************************
+**************************** sqlite3_vfs methods ****************************
+**
+** This division contains the implementation of methods on the
+** sqlite3_vfs object.
+*/
+
+/*
+** Initialize the contents of the unixFile structure pointed to by pId.
+*/
+static int fillInUnixFile(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, /* Pointer to vfs object */
+ int h, /* Open file descriptor of file being opened */
+ sqlite3_file *pId, /* Write to the unixFile structure here */
+ const char *zFilename, /* Name of the file being opened */
+ int ctrlFlags /* Zero or more UNIXFILE_* values */
+){
+ const sqlite3_io_methods *pLockingStyle;
+ unixFile *pNew = (unixFile *)pId;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ assert( pNew->pInode==NULL );
+
+ /* No locking occurs in temporary files */
+ assert( zFilename!=0 || (ctrlFlags & UNIXFILE_NOLOCK)!=0 );
+
+ OSTRACE(("OPEN %-3d %s\n", h, zFilename));
+ pNew->h = h;
+ pNew->pVfs = pVfs;
+ pNew->zPath = zFilename;
+ pNew->ctrlFlags = (u8)ctrlFlags;
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ pNew->mmapSizeMax = sqlite3GlobalConfig.szMmap;
+#endif
+ if( sqlite3_uri_boolean(((ctrlFlags & UNIXFILE_URI) ? zFilename : 0),
+ "psow", SQLITE_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE) ){
+ pNew->ctrlFlags |= UNIXFILE_PSOW;
+ }
+ if( strcmp(pVfs->zName,"unix-excl")==0 ){
+ pNew->ctrlFlags |= UNIXFILE_EXCL;
+ }
+
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ pNew->pId = vxworksFindFileId(zFilename);
+ if( pNew->pId==0 ){
+ ctrlFlags |= UNIXFILE_NOLOCK;
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ if( ctrlFlags & UNIXFILE_NOLOCK ){
+ pLockingStyle = &nolockIoMethods;
+ }else{
+ pLockingStyle = (**(finder_type*)pVfs->pAppData)(zFilename, pNew);
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ /* Cache zFilename in the locking context (AFP and dotlock override) for
+ ** proxyLock activation is possible (remote proxy is based on db name)
+ ** zFilename remains valid until file is closed, to support */
+ pNew->lockingContext = (void*)zFilename;
+#endif
+ }
+
+ if( pLockingStyle == &posixIoMethods
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ || pLockingStyle == &nfsIoMethods
+#endif
+ ){
+ unixEnterMutex();
+ rc = findInodeInfo(pNew, &pNew->pInode);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ /* If an error occurred in findInodeInfo(), close the file descriptor
+ ** immediately, before releasing the mutex. findInodeInfo() may fail
+ ** in two scenarios:
+ **
+ ** (a) A call to fstat() failed.
+ ** (b) A malloc failed.
+ **
+ ** Scenario (b) may only occur if the process is holding no other
+ ** file descriptors open on the same file. If there were other file
+ ** descriptors on this file, then no malloc would be required by
+ ** findInodeInfo(). If this is the case, it is quite safe to close
+ ** handle h - as it is guaranteed that no posix locks will be released
+ ** by doing so.
+ **
+ ** If scenario (a) caused the error then things are not so safe. The
+ ** implicit assumption here is that if fstat() fails, things are in
+ ** such bad shape that dropping a lock or two doesn't matter much.
+ */
+ robust_close(pNew, h, __LINE__);
+ h = -1;
+ }
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+ }
+
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE && defined(__APPLE__)
+ else if( pLockingStyle == &afpIoMethods ){
+ /* AFP locking uses the file path so it needs to be included in
+ ** the afpLockingContext.
+ */
+ afpLockingContext *pCtx;
+ pNew->lockingContext = pCtx = sqlite3_malloc64( sizeof(*pCtx) );
+ if( pCtx==0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }else{
+ /* NB: zFilename exists and remains valid until the file is closed
+ ** according to requirement F11141. So we do not need to make a
+ ** copy of the filename. */
+ pCtx->dbPath = zFilename;
+ pCtx->reserved = 0;
+ srandomdev();
+ unixEnterMutex();
+ rc = findInodeInfo(pNew, &pNew->pInode);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ sqlite3_free(pNew->lockingContext);
+ robust_close(pNew, h, __LINE__);
+ h = -1;
+ }
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ else if( pLockingStyle == &dotlockIoMethods ){
+ /* Dotfile locking uses the file path so it needs to be included in
+ ** the dotlockLockingContext
+ */
+ char *zLockFile;
+ int nFilename;
+ assert( zFilename!=0 );
+ nFilename = (int)strlen(zFilename) + 6;
+ zLockFile = (char *)sqlite3_malloc64(nFilename);
+ if( zLockFile==0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }else{
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nFilename, zLockFile, "%s" DOTLOCK_SUFFIX, zFilename);
+ }
+ pNew->lockingContext = zLockFile;
+ }
+
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ else if( pLockingStyle == &semIoMethods ){
+ /* Named semaphore locking uses the file path so it needs to be
+ ** included in the semLockingContext
+ */
+ unixEnterMutex();
+ rc = findInodeInfo(pNew, &pNew->pInode);
+ if( (rc==SQLITE_OK) && (pNew->pInode->pSem==NULL) ){
+ char *zSemName = pNew->pInode->aSemName;
+ int n;
+ sqlite3_snprintf(MAX_PATHNAME, zSemName, "/%s.sem",
+ pNew->pId->zCanonicalName);
+ for( n=1; zSemName[n]; n++ )
+ if( zSemName[n]=='/' ) zSemName[n] = '_';
+ pNew->pInode->pSem = sem_open(zSemName, O_CREAT, 0666, 1);
+ if( pNew->pInode->pSem == SEM_FAILED ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ pNew->pInode->aSemName[0] = '\0';
+ }
+ }
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+ }
+#endif
+
+ storeLastErrno(pNew, 0);
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ if( h>=0 ) robust_close(pNew, h, __LINE__);
+ h = -1;
+ osUnlink(zFilename);
+ pNew->ctrlFlags |= UNIXFILE_DELETE;
+ }
+#endif
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ if( h>=0 ) robust_close(pNew, h, __LINE__);
+ }else{
+ pId->pMethods = pLockingStyle;
+ OpenCounter(+1);
+ verifyDbFile(pNew);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the name of a directory in which to put temporary files.
+** If no suitable temporary file directory can be found, return NULL.
+*/
+static const char *unixTempFileDir(void){
+ static const char *azDirs[] = {
+ 0,
+ 0,
+ "/var/tmp",
+ "/usr/tmp",
+ "/tmp",
+ "."
+ };
+ unsigned int i = 0;
+ struct stat buf;
+ const char *zDir = sqlite3_temp_directory;
+
+ if( !azDirs[0] ) azDirs[0] = getenv("SQLITE_TMPDIR");
+ if( !azDirs[1] ) azDirs[1] = getenv("TMPDIR");
+ while(1){
+ if( zDir!=0
+ && osStat(zDir, &buf)==0
+ && S_ISDIR(buf.st_mode)
+ && osAccess(zDir, 03)==0
+ ){
+ return zDir;
+ }
+ if( i>=sizeof(azDirs)/sizeof(azDirs[0]) ) break;
+ zDir = azDirs[i++];
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Create a temporary file name in zBuf. zBuf must be allocated
+** by the calling process and must be big enough to hold at least
+** pVfs->mxPathname bytes.
+*/
+static int unixGetTempname(int nBuf, char *zBuf){
+ const char *zDir;
+ int iLimit = 0;
+
+ /* It's odd to simulate an io-error here, but really this is just
+ ** using the io-error infrastructure to test that SQLite handles this
+ ** function failing.
+ */
+ zBuf[0] = 0;
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_IOERR );
+
+ zDir = unixTempFileDir();
+ if( zDir==0 ) return SQLITE_IOERR_GETTEMPPATH;
+ do{
+ u64 r;
+ sqlite3_randomness(sizeof(r), &r);
+ assert( nBuf>2 );
+ zBuf[nBuf-2] = 0;
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nBuf, zBuf, "%s/"SQLITE_TEMP_FILE_PREFIX"%llx%c",
+ zDir, r, 0);
+ if( zBuf[nBuf-2]!=0 || (iLimit++)>10 ) return SQLITE_ERROR;
+ }while( osAccess(zBuf,0)==0 );
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE && defined(__APPLE__)
+/*
+** Routine to transform a unixFile into a proxy-locking unixFile.
+** Implementation in the proxy-lock division, but used by unixOpen()
+** if SQLITE_PREFER_PROXY_LOCKING is defined.
+*/
+static int proxyTransformUnixFile(unixFile*, const char*);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Search for an unused file descriptor that was opened on the database
+** file (not a journal or super-journal file) identified by pathname
+** zPath with SQLITE_OPEN_XXX flags matching those passed as the second
+** argument to this function.
+**
+** Such a file descriptor may exist if a database connection was closed
+** but the associated file descriptor could not be closed because some
+** other file descriptor open on the same file is holding a file-lock.
+** Refer to comments in the unixClose() function and the lengthy comment
+** describing "Posix Advisory Locking" at the start of this file for
+** further details. Also, ticket #4018.
+**
+** If a suitable file descriptor is found, then it is returned. If no
+** such file descriptor is located, -1 is returned.
+*/
+static UnixUnusedFd *findReusableFd(const char *zPath, int flags){
+ UnixUnusedFd *pUnused = 0;
+
+ /* Do not search for an unused file descriptor on vxworks. Not because
+ ** vxworks would not benefit from the change (it might, we're not sure),
+ ** but because no way to test it is currently available. It is better
+ ** not to risk breaking vxworks support for the sake of such an obscure
+ ** feature. */
+#if !OS_VXWORKS
+ struct stat sStat; /* Results of stat() call */
+
+ unixEnterMutex();
+
+ /* A stat() call may fail for various reasons. If this happens, it is
+ ** almost certain that an open() call on the same path will also fail.
+ ** For this reason, if an error occurs in the stat() call here, it is
+ ** ignored and -1 is returned. The caller will try to open a new file
+ ** descriptor on the same path, fail, and return an error to SQLite.
+ **
+ ** Even if a subsequent open() call does succeed, the consequences of
+ ** not searching for a reusable file descriptor are not dire. */
+ if( inodeList!=0 && 0==osStat(zPath, &sStat) ){
+ unixInodeInfo *pInode;
+
+ pInode = inodeList;
+ while( pInode && (pInode->fileId.dev!=sStat.st_dev
+ || pInode->fileId.ino!=(u64)sStat.st_ino) ){
+ pInode = pInode->pNext;
+ }
+ if( pInode ){
+ UnixUnusedFd **pp;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_notheld(pInode->pLockMutex) );
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ flags &= (SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY|SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE);
+ for(pp=&pInode->pUnused; *pp && (*pp)->flags!=flags; pp=&((*pp)->pNext));
+ pUnused = *pp;
+ if( pUnused ){
+ *pp = pUnused->pNext;
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pInode->pLockMutex);
+ }
+ }
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+#endif /* if !OS_VXWORKS */
+ return pUnused;
+}
+
+/*
+** Find the mode, uid and gid of file zFile.
+*/
+static int getFileMode(
+ const char *zFile, /* File name */
+ mode_t *pMode, /* OUT: Permissions of zFile */
+ uid_t *pUid, /* OUT: uid of zFile. */
+ gid_t *pGid /* OUT: gid of zFile. */
+){
+ struct stat sStat; /* Output of stat() on database file */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ if( 0==osStat(zFile, &sStat) ){
+ *pMode = sStat.st_mode & 0777;
+ *pUid = sStat.st_uid;
+ *pGid = sStat.st_gid;
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is called by unixOpen() to determine the unix permissions
+** to create new files with. If no error occurs, then SQLITE_OK is returned
+** and a value suitable for passing as the third argument to open(2) is
+** written to *pMode. If an IO error occurs, an SQLite error code is
+** returned and the value of *pMode is not modified.
+**
+** In most cases, this routine sets *pMode to 0, which will become
+** an indication to robust_open() to create the file using
+** SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_PERMISSIONS adjusted by the umask.
+** But if the file being opened is a WAL or regular journal file, then
+** this function queries the file-system for the permissions on the
+** corresponding database file and sets *pMode to this value. Whenever
+** possible, WAL and journal files are created using the same permissions
+** as the associated database file.
+**
+** If the SQLITE_ENABLE_8_3_NAMES option is enabled, then the
+** original filename is unavailable. But 8_3_NAMES is only used for
+** FAT filesystems and permissions do not matter there, so just use
+** the default permissions. In 8_3_NAMES mode, leave *pMode set to zero.
+*/
+static int findCreateFileMode(
+ const char *zPath, /* Path of file (possibly) being created */
+ int flags, /* Flags passed as 4th argument to xOpen() */
+ mode_t *pMode, /* OUT: Permissions to open file with */
+ uid_t *pUid, /* OUT: uid to set on the file */
+ gid_t *pGid /* OUT: gid to set on the file */
+){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Return Code */
+ *pMode = 0;
+ *pUid = 0;
+ *pGid = 0;
+ if( flags & (SQLITE_OPEN_WAL|SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL) ){
+ char zDb[MAX_PATHNAME+1]; /* Database file path */
+ int nDb; /* Number of valid bytes in zDb */
+
+ /* zPath is a path to a WAL or journal file. The following block derives
+ ** the path to the associated database file from zPath. This block handles
+ ** the following naming conventions:
+ **
+ ** "-journal"
+ ** "-wal"
+ ** "-journalNN"
+ ** "-walNN"
+ **
+ ** where NN is a decimal number. The NN naming schemes are
+ ** used by the test_multiplex.c module.
+ */
+ nDb = sqlite3Strlen30(zPath) - 1;
+ while( zPath[nDb]!='-' ){
+ /* In normal operation, the journal file name will always contain
+ ** a '-' character. However in 8+3 filename mode, or if a corrupt
+ ** rollback journal specifies a super-journal with a goofy name, then
+ ** the '-' might be missing. */
+ if( nDb==0 || zPath[nDb]=='.' ) return SQLITE_OK;
+ nDb--;
+ }
+ memcpy(zDb, zPath, nDb);
+ zDb[nDb] = '\0';
+
+ rc = getFileMode(zDb, pMode, pUid, pGid);
+ }else if( flags & SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE ){
+ *pMode = 0600;
+ }else if( flags & SQLITE_OPEN_URI ){
+ /* If this is a main database file and the file was opened using a URI
+ ** filename, check for the "modeof" parameter. If present, interpret
+ ** its value as a filename and try to copy the mode, uid and gid from
+ ** that file. */
+ const char *z = sqlite3_uri_parameter(zPath, "modeof");
+ if( z ){
+ rc = getFileMode(z, pMode, pUid, pGid);
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Open the file zPath.
+**
+** Previously, the SQLite OS layer used three functions in place of this
+** one:
+**
+** sqlite3OsOpenReadWrite();
+** sqlite3OsOpenReadOnly();
+** sqlite3OsOpenExclusive();
+**
+** These calls correspond to the following combinations of flags:
+**
+** ReadWrite() -> (READWRITE | CREATE)
+** ReadOnly() -> (READONLY)
+** OpenExclusive() -> (READWRITE | CREATE | EXCLUSIVE)
+**
+** The old OpenExclusive() accepted a boolean argument - "delFlag". If
+** true, the file was configured to be automatically deleted when the
+** file handle closed. To achieve the same effect using this new
+** interface, add the DELETEONCLOSE flag to those specified above for
+** OpenExclusive().
+*/
+static int unixOpen(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, /* The VFS for which this is the xOpen method */
+ const char *zPath, /* Pathname of file to be opened */
+ sqlite3_file *pFile, /* The file descriptor to be filled in */
+ int flags, /* Input flags to control the opening */
+ int *pOutFlags /* Output flags returned to SQLite core */
+){
+ unixFile *p = (unixFile *)pFile;
+ int fd = -1; /* File descriptor returned by open() */
+ int openFlags = 0; /* Flags to pass to open() */
+ int eType = flags&0x0FFF00; /* Type of file to open */
+ int noLock; /* True to omit locking primitives */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Function Return Code */
+ int ctrlFlags = 0; /* UNIXFILE_* flags */
+
+ int isExclusive = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE);
+ int isDelete = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE);
+ int isCreate = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE);
+ int isReadonly = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY);
+ int isReadWrite = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE);
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ int isAutoProxy = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_AUTOPROXY);
+#endif
+#if defined(__APPLE__) || SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ struct statfs fsInfo;
+#endif
+
+ /* If creating a super- or main-file journal, this function will open
+ ** a file-descriptor on the directory too. The first time unixSync()
+ ** is called the directory file descriptor will be fsync()ed and close()d.
+ */
+ int isNewJrnl = (isCreate && (
+ eType==SQLITE_OPEN_SUPER_JOURNAL
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_WAL
+ ));
+
+ /* If argument zPath is a NULL pointer, this function is required to open
+ ** a temporary file. Use this buffer to store the file name in.
+ */
+ char zTmpname[MAX_PATHNAME+2];
+ const char *zName = zPath;
+
+ /* Check the following statements are true:
+ **
+ ** (a) Exactly one of the READWRITE and READONLY flags must be set, and
+ ** (b) if CREATE is set, then READWRITE must also be set, and
+ ** (c) if EXCLUSIVE is set, then CREATE must also be set.
+ ** (d) if DELETEONCLOSE is set, then CREATE must also be set.
+ */
+ assert((isReadonly==0 || isReadWrite==0) && (isReadWrite || isReadonly));
+ assert(isCreate==0 || isReadWrite);
+ assert(isExclusive==0 || isCreate);
+ assert(isDelete==0 || isCreate);
+
+ /* The main DB, main journal, WAL file and super-journal are never
+ ** automatically deleted. Nor are they ever temporary files. */
+ assert( (!isDelete && zName) || eType!=SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB );
+ assert( (!isDelete && zName) || eType!=SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL );
+ assert( (!isDelete && zName) || eType!=SQLITE_OPEN_SUPER_JOURNAL );
+ assert( (!isDelete && zName) || eType!=SQLITE_OPEN_WAL );
+
+ /* Assert that the upper layer has set one of the "file-type" flags. */
+ assert( eType==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_DB
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_JOURNAL
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_SUBJOURNAL || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_SUPER_JOURNAL
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_TRANSIENT_DB || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_WAL
+ );
+
+ /* Detect a pid change and reset the PRNG. There is a race condition
+ ** here such that two or more threads all trying to open databases at
+ ** the same instant might all reset the PRNG. But multiple resets
+ ** are harmless.
+ */
+ if( randomnessPid!=osGetpid(0) ){
+ randomnessPid = osGetpid(0);
+ sqlite3_randomness(0,0);
+ }
+ memset(p, 0, sizeof(unixFile));
+
+ if( eType==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB ){
+ UnixUnusedFd *pUnused;
+ pUnused = findReusableFd(zName, flags);
+ if( pUnused ){
+ fd = pUnused->fd;
+ }else{
+ pUnused = sqlite3_malloc64(sizeof(*pUnused));
+ if( !pUnused ){
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ }
+ p->pPreallocatedUnused = pUnused;
+
+ /* Database filenames are double-zero terminated if they are not
+ ** URIs with parameters. Hence, they can always be passed into
+ ** sqlite3_uri_parameter(). */
+ assert( (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_URI) || zName[strlen(zName)+1]==0 );
+
+ }else if( !zName ){
+ /* If zName is NULL, the upper layer is requesting a temp file. */
+ assert(isDelete && !isNewJrnl);
+ rc = unixGetTempname(pVfs->mxPathname, zTmpname);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ return rc;
+ }
+ zName = zTmpname;
+
+ /* Generated temporary filenames are always double-zero terminated
+ ** for use by sqlite3_uri_parameter(). */
+ assert( zName[strlen(zName)+1]==0 );
+ }
+
+ /* Determine the value of the flags parameter passed to POSIX function
+ ** open(). These must be calculated even if open() is not called, as
+ ** they may be stored as part of the file handle and used by the
+ ** 'conch file' locking functions later on. */
+ if( isReadonly ) openFlags |= O_RDONLY;
+ if( isReadWrite ) openFlags |= O_RDWR;
+ if( isCreate ) openFlags |= O_CREAT;
+ if( isExclusive ) openFlags |= (O_EXCL|O_NOFOLLOW);
+ openFlags |= (O_LARGEFILE|O_BINARY|O_NOFOLLOW);
+
+ if( fd<0 ){
+ mode_t openMode; /* Permissions to create file with */
+ uid_t uid; /* Userid for the file */
+ gid_t gid; /* Groupid for the file */
+ rc = findCreateFileMode(zName, flags, &openMode, &uid, &gid);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ assert( !p->pPreallocatedUnused );
+ assert( eType==SQLITE_OPEN_WAL || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL );
+ return rc;
+ }
+ fd = robust_open(zName, openFlags, openMode);
+ OSTRACE(("OPENX %-3d %s 0%o\n", fd, zName, openFlags));
+ assert( !isExclusive || (openFlags & O_CREAT)!=0 );
+ if( fd<0 ){
+ if( isNewJrnl && errno==EACCES && osAccess(zName, F_OK) ){
+ /* If unable to create a journal because the directory is not
+ ** writable, change the error code to indicate that. */
+ rc = SQLITE_READONLY_DIRECTORY;
+ }else if( errno!=EISDIR && isReadWrite ){
+ /* Failed to open the file for read/write access. Try read-only. */
+ flags &= ~(SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE|SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE);
+ openFlags &= ~(O_RDWR|O_CREAT);
+ flags |= SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY;
+ openFlags |= O_RDONLY;
+ isReadonly = 1;
+ fd = robust_open(zName, openFlags, openMode);
+ }
+ }
+ if( fd<0 ){
+ int rc2 = unixLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT, "open", zName);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ) rc = rc2;
+ goto open_finished;
+ }
+
+ /* The owner of the rollback journal or WAL file should always be the
+ ** same as the owner of the database file. Try to ensure that this is
+ ** the case. The chown() system call will be a no-op if the current
+ ** process lacks root privileges, be we should at least try. Without
+ ** this step, if a root process opens a database file, it can leave
+ ** behinds a journal/WAL that is owned by root and hence make the
+ ** database inaccessible to unprivileged processes.
+ **
+ ** If openMode==0, then that means uid and gid are not set correctly
+ ** (probably because SQLite is configured to use 8+3 filename mode) and
+ ** in that case we do not want to attempt the chown().
+ */
+ if( openMode && (flags & (SQLITE_OPEN_WAL|SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL))!=0 ){
+ robustFchown(fd, uid, gid);
+ }
+ }
+ assert( fd>=0 );
+ if( pOutFlags ){
+ *pOutFlags = flags;
+ }
+
+ if( p->pPreallocatedUnused ){
+ p->pPreallocatedUnused->fd = fd;
+ p->pPreallocatedUnused->flags =
+ flags & (SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY|SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE);
+ }
+
+ if( isDelete ){
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ zPath = zName;
+#elif defined(SQLITE_UNLINK_AFTER_CLOSE)
+ zPath = sqlite3_mprintf("%s", zName);
+ if( zPath==0 ){
+ robust_close(p, fd, __LINE__);
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+#else
+ osUnlink(zName);
+#endif
+ }
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ else{
+ p->openFlags = openFlags;
+ }
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__APPLE__) || SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ if( fstatfs(fd, &fsInfo) == -1 ){
+ storeLastErrno(p, errno);
+ robust_close(p, fd, __LINE__);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_ACCESS;
+ }
+ if (0 == strncmp("msdos", fsInfo.f_fstypename, 5)) {
+ ((unixFile*)pFile)->fsFlags |= SQLITE_FSFLAGS_IS_MSDOS;
+ }
+ if (0 == strncmp("exfat", fsInfo.f_fstypename, 5)) {
+ ((unixFile*)pFile)->fsFlags |= SQLITE_FSFLAGS_IS_MSDOS;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* Set up appropriate ctrlFlags */
+ if( isDelete ) ctrlFlags |= UNIXFILE_DELETE;
+ if( isReadonly ) ctrlFlags |= UNIXFILE_RDONLY;
+ noLock = eType!=SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB;
+ if( noLock ) ctrlFlags |= UNIXFILE_NOLOCK;
+ if( isNewJrnl ) ctrlFlags |= UNIXFILE_DIRSYNC;
+ if( flags & SQLITE_OPEN_URI ) ctrlFlags |= UNIXFILE_URI;
+
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+#if SQLITE_PREFER_PROXY_LOCKING
+ isAutoProxy = 1;
+#endif
+ if( isAutoProxy && (zPath!=NULL) && (!noLock) && pVfs->xOpen ){
+ char *envforce = getenv("SQLITE_FORCE_PROXY_LOCKING");
+ int useProxy = 0;
+
+ /* SQLITE_FORCE_PROXY_LOCKING==1 means force always use proxy, 0 means
+ ** never use proxy, NULL means use proxy for non-local files only. */
+ if( envforce!=NULL ){
+ useProxy = atoi(envforce)>0;
+ }else{
+ useProxy = !(fsInfo.f_flags&MNT_LOCAL);
+ }
+ if( useProxy ){
+ rc = fillInUnixFile(pVfs, fd, pFile, zPath, ctrlFlags);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ rc = proxyTransformUnixFile((unixFile*)pFile, ":auto:");
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ /* Use unixClose to clean up the resources added in fillInUnixFile
+ ** and clear all the structure's references. Specifically,
+ ** pFile->pMethods will be NULL so sqlite3OsClose will be a no-op
+ */
+ unixClose(pFile);
+ return rc;
+ }
+ }
+ goto open_finished;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ assert( zPath==0 || zPath[0]=='/'
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_SUPER_JOURNAL || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL
+ );
+ rc = fillInUnixFile(pVfs, fd, pFile, zPath, ctrlFlags);
+
+open_finished:
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ sqlite3_free(p->pPreallocatedUnused);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Delete the file at zPath. If the dirSync argument is true, fsync()
+** the directory after deleting the file.
+*/
+static int unixDelete(
+ sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, /* VFS containing this as the xDelete method */
+ const char *zPath, /* Name of file to be deleted */
+ int dirSync /* If true, fsync() directory after deleting file */
+){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ SimulateIOError(return SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE);
+ if( osUnlink(zPath)==(-1) ){
+ if( errno==ENOENT
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ || osAccess(zPath,0)!=0
+#endif
+ ){
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE_NOENT;
+ }else{
+ rc = unixLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE, "unlink", zPath);
+ }
+ return rc;
+ }
+#ifndef SQLITE_DISABLE_DIRSYNC
+ if( (dirSync & 1)!=0 ){
+ int fd;
+ rc = osOpenDirectory(zPath, &fd);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ if( full_fsync(fd,0,0) ){
+ rc = unixLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_DIR_FSYNC, "fsync", zPath);
+ }
+ robust_close(0, fd, __LINE__);
+ }else{
+ assert( rc==SQLITE_CANTOPEN );
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Test the existence of or access permissions of file zPath. The
+** test performed depends on the value of flags:
+**
+** SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS: Return 1 if the file exists
+** SQLITE_ACCESS_READWRITE: Return 1 if the file is read and writable.
+** SQLITE_ACCESS_READONLY: Return 1 if the file is readable.
+**
+** Otherwise return 0.
+*/
+static int unixAccess(
+ sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, /* The VFS containing this xAccess method */
+ const char *zPath, /* Path of the file to examine */
+ int flags, /* What do we want to learn about the zPath file? */
+ int *pResOut /* Write result boolean here */
+){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_IOERR_ACCESS; );
+ assert( pResOut!=0 );
+
+ /* The spec says there are three possible values for flags. But only
+ ** two of them are actually used */
+ assert( flags==SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS || flags==SQLITE_ACCESS_READWRITE );
+
+ if( flags==SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS ){
+ struct stat buf;
+ *pResOut = 0==osStat(zPath, &buf) &&
+ (!S_ISREG(buf.st_mode) || buf.st_size>0);
+ }else{
+ *pResOut = osAccess(zPath, W_OK|R_OK)==0;
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+**
+*/
+static int mkFullPathname(
+ const char *zPath, /* Input path */
+ char *zOut, /* Output buffer */
+ int nOut /* Allocated size of buffer zOut */
+){
+ int nPath = sqlite3Strlen30(zPath);
+ int iOff = 0;
+ if( zPath[0]!='/' ){
+ if( osGetcwd(zOut, nOut-2)==0 ){
+ return unixLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT, "getcwd", zPath);
+ }
+ iOff = sqlite3Strlen30(zOut);
+ zOut[iOff++] = '/';
+ }
+ if( (iOff+nPath+1)>nOut ){
+ /* SQLite assumes that xFullPathname() nul-terminates the output buffer
+ ** even if it returns an error. */
+ zOut[iOff] = '\0';
+ return SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT;
+ }
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nOut-iOff, &zOut[iOff], "%s", zPath);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Turn a relative pathname into a full pathname. The relative path
+** is stored as a nul-terminated string in the buffer pointed to by
+** zPath.
+**
+** zOut points to a buffer of at least sqlite3_vfs.mxPathname bytes
+** (in this case, MAX_PATHNAME bytes). The full-path is written to
+** this buffer before returning.
+*/
+static int unixFullPathname(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, /* Pointer to vfs object */
+ const char *zPath, /* Possibly relative input path */
+ int nOut, /* Size of output buffer in bytes */
+ char *zOut /* Output buffer */
+){
+#if !defined(HAVE_READLINK) || !defined(HAVE_LSTAT)
+ return mkFullPathname(zPath, zOut, nOut);
+#else
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int nByte;
+ int nLink = 0; /* Number of symbolic links followed so far */
+ const char *zIn = zPath; /* Input path for each iteration of loop */
+ char *zDel = 0;
+
+ assert( pVfs->mxPathname==MAX_PATHNAME );
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+
+ /* It's odd to simulate an io-error here, but really this is just
+ ** using the io-error infrastructure to test that SQLite handles this
+ ** function failing. This function could fail if, for example, the
+ ** current working directory has been unlinked.
+ */
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_ERROR );
+
+ do {
+
+ /* Call stat() on path zIn. Set bLink to true if the path is a symbolic
+ ** link, or false otherwise. */
+ int bLink = 0;
+ struct stat buf;
+ if( osLstat(zIn, &buf)!=0 ){
+ if( errno!=ENOENT ){
+ rc = unixLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT, "lstat", zIn);
+ }
+ }else{
+ bLink = S_ISLNK(buf.st_mode);
+ }
+
+ if( bLink ){
+ nLink++;
+ if( zDel==0 ){
+ zDel = sqlite3_malloc(nOut);
+ if( zDel==0 ) rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }else if( nLink>=SQLITE_MAX_SYMLINKS ){
+ rc = SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT;
+ }
+
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ nByte = osReadlink(zIn, zDel, nOut-1);
+ if( nByte<0 ){
+ rc = unixLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT, "readlink", zIn);
+ }else{
+ if( zDel[0]!='/' ){
+ int n;
+ for(n = sqlite3Strlen30(zIn); n>0 && zIn[n-1]!='/'; n--);
+ if( nByte+n+1>nOut ){
+ rc = SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT;
+ }else{
+ memmove(&zDel[n], zDel, nByte+1);
+ memcpy(zDel, zIn, n);
+ nByte += n;
+ }
+ }
+ zDel[nByte] = '\0';
+ }
+ }
+
+ zIn = zDel;
+ }
+
+ assert( rc!=SQLITE_OK || zIn!=zOut || zIn[0]=='/' );
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && zIn!=zOut ){
+ rc = mkFullPathname(zIn, zOut, nOut);
+ }
+ if( bLink==0 ) break;
+ zIn = zOut;
+ }while( rc==SQLITE_OK );
+
+ sqlite3_free(zDel);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && nLink ) rc = SQLITE_OK_SYMLINK;
+ return rc;
+#endif /* HAVE_READLINK && HAVE_LSTAT */
+}
+
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION
+/*
+** Interfaces for opening a shared library, finding entry points
+** within the shared library, and closing the shared library.
+*/
+#include
+static void *unixDlOpen(sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, const char *zFilename){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ return dlopen(zFilename, RTLD_NOW | RTLD_GLOBAL);
+}
+
+/*
+** SQLite calls this function immediately after a call to unixDlSym() or
+** unixDlOpen() fails (returns a null pointer). If a more detailed error
+** message is available, it is written to zBufOut. If no error message
+** is available, zBufOut is left unmodified and SQLite uses a default
+** error message.
+*/
+static void unixDlError(sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, int nBuf, char *zBufOut){
+ const char *zErr;
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ unixEnterMutex();
+ zErr = dlerror();
+ if( zErr ){
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nBuf, zBufOut, "%s", zErr);
+ }
+ unixLeaveMutex();
+}
+static void (*unixDlSym(sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, void *p, const char*zSym))(void){
+ /*
+ ** GCC with -pedantic-errors says that C90 does not allow a void* to be
+ ** cast into a pointer to a function. And yet the library dlsym() routine
+ ** returns a void* which is really a pointer to a function. So how do we
+ ** use dlsym() with -pedantic-errors?
+ **
+ ** Variable x below is defined to be a pointer to a function taking
+ ** parameters void* and const char* and returning a pointer to a function.
+ ** We initialize x by assigning it a pointer to the dlsym() function.
+ ** (That assignment requires a cast.) Then we call the function that
+ ** x points to.
+ **
+ ** This work-around is unlikely to work correctly on any system where
+ ** you really cannot cast a function pointer into void*. But then, on the
+ ** other hand, dlsym() will not work on such a system either, so we have
+ ** not really lost anything.
+ */
+ void (*(*x)(void*,const char*))(void);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ x = (void(*(*)(void*,const char*))(void))dlsym;
+ return (*x)(p, zSym);
+}
+static void unixDlClose(sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, void *pHandle){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ dlclose(pHandle);
+}
+#else /* if SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION is defined: */
+ #define unixDlOpen 0
+ #define unixDlError 0
+ #define unixDlSym 0
+ #define unixDlClose 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Write nBuf bytes of random data to the supplied buffer zBuf.
+*/
+static int unixRandomness(sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, int nBuf, char *zBuf){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ assert((size_t)nBuf>=(sizeof(time_t)+sizeof(int)));
+
+ /* We have to initialize zBuf to prevent valgrind from reporting
+ ** errors. The reports issued by valgrind are incorrect - we would
+ ** prefer that the randomness be increased by making use of the
+ ** uninitialized space in zBuf - but valgrind errors tend to worry
+ ** some users. Rather than argue, it seems easier just to initialize
+ ** the whole array and silence valgrind, even if that means less randomness
+ ** in the random seed.
+ **
+ ** When testing, initializing zBuf[] to zero is all we do. That means
+ ** that we always use the same random number sequence. This makes the
+ ** tests repeatable.
+ */
+ memset(zBuf, 0, nBuf);
+ randomnessPid = osGetpid(0);
+#if !defined(SQLITE_TEST) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_RANDOMNESS)
+ {
+ int fd, got;
+ fd = robust_open("/dev/urandom", O_RDONLY, 0);
+ if( fd<0 ){
+ time_t t;
+ time(&t);
+ memcpy(zBuf, &t, sizeof(t));
+ memcpy(&zBuf[sizeof(t)], &randomnessPid, sizeof(randomnessPid));
+ assert( sizeof(t)+sizeof(randomnessPid)<=(size_t)nBuf );
+ nBuf = sizeof(t) + sizeof(randomnessPid);
+ }else{
+ do{ got = osRead(fd, zBuf, nBuf); }while( got<0 && errno==EINTR );
+ robust_close(0, fd, __LINE__);
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ return nBuf;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Sleep for a little while. Return the amount of time slept.
+** The argument is the number of microseconds we want to sleep.
+** The return value is the number of microseconds of sleep actually
+** requested from the underlying operating system, a number which
+** might be greater than or equal to the argument, but not less
+** than the argument.
+*/
+static int unixSleep(sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, int microseconds){
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ struct timespec sp;
+
+ sp.tv_sec = microseconds / 1000000;
+ sp.tv_nsec = (microseconds % 1000000) * 1000;
+ nanosleep(&sp, NULL);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ return microseconds;
+#elif defined(HAVE_USLEEP) && HAVE_USLEEP
+ usleep(microseconds);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ return microseconds;
+#else
+ int seconds = (microseconds+999999)/1000000;
+ sleep(seconds);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ return seconds*1000000;
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** The following variable, if set to a non-zero value, is interpreted as
+** the number of seconds since 1970 and is used to set the result of
+** sqlite3OsCurrentTime() during testing.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_current_time = 0; /* Fake system time in seconds since 1970. */
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Find the current time (in Universal Coordinated Time). Write into *piNow
+** the current time and date as a Julian Day number times 86_400_000. In
+** other words, write into *piNow the number of milliseconds since the Julian
+** epoch of noon in Greenwich on November 24, 4714 B.C according to the
+** proleptic Gregorian calendar.
+**
+** On success, return SQLITE_OK. Return SQLITE_ERROR if the time and date
+** cannot be found.
+*/
+static int unixCurrentTimeInt64(sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, sqlite3_int64 *piNow){
+ static const sqlite3_int64 unixEpoch = 24405875*(sqlite3_int64)8640000;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+#if defined(NO_GETTOD)
+ time_t t;
+ time(&t);
+ *piNow = ((sqlite3_int64)t)*1000 + unixEpoch;
+#elif OS_VXWORKS
+ struct timespec sNow;
+ clock_gettime(CLOCK_REALTIME, &sNow);
+ *piNow = unixEpoch + 1000*(sqlite3_int64)sNow.tv_sec + sNow.tv_nsec/1000000;
+#else
+ struct timeval sNow;
+ (void)gettimeofday(&sNow, 0); /* Cannot fail given valid arguments */
+ *piNow = unixEpoch + 1000*(sqlite3_int64)sNow.tv_sec + sNow.tv_usec/1000;
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ if( sqlite3_current_time ){
+ *piNow = 1000*(sqlite3_int64)sqlite3_current_time + unixEpoch;
+ }
+#endif
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_DEPRECATED
+/*
+** Find the current time (in Universal Coordinated Time). Write the
+** current time and date as a Julian Day number into *prNow and
+** return 0. Return 1 if the time and date cannot be found.
+*/
+static int unixCurrentTime(sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, double *prNow){
+ sqlite3_int64 i = 0;
+ int rc;
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ rc = unixCurrentTimeInt64(0, &i);
+ *prNow = i/86400000.0;
+ return rc;
+}
+#else
+# define unixCurrentTime 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The xGetLastError() method is designed to return a better
+** low-level error message when operating-system problems come up
+** during SQLite operation. Only the integer return code is currently
+** used.
+*/
+static int unixGetLastError(sqlite3_vfs *NotUsed, int NotUsed2, char *NotUsed3){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed2);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed3);
+ return errno;
+}
+
+
+/*
+************************ End of sqlite3_vfs methods ***************************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/******************************************************************************
+************************** Begin Proxy Locking ********************************
+**
+** Proxy locking is a "uber-locking-method" in this sense: It uses the
+** other locking methods on secondary lock files. Proxy locking is a
+** meta-layer over top of the primitive locking implemented above. For
+** this reason, the division that implements of proxy locking is deferred
+** until late in the file (here) after all of the other I/O methods have
+** been defined - so that the primitive locking methods are available
+** as services to help with the implementation of proxy locking.
+**
+****
+**
+** The default locking schemes in SQLite use byte-range locks on the
+** database file to coordinate safe, concurrent access by multiple readers
+** and writers [http://sqlite.org/lockingv3.html]. The five file locking
+** states (UNLOCKED, PENDING, SHARED, RESERVED, EXCLUSIVE) are implemented
+** as POSIX read & write locks over fixed set of locations (via fsctl),
+** on AFP and SMB only exclusive byte-range locks are available via fsctl
+** with _IOWR('z', 23, struct ByteRangeLockPB2) to track the same 5 states.
+** To simulate a F_RDLCK on the shared range, on AFP a randomly selected
+** address in the shared range is taken for a SHARED lock, the entire
+** shared range is taken for an EXCLUSIVE lock):
+**
+** PENDING_BYTE 0x40000000
+** RESERVED_BYTE 0x40000001
+** SHARED_RANGE 0x40000002 -> 0x40000200
+**
+** This works well on the local file system, but shows a nearly 100x
+** slowdown in read performance on AFP because the AFP client disables
+** the read cache when byte-range locks are present. Enabling the read
+** cache exposes a cache coherency problem that is present on all OS X
+** supported network file systems. NFS and AFP both observe the
+** close-to-open semantics for ensuring cache coherency
+** [http://nfs.sourceforge.net/#faq_a8], which does not effectively
+** address the requirements for concurrent database access by multiple
+** readers and writers
+** [http://www.nabble.com/SQLite-on-NFS-cache-coherency-td15655701.html].
+**
+** To address the performance and cache coherency issues, proxy file locking
+** changes the way database access is controlled by limiting access to a
+** single host at a time and moving file locks off of the database file
+** and onto a proxy file on the local file system.
+**
+**
+** Using proxy locks
+** -----------------
+**
+** C APIs
+**
+** sqlite3_file_control(db, dbname, SQLITE_FCNTL_SET_LOCKPROXYFILE,
+** | ":auto:");
+** sqlite3_file_control(db, dbname, SQLITE_FCNTL_GET_LOCKPROXYFILE,
+** &);
+**
+**
+** SQL pragmas
+**
+** PRAGMA [database.]lock_proxy_file= | :auto:
+** PRAGMA [database.]lock_proxy_file
+**
+** Specifying ":auto:" means that if there is a conch file with a matching
+** host ID in it, the proxy path in the conch file will be used, otherwise
+** a proxy path based on the user's temp dir
+** (via confstr(_CS_DARWIN_USER_TEMP_DIR,...)) will be used and the
+** actual proxy file name is generated from the name and path of the
+** database file. For example:
+**
+** For database path "/Users/me/foo.db"
+** The lock path will be "/sqliteplocks/_Users_me_foo.db:auto:")
+**
+** Once a lock proxy is configured for a database connection, it can not
+** be removed, however it may be switched to a different proxy path via
+** the above APIs (assuming the conch file is not being held by another
+** connection or process).
+**
+**
+** How proxy locking works
+** -----------------------
+**
+** Proxy file locking relies primarily on two new supporting files:
+**
+** * conch file to limit access to the database file to a single host
+** at a time
+**
+** * proxy file to act as a proxy for the advisory locks normally
+** taken on the database
+**
+** The conch file - to use a proxy file, sqlite must first "hold the conch"
+** by taking an sqlite-style shared lock on the conch file, reading the
+** contents and comparing the host's unique host ID (see below) and lock
+** proxy path against the values stored in the conch. The conch file is
+** stored in the same directory as the database file and the file name
+** is patterned after the database file name as ".-conch".
+** If the conch file does not exist, or its contents do not match the
+** host ID and/or proxy path, then the lock is escalated to an exclusive
+** lock and the conch file contents is updated with the host ID and proxy
+** path and the lock is downgraded to a shared lock again. If the conch
+** is held by another process (with a shared lock), the exclusive lock
+** will fail and SQLITE_BUSY is returned.
+**
+** The proxy file - a single-byte file used for all advisory file locks
+** normally taken on the database file. This allows for safe sharing
+** of the database file for multiple readers and writers on the same
+** host (the conch ensures that they all use the same local lock file).
+**
+** Requesting the lock proxy does not immediately take the conch, it is
+** only taken when the first request to lock database file is made.
+** This matches the semantics of the traditional locking behavior, where
+** opening a connection to a database file does not take a lock on it.
+** The shared lock and an open file descriptor are maintained until
+** the connection to the database is closed.
+**
+** The proxy file and the lock file are never deleted so they only need
+** to be created the first time they are used.
+**
+** Configuration options
+** ---------------------
+**
+** SQLITE_PREFER_PROXY_LOCKING
+**
+** Database files accessed on non-local file systems are
+** automatically configured for proxy locking, lock files are
+** named automatically using the same logic as
+** PRAGMA lock_proxy_file=":auto:"
+**
+** SQLITE_PROXY_DEBUG
+**
+** Enables the logging of error messages during host id file
+** retrieval and creation
+**
+** LOCKPROXYDIR
+**
+** Overrides the default directory used for lock proxy files that
+** are named automatically via the ":auto:" setting
+**
+** SQLITE_DEFAULT_PROXYDIR_PERMISSIONS
+**
+** Permissions to use when creating a directory for storing the
+** lock proxy files, only used when LOCKPROXYDIR is not set.
+**
+**
+** As mentioned above, when compiled with SQLITE_PREFER_PROXY_LOCKING,
+** setting the environment variable SQLITE_FORCE_PROXY_LOCKING to 1 will
+** force proxy locking to be used for every database file opened, and 0
+** will force automatic proxy locking to be disabled for all database
+** files (explicitly calling the SQLITE_FCNTL_SET_LOCKPROXYFILE pragma or
+** sqlite_file_control API is not affected by SQLITE_FORCE_PROXY_LOCKING).
+*/
+
+/*
+** Proxy locking is only available on MacOSX
+*/
+#if defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+
+/*
+** The proxyLockingContext has the path and file structures for the remote
+** and local proxy files in it
+*/
+typedef struct proxyLockingContext proxyLockingContext;
+struct proxyLockingContext {
+ unixFile *conchFile; /* Open conch file */
+ char *conchFilePath; /* Name of the conch file */
+ unixFile *lockProxy; /* Open proxy lock file */
+ char *lockProxyPath; /* Name of the proxy lock file */
+ char *dbPath; /* Name of the open file */
+ int conchHeld; /* 1 if the conch is held, -1 if lockless */
+ int nFails; /* Number of conch taking failures */
+ void *oldLockingContext; /* Original lockingcontext to restore on close */
+ sqlite3_io_methods const *pOldMethod; /* Original I/O methods for close */
+};
+
+/*
+** The proxy lock file path for the database at dbPath is written into lPath,
+** which must point to valid, writable memory large enough for a maxLen length
+** file path.
+*/
+static int proxyGetLockPath(const char *dbPath, char *lPath, size_t maxLen){
+ int len;
+ int dbLen;
+ int i;
+
+#ifdef LOCKPROXYDIR
+ len = strlcpy(lPath, LOCKPROXYDIR, maxLen);
+#else
+# ifdef _CS_DARWIN_USER_TEMP_DIR
+ {
+ if( !confstr(_CS_DARWIN_USER_TEMP_DIR, lPath, maxLen) ){
+ OSTRACE(("GETLOCKPATH failed %s errno=%d pid=%d\n",
+ lPath, errno, osGetpid(0)));
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK;
+ }
+ len = strlcat(lPath, "sqliteplocks", maxLen);
+ }
+# else
+ len = strlcpy(lPath, "/tmp/", maxLen);
+# endif
+#endif
+
+ if( lPath[len-1]!='/' ){
+ len = strlcat(lPath, "/", maxLen);
+ }
+
+ /* transform the db path to a unique cache name */
+ dbLen = (int)strlen(dbPath);
+ for( i=0; i 0) ){
+ /* only mkdir if leaf dir != "." or "/" or ".." */
+ if( i-start>2 || (i-start==1 && buf[start] != '.' && buf[start] != '/')
+ || (i-start==2 && buf[start] != '.' && buf[start+1] != '.') ){
+ buf[i]='\0';
+ if( osMkdir(buf, SQLITE_DEFAULT_PROXYDIR_PERMISSIONS) ){
+ int err=errno;
+ if( err!=EEXIST ) {
+ OSTRACE(("CREATELOCKPATH FAILED creating %s, "
+ "'%s' proxy lock path=%s pid=%d\n",
+ buf, strerror(err), lockPath, osGetpid(0)));
+ return err;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ start=i+1;
+ }
+ buf[i] = lockPath[i];
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("CREATELOCKPATH proxy lock path=%s pid=%d\n",lockPath,osGetpid(0)));
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Create a new VFS file descriptor (stored in memory obtained from
+** sqlite3_malloc) and open the file named "path" in the file descriptor.
+**
+** The caller is responsible not only for closing the file descriptor
+** but also for freeing the memory associated with the file descriptor.
+*/
+static int proxyCreateUnixFile(
+ const char *path, /* path for the new unixFile */
+ unixFile **ppFile, /* unixFile created and returned by ref */
+ int islockfile /* if non zero missing dirs will be created */
+) {
+ int fd = -1;
+ unixFile *pNew;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int openFlags = O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_NOFOLLOW;
+ sqlite3_vfs dummyVfs;
+ int terrno = 0;
+ UnixUnusedFd *pUnused = NULL;
+
+ /* 1. first try to open/create the file
+ ** 2. if that fails, and this is a lock file (not-conch), try creating
+ ** the parent directories and then try again.
+ ** 3. if that fails, try to open the file read-only
+ ** otherwise return BUSY (if lock file) or CANTOPEN for the conch file
+ */
+ pUnused = findReusableFd(path, openFlags);
+ if( pUnused ){
+ fd = pUnused->fd;
+ }else{
+ pUnused = sqlite3_malloc64(sizeof(*pUnused));
+ if( !pUnused ){
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ }
+ if( fd<0 ){
+ fd = robust_open(path, openFlags, 0);
+ terrno = errno;
+ if( fd<0 && errno==ENOENT && islockfile ){
+ if( proxyCreateLockPath(path) == SQLITE_OK ){
+ fd = robust_open(path, openFlags, 0);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ if( fd<0 ){
+ openFlags = O_RDONLY | O_NOFOLLOW;
+ fd = robust_open(path, openFlags, 0);
+ terrno = errno;
+ }
+ if( fd<0 ){
+ if( islockfile ){
+ return SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+ switch (terrno) {
+ case EACCES:
+ return SQLITE_PERM;
+ case EIO:
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK; /* even though it is the conch */
+ default:
+ return SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT;
+ }
+ }
+
+ pNew = (unixFile *)sqlite3_malloc64(sizeof(*pNew));
+ if( pNew==NULL ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ goto end_create_proxy;
+ }
+ memset(pNew, 0, sizeof(unixFile));
+ pNew->openFlags = openFlags;
+ memset(&dummyVfs, 0, sizeof(dummyVfs));
+ dummyVfs.pAppData = (void*)&autolockIoFinder;
+ dummyVfs.zName = "dummy";
+ pUnused->fd = fd;
+ pUnused->flags = openFlags;
+ pNew->pPreallocatedUnused = pUnused;
+
+ rc = fillInUnixFile(&dummyVfs, fd, (sqlite3_file*)pNew, path, 0);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ *ppFile = pNew;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+end_create_proxy:
+ robust_close(pNew, fd, __LINE__);
+ sqlite3_free(pNew);
+ sqlite3_free(pUnused);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+/* simulate multiple hosts by creating unique hostid file paths */
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_hostid_num = 0;
+#endif
+
+#define PROXY_HOSTIDLEN 16 /* conch file host id length */
+
+#if HAVE_GETHOSTUUID
+/* Not always defined in the headers as it ought to be */
+extern int gethostuuid(uuid_t id, const struct timespec *wait);
+#endif
+
+/* get the host ID via gethostuuid(), pHostID must point to PROXY_HOSTIDLEN
+** bytes of writable memory.
+*/
+static int proxyGetHostID(unsigned char *pHostID, int *pError){
+ assert(PROXY_HOSTIDLEN == sizeof(uuid_t));
+ memset(pHostID, 0, PROXY_HOSTIDLEN);
+#if HAVE_GETHOSTUUID
+ {
+ struct timespec timeout = {1, 0}; /* 1 sec timeout */
+ if( gethostuuid(pHostID, &timeout) ){
+ int err = errno;
+ if( pError ){
+ *pError = err;
+ }
+ return SQLITE_IOERR;
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pError);
+#endif
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ /* simulate multiple hosts by creating unique hostid file paths */
+ if( sqlite3_hostid_num != 0){
+ pHostID[0] = (char)(pHostID[0] + (char)(sqlite3_hostid_num & 0xFF));
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/* The conch file contains the header, host id and lock file path
+ */
+#define PROXY_CONCHVERSION 2 /* 1-byte header, 16-byte host id, path */
+#define PROXY_HEADERLEN 1 /* conch file header length */
+#define PROXY_PATHINDEX (PROXY_HEADERLEN+PROXY_HOSTIDLEN)
+#define PROXY_MAXCONCHLEN (PROXY_HEADERLEN+PROXY_HOSTIDLEN+MAXPATHLEN)
+
+/*
+** Takes an open conch file, copies the contents to a new path and then moves
+** it back. The newly created file's file descriptor is assigned to the
+** conch file structure and finally the original conch file descriptor is
+** closed. Returns zero if successful.
+*/
+static int proxyBreakConchLock(unixFile *pFile, uuid_t myHostID){
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx = (proxyLockingContext *)pFile->lockingContext;
+ unixFile *conchFile = pCtx->conchFile;
+ char tPath[MAXPATHLEN];
+ char buf[PROXY_MAXCONCHLEN];
+ char *cPath = pCtx->conchFilePath;
+ size_t readLen = 0;
+ size_t pathLen = 0;
+ char errmsg[64] = "";
+ int fd = -1;
+ int rc = -1;
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(myHostID);
+
+ /* create a new path by replace the trailing '-conch' with '-break' */
+ pathLen = strlcpy(tPath, cPath, MAXPATHLEN);
+ if( pathLen>MAXPATHLEN || pathLen<6 ||
+ (strlcpy(&tPath[pathLen-5], "break", 6) != 5) ){
+ sqlite3_snprintf(sizeof(errmsg),errmsg,"path error (len %d)",(int)pathLen);
+ goto end_breaklock;
+ }
+ /* read the conch content */
+ readLen = osPread(conchFile->h, buf, PROXY_MAXCONCHLEN, 0);
+ if( readLenh, __LINE__);
+ conchFile->h = fd;
+ conchFile->openFlags = O_RDWR | O_CREAT;
+
+end_breaklock:
+ if( rc ){
+ if( fd>=0 ){
+ osUnlink(tPath);
+ robust_close(pFile, fd, __LINE__);
+ }
+ fprintf(stderr, "failed to break stale lock on %s, %s\n", cPath, errmsg);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/* Take the requested lock on the conch file and break a stale lock if the
+** host id matches.
+*/
+static int proxyConchLock(unixFile *pFile, uuid_t myHostID, int lockType){
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx = (proxyLockingContext *)pFile->lockingContext;
+ unixFile *conchFile = pCtx->conchFile;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int nTries = 0;
+ struct timespec conchModTime;
+
+ memset(&conchModTime, 0, sizeof(conchModTime));
+ do {
+ rc = conchFile->pMethod->xLock((sqlite3_file*)conchFile, lockType);
+ nTries ++;
+ if( rc==SQLITE_BUSY ){
+ /* If the lock failed (busy):
+ * 1st try: get the mod time of the conch, wait 0.5s and try again.
+ * 2nd try: fail if the mod time changed or host id is different, wait
+ * 10 sec and try again
+ * 3rd try: break the lock unless the mod time has changed.
+ */
+ struct stat buf;
+ if( osFstat(conchFile->h, &buf) ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK;
+ }
+
+ if( nTries==1 ){
+ conchModTime = buf.st_mtimespec;
+ usleep(500000); /* wait 0.5 sec and try the lock again*/
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ assert( nTries>1 );
+ if( conchModTime.tv_sec != buf.st_mtimespec.tv_sec ||
+ conchModTime.tv_nsec != buf.st_mtimespec.tv_nsec ){
+ return SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+
+ if( nTries==2 ){
+ char tBuf[PROXY_MAXCONCHLEN];
+ int len = osPread(conchFile->h, tBuf, PROXY_MAXCONCHLEN, 0);
+ if( len<0 ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, errno);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK;
+ }
+ if( len>PROXY_PATHINDEX && tBuf[0]==(char)PROXY_CONCHVERSION){
+ /* don't break the lock if the host id doesn't match */
+ if( 0!=memcmp(&tBuf[PROXY_HEADERLEN], myHostID, PROXY_HOSTIDLEN) ){
+ return SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+ }else{
+ /* don't break the lock on short read or a version mismatch */
+ return SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+ usleep(10000000); /* wait 10 sec and try the lock again */
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ assert( nTries==3 );
+ if( 0==proxyBreakConchLock(pFile, myHostID) ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ if( lockType==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK ){
+ rc = conchFile->pMethod->xLock((sqlite3_file*)conchFile, SHARED_LOCK);
+ }
+ if( !rc ){
+ rc = conchFile->pMethod->xLock((sqlite3_file*)conchFile, lockType);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ } while( rc==SQLITE_BUSY && nTries<3 );
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/* Takes the conch by taking a shared lock and read the contents conch, if
+** lockPath is non-NULL, the host ID and lock file path must match. A NULL
+** lockPath means that the lockPath in the conch file will be used if the
+** host IDs match, or a new lock path will be generated automatically
+** and written to the conch file.
+*/
+static int proxyTakeConch(unixFile *pFile){
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx = (proxyLockingContext *)pFile->lockingContext;
+
+ if( pCtx->conchHeld!=0 ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ unixFile *conchFile = pCtx->conchFile;
+ uuid_t myHostID;
+ int pError = 0;
+ char readBuf[PROXY_MAXCONCHLEN];
+ char lockPath[MAXPATHLEN];
+ char *tempLockPath = NULL;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int createConch = 0;
+ int hostIdMatch = 0;
+ int readLen = 0;
+ int tryOldLockPath = 0;
+ int forceNewLockPath = 0;
+
+ OSTRACE(("TAKECONCH %d for %s pid=%d\n", conchFile->h,
+ (pCtx->lockProxyPath ? pCtx->lockProxyPath : ":auto:"),
+ osGetpid(0)));
+
+ rc = proxyGetHostID(myHostID, &pError);
+ if( (rc&0xff)==SQLITE_IOERR ){
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, pError);
+ goto end_takeconch;
+ }
+ rc = proxyConchLock(pFile, myHostID, SHARED_LOCK);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ goto end_takeconch;
+ }
+ /* read the existing conch file */
+ readLen = seekAndRead((unixFile*)conchFile, 0, readBuf, PROXY_MAXCONCHLEN);
+ if( readLen<0 ){
+ /* I/O error: lastErrno set by seekAndRead */
+ storeLastErrno(pFile, conchFile->lastErrno);
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_READ;
+ goto end_takeconch;
+ }else if( readLen<=(PROXY_HEADERLEN+PROXY_HOSTIDLEN) ||
+ readBuf[0]!=(char)PROXY_CONCHVERSION ){
+ /* a short read or version format mismatch means we need to create a new
+ ** conch file.
+ */
+ createConch = 1;
+ }
+ /* if the host id matches and the lock path already exists in the conch
+ ** we'll try to use the path there, if we can't open that path, we'll
+ ** retry with a new auto-generated path
+ */
+ do { /* in case we need to try again for an :auto: named lock file */
+
+ if( !createConch && !forceNewLockPath ){
+ hostIdMatch = !memcmp(&readBuf[PROXY_HEADERLEN], myHostID,
+ PROXY_HOSTIDLEN);
+ /* if the conch has data compare the contents */
+ if( !pCtx->lockProxyPath ){
+ /* for auto-named local lock file, just check the host ID and we'll
+ ** use the local lock file path that's already in there
+ */
+ if( hostIdMatch ){
+ size_t pathLen = (readLen - PROXY_PATHINDEX);
+
+ if( pathLen>=MAXPATHLEN ){
+ pathLen=MAXPATHLEN-1;
+ }
+ memcpy(lockPath, &readBuf[PROXY_PATHINDEX], pathLen);
+ lockPath[pathLen] = 0;
+ tempLockPath = lockPath;
+ tryOldLockPath = 1;
+ /* create a copy of the lock path if the conch is taken */
+ goto end_takeconch;
+ }
+ }else if( hostIdMatch
+ && !strncmp(pCtx->lockProxyPath, &readBuf[PROXY_PATHINDEX],
+ readLen-PROXY_PATHINDEX)
+ ){
+ /* conch host and lock path match */
+ goto end_takeconch;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* if the conch isn't writable and doesn't match, we can't take it */
+ if( (conchFile->openFlags&O_RDWR) == 0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ goto end_takeconch;
+ }
+
+ /* either the conch didn't match or we need to create a new one */
+ if( !pCtx->lockProxyPath ){
+ proxyGetLockPath(pCtx->dbPath, lockPath, MAXPATHLEN);
+ tempLockPath = lockPath;
+ /* create a copy of the lock path _only_ if the conch is taken */
+ }
+
+ /* update conch with host and path (this will fail if other process
+ ** has a shared lock already), if the host id matches, use the big
+ ** stick.
+ */
+ futimes(conchFile->h, NULL);
+ if( hostIdMatch && !createConch ){
+ if( conchFile->pInode && conchFile->pInode->nShared>1 ){
+ /* We are trying for an exclusive lock but another thread in this
+ ** same process is still holding a shared lock. */
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ } else {
+ rc = proxyConchLock(pFile, myHostID, EXCLUSIVE_LOCK);
+ }
+ }else{
+ rc = proxyConchLock(pFile, myHostID, EXCLUSIVE_LOCK);
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ char writeBuffer[PROXY_MAXCONCHLEN];
+ int writeSize = 0;
+
+ writeBuffer[0] = (char)PROXY_CONCHVERSION;
+ memcpy(&writeBuffer[PROXY_HEADERLEN], myHostID, PROXY_HOSTIDLEN);
+ if( pCtx->lockProxyPath!=NULL ){
+ strlcpy(&writeBuffer[PROXY_PATHINDEX], pCtx->lockProxyPath,
+ MAXPATHLEN);
+ }else{
+ strlcpy(&writeBuffer[PROXY_PATHINDEX], tempLockPath, MAXPATHLEN);
+ }
+ writeSize = PROXY_PATHINDEX + strlen(&writeBuffer[PROXY_PATHINDEX]);
+ robust_ftruncate(conchFile->h, writeSize);
+ rc = unixWrite((sqlite3_file *)conchFile, writeBuffer, writeSize, 0);
+ full_fsync(conchFile->h,0,0);
+ /* If we created a new conch file (not just updated the contents of a
+ ** valid conch file), try to match the permissions of the database
+ */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && createConch ){
+ struct stat buf;
+ int err = osFstat(pFile->h, &buf);
+ if( err==0 ){
+ mode_t cmode = buf.st_mode&(S_IRUSR|S_IWUSR | S_IRGRP|S_IWGRP |
+ S_IROTH|S_IWOTH);
+ /* try to match the database file R/W permissions, ignore failure */
+#ifndef SQLITE_PROXY_DEBUG
+ osFchmod(conchFile->h, cmode);
+#else
+ do{
+ rc = osFchmod(conchFile->h, cmode);
+ }while( rc==(-1) && errno==EINTR );
+ if( rc!=0 ){
+ int code = errno;
+ fprintf(stderr, "fchmod %o FAILED with %d %s\n",
+ cmode, code, strerror(code));
+ } else {
+ fprintf(stderr, "fchmod %o SUCCEDED\n",cmode);
+ }
+ }else{
+ int code = errno;
+ fprintf(stderr, "STAT FAILED[%d] with %d %s\n",
+ err, code, strerror(code));
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ conchFile->pMethod->xUnlock((sqlite3_file*)conchFile, SHARED_LOCK);
+
+ end_takeconch:
+ OSTRACE(("TRANSPROXY: CLOSE %d\n", pFile->h));
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && pFile->openFlags ){
+ int fd;
+ if( pFile->h>=0 ){
+ robust_close(pFile, pFile->h, __LINE__);
+ }
+ pFile->h = -1;
+ fd = robust_open(pCtx->dbPath, pFile->openFlags, 0);
+ OSTRACE(("TRANSPROXY: OPEN %d\n", fd));
+ if( fd>=0 ){
+ pFile->h = fd;
+ }else{
+ rc=SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT; /* SQLITE_BUSY? proxyTakeConch called
+ during locking */
+ }
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && !pCtx->lockProxy ){
+ char *path = tempLockPath ? tempLockPath : pCtx->lockProxyPath;
+ rc = proxyCreateUnixFile(path, &pCtx->lockProxy, 1);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK && rc!=SQLITE_NOMEM && tryOldLockPath ){
+ /* we couldn't create the proxy lock file with the old lock file path
+ ** so try again via auto-naming
+ */
+ forceNewLockPath = 1;
+ tryOldLockPath = 0;
+ continue; /* go back to the do {} while start point, try again */
+ }
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ /* Need to make a copy of path if we extracted the value
+ ** from the conch file or the path was allocated on the stack
+ */
+ if( tempLockPath ){
+ pCtx->lockProxyPath = sqlite3DbStrDup(0, tempLockPath);
+ if( !pCtx->lockProxyPath ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pCtx->conchHeld = 1;
+
+ if( pCtx->lockProxy->pMethod == &afpIoMethods ){
+ afpLockingContext *afpCtx;
+ afpCtx = (afpLockingContext *)pCtx->lockProxy->lockingContext;
+ afpCtx->dbPath = pCtx->lockProxyPath;
+ }
+ } else {
+ conchFile->pMethod->xUnlock((sqlite3_file*)conchFile, NO_LOCK);
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("TAKECONCH %d %s\n", conchFile->h,
+ rc==SQLITE_OK?"ok":"failed"));
+ return rc;
+ } while (1); /* in case we need to retry the :auto: lock file -
+ ** we should never get here except via the 'continue' call. */
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** If pFile holds a lock on a conch file, then release that lock.
+*/
+static int proxyReleaseConch(unixFile *pFile){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Subroutine return code */
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx; /* The locking context for the proxy lock */
+ unixFile *conchFile; /* Name of the conch file */
+
+ pCtx = (proxyLockingContext *)pFile->lockingContext;
+ conchFile = pCtx->conchFile;
+ OSTRACE(("RELEASECONCH %d for %s pid=%d\n", conchFile->h,
+ (pCtx->lockProxyPath ? pCtx->lockProxyPath : ":auto:"),
+ osGetpid(0)));
+ if( pCtx->conchHeld>0 ){
+ rc = conchFile->pMethod->xUnlock((sqlite3_file*)conchFile, NO_LOCK);
+ }
+ pCtx->conchHeld = 0;
+ OSTRACE(("RELEASECONCH %d %s\n", conchFile->h,
+ (rc==SQLITE_OK ? "ok" : "failed")));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Given the name of a database file, compute the name of its conch file.
+** Store the conch filename in memory obtained from sqlite3_malloc64().
+** Make *pConchPath point to the new name. Return SQLITE_OK on success
+** or SQLITE_NOMEM if unable to obtain memory.
+**
+** The caller is responsible for ensuring that the allocated memory
+** space is eventually freed.
+**
+** *pConchPath is set to NULL if a memory allocation error occurs.
+*/
+static int proxyCreateConchPathname(char *dbPath, char **pConchPath){
+ int i; /* Loop counter */
+ int len = (int)strlen(dbPath); /* Length of database filename - dbPath */
+ char *conchPath; /* buffer in which to construct conch name */
+
+ /* Allocate space for the conch filename and initialize the name to
+ ** the name of the original database file. */
+ *pConchPath = conchPath = (char *)sqlite3_malloc64(len + 8);
+ if( conchPath==0 ){
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ memcpy(conchPath, dbPath, len+1);
+
+ /* now insert a "." before the last / character */
+ for( i=(len-1); i>=0; i-- ){
+ if( conchPath[i]=='/' ){
+ i++;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ conchPath[i]='.';
+ while ( ilockingContext;
+ char *oldPath = pCtx->lockProxyPath;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ if( pFile->eFileLock!=NO_LOCK ){
+ return SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+
+ /* nothing to do if the path is NULL, :auto: or matches the existing path */
+ if( !path || path[0]=='\0' || !strcmp(path, ":auto:") ||
+ (oldPath && !strncmp(oldPath, path, MAXPATHLEN)) ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ unixFile *lockProxy = pCtx->lockProxy;
+ pCtx->lockProxy=NULL;
+ pCtx->conchHeld = 0;
+ if( lockProxy!=NULL ){
+ rc=lockProxy->pMethod->xClose((sqlite3_file *)lockProxy);
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+ sqlite3_free(lockProxy);
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(oldPath);
+ pCtx->lockProxyPath = sqlite3DbStrDup(0, path);
+ }
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** pFile is a file that has been opened by a prior xOpen call. dbPath
+** is a string buffer at least MAXPATHLEN+1 characters in size.
+**
+** This routine find the filename associated with pFile and writes it
+** int dbPath.
+*/
+static int proxyGetDbPathForUnixFile(unixFile *pFile, char *dbPath){
+#if defined(__APPLE__)
+ if( pFile->pMethod == &afpIoMethods ){
+ /* afp style keeps a reference to the db path in the filePath field
+ ** of the struct */
+ assert( (int)strlen((char*)pFile->lockingContext)<=MAXPATHLEN );
+ strlcpy(dbPath, ((afpLockingContext *)pFile->lockingContext)->dbPath,
+ MAXPATHLEN);
+ } else
+#endif
+ if( pFile->pMethod == &dotlockIoMethods ){
+ /* dot lock style uses the locking context to store the dot lock
+ ** file path */
+ int len = strlen((char *)pFile->lockingContext) - strlen(DOTLOCK_SUFFIX);
+ memcpy(dbPath, (char *)pFile->lockingContext, len + 1);
+ }else{
+ /* all other styles use the locking context to store the db file path */
+ assert( strlen((char*)pFile->lockingContext)<=MAXPATHLEN );
+ strlcpy(dbPath, (char *)pFile->lockingContext, MAXPATHLEN);
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Takes an already filled in unix file and alters it so all file locking
+** will be performed on the local proxy lock file. The following fields
+** are preserved in the locking context so that they can be restored and
+** the unix structure properly cleaned up at close time:
+** ->lockingContext
+** ->pMethod
+*/
+static int proxyTransformUnixFile(unixFile *pFile, const char *path) {
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx;
+ char dbPath[MAXPATHLEN+1]; /* Name of the database file */
+ char *lockPath=NULL;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ if( pFile->eFileLock!=NO_LOCK ){
+ return SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+ proxyGetDbPathForUnixFile(pFile, dbPath);
+ if( !path || path[0]=='\0' || !strcmp(path, ":auto:") ){
+ lockPath=NULL;
+ }else{
+ lockPath=(char *)path;
+ }
+
+ OSTRACE(("TRANSPROXY %d for %s pid=%d\n", pFile->h,
+ (lockPath ? lockPath : ":auto:"), osGetpid(0)));
+
+ pCtx = sqlite3_malloc64( sizeof(*pCtx) );
+ if( pCtx==0 ){
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ memset(pCtx, 0, sizeof(*pCtx));
+
+ rc = proxyCreateConchPathname(dbPath, &pCtx->conchFilePath);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ rc = proxyCreateUnixFile(pCtx->conchFilePath, &pCtx->conchFile, 0);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_CANTOPEN && ((pFile->openFlags&O_RDWR) == 0) ){
+ /* if (a) the open flags are not O_RDWR, (b) the conch isn't there, and
+ ** (c) the file system is read-only, then enable no-locking access.
+ ** Ugh, since O_RDONLY==0x0000 we test for !O_RDWR since unixOpen asserts
+ ** that openFlags will have only one of O_RDONLY or O_RDWR.
+ */
+ struct statfs fsInfo;
+ struct stat conchInfo;
+ int goLockless = 0;
+
+ if( osStat(pCtx->conchFilePath, &conchInfo) == -1 ) {
+ int err = errno;
+ if( (err==ENOENT) && (statfs(dbPath, &fsInfo) != -1) ){
+ goLockless = (fsInfo.f_flags&MNT_RDONLY) == MNT_RDONLY;
+ }
+ }
+ if( goLockless ){
+ pCtx->conchHeld = -1; /* read only FS/ lockless */
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && lockPath ){
+ pCtx->lockProxyPath = sqlite3DbStrDup(0, lockPath);
+ }
+
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pCtx->dbPath = sqlite3DbStrDup(0, dbPath);
+ if( pCtx->dbPath==NULL ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ /* all memory is allocated, proxys are created and assigned,
+ ** switch the locking context and pMethod then return.
+ */
+ pCtx->oldLockingContext = pFile->lockingContext;
+ pFile->lockingContext = pCtx;
+ pCtx->pOldMethod = pFile->pMethod;
+ pFile->pMethod = &proxyIoMethods;
+ }else{
+ if( pCtx->conchFile ){
+ pCtx->conchFile->pMethod->xClose((sqlite3_file *)pCtx->conchFile);
+ sqlite3_free(pCtx->conchFile);
+ }
+ sqlite3DbFree(0, pCtx->lockProxyPath);
+ sqlite3_free(pCtx->conchFilePath);
+ sqlite3_free(pCtx);
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("TRANSPROXY %d %s\n", pFile->h,
+ (rc==SQLITE_OK ? "ok" : "failed")));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** This routine handles sqlite3_file_control() calls that are specific
+** to proxy locking.
+*/
+static int proxyFileControl(sqlite3_file *id, int op, void *pArg){
+ switch( op ){
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_GET_LOCKPROXYFILE: {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ if( pFile->pMethod == &proxyIoMethods ){
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx = (proxyLockingContext*)pFile->lockingContext;
+ proxyTakeConch(pFile);
+ if( pCtx->lockProxyPath ){
+ *(const char **)pArg = pCtx->lockProxyPath;
+ }else{
+ *(const char **)pArg = ":auto: (not held)";
+ }
+ } else {
+ *(const char **)pArg = NULL;
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_SET_LOCKPROXYFILE: {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ int isProxyStyle = (pFile->pMethod == &proxyIoMethods);
+ if( pArg==NULL || (const char *)pArg==0 ){
+ if( isProxyStyle ){
+ /* turn off proxy locking - not supported. If support is added for
+ ** switching proxy locking mode off then it will need to fail if
+ ** the journal mode is WAL mode.
+ */
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR /*SQLITE_PROTOCOL? SQLITE_MISUSE?*/;
+ }else{
+ /* turn off proxy locking - already off - NOOP */
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ }else{
+ const char *proxyPath = (const char *)pArg;
+ if( isProxyStyle ){
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx =
+ (proxyLockingContext*)pFile->lockingContext;
+ if( !strcmp(pArg, ":auto:")
+ || (pCtx->lockProxyPath &&
+ !strncmp(pCtx->lockProxyPath, proxyPath, MAXPATHLEN))
+ ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ rc = switchLockProxyPath(pFile, proxyPath);
+ }
+ }else{
+ /* turn on proxy file locking */
+ rc = proxyTransformUnixFile(pFile, proxyPath);
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+ }
+ default: {
+ assert( 0 ); /* The call assures that only valid opcodes are sent */
+ }
+ }
+ /*NOTREACHED*/ assert(0);
+ return SQLITE_ERROR;
+}
+
+/*
+** Within this division (the proxying locking implementation) the procedures
+** above this point are all utilities. The lock-related methods of the
+** proxy-locking sqlite3_io_method object follow.
+*/
+
+
+/*
+** This routine checks if there is a RESERVED lock held on the specified
+** file by this or any other process. If such a lock is held, set *pResOut
+** to a non-zero value otherwise *pResOut is set to zero. The return value
+** is set to SQLITE_OK unless an I/O error occurs during lock checking.
+*/
+static int proxyCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id, int *pResOut) {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ int rc = proxyTakeConch(pFile);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx = (proxyLockingContext *)pFile->lockingContext;
+ if( pCtx->conchHeld>0 ){
+ unixFile *proxy = pCtx->lockProxy;
+ return proxy->pMethod->xCheckReservedLock((sqlite3_file*)proxy, pResOut);
+ }else{ /* conchHeld < 0 is lockless */
+ pResOut=0;
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lock the file with the lock specified by parameter eFileLock - one
+** of the following:
+**
+** (1) SHARED_LOCK
+** (2) RESERVED_LOCK
+** (3) PENDING_LOCK
+** (4) EXCLUSIVE_LOCK
+**
+** Sometimes when requesting one lock state, additional lock states
+** are inserted in between. The locking might fail on one of the later
+** transitions leaving the lock state different from what it started but
+** still short of its goal. The following chart shows the allowed
+** transitions and the inserted intermediate states:
+**
+** UNLOCKED -> SHARED
+** SHARED -> RESERVED
+** SHARED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** RESERVED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** PENDING -> EXCLUSIVE
+**
+** This routine will only increase a lock. Use the sqlite3OsUnlock()
+** routine to lower a locking level.
+*/
+static int proxyLock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock) {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ int rc = proxyTakeConch(pFile);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx = (proxyLockingContext *)pFile->lockingContext;
+ if( pCtx->conchHeld>0 ){
+ unixFile *proxy = pCtx->lockProxy;
+ rc = proxy->pMethod->xLock((sqlite3_file*)proxy, eFileLock);
+ pFile->eFileLock = proxy->eFileLock;
+ }else{
+ /* conchHeld < 0 is lockless */
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Lower the locking level on file descriptor pFile to eFileLock. eFileLock
+** must be either NO_LOCK or SHARED_LOCK.
+**
+** If the locking level of the file descriptor is already at or below
+** the requested locking level, this routine is a no-op.
+*/
+static int proxyUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int eFileLock) {
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ int rc = proxyTakeConch(pFile);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx = (proxyLockingContext *)pFile->lockingContext;
+ if( pCtx->conchHeld>0 ){
+ unixFile *proxy = pCtx->lockProxy;
+ rc = proxy->pMethod->xUnlock((sqlite3_file*)proxy, eFileLock);
+ pFile->eFileLock = proxy->eFileLock;
+ }else{
+ /* conchHeld < 0 is lockless */
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Close a file that uses proxy locks.
+*/
+static int proxyClose(sqlite3_file *id) {
+ if( ALWAYS(id) ){
+ unixFile *pFile = (unixFile*)id;
+ proxyLockingContext *pCtx = (proxyLockingContext *)pFile->lockingContext;
+ unixFile *lockProxy = pCtx->lockProxy;
+ unixFile *conchFile = pCtx->conchFile;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ if( lockProxy ){
+ rc = lockProxy->pMethod->xUnlock((sqlite3_file*)lockProxy, NO_LOCK);
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+ rc = lockProxy->pMethod->xClose((sqlite3_file*)lockProxy);
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+ sqlite3_free(lockProxy);
+ pCtx->lockProxy = 0;
+ }
+ if( conchFile ){
+ if( pCtx->conchHeld ){
+ rc = proxyReleaseConch(pFile);
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+ }
+ rc = conchFile->pMethod->xClose((sqlite3_file*)conchFile);
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+ sqlite3_free(conchFile);
+ }
+ sqlite3DbFree(0, pCtx->lockProxyPath);
+ sqlite3_free(pCtx->conchFilePath);
+ sqlite3DbFree(0, pCtx->dbPath);
+ /* restore the original locking context and pMethod then close it */
+ pFile->lockingContext = pCtx->oldLockingContext;
+ pFile->pMethod = pCtx->pOldMethod;
+ sqlite3_free(pCtx);
+ return pFile->pMethod->xClose(id);
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+
+
+#endif /* defined(__APPLE__) && SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE */
+/*
+** The proxy locking style is intended for use with AFP filesystems.
+** And since AFP is only supported on MacOSX, the proxy locking is also
+** restricted to MacOSX.
+**
+**
+******************* End of the proxy lock implementation **********************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/*
+** Initialize the operating system interface.
+**
+** This routine registers all VFS implementations for unix-like operating
+** systems. This routine, and the sqlite3_os_end() routine that follows,
+** should be the only routines in this file that are visible from other
+** files.
+**
+** This routine is called once during SQLite initialization and by a
+** single thread. The memory allocation and mutex subsystems have not
+** necessarily been initialized when this routine is called, and so they
+** should not be used.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_os_init(void){
+ /*
+ ** The following macro defines an initializer for an sqlite3_vfs object.
+ ** The name of the VFS is NAME. The pAppData is a pointer to a pointer
+ ** to the "finder" function. (pAppData is a pointer to a pointer because
+ ** silly C90 rules prohibit a void* from being cast to a function pointer
+ ** and so we have to go through the intermediate pointer to avoid problems
+ ** when compiling with -pedantic-errors on GCC.)
+ **
+ ** The FINDER parameter to this macro is the name of the pointer to the
+ ** finder-function. The finder-function returns a pointer to the
+ ** sqlite_io_methods object that implements the desired locking
+ ** behaviors. See the division above that contains the IOMETHODS
+ ** macro for addition information on finder-functions.
+ **
+ ** Most finders simply return a pointer to a fixed sqlite3_io_methods
+ ** object. But the "autolockIoFinder" available on MacOSX does a little
+ ** more than that; it looks at the filesystem type that hosts the
+ ** database file and tries to choose an locking method appropriate for
+ ** that filesystem time.
+ */
+ #define UNIXVFS(VFSNAME, FINDER) { \
+ 3, /* iVersion */ \
+ sizeof(unixFile), /* szOsFile */ \
+ MAX_PATHNAME, /* mxPathname */ \
+ 0, /* pNext */ \
+ VFSNAME, /* zName */ \
+ (void*)&FINDER, /* pAppData */ \
+ unixOpen, /* xOpen */ \
+ unixDelete, /* xDelete */ \
+ unixAccess, /* xAccess */ \
+ unixFullPathname, /* xFullPathname */ \
+ unixDlOpen, /* xDlOpen */ \
+ unixDlError, /* xDlError */ \
+ unixDlSym, /* xDlSym */ \
+ unixDlClose, /* xDlClose */ \
+ unixRandomness, /* xRandomness */ \
+ unixSleep, /* xSleep */ \
+ unixCurrentTime, /* xCurrentTime */ \
+ unixGetLastError, /* xGetLastError */ \
+ unixCurrentTimeInt64, /* xCurrentTimeInt64 */ \
+ unixSetSystemCall, /* xSetSystemCall */ \
+ unixGetSystemCall, /* xGetSystemCall */ \
+ unixNextSystemCall, /* xNextSystemCall */ \
+ }
+
+ /*
+ ** All default VFSes for unix are contained in the following array.
+ **
+ ** Note that the sqlite3_vfs.pNext field of the VFS object is modified
+ ** by the SQLite core when the VFS is registered. So the following
+ ** array cannot be const.
+ */
+ static sqlite3_vfs aVfs[] = {
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE && defined(__APPLE__)
+ UNIXVFS("unix", autolockIoFinder ),
+#elif OS_VXWORKS
+ UNIXVFS("unix", vxworksIoFinder ),
+#else
+ UNIXVFS("unix", posixIoFinder ),
+#endif
+ UNIXVFS("unix-none", nolockIoFinder ),
+ UNIXVFS("unix-dotfile", dotlockIoFinder ),
+ UNIXVFS("unix-excl", posixIoFinder ),
+#if OS_VXWORKS
+ UNIXVFS("unix-namedsem", semIoFinder ),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE || OS_VXWORKS
+ UNIXVFS("unix-posix", posixIoFinder ),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE
+ UNIXVFS("unix-flock", flockIoFinder ),
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_ENABLE_LOCKING_STYLE && defined(__APPLE__)
+ UNIXVFS("unix-afp", afpIoFinder ),
+ UNIXVFS("unix-nfs", nfsIoFinder ),
+ UNIXVFS("unix-proxy", proxyIoFinder ),
+#endif
+ };
+ unsigned int i; /* Loop counter */
+
+ /* Double-check that the aSyscall[] array has been constructed
+ ** correctly. See ticket [bb3a86e890c8e96ab] */
+ assert( ArraySize(aSyscall)==29 );
+
+ /* Register all VFSes defined in the aVfs[] array */
+ for(i=0; i<(sizeof(aVfs)/sizeof(sqlite3_vfs)); i++){
+ sqlite3_vfs_register(&aVfs[i], i==0);
+ }
+ unixBigLock = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS1);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Shutdown the operating system interface.
+**
+** Some operating systems might need to do some cleanup in this routine,
+** to release dynamically allocated objects. But not on unix.
+** This routine is a no-op for unix.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_os_end(void){
+ unixBigLock = 0;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_OS_UNIX */
+
+/************** End of os_unix.c *********************************************/
+/************** Begin file os_win.c ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2004 May 22
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains code that is specific to Windows.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+#if SQLITE_OS_WIN /* This file is used for Windows only */
+
+/*
+** Include code that is common to all os_*.c files
+*/
+/************** Include os_common.h in the middle of os_win.c ****************/
+/************** Begin file os_common.h ***************************************/
+/*
+** 2004 May 22
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains macros and a little bit of code that is common to
+** all of the platform-specific files (os_*.c) and is #included into those
+** files.
+**
+** This file should be #included by the os_*.c files only. It is not a
+** general purpose header file.
+*/
+#ifndef _OS_COMMON_H_
+#define _OS_COMMON_H_
+
+/*
+** At least two bugs have slipped in because we changed the MEMORY_DEBUG
+** macro to SQLITE_DEBUG and some older makefiles have not yet made the
+** switch. The following code should catch this problem at compile-time.
+*/
+#ifdef MEMORY_DEBUG
+# error "The MEMORY_DEBUG macro is obsolete. Use SQLITE_DEBUG instead."
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Macros for performance tracing. Normally turned off. Only works
+** on i486 hardware.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_PERFORMANCE_TRACE
+
+/*
+** hwtime.h contains inline assembler code for implementing
+** high-performance timing routines.
+*/
+/************** Include hwtime.h in the middle of os_common.h ****************/
+/************** Begin file hwtime.h ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 May 27
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file contains inline asm code for retrieving "high-performance"
+** counters for x86 and x86_64 class CPUs.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_HWTIME_H
+#define SQLITE_HWTIME_H
+
+/*
+** The following routine only works on pentium-class (or newer) processors.
+** It uses the RDTSC opcode to read the cycle count value out of the
+** processor and returns that value. This can be used for high-res
+** profiling.
+*/
+#if !defined(__STRICT_ANSI__) && \
+ (defined(__GNUC__) || defined(_MSC_VER)) && \
+ (defined(i386) || defined(__i386__) || defined(_M_IX86))
+
+ #if defined(__GNUC__)
+
+ __inline__ sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ unsigned int lo, hi;
+ __asm__ __volatile__ ("rdtsc" : "=a" (lo), "=d" (hi));
+ return (sqlite_uint64)hi << 32 | lo;
+ }
+
+ #elif defined(_MSC_VER)
+
+ __declspec(naked) __inline sqlite_uint64 __cdecl sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ __asm {
+ rdtsc
+ ret ; return value at EDX:EAX
+ }
+ }
+
+ #endif
+
+#elif !defined(__STRICT_ANSI__) && (defined(__GNUC__) && defined(__x86_64__))
+
+ __inline__ sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ unsigned long val;
+ __asm__ __volatile__ ("rdtsc" : "=A" (val));
+ return val;
+ }
+
+#elif !defined(__STRICT_ANSI__) && (defined(__GNUC__) && defined(__ppc__))
+
+ __inline__ sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){
+ unsigned long long retval;
+ unsigned long junk;
+ __asm__ __volatile__ ("\n\
+ 1: mftbu %1\n\
+ mftb %L0\n\
+ mftbu %0\n\
+ cmpw %0,%1\n\
+ bne 1b"
+ : "=r" (retval), "=r" (junk));
+ return retval;
+ }
+
+#else
+
+ /*
+ ** asm() is needed for hardware timing support. Without asm(),
+ ** disable the sqlite3Hwtime() routine.
+ **
+ ** sqlite3Hwtime() is only used for some obscure debugging
+ ** and analysis configurations, not in any deliverable, so this
+ ** should not be a great loss.
+ */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite_uint64 sqlite3Hwtime(void){ return ((sqlite_uint64)0); }
+
+#endif
+
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_HWTIME_H) */
+
+/************** End of hwtime.h **********************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in os_common.h ******************/
+
+static sqlite_uint64 g_start;
+static sqlite_uint64 g_elapsed;
+#define TIMER_START g_start=sqlite3Hwtime()
+#define TIMER_END g_elapsed=sqlite3Hwtime()-g_start
+#define TIMER_ELAPSED g_elapsed
+#else
+#define TIMER_START
+#define TIMER_END
+#define TIMER_ELAPSED ((sqlite_uint64)0)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** If we compile with the SQLITE_TEST macro set, then the following block
+** of code will give us the ability to simulate a disk I/O error. This
+** is used for testing the I/O recovery logic.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_hit;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_hardhit;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_pending;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_persist;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_benign;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_diskfull_pending;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_diskfull;
+#define SimulateIOErrorBenign(X) sqlite3_io_error_benign=(X)
+#define SimulateIOError(CODE) \
+ if( (sqlite3_io_error_persist && sqlite3_io_error_hit) \
+ || sqlite3_io_error_pending-- == 1 ) \
+ { local_ioerr(); CODE; }
+static void local_ioerr(){
+ IOTRACE(("IOERR\n"));
+ sqlite3_io_error_hit++;
+ if( !sqlite3_io_error_benign ) sqlite3_io_error_hardhit++;
+}
+#define SimulateDiskfullError(CODE) \
+ if( sqlite3_diskfull_pending ){ \
+ if( sqlite3_diskfull_pending == 1 ){ \
+ local_ioerr(); \
+ sqlite3_diskfull = 1; \
+ sqlite3_io_error_hit = 1; \
+ CODE; \
+ }else{ \
+ sqlite3_diskfull_pending--; \
+ } \
+ }
+#else
+#define SimulateIOErrorBenign(X)
+#define SimulateIOError(A)
+#define SimulateDiskfullError(A)
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_TEST) */
+
+/*
+** When testing, keep a count of the number of open files.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_open_file_count;
+#define OpenCounter(X) sqlite3_open_file_count+=(X)
+#else
+#define OpenCounter(X)
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_TEST) */
+
+#endif /* !defined(_OS_COMMON_H_) */
+
+/************** End of os_common.h *******************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in os_win.c *********************/
+
+/*
+** Include the header file for the Windows VFS.
+*/
+/* #include "os_win.h" */
+
+/*
+** Compiling and using WAL mode requires several APIs that are only
+** available in Windows platforms based on the NT kernel.
+*/
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINNT && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL)
+# error "WAL mode requires support from the Windows NT kernel, compile\
+ with SQLITE_OMIT_WAL."
+#endif
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINNT && SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+# error "Memory mapped files require support from the Windows NT kernel,\
+ compile with SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE=0."
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Are most of the Win32 ANSI APIs available (i.e. with certain exceptions
+** based on the sub-platform)?
+*/
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && !defined(SQLITE_WIN32_NO_ANSI)
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Are most of the Win32 Unicode APIs available (i.e. with certain exceptions
+** based on the sub-platform)?
+*/
+#if (SQLITE_OS_WINCE || SQLITE_OS_WINNT || SQLITE_OS_WINRT) && \
+ !defined(SQLITE_WIN32_NO_WIDE)
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Make sure at least one set of Win32 APIs is available.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI) && !defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+# error "At least one of SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI and SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE\
+ must be defined."
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Define the required Windows SDK version constants if they are not
+** already available.
+*/
+#ifndef NTDDI_WIN8
+# define NTDDI_WIN8 0x06020000
+#endif
+
+#ifndef NTDDI_WINBLUE
+# define NTDDI_WINBLUE 0x06030000
+#endif
+
+#ifndef NTDDI_WINTHRESHOLD
+# define NTDDI_WINTHRESHOLD 0x06040000
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Check to see if the GetVersionEx[AW] functions are deprecated on the
+** target system. GetVersionEx was first deprecated in Win8.1.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_GETVERSIONEX
+# if defined(NTDDI_VERSION) && NTDDI_VERSION >= NTDDI_WINBLUE
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_GETVERSIONEX 0 /* GetVersionEx() is deprecated */
+# else
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_GETVERSIONEX 1 /* GetVersionEx() is current */
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Check to see if the CreateFileMappingA function is supported on the
+** target system. It is unavailable when using "mincore.lib" on Win10.
+** When compiling for Windows 10, always assume "mincore.lib" is in use.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_CREATEFILEMAPPINGA
+# if defined(NTDDI_VERSION) && NTDDI_VERSION >= NTDDI_WINTHRESHOLD
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_CREATEFILEMAPPINGA 0
+# else
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_CREATEFILEMAPPINGA 1
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This constant should already be defined (in the "WinDef.h" SDK file).
+*/
+#ifndef MAX_PATH
+# define MAX_PATH (260)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Maximum pathname length (in chars) for Win32. This should normally be
+** MAX_PATH.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_PATH_CHARS
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_PATH_CHARS (MAX_PATH)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This constant should already be defined (in the "WinNT.h" SDK file).
+*/
+#ifndef UNICODE_STRING_MAX_CHARS
+# define UNICODE_STRING_MAX_CHARS (32767)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Maximum pathname length (in chars) for WinNT. This should normally be
+** UNICODE_STRING_MAX_CHARS.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_WINNT_MAX_PATH_CHARS
+# define SQLITE_WINNT_MAX_PATH_CHARS (UNICODE_STRING_MAX_CHARS)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Maximum pathname length (in bytes) for Win32. The MAX_PATH macro is in
+** characters, so we allocate 4 bytes per character assuming worst-case of
+** 4-bytes-per-character for UTF8.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_PATH_BYTES
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_PATH_BYTES (SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_PATH_CHARS*4)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Maximum pathname length (in bytes) for WinNT. This should normally be
+** UNICODE_STRING_MAX_CHARS * sizeof(WCHAR).
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_WINNT_MAX_PATH_BYTES
+# define SQLITE_WINNT_MAX_PATH_BYTES \
+ (sizeof(WCHAR) * SQLITE_WINNT_MAX_PATH_CHARS)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Maximum error message length (in chars) for WinRT.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_ERRMSG_CHARS
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_ERRMSG_CHARS (1024)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Returns non-zero if the character should be treated as a directory
+** separator.
+*/
+#ifndef winIsDirSep
+# define winIsDirSep(a) (((a) == '/') || ((a) == '\\'))
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This macro is used when a local variable is set to a value that is
+** [sometimes] not used by the code (e.g. via conditional compilation).
+*/
+#ifndef UNUSED_VARIABLE_VALUE
+# define UNUSED_VARIABLE_VALUE(x) (void)(x)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Returns the character that should be used as the directory separator.
+*/
+#ifndef winGetDirSep
+# define winGetDirSep() '\\'
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Do we need to manually define the Win32 file mapping APIs for use with WAL
+** mode or memory mapped files (e.g. these APIs are available in the Windows
+** CE SDK; however, they are not present in the header file)?
+*/
+#if SQLITE_WIN32_FILEMAPPING_API && \
+ (!defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0)
+/*
+** Two of the file mapping APIs are different under WinRT. Figure out which
+** set we need.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+WINBASEAPI HANDLE WINAPI CreateFileMappingFromApp(HANDLE, \
+ LPSECURITY_ATTRIBUTES, ULONG, ULONG64, LPCWSTR);
+
+WINBASEAPI LPVOID WINAPI MapViewOfFileFromApp(HANDLE, ULONG, ULONG64, SIZE_T);
+#else
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+WINBASEAPI HANDLE WINAPI CreateFileMappingA(HANDLE, LPSECURITY_ATTRIBUTES, \
+ DWORD, DWORD, DWORD, LPCSTR);
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI) */
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+WINBASEAPI HANDLE WINAPI CreateFileMappingW(HANDLE, LPSECURITY_ATTRIBUTES, \
+ DWORD, DWORD, DWORD, LPCWSTR);
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE) */
+
+WINBASEAPI LPVOID WINAPI MapViewOfFile(HANDLE, DWORD, DWORD, DWORD, SIZE_T);
+#endif /* SQLITE_OS_WINRT */
+
+/*
+** These file mapping APIs are common to both Win32 and WinRT.
+*/
+
+WINBASEAPI BOOL WINAPI FlushViewOfFile(LPCVOID, SIZE_T);
+WINBASEAPI BOOL WINAPI UnmapViewOfFile(LPCVOID);
+#endif /* SQLITE_WIN32_FILEMAPPING_API */
+
+/*
+** Some Microsoft compilers lack this definition.
+*/
+#ifndef INVALID_FILE_ATTRIBUTES
+# define INVALID_FILE_ATTRIBUTES ((DWORD)-1)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef FILE_FLAG_MASK
+# define FILE_FLAG_MASK (0xFF3C0000)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef FILE_ATTRIBUTE_MASK
+# define FILE_ATTRIBUTE_MASK (0x0003FFF7)
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+/* Forward references to structures used for WAL */
+typedef struct winShm winShm; /* A connection to shared-memory */
+typedef struct winShmNode winShmNode; /* A region of shared-memory */
+#endif
+
+/*
+** WinCE lacks native support for file locking so we have to fake it
+** with some code of our own.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+typedef struct winceLock {
+ int nReaders; /* Number of reader locks obtained */
+ BOOL bPending; /* Indicates a pending lock has been obtained */
+ BOOL bReserved; /* Indicates a reserved lock has been obtained */
+ BOOL bExclusive; /* Indicates an exclusive lock has been obtained */
+} winceLock;
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The winFile structure is a subclass of sqlite3_file* specific to the win32
+** portability layer.
+*/
+typedef struct winFile winFile;
+struct winFile {
+ const sqlite3_io_methods *pMethod; /*** Must be first ***/
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs; /* The VFS used to open this file */
+ HANDLE h; /* Handle for accessing the file */
+ u8 locktype; /* Type of lock currently held on this file */
+ short sharedLockByte; /* Randomly chosen byte used as a shared lock */
+ u8 ctrlFlags; /* Flags. See WINFILE_* below */
+ DWORD lastErrno; /* The Windows errno from the last I/O error */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ winShm *pShm; /* Instance of shared memory on this file */
+#endif
+ const char *zPath; /* Full pathname of this file */
+ int szChunk; /* Chunk size configured by FCNTL_CHUNK_SIZE */
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ LPWSTR zDeleteOnClose; /* Name of file to delete when closing */
+ HANDLE hMutex; /* Mutex used to control access to shared lock */
+ HANDLE hShared; /* Shared memory segment used for locking */
+ winceLock local; /* Locks obtained by this instance of winFile */
+ winceLock *shared; /* Global shared lock memory for the file */
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ int nFetchOut; /* Number of outstanding xFetch references */
+ HANDLE hMap; /* Handle for accessing memory mapping */
+ void *pMapRegion; /* Area memory mapped */
+ sqlite3_int64 mmapSize; /* Size of mapped region */
+ sqlite3_int64 mmapSizeMax; /* Configured FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE value */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** The winVfsAppData structure is used for the pAppData member for all of the
+** Win32 VFS variants.
+*/
+typedef struct winVfsAppData winVfsAppData;
+struct winVfsAppData {
+ const sqlite3_io_methods *pMethod; /* The file I/O methods to use. */
+ void *pAppData; /* The extra pAppData, if any. */
+ BOOL bNoLock; /* Non-zero if locking is disabled. */
+};
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for winFile.ctrlFlags
+*/
+#define WINFILE_RDONLY 0x02 /* Connection is read only */
+#define WINFILE_PERSIST_WAL 0x04 /* Persistent WAL mode */
+#define WINFILE_PSOW 0x10 /* SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE */
+
+/*
+ * The size of the buffer used by sqlite3_win32_write_debug().
+ */
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_DBG_BUF_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_DBG_BUF_SIZE ((int)(4096-sizeof(DWORD)))
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * If compiled with SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC on Windows, we will use the
+ * various Win32 API heap functions instead of our own.
+ */
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC
+
+/*
+ * If this is non-zero, an isolated heap will be created by the native Win32
+ * allocator subsystem; otherwise, the default process heap will be used. This
+ * setting has no effect when compiling for WinRT. By default, this is enabled
+ * and an isolated heap will be created to store all allocated data.
+ *
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * WARNING: It is important to note that when this setting is non-zero and the
+ * winMemShutdown function is called (e.g. by the sqlite3_shutdown
+ * function), all data that was allocated using the isolated heap will
+ * be freed immediately and any attempt to access any of that freed
+ * data will almost certainly result in an immediate access violation.
+ ******************************************************************************
+ */
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_CREATE
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_CREATE (TRUE)
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * This is the maximum possible initial size of the Win32-specific heap, in
+ * bytes.
+ */
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_MAX_INIT_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_MAX_INIT_SIZE (4294967295U)
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * This is the extra space for the initial size of the Win32-specific heap,
+ * in bytes. This value may be zero.
+ */
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_INIT_EXTRA
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_INIT_EXTRA (4194304)
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Calculate the maximum legal cache size, in pages, based on the maximum
+ * possible initial heap size and the default page size, setting aside the
+ * needed extra space.
+ */
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_CACHE_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_CACHE_SIZE (((SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_MAX_INIT_SIZE) - \
+ (SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_INIT_EXTRA)) / \
+ (SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE))
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * This is cache size used in the calculation of the initial size of the
+ * Win32-specific heap. It cannot be negative.
+ */
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_CACHE_SIZE
+# if SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE>=0
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_CACHE_SIZE (SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE)
+# else
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_CACHE_SIZE (-(SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE))
+# endif
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Make sure that the calculated cache size, in pages, cannot cause the
+ * initial size of the Win32-specific heap to exceed the maximum amount
+ * of memory that can be specified in the call to HeapCreate.
+ */
+#if SQLITE_WIN32_CACHE_SIZE>SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_CACHE_SIZE
+# undef SQLITE_WIN32_CACHE_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_CACHE_SIZE (2000)
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * The initial size of the Win32-specific heap. This value may be zero.
+ */
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_INIT_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_INIT_SIZE ((SQLITE_WIN32_CACHE_SIZE) * \
+ (SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE) + \
+ (SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_INIT_EXTRA))
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * The maximum size of the Win32-specific heap. This value may be zero.
+ */
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_MAX_SIZE
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_MAX_SIZE (0)
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * The extra flags to use in calls to the Win32 heap APIs. This value may be
+ * zero for the default behavior.
+ */
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS (0)
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+** The winMemData structure stores information required by the Win32-specific
+** sqlite3_mem_methods implementation.
+*/
+typedef struct winMemData winMemData;
+struct winMemData {
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+ u32 magic1; /* Magic number to detect structure corruption. */
+#endif
+ HANDLE hHeap; /* The handle to our heap. */
+ BOOL bOwned; /* Do we own the heap (i.e. destroy it on shutdown)? */
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+ u32 magic2; /* Magic number to detect structure corruption. */
+#endif
+};
+
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+#define WINMEM_MAGIC1 0x42b2830b
+#define WINMEM_MAGIC2 0xbd4d7cf4
+#endif
+
+static struct winMemData win_mem_data = {
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+ WINMEM_MAGIC1,
+#endif
+ NULL, FALSE
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+ ,WINMEM_MAGIC2
+#endif
+};
+
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+#define winMemAssertMagic1() assert( win_mem_data.magic1==WINMEM_MAGIC1 )
+#define winMemAssertMagic2() assert( win_mem_data.magic2==WINMEM_MAGIC2 )
+#define winMemAssertMagic() winMemAssertMagic1(); winMemAssertMagic2();
+#else
+#define winMemAssertMagic()
+#endif
+
+#define winMemGetDataPtr() &win_mem_data
+#define winMemGetHeap() win_mem_data.hHeap
+#define winMemGetOwned() win_mem_data.bOwned
+
+static void *winMemMalloc(int nBytes);
+static void winMemFree(void *pPrior);
+static void *winMemRealloc(void *pPrior, int nBytes);
+static int winMemSize(void *p);
+static int winMemRoundup(int n);
+static int winMemInit(void *pAppData);
+static void winMemShutdown(void *pAppData);
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const sqlite3_mem_methods *sqlite3MemGetWin32(void);
+#endif /* SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC */
+
+/*
+** The following variable is (normally) set once and never changes
+** thereafter. It records whether the operating system is Win9x
+** or WinNT.
+**
+** 0: Operating system unknown.
+** 1: Operating system is Win9x.
+** 2: Operating system is WinNT.
+**
+** In order to facilitate testing on a WinNT system, the test fixture
+** can manually set this value to 1 to emulate Win98 behavior.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_API LONG SQLITE_WIN32_VOLATILE sqlite3_os_type = 0;
+#else
+static LONG SQLITE_WIN32_VOLATILE sqlite3_os_type = 0;
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SYSCALL
+# define SYSCALL sqlite3_syscall_ptr
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This function is not available on Windows CE or WinRT.
+ */
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE || SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+# define osAreFileApisANSI() 1
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Many system calls are accessed through pointer-to-functions so that
+** they may be overridden at runtime to facilitate fault injection during
+** testing and sandboxing. The following array holds the names and pointers
+** to all overrideable system calls.
+*/
+static struct win_syscall {
+ const char *zName; /* Name of the system call */
+ sqlite3_syscall_ptr pCurrent; /* Current value of the system call */
+ sqlite3_syscall_ptr pDefault; /* Default value */
+} aSyscall[] = {
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "AreFileApisANSI", (SYSCALL)AreFileApisANSI, 0 },
+#else
+ { "AreFileApisANSI", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#ifndef osAreFileApisANSI
+#define osAreFileApisANSI ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(VOID))aSyscall[0].pCurrent)
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "CharLowerW", (SYSCALL)CharLowerW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "CharLowerW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osCharLowerW ((LPWSTR(WINAPI*)(LPWSTR))aSyscall[1].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "CharUpperW", (SYSCALL)CharUpperW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "CharUpperW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osCharUpperW ((LPWSTR(WINAPI*)(LPWSTR))aSyscall[2].pCurrent)
+
+ { "CloseHandle", (SYSCALL)CloseHandle, 0 },
+
+#define osCloseHandle ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE))aSyscall[3].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+ { "CreateFileA", (SYSCALL)CreateFileA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "CreateFileA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osCreateFileA ((HANDLE(WINAPI*)(LPCSTR,DWORD,DWORD, \
+ LPSECURITY_ATTRIBUTES,DWORD,DWORD,HANDLE))aSyscall[4].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "CreateFileW", (SYSCALL)CreateFileW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "CreateFileW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osCreateFileW ((HANDLE(WINAPI*)(LPCWSTR,DWORD,DWORD, \
+ LPSECURITY_ATTRIBUTES,DWORD,DWORD,HANDLE))aSyscall[5].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI) && \
+ (!defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0) && \
+ SQLITE_WIN32_CREATEFILEMAPPINGA
+ { "CreateFileMappingA", (SYSCALL)CreateFileMappingA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "CreateFileMappingA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osCreateFileMappingA ((HANDLE(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,LPSECURITY_ATTRIBUTES, \
+ DWORD,DWORD,DWORD,LPCSTR))aSyscall[6].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE || (!SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE) && \
+ (!defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0))
+ { "CreateFileMappingW", (SYSCALL)CreateFileMappingW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "CreateFileMappingW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osCreateFileMappingW ((HANDLE(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,LPSECURITY_ATTRIBUTES, \
+ DWORD,DWORD,DWORD,LPCWSTR))aSyscall[7].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "CreateMutexW", (SYSCALL)CreateMutexW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "CreateMutexW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osCreateMutexW ((HANDLE(WINAPI*)(LPSECURITY_ATTRIBUTES,BOOL, \
+ LPCWSTR))aSyscall[8].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+ { "DeleteFileA", (SYSCALL)DeleteFileA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "DeleteFileA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osDeleteFileA ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(LPCSTR))aSyscall[9].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "DeleteFileW", (SYSCALL)DeleteFileW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "DeleteFileW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osDeleteFileW ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(LPCWSTR))aSyscall[10].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ { "FileTimeToLocalFileTime", (SYSCALL)FileTimeToLocalFileTime, 0 },
+#else
+ { "FileTimeToLocalFileTime", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osFileTimeToLocalFileTime ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(CONST FILETIME*, \
+ LPFILETIME))aSyscall[11].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ { "FileTimeToSystemTime", (SYSCALL)FileTimeToSystemTime, 0 },
+#else
+ { "FileTimeToSystemTime", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osFileTimeToSystemTime ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(CONST FILETIME*, \
+ LPSYSTEMTIME))aSyscall[12].pCurrent)
+
+ { "FlushFileBuffers", (SYSCALL)FlushFileBuffers, 0 },
+
+#define osFlushFileBuffers ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE))aSyscall[13].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+ { "FormatMessageA", (SYSCALL)FormatMessageA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "FormatMessageA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osFormatMessageA ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(DWORD,LPCVOID,DWORD,DWORD,LPSTR, \
+ DWORD,va_list*))aSyscall[14].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "FormatMessageW", (SYSCALL)FormatMessageW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "FormatMessageW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osFormatMessageW ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(DWORD,LPCVOID,DWORD,DWORD,LPWSTR, \
+ DWORD,va_list*))aSyscall[15].pCurrent)
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION)
+ { "FreeLibrary", (SYSCALL)FreeLibrary, 0 },
+#else
+ { "FreeLibrary", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osFreeLibrary ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HMODULE))aSyscall[16].pCurrent)
+
+ { "GetCurrentProcessId", (SYSCALL)GetCurrentProcessId, 0 },
+
+#define osGetCurrentProcessId ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(VOID))aSyscall[17].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+ { "GetDiskFreeSpaceA", (SYSCALL)GetDiskFreeSpaceA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetDiskFreeSpaceA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetDiskFreeSpaceA ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(LPCSTR,LPDWORD,LPDWORD,LPDWORD, \
+ LPDWORD))aSyscall[18].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "GetDiskFreeSpaceW", (SYSCALL)GetDiskFreeSpaceW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetDiskFreeSpaceW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetDiskFreeSpaceW ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(LPCWSTR,LPDWORD,LPDWORD,LPDWORD, \
+ LPDWORD))aSyscall[19].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+ { "GetFileAttributesA", (SYSCALL)GetFileAttributesA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetFileAttributesA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetFileAttributesA ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(LPCSTR))aSyscall[20].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "GetFileAttributesW", (SYSCALL)GetFileAttributesW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetFileAttributesW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetFileAttributesW ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(LPCWSTR))aSyscall[21].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "GetFileAttributesExW", (SYSCALL)GetFileAttributesExW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetFileAttributesExW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetFileAttributesExW ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(LPCWSTR,GET_FILEEX_INFO_LEVELS, \
+ LPVOID))aSyscall[22].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "GetFileSize", (SYSCALL)GetFileSize, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetFileSize", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetFileSize ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,LPDWORD))aSyscall[23].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+ { "GetFullPathNameA", (SYSCALL)GetFullPathNameA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetFullPathNameA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetFullPathNameA ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(LPCSTR,DWORD,LPSTR, \
+ LPSTR*))aSyscall[24].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "GetFullPathNameW", (SYSCALL)GetFullPathNameW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetFullPathNameW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetFullPathNameW ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(LPCWSTR,DWORD,LPWSTR, \
+ LPWSTR*))aSyscall[25].pCurrent)
+
+ { "GetLastError", (SYSCALL)GetLastError, 0 },
+
+#define osGetLastError ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(VOID))aSyscall[26].pCurrent)
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION)
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ /* The GetProcAddressA() routine is only available on Windows CE. */
+ { "GetProcAddressA", (SYSCALL)GetProcAddressA, 0 },
+#else
+ /* All other Windows platforms expect GetProcAddress() to take
+ ** an ANSI string regardless of the _UNICODE setting */
+ { "GetProcAddressA", (SYSCALL)GetProcAddress, 0 },
+#endif
+#else
+ { "GetProcAddressA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetProcAddressA ((FARPROC(WINAPI*)(HMODULE, \
+ LPCSTR))aSyscall[27].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "GetSystemInfo", (SYSCALL)GetSystemInfo, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetSystemInfo", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetSystemInfo ((VOID(WINAPI*)(LPSYSTEM_INFO))aSyscall[28].pCurrent)
+
+ { "GetSystemTime", (SYSCALL)GetSystemTime, 0 },
+
+#define osGetSystemTime ((VOID(WINAPI*)(LPSYSTEMTIME))aSyscall[29].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ { "GetSystemTimeAsFileTime", (SYSCALL)GetSystemTimeAsFileTime, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetSystemTimeAsFileTime", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetSystemTimeAsFileTime ((VOID(WINAPI*)( \
+ LPFILETIME))aSyscall[30].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+ { "GetTempPathA", (SYSCALL)GetTempPathA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetTempPathA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetTempPathA ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(DWORD,LPSTR))aSyscall[31].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "GetTempPathW", (SYSCALL)GetTempPathW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetTempPathW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetTempPathW ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(DWORD,LPWSTR))aSyscall[32].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "GetTickCount", (SYSCALL)GetTickCount, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetTickCount", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetTickCount ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(VOID))aSyscall[33].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI) && SQLITE_WIN32_GETVERSIONEX
+ { "GetVersionExA", (SYSCALL)GetVersionExA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetVersionExA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetVersionExA ((BOOL(WINAPI*)( \
+ LPOSVERSIONINFOA))aSyscall[34].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE) && \
+ SQLITE_WIN32_GETVERSIONEX
+ { "GetVersionExW", (SYSCALL)GetVersionExW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetVersionExW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetVersionExW ((BOOL(WINAPI*)( \
+ LPOSVERSIONINFOW))aSyscall[35].pCurrent)
+
+ { "HeapAlloc", (SYSCALL)HeapAlloc, 0 },
+
+#define osHeapAlloc ((LPVOID(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD, \
+ SIZE_T))aSyscall[36].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "HeapCreate", (SYSCALL)HeapCreate, 0 },
+#else
+ { "HeapCreate", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osHeapCreate ((HANDLE(WINAPI*)(DWORD,SIZE_T, \
+ SIZE_T))aSyscall[37].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "HeapDestroy", (SYSCALL)HeapDestroy, 0 },
+#else
+ { "HeapDestroy", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osHeapDestroy ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE))aSyscall[38].pCurrent)
+
+ { "HeapFree", (SYSCALL)HeapFree, 0 },
+
+#define osHeapFree ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD,LPVOID))aSyscall[39].pCurrent)
+
+ { "HeapReAlloc", (SYSCALL)HeapReAlloc, 0 },
+
+#define osHeapReAlloc ((LPVOID(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD,LPVOID, \
+ SIZE_T))aSyscall[40].pCurrent)
+
+ { "HeapSize", (SYSCALL)HeapSize, 0 },
+
+#define osHeapSize ((SIZE_T(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD, \
+ LPCVOID))aSyscall[41].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "HeapValidate", (SYSCALL)HeapValidate, 0 },
+#else
+ { "HeapValidate", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osHeapValidate ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD, \
+ LPCVOID))aSyscall[42].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "HeapCompact", (SYSCALL)HeapCompact, 0 },
+#else
+ { "HeapCompact", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osHeapCompact ((UINT(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD))aSyscall[43].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION)
+ { "LoadLibraryA", (SYSCALL)LoadLibraryA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "LoadLibraryA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osLoadLibraryA ((HMODULE(WINAPI*)(LPCSTR))aSyscall[44].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE) && \
+ !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION)
+ { "LoadLibraryW", (SYSCALL)LoadLibraryW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "LoadLibraryW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osLoadLibraryW ((HMODULE(WINAPI*)(LPCWSTR))aSyscall[45].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "LocalFree", (SYSCALL)LocalFree, 0 },
+#else
+ { "LocalFree", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osLocalFree ((HLOCAL(WINAPI*)(HLOCAL))aSyscall[46].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "LockFile", (SYSCALL)LockFile, 0 },
+#else
+ { "LockFile", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#ifndef osLockFile
+#define osLockFile ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD,DWORD,DWORD, \
+ DWORD))aSyscall[47].pCurrent)
+#endif
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ { "LockFileEx", (SYSCALL)LockFileEx, 0 },
+#else
+ { "LockFileEx", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#ifndef osLockFileEx
+#define osLockFileEx ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD,DWORD,DWORD,DWORD, \
+ LPOVERLAPPED))aSyscall[48].pCurrent)
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE || (!SQLITE_OS_WINRT && \
+ (!defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0))
+ { "MapViewOfFile", (SYSCALL)MapViewOfFile, 0 },
+#else
+ { "MapViewOfFile", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osMapViewOfFile ((LPVOID(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD,DWORD,DWORD, \
+ SIZE_T))aSyscall[49].pCurrent)
+
+ { "MultiByteToWideChar", (SYSCALL)MultiByteToWideChar, 0 },
+
+#define osMultiByteToWideChar ((int(WINAPI*)(UINT,DWORD,LPCSTR,int,LPWSTR, \
+ int))aSyscall[50].pCurrent)
+
+ { "QueryPerformanceCounter", (SYSCALL)QueryPerformanceCounter, 0 },
+
+#define osQueryPerformanceCounter ((BOOL(WINAPI*)( \
+ LARGE_INTEGER*))aSyscall[51].pCurrent)
+
+ { "ReadFile", (SYSCALL)ReadFile, 0 },
+
+#define osReadFile ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,LPVOID,DWORD,LPDWORD, \
+ LPOVERLAPPED))aSyscall[52].pCurrent)
+
+ { "SetEndOfFile", (SYSCALL)SetEndOfFile, 0 },
+
+#define osSetEndOfFile ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE))aSyscall[53].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "SetFilePointer", (SYSCALL)SetFilePointer, 0 },
+#else
+ { "SetFilePointer", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osSetFilePointer ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,LONG,PLONG, \
+ DWORD))aSyscall[54].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "Sleep", (SYSCALL)Sleep, 0 },
+#else
+ { "Sleep", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osSleep ((VOID(WINAPI*)(DWORD))aSyscall[55].pCurrent)
+
+ { "SystemTimeToFileTime", (SYSCALL)SystemTimeToFileTime, 0 },
+
+#define osSystemTimeToFileTime ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(CONST SYSTEMTIME*, \
+ LPFILETIME))aSyscall[56].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "UnlockFile", (SYSCALL)UnlockFile, 0 },
+#else
+ { "UnlockFile", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#ifndef osUnlockFile
+#define osUnlockFile ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD,DWORD,DWORD, \
+ DWORD))aSyscall[57].pCurrent)
+#endif
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ { "UnlockFileEx", (SYSCALL)UnlockFileEx, 0 },
+#else
+ { "UnlockFileEx", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osUnlockFileEx ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD,DWORD,DWORD, \
+ LPOVERLAPPED))aSyscall[58].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE || !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ { "UnmapViewOfFile", (SYSCALL)UnmapViewOfFile, 0 },
+#else
+ { "UnmapViewOfFile", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osUnmapViewOfFile ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(LPCVOID))aSyscall[59].pCurrent)
+
+ { "WideCharToMultiByte", (SYSCALL)WideCharToMultiByte, 0 },
+
+#define osWideCharToMultiByte ((int(WINAPI*)(UINT,DWORD,LPCWSTR,int,LPSTR,int, \
+ LPCSTR,LPBOOL))aSyscall[60].pCurrent)
+
+ { "WriteFile", (SYSCALL)WriteFile, 0 },
+
+#define osWriteFile ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,LPCVOID,DWORD,LPDWORD, \
+ LPOVERLAPPED))aSyscall[61].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "CreateEventExW", (SYSCALL)CreateEventExW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "CreateEventExW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osCreateEventExW ((HANDLE(WINAPI*)(LPSECURITY_ATTRIBUTES,LPCWSTR, \
+ DWORD,DWORD))aSyscall[62].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "WaitForSingleObject", (SYSCALL)WaitForSingleObject, 0 },
+#else
+ { "WaitForSingleObject", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osWaitForSingleObject ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(HANDLE, \
+ DWORD))aSyscall[63].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ { "WaitForSingleObjectEx", (SYSCALL)WaitForSingleObjectEx, 0 },
+#else
+ { "WaitForSingleObjectEx", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osWaitForSingleObjectEx ((DWORD(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,DWORD, \
+ BOOL))aSyscall[64].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "SetFilePointerEx", (SYSCALL)SetFilePointerEx, 0 },
+#else
+ { "SetFilePointerEx", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osSetFilePointerEx ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,LARGE_INTEGER, \
+ PLARGE_INTEGER,DWORD))aSyscall[65].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "GetFileInformationByHandleEx", (SYSCALL)GetFileInformationByHandleEx, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetFileInformationByHandleEx", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetFileInformationByHandleEx ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(HANDLE, \
+ FILE_INFO_BY_HANDLE_CLASS,LPVOID,DWORD))aSyscall[66].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT && (!defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0)
+ { "MapViewOfFileFromApp", (SYSCALL)MapViewOfFileFromApp, 0 },
+#else
+ { "MapViewOfFileFromApp", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osMapViewOfFileFromApp ((LPVOID(WINAPI*)(HANDLE,ULONG,ULONG64, \
+ SIZE_T))aSyscall[67].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "CreateFile2", (SYSCALL)CreateFile2, 0 },
+#else
+ { "CreateFile2", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osCreateFile2 ((HANDLE(WINAPI*)(LPCWSTR,DWORD,DWORD,DWORD, \
+ LPCREATEFILE2_EXTENDED_PARAMETERS))aSyscall[68].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION)
+ { "LoadPackagedLibrary", (SYSCALL)LoadPackagedLibrary, 0 },
+#else
+ { "LoadPackagedLibrary", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osLoadPackagedLibrary ((HMODULE(WINAPI*)(LPCWSTR, \
+ DWORD))aSyscall[69].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "GetTickCount64", (SYSCALL)GetTickCount64, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetTickCount64", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetTickCount64 ((ULONGLONG(WINAPI*)(VOID))aSyscall[70].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ { "GetNativeSystemInfo", (SYSCALL)GetNativeSystemInfo, 0 },
+#else
+ { "GetNativeSystemInfo", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osGetNativeSystemInfo ((VOID(WINAPI*)( \
+ LPSYSTEM_INFO))aSyscall[71].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+ { "OutputDebugStringA", (SYSCALL)OutputDebugStringA, 0 },
+#else
+ { "OutputDebugStringA", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osOutputDebugStringA ((VOID(WINAPI*)(LPCSTR))aSyscall[72].pCurrent)
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ { "OutputDebugStringW", (SYSCALL)OutputDebugStringW, 0 },
+#else
+ { "OutputDebugStringW", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osOutputDebugStringW ((VOID(WINAPI*)(LPCWSTR))aSyscall[73].pCurrent)
+
+ { "GetProcessHeap", (SYSCALL)GetProcessHeap, 0 },
+
+#define osGetProcessHeap ((HANDLE(WINAPI*)(VOID))aSyscall[74].pCurrent)
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT && (!defined(SQLITE_OMIT_WAL) || SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0)
+ { "CreateFileMappingFromApp", (SYSCALL)CreateFileMappingFromApp, 0 },
+#else
+ { "CreateFileMappingFromApp", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osCreateFileMappingFromApp ((HANDLE(WINAPI*)(HANDLE, \
+ LPSECURITY_ATTRIBUTES,ULONG,ULONG64,LPCWSTR))aSyscall[75].pCurrent)
+
+/*
+** NOTE: On some sub-platforms, the InterlockedCompareExchange "function"
+** is really just a macro that uses a compiler intrinsic (e.g. x64).
+** So do not try to make this is into a redefinable interface.
+*/
+#if defined(InterlockedCompareExchange)
+ { "InterlockedCompareExchange", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+
+#define osInterlockedCompareExchange InterlockedCompareExchange
+#else
+ { "InterlockedCompareExchange", (SYSCALL)InterlockedCompareExchange, 0 },
+
+#define osInterlockedCompareExchange ((LONG(WINAPI*)(LONG \
+ SQLITE_WIN32_VOLATILE*, LONG,LONG))aSyscall[76].pCurrent)
+#endif /* defined(InterlockedCompareExchange) */
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && SQLITE_WIN32_USE_UUID
+ { "UuidCreate", (SYSCALL)UuidCreate, 0 },
+#else
+ { "UuidCreate", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osUuidCreate ((RPC_STATUS(RPC_ENTRY*)(UUID*))aSyscall[77].pCurrent)
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && SQLITE_WIN32_USE_UUID
+ { "UuidCreateSequential", (SYSCALL)UuidCreateSequential, 0 },
+#else
+ { "UuidCreateSequential", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osUuidCreateSequential \
+ ((RPC_STATUS(RPC_ENTRY*)(UUID*))aSyscall[78].pCurrent)
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_NO_SYNC) && SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ { "FlushViewOfFile", (SYSCALL)FlushViewOfFile, 0 },
+#else
+ { "FlushViewOfFile", (SYSCALL)0, 0 },
+#endif
+
+#define osFlushViewOfFile \
+ ((BOOL(WINAPI*)(LPCVOID,SIZE_T))aSyscall[79].pCurrent)
+
+}; /* End of the overrideable system calls */
+
+/*
+** This is the xSetSystemCall() method of sqlite3_vfs for all of the
+** "win32" VFSes. Return SQLITE_OK opon successfully updating the
+** system call pointer, or SQLITE_NOTFOUND if there is no configurable
+** system call named zName.
+*/
+static int winSetSystemCall(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pNotUsed, /* The VFS pointer. Not used */
+ const char *zName, /* Name of system call to override */
+ sqlite3_syscall_ptr pNewFunc /* Pointer to new system call value */
+){
+ unsigned int i;
+ int rc = SQLITE_NOTFOUND;
+
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pNotUsed);
+ if( zName==0 ){
+ /* If no zName is given, restore all system calls to their default
+ ** settings and return NULL
+ */
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ for(i=0; i0 ){
+ memset(zDbgBuf, 0, SQLITE_WIN32_DBG_BUF_SIZE);
+ memcpy(zDbgBuf, zBuf, nMin);
+ osOutputDebugStringA(zDbgBuf);
+ }else{
+ osOutputDebugStringA(zBuf);
+ }
+#elif defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ memset(zDbgBuf, 0, SQLITE_WIN32_DBG_BUF_SIZE);
+ if ( osMultiByteToWideChar(
+ osAreFileApisANSI() ? CP_ACP : CP_OEMCP, 0, zBuf,
+ nMin, (LPWSTR)zDbgBuf, SQLITE_WIN32_DBG_BUF_SIZE/sizeof(WCHAR))<=0 ){
+ return;
+ }
+ osOutputDebugStringW((LPCWSTR)zDbgBuf);
+#else
+ if( nMin>0 ){
+ memset(zDbgBuf, 0, SQLITE_WIN32_DBG_BUF_SIZE);
+ memcpy(zDbgBuf, zBuf, nMin);
+ fprintf(stderr, "%s", zDbgBuf);
+ }else{
+ fprintf(stderr, "%s", zBuf);
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** The following routine suspends the current thread for at least ms
+** milliseconds. This is equivalent to the Win32 Sleep() interface.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+static HANDLE sleepObj = NULL;
+#endif
+
+SQLITE_API void sqlite3_win32_sleep(DWORD milliseconds){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ if ( sleepObj==NULL ){
+ sleepObj = osCreateEventExW(NULL, NULL, CREATE_EVENT_MANUAL_RESET,
+ SYNCHRONIZE);
+ }
+ assert( sleepObj!=NULL );
+ osWaitForSingleObjectEx(sleepObj, milliseconds, FALSE);
+#else
+ osSleep(milliseconds);
+#endif
+}
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_WORKER_THREADS>0 && !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && \
+ SQLITE_THREADSAFE>0
+SQLITE_PRIVATE DWORD sqlite3Win32Wait(HANDLE hObject){
+ DWORD rc;
+ while( (rc = osWaitForSingleObjectEx(hObject, INFINITE,
+ TRUE))==WAIT_IO_COMPLETION ){}
+ return rc;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Return true (non-zero) if we are running under WinNT, Win2K, WinXP,
+** or WinCE. Return false (zero) for Win95, Win98, or WinME.
+**
+** Here is an interesting observation: Win95, Win98, and WinME lack
+** the LockFileEx() API. But we can still statically link against that
+** API as long as we don't call it when running Win95/98/ME. A call to
+** this routine is used to determine if the host is Win95/98/ME or
+** WinNT/2K/XP so that we will know whether or not we can safely call
+** the LockFileEx() API.
+*/
+
+#if !SQLITE_WIN32_GETVERSIONEX
+# define osIsNT() (1)
+#elif SQLITE_OS_WINCE || SQLITE_OS_WINRT || !defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+# define osIsNT() (1)
+#elif !defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+# define osIsNT() (0)
+#else
+# define osIsNT() ((sqlite3_os_type==2) || sqlite3_win32_is_nt())
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This function determines if the machine is running a version of Windows
+** based on the NT kernel.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_win32_is_nt(void){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ /*
+ ** NOTE: The WinRT sub-platform is always assumed to be based on the NT
+ ** kernel.
+ */
+ return 1;
+#elif SQLITE_WIN32_GETVERSIONEX
+ if( osInterlockedCompareExchange(&sqlite3_os_type, 0, 0)==0 ){
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI)
+ OSVERSIONINFOA sInfo;
+ sInfo.dwOSVersionInfoSize = sizeof(sInfo);
+ osGetVersionExA(&sInfo);
+ osInterlockedCompareExchange(&sqlite3_os_type,
+ (sInfo.dwPlatformId == VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT) ? 2 : 1, 0);
+#elif defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ OSVERSIONINFOW sInfo;
+ sInfo.dwOSVersionInfoSize = sizeof(sInfo);
+ osGetVersionExW(&sInfo);
+ osInterlockedCompareExchange(&sqlite3_os_type,
+ (sInfo.dwPlatformId == VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT) ? 2 : 1, 0);
+#endif
+ }
+ return osInterlockedCompareExchange(&sqlite3_os_type, 2, 2)==2;
+#elif SQLITE_TEST
+ return osInterlockedCompareExchange(&sqlite3_os_type, 2, 2)==2;
+#else
+ /*
+ ** NOTE: All sub-platforms where the GetVersionEx[AW] functions are
+ ** deprecated are always assumed to be based on the NT kernel.
+ */
+ return 1;
+#endif
+}
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC
+/*
+** Allocate nBytes of memory.
+*/
+static void *winMemMalloc(int nBytes){
+ HANDLE hHeap;
+ void *p;
+
+ winMemAssertMagic();
+ hHeap = winMemGetHeap();
+ assert( hHeap!=0 );
+ assert( hHeap!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE );
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC_VALIDATE)
+ assert( osHeapValidate(hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, NULL) );
+#endif
+ assert( nBytes>=0 );
+ p = osHeapAlloc(hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, (SIZE_T)nBytes);
+ if( !p ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM, "failed to HeapAlloc %u bytes (%lu), heap=%p",
+ nBytes, osGetLastError(), (void*)hHeap);
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free memory.
+*/
+static void winMemFree(void *pPrior){
+ HANDLE hHeap;
+
+ winMemAssertMagic();
+ hHeap = winMemGetHeap();
+ assert( hHeap!=0 );
+ assert( hHeap!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE );
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC_VALIDATE)
+ assert( osHeapValidate(hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, pPrior) );
+#endif
+ if( !pPrior ) return; /* Passing NULL to HeapFree is undefined. */
+ if( !osHeapFree(hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, pPrior) ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM, "failed to HeapFree block %p (%lu), heap=%p",
+ pPrior, osGetLastError(), (void*)hHeap);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the size of an existing memory allocation
+*/
+static void *winMemRealloc(void *pPrior, int nBytes){
+ HANDLE hHeap;
+ void *p;
+
+ winMemAssertMagic();
+ hHeap = winMemGetHeap();
+ assert( hHeap!=0 );
+ assert( hHeap!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE );
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC_VALIDATE)
+ assert( osHeapValidate(hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, pPrior) );
+#endif
+ assert( nBytes>=0 );
+ if( !pPrior ){
+ p = osHeapAlloc(hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, (SIZE_T)nBytes);
+ }else{
+ p = osHeapReAlloc(hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, pPrior, (SIZE_T)nBytes);
+ }
+ if( !p ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM, "failed to %s %u bytes (%lu), heap=%p",
+ pPrior ? "HeapReAlloc" : "HeapAlloc", nBytes, osGetLastError(),
+ (void*)hHeap);
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the size of an outstanding allocation, in bytes.
+*/
+static int winMemSize(void *p){
+ HANDLE hHeap;
+ SIZE_T n;
+
+ winMemAssertMagic();
+ hHeap = winMemGetHeap();
+ assert( hHeap!=0 );
+ assert( hHeap!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE );
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC_VALIDATE)
+ assert( osHeapValidate(hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, p) );
+#endif
+ if( !p ) return 0;
+ n = osHeapSize(hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, p);
+ if( n==(SIZE_T)-1 ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM, "failed to HeapSize block %p (%lu), heap=%p",
+ p, osGetLastError(), (void*)hHeap);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return (int)n;
+}
+
+/*
+** Round up a request size to the next valid allocation size.
+*/
+static int winMemRoundup(int n){
+ return n;
+}
+
+/*
+** Initialize this module.
+*/
+static int winMemInit(void *pAppData){
+ winMemData *pWinMemData = (winMemData *)pAppData;
+
+ if( !pWinMemData ) return SQLITE_ERROR;
+ assert( pWinMemData->magic1==WINMEM_MAGIC1 );
+ assert( pWinMemData->magic2==WINMEM_MAGIC2 );
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_CREATE
+ if( !pWinMemData->hHeap ){
+ DWORD dwInitialSize = SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_INIT_SIZE;
+ DWORD dwMaximumSize = (DWORD)sqlite3GlobalConfig.nHeap;
+ if( dwMaximumSize==0 ){
+ dwMaximumSize = SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_MAX_SIZE;
+ }else if( dwInitialSize>dwMaximumSize ){
+ dwInitialSize = dwMaximumSize;
+ }
+ pWinMemData->hHeap = osHeapCreate(SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS,
+ dwInitialSize, dwMaximumSize);
+ if( !pWinMemData->hHeap ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM,
+ "failed to HeapCreate (%lu), flags=%u, initSize=%lu, maxSize=%lu",
+ osGetLastError(), SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, dwInitialSize,
+ dwMaximumSize);
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ pWinMemData->bOwned = TRUE;
+ assert( pWinMemData->bOwned );
+ }
+#else
+ pWinMemData->hHeap = osGetProcessHeap();
+ if( !pWinMemData->hHeap ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM,
+ "failed to GetProcessHeap (%lu)", osGetLastError());
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ pWinMemData->bOwned = FALSE;
+ assert( !pWinMemData->bOwned );
+#endif
+ assert( pWinMemData->hHeap!=0 );
+ assert( pWinMemData->hHeap!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE );
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC_VALIDATE)
+ assert( osHeapValidate(pWinMemData->hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, NULL) );
+#endif
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Deinitialize this module.
+*/
+static void winMemShutdown(void *pAppData){
+ winMemData *pWinMemData = (winMemData *)pAppData;
+
+ if( !pWinMemData ) return;
+ assert( pWinMemData->magic1==WINMEM_MAGIC1 );
+ assert( pWinMemData->magic2==WINMEM_MAGIC2 );
+
+ if( pWinMemData->hHeap ){
+ assert( pWinMemData->hHeap!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE );
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && defined(SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC_VALIDATE)
+ assert( osHeapValidate(pWinMemData->hHeap, SQLITE_WIN32_HEAP_FLAGS, NULL) );
+#endif
+ if( pWinMemData->bOwned ){
+ if( !osHeapDestroy(pWinMemData->hHeap) ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOMEM, "failed to HeapDestroy (%lu), heap=%p",
+ osGetLastError(), (void*)pWinMemData->hHeap);
+ }
+ pWinMemData->bOwned = FALSE;
+ }
+ pWinMemData->hHeap = NULL;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Populate the low-level memory allocation function pointers in
+** sqlite3GlobalConfig.m with pointers to the routines in this file. The
+** arguments specify the block of memory to manage.
+**
+** This routine is only called by sqlite3_config(), and therefore
+** is not required to be threadsafe (it is not).
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE const sqlite3_mem_methods *sqlite3MemGetWin32(void){
+ static const sqlite3_mem_methods winMemMethods = {
+ winMemMalloc,
+ winMemFree,
+ winMemRealloc,
+ winMemSize,
+ winMemRoundup,
+ winMemInit,
+ winMemShutdown,
+ &win_mem_data
+ };
+ return &winMemMethods;
+}
+
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3MemSetDefault(void){
+ sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_MALLOC, sqlite3MemGetWin32());
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_WIN32_MALLOC */
+
+/*
+** Convert a UTF-8 string to Microsoft Unicode.
+**
+** Space to hold the returned string is obtained from sqlite3_malloc().
+*/
+static LPWSTR winUtf8ToUnicode(const char *zText){
+ int nChar;
+ LPWSTR zWideText;
+
+ nChar = osMultiByteToWideChar(CP_UTF8, 0, zText, -1, NULL, 0);
+ if( nChar==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ zWideText = sqlite3MallocZero( nChar*sizeof(WCHAR) );
+ if( zWideText==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ nChar = osMultiByteToWideChar(CP_UTF8, 0, zText, -1, zWideText,
+ nChar);
+ if( nChar==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zWideText);
+ zWideText = 0;
+ }
+ return zWideText;
+}
+
+/*
+** Convert a Microsoft Unicode string to UTF-8.
+**
+** Space to hold the returned string is obtained from sqlite3_malloc().
+*/
+static char *winUnicodeToUtf8(LPCWSTR zWideText){
+ int nByte;
+ char *zText;
+
+ nByte = osWideCharToMultiByte(CP_UTF8, 0, zWideText, -1, 0, 0, 0, 0);
+ if( nByte == 0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ zText = sqlite3MallocZero( nByte );
+ if( zText==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ nByte = osWideCharToMultiByte(CP_UTF8, 0, zWideText, -1, zText, nByte,
+ 0, 0);
+ if( nByte == 0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zText);
+ zText = 0;
+ }
+ return zText;
+}
+
+/*
+** Convert an ANSI string to Microsoft Unicode, using the ANSI or OEM
+** code page.
+**
+** Space to hold the returned string is obtained from sqlite3_malloc().
+*/
+static LPWSTR winMbcsToUnicode(const char *zText, int useAnsi){
+ int nByte;
+ LPWSTR zMbcsText;
+ int codepage = useAnsi ? CP_ACP : CP_OEMCP;
+
+ nByte = osMultiByteToWideChar(codepage, 0, zText, -1, NULL,
+ 0)*sizeof(WCHAR);
+ if( nByte==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ zMbcsText = sqlite3MallocZero( nByte*sizeof(WCHAR) );
+ if( zMbcsText==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ nByte = osMultiByteToWideChar(codepage, 0, zText, -1, zMbcsText,
+ nByte);
+ if( nByte==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zMbcsText);
+ zMbcsText = 0;
+ }
+ return zMbcsText;
+}
+
+/*
+** Convert a Microsoft Unicode string to a multi-byte character string,
+** using the ANSI or OEM code page.
+**
+** Space to hold the returned string is obtained from sqlite3_malloc().
+*/
+static char *winUnicodeToMbcs(LPCWSTR zWideText, int useAnsi){
+ int nByte;
+ char *zText;
+ int codepage = useAnsi ? CP_ACP : CP_OEMCP;
+
+ nByte = osWideCharToMultiByte(codepage, 0, zWideText, -1, 0, 0, 0, 0);
+ if( nByte == 0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ zText = sqlite3MallocZero( nByte );
+ if( zText==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ nByte = osWideCharToMultiByte(codepage, 0, zWideText, -1, zText,
+ nByte, 0, 0);
+ if( nByte == 0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zText);
+ zText = 0;
+ }
+ return zText;
+}
+
+/*
+** Convert a multi-byte character string to UTF-8.
+**
+** Space to hold the returned string is obtained from sqlite3_malloc().
+*/
+static char *winMbcsToUtf8(const char *zText, int useAnsi){
+ char *zTextUtf8;
+ LPWSTR zTmpWide;
+
+ zTmpWide = winMbcsToUnicode(zText, useAnsi);
+ if( zTmpWide==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ zTextUtf8 = winUnicodeToUtf8(zTmpWide);
+ sqlite3_free(zTmpWide);
+ return zTextUtf8;
+}
+
+/*
+** Convert a UTF-8 string to a multi-byte character string.
+**
+** Space to hold the returned string is obtained from sqlite3_malloc().
+*/
+static char *winUtf8ToMbcs(const char *zText, int useAnsi){
+ char *zTextMbcs;
+ LPWSTR zTmpWide;
+
+ zTmpWide = winUtf8ToUnicode(zText);
+ if( zTmpWide==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ zTextMbcs = winUnicodeToMbcs(zTmpWide, useAnsi);
+ sqlite3_free(zTmpWide);
+ return zTextMbcs;
+}
+
+/*
+** This is a public wrapper for the winUtf8ToUnicode() function.
+*/
+SQLITE_API LPWSTR sqlite3_win32_utf8_to_unicode(const char *zText){
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( !zText ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ return winUtf8ToUnicode(zText);
+}
+
+/*
+** This is a public wrapper for the winUnicodeToUtf8() function.
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_win32_unicode_to_utf8(LPCWSTR zWideText){
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( !zWideText ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ return winUnicodeToUtf8(zWideText);
+}
+
+/*
+** This is a public wrapper for the winMbcsToUtf8() function.
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_win32_mbcs_to_utf8(const char *zText){
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( !zText ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ return winMbcsToUtf8(zText, osAreFileApisANSI());
+}
+
+/*
+** This is a public wrapper for the winMbcsToUtf8() function.
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_win32_mbcs_to_utf8_v2(const char *zText, int useAnsi){
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( !zText ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ return winMbcsToUtf8(zText, useAnsi);
+}
+
+/*
+** This is a public wrapper for the winUtf8ToMbcs() function.
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_win32_utf8_to_mbcs(const char *zText){
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( !zText ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ return winUtf8ToMbcs(zText, osAreFileApisANSI());
+}
+
+/*
+** This is a public wrapper for the winUtf8ToMbcs() function.
+*/
+SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_win32_utf8_to_mbcs_v2(const char *zText, int useAnsi){
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( !zText ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ if( sqlite3_initialize() ) return 0;
+#endif
+ return winUtf8ToMbcs(zText, useAnsi);
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is the same as sqlite3_win32_set_directory (below); however,
+** it accepts a UTF-8 string.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_win32_set_directory8(
+ unsigned long type, /* Identifier for directory being set or reset */
+ const char *zValue /* New value for directory being set or reset */
+){
+ char **ppDirectory = 0;
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTOINIT
+ int rc = sqlite3_initialize();
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+#endif
+ if( type==SQLITE_WIN32_DATA_DIRECTORY_TYPE ){
+ ppDirectory = &sqlite3_data_directory;
+ }else if( type==SQLITE_WIN32_TEMP_DIRECTORY_TYPE ){
+ ppDirectory = &sqlite3_temp_directory;
+ }
+ assert( !ppDirectory || type==SQLITE_WIN32_DATA_DIRECTORY_TYPE
+ || type==SQLITE_WIN32_TEMP_DIRECTORY_TYPE
+ );
+ assert( !ppDirectory || sqlite3MemdebugHasType(*ppDirectory, MEMTYPE_HEAP) );
+ if( ppDirectory ){
+ char *zCopy = 0;
+ if( zValue && zValue[0] ){
+ zCopy = sqlite3_mprintf("%s", zValue);
+ if ( zCopy==0 ){
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(*ppDirectory);
+ *ppDirectory = zCopy;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ return SQLITE_ERROR;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is the same as sqlite3_win32_set_directory (below); however,
+** it accepts a UTF-16 string.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_win32_set_directory16(
+ unsigned long type, /* Identifier for directory being set or reset */
+ const void *zValue /* New value for directory being set or reset */
+){
+ int rc;
+ char *zUtf8 = 0;
+ if( zValue ){
+ zUtf8 = sqlite3_win32_unicode_to_utf8(zValue);
+ if( zUtf8==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ rc = sqlite3_win32_set_directory8(type, zUtf8);
+ if( zUtf8 ) sqlite3_free(zUtf8);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function sets the data directory or the temporary directory based on
+** the provided arguments. The type argument must be 1 in order to set the
+** data directory or 2 in order to set the temporary directory. The zValue
+** argument is the name of the directory to use. The return value will be
+** SQLITE_OK if successful.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_win32_set_directory(
+ unsigned long type, /* Identifier for directory being set or reset */
+ void *zValue /* New value for directory being set or reset */
+){
+ return sqlite3_win32_set_directory16(type, zValue);
+}
+
+/*
+** The return value of winGetLastErrorMsg
+** is zero if the error message fits in the buffer, or non-zero
+** otherwise (if the message was truncated).
+*/
+static int winGetLastErrorMsg(DWORD lastErrno, int nBuf, char *zBuf){
+ /* FormatMessage returns 0 on failure. Otherwise it
+ ** returns the number of TCHARs written to the output
+ ** buffer, excluding the terminating null char.
+ */
+ DWORD dwLen = 0;
+ char *zOut = 0;
+
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ WCHAR zTempWide[SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_ERRMSG_CHARS+1];
+ dwLen = osFormatMessageW(FORMAT_MESSAGE_FROM_SYSTEM |
+ FORMAT_MESSAGE_IGNORE_INSERTS,
+ NULL,
+ lastErrno,
+ 0,
+ zTempWide,
+ SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_ERRMSG_CHARS,
+ 0);
+#else
+ LPWSTR zTempWide = NULL;
+ dwLen = osFormatMessageW(FORMAT_MESSAGE_ALLOCATE_BUFFER |
+ FORMAT_MESSAGE_FROM_SYSTEM |
+ FORMAT_MESSAGE_IGNORE_INSERTS,
+ NULL,
+ lastErrno,
+ 0,
+ (LPWSTR) &zTempWide,
+ 0,
+ 0);
+#endif
+ if( dwLen > 0 ){
+ /* allocate a buffer and convert to UTF8 */
+ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc();
+ zOut = winUnicodeToUtf8(zTempWide);
+ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc();
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ /* free the system buffer allocated by FormatMessage */
+ osLocalFree(zTempWide);
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+ else{
+ char *zTemp = NULL;
+ dwLen = osFormatMessageA(FORMAT_MESSAGE_ALLOCATE_BUFFER |
+ FORMAT_MESSAGE_FROM_SYSTEM |
+ FORMAT_MESSAGE_IGNORE_INSERTS,
+ NULL,
+ lastErrno,
+ 0,
+ (LPSTR) &zTemp,
+ 0,
+ 0);
+ if( dwLen > 0 ){
+ /* allocate a buffer and convert to UTF8 */
+ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc();
+ zOut = winMbcsToUtf8(zTemp, osAreFileApisANSI());
+ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc();
+ /* free the system buffer allocated by FormatMessage */
+ osLocalFree(zTemp);
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ if( 0 == dwLen ){
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nBuf, zBuf, "OsError 0x%lx (%lu)", lastErrno, lastErrno);
+ }else{
+ /* copy a maximum of nBuf chars to output buffer */
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nBuf, zBuf, "%s", zOut);
+ /* free the UTF8 buffer */
+ sqlite3_free(zOut);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/*
+**
+** This function - winLogErrorAtLine() - is only ever called via the macro
+** winLogError().
+**
+** This routine is invoked after an error occurs in an OS function.
+** It logs a message using sqlite3_log() containing the current value of
+** error code and, if possible, the human-readable equivalent from
+** FormatMessage.
+**
+** The first argument passed to the macro should be the error code that
+** will be returned to SQLite (e.g. SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE, SQLITE_CANTOPEN).
+** The two subsequent arguments should be the name of the OS function that
+** failed and the associated file-system path, if any.
+*/
+#define winLogError(a,b,c,d) winLogErrorAtLine(a,b,c,d,__LINE__)
+static int winLogErrorAtLine(
+ int errcode, /* SQLite error code */
+ DWORD lastErrno, /* Win32 last error */
+ const char *zFunc, /* Name of OS function that failed */
+ const char *zPath, /* File path associated with error */
+ int iLine /* Source line number where error occurred */
+){
+ char zMsg[500]; /* Human readable error text */
+ int i; /* Loop counter */
+
+ zMsg[0] = 0;
+ winGetLastErrorMsg(lastErrno, sizeof(zMsg), zMsg);
+ assert( errcode!=SQLITE_OK );
+ if( zPath==0 ) zPath = "";
+ for(i=0; zMsg[i] && zMsg[i]!='\r' && zMsg[i]!='\n'; i++){}
+ zMsg[i] = 0;
+ sqlite3_log(errcode,
+ "os_win.c:%d: (%lu) %s(%s) - %s",
+ iLine, lastErrno, zFunc, zPath, zMsg
+ );
+
+ return errcode;
+}
+
+/*
+** The number of times that a ReadFile(), WriteFile(), and DeleteFile()
+** will be retried following a locking error - probably caused by
+** antivirus software. Also the initial delay before the first retry.
+** The delay increases linearly with each retry.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_IOERR_RETRY
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_IOERR_RETRY 10
+#endif
+#ifndef SQLITE_WIN32_IOERR_RETRY_DELAY
+# define SQLITE_WIN32_IOERR_RETRY_DELAY 25
+#endif
+static int winIoerrRetry = SQLITE_WIN32_IOERR_RETRY;
+static int winIoerrRetryDelay = SQLITE_WIN32_IOERR_RETRY_DELAY;
+
+/*
+** The "winIoerrCanRetry1" macro is used to determine if a particular I/O
+** error code obtained via GetLastError() is eligible to be retried. It
+** must accept the error code DWORD as its only argument and should return
+** non-zero if the error code is transient in nature and the operation
+** responsible for generating the original error might succeed upon being
+** retried. The argument to this macro should be a variable.
+**
+** Additionally, a macro named "winIoerrCanRetry2" may be defined. If it
+** is defined, it will be consulted only when the macro "winIoerrCanRetry1"
+** returns zero. The "winIoerrCanRetry2" macro is completely optional and
+** may be used to include additional error codes in the set that should
+** result in the failing I/O operation being retried by the caller. If
+** defined, the "winIoerrCanRetry2" macro must exhibit external semantics
+** identical to those of the "winIoerrCanRetry1" macro.
+*/
+#if !defined(winIoerrCanRetry1)
+#define winIoerrCanRetry1(a) (((a)==ERROR_ACCESS_DENIED) || \
+ ((a)==ERROR_SHARING_VIOLATION) || \
+ ((a)==ERROR_LOCK_VIOLATION) || \
+ ((a)==ERROR_DEV_NOT_EXIST) || \
+ ((a)==ERROR_NETNAME_DELETED) || \
+ ((a)==ERROR_SEM_TIMEOUT) || \
+ ((a)==ERROR_NETWORK_UNREACHABLE))
+#endif
+
+/*
+** If a ReadFile() or WriteFile() error occurs, invoke this routine
+** to see if it should be retried. Return TRUE to retry. Return FALSE
+** to give up with an error.
+*/
+static int winRetryIoerr(int *pnRetry, DWORD *pError){
+ DWORD e = osGetLastError();
+ if( *pnRetry>=winIoerrRetry ){
+ if( pError ){
+ *pError = e;
+ }
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if( winIoerrCanRetry1(e) ){
+ sqlite3_win32_sleep(winIoerrRetryDelay*(1+*pnRetry));
+ ++*pnRetry;
+ return 1;
+ }
+#if defined(winIoerrCanRetry2)
+ else if( winIoerrCanRetry2(e) ){
+ sqlite3_win32_sleep(winIoerrRetryDelay*(1+*pnRetry));
+ ++*pnRetry;
+ return 1;
+ }
+#endif
+ if( pError ){
+ *pError = e;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Log a I/O error retry episode.
+*/
+static void winLogIoerr(int nRetry, int lineno){
+ if( nRetry ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOTICE,
+ "delayed %dms for lock/sharing conflict at line %d",
+ winIoerrRetryDelay*nRetry*(nRetry+1)/2, lineno
+ );
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** This #if does not rely on the SQLITE_OS_WINCE define because the
+** corresponding section in "date.c" cannot use it.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_LOCALTIME) && defined(_WIN32_WCE) && \
+ (!defined(SQLITE_MSVC_LOCALTIME_API) || !SQLITE_MSVC_LOCALTIME_API)
+/*
+** The MSVC CRT on Windows CE may not have a localtime() function.
+** So define a substitute.
+*/
+/* # include */
+struct tm *__cdecl localtime(const time_t *t)
+{
+ static struct tm y;
+ FILETIME uTm, lTm;
+ SYSTEMTIME pTm;
+ sqlite3_int64 t64;
+ t64 = *t;
+ t64 = (t64 + 11644473600)*10000000;
+ uTm.dwLowDateTime = (DWORD)(t64 & 0xFFFFFFFF);
+ uTm.dwHighDateTime= (DWORD)(t64 >> 32);
+ osFileTimeToLocalFileTime(&uTm,&lTm);
+ osFileTimeToSystemTime(&lTm,&pTm);
+ y.tm_year = pTm.wYear - 1900;
+ y.tm_mon = pTm.wMonth - 1;
+ y.tm_wday = pTm.wDayOfWeek;
+ y.tm_mday = pTm.wDay;
+ y.tm_hour = pTm.wHour;
+ y.tm_min = pTm.wMinute;
+ y.tm_sec = pTm.wSecond;
+ return &y;
+}
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+/*************************************************************************
+** This section contains code for WinCE only.
+*/
+#define HANDLE_TO_WINFILE(a) (winFile*)&((char*)a)[-(int)offsetof(winFile,h)]
+
+/*
+** Acquire a lock on the handle h
+*/
+static void winceMutexAcquire(HANDLE h){
+ DWORD dwErr;
+ do {
+ dwErr = osWaitForSingleObject(h, INFINITE);
+ } while (dwErr != WAIT_OBJECT_0 && dwErr != WAIT_ABANDONED);
+}
+/*
+** Release a lock acquired by winceMutexAcquire()
+*/
+#define winceMutexRelease(h) ReleaseMutex(h)
+
+/*
+** Create the mutex and shared memory used for locking in the file
+** descriptor pFile
+*/
+static int winceCreateLock(const char *zFilename, winFile *pFile){
+ LPWSTR zTok;
+ LPWSTR zName;
+ DWORD lastErrno;
+ BOOL bLogged = FALSE;
+ BOOL bInit = TRUE;
+
+ zName = winUtf8ToUnicode(zFilename);
+ if( zName==0 ){
+ /* out of memory */
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+
+ /* Initialize the local lockdata */
+ memset(&pFile->local, 0, sizeof(pFile->local));
+
+ /* Replace the backslashes from the filename and lowercase it
+ ** to derive a mutex name. */
+ zTok = osCharLowerW(zName);
+ for (;*zTok;zTok++){
+ if (*zTok == '\\') *zTok = '_';
+ }
+
+ /* Create/open the named mutex */
+ pFile->hMutex = osCreateMutexW(NULL, FALSE, zName);
+ if (!pFile->hMutex){
+ pFile->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ sqlite3_free(zName);
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winceCreateLock1", zFilename);
+ }
+
+ /* Acquire the mutex before continuing */
+ winceMutexAcquire(pFile->hMutex);
+
+ /* Since the names of named mutexes, semaphores, file mappings etc are
+ ** case-sensitive, take advantage of that by uppercasing the mutex name
+ ** and using that as the shared filemapping name.
+ */
+ osCharUpperW(zName);
+ pFile->hShared = osCreateFileMappingW(INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE, NULL,
+ PAGE_READWRITE, 0, sizeof(winceLock),
+ zName);
+
+ /* Set a flag that indicates we're the first to create the memory so it
+ ** must be zero-initialized */
+ lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ if (lastErrno == ERROR_ALREADY_EXISTS){
+ bInit = FALSE;
+ }
+
+ sqlite3_free(zName);
+
+ /* If we succeeded in making the shared memory handle, map it. */
+ if( pFile->hShared ){
+ pFile->shared = (winceLock*)osMapViewOfFile(pFile->hShared,
+ FILE_MAP_READ|FILE_MAP_WRITE, 0, 0, sizeof(winceLock));
+ /* If mapping failed, close the shared memory handle and erase it */
+ if( !pFile->shared ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winceCreateLock2", zFilename);
+ bLogged = TRUE;
+ osCloseHandle(pFile->hShared);
+ pFile->hShared = NULL;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If shared memory could not be created, then close the mutex and fail */
+ if( pFile->hShared==NULL ){
+ if( !bLogged ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = lastErrno;
+ winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winceCreateLock3", zFilename);
+ bLogged = TRUE;
+ }
+ winceMutexRelease(pFile->hMutex);
+ osCloseHandle(pFile->hMutex);
+ pFile->hMutex = NULL;
+ return SQLITE_IOERR;
+ }
+
+ /* Initialize the shared memory if we're supposed to */
+ if( bInit ){
+ memset(pFile->shared, 0, sizeof(winceLock));
+ }
+
+ winceMutexRelease(pFile->hMutex);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Destroy the part of winFile that deals with wince locks
+*/
+static void winceDestroyLock(winFile *pFile){
+ if (pFile->hMutex){
+ /* Acquire the mutex */
+ winceMutexAcquire(pFile->hMutex);
+
+ /* The following blocks should probably assert in debug mode, but they
+ are to cleanup in case any locks remained open */
+ if (pFile->local.nReaders){
+ pFile->shared->nReaders --;
+ }
+ if (pFile->local.bReserved){
+ pFile->shared->bReserved = FALSE;
+ }
+ if (pFile->local.bPending){
+ pFile->shared->bPending = FALSE;
+ }
+ if (pFile->local.bExclusive){
+ pFile->shared->bExclusive = FALSE;
+ }
+
+ /* De-reference and close our copy of the shared memory handle */
+ osUnmapViewOfFile(pFile->shared);
+ osCloseHandle(pFile->hShared);
+
+ /* Done with the mutex */
+ winceMutexRelease(pFile->hMutex);
+ osCloseHandle(pFile->hMutex);
+ pFile->hMutex = NULL;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** An implementation of the LockFile() API of Windows for CE
+*/
+static BOOL winceLockFile(
+ LPHANDLE phFile,
+ DWORD dwFileOffsetLow,
+ DWORD dwFileOffsetHigh,
+ DWORD nNumberOfBytesToLockLow,
+ DWORD nNumberOfBytesToLockHigh
+){
+ winFile *pFile = HANDLE_TO_WINFILE(phFile);
+ BOOL bReturn = FALSE;
+
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(dwFileOffsetHigh);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(nNumberOfBytesToLockHigh);
+
+ if (!pFile->hMutex) return TRUE;
+ winceMutexAcquire(pFile->hMutex);
+
+ /* Wanting an exclusive lock? */
+ if (dwFileOffsetLow == (DWORD)SHARED_FIRST
+ && nNumberOfBytesToLockLow == (DWORD)SHARED_SIZE){
+ if (pFile->shared->nReaders == 0 && pFile->shared->bExclusive == 0){
+ pFile->shared->bExclusive = TRUE;
+ pFile->local.bExclusive = TRUE;
+ bReturn = TRUE;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Want a read-only lock? */
+ else if (dwFileOffsetLow == (DWORD)SHARED_FIRST &&
+ nNumberOfBytesToLockLow == 1){
+ if (pFile->shared->bExclusive == 0){
+ pFile->local.nReaders ++;
+ if (pFile->local.nReaders == 1){
+ pFile->shared->nReaders ++;
+ }
+ bReturn = TRUE;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Want a pending lock? */
+ else if (dwFileOffsetLow == (DWORD)PENDING_BYTE
+ && nNumberOfBytesToLockLow == 1){
+ /* If no pending lock has been acquired, then acquire it */
+ if (pFile->shared->bPending == 0) {
+ pFile->shared->bPending = TRUE;
+ pFile->local.bPending = TRUE;
+ bReturn = TRUE;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Want a reserved lock? */
+ else if (dwFileOffsetLow == (DWORD)RESERVED_BYTE
+ && nNumberOfBytesToLockLow == 1){
+ if (pFile->shared->bReserved == 0) {
+ pFile->shared->bReserved = TRUE;
+ pFile->local.bReserved = TRUE;
+ bReturn = TRUE;
+ }
+ }
+
+ winceMutexRelease(pFile->hMutex);
+ return bReturn;
+}
+
+/*
+** An implementation of the UnlockFile API of Windows for CE
+*/
+static BOOL winceUnlockFile(
+ LPHANDLE phFile,
+ DWORD dwFileOffsetLow,
+ DWORD dwFileOffsetHigh,
+ DWORD nNumberOfBytesToUnlockLow,
+ DWORD nNumberOfBytesToUnlockHigh
+){
+ winFile *pFile = HANDLE_TO_WINFILE(phFile);
+ BOOL bReturn = FALSE;
+
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(dwFileOffsetHigh);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(nNumberOfBytesToUnlockHigh);
+
+ if (!pFile->hMutex) return TRUE;
+ winceMutexAcquire(pFile->hMutex);
+
+ /* Releasing a reader lock or an exclusive lock */
+ if (dwFileOffsetLow == (DWORD)SHARED_FIRST){
+ /* Did we have an exclusive lock? */
+ if (pFile->local.bExclusive){
+ assert(nNumberOfBytesToUnlockLow == (DWORD)SHARED_SIZE);
+ pFile->local.bExclusive = FALSE;
+ pFile->shared->bExclusive = FALSE;
+ bReturn = TRUE;
+ }
+
+ /* Did we just have a reader lock? */
+ else if (pFile->local.nReaders){
+ assert(nNumberOfBytesToUnlockLow == (DWORD)SHARED_SIZE
+ || nNumberOfBytesToUnlockLow == 1);
+ pFile->local.nReaders --;
+ if (pFile->local.nReaders == 0)
+ {
+ pFile->shared->nReaders --;
+ }
+ bReturn = TRUE;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Releasing a pending lock */
+ else if (dwFileOffsetLow == (DWORD)PENDING_BYTE
+ && nNumberOfBytesToUnlockLow == 1){
+ if (pFile->local.bPending){
+ pFile->local.bPending = FALSE;
+ pFile->shared->bPending = FALSE;
+ bReturn = TRUE;
+ }
+ }
+ /* Releasing a reserved lock */
+ else if (dwFileOffsetLow == (DWORD)RESERVED_BYTE
+ && nNumberOfBytesToUnlockLow == 1){
+ if (pFile->local.bReserved) {
+ pFile->local.bReserved = FALSE;
+ pFile->shared->bReserved = FALSE;
+ bReturn = TRUE;
+ }
+ }
+
+ winceMutexRelease(pFile->hMutex);
+ return bReturn;
+}
+/*
+** End of the special code for wince
+*****************************************************************************/
+#endif /* SQLITE_OS_WINCE */
+
+/*
+** Lock a file region.
+*/
+static BOOL winLockFile(
+ LPHANDLE phFile,
+ DWORD flags,
+ DWORD offsetLow,
+ DWORD offsetHigh,
+ DWORD numBytesLow,
+ DWORD numBytesHigh
+){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ /*
+ ** NOTE: Windows CE is handled differently here due its lack of the Win32
+ ** API LockFile.
+ */
+ return winceLockFile(phFile, offsetLow, offsetHigh,
+ numBytesLow, numBytesHigh);
+#else
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+ OVERLAPPED ovlp;
+ memset(&ovlp, 0, sizeof(OVERLAPPED));
+ ovlp.Offset = offsetLow;
+ ovlp.OffsetHigh = offsetHigh;
+ return osLockFileEx(*phFile, flags, 0, numBytesLow, numBytesHigh, &ovlp);
+ }else{
+ return osLockFile(*phFile, offsetLow, offsetHigh, numBytesLow,
+ numBytesHigh);
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Unlock a file region.
+ */
+static BOOL winUnlockFile(
+ LPHANDLE phFile,
+ DWORD offsetLow,
+ DWORD offsetHigh,
+ DWORD numBytesLow,
+ DWORD numBytesHigh
+){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ /*
+ ** NOTE: Windows CE is handled differently here due its lack of the Win32
+ ** API UnlockFile.
+ */
+ return winceUnlockFile(phFile, offsetLow, offsetHigh,
+ numBytesLow, numBytesHigh);
+#else
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+ OVERLAPPED ovlp;
+ memset(&ovlp, 0, sizeof(OVERLAPPED));
+ ovlp.Offset = offsetLow;
+ ovlp.OffsetHigh = offsetHigh;
+ return osUnlockFileEx(*phFile, 0, numBytesLow, numBytesHigh, &ovlp);
+ }else{
+ return osUnlockFile(*phFile, offsetLow, offsetHigh, numBytesLow,
+ numBytesHigh);
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+/*****************************************************************************
+** The next group of routines implement the I/O methods specified
+** by the sqlite3_io_methods object.
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/*
+** Some Microsoft compilers lack this definition.
+*/
+#ifndef INVALID_SET_FILE_POINTER
+# define INVALID_SET_FILE_POINTER ((DWORD)-1)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Move the current position of the file handle passed as the first
+** argument to offset iOffset within the file. If successful, return 0.
+** Otherwise, set pFile->lastErrno and return non-zero.
+*/
+static int winSeekFile(winFile *pFile, sqlite3_int64 iOffset){
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ LONG upperBits; /* Most sig. 32 bits of new offset */
+ LONG lowerBits; /* Least sig. 32 bits of new offset */
+ DWORD dwRet; /* Value returned by SetFilePointer() */
+ DWORD lastErrno; /* Value returned by GetLastError() */
+
+ OSTRACE(("SEEK file=%p, offset=%lld\n", pFile->h, iOffset));
+
+ upperBits = (LONG)((iOffset>>32) & 0x7fffffff);
+ lowerBits = (LONG)(iOffset & 0xffffffff);
+
+ /* API oddity: If successful, SetFilePointer() returns a dword
+ ** containing the lower 32-bits of the new file-offset. Or, if it fails,
+ ** it returns INVALID_SET_FILE_POINTER. However according to MSDN,
+ ** INVALID_SET_FILE_POINTER may also be a valid new offset. So to determine
+ ** whether an error has actually occurred, it is also necessary to call
+ ** GetLastError().
+ */
+ dwRet = osSetFilePointer(pFile->h, lowerBits, &upperBits, FILE_BEGIN);
+
+ if( (dwRet==INVALID_SET_FILE_POINTER
+ && ((lastErrno = osGetLastError())!=NO_ERROR)) ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = lastErrno;
+ winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_SEEK, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winSeekFile", pFile->zPath);
+ OSTRACE(("SEEK file=%p, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_SEEK\n", pFile->h));
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ OSTRACE(("SEEK file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return 0;
+#else
+ /*
+ ** Same as above, except that this implementation works for WinRT.
+ */
+
+ LARGE_INTEGER x; /* The new offset */
+ BOOL bRet; /* Value returned by SetFilePointerEx() */
+
+ x.QuadPart = iOffset;
+ bRet = osSetFilePointerEx(pFile->h, x, 0, FILE_BEGIN);
+
+ if(!bRet){
+ pFile->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_SEEK, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winSeekFile", pFile->zPath);
+ OSTRACE(("SEEK file=%p, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_SEEK\n", pFile->h));
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ OSTRACE(("SEEK file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return 0;
+#endif
+}
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+/* Forward references to VFS helper methods used for memory mapped files */
+static int winMapfile(winFile*, sqlite3_int64);
+static int winUnmapfile(winFile*);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Close a file.
+**
+** It is reported that an attempt to close a handle might sometimes
+** fail. This is a very unreasonable result, but Windows is notorious
+** for being unreasonable so I do not doubt that it might happen. If
+** the close fails, we pause for 100 milliseconds and try again. As
+** many as MX_CLOSE_ATTEMPT attempts to close the handle are made before
+** giving up and returning an error.
+*/
+#define MX_CLOSE_ATTEMPT 3
+static int winClose(sqlite3_file *id){
+ int rc, cnt = 0;
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id;
+
+ assert( id!=0 );
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ assert( pFile->pShm==0 );
+#endif
+ assert( pFile->h!=NULL && pFile->h!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE );
+ OSTRACE(("CLOSE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ winUnmapfile(pFile);
+#endif
+
+ do{
+ rc = osCloseHandle(pFile->h);
+ /* SimulateIOError( rc=0; cnt=MX_CLOSE_ATTEMPT; ); */
+ }while( rc==0 && ++cnt < MX_CLOSE_ATTEMPT && (sqlite3_win32_sleep(100), 1) );
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+#define WINCE_DELETION_ATTEMPTS 3
+ {
+ winVfsAppData *pAppData = (winVfsAppData*)pFile->pVfs->pAppData;
+ if( pAppData==NULL || !pAppData->bNoLock ){
+ winceDestroyLock(pFile);
+ }
+ }
+ if( pFile->zDeleteOnClose ){
+ int cnt = 0;
+ while(
+ osDeleteFileW(pFile->zDeleteOnClose)==0
+ && osGetFileAttributesW(pFile->zDeleteOnClose)!=0xffffffff
+ && cnt++ < WINCE_DELETION_ATTEMPTS
+ ){
+ sqlite3_win32_sleep(100); /* Wait a little before trying again */
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(pFile->zDeleteOnClose);
+ }
+#endif
+ if( rc ){
+ pFile->h = NULL;
+ }
+ OpenCounter(-1);
+ OSTRACE(("CLOSE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=%s\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h, rc ? "ok" : "failed"));
+ return rc ? SQLITE_OK
+ : winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_CLOSE, osGetLastError(),
+ "winClose", pFile->zPath);
+}
+
+/*
+** Read data from a file into a buffer. Return SQLITE_OK if all
+** bytes were read successfully and SQLITE_IOERR if anything goes
+** wrong.
+*/
+static int winRead(
+ sqlite3_file *id, /* File to read from */
+ void *pBuf, /* Write content into this buffer */
+ int amt, /* Number of bytes to read */
+ sqlite3_int64 offset /* Begin reading at this offset */
+){
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !defined(SQLITE_WIN32_NO_OVERLAPPED)
+ OVERLAPPED overlapped; /* The offset for ReadFile. */
+#endif
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id; /* file handle */
+ DWORD nRead; /* Number of bytes actually read from file */
+ int nRetry = 0; /* Number of retrys */
+
+ assert( id!=0 );
+ assert( amt>0 );
+ assert( offset>=0 );
+ SimulateIOError(return SQLITE_IOERR_READ);
+ OSTRACE(("READ pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, buffer=%p, amount=%d, "
+ "offset=%lld, lock=%d\n", osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile,
+ pFile->h, pBuf, amt, offset, pFile->locktype));
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ /* Deal with as much of this read request as possible by transfering
+ ** data from the memory mapping using memcpy(). */
+ if( offsetmmapSize ){
+ if( offset+amt <= pFile->mmapSize ){
+ memcpy(pBuf, &((u8 *)(pFile->pMapRegion))[offset], amt);
+ OSTRACE(("READ-MMAP pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ int nCopy = (int)(pFile->mmapSize - offset);
+ memcpy(pBuf, &((u8 *)(pFile->pMapRegion))[offset], nCopy);
+ pBuf = &((u8 *)pBuf)[nCopy];
+ amt -= nCopy;
+ offset += nCopy;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE || defined(SQLITE_WIN32_NO_OVERLAPPED)
+ if( winSeekFile(pFile, offset) ){
+ OSTRACE(("READ pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_FULL\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_FULL;
+ }
+ while( !osReadFile(pFile->h, pBuf, amt, &nRead, 0) ){
+#else
+ memset(&overlapped, 0, sizeof(OVERLAPPED));
+ overlapped.Offset = (LONG)(offset & 0xffffffff);
+ overlapped.OffsetHigh = (LONG)((offset>>32) & 0x7fffffff);
+ while( !osReadFile(pFile->h, pBuf, amt, &nRead, &overlapped) &&
+ osGetLastError()!=ERROR_HANDLE_EOF ){
+#endif
+ DWORD lastErrno;
+ if( winRetryIoerr(&nRetry, &lastErrno) ) continue;
+ pFile->lastErrno = lastErrno;
+ OSTRACE(("READ pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_READ\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_READ, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winRead", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+ winLogIoerr(nRetry, __LINE__);
+ if( nRead<(DWORD)amt ){
+ /* Unread parts of the buffer must be zero-filled */
+ memset(&((char*)pBuf)[nRead], 0, amt-nRead);
+ OSTRACE(("READ pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ;
+ }
+
+ OSTRACE(("READ pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Write data from a buffer into a file. Return SQLITE_OK on success
+** or some other error code on failure.
+*/
+static int winWrite(
+ sqlite3_file *id, /* File to write into */
+ const void *pBuf, /* The bytes to be written */
+ int amt, /* Number of bytes to write */
+ sqlite3_int64 offset /* Offset into the file to begin writing at */
+){
+ int rc = 0; /* True if error has occurred, else false */
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id; /* File handle */
+ int nRetry = 0; /* Number of retries */
+
+ assert( amt>0 );
+ assert( pFile );
+ SimulateIOError(return SQLITE_IOERR_WRITE);
+ SimulateDiskfullError(return SQLITE_FULL);
+
+ OSTRACE(("WRITE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, buffer=%p, amount=%d, "
+ "offset=%lld, lock=%d\n", osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile,
+ pFile->h, pBuf, amt, offset, pFile->locktype));
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_MMAP_READWRITE) && SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ /* Deal with as much of this write request as possible by transfering
+ ** data from the memory mapping using memcpy(). */
+ if( offsetmmapSize ){
+ if( offset+amt <= pFile->mmapSize ){
+ memcpy(&((u8 *)(pFile->pMapRegion))[offset], pBuf, amt);
+ OSTRACE(("WRITE-MMAP pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ int nCopy = (int)(pFile->mmapSize - offset);
+ memcpy(&((u8 *)(pFile->pMapRegion))[offset], pBuf, nCopy);
+ pBuf = &((u8 *)pBuf)[nCopy];
+ amt -= nCopy;
+ offset += nCopy;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE || defined(SQLITE_WIN32_NO_OVERLAPPED)
+ rc = winSeekFile(pFile, offset);
+ if( rc==0 ){
+#else
+ {
+#endif
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !defined(SQLITE_WIN32_NO_OVERLAPPED)
+ OVERLAPPED overlapped; /* The offset for WriteFile. */
+#endif
+ u8 *aRem = (u8 *)pBuf; /* Data yet to be written */
+ int nRem = amt; /* Number of bytes yet to be written */
+ DWORD nWrite; /* Bytes written by each WriteFile() call */
+ DWORD lastErrno = NO_ERROR; /* Value returned by GetLastError() */
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !defined(SQLITE_WIN32_NO_OVERLAPPED)
+ memset(&overlapped, 0, sizeof(OVERLAPPED));
+ overlapped.Offset = (LONG)(offset & 0xffffffff);
+ overlapped.OffsetHigh = (LONG)((offset>>32) & 0x7fffffff);
+#endif
+
+ while( nRem>0 ){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE || defined(SQLITE_WIN32_NO_OVERLAPPED)
+ if( !osWriteFile(pFile->h, aRem, nRem, &nWrite, 0) ){
+#else
+ if( !osWriteFile(pFile->h, aRem, nRem, &nWrite, &overlapped) ){
+#endif
+ if( winRetryIoerr(&nRetry, &lastErrno) ) continue;
+ break;
+ }
+ assert( nWrite==0 || nWrite<=(DWORD)nRem );
+ if( nWrite==0 || nWrite>(DWORD)nRem ){
+ lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ break;
+ }
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !defined(SQLITE_WIN32_NO_OVERLAPPED)
+ offset += nWrite;
+ overlapped.Offset = (LONG)(offset & 0xffffffff);
+ overlapped.OffsetHigh = (LONG)((offset>>32) & 0x7fffffff);
+#endif
+ aRem += nWrite;
+ nRem -= nWrite;
+ }
+ if( nRem>0 ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = lastErrno;
+ rc = 1;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if( rc ){
+ if( ( pFile->lastErrno==ERROR_HANDLE_DISK_FULL )
+ || ( pFile->lastErrno==ERROR_DISK_FULL )){
+ OSTRACE(("WRITE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_FULL\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_FULL, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winWrite1", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("WRITE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_WRITE\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_WRITE, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winWrite2", pFile->zPath);
+ }else{
+ winLogIoerr(nRetry, __LINE__);
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("WRITE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Truncate an open file to a specified size
+*/
+static int winTruncate(sqlite3_file *id, sqlite3_int64 nByte){
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id; /* File handle object */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Return code for this function */
+ DWORD lastErrno;
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ sqlite3_int64 oldMmapSize;
+ if( pFile->nFetchOut>0 ){
+ /* File truncation is a no-op if there are outstanding memory mapped
+ ** pages. This is because truncating the file means temporarily unmapping
+ ** the file, and that might delete memory out from under existing cursors.
+ **
+ ** This can result in incremental vacuum not truncating the file,
+ ** if there is an active read cursor when the incremental vacuum occurs.
+ ** No real harm comes of this - the database file is not corrupted,
+ ** though some folks might complain that the file is bigger than it
+ ** needs to be.
+ **
+ ** The only feasible work-around is to defer the truncation until after
+ ** all references to memory-mapped content are closed. That is doable,
+ ** but involves adding a few branches in the common write code path which
+ ** could slow down normal operations slightly. Hence, we have decided for
+ ** now to simply make trancations a no-op if there are pending reads. We
+ ** can maybe revisit this decision in the future.
+ */
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ SimulateIOError(return SQLITE_IOERR_TRUNCATE);
+ OSTRACE(("TRUNCATE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, size=%lld, lock=%d\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h, nByte, pFile->locktype));
+
+ /* If the user has configured a chunk-size for this file, truncate the
+ ** file so that it consists of an integer number of chunks (i.e. the
+ ** actual file size after the operation may be larger than the requested
+ ** size).
+ */
+ if( pFile->szChunk>0 ){
+ nByte = ((nByte + pFile->szChunk - 1)/pFile->szChunk) * pFile->szChunk;
+ }
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ if( pFile->pMapRegion ){
+ oldMmapSize = pFile->mmapSize;
+ }else{
+ oldMmapSize = 0;
+ }
+ winUnmapfile(pFile);
+#endif
+
+ /* SetEndOfFile() returns non-zero when successful, or zero when it fails. */
+ if( winSeekFile(pFile, nByte) ){
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_TRUNCATE, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winTruncate1", pFile->zPath);
+ }else if( 0==osSetEndOfFile(pFile->h) &&
+ ((lastErrno = osGetLastError())!=ERROR_USER_MAPPED_FILE) ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = lastErrno;
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_TRUNCATE, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winTruncate2", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && oldMmapSize>0 ){
+ if( oldMmapSize>nByte ){
+ winMapfile(pFile, -1);
+ }else{
+ winMapfile(pFile, oldMmapSize);
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ OSTRACE(("TRUNCATE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=%s\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+/*
+** Count the number of fullsyncs and normal syncs. This is used to test
+** that syncs and fullsyncs are occuring at the right times.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_sync_count = 0;
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_fullsync_count = 0;
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Make sure all writes to a particular file are committed to disk.
+*/
+static int winSync(sqlite3_file *id, int flags){
+#ifndef SQLITE_NO_SYNC
+ /*
+ ** Used only when SQLITE_NO_SYNC is not defined.
+ */
+ BOOL rc;
+#endif
+#if !defined(NDEBUG) || !defined(SQLITE_NO_SYNC) || \
+ defined(SQLITE_HAVE_OS_TRACE)
+ /*
+ ** Used when SQLITE_NO_SYNC is not defined and by the assert() and/or
+ ** OSTRACE() macros.
+ */
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id;
+#else
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(id);
+#endif
+
+ assert( pFile );
+ /* Check that one of SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL or FULL was passed */
+ assert((flags&0x0F)==SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL
+ || (flags&0x0F)==SQLITE_SYNC_FULL
+ );
+
+ /* Unix cannot, but some systems may return SQLITE_FULL from here. This
+ ** line is to test that doing so does not cause any problems.
+ */
+ SimulateDiskfullError( return SQLITE_FULL );
+
+ OSTRACE(("SYNC pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, flags=%x, lock=%d\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h, flags,
+ pFile->locktype));
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_TEST
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(flags);
+#else
+ if( (flags&0x0F)==SQLITE_SYNC_FULL ){
+ sqlite3_fullsync_count++;
+ }
+ sqlite3_sync_count++;
+#endif
+
+ /* If we compiled with the SQLITE_NO_SYNC flag, then syncing is a
+ ** no-op
+ */
+#ifdef SQLITE_NO_SYNC
+ OSTRACE(("SYNC-NOP pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+#else
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ if( pFile->pMapRegion ){
+ if( osFlushViewOfFile(pFile->pMapRegion, 0) ){
+ OSTRACE(("SYNC-MMAP pid=%lu, pFile=%p, pMapRegion=%p, "
+ "rc=SQLITE_OK\n", osGetCurrentProcessId(),
+ pFile, pFile->pMapRegion));
+ }else{
+ pFile->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ OSTRACE(("SYNC-MMAP pid=%lu, pFile=%p, pMapRegion=%p, "
+ "rc=SQLITE_IOERR_MMAP\n", osGetCurrentProcessId(),
+ pFile, pFile->pMapRegion));
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_MMAP, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winSync1", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ rc = osFlushFileBuffers(pFile->h);
+ SimulateIOError( rc=FALSE );
+ if( rc ){
+ OSTRACE(("SYNC pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ pFile->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ OSTRACE(("SYNC pid=%lu, pFile=%p, file=%p, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_FSYNC\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->h));
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_FSYNC, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winSync2", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Determine the current size of a file in bytes
+*/
+static int winFileSize(sqlite3_file *id, sqlite3_int64 *pSize){
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ assert( id!=0 );
+ assert( pSize!=0 );
+ SimulateIOError(return SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT);
+ OSTRACE(("SIZE file=%p, pSize=%p\n", pFile->h, pSize));
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ {
+ FILE_STANDARD_INFO info;
+ if( osGetFileInformationByHandleEx(pFile->h, FileStandardInfo,
+ &info, sizeof(info)) ){
+ *pSize = info.EndOfFile.QuadPart;
+ }else{
+ pFile->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winFileSize", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ {
+ DWORD upperBits;
+ DWORD lowerBits;
+ DWORD lastErrno;
+
+ lowerBits = osGetFileSize(pFile->h, &upperBits);
+ *pSize = (((sqlite3_int64)upperBits)<<32) + lowerBits;
+ if( (lowerBits == INVALID_FILE_SIZE)
+ && ((lastErrno = osGetLastError())!=NO_ERROR) ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = lastErrno;
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winFileSize", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ OSTRACE(("SIZE file=%p, pSize=%p, *pSize=%lld, rc=%s\n",
+ pFile->h, pSize, *pSize, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** LOCKFILE_FAIL_IMMEDIATELY is undefined on some Windows systems.
+*/
+#ifndef LOCKFILE_FAIL_IMMEDIATELY
+# define LOCKFILE_FAIL_IMMEDIATELY 1
+#endif
+
+#ifndef LOCKFILE_EXCLUSIVE_LOCK
+# define LOCKFILE_EXCLUSIVE_LOCK 2
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Historically, SQLite has used both the LockFile and LockFileEx functions.
+** When the LockFile function was used, it was always expected to fail
+** immediately if the lock could not be obtained. Also, it always expected to
+** obtain an exclusive lock. These flags are used with the LockFileEx function
+** and reflect those expectations; therefore, they should not be changed.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_LOCKFILE_FLAGS
+# define SQLITE_LOCKFILE_FLAGS (LOCKFILE_FAIL_IMMEDIATELY | \
+ LOCKFILE_EXCLUSIVE_LOCK)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Currently, SQLite never calls the LockFileEx function without wanting the
+** call to fail immediately if the lock cannot be obtained.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_LOCKFILEEX_FLAGS
+# define SQLITE_LOCKFILEEX_FLAGS (LOCKFILE_FAIL_IMMEDIATELY)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Acquire a reader lock.
+** Different API routines are called depending on whether or not this
+** is Win9x or WinNT.
+*/
+static int winGetReadLock(winFile *pFile){
+ int res;
+ OSTRACE(("READ-LOCK file=%p, lock=%d\n", pFile->h, pFile->locktype));
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ /*
+ ** NOTE: Windows CE is handled differently here due its lack of the Win32
+ ** API LockFileEx.
+ */
+ res = winceLockFile(&pFile->h, SHARED_FIRST, 0, 1, 0);
+#else
+ res = winLockFile(&pFile->h, SQLITE_LOCKFILEEX_FLAGS, SHARED_FIRST, 0,
+ SHARED_SIZE, 0);
+#endif
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+ else{
+ int lk;
+ sqlite3_randomness(sizeof(lk), &lk);
+ pFile->sharedLockByte = (short)((lk & 0x7fffffff)%(SHARED_SIZE - 1));
+ res = winLockFile(&pFile->h, SQLITE_LOCKFILE_FLAGS,
+ SHARED_FIRST+pFile->sharedLockByte, 0, 1, 0);
+ }
+#endif
+ if( res == 0 ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ /* No need to log a failure to lock */
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("READ-LOCK file=%p, result=%d\n", pFile->h, res));
+ return res;
+}
+
+/*
+** Undo a readlock
+*/
+static int winUnlockReadLock(winFile *pFile){
+ int res;
+ DWORD lastErrno;
+ OSTRACE(("READ-UNLOCK file=%p, lock=%d\n", pFile->h, pFile->locktype));
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+ res = winUnlockFile(&pFile->h, SHARED_FIRST, 0, SHARED_SIZE, 0);
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+ else{
+ res = winUnlockFile(&pFile->h, SHARED_FIRST+pFile->sharedLockByte, 0, 1, 0);
+ }
+#endif
+ if( res==0 && ((lastErrno = osGetLastError())!=ERROR_NOT_LOCKED) ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = lastErrno;
+ winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winUnlockReadLock", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("READ-UNLOCK file=%p, result=%d\n", pFile->h, res));
+ return res;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lock the file with the lock specified by parameter locktype - one
+** of the following:
+**
+** (1) SHARED_LOCK
+** (2) RESERVED_LOCK
+** (3) PENDING_LOCK
+** (4) EXCLUSIVE_LOCK
+**
+** Sometimes when requesting one lock state, additional lock states
+** are inserted in between. The locking might fail on one of the later
+** transitions leaving the lock state different from what it started but
+** still short of its goal. The following chart shows the allowed
+** transitions and the inserted intermediate states:
+**
+** UNLOCKED -> SHARED
+** SHARED -> RESERVED
+** SHARED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** RESERVED -> (PENDING) -> EXCLUSIVE
+** PENDING -> EXCLUSIVE
+**
+** This routine will only increase a lock. The winUnlock() routine
+** erases all locks at once and returns us immediately to locking level 0.
+** It is not possible to lower the locking level one step at a time. You
+** must go straight to locking level 0.
+*/
+static int winLock(sqlite3_file *id, int locktype){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Return code from subroutines */
+ int res = 1; /* Result of a Windows lock call */
+ int newLocktype; /* Set pFile->locktype to this value before exiting */
+ int gotPendingLock = 0;/* True if we acquired a PENDING lock this time */
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id;
+ DWORD lastErrno = NO_ERROR;
+
+ assert( id!=0 );
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK file=%p, oldLock=%d(%d), newLock=%d\n",
+ pFile->h, pFile->locktype, pFile->sharedLockByte, locktype));
+
+ /* If there is already a lock of this type or more restrictive on the
+ ** OsFile, do nothing. Don't use the end_lock: exit path, as
+ ** sqlite3OsEnterMutex() hasn't been called yet.
+ */
+ if( pFile->locktype>=locktype ){
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK-HELD file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* Do not allow any kind of write-lock on a read-only database
+ */
+ if( (pFile->ctrlFlags & WINFILE_RDONLY)!=0 && locktype>=RESERVED_LOCK ){
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK;
+ }
+
+ /* Make sure the locking sequence is correct
+ */
+ assert( pFile->locktype!=NO_LOCK || locktype==SHARED_LOCK );
+ assert( locktype!=PENDING_LOCK );
+ assert( locktype!=RESERVED_LOCK || pFile->locktype==SHARED_LOCK );
+
+ /* Lock the PENDING_LOCK byte if we need to acquire a PENDING lock or
+ ** a SHARED lock. If we are acquiring a SHARED lock, the acquisition of
+ ** the PENDING_LOCK byte is temporary.
+ */
+ newLocktype = pFile->locktype;
+ if( pFile->locktype==NO_LOCK
+ || (locktype==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK && pFile->locktype<=RESERVED_LOCK)
+ ){
+ int cnt = 3;
+ while( cnt-->0 && (res = winLockFile(&pFile->h, SQLITE_LOCKFILE_FLAGS,
+ PENDING_BYTE, 0, 1, 0))==0 ){
+ /* Try 3 times to get the pending lock. This is needed to work
+ ** around problems caused by indexing and/or anti-virus software on
+ ** Windows systems.
+ ** If you are using this code as a model for alternative VFSes, do not
+ ** copy this retry logic. It is a hack intended for Windows only.
+ */
+ lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK-PENDING-FAIL file=%p, count=%d, result=%d\n",
+ pFile->h, cnt, res));
+ if( lastErrno==ERROR_INVALID_HANDLE ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = lastErrno;
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_LOCK;
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK-FAIL file=%p, count=%d, rc=%s\n",
+ pFile->h, cnt, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+ }
+ if( cnt ) sqlite3_win32_sleep(1);
+ }
+ gotPendingLock = res;
+ if( !res ){
+ lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Acquire a shared lock
+ */
+ if( locktype==SHARED_LOCK && res ){
+ assert( pFile->locktype==NO_LOCK );
+ res = winGetReadLock(pFile);
+ if( res ){
+ newLocktype = SHARED_LOCK;
+ }else{
+ lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Acquire a RESERVED lock
+ */
+ if( locktype==RESERVED_LOCK && res ){
+ assert( pFile->locktype==SHARED_LOCK );
+ res = winLockFile(&pFile->h, SQLITE_LOCKFILE_FLAGS, RESERVED_BYTE, 0, 1, 0);
+ if( res ){
+ newLocktype = RESERVED_LOCK;
+ }else{
+ lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Acquire a PENDING lock
+ */
+ if( locktype==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK && res ){
+ newLocktype = PENDING_LOCK;
+ gotPendingLock = 0;
+ }
+
+ /* Acquire an EXCLUSIVE lock
+ */
+ if( locktype==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK && res ){
+ assert( pFile->locktype>=SHARED_LOCK );
+ res = winUnlockReadLock(pFile);
+ res = winLockFile(&pFile->h, SQLITE_LOCKFILE_FLAGS, SHARED_FIRST, 0,
+ SHARED_SIZE, 0);
+ if( res ){
+ newLocktype = EXCLUSIVE_LOCK;
+ }else{
+ lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ winGetReadLock(pFile);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If we are holding a PENDING lock that ought to be released, then
+ ** release it now.
+ */
+ if( gotPendingLock && locktype==SHARED_LOCK ){
+ winUnlockFile(&pFile->h, PENDING_BYTE, 0, 1, 0);
+ }
+
+ /* Update the state of the lock has held in the file descriptor then
+ ** return the appropriate result code.
+ */
+ if( res ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ pFile->lastErrno = lastErrno;
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK-FAIL file=%p, wanted=%d, got=%d\n",
+ pFile->h, locktype, newLocktype));
+ }
+ pFile->locktype = (u8)newLocktype;
+ OSTRACE(("LOCK file=%p, lock=%d, rc=%s\n",
+ pFile->h, pFile->locktype, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This routine checks if there is a RESERVED lock held on the specified
+** file by this or any other process. If such a lock is held, return
+** non-zero, otherwise zero.
+*/
+static int winCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id, int *pResOut){
+ int res;
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id;
+
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_IOERR_CHECKRESERVEDLOCK; );
+ OSTRACE(("TEST-WR-LOCK file=%p, pResOut=%p\n", pFile->h, pResOut));
+
+ assert( id!=0 );
+ if( pFile->locktype>=RESERVED_LOCK ){
+ res = 1;
+ OSTRACE(("TEST-WR-LOCK file=%p, result=%d (local)\n", pFile->h, res));
+ }else{
+ res = winLockFile(&pFile->h, SQLITE_LOCKFILEEX_FLAGS,RESERVED_BYTE,0,1,0);
+ if( res ){
+ winUnlockFile(&pFile->h, RESERVED_BYTE, 0, 1, 0);
+ }
+ res = !res;
+ OSTRACE(("TEST-WR-LOCK file=%p, result=%d (remote)\n", pFile->h, res));
+ }
+ *pResOut = res;
+ OSTRACE(("TEST-WR-LOCK file=%p, pResOut=%p, *pResOut=%d, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ pFile->h, pResOut, *pResOut));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lower the locking level on file descriptor id to locktype. locktype
+** must be either NO_LOCK or SHARED_LOCK.
+**
+** If the locking level of the file descriptor is already at or below
+** the requested locking level, this routine is a no-op.
+**
+** It is not possible for this routine to fail if the second argument
+** is NO_LOCK. If the second argument is SHARED_LOCK then this routine
+** might return SQLITE_IOERR;
+*/
+static int winUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int locktype){
+ int type;
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ assert( pFile!=0 );
+ assert( locktype<=SHARED_LOCK );
+ OSTRACE(("UNLOCK file=%p, oldLock=%d(%d), newLock=%d\n",
+ pFile->h, pFile->locktype, pFile->sharedLockByte, locktype));
+ type = pFile->locktype;
+ if( type>=EXCLUSIVE_LOCK ){
+ winUnlockFile(&pFile->h, SHARED_FIRST, 0, SHARED_SIZE, 0);
+ if( locktype==SHARED_LOCK && !winGetReadLock(pFile) ){
+ /* This should never happen. We should always be able to
+ ** reacquire the read lock */
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK, osGetLastError(),
+ "winUnlock", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+ }
+ if( type>=RESERVED_LOCK ){
+ winUnlockFile(&pFile->h, RESERVED_BYTE, 0, 1, 0);
+ }
+ if( locktype==NO_LOCK && type>=SHARED_LOCK ){
+ winUnlockReadLock(pFile);
+ }
+ if( type>=PENDING_LOCK ){
+ winUnlockFile(&pFile->h, PENDING_BYTE, 0, 1, 0);
+ }
+ pFile->locktype = (u8)locktype;
+ OSTRACE(("UNLOCK file=%p, lock=%d, rc=%s\n",
+ pFile->h, pFile->locktype, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/******************************************************************************
+****************************** No-op Locking **********************************
+**
+** Of the various locking implementations available, this is by far the
+** simplest: locking is ignored. No attempt is made to lock the database
+** file for reading or writing.
+**
+** This locking mode is appropriate for use on read-only databases
+** (ex: databases that are burned into CD-ROM, for example.) It can
+** also be used if the application employs some external mechanism to
+** prevent simultaneous access of the same database by two or more
+** database connections. But there is a serious risk of database
+** corruption if this locking mode is used in situations where multiple
+** database connections are accessing the same database file at the same
+** time and one or more of those connections are writing.
+*/
+
+static int winNolockLock(sqlite3_file *id, int locktype){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(id);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(locktype);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+static int winNolockCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id, int *pResOut){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(id);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pResOut);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+static int winNolockUnlock(sqlite3_file *id, int locktype){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(id);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(locktype);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/******************* End of the no-op lock implementation *********************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/*
+** If *pArg is initially negative then this is a query. Set *pArg to
+** 1 or 0 depending on whether or not bit mask of pFile->ctrlFlags is set.
+**
+** If *pArg is 0 or 1, then clear or set the mask bit of pFile->ctrlFlags.
+*/
+static void winModeBit(winFile *pFile, unsigned char mask, int *pArg){
+ if( *pArg<0 ){
+ *pArg = (pFile->ctrlFlags & mask)!=0;
+ }else if( (*pArg)==0 ){
+ pFile->ctrlFlags &= ~mask;
+ }else{
+ pFile->ctrlFlags |= mask;
+ }
+}
+
+/* Forward references to VFS helper methods used for temporary files */
+static int winGetTempname(sqlite3_vfs *, char **);
+static int winIsDir(const void *);
+static BOOL winIsLongPathPrefix(const char *);
+static BOOL winIsDriveLetterAndColon(const char *);
+
+/*
+** Control and query of the open file handle.
+*/
+static int winFileControl(sqlite3_file *id, int op, void *pArg){
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id;
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, op=%d, pArg=%p\n", pFile->h, op, pArg));
+ switch( op ){
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCKSTATE: {
+ *(int*)pArg = pFile->locktype;
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_LAST_ERRNO: {
+ *(int*)pArg = (int)pFile->lastErrno;
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_CHUNK_SIZE: {
+ pFile->szChunk = *(int *)pArg;
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_HINT: {
+ if( pFile->szChunk>0 ){
+ sqlite3_int64 oldSz;
+ int rc = winFileSize(id, &oldSz);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ sqlite3_int64 newSz = *(sqlite3_int64*)pArg;
+ if( newSz>oldSz ){
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(1);
+ rc = winTruncate(id, newSz);
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(0);
+ }
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=%s\n", pFile->h, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_PERSIST_WAL: {
+ winModeBit(pFile, WINFILE_PERSIST_WAL, (int*)pArg);
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE: {
+ winModeBit(pFile, WINFILE_PSOW, (int*)pArg);
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_VFSNAME: {
+ *(char**)pArg = sqlite3_mprintf("%s", pFile->pVfs->zName);
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_AV_RETRY: {
+ int *a = (int*)pArg;
+ if( a[0]>0 ){
+ winIoerrRetry = a[0];
+ }else{
+ a[0] = winIoerrRetry;
+ }
+ if( a[1]>0 ){
+ winIoerrRetryDelay = a[1];
+ }else{
+ a[1] = winIoerrRetryDelay;
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_GET_HANDLE: {
+ LPHANDLE phFile = (LPHANDLE)pArg;
+ *phFile = pFile->h;
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_WIN32_SET_HANDLE: {
+ LPHANDLE phFile = (LPHANDLE)pArg;
+ HANDLE hOldFile = pFile->h;
+ pFile->h = *phFile;
+ *phFile = hOldFile;
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL oldFile=%p, newFile=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ hOldFile, pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+#endif
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_TEMPFILENAME: {
+ char *zTFile = 0;
+ int rc = winGetTempname(pFile->pVfs, &zTFile);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ *(char**)pArg = zTFile;
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=%s\n", pFile->h, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+ }
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ case SQLITE_FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE: {
+ i64 newLimit = *(i64*)pArg;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ if( newLimit>sqlite3GlobalConfig.mxMmap ){
+ newLimit = sqlite3GlobalConfig.mxMmap;
+ }
+
+ /* The value of newLimit may be eventually cast to (SIZE_T) and passed
+ ** to MapViewOfFile(). Restrict its value to 2GB if (SIZE_T) is not at
+ ** least a 64-bit type. */
+ if( newLimit>0 && sizeof(SIZE_T)<8 ){
+ newLimit = (newLimit & 0x7FFFFFFF);
+ }
+
+ *(i64*)pArg = pFile->mmapSizeMax;
+ if( newLimit>=0 && newLimit!=pFile->mmapSizeMax && pFile->nFetchOut==0 ){
+ pFile->mmapSizeMax = newLimit;
+ if( pFile->mmapSize>0 ){
+ winUnmapfile(pFile);
+ rc = winMapfile(pFile, -1);
+ }
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=%s\n", pFile->h, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+ }
+#endif
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("FCNTL file=%p, rc=SQLITE_NOTFOUND\n", pFile->h));
+ return SQLITE_NOTFOUND;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the sector size in bytes of the underlying block device for
+** the specified file. This is almost always 512 bytes, but may be
+** larger for some devices.
+**
+** SQLite code assumes this function cannot fail. It also assumes that
+** if two files are created in the same file-system directory (i.e.
+** a database and its journal file) that the sector size will be the
+** same for both.
+*/
+static int winSectorSize(sqlite3_file *id){
+ (void)id;
+ return SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return a vector of device characteristics.
+*/
+static int winDeviceCharacteristics(sqlite3_file *id){
+ winFile *p = (winFile*)id;
+ return SQLITE_IOCAP_UNDELETABLE_WHEN_OPEN |
+ ((p->ctrlFlags & WINFILE_PSOW)?SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE:0);
+}
+
+/*
+** Windows will only let you create file view mappings
+** on allocation size granularity boundaries.
+** During sqlite3_os_init() we do a GetSystemInfo()
+** to get the granularity size.
+*/
+static SYSTEM_INFO winSysInfo;
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+
+/*
+** Helper functions to obtain and relinquish the global mutex. The
+** global mutex is used to protect the winLockInfo objects used by
+** this file, all of which may be shared by multiple threads.
+**
+** Function winShmMutexHeld() is used to assert() that the global mutex
+** is held when required. This function is only used as part of assert()
+** statements. e.g.
+**
+** winShmEnterMutex()
+** assert( winShmMutexHeld() );
+** winShmLeaveMutex()
+*/
+static sqlite3_mutex *winBigLock = 0;
+static void winShmEnterMutex(void){
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(winBigLock);
+}
+static void winShmLeaveMutex(void){
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(winBigLock);
+}
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+static int winShmMutexHeld(void) {
+ return sqlite3_mutex_held(winBigLock);
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Object used to represent a single file opened and mmapped to provide
+** shared memory. When multiple threads all reference the same
+** log-summary, each thread has its own winFile object, but they all
+** point to a single instance of this object. In other words, each
+** log-summary is opened only once per process.
+**
+** winShmMutexHeld() must be true when creating or destroying
+** this object or while reading or writing the following fields:
+**
+** nRef
+** pNext
+**
+** The following fields are read-only after the object is created:
+**
+** fid
+** zFilename
+**
+** Either winShmNode.mutex must be held or winShmNode.nRef==0 and
+** winShmMutexHeld() is true when reading or writing any other field
+** in this structure.
+**
+*/
+struct winShmNode {
+ sqlite3_mutex *mutex; /* Mutex to access this object */
+ char *zFilename; /* Name of the file */
+ winFile hFile; /* File handle from winOpen */
+
+ int szRegion; /* Size of shared-memory regions */
+ int nRegion; /* Size of array apRegion */
+ u8 isReadonly; /* True if read-only */
+ u8 isUnlocked; /* True if no DMS lock held */
+
+ struct ShmRegion {
+ HANDLE hMap; /* File handle from CreateFileMapping */
+ void *pMap;
+ } *aRegion;
+ DWORD lastErrno; /* The Windows errno from the last I/O error */
+
+ int nRef; /* Number of winShm objects pointing to this */
+ winShm *pFirst; /* All winShm objects pointing to this */
+ winShmNode *pNext; /* Next in list of all winShmNode objects */
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_HAVE_OS_TRACE)
+ u8 nextShmId; /* Next available winShm.id value */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** A global array of all winShmNode objects.
+**
+** The winShmMutexHeld() must be true while reading or writing this list.
+*/
+static winShmNode *winShmNodeList = 0;
+
+/*
+** Structure used internally by this VFS to record the state of an
+** open shared memory connection.
+**
+** The following fields are initialized when this object is created and
+** are read-only thereafter:
+**
+** winShm.pShmNode
+** winShm.id
+**
+** All other fields are read/write. The winShm.pShmNode->mutex must be held
+** while accessing any read/write fields.
+*/
+struct winShm {
+ winShmNode *pShmNode; /* The underlying winShmNode object */
+ winShm *pNext; /* Next winShm with the same winShmNode */
+ u8 hasMutex; /* True if holding the winShmNode mutex */
+ u16 sharedMask; /* Mask of shared locks held */
+ u16 exclMask; /* Mask of exclusive locks held */
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_HAVE_OS_TRACE)
+ u8 id; /* Id of this connection with its winShmNode */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** Constants used for locking
+*/
+#define WIN_SHM_BASE ((22+SQLITE_SHM_NLOCK)*4) /* first lock byte */
+#define WIN_SHM_DMS (WIN_SHM_BASE+SQLITE_SHM_NLOCK) /* deadman switch */
+
+/*
+** Apply advisory locks for all n bytes beginning at ofst.
+*/
+#define WINSHM_UNLCK 1
+#define WINSHM_RDLCK 2
+#define WINSHM_WRLCK 3
+static int winShmSystemLock(
+ winShmNode *pFile, /* Apply locks to this open shared-memory segment */
+ int lockType, /* WINSHM_UNLCK, WINSHM_RDLCK, or WINSHM_WRLCK */
+ int ofst, /* Offset to first byte to be locked/unlocked */
+ int nByte /* Number of bytes to lock or unlock */
+){
+ int rc = 0; /* Result code form Lock/UnlockFileEx() */
+
+ /* Access to the winShmNode object is serialized by the caller */
+ assert( pFile->nRef==0 || sqlite3_mutex_held(pFile->mutex) );
+
+ OSTRACE(("SHM-LOCK file=%p, lock=%d, offset=%d, size=%d\n",
+ pFile->hFile.h, lockType, ofst, nByte));
+
+ /* Release/Acquire the system-level lock */
+ if( lockType==WINSHM_UNLCK ){
+ rc = winUnlockFile(&pFile->hFile.h, ofst, 0, nByte, 0);
+ }else{
+ /* Initialize the locking parameters */
+ DWORD dwFlags = LOCKFILE_FAIL_IMMEDIATELY;
+ if( lockType == WINSHM_WRLCK ) dwFlags |= LOCKFILE_EXCLUSIVE_LOCK;
+ rc = winLockFile(&pFile->hFile.h, dwFlags, ofst, 0, nByte, 0);
+ }
+
+ if( rc!= 0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ pFile->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ }
+
+ OSTRACE(("SHM-LOCK file=%p, func=%s, errno=%lu, rc=%s\n",
+ pFile->hFile.h, (lockType == WINSHM_UNLCK) ? "winUnlockFile" :
+ "winLockFile", pFile->lastErrno, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/* Forward references to VFS methods */
+static int winOpen(sqlite3_vfs*,const char*,sqlite3_file*,int,int*);
+static int winDelete(sqlite3_vfs *,const char*,int);
+
+/*
+** Purge the winShmNodeList list of all entries with winShmNode.nRef==0.
+**
+** This is not a VFS shared-memory method; it is a utility function called
+** by VFS shared-memory methods.
+*/
+static void winShmPurge(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int deleteFlag){
+ winShmNode **pp;
+ winShmNode *p;
+ assert( winShmMutexHeld() );
+ OSTRACE(("SHM-PURGE pid=%lu, deleteFlag=%d\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), deleteFlag));
+ pp = &winShmNodeList;
+ while( (p = *pp)!=0 ){
+ if( p->nRef==0 ){
+ int i;
+ if( p->mutex ){ sqlite3_mutex_free(p->mutex); }
+ for(i=0; inRegion; i++){
+ BOOL bRc = osUnmapViewOfFile(p->aRegion[i].pMap);
+ OSTRACE(("SHM-PURGE-UNMAP pid=%lu, region=%d, rc=%s\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), i, bRc ? "ok" : "failed"));
+ UNUSED_VARIABLE_VALUE(bRc);
+ bRc = osCloseHandle(p->aRegion[i].hMap);
+ OSTRACE(("SHM-PURGE-CLOSE pid=%lu, region=%d, rc=%s\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), i, bRc ? "ok" : "failed"));
+ UNUSED_VARIABLE_VALUE(bRc);
+ }
+ if( p->hFile.h!=NULL && p->hFile.h!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE ){
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(1);
+ winClose((sqlite3_file *)&p->hFile);
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(0);
+ }
+ if( deleteFlag ){
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(1);
+ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc();
+ winDelete(pVfs, p->zFilename, 0);
+ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc();
+ SimulateIOErrorBenign(0);
+ }
+ *pp = p->pNext;
+ sqlite3_free(p->aRegion);
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ }else{
+ pp = &p->pNext;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** The DMS lock has not yet been taken on shm file pShmNode. Attempt to
+** take it now. Return SQLITE_OK if successful, or an SQLite error
+** code otherwise.
+**
+** If the DMS cannot be locked because this is a readonly_shm=1
+** connection and no other process already holds a lock, return
+** SQLITE_READONLY_CANTINIT and set pShmNode->isUnlocked=1.
+*/
+static int winLockSharedMemory(winShmNode *pShmNode){
+ int rc = winShmSystemLock(pShmNode, WINSHM_WRLCK, WIN_SHM_DMS, 1);
+
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ if( pShmNode->isReadonly ){
+ pShmNode->isUnlocked = 1;
+ winShmSystemLock(pShmNode, WINSHM_UNLCK, WIN_SHM_DMS, 1);
+ return SQLITE_READONLY_CANTINIT;
+ }else if( winTruncate((sqlite3_file*)&pShmNode->hFile, 0) ){
+ winShmSystemLock(pShmNode, WINSHM_UNLCK, WIN_SHM_DMS, 1);
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_SHMOPEN, osGetLastError(),
+ "winLockSharedMemory", pShmNode->zFilename);
+ }
+ }
+
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ winShmSystemLock(pShmNode, WINSHM_UNLCK, WIN_SHM_DMS, 1);
+ }
+
+ return winShmSystemLock(pShmNode, WINSHM_RDLCK, WIN_SHM_DMS, 1);
+}
+
+/*
+** Open the shared-memory area associated with database file pDbFd.
+**
+** When opening a new shared-memory file, if no other instances of that
+** file are currently open, in this process or in other processes, then
+** the file must be truncated to zero length or have its header cleared.
+*/
+static int winOpenSharedMemory(winFile *pDbFd){
+ struct winShm *p; /* The connection to be opened */
+ winShmNode *pShmNode = 0; /* The underlying mmapped file */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Result code */
+ winShmNode *pNew; /* Newly allocated winShmNode */
+ int nName; /* Size of zName in bytes */
+
+ assert( pDbFd->pShm==0 ); /* Not previously opened */
+
+ /* Allocate space for the new sqlite3_shm object. Also speculatively
+ ** allocate space for a new winShmNode and filename.
+ */
+ p = sqlite3MallocZero( sizeof(*p) );
+ if( p==0 ) return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ nName = sqlite3Strlen30(pDbFd->zPath);
+ pNew = sqlite3MallocZero( sizeof(*pShmNode) + nName + 17 );
+ if( pNew==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ pNew->zFilename = (char*)&pNew[1];
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nName+15, pNew->zFilename, "%s-shm", pDbFd->zPath);
+ sqlite3FileSuffix3(pDbFd->zPath, pNew->zFilename);
+
+ /* Look to see if there is an existing winShmNode that can be used.
+ ** If no matching winShmNode currently exists, create a new one.
+ */
+ winShmEnterMutex();
+ for(pShmNode = winShmNodeList; pShmNode; pShmNode=pShmNode->pNext){
+ /* TBD need to come up with better match here. Perhaps
+ ** use FILE_ID_BOTH_DIR_INFO Structure.
+ */
+ if( sqlite3StrICmp(pShmNode->zFilename, pNew->zFilename)==0 ) break;
+ }
+ if( pShmNode ){
+ sqlite3_free(pNew);
+ }else{
+ int inFlags = SQLITE_OPEN_WAL;
+ int outFlags = 0;
+
+ pShmNode = pNew;
+ pNew = 0;
+ ((winFile*)(&pShmNode->hFile))->h = INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE;
+ pShmNode->pNext = winShmNodeList;
+ winShmNodeList = pShmNode;
+
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex ){
+ pShmNode->mutex = sqlite3_mutex_alloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST);
+ if( pShmNode->mutex==0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ goto shm_open_err;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if( 0==sqlite3_uri_boolean(pDbFd->zPath, "readonly_shm", 0) ){
+ inFlags |= SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE | SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE;
+ }else{
+ inFlags |= SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY;
+ }
+ rc = winOpen(pDbFd->pVfs, pShmNode->zFilename,
+ (sqlite3_file*)&pShmNode->hFile,
+ inFlags, &outFlags);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ rc = winLogError(rc, osGetLastError(), "winOpenShm",
+ pShmNode->zFilename);
+ goto shm_open_err;
+ }
+ if( outFlags==SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY ) pShmNode->isReadonly = 1;
+
+ rc = winLockSharedMemory(pShmNode);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK && rc!=SQLITE_READONLY_CANTINIT ) goto shm_open_err;
+ }
+
+ /* Make the new connection a child of the winShmNode */
+ p->pShmNode = pShmNode;
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_HAVE_OS_TRACE)
+ p->id = pShmNode->nextShmId++;
+#endif
+ pShmNode->nRef++;
+ pDbFd->pShm = p;
+ winShmLeaveMutex();
+
+ /* The reference count on pShmNode has already been incremented under
+ ** the cover of the winShmEnterMutex() mutex and the pointer from the
+ ** new (struct winShm) object to the pShmNode has been set. All that is
+ ** left to do is to link the new object into the linked list starting
+ ** at pShmNode->pFirst. This must be done while holding the pShmNode->mutex
+ ** mutex.
+ */
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pShmNode->mutex);
+ p->pNext = pShmNode->pFirst;
+ pShmNode->pFirst = p;
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pShmNode->mutex);
+ return rc;
+
+ /* Jump here on any error */
+shm_open_err:
+ winShmSystemLock(pShmNode, WINSHM_UNLCK, WIN_SHM_DMS, 1);
+ winShmPurge(pDbFd->pVfs, 0); /* This call frees pShmNode if required */
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ sqlite3_free(pNew);
+ winShmLeaveMutex();
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Close a connection to shared-memory. Delete the underlying
+** storage if deleteFlag is true.
+*/
+static int winShmUnmap(
+ sqlite3_file *fd, /* Database holding shared memory */
+ int deleteFlag /* Delete after closing if true */
+){
+ winFile *pDbFd; /* Database holding shared-memory */
+ winShm *p; /* The connection to be closed */
+ winShmNode *pShmNode; /* The underlying shared-memory file */
+ winShm **pp; /* For looping over sibling connections */
+
+ pDbFd = (winFile*)fd;
+ p = pDbFd->pShm;
+ if( p==0 ) return SQLITE_OK;
+ pShmNode = p->pShmNode;
+
+ /* Remove connection p from the set of connections associated
+ ** with pShmNode */
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pShmNode->mutex);
+ for(pp=&pShmNode->pFirst; (*pp)!=p; pp = &(*pp)->pNext){}
+ *pp = p->pNext;
+
+ /* Free the connection p */
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ pDbFd->pShm = 0;
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pShmNode->mutex);
+
+ /* If pShmNode->nRef has reached 0, then close the underlying
+ ** shared-memory file, too */
+ winShmEnterMutex();
+ assert( pShmNode->nRef>0 );
+ pShmNode->nRef--;
+ if( pShmNode->nRef==0 ){
+ winShmPurge(pDbFd->pVfs, deleteFlag);
+ }
+ winShmLeaveMutex();
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the lock state for a shared-memory segment.
+*/
+static int winShmLock(
+ sqlite3_file *fd, /* Database file holding the shared memory */
+ int ofst, /* First lock to acquire or release */
+ int n, /* Number of locks to acquire or release */
+ int flags /* What to do with the lock */
+){
+ winFile *pDbFd = (winFile*)fd; /* Connection holding shared memory */
+ winShm *p = pDbFd->pShm; /* The shared memory being locked */
+ winShm *pX; /* For looping over all siblings */
+ winShmNode *pShmNode = p->pShmNode;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Result code */
+ u16 mask; /* Mask of locks to take or release */
+
+ assert( ofst>=0 && ofst+n<=SQLITE_SHM_NLOCK );
+ assert( n>=1 );
+ assert( flags==(SQLITE_SHM_LOCK | SQLITE_SHM_SHARED)
+ || flags==(SQLITE_SHM_LOCK | SQLITE_SHM_EXCLUSIVE)
+ || flags==(SQLITE_SHM_UNLOCK | SQLITE_SHM_SHARED)
+ || flags==(SQLITE_SHM_UNLOCK | SQLITE_SHM_EXCLUSIVE) );
+ assert( n==1 || (flags & SQLITE_SHM_EXCLUSIVE)!=0 );
+
+ mask = (u16)((1U<<(ofst+n)) - (1U<1 || mask==(1<mutex);
+ if( flags & SQLITE_SHM_UNLOCK ){
+ u16 allMask = 0; /* Mask of locks held by siblings */
+
+ /* See if any siblings hold this same lock */
+ for(pX=pShmNode->pFirst; pX; pX=pX->pNext){
+ if( pX==p ) continue;
+ assert( (pX->exclMask & (p->exclMask|p->sharedMask))==0 );
+ allMask |= pX->sharedMask;
+ }
+
+ /* Unlock the system-level locks */
+ if( (mask & allMask)==0 ){
+ rc = winShmSystemLock(pShmNode, WINSHM_UNLCK, ofst+WIN_SHM_BASE, n);
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ /* Undo the local locks */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ p->exclMask &= ~mask;
+ p->sharedMask &= ~mask;
+ }
+ }else if( flags & SQLITE_SHM_SHARED ){
+ u16 allShared = 0; /* Union of locks held by connections other than "p" */
+
+ /* Find out which shared locks are already held by sibling connections.
+ ** If any sibling already holds an exclusive lock, go ahead and return
+ ** SQLITE_BUSY.
+ */
+ for(pX=pShmNode->pFirst; pX; pX=pX->pNext){
+ if( (pX->exclMask & mask)!=0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ break;
+ }
+ allShared |= pX->sharedMask;
+ }
+
+ /* Get shared locks at the system level, if necessary */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ if( (allShared & mask)==0 ){
+ rc = winShmSystemLock(pShmNode, WINSHM_RDLCK, ofst+WIN_SHM_BASE, n);
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Get the local shared locks */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ p->sharedMask |= mask;
+ }
+ }else{
+ /* Make sure no sibling connections hold locks that will block this
+ ** lock. If any do, return SQLITE_BUSY right away.
+ */
+ for(pX=pShmNode->pFirst; pX; pX=pX->pNext){
+ if( (pX->exclMask & mask)!=0 || (pX->sharedMask & mask)!=0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_BUSY;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Get the exclusive locks at the system level. Then if successful
+ ** also mark the local connection as being locked.
+ */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ rc = winShmSystemLock(pShmNode, WINSHM_WRLCK, ofst+WIN_SHM_BASE, n);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ assert( (p->sharedMask & mask)==0 );
+ p->exclMask |= mask;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pShmNode->mutex);
+ OSTRACE(("SHM-LOCK pid=%lu, id=%d, sharedMask=%03x, exclMask=%03x, rc=%s\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), p->id, p->sharedMask, p->exclMask,
+ sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Implement a memory barrier or memory fence on shared memory.
+**
+** All loads and stores begun before the barrier must complete before
+** any load or store begun after the barrier.
+*/
+static void winShmBarrier(
+ sqlite3_file *fd /* Database holding the shared memory */
+){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(fd);
+ sqlite3MemoryBarrier(); /* compiler-defined memory barrier */
+ winShmEnterMutex(); /* Also mutex, for redundancy */
+ winShmLeaveMutex();
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is called to obtain a pointer to region iRegion of the
+** shared-memory associated with the database file fd. Shared-memory regions
+** are numbered starting from zero. Each shared-memory region is szRegion
+** bytes in size.
+**
+** If an error occurs, an error code is returned and *pp is set to NULL.
+**
+** Otherwise, if the isWrite parameter is 0 and the requested shared-memory
+** region has not been allocated (by any client, including one running in a
+** separate process), then *pp is set to NULL and SQLITE_OK returned. If
+** isWrite is non-zero and the requested shared-memory region has not yet
+** been allocated, it is allocated by this function.
+**
+** If the shared-memory region has already been allocated or is allocated by
+** this call as described above, then it is mapped into this processes
+** address space (if it is not already), *pp is set to point to the mapped
+** memory and SQLITE_OK returned.
+*/
+static int winShmMap(
+ sqlite3_file *fd, /* Handle open on database file */
+ int iRegion, /* Region to retrieve */
+ int szRegion, /* Size of regions */
+ int isWrite, /* True to extend file if necessary */
+ void volatile **pp /* OUT: Mapped memory */
+){
+ winFile *pDbFd = (winFile*)fd;
+ winShm *pShm = pDbFd->pShm;
+ winShmNode *pShmNode;
+ DWORD protect = PAGE_READWRITE;
+ DWORD flags = FILE_MAP_WRITE | FILE_MAP_READ;
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ if( !pShm ){
+ rc = winOpenSharedMemory(pDbFd);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) return rc;
+ pShm = pDbFd->pShm;
+ assert( pShm!=0 );
+ }
+ pShmNode = pShm->pShmNode;
+
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pShmNode->mutex);
+ if( pShmNode->isUnlocked ){
+ rc = winLockSharedMemory(pShmNode);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) goto shmpage_out;
+ pShmNode->isUnlocked = 0;
+ }
+ assert( szRegion==pShmNode->szRegion || pShmNode->nRegion==0 );
+
+ if( pShmNode->nRegion<=iRegion ){
+ struct ShmRegion *apNew; /* New aRegion[] array */
+ int nByte = (iRegion+1)*szRegion; /* Minimum required file size */
+ sqlite3_int64 sz; /* Current size of wal-index file */
+
+ pShmNode->szRegion = szRegion;
+
+ /* The requested region is not mapped into this processes address space.
+ ** Check to see if it has been allocated (i.e. if the wal-index file is
+ ** large enough to contain the requested region).
+ */
+ rc = winFileSize((sqlite3_file *)&pShmNode->hFile, &sz);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_SHMSIZE, osGetLastError(),
+ "winShmMap1", pDbFd->zPath);
+ goto shmpage_out;
+ }
+
+ if( szhFile, nByte);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_SHMSIZE, osGetLastError(),
+ "winShmMap2", pDbFd->zPath);
+ goto shmpage_out;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Map the requested memory region into this processes address space. */
+ apNew = (struct ShmRegion *)sqlite3_realloc64(
+ pShmNode->aRegion, (iRegion+1)*sizeof(apNew[0])
+ );
+ if( !apNew ){
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ goto shmpage_out;
+ }
+ pShmNode->aRegion = apNew;
+
+ if( pShmNode->isReadonly ){
+ protect = PAGE_READONLY;
+ flags = FILE_MAP_READ;
+ }
+
+ while( pShmNode->nRegion<=iRegion ){
+ HANDLE hMap = NULL; /* file-mapping handle */
+ void *pMap = 0; /* Mapped memory region */
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ hMap = osCreateFileMappingFromApp(pShmNode->hFile.h,
+ NULL, protect, nByte, NULL
+ );
+#elif defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ hMap = osCreateFileMappingW(pShmNode->hFile.h,
+ NULL, protect, 0, nByte, NULL
+ );
+#elif defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI) && SQLITE_WIN32_CREATEFILEMAPPINGA
+ hMap = osCreateFileMappingA(pShmNode->hFile.h,
+ NULL, protect, 0, nByte, NULL
+ );
+#endif
+ OSTRACE(("SHM-MAP-CREATE pid=%lu, region=%d, size=%d, rc=%s\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pShmNode->nRegion, nByte,
+ hMap ? "ok" : "failed"));
+ if( hMap ){
+ int iOffset = pShmNode->nRegion*szRegion;
+ int iOffsetShift = iOffset % winSysInfo.dwAllocationGranularity;
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ pMap = osMapViewOfFileFromApp(hMap, flags,
+ iOffset - iOffsetShift, szRegion + iOffsetShift
+ );
+#else
+ pMap = osMapViewOfFile(hMap, flags,
+ 0, iOffset - iOffsetShift, szRegion + iOffsetShift
+ );
+#endif
+ OSTRACE(("SHM-MAP-MAP pid=%lu, region=%d, offset=%d, size=%d, rc=%s\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pShmNode->nRegion, iOffset,
+ szRegion, pMap ? "ok" : "failed"));
+ }
+ if( !pMap ){
+ pShmNode->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_SHMMAP, pShmNode->lastErrno,
+ "winShmMap3", pDbFd->zPath);
+ if( hMap ) osCloseHandle(hMap);
+ goto shmpage_out;
+ }
+
+ pShmNode->aRegion[pShmNode->nRegion].pMap = pMap;
+ pShmNode->aRegion[pShmNode->nRegion].hMap = hMap;
+ pShmNode->nRegion++;
+ }
+ }
+
+shmpage_out:
+ if( pShmNode->nRegion>iRegion ){
+ int iOffset = iRegion*szRegion;
+ int iOffsetShift = iOffset % winSysInfo.dwAllocationGranularity;
+ char *p = (char *)pShmNode->aRegion[iRegion].pMap;
+ *pp = (void *)&p[iOffsetShift];
+ }else{
+ *pp = 0;
+ }
+ if( pShmNode->isReadonly && rc==SQLITE_OK ) rc = SQLITE_READONLY;
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pShmNode->mutex);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+#else
+# define winShmMap 0
+# define winShmLock 0
+# define winShmBarrier 0
+# define winShmUnmap 0
+#endif /* #ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL */
+
+/*
+** Cleans up the mapped region of the specified file, if any.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+static int winUnmapfile(winFile *pFile){
+ assert( pFile!=0 );
+ OSTRACE(("UNMAP-FILE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, hMap=%p, pMapRegion=%p, "
+ "mmapSize=%lld, mmapSizeMax=%lld\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->hMap, pFile->pMapRegion,
+ pFile->mmapSize, pFile->mmapSizeMax));
+ if( pFile->pMapRegion ){
+ if( !osUnmapViewOfFile(pFile->pMapRegion) ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ OSTRACE(("UNMAP-FILE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, pMapRegion=%p, "
+ "rc=SQLITE_IOERR_MMAP\n", osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile,
+ pFile->pMapRegion));
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_MMAP, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winUnmapfile1", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+ pFile->pMapRegion = 0;
+ pFile->mmapSize = 0;
+ }
+ if( pFile->hMap!=NULL ){
+ if( !osCloseHandle(pFile->hMap) ){
+ pFile->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ OSTRACE(("UNMAP-FILE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, hMap=%p, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_MMAP\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile, pFile->hMap));
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_MMAP, pFile->lastErrno,
+ "winUnmapfile2", pFile->zPath);
+ }
+ pFile->hMap = NULL;
+ }
+ OSTRACE(("UNMAP-FILE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFile));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Memory map or remap the file opened by file-descriptor pFd (if the file
+** is already mapped, the existing mapping is replaced by the new). Or, if
+** there already exists a mapping for this file, and there are still
+** outstanding xFetch() references to it, this function is a no-op.
+**
+** If parameter nByte is non-negative, then it is the requested size of
+** the mapping to create. Otherwise, if nByte is less than zero, then the
+** requested size is the size of the file on disk. The actual size of the
+** created mapping is either the requested size or the value configured
+** using SQLITE_FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE, whichever is smaller.
+**
+** SQLITE_OK is returned if no error occurs (even if the mapping is not
+** recreated as a result of outstanding references) or an SQLite error
+** code otherwise.
+*/
+static int winMapfile(winFile *pFd, sqlite3_int64 nByte){
+ sqlite3_int64 nMap = nByte;
+ int rc;
+
+ assert( nMap>=0 || pFd->nFetchOut==0 );
+ OSTRACE(("MAP-FILE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, size=%lld\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFd, nByte));
+
+ if( pFd->nFetchOut>0 ) return SQLITE_OK;
+
+ if( nMap<0 ){
+ rc = winFileSize((sqlite3_file*)pFd, &nMap);
+ if( rc ){
+ OSTRACE(("MAP-FILE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFd));
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT;
+ }
+ }
+ if( nMap>pFd->mmapSizeMax ){
+ nMap = pFd->mmapSizeMax;
+ }
+ nMap &= ~(sqlite3_int64)(winSysInfo.dwPageSize - 1);
+
+ if( nMap==0 && pFd->mmapSize>0 ){
+ winUnmapfile(pFd);
+ }
+ if( nMap!=pFd->mmapSize ){
+ void *pNew = 0;
+ DWORD protect = PAGE_READONLY;
+ DWORD flags = FILE_MAP_READ;
+
+ winUnmapfile(pFd);
+#ifdef SQLITE_MMAP_READWRITE
+ if( (pFd->ctrlFlags & WINFILE_RDONLY)==0 ){
+ protect = PAGE_READWRITE;
+ flags |= FILE_MAP_WRITE;
+ }
+#endif
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ pFd->hMap = osCreateFileMappingFromApp(pFd->h, NULL, protect, nMap, NULL);
+#elif defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ pFd->hMap = osCreateFileMappingW(pFd->h, NULL, protect,
+ (DWORD)((nMap>>32) & 0xffffffff),
+ (DWORD)(nMap & 0xffffffff), NULL);
+#elif defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI) && SQLITE_WIN32_CREATEFILEMAPPINGA
+ pFd->hMap = osCreateFileMappingA(pFd->h, NULL, protect,
+ (DWORD)((nMap>>32) & 0xffffffff),
+ (DWORD)(nMap & 0xffffffff), NULL);
+#endif
+ if( pFd->hMap==NULL ){
+ pFd->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_MMAP, pFd->lastErrno,
+ "winMapfile1", pFd->zPath);
+ /* Log the error, but continue normal operation using xRead/xWrite */
+ OSTRACE(("MAP-FILE-CREATE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, rc=%s\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFd, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ assert( (nMap % winSysInfo.dwPageSize)==0 );
+ assert( sizeof(SIZE_T)==sizeof(sqlite3_int64) || nMap<=0xffffffff );
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ pNew = osMapViewOfFileFromApp(pFd->hMap, flags, 0, (SIZE_T)nMap);
+#else
+ pNew = osMapViewOfFile(pFd->hMap, flags, 0, 0, (SIZE_T)nMap);
+#endif
+ if( pNew==NULL ){
+ osCloseHandle(pFd->hMap);
+ pFd->hMap = NULL;
+ pFd->lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_MMAP, pFd->lastErrno,
+ "winMapfile2", pFd->zPath);
+ /* Log the error, but continue normal operation using xRead/xWrite */
+ OSTRACE(("MAP-FILE-MAP pid=%lu, pFile=%p, rc=%s\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFd, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ pFd->pMapRegion = pNew;
+ pFd->mmapSize = nMap;
+ }
+
+ OSTRACE(("MAP-FILE pid=%lu, pFile=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFd));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0 */
+
+/*
+** If possible, return a pointer to a mapping of file fd starting at offset
+** iOff. The mapping must be valid for at least nAmt bytes.
+**
+** If such a pointer can be obtained, store it in *pp and return SQLITE_OK.
+** Or, if one cannot but no error occurs, set *pp to 0 and return SQLITE_OK.
+** Finally, if an error does occur, return an SQLite error code. The final
+** value of *pp is undefined in this case.
+**
+** If this function does return a pointer, the caller must eventually
+** release the reference by calling winUnfetch().
+*/
+static int winFetch(sqlite3_file *fd, i64 iOff, int nAmt, void **pp){
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ winFile *pFd = (winFile*)fd; /* The underlying database file */
+#endif
+ *pp = 0;
+
+ OSTRACE(("FETCH pid=%lu, pFile=%p, offset=%lld, amount=%d, pp=%p\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), fd, iOff, nAmt, pp));
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ if( pFd->mmapSizeMax>0 ){
+ if( pFd->pMapRegion==0 ){
+ int rc = winMapfile(pFd, -1);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ OSTRACE(("FETCH pid=%lu, pFile=%p, rc=%s\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFd, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+ }
+ }
+ if( pFd->mmapSize >= iOff+nAmt ){
+ assert( pFd->pMapRegion!=0 );
+ *pp = &((u8 *)pFd->pMapRegion)[iOff];
+ pFd->nFetchOut++;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ OSTRACE(("FETCH pid=%lu, pFile=%p, pp=%p, *pp=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), fd, pp, *pp));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** If the third argument is non-NULL, then this function releases a
+** reference obtained by an earlier call to winFetch(). The second
+** argument passed to this function must be the same as the corresponding
+** argument that was passed to the winFetch() invocation.
+**
+** Or, if the third argument is NULL, then this function is being called
+** to inform the VFS layer that, according to POSIX, any existing mapping
+** may now be invalid and should be unmapped.
+*/
+static int winUnfetch(sqlite3_file *fd, i64 iOff, void *p){
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ winFile *pFd = (winFile*)fd; /* The underlying database file */
+
+ /* If p==0 (unmap the entire file) then there must be no outstanding
+ ** xFetch references. Or, if p!=0 (meaning it is an xFetch reference),
+ ** then there must be at least one outstanding. */
+ assert( (p==0)==(pFd->nFetchOut==0) );
+
+ /* If p!=0, it must match the iOff value. */
+ assert( p==0 || p==&((u8 *)pFd->pMapRegion)[iOff] );
+
+ OSTRACE(("UNFETCH pid=%lu, pFile=%p, offset=%lld, p=%p\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), pFd, iOff, p));
+
+ if( p ){
+ pFd->nFetchOut--;
+ }else{
+ /* FIXME: If Windows truly always prevents truncating or deleting a
+ ** file while a mapping is held, then the following winUnmapfile() call
+ ** is unnecessary can be omitted - potentially improving
+ ** performance. */
+ winUnmapfile(pFd);
+ }
+
+ assert( pFd->nFetchOut>=0 );
+#endif
+
+ OSTRACE(("UNFETCH pid=%lu, pFile=%p, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ osGetCurrentProcessId(), fd));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Here ends the implementation of all sqlite3_file methods.
+**
+********************** End sqlite3_file Methods *******************************
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/*
+** This vector defines all the methods that can operate on an
+** sqlite3_file for win32.
+*/
+static const sqlite3_io_methods winIoMethod = {
+ 3, /* iVersion */
+ winClose, /* xClose */
+ winRead, /* xRead */
+ winWrite, /* xWrite */
+ winTruncate, /* xTruncate */
+ winSync, /* xSync */
+ winFileSize, /* xFileSize */
+ winLock, /* xLock */
+ winUnlock, /* xUnlock */
+ winCheckReservedLock, /* xCheckReservedLock */
+ winFileControl, /* xFileControl */
+ winSectorSize, /* xSectorSize */
+ winDeviceCharacteristics, /* xDeviceCharacteristics */
+ winShmMap, /* xShmMap */
+ winShmLock, /* xShmLock */
+ winShmBarrier, /* xShmBarrier */
+ winShmUnmap, /* xShmUnmap */
+ winFetch, /* xFetch */
+ winUnfetch /* xUnfetch */
+};
+
+/*
+** This vector defines all the methods that can operate on an
+** sqlite3_file for win32 without performing any locking.
+*/
+static const sqlite3_io_methods winIoNolockMethod = {
+ 3, /* iVersion */
+ winClose, /* xClose */
+ winRead, /* xRead */
+ winWrite, /* xWrite */
+ winTruncate, /* xTruncate */
+ winSync, /* xSync */
+ winFileSize, /* xFileSize */
+ winNolockLock, /* xLock */
+ winNolockUnlock, /* xUnlock */
+ winNolockCheckReservedLock, /* xCheckReservedLock */
+ winFileControl, /* xFileControl */
+ winSectorSize, /* xSectorSize */
+ winDeviceCharacteristics, /* xDeviceCharacteristics */
+ winShmMap, /* xShmMap */
+ winShmLock, /* xShmLock */
+ winShmBarrier, /* xShmBarrier */
+ winShmUnmap, /* xShmUnmap */
+ winFetch, /* xFetch */
+ winUnfetch /* xUnfetch */
+};
+
+static winVfsAppData winAppData = {
+ &winIoMethod, /* pMethod */
+ 0, /* pAppData */
+ 0 /* bNoLock */
+};
+
+static winVfsAppData winNolockAppData = {
+ &winIoNolockMethod, /* pMethod */
+ 0, /* pAppData */
+ 1 /* bNoLock */
+};
+
+/****************************************************************************
+**************************** sqlite3_vfs methods ****************************
+**
+** This division contains the implementation of methods on the
+** sqlite3_vfs object.
+*/
+
+#if defined(__CYGWIN__)
+/*
+** Convert a filename from whatever the underlying operating system
+** supports for filenames into UTF-8. Space to hold the result is
+** obtained from malloc and must be freed by the calling function.
+*/
+static char *winConvertToUtf8Filename(const void *zFilename){
+ char *zConverted = 0;
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+ zConverted = winUnicodeToUtf8(zFilename);
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+ else{
+ zConverted = winMbcsToUtf8(zFilename, osAreFileApisANSI());
+ }
+#endif
+ /* caller will handle out of memory */
+ return zConverted;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Convert a UTF-8 filename into whatever form the underlying
+** operating system wants filenames in. Space to hold the result
+** is obtained from malloc and must be freed by the calling
+** function.
+*/
+static void *winConvertFromUtf8Filename(const char *zFilename){
+ void *zConverted = 0;
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+ zConverted = winUtf8ToUnicode(zFilename);
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+ else{
+ zConverted = winUtf8ToMbcs(zFilename, osAreFileApisANSI());
+ }
+#endif
+ /* caller will handle out of memory */
+ return zConverted;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function returns non-zero if the specified UTF-8 string buffer
+** ends with a directory separator character or one was successfully
+** added to it.
+*/
+static int winMakeEndInDirSep(int nBuf, char *zBuf){
+ if( zBuf ){
+ int nLen = sqlite3Strlen30(zBuf);
+ if( nLen>0 ){
+ if( winIsDirSep(zBuf[nLen-1]) ){
+ return 1;
+ }else if( nLen+1mxPathname; nBuf = nMax + 2;
+ zBuf = sqlite3MallocZero( nBuf );
+ if( !zBuf ){
+ OSTRACE(("TEMP-FILENAME rc=SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM\n"));
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+
+ /* Figure out the effective temporary directory. First, check if one
+ ** has been explicitly set by the application; otherwise, use the one
+ ** configured by the operating system.
+ */
+ nDir = nMax - (nPre + 15);
+ assert( nDir>0 );
+ if( sqlite3_temp_directory ){
+ int nDirLen = sqlite3Strlen30(sqlite3_temp_directory);
+ if( nDirLen>0 ){
+ if( !winIsDirSep(sqlite3_temp_directory[nDirLen-1]) ){
+ nDirLen++;
+ }
+ if( nDirLen>nDir ){
+ sqlite3_free(zBuf);
+ OSTRACE(("TEMP-FILENAME rc=SQLITE_ERROR\n"));
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_ERROR, 0, "winGetTempname1", 0);
+ }
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nMax, zBuf, "%s", sqlite3_temp_directory);
+ }
+ }
+#if defined(__CYGWIN__)
+ else{
+ static const char *azDirs[] = {
+ 0, /* getenv("SQLITE_TMPDIR") */
+ 0, /* getenv("TMPDIR") */
+ 0, /* getenv("TMP") */
+ 0, /* getenv("TEMP") */
+ 0, /* getenv("USERPROFILE") */
+ "/var/tmp",
+ "/usr/tmp",
+ "/tmp",
+ ".",
+ 0 /* List terminator */
+ };
+ unsigned int i;
+ const char *zDir = 0;
+
+ if( !azDirs[0] ) azDirs[0] = getenv("SQLITE_TMPDIR");
+ if( !azDirs[1] ) azDirs[1] = getenv("TMPDIR");
+ if( !azDirs[2] ) azDirs[2] = getenv("TMP");
+ if( !azDirs[3] ) azDirs[3] = getenv("TEMP");
+ if( !azDirs[4] ) azDirs[4] = getenv("USERPROFILE");
+ for(i=0; i/etilqs_XXXXXXXXXXXXXXX\0\0"
+ **
+ ** If not, return SQLITE_ERROR. The number 17 is used here in order to
+ ** account for the space used by the 15 character random suffix and the
+ ** two trailing NUL characters. The final directory separator character
+ ** has already added if it was not already present.
+ */
+ nLen = sqlite3Strlen30(zBuf);
+ if( (nLen + nPre + 17) > nBuf ){
+ sqlite3_free(zBuf);
+ OSTRACE(("TEMP-FILENAME rc=SQLITE_ERROR\n"));
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_ERROR, 0, "winGetTempname5", 0);
+ }
+
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nBuf-16-nLen, zBuf+nLen, SQLITE_TEMP_FILE_PREFIX);
+
+ j = sqlite3Strlen30(zBuf);
+ sqlite3_randomness(15, &zBuf[j]);
+ for(i=0; i<15; i++, j++){
+ zBuf[j] = (char)zChars[ ((unsigned char)zBuf[j])%(sizeof(zChars)-1) ];
+ }
+ zBuf[j] = 0;
+ zBuf[j+1] = 0;
+ *pzBuf = zBuf;
+
+ OSTRACE(("TEMP-FILENAME name=%s, rc=SQLITE_OK\n", zBuf));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return TRUE if the named file is really a directory. Return false if
+** it is something other than a directory, or if there is any kind of memory
+** allocation failure.
+*/
+static int winIsDir(const void *zConverted){
+ DWORD attr;
+ int rc = 0;
+ DWORD lastErrno;
+
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+ int cnt = 0;
+ WIN32_FILE_ATTRIBUTE_DATA sAttrData;
+ memset(&sAttrData, 0, sizeof(sAttrData));
+ while( !(rc = osGetFileAttributesExW((LPCWSTR)zConverted,
+ GetFileExInfoStandard,
+ &sAttrData)) && winRetryIoerr(&cnt, &lastErrno) ){}
+ if( !rc ){
+ return 0; /* Invalid name? */
+ }
+ attr = sAttrData.dwFileAttributes;
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE==0
+ }else{
+ attr = osGetFileAttributesA((char*)zConverted);
+#endif
+ }
+ return (attr!=INVALID_FILE_ATTRIBUTES) && (attr&FILE_ATTRIBUTE_DIRECTORY);
+}
+
+/* forward reference */
+static int winAccess(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, /* Not used on win32 */
+ const char *zFilename, /* Name of file to check */
+ int flags, /* Type of test to make on this file */
+ int *pResOut /* OUT: Result */
+);
+
+/*
+** Open a file.
+*/
+static int winOpen(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, /* Used to get maximum path length and AppData */
+ const char *zName, /* Name of the file (UTF-8) */
+ sqlite3_file *id, /* Write the SQLite file handle here */
+ int flags, /* Open mode flags */
+ int *pOutFlags /* Status return flags */
+){
+ HANDLE h;
+ DWORD lastErrno = 0;
+ DWORD dwDesiredAccess;
+ DWORD dwShareMode;
+ DWORD dwCreationDisposition;
+ DWORD dwFlagsAndAttributes = 0;
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ int isTemp = 0;
+#endif
+ winVfsAppData *pAppData;
+ winFile *pFile = (winFile*)id;
+ void *zConverted; /* Filename in OS encoding */
+ const char *zUtf8Name = zName; /* Filename in UTF-8 encoding */
+ int cnt = 0;
+
+ /* If argument zPath is a NULL pointer, this function is required to open
+ ** a temporary file. Use this buffer to store the file name in.
+ */
+ char *zTmpname = 0; /* For temporary filename, if necessary. */
+
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Function Return Code */
+#if !defined(NDEBUG) || SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ int eType = flags&0xFFFFFF00; /* Type of file to open */
+#endif
+
+ int isExclusive = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE);
+ int isDelete = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE);
+ int isCreate = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE);
+ int isReadonly = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY);
+ int isReadWrite = (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE);
+
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+ int isOpenJournal = (isCreate && (
+ eType==SQLITE_OPEN_SUPER_JOURNAL
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_WAL
+ ));
+#endif
+
+ OSTRACE(("OPEN name=%s, pFile=%p, flags=%x, pOutFlags=%p\n",
+ zUtf8Name, id, flags, pOutFlags));
+
+ /* Check the following statements are true:
+ **
+ ** (a) Exactly one of the READWRITE and READONLY flags must be set, and
+ ** (b) if CREATE is set, then READWRITE must also be set, and
+ ** (c) if EXCLUSIVE is set, then CREATE must also be set.
+ ** (d) if DELETEONCLOSE is set, then CREATE must also be set.
+ */
+ assert((isReadonly==0 || isReadWrite==0) && (isReadWrite || isReadonly));
+ assert(isCreate==0 || isReadWrite);
+ assert(isExclusive==0 || isCreate);
+ assert(isDelete==0 || isCreate);
+
+ /* The main DB, main journal, WAL file and super-journal are never
+ ** automatically deleted. Nor are they ever temporary files. */
+ assert( (!isDelete && zName) || eType!=SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB );
+ assert( (!isDelete && zName) || eType!=SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL );
+ assert( (!isDelete && zName) || eType!=SQLITE_OPEN_SUPER_JOURNAL );
+ assert( (!isDelete && zName) || eType!=SQLITE_OPEN_WAL );
+
+ /* Assert that the upper layer has set one of the "file-type" flags. */
+ assert( eType==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_DB
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_JOURNAL
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_SUBJOURNAL || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_SUPER_JOURNAL
+ || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_TRANSIENT_DB || eType==SQLITE_OPEN_WAL
+ );
+
+ assert( pFile!=0 );
+ memset(pFile, 0, sizeof(winFile));
+ pFile->h = INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE;
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ if( !zUtf8Name && !sqlite3_temp_directory ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_ERROR,
+ "sqlite3_temp_directory variable should be set for WinRT");
+ }
+#endif
+
+ /* If the second argument to this function is NULL, generate a
+ ** temporary file name to use
+ */
+ if( !zUtf8Name ){
+ assert( isDelete && !isOpenJournal );
+ rc = winGetTempname(pVfs, &zTmpname);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ OSTRACE(("OPEN name=%s, rc=%s", zUtf8Name, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+ }
+ zUtf8Name = zTmpname;
+ }
+
+ /* Database filenames are double-zero terminated if they are not
+ ** URIs with parameters. Hence, they can always be passed into
+ ** sqlite3_uri_parameter().
+ */
+ assert( (eType!=SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB) || (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_URI) ||
+ zUtf8Name[sqlite3Strlen30(zUtf8Name)+1]==0 );
+
+ /* Convert the filename to the system encoding. */
+ zConverted = winConvertFromUtf8Filename(zUtf8Name);
+ if( zConverted==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zTmpname);
+ OSTRACE(("OPEN name=%s, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM", zUtf8Name));
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+
+ if( winIsDir(zConverted) ){
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ sqlite3_free(zTmpname);
+ OSTRACE(("OPEN name=%s, rc=SQLITE_CANTOPEN_ISDIR", zUtf8Name));
+ return SQLITE_CANTOPEN_ISDIR;
+ }
+
+ if( isReadWrite ){
+ dwDesiredAccess = GENERIC_READ | GENERIC_WRITE;
+ }else{
+ dwDesiredAccess = GENERIC_READ;
+ }
+
+ /* SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE is used to make sure that a new file is
+ ** created. SQLite doesn't use it to indicate "exclusive access"
+ ** as it is usually understood.
+ */
+ if( isExclusive ){
+ /* Creates a new file, only if it does not already exist. */
+ /* If the file exists, it fails. */
+ dwCreationDisposition = CREATE_NEW;
+ }else if( isCreate ){
+ /* Open existing file, or create if it doesn't exist */
+ dwCreationDisposition = OPEN_ALWAYS;
+ }else{
+ /* Opens a file, only if it exists. */
+ dwCreationDisposition = OPEN_EXISTING;
+ }
+
+ dwShareMode = FILE_SHARE_READ | FILE_SHARE_WRITE;
+
+ if( isDelete ){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ dwFlagsAndAttributes = FILE_ATTRIBUTE_HIDDEN;
+ isTemp = 1;
+#else
+ dwFlagsAndAttributes = FILE_ATTRIBUTE_TEMPORARY
+ | FILE_ATTRIBUTE_HIDDEN
+ | FILE_FLAG_DELETE_ON_CLOSE;
+#endif
+ }else{
+ dwFlagsAndAttributes = FILE_ATTRIBUTE_NORMAL;
+ }
+ /* Reports from the internet are that performance is always
+ ** better if FILE_FLAG_RANDOM_ACCESS is used. Ticket #2699. */
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ dwFlagsAndAttributes |= FILE_FLAG_RANDOM_ACCESS;
+#endif
+
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ CREATEFILE2_EXTENDED_PARAMETERS extendedParameters;
+ extendedParameters.dwSize = sizeof(CREATEFILE2_EXTENDED_PARAMETERS);
+ extendedParameters.dwFileAttributes =
+ dwFlagsAndAttributes & FILE_ATTRIBUTE_MASK;
+ extendedParameters.dwFileFlags = dwFlagsAndAttributes & FILE_FLAG_MASK;
+ extendedParameters.dwSecurityQosFlags = SECURITY_ANONYMOUS;
+ extendedParameters.lpSecurityAttributes = NULL;
+ extendedParameters.hTemplateFile = NULL;
+ do{
+ h = osCreateFile2((LPCWSTR)zConverted,
+ dwDesiredAccess,
+ dwShareMode,
+ dwCreationDisposition,
+ &extendedParameters);
+ if( h!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE ) break;
+ if( isReadWrite ){
+ int rc2, isRO = 0;
+ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc();
+ rc2 = winAccess(pVfs, zName, SQLITE_ACCESS_READ, &isRO);
+ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc();
+ if( rc2==SQLITE_OK && isRO ) break;
+ }
+ }while( winRetryIoerr(&cnt, &lastErrno) );
+#else
+ do{
+ h = osCreateFileW((LPCWSTR)zConverted,
+ dwDesiredAccess,
+ dwShareMode, NULL,
+ dwCreationDisposition,
+ dwFlagsAndAttributes,
+ NULL);
+ if( h!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE ) break;
+ if( isReadWrite ){
+ int rc2, isRO = 0;
+ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc();
+ rc2 = winAccess(pVfs, zName, SQLITE_ACCESS_READ, &isRO);
+ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc();
+ if( rc2==SQLITE_OK && isRO ) break;
+ }
+ }while( winRetryIoerr(&cnt, &lastErrno) );
+#endif
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+ else{
+ do{
+ h = osCreateFileA((LPCSTR)zConverted,
+ dwDesiredAccess,
+ dwShareMode, NULL,
+ dwCreationDisposition,
+ dwFlagsAndAttributes,
+ NULL);
+ if( h!=INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE ) break;
+ if( isReadWrite ){
+ int rc2, isRO = 0;
+ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc();
+ rc2 = winAccess(pVfs, zName, SQLITE_ACCESS_READ, &isRO);
+ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc();
+ if( rc2==SQLITE_OK && isRO ) break;
+ }
+ }while( winRetryIoerr(&cnt, &lastErrno) );
+ }
+#endif
+ winLogIoerr(cnt, __LINE__);
+
+ OSTRACE(("OPEN file=%p, name=%s, access=%lx, rc=%s\n", h, zUtf8Name,
+ dwDesiredAccess, (h==INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE) ? "failed" : "ok"));
+
+ if( h==INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE ){
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ sqlite3_free(zTmpname);
+ if( isReadWrite && !isExclusive ){
+ return winOpen(pVfs, zName, id,
+ ((flags|SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY) &
+ ~(SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE|SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE)),
+ pOutFlags);
+ }else{
+ pFile->lastErrno = lastErrno;
+ winLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN, pFile->lastErrno, "winOpen", zUtf8Name);
+ return SQLITE_CANTOPEN_BKPT;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if( pOutFlags ){
+ if( isReadWrite ){
+ *pOutFlags = SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE;
+ }else{
+ *pOutFlags = SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY;
+ }
+ }
+
+ OSTRACE(("OPEN file=%p, name=%s, access=%lx, pOutFlags=%p, *pOutFlags=%d, "
+ "rc=%s\n", h, zUtf8Name, dwDesiredAccess, pOutFlags, pOutFlags ?
+ *pOutFlags : 0, (h==INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE) ? "failed" : "ok"));
+
+ pAppData = (winVfsAppData*)pVfs->pAppData;
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ {
+ if( isReadWrite && eType==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB
+ && ((pAppData==NULL) || !pAppData->bNoLock)
+ && (rc = winceCreateLock(zName, pFile))!=SQLITE_OK
+ ){
+ osCloseHandle(h);
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ sqlite3_free(zTmpname);
+ OSTRACE(("OPEN-CE-LOCK name=%s, rc=%s\n", zName, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+ }
+ }
+ if( isTemp ){
+ pFile->zDeleteOnClose = zConverted;
+ }else
+#endif
+ {
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ }
+
+ sqlite3_free(zTmpname);
+ id->pMethods = pAppData ? pAppData->pMethod : &winIoMethod;
+ pFile->pVfs = pVfs;
+ pFile->h = h;
+ if( isReadonly ){
+ pFile->ctrlFlags |= WINFILE_RDONLY;
+ }
+ if( (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB)
+ && sqlite3_uri_boolean(zName, "psow", SQLITE_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE)
+ ){
+ pFile->ctrlFlags |= WINFILE_PSOW;
+ }
+ pFile->lastErrno = NO_ERROR;
+ pFile->zPath = zName;
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ pFile->hMap = NULL;
+ pFile->pMapRegion = 0;
+ pFile->mmapSize = 0;
+ pFile->mmapSizeMax = sqlite3GlobalConfig.szMmap;
+#endif
+
+ OpenCounter(+1);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Delete the named file.
+**
+** Note that Windows does not allow a file to be deleted if some other
+** process has it open. Sometimes a virus scanner or indexing program
+** will open a journal file shortly after it is created in order to do
+** whatever it does. While this other process is holding the
+** file open, we will be unable to delete it. To work around this
+** problem, we delay 100 milliseconds and try to delete again. Up
+** to MX_DELETION_ATTEMPTs deletion attempts are run before giving
+** up and returning an error.
+*/
+static int winDelete(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, /* Not used on win32 */
+ const char *zFilename, /* Name of file to delete */
+ int syncDir /* Not used on win32 */
+){
+ int cnt = 0;
+ int rc;
+ DWORD attr;
+ DWORD lastErrno = 0;
+ void *zConverted;
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(syncDir);
+
+ SimulateIOError(return SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE);
+ OSTRACE(("DELETE name=%s, syncDir=%d\n", zFilename, syncDir));
+
+ zConverted = winConvertFromUtf8Filename(zFilename);
+ if( zConverted==0 ){
+ OSTRACE(("DELETE name=%s, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM\n", zFilename));
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+ do {
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ WIN32_FILE_ATTRIBUTE_DATA sAttrData;
+ memset(&sAttrData, 0, sizeof(sAttrData));
+ if ( osGetFileAttributesExW(zConverted, GetFileExInfoStandard,
+ &sAttrData) ){
+ attr = sAttrData.dwFileAttributes;
+ }else{
+ lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ if( lastErrno==ERROR_FILE_NOT_FOUND
+ || lastErrno==ERROR_PATH_NOT_FOUND ){
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE_NOENT; /* Already gone? */
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+#else
+ attr = osGetFileAttributesW(zConverted);
+#endif
+ if ( attr==INVALID_FILE_ATTRIBUTES ){
+ lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ if( lastErrno==ERROR_FILE_NOT_FOUND
+ || lastErrno==ERROR_PATH_NOT_FOUND ){
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE_NOENT; /* Already gone? */
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ if ( attr&FILE_ATTRIBUTE_DIRECTORY ){
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR; /* Files only. */
+ break;
+ }
+ if ( osDeleteFileW(zConverted) ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Deleted OK. */
+ break;
+ }
+ if ( !winRetryIoerr(&cnt, &lastErrno) ){
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR; /* No more retries. */
+ break;
+ }
+ } while(1);
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+ else{
+ do {
+ attr = osGetFileAttributesA(zConverted);
+ if ( attr==INVALID_FILE_ATTRIBUTES ){
+ lastErrno = osGetLastError();
+ if( lastErrno==ERROR_FILE_NOT_FOUND
+ || lastErrno==ERROR_PATH_NOT_FOUND ){
+ rc = SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE_NOENT; /* Already gone? */
+ }else{
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ if ( attr&FILE_ATTRIBUTE_DIRECTORY ){
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR; /* Files only. */
+ break;
+ }
+ if ( osDeleteFileA(zConverted) ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Deleted OK. */
+ break;
+ }
+ if ( !winRetryIoerr(&cnt, &lastErrno) ){
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR; /* No more retries. */
+ break;
+ }
+ } while(1);
+ }
+#endif
+ if( rc && rc!=SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE_NOENT ){
+ rc = winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE, lastErrno, "winDelete", zFilename);
+ }else{
+ winLogIoerr(cnt, __LINE__);
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ OSTRACE(("DELETE name=%s, rc=%s\n", zFilename, sqlite3ErrName(rc)));
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Check the existence and status of a file.
+*/
+static int winAccess(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, /* Not used on win32 */
+ const char *zFilename, /* Name of file to check */
+ int flags, /* Type of test to make on this file */
+ int *pResOut /* OUT: Result */
+){
+ DWORD attr;
+ int rc = 0;
+ DWORD lastErrno = 0;
+ void *zConverted;
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_IOERR_ACCESS; );
+ OSTRACE(("ACCESS name=%s, flags=%x, pResOut=%p\n",
+ zFilename, flags, pResOut));
+
+ zConverted = winConvertFromUtf8Filename(zFilename);
+ if( zConverted==0 ){
+ OSTRACE(("ACCESS name=%s, rc=SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM\n", zFilename));
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+ int cnt = 0;
+ WIN32_FILE_ATTRIBUTE_DATA sAttrData;
+ memset(&sAttrData, 0, sizeof(sAttrData));
+ while( !(rc = osGetFileAttributesExW((LPCWSTR)zConverted,
+ GetFileExInfoStandard,
+ &sAttrData)) && winRetryIoerr(&cnt, &lastErrno) ){}
+ if( rc ){
+ /* For an SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS query, treat a zero-length file
+ ** as if it does not exist.
+ */
+ if( flags==SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS
+ && sAttrData.nFileSizeHigh==0
+ && sAttrData.nFileSizeLow==0 ){
+ attr = INVALID_FILE_ATTRIBUTES;
+ }else{
+ attr = sAttrData.dwFileAttributes;
+ }
+ }else{
+ winLogIoerr(cnt, __LINE__);
+ if( lastErrno!=ERROR_FILE_NOT_FOUND && lastErrno!=ERROR_PATH_NOT_FOUND ){
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_IOERR_ACCESS, lastErrno, "winAccess",
+ zFilename);
+ }else{
+ attr = INVALID_FILE_ATTRIBUTES;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+ else{
+ attr = osGetFileAttributesA((char*)zConverted);
+ }
+#endif
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ switch( flags ){
+ case SQLITE_ACCESS_READ:
+ case SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS:
+ rc = attr!=INVALID_FILE_ATTRIBUTES;
+ break;
+ case SQLITE_ACCESS_READWRITE:
+ rc = attr!=INVALID_FILE_ATTRIBUTES &&
+ (attr & FILE_ATTRIBUTE_READONLY)==0;
+ break;
+ default:
+ assert(!"Invalid flags argument");
+ }
+ *pResOut = rc;
+ OSTRACE(("ACCESS name=%s, pResOut=%p, *pResOut=%d, rc=SQLITE_OK\n",
+ zFilename, pResOut, *pResOut));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Returns non-zero if the specified path name starts with the "long path"
+** prefix.
+*/
+static BOOL winIsLongPathPrefix(
+ const char *zPathname
+){
+ return ( zPathname[0]=='\\' && zPathname[1]=='\\'
+ && zPathname[2]=='?' && zPathname[3]=='\\' );
+}
+
+/*
+** Returns non-zero if the specified path name starts with a drive letter
+** followed by a colon character.
+*/
+static BOOL winIsDriveLetterAndColon(
+ const char *zPathname
+){
+ return ( sqlite3Isalpha(zPathname[0]) && zPathname[1]==':' );
+}
+
+/*
+** Returns non-zero if the specified path name should be used verbatim. If
+** non-zero is returned from this function, the calling function must simply
+** use the provided path name verbatim -OR- resolve it into a full path name
+** using the GetFullPathName Win32 API function (if available).
+*/
+static BOOL winIsVerbatimPathname(
+ const char *zPathname
+){
+ /*
+ ** If the path name starts with a forward slash or a backslash, it is either
+ ** a legal UNC name, a volume relative path, or an absolute path name in the
+ ** "Unix" format on Windows. There is no easy way to differentiate between
+ ** the final two cases; therefore, we return the safer return value of TRUE
+ ** so that callers of this function will simply use it verbatim.
+ */
+ if ( winIsDirSep(zPathname[0]) ){
+ return TRUE;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ ** If the path name starts with a letter and a colon it is either a volume
+ ** relative path or an absolute path. Callers of this function must not
+ ** attempt to treat it as a relative path name (i.e. they should simply use
+ ** it verbatim).
+ */
+ if ( winIsDriveLetterAndColon(zPathname) ){
+ return TRUE;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ ** If we get to this point, the path name should almost certainly be a purely
+ ** relative one (i.e. not a UNC name, not absolute, and not volume relative).
+ */
+ return FALSE;
+}
+
+/*
+** Turn a relative pathname into a full pathname. Write the full
+** pathname into zOut[]. zOut[] will be at least pVfs->mxPathname
+** bytes in size.
+*/
+static int winFullPathname(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, /* Pointer to vfs object */
+ const char *zRelative, /* Possibly relative input path */
+ int nFull, /* Size of output buffer in bytes */
+ char *zFull /* Output buffer */
+){
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && !defined(__CYGWIN__)
+ DWORD nByte;
+ void *zConverted;
+ char *zOut;
+#endif
+
+ /* If this path name begins with "/X:" or "\\?\", where "X" is any
+ ** alphabetic character, discard the initial "/" from the pathname.
+ */
+ if( zRelative[0]=='/' && (winIsDriveLetterAndColon(zRelative+1)
+ || winIsLongPathPrefix(zRelative+1)) ){
+ zRelative++;
+ }
+
+#if defined(__CYGWIN__)
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_ERROR );
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(nFull);
+ assert( nFull>=pVfs->mxPathname );
+ if ( sqlite3_data_directory && !winIsVerbatimPathname(zRelative) ){
+ /*
+ ** NOTE: We are dealing with a relative path name and the data
+ ** directory has been set. Therefore, use it as the basis
+ ** for converting the relative path name to an absolute
+ ** one by prepending the data directory and a slash.
+ */
+ char *zOut = sqlite3MallocZero( pVfs->mxPathname+1 );
+ if( !zOut ){
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ if( cygwin_conv_path(
+ (osIsNT() ? CCP_POSIX_TO_WIN_W : CCP_POSIX_TO_WIN_A) |
+ CCP_RELATIVE, zRelative, zOut, pVfs->mxPathname+1)<0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zOut);
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_CONVPATH, (DWORD)errno,
+ "winFullPathname1", zRelative);
+ }else{
+ char *zUtf8 = winConvertToUtf8Filename(zOut);
+ if( !zUtf8 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zOut);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ sqlite3_snprintf(MIN(nFull, pVfs->mxPathname), zFull, "%s%c%s",
+ sqlite3_data_directory, winGetDirSep(), zUtf8);
+ sqlite3_free(zUtf8);
+ sqlite3_free(zOut);
+ }
+ }else{
+ char *zOut = sqlite3MallocZero( pVfs->mxPathname+1 );
+ if( !zOut ){
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ if( cygwin_conv_path(
+ (osIsNT() ? CCP_POSIX_TO_WIN_W : CCP_POSIX_TO_WIN_A),
+ zRelative, zOut, pVfs->mxPathname+1)<0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zOut);
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_CONVPATH, (DWORD)errno,
+ "winFullPathname2", zRelative);
+ }else{
+ char *zUtf8 = winConvertToUtf8Filename(zOut);
+ if( !zUtf8 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zOut);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ sqlite3_snprintf(MIN(nFull, pVfs->mxPathname), zFull, "%s", zUtf8);
+ sqlite3_free(zUtf8);
+ sqlite3_free(zOut);
+ }
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+#endif
+
+#if (SQLITE_OS_WINCE || SQLITE_OS_WINRT) && !defined(__CYGWIN__)
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_ERROR );
+ /* WinCE has no concept of a relative pathname, or so I am told. */
+ /* WinRT has no way to convert a relative path to an absolute one. */
+ if ( sqlite3_data_directory && !winIsVerbatimPathname(zRelative) ){
+ /*
+ ** NOTE: We are dealing with a relative path name and the data
+ ** directory has been set. Therefore, use it as the basis
+ ** for converting the relative path name to an absolute
+ ** one by prepending the data directory and a backslash.
+ */
+ sqlite3_snprintf(MIN(nFull, pVfs->mxPathname), zFull, "%s%c%s",
+ sqlite3_data_directory, winGetDirSep(), zRelative);
+ }else{
+ sqlite3_snprintf(MIN(nFull, pVfs->mxPathname), zFull, "%s", zRelative);
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+#endif
+
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && !defined(__CYGWIN__)
+ /* It's odd to simulate an io-error here, but really this is just
+ ** using the io-error infrastructure to test that SQLite handles this
+ ** function failing. This function could fail if, for example, the
+ ** current working directory has been unlinked.
+ */
+ SimulateIOError( return SQLITE_ERROR );
+ if ( sqlite3_data_directory && !winIsVerbatimPathname(zRelative) ){
+ /*
+ ** NOTE: We are dealing with a relative path name and the data
+ ** directory has been set. Therefore, use it as the basis
+ ** for converting the relative path name to an absolute
+ ** one by prepending the data directory and a backslash.
+ */
+ sqlite3_snprintf(MIN(nFull, pVfs->mxPathname), zFull, "%s%c%s",
+ sqlite3_data_directory, winGetDirSep(), zRelative);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ zConverted = winConvertFromUtf8Filename(zRelative);
+ if( zConverted==0 ){
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+ LPWSTR zTemp;
+ nByte = osGetFullPathNameW((LPCWSTR)zConverted, 0, 0, 0);
+ if( nByte==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_FULLPATH, osGetLastError(),
+ "winFullPathname1", zRelative);
+ }
+ nByte += 3;
+ zTemp = sqlite3MallocZero( nByte*sizeof(zTemp[0]) );
+ if( zTemp==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ nByte = osGetFullPathNameW((LPCWSTR)zConverted, nByte, zTemp, 0);
+ if( nByte==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ sqlite3_free(zTemp);
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_FULLPATH, osGetLastError(),
+ "winFullPathname2", zRelative);
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ zOut = winUnicodeToUtf8(zTemp);
+ sqlite3_free(zTemp);
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+ else{
+ char *zTemp;
+ nByte = osGetFullPathNameA((char*)zConverted, 0, 0, 0);
+ if( nByte==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_FULLPATH, osGetLastError(),
+ "winFullPathname3", zRelative);
+ }
+ nByte += 3;
+ zTemp = sqlite3MallocZero( nByte*sizeof(zTemp[0]) );
+ if( zTemp==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ nByte = osGetFullPathNameA((char*)zConverted, nByte, zTemp, 0);
+ if( nByte==0 ){
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ sqlite3_free(zTemp);
+ return winLogError(SQLITE_CANTOPEN_FULLPATH, osGetLastError(),
+ "winFullPathname4", zRelative);
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ zOut = winMbcsToUtf8(zTemp, osAreFileApisANSI());
+ sqlite3_free(zTemp);
+ }
+#endif
+ if( zOut ){
+ sqlite3_snprintf(MIN(nFull, pVfs->mxPathname), zFull, "%s", zOut);
+ sqlite3_free(zOut);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION
+/*
+** Interfaces for opening a shared library, finding entry points
+** within the shared library, and closing the shared library.
+*/
+static void *winDlOpen(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, const char *zFilename){
+ HANDLE h;
+#if defined(__CYGWIN__)
+ int nFull = pVfs->mxPathname+1;
+ char *zFull = sqlite3MallocZero( nFull );
+ void *zConverted = 0;
+ if( zFull==0 ){
+ OSTRACE(("DLOPEN name=%s, handle=%p\n", zFilename, (void*)0));
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if( winFullPathname(pVfs, zFilename, nFull, zFull)!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ sqlite3_free(zFull);
+ OSTRACE(("DLOPEN name=%s, handle=%p\n", zFilename, (void*)0));
+ return 0;
+ }
+ zConverted = winConvertFromUtf8Filename(zFull);
+ sqlite3_free(zFull);
+#else
+ void *zConverted = winConvertFromUtf8Filename(zFilename);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+#endif
+ if( zConverted==0 ){
+ OSTRACE(("DLOPEN name=%s, handle=%p\n", zFilename, (void*)0));
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if( osIsNT() ){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ h = osLoadPackagedLibrary((LPCWSTR)zConverted, 0);
+#else
+ h = osLoadLibraryW((LPCWSTR)zConverted);
+#endif
+ }
+#ifdef SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_ANSI
+ else{
+ h = osLoadLibraryA((char*)zConverted);
+ }
+#endif
+ OSTRACE(("DLOPEN name=%s, handle=%p\n", zFilename, (void*)h));
+ sqlite3_free(zConverted);
+ return (void*)h;
+}
+static void winDlError(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int nBuf, char *zBufOut){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+ winGetLastErrorMsg(osGetLastError(), nBuf, zBufOut);
+}
+static void (*winDlSym(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs,void *pH,const char *zSym))(void){
+ FARPROC proc;
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+ proc = osGetProcAddressA((HANDLE)pH, zSym);
+ OSTRACE(("DLSYM handle=%p, symbol=%s, address=%p\n",
+ (void*)pH, zSym, (void*)proc));
+ return (void(*)(void))proc;
+}
+static void winDlClose(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, void *pHandle){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+ osFreeLibrary((HANDLE)pHandle);
+ OSTRACE(("DLCLOSE handle=%p\n", (void*)pHandle));
+}
+#else /* if SQLITE_OMIT_LOAD_EXTENSION is defined: */
+ #define winDlOpen 0
+ #define winDlError 0
+ #define winDlSym 0
+ #define winDlClose 0
+#endif
+
+/* State information for the randomness gatherer. */
+typedef struct EntropyGatherer EntropyGatherer;
+struct EntropyGatherer {
+ unsigned char *a; /* Gather entropy into this buffer */
+ int na; /* Size of a[] in bytes */
+ int i; /* XOR next input into a[i] */
+ int nXor; /* Number of XOR operations done */
+};
+
+#if !defined(SQLITE_TEST) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_RANDOMNESS)
+/* Mix sz bytes of entropy into p. */
+static void xorMemory(EntropyGatherer *p, unsigned char *x, int sz){
+ int j, k;
+ for(j=0, k=p->i; ja[k++] ^= x[j];
+ if( k>=p->na ) k = 0;
+ }
+ p->i = k;
+ p->nXor += sz;
+}
+#endif /* !defined(SQLITE_TEST) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_RANDOMNESS) */
+
+/*
+** Write up to nBuf bytes of randomness into zBuf.
+*/
+static int winRandomness(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int nBuf, char *zBuf){
+#if defined(SQLITE_TEST) || defined(SQLITE_OMIT_RANDOMNESS)
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+ memset(zBuf, 0, nBuf);
+ return nBuf;
+#else
+ EntropyGatherer e;
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+ memset(zBuf, 0, nBuf);
+ e.a = (unsigned char*)zBuf;
+ e.na = nBuf;
+ e.nXor = 0;
+ e.i = 0;
+ {
+ SYSTEMTIME x;
+ osGetSystemTime(&x);
+ xorMemory(&e, (unsigned char*)&x, sizeof(SYSTEMTIME));
+ }
+ {
+ DWORD pid = osGetCurrentProcessId();
+ xorMemory(&e, (unsigned char*)&pid, sizeof(DWORD));
+ }
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ {
+ ULONGLONG cnt = osGetTickCount64();
+ xorMemory(&e, (unsigned char*)&cnt, sizeof(ULONGLONG));
+ }
+#else
+ {
+ DWORD cnt = osGetTickCount();
+ xorMemory(&e, (unsigned char*)&cnt, sizeof(DWORD));
+ }
+#endif /* SQLITE_OS_WINRT */
+ {
+ LARGE_INTEGER i;
+ osQueryPerformanceCounter(&i);
+ xorMemory(&e, (unsigned char*)&i, sizeof(LARGE_INTEGER));
+ }
+#if !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && SQLITE_WIN32_USE_UUID
+ {
+ UUID id;
+ memset(&id, 0, sizeof(UUID));
+ osUuidCreate(&id);
+ xorMemory(&e, (unsigned char*)&id, sizeof(UUID));
+ memset(&id, 0, sizeof(UUID));
+ osUuidCreateSequential(&id);
+ xorMemory(&e, (unsigned char*)&id, sizeof(UUID));
+ }
+#endif /* !SQLITE_OS_WINCE && !SQLITE_OS_WINRT && SQLITE_WIN32_USE_UUID */
+ return e.nXor>nBuf ? nBuf : e.nXor;
+#endif /* defined(SQLITE_TEST) || defined(SQLITE_OMIT_RANDOMNESS) */
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Sleep for a little while. Return the amount of time slept.
+*/
+static int winSleep(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int microsec){
+ sqlite3_win32_sleep((microsec+999)/1000);
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+ return ((microsec+999)/1000)*1000;
+}
+
+/*
+** The following variable, if set to a non-zero value, is interpreted as
+** the number of seconds since 1970 and is used to set the result of
+** sqlite3OsCurrentTime() during testing.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_current_time = 0; /* Fake system time in seconds since 1970. */
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Find the current time (in Universal Coordinated Time). Write into *piNow
+** the current time and date as a Julian Day number times 86_400_000. In
+** other words, write into *piNow the number of milliseconds since the Julian
+** epoch of noon in Greenwich on November 24, 4714 B.C according to the
+** proleptic Gregorian calendar.
+**
+** On success, return SQLITE_OK. Return SQLITE_ERROR if the time and date
+** cannot be found.
+*/
+static int winCurrentTimeInt64(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, sqlite3_int64 *piNow){
+ /* FILETIME structure is a 64-bit value representing the number of
+ 100-nanosecond intervals since January 1, 1601 (= JD 2305813.5).
+ */
+ FILETIME ft;
+ static const sqlite3_int64 winFiletimeEpoch = 23058135*(sqlite3_int64)8640000;
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ static const sqlite3_int64 unixEpoch = 24405875*(sqlite3_int64)8640000;
+#endif
+ /* 2^32 - to avoid use of LL and warnings in gcc */
+ static const sqlite3_int64 max32BitValue =
+ (sqlite3_int64)2000000000 + (sqlite3_int64)2000000000 +
+ (sqlite3_int64)294967296;
+
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINCE
+ SYSTEMTIME time;
+ osGetSystemTime(&time);
+ /* if SystemTimeToFileTime() fails, it returns zero. */
+ if (!osSystemTimeToFileTime(&time,&ft)){
+ return SQLITE_ERROR;
+ }
+#else
+ osGetSystemTimeAsFileTime( &ft );
+#endif
+
+ *piNow = winFiletimeEpoch +
+ ((((sqlite3_int64)ft.dwHighDateTime)*max32BitValue) +
+ (sqlite3_int64)ft.dwLowDateTime)/(sqlite3_int64)10000;
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ if( sqlite3_current_time ){
+ *piNow = 1000*(sqlite3_int64)sqlite3_current_time + unixEpoch;
+ }
+#endif
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Find the current time (in Universal Coordinated Time). Write the
+** current time and date as a Julian Day number into *prNow and
+** return 0. Return 1 if the time and date cannot be found.
+*/
+static int winCurrentTime(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, double *prNow){
+ int rc;
+ sqlite3_int64 i;
+ rc = winCurrentTimeInt64(pVfs, &i);
+ if( !rc ){
+ *prNow = i/86400000.0;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** The idea is that this function works like a combination of
+** GetLastError() and FormatMessage() on Windows (or errno and
+** strerror_r() on Unix). After an error is returned by an OS
+** function, SQLite calls this function with zBuf pointing to
+** a buffer of nBuf bytes. The OS layer should populate the
+** buffer with a nul-terminated UTF-8 encoded error message
+** describing the last IO error to have occurred within the calling
+** thread.
+**
+** If the error message is too large for the supplied buffer,
+** it should be truncated. The return value of xGetLastError
+** is zero if the error message fits in the buffer, or non-zero
+** otherwise (if the message was truncated). If non-zero is returned,
+** then it is not necessary to include the nul-terminator character
+** in the output buffer.
+**
+** Not supplying an error message will have no adverse effect
+** on SQLite. It is fine to have an implementation that never
+** returns an error message:
+**
+** int xGetLastError(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int nBuf, char *zBuf){
+** assert(zBuf[0]=='\0');
+** return 0;
+** }
+**
+** However if an error message is supplied, it will be incorporated
+** by sqlite into the error message available to the user using
+** sqlite3_errmsg(), possibly making IO errors easier to debug.
+*/
+static int winGetLastError(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int nBuf, char *zBuf){
+ DWORD e = osGetLastError();
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pVfs);
+ if( nBuf>0 ) winGetLastErrorMsg(e, nBuf, zBuf);
+ return e;
+}
+
+/*
+** Initialize and deinitialize the operating system interface.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_os_init(void){
+ static sqlite3_vfs winVfs = {
+ 3, /* iVersion */
+ sizeof(winFile), /* szOsFile */
+ SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_PATH_BYTES, /* mxPathname */
+ 0, /* pNext */
+ "win32", /* zName */
+ &winAppData, /* pAppData */
+ winOpen, /* xOpen */
+ winDelete, /* xDelete */
+ winAccess, /* xAccess */
+ winFullPathname, /* xFullPathname */
+ winDlOpen, /* xDlOpen */
+ winDlError, /* xDlError */
+ winDlSym, /* xDlSym */
+ winDlClose, /* xDlClose */
+ winRandomness, /* xRandomness */
+ winSleep, /* xSleep */
+ winCurrentTime, /* xCurrentTime */
+ winGetLastError, /* xGetLastError */
+ winCurrentTimeInt64, /* xCurrentTimeInt64 */
+ winSetSystemCall, /* xSetSystemCall */
+ winGetSystemCall, /* xGetSystemCall */
+ winNextSystemCall, /* xNextSystemCall */
+ };
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ static sqlite3_vfs winLongPathVfs = {
+ 3, /* iVersion */
+ sizeof(winFile), /* szOsFile */
+ SQLITE_WINNT_MAX_PATH_BYTES, /* mxPathname */
+ 0, /* pNext */
+ "win32-longpath", /* zName */
+ &winAppData, /* pAppData */
+ winOpen, /* xOpen */
+ winDelete, /* xDelete */
+ winAccess, /* xAccess */
+ winFullPathname, /* xFullPathname */
+ winDlOpen, /* xDlOpen */
+ winDlError, /* xDlError */
+ winDlSym, /* xDlSym */
+ winDlClose, /* xDlClose */
+ winRandomness, /* xRandomness */
+ winSleep, /* xSleep */
+ winCurrentTime, /* xCurrentTime */
+ winGetLastError, /* xGetLastError */
+ winCurrentTimeInt64, /* xCurrentTimeInt64 */
+ winSetSystemCall, /* xSetSystemCall */
+ winGetSystemCall, /* xGetSystemCall */
+ winNextSystemCall, /* xNextSystemCall */
+ };
+#endif
+ static sqlite3_vfs winNolockVfs = {
+ 3, /* iVersion */
+ sizeof(winFile), /* szOsFile */
+ SQLITE_WIN32_MAX_PATH_BYTES, /* mxPathname */
+ 0, /* pNext */
+ "win32-none", /* zName */
+ &winNolockAppData, /* pAppData */
+ winOpen, /* xOpen */
+ winDelete, /* xDelete */
+ winAccess, /* xAccess */
+ winFullPathname, /* xFullPathname */
+ winDlOpen, /* xDlOpen */
+ winDlError, /* xDlError */
+ winDlSym, /* xDlSym */
+ winDlClose, /* xDlClose */
+ winRandomness, /* xRandomness */
+ winSleep, /* xSleep */
+ winCurrentTime, /* xCurrentTime */
+ winGetLastError, /* xGetLastError */
+ winCurrentTimeInt64, /* xCurrentTimeInt64 */
+ winSetSystemCall, /* xSetSystemCall */
+ winGetSystemCall, /* xGetSystemCall */
+ winNextSystemCall, /* xNextSystemCall */
+ };
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ static sqlite3_vfs winLongPathNolockVfs = {
+ 3, /* iVersion */
+ sizeof(winFile), /* szOsFile */
+ SQLITE_WINNT_MAX_PATH_BYTES, /* mxPathname */
+ 0, /* pNext */
+ "win32-longpath-none", /* zName */
+ &winNolockAppData, /* pAppData */
+ winOpen, /* xOpen */
+ winDelete, /* xDelete */
+ winAccess, /* xAccess */
+ winFullPathname, /* xFullPathname */
+ winDlOpen, /* xDlOpen */
+ winDlError, /* xDlError */
+ winDlSym, /* xDlSym */
+ winDlClose, /* xDlClose */
+ winRandomness, /* xRandomness */
+ winSleep, /* xSleep */
+ winCurrentTime, /* xCurrentTime */
+ winGetLastError, /* xGetLastError */
+ winCurrentTimeInt64, /* xCurrentTimeInt64 */
+ winSetSystemCall, /* xSetSystemCall */
+ winGetSystemCall, /* xGetSystemCall */
+ winNextSystemCall, /* xNextSystemCall */
+ };
+#endif
+
+ /* Double-check that the aSyscall[] array has been constructed
+ ** correctly. See ticket [bb3a86e890c8e96ab] */
+ assert( ArraySize(aSyscall)==80 );
+
+ /* get memory map allocation granularity */
+ memset(&winSysInfo, 0, sizeof(SYSTEM_INFO));
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ osGetNativeSystemInfo(&winSysInfo);
+#else
+ osGetSystemInfo(&winSysInfo);
+#endif
+ assert( winSysInfo.dwAllocationGranularity>0 );
+ assert( winSysInfo.dwPageSize>0 );
+
+ sqlite3_vfs_register(&winVfs, 1);
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ sqlite3_vfs_register(&winLongPathVfs, 0);
+#endif
+
+ sqlite3_vfs_register(&winNolockVfs, 0);
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_WIN32_HAS_WIDE)
+ sqlite3_vfs_register(&winLongPathNolockVfs, 0);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ winBigLock = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_VFS1);
+#endif
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_os_end(void){
+#if SQLITE_OS_WINRT
+ if( sleepObj!=NULL ){
+ osCloseHandle(sleepObj);
+ sleepObj = NULL;
+ }
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ winBigLock = 0;
+#endif
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#endif /* SQLITE_OS_WIN */
+
+/************** End of os_win.c **********************************************/
+/************** Begin file memdb.c *******************************************/
+/*
+** 2016-09-07
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+******************************************************************************
+**
+** This file implements an in-memory VFS. A database is held as a contiguous
+** block of memory.
+**
+** This file also implements interface sqlite3_serialize() and
+** sqlite3_deserialize().
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_DESERIALIZE
+
+/*
+** Forward declaration of objects used by this utility
+*/
+typedef struct sqlite3_vfs MemVfs;
+typedef struct MemFile MemFile;
+
+/* Access to a lower-level VFS that (might) implement dynamic loading,
+** access to randomness, etc.
+*/
+#define ORIGVFS(p) ((sqlite3_vfs*)((p)->pAppData))
+
+/* An open file */
+struct MemFile {
+ sqlite3_file base; /* IO methods */
+ sqlite3_int64 sz; /* Size of the file */
+ sqlite3_int64 szAlloc; /* Space allocated to aData */
+ sqlite3_int64 szMax; /* Maximum allowed size of the file */
+ unsigned char *aData; /* content of the file */
+ int nMmap; /* Number of memory mapped pages */
+ unsigned mFlags; /* Flags */
+ int eLock; /* Most recent lock against this file */
+};
+
+/*
+** Methods for MemFile
+*/
+static int memdbClose(sqlite3_file*);
+static int memdbRead(sqlite3_file*, void*, int iAmt, sqlite3_int64 iOfst);
+static int memdbWrite(sqlite3_file*,const void*,int iAmt, sqlite3_int64 iOfst);
+static int memdbTruncate(sqlite3_file*, sqlite3_int64 size);
+static int memdbSync(sqlite3_file*, int flags);
+static int memdbFileSize(sqlite3_file*, sqlite3_int64 *pSize);
+static int memdbLock(sqlite3_file*, int);
+/* static int memdbCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file*, int *pResOut);// not used */
+static int memdbFileControl(sqlite3_file*, int op, void *pArg);
+/* static int memdbSectorSize(sqlite3_file*); // not used */
+static int memdbDeviceCharacteristics(sqlite3_file*);
+static int memdbFetch(sqlite3_file*, sqlite3_int64 iOfst, int iAmt, void **pp);
+static int memdbUnfetch(sqlite3_file*, sqlite3_int64 iOfst, void *p);
+
+/*
+** Methods for MemVfs
+*/
+static int memdbOpen(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *, sqlite3_file*, int , int *);
+/* static int memdbDelete(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, int syncDir); */
+static int memdbAccess(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, int flags, int *);
+static int memdbFullPathname(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, int, char *zOut);
+static void *memdbDlOpen(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zFilename);
+static void memdbDlError(sqlite3_vfs*, int nByte, char *zErrMsg);
+static void (*memdbDlSym(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, void *p, const char*zSym))(void);
+static void memdbDlClose(sqlite3_vfs*, void*);
+static int memdbRandomness(sqlite3_vfs*, int nByte, char *zOut);
+static int memdbSleep(sqlite3_vfs*, int microseconds);
+/* static int memdbCurrentTime(sqlite3_vfs*, double*); */
+static int memdbGetLastError(sqlite3_vfs*, int, char *);
+static int memdbCurrentTimeInt64(sqlite3_vfs*, sqlite3_int64*);
+
+static sqlite3_vfs memdb_vfs = {
+ 2, /* iVersion */
+ 0, /* szOsFile (set when registered) */
+ 1024, /* mxPathname */
+ 0, /* pNext */
+ "memdb", /* zName */
+ 0, /* pAppData (set when registered) */
+ memdbOpen, /* xOpen */
+ 0, /* memdbDelete, */ /* xDelete */
+ memdbAccess, /* xAccess */
+ memdbFullPathname, /* xFullPathname */
+ memdbDlOpen, /* xDlOpen */
+ memdbDlError, /* xDlError */
+ memdbDlSym, /* xDlSym */
+ memdbDlClose, /* xDlClose */
+ memdbRandomness, /* xRandomness */
+ memdbSleep, /* xSleep */
+ 0, /* memdbCurrentTime, */ /* xCurrentTime */
+ memdbGetLastError, /* xGetLastError */
+ memdbCurrentTimeInt64 /* xCurrentTimeInt64 */
+};
+
+static const sqlite3_io_methods memdb_io_methods = {
+ 3, /* iVersion */
+ memdbClose, /* xClose */
+ memdbRead, /* xRead */
+ memdbWrite, /* xWrite */
+ memdbTruncate, /* xTruncate */
+ memdbSync, /* xSync */
+ memdbFileSize, /* xFileSize */
+ memdbLock, /* xLock */
+ memdbLock, /* xUnlock - same as xLock in this case */
+ 0, /* memdbCheckReservedLock, */ /* xCheckReservedLock */
+ memdbFileControl, /* xFileControl */
+ 0, /* memdbSectorSize,*/ /* xSectorSize */
+ memdbDeviceCharacteristics, /* xDeviceCharacteristics */
+ 0, /* xShmMap */
+ 0, /* xShmLock */
+ 0, /* xShmBarrier */
+ 0, /* xShmUnmap */
+ memdbFetch, /* xFetch */
+ memdbUnfetch /* xUnfetch */
+};
+
+
+
+/*
+** Close an memdb-file.
+**
+** The pData pointer is owned by the application, so there is nothing
+** to free.
+*/
+static int memdbClose(sqlite3_file *pFile){
+ MemFile *p = (MemFile *)pFile;
+ if( p->mFlags & SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_FREEONCLOSE ) sqlite3_free(p->aData);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Read data from an memdb-file.
+*/
+static int memdbRead(
+ sqlite3_file *pFile,
+ void *zBuf,
+ int iAmt,
+ sqlite_int64 iOfst
+){
+ MemFile *p = (MemFile *)pFile;
+ if( iOfst+iAmt>p->sz ){
+ memset(zBuf, 0, iAmt);
+ if( iOfstsz ) memcpy(zBuf, p->aData+iOfst, p->sz - iOfst);
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ;
+ }
+ memcpy(zBuf, p->aData+iOfst, iAmt);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Try to enlarge the memory allocation to hold at least sz bytes
+*/
+static int memdbEnlarge(MemFile *p, sqlite3_int64 newSz){
+ unsigned char *pNew;
+ if( (p->mFlags & SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_RESIZEABLE)==0 || p->nMmap>0 ){
+ return SQLITE_FULL;
+ }
+ if( newSz>p->szMax ){
+ return SQLITE_FULL;
+ }
+ newSz *= 2;
+ if( newSz>p->szMax ) newSz = p->szMax;
+ pNew = sqlite3Realloc(p->aData, newSz);
+ if( pNew==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM;
+ p->aData = pNew;
+ p->szAlloc = newSz;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Write data to an memdb-file.
+*/
+static int memdbWrite(
+ sqlite3_file *pFile,
+ const void *z,
+ int iAmt,
+ sqlite_int64 iOfst
+){
+ MemFile *p = (MemFile *)pFile;
+ if( NEVER(p->mFlags & SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_READONLY) ) return SQLITE_READONLY;
+ if( iOfst+iAmt>p->sz ){
+ int rc;
+ if( iOfst+iAmt>p->szAlloc
+ && (rc = memdbEnlarge(p, iOfst+iAmt))!=SQLITE_OK
+ ){
+ return rc;
+ }
+ if( iOfst>p->sz ) memset(p->aData+p->sz, 0, iOfst-p->sz);
+ p->sz = iOfst+iAmt;
+ }
+ memcpy(p->aData+iOfst, z, iAmt);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Truncate an memdb-file.
+**
+** In rollback mode (which is always the case for memdb, as it does not
+** support WAL mode) the truncate() method is only used to reduce
+** the size of a file, never to increase the size.
+*/
+static int memdbTruncate(sqlite3_file *pFile, sqlite_int64 size){
+ MemFile *p = (MemFile *)pFile;
+ if( NEVER(size>p->sz) ) return SQLITE_FULL;
+ p->sz = size;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Sync an memdb-file.
+*/
+static int memdbSync(sqlite3_file *pFile, int flags){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the current file-size of an memdb-file.
+*/
+static int memdbFileSize(sqlite3_file *pFile, sqlite_int64 *pSize){
+ MemFile *p = (MemFile *)pFile;
+ *pSize = p->sz;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lock an memdb-file.
+*/
+static int memdbLock(sqlite3_file *pFile, int eLock){
+ MemFile *p = (MemFile *)pFile;
+ if( eLock>SQLITE_LOCK_SHARED
+ && (p->mFlags & SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_READONLY)!=0
+ ){
+ return SQLITE_READONLY;
+ }
+ p->eLock = eLock;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#if 0 /* Never used because memdbAccess() always returns false */
+/*
+** Check if another file-handle holds a RESERVED lock on an memdb-file.
+*/
+static int memdbCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *pFile, int *pResOut){
+ *pResOut = 0;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** File control method. For custom operations on an memdb-file.
+*/
+static int memdbFileControl(sqlite3_file *pFile, int op, void *pArg){
+ MemFile *p = (MemFile *)pFile;
+ int rc = SQLITE_NOTFOUND;
+ if( op==SQLITE_FCNTL_VFSNAME ){
+ *(char**)pArg = sqlite3_mprintf("memdb(%p,%lld)", p->aData, p->sz);
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ if( op==SQLITE_FCNTL_SIZE_LIMIT ){
+ sqlite3_int64 iLimit = *(sqlite3_int64*)pArg;
+ if( iLimitsz ){
+ if( iLimit<0 ){
+ iLimit = p->szMax;
+ }else{
+ iLimit = p->sz;
+ }
+ }
+ p->szMax = iLimit;
+ *(sqlite3_int64*)pArg = iLimit;
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+#if 0 /* Not used because of SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE */
+/*
+** Return the sector-size in bytes for an memdb-file.
+*/
+static int memdbSectorSize(sqlite3_file *pFile){
+ return 1024;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Return the device characteristic flags supported by an memdb-file.
+*/
+static int memdbDeviceCharacteristics(sqlite3_file *pFile){
+ return SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC |
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE |
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND |
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL;
+}
+
+/* Fetch a page of a memory-mapped file */
+static int memdbFetch(
+ sqlite3_file *pFile,
+ sqlite3_int64 iOfst,
+ int iAmt,
+ void **pp
+){
+ MemFile *p = (MemFile *)pFile;
+ if( iOfst+iAmt>p->sz ){
+ *pp = 0;
+ }else{
+ p->nMmap++;
+ *pp = (void*)(p->aData + iOfst);
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/* Release a memory-mapped page */
+static int memdbUnfetch(sqlite3_file *pFile, sqlite3_int64 iOfst, void *pPage){
+ MemFile *p = (MemFile *)pFile;
+ p->nMmap--;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Open an mem file handle.
+*/
+static int memdbOpen(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs,
+ const char *zName,
+ sqlite3_file *pFile,
+ int flags,
+ int *pOutFlags
+){
+ MemFile *p = (MemFile*)pFile;
+ if( (flags & SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB)==0 ){
+ return ORIGVFS(pVfs)->xOpen(ORIGVFS(pVfs), zName, pFile, flags, pOutFlags);
+ }
+ memset(p, 0, sizeof(*p));
+ p->mFlags = SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_RESIZEABLE | SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_FREEONCLOSE;
+ assert( pOutFlags!=0 ); /* True because flags==SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB */
+ *pOutFlags = flags | SQLITE_OPEN_MEMORY;
+ pFile->pMethods = &memdb_io_methods;
+ p->szMax = sqlite3GlobalConfig.mxMemdbSize;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#if 0 /* Only used to delete rollback journals, super-journals, and WAL
+ ** files, none of which exist in memdb. So this routine is never used */
+/*
+** Delete the file located at zPath. If the dirSync argument is true,
+** ensure the file-system modifications are synced to disk before
+** returning.
+*/
+static int memdbDelete(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, const char *zPath, int dirSync){
+ return SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Test for access permissions. Return true if the requested permission
+** is available, or false otherwise.
+**
+** With memdb, no files ever exist on disk. So always return false.
+*/
+static int memdbAccess(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs,
+ const char *zPath,
+ int flags,
+ int *pResOut
+){
+ *pResOut = 0;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Populate buffer zOut with the full canonical pathname corresponding
+** to the pathname in zPath. zOut is guaranteed to point to a buffer
+** of at least (INST_MAX_PATHNAME+1) bytes.
+*/
+static int memdbFullPathname(
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs,
+ const char *zPath,
+ int nOut,
+ char *zOut
+){
+ sqlite3_snprintf(nOut, zOut, "%s", zPath);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Open the dynamic library located at zPath and return a handle.
+*/
+static void *memdbDlOpen(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, const char *zPath){
+ return ORIGVFS(pVfs)->xDlOpen(ORIGVFS(pVfs), zPath);
+}
+
+/*
+** Populate the buffer zErrMsg (size nByte bytes) with a human readable
+** utf-8 string describing the most recent error encountered associated
+** with dynamic libraries.
+*/
+static void memdbDlError(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int nByte, char *zErrMsg){
+ ORIGVFS(pVfs)->xDlError(ORIGVFS(pVfs), nByte, zErrMsg);
+}
+
+/*
+** Return a pointer to the symbol zSymbol in the dynamic library pHandle.
+*/
+static void (*memdbDlSym(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, void *p, const char *zSym))(void){
+ return ORIGVFS(pVfs)->xDlSym(ORIGVFS(pVfs), p, zSym);
+}
+
+/*
+** Close the dynamic library handle pHandle.
+*/
+static void memdbDlClose(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, void *pHandle){
+ ORIGVFS(pVfs)->xDlClose(ORIGVFS(pVfs), pHandle);
+}
+
+/*
+** Populate the buffer pointed to by zBufOut with nByte bytes of
+** random data.
+*/
+static int memdbRandomness(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int nByte, char *zBufOut){
+ return ORIGVFS(pVfs)->xRandomness(ORIGVFS(pVfs), nByte, zBufOut);
+}
+
+/*
+** Sleep for nMicro microseconds. Return the number of microseconds
+** actually slept.
+*/
+static int memdbSleep(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int nMicro){
+ return ORIGVFS(pVfs)->xSleep(ORIGVFS(pVfs), nMicro);
+}
+
+#if 0 /* Never used. Modern cores only call xCurrentTimeInt64() */
+/*
+** Return the current time as a Julian Day number in *pTimeOut.
+*/
+static int memdbCurrentTime(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, double *pTimeOut){
+ return ORIGVFS(pVfs)->xCurrentTime(ORIGVFS(pVfs), pTimeOut);
+}
+#endif
+
+static int memdbGetLastError(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, int a, char *b){
+ return ORIGVFS(pVfs)->xGetLastError(ORIGVFS(pVfs), a, b);
+}
+static int memdbCurrentTimeInt64(sqlite3_vfs *pVfs, sqlite3_int64 *p){
+ return ORIGVFS(pVfs)->xCurrentTimeInt64(ORIGVFS(pVfs), p);
+}
+
+/*
+** Translate a database connection pointer and schema name into a
+** MemFile pointer.
+*/
+static MemFile *memdbFromDbSchema(sqlite3 *db, const char *zSchema){
+ MemFile *p = 0;
+ int rc = sqlite3_file_control(db, zSchema, SQLITE_FCNTL_FILE_POINTER, &p);
+ if( rc ) return 0;
+ if( p->base.pMethods!=&memdb_io_methods ) return 0;
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the serialization of a database
+*/
+SQLITE_API unsigned char *sqlite3_serialize(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* The database connection */
+ const char *zSchema, /* Which database within the connection */
+ sqlite3_int64 *piSize, /* Write size here, if not NULL */
+ unsigned int mFlags /* Maybe SQLITE_SERIALIZE_NOCOPY */
+){
+ MemFile *p;
+ int iDb;
+ Btree *pBt;
+ sqlite3_int64 sz;
+ int szPage = 0;
+ sqlite3_stmt *pStmt = 0;
+ unsigned char *pOut;
+ char *zSql;
+ int rc;
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( !sqlite3SafetyCheckOk(db) ){
+ (void)SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ return 0;
+ }
+#endif
+
+ if( zSchema==0 ) zSchema = db->aDb[0].zDbSName;
+ p = memdbFromDbSchema(db, zSchema);
+ iDb = sqlite3FindDbName(db, zSchema);
+ if( piSize ) *piSize = -1;
+ if( iDb<0 ) return 0;
+ if( p ){
+ if( piSize ) *piSize = p->sz;
+ if( mFlags & SQLITE_SERIALIZE_NOCOPY ){
+ pOut = p->aData;
+ }else{
+ pOut = sqlite3_malloc64( p->sz );
+ if( pOut ) memcpy(pOut, p->aData, p->sz);
+ }
+ return pOut;
+ }
+ pBt = db->aDb[iDb].pBt;
+ if( pBt==0 ) return 0;
+ szPage = sqlite3BtreeGetPageSize(pBt);
+ zSql = sqlite3_mprintf("PRAGMA \"%w\".page_count", zSchema);
+ rc = zSql ? sqlite3_prepare_v2(db, zSql, -1, &pStmt, 0) : SQLITE_NOMEM;
+ sqlite3_free(zSql);
+ if( rc ) return 0;
+ rc = sqlite3_step(pStmt);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_ROW ){
+ pOut = 0;
+ }else{
+ sz = sqlite3_column_int64(pStmt, 0)*szPage;
+ if( piSize ) *piSize = sz;
+ if( mFlags & SQLITE_SERIALIZE_NOCOPY ){
+ pOut = 0;
+ }else{
+ pOut = sqlite3_malloc64( sz );
+ if( pOut ){
+ int nPage = sqlite3_column_int(pStmt, 0);
+ Pager *pPager = sqlite3BtreePager(pBt);
+ int pgno;
+ for(pgno=1; pgno<=nPage; pgno++){
+ DbPage *pPage = 0;
+ unsigned char *pTo = pOut + szPage*(sqlite3_int64)(pgno-1);
+ rc = sqlite3PagerGet(pPager, pgno, (DbPage**)&pPage, 0);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ memcpy(pTo, sqlite3PagerGetData(pPage), szPage);
+ }else{
+ memset(pTo, 0, szPage);
+ }
+ sqlite3PagerUnref(pPage);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ sqlite3_finalize(pStmt);
+ return pOut;
+}
+
+/* Convert zSchema to a MemDB and initialize its content.
+*/
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_deserialize(
+ sqlite3 *db, /* The database connection */
+ const char *zSchema, /* Which DB to reopen with the deserialization */
+ unsigned char *pData, /* The serialized database content */
+ sqlite3_int64 szDb, /* Number bytes in the deserialization */
+ sqlite3_int64 szBuf, /* Total size of buffer pData[] */
+ unsigned mFlags /* Zero or more SQLITE_DESERIALIZE_* flags */
+){
+ MemFile *p;
+ char *zSql;
+ sqlite3_stmt *pStmt = 0;
+ int rc;
+ int iDb;
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_API_ARMOR
+ if( !sqlite3SafetyCheckOk(db) ){
+ return SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ }
+ if( szDb<0 ) return SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+ if( szBuf<0 ) return SQLITE_MISUSE_BKPT;
+#endif
+
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(db->mutex);
+ if( zSchema==0 ) zSchema = db->aDb[0].zDbSName;
+ iDb = sqlite3FindDbName(db, zSchema);
+ if( iDb<0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR;
+ goto end_deserialize;
+ }
+ zSql = sqlite3_mprintf("ATTACH x AS %Q", zSchema);
+ rc = sqlite3_prepare_v2(db, zSql, -1, &pStmt, 0);
+ sqlite3_free(zSql);
+ if( rc ) goto end_deserialize;
+ db->init.iDb = (u8)iDb;
+ db->init.reopenMemdb = 1;
+ rc = sqlite3_step(pStmt);
+ db->init.reopenMemdb = 0;
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_DONE ){
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR;
+ goto end_deserialize;
+ }
+ p = memdbFromDbSchema(db, zSchema);
+ if( p==0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_ERROR;
+ }else{
+ p->aData = pData;
+ p->sz = szDb;
+ p->szAlloc = szBuf;
+ p->szMax = szBuf;
+ if( p->szMaxszMax = sqlite3GlobalConfig.mxMemdbSize;
+ }
+ p->mFlags = mFlags;
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+end_deserialize:
+ sqlite3_finalize(pStmt);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(db->mutex);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This routine is called when the extension is loaded.
+** Register the new VFS.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3MemdbInit(void){
+ sqlite3_vfs *pLower = sqlite3_vfs_find(0);
+ int sz = pLower->szOsFile;
+ memdb_vfs.pAppData = pLower;
+ /* The following conditional can only be true when compiled for
+ ** Windows x86 and SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE=0. We always leave
+ ** it in, to be safe, but it is marked as NO_TEST since there
+ ** is no way to reach it under most builds. */
+ if( szBITVEC_NBIT and iDivisor==0 then Bitvec.u.aHash[] is
+** a hash table that will hold up to BITVEC_MXHASH distinct values.
+**
+** Otherwise, the value i is redirected into one of BITVEC_NPTR
+** sub-bitmaps pointed to by Bitvec.u.apSub[]. Each subbitmap
+** handles up to iDivisor separate values of i. apSub[0] holds
+** values between 1 and iDivisor. apSub[1] holds values between
+** iDivisor+1 and 2*iDivisor. apSub[N] holds values between
+** N*iDivisor+1 and (N+1)*iDivisor. Each subbitmap is normalized
+** to hold deal with values between 1 and iDivisor.
+*/
+struct Bitvec {
+ u32 iSize; /* Maximum bit index. Max iSize is 4,294,967,296. */
+ u32 nSet; /* Number of bits that are set - only valid for aHash
+ ** element. Max is BITVEC_NINT. For BITVEC_SZ of 512,
+ ** this would be 125. */
+ u32 iDivisor; /* Number of bits handled by each apSub[] entry. */
+ /* Should >=0 for apSub element. */
+ /* Max iDivisor is max(u32) / BITVEC_NPTR + 1. */
+ /* For a BITVEC_SZ of 512, this would be 34,359,739. */
+ union {
+ BITVEC_TELEM aBitmap[BITVEC_NELEM]; /* Bitmap representation */
+ u32 aHash[BITVEC_NINT]; /* Hash table representation */
+ Bitvec *apSub[BITVEC_NPTR]; /* Recursive representation */
+ } u;
+};
+
+/*
+** Create a new bitmap object able to handle bits between 0 and iSize,
+** inclusive. Return a pointer to the new object. Return NULL if
+** malloc fails.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Bitvec *sqlite3BitvecCreate(u32 iSize){
+ Bitvec *p;
+ assert( sizeof(*p)==BITVEC_SZ );
+ p = sqlite3MallocZero( sizeof(*p) );
+ if( p ){
+ p->iSize = iSize;
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Check to see if the i-th bit is set. Return true or false.
+** If p is NULL (if the bitmap has not been created) or if
+** i is out of range, then return false.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BitvecTestNotNull(Bitvec *p, u32 i){
+ assert( p!=0 );
+ i--;
+ if( i>=p->iSize ) return 0;
+ while( p->iDivisor ){
+ u32 bin = i/p->iDivisor;
+ i = i%p->iDivisor;
+ p = p->u.apSub[bin];
+ if (!p) {
+ return 0;
+ }
+ }
+ if( p->iSize<=BITVEC_NBIT ){
+ return (p->u.aBitmap[i/BITVEC_SZELEM] & (1<<(i&(BITVEC_SZELEM-1))))!=0;
+ } else{
+ u32 h = BITVEC_HASH(i++);
+ while( p->u.aHash[h] ){
+ if( p->u.aHash[h]==i ) return 1;
+ h = (h+1) % BITVEC_NINT;
+ }
+ return 0;
+ }
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BitvecTest(Bitvec *p, u32 i){
+ return p!=0 && sqlite3BitvecTestNotNull(p,i);
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the i-th bit. Return 0 on success and an error code if
+** anything goes wrong.
+**
+** This routine might cause sub-bitmaps to be allocated. Failing
+** to get the memory needed to hold the sub-bitmap is the only
+** that can go wrong with an insert, assuming p and i are valid.
+**
+** The calling function must ensure that p is a valid Bitvec object
+** and that the value for "i" is within range of the Bitvec object.
+** Otherwise the behavior is undefined.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BitvecSet(Bitvec *p, u32 i){
+ u32 h;
+ if( p==0 ) return SQLITE_OK;
+ assert( i>0 );
+ assert( i<=p->iSize );
+ i--;
+ while((p->iSize > BITVEC_NBIT) && p->iDivisor) {
+ u32 bin = i/p->iDivisor;
+ i = i%p->iDivisor;
+ if( p->u.apSub[bin]==0 ){
+ p->u.apSub[bin] = sqlite3BitvecCreate( p->iDivisor );
+ if( p->u.apSub[bin]==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ p = p->u.apSub[bin];
+ }
+ if( p->iSize<=BITVEC_NBIT ){
+ p->u.aBitmap[i/BITVEC_SZELEM] |= 1 << (i&(BITVEC_SZELEM-1));
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ h = BITVEC_HASH(i++);
+ /* if there wasn't a hash collision, and this doesn't */
+ /* completely fill the hash, then just add it without */
+ /* worring about sub-dividing and re-hashing. */
+ if( !p->u.aHash[h] ){
+ if (p->nSet<(BITVEC_NINT-1)) {
+ goto bitvec_set_end;
+ } else {
+ goto bitvec_set_rehash;
+ }
+ }
+ /* there was a collision, check to see if it's already */
+ /* in hash, if not, try to find a spot for it */
+ do {
+ if( p->u.aHash[h]==i ) return SQLITE_OK;
+ h++;
+ if( h>=BITVEC_NINT ) h = 0;
+ } while( p->u.aHash[h] );
+ /* we didn't find it in the hash. h points to the first */
+ /* available free spot. check to see if this is going to */
+ /* make our hash too "full". */
+bitvec_set_rehash:
+ if( p->nSet>=BITVEC_MXHASH ){
+ unsigned int j;
+ int rc;
+ u32 *aiValues = sqlite3StackAllocRaw(0, sizeof(p->u.aHash));
+ if( aiValues==0 ){
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }else{
+ memcpy(aiValues, p->u.aHash, sizeof(p->u.aHash));
+ memset(p->u.apSub, 0, sizeof(p->u.apSub));
+ p->iDivisor = (p->iSize + BITVEC_NPTR - 1)/BITVEC_NPTR;
+ rc = sqlite3BitvecSet(p, i);
+ for(j=0; jnSet++;
+ p->u.aHash[h] = i;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Clear the i-th bit.
+**
+** pBuf must be a pointer to at least BITVEC_SZ bytes of temporary storage
+** that BitvecClear can use to rebuilt its hash table.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BitvecClear(Bitvec *p, u32 i, void *pBuf){
+ if( p==0 ) return;
+ assert( i>0 );
+ i--;
+ while( p->iDivisor ){
+ u32 bin = i/p->iDivisor;
+ i = i%p->iDivisor;
+ p = p->u.apSub[bin];
+ if (!p) {
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ if( p->iSize<=BITVEC_NBIT ){
+ p->u.aBitmap[i/BITVEC_SZELEM] &= ~(1 << (i&(BITVEC_SZELEM-1)));
+ }else{
+ unsigned int j;
+ u32 *aiValues = pBuf;
+ memcpy(aiValues, p->u.aHash, sizeof(p->u.aHash));
+ memset(p->u.aHash, 0, sizeof(p->u.aHash));
+ p->nSet = 0;
+ for(j=0; jnSet++;
+ while( p->u.aHash[h] ){
+ h++;
+ if( h>=BITVEC_NINT ) h = 0;
+ }
+ p->u.aHash[h] = aiValues[j];
+ }
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Destroy a bitmap object. Reclaim all memory used.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BitvecDestroy(Bitvec *p){
+ if( p==0 ) return;
+ if( p->iDivisor ){
+ unsigned int i;
+ for(i=0; iu.apSub[i]);
+ }
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the value of the iSize parameter specified when Bitvec *p
+** was created.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3BitvecSize(Bitvec *p){
+ return p->iSize;
+}
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_UNTESTABLE
+/*
+** Let V[] be an array of unsigned characters sufficient to hold
+** up to N bits. Let I be an integer between 0 and N. 0<=I>3] |= (1<<(I&7))
+#define CLEARBIT(V,I) V[I>>3] &= ~(1<<(I&7))
+#define TESTBIT(V,I) (V[I>>3]&(1<<(I&7)))!=0
+
+/*
+** This routine runs an extensive test of the Bitvec code.
+**
+** The input is an array of integers that acts as a program
+** to test the Bitvec. The integers are opcodes followed
+** by 0, 1, or 3 operands, depending on the opcode. Another
+** opcode follows immediately after the last operand.
+**
+** There are 6 opcodes numbered from 0 through 5. 0 is the
+** "halt" opcode and causes the test to end.
+**
+** 0 Halt and return the number of errors
+** 1 N S X Set N bits beginning with S and incrementing by X
+** 2 N S X Clear N bits beginning with S and incrementing by X
+** 3 N Set N randomly chosen bits
+** 4 N Clear N randomly chosen bits
+** 5 N S X Set N bits from S increment X in array only, not in bitvec
+**
+** The opcodes 1 through 4 perform set and clear operations are performed
+** on both a Bitvec object and on a linear array of bits obtained from malloc.
+** Opcode 5 works on the linear array only, not on the Bitvec.
+** Opcode 5 is used to deliberately induce a fault in order to
+** confirm that error detection works.
+**
+** At the conclusion of the test the linear array is compared
+** against the Bitvec object. If there are any differences,
+** an error is returned. If they are the same, zero is returned.
+**
+** If a memory allocation error occurs, return -1.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BitvecBuiltinTest(int sz, int *aOp){
+ Bitvec *pBitvec = 0;
+ unsigned char *pV = 0;
+ int rc = -1;
+ int i, nx, pc, op;
+ void *pTmpSpace;
+
+ /* Allocate the Bitvec to be tested and a linear array of
+ ** bits to act as the reference */
+ pBitvec = sqlite3BitvecCreate( sz );
+ pV = sqlite3MallocZero( (sz+7)/8 + 1 );
+ pTmpSpace = sqlite3_malloc64(BITVEC_SZ);
+ if( pBitvec==0 || pV==0 || pTmpSpace==0 ) goto bitvec_end;
+
+ /* NULL pBitvec tests */
+ sqlite3BitvecSet(0, 1);
+ sqlite3BitvecClear(0, 1, pTmpSpace);
+
+ /* Run the program */
+ pc = 0;
+ while( (op = aOp[pc])!=0 ){
+ switch( op ){
+ case 1:
+ case 2:
+ case 5: {
+ nx = 4;
+ i = aOp[pc+2] - 1;
+ aOp[pc+2] += aOp[pc+3];
+ break;
+ }
+ case 3:
+ case 4:
+ default: {
+ nx = 2;
+ sqlite3_randomness(sizeof(i), &i);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if( (--aOp[pc+1]) > 0 ) nx = 0;
+ pc += nx;
+ i = (i & 0x7fffffff)%sz;
+ if( (op & 1)!=0 ){
+ SETBIT(pV, (i+1));
+ if( op!=5 ){
+ if( sqlite3BitvecSet(pBitvec, i+1) ) goto bitvec_end;
+ }
+ }else{
+ CLEARBIT(pV, (i+1));
+ sqlite3BitvecClear(pBitvec, i+1, pTmpSpace);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Test to make sure the linear array exactly matches the
+ ** Bitvec object. Start with the assumption that they do
+ ** match (rc==0). Change rc to non-zero if a discrepancy
+ ** is found.
+ */
+ rc = sqlite3BitvecTest(0,0) + sqlite3BitvecTest(pBitvec, sz+1)
+ + sqlite3BitvecTest(pBitvec, 0)
+ + (sqlite3BitvecSize(pBitvec) - sz);
+ for(i=1; i<=sz; i++){
+ if( (TESTBIT(pV,i))!=sqlite3BitvecTest(pBitvec,i) ){
+ rc = i;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Free allocated structure */
+bitvec_end:
+ sqlite3_free(pTmpSpace);
+ sqlite3_free(pV);
+ sqlite3BitvecDestroy(pBitvec);
+ return rc;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_UNTESTABLE */
+
+/************** End of bitvec.c **********************************************/
+/************** Begin file pcache.c ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 August 05
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This file implements that page cache.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+/*
+** A complete page cache is an instance of this structure. Every
+** entry in the cache holds a single page of the database file. The
+** btree layer only operates on the cached copy of the database pages.
+**
+** A page cache entry is "clean" if it exactly matches what is currently
+** on disk. A page is "dirty" if it has been modified and needs to be
+** persisted to disk.
+**
+** pDirty, pDirtyTail, pSynced:
+** All dirty pages are linked into the doubly linked list using
+** PgHdr.pDirtyNext and pDirtyPrev. The list is maintained in LRU order
+** such that p was added to the list more recently than p->pDirtyNext.
+** PCache.pDirty points to the first (newest) element in the list and
+** pDirtyTail to the last (oldest).
+**
+** The PCache.pSynced variable is used to optimize searching for a dirty
+** page to eject from the cache mid-transaction. It is better to eject
+** a page that does not require a journal sync than one that does.
+** Therefore, pSynced is maintained so that it *almost* always points
+** to either the oldest page in the pDirty/pDirtyTail list that has a
+** clear PGHDR_NEED_SYNC flag or to a page that is older than this one
+** (so that the right page to eject can be found by following pDirtyPrev
+** pointers).
+*/
+struct PCache {
+ PgHdr *pDirty, *pDirtyTail; /* List of dirty pages in LRU order */
+ PgHdr *pSynced; /* Last synced page in dirty page list */
+ int nRefSum; /* Sum of ref counts over all pages */
+ int szCache; /* Configured cache size */
+ int szSpill; /* Size before spilling occurs */
+ int szPage; /* Size of every page in this cache */
+ int szExtra; /* Size of extra space for each page */
+ u8 bPurgeable; /* True if pages are on backing store */
+ u8 eCreate; /* eCreate value for for xFetch() */
+ int (*xStress)(void*,PgHdr*); /* Call to try make a page clean */
+ void *pStress; /* Argument to xStress */
+ sqlite3_pcache *pCache; /* Pluggable cache module */
+};
+
+/********************************** Test and Debug Logic **********************/
+/*
+** Debug tracing macros. Enable by by changing the "0" to "1" and
+** recompiling.
+**
+** When sqlite3PcacheTrace is 1, single line trace messages are issued.
+** When sqlite3PcacheTrace is 2, a dump of the pcache showing all cache entries
+** is displayed for many operations, resulting in a lot of output.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) && 0
+ int sqlite3PcacheTrace = 2; /* 0: off 1: simple 2: cache dumps */
+ int sqlite3PcacheMxDump = 9999; /* Max cache entries for pcacheDump() */
+# define pcacheTrace(X) if(sqlite3PcacheTrace){sqlite3DebugPrintf X;}
+ void pcacheDump(PCache *pCache){
+ int N;
+ int i, j;
+ sqlite3_pcache_page *pLower;
+ PgHdr *pPg;
+ unsigned char *a;
+
+ if( sqlite3PcacheTrace<2 ) return;
+ if( pCache->pCache==0 ) return;
+ N = sqlite3PcachePagecount(pCache);
+ if( N>sqlite3PcacheMxDump ) N = sqlite3PcacheMxDump;
+ for(i=1; i<=N; i++){
+ pLower = sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xFetch(pCache->pCache, i, 0);
+ if( pLower==0 ) continue;
+ pPg = (PgHdr*)pLower->pExtra;
+ printf("%3d: nRef %2d flgs %02x data ", i, pPg->nRef, pPg->flags);
+ a = (unsigned char *)pLower->pBuf;
+ for(j=0; j<12; j++) printf("%02x", a[j]);
+ printf("\n");
+ if( pPg->pPage==0 ){
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xUnpin(pCache->pCache, pLower, 0);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ #else
+# define pcacheTrace(X)
+# define pcacheDump(X)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Check invariants on a PgHdr entry. Return true if everything is OK.
+** Return false if any invariant is violated.
+**
+** This routine is for use inside of assert() statements only. For
+** example:
+**
+** assert( sqlite3PcachePageSanity(pPg) );
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcachePageSanity(PgHdr *pPg){
+ PCache *pCache;
+ assert( pPg!=0 );
+ assert( pPg->pgno>0 || pPg->pPager==0 ); /* Page number is 1 or more */
+ pCache = pPg->pCache;
+ assert( pCache!=0 ); /* Every page has an associated PCache */
+ if( pPg->flags & PGHDR_CLEAN ){
+ assert( (pPg->flags & PGHDR_DIRTY)==0 );/* Cannot be both CLEAN and DIRTY */
+ assert( pCache->pDirty!=pPg ); /* CLEAN pages not on dirty list */
+ assert( pCache->pDirtyTail!=pPg );
+ }
+ /* WRITEABLE pages must also be DIRTY */
+ if( pPg->flags & PGHDR_WRITEABLE ){
+ assert( pPg->flags & PGHDR_DIRTY ); /* WRITEABLE implies DIRTY */
+ }
+ /* NEED_SYNC can be set independently of WRITEABLE. This can happen,
+ ** for example, when using the sqlite3PagerDontWrite() optimization:
+ ** (1) Page X is journalled, and gets WRITEABLE and NEED_SEEK.
+ ** (2) Page X moved to freelist, WRITEABLE is cleared
+ ** (3) Page X reused, WRITEABLE is set again
+ ** If NEED_SYNC had been cleared in step 2, then it would not be reset
+ ** in step 3, and page might be written into the database without first
+ ** syncing the rollback journal, which might cause corruption on a power
+ ** loss.
+ **
+ ** Another example is when the database page size is smaller than the
+ ** disk sector size. When any page of a sector is journalled, all pages
+ ** in that sector are marked NEED_SYNC even if they are still CLEAN, just
+ ** in case they are later modified, since all pages in the same sector
+ ** must be journalled and synced before any of those pages can be safely
+ ** written.
+ */
+ return 1;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_DEBUG */
+
+
+/********************************** Linked List Management ********************/
+
+/* Allowed values for second argument to pcacheManageDirtyList() */
+#define PCACHE_DIRTYLIST_REMOVE 1 /* Remove pPage from dirty list */
+#define PCACHE_DIRTYLIST_ADD 2 /* Add pPage to the dirty list */
+#define PCACHE_DIRTYLIST_FRONT 3 /* Move pPage to the front of the list */
+
+/*
+** Manage pPage's participation on the dirty list. Bits of the addRemove
+** argument determines what operation to do. The 0x01 bit means first
+** remove pPage from the dirty list. The 0x02 means add pPage back to
+** the dirty list. Doing both moves pPage to the front of the dirty list.
+*/
+static void pcacheManageDirtyList(PgHdr *pPage, u8 addRemove){
+ PCache *p = pPage->pCache;
+
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.DIRTYLIST.%s %d\n", p,
+ addRemove==1 ? "REMOVE" : addRemove==2 ? "ADD" : "FRONT",
+ pPage->pgno));
+ if( addRemove & PCACHE_DIRTYLIST_REMOVE ){
+ assert( pPage->pDirtyNext || pPage==p->pDirtyTail );
+ assert( pPage->pDirtyPrev || pPage==p->pDirty );
+
+ /* Update the PCache1.pSynced variable if necessary. */
+ if( p->pSynced==pPage ){
+ p->pSynced = pPage->pDirtyPrev;
+ }
+
+ if( pPage->pDirtyNext ){
+ pPage->pDirtyNext->pDirtyPrev = pPage->pDirtyPrev;
+ }else{
+ assert( pPage==p->pDirtyTail );
+ p->pDirtyTail = pPage->pDirtyPrev;
+ }
+ if( pPage->pDirtyPrev ){
+ pPage->pDirtyPrev->pDirtyNext = pPage->pDirtyNext;
+ }else{
+ /* If there are now no dirty pages in the cache, set eCreate to 2.
+ ** This is an optimization that allows sqlite3PcacheFetch() to skip
+ ** searching for a dirty page to eject from the cache when it might
+ ** otherwise have to. */
+ assert( pPage==p->pDirty );
+ p->pDirty = pPage->pDirtyNext;
+ assert( p->bPurgeable || p->eCreate==2 );
+ if( p->pDirty==0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ assert( p->bPurgeable==0 || p->eCreate==1 );
+ p->eCreate = 2;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ if( addRemove & PCACHE_DIRTYLIST_ADD ){
+ pPage->pDirtyPrev = 0;
+ pPage->pDirtyNext = p->pDirty;
+ if( pPage->pDirtyNext ){
+ assert( pPage->pDirtyNext->pDirtyPrev==0 );
+ pPage->pDirtyNext->pDirtyPrev = pPage;
+ }else{
+ p->pDirtyTail = pPage;
+ if( p->bPurgeable ){
+ assert( p->eCreate==2 );
+ p->eCreate = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ p->pDirty = pPage;
+
+ /* If pSynced is NULL and this page has a clear NEED_SYNC flag, set
+ ** pSynced to point to it. Checking the NEED_SYNC flag is an
+ ** optimization, as if pSynced points to a page with the NEED_SYNC
+ ** flag set sqlite3PcacheFetchStress() searches through all newer
+ ** entries of the dirty-list for a page with NEED_SYNC clear anyway. */
+ if( !p->pSynced
+ && 0==(pPage->flags&PGHDR_NEED_SYNC) /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ ){
+ p->pSynced = pPage;
+ }
+ }
+ pcacheDump(p);
+}
+
+/*
+** Wrapper around the pluggable caches xUnpin method. If the cache is
+** being used for an in-memory database, this function is a no-op.
+*/
+static void pcacheUnpin(PgHdr *p){
+ if( p->pCache->bPurgeable ){
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.UNPIN %d\n", p->pCache, p->pgno));
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xUnpin(p->pCache->pCache, p->pPage, 0);
+ pcacheDump(p->pCache);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Compute the number of pages of cache requested. p->szCache is the
+** cache size requested by the "PRAGMA cache_size" statement.
+*/
+static int numberOfCachePages(PCache *p){
+ if( p->szCache>=0 ){
+ /* IMPLEMENTATION-OF: R-42059-47211 If the argument N is positive then the
+ ** suggested cache size is set to N. */
+ return p->szCache;
+ }else{
+ /* IMPLEMANTATION-OF: R-59858-46238 If the argument N is negative, then the
+ ** number of cache pages is adjusted to be a number of pages that would
+ ** use approximately abs(N*1024) bytes of memory based on the current
+ ** page size. */
+ return (int)((-1024*(i64)p->szCache)/(p->szPage+p->szExtra));
+ }
+}
+
+/*************************************************** General Interfaces ******
+**
+** Initialize and shutdown the page cache subsystem. Neither of these
+** functions are threadsafe.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheInitialize(void){
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xInit==0 ){
+ /* IMPLEMENTATION-OF: R-26801-64137 If the xInit() method is NULL, then the
+ ** built-in default page cache is used instead of the application defined
+ ** page cache. */
+ sqlite3PCacheSetDefault();
+ assert( sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xInit!=0 );
+ }
+ return sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xInit(sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.pArg);
+}
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheShutdown(void){
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xShutdown ){
+ /* IMPLEMENTATION-OF: R-26000-56589 The xShutdown() method may be NULL. */
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xShutdown(sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.pArg);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the size in bytes of a PCache object.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheSize(void){ return sizeof(PCache); }
+
+/*
+** Create a new PCache object. Storage space to hold the object
+** has already been allocated and is passed in as the p pointer.
+** The caller discovers how much space needs to be allocated by
+** calling sqlite3PcacheSize().
+**
+** szExtra is some extra space allocated for each page. The first
+** 8 bytes of the extra space will be zeroed as the page is allocated,
+** but remaining content will be uninitialized. Though it is opaque
+** to this module, the extra space really ends up being the MemPage
+** structure in the pager.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheOpen(
+ int szPage, /* Size of every page */
+ int szExtra, /* Extra space associated with each page */
+ int bPurgeable, /* True if pages are on backing store */
+ int (*xStress)(void*,PgHdr*),/* Call to try to make pages clean */
+ void *pStress, /* Argument to xStress */
+ PCache *p /* Preallocated space for the PCache */
+){
+ memset(p, 0, sizeof(PCache));
+ p->szPage = 1;
+ p->szExtra = szExtra;
+ assert( szExtra>=8 ); /* First 8 bytes will be zeroed */
+ p->bPurgeable = bPurgeable;
+ p->eCreate = 2;
+ p->xStress = xStress;
+ p->pStress = pStress;
+ p->szCache = 100;
+ p->szSpill = 1;
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.OPEN szPage %d bPurgeable %d\n",p,szPage,bPurgeable));
+ return sqlite3PcacheSetPageSize(p, szPage);
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the page size for PCache object. The caller must ensure that there
+** are no outstanding page references when this function is called.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheSetPageSize(PCache *pCache, int szPage){
+ assert( pCache->nRefSum==0 && pCache->pDirty==0 );
+ if( pCache->szPage ){
+ sqlite3_pcache *pNew;
+ pNew = sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xCreate(
+ szPage, pCache->szExtra + ROUND8(sizeof(PgHdr)),
+ pCache->bPurgeable
+ );
+ if( pNew==0 ) return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xCachesize(pNew, numberOfCachePages(pCache));
+ if( pCache->pCache ){
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xDestroy(pCache->pCache);
+ }
+ pCache->pCache = pNew;
+ pCache->szPage = szPage;
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.PAGESIZE %d\n",pCache,szPage));
+ }
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Try to obtain a page from the cache.
+**
+** This routine returns a pointer to an sqlite3_pcache_page object if
+** such an object is already in cache, or if a new one is created.
+** This routine returns a NULL pointer if the object was not in cache
+** and could not be created.
+**
+** The createFlags should be 0 to check for existing pages and should
+** be 3 (not 1, but 3) to try to create a new page.
+**
+** If the createFlag is 0, then NULL is always returned if the page
+** is not already in the cache. If createFlag is 1, then a new page
+** is created only if that can be done without spilling dirty pages
+** and without exceeding the cache size limit.
+**
+** The caller needs to invoke sqlite3PcacheFetchFinish() to properly
+** initialize the sqlite3_pcache_page object and convert it into a
+** PgHdr object. The sqlite3PcacheFetch() and sqlite3PcacheFetchFinish()
+** routines are split this way for performance reasons. When separated
+** they can both (usually) operate without having to push values to
+** the stack on entry and pop them back off on exit, which saves a
+** lot of pushing and popping.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_pcache_page *sqlite3PcacheFetch(
+ PCache *pCache, /* Obtain the page from this cache */
+ Pgno pgno, /* Page number to obtain */
+ int createFlag /* If true, create page if it does not exist already */
+){
+ int eCreate;
+ sqlite3_pcache_page *pRes;
+
+ assert( pCache!=0 );
+ assert( pCache->pCache!=0 );
+ assert( createFlag==3 || createFlag==0 );
+ assert( pCache->eCreate==((pCache->bPurgeable && pCache->pDirty) ? 1 : 2) );
+
+ /* eCreate defines what to do if the page does not exist.
+ ** 0 Do not allocate a new page. (createFlag==0)
+ ** 1 Allocate a new page if doing so is inexpensive.
+ ** (createFlag==1 AND bPurgeable AND pDirty)
+ ** 2 Allocate a new page even it doing so is difficult.
+ ** (createFlag==1 AND !(bPurgeable AND pDirty)
+ */
+ eCreate = createFlag & pCache->eCreate;
+ assert( eCreate==0 || eCreate==1 || eCreate==2 );
+ assert( createFlag==0 || pCache->eCreate==eCreate );
+ assert( createFlag==0 || eCreate==1+(!pCache->bPurgeable||!pCache->pDirty) );
+ pRes = sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xFetch(pCache->pCache, pgno, eCreate);
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.FETCH %d%s (result: %p)\n",pCache,pgno,
+ createFlag?" create":"",pRes));
+ return pRes;
+}
+
+/*
+** If the sqlite3PcacheFetch() routine is unable to allocate a new
+** page because no clean pages are available for reuse and the cache
+** size limit has been reached, then this routine can be invoked to
+** try harder to allocate a page. This routine might invoke the stress
+** callback to spill dirty pages to the journal. It will then try to
+** allocate the new page and will only fail to allocate a new page on
+** an OOM error.
+**
+** This routine should be invoked only after sqlite3PcacheFetch() fails.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheFetchStress(
+ PCache *pCache, /* Obtain the page from this cache */
+ Pgno pgno, /* Page number to obtain */
+ sqlite3_pcache_page **ppPage /* Write result here */
+){
+ PgHdr *pPg;
+ if( pCache->eCreate==2 ) return 0;
+
+ if( sqlite3PcachePagecount(pCache)>pCache->szSpill ){
+ /* Find a dirty page to write-out and recycle. First try to find a
+ ** page that does not require a journal-sync (one with PGHDR_NEED_SYNC
+ ** cleared), but if that is not possible settle for any other
+ ** unreferenced dirty page.
+ **
+ ** If the LRU page in the dirty list that has a clear PGHDR_NEED_SYNC
+ ** flag is currently referenced, then the following may leave pSynced
+ ** set incorrectly (pointing to other than the LRU page with NEED_SYNC
+ ** cleared). This is Ok, as pSynced is just an optimization. */
+ for(pPg=pCache->pSynced;
+ pPg && (pPg->nRef || (pPg->flags&PGHDR_NEED_SYNC));
+ pPg=pPg->pDirtyPrev
+ );
+ pCache->pSynced = pPg;
+ if( !pPg ){
+ for(pPg=pCache->pDirtyTail; pPg && pPg->nRef; pPg=pPg->pDirtyPrev);
+ }
+ if( pPg ){
+ int rc;
+#ifdef SQLITE_LOG_CACHE_SPILL
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_FULL,
+ "spill page %d making room for %d - cache used: %d/%d",
+ pPg->pgno, pgno,
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xPagecount(pCache->pCache),
+ numberOfCachePages(pCache));
+#endif
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.SPILL %d\n",pCache,pPg->pgno));
+ rc = pCache->xStress(pCache->pStress, pPg);
+ pcacheDump(pCache);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK && rc!=SQLITE_BUSY ){
+ return rc;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ *ppPage = sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xFetch(pCache->pCache, pgno, 2);
+ return *ppPage==0 ? SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT : SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** This is a helper routine for sqlite3PcacheFetchFinish()
+**
+** In the uncommon case where the page being fetched has not been
+** initialized, this routine is invoked to do the initialization.
+** This routine is broken out into a separate function since it
+** requires extra stack manipulation that can be avoided in the common
+** case.
+*/
+static SQLITE_NOINLINE PgHdr *pcacheFetchFinishWithInit(
+ PCache *pCache, /* Obtain the page from this cache */
+ Pgno pgno, /* Page number obtained */
+ sqlite3_pcache_page *pPage /* Page obtained by prior PcacheFetch() call */
+){
+ PgHdr *pPgHdr;
+ assert( pPage!=0 );
+ pPgHdr = (PgHdr*)pPage->pExtra;
+ assert( pPgHdr->pPage==0 );
+ memset(&pPgHdr->pDirty, 0, sizeof(PgHdr) - offsetof(PgHdr,pDirty));
+ pPgHdr->pPage = pPage;
+ pPgHdr->pData = pPage->pBuf;
+ pPgHdr->pExtra = (void *)&pPgHdr[1];
+ memset(pPgHdr->pExtra, 0, 8);
+ pPgHdr->pCache = pCache;
+ pPgHdr->pgno = pgno;
+ pPgHdr->flags = PGHDR_CLEAN;
+ return sqlite3PcacheFetchFinish(pCache,pgno,pPage);
+}
+
+/*
+** This routine converts the sqlite3_pcache_page object returned by
+** sqlite3PcacheFetch() into an initialized PgHdr object. This routine
+** must be called after sqlite3PcacheFetch() in order to get a usable
+** result.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE PgHdr *sqlite3PcacheFetchFinish(
+ PCache *pCache, /* Obtain the page from this cache */
+ Pgno pgno, /* Page number obtained */
+ sqlite3_pcache_page *pPage /* Page obtained by prior PcacheFetch() call */
+){
+ PgHdr *pPgHdr;
+
+ assert( pPage!=0 );
+ pPgHdr = (PgHdr *)pPage->pExtra;
+
+ if( !pPgHdr->pPage ){
+ return pcacheFetchFinishWithInit(pCache, pgno, pPage);
+ }
+ pCache->nRefSum++;
+ pPgHdr->nRef++;
+ assert( sqlite3PcachePageSanity(pPgHdr) );
+ return pPgHdr;
+}
+
+/*
+** Decrement the reference count on a page. If the page is clean and the
+** reference count drops to 0, then it is made eligible for recycling.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void SQLITE_NOINLINE sqlite3PcacheRelease(PgHdr *p){
+ assert( p->nRef>0 );
+ p->pCache->nRefSum--;
+ if( (--p->nRef)==0 ){
+ if( p->flags&PGHDR_CLEAN ){
+ pcacheUnpin(p);
+ }else{
+ pcacheManageDirtyList(p, PCACHE_DIRTYLIST_FRONT);
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Increase the reference count of a supplied page by 1.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheRef(PgHdr *p){
+ assert(p->nRef>0);
+ assert( sqlite3PcachePageSanity(p) );
+ p->nRef++;
+ p->pCache->nRefSum++;
+}
+
+/*
+** Drop a page from the cache. There must be exactly one reference to the
+** page. This function deletes that reference, so after it returns the
+** page pointed to by p is invalid.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheDrop(PgHdr *p){
+ assert( p->nRef==1 );
+ assert( sqlite3PcachePageSanity(p) );
+ if( p->flags&PGHDR_DIRTY ){
+ pcacheManageDirtyList(p, PCACHE_DIRTYLIST_REMOVE);
+ }
+ p->pCache->nRefSum--;
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xUnpin(p->pCache->pCache, p->pPage, 1);
+}
+
+/*
+** Make sure the page is marked as dirty. If it isn't dirty already,
+** make it so.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheMakeDirty(PgHdr *p){
+ assert( p->nRef>0 );
+ assert( sqlite3PcachePageSanity(p) );
+ if( p->flags & (PGHDR_CLEAN|PGHDR_DONT_WRITE) ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ p->flags &= ~PGHDR_DONT_WRITE;
+ if( p->flags & PGHDR_CLEAN ){
+ p->flags ^= (PGHDR_DIRTY|PGHDR_CLEAN);
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.DIRTY %d\n",p->pCache,p->pgno));
+ assert( (p->flags & (PGHDR_DIRTY|PGHDR_CLEAN))==PGHDR_DIRTY );
+ pcacheManageDirtyList(p, PCACHE_DIRTYLIST_ADD);
+ }
+ assert( sqlite3PcachePageSanity(p) );
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Make sure the page is marked as clean. If it isn't clean already,
+** make it so.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheMakeClean(PgHdr *p){
+ assert( sqlite3PcachePageSanity(p) );
+ assert( (p->flags & PGHDR_DIRTY)!=0 );
+ assert( (p->flags & PGHDR_CLEAN)==0 );
+ pcacheManageDirtyList(p, PCACHE_DIRTYLIST_REMOVE);
+ p->flags &= ~(PGHDR_DIRTY|PGHDR_NEED_SYNC|PGHDR_WRITEABLE);
+ p->flags |= PGHDR_CLEAN;
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.CLEAN %d\n",p->pCache,p->pgno));
+ assert( sqlite3PcachePageSanity(p) );
+ if( p->nRef==0 ){
+ pcacheUnpin(p);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Make every page in the cache clean.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheCleanAll(PCache *pCache){
+ PgHdr *p;
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.CLEAN-ALL\n",pCache));
+ while( (p = pCache->pDirty)!=0 ){
+ sqlite3PcacheMakeClean(p);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Clear the PGHDR_NEED_SYNC and PGHDR_WRITEABLE flag from all dirty pages.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheClearWritable(PCache *pCache){
+ PgHdr *p;
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.CLEAR-WRITEABLE\n",pCache));
+ for(p=pCache->pDirty; p; p=p->pDirtyNext){
+ p->flags &= ~(PGHDR_NEED_SYNC|PGHDR_WRITEABLE);
+ }
+ pCache->pSynced = pCache->pDirtyTail;
+}
+
+/*
+** Clear the PGHDR_NEED_SYNC flag from all dirty pages.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheClearSyncFlags(PCache *pCache){
+ PgHdr *p;
+ for(p=pCache->pDirty; p; p=p->pDirtyNext){
+ p->flags &= ~PGHDR_NEED_SYNC;
+ }
+ pCache->pSynced = pCache->pDirtyTail;
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the page number of page p to newPgno.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheMove(PgHdr *p, Pgno newPgno){
+ PCache *pCache = p->pCache;
+ assert( p->nRef>0 );
+ assert( newPgno>0 );
+ assert( sqlite3PcachePageSanity(p) );
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.MOVE %d -> %d\n",pCache,p->pgno,newPgno));
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xRekey(pCache->pCache, p->pPage, p->pgno,newPgno);
+ p->pgno = newPgno;
+ if( (p->flags&PGHDR_DIRTY) && (p->flags&PGHDR_NEED_SYNC) ){
+ pcacheManageDirtyList(p, PCACHE_DIRTYLIST_FRONT);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Drop every cache entry whose page number is greater than "pgno". The
+** caller must ensure that there are no outstanding references to any pages
+** other than page 1 with a page number greater than pgno.
+**
+** If there is a reference to page 1 and the pgno parameter passed to this
+** function is 0, then the data area associated with page 1 is zeroed, but
+** the page object is not dropped.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheTruncate(PCache *pCache, Pgno pgno){
+ if( pCache->pCache ){
+ PgHdr *p;
+ PgHdr *pNext;
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.TRUNCATE %d\n",pCache,pgno));
+ for(p=pCache->pDirty; p; p=pNext){
+ pNext = p->pDirtyNext;
+ /* This routine never gets call with a positive pgno except right
+ ** after sqlite3PcacheCleanAll(). So if there are dirty pages,
+ ** it must be that pgno==0.
+ */
+ assert( p->pgno>0 );
+ if( p->pgno>pgno ){
+ assert( p->flags&PGHDR_DIRTY );
+ sqlite3PcacheMakeClean(p);
+ }
+ }
+ if( pgno==0 && pCache->nRefSum ){
+ sqlite3_pcache_page *pPage1;
+ pPage1 = sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xFetch(pCache->pCache,1,0);
+ if( ALWAYS(pPage1) ){ /* Page 1 is always available in cache, because
+ ** pCache->nRefSum>0 */
+ memset(pPage1->pBuf, 0, pCache->szPage);
+ pgno = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xTruncate(pCache->pCache, pgno+1);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Close a cache.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheClose(PCache *pCache){
+ assert( pCache->pCache!=0 );
+ pcacheTrace(("%p.CLOSE\n",pCache));
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xDestroy(pCache->pCache);
+}
+
+/*
+** Discard the contents of the cache.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheClear(PCache *pCache){
+ sqlite3PcacheTruncate(pCache, 0);
+}
+
+/*
+** Merge two lists of pages connected by pDirty and in pgno order.
+** Do not bother fixing the pDirtyPrev pointers.
+*/
+static PgHdr *pcacheMergeDirtyList(PgHdr *pA, PgHdr *pB){
+ PgHdr result, *pTail;
+ pTail = &result;
+ assert( pA!=0 && pB!=0 );
+ for(;;){
+ if( pA->pgnopgno ){
+ pTail->pDirty = pA;
+ pTail = pA;
+ pA = pA->pDirty;
+ if( pA==0 ){
+ pTail->pDirty = pB;
+ break;
+ }
+ }else{
+ pTail->pDirty = pB;
+ pTail = pB;
+ pB = pB->pDirty;
+ if( pB==0 ){
+ pTail->pDirty = pA;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return result.pDirty;
+}
+
+/*
+** Sort the list of pages in accending order by pgno. Pages are
+** connected by pDirty pointers. The pDirtyPrev pointers are
+** corrupted by this sort.
+**
+** Since there cannot be more than 2^31 distinct pages in a database,
+** there cannot be more than 31 buckets required by the merge sorter.
+** One extra bucket is added to catch overflow in case something
+** ever changes to make the previous sentence incorrect.
+*/
+#define N_SORT_BUCKET 32
+static PgHdr *pcacheSortDirtyList(PgHdr *pIn){
+ PgHdr *a[N_SORT_BUCKET], *p;
+ int i;
+ memset(a, 0, sizeof(a));
+ while( pIn ){
+ p = pIn;
+ pIn = p->pDirty;
+ p->pDirty = 0;
+ for(i=0; ALWAYS(ipDirty; p; p=p->pDirtyNext){
+ p->pDirty = p->pDirtyNext;
+ }
+ return pcacheSortDirtyList(pCache->pDirty);
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the total number of references to all pages held by the cache.
+**
+** This is not the total number of pages referenced, but the sum of the
+** reference count for all pages.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheRefCount(PCache *pCache){
+ return pCache->nRefSum;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the number of references to the page supplied as an argument.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcachePageRefcount(PgHdr *p){
+ return p->nRef;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the total number of pages in the cache.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcachePagecount(PCache *pCache){
+ assert( pCache->pCache!=0 );
+ return sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xPagecount(pCache->pCache);
+}
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+/*
+** Get the suggested cache-size value.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheGetCachesize(PCache *pCache){
+ return numberOfCachePages(pCache);
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Set the suggested cache-size value.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheSetCachesize(PCache *pCache, int mxPage){
+ assert( pCache->pCache!=0 );
+ pCache->szCache = mxPage;
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xCachesize(pCache->pCache,
+ numberOfCachePages(pCache));
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the suggested cache-spill value. Make no changes if if the
+** argument is zero. Return the effective cache-spill size, which will
+** be the larger of the szSpill and szCache.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheSetSpillsize(PCache *p, int mxPage){
+ int res;
+ assert( p->pCache!=0 );
+ if( mxPage ){
+ if( mxPage<0 ){
+ mxPage = (int)((-1024*(i64)mxPage)/(p->szPage+p->szExtra));
+ }
+ p->szSpill = mxPage;
+ }
+ res = numberOfCachePages(p);
+ if( resszSpill ) res = p->szSpill;
+ return res;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free up as much memory as possible from the page cache.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheShrink(PCache *pCache){
+ assert( pCache->pCache!=0 );
+ sqlite3GlobalConfig.pcache2.xShrink(pCache->pCache);
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the size of the header added by this middleware layer
+** in the page-cache hierarchy.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3HeaderSizePcache(void){ return ROUND8(sizeof(PgHdr)); }
+
+/*
+** Return the number of dirty pages currently in the cache, as a percentage
+** of the configured cache size.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PCachePercentDirty(PCache *pCache){
+ PgHdr *pDirty;
+ int nDirty = 0;
+ int nCache = numberOfCachePages(pCache);
+ for(pDirty=pCache->pDirty; pDirty; pDirty=pDirty->pDirtyNext) nDirty++;
+ return nCache ? (int)(((i64)nDirty * 100) / nCache) : 0;
+}
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DIRECT_OVERFLOW_READ
+/*
+** Return true if there are one or more dirty pages in the cache. Else false.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PCacheIsDirty(PCache *pCache){
+ return (pCache->pDirty!=0);
+}
+#endif
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES) || defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+/*
+** For all dirty pages currently in the cache, invoke the specified
+** callback. This is only used if the SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES macro is
+** defined.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheIterateDirty(PCache *pCache, void (*xIter)(PgHdr *)){
+ PgHdr *pDirty;
+ for(pDirty=pCache->pDirty; pDirty; pDirty=pDirty->pDirtyNext){
+ xIter(pDirty);
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+/************** End of pcache.c **********************************************/
+/************** Begin file pcache1.c *****************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 November 05
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This file implements the default page cache implementation (the
+** sqlite3_pcache interface). It also contains part of the implementation
+** of the SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE and sqlite3_release_memory() features.
+** If the default page cache implementation is overridden, then neither of
+** these two features are available.
+**
+** A Page cache line looks like this:
+**
+** -------------------------------------------------------------
+** | database page content | PgHdr1 | MemPage | PgHdr |
+** -------------------------------------------------------------
+**
+** The database page content is up front (so that buffer overreads tend to
+** flow harmlessly into the PgHdr1, MemPage, and PgHdr extensions). MemPage
+** is the extension added by the btree.c module containing information such
+** as the database page number and how that database page is used. PgHdr
+** is added by the pcache.c layer and contains information used to keep track
+** of which pages are "dirty". PgHdr1 is an extension added by this
+** module (pcache1.c). The PgHdr1 header is a subclass of sqlite3_pcache_page.
+** PgHdr1 contains information needed to look up a page by its page number.
+** The superclass sqlite3_pcache_page.pBuf points to the start of the
+** database page content and sqlite3_pcache_page.pExtra points to PgHdr.
+**
+** The size of the extension (MemPage+PgHdr+PgHdr1) can be determined at
+** runtime using sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE_HDRSZ, &size). The
+** sizes of the extensions sum to 272 bytes on x64 for 3.8.10, but this
+** size can vary according to architecture, compile-time options, and
+** SQLite library version number.
+**
+** If SQLITE_PCACHE_SEPARATE_HEADER is defined, then the extension is obtained
+** using a separate memory allocation from the database page content. This
+** seeks to overcome the "clownshoe" problem (also called "internal
+** fragmentation" in academic literature) of allocating a few bytes more
+** than a power of two with the memory allocator rounding up to the next
+** power of two, and leaving the rounded-up space unused.
+**
+** This module tracks pointers to PgHdr1 objects. Only pcache.c communicates
+** with this module. Information is passed back and forth as PgHdr1 pointers.
+**
+** The pcache.c and pager.c modules deal pointers to PgHdr objects.
+** The btree.c module deals with pointers to MemPage objects.
+**
+** SOURCE OF PAGE CACHE MEMORY:
+**
+** Memory for a page might come from any of three sources:
+**
+** (1) The general-purpose memory allocator - sqlite3Malloc()
+** (2) Global page-cache memory provided using sqlite3_config() with
+** SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE.
+** (3) PCache-local bulk allocation.
+**
+** The third case is a chunk of heap memory (defaulting to 100 pages worth)
+** that is allocated when the page cache is created. The size of the local
+** bulk allocation can be adjusted using
+**
+** sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE, (void*)0, 0, N).
+**
+** If N is positive, then N pages worth of memory are allocated using a single
+** sqlite3Malloc() call and that memory is used for the first N pages allocated.
+** Or if N is negative, then -1024*N bytes of memory are allocated and used
+** for as many pages as can be accomodated.
+**
+** Only one of (2) or (3) can be used. Once the memory available to (2) or
+** (3) is exhausted, subsequent allocations fail over to the general-purpose
+** memory allocator (1).
+**
+** Earlier versions of SQLite used only methods (1) and (2). But experiments
+** show that method (3) with N==100 provides about a 5% performance boost for
+** common workloads.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+typedef struct PCache1 PCache1;
+typedef struct PgHdr1 PgHdr1;
+typedef struct PgFreeslot PgFreeslot;
+typedef struct PGroup PGroup;
+
+/*
+** Each cache entry is represented by an instance of the following
+** structure. Unless SQLITE_PCACHE_SEPARATE_HEADER is defined, a buffer of
+** PgHdr1.pCache->szPage bytes is allocated directly before this structure
+** in memory.
+**
+** Note: Variables isBulkLocal and isAnchor were once type "u8". That works,
+** but causes a 2-byte gap in the structure for most architectures (since
+** pointers must be either 4 or 8-byte aligned). As this structure is located
+** in memory directly after the associated page data, if the database is
+** corrupt, code at the b-tree layer may overread the page buffer and
+** read part of this structure before the corruption is detected. This
+** can cause a valgrind error if the unitialized gap is accessed. Using u16
+** ensures there is no such gap, and therefore no bytes of unitialized memory
+** in the structure.
+*/
+struct PgHdr1 {
+ sqlite3_pcache_page page; /* Base class. Must be first. pBuf & pExtra */
+ unsigned int iKey; /* Key value (page number) */
+ u16 isBulkLocal; /* This page from bulk local storage */
+ u16 isAnchor; /* This is the PGroup.lru element */
+ PgHdr1 *pNext; /* Next in hash table chain */
+ PCache1 *pCache; /* Cache that currently owns this page */
+ PgHdr1 *pLruNext; /* Next in LRU list of unpinned pages */
+ PgHdr1 *pLruPrev; /* Previous in LRU list of unpinned pages */
+ /* NB: pLruPrev is only valid if pLruNext!=0 */
+};
+
+/*
+** A page is pinned if it is not on the LRU list. To be "pinned" means
+** that the page is in active use and must not be deallocated.
+*/
+#define PAGE_IS_PINNED(p) ((p)->pLruNext==0)
+#define PAGE_IS_UNPINNED(p) ((p)->pLruNext!=0)
+
+/* Each page cache (or PCache) belongs to a PGroup. A PGroup is a set
+** of one or more PCaches that are able to recycle each other's unpinned
+** pages when they are under memory pressure. A PGroup is an instance of
+** the following object.
+**
+** This page cache implementation works in one of two modes:
+**
+** (1) Every PCache is the sole member of its own PGroup. There is
+** one PGroup per PCache.
+**
+** (2) There is a single global PGroup that all PCaches are a member
+** of.
+**
+** Mode 1 uses more memory (since PCache instances are not able to rob
+** unused pages from other PCaches) but it also operates without a mutex,
+** and is therefore often faster. Mode 2 requires a mutex in order to be
+** threadsafe, but recycles pages more efficiently.
+**
+** For mode (1), PGroup.mutex is NULL. For mode (2) there is only a single
+** PGroup which is the pcache1.grp global variable and its mutex is
+** SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_LRU.
+*/
+struct PGroup {
+ sqlite3_mutex *mutex; /* MUTEX_STATIC_LRU or NULL */
+ unsigned int nMaxPage; /* Sum of nMax for purgeable caches */
+ unsigned int nMinPage; /* Sum of nMin for purgeable caches */
+ unsigned int mxPinned; /* nMaxpage + 10 - nMinPage */
+ unsigned int nPurgeable; /* Number of purgeable pages allocated */
+ PgHdr1 lru; /* The beginning and end of the LRU list */
+};
+
+/* Each page cache is an instance of the following object. Every
+** open database file (including each in-memory database and each
+** temporary or transient database) has a single page cache which
+** is an instance of this object.
+**
+** Pointers to structures of this type are cast and returned as
+** opaque sqlite3_pcache* handles.
+*/
+struct PCache1 {
+ /* Cache configuration parameters. Page size (szPage) and the purgeable
+ ** flag (bPurgeable) and the pnPurgeable pointer are all set when the
+ ** cache is created and are never changed thereafter. nMax may be
+ ** modified at any time by a call to the pcache1Cachesize() method.
+ ** The PGroup mutex must be held when accessing nMax.
+ */
+ PGroup *pGroup; /* PGroup this cache belongs to */
+ unsigned int *pnPurgeable; /* Pointer to pGroup->nPurgeable */
+ int szPage; /* Size of database content section */
+ int szExtra; /* sizeof(MemPage)+sizeof(PgHdr) */
+ int szAlloc; /* Total size of one pcache line */
+ int bPurgeable; /* True if cache is purgeable */
+ unsigned int nMin; /* Minimum number of pages reserved */
+ unsigned int nMax; /* Configured "cache_size" value */
+ unsigned int n90pct; /* nMax*9/10 */
+ unsigned int iMaxKey; /* Largest key seen since xTruncate() */
+ unsigned int nPurgeableDummy; /* pnPurgeable points here when not used*/
+
+ /* Hash table of all pages. The following variables may only be accessed
+ ** when the accessor is holding the PGroup mutex.
+ */
+ unsigned int nRecyclable; /* Number of pages in the LRU list */
+ unsigned int nPage; /* Total number of pages in apHash */
+ unsigned int nHash; /* Number of slots in apHash[] */
+ PgHdr1 **apHash; /* Hash table for fast lookup by key */
+ PgHdr1 *pFree; /* List of unused pcache-local pages */
+ void *pBulk; /* Bulk memory used by pcache-local */
+};
+
+/*
+** Free slots in the allocator used to divide up the global page cache
+** buffer provided using the SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE mechanism.
+*/
+struct PgFreeslot {
+ PgFreeslot *pNext; /* Next free slot */
+};
+
+/*
+** Global data used by this cache.
+*/
+static SQLITE_WSD struct PCacheGlobal {
+ PGroup grp; /* The global PGroup for mode (2) */
+
+ /* Variables related to SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE settings. The
+ ** szSlot, nSlot, pStart, pEnd, nReserve, and isInit values are all
+ ** fixed at sqlite3_initialize() time and do not require mutex protection.
+ ** The nFreeSlot and pFree values do require mutex protection.
+ */
+ int isInit; /* True if initialized */
+ int separateCache; /* Use a new PGroup for each PCache */
+ int nInitPage; /* Initial bulk allocation size */
+ int szSlot; /* Size of each free slot */
+ int nSlot; /* The number of pcache slots */
+ int nReserve; /* Try to keep nFreeSlot above this */
+ void *pStart, *pEnd; /* Bounds of global page cache memory */
+ /* Above requires no mutex. Use mutex below for variable that follow. */
+ sqlite3_mutex *mutex; /* Mutex for accessing the following: */
+ PgFreeslot *pFree; /* Free page blocks */
+ int nFreeSlot; /* Number of unused pcache slots */
+ /* The following value requires a mutex to change. We skip the mutex on
+ ** reading because (1) most platforms read a 32-bit integer atomically and
+ ** (2) even if an incorrect value is read, no great harm is done since this
+ ** is really just an optimization. */
+ int bUnderPressure; /* True if low on PAGECACHE memory */
+} pcache1_g;
+
+/*
+** All code in this file should access the global structure above via the
+** alias "pcache1". This ensures that the WSD emulation is used when
+** compiling for systems that do not support real WSD.
+*/
+#define pcache1 (GLOBAL(struct PCacheGlobal, pcache1_g))
+
+/*
+** Macros to enter and leave the PCache LRU mutex.
+*/
+#if !defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT) || SQLITE_THREADSAFE==0
+# define pcache1EnterMutex(X) assert((X)->mutex==0)
+# define pcache1LeaveMutex(X) assert((X)->mutex==0)
+# define PCACHE1_MIGHT_USE_GROUP_MUTEX 0
+#else
+# define pcache1EnterMutex(X) sqlite3_mutex_enter((X)->mutex)
+# define pcache1LeaveMutex(X) sqlite3_mutex_leave((X)->mutex)
+# define PCACHE1_MIGHT_USE_GROUP_MUTEX 1
+#endif
+
+/******************************************************************************/
+/******** Page Allocation/SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE Related Functions **************/
+
+
+/*
+** This function is called during initialization if a static buffer is
+** supplied to use for the page-cache by passing the SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE
+** verb to sqlite3_config(). Parameter pBuf points to an allocation large
+** enough to contain 'n' buffers of 'sz' bytes each.
+**
+** This routine is called from sqlite3_initialize() and so it is guaranteed
+** to be serialized already. There is no need for further mutexing.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PCacheBufferSetup(void *pBuf, int sz, int n){
+ if( pcache1.isInit ){
+ PgFreeslot *p;
+ if( pBuf==0 ) sz = n = 0;
+ if( n==0 ) sz = 0;
+ sz = ROUNDDOWN8(sz);
+ pcache1.szSlot = sz;
+ pcache1.nSlot = pcache1.nFreeSlot = n;
+ pcache1.nReserve = n>90 ? 10 : (n/10 + 1);
+ pcache1.pStart = pBuf;
+ pcache1.pFree = 0;
+ pcache1.bUnderPressure = 0;
+ while( n-- ){
+ p = (PgFreeslot*)pBuf;
+ p->pNext = pcache1.pFree;
+ pcache1.pFree = p;
+ pBuf = (void*)&((char*)pBuf)[sz];
+ }
+ pcache1.pEnd = pBuf;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Try to initialize the pCache->pFree and pCache->pBulk fields. Return
+** true if pCache->pFree ends up containing one or more free pages.
+*/
+static int pcache1InitBulk(PCache1 *pCache){
+ i64 szBulk;
+ char *zBulk;
+ if( pcache1.nInitPage==0 ) return 0;
+ /* Do not bother with a bulk allocation if the cache size very small */
+ if( pCache->nMax<3 ) return 0;
+ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc();
+ if( pcache1.nInitPage>0 ){
+ szBulk = pCache->szAlloc * (i64)pcache1.nInitPage;
+ }else{
+ szBulk = -1024 * (i64)pcache1.nInitPage;
+ }
+ if( szBulk > pCache->szAlloc*(i64)pCache->nMax ){
+ szBulk = pCache->szAlloc*(i64)pCache->nMax;
+ }
+ zBulk = pCache->pBulk = sqlite3Malloc( szBulk );
+ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc();
+ if( zBulk ){
+ int nBulk = sqlite3MallocSize(zBulk)/pCache->szAlloc;
+ do{
+ PgHdr1 *pX = (PgHdr1*)&zBulk[pCache->szPage];
+ pX->page.pBuf = zBulk;
+ pX->page.pExtra = &pX[1];
+ pX->isBulkLocal = 1;
+ pX->isAnchor = 0;
+ pX->pNext = pCache->pFree;
+ pX->pLruPrev = 0; /* Initializing this saves a valgrind error */
+ pCache->pFree = pX;
+ zBulk += pCache->szAlloc;
+ }while( --nBulk );
+ }
+ return pCache->pFree!=0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Malloc function used within this file to allocate space from the buffer
+** configured using sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE) option. If no
+** such buffer exists or there is no space left in it, this function falls
+** back to sqlite3Malloc().
+**
+** Multiple threads can run this routine at the same time. Global variables
+** in pcache1 need to be protected via mutex.
+*/
+static void *pcache1Alloc(int nByte){
+ void *p = 0;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_notheld(pcache1.grp.mutex) );
+ if( nByte<=pcache1.szSlot ){
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pcache1.mutex);
+ p = (PgHdr1 *)pcache1.pFree;
+ if( p ){
+ pcache1.pFree = pcache1.pFree->pNext;
+ pcache1.nFreeSlot--;
+ pcache1.bUnderPressure = pcache1.nFreeSlot=0 );
+ sqlite3StatusHighwater(SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_SIZE, nByte);
+ sqlite3StatusUp(SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_USED, 1);
+ }
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pcache1.mutex);
+ }
+ if( p==0 ){
+ /* Memory is not available in the SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE pool. Get
+ ** it from sqlite3Malloc instead.
+ */
+ p = sqlite3Malloc(nByte);
+#ifndef SQLITE_DISABLE_PAGECACHE_OVERFLOW_STATS
+ if( p ){
+ int sz = sqlite3MallocSize(p);
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pcache1.mutex);
+ sqlite3StatusHighwater(SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_SIZE, nByte);
+ sqlite3StatusUp(SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_OVERFLOW, sz);
+ sqlite3_mutex_leave(pcache1.mutex);
+ }
+#endif
+ sqlite3MemdebugSetType(p, MEMTYPE_PCACHE);
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free an allocated buffer obtained from pcache1Alloc().
+*/
+static void pcache1Free(void *p){
+ if( p==0 ) return;
+ if( SQLITE_WITHIN(p, pcache1.pStart, pcache1.pEnd) ){
+ PgFreeslot *pSlot;
+ sqlite3_mutex_enter(pcache1.mutex);
+ sqlite3StatusDown(SQLITE_STATUS_PAGECACHE_USED, 1);
+ pSlot = (PgFreeslot*)p;
+ pSlot->pNext = pcache1.pFree;
+ pcache1.pFree = pSlot;
+ pcache1.nFreeSlot++;
+ pcache1.bUnderPressure = pcache1.nFreeSlot=pcache1.pStart && ppGroup->mutex) );
+ if( pCache->pFree || (pCache->nPage==0 && pcache1InitBulk(pCache)) ){
+ assert( pCache->pFree!=0 );
+ p = pCache->pFree;
+ pCache->pFree = p->pNext;
+ p->pNext = 0;
+ }else{
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT
+ /* The group mutex must be released before pcache1Alloc() is called. This
+ ** is because it might call sqlite3_release_memory(), which assumes that
+ ** this mutex is not held. */
+ assert( pcache1.separateCache==0 );
+ assert( pCache->pGroup==&pcache1.grp );
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+#endif
+ if( benignMalloc ){ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc(); }
+#ifdef SQLITE_PCACHE_SEPARATE_HEADER
+ pPg = pcache1Alloc(pCache->szPage);
+ p = sqlite3Malloc(sizeof(PgHdr1) + pCache->szExtra);
+ if( !pPg || !p ){
+ pcache1Free(pPg);
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ pPg = 0;
+ }
+#else
+ pPg = pcache1Alloc(pCache->szAlloc);
+#endif
+ if( benignMalloc ){ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc(); }
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT
+ pcache1EnterMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+#endif
+ if( pPg==0 ) return 0;
+#ifndef SQLITE_PCACHE_SEPARATE_HEADER
+ p = (PgHdr1 *)&((u8 *)pPg)[pCache->szPage];
+#endif
+ p->page.pBuf = pPg;
+ p->page.pExtra = &p[1];
+ p->isBulkLocal = 0;
+ p->isAnchor = 0;
+ }
+ (*pCache->pnPurgeable)++;
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free a page object allocated by pcache1AllocPage().
+*/
+static void pcache1FreePage(PgHdr1 *p){
+ PCache1 *pCache;
+ assert( p!=0 );
+ pCache = p->pCache;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->pCache->pGroup->mutex) );
+ if( p->isBulkLocal ){
+ p->pNext = pCache->pFree;
+ pCache->pFree = p;
+ }else{
+ pcache1Free(p->page.pBuf);
+#ifdef SQLITE_PCACHE_SEPARATE_HEADER
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+#endif
+ }
+ (*pCache->pnPurgeable)--;
+}
+
+/*
+** Malloc function used by SQLite to obtain space from the buffer configured
+** using sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE) option. If no such buffer
+** exists, this function falls back to sqlite3Malloc().
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3PageMalloc(int sz){
+ assert( sz<=65536+8 ); /* These allocations are never very large */
+ return pcache1Alloc(sz);
+}
+
+/*
+** Free an allocated buffer obtained from sqlite3PageMalloc().
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PageFree(void *p){
+ pcache1Free(p);
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Return true if it desirable to avoid allocating a new page cache
+** entry.
+**
+** If memory was allocated specifically to the page cache using
+** SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE but that memory has all been used, then
+** it is desirable to avoid allocating a new page cache entry because
+** presumably SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE was suppose to be sufficient
+** for all page cache needs and we should not need to spill the
+** allocation onto the heap.
+**
+** Or, the heap is used for all page cache memory but the heap is
+** under memory pressure, then again it is desirable to avoid
+** allocating a new page cache entry in order to avoid stressing
+** the heap even further.
+*/
+static int pcache1UnderMemoryPressure(PCache1 *pCache){
+ if( pcache1.nSlot && (pCache->szPage+pCache->szExtra)<=pcache1.szSlot ){
+ return pcache1.bUnderPressure;
+ }else{
+ return sqlite3HeapNearlyFull();
+ }
+}
+
+/******************************************************************************/
+/******** General Implementation Functions ************************************/
+
+/*
+** This function is used to resize the hash table used by the cache passed
+** as the first argument.
+**
+** The PCache mutex must be held when this function is called.
+*/
+static void pcache1ResizeHash(PCache1 *p){
+ PgHdr1 **apNew;
+ unsigned int nNew;
+ unsigned int i;
+
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(p->pGroup->mutex) );
+
+ nNew = p->nHash*2;
+ if( nNew<256 ){
+ nNew = 256;
+ }
+
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(p->pGroup);
+ if( p->nHash ){ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc(); }
+ apNew = (PgHdr1 **)sqlite3MallocZero(sizeof(PgHdr1 *)*nNew);
+ if( p->nHash ){ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc(); }
+ pcache1EnterMutex(p->pGroup);
+ if( apNew ){
+ for(i=0; inHash; i++){
+ PgHdr1 *pPage;
+ PgHdr1 *pNext = p->apHash[i];
+ while( (pPage = pNext)!=0 ){
+ unsigned int h = pPage->iKey % nNew;
+ pNext = pPage->pNext;
+ pPage->pNext = apNew[h];
+ apNew[h] = pPage;
+ }
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(p->apHash);
+ p->apHash = apNew;
+ p->nHash = nNew;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is used internally to remove the page pPage from the
+** PGroup LRU list, if is part of it. If pPage is not part of the PGroup
+** LRU list, then this function is a no-op.
+**
+** The PGroup mutex must be held when this function is called.
+*/
+static PgHdr1 *pcache1PinPage(PgHdr1 *pPage){
+ assert( pPage!=0 );
+ assert( PAGE_IS_UNPINNED(pPage) );
+ assert( pPage->pLruNext );
+ assert( pPage->pLruPrev );
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pPage->pCache->pGroup->mutex) );
+ pPage->pLruPrev->pLruNext = pPage->pLruNext;
+ pPage->pLruNext->pLruPrev = pPage->pLruPrev;
+ pPage->pLruNext = 0;
+ /* pPage->pLruPrev = 0;
+ ** No need to clear pLruPrev as it is never accessed if pLruNext is 0 */
+ assert( pPage->isAnchor==0 );
+ assert( pPage->pCache->pGroup->lru.isAnchor==1 );
+ pPage->pCache->nRecyclable--;
+ return pPage;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Remove the page supplied as an argument from the hash table
+** (PCache1.apHash structure) that it is currently stored in.
+** Also free the page if freePage is true.
+**
+** The PGroup mutex must be held when this function is called.
+*/
+static void pcache1RemoveFromHash(PgHdr1 *pPage, int freeFlag){
+ unsigned int h;
+ PCache1 *pCache = pPage->pCache;
+ PgHdr1 **pp;
+
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pCache->pGroup->mutex) );
+ h = pPage->iKey % pCache->nHash;
+ for(pp=&pCache->apHash[h]; (*pp)!=pPage; pp=&(*pp)->pNext);
+ *pp = (*pp)->pNext;
+
+ pCache->nPage--;
+ if( freeFlag ) pcache1FreePage(pPage);
+}
+
+/*
+** If there are currently more than nMaxPage pages allocated, try
+** to recycle pages to reduce the number allocated to nMaxPage.
+*/
+static void pcache1EnforceMaxPage(PCache1 *pCache){
+ PGroup *pGroup = pCache->pGroup;
+ PgHdr1 *p;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pGroup->mutex) );
+ while( pGroup->nPurgeable>pGroup->nMaxPage
+ && (p=pGroup->lru.pLruPrev)->isAnchor==0
+ ){
+ assert( p->pCache->pGroup==pGroup );
+ assert( PAGE_IS_UNPINNED(p) );
+ pcache1PinPage(p);
+ pcache1RemoveFromHash(p, 1);
+ }
+ if( pCache->nPage==0 && pCache->pBulk ){
+ sqlite3_free(pCache->pBulk);
+ pCache->pBulk = pCache->pFree = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Discard all pages from cache pCache with a page number (key value)
+** greater than or equal to iLimit. Any pinned pages that meet this
+** criteria are unpinned before they are discarded.
+**
+** The PCache mutex must be held when this function is called.
+*/
+static void pcache1TruncateUnsafe(
+ PCache1 *pCache, /* The cache to truncate */
+ unsigned int iLimit /* Drop pages with this pgno or larger */
+){
+ TESTONLY( int nPage = 0; ) /* To assert pCache->nPage is correct */
+ unsigned int h, iStop;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_held(pCache->pGroup->mutex) );
+ assert( pCache->iMaxKey >= iLimit );
+ assert( pCache->nHash > 0 );
+ if( pCache->iMaxKey - iLimit < pCache->nHash ){
+ /* If we are just shaving the last few pages off the end of the
+ ** cache, then there is no point in scanning the entire hash table.
+ ** Only scan those hash slots that might contain pages that need to
+ ** be removed. */
+ h = iLimit % pCache->nHash;
+ iStop = pCache->iMaxKey % pCache->nHash;
+ TESTONLY( nPage = -10; ) /* Disable the pCache->nPage validity check */
+ }else{
+ /* This is the general case where many pages are being removed.
+ ** It is necessary to scan the entire hash table */
+ h = pCache->nHash/2;
+ iStop = h - 1;
+ }
+ for(;;){
+ PgHdr1 **pp;
+ PgHdr1 *pPage;
+ assert( hnHash );
+ pp = &pCache->apHash[h];
+ while( (pPage = *pp)!=0 ){
+ if( pPage->iKey>=iLimit ){
+ pCache->nPage--;
+ *pp = pPage->pNext;
+ if( PAGE_IS_UNPINNED(pPage) ) pcache1PinPage(pPage);
+ pcache1FreePage(pPage);
+ }else{
+ pp = &pPage->pNext;
+ TESTONLY( if( nPage>=0 ) nPage++; )
+ }
+ }
+ if( h==iStop ) break;
+ h = (h+1) % pCache->nHash;
+ }
+ assert( nPage<0 || pCache->nPage==(unsigned)nPage );
+}
+
+/******************************************************************************/
+/******** sqlite3_pcache Methods **********************************************/
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xInit method.
+*/
+static int pcache1Init(void *NotUsed){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ assert( pcache1.isInit==0 );
+ memset(&pcache1, 0, sizeof(pcache1));
+
+
+ /*
+ ** The pcache1.separateCache variable is true if each PCache has its own
+ ** private PGroup (mode-1). pcache1.separateCache is false if the single
+ ** PGroup in pcache1.grp is used for all page caches (mode-2).
+ **
+ ** * Always use a unified cache (mode-2) if ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT
+ **
+ ** * Use a unified cache in single-threaded applications that have
+ ** configured a start-time buffer for use as page-cache memory using
+ ** sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_PAGECACHE, pBuf, sz, N) with non-NULL
+ ** pBuf argument.
+ **
+ ** * Otherwise use separate caches (mode-1)
+ */
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT)
+ pcache1.separateCache = 0;
+#elif SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+ pcache1.separateCache = sqlite3GlobalConfig.pPage==0
+ || sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex>0;
+#else
+ pcache1.separateCache = sqlite3GlobalConfig.pPage==0;
+#endif
+
+#if SQLITE_THREADSAFE
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.bCoreMutex ){
+ pcache1.grp.mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_LRU);
+ pcache1.mutex = sqlite3MutexAlloc(SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PMEM);
+ }
+#endif
+ if( pcache1.separateCache
+ && sqlite3GlobalConfig.nPage!=0
+ && sqlite3GlobalConfig.pPage==0
+ ){
+ pcache1.nInitPage = sqlite3GlobalConfig.nPage;
+ }else{
+ pcache1.nInitPage = 0;
+ }
+ pcache1.grp.mxPinned = 10;
+ pcache1.isInit = 1;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xShutdown method.
+** Note that the static mutex allocated in xInit does
+** not need to be freed.
+*/
+static void pcache1Shutdown(void *NotUsed){
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(NotUsed);
+ assert( pcache1.isInit!=0 );
+ memset(&pcache1, 0, sizeof(pcache1));
+}
+
+/* forward declaration */
+static void pcache1Destroy(sqlite3_pcache *p);
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xCreate method.
+**
+** Allocate a new cache.
+*/
+static sqlite3_pcache *pcache1Create(int szPage, int szExtra, int bPurgeable){
+ PCache1 *pCache; /* The newly created page cache */
+ PGroup *pGroup; /* The group the new page cache will belong to */
+ int sz; /* Bytes of memory required to allocate the new cache */
+
+ assert( (szPage & (szPage-1))==0 && szPage>=512 && szPage<=65536 );
+ assert( szExtra < 300 );
+
+ sz = sizeof(PCache1) + sizeof(PGroup)*pcache1.separateCache;
+ pCache = (PCache1 *)sqlite3MallocZero(sz);
+ if( pCache ){
+ if( pcache1.separateCache ){
+ pGroup = (PGroup*)&pCache[1];
+ pGroup->mxPinned = 10;
+ }else{
+ pGroup = &pcache1.grp;
+ }
+ pcache1EnterMutex(pGroup);
+ if( pGroup->lru.isAnchor==0 ){
+ pGroup->lru.isAnchor = 1;
+ pGroup->lru.pLruPrev = pGroup->lru.pLruNext = &pGroup->lru;
+ }
+ pCache->pGroup = pGroup;
+ pCache->szPage = szPage;
+ pCache->szExtra = szExtra;
+ pCache->szAlloc = szPage + szExtra + ROUND8(sizeof(PgHdr1));
+ pCache->bPurgeable = (bPurgeable ? 1 : 0);
+ pcache1ResizeHash(pCache);
+ if( bPurgeable ){
+ pCache->nMin = 10;
+ pGroup->nMinPage += pCache->nMin;
+ pGroup->mxPinned = pGroup->nMaxPage + 10 - pGroup->nMinPage;
+ pCache->pnPurgeable = &pGroup->nPurgeable;
+ }else{
+ pCache->pnPurgeable = &pCache->nPurgeableDummy;
+ }
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(pGroup);
+ if( pCache->nHash==0 ){
+ pcache1Destroy((sqlite3_pcache*)pCache);
+ pCache = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ return (sqlite3_pcache *)pCache;
+}
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xCachesize method.
+**
+** Configure the cache_size limit for a cache.
+*/
+static void pcache1Cachesize(sqlite3_pcache *p, int nMax){
+ PCache1 *pCache = (PCache1 *)p;
+ if( pCache->bPurgeable ){
+ PGroup *pGroup = pCache->pGroup;
+ pcache1EnterMutex(pGroup);
+ pGroup->nMaxPage += (nMax - pCache->nMax);
+ pGroup->mxPinned = pGroup->nMaxPage + 10 - pGroup->nMinPage;
+ pCache->nMax = nMax;
+ pCache->n90pct = pCache->nMax*9/10;
+ pcache1EnforceMaxPage(pCache);
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(pGroup);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xShrink method.
+**
+** Free up as much memory as possible.
+*/
+static void pcache1Shrink(sqlite3_pcache *p){
+ PCache1 *pCache = (PCache1*)p;
+ if( pCache->bPurgeable ){
+ PGroup *pGroup = pCache->pGroup;
+ int savedMaxPage;
+ pcache1EnterMutex(pGroup);
+ savedMaxPage = pGroup->nMaxPage;
+ pGroup->nMaxPage = 0;
+ pcache1EnforceMaxPage(pCache);
+ pGroup->nMaxPage = savedMaxPage;
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(pGroup);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xPagecount method.
+*/
+static int pcache1Pagecount(sqlite3_pcache *p){
+ int n;
+ PCache1 *pCache = (PCache1*)p;
+ pcache1EnterMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+ n = pCache->nPage;
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+ return n;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Implement steps 3, 4, and 5 of the pcache1Fetch() algorithm described
+** in the header of the pcache1Fetch() procedure.
+**
+** This steps are broken out into a separate procedure because they are
+** usually not needed, and by avoiding the stack initialization required
+** for these steps, the main pcache1Fetch() procedure can run faster.
+*/
+static SQLITE_NOINLINE PgHdr1 *pcache1FetchStage2(
+ PCache1 *pCache,
+ unsigned int iKey,
+ int createFlag
+){
+ unsigned int nPinned;
+ PGroup *pGroup = pCache->pGroup;
+ PgHdr1 *pPage = 0;
+
+ /* Step 3: Abort if createFlag is 1 but the cache is nearly full */
+ assert( pCache->nPage >= pCache->nRecyclable );
+ nPinned = pCache->nPage - pCache->nRecyclable;
+ assert( pGroup->mxPinned == pGroup->nMaxPage + 10 - pGroup->nMinPage );
+ assert( pCache->n90pct == pCache->nMax*9/10 );
+ if( createFlag==1 && (
+ nPinned>=pGroup->mxPinned
+ || nPinned>=pCache->n90pct
+ || (pcache1UnderMemoryPressure(pCache) && pCache->nRecyclablenPage>=pCache->nHash ) pcache1ResizeHash(pCache);
+ assert( pCache->nHash>0 && pCache->apHash );
+
+ /* Step 4. Try to recycle a page. */
+ if( pCache->bPurgeable
+ && !pGroup->lru.pLruPrev->isAnchor
+ && ((pCache->nPage+1>=pCache->nMax) || pcache1UnderMemoryPressure(pCache))
+ ){
+ PCache1 *pOther;
+ pPage = pGroup->lru.pLruPrev;
+ assert( PAGE_IS_UNPINNED(pPage) );
+ pcache1RemoveFromHash(pPage, 0);
+ pcache1PinPage(pPage);
+ pOther = pPage->pCache;
+ if( pOther->szAlloc != pCache->szAlloc ){
+ pcache1FreePage(pPage);
+ pPage = 0;
+ }else{
+ pGroup->nPurgeable -= (pOther->bPurgeable - pCache->bPurgeable);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Step 5. If a usable page buffer has still not been found,
+ ** attempt to allocate a new one.
+ */
+ if( !pPage ){
+ pPage = pcache1AllocPage(pCache, createFlag==1);
+ }
+
+ if( pPage ){
+ unsigned int h = iKey % pCache->nHash;
+ pCache->nPage++;
+ pPage->iKey = iKey;
+ pPage->pNext = pCache->apHash[h];
+ pPage->pCache = pCache;
+ pPage->pLruNext = 0;
+ /* pPage->pLruPrev = 0;
+ ** No need to clear pLruPrev since it is not accessed when pLruNext==0 */
+ *(void **)pPage->page.pExtra = 0;
+ pCache->apHash[h] = pPage;
+ if( iKey>pCache->iMaxKey ){
+ pCache->iMaxKey = iKey;
+ }
+ }
+ return pPage;
+}
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xFetch method.
+**
+** Fetch a page by key value.
+**
+** Whether or not a new page may be allocated by this function depends on
+** the value of the createFlag argument. 0 means do not allocate a new
+** page. 1 means allocate a new page if space is easily available. 2
+** means to try really hard to allocate a new page.
+**
+** For a non-purgeable cache (a cache used as the storage for an in-memory
+** database) there is really no difference between createFlag 1 and 2. So
+** the calling function (pcache.c) will never have a createFlag of 1 on
+** a non-purgeable cache.
+**
+** There are three different approaches to obtaining space for a page,
+** depending on the value of parameter createFlag (which may be 0, 1 or 2).
+**
+** 1. Regardless of the value of createFlag, the cache is searched for a
+** copy of the requested page. If one is found, it is returned.
+**
+** 2. If createFlag==0 and the page is not already in the cache, NULL is
+** returned.
+**
+** 3. If createFlag is 1, and the page is not already in the cache, then
+** return NULL (do not allocate a new page) if any of the following
+** conditions are true:
+**
+** (a) the number of pages pinned by the cache is greater than
+** PCache1.nMax, or
+**
+** (b) the number of pages pinned by the cache is greater than
+** the sum of nMax for all purgeable caches, less the sum of
+** nMin for all other purgeable caches, or
+**
+** 4. If none of the first three conditions apply and the cache is marked
+** as purgeable, and if one of the following is true:
+**
+** (a) The number of pages allocated for the cache is already
+** PCache1.nMax, or
+**
+** (b) The number of pages allocated for all purgeable caches is
+** already equal to or greater than the sum of nMax for all
+** purgeable caches,
+**
+** (c) The system is under memory pressure and wants to avoid
+** unnecessary pages cache entry allocations
+**
+** then attempt to recycle a page from the LRU list. If it is the right
+** size, return the recycled buffer. Otherwise, free the buffer and
+** proceed to step 5.
+**
+** 5. Otherwise, allocate and return a new page buffer.
+**
+** There are two versions of this routine. pcache1FetchWithMutex() is
+** the general case. pcache1FetchNoMutex() is a faster implementation for
+** the common case where pGroup->mutex is NULL. The pcache1Fetch() wrapper
+** invokes the appropriate routine.
+*/
+static PgHdr1 *pcache1FetchNoMutex(
+ sqlite3_pcache *p,
+ unsigned int iKey,
+ int createFlag
+){
+ PCache1 *pCache = (PCache1 *)p;
+ PgHdr1 *pPage = 0;
+
+ /* Step 1: Search the hash table for an existing entry. */
+ pPage = pCache->apHash[iKey % pCache->nHash];
+ while( pPage && pPage->iKey!=iKey ){ pPage = pPage->pNext; }
+
+ /* Step 2: If the page was found in the hash table, then return it.
+ ** If the page was not in the hash table and createFlag is 0, abort.
+ ** Otherwise (page not in hash and createFlag!=0) continue with
+ ** subsequent steps to try to create the page. */
+ if( pPage ){
+ if( PAGE_IS_UNPINNED(pPage) ){
+ return pcache1PinPage(pPage);
+ }else{
+ return pPage;
+ }
+ }else if( createFlag ){
+ /* Steps 3, 4, and 5 implemented by this subroutine */
+ return pcache1FetchStage2(pCache, iKey, createFlag);
+ }else{
+ return 0;
+ }
+}
+#if PCACHE1_MIGHT_USE_GROUP_MUTEX
+static PgHdr1 *pcache1FetchWithMutex(
+ sqlite3_pcache *p,
+ unsigned int iKey,
+ int createFlag
+){
+ PCache1 *pCache = (PCache1 *)p;
+ PgHdr1 *pPage;
+
+ pcache1EnterMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+ pPage = pcache1FetchNoMutex(p, iKey, createFlag);
+ assert( pPage==0 || pCache->iMaxKey>=iKey );
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+ return pPage;
+}
+#endif
+static sqlite3_pcache_page *pcache1Fetch(
+ sqlite3_pcache *p,
+ unsigned int iKey,
+ int createFlag
+){
+#if PCACHE1_MIGHT_USE_GROUP_MUTEX || defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+ PCache1 *pCache = (PCache1 *)p;
+#endif
+
+ assert( offsetof(PgHdr1,page)==0 );
+ assert( pCache->bPurgeable || createFlag!=1 );
+ assert( pCache->bPurgeable || pCache->nMin==0 );
+ assert( pCache->bPurgeable==0 || pCache->nMin==10 );
+ assert( pCache->nMin==0 || pCache->bPurgeable );
+ assert( pCache->nHash>0 );
+#if PCACHE1_MIGHT_USE_GROUP_MUTEX
+ if( pCache->pGroup->mutex ){
+ return (sqlite3_pcache_page*)pcache1FetchWithMutex(p, iKey, createFlag);
+ }else
+#endif
+ {
+ return (sqlite3_pcache_page*)pcache1FetchNoMutex(p, iKey, createFlag);
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xUnpin method.
+**
+** Mark a page as unpinned (eligible for asynchronous recycling).
+*/
+static void pcache1Unpin(
+ sqlite3_pcache *p,
+ sqlite3_pcache_page *pPg,
+ int reuseUnlikely
+){
+ PCache1 *pCache = (PCache1 *)p;
+ PgHdr1 *pPage = (PgHdr1 *)pPg;
+ PGroup *pGroup = pCache->pGroup;
+
+ assert( pPage->pCache==pCache );
+ pcache1EnterMutex(pGroup);
+
+ /* It is an error to call this function if the page is already
+ ** part of the PGroup LRU list.
+ */
+ assert( pPage->pLruNext==0 );
+ assert( PAGE_IS_PINNED(pPage) );
+
+ if( reuseUnlikely || pGroup->nPurgeable>pGroup->nMaxPage ){
+ pcache1RemoveFromHash(pPage, 1);
+ }else{
+ /* Add the page to the PGroup LRU list. */
+ PgHdr1 **ppFirst = &pGroup->lru.pLruNext;
+ pPage->pLruPrev = &pGroup->lru;
+ (pPage->pLruNext = *ppFirst)->pLruPrev = pPage;
+ *ppFirst = pPage;
+ pCache->nRecyclable++;
+ }
+
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+}
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xRekey method.
+*/
+static void pcache1Rekey(
+ sqlite3_pcache *p,
+ sqlite3_pcache_page *pPg,
+ unsigned int iOld,
+ unsigned int iNew
+){
+ PCache1 *pCache = (PCache1 *)p;
+ PgHdr1 *pPage = (PgHdr1 *)pPg;
+ PgHdr1 **pp;
+ unsigned int h;
+ assert( pPage->iKey==iOld );
+ assert( pPage->pCache==pCache );
+
+ pcache1EnterMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+
+ h = iOld%pCache->nHash;
+ pp = &pCache->apHash[h];
+ while( (*pp)!=pPage ){
+ pp = &(*pp)->pNext;
+ }
+ *pp = pPage->pNext;
+
+ h = iNew%pCache->nHash;
+ pPage->iKey = iNew;
+ pPage->pNext = pCache->apHash[h];
+ pCache->apHash[h] = pPage;
+ if( iNew>pCache->iMaxKey ){
+ pCache->iMaxKey = iNew;
+ }
+
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+}
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xTruncate method.
+**
+** Discard all unpinned pages in the cache with a page number equal to
+** or greater than parameter iLimit. Any pinned pages with a page number
+** equal to or greater than iLimit are implicitly unpinned.
+*/
+static void pcache1Truncate(sqlite3_pcache *p, unsigned int iLimit){
+ PCache1 *pCache = (PCache1 *)p;
+ pcache1EnterMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+ if( iLimit<=pCache->iMaxKey ){
+ pcache1TruncateUnsafe(pCache, iLimit);
+ pCache->iMaxKey = iLimit-1;
+ }
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(pCache->pGroup);
+}
+
+/*
+** Implementation of the sqlite3_pcache.xDestroy method.
+**
+** Destroy a cache allocated using pcache1Create().
+*/
+static void pcache1Destroy(sqlite3_pcache *p){
+ PCache1 *pCache = (PCache1 *)p;
+ PGroup *pGroup = pCache->pGroup;
+ assert( pCache->bPurgeable || (pCache->nMax==0 && pCache->nMin==0) );
+ pcache1EnterMutex(pGroup);
+ if( pCache->nPage ) pcache1TruncateUnsafe(pCache, 0);
+ assert( pGroup->nMaxPage >= pCache->nMax );
+ pGroup->nMaxPage -= pCache->nMax;
+ assert( pGroup->nMinPage >= pCache->nMin );
+ pGroup->nMinPage -= pCache->nMin;
+ pGroup->mxPinned = pGroup->nMaxPage + 10 - pGroup->nMinPage;
+ pcache1EnforceMaxPage(pCache);
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(pGroup);
+ sqlite3_free(pCache->pBulk);
+ sqlite3_free(pCache->apHash);
+ sqlite3_free(pCache);
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is called during initialization (sqlite3_initialize()) to
+** install the default pluggable cache module, assuming the user has not
+** already provided an alternative.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PCacheSetDefault(void){
+ static const sqlite3_pcache_methods2 defaultMethods = {
+ 1, /* iVersion */
+ 0, /* pArg */
+ pcache1Init, /* xInit */
+ pcache1Shutdown, /* xShutdown */
+ pcache1Create, /* xCreate */
+ pcache1Cachesize, /* xCachesize */
+ pcache1Pagecount, /* xPagecount */
+ pcache1Fetch, /* xFetch */
+ pcache1Unpin, /* xUnpin */
+ pcache1Rekey, /* xRekey */
+ pcache1Truncate, /* xTruncate */
+ pcache1Destroy, /* xDestroy */
+ pcache1Shrink /* xShrink */
+ };
+ sqlite3_config(SQLITE_CONFIG_PCACHE2, &defaultMethods);
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the size of the header on each page of this PCACHE implementation.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3HeaderSizePcache1(void){ return ROUND8(sizeof(PgHdr1)); }
+
+/*
+** Return the global mutex used by this PCACHE implementation. The
+** sqlite3_status() routine needs access to this mutex.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_mutex *sqlite3Pcache1Mutex(void){
+ return pcache1.mutex;
+}
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT
+/*
+** This function is called to free superfluous dynamically allocated memory
+** held by the pager system. Memory in use by any SQLite pager allocated
+** by the current thread may be sqlite3_free()ed.
+**
+** nReq is the number of bytes of memory required. Once this much has
+** been released, the function returns. The return value is the total number
+** of bytes of memory released.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PcacheReleaseMemory(int nReq){
+ int nFree = 0;
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_notheld(pcache1.grp.mutex) );
+ assert( sqlite3_mutex_notheld(pcache1.mutex) );
+ if( sqlite3GlobalConfig.pPage==0 ){
+ PgHdr1 *p;
+ pcache1EnterMutex(&pcache1.grp);
+ while( (nReq<0 || nFreeisAnchor==0
+ ){
+ nFree += pcache1MemSize(p->page.pBuf);
+#ifdef SQLITE_PCACHE_SEPARATE_HEADER
+ nFree += sqlite3MemSize(p);
+#endif
+ assert( PAGE_IS_UNPINNED(p) );
+ pcache1PinPage(p);
+ pcache1RemoveFromHash(p, 1);
+ }
+ pcache1LeaveMutex(&pcache1.grp);
+ }
+ return nFree;
+}
+#endif /* SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT */
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+/*
+** This function is used by test procedures to inspect the internal state
+** of the global cache.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PcacheStats(
+ int *pnCurrent, /* OUT: Total number of pages cached */
+ int *pnMax, /* OUT: Global maximum cache size */
+ int *pnMin, /* OUT: Sum of PCache1.nMin for purgeable caches */
+ int *pnRecyclable /* OUT: Total number of pages available for recycling */
+){
+ PgHdr1 *p;
+ int nRecyclable = 0;
+ for(p=pcache1.grp.lru.pLruNext; p && !p->isAnchor; p=p->pLruNext){
+ assert( PAGE_IS_UNPINNED(p) );
+ nRecyclable++;
+ }
+ *pnCurrent = pcache1.grp.nPurgeable;
+ *pnMax = (int)pcache1.grp.nMaxPage;
+ *pnMin = (int)pcache1.grp.nMinPage;
+ *pnRecyclable = nRecyclable;
+}
+#endif
+
+/************** End of pcache1.c *********************************************/
+/************** Begin file rowset.c ******************************************/
+/*
+** 2008 December 3
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+**
+** This module implements an object we call a "RowSet".
+**
+** The RowSet object is a collection of rowids. Rowids
+** are inserted into the RowSet in an arbitrary order. Inserts
+** can be intermixed with tests to see if a given rowid has been
+** previously inserted into the RowSet.
+**
+** After all inserts are finished, it is possible to extract the
+** elements of the RowSet in sorted order. Once this extraction
+** process has started, no new elements may be inserted.
+**
+** Hence, the primitive operations for a RowSet are:
+**
+** CREATE
+** INSERT
+** TEST
+** SMALLEST
+** DESTROY
+**
+** The CREATE and DESTROY primitives are the constructor and destructor,
+** obviously. The INSERT primitive adds a new element to the RowSet.
+** TEST checks to see if an element is already in the RowSet. SMALLEST
+** extracts the least value from the RowSet.
+**
+** The INSERT primitive might allocate additional memory. Memory is
+** allocated in chunks so most INSERTs do no allocation. There is an
+** upper bound on the size of allocated memory. No memory is freed
+** until DESTROY.
+**
+** The TEST primitive includes a "batch" number. The TEST primitive
+** will only see elements that were inserted before the last change
+** in the batch number. In other words, if an INSERT occurs between
+** two TESTs where the TESTs have the same batch nubmer, then the
+** value added by the INSERT will not be visible to the second TEST.
+** The initial batch number is zero, so if the very first TEST contains
+** a non-zero batch number, it will see all prior INSERTs.
+**
+** No INSERTs may occurs after a SMALLEST. An assertion will fail if
+** that is attempted.
+**
+** The cost of an INSERT is roughly constant. (Sometimes new memory
+** has to be allocated on an INSERT.) The cost of a TEST with a new
+** batch number is O(NlogN) where N is the number of elements in the RowSet.
+** The cost of a TEST using the same batch number is O(logN). The cost
+** of the first SMALLEST is O(NlogN). Second and subsequent SMALLEST
+** primitives are constant time. The cost of DESTROY is O(N).
+**
+** TEST and SMALLEST may not be used by the same RowSet. This used to
+** be possible, but the feature was not used, so it was removed in order
+** to simplify the code.
+*/
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+
+/*
+** Target size for allocation chunks.
+*/
+#define ROWSET_ALLOCATION_SIZE 1024
+
+/*
+** The number of rowset entries per allocation chunk.
+*/
+#define ROWSET_ENTRY_PER_CHUNK \
+ ((ROWSET_ALLOCATION_SIZE-8)/sizeof(struct RowSetEntry))
+
+/*
+** Each entry in a RowSet is an instance of the following object.
+**
+** This same object is reused to store a linked list of trees of RowSetEntry
+** objects. In that alternative use, pRight points to the next entry
+** in the list, pLeft points to the tree, and v is unused. The
+** RowSet.pForest value points to the head of this forest list.
+*/
+struct RowSetEntry {
+ i64 v; /* ROWID value for this entry */
+ struct RowSetEntry *pRight; /* Right subtree (larger entries) or list */
+ struct RowSetEntry *pLeft; /* Left subtree (smaller entries) */
+};
+
+/*
+** RowSetEntry objects are allocated in large chunks (instances of the
+** following structure) to reduce memory allocation overhead. The
+** chunks are kept on a linked list so that they can be deallocated
+** when the RowSet is destroyed.
+*/
+struct RowSetChunk {
+ struct RowSetChunk *pNextChunk; /* Next chunk on list of them all */
+ struct RowSetEntry aEntry[ROWSET_ENTRY_PER_CHUNK]; /* Allocated entries */
+};
+
+/*
+** A RowSet in an instance of the following structure.
+**
+** A typedef of this structure if found in sqliteInt.h.
+*/
+struct RowSet {
+ struct RowSetChunk *pChunk; /* List of all chunk allocations */
+ sqlite3 *db; /* The database connection */
+ struct RowSetEntry *pEntry; /* List of entries using pRight */
+ struct RowSetEntry *pLast; /* Last entry on the pEntry list */
+ struct RowSetEntry *pFresh; /* Source of new entry objects */
+ struct RowSetEntry *pForest; /* List of binary trees of entries */
+ u16 nFresh; /* Number of objects on pFresh */
+ u16 rsFlags; /* Various flags */
+ int iBatch; /* Current insert batch */
+};
+
+/*
+** Allowed values for RowSet.rsFlags
+*/
+#define ROWSET_SORTED 0x01 /* True if RowSet.pEntry is sorted */
+#define ROWSET_NEXT 0x02 /* True if sqlite3RowSetNext() has been called */
+
+/*
+** Allocate a RowSet object. Return NULL if a memory allocation
+** error occurs.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE RowSet *sqlite3RowSetInit(sqlite3 *db){
+ RowSet *p = sqlite3DbMallocRawNN(db, sizeof(*p));
+ if( p ){
+ int N = sqlite3DbMallocSize(db, p);
+ p->pChunk = 0;
+ p->db = db;
+ p->pEntry = 0;
+ p->pLast = 0;
+ p->pForest = 0;
+ p->pFresh = (struct RowSetEntry*)(ROUND8(sizeof(*p)) + (char*)p);
+ p->nFresh = (u16)((N - ROUND8(sizeof(*p)))/sizeof(struct RowSetEntry));
+ p->rsFlags = ROWSET_SORTED;
+ p->iBatch = 0;
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Deallocate all chunks from a RowSet. This frees all memory that
+** the RowSet has allocated over its lifetime. This routine is
+** the destructor for the RowSet.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RowSetClear(void *pArg){
+ RowSet *p = (RowSet*)pArg;
+ struct RowSetChunk *pChunk, *pNextChunk;
+ for(pChunk=p->pChunk; pChunk; pChunk = pNextChunk){
+ pNextChunk = pChunk->pNextChunk;
+ sqlite3DbFree(p->db, pChunk);
+ }
+ p->pChunk = 0;
+ p->nFresh = 0;
+ p->pEntry = 0;
+ p->pLast = 0;
+ p->pForest = 0;
+ p->rsFlags = ROWSET_SORTED;
+}
+
+/*
+** Deallocate all chunks from a RowSet. This frees all memory that
+** the RowSet has allocated over its lifetime. This routine is
+** the destructor for the RowSet.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RowSetDelete(void *pArg){
+ sqlite3RowSetClear(pArg);
+ sqlite3DbFree(((RowSet*)pArg)->db, pArg);
+}
+
+/*
+** Allocate a new RowSetEntry object that is associated with the
+** given RowSet. Return a pointer to the new and completely uninitialized
+** object.
+**
+** In an OOM situation, the RowSet.db->mallocFailed flag is set and this
+** routine returns NULL.
+*/
+static struct RowSetEntry *rowSetEntryAlloc(RowSet *p){
+ assert( p!=0 );
+ if( p->nFresh==0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ /* We could allocate a fresh RowSetEntry each time one is needed, but it
+ ** is more efficient to pull a preallocated entry from the pool */
+ struct RowSetChunk *pNew;
+ pNew = sqlite3DbMallocRawNN(p->db, sizeof(*pNew));
+ if( pNew==0 ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ pNew->pNextChunk = p->pChunk;
+ p->pChunk = pNew;
+ p->pFresh = pNew->aEntry;
+ p->nFresh = ROWSET_ENTRY_PER_CHUNK;
+ }
+ p->nFresh--;
+ return p->pFresh++;
+}
+
+/*
+** Insert a new value into a RowSet.
+**
+** The mallocFailed flag of the database connection is set if a
+** memory allocation fails.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3RowSetInsert(RowSet *p, i64 rowid){
+ struct RowSetEntry *pEntry; /* The new entry */
+ struct RowSetEntry *pLast; /* The last prior entry */
+
+ /* This routine is never called after sqlite3RowSetNext() */
+ assert( p!=0 && (p->rsFlags & ROWSET_NEXT)==0 );
+
+ pEntry = rowSetEntryAlloc(p);
+ if( pEntry==0 ) return;
+ pEntry->v = rowid;
+ pEntry->pRight = 0;
+ pLast = p->pLast;
+ if( pLast ){
+ if( rowid<=pLast->v ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ /* Avoid unnecessary sorts by preserving the ROWSET_SORTED flags
+ ** where possible */
+ p->rsFlags &= ~ROWSET_SORTED;
+ }
+ pLast->pRight = pEntry;
+ }else{
+ p->pEntry = pEntry;
+ }
+ p->pLast = pEntry;
+}
+
+/*
+** Merge two lists of RowSetEntry objects. Remove duplicates.
+**
+** The input lists are connected via pRight pointers and are
+** assumed to each already be in sorted order.
+*/
+static struct RowSetEntry *rowSetEntryMerge(
+ struct RowSetEntry *pA, /* First sorted list to be merged */
+ struct RowSetEntry *pB /* Second sorted list to be merged */
+){
+ struct RowSetEntry head;
+ struct RowSetEntry *pTail;
+
+ pTail = &head;
+ assert( pA!=0 && pB!=0 );
+ for(;;){
+ assert( pA->pRight==0 || pA->v<=pA->pRight->v );
+ assert( pB->pRight==0 || pB->v<=pB->pRight->v );
+ if( pA->v<=pB->v ){
+ if( pA->vv ) pTail = pTail->pRight = pA;
+ pA = pA->pRight;
+ if( pA==0 ){
+ pTail->pRight = pB;
+ break;
+ }
+ }else{
+ pTail = pTail->pRight = pB;
+ pB = pB->pRight;
+ if( pB==0 ){
+ pTail->pRight = pA;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return head.pRight;
+}
+
+/*
+** Sort all elements on the list of RowSetEntry objects into order of
+** increasing v.
+*/
+static struct RowSetEntry *rowSetEntrySort(struct RowSetEntry *pIn){
+ unsigned int i;
+ struct RowSetEntry *pNext, *aBucket[40];
+
+ memset(aBucket, 0, sizeof(aBucket));
+ while( pIn ){
+ pNext = pIn->pRight;
+ pIn->pRight = 0;
+ for(i=0; aBucket[i]; i++){
+ pIn = rowSetEntryMerge(aBucket[i], pIn);
+ aBucket[i] = 0;
+ }
+ aBucket[i] = pIn;
+ pIn = pNext;
+ }
+ pIn = aBucket[0];
+ for(i=1; ipLeft ){
+ struct RowSetEntry *p;
+ rowSetTreeToList(pIn->pLeft, ppFirst, &p);
+ p->pRight = pIn;
+ }else{
+ *ppFirst = pIn;
+ }
+ if( pIn->pRight ){
+ rowSetTreeToList(pIn->pRight, &pIn->pRight, ppLast);
+ }else{
+ *ppLast = pIn;
+ }
+ assert( (*ppLast)->pRight==0 );
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Convert a sorted list of elements (connected by pRight) into a binary
+** tree with depth of iDepth. A depth of 1 means the tree contains a single
+** node taken from the head of *ppList. A depth of 2 means a tree with
+** three nodes. And so forth.
+**
+** Use as many entries from the input list as required and update the
+** *ppList to point to the unused elements of the list. If the input
+** list contains too few elements, then construct an incomplete tree
+** and leave *ppList set to NULL.
+**
+** Return a pointer to the root of the constructed binary tree.
+*/
+static struct RowSetEntry *rowSetNDeepTree(
+ struct RowSetEntry **ppList,
+ int iDepth
+){
+ struct RowSetEntry *p; /* Root of the new tree */
+ struct RowSetEntry *pLeft; /* Left subtree */
+ if( *ppList==0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ /* Prevent unnecessary deep recursion when we run out of entries */
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if( iDepth>1 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ /* This branch causes a *balanced* tree to be generated. A valid tree
+ ** is still generated without this branch, but the tree is wildly
+ ** unbalanced and inefficient. */
+ pLeft = rowSetNDeepTree(ppList, iDepth-1);
+ p = *ppList;
+ if( p==0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ /* It is safe to always return here, but the resulting tree
+ ** would be unbalanced */
+ return pLeft;
+ }
+ p->pLeft = pLeft;
+ *ppList = p->pRight;
+ p->pRight = rowSetNDeepTree(ppList, iDepth-1);
+ }else{
+ p = *ppList;
+ *ppList = p->pRight;
+ p->pLeft = p->pRight = 0;
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Convert a sorted list of elements into a binary tree. Make the tree
+** as deep as it needs to be in order to contain the entire list.
+*/
+static struct RowSetEntry *rowSetListToTree(struct RowSetEntry *pList){
+ int iDepth; /* Depth of the tree so far */
+ struct RowSetEntry *p; /* Current tree root */
+ struct RowSetEntry *pLeft; /* Left subtree */
+
+ assert( pList!=0 );
+ p = pList;
+ pList = p->pRight;
+ p->pLeft = p->pRight = 0;
+ for(iDepth=1; pList; iDepth++){
+ pLeft = p;
+ p = pList;
+ pList = p->pRight;
+ p->pLeft = pLeft;
+ p->pRight = rowSetNDeepTree(&pList, iDepth);
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+/*
+** Extract the smallest element from the RowSet.
+** Write the element into *pRowid. Return 1 on success. Return
+** 0 if the RowSet is already empty.
+**
+** After this routine has been called, the sqlite3RowSetInsert()
+** routine may not be called again.
+**
+** This routine may not be called after sqlite3RowSetTest() has
+** been used. Older versions of RowSet allowed that, but as the
+** capability was not used by the code generator, it was removed
+** for code economy.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3RowSetNext(RowSet *p, i64 *pRowid){
+ assert( p!=0 );
+ assert( p->pForest==0 ); /* Cannot be used with sqlite3RowSetText() */
+
+ /* Merge the forest into a single sorted list on first call */
+ if( (p->rsFlags & ROWSET_NEXT)==0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ if( (p->rsFlags & ROWSET_SORTED)==0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ p->pEntry = rowSetEntrySort(p->pEntry);
+ }
+ p->rsFlags |= ROWSET_SORTED|ROWSET_NEXT;
+ }
+
+ /* Return the next entry on the list */
+ if( p->pEntry ){
+ *pRowid = p->pEntry->v;
+ p->pEntry = p->pEntry->pRight;
+ if( p->pEntry==0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-TRUE*/
+ /* Free memory immediately, rather than waiting on sqlite3_finalize() */
+ sqlite3RowSetClear(p);
+ }
+ return 1;
+ }else{
+ return 0;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Check to see if element iRowid was inserted into the rowset as
+** part of any insert batch prior to iBatch. Return 1 or 0.
+**
+** If this is the first test of a new batch and if there exist entries
+** on pRowSet->pEntry, then sort those entries into the forest at
+** pRowSet->pForest so that they can be tested.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3RowSetTest(RowSet *pRowSet, int iBatch, sqlite3_int64 iRowid){
+ struct RowSetEntry *p, *pTree;
+
+ /* This routine is never called after sqlite3RowSetNext() */
+ assert( pRowSet!=0 && (pRowSet->rsFlags & ROWSET_NEXT)==0 );
+
+ /* Sort entries into the forest on the first test of a new batch.
+ ** To save unnecessary work, only do this when the batch number changes.
+ */
+ if( iBatch!=pRowSet->iBatch ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ p = pRowSet->pEntry;
+ if( p ){
+ struct RowSetEntry **ppPrevTree = &pRowSet->pForest;
+ if( (pRowSet->rsFlags & ROWSET_SORTED)==0 ){ /*OPTIMIZATION-IF-FALSE*/
+ /* Only sort the current set of entries if they need it */
+ p = rowSetEntrySort(p);
+ }
+ for(pTree = pRowSet->pForest; pTree; pTree=pTree->pRight){
+ ppPrevTree = &pTree->pRight;
+ if( pTree->pLeft==0 ){
+ pTree->pLeft = rowSetListToTree(p);
+ break;
+ }else{
+ struct RowSetEntry *pAux, *pTail;
+ rowSetTreeToList(pTree->pLeft, &pAux, &pTail);
+ pTree->pLeft = 0;
+ p = rowSetEntryMerge(pAux, p);
+ }
+ }
+ if( pTree==0 ){
+ *ppPrevTree = pTree = rowSetEntryAlloc(pRowSet);
+ if( pTree ){
+ pTree->v = 0;
+ pTree->pRight = 0;
+ pTree->pLeft = rowSetListToTree(p);
+ }
+ }
+ pRowSet->pEntry = 0;
+ pRowSet->pLast = 0;
+ pRowSet->rsFlags |= ROWSET_SORTED;
+ }
+ pRowSet->iBatch = iBatch;
+ }
+
+ /* Test to see if the iRowid value appears anywhere in the forest.
+ ** Return 1 if it does and 0 if not.
+ */
+ for(pTree = pRowSet->pForest; pTree; pTree=pTree->pRight){
+ p = pTree->pLeft;
+ while( p ){
+ if( p->vpRight;
+ }else if( p->v>iRowid ){
+ p = p->pLeft;
+ }else{
+ return 1;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/************** End of rowset.c **********************************************/
+/************** Begin file pager.c *******************************************/
+/*
+** 2001 September 15
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This is the implementation of the page cache subsystem or "pager".
+**
+** The pager is used to access a database disk file. It implements
+** atomic commit and rollback through the use of a journal file that
+** is separate from the database file. The pager also implements file
+** locking to prevent two processes from writing the same database
+** file simultaneously, or one process from reading the database while
+** another is writing.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_DISKIO
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+/************** Include wal.h in the middle of pager.c ***********************/
+/************** Begin file wal.h *********************************************/
+/*
+** 2010 February 1
+**
+** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of
+** a legal notice, here is a blessing:
+**
+** May you do good and not evil.
+** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others.
+** May you share freely, never taking more than you give.
+**
+*************************************************************************
+** This header file defines the interface to the write-ahead logging
+** system. Refer to the comments below and the header comment attached to
+** the implementation of each function in log.c for further details.
+*/
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_WAL_H
+#define SQLITE_WAL_H
+
+/* #include "sqliteInt.h" */
+
+/* Macros for extracting appropriate sync flags for either transaction
+** commits (WAL_SYNC_FLAGS(X)) or for checkpoint ops (CKPT_SYNC_FLAGS(X)):
+*/
+#define WAL_SYNC_FLAGS(X) ((X)&0x03)
+#define CKPT_SYNC_FLAGS(X) (((X)>>2)&0x03)
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+# define sqlite3WalOpen(x,y,z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalLimit(x,y)
+# define sqlite3WalClose(v,w,x,y,z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalBeginReadTransaction(y,z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalEndReadTransaction(z)
+# define sqlite3WalDbsize(y) 0
+# define sqlite3WalBeginWriteTransaction(y) 0
+# define sqlite3WalEndWriteTransaction(x) 0
+# define sqlite3WalUndo(x,y,z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalSavepoint(y,z)
+# define sqlite3WalSavepointUndo(y,z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalFrames(u,v,w,x,y,z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalCheckpoint(q,r,s,t,u,v,w,x,y,z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalCallback(z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalExclusiveMode(y,z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalHeapMemory(z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalFramesize(z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalFindFrame(x,y,z) 0
+# define sqlite3WalFile(x) 0
+#else
+
+#define WAL_SAVEPOINT_NDATA 4
+
+/* Connection to a write-ahead log (WAL) file.
+** There is one object of this type for each pager.
+*/
+typedef struct Wal Wal;
+
+/* Open and close a connection to a write-ahead log. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalOpen(sqlite3_vfs*, sqlite3_file*, const char *, int, i64, Wal**);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalClose(Wal *pWal, sqlite3*, int sync_flags, int, u8 *);
+
+/* Set the limiting size of a WAL file. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WalLimit(Wal*, i64);
+
+/* Used by readers to open (lock) and close (unlock) a snapshot. A
+** snapshot is like a read-transaction. It is the state of the database
+** at an instant in time. sqlite3WalOpenSnapshot gets a read lock and
+** preserves the current state even if the other threads or processes
+** write to or checkpoint the WAL. sqlite3WalCloseSnapshot() closes the
+** transaction and releases the lock.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalBeginReadTransaction(Wal *pWal, int *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WalEndReadTransaction(Wal *pWal);
+
+/* Read a page from the write-ahead log, if it is present. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalFindFrame(Wal *, Pgno, u32 *);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalReadFrame(Wal *, u32, int, u8 *);
+
+/* If the WAL is not empty, return the size of the database. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Pgno sqlite3WalDbsize(Wal *pWal);
+
+/* Obtain or release the WRITER lock. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalBeginWriteTransaction(Wal *pWal);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalEndWriteTransaction(Wal *pWal);
+
+/* Undo any frames written (but not committed) to the log */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalUndo(Wal *pWal, int (*xUndo)(void *, Pgno), void *pUndoCtx);
+
+/* Return an integer that records the current (uncommitted) write
+** position in the WAL */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WalSavepoint(Wal *pWal, u32 *aWalData);
+
+/* Move the write position of the WAL back to iFrame. Called in
+** response to a ROLLBACK TO command. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalSavepointUndo(Wal *pWal, u32 *aWalData);
+
+/* Write a frame or frames to the log. */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalFrames(Wal *pWal, int, PgHdr *, Pgno, int, int);
+
+/* Copy pages from the log to the database file */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalCheckpoint(
+ Wal *pWal, /* Write-ahead log connection */
+ sqlite3 *db, /* Check this handle's interrupt flag */
+ int eMode, /* One of PASSIVE, FULL and RESTART */
+ int (*xBusy)(void*), /* Function to call when busy */
+ void *pBusyArg, /* Context argument for xBusyHandler */
+ int sync_flags, /* Flags to sync db file with (or 0) */
+ int nBuf, /* Size of buffer nBuf */
+ u8 *zBuf, /* Temporary buffer to use */
+ int *pnLog, /* OUT: Number of frames in WAL */
+ int *pnCkpt /* OUT: Number of backfilled frames in WAL */
+);
+
+/* Return the value to pass to a sqlite3_wal_hook callback, the
+** number of frames in the WAL at the point of the last commit since
+** sqlite3WalCallback() was called. If no commits have occurred since
+** the last call, then return 0.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalCallback(Wal *pWal);
+
+/* Tell the wal layer that an EXCLUSIVE lock has been obtained (or released)
+** by the pager layer on the database file.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalExclusiveMode(Wal *pWal, int op);
+
+/* Return true if the argument is non-NULL and the WAL module is using
+** heap-memory for the wal-index. Otherwise, if the argument is NULL or the
+** WAL module is using shared-memory, return false.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalHeapMemory(Wal *pWal);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_SNAPSHOT
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalSnapshotGet(Wal *pWal, sqlite3_snapshot **ppSnapshot);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WalSnapshotOpen(Wal *pWal, sqlite3_snapshot *pSnapshot);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalSnapshotRecover(Wal *pWal);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalSnapshotCheck(Wal *pWal, sqlite3_snapshot *pSnapshot);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WalSnapshotUnlock(Wal *pWal);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_ZIPVFS
+/* If the WAL file is not empty, return the number of bytes of content
+** stored in each frame (i.e. the db page-size when the WAL was created).
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalFramesize(Wal *pWal);
+#endif
+
+/* Return the sqlite3_file object for the WAL file */
+SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_file *sqlite3WalFile(Wal *pWal);
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_SETLK_TIMEOUT
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3WalWriteLock(Wal *pWal, int bLock);
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3WalDb(Wal *pWal, sqlite3 *db);
+#endif
+
+#endif /* ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL */
+#endif /* SQLITE_WAL_H */
+
+/************** End of wal.h *************************************************/
+/************** Continuing where we left off in pager.c **********************/
+
+
+/******************* NOTES ON THE DESIGN OF THE PAGER ************************
+**
+** This comment block describes invariants that hold when using a rollback
+** journal. These invariants do not apply for journal_mode=WAL,
+** journal_mode=MEMORY, or journal_mode=OFF.
+**
+** Within this comment block, a page is deemed to have been synced
+** automatically as soon as it is written when PRAGMA synchronous=OFF.
+** Otherwise, the page is not synced until the xSync method of the VFS
+** is called successfully on the file containing the page.
+**
+** Definition: A page of the database file is said to be "overwriteable" if
+** one or more of the following are true about the page:
+**
+** (a) The original content of the page as it was at the beginning of
+** the transaction has been written into the rollback journal and
+** synced.
+**
+** (b) The page was a freelist leaf page at the start of the transaction.
+**
+** (c) The page number is greater than the largest page that existed in
+** the database file at the start of the transaction.
+**
+** (1) A page of the database file is never overwritten unless one of the
+** following are true:
+**
+** (a) The page and all other pages on the same sector are overwriteable.
+**
+** (b) The atomic page write optimization is enabled, and the entire
+** transaction other than the update of the transaction sequence
+** number consists of a single page change.
+**
+** (2) The content of a page written into the rollback journal exactly matches
+** both the content in the database when the rollback journal was written
+** and the content in the database at the beginning of the current
+** transaction.
+**
+** (3) Writes to the database file are an integer multiple of the page size
+** in length and are aligned on a page boundary.
+**
+** (4) Reads from the database file are either aligned on a page boundary and
+** an integer multiple of the page size in length or are taken from the
+** first 100 bytes of the database file.
+**
+** (5) All writes to the database file are synced prior to the rollback journal
+** being deleted, truncated, or zeroed.
+**
+** (6) If a super-journal file is used, then all writes to the database file
+** are synced prior to the super-journal being deleted.
+**
+** Definition: Two databases (or the same database at two points it time)
+** are said to be "logically equivalent" if they give the same answer to
+** all queries. Note in particular the content of freelist leaf
+** pages can be changed arbitrarily without affecting the logical equivalence
+** of the database.
+**
+** (7) At any time, if any subset, including the empty set and the total set,
+** of the unsynced changes to a rollback journal are removed and the
+** journal is rolled back, the resulting database file will be logically
+** equivalent to the database file at the beginning of the transaction.
+**
+** (8) When a transaction is rolled back, the xTruncate method of the VFS
+** is called to restore the database file to the same size it was at
+** the beginning of the transaction. (In some VFSes, the xTruncate
+** method is a no-op, but that does not change the fact the SQLite will
+** invoke it.)
+**
+** (9) Whenever the database file is modified, at least one bit in the range
+** of bytes from 24 through 39 inclusive will be changed prior to releasing
+** the EXCLUSIVE lock, thus signaling other connections on the same
+** database to flush their caches.
+**
+** (10) The pattern of bits in bytes 24 through 39 shall not repeat in less
+** than one billion transactions.
+**
+** (11) A database file is well-formed at the beginning and at the conclusion
+** of every transaction.
+**
+** (12) An EXCLUSIVE lock is held on the database file when writing to
+** the database file.
+**
+** (13) A SHARED lock is held on the database file while reading any
+** content out of the database file.
+**
+******************************************************************************/
+
+/*
+** Macros for troubleshooting. Normally turned off
+*/
+#if 0
+int sqlite3PagerTrace=1; /* True to enable tracing */
+#define sqlite3DebugPrintf printf
+#define PAGERTRACE(X) if( sqlite3PagerTrace ){ sqlite3DebugPrintf X; }
+#else
+#define PAGERTRACE(X)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The following two macros are used within the PAGERTRACE() macros above
+** to print out file-descriptors.
+**
+** PAGERID() takes a pointer to a Pager struct as its argument. The
+** associated file-descriptor is returned. FILEHANDLEID() takes an sqlite3_file
+** struct as its argument.
+*/
+#define PAGERID(p) (SQLITE_PTR_TO_INT(p->fd))
+#define FILEHANDLEID(fd) (SQLITE_PTR_TO_INT(fd))
+
+/*
+** The Pager.eState variable stores the current 'state' of a pager. A
+** pager may be in any one of the seven states shown in the following
+** state diagram.
+**
+** OPEN <------+------+
+** | | |
+** V | |
+** +---------> READER-------+ |
+** | | |
+** | V |
+** |<-------WRITER_LOCKED------> ERROR
+** | | ^
+** | V |
+** |<------WRITER_CACHEMOD-------->|
+** | | |
+** | V |
+** |<-------WRITER_DBMOD---------->|
+** | | |
+** | V |
+** +<------WRITER_FINISHED-------->+
+**
+**
+** List of state transitions and the C [function] that performs each:
+**
+** OPEN -> READER [sqlite3PagerSharedLock]
+** READER -> OPEN [pager_unlock]
+**
+** READER -> WRITER_LOCKED [sqlite3PagerBegin]
+** WRITER_LOCKED -> WRITER_CACHEMOD [pager_open_journal]
+** WRITER_CACHEMOD -> WRITER_DBMOD [syncJournal]
+** WRITER_DBMOD -> WRITER_FINISHED [sqlite3PagerCommitPhaseOne]
+** WRITER_*** -> READER [pager_end_transaction]
+**
+** WRITER_*** -> ERROR [pager_error]
+** ERROR -> OPEN [pager_unlock]
+**
+**
+** OPEN:
+**
+** The pager starts up in this state. Nothing is guaranteed in this
+** state - the file may or may not be locked and the database size is
+** unknown. The database may not be read or written.
+**
+** * No read or write transaction is active.
+** * Any lock, or no lock at all, may be held on the database file.
+** * The dbSize, dbOrigSize and dbFileSize variables may not be trusted.
+**
+** READER:
+**
+** In this state all the requirements for reading the database in
+** rollback (non-WAL) mode are met. Unless the pager is (or recently
+** was) in exclusive-locking mode, a user-level read transaction is
+** open. The database size is known in this state.
+**
+** A connection running with locking_mode=normal enters this state when
+** it opens a read-transaction on the database and returns to state
+** OPEN after the read-transaction is completed. However a connection
+** running in locking_mode=exclusive (including temp databases) remains in
+** this state even after the read-transaction is closed. The only way
+** a locking_mode=exclusive connection can transition from READER to OPEN
+** is via the ERROR state (see below).
+**
+** * A read transaction may be active (but a write-transaction cannot).
+** * A SHARED or greater lock is held on the database file.
+** * The dbSize variable may be trusted (even if a user-level read
+** transaction is not active). The dbOrigSize and dbFileSize variables
+** may not be trusted at this point.
+** * If the database is a WAL database, then the WAL connection is open.
+** * Even if a read-transaction is not open, it is guaranteed that
+** there is no hot-journal in the file-system.
+**
+** WRITER_LOCKED:
+**
+** The pager moves to this state from READER when a write-transaction
+** is first opened on the database. In WRITER_LOCKED state, all locks
+** required to start a write-transaction are held, but no actual
+** modifications to the cache or database have taken place.
+**
+** In rollback mode, a RESERVED or (if the transaction was opened with
+** BEGIN EXCLUSIVE) EXCLUSIVE lock is obtained on the database file when
+** moving to this state, but the journal file is not written to or opened
+** to in this state. If the transaction is committed or rolled back while
+** in WRITER_LOCKED state, all that is required is to unlock the database
+** file.
+**
+** IN WAL mode, WalBeginWriteTransaction() is called to lock the log file.
+** If the connection is running with locking_mode=exclusive, an attempt
+** is made to obtain an EXCLUSIVE lock on the database file.
+**
+** * A write transaction is active.
+** * If the connection is open in rollback-mode, a RESERVED or greater
+** lock is held on the database file.
+** * If the connection is open in WAL-mode, a WAL write transaction
+** is open (i.e. sqlite3WalBeginWriteTransaction() has been successfully
+** called).
+** * The dbSize, dbOrigSize and dbFileSize variables are all valid.
+** * The contents of the pager cache have not been modified.
+** * The journal file may or may not be open.
+** * Nothing (not even the first header) has been written to the journal.
+**
+** WRITER_CACHEMOD:
+**
+** A pager moves from WRITER_LOCKED state to this state when a page is
+** first modified by the upper layer. In rollback mode the journal file
+** is opened (if it is not already open) and a header written to the
+** start of it. The database file on disk has not been modified.
+**
+** * A write transaction is active.
+** * A RESERVED or greater lock is held on the database file.
+** * The journal file is open and the first header has been written
+** to it, but the header has not been synced to disk.
+** * The contents of the page cache have been modified.
+**
+** WRITER_DBMOD:
+**
+** The pager transitions from WRITER_CACHEMOD into WRITER_DBMOD state
+** when it modifies the contents of the database file. WAL connections
+** never enter this state (since they do not modify the database file,
+** just the log file).
+**
+** * A write transaction is active.
+** * An EXCLUSIVE or greater lock is held on the database file.
+** * The journal file is open and the first header has been written
+** and synced to disk.
+** * The contents of the page cache have been modified (and possibly
+** written to disk).
+**
+** WRITER_FINISHED:
+**
+** It is not possible for a WAL connection to enter this state.
+**
+** A rollback-mode pager changes to WRITER_FINISHED state from WRITER_DBMOD
+** state after the entire transaction has been successfully written into the
+** database file. In this state the transaction may be committed simply
+** by finalizing the journal file. Once in WRITER_FINISHED state, it is
+** not possible to modify the database further. At this point, the upper
+** layer must either commit or rollback the transaction.
+**
+** * A write transaction is active.
+** * An EXCLUSIVE or greater lock is held on the database file.
+** * All writing and syncing of journal and database data has finished.
+** If no error occurred, all that remains is to finalize the journal to
+** commit the transaction. If an error did occur, the caller will need
+** to rollback the transaction.
+**
+** ERROR:
+**
+** The ERROR state is entered when an IO or disk-full error (including
+** SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM) occurs at a point in the code that makes it
+** difficult to be sure that the in-memory pager state (cache contents,
+** db size etc.) are consistent with the contents of the file-system.
+**
+** Temporary pager files may enter the ERROR state, but in-memory pagers
+** cannot.
+**
+** For example, if an IO error occurs while performing a rollback,
+** the contents of the page-cache may be left in an inconsistent state.
+** At this point it would be dangerous to change back to READER state
+** (as usually happens after a rollback). Any subsequent readers might
+** report database corruption (due to the inconsistent cache), and if
+** they upgrade to writers, they may inadvertently corrupt the database
+** file. To avoid this hazard, the pager switches into the ERROR state
+** instead of READER following such an error.
+**
+** Once it has entered the ERROR state, any attempt to use the pager
+** to read or write data returns an error. Eventually, once all
+** outstanding transactions have been abandoned, the pager is able to
+** transition back to OPEN state, discarding the contents of the
+** page-cache and any other in-memory state at the same time. Everything
+** is reloaded from disk (and, if necessary, hot-journal rollback peformed)
+** when a read-transaction is next opened on the pager (transitioning
+** the pager into READER state). At that point the system has recovered
+** from the error.
+**
+** Specifically, the pager jumps into the ERROR state if:
+**
+** 1. An error occurs while attempting a rollback. This happens in
+** function sqlite3PagerRollback().
+**
+** 2. An error occurs while attempting to finalize a journal file
+** following a commit in function sqlite3PagerCommitPhaseTwo().
+**
+** 3. An error occurs while attempting to write to the journal or
+** database file in function pagerStress() in order to free up
+** memory.
+**
+** In other cases, the error is returned to the b-tree layer. The b-tree
+** layer then attempts a rollback operation. If the error condition
+** persists, the pager enters the ERROR state via condition (1) above.
+**
+** Condition (3) is necessary because it can be triggered by a read-only
+** statement executed within a transaction. In this case, if the error
+** code were simply returned to the user, the b-tree layer would not
+** automatically attempt a rollback, as it assumes that an error in a
+** read-only statement cannot leave the pager in an internally inconsistent
+** state.
+**
+** * The Pager.errCode variable is set to something other than SQLITE_OK.
+** * There are one or more outstanding references to pages (after the
+** last reference is dropped the pager should move back to OPEN state).
+** * The pager is not an in-memory pager.
+**
+**
+** Notes:
+**
+** * A pager is never in WRITER_DBMOD or WRITER_FINISHED state if the
+** connection is open in WAL mode. A WAL connection is always in one
+** of the first four states.
+**
+** * Normally, a connection open in exclusive mode is never in PAGER_OPEN
+** state. There are two exceptions: immediately after exclusive-mode has
+** been turned on (and before any read or write transactions are
+** executed), and when the pager is leaving the "error state".
+**
+** * See also: assert_pager_state().
+*/
+#define PAGER_OPEN 0
+#define PAGER_READER 1
+#define PAGER_WRITER_LOCKED 2
+#define PAGER_WRITER_CACHEMOD 3
+#define PAGER_WRITER_DBMOD 4
+#define PAGER_WRITER_FINISHED 5
+#define PAGER_ERROR 6
+
+/*
+** The Pager.eLock variable is almost always set to one of the
+** following locking-states, according to the lock currently held on
+** the database file: NO_LOCK, SHARED_LOCK, RESERVED_LOCK or EXCLUSIVE_LOCK.
+** This variable is kept up to date as locks are taken and released by
+** the pagerLockDb() and pagerUnlockDb() wrappers.
+**
+** If the VFS xLock() or xUnlock() returns an error other than SQLITE_BUSY
+** (i.e. one of the SQLITE_IOERR subtypes), it is not clear whether or not
+** the operation was successful. In these circumstances pagerLockDb() and
+** pagerUnlockDb() take a conservative approach - eLock is always updated
+** when unlocking the file, and only updated when locking the file if the
+** VFS call is successful. This way, the Pager.eLock variable may be set
+** to a less exclusive (lower) value than the lock that is actually held
+** at the system level, but it is never set to a more exclusive value.
+**
+** This is usually safe. If an xUnlock fails or appears to fail, there may
+** be a few redundant xLock() calls or a lock may be held for longer than
+** required, but nothing really goes wrong.
+**
+** The exception is when the database file is unlocked as the pager moves
+** from ERROR to OPEN state. At this point there may be a hot-journal file
+** in the file-system that needs to be rolled back (as part of an OPEN->SHARED
+** transition, by the same pager or any other). If the call to xUnlock()
+** fails at this point and the pager is left holding an EXCLUSIVE lock, this
+** can confuse the call to xCheckReservedLock() call made later as part
+** of hot-journal detection.
+**
+** xCheckReservedLock() is defined as returning true "if there is a RESERVED
+** lock held by this process or any others". So xCheckReservedLock may
+** return true because the caller itself is holding an EXCLUSIVE lock (but
+** doesn't know it because of a previous error in xUnlock). If this happens
+** a hot-journal may be mistaken for a journal being created by an active
+** transaction in another process, causing SQLite to read from the database
+** without rolling it back.
+**
+** To work around this, if a call to xUnlock() fails when unlocking the
+** database in the ERROR state, Pager.eLock is set to UNKNOWN_LOCK. It
+** is only changed back to a real locking state after a successful call
+** to xLock(EXCLUSIVE). Also, the code to do the OPEN->SHARED state transition
+** omits the check for a hot-journal if Pager.eLock is set to UNKNOWN_LOCK
+** lock. Instead, it assumes a hot-journal exists and obtains an EXCLUSIVE
+** lock on the database file before attempting to roll it back. See function
+** PagerSharedLock() for more detail.
+**
+** Pager.eLock may only be set to UNKNOWN_LOCK when the pager is in
+** PAGER_OPEN state.
+*/
+#define UNKNOWN_LOCK (EXCLUSIVE_LOCK+1)
+
+/*
+** The maximum allowed sector size. 64KiB. If the xSectorsize() method
+** returns a value larger than this, then MAX_SECTOR_SIZE is used instead.
+** This could conceivably cause corruption following a power failure on
+** such a system. This is currently an undocumented limit.
+*/
+#define MAX_SECTOR_SIZE 0x10000
+
+
+/*
+** An instance of the following structure is allocated for each active
+** savepoint and statement transaction in the system. All such structures
+** are stored in the Pager.aSavepoint[] array, which is allocated and
+** resized using sqlite3Realloc().
+**
+** When a savepoint is created, the PagerSavepoint.iHdrOffset field is
+** set to 0. If a journal-header is written into the main journal while
+** the savepoint is active, then iHdrOffset is set to the byte offset
+** immediately following the last journal record written into the main
+** journal before the journal-header. This is required during savepoint
+** rollback (see pagerPlaybackSavepoint()).
+*/
+typedef struct PagerSavepoint PagerSavepoint;
+struct PagerSavepoint {
+ i64 iOffset; /* Starting offset in main journal */
+ i64 iHdrOffset; /* See above */
+ Bitvec *pInSavepoint; /* Set of pages in this savepoint */
+ Pgno nOrig; /* Original number of pages in file */
+ Pgno iSubRec; /* Index of first record in sub-journal */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ u32 aWalData[WAL_SAVEPOINT_NDATA]; /* WAL savepoint context */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** Bits of the Pager.doNotSpill flag. See further description below.
+*/
+#define SPILLFLAG_OFF 0x01 /* Never spill cache. Set via pragma */
+#define SPILLFLAG_ROLLBACK 0x02 /* Current rolling back, so do not spill */
+#define SPILLFLAG_NOSYNC 0x04 /* Spill is ok, but do not sync */
+
+/*
+** An open page cache is an instance of struct Pager. A description of
+** some of the more important member variables follows:
+**
+** eState
+**
+** The current 'state' of the pager object. See the comment and state
+** diagram above for a description of the pager state.
+**
+** eLock
+**
+** For a real on-disk database, the current lock held on the database file -
+** NO_LOCK, SHARED_LOCK, RESERVED_LOCK or EXCLUSIVE_LOCK.
+**
+** For a temporary or in-memory database (neither of which require any
+** locks), this variable is always set to EXCLUSIVE_LOCK. Since such
+** databases always have Pager.exclusiveMode==1, this tricks the pager
+** logic into thinking that it already has all the locks it will ever
+** need (and no reason to release them).
+**
+** In some (obscure) circumstances, this variable may also be set to
+** UNKNOWN_LOCK. See the comment above the #define of UNKNOWN_LOCK for
+** details.
+**
+** changeCountDone
+**
+** This boolean variable is used to make sure that the change-counter
+** (the 4-byte header field at byte offset 24 of the database file) is
+** not updated more often than necessary.
+**
+** It is set to true when the change-counter field is updated, which
+** can only happen if an exclusive lock is held on the database file.
+** It is cleared (set to false) whenever an exclusive lock is
+** relinquished on the database file. Each time a transaction is committed,
+** The changeCountDone flag is inspected. If it is true, the work of
+** updating the change-counter is omitted for the current transaction.
+**
+** This mechanism means that when running in exclusive mode, a connection
+** need only update the change-counter once, for the first transaction
+** committed.
+**
+** setSuper
+**
+** When PagerCommitPhaseOne() is called to commit a transaction, it may
+** (or may not) specify a super-journal name to be written into the
+** journal file before it is synced to disk.
+**
+** Whether or not a journal file contains a super-journal pointer affects
+** the way in which the journal file is finalized after the transaction is
+** committed or rolled back when running in "journal_mode=PERSIST" mode.
+** If a journal file does not contain a super-journal pointer, it is
+** finalized by overwriting the first journal header with zeroes. If
+** it does contain a super-journal pointer the journal file is finalized
+** by truncating it to zero bytes, just as if the connection were
+** running in "journal_mode=truncate" mode.
+**
+** Journal files that contain super-journal pointers cannot be finalized
+** simply by overwriting the first journal-header with zeroes, as the
+** super-journal pointer could interfere with hot-journal rollback of any
+** subsequently interrupted transaction that reuses the journal file.
+**
+** The flag is cleared as soon as the journal file is finalized (either
+** by PagerCommitPhaseTwo or PagerRollback). If an IO error prevents the
+** journal file from being successfully finalized, the setSuper flag
+** is cleared anyway (and the pager will move to ERROR state).
+**
+** doNotSpill
+**
+** This variables control the behavior of cache-spills (calls made by
+** the pcache module to the pagerStress() routine to write cached data
+** to the file-system in order to free up memory).
+**
+** When bits SPILLFLAG_OFF or SPILLFLAG_ROLLBACK of doNotSpill are set,
+** writing to the database from pagerStress() is disabled altogether.
+** The SPILLFLAG_ROLLBACK case is done in a very obscure case that
+** comes up during savepoint rollback that requires the pcache module
+** to allocate a new page to prevent the journal file from being written
+** while it is being traversed by code in pager_playback(). The SPILLFLAG_OFF
+** case is a user preference.
+**
+** If the SPILLFLAG_NOSYNC bit is set, writing to the database from
+** pagerStress() is permitted, but syncing the journal file is not.
+** This flag is set by sqlite3PagerWrite() when the file-system sector-size
+** is larger than the database page-size in order to prevent a journal sync
+** from happening in between the journalling of two pages on the same sector.
+**
+** subjInMemory
+**
+** This is a boolean variable. If true, then any required sub-journal
+** is opened as an in-memory journal file. If false, then in-memory
+** sub-journals are only used for in-memory pager files.
+**
+** This variable is updated by the upper layer each time a new
+** write-transaction is opened.
+**
+** dbSize, dbOrigSize, dbFileSize
+**
+** Variable dbSize is set to the number of pages in the database file.
+** It is valid in PAGER_READER and higher states (all states except for
+** OPEN and ERROR).
+**
+** dbSize is set based on the size of the database file, which may be
+** larger than the size of the database (the value stored at offset
+** 28 of the database header by the btree). If the size of the file
+** is not an integer multiple of the page-size, the value stored in
+** dbSize is rounded down (i.e. a 5KB file with 2K page-size has dbSize==2).
+** Except, any file that is greater than 0 bytes in size is considered
+** to have at least one page. (i.e. a 1KB file with 2K page-size leads
+** to dbSize==1).
+**
+** During a write-transaction, if pages with page-numbers greater than
+** dbSize are modified in the cache, dbSize is updated accordingly.
+** Similarly, if the database is truncated using PagerTruncateImage(),
+** dbSize is updated.
+**
+** Variables dbOrigSize and dbFileSize are valid in states
+** PAGER_WRITER_LOCKED and higher. dbOrigSize is a copy of the dbSize
+** variable at the start of the transaction. It is used during rollback,
+** and to determine whether or not pages need to be journalled before
+** being modified.
+**
+** Throughout a write-transaction, dbFileSize contains the size of
+** the file on disk in pages. It is set to a copy of dbSize when the
+** write-transaction is first opened, and updated when VFS calls are made
+** to write or truncate the database file on disk.
+**
+** The only reason the dbFileSize variable is required is to suppress
+** unnecessary calls to xTruncate() after committing a transaction. If,
+** when a transaction is committed, the dbFileSize variable indicates
+** that the database file is larger than the database image (Pager.dbSize),
+** pager_truncate() is called. The pager_truncate() call uses xFilesize()
+** to measure the database file on disk, and then truncates it if required.
+** dbFileSize is not used when rolling back a transaction. In this case
+** pager_truncate() is called unconditionally (which means there may be
+** a call to xFilesize() that is not strictly required). In either case,
+** pager_truncate() may cause the file to become smaller or larger.
+**
+** dbHintSize
+**
+** The dbHintSize variable is used to limit the number of calls made to
+** the VFS xFileControl(FCNTL_SIZE_HINT) method.
+**
+** dbHintSize is set to a copy of the dbSize variable when a
+** write-transaction is opened (at the same time as dbFileSize and
+** dbOrigSize). If the xFileControl(FCNTL_SIZE_HINT) method is called,
+** dbHintSize is increased to the number of pages that correspond to the
+** size-hint passed to the method call. See pager_write_pagelist() for
+** details.
+**
+** errCode
+**
+** The Pager.errCode variable is only ever used in PAGER_ERROR state. It
+** is set to zero in all other states. In PAGER_ERROR state, Pager.errCode
+** is always set to SQLITE_FULL, SQLITE_IOERR or one of the SQLITE_IOERR_XXX
+** sub-codes.
+**
+** syncFlags, walSyncFlags
+**
+** syncFlags is either SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL (0x02) or SQLITE_SYNC_FULL (0x03).
+** syncFlags is used for rollback mode. walSyncFlags is used for WAL mode
+** and contains the flags used to sync the checkpoint operations in the
+** lower two bits, and sync flags used for transaction commits in the WAL
+** file in bits 0x04 and 0x08. In other words, to get the correct sync flags
+** for checkpoint operations, use (walSyncFlags&0x03) and to get the correct
+** sync flags for transaction commit, use ((walSyncFlags>>2)&0x03). Note
+** that with synchronous=NORMAL in WAL mode, transaction commit is not synced
+** meaning that the 0x04 and 0x08 bits are both zero.
+*/
+struct Pager {
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs; /* OS functions to use for IO */
+ u8 exclusiveMode; /* Boolean. True if locking_mode==EXCLUSIVE */
+ u8 journalMode; /* One of the PAGER_JOURNALMODE_* values */
+ u8 useJournal; /* Use a rollback journal on this file */
+ u8 noSync; /* Do not sync the journal if true */
+ u8 fullSync; /* Do extra syncs of the journal for robustness */
+ u8 extraSync; /* sync directory after journal delete */
+ u8 syncFlags; /* SYNC_NORMAL or SYNC_FULL otherwise */
+ u8 walSyncFlags; /* See description above */
+ u8 tempFile; /* zFilename is a temporary or immutable file */
+ u8 noLock; /* Do not lock (except in WAL mode) */
+ u8 readOnly; /* True for a read-only database */
+ u8 memDb; /* True to inhibit all file I/O */
+
+ /**************************************************************************
+ ** The following block contains those class members that change during
+ ** routine operation. Class members not in this block are either fixed
+ ** when the pager is first created or else only change when there is a
+ ** significant mode change (such as changing the page_size, locking_mode,
+ ** or the journal_mode). From another view, these class members describe
+ ** the "state" of the pager, while other class members describe the
+ ** "configuration" of the pager.
+ */
+ u8 eState; /* Pager state (OPEN, READER, WRITER_LOCKED..) */
+ u8 eLock; /* Current lock held on database file */
+ u8 changeCountDone; /* Set after incrementing the change-counter */
+ u8 setSuper; /* Super-jrnl name is written into jrnl */
+ u8 doNotSpill; /* Do not spill the cache when non-zero */
+ u8 subjInMemory; /* True to use in-memory sub-journals */
+ u8 bUseFetch; /* True to use xFetch() */
+ u8 hasHeldSharedLock; /* True if a shared lock has ever been held */
+ Pgno dbSize; /* Number of pages in the database */
+ Pgno dbOrigSize; /* dbSize before the current transaction */
+ Pgno dbFileSize; /* Number of pages in the database file */
+ Pgno dbHintSize; /* Value passed to FCNTL_SIZE_HINT call */
+ int errCode; /* One of several kinds of errors */
+ int nRec; /* Pages journalled since last j-header written */
+ u32 cksumInit; /* Quasi-random value added to every checksum */
+ u32 nSubRec; /* Number of records written to sub-journal */
+ Bitvec *pInJournal; /* One bit for each page in the database file */
+ sqlite3_file *fd; /* File descriptor for database */
+ sqlite3_file *jfd; /* File descriptor for main journal */
+ sqlite3_file *sjfd; /* File descriptor for sub-journal */
+ i64 journalOff; /* Current write offset in the journal file */
+ i64 journalHdr; /* Byte offset to previous journal header */
+ sqlite3_backup *pBackup; /* Pointer to list of ongoing backup processes */
+ PagerSavepoint *aSavepoint; /* Array of active savepoints */
+ int nSavepoint; /* Number of elements in aSavepoint[] */
+ u32 iDataVersion; /* Changes whenever database content changes */
+ char dbFileVers[16]; /* Changes whenever database file changes */
+
+ int nMmapOut; /* Number of mmap pages currently outstanding */
+ sqlite3_int64 szMmap; /* Desired maximum mmap size */
+ PgHdr *pMmapFreelist; /* List of free mmap page headers (pDirty) */
+ /*
+ ** End of the routinely-changing class members
+ ***************************************************************************/
+
+ u16 nExtra; /* Add this many bytes to each in-memory page */
+ i16 nReserve; /* Number of unused bytes at end of each page */
+ u32 vfsFlags; /* Flags for sqlite3_vfs.xOpen() */
+ u32 sectorSize; /* Assumed sector size during rollback */
+ int pageSize; /* Number of bytes in a page */
+ Pgno mxPgno; /* Maximum allowed size of the database */
+ i64 journalSizeLimit; /* Size limit for persistent journal files */
+ char *zFilename; /* Name of the database file */
+ char *zJournal; /* Name of the journal file */
+ int (*xBusyHandler)(void*); /* Function to call when busy */
+ void *pBusyHandlerArg; /* Context argument for xBusyHandler */
+ int aStat[4]; /* Total cache hits, misses, writes, spills */
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ int nRead; /* Database pages read */
+#endif
+ void (*xReiniter)(DbPage*); /* Call this routine when reloading pages */
+ int (*xGet)(Pager*,Pgno,DbPage**,int); /* Routine to fetch a patch */
+ char *pTmpSpace; /* Pager.pageSize bytes of space for tmp use */
+ PCache *pPCache; /* Pointer to page cache object */
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ Wal *pWal; /* Write-ahead log used by "journal_mode=wal" */
+ char *zWal; /* File name for write-ahead log */
+#endif
+};
+
+/*
+** Indexes for use with Pager.aStat[]. The Pager.aStat[] array contains
+** the values accessed by passing SQLITE_DBSTATUS_CACHE_HIT, CACHE_MISS
+** or CACHE_WRITE to sqlite3_db_status().
+*/
+#define PAGER_STAT_HIT 0
+#define PAGER_STAT_MISS 1
+#define PAGER_STAT_WRITE 2
+#define PAGER_STAT_SPILL 3
+
+/*
+** The following global variables hold counters used for
+** testing purposes only. These variables do not exist in
+** a non-testing build. These variables are not thread-safe.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_pager_readdb_count = 0; /* Number of full pages read from DB */
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_pager_writedb_count = 0; /* Number of full pages written to DB */
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_pager_writej_count = 0; /* Number of pages written to journal */
+# define PAGER_INCR(v) v++
+#else
+# define PAGER_INCR(v)
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+** Journal files begin with the following magic string. The data
+** was obtained from /dev/random. It is used only as a sanity check.
+**
+** Since version 2.8.0, the journal format contains additional sanity
+** checking information. If the power fails while the journal is being
+** written, semi-random garbage data might appear in the journal
+** file after power is restored. If an attempt is then made
+** to roll the journal back, the database could be corrupted. The additional
+** sanity checking data is an attempt to discover the garbage in the
+** journal and ignore it.
+**
+** The sanity checking information for the new journal format consists
+** of a 32-bit checksum on each page of data. The checksum covers both
+** the page number and the pPager->pageSize bytes of data for the page.
+** This cksum is initialized to a 32-bit random value that appears in the
+** journal file right after the header. The random initializer is important,
+** because garbage data that appears at the end of a journal is likely
+** data that was once in other files that have now been deleted. If the
+** garbage data came from an obsolete journal file, the checksums might
+** be correct. But by initializing the checksum to random value which
+** is different for every journal, we minimize that risk.
+*/
+static const unsigned char aJournalMagic[] = {
+ 0xd9, 0xd5, 0x05, 0xf9, 0x20, 0xa1, 0x63, 0xd7,
+};
+
+/*
+** The size of the of each page record in the journal is given by
+** the following macro.
+*/
+#define JOURNAL_PG_SZ(pPager) ((pPager->pageSize) + 8)
+
+/*
+** The journal header size for this pager. This is usually the same
+** size as a single disk sector. See also setSectorSize().
+*/
+#define JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager) (pPager->sectorSize)
+
+/*
+** The macro MEMDB is true if we are dealing with an in-memory database.
+** We do this as a macro so that if the SQLITE_OMIT_MEMORYDB macro is set,
+** the value of MEMDB will be a constant and the compiler will optimize
+** out code that would never execute.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_MEMORYDB
+# define MEMDB 0
+#else
+# define MEMDB pPager->memDb
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The macro USEFETCH is true if we are allowed to use the xFetch and xUnfetch
+** interfaces to access the database using memory-mapped I/O.
+*/
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+# define USEFETCH(x) ((x)->bUseFetch)
+#else
+# define USEFETCH(x) 0
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The argument to this macro is a file descriptor (type sqlite3_file*).
+** Return 0 if it is not open, or non-zero (but not 1) if it is.
+**
+** This is so that expressions can be written as:
+**
+** if( isOpen(pPager->jfd) ){ ...
+**
+** instead of
+**
+** if( pPager->jfd->pMethods ){ ...
+*/
+#define isOpen(pFd) ((pFd)->pMethods!=0)
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DIRECT_OVERFLOW_READ
+/*
+** Return true if page pgno can be read directly from the database file
+** by the b-tree layer. This is the case if:
+**
+** * the database file is open,
+** * there are no dirty pages in the cache, and
+** * the desired page is not currently in the wal file.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerDirectReadOk(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno){
+ if( pPager->fd->pMethods==0 ) return 0;
+ if( sqlite3PCacheIsDirty(pPager->pPCache) ) return 0;
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ if( pPager->pWal ){
+ u32 iRead = 0;
+ int rc;
+ rc = sqlite3WalFindFrame(pPager->pWal, pgno, &iRead);
+ return (rc==SQLITE_OK && iRead==0);
+ }
+#endif
+ return 1;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+# define pagerUseWal(x) ((x)->pWal!=0)
+#else
+# define pagerUseWal(x) 0
+# define pagerRollbackWal(x) 0
+# define pagerWalFrames(v,w,x,y) 0
+# define pagerOpenWalIfPresent(z) SQLITE_OK
+# define pagerBeginReadTransaction(z) SQLITE_OK
+#endif
+
+#ifndef NDEBUG
+/*
+** Usage:
+**
+** assert( assert_pager_state(pPager) );
+**
+** This function runs many asserts to try to find inconsistencies in
+** the internal state of the Pager object.
+*/
+static int assert_pager_state(Pager *p){
+ Pager *pPager = p;
+
+ /* State must be valid. */
+ assert( p->eState==PAGER_OPEN
+ || p->eState==PAGER_READER
+ || p->eState==PAGER_WRITER_LOCKED
+ || p->eState==PAGER_WRITER_CACHEMOD
+ || p->eState==PAGER_WRITER_DBMOD
+ || p->eState==PAGER_WRITER_FINISHED
+ || p->eState==PAGER_ERROR
+ );
+
+ /* Regardless of the current state, a temp-file connection always behaves
+ ** as if it has an exclusive lock on the database file. It never updates
+ ** the change-counter field, so the changeCountDone flag is always set.
+ */
+ assert( p->tempFile==0 || p->eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK );
+ assert( p->tempFile==0 || pPager->changeCountDone );
+
+ /* If the useJournal flag is clear, the journal-mode must be "OFF".
+ ** And if the journal-mode is "OFF", the journal file must not be open.
+ */
+ assert( p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_OFF || p->useJournal );
+ assert( p->journalMode!=PAGER_JOURNALMODE_OFF || !isOpen(p->jfd) );
+
+ /* Check that MEMDB implies noSync. And an in-memory journal. Since
+ ** this means an in-memory pager performs no IO at all, it cannot encounter
+ ** either SQLITE_IOERR or SQLITE_FULL during rollback or while finalizing
+ ** a journal file. (although the in-memory journal implementation may
+ ** return SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM while the journal file is being written). It
+ ** is therefore not possible for an in-memory pager to enter the ERROR
+ ** state.
+ */
+ if( MEMDB ){
+ assert( !isOpen(p->fd) );
+ assert( p->noSync );
+ assert( p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_OFF
+ || p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_MEMORY
+ );
+ assert( p->eState!=PAGER_ERROR && p->eState!=PAGER_OPEN );
+ assert( pagerUseWal(p)==0 );
+ }
+
+ /* If changeCountDone is set, a RESERVED lock or greater must be held
+ ** on the file.
+ */
+ assert( pPager->changeCountDone==0 || pPager->eLock>=RESERVED_LOCK );
+ assert( p->eLock!=PENDING_LOCK );
+
+ switch( p->eState ){
+ case PAGER_OPEN:
+ assert( !MEMDB );
+ assert( pPager->errCode==SQLITE_OK );
+ assert( sqlite3PcacheRefCount(pPager->pPCache)==0 || pPager->tempFile );
+ break;
+
+ case PAGER_READER:
+ assert( pPager->errCode==SQLITE_OK );
+ assert( p->eLock!=UNKNOWN_LOCK );
+ assert( p->eLock>=SHARED_LOCK );
+ break;
+
+ case PAGER_WRITER_LOCKED:
+ assert( p->eLock!=UNKNOWN_LOCK );
+ assert( pPager->errCode==SQLITE_OK );
+ if( !pagerUseWal(pPager) ){
+ assert( p->eLock>=RESERVED_LOCK );
+ }
+ assert( pPager->dbSize==pPager->dbOrigSize );
+ assert( pPager->dbOrigSize==pPager->dbFileSize );
+ assert( pPager->dbOrigSize==pPager->dbHintSize );
+ assert( pPager->setSuper==0 );
+ break;
+
+ case PAGER_WRITER_CACHEMOD:
+ assert( p->eLock!=UNKNOWN_LOCK );
+ assert( pPager->errCode==SQLITE_OK );
+ if( !pagerUseWal(pPager) ){
+ /* It is possible that if journal_mode=wal here that neither the
+ ** journal file nor the WAL file are open. This happens during
+ ** a rollback transaction that switches from journal_mode=off
+ ** to journal_mode=wal.
+ */
+ assert( p->eLock>=RESERVED_LOCK );
+ assert( isOpen(p->jfd)
+ || p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_OFF
+ || p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_WAL
+ );
+ }
+ assert( pPager->dbOrigSize==pPager->dbFileSize );
+ assert( pPager->dbOrigSize==pPager->dbHintSize );
+ break;
+
+ case PAGER_WRITER_DBMOD:
+ assert( p->eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK );
+ assert( pPager->errCode==SQLITE_OK );
+ assert( !pagerUseWal(pPager) );
+ assert( p->eLock>=EXCLUSIVE_LOCK );
+ assert( isOpen(p->jfd)
+ || p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_OFF
+ || p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_WAL
+ || (sqlite3OsDeviceCharacteristics(p->fd)&SQLITE_IOCAP_BATCH_ATOMIC)
+ );
+ assert( pPager->dbOrigSize<=pPager->dbHintSize );
+ break;
+
+ case PAGER_WRITER_FINISHED:
+ assert( p->eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK );
+ assert( pPager->errCode==SQLITE_OK );
+ assert( !pagerUseWal(pPager) );
+ assert( isOpen(p->jfd)
+ || p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_OFF
+ || p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_WAL
+ || (sqlite3OsDeviceCharacteristics(p->fd)&SQLITE_IOCAP_BATCH_ATOMIC)
+ );
+ break;
+
+ case PAGER_ERROR:
+ /* There must be at least one outstanding reference to the pager if
+ ** in ERROR state. Otherwise the pager should have already dropped
+ ** back to OPEN state.
+ */
+ assert( pPager->errCode!=SQLITE_OK );
+ assert( sqlite3PcacheRefCount(pPager->pPCache)>0 || pPager->tempFile );
+ break;
+ }
+
+ return 1;
+}
+#endif /* ifndef NDEBUG */
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+/*
+** Return a pointer to a human readable string in a static buffer
+** containing the state of the Pager object passed as an argument. This
+** is intended to be used within debuggers. For example, as an alternative
+** to "print *pPager" in gdb:
+**
+** (gdb) printf "%s", print_pager_state(pPager)
+**
+** This routine has external linkage in order to suppress compiler warnings
+** about an unused function. It is enclosed within SQLITE_DEBUG and so does
+** not appear in normal builds.
+*/
+char *print_pager_state(Pager *p){
+ static char zRet[1024];
+
+ sqlite3_snprintf(1024, zRet,
+ "Filename: %s\n"
+ "State: %s errCode=%d\n"
+ "Lock: %s\n"
+ "Locking mode: locking_mode=%s\n"
+ "Journal mode: journal_mode=%s\n"
+ "Backing store: tempFile=%d memDb=%d useJournal=%d\n"
+ "Journal: journalOff=%lld journalHdr=%lld\n"
+ "Size: dbsize=%d dbOrigSize=%d dbFileSize=%d\n"
+ , p->zFilename
+ , p->eState==PAGER_OPEN ? "OPEN" :
+ p->eState==PAGER_READER ? "READER" :
+ p->eState==PAGER_WRITER_LOCKED ? "WRITER_LOCKED" :
+ p->eState==PAGER_WRITER_CACHEMOD ? "WRITER_CACHEMOD" :
+ p->eState==PAGER_WRITER_DBMOD ? "WRITER_DBMOD" :
+ p->eState==PAGER_WRITER_FINISHED ? "WRITER_FINISHED" :
+ p->eState==PAGER_ERROR ? "ERROR" : "?error?"
+ , (int)p->errCode
+ , p->eLock==NO_LOCK ? "NO_LOCK" :
+ p->eLock==RESERVED_LOCK ? "RESERVED" :
+ p->eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK ? "EXCLUSIVE" :
+ p->eLock==SHARED_LOCK ? "SHARED" :
+ p->eLock==UNKNOWN_LOCK ? "UNKNOWN" : "?error?"
+ , p->exclusiveMode ? "exclusive" : "normal"
+ , p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_MEMORY ? "memory" :
+ p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_OFF ? "off" :
+ p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_DELETE ? "delete" :
+ p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_PERSIST ? "persist" :
+ p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_TRUNCATE ? "truncate" :
+ p->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_WAL ? "wal" : "?error?"
+ , (int)p->tempFile, (int)p->memDb, (int)p->useJournal
+ , p->journalOff, p->journalHdr
+ , (int)p->dbSize, (int)p->dbOrigSize, (int)p->dbFileSize
+ );
+
+ return zRet;
+}
+#endif
+
+/* Forward references to the various page getters */
+static int getPageNormal(Pager*,Pgno,DbPage**,int);
+static int getPageError(Pager*,Pgno,DbPage**,int);
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+static int getPageMMap(Pager*,Pgno,DbPage**,int);
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Set the Pager.xGet method for the appropriate routine used to fetch
+** content from the pager.
+*/
+static void setGetterMethod(Pager *pPager){
+ if( pPager->errCode ){
+ pPager->xGet = getPageError;
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ }else if( USEFETCH(pPager) ){
+ pPager->xGet = getPageMMap;
+#endif /* SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0 */
+ }else{
+ pPager->xGet = getPageNormal;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Return true if it is necessary to write page *pPg into the sub-journal.
+** A page needs to be written into the sub-journal if there exists one
+** or more open savepoints for which:
+**
+** * The page-number is less than or equal to PagerSavepoint.nOrig, and
+** * The bit corresponding to the page-number is not set in
+** PagerSavepoint.pInSavepoint.
+*/
+static int subjRequiresPage(PgHdr *pPg){
+ Pager *pPager = pPg->pPager;
+ PagerSavepoint *p;
+ Pgno pgno = pPg->pgno;
+ int i;
+ for(i=0; inSavepoint; i++){
+ p = &pPager->aSavepoint[i];
+ if( p->nOrig>=pgno && 0==sqlite3BitvecTestNotNull(p->pInSavepoint, pgno) ){
+ return 1;
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+/*
+** Return true if the page is already in the journal file.
+*/
+static int pageInJournal(Pager *pPager, PgHdr *pPg){
+ return sqlite3BitvecTest(pPager->pInJournal, pPg->pgno);
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Read a 32-bit integer from the given file descriptor. Store the integer
+** that is read in *pRes. Return SQLITE_OK if everything worked, or an
+** error code is something goes wrong.
+**
+** All values are stored on disk as big-endian.
+*/
+static int read32bits(sqlite3_file *fd, i64 offset, u32 *pRes){
+ unsigned char ac[4];
+ int rc = sqlite3OsRead(fd, ac, sizeof(ac), offset);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ *pRes = sqlite3Get4byte(ac);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Write a 32-bit integer into a string buffer in big-endian byte order.
+*/
+#define put32bits(A,B) sqlite3Put4byte((u8*)A,B)
+
+
+/*
+** Write a 32-bit integer into the given file descriptor. Return SQLITE_OK
+** on success or an error code is something goes wrong.
+*/
+static int write32bits(sqlite3_file *fd, i64 offset, u32 val){
+ char ac[4];
+ put32bits(ac, val);
+ return sqlite3OsWrite(fd, ac, 4, offset);
+}
+
+/*
+** Unlock the database file to level eLock, which must be either NO_LOCK
+** or SHARED_LOCK. Regardless of whether or not the call to xUnlock()
+** succeeds, set the Pager.eLock variable to match the (attempted) new lock.
+**
+** Except, if Pager.eLock is set to UNKNOWN_LOCK when this function is
+** called, do not modify it. See the comment above the #define of
+** UNKNOWN_LOCK for an explanation of this.
+*/
+static int pagerUnlockDb(Pager *pPager, int eLock){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ assert( !pPager->exclusiveMode || pPager->eLock==eLock );
+ assert( eLock==NO_LOCK || eLock==SHARED_LOCK );
+ assert( eLock!=NO_LOCK || pagerUseWal(pPager)==0 );
+ if( isOpen(pPager->fd) ){
+ assert( pPager->eLock>=eLock );
+ rc = pPager->noLock ? SQLITE_OK : sqlite3OsUnlock(pPager->fd, eLock);
+ if( pPager->eLock!=UNKNOWN_LOCK ){
+ pPager->eLock = (u8)eLock;
+ }
+ IOTRACE(("UNLOCK %p %d\n", pPager, eLock))
+ }
+ pPager->changeCountDone = pPager->tempFile; /* ticket fb3b3024ea238d5c */
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Lock the database file to level eLock, which must be either SHARED_LOCK,
+** RESERVED_LOCK or EXCLUSIVE_LOCK. If the caller is successful, set the
+** Pager.eLock variable to the new locking state.
+**
+** Except, if Pager.eLock is set to UNKNOWN_LOCK when this function is
+** called, do not modify it unless the new locking state is EXCLUSIVE_LOCK.
+** See the comment above the #define of UNKNOWN_LOCK for an explanation
+** of this.
+*/
+static int pagerLockDb(Pager *pPager, int eLock){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ assert( eLock==SHARED_LOCK || eLock==RESERVED_LOCK || eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK );
+ if( pPager->eLockeLock==UNKNOWN_LOCK ){
+ rc = pPager->noLock ? SQLITE_OK : sqlite3OsLock(pPager->fd, eLock);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && (pPager->eLock!=UNKNOWN_LOCK||eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK) ){
+ pPager->eLock = (u8)eLock;
+ IOTRACE(("LOCK %p %d\n", pPager, eLock))
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function determines whether or not the atomic-write or
+** atomic-batch-write optimizations can be used with this pager. The
+** atomic-write optimization can be used if:
+**
+** (a) the value returned by OsDeviceCharacteristics() indicates that
+** a database page may be written atomically, and
+** (b) the value returned by OsSectorSize() is less than or equal
+** to the page size.
+**
+** If it can be used, then the value returned is the size of the journal
+** file when it contains rollback data for exactly one page.
+**
+** The atomic-batch-write optimization can be used if OsDeviceCharacteristics()
+** returns a value with the SQLITE_IOCAP_BATCH_ATOMIC bit set. -1 is
+** returned in this case.
+**
+** If neither optimization can be used, 0 is returned.
+*/
+static int jrnlBufferSize(Pager *pPager){
+ assert( !MEMDB );
+
+#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_ATOMIC_WRITE) \
+ || defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE)
+ int dc; /* Device characteristics */
+
+ assert( isOpen(pPager->fd) );
+ dc = sqlite3OsDeviceCharacteristics(pPager->fd);
+#else
+ UNUSED_PARAMETER(pPager);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_BATCH_ATOMIC_WRITE
+ if( pPager->dbSize>0 && (dc&SQLITE_IOCAP_BATCH_ATOMIC) ){
+ return -1;
+ }
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_ENABLE_ATOMIC_WRITE
+ {
+ int nSector = pPager->sectorSize;
+ int szPage = pPager->pageSize;
+
+ assert(SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC512==(512>>8));
+ assert(SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC64K==(65536>>8));
+ if( 0==(dc&(SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC|(szPage>>8)) || nSector>szPage) ){
+ return 0;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager) + JOURNAL_PG_SZ(pPager);
+#endif
+
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** If SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES is defined then we do some sanity checking
+** on the cache using a hash function. This is used for testing
+** and debugging only.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES
+/*
+** Return a 32-bit hash of the page data for pPage.
+*/
+static u32 pager_datahash(int nByte, unsigned char *pData){
+ u32 hash = 0;
+ int i;
+ for(i=0; ipPager->pageSize, (unsigned char *)pPage->pData);
+}
+static void pager_set_pagehash(PgHdr *pPage){
+ pPage->pageHash = pager_pagehash(pPage);
+}
+
+/*
+** The CHECK_PAGE macro takes a PgHdr* as an argument. If SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES
+** is defined, and NDEBUG is not defined, an assert() statement checks
+** that the page is either dirty or still matches the calculated page-hash.
+*/
+#define CHECK_PAGE(x) checkPage(x)
+static void checkPage(PgHdr *pPg){
+ Pager *pPager = pPg->pPager;
+ assert( pPager->eState!=PAGER_ERROR );
+ assert( (pPg->flags&PGHDR_DIRTY) || pPg->pageHash==pager_pagehash(pPg) );
+}
+
+#else
+#define pager_datahash(X,Y) 0
+#define pager_pagehash(X) 0
+#define pager_set_pagehash(X)
+#define CHECK_PAGE(x)
+#endif /* SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES */
+
+/*
+** When this is called the journal file for pager pPager must be open.
+** This function attempts to read a super-journal file name from the
+** end of the file and, if successful, copies it into memory supplied
+** by the caller. See comments above writeSuperJournal() for the format
+** used to store a super-journal file name at the end of a journal file.
+**
+** zSuper must point to a buffer of at least nSuper bytes allocated by
+** the caller. This should be sqlite3_vfs.mxPathname+1 (to ensure there is
+** enough space to write the super-journal name). If the super-journal
+** name in the journal is longer than nSuper bytes (including a
+** nul-terminator), then this is handled as if no super-journal name
+** were present in the journal.
+**
+** If a super-journal file name is present at the end of the journal
+** file, then it is copied into the buffer pointed to by zSuper. A
+** nul-terminator byte is appended to the buffer following the
+** super-journal file name.
+**
+** If it is determined that no super-journal file name is present
+** zSuper[0] is set to 0 and SQLITE_OK returned.
+**
+** If an error occurs while reading from the journal file, an SQLite
+** error code is returned.
+*/
+static int readSuperJournal(sqlite3_file *pJrnl, char *zSuper, u32 nSuper){
+ int rc; /* Return code */
+ u32 len; /* Length in bytes of super-journal name */
+ i64 szJ; /* Total size in bytes of journal file pJrnl */
+ u32 cksum; /* MJ checksum value read from journal */
+ u32 u; /* Unsigned loop counter */
+ unsigned char aMagic[8]; /* A buffer to hold the magic header */
+ zSuper[0] = '\0';
+
+ if( SQLITE_OK!=(rc = sqlite3OsFileSize(pJrnl, &szJ))
+ || szJ<16
+ || SQLITE_OK!=(rc = read32bits(pJrnl, szJ-16, &len))
+ || len>=nSuper
+ || len>szJ-16
+ || len==0
+ || SQLITE_OK!=(rc = read32bits(pJrnl, szJ-12, &cksum))
+ || SQLITE_OK!=(rc = sqlite3OsRead(pJrnl, aMagic, 8, szJ-8))
+ || memcmp(aMagic, aJournalMagic, 8)
+ || SQLITE_OK!=(rc = sqlite3OsRead(pJrnl, zSuper, len, szJ-16-len))
+ ){
+ return rc;
+ }
+
+ /* See if the checksum matches the super-journal name */
+ for(u=0; ujournalOff, assuming a sector
+** size of pPager->sectorSize bytes.
+**
+** i.e for a sector size of 512:
+**
+** Pager.journalOff Return value
+** ---------------------------------------
+** 0 0
+** 512 512
+** 100 512
+** 2000 2048
+**
+*/
+static i64 journalHdrOffset(Pager *pPager){
+ i64 offset = 0;
+ i64 c = pPager->journalOff;
+ if( c ){
+ offset = ((c-1)/JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager) + 1) * JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager);
+ }
+ assert( offset%JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager)==0 );
+ assert( offset>=c );
+ assert( (offset-c)jfd) );
+ assert( !sqlite3JournalIsInMemory(pPager->jfd) );
+ if( pPager->journalOff ){
+ const i64 iLimit = pPager->journalSizeLimit; /* Local cache of jsl */
+
+ IOTRACE(("JZEROHDR %p\n", pPager))
+ if( doTruncate || iLimit==0 ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsTruncate(pPager->jfd, 0);
+ }else{
+ static const char zeroHdr[28] = {0};
+ rc = sqlite3OsWrite(pPager->jfd, zeroHdr, sizeof(zeroHdr), 0);
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && !pPager->noSync ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsSync(pPager->jfd, SQLITE_SYNC_DATAONLY|pPager->syncFlags);
+ }
+
+ /* At this point the transaction is committed but the write lock
+ ** is still held on the file. If there is a size limit configured for
+ ** the persistent journal and the journal file currently consumes more
+ ** space than that limit allows for, truncate it now. There is no need
+ ** to sync the file following this operation.
+ */
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && iLimit>0 ){
+ i64 sz;
+ rc = sqlite3OsFileSize(pPager->jfd, &sz);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && sz>iLimit ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsTruncate(pPager->jfd, iLimit);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** The journal file must be open when this routine is called. A journal
+** header (JOURNAL_HDR_SZ bytes) is written into the journal file at the
+** current location.
+**
+** The format for the journal header is as follows:
+** - 8 bytes: Magic identifying journal format.
+** - 4 bytes: Number of records in journal, or -1 no-sync mode is on.
+** - 4 bytes: Random number used for page hash.
+** - 4 bytes: Initial database page count.
+** - 4 bytes: Sector size used by the process that wrote this journal.
+** - 4 bytes: Database page size.
+**
+** Followed by (JOURNAL_HDR_SZ - 28) bytes of unused space.
+*/
+static int writeJournalHdr(Pager *pPager){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Return code */
+ char *zHeader = pPager->pTmpSpace; /* Temporary space used to build header */
+ u32 nHeader = (u32)pPager->pageSize;/* Size of buffer pointed to by zHeader */
+ u32 nWrite; /* Bytes of header sector written */
+ int ii; /* Loop counter */
+
+ assert( isOpen(pPager->jfd) ); /* Journal file must be open. */
+
+ if( nHeader>JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager) ){
+ nHeader = JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager);
+ }
+
+ /* If there are active savepoints and any of them were created
+ ** since the most recent journal header was written, update the
+ ** PagerSavepoint.iHdrOffset fields now.
+ */
+ for(ii=0; iinSavepoint; ii++){
+ if( pPager->aSavepoint[ii].iHdrOffset==0 ){
+ pPager->aSavepoint[ii].iHdrOffset = pPager->journalOff;
+ }
+ }
+
+ pPager->journalHdr = pPager->journalOff = journalHdrOffset(pPager);
+
+ /*
+ ** Write the nRec Field - the number of page records that follow this
+ ** journal header. Normally, zero is written to this value at this time.
+ ** After the records are added to the journal (and the journal synced,
+ ** if in full-sync mode), the zero is overwritten with the true number
+ ** of records (see syncJournal()).
+ **
+ ** A faster alternative is to write 0xFFFFFFFF to the nRec field. When
+ ** reading the journal this value tells SQLite to assume that the
+ ** rest of the journal file contains valid page records. This assumption
+ ** is dangerous, as if a failure occurred whilst writing to the journal
+ ** file it may contain some garbage data. There are two scenarios
+ ** where this risk can be ignored:
+ **
+ ** * When the pager is in no-sync mode. Corruption can follow a
+ ** power failure in this case anyway.
+ **
+ ** * When the SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND flag is set. This guarantees
+ ** that garbage data is never appended to the journal file.
+ */
+ assert( isOpen(pPager->fd) || pPager->noSync );
+ if( pPager->noSync || (pPager->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_MEMORY)
+ || (sqlite3OsDeviceCharacteristics(pPager->fd)&SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND)
+ ){
+ memcpy(zHeader, aJournalMagic, sizeof(aJournalMagic));
+ put32bits(&zHeader[sizeof(aJournalMagic)], 0xffffffff);
+ }else{
+ memset(zHeader, 0, sizeof(aJournalMagic)+4);
+ }
+
+ /* The random check-hash initializer */
+ sqlite3_randomness(sizeof(pPager->cksumInit), &pPager->cksumInit);
+ put32bits(&zHeader[sizeof(aJournalMagic)+4], pPager->cksumInit);
+ /* The initial database size */
+ put32bits(&zHeader[sizeof(aJournalMagic)+8], pPager->dbOrigSize);
+ /* The assumed sector size for this process */
+ put32bits(&zHeader[sizeof(aJournalMagic)+12], pPager->sectorSize);
+
+ /* The page size */
+ put32bits(&zHeader[sizeof(aJournalMagic)+16], pPager->pageSize);
+
+ /* Initializing the tail of the buffer is not necessary. Everything
+ ** works find if the following memset() is omitted. But initializing
+ ** the memory prevents valgrind from complaining, so we are willing to
+ ** take the performance hit.
+ */
+ memset(&zHeader[sizeof(aJournalMagic)+20], 0,
+ nHeader-(sizeof(aJournalMagic)+20));
+
+ /* In theory, it is only necessary to write the 28 bytes that the
+ ** journal header consumes to the journal file here. Then increment the
+ ** Pager.journalOff variable by JOURNAL_HDR_SZ so that the next
+ ** record is written to the following sector (leaving a gap in the file
+ ** that will be implicitly filled in by the OS).
+ **
+ ** However it has been discovered that on some systems this pattern can
+ ** be significantly slower than contiguously writing data to the file,
+ ** even if that means explicitly writing data to the block of
+ ** (JOURNAL_HDR_SZ - 28) bytes that will not be used. So that is what
+ ** is done.
+ **
+ ** The loop is required here in case the sector-size is larger than the
+ ** database page size. Since the zHeader buffer is only Pager.pageSize
+ ** bytes in size, more than one call to sqlite3OsWrite() may be required
+ ** to populate the entire journal header sector.
+ */
+ for(nWrite=0; rc==SQLITE_OK&&nWritejournalHdr, nHeader))
+ rc = sqlite3OsWrite(pPager->jfd, zHeader, nHeader, pPager->journalOff);
+ assert( pPager->journalHdr <= pPager->journalOff );
+ pPager->journalOff += nHeader;
+ }
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** The journal file must be open when this is called. A journal header file
+** (JOURNAL_HDR_SZ bytes) is read from the current location in the journal
+** file. The current location in the journal file is given by
+** pPager->journalOff. See comments above function writeJournalHdr() for
+** a description of the journal header format.
+**
+** If the header is read successfully, *pNRec is set to the number of
+** page records following this header and *pDbSize is set to the size of the
+** database before the transaction began, in pages. Also, pPager->cksumInit
+** is set to the value read from the journal header. SQLITE_OK is returned
+** in this case.
+**
+** If the journal header file appears to be corrupted, SQLITE_DONE is
+** returned and *pNRec and *PDbSize are undefined. If JOURNAL_HDR_SZ bytes
+** cannot be read from the journal file an error code is returned.
+*/
+static int readJournalHdr(
+ Pager *pPager, /* Pager object */
+ int isHot,
+ i64 journalSize, /* Size of the open journal file in bytes */
+ u32 *pNRec, /* OUT: Value read from the nRec field */
+ u32 *pDbSize /* OUT: Value of original database size field */
+){
+ int rc; /* Return code */
+ unsigned char aMagic[8]; /* A buffer to hold the magic header */
+ i64 iHdrOff; /* Offset of journal header being read */
+
+ assert( isOpen(pPager->jfd) ); /* Journal file must be open. */
+
+ /* Advance Pager.journalOff to the start of the next sector. If the
+ ** journal file is too small for there to be a header stored at this
+ ** point, return SQLITE_DONE.
+ */
+ pPager->journalOff = journalHdrOffset(pPager);
+ if( pPager->journalOff+JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager) > journalSize ){
+ return SQLITE_DONE;
+ }
+ iHdrOff = pPager->journalOff;
+
+ /* Read in the first 8 bytes of the journal header. If they do not match
+ ** the magic string found at the start of each journal header, return
+ ** SQLITE_DONE. If an IO error occurs, return an error code. Otherwise,
+ ** proceed.
+ */
+ if( isHot || iHdrOff!=pPager->journalHdr ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsRead(pPager->jfd, aMagic, sizeof(aMagic), iHdrOff);
+ if( rc ){
+ return rc;
+ }
+ if( memcmp(aMagic, aJournalMagic, sizeof(aMagic))!=0 ){
+ return SQLITE_DONE;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Read the first three 32-bit fields of the journal header: The nRec
+ ** field, the checksum-initializer and the database size at the start
+ ** of the transaction. Return an error code if anything goes wrong.
+ */
+ if( SQLITE_OK!=(rc = read32bits(pPager->jfd, iHdrOff+8, pNRec))
+ || SQLITE_OK!=(rc = read32bits(pPager->jfd, iHdrOff+12, &pPager->cksumInit))
+ || SQLITE_OK!=(rc = read32bits(pPager->jfd, iHdrOff+16, pDbSize))
+ ){
+ return rc;
+ }
+
+ if( pPager->journalOff==0 ){
+ u32 iPageSize; /* Page-size field of journal header */
+ u32 iSectorSize; /* Sector-size field of journal header */
+
+ /* Read the page-size and sector-size journal header fields. */
+ if( SQLITE_OK!=(rc = read32bits(pPager->jfd, iHdrOff+20, &iSectorSize))
+ || SQLITE_OK!=(rc = read32bits(pPager->jfd, iHdrOff+24, &iPageSize))
+ ){
+ return rc;
+ }
+
+ /* Versions of SQLite prior to 3.5.8 set the page-size field of the
+ ** journal header to zero. In this case, assume that the Pager.pageSize
+ ** variable is already set to the correct page size.
+ */
+ if( iPageSize==0 ){
+ iPageSize = pPager->pageSize;
+ }
+
+ /* Check that the values read from the page-size and sector-size fields
+ ** are within range. To be 'in range', both values need to be a power
+ ** of two greater than or equal to 512 or 32, and not greater than their
+ ** respective compile time maximum limits.
+ */
+ if( iPageSize<512 || iSectorSize<32
+ || iPageSize>SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE || iSectorSize>MAX_SECTOR_SIZE
+ || ((iPageSize-1)&iPageSize)!=0 || ((iSectorSize-1)&iSectorSize)!=0
+ ){
+ /* If the either the page-size or sector-size in the journal-header is
+ ** invalid, then the process that wrote the journal-header must have
+ ** crashed before the header was synced. In this case stop reading
+ ** the journal file here.
+ */
+ return SQLITE_DONE;
+ }
+
+ /* Update the page-size to match the value read from the journal.
+ ** Use a testcase() macro to make sure that malloc failure within
+ ** PagerSetPagesize() is tested.
+ */
+ rc = sqlite3PagerSetPagesize(pPager, &iPageSize, -1);
+ testcase( rc!=SQLITE_OK );
+
+ /* Update the assumed sector-size to match the value used by
+ ** the process that created this journal. If this journal was
+ ** created by a process other than this one, then this routine
+ ** is being called from within pager_playback(). The local value
+ ** of Pager.sectorSize is restored at the end of that routine.
+ */
+ pPager->sectorSize = iSectorSize;
+ }
+
+ pPager->journalOff += JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Write the supplied super-journal name into the journal file for pager
+** pPager at the current location. The super-journal name must be the last
+** thing written to a journal file. If the pager is in full-sync mode, the
+** journal file descriptor is advanced to the next sector boundary before
+** anything is written. The format is:
+**
+** + 4 bytes: PAGER_MJ_PGNO.
+** + N bytes: super-journal filename in utf-8.
+** + 4 bytes: N (length of super-journal name in bytes, no nul-terminator).
+** + 4 bytes: super-journal name checksum.
+** + 8 bytes: aJournalMagic[].
+**
+** The super-journal page checksum is the sum of the bytes in thesuper-journal
+** name, where each byte is interpreted as a signed 8-bit integer.
+**
+** If zSuper is a NULL pointer (occurs for a single database transaction),
+** this call is a no-op.
+*/
+static int writeSuperJournal(Pager *pPager, const char *zSuper){
+ int rc; /* Return code */
+ int nSuper; /* Length of string zSuper */
+ i64 iHdrOff; /* Offset of header in journal file */
+ i64 jrnlSize; /* Size of journal file on disk */
+ u32 cksum = 0; /* Checksum of string zSuper */
+
+ assert( pPager->setSuper==0 );
+ assert( !pagerUseWal(pPager) );
+
+ if( !zSuper
+ || pPager->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_MEMORY
+ || !isOpen(pPager->jfd)
+ ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ pPager->setSuper = 1;
+ assert( pPager->journalHdr <= pPager->journalOff );
+
+ /* Calculate the length in bytes and the checksum of zSuper */
+ for(nSuper=0; zSuper[nSuper]; nSuper++){
+ cksum += zSuper[nSuper];
+ }
+
+ /* If in full-sync mode, advance to the next disk sector before writing
+ ** the super-journal name. This is in case the previous page written to
+ ** the journal has already been synced.
+ */
+ if( pPager->fullSync ){
+ pPager->journalOff = journalHdrOffset(pPager);
+ }
+ iHdrOff = pPager->journalOff;
+
+ /* Write the super-journal data to the end of the journal file. If
+ ** an error occurs, return the error code to the caller.
+ */
+ if( (0 != (rc = write32bits(pPager->jfd, iHdrOff, PAGER_MJ_PGNO(pPager))))
+ || (0 != (rc = sqlite3OsWrite(pPager->jfd, zSuper, nSuper, iHdrOff+4)))
+ || (0 != (rc = write32bits(pPager->jfd, iHdrOff+4+nSuper, nSuper)))
+ || (0 != (rc = write32bits(pPager->jfd, iHdrOff+4+nSuper+4, cksum)))
+ || (0 != (rc = sqlite3OsWrite(pPager->jfd, aJournalMagic, 8,
+ iHdrOff+4+nSuper+8)))
+ ){
+ return rc;
+ }
+ pPager->journalOff += (nSuper+20);
+
+ /* If the pager is in peristent-journal mode, then the physical
+ ** journal-file may extend past the end of the super-journal name
+ ** and 8 bytes of magic data just written to the file. This is
+ ** dangerous because the code to rollback a hot-journal file
+ ** will not be able to find the super-journal name to determine
+ ** whether or not the journal is hot.
+ **
+ ** Easiest thing to do in this scenario is to truncate the journal
+ ** file to the required size.
+ */
+ if( SQLITE_OK==(rc = sqlite3OsFileSize(pPager->jfd, &jrnlSize))
+ && jrnlSize>pPager->journalOff
+ ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsTruncate(pPager->jfd, pPager->journalOff);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Discard the entire contents of the in-memory page-cache.
+*/
+static void pager_reset(Pager *pPager){
+ pPager->iDataVersion++;
+ sqlite3BackupRestart(pPager->pBackup);
+ sqlite3PcacheClear(pPager->pPCache);
+}
+
+/*
+** Return the pPager->iDataVersion value
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE u32 sqlite3PagerDataVersion(Pager *pPager){
+ return pPager->iDataVersion;
+}
+
+/*
+** Free all structures in the Pager.aSavepoint[] array and set both
+** Pager.aSavepoint and Pager.nSavepoint to zero. Close the sub-journal
+** if it is open and the pager is not in exclusive mode.
+*/
+static void releaseAllSavepoints(Pager *pPager){
+ int ii; /* Iterator for looping through Pager.aSavepoint */
+ for(ii=0; iinSavepoint; ii++){
+ sqlite3BitvecDestroy(pPager->aSavepoint[ii].pInSavepoint);
+ }
+ if( !pPager->exclusiveMode || sqlite3JournalIsInMemory(pPager->sjfd) ){
+ sqlite3OsClose(pPager->sjfd);
+ }
+ sqlite3_free(pPager->aSavepoint);
+ pPager->aSavepoint = 0;
+ pPager->nSavepoint = 0;
+ pPager->nSubRec = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the bit number pgno in the PagerSavepoint.pInSavepoint
+** bitvecs of all open savepoints. Return SQLITE_OK if successful
+** or SQLITE_NOMEM if a malloc failure occurs.
+*/
+static int addToSavepointBitvecs(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno){
+ int ii; /* Loop counter */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Result code */
+
+ for(ii=0; iinSavepoint; ii++){
+ PagerSavepoint *p = &pPager->aSavepoint[ii];
+ if( pgno<=p->nOrig ){
+ rc |= sqlite3BitvecSet(p->pInSavepoint, pgno);
+ testcase( rc==SQLITE_NOMEM );
+ assert( rc==SQLITE_OK || rc==SQLITE_NOMEM );
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is a no-op if the pager is in exclusive mode and not
+** in the ERROR state. Otherwise, it switches the pager to PAGER_OPEN
+** state.
+**
+** If the pager is not in exclusive-access mode, the database file is
+** completely unlocked. If the file is unlocked and the file-system does
+** not exhibit the UNDELETABLE_WHEN_OPEN property, the journal file is
+** closed (if it is open).
+**
+** If the pager is in ERROR state when this function is called, the
+** contents of the pager cache are discarded before switching back to
+** the OPEN state. Regardless of whether the pager is in exclusive-mode
+** or not, any journal file left in the file-system will be treated
+** as a hot-journal and rolled back the next time a read-transaction
+** is opened (by this or by any other connection).
+*/
+static void pager_unlock(Pager *pPager){
+
+ assert( pPager->eState==PAGER_READER
+ || pPager->eState==PAGER_OPEN
+ || pPager->eState==PAGER_ERROR
+ );
+
+ sqlite3BitvecDestroy(pPager->pInJournal);
+ pPager->pInJournal = 0;
+ releaseAllSavepoints(pPager);
+
+ if( pagerUseWal(pPager) ){
+ assert( !isOpen(pPager->jfd) );
+ sqlite3WalEndReadTransaction(pPager->pWal);
+ pPager->eState = PAGER_OPEN;
+ }else if( !pPager->exclusiveMode ){
+ int rc; /* Error code returned by pagerUnlockDb() */
+ int iDc = isOpen(pPager->fd)?sqlite3OsDeviceCharacteristics(pPager->fd):0;
+
+ /* If the operating system support deletion of open files, then
+ ** close the journal file when dropping the database lock. Otherwise
+ ** another connection with journal_mode=delete might delete the file
+ ** out from under us.
+ */
+ assert( (PAGER_JOURNALMODE_MEMORY & 5)!=1 );
+ assert( (PAGER_JOURNALMODE_OFF & 5)!=1 );
+ assert( (PAGER_JOURNALMODE_WAL & 5)!=1 );
+ assert( (PAGER_JOURNALMODE_DELETE & 5)!=1 );
+ assert( (PAGER_JOURNALMODE_TRUNCATE & 5)==1 );
+ assert( (PAGER_JOURNALMODE_PERSIST & 5)==1 );
+ if( 0==(iDc & SQLITE_IOCAP_UNDELETABLE_WHEN_OPEN)
+ || 1!=(pPager->journalMode & 5)
+ ){
+ sqlite3OsClose(pPager->jfd);
+ }
+
+ /* If the pager is in the ERROR state and the call to unlock the database
+ ** file fails, set the current lock to UNKNOWN_LOCK. See the comment
+ ** above the #define for UNKNOWN_LOCK for an explanation of why this
+ ** is necessary.
+ */
+ rc = pagerUnlockDb(pPager, NO_LOCK);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK && pPager->eState==PAGER_ERROR ){
+ pPager->eLock = UNKNOWN_LOCK;
+ }
+
+ /* The pager state may be changed from PAGER_ERROR to PAGER_OPEN here
+ ** without clearing the error code. This is intentional - the error
+ ** code is cleared and the cache reset in the block below.
+ */
+ assert( pPager->errCode || pPager->eState!=PAGER_ERROR );
+ pPager->eState = PAGER_OPEN;
+ }
+
+ /* If Pager.errCode is set, the contents of the pager cache cannot be
+ ** trusted. Now that there are no outstanding references to the pager,
+ ** it can safely move back to PAGER_OPEN state. This happens in both
+ ** normal and exclusive-locking mode.
+ */
+ assert( pPager->errCode==SQLITE_OK || !MEMDB );
+ if( pPager->errCode ){
+ if( pPager->tempFile==0 ){
+ pager_reset(pPager);
+ pPager->changeCountDone = 0;
+ pPager->eState = PAGER_OPEN;
+ }else{
+ pPager->eState = (isOpen(pPager->jfd) ? PAGER_OPEN : PAGER_READER);
+ }
+ if( USEFETCH(pPager) ) sqlite3OsUnfetch(pPager->fd, 0, 0);
+ pPager->errCode = SQLITE_OK;
+ setGetterMethod(pPager);
+ }
+
+ pPager->journalOff = 0;
+ pPager->journalHdr = 0;
+ pPager->setSuper = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is called whenever an IOERR or FULL error that requires
+** the pager to transition into the ERROR state may ahve occurred.
+** The first argument is a pointer to the pager structure, the second
+** the error-code about to be returned by a pager API function. The
+** value returned is a copy of the second argument to this function.
+**
+** If the second argument is SQLITE_FULL, SQLITE_IOERR or one of the
+** IOERR sub-codes, the pager enters the ERROR state and the error code
+** is stored in Pager.errCode. While the pager remains in the ERROR state,
+** all major API calls on the Pager will immediately return Pager.errCode.
+**
+** The ERROR state indicates that the contents of the pager-cache
+** cannot be trusted. This state can be cleared by completely discarding
+** the contents of the pager-cache. If a transaction was active when
+** the persistent error occurred, then the rollback journal may need
+** to be replayed to restore the contents of the database file (as if
+** it were a hot-journal).
+*/
+static int pager_error(Pager *pPager, int rc){
+ int rc2 = rc & 0xff;
+ assert( rc==SQLITE_OK || !MEMDB );
+ assert(
+ pPager->errCode==SQLITE_FULL ||
+ pPager->errCode==SQLITE_OK ||
+ (pPager->errCode & 0xff)==SQLITE_IOERR
+ );
+ if( rc2==SQLITE_FULL || rc2==SQLITE_IOERR ){
+ pPager->errCode = rc;
+ pPager->eState = PAGER_ERROR;
+ setGetterMethod(pPager);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+static int pager_truncate(Pager *pPager, Pgno nPage);
+
+/*
+** The write transaction open on pPager is being committed (bCommit==1)
+** or rolled back (bCommit==0).
+**
+** Return TRUE if and only if all dirty pages should be flushed to disk.
+**
+** Rules:
+**
+** * For non-TEMP databases, always sync to disk. This is necessary
+** for transactions to be durable.
+**
+** * Sync TEMP database only on a COMMIT (not a ROLLBACK) when the backing
+** file has been created already (via a spill on pagerStress()) and
+** when the number of dirty pages in memory exceeds 25% of the total
+** cache size.
+*/
+static int pagerFlushOnCommit(Pager *pPager, int bCommit){
+ if( pPager->tempFile==0 ) return 1;
+ if( !bCommit ) return 0;
+ if( !isOpen(pPager->fd) ) return 0;
+ return (sqlite3PCachePercentDirty(pPager->pPCache)>=25);
+}
+
+/*
+** This routine ends a transaction. A transaction is usually ended by
+** either a COMMIT or a ROLLBACK operation. This routine may be called
+** after rollback of a hot-journal, or if an error occurs while opening
+** the journal file or writing the very first journal-header of a
+** database transaction.
+**
+** This routine is never called in PAGER_ERROR state. If it is called
+** in PAGER_NONE or PAGER_SHARED state and the lock held is less
+** exclusive than a RESERVED lock, it is a no-op.
+**
+** Otherwise, any active savepoints are released.
+**
+** If the journal file is open, then it is "finalized". Once a journal
+** file has been finalized it is not possible to use it to roll back a
+** transaction. Nor will it be considered to be a hot-journal by this
+** or any other database connection. Exactly how a journal is finalized
+** depends on whether or not the pager is running in exclusive mode and
+** the current journal-mode (Pager.journalMode value), as follows:
+**
+** journalMode==MEMORY
+** Journal file descriptor is simply closed. This destroys an
+** in-memory journal.
+**
+** journalMode==TRUNCATE
+** Journal file is truncated to zero bytes in size.
+**
+** journalMode==PERSIST
+** The first 28 bytes of the journal file are zeroed. This invalidates
+** the first journal header in the file, and hence the entire journal
+** file. An invalid journal file cannot be rolled back.
+**
+** journalMode==DELETE
+** The journal file is closed and deleted using sqlite3OsDelete().
+**
+** If the pager is running in exclusive mode, this method of finalizing
+** the journal file is never used. Instead, if the journalMode is
+** DELETE and the pager is in exclusive mode, the method described under
+** journalMode==PERSIST is used instead.
+**
+** After the journal is finalized, the pager moves to PAGER_READER state.
+** If running in non-exclusive rollback mode, the lock on the file is
+** downgraded to a SHARED_LOCK.
+**
+** SQLITE_OK is returned if no error occurs. If an error occurs during
+** any of the IO operations to finalize the journal file or unlock the
+** database then the IO error code is returned to the user. If the
+** operation to finalize the journal file fails, then the code still
+** tries to unlock the database file if not in exclusive mode. If the
+** unlock operation fails as well, then the first error code related
+** to the first error encountered (the journal finalization one) is
+** returned.
+*/
+static int pager_end_transaction(Pager *pPager, int hasSuper, int bCommit){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Error code from journal finalization operation */
+ int rc2 = SQLITE_OK; /* Error code from db file unlock operation */
+
+ /* Do nothing if the pager does not have an open write transaction
+ ** or at least a RESERVED lock. This function may be called when there
+ ** is no write-transaction active but a RESERVED or greater lock is
+ ** held under two circumstances:
+ **
+ ** 1. After a successful hot-journal rollback, it is called with
+ ** eState==PAGER_NONE and eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK.
+ **
+ ** 2. If a connection with locking_mode=exclusive holding an EXCLUSIVE
+ ** lock switches back to locking_mode=normal and then executes a
+ ** read-transaction, this function is called with eState==PAGER_READER
+ ** and eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK when the read-transaction is closed.
+ */
+ assert( assert_pager_state(pPager) );
+ assert( pPager->eState!=PAGER_ERROR );
+ if( pPager->eStateeLockjfd) || pPager->pInJournal==0
+ || (sqlite3OsDeviceCharacteristics(pPager->fd)&SQLITE_IOCAP_BATCH_ATOMIC)
+ );
+ if( isOpen(pPager->jfd) ){
+ assert( !pagerUseWal(pPager) );
+
+ /* Finalize the journal file. */
+ if( sqlite3JournalIsInMemory(pPager->jfd) ){
+ /* assert( pPager->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_MEMORY ); */
+ sqlite3OsClose(pPager->jfd);
+ }else if( pPager->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_TRUNCATE ){
+ if( pPager->journalOff==0 ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else{
+ rc = sqlite3OsTruncate(pPager->jfd, 0);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && pPager->fullSync ){
+ /* Make sure the new file size is written into the inode right away.
+ ** Otherwise the journal might resurrect following a power loss and
+ ** cause the last transaction to roll back. See
+ ** https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=1072773
+ */
+ rc = sqlite3OsSync(pPager->jfd, pPager->syncFlags);
+ }
+ }
+ pPager->journalOff = 0;
+ }else if( pPager->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_PERSIST
+ || (pPager->exclusiveMode && pPager->journalMode!=PAGER_JOURNALMODE_WAL)
+ ){
+ rc = zeroJournalHdr(pPager, hasSuper||pPager->tempFile);
+ pPager->journalOff = 0;
+ }else{
+ /* This branch may be executed with Pager.journalMode==MEMORY if
+ ** a hot-journal was just rolled back. In this case the journal
+ ** file should be closed and deleted. If this connection writes to
+ ** the database file, it will do so using an in-memory journal.
+ */
+ int bDelete = !pPager->tempFile;
+ assert( sqlite3JournalIsInMemory(pPager->jfd)==0 );
+ assert( pPager->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_DELETE
+ || pPager->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_MEMORY
+ || pPager->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_WAL
+ );
+ sqlite3OsClose(pPager->jfd);
+ if( bDelete ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsDelete(pPager->pVfs, pPager->zJournal, pPager->extraSync);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES
+ sqlite3PcacheIterateDirty(pPager->pPCache, pager_set_pagehash);
+ if( pPager->dbSize==0 && sqlite3PcacheRefCount(pPager->pPCache)>0 ){
+ PgHdr *p = sqlite3PagerLookup(pPager, 1);
+ if( p ){
+ p->pageHash = 0;
+ sqlite3PagerUnrefNotNull(p);
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+
+ sqlite3BitvecDestroy(pPager->pInJournal);
+ pPager->pInJournal = 0;
+ pPager->nRec = 0;
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ if( MEMDB || pagerFlushOnCommit(pPager, bCommit) ){
+ sqlite3PcacheCleanAll(pPager->pPCache);
+ }else{
+ sqlite3PcacheClearWritable(pPager->pPCache);
+ }
+ sqlite3PcacheTruncate(pPager->pPCache, pPager->dbSize);
+ }
+
+ if( pagerUseWal(pPager) ){
+ /* Drop the WAL write-lock, if any. Also, if the connection was in
+ ** locking_mode=exclusive mode but is no longer, drop the EXCLUSIVE
+ ** lock held on the database file.
+ */
+ rc2 = sqlite3WalEndWriteTransaction(pPager->pWal);
+ assert( rc2==SQLITE_OK );
+ }else if( rc==SQLITE_OK && bCommit && pPager->dbFileSize>pPager->dbSize ){
+ /* This branch is taken when committing a transaction in rollback-journal
+ ** mode if the database file on disk is larger than the database image.
+ ** At this point the journal has been finalized and the transaction
+ ** successfully committed, but the EXCLUSIVE lock is still held on the
+ ** file. So it is safe to truncate the database file to its minimum
+ ** required size. */
+ assert( pPager->eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK );
+ rc = pager_truncate(pPager, pPager->dbSize);
+ }
+
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && bCommit ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsFileControl(pPager->fd, SQLITE_FCNTL_COMMIT_PHASETWO, 0);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_NOTFOUND ) rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+
+ if( !pPager->exclusiveMode
+ && (!pagerUseWal(pPager) || sqlite3WalExclusiveMode(pPager->pWal, 0))
+ ){
+ rc2 = pagerUnlockDb(pPager, SHARED_LOCK);
+ }
+ pPager->eState = PAGER_READER;
+ pPager->setSuper = 0;
+
+ return (rc==SQLITE_OK?rc2:rc);
+}
+
+/*
+** Execute a rollback if a transaction is active and unlock the
+** database file.
+**
+** If the pager has already entered the ERROR state, do not attempt
+** the rollback at this time. Instead, pager_unlock() is called. The
+** call to pager_unlock() will discard all in-memory pages, unlock
+** the database file and move the pager back to OPEN state. If this
+** means that there is a hot-journal left in the file-system, the next
+** connection to obtain a shared lock on the pager (which may be this one)
+** will roll it back.
+**
+** If the pager has not already entered the ERROR state, but an IO or
+** malloc error occurs during a rollback, then this will itself cause
+** the pager to enter the ERROR state. Which will be cleared by the
+** call to pager_unlock(), as described above.
+*/
+static void pagerUnlockAndRollback(Pager *pPager){
+ if( pPager->eState!=PAGER_ERROR && pPager->eState!=PAGER_OPEN ){
+ assert( assert_pager_state(pPager) );
+ if( pPager->eState>=PAGER_WRITER_LOCKED ){
+ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc();
+ sqlite3PagerRollback(pPager);
+ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc();
+ }else if( !pPager->exclusiveMode ){
+ assert( pPager->eState==PAGER_READER );
+ pager_end_transaction(pPager, 0, 0);
+ }
+ }
+ pager_unlock(pPager);
+}
+
+/*
+** Parameter aData must point to a buffer of pPager->pageSize bytes
+** of data. Compute and return a checksum based ont the contents of the
+** page of data and the current value of pPager->cksumInit.
+**
+** This is not a real checksum. It is really just the sum of the
+** random initial value (pPager->cksumInit) and every 200th byte
+** of the page data, starting with byte offset (pPager->pageSize%200).
+** Each byte is interpreted as an 8-bit unsigned integer.
+**
+** Changing the formula used to compute this checksum results in an
+** incompatible journal file format.
+**
+** If journal corruption occurs due to a power failure, the most likely
+** scenario is that one end or the other of the record will be changed.
+** It is much less likely that the two ends of the journal record will be
+** correct and the middle be corrupt. Thus, this "checksum" scheme,
+** though fast and simple, catches the mostly likely kind of corruption.
+*/
+static u32 pager_cksum(Pager *pPager, const u8 *aData){
+ u32 cksum = pPager->cksumInit; /* Checksum value to return */
+ int i = pPager->pageSize-200; /* Loop counter */
+ while( i>0 ){
+ cksum += aData[i];
+ i -= 200;
+ }
+ return cksum;
+}
+
+/*
+** Read a single page from either the journal file (if isMainJrnl==1) or
+** from the sub-journal (if isMainJrnl==0) and playback that page.
+** The page begins at offset *pOffset into the file. The *pOffset
+** value is increased to the start of the next page in the journal.
+**
+** The main rollback journal uses checksums - the statement journal does
+** not.
+**
+** If the page number of the page record read from the (sub-)journal file
+** is greater than the current value of Pager.dbSize, then playback is
+** skipped and SQLITE_OK is returned.
+**
+** If pDone is not NULL, then it is a record of pages that have already
+** been played back. If the page at *pOffset has already been played back
+** (if the corresponding pDone bit is set) then skip the playback.
+** Make sure the pDone bit corresponding to the *pOffset page is set
+** prior to returning.
+**
+** If the page record is successfully read from the (sub-)journal file
+** and played back, then SQLITE_OK is returned. If an IO error occurs
+** while reading the record from the (sub-)journal file or while writing
+** to the database file, then the IO error code is returned. If data
+** is successfully read from the (sub-)journal file but appears to be
+** corrupted, SQLITE_DONE is returned. Data is considered corrupted in
+** two circumstances:
+**
+** * If the record page-number is illegal (0 or PAGER_MJ_PGNO), or
+** * If the record is being rolled back from the main journal file
+** and the checksum field does not match the record content.
+**
+** Neither of these two scenarios are possible during a savepoint rollback.
+**
+** If this is a savepoint rollback, then memory may have to be dynamically
+** allocated by this function. If this is the case and an allocation fails,
+** SQLITE_NOMEM is returned.
+*/
+static int pager_playback_one_page(
+ Pager *pPager, /* The pager being played back */
+ i64 *pOffset, /* Offset of record to playback */
+ Bitvec *pDone, /* Bitvec of pages already played back */
+ int isMainJrnl, /* 1 -> main journal. 0 -> sub-journal. */
+ int isSavepnt /* True for a savepoint rollback */
+){
+ int rc;
+ PgHdr *pPg; /* An existing page in the cache */
+ Pgno pgno; /* The page number of a page in journal */
+ u32 cksum; /* Checksum used for sanity checking */
+ char *aData; /* Temporary storage for the page */
+ sqlite3_file *jfd; /* The file descriptor for the journal file */
+ int isSynced; /* True if journal page is synced */
+
+ assert( (isMainJrnl&~1)==0 ); /* isMainJrnl is 0 or 1 */
+ assert( (isSavepnt&~1)==0 ); /* isSavepnt is 0 or 1 */
+ assert( isMainJrnl || pDone ); /* pDone always used on sub-journals */
+ assert( isSavepnt || pDone==0 ); /* pDone never used on non-savepoint */
+
+ aData = pPager->pTmpSpace;
+ assert( aData ); /* Temp storage must have already been allocated */
+ assert( pagerUseWal(pPager)==0 || (!isMainJrnl && isSavepnt) );
+
+ /* Either the state is greater than PAGER_WRITER_CACHEMOD (a transaction
+ ** or savepoint rollback done at the request of the caller) or this is
+ ** a hot-journal rollback. If it is a hot-journal rollback, the pager
+ ** is in state OPEN and holds an EXCLUSIVE lock. Hot-journal rollback
+ ** only reads from the main journal, not the sub-journal.
+ */
+ assert( pPager->eState>=PAGER_WRITER_CACHEMOD
+ || (pPager->eState==PAGER_OPEN && pPager->eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK)
+ );
+ assert( pPager->eState>=PAGER_WRITER_CACHEMOD || isMainJrnl );
+
+ /* Read the page number and page data from the journal or sub-journal
+ ** file. Return an error code to the caller if an IO error occurs.
+ */
+ jfd = isMainJrnl ? pPager->jfd : pPager->sjfd;
+ rc = read32bits(jfd, *pOffset, &pgno);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) return rc;
+ rc = sqlite3OsRead(jfd, (u8*)aData, pPager->pageSize, (*pOffset)+4);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) return rc;
+ *pOffset += pPager->pageSize + 4 + isMainJrnl*4;
+
+ /* Sanity checking on the page. This is more important that I originally
+ ** thought. If a power failure occurs while the journal is being written,
+ ** it could cause invalid data to be written into the journal. We need to
+ ** detect this invalid data (with high probability) and ignore it.
+ */
+ if( pgno==0 || pgno==PAGER_MJ_PGNO(pPager) ){
+ assert( !isSavepnt );
+ return SQLITE_DONE;
+ }
+ if( pgno>(Pgno)pPager->dbSize || sqlite3BitvecTest(pDone, pgno) ){
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ if( isMainJrnl ){
+ rc = read32bits(jfd, (*pOffset)-4, &cksum);
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+ if( !isSavepnt && pager_cksum(pPager, (u8*)aData)!=cksum ){
+ return SQLITE_DONE;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If this page has already been played back before during the current
+ ** rollback, then don't bother to play it back again.
+ */
+ if( pDone && (rc = sqlite3BitvecSet(pDone, pgno))!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ return rc;
+ }
+
+ /* When playing back page 1, restore the nReserve setting
+ */
+ if( pgno==1 && pPager->nReserve!=((u8*)aData)[20] ){
+ pPager->nReserve = ((u8*)aData)[20];
+ }
+
+ /* If the pager is in CACHEMOD state, then there must be a copy of this
+ ** page in the pager cache. In this case just update the pager cache,
+ ** not the database file. The page is left marked dirty in this case.
+ **
+ ** An exception to the above rule: If the database is in no-sync mode
+ ** and a page is moved during an incremental vacuum then the page may
+ ** not be in the pager cache. Later: if a malloc() or IO error occurs
+ ** during a Movepage() call, then the page may not be in the cache
+ ** either. So the condition described in the above paragraph is not
+ ** assert()able.
+ **
+ ** If in WRITER_DBMOD, WRITER_FINISHED or OPEN state, then we update the
+ ** pager cache if it exists and the main file. The page is then marked
+ ** not dirty. Since this code is only executed in PAGER_OPEN state for
+ ** a hot-journal rollback, it is guaranteed that the page-cache is empty
+ ** if the pager is in OPEN state.
+ **
+ ** Ticket #1171: The statement journal might contain page content that is
+ ** different from the page content at the start of the transaction.
+ ** This occurs when a page is changed prior to the start of a statement
+ ** then changed again within the statement. When rolling back such a
+ ** statement we must not write to the original database unless we know
+ ** for certain that original page contents are synced into the main rollback
+ ** journal. Otherwise, a power loss might leave modified data in the
+ ** database file without an entry in the rollback journal that can
+ ** restore the database to its original form. Two conditions must be
+ ** met before writing to the database files. (1) the database must be
+ ** locked. (2) we know that the original page content is fully synced
+ ** in the main journal either because the page is not in cache or else
+ ** the page is marked as needSync==0.
+ **
+ ** 2008-04-14: When attempting to vacuum a corrupt database file, it
+ ** is possible to fail a statement on a database that does not yet exist.
+ ** Do not attempt to write if database file has never been opened.
+ */
+ if( pagerUseWal(pPager) ){
+ pPg = 0;
+ }else{
+ pPg = sqlite3PagerLookup(pPager, pgno);
+ }
+ assert( pPg || !MEMDB );
+ assert( pPager->eState!=PAGER_OPEN || pPg==0 || pPager->tempFile );
+ PAGERTRACE(("PLAYBACK %d page %d hash(%08x) %s\n",
+ PAGERID(pPager), pgno, pager_datahash(pPager->pageSize, (u8*)aData),
+ (isMainJrnl?"main-journal":"sub-journal")
+ ));
+ if( isMainJrnl ){
+ isSynced = pPager->noSync || (*pOffset <= pPager->journalHdr);
+ }else{
+ isSynced = (pPg==0 || 0==(pPg->flags & PGHDR_NEED_SYNC));
+ }
+ if( isOpen(pPager->fd)
+ && (pPager->eState>=PAGER_WRITER_DBMOD || pPager->eState==PAGER_OPEN)
+ && isSynced
+ ){
+ i64 ofst = (pgno-1)*(i64)pPager->pageSize;
+ testcase( !isSavepnt && pPg!=0 && (pPg->flags&PGHDR_NEED_SYNC)!=0 );
+ assert( !pagerUseWal(pPager) );
+
+ /* Write the data read from the journal back into the database file.
+ ** This is usually safe even for an encrypted database - as the data
+ ** was encrypted before it was written to the journal file. The exception
+ ** is if the data was just read from an in-memory sub-journal. In that
+ ** case it must be encrypted here before it is copied into the database
+ ** file. */
+ rc = sqlite3OsWrite(pPager->fd, (u8 *)aData, pPager->pageSize, ofst);
+
+ if( pgno>pPager->dbFileSize ){
+ pPager->dbFileSize = pgno;
+ }
+ if( pPager->pBackup ){
+ sqlite3BackupUpdate(pPager->pBackup, pgno, (u8*)aData);
+ }
+ }else if( !isMainJrnl && pPg==0 ){
+ /* If this is a rollback of a savepoint and data was not written to
+ ** the database and the page is not in-memory, there is a potential
+ ** problem. When the page is next fetched by the b-tree layer, it
+ ** will be read from the database file, which may or may not be
+ ** current.
+ **
+ ** There are a couple of different ways this can happen. All are quite
+ ** obscure. When running in synchronous mode, this can only happen
+ ** if the page is on the free-list at the start of the transaction, then
+ ** populated, then moved using sqlite3PagerMovepage().
+ **
+ ** The solution is to add an in-memory page to the cache containing
+ ** the data just read from the sub-journal. Mark the page as dirty
+ ** and if the pager requires a journal-sync, then mark the page as
+ ** requiring a journal-sync before it is written.
+ */
+ assert( isSavepnt );
+ assert( (pPager->doNotSpill & SPILLFLAG_ROLLBACK)==0 );
+ pPager->doNotSpill |= SPILLFLAG_ROLLBACK;
+ rc = sqlite3PagerGet(pPager, pgno, &pPg, 1);
+ assert( (pPager->doNotSpill & SPILLFLAG_ROLLBACK)!=0 );
+ pPager->doNotSpill &= ~SPILLFLAG_ROLLBACK;
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) return rc;
+ sqlite3PcacheMakeDirty(pPg);
+ }
+ if( pPg ){
+ /* No page should ever be explicitly rolled back that is in use, except
+ ** for page 1 which is held in use in order to keep the lock on the
+ ** database active. However such a page may be rolled back as a result
+ ** of an internal error resulting in an automatic call to
+ ** sqlite3PagerRollback().
+ */
+ void *pData;
+ pData = pPg->pData;
+ memcpy(pData, (u8*)aData, pPager->pageSize);
+ pPager->xReiniter(pPg);
+ /* It used to be that sqlite3PcacheMakeClean(pPg) was called here. But
+ ** that call was dangerous and had no detectable benefit since the cache
+ ** is normally cleaned by sqlite3PcacheCleanAll() after rollback and so
+ ** has been removed. */
+ pager_set_pagehash(pPg);
+
+ /* If this was page 1, then restore the value of Pager.dbFileVers.
+ ** Do this before any decoding. */
+ if( pgno==1 ){
+ memcpy(&pPager->dbFileVers, &((u8*)pData)[24],sizeof(pPager->dbFileVers));
+ }
+ sqlite3PcacheRelease(pPg);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Parameter zSuper is the name of a super-journal file. A single journal
+** file that referred to the super-journal file has just been rolled back.
+** This routine checks if it is possible to delete the super-journal file,
+** and does so if it is.
+**
+** Argument zSuper may point to Pager.pTmpSpace. So that buffer is not
+** available for use within this function.
+**
+** When a super-journal file is created, it is populated with the names
+** of all of its child journals, one after another, formatted as utf-8
+** encoded text. The end of each child journal file is marked with a
+** nul-terminator byte (0x00). i.e. the entire contents of a super-journal
+** file for a transaction involving two databases might be:
+**
+** "/home/bill/a.db-journal\x00/home/bill/b.db-journal\x00"
+**
+** A super-journal file may only be deleted once all of its child
+** journals have been rolled back.
+**
+** This function reads the contents of the super-journal file into
+** memory and loops through each of the child journal names. For
+** each child journal, it checks if:
+**
+** * if the child journal exists, and if so
+** * if the child journal contains a reference to super-journal
+** file zSuper
+**
+** If a child journal can be found that matches both of the criteria
+** above, this function returns without doing anything. Otherwise, if
+** no such child journal can be found, file zSuper is deleted from
+** the file-system using sqlite3OsDelete().
+**
+** If an IO error within this function, an error code is returned. This
+** function allocates memory by calling sqlite3Malloc(). If an allocation
+** fails, SQLITE_NOMEM is returned. Otherwise, if no IO or malloc errors
+** occur, SQLITE_OK is returned.
+**
+** TODO: This function allocates a single block of memory to load
+** the entire contents of the super-journal file. This could be
+** a couple of kilobytes or so - potentially larger than the page
+** size.
+*/
+static int pager_delsuper(Pager *pPager, const char *zSuper){
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs = pPager->pVfs;
+ int rc; /* Return code */
+ sqlite3_file *pSuper; /* Malloc'd super-journal file descriptor */
+ sqlite3_file *pJournal; /* Malloc'd child-journal file descriptor */
+ char *zSuperJournal = 0; /* Contents of super-journal file */
+ i64 nSuperJournal; /* Size of super-journal file */
+ char *zJournal; /* Pointer to one journal within MJ file */
+ char *zSuperPtr; /* Space to hold super-journal filename */
+ int nSuperPtr; /* Amount of space allocated to zSuperPtr[] */
+
+ /* Allocate space for both the pJournal and pSuper file descriptors.
+ ** If successful, open the super-journal file for reading.
+ */
+ pSuper = (sqlite3_file *)sqlite3MallocZero(pVfs->szOsFile * 2);
+ if( !pSuper ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ pJournal = 0;
+ }else{
+ const int flags = (SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY|SQLITE_OPEN_SUPER_JOURNAL);
+ rc = sqlite3OsOpen(pVfs, zSuper, pSuper, flags, 0);
+ pJournal = (sqlite3_file *)(((u8 *)pSuper) + pVfs->szOsFile);
+ }
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) goto delsuper_out;
+
+ /* Load the entire super-journal file into space obtained from
+ ** sqlite3_malloc() and pointed to by zSuperJournal. Also obtain
+ ** sufficient space (in zSuperPtr) to hold the names of super-journal
+ ** files extracted from regular rollback-journals.
+ */
+ rc = sqlite3OsFileSize(pSuper, &nSuperJournal);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) goto delsuper_out;
+ nSuperPtr = pVfs->mxPathname+1;
+ zSuperJournal = sqlite3Malloc(nSuperJournal + nSuperPtr + 2);
+ if( !zSuperJournal ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ goto delsuper_out;
+ }
+ zSuperPtr = &zSuperJournal[nSuperJournal+2];
+ rc = sqlite3OsRead(pSuper, zSuperJournal, (int)nSuperJournal, 0);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ) goto delsuper_out;
+ zSuperJournal[nSuperJournal] = 0;
+ zSuperJournal[nSuperJournal+1] = 0;
+
+ zJournal = zSuperJournal;
+ while( (zJournal-zSuperJournal)pageSize bytes).
+** If the file on disk is currently larger than nPage pages, then use the VFS
+** xTruncate() method to truncate it.
+**
+** Or, it might be the case that the file on disk is smaller than
+** nPage pages. Some operating system implementations can get confused if
+** you try to truncate a file to some size that is larger than it
+** currently is, so detect this case and write a single zero byte to
+** the end of the new file instead.
+**
+** If successful, return SQLITE_OK. If an IO error occurs while modifying
+** the database file, return the error code to the caller.
+*/
+static int pager_truncate(Pager *pPager, Pgno nPage){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ assert( pPager->eState!=PAGER_ERROR );
+ assert( pPager->eState!=PAGER_READER );
+
+ if( isOpen(pPager->fd)
+ && (pPager->eState>=PAGER_WRITER_DBMOD || pPager->eState==PAGER_OPEN)
+ ){
+ i64 currentSize, newSize;
+ int szPage = pPager->pageSize;
+ assert( pPager->eLock==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK );
+ /* TODO: Is it safe to use Pager.dbFileSize here? */
+ rc = sqlite3OsFileSize(pPager->fd, ¤tSize);
+ newSize = szPage*(i64)nPage;
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && currentSize!=newSize ){
+ if( currentSize>newSize ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsTruncate(pPager->fd, newSize);
+ }else if( (currentSize+szPage)<=newSize ){
+ char *pTmp = pPager->pTmpSpace;
+ memset(pTmp, 0, szPage);
+ testcase( (newSize-szPage) == currentSize );
+ testcase( (newSize-szPage) > currentSize );
+ rc = sqlite3OsWrite(pPager->fd, pTmp, szPage, newSize-szPage);
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pPager->dbFileSize = nPage;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return a sanitized version of the sector-size of OS file pFile. The
+** return value is guaranteed to lie between 32 and MAX_SECTOR_SIZE.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3SectorSize(sqlite3_file *pFile){
+ int iRet = sqlite3OsSectorSize(pFile);
+ if( iRet<32 ){
+ iRet = 512;
+ }else if( iRet>MAX_SECTOR_SIZE ){
+ assert( MAX_SECTOR_SIZE>=512 );
+ iRet = MAX_SECTOR_SIZE;
+ }
+ return iRet;
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the value of the Pager.sectorSize variable for the given
+** pager based on the value returned by the xSectorSize method
+** of the open database file. The sector size will be used
+** to determine the size and alignment of journal header and
+** super-journal pointers within created journal files.
+**
+** For temporary files the effective sector size is always 512 bytes.
+**
+** Otherwise, for non-temporary files, the effective sector size is
+** the value returned by the xSectorSize() method rounded up to 32 if
+** it is less than 32, or rounded down to MAX_SECTOR_SIZE if it
+** is greater than MAX_SECTOR_SIZE.
+**
+** If the file has the SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE property, then set
+** the effective sector size to its minimum value (512). The purpose of
+** pPager->sectorSize is to define the "blast radius" of bytes that
+** might change if a crash occurs while writing to a single byte in
+** that range. But with POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE, the blast radius is zero
+** (that is what POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE means), so we minimize the sector
+** size. For backwards compatibility of the rollback journal file format,
+** we cannot reduce the effective sector size below 512.
+*/
+static void setSectorSize(Pager *pPager){
+ assert( isOpen(pPager->fd) || pPager->tempFile );
+
+ if( pPager->tempFile
+ || (sqlite3OsDeviceCharacteristics(pPager->fd) &
+ SQLITE_IOCAP_POWERSAFE_OVERWRITE)!=0
+ ){
+ /* Sector size doesn't matter for temporary files. Also, the file
+ ** may not have been opened yet, in which case the OsSectorSize()
+ ** call will segfault. */
+ pPager->sectorSize = 512;
+ }else{
+ pPager->sectorSize = sqlite3SectorSize(pPager->fd);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+** Playback the journal and thus restore the database file to
+** the state it was in before we started making changes.
+**
+** The journal file format is as follows:
+**
+** (1) 8 byte prefix. A copy of aJournalMagic[].
+** (2) 4 byte big-endian integer which is the number of valid page records
+** in the journal. If this value is 0xffffffff, then compute the
+** number of page records from the journal size.
+** (3) 4 byte big-endian integer which is the initial value for the
+** sanity checksum.
+** (4) 4 byte integer which is the number of pages to truncate the
+** database to during a rollback.
+** (5) 4 byte big-endian integer which is the sector size. The header
+** is this many bytes in size.
+** (6) 4 byte big-endian integer which is the page size.
+** (7) zero padding out to the next sector size.
+** (8) Zero or more pages instances, each as follows:
+** + 4 byte page number.
+** + pPager->pageSize bytes of data.
+** + 4 byte checksum
+**
+** When we speak of the journal header, we mean the first 7 items above.
+** Each entry in the journal is an instance of the 8th item.
+**
+** Call the value from the second bullet "nRec". nRec is the number of
+** valid page entries in the journal. In most cases, you can compute the
+** value of nRec from the size of the journal file. But if a power
+** failure occurred while the journal was being written, it could be the
+** case that the size of the journal file had already been increased but
+** the extra entries had not yet made it safely to disk. In such a case,
+** the value of nRec computed from the file size would be too large. For
+** that reason, we always use the nRec value in the header.
+**
+** If the nRec value is 0xffffffff it means that nRec should be computed
+** from the file size. This value is used when the user selects the
+** no-sync option for the journal. A power failure could lead to corruption
+** in this case. But for things like temporary table (which will be
+** deleted when the power is restored) we don't care.
+**
+** If the file opened as the journal file is not a well-formed
+** journal file then all pages up to the first corrupted page are rolled
+** back (or no pages if the journal header is corrupted). The journal file
+** is then deleted and SQLITE_OK returned, just as if no corruption had
+** been encountered.
+**
+** If an I/O or malloc() error occurs, the journal-file is not deleted
+** and an error code is returned.
+**
+** The isHot parameter indicates that we are trying to rollback a journal
+** that might be a hot journal. Or, it could be that the journal is
+** preserved because of JOURNALMODE_PERSIST or JOURNALMODE_TRUNCATE.
+** If the journal really is hot, reset the pager cache prior rolling
+** back any content. If the journal is merely persistent, no reset is
+** needed.
+*/
+static int pager_playback(Pager *pPager, int isHot){
+ sqlite3_vfs *pVfs = pPager->pVfs;
+ i64 szJ; /* Size of the journal file in bytes */
+ u32 nRec; /* Number of Records in the journal */
+ u32 u; /* Unsigned loop counter */
+ Pgno mxPg = 0; /* Size of the original file in pages */
+ int rc; /* Result code of a subroutine */
+ int res = 1; /* Value returned by sqlite3OsAccess() */
+ char *zSuper = 0; /* Name of super-journal file if any */
+ int needPagerReset; /* True to reset page prior to first page rollback */
+ int nPlayback = 0; /* Total number of pages restored from journal */
+ u32 savedPageSize = pPager->pageSize;
+
+ /* Figure out how many records are in the journal. Abort early if
+ ** the journal is empty.
+ */
+ assert( isOpen(pPager->jfd) );
+ rc = sqlite3OsFileSize(pPager->jfd, &szJ);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ goto end_playback;
+ }
+
+ /* Read the super-journal name from the journal, if it is present.
+ ** If a super-journal file name is specified, but the file is not
+ ** present on disk, then the journal is not hot and does not need to be
+ ** played back.
+ **
+ ** TODO: Technically the following is an error because it assumes that
+ ** buffer Pager.pTmpSpace is (mxPathname+1) bytes or larger. i.e. that
+ ** (pPager->pageSize >= pPager->pVfs->mxPathname+1). Using os_unix.c,
+ ** mxPathname is 512, which is the same as the minimum allowable value
+ ** for pageSize.
+ */
+ zSuper = pPager->pTmpSpace;
+ rc = readSuperJournal(pPager->jfd, zSuper, pPager->pVfs->mxPathname+1);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && zSuper[0] ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsAccess(pVfs, zSuper, SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS, &res);
+ }
+ zSuper = 0;
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK || !res ){
+ goto end_playback;
+ }
+ pPager->journalOff = 0;
+ needPagerReset = isHot;
+
+ /* This loop terminates either when a readJournalHdr() or
+ ** pager_playback_one_page() call returns SQLITE_DONE or an IO error
+ ** occurs.
+ */
+ while( 1 ){
+ /* Read the next journal header from the journal file. If there are
+ ** not enough bytes left in the journal file for a complete header, or
+ ** it is corrupted, then a process must have failed while writing it.
+ ** This indicates nothing more needs to be rolled back.
+ */
+ rc = readJournalHdr(pPager, isHot, szJ, &nRec, &mxPg);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ if( rc==SQLITE_DONE ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ goto end_playback;
+ }
+
+ /* If nRec is 0xffffffff, then this journal was created by a process
+ ** working in no-sync mode. This means that the rest of the journal
+ ** file consists of pages, there are no more journal headers. Compute
+ ** the value of nRec based on this assumption.
+ */
+ if( nRec==0xffffffff ){
+ assert( pPager->journalOff==JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager) );
+ nRec = (int)((szJ - JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager))/JOURNAL_PG_SZ(pPager));
+ }
+
+ /* If nRec is 0 and this rollback is of a transaction created by this
+ ** process and if this is the final header in the journal, then it means
+ ** that this part of the journal was being filled but has not yet been
+ ** synced to disk. Compute the number of pages based on the remaining
+ ** size of the file.
+ **
+ ** The third term of the test was added to fix ticket #2565.
+ ** When rolling back a hot journal, nRec==0 always means that the next
+ ** chunk of the journal contains zero pages to be rolled back. But
+ ** when doing a ROLLBACK and the nRec==0 chunk is the last chunk in
+ ** the journal, it means that the journal might contain additional
+ ** pages that need to be rolled back and that the number of pages
+ ** should be computed based on the journal file size.
+ */
+ if( nRec==0 && !isHot &&
+ pPager->journalHdr+JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager)==pPager->journalOff ){
+ nRec = (int)((szJ - pPager->journalOff) / JOURNAL_PG_SZ(pPager));
+ }
+
+ /* If this is the first header read from the journal, truncate the
+ ** database file back to its original size.
+ */
+ if( pPager->journalOff==JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager) ){
+ rc = pager_truncate(pPager, mxPg);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ goto end_playback;
+ }
+ pPager->dbSize = mxPg;
+ }
+
+ /* Copy original pages out of the journal and back into the
+ ** database file and/or page cache.
+ */
+ for(u=0; ujournalOff,0,1,0);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ nPlayback++;
+ }else{
+ if( rc==SQLITE_DONE ){
+ pPager->journalOff = szJ;
+ break;
+ }else if( rc==SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ ){
+ /* If the journal has been truncated, simply stop reading and
+ ** processing the journal. This might happen if the journal was
+ ** not completely written and synced prior to a crash. In that
+ ** case, the database should have never been written in the
+ ** first place so it is OK to simply abandon the rollback. */
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ goto end_playback;
+ }else{
+ /* If we are unable to rollback, quit and return the error
+ ** code. This will cause the pager to enter the error state
+ ** so that no further harm will be done. Perhaps the next
+ ** process to come along will be able to rollback the database.
+ */
+ goto end_playback;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ /*NOTREACHED*/
+ assert( 0 );
+
+end_playback:
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ rc = sqlite3PagerSetPagesize(pPager, &savedPageSize, -1);
+ }
+ /* Following a rollback, the database file should be back in its original
+ ** state prior to the start of the transaction, so invoke the
+ ** SQLITE_FCNTL_DB_UNCHANGED file-control method to disable the
+ ** assertion that the transaction counter was modified.
+ */
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ sqlite3OsFileControlHint(pPager->fd,SQLITE_FCNTL_DB_UNCHANGED,0);
+#endif
+
+ /* If this playback is happening automatically as a result of an IO or
+ ** malloc error that occurred after the change-counter was updated but
+ ** before the transaction was committed, then the change-counter
+ ** modification may just have been reverted. If this happens in exclusive
+ ** mode, then subsequent transactions performed by the connection will not
+ ** update the change-counter at all. This may lead to cache inconsistency
+ ** problems for other processes at some point in the future. So, just
+ ** in case this has happened, clear the changeCountDone flag now.
+ */
+ pPager->changeCountDone = pPager->tempFile;
+
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ zSuper = pPager->pTmpSpace;
+ rc = readSuperJournal(pPager->jfd, zSuper, pPager->pVfs->mxPathname+1);
+ testcase( rc!=SQLITE_OK );
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK
+ && (pPager->eState>=PAGER_WRITER_DBMOD || pPager->eState==PAGER_OPEN)
+ ){
+ rc = sqlite3PagerSync(pPager, 0);
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ rc = pager_end_transaction(pPager, zSuper[0]!='\0', 0);
+ testcase( rc!=SQLITE_OK );
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && zSuper[0] && res ){
+ /* If there was a super-journal and this routine will return success,
+ ** see if it is possible to delete the super-journal.
+ */
+ rc = pager_delsuper(pPager, zSuper);
+ testcase( rc!=SQLITE_OK );
+ }
+ if( isHot && nPlayback ){
+ sqlite3_log(SQLITE_NOTICE_RECOVER_ROLLBACK, "recovered %d pages from %s",
+ nPlayback, pPager->zJournal);
+ }
+
+ /* The Pager.sectorSize variable may have been updated while rolling
+ ** back a journal created by a process with a different sector size
+ ** value. Reset it to the correct value for this process.
+ */
+ setSectorSize(pPager);
+ return rc;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Read the content for page pPg out of the database file (or out of
+** the WAL if that is where the most recent copy if found) into
+** pPg->pData. A shared lock or greater must be held on the database
+** file before this function is called.
+**
+** If page 1 is read, then the value of Pager.dbFileVers[] is set to
+** the value read from the database file.
+**
+** If an IO error occurs, then the IO error is returned to the caller.
+** Otherwise, SQLITE_OK is returned.
+*/
+static int readDbPage(PgHdr *pPg){
+ Pager *pPager = pPg->pPager; /* Pager object associated with page pPg */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Return code */
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ u32 iFrame = 0; /* Frame of WAL containing pgno */
+
+ assert( pPager->eState>=PAGER_READER && !MEMDB );
+ assert( isOpen(pPager->fd) );
+
+ if( pagerUseWal(pPager) ){
+ rc = sqlite3WalFindFrame(pPager->pWal, pPg->pgno, &iFrame);
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+ }
+ if( iFrame ){
+ rc = sqlite3WalReadFrame(pPager->pWal, iFrame,pPager->pageSize,pPg->pData);
+ }else
+#endif
+ {
+ i64 iOffset = (pPg->pgno-1)*(i64)pPager->pageSize;
+ rc = sqlite3OsRead(pPager->fd, pPg->pData, pPager->pageSize, iOffset);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if( pPg->pgno==1 ){
+ if( rc ){
+ /* If the read is unsuccessful, set the dbFileVers[] to something
+ ** that will never be a valid file version. dbFileVers[] is a copy
+ ** of bytes 24..39 of the database. Bytes 28..31 should always be
+ ** zero or the size of the database in page. Bytes 32..35 and 35..39
+ ** should be page numbers which are never 0xffffffff. So filling
+ ** pPager->dbFileVers[] with all 0xff bytes should suffice.
+ **
+ ** For an encrypted database, the situation is more complex: bytes
+ ** 24..39 of the database are white noise. But the probability of
+ ** white noise equaling 16 bytes of 0xff is vanishingly small so
+ ** we should still be ok.
+ */
+ memset(pPager->dbFileVers, 0xff, sizeof(pPager->dbFileVers));
+ }else{
+ u8 *dbFileVers = &((u8*)pPg->pData)[24];
+ memcpy(&pPager->dbFileVers, dbFileVers, sizeof(pPager->dbFileVers));
+ }
+ }
+ PAGER_INCR(sqlite3_pager_readdb_count);
+ PAGER_INCR(pPager->nRead);
+ IOTRACE(("PGIN %p %d\n", pPager, pPg->pgno));
+ PAGERTRACE(("FETCH %d page %d hash(%08x)\n",
+ PAGERID(pPager), pPg->pgno, pager_pagehash(pPg)));
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Update the value of the change-counter at offsets 24 and 92 in
+** the header and the sqlite version number at offset 96.
+**
+** This is an unconditional update. See also the pager_incr_changecounter()
+** routine which only updates the change-counter if the update is actually
+** needed, as determined by the pPager->changeCountDone state variable.
+*/
+static void pager_write_changecounter(PgHdr *pPg){
+ u32 change_counter;
+
+ /* Increment the value just read and write it back to byte 24. */
+ change_counter = sqlite3Get4byte((u8*)pPg->pPager->dbFileVers)+1;
+ put32bits(((char*)pPg->pData)+24, change_counter);
+
+ /* Also store the SQLite version number in bytes 96..99 and in
+ ** bytes 92..95 store the change counter for which the version number
+ ** is valid. */
+ put32bits(((char*)pPg->pData)+92, change_counter);
+ put32bits(((char*)pPg->pData)+96, SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER);
+}
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+/*
+** This function is invoked once for each page that has already been
+** written into the log file when a WAL transaction is rolled back.
+** Parameter iPg is the page number of said page. The pCtx argument
+** is actually a pointer to the Pager structure.
+**
+** If page iPg is present in the cache, and has no outstanding references,
+** it is discarded. Otherwise, if there are one or more outstanding
+** references, the page content is reloaded from the database. If the
+** attempt to reload content from the database is required and fails,
+** return an SQLite error code. Otherwise, SQLITE_OK.
+*/
+static int pagerUndoCallback(void *pCtx, Pgno iPg){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ Pager *pPager = (Pager *)pCtx;
+ PgHdr *pPg;
+
+ assert( pagerUseWal(pPager) );
+ pPg = sqlite3PagerLookup(pPager, iPg);
+ if( pPg ){
+ if( sqlite3PcachePageRefcount(pPg)==1 ){
+ sqlite3PcacheDrop(pPg);
+ }else{
+ rc = readDbPage(pPg);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pPager->xReiniter(pPg);
+ }
+ sqlite3PagerUnrefNotNull(pPg);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Normally, if a transaction is rolled back, any backup processes are
+ ** updated as data is copied out of the rollback journal and into the
+ ** database. This is not generally possible with a WAL database, as
+ ** rollback involves simply truncating the log file. Therefore, if one
+ ** or more frames have already been written to the log (and therefore
+ ** also copied into the backup databases) as part of this transaction,
+ ** the backups must be restarted.
+ */
+ sqlite3BackupRestart(pPager->pBackup);
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is called to rollback a transaction on a WAL database.
+*/
+static int pagerRollbackWal(Pager *pPager){
+ int rc; /* Return Code */
+ PgHdr *pList; /* List of dirty pages to revert */
+
+ /* For all pages in the cache that are currently dirty or have already
+ ** been written (but not committed) to the log file, do one of the
+ ** following:
+ **
+ ** + Discard the cached page (if refcount==0), or
+ ** + Reload page content from the database (if refcount>0).
+ */
+ pPager->dbSize = pPager->dbOrigSize;
+ rc = sqlite3WalUndo(pPager->pWal, pagerUndoCallback, (void *)pPager);
+ pList = sqlite3PcacheDirtyList(pPager->pPCache);
+ while( pList && rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ PgHdr *pNext = pList->pDirty;
+ rc = pagerUndoCallback((void *)pPager, pList->pgno);
+ pList = pNext;
+ }
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function is a wrapper around sqlite3WalFrames(). As well as logging
+** the contents of the list of pages headed by pList (connected by pDirty),
+** this function notifies any active backup processes that the pages have
+** changed.
+**
+** The list of pages passed into this routine is always sorted by page number.
+** Hence, if page 1 appears anywhere on the list, it will be the first page.
+*/
+static int pagerWalFrames(
+ Pager *pPager, /* Pager object */
+ PgHdr *pList, /* List of frames to log */
+ Pgno nTruncate, /* Database size after this commit */
+ int isCommit /* True if this is a commit */
+){
+ int rc; /* Return code */
+ int nList; /* Number of pages in pList */
+ PgHdr *p; /* For looping over pages */
+
+ assert( pPager->pWal );
+ assert( pList );
+#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG
+ /* Verify that the page list is in accending order */
+ for(p=pList; p && p->pDirty; p=p->pDirty){
+ assert( p->pgno < p->pDirty->pgno );
+ }
+#endif
+
+ assert( pList->pDirty==0 || isCommit );
+ if( isCommit ){
+ /* If a WAL transaction is being committed, there is no point in writing
+ ** any pages with page numbers greater than nTruncate into the WAL file.
+ ** They will never be read by any client. So remove them from the pDirty
+ ** list here. */
+ PgHdr **ppNext = &pList;
+ nList = 0;
+ for(p=pList; (*ppNext = p)!=0; p=p->pDirty){
+ if( p->pgno<=nTruncate ){
+ ppNext = &p->pDirty;
+ nList++;
+ }
+ }
+ assert( pList );
+ }else{
+ nList = 1;
+ }
+ pPager->aStat[PAGER_STAT_WRITE] += nList;
+
+ if( pList->pgno==1 ) pager_write_changecounter(pList);
+ rc = sqlite3WalFrames(pPager->pWal,
+ pPager->pageSize, pList, nTruncate, isCommit, pPager->walSyncFlags
+ );
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK && pPager->pBackup ){
+ for(p=pList; p; p=p->pDirty){
+ sqlite3BackupUpdate(pPager->pBackup, p->pgno, (u8 *)p->pData);
+ }
+ }
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_CHECK_PAGES
+ pList = sqlite3PcacheDirtyList(pPager->pPCache);
+ for(p=pList; p; p=p->pDirty){
+ pager_set_pagehash(p);
+ }
+#endif
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Begin a read transaction on the WAL.
+**
+** This routine used to be called "pagerOpenSnapshot()" because it essentially
+** makes a snapshot of the database at the current point in time and preserves
+** that snapshot for use by the reader in spite of concurrently changes by
+** other writers or checkpointers.
+*/
+static int pagerBeginReadTransaction(Pager *pPager){
+ int rc; /* Return code */
+ int changed = 0; /* True if cache must be reset */
+
+ assert( pagerUseWal(pPager) );
+ assert( pPager->eState==PAGER_OPEN || pPager->eState==PAGER_READER );
+
+ /* sqlite3WalEndReadTransaction() was not called for the previous
+ ** transaction in locking_mode=EXCLUSIVE. So call it now. If we
+ ** are in locking_mode=NORMAL and EndRead() was previously called,
+ ** the duplicate call is harmless.
+ */
+ sqlite3WalEndReadTransaction(pPager->pWal);
+
+ rc = sqlite3WalBeginReadTransaction(pPager->pWal, &changed);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK || changed ){
+ pager_reset(pPager);
+ if( USEFETCH(pPager) ) sqlite3OsUnfetch(pPager->fd, 0, 0);
+ }
+
+ return rc;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** This function is called as part of the transition from PAGER_OPEN
+** to PAGER_READER state to determine the size of the database file
+** in pages (assuming the page size currently stored in Pager.pageSize).
+**
+** If no error occurs, SQLITE_OK is returned and the size of the database
+** in pages is stored in *pnPage. Otherwise, an error code (perhaps
+** SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT) is returned and *pnPage is left unmodified.
+*/
+static int pagerPagecount(Pager *pPager, Pgno *pnPage){
+ Pgno nPage; /* Value to return via *pnPage */
+
+ /* Query the WAL sub-system for the database size. The WalDbsize()
+ ** function returns zero if the WAL is not open (i.e. Pager.pWal==0), or
+ ** if the database size is not available. The database size is not
+ ** available from the WAL sub-system if the log file is empty or
+ ** contains no valid committed transactions.
+ */
+ assert( pPager->eState==PAGER_OPEN );
+ assert( pPager->eLock>=SHARED_LOCK );
+ assert( isOpen(pPager->fd) );
+ assert( pPager->tempFile==0 );
+ nPage = sqlite3WalDbsize(pPager->pWal);
+
+ /* If the number of pages in the database is not available from the
+ ** WAL sub-system, determine the page count based on the size of
+ ** the database file. If the size of the database file is not an
+ ** integer multiple of the page-size, round up the result.
+ */
+ if( nPage==0 && ALWAYS(isOpen(pPager->fd)) ){
+ i64 n = 0; /* Size of db file in bytes */
+ int rc = sqlite3OsFileSize(pPager->fd, &n);
+ if( rc!=SQLITE_OK ){
+ return rc;
+ }
+ nPage = (Pgno)((n+pPager->pageSize-1) / pPager->pageSize);
+ }
+
+ /* If the current number of pages in the file is greater than the
+ ** configured maximum pager number, increase the allowed limit so
+ ** that the file can be read.
+ */
+ if( nPage>pPager->mxPgno ){
+ pPager->mxPgno = (Pgno)nPage;
+ }
+
+ *pnPage = nPage;
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+/*
+** Check if the *-wal file that corresponds to the database opened by pPager
+** exists if the database is not empy, or verify that the *-wal file does
+** not exist (by deleting it) if the database file is empty.
+**
+** If the database is not empty and the *-wal file exists, open the pager
+** in WAL mode. If the database is empty or if no *-wal file exists and
+** if no error occurs, make sure Pager.journalMode is not set to
+** PAGER_JOURNALMODE_WAL.
+**
+** Return SQLITE_OK or an error code.
+**
+** The caller must hold a SHARED lock on the database file to call this
+** function. Because an EXCLUSIVE lock on the db file is required to delete
+** a WAL on a none-empty database, this ensures there is no race condition
+** between the xAccess() below and an xDelete() being executed by some
+** other connection.
+*/
+static int pagerOpenWalIfPresent(Pager *pPager){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ assert( pPager->eState==PAGER_OPEN );
+ assert( pPager->eLock>=SHARED_LOCK );
+
+ if( !pPager->tempFile ){
+ int isWal; /* True if WAL file exists */
+ rc = sqlite3OsAccess(
+ pPager->pVfs, pPager->zWal, SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS, &isWal
+ );
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ if( isWal ){
+ Pgno nPage; /* Size of the database file */
+
+ rc = pagerPagecount(pPager, &nPage);
+ if( rc ) return rc;
+ if( nPage==0 ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsDelete(pPager->pVfs, pPager->zWal, 0);
+ }else{
+ testcase( sqlite3PcachePagecount(pPager->pPCache)==0 );
+ rc = sqlite3PagerOpenWal(pPager, 0);
+ }
+ }else if( pPager->journalMode==PAGER_JOURNALMODE_WAL ){
+ pPager->journalMode = PAGER_JOURNALMODE_DELETE;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Playback savepoint pSavepoint. Or, if pSavepoint==NULL, then playback
+** the entire super-journal file. The case pSavepoint==NULL occurs when
+** a ROLLBACK TO command is invoked on a SAVEPOINT that is a transaction
+** savepoint.
+**
+** When pSavepoint is not NULL (meaning a non-transaction savepoint is
+** being rolled back), then the rollback consists of up to three stages,
+** performed in the order specified:
+**
+** * Pages are played back from the main journal starting at byte
+** offset PagerSavepoint.iOffset and continuing to
+** PagerSavepoint.iHdrOffset, or to the end of the main journal
+** file if PagerSavepoint.iHdrOffset is zero.
+**
+** * If PagerSavepoint.iHdrOffset is not zero, then pages are played
+** back starting from the journal header immediately following
+** PagerSavepoint.iHdrOffset to the end of the main journal file.
+**
+** * Pages are then played back from the sub-journal file, starting
+** with the PagerSavepoint.iSubRec and continuing to the end of
+** the journal file.
+**
+** Throughout the rollback process, each time a page is rolled back, the
+** corresponding bit is set in a bitvec structure (variable pDone in the
+** implementation below). This is used to ensure that a page is only
+** rolled back the first time it is encountered in either journal.
+**
+** If pSavepoint is NULL, then pages are only played back from the main
+** journal file. There is no need for a bitvec in this case.
+**
+** In either case, before playback commences the Pager.dbSize variable
+** is reset to the value that it held at the start of the savepoint
+** (or transaction). No page with a page-number greater than this value
+** is played back. If one is encountered it is simply skipped.
+*/
+static int pagerPlaybackSavepoint(Pager *pPager, PagerSavepoint *pSavepoint){
+ i64 szJ; /* Effective size of the main journal */
+ i64 iHdrOff; /* End of first segment of main-journal records */
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK; /* Return code */
+ Bitvec *pDone = 0; /* Bitvec to ensure pages played back only once */
+
+ assert( pPager->eState!=PAGER_ERROR );
+ assert( pPager->eState>=PAGER_WRITER_LOCKED );
+
+ /* Allocate a bitvec to use to store the set of pages rolled back */
+ if( pSavepoint ){
+ pDone = sqlite3BitvecCreate(pSavepoint->nOrig);
+ if( !pDone ){
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Set the database size back to the value it was before the savepoint
+ ** being reverted was opened.
+ */
+ pPager->dbSize = pSavepoint ? pSavepoint->nOrig : pPager->dbOrigSize;
+ pPager->changeCountDone = pPager->tempFile;
+
+ if( !pSavepoint && pagerUseWal(pPager) ){
+ return pagerRollbackWal(pPager);
+ }
+
+ /* Use pPager->journalOff as the effective size of the main rollback
+ ** journal. The actual file might be larger than this in
+ ** PAGER_JOURNALMODE_TRUNCATE or PAGER_JOURNALMODE_PERSIST. But anything
+ ** past pPager->journalOff is off-limits to us.
+ */
+ szJ = pPager->journalOff;
+ assert( pagerUseWal(pPager)==0 || szJ==0 );
+
+ /* Begin by rolling back records from the main journal starting at
+ ** PagerSavepoint.iOffset and continuing to the next journal header.
+ ** There might be records in the main journal that have a page number
+ ** greater than the current database size (pPager->dbSize) but those
+ ** will be skipped automatically. Pages are added to pDone as they
+ ** are played back.
+ */
+ if( pSavepoint && !pagerUseWal(pPager) ){
+ iHdrOff = pSavepoint->iHdrOffset ? pSavepoint->iHdrOffset : szJ;
+ pPager->journalOff = pSavepoint->iOffset;
+ while( rc==SQLITE_OK && pPager->journalOffjournalOff, pDone, 1, 1);
+ }
+ assert( rc!=SQLITE_DONE );
+ }else{
+ pPager->journalOff = 0;
+ }
+
+ /* Continue rolling back records out of the main journal starting at
+ ** the first journal header seen and continuing until the effective end
+ ** of the main journal file. Continue to skip out-of-range pages and
+ ** continue adding pages rolled back to pDone.
+ */
+ while( rc==SQLITE_OK && pPager->journalOffjournalHdr+JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager)==pPager->journalOff"
+ ** test is related to ticket #2565. See the discussion in the
+ ** pager_playback() function for additional information.
+ */
+ if( nJRec==0
+ && pPager->journalHdr+JOURNAL_HDR_SZ(pPager)==pPager->journalOff
+ ){
+ nJRec = (u32)((szJ - pPager->journalOff)/JOURNAL_PG_SZ(pPager));
+ }
+ for(ii=0; rc==SQLITE_OK && iijournalOffjournalOff, pDone, 1, 1);
+ }
+ assert( rc!=SQLITE_DONE );
+ }
+ assert( rc!=SQLITE_OK || pPager->journalOff>=szJ );
+
+ /* Finally, rollback pages from the sub-journal. Page that were
+ ** previously rolled back out of the main journal (and are hence in pDone)
+ ** will be skipped. Out-of-range pages are also skipped.
+ */
+ if( pSavepoint ){
+ u32 ii; /* Loop counter */
+ i64 offset = (i64)pSavepoint->iSubRec*(4+pPager->pageSize);
+
+ if( pagerUseWal(pPager) ){
+ rc = sqlite3WalSavepointUndo(pPager->pWal, pSavepoint->aWalData);
+ }
+ for(ii=pSavepoint->iSubRec; rc==SQLITE_OK && iinSubRec; ii++){
+ assert( offset==(i64)ii*(4+pPager->pageSize) );
+ rc = pager_playback_one_page(pPager, &offset, pDone, 0, 1);
+ }
+ assert( rc!=SQLITE_DONE );
+ }
+
+ sqlite3BitvecDestroy(pDone);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pPager->journalOff = szJ;
+ }
+
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the maximum number of in-memory pages that are allowed
+** before attempting to recycle clean and unused pages.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetCachesize(Pager *pPager, int mxPage){
+ sqlite3PcacheSetCachesize(pPager->pPCache, mxPage);
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the maximum number of in-memory pages that are allowed
+** before attempting to spill pages to journal.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSetSpillsize(Pager *pPager, int mxPage){
+ return sqlite3PcacheSetSpillsize(pPager->pPCache, mxPage);
+}
+
+/*
+** Invoke SQLITE_FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE based on the current value of szMmap.
+*/
+static void pagerFixMaplimit(Pager *pPager){
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+ sqlite3_file *fd = pPager->fd;
+ if( isOpen(fd) && fd->pMethods->iVersion>=3 ){
+ sqlite3_int64 sz;
+ sz = pPager->szMmap;
+ pPager->bUseFetch = (sz>0);
+ setGetterMethod(pPager);
+ sqlite3OsFileControlHint(pPager->fd, SQLITE_FCNTL_MMAP_SIZE, &sz);
+ }
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the maximum size of any memory mapping made of the database file.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetMmapLimit(Pager *pPager, sqlite3_int64 szMmap){
+ pPager->szMmap = szMmap;
+ pagerFixMaplimit(pPager);
+}
+
+/*
+** Free as much memory as possible from the pager.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerShrink(Pager *pPager){
+ sqlite3PcacheShrink(pPager->pPCache);
+}
+
+/*
+** Adjust settings of the pager to those specified in the pgFlags parameter.
+**
+** The "level" in pgFlags & PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_MASK sets the robustness
+** of the database to damage due to OS crashes or power failures by
+** changing the number of syncs()s when writing the journals.
+** There are four levels:
+**
+** OFF sqlite3OsSync() is never called. This is the default
+** for temporary and transient files.
+**
+** NORMAL The journal is synced once before writes begin on the
+** database. This is normally adequate protection, but
+** it is theoretically possible, though very unlikely,
+** that an inopertune power failure could leave the journal
+** in a state which would cause damage to the database
+** when it is rolled back.
+**
+** FULL The journal is synced twice before writes begin on the
+** database (with some additional information - the nRec field
+** of the journal header - being written in between the two
+** syncs). If we assume that writing a
+** single disk sector is atomic, then this mode provides
+** assurance that the journal will not be corrupted to the
+** point of causing damage to the database during rollback.
+**
+** EXTRA This is like FULL except that is also syncs the directory
+** that contains the rollback journal after the rollback
+** journal is unlinked.
+**
+** The above is for a rollback-journal mode. For WAL mode, OFF continues
+** to mean that no syncs ever occur. NORMAL means that the WAL is synced
+** prior to the start of checkpoint and that the database file is synced
+** at the conclusion of the checkpoint if the entire content of the WAL
+** was written back into the database. But no sync operations occur for
+** an ordinary commit in NORMAL mode with WAL. FULL means that the WAL
+** file is synced following each commit operation, in addition to the
+** syncs associated with NORMAL. There is no difference between FULL
+** and EXTRA for WAL mode.
+**
+** Do not confuse synchronous=FULL with SQLITE_SYNC_FULL. The
+** SQLITE_SYNC_FULL macro means to use the MacOSX-style full-fsync
+** using fcntl(F_FULLFSYNC). SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL means to do an
+** ordinary fsync() call. There is no difference between SQLITE_SYNC_FULL
+** and SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL on platforms other than MacOSX. But the
+** synchronous=FULL versus synchronous=NORMAL setting determines when
+** the xSync primitive is called and is relevant to all platforms.
+**
+** Numeric values associated with these states are OFF==1, NORMAL=2,
+** and FULL=3.
+*/
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_PAGER_PRAGMAS
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetFlags(
+ Pager *pPager, /* The pager to set safety level for */
+ unsigned pgFlags /* Various flags */
+){
+ unsigned level = pgFlags & PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_MASK;
+ if( pPager->tempFile ){
+ pPager->noSync = 1;
+ pPager->fullSync = 0;
+ pPager->extraSync = 0;
+ }else{
+ pPager->noSync = level==PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_OFF ?1:0;
+ pPager->fullSync = level>=PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_FULL ?1:0;
+ pPager->extraSync = level==PAGER_SYNCHRONOUS_EXTRA ?1:0;
+ }
+ if( pPager->noSync ){
+ pPager->syncFlags = 0;
+ }else if( pgFlags & PAGER_FULLFSYNC ){
+ pPager->syncFlags = SQLITE_SYNC_FULL;
+ }else{
+ pPager->syncFlags = SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL;
+ }
+ pPager->walSyncFlags = (pPager->syncFlags<<2);
+ if( pPager->fullSync ){
+ pPager->walSyncFlags |= pPager->syncFlags;
+ }
+ if( (pgFlags & PAGER_CKPT_FULLFSYNC) && !pPager->noSync ){
+ pPager->walSyncFlags |= (SQLITE_SYNC_FULL<<2);
+ }
+ if( pgFlags & PAGER_CACHESPILL ){
+ pPager->doNotSpill &= ~SPILLFLAG_OFF;
+ }else{
+ pPager->doNotSpill |= SPILLFLAG_OFF;
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** The following global variable is incremented whenever the library
+** attempts to open a temporary file. This information is used for
+** testing and analysis only.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_API int sqlite3_opentemp_count = 0;
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Open a temporary file.
+**
+** Write the file descriptor into *pFile. Return SQLITE_OK on success
+** or some other error code if we fail. The OS will automatically
+** delete the temporary file when it is closed.
+**
+** The flags passed to the VFS layer xOpen() call are those specified
+** by parameter vfsFlags ORed with the following:
+**
+** SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE
+** SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE
+** SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE
+** SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE
+*/
+static int pagerOpentemp(
+ Pager *pPager, /* The pager object */
+ sqlite3_file *pFile, /* Write the file descriptor here */
+ int vfsFlags /* Flags passed through to the VFS */
+){
+ int rc; /* Return code */
+
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+ sqlite3_opentemp_count++; /* Used for testing and analysis only */
+#endif
+
+ vfsFlags |= SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE | SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE |
+ SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE | SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE;
+ rc = sqlite3OsOpen(pPager->pVfs, 0, pFile, vfsFlags, 0);
+ assert( rc!=SQLITE_OK || isOpen(pFile) );
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Set the busy handler function.
+**
+** The pager invokes the busy-handler if sqlite3OsLock() returns
+** SQLITE_BUSY when trying to upgrade from no-lock to a SHARED lock,
+** or when trying to upgrade from a RESERVED lock to an EXCLUSIVE
+** lock. It does *not* invoke the busy handler when upgrading from
+** SHARED to RESERVED, or when upgrading from SHARED to EXCLUSIVE
+** (which occurs during hot-journal rollback). Summary:
+**
+** Transition | Invokes xBusyHandler
+** --------------------------------------------------------
+** NO_LOCK -> SHARED_LOCK | Yes
+** SHARED_LOCK -> RESERVED_LOCK | No
+** SHARED_LOCK -> EXCLUSIVE_LOCK | No
+** RESERVED_LOCK -> EXCLUSIVE_LOCK | Yes
+**
+** If the busy-handler callback returns non-zero, the lock is
+** retried. If it returns zero, then the SQLITE_BUSY error is
+** returned to the caller of the pager API function.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetBusyHandler(
+ Pager *pPager, /* Pager object */
+ int (*xBusyHandler)(void *), /* Pointer to busy-handler function */
+ void *pBusyHandlerArg /* Argument to pass to xBusyHandler */
+){
+ void **ap;
+ pPager->xBusyHandler = xBusyHandler;
+ pPager->pBusyHandlerArg = pBusyHandlerArg;
+ ap = (void **)&pPager->xBusyHandler;
+ assert( ((int(*)(void *))(ap[0]))==xBusyHandler );
+ assert( ap[1]==pBusyHandlerArg );
+ sqlite3OsFileControlHint(pPager->fd, SQLITE_FCNTL_BUSYHANDLER, (void *)ap);
+}
+
+/*
+** Change the page size used by the Pager object. The new page size
+** is passed in *pPageSize.
+**
+** If the pager is in the error state when this function is called, it
+** is a no-op. The value returned is the error state error code (i.e.
+** one of SQLITE_IOERR, an SQLITE_IOERR_xxx sub-code or SQLITE_FULL).
+**
+** Otherwise, if all of the following are true:
+**
+** * the new page size (value of *pPageSize) is valid (a power
+** of two between 512 and SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE, inclusive), and
+**
+** * there are no outstanding page references, and
+**
+** * the database is either not an in-memory database or it is
+** an in-memory database that currently consists of zero pages.
+**
+** then the pager object page size is set to *pPageSize.
+**
+** If the page size is changed, then this function uses sqlite3PagerMalloc()
+** to obtain a new Pager.pTmpSpace buffer. If this allocation attempt
+** fails, SQLITE_NOMEM is returned and the page size remains unchanged.
+** In all other cases, SQLITE_OK is returned.
+**
+** If the page size is not changed, either because one of the enumerated
+** conditions above is not true, the pager was in error state when this
+** function was called, or because the memory allocation attempt failed,
+** then *pPageSize is set to the old, retained page size before returning.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSetPagesize(Pager *pPager, u32 *pPageSize, int nReserve){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+
+ /* It is not possible to do a full assert_pager_state() here, as this
+ ** function may be called from within PagerOpen(), before the state
+ ** of the Pager object is internally consistent.
+ **
+ ** At one point this function returned an error if the pager was in
+ ** PAGER_ERROR state. But since PAGER_ERROR state guarantees that
+ ** there is at least one outstanding page reference, this function
+ ** is a no-op for that case anyhow.
+ */
+
+ u32 pageSize = *pPageSize;
+ assert( pageSize==0 || (pageSize>=512 && pageSize<=SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE) );
+ if( (pPager->memDb==0 || pPager->dbSize==0)
+ && sqlite3PcacheRefCount(pPager->pPCache)==0
+ && pageSize && pageSize!=(u32)pPager->pageSize
+ ){
+ char *pNew = NULL; /* New temp space */
+ i64 nByte = 0;
+
+ if( pPager->eState>PAGER_OPEN && isOpen(pPager->fd) ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsFileSize(pPager->fd, &nByte);
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ /* 8 bytes of zeroed overrun space is sufficient so that the b-tree
+ * cell header parser will never run off the end of the allocation */
+ pNew = (char *)sqlite3PageMalloc(pageSize+8);
+ if( !pNew ){
+ rc = SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }else{
+ memset(pNew+pageSize, 0, 8);
+ }
+ }
+
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ pager_reset(pPager);
+ rc = sqlite3PcacheSetPageSize(pPager->pPCache, pageSize);
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ sqlite3PageFree(pPager->pTmpSpace);
+ pPager->pTmpSpace = pNew;
+ pPager->dbSize = (Pgno)((nByte+pageSize-1)/pageSize);
+ pPager->pageSize = pageSize;
+ }else{
+ sqlite3PageFree(pNew);
+ }
+ }
+
+ *pPageSize = pPager->pageSize;
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ if( nReserve<0 ) nReserve = pPager->nReserve;
+ assert( nReserve>=0 && nReserve<1000 );
+ pPager->nReserve = (i16)nReserve;
+ pagerFixMaplimit(pPager);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Return a pointer to the "temporary page" buffer held internally
+** by the pager. This is a buffer that is big enough to hold the
+** entire content of a database page. This buffer is used internally
+** during rollback and will be overwritten whenever a rollback
+** occurs. But other modules are free to use it too, as long as
+** no rollbacks are happening.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3PagerTempSpace(Pager *pPager){
+ return pPager->pTmpSpace;
+}
+
+/*
+** Attempt to set the maximum database page count if mxPage is positive.
+** Make no changes if mxPage is zero or negative. And never reduce the
+** maximum page count below the current size of the database.
+**
+** Regardless of mxPage, return the current maximum page count.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Pgno sqlite3PagerMaxPageCount(Pager *pPager, Pgno mxPage){
+ if( mxPage>0 ){
+ pPager->mxPgno = mxPage;
+ }
+ assert( pPager->eState!=PAGER_OPEN ); /* Called only by OP_MaxPgcnt */
+ /* assert( pPager->mxPgno>=pPager->dbSize ); */
+ /* OP_MaxPgcnt ensures that the parameter passed to this function is not
+ ** less than the total number of valid pages in the database. But this
+ ** may be less than Pager.dbSize, and so the assert() above is not valid */
+ return pPager->mxPgno;
+}
+
+/*
+** The following set of routines are used to disable the simulated
+** I/O error mechanism. These routines are used to avoid simulated
+** errors in places where we do not care about errors.
+**
+** Unless -DSQLITE_TEST=1 is used, these routines are all no-ops
+** and generate no code.
+*/
+#ifdef SQLITE_TEST
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_pending;
+SQLITE_API extern int sqlite3_io_error_hit;
+static int saved_cnt;
+void disable_simulated_io_errors(void){
+ saved_cnt = sqlite3_io_error_pending;
+ sqlite3_io_error_pending = -1;
+}
+void enable_simulated_io_errors(void){
+ sqlite3_io_error_pending = saved_cnt;
+}
+#else
+# define disable_simulated_io_errors()
+# define enable_simulated_io_errors()
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Read the first N bytes from the beginning of the file into memory
+** that pDest points to.
+**
+** If the pager was opened on a transient file (zFilename==""), or
+** opened on a file less than N bytes in size, the output buffer is
+** zeroed and SQLITE_OK returned. The rationale for this is that this
+** function is used to read database headers, and a new transient or
+** zero sized database has a header than consists entirely of zeroes.
+**
+** If any IO error apart from SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ is encountered,
+** the error code is returned to the caller and the contents of the
+** output buffer undefined.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerReadFileheader(Pager *pPager, int N, unsigned char *pDest){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ memset(pDest, 0, N);
+ assert( isOpen(pPager->fd) || pPager->tempFile );
+
+ /* This routine is only called by btree immediately after creating
+ ** the Pager object. There has not been an opportunity to transition
+ ** to WAL mode yet.
+ */
+ assert( !pagerUseWal(pPager) );
+
+ if( isOpen(pPager->fd) ){
+ IOTRACE(("DBHDR %p 0 %d\n", pPager, N))
+ rc = sqlite3OsRead(pPager->fd, pDest, N, 0);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ ){
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** This function may only be called when a read-transaction is open on
+** the pager. It returns the total number of pages in the database.
+**
+** However, if the file is between 1 and bytes in size, then
+** this is considered a 1 page file.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerPagecount(Pager *pPager, int *pnPage){
+ assert( pPager->eState>=PAGER_READER );
+ assert( pPager->eState!=PAGER_WRITER_FINISHED );
+ *pnPage = (int)pPager->dbSize;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Try to obtain a lock of type locktype on the database file. If
+** a similar or greater lock is already held, this function is a no-op
+** (returning SQLITE_OK immediately).
+**
+** Otherwise, attempt to obtain the lock using sqlite3OsLock(). Invoke
+** the busy callback if the lock is currently not available. Repeat
+** until the busy callback returns false or until the attempt to
+** obtain the lock succeeds.
+**
+** Return SQLITE_OK on success and an error code if we cannot obtain
+** the lock. If the lock is obtained successfully, set the Pager.state
+** variable to locktype before returning.
+*/
+static int pager_wait_on_lock(Pager *pPager, int locktype){
+ int rc; /* Return code */
+
+ /* Check that this is either a no-op (because the requested lock is
+ ** already held), or one of the transitions that the busy-handler
+ ** may be invoked during, according to the comment above
+ ** sqlite3PagerSetBusyhandler().
+ */
+ assert( (pPager->eLock>=locktype)
+ || (pPager->eLock==NO_LOCK && locktype==SHARED_LOCK)
+ || (pPager->eLock==RESERVED_LOCK && locktype==EXCLUSIVE_LOCK)
+ );
+
+ do {
+ rc = pagerLockDb(pPager, locktype);
+ }while( rc==SQLITE_BUSY && pPager->xBusyHandler(pPager->pBusyHandlerArg) );
+ return rc;
+}
+
+/*
+** Function assertTruncateConstraint(pPager) checks that one of the
+** following is true for all dirty pages currently in the page-cache:
+**
+** a) The page number is less than or equal to the size of the
+** current database image, in pages, OR
+**
+** b) if the page content were written at this time, it would not
+** be necessary to write the current content out to the sub-journal
+** (as determined by function subjRequiresPage()).
+**
+** If the condition asserted by this function were not true, and the
+** dirty page were to be discarded from the cache via the pagerStress()
+** routine, pagerStress() would not write the current page content to
+** the database file. If a savepoint transaction were rolled back after
+** this happened, the correct behavior would be to restore the current
+** content of the page. However, since this content is not present in either
+** the database file or the portion of the rollback journal and
+** sub-journal rolled back the content could not be restored and the
+** database image would become corrupt. It is therefore fortunate that
+** this circumstance cannot arise.
+*/
+#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG)
+static void assertTruncateConstraintCb(PgHdr *pPg){
+ assert( pPg->flags&PGHDR_DIRTY );
+ assert( !subjRequiresPage(pPg) || pPg->pgno<=pPg->pPager->dbSize );
+}
+static void assertTruncateConstraint(Pager *pPager){
+ sqlite3PcacheIterateDirty(pPager->pPCache, assertTruncateConstraintCb);
+}
+#else
+# define assertTruncateConstraint(pPager)
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Truncate the in-memory database file image to nPage pages. This
+** function does not actually modify the database file on disk. It
+** just sets the internal state of the pager object so that the
+** truncation will be done when the current transaction is committed.
+**
+** This function is only called right before committing a transaction.
+** Once this function has been called, the transaction must either be
+** rolled back or committed. It is not safe to call this function and
+** then continue writing to the database.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerTruncateImage(Pager *pPager, Pgno nPage){
+ assert( pPager->dbSize>=nPage );
+ assert( pPager->eState>=PAGER_WRITER_CACHEMOD );
+ pPager->dbSize = nPage;
+
+ /* At one point the code here called assertTruncateConstraint() to
+ ** ensure that all pages being truncated away by this operation are,
+ ** if one or more savepoints are open, present in the savepoint
+ ** journal so that they can be restored if the savepoint is rolled
+ ** back. This is no longer necessary as this function is now only
+ ** called right before committing a transaction. So although the
+ ** Pager object may still have open savepoints (Pager.nSavepoint!=0),
+ ** they cannot be rolled back. So the assertTruncateConstraint() call
+ ** is no longer correct. */
+}
+
+
+/*
+** This function is called before attempting a hot-journal rollback. It
+** syncs the journal file to disk, then sets pPager->journalHdr to the
+** size of the journal file so that the pager_playback() routine knows
+** that the entire journal file has been synced.
+**
+** Syncing a hot-journal to disk before attempting to roll it back ensures
+** that if a power-failure occurs during the rollback, the process that
+** attempts rollback following system recovery sees the same journal
+** content as this process.
+**
+** If everything goes as planned, SQLITE_OK is returned. Otherwise,
+** an SQLite error code.
+*/
+static int pagerSyncHotJournal(Pager *pPager){
+ int rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ if( !pPager->noSync ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsSync(pPager->jfd, SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL);
+ }
+ if( rc==SQLITE_OK ){
+ rc = sqlite3OsFileSize(pPager->jfd, &pPager->journalHdr);
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+#if SQLITE_MAX_MMAP_SIZE>0
+/*
+** Obtain a reference to a memory mapped page object for page number pgno.
+** The new object will use the pointer pData, obtained from xFetch().
+** If successful, set *ppPage to point to the new page reference
+** and return SQLITE_OK. Otherwise, return an SQLite error code and set
+** *ppPage to zero.
+**
+** Page references obtained by calling this function should be released
+** by calling pagerReleaseMapPage().
+*/
+static int pagerAcquireMapPage(
+ Pager *pPager, /* Pager object */
+ Pgno pgno, /* Page number */
+ void *pData, /* xFetch()'d data for this page */
+ PgHdr **ppPage /* OUT: Acquired page object */
+){
+ PgHdr *p; /* Memory mapped page to return */
+
+ if( pPager->pMmapFreelist ){
+ *ppPage = p = pPager->pMmapFreelist;
+ pPager->pMmapFreelist = p->pDirty;
+ p->pDirty = 0;
+ assert( pPager->nExtra>=8 );
+ memset(p->pExtra, 0, 8);
+ }else{
+ *ppPage = p = (PgHdr *)sqlite3MallocZero(sizeof(PgHdr) + pPager->nExtra);
+ if( p==0 ){
+ sqlite3OsUnfetch(pPager->fd, (i64)(pgno-1) * pPager->pageSize, pData);
+ return SQLITE_NOMEM_BKPT;
+ }
+ p->pExtra = (void *)&p[1];
+ p->flags = PGHDR_MMAP;
+ p->nRef = 1;
+ p->pPager = pPager;
+ }
+
+ assert( p->pExtra==(void *)&p[1] );
+ assert( p->pPage==0 );
+ assert( p->flags==PGHDR_MMAP );
+ assert( p->pPager==pPager );
+ assert( p->nRef==1 );
+
+ p->pgno = pgno;
+ p->pData = pData;
+ pPager->nMmapOut++;
+
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Release a reference to page pPg. pPg must have been returned by an
+** earlier call to pagerAcquireMapPage().
+*/
+static void pagerReleaseMapPage(PgHdr *pPg){
+ Pager *pPager = pPg->pPager;
+ pPager->nMmapOut--;
+ pPg->pDirty = pPager->pMmapFreelist;
+ pPager->pMmapFreelist = pPg;
+
+ assert( pPager->fd->pMethods->iVersion>=3 );
+ sqlite3OsUnfetch(pPager->fd, (i64)(pPg->pgno-1)*pPager->pageSize, pPg->pData);
+}
+
+/*
+** Free all PgHdr objects stored in the Pager.pMmapFreelist list.
+*/
+static void pagerFreeMapHdrs(Pager *pPager){
+ PgHdr *p;
+ PgHdr *pNext;
+ for(p=pPager->pMmapFreelist; p; p=pNext){
+ pNext = p->pDirty;
+ sqlite3_free(p);
+ }
+}
+
+/* Verify that the database file has not be deleted or renamed out from
+** under the pager. Return SQLITE_OK if the database is still where it ought
+** to be on disk. Return non-zero (SQLITE_READONLY_DBMOVED or some other error
+** code from sqlite3OsAccess()) if the database has gone missing.
+*/
+static int databaseIsUnmoved(Pager *pPager){
+ int bHasMoved = 0;
+ int rc;
+
+ if( pPager->tempFile ) return SQLITE_OK;
+ if( pPager->dbSize==0 ) return SQLITE_OK;
+ assert( pPager->zFilename && pPager->zFilename[0] );
+ rc = sqlite3OsFileControl(pPager->fd, SQLITE_FCNTL_HAS_MOVED, &bHasMoved);
+ if( rc==SQLITE_NOTFOUND ){
+ /* If the HAS_MOVED file-control is unimplemented, assume that the file
+ ** has not been moved. That is the historical behavior of SQLite: prior to
+ ** version 3.8.3, it never checked */
+ rc = SQLITE_OK;
+ }else if( rc==SQLITE_OK && bHasMoved ){
+ rc = SQLITE_READONLY_DBMOVED;
+ }
+ return rc;
+}
+
+
+/*
+** Shutdown the page cache. Free all memory and close all files.
+**
+** If a transaction was in progress when this routine is called, that
+** transaction is rolled back. All outstanding pages are invalidated
+** and their memory is freed. Any attempt to use a page associated
+** with this page cache after this function returns will likely
+** result in a coredump.
+**
+** This function always succeeds. If a transaction is active an attempt
+** is made to roll it back. If an error occurs during the rollback
+** a hot journal may be left in the filesystem but no error is returned
+** to the caller.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerClose(Pager *pPager, sqlite3 *db){
+ u8 *pTmp = (u8*)pPager->pTmpSpace;
+ assert( db || pagerUseWal(pPager)==0 );
+ assert( assert_pager_state(pPager) );
+ disable_simulated_io_errors();
+ sqlite3BeginBenignMalloc();
+ pagerFreeMapHdrs(pPager);
+ /* pPager->errCode = 0; */
+ pPager->exclusiveMode = 0;
+#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_WAL
+ {
+ u8 *a = 0;
+ assert( db || pPager->pWal==0 );
+ if( db && 0==(db->flags & SQLITE_NoCkptOnClose)
+ && SQLITE_OK==databaseIsUnmoved(pPager)
+ ){
+ a = pTmp;
+ }
+ sqlite3WalClose(pPager->pWal, db, pPager->walSyncFlags, pPager->pageSize,a);
+ pPager->pWal = 0;
+ }
+#endif
+ pager_reset(pPager);
+ if( MEMDB ){
+ pager_unlock(pPager);
+ }else{
+ /* If it is open, sync the journal file before calling UnlockAndRollback.
+ ** If this is not done, then an unsynced portion of the open journal
+ ** file may be played back into the database. If a power failure occurs
+ ** while this is happening, the database could become corrupt.
+ **
+ ** If an error occurs while trying to sync the journal, shift the pager
+ ** into the ERROR state. This causes UnlockAndRollback to unlock the
+ ** database and close the journal file without attempting to roll it
+ ** back or finalize it. The next database user will have to do hot-journal
+ ** rollback before accessing the database file.
+ */
+ if( isOpen(pPager->jfd) ){
+ pager_error(pPager, pagerSyncHotJournal(pPager));
+ }
+ pagerUnlockAndRollback(pPager);
+ }
+ sqlite3EndBenignMalloc();
+ enable_simulated_io_errors();
+ PAGERTRACE(("CLOSE %d\n", PAGERID(pPager)));
+ IOTRACE(("CLOSE %p\n", pPager))
+ sqlite3OsClose(pPager->jfd);
+ sqlite3OsClose(pPager->fd);
+ sqlite3PageFree(pTmp);
+ sqlite3PcacheClose(pPager->pPCache);
+ assert( !pPager->aSavepoint && !pPager->pInJournal );
+ assert( !isOpen(pPager->jfd) && !isOpen(pPager->sjfd) );
+
+ sqlite3_free(pPager);
+ return SQLITE_OK;
+}
+
+#if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_TEST)
+/*
+** Return the page number for page pPg.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE Pgno sqlite3PagerPagenumber(DbPage *pPg){
+ return pPg->pgno;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+** Increment the reference count for page pPg.
+*/
+SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerRef(DbPage *pPg){
+ sqlite3PcacheRef(pPg);
+}
+
+/*
+** Sync the journal. In other words, make sure all the pages that have
+** been written to the journal have actually reached the surface of the
+** disk and can be restored in the event of a hot-journal rollback.
+**
+** If the Pager.noSync flag is set, then this function is a no-op.
+** Otherwise, the actions required depend on the journal-mode and the
+** device characteristics of the file-system, as follows:
+**
+** * If the journal file is an in-memory journal file, no action need
+** be taken.
+**
+** * Otherwise, if the device does not support the SAFE_APPEND property,
+** then the nRec field of the most recently written journal header
+** is updated to contain the number of journal records that have
+** been written following it. If the pager is operating in full-sync
+** mode, then the journal file is synced before this field is updated.
+**
+** * If the device does not support the SEQUENTIAL property, then
+** journal file is synced.
+**
+** Or, in pseudo-code:
+**
+** if( NOT ){
+** if( NOT SAFE_APPEND ){
+** if( ) xSync();
+**